spec: TLS certificates: avoid MD5
[exim.git] / doc / doc-docbook / spec.xfpt
1 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2 . This is the primary source of the Exim Manual. It is an xfpt document that is
3 . converted into DocBook XML for subsequent conversion into printing and online
4 . formats. The markup used herein is "standard" xfpt markup, with some extras.
5 . The markup is summarized in a file called Markup.txt.
6 .
7 . WARNING: When you use the .new macro, make sure it appears *before* any
8 . adjacent index items; otherwise you get an empty "paragraph" which causes
9 . unwanted vertical space.
10 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
11
12 .include stdflags
13 .include stdmacs
14
15 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
16 . This outputs the standard DocBook boilerplate.
17 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18
19 .docbook
20
21 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22 . These lines are processing instructions for the Simple DocBook Processor that
23 . Philip Hazel has developed as a less cumbersome way of making PostScript and
24 . PDFs than using xmlto and fop. They will be ignored by all other XML
25 . processors.
26 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27
28 .literal xml
29 <?sdop
30 foot_right_recto="&chaptertitle; (&chapternumber;)"
31 foot_right_verso="&chaptertitle; (&chapternumber;)"
32 toc_chapter_blanks="yes,yes"
33 table_warn_overflow="overprint"
34 ?>
35 .literal off
36
37 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38 . This generate the outermost <book> element that wraps then entire document.
39 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
40
41 .book
42
43 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
44 . These definitions set some parameters and save some typing.
45 . Update the Copyright year (only) when changing content.
46 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
47
48 .set previousversion "4.80"
49 .include ./local_params
50
51 .set ACL "access control lists (ACLs)"
52 .set I "&nbsp;&nbsp;&nbsp;&nbsp;"
53
54 .macro copyyear
55 2013
56 .endmacro
57
58 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
59 . Additional xfpt markup used by this document, over and above the default
60 . provided in the xfpt library.
61 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
62
63 . --- Override the &$ flag to automatically insert a $ with the variable name
64
65 .flag &$ $& "<varname>$" "</varname>"
66
67 . --- Short flags for daggers in option headings. They will always be inside
68 . --- an italic string, but we want the daggers to be roman.
69
70 .flag &!! "</emphasis>&dagger;<emphasis>"
71 .flag &!? "</emphasis>&Dagger;<emphasis>"
72
73 . --- A macro for an Exim option definition heading, generating a one-line
74 . --- table with four columns. For cases when the option name is given with
75 . --- a space, so that it can be split, a fifth argument is used for the
76 . --- index entry.
77
78 .macro option
79 .arg 5
80 .oindex "&%$5%&"
81 .endarg
82 .arg -5
83 .oindex "&%$1%&"
84 .endarg
85 .itable all 0 0 4 8* left 6* center 6* center 6* right
86 .row "&%$1%&" "Use: &'$2'&" "Type: &'$3'&" "Default: &'$4'&"
87 .endtable
88 .endmacro
89
90 . --- A macro for the common 2-column tables. The width of the first column
91 . --- is suitable for the many tables at the start of the main options chapter;
92 . --- the small number of other 2-column tables override it.
93
94 .macro table2 196pt 254pt
95 .itable none 0 0 2 $1 left $2 left
96 .endmacro
97
98 . --- A macro that generates .row, but puts &I; at the start of the first
99 . --- argument, thus indenting it. Assume a minimum of two arguments, and
100 . --- allow up to four arguments, which is as many as we'll ever need.
101
102 .macro irow
103 .arg 4
104 .row "&I;$1" "$2" "$3" "$4"
105 .endarg
106 .arg -4
107 .arg 3
108 .row "&I;$1" "$2" "$3"
109 .endarg
110 .arg -3
111 .row "&I;$1" "$2"
112 .endarg
113 .endarg
114 .endmacro
115
116 . --- Macros for option, variable, and concept index entries. For a "range"
117 . --- style of entry, use .scindex for the start and .ecindex for the end. The
118 . --- first argument of .scindex and the only argument of .ecindex must be the
119 . --- ID that ties them together.
120
121 .macro cindex
122 &<indexterm role="concept">&
123 &<primary>&$1&</primary>&
124 .arg 2
125 &<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
126 .endarg
127 &</indexterm>&
128 .endmacro
129
130 .macro scindex
131 &<indexterm role="concept" id="$1" class="startofrange">&
132 &<primary>&$2&</primary>&
133 .arg 3
134 &<secondary>&$3&</secondary>&
135 .endarg
136 &</indexterm>&
137 .endmacro
138
139 .macro ecindex
140 &<indexterm role="concept" startref="$1" class="endofrange"/>&
141 .endmacro
142
143 .macro oindex
144 &<indexterm role="option">&
145 &<primary>&$1&</primary>&
146 .arg 2
147 &<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
148 .endarg
149 &</indexterm>&
150 .endmacro
151
152 .macro vindex
153 &<indexterm role="variable">&
154 &<primary>&$1&</primary>&
155 .arg 2
156 &<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
157 .endarg
158 &</indexterm>&
159 .endmacro
160
161 .macro index
162 .echo "** Don't use .index; use .cindex or .oindex or .vindex"
163 .endmacro
164 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
165
166
167 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
168 . The <bookinfo> element is removed from the XML before processing for Ascii
169 . output formats.
170 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
171
172 .literal xml
173 <bookinfo>
174 <title>Specification of the Exim Mail Transfer Agent</title>
175 <titleabbrev>The Exim MTA</titleabbrev>
176 <date>
177 .fulldate
178 </date>
179 <author><firstname>Exim</firstname><surname>Maintainers</surname></author>
180 <authorinitials>EM</authorinitials>
181 <revhistory><revision>
182 .versiondatexml
183 <authorinitials>EM</authorinitials>
184 </revision></revhistory>
185 <copyright><year>
186 .copyyear
187 </year><holder>University of Cambridge</holder></copyright>
188 </bookinfo>
189 .literal off
190
191
192 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
193 . This chunk of literal XML implements index entries of the form "x, see y" and
194 . "x, see also y". However, the DocBook DTD doesn't allow <indexterm> entries
195 . at the top level, so we have to put the .chapter directive first.
196 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
197
198 .chapter "Introduction" "CHID1"
199 .literal xml
200
201 <indexterm role="variable">
202 <primary>$1, $2, etc.</primary>
203 <see><emphasis>numerical variables</emphasis></see>
204 </indexterm>
205 <indexterm role="concept">
206 <primary>address</primary>
207 <secondary>rewriting</secondary>
208 <see><emphasis>rewriting</emphasis></see>
209 </indexterm>
210 <indexterm role="concept">
211 <primary>Bounce Address Tag Validation</primary>
212 <see><emphasis>BATV</emphasis></see>
213 </indexterm>
214 <indexterm role="concept">
215 <primary>Client SMTP Authorization</primary>
216 <see><emphasis>CSA</emphasis></see>
217 </indexterm>
218 <indexterm role="concept">
219 <primary>CR character</primary>
220 <see><emphasis>carriage return</emphasis></see>
221 </indexterm>
222 <indexterm role="concept">
223 <primary>CRL</primary>
224 <see><emphasis>certificate revocation list</emphasis></see>
225 </indexterm>
226 <indexterm role="concept">
227 <primary>delivery</primary>
228 <secondary>failure report</secondary>
229 <see><emphasis>bounce message</emphasis></see>
230 </indexterm>
231 <indexterm role="concept">
232 <primary>dialup</primary>
233 <see><emphasis>intermittently connected hosts</emphasis></see>
234 </indexterm>
235 <indexterm role="concept">
236 <primary>exiscan</primary>
237 <see><emphasis>content scanning</emphasis></see>
238 </indexterm>
239 <indexterm role="concept">
240 <primary>failover</primary>
241 <see><emphasis>fallback</emphasis></see>
242 </indexterm>
243 <indexterm role="concept">
244 <primary>fallover</primary>
245 <see><emphasis>fallback</emphasis></see>
246 </indexterm>
247 <indexterm role="concept">
248 <primary>filter</primary>
249 <secondary>Sieve</secondary>
250 <see><emphasis>Sieve filter</emphasis></see>
251 </indexterm>
252 <indexterm role="concept">
253 <primary>ident</primary>
254 <see><emphasis>RFC 1413</emphasis></see>
255 </indexterm>
256 <indexterm role="concept">
257 <primary>LF character</primary>
258 <see><emphasis>linefeed</emphasis></see>
259 </indexterm>
260 <indexterm role="concept">
261 <primary>maximum</primary>
262 <seealso><emphasis>limit</emphasis></seealso>
263 </indexterm>
264 <indexterm role="concept">
265 <primary>monitor</primary>
266 <see><emphasis>Exim monitor</emphasis></see>
267 </indexterm>
268 <indexterm role="concept">
269 <primary>no_<emphasis>xxx</emphasis></primary>
270 <see>entry for xxx</see>
271 </indexterm>
272 <indexterm role="concept">
273 <primary>NUL</primary>
274 <see><emphasis>binary zero</emphasis></see>
275 </indexterm>
276 <indexterm role="concept">
277 <primary>passwd file</primary>
278 <see><emphasis>/etc/passwd</emphasis></see>
279 </indexterm>
280 <indexterm role="concept">
281 <primary>process id</primary>
282 <see><emphasis>pid</emphasis></see>
283 </indexterm>
284 <indexterm role="concept">
285 <primary>RBL</primary>
286 <see><emphasis>DNS list</emphasis></see>
287 </indexterm>
288 <indexterm role="concept">
289 <primary>redirection</primary>
290 <see><emphasis>address redirection</emphasis></see>
291 </indexterm>
292 <indexterm role="concept">
293 <primary>return path</primary>
294 <seealso><emphasis>envelope sender</emphasis></seealso>
295 </indexterm>
296 <indexterm role="concept">
297 <primary>scanning</primary>
298 <see><emphasis>content scanning</emphasis></see>
299 </indexterm>
300 <indexterm role="concept">
301 <primary>SSL</primary>
302 <see><emphasis>TLS</emphasis></see>
303 </indexterm>
304 <indexterm role="concept">
305 <primary>string</primary>
306 <secondary>expansion</secondary>
307 <see><emphasis>expansion</emphasis></see>
308 </indexterm>
309 <indexterm role="concept">
310 <primary>top bit</primary>
311 <see><emphasis>8-bit characters</emphasis></see>
312 </indexterm>
313 <indexterm role="concept">
314 <primary>variables</primary>
315 <see><emphasis>expansion, variables</emphasis></see>
316 </indexterm>
317 <indexterm role="concept">
318 <primary>zero, binary</primary>
319 <see><emphasis>binary zero</emphasis></see>
320 </indexterm>
321
322 .literal off
323
324
325 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
326 . This is the real start of the first chapter. See the comment above as to why
327 . we can't have the .chapter line here.
328 . chapter "Introduction"
329 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
330
331 Exim is a mail transfer agent (MTA) for hosts that are running Unix or
332 Unix-like operating systems. It was designed on the assumption that it would be
333 run on hosts that are permanently connected to the Internet. However, it can be
334 used on intermittently connected hosts with suitable configuration adjustments.
335
336 Configuration files currently exist for the following operating systems: AIX,
337 BSD/OS (aka BSDI), Darwin (Mac OS X), DGUX, Dragonfly, FreeBSD, GNU/Hurd,
338 GNU/Linux, HI-OSF (Hitachi), HI-UX, HP-UX, IRIX, MIPS RISCOS, NetBSD, OpenBSD,
339 OpenUNIX, QNX, SCO, SCO SVR4.2 (aka UNIX-SV), Solaris (aka SunOS5), SunOS4,
340 Tru64-Unix (formerly Digital UNIX, formerly DEC-OSF1), Ultrix, and Unixware.
341 Some of these operating systems are no longer current and cannot easily be
342 tested, so the configuration files may no longer work in practice.
343
344 There are also configuration files for compiling Exim in the Cygwin environment
345 that can be installed on systems running Windows. However, this document does
346 not contain any information about running Exim in the Cygwin environment.
347
348 The terms and conditions for the use and distribution of Exim are contained in
349 the file &_NOTICE_&. Exim is distributed under the terms of the GNU General
350 Public Licence, a copy of which may be found in the file &_LICENCE_&.
351
352 The use, supply or promotion of Exim for the purpose of sending bulk,
353 unsolicited electronic mail is incompatible with the basic aims of the program,
354 which revolve around the free provision of a service that enhances the quality
355 of personal communications. The author of Exim regards indiscriminate
356 mass-mailing as an antisocial, irresponsible abuse of the Internet.
357
358 Exim owes a great deal to Smail 3 and its author, Ron Karr. Without the
359 experience of running and working on the Smail 3 code, I could never have
360 contemplated starting to write a new MTA. Many of the ideas and user interfaces
361 were originally taken from Smail 3, though the actual code of Exim is entirely
362 new, and has developed far beyond the initial concept.
363
364 Many people, both in Cambridge and around the world, have contributed to the
365 development and the testing of Exim, and to porting it to various operating
366 systems. I am grateful to them all. The distribution now contains a file called
367 &_ACKNOWLEDGMENTS_&, in which I have started recording the names of
368 contributors.
369
370
371 .section "Exim documentation" "SECID1"
372 . Keep this example change bar when updating the documentation!
373
374 .new
375 .cindex "documentation"
376 This edition of the Exim specification applies to version &version() of Exim.
377 Substantive changes from the &previousversion; edition are marked in some
378 renditions of the document; this paragraph is so marked if the rendition is
379 capable of showing a change indicator.
380 .wen
381
382 This document is very much a reference manual; it is not a tutorial. The reader
383 is expected to have some familiarity with the SMTP mail transfer protocol and
384 with general Unix system administration. Although there are some discussions
385 and examples in places, the information is mostly organized in a way that makes
386 it easy to look up, rather than in a natural order for sequential reading.
387 Furthermore, the manual aims to cover every aspect of Exim in detail, including
388 a number of rarely-used, special-purpose features that are unlikely to be of
389 very wide interest.
390
391 .cindex "books about Exim"
392 An &"easier"& discussion of Exim which provides more in-depth explanatory,
393 introductory, and tutorial material can be found in a book entitled &'The Exim
394 SMTP Mail Server'& (second edition, 2007), published by UIT Cambridge
395 (&url(http://www.uit.co.uk/exim-book/)).
396
397 This book also contains a chapter that gives a general introduction to SMTP and
398 Internet mail. Inevitably, however, the book is unlikely to be fully up-to-date
399 with the latest release of Exim. (Note that the earlier book about Exim,
400 published by O'Reilly, covers Exim 3, and many things have changed in Exim 4.)
401
402 .cindex "Debian" "information sources"
403 If you are using a Debian distribution of Exim, you will find information about
404 Debian-specific features in the file
405 &_/usr/share/doc/exim4-base/README.Debian_&.
406 The command &(man update-exim.conf)& is another source of Debian-specific
407 information.
408
409 .cindex "&_doc/NewStuff_&"
410 .cindex "&_doc/ChangeLog_&"
411 .cindex "change log"
412 As the program develops, there may be features in newer versions that have not
413 yet made it into this document, which is updated only when the most significant
414 digit of the fractional part of the version number changes. Specifications of
415 new features that are not yet in this manual are placed in the file
416 &_doc/NewStuff_& in the Exim distribution.
417
418 Some features may be classified as &"experimental"&. These may change
419 incompatibly while they are developing, or even be withdrawn. For this reason,
420 they are not documented in this manual. Information about experimental features
421 can be found in the file &_doc/experimental.txt_&.
422
423 All changes to the program (whether new features, bug fixes, or other kinds of
424 change) are noted briefly in the file called &_doc/ChangeLog_&.
425
426 .cindex "&_doc/spec.txt_&"
427 This specification itself is available as an ASCII file in &_doc/spec.txt_& so
428 that it can easily be searched with a text editor. Other files in the &_doc_&
429 directory are:
430
431 .table2 100pt
432 .row &_OptionLists.txt_& "list of all options in alphabetical order"
433 .row &_dbm.discuss.txt_& "discussion about DBM libraries"
434 .row &_exim.8_& "a man page of Exim's command line options"
435 .row &_experimental.txt_& "documentation of experimental features"
436 .row &_filter.txt_& "specification of the filter language"
437 .row &_Exim3.upgrade_& "upgrade notes from release 2 to release 3"
438 .row &_Exim4.upgrade_& "upgrade notes from release 3 to release 4"
439 .endtable
440
441 The main specification and the specification of the filtering language are also
442 available in other formats (HTML, PostScript, PDF, and Texinfo). Section
443 &<<SECTavail>>& below tells you how to get hold of these.
444
445
446
447 .section "FTP and web sites" "SECID2"
448 .cindex "web site"
449 .cindex "FTP site"
450 The primary site for Exim source distributions is currently the University of
451 Cambridge's FTP site, whose contents are described in &'Where to find the Exim
452 distribution'& below. In addition, there is a web site and an FTP site at
453 &%exim.org%&. These are now also hosted at the University of Cambridge. The
454 &%exim.org%& site was previously hosted for a number of years by Energis
455 Squared, formerly Planet Online Ltd, whose support I gratefully acknowledge.
456
457 .cindex "wiki"
458 .cindex "FAQ"
459 As well as Exim distribution tar files, the Exim web site contains a number of
460 differently formatted versions of the documentation. A recent addition to the
461 online information is the Exim wiki (&url(http://wiki.exim.org)),
462 which contains what used to be a separate FAQ, as well as various other
463 examples, tips, and know-how that have been contributed by Exim users.
464
465 .cindex Bugzilla
466 An Exim Bugzilla exists at &url(http://bugs.exim.org). You can use
467 this to report bugs, and also to add items to the wish list. Please search
468 first to check that you are not duplicating a previous entry.
469
470
471
472 .section "Mailing lists" "SECID3"
473 .cindex "mailing lists" "for Exim users"
474 The following Exim mailing lists exist:
475
476 .table2 140pt
477 .row &'exim-announce@exim.org'& "Moderated, low volume announcements list"
478 .row &'exim-users@exim.org'& "General discussion list"
479 .row &'exim-dev@exim.org'& "Discussion of bugs, enhancements, etc."
480 .row &'exim-cvs@exim.org'& "Automated commit messages from the VCS"
481 .endtable
482
483 You can subscribe to these lists, change your existing subscriptions, and view
484 or search the archives via the mailing lists link on the Exim home page.
485 .cindex "Debian" "mailing list for"
486 If you are using a Debian distribution of Exim, you may wish to subscribe to
487 the Debian-specific mailing list &'pkg-exim4-users@lists.alioth.debian.org'&
488 via this web page:
489 .display
490 &url(http://lists.alioth.debian.org/mailman/listinfo/pkg-exim4-users)
491 .endd
492 Please ask Debian-specific questions on this list and not on the general Exim
493 lists.
494
495 .section "Exim training" "SECID4"
496 .cindex "training courses"
497 Training courses in Cambridge (UK) used to be run annually by the author of
498 Exim, before he retired. At the time of writing, there are no plans to run
499 further Exim courses in Cambridge. However, if that changes, relevant
500 information will be posted at &url(http://www-tus.csx.cam.ac.uk/courses/exim/).
501
502 .section "Bug reports" "SECID5"
503 .cindex "bug reports"
504 .cindex "reporting bugs"
505 Reports of obvious bugs can be emailed to &'bugs@exim.org'& or reported
506 via the Bugzilla (&url(http://bugs.exim.org)). However, if you are unsure
507 whether some behaviour is a bug or not, the best thing to do is to post a
508 message to the &'exim-dev'& mailing list and have it discussed.
509
510
511
512 .section "Where to find the Exim distribution" "SECTavail"
513 .cindex "FTP site"
514 .cindex "distribution" "ftp site"
515 The master ftp site for the Exim distribution is
516 .display
517 &*ftp://ftp.csx.cam.ac.uk/pub/software/email/exim*&
518 .endd
519 This is mirrored by
520 .display
521 &*ftp://ftp.exim.org/pub/exim*&
522 .endd
523 The file references that follow are relative to the &_exim_& directories at
524 these sites. There are now quite a number of independent mirror sites around
525 the world. Those that I know about are listed in the file called &_Mirrors_&.
526
527 Within the &_exim_& directory there are subdirectories called &_exim3_& (for
528 previous Exim 3 distributions), &_exim4_& (for the latest Exim 4
529 distributions), and &_Testing_& for testing versions. In the &_exim4_&
530 subdirectory, the current release can always be found in files called
531 .display
532 &_exim-n.nn.tar.gz_&
533 &_exim-n.nn.tar.bz2_&
534 .endd
535 where &'n.nn'& is the highest such version number in the directory. The two
536 files contain identical data; the only difference is the type of compression.
537 The &_.bz2_& file is usually a lot smaller than the &_.gz_& file.
538
539 .cindex "distribution" "signing details"
540 .cindex "distribution" "public key"
541 .cindex "public key for signed distribution"
542 The distributions will be PGP signed by an individual key of the Release
543 Coordinator. This key will have a uid containing an email address in the
544 &'exim.org'& domain and will have signatures from other people, including
545 other Exim maintainers. We expect that the key will be in the "strong set" of
546 PGP keys. There should be a trust path to that key from Nigel Metheringham's
547 PGP key, a version of which can be found in the release directory in the file
548 &_nigel-pubkey.asc_&. All keys used will be available in public keyserver pools,
549 such as &'pool.sks-keyservers.net'&.
550
551 At time of last update, releases were being made by Phil Pennock and signed with
552 key &'0x403043153903637F'&, although that key is expected to be replaced in 2013.
553 A trust path from Nigel's key to Phil's can be observed at
554 &url(https://www.security.spodhuis.org/exim-trustpath).
555
556 Releases have also been authorized to be performed by Todd Lyons who signs with
557 key &'0xC4F4F94804D29EBA'&. A direct trust path exists between previous RE Phil
558 Pennock and Todd Lyons through a common associate.
559
560 The signatures for the tar bundles are in:
561 .display
562 &_exim-n.nn.tar.gz.asc_&
563 &_exim-n.nn.tar.bz2.asc_&
564 .endd
565 For each released version, the log of changes is made separately available in a
566 separate file in the directory &_ChangeLogs_& so that it is possible to
567 find out what has changed without having to download the entire distribution.
568
569 .cindex "documentation" "available formats"
570 The main distribution contains ASCII versions of this specification and other
571 documentation; other formats of the documents are available in separate files
572 inside the &_exim4_& directory of the FTP site:
573 .display
574 &_exim-html-n.nn.tar.gz_&
575 &_exim-pdf-n.nn.tar.gz_&
576 &_exim-postscript-n.nn.tar.gz_&
577 &_exim-texinfo-n.nn.tar.gz_&
578 .endd
579 These tar files contain only the &_doc_& directory, not the complete
580 distribution, and are also available in &_.bz2_& as well as &_.gz_& forms.
581
582
583 .section "Limitations" "SECID6"
584 .ilist
585 .cindex "limitations of Exim"
586 .cindex "bang paths" "not handled by Exim"
587 Exim is designed for use as an Internet MTA, and therefore handles addresses in
588 RFC 2822 domain format only. It cannot handle UUCP &"bang paths"&, though
589 simple two-component bang paths can be converted by a straightforward rewriting
590 configuration. This restriction does not prevent Exim from being interfaced to
591 UUCP as a transport mechanism, provided that domain addresses are used.
592 .next
593 .cindex "domainless addresses"
594 .cindex "address" "without domain"
595 Exim insists that every address it handles has a domain attached. For incoming
596 local messages, domainless addresses are automatically qualified with a
597 configured domain value. Configuration options specify from which remote
598 systems unqualified addresses are acceptable. These are then qualified on
599 arrival.
600 .next
601 .cindex "transport" "external"
602 .cindex "external transports"
603 The only external transport mechanisms that are currently implemented are SMTP
604 and LMTP over a TCP/IP network (including support for IPv6). However, a pipe
605 transport is available, and there are facilities for writing messages to files
606 and pipes, optionally in &'batched SMTP'& format; these facilities can be used
607 to send messages to other transport mechanisms such as UUCP, provided they can
608 handle domain-style addresses. Batched SMTP input is also catered for.
609 .next
610 Exim is not designed for storing mail for dial-in hosts. When the volumes of
611 such mail are large, it is better to get the messages &"delivered"& into files
612 (that is, off Exim's queue) and subsequently passed on to the dial-in hosts by
613 other means.
614 .next
615 Although Exim does have basic facilities for scanning incoming messages, these
616 are not comprehensive enough to do full virus or spam scanning. Such operations
617 are best carried out using additional specialized software packages. If you
618 compile Exim with the content-scanning extension, straightforward interfaces to
619 a number of common scanners are provided.
620 .endlist
621
622
623 .section "Run time configuration" "SECID7"
624 Exim's run time configuration is held in a single text file that is divided
625 into a number of sections. The entries in this file consist of keywords and
626 values, in the style of Smail 3 configuration files. A default configuration
627 file which is suitable for simple online installations is provided in the
628 distribution, and is described in chapter &<<CHAPdefconfil>>& below.
629
630
631 .section "Calling interface" "SECID8"
632 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "command line interface"
633 Like many MTAs, Exim has adopted the Sendmail command line interface so that it
634 can be a straight replacement for &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& or
635 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& when sending mail, but you do not need to know anything
636 about Sendmail in order to run Exim. For actions other than sending messages,
637 Sendmail-compatible options also exist, but those that produce output (for
638 example, &%-bp%&, which lists the messages on the queue) do so in Exim's own
639 format. There are also some additional options that are compatible with Smail
640 3, and some further options that are new to Exim. Chapter &<<CHAPcommandline>>&
641 documents all Exim's command line options. This information is automatically
642 made into the man page that forms part of the Exim distribution.
643
644 Control of messages on the queue can be done via certain privileged command
645 line options. There is also an optional monitor program called &'eximon'&,
646 which displays current information in an X window, and which contains a menu
647 interface to Exim's command line administration options.
648
649
650
651 .section "Terminology" "SECID9"
652 .cindex "terminology definitions"
653 .cindex "body of message" "definition of"
654 The &'body'& of a message is the actual data that the sender wants to transmit.
655 It is the last part of a message, and is separated from the &'header'& (see
656 below) by a blank line.
657
658 .cindex "bounce message" "definition of"
659 When a message cannot be delivered, it is normally returned to the sender in a
660 delivery failure message or a &"non-delivery report"& (NDR). The term
661 &'bounce'& is commonly used for this action, and the error reports are often
662 called &'bounce messages'&. This is a convenient shorthand for &"delivery
663 failure error report"&. Such messages have an empty sender address in the
664 message's &'envelope'& (see below) to ensure that they cannot themselves give
665 rise to further bounce messages.
666
667 The term &'default'& appears frequently in this manual. It is used to qualify a
668 value which is used in the absence of any setting in the configuration. It may
669 also qualify an action which is taken unless a configuration setting specifies
670 otherwise.
671
672 The term &'defer'& is used when the delivery of a message to a specific
673 destination cannot immediately take place for some reason (a remote host may be
674 down, or a user's local mailbox may be full). Such deliveries are &'deferred'&
675 until a later time.
676
677 The word &'domain'& is sometimes used to mean all but the first component of a
678 host's name. It is &'not'& used in that sense here, where it normally refers to
679 the part of an email address following the @ sign.
680
681 .cindex "envelope, definition of"
682 .cindex "sender" "definition of"
683 A message in transit has an associated &'envelope'&, as well as a header and a
684 body. The envelope contains a sender address (to which bounce messages should
685 be delivered), and any number of recipient addresses. References to the
686 sender or the recipients of a message usually mean the addresses in the
687 envelope. An MTA uses these addresses for delivery, and for returning bounce
688 messages, not the addresses that appear in the header lines.
689
690 .cindex "message" "header, definition of"
691 .cindex "header section" "definition of"
692 The &'header'& of a message is the first part of a message's text, consisting
693 of a number of lines, each of which has a name such as &'From:'&, &'To:'&,
694 &'Subject:'&, etc. Long header lines can be split over several text lines by
695 indenting the continuations. The header is separated from the body by a blank
696 line.
697
698 .cindex "local part" "definition of"
699 .cindex "domain" "definition of"
700 The term &'local part'&, which is taken from RFC 2822, is used to refer to that
701 part of an email address that precedes the @ sign. The part that follows the
702 @ sign is called the &'domain'& or &'mail domain'&.
703
704 .cindex "local delivery" "definition of"
705 .cindex "remote delivery, definition of"
706 The terms &'local delivery'& and &'remote delivery'& are used to distinguish
707 delivery to a file or a pipe on the local host from delivery by SMTP over
708 TCP/IP to another host. As far as Exim is concerned, all hosts other than the
709 host it is running on are &'remote'&.
710
711 .cindex "return path" "definition of"
712 &'Return path'& is another name that is used for the sender address in a
713 message's envelope.
714
715 .cindex "queue" "definition of"
716 The term &'queue'& is used to refer to the set of messages awaiting delivery,
717 because this term is in widespread use in the context of MTAs. However, in
718 Exim's case the reality is more like a pool than a queue, because there is
719 normally no ordering of waiting messages.
720
721 .cindex "queue runner" "definition of"
722 The term &'queue runner'& is used to describe a process that scans the queue
723 and attempts to deliver those messages whose retry times have come. This term
724 is used by other MTAs, and also relates to the command &%runq%&, but in Exim
725 the waiting messages are normally processed in an unpredictable order.
726
727 .cindex "spool directory" "definition of"
728 The term &'spool directory'& is used for a directory in which Exim keeps the
729 messages on its queue &-- that is, those that it is in the process of
730 delivering. This should not be confused with the directory in which local
731 mailboxes are stored, which is called a &"spool directory"& by some people. In
732 the Exim documentation, &"spool"& is always used in the first sense.
733
734
735
736
737
738
739 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
740 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
741
742 .chapter "Incorporated code" "CHID2"
743 .cindex "incorporated code"
744 .cindex "regular expressions" "library"
745 .cindex "PCRE"
746 .cindex "OpenDMARC"
747 A number of pieces of external code are included in the Exim distribution.
748
749 .ilist
750 Regular expressions are supported in the main Exim program and in the
751 Exim monitor using the freely-distributable PCRE library, copyright
752 &copy; University of Cambridge. The source to PCRE is no longer shipped with
753 Exim, so you will need to use the version of PCRE shipped with your system,
754 or obtain and install the full version of the library from
755 &url(ftp://ftp.csx.cam.ac.uk/pub/software/programming/pcre).
756 .next
757 .cindex "cdb" "acknowledgment"
758 Support for the cdb (Constant DataBase) lookup method is provided by code
759 contributed by Nigel Metheringham of (at the time he contributed it) Planet
760 Online Ltd. The implementation is completely contained within the code of Exim.
761 It does not link against an external cdb library. The code contains the
762 following statements:
763
764 .blockquote
765 Copyright &copy; 1998 Nigel Metheringham, Planet Online Ltd
766
767 This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it under
768 the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by the Free Software
769 Foundation; either version 2 of the License, or (at your option) any later
770 version.
771 This code implements Dan Bernstein's Constant DataBase (cdb) spec. Information,
772 the spec and sample code for cdb can be obtained from
773 &url(http://www.pobox.com/~djb/cdb.html). This implementation borrows
774 some code from Dan Bernstein's implementation (which has no license
775 restrictions applied to it).
776 .endblockquote
777 .next
778 .cindex "SPA authentication"
779 .cindex "Samba project"
780 .cindex "Microsoft Secure Password Authentication"
781 Client support for Microsoft's &'Secure Password Authentication'& is provided
782 by code contributed by Marc Prud'hommeaux. Server support was contributed by
783 Tom Kistner. This includes code taken from the Samba project, which is released
784 under the Gnu GPL.
785 .next
786 .cindex "Cyrus"
787 .cindex "&'pwcheck'& daemon"
788 .cindex "&'pwauthd'& daemon"
789 Support for calling the Cyrus &'pwcheck'& and &'saslauthd'& daemons is provided
790 by code taken from the Cyrus-SASL library and adapted by Alexander S.
791 Sabourenkov. The permission notice appears below, in accordance with the
792 conditions expressed therein.
793
794 .blockquote
795 Copyright &copy; 2001 Carnegie Mellon University. All rights reserved.
796
797 Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
798 modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
799 are met:
800
801 .olist
802 Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
803 notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
804 .next
805 Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
806 notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in
807 the documentation and/or other materials provided with the
808 distribution.
809 .next
810 The name &"Carnegie Mellon University"& must not be used to
811 endorse or promote products derived from this software without
812 prior written permission. For permission or any other legal
813 details, please contact
814 .display
815 Office of Technology Transfer
816 Carnegie Mellon University
817 5000 Forbes Avenue
818 Pittsburgh, PA 15213-3890
819 (412) 268-4387, fax: (412) 268-7395
820 tech-transfer@andrew.cmu.edu
821 .endd
822 .next
823 Redistributions of any form whatsoever must retain the following
824 acknowledgment:
825
826 &"This product includes software developed by Computing Services
827 at Carnegie Mellon University (&url(http://www.cmu.edu/computing/)."&
828
829 CARNEGIE MELLON UNIVERSITY DISCLAIMS ALL WARRANTIES WITH REGARD TO
830 THIS SOFTWARE, INCLUDING ALL IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY
831 AND FITNESS, IN NO EVENT SHALL CARNEGIE MELLON UNIVERSITY BE LIABLE
832 FOR ANY SPECIAL, INDIRECT OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES OR ANY DAMAGES
833 WHATSOEVER RESULTING FROM LOSS OF USE, DATA OR PROFITS, WHETHER IN
834 AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, NEGLIGENCE OR OTHER TORTIOUS ACTION, ARISING
835 OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE USE OR PERFORMANCE OF THIS SOFTWARE.
836 .endlist
837 .endblockquote
838
839 .next
840 .cindex "Exim monitor" "acknowledgment"
841 .cindex "X-windows"
842 .cindex "Athena"
843 The Exim Monitor program, which is an X-Window application, includes
844 modified versions of the Athena StripChart and TextPop widgets.
845 This code is copyright by DEC and MIT, and their permission notice appears
846 below, in accordance with the conditions expressed therein.
847
848 .blockquote
849 Copyright 1987, 1988 by Digital Equipment Corporation, Maynard, Massachusetts,
850 and the Massachusetts Institute of Technology, Cambridge, Massachusetts.
851
852 All Rights Reserved
853
854 Permission to use, copy, modify, and distribute this software and its
855 documentation for any purpose and without fee is hereby granted,
856 provided that the above copyright notice appear in all copies and that
857 both that copyright notice and this permission notice appear in
858 supporting documentation, and that the names of Digital or MIT not be
859 used in advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the
860 software without specific, written prior permission.
861
862 DIGITAL DISCLAIMS ALL WARRANTIES WITH REGARD TO THIS SOFTWARE, INCLUDING
863 ALL IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS, IN NO EVENT SHALL
864 DIGITAL BE LIABLE FOR ANY SPECIAL, INDIRECT OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES OR
865 ANY DAMAGES WHATSOEVER RESULTING FROM LOSS OF USE, DATA OR PROFITS,
866 WHETHER IN AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, NEGLIGENCE OR OTHER TORTIOUS ACTION,
867 ARISING OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE USE OR PERFORMANCE OF THIS
868 SOFTWARE.
869 .endblockquote
870
871 .next
872 .cindex "opendmarc" "acknowledgment"
873 The DMARC implementation uses the OpenDMARC library which is Copyrighted by
874 The Trusted Domain Project. Portions of Exim source which use OpenDMARC
875 derived code are indicated in the respective source files. The full OpenDMARC
876 license is provided in the LICENSE.opendmarc file contained in the distributed
877 source code.
878
879 .next
880 Many people have contributed code fragments, some large, some small, that were
881 not covered by any specific licence requirements. It is assumed that the
882 contributors are happy to see their code incorporated into Exim under the GPL.
883 .endlist
884
885
886
887
888
889 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
890 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
891
892 .chapter "How Exim receives and delivers mail" "CHID11" &&&
893 "Receiving and delivering mail"
894
895
896 .section "Overall philosophy" "SECID10"
897 .cindex "design philosophy"
898 Exim is designed to work efficiently on systems that are permanently connected
899 to the Internet and are handling a general mix of mail. In such circumstances,
900 most messages can be delivered immediately. Consequently, Exim does not
901 maintain independent queues of messages for specific domains or hosts, though
902 it does try to send several messages in a single SMTP connection after a host
903 has been down, and it also maintains per-host retry information.
904
905
906 .section "Policy control" "SECID11"
907 .cindex "policy control" "overview"
908 Policy controls are now an important feature of MTAs that are connected to the
909 Internet. Perhaps their most important job is to stop MTAs being abused as
910 &"open relays"& by misguided individuals who send out vast amounts of
911 unsolicited junk, and want to disguise its source. Exim provides flexible
912 facilities for specifying policy controls on incoming mail:
913
914 .ilist
915 .cindex "&ACL;" "introduction"
916 Exim 4 (unlike previous versions of Exim) implements policy controls on
917 incoming mail by means of &'Access Control Lists'& (ACLs). Each list is a
918 series of statements that may either grant or deny access. ACLs can be used at
919 several places in the SMTP dialogue while receiving a message from a remote
920 host. However, the most common places are after each RCPT command, and at the
921 very end of the message. The sysadmin can specify conditions for accepting or
922 rejecting individual recipients or the entire message, respectively, at these
923 two points (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). Denial of access results in an SMTP
924 error code.
925 .next
926 An ACL is also available for locally generated, non-SMTP messages. In this
927 case, the only available actions are to accept or deny the entire message.
928 .next
929 When Exim is compiled with the content-scanning extension, facilities are
930 provided in the ACL mechanism for passing the message to external virus and/or
931 spam scanning software. The result of such a scan is passed back to the ACL,
932 which can then use it to decide what to do with the message.
933 .next
934 When a message has been received, either from a remote host or from the local
935 host, but before the final acknowledgment has been sent, a locally supplied C
936 function called &[local_scan()]& can be run to inspect the message and decide
937 whether to accept it or not (see chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&). If the message
938 is accepted, the list of recipients can be modified by the function.
939 .next
940 Using the &[local_scan()]& mechanism is another way of calling external scanner
941 software. The &%SA-Exim%& add-on package works this way. It does not require
942 Exim to be compiled with the content-scanning extension.
943 .next
944 After a message has been accepted, a further checking mechanism is available in
945 the form of the &'system filter'& (see chapter &<<CHAPsystemfilter>>&). This
946 runs at the start of every delivery process.
947 .endlist
948
949
950
951 .section "User filters" "SECID12"
952 .cindex "filter" "introduction"
953 .cindex "Sieve filter"
954 In a conventional Exim configuration, users are able to run private filters by
955 setting up appropriate &_.forward_& files in their home directories. See
956 chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>& (about the &(redirect)& router) for the
957 configuration needed to support this, and the separate document entitled
958 &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'& for user details. Two different kinds
959 of filtering are available:
960
961 .ilist
962 Sieve filters are written in the standard filtering language that is defined
963 by RFC 3028.
964 .next
965 Exim filters are written in a syntax that is unique to Exim, but which is more
966 powerful than Sieve, which it pre-dates.
967 .endlist
968
969 User filters are run as part of the routing process, described below.
970
971
972
973 .section "Message identification" "SECTmessiden"
974 .cindex "message ids" "details of format"
975 .cindex "format" "of message id"
976 .cindex "id of message"
977 .cindex "base62"
978 .cindex "base36"
979 .cindex "Darwin"
980 .cindex "Cygwin"
981 Every message handled by Exim is given a &'message id'& which is sixteen
982 characters long. It is divided into three parts, separated by hyphens, for
983 example &`16VDhn-0001bo-D3`&. Each part is a sequence of letters and digits,
984 normally encoding numbers in base 62. However, in the Darwin operating
985 system (Mac OS X) and when Exim is compiled to run under Cygwin, base 36
986 (avoiding the use of lower case letters) is used instead, because the message
987 id is used to construct file names, and the names of files in those systems are
988 not always case-sensitive.
989
990 .cindex "pid (process id)" "re-use of"
991 The detail of the contents of the message id have changed as Exim has evolved.
992 Earlier versions relied on the operating system not re-using a process id (pid)
993 within one second. On modern operating systems, this assumption can no longer
994 be made, so the algorithm had to be changed. To retain backward compatibility,
995 the format of the message id was retained, which is why the following rules are
996 somewhat eccentric:
997
998 .ilist
999 The first six characters of the message id are the time at which the message
1000 started to be received, to a granularity of one second. That is, this field
1001 contains the number of seconds since the start of the epoch (the normal Unix
1002 way of representing the date and time of day).
1003 .next
1004 After the first hyphen, the next six characters are the id of the process that
1005 received the message.
1006 .next
1007 There are two different possibilities for the final two characters:
1008 .olist
1009 .oindex "&%localhost_number%&"
1010 If &%localhost_number%& is not set, this value is the fractional part of the
1011 time of reception, normally in units of 1/2000 of a second, but for systems
1012 that must use base 36 instead of base 62 (because of case-insensitive file
1013 systems), the units are 1/1000 of a second.
1014 .next
1015 If &%localhost_number%& is set, it is multiplied by 200 (100) and added to
1016 the fractional part of the time, which in this case is in units of 1/200
1017 (1/100) of a second.
1018 .endlist
1019 .endlist
1020
1021 After a message has been received, Exim waits for the clock to tick at the
1022 appropriate resolution before proceeding, so that if another message is
1023 received by the same process, or by another process with the same (re-used)
1024 pid, it is guaranteed that the time will be different. In most cases, the clock
1025 will already have ticked while the message was being received.
1026
1027
1028 .section "Receiving mail" "SECID13"
1029 .cindex "receiving mail"
1030 .cindex "message" "reception"
1031 The only way Exim can receive mail from another host is using SMTP over
1032 TCP/IP, in which case the sender and recipient addresses are transferred using
1033 SMTP commands. However, from a locally running process (such as a user's MUA),
1034 there are several possibilities:
1035
1036 .ilist
1037 If the process runs Exim with the &%-bm%& option, the message is read
1038 non-interactively (usually via a pipe), with the recipients taken from the
1039 command line, or from the body of the message if &%-t%& is also used.
1040 .next
1041 If the process runs Exim with the &%-bS%& option, the message is also read
1042 non-interactively, but in this case the recipients are listed at the start of
1043 the message in a series of SMTP RCPT commands, terminated by a DATA
1044 command. This is so-called &"batch SMTP"& format,
1045 but it isn't really SMTP. The SMTP commands are just another way of passing
1046 envelope addresses in a non-interactive submission.
1047 .next
1048 If the process runs Exim with the &%-bs%& option, the message is read
1049 interactively, using the SMTP protocol. A two-way pipe is normally used for
1050 passing data between the local process and the Exim process.
1051 This is &"real"& SMTP and is handled in the same way as SMTP over TCP/IP. For
1052 example, the ACLs for SMTP commands are used for this form of submission.
1053 .next
1054 A local process may also make a TCP/IP call to the host's loopback address
1055 (127.0.0.1) or any other of its IP addresses. When receiving messages, Exim
1056 does not treat the loopback address specially. It treats all such connections
1057 in the same way as connections from other hosts.
1058 .endlist
1059
1060
1061 .cindex "message sender, constructed by Exim"
1062 .cindex "sender" "constructed by Exim"
1063 In the three cases that do not involve TCP/IP, the sender address is
1064 constructed from the login name of the user that called Exim and a default
1065 qualification domain (which can be set by the &%qualify_domain%& configuration
1066 option). For local or batch SMTP, a sender address that is passed using the
1067 SMTP MAIL command is ignored. However, the system administrator may allow
1068 certain users (&"trusted users"&) to specify a different sender address
1069 unconditionally, or all users to specify certain forms of different sender
1070 address. The &%-f%& option or the SMTP MAIL command is used to specify these
1071 different addresses. See section &<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for details of trusted
1072 users, and the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option for a way of allowing untrusted
1073 users to change sender addresses.
1074
1075 Messages received by either of the non-interactive mechanisms are subject to
1076 checking by the non-SMTP ACL, if one is defined. Messages received using SMTP
1077 (either over TCP/IP, or interacting with a local process) can be checked by a
1078 number of ACLs that operate at different times during the SMTP session. Either
1079 individual recipients, or the entire message, can be rejected if local policy
1080 requirements are not met. The &[local_scan()]& function (see chapter
1081 &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&) is run for all incoming messages.
1082
1083 Exim can be configured not to start a delivery process when a message is
1084 received; this can be unconditional, or depend on the number of incoming SMTP
1085 connections or the system load. In these situations, new messages wait on the
1086 queue until a queue runner process picks them up. However, in standard
1087 configurations under normal conditions, delivery is started as soon as a
1088 message is received.
1089
1090
1091
1092
1093
1094 .section "Handling an incoming message" "SECID14"
1095 .cindex "spool directory" "files that hold a message"
1096 .cindex "file" "how a message is held"
1097 When Exim accepts a message, it writes two files in its spool directory. The
1098 first contains the envelope information, the current status of the message, and
1099 the header lines, and the second contains the body of the message. The names of
1100 the two spool files consist of the message id, followed by &`-H`& for the
1101 file containing the envelope and header, and &`-D`& for the data file.
1102
1103 .cindex "spool directory" "&_input_& sub-directory"
1104 By default all these message files are held in a single directory called
1105 &_input_& inside the general Exim spool directory. Some operating systems do
1106 not perform very well if the number of files in a directory gets large; to
1107 improve performance in such cases, the &%split_spool_directory%& option can be
1108 used. This causes Exim to split up the input files into 62 sub-directories
1109 whose names are single letters or digits. When this is done, the queue is
1110 processed one sub-directory at a time instead of all at once, which can improve
1111 overall performance even when there are not enough files in each directory to
1112 affect file system performance.
1113
1114 The envelope information consists of the address of the message's sender and
1115 the addresses of the recipients. This information is entirely separate from
1116 any addresses contained in the header lines. The status of the message includes
1117 a list of recipients who have already received the message. The format of the
1118 first spool file is described in chapter &<<CHAPspool>>&.
1119
1120 .cindex "rewriting" "addresses"
1121 Address rewriting that is specified in the rewrite section of the configuration
1122 (see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&) is done once and for all on incoming addresses,
1123 both in the header lines and the envelope, at the time the message is accepted.
1124 If during the course of delivery additional addresses are generated (for
1125 example, via aliasing), these new addresses are rewritten as soon as they are
1126 generated. At the time a message is actually delivered (transported) further
1127 rewriting can take place; because this is a transport option, it can be
1128 different for different forms of delivery. It is also possible to specify the
1129 addition or removal of certain header lines at the time the message is
1130 delivered (see chapters &<<CHAProutergeneric>>& and
1131 &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
1132
1133
1134
1135 .section "Life of a message" "SECID15"
1136 .cindex "message" "life of"
1137 .cindex "message" "frozen"
1138 A message remains in the spool directory until it is completely delivered to
1139 its recipients or to an error address, or until it is deleted by an
1140 administrator or by the user who originally created it. In cases when delivery
1141 cannot proceed &-- for example, when a message can neither be delivered to its
1142 recipients nor returned to its sender, the message is marked &"frozen"& on the
1143 spool, and no more deliveries are attempted.
1144
1145 .cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
1146 .cindex "message" "thawing frozen"
1147 An administrator can &"thaw"& such messages when the problem has been
1148 corrected, and can also freeze individual messages by hand if necessary. In
1149 addition, an administrator can force a delivery error, causing a bounce message
1150 to be sent.
1151
1152 .oindex "&%timeout_frozen_after%&"
1153 .oindex "&%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&"
1154 There are options called &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%& and
1155 &%timeout_frozen_after%&, which discard frozen messages after a certain time.
1156 The first applies only to frozen bounces, the second to any frozen messages.
1157
1158 .cindex "message" "log file for"
1159 .cindex "log" "file for each message"
1160 While Exim is working on a message, it writes information about each delivery
1161 attempt to its main log file. This includes successful, unsuccessful, and
1162 delayed deliveries for each recipient (see chapter &<<CHAPlog>>&). The log
1163 lines are also written to a separate &'message log'& file for each message.
1164 These logs are solely for the benefit of the administrator, and are normally
1165 deleted along with the spool files when processing of a message is complete.
1166 The use of individual message logs can be disabled by setting
1167 &%no_message_logs%&; this might give an improvement in performance on very busy
1168 systems.
1169
1170 .cindex "journal file"
1171 .cindex "file" "journal"
1172 All the information Exim itself needs to set up a delivery is kept in the first
1173 spool file, along with the header lines. When a successful delivery occurs, the
1174 address is immediately written at the end of a journal file, whose name is the
1175 message id followed by &`-J`&. At the end of a delivery run, if there are some
1176 addresses left to be tried again later, the first spool file (the &`-H`& file)
1177 is updated to indicate which these are, and the journal file is then deleted.
1178 Updating the spool file is done by writing a new file and renaming it, to
1179 minimize the possibility of data loss.
1180
1181 Should the system or the program crash after a successful delivery but before
1182 the spool file has been updated, the journal is left lying around. The next
1183 time Exim attempts to deliver the message, it reads the journal file and
1184 updates the spool file before proceeding. This minimizes the chances of double
1185 deliveries caused by crashes.
1186
1187
1188
1189 .section "Processing an address for delivery" "SECTprocaddress"
1190 .cindex "drivers" "definition of"
1191 .cindex "router" "definition of"
1192 .cindex "transport" "definition of"
1193 The main delivery processing elements of Exim are called &'routers'& and
1194 &'transports'&, and collectively these are known as &'drivers'&. Code for a
1195 number of them is provided in the source distribution, and compile-time options
1196 specify which ones are included in the binary. Run time options specify which
1197 ones are actually used for delivering messages.
1198
1199 .cindex "drivers" "instance definition"
1200 Each driver that is specified in the run time configuration is an &'instance'&
1201 of that particular driver type. Multiple instances are allowed; for example,
1202 you can set up several different &(smtp)& transports, each with different
1203 option values that might specify different ports or different timeouts. Each
1204 instance has its own identifying name. In what follows we will normally use the
1205 instance name when discussing one particular instance (that is, one specific
1206 configuration of the driver), and the generic driver name when discussing
1207 the driver's features in general.
1208
1209 A &'router'& is a driver that operates on an address, either determining how
1210 its delivery should happen, by assigning it to a specific transport, or
1211 converting the address into one or more new addresses (for example, via an
1212 alias file). A router may also explicitly choose to fail an address, causing it
1213 to be bounced.
1214
1215 A &'transport'& is a driver that transmits a copy of the message from Exim's
1216 spool to some destination. There are two kinds of transport: for a &'local'&
1217 transport, the destination is a file or a pipe on the local host, whereas for a
1218 &'remote'& transport the destination is some other host. A message is passed
1219 to a specific transport as a result of successful routing. If a message has
1220 several recipients, it may be passed to a number of different transports.
1221
1222 .cindex "preconditions" "definition of"
1223 An address is processed by passing it to each configured router instance in
1224 turn, subject to certain preconditions, until a router accepts the address or
1225 specifies that it should be bounced. We will describe this process in more
1226 detail shortly. First, as a simple example, we consider how each recipient
1227 address in a message is processed in a small configuration of three routers.
1228
1229 To make this a more concrete example, it is described in terms of some actual
1230 routers, but remember, this is only an example. You can configure Exim's
1231 routers in many different ways, and there may be any number of routers in a
1232 configuration.
1233
1234 The first router that is specified in a configuration is often one that handles
1235 addresses in domains that are not recognized specially by the local host. These
1236 are typically addresses for arbitrary domains on the Internet. A precondition
1237 is set up which looks for the special domains known to the host (for example,
1238 its own domain name), and the router is run for addresses that do &'not'&
1239 match. Typically, this is a router that looks up domains in the DNS in order to
1240 find the hosts to which this address routes. If it succeeds, the address is
1241 assigned to a suitable SMTP transport; if it does not succeed, the router is
1242 configured to fail the address.
1243
1244 The second router is reached only when the domain is recognized as one that
1245 &"belongs"& to the local host. This router does redirection &-- also known as
1246 aliasing and forwarding. When it generates one or more new addresses from the
1247 original, each of them is routed independently from the start. Otherwise, the
1248 router may cause an address to fail, or it may simply decline to handle the
1249 address, in which case the address is passed to the next router.
1250
1251 The final router in many configurations is one that checks to see if the
1252 address belongs to a local mailbox. The precondition may involve a check to
1253 see if the local part is the name of a login account, or it may look up the
1254 local part in a file or a database. If its preconditions are not met, or if
1255 the router declines, we have reached the end of the routers. When this happens,
1256 the address is bounced.
1257
1258
1259
1260 .section "Processing an address for verification" "SECID16"
1261 .cindex "router" "for verification"
1262 .cindex "verifying address" "overview"
1263 As well as being used to decide how to deliver to an address, Exim's routers
1264 are also used for &'address verification'&. Verification can be requested as
1265 one of the checks to be performed in an ACL for incoming messages, on both
1266 sender and recipient addresses, and it can be tested using the &%-bv%& and
1267 &%-bvs%& command line options.
1268
1269 When an address is being verified, the routers are run in &"verify mode"&. This
1270 does not affect the way the routers work, but it is a state that can be
1271 detected. By this means, a router can be skipped or made to behave differently
1272 when verifying. A common example is a configuration in which the first router
1273 sends all messages to a message-scanning program, unless they have been
1274 previously scanned. Thus, the first router accepts all addresses without any
1275 checking, making it useless for verifying. Normally, the &%no_verify%& option
1276 would be set for such a router, causing it to be skipped in verify mode.
1277
1278
1279
1280
1281 .section "Running an individual router" "SECTrunindrou"
1282 .cindex "router" "running details"
1283 .cindex "preconditions" "checking"
1284 .cindex "router" "result of running"
1285 As explained in the example above, a number of preconditions are checked before
1286 running a router. If any are not met, the router is skipped, and the address is
1287 passed to the next router. When all the preconditions on a router &'are'& met,
1288 the router is run. What happens next depends on the outcome, which is one of
1289 the following:
1290
1291 .ilist
1292 &'accept'&: The router accepts the address, and either assigns it to a
1293 transport, or generates one or more &"child"& addresses. Processing the
1294 original address ceases,
1295 .oindex "&%unseen%&"
1296 unless the &%unseen%& option is set on the router. This option
1297 can be used to set up multiple deliveries with different routing (for example,
1298 for keeping archive copies of messages). When &%unseen%& is set, the address is
1299 passed to the next router. Normally, however, an &'accept'& return marks the
1300 end of routing.
1301
1302 Any child addresses generated by the router are processed independently,
1303 starting with the first router by default. It is possible to change this by
1304 setting the &%redirect_router%& option to specify which router to start at for
1305 child addresses. Unlike &%pass_router%& (see below) the router specified by
1306 &%redirect_router%& may be anywhere in the router configuration.
1307 .next
1308 &'pass'&: The router recognizes the address, but cannot handle it itself. It
1309 requests that the address be passed to another router. By default the address
1310 is passed to the next router, but this can be changed by setting the
1311 &%pass_router%& option. However, (unlike &%redirect_router%&) the named router
1312 must be below the current router (to avoid loops).
1313 .next
1314 &'decline'&: The router declines to accept the address because it does not
1315 recognize it at all. By default, the address is passed to the next router, but
1316 this can be prevented by setting the &%no_more%& option. When &%no_more%& is
1317 set, all the remaining routers are skipped. In effect, &%no_more%& converts
1318 &'decline'& into &'fail'&.
1319 .next
1320 &'fail'&: The router determines that the address should fail, and queues it for
1321 the generation of a bounce message. There is no further processing of the
1322 original address unless &%unseen%& is set on the router.
1323 .next
1324 &'defer'&: The router cannot handle the address at the present time. (A
1325 database may be offline, or a DNS lookup may have timed out.) No further
1326 processing of the address happens in this delivery attempt. It is tried again
1327 next time the message is considered for delivery.
1328 .next
1329 &'error'&: There is some error in the router (for example, a syntax error in
1330 its configuration). The action is as for defer.
1331 .endlist
1332
1333 If an address reaches the end of the routers without having been accepted by
1334 any of them, it is bounced as unrouteable. The default error message in this
1335 situation is &"unrouteable address"&, but you can set your own message by
1336 making use of the &%cannot_route_message%& option. This can be set for any
1337 router; the value from the last router that &"saw"& the address is used.
1338
1339 Sometimes while routing you want to fail a delivery when some conditions are
1340 met but others are not, instead of passing the address on for further routing.
1341 You can do this by having a second router that explicitly fails the delivery
1342 when the relevant conditions are met. The &(redirect)& router has a &"fail"&
1343 facility for this purpose.
1344
1345
1346 .section "Duplicate addresses" "SECID17"
1347 .cindex "case of local parts"
1348 .cindex "address duplicate, discarding"
1349 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
1350 Once routing is complete, Exim scans the addresses that are assigned to local
1351 and remote transports, and discards any duplicates that it finds. During this
1352 check, local parts are treated as case-sensitive. This happens only when
1353 actually delivering a message; when testing routers with &%-bt%&, all the
1354 routed addresses are shown.
1355
1356
1357
1358 .section "Router preconditions" "SECTrouprecon"
1359 .cindex "router" "preconditions, order of processing"
1360 .cindex "preconditions" "order of processing"
1361 The preconditions that are tested for each router are listed below, in the
1362 order in which they are tested. The individual configuration options are
1363 described in more detail in chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&.
1364
1365 .ilist
1366 The &%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& options can specify that
1367 the local parts handled by the router may or must have certain prefixes and/or
1368 suffixes. If a mandatory affix (prefix or suffix) is not present, the router is
1369 skipped. These conditions are tested first. When an affix is present, it is
1370 removed from the local part before further processing, including the evaluation
1371 of any other conditions.
1372 .next
1373 Routers can be designated for use only when not verifying an address, that is,
1374 only when routing it for delivery (or testing its delivery routing). If the
1375 &%verify%& option is set false, the router is skipped when Exim is verifying an
1376 address.
1377 Setting the &%verify%& option actually sets two options, &%verify_sender%& and
1378 &%verify_recipient%&, which independently control the use of the router for
1379 sender and recipient verification. You can set these options directly if
1380 you want a router to be used for only one type of verification.
1381 Note that cutthrough delivery is classed as a recipient verification for this purpose.
1382 .next
1383 If the &%address_test%& option is set false, the router is skipped when Exim is
1384 run with the &%-bt%& option to test an address routing. This can be helpful
1385 when the first router sends all new messages to a scanner of some sort; it
1386 makes it possible to use &%-bt%& to test subsequent delivery routing without
1387 having to simulate the effect of the scanner.
1388 .next
1389 Routers can be designated for use only when verifying an address, as
1390 opposed to routing it for delivery. The &%verify_only%& option controls this.
1391 Again, cutthrough delivery counts as a verification.
1392 .next
1393 Individual routers can be explicitly skipped when running the routers to
1394 check an address given in the SMTP EXPN command (see the &%expn%& option).
1395 .next
1396 If the &%domains%& option is set, the domain of the address must be in the set
1397 of domains that it defines.
1398 .next
1399 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
1400 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
1401 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
1402 If the &%local_parts%& option is set, the local part of the address must be in
1403 the set of local parts that it defines. If &%local_part_prefix%& or
1404 &%local_part_suffix%& is in use, the prefix or suffix is removed from the local
1405 part before this check. If you want to do precondition tests on local parts
1406 that include affixes, you can do so by using a &%condition%& option (see below)
1407 that uses the variables &$local_part$&, &$local_part_prefix$&, and
1408 &$local_part_suffix$& as necessary.
1409 .next
1410 .vindex "&$local_user_uid$&"
1411 .vindex "&$local_user_gid$&"
1412 .vindex "&$home$&"
1413 If the &%check_local_user%& option is set, the local part must be the name of
1414 an account on the local host. If this check succeeds, the uid and gid of the
1415 local user are placed in &$local_user_uid$& and &$local_user_gid$& and the
1416 user's home directory is placed in &$home$&; these values can be used in the
1417 remaining preconditions.
1418 .next
1419 If the &%router_home_directory%& option is set, it is expanded at this point,
1420 because it overrides the value of &$home$&. If this expansion were left till
1421 later, the value of &$home$& as set by &%check_local_user%& would be used in
1422 subsequent tests. Having two different values of &$home$& in the same router
1423 could lead to confusion.
1424 .next
1425 If the &%senders%& option is set, the envelope sender address must be in the
1426 set of addresses that it defines.
1427 .next
1428 If the &%require_files%& option is set, the existence or non-existence of
1429 specified files is tested.
1430 .next
1431 .cindex "customizing" "precondition"
1432 If the &%condition%& option is set, it is evaluated and tested. This option
1433 uses an expanded string to allow you to set up your own custom preconditions.
1434 Expanded strings are described in chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&.
1435 .endlist
1436
1437
1438 Note that &%require_files%& comes near the end of the list, so you cannot use
1439 it to check for the existence of a file in which to lookup up a domain, local
1440 part, or sender. However, as these options are all expanded, you can use the
1441 &%exists%& expansion condition to make such tests within each condition. The
1442 &%require_files%& option is intended for checking files that the router may be
1443 going to use internally, or which are needed by a specific transport (for
1444 example, &_.procmailrc_&).
1445
1446
1447
1448 .section "Delivery in detail" "SECID18"
1449 .cindex "delivery" "in detail"
1450 When a message is to be delivered, the sequence of events is as follows:
1451
1452 .ilist
1453 If a system-wide filter file is specified, the message is passed to it. The
1454 filter may add recipients to the message, replace the recipients, discard the
1455 message, cause a new message to be generated, or cause the message delivery to
1456 fail. The format of the system filter file is the same as for Exim user filter
1457 files, described in the separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail
1458 filtering'&.
1459 .cindex "Sieve filter" "not available for system filter"
1460 (&*Note*&: Sieve cannot be used for system filter files.)
1461
1462 Some additional features are available in system filters &-- see chapter
1463 &<<CHAPsystemfilter>>& for details. Note that a message is passed to the system
1464 filter only once per delivery attempt, however many recipients it has. However,
1465 if there are several delivery attempts because one or more addresses could not
1466 be immediately delivered, the system filter is run each time. The filter
1467 condition &%first_delivery%& can be used to detect the first run of the system
1468 filter.
1469 .next
1470 Each recipient address is offered to each configured router in turn, subject to
1471 its preconditions, until one is able to handle it. If no router can handle the
1472 address, that is, if they all decline, the address is failed. Because routers
1473 can be targeted at particular domains, several locally handled domains can be
1474 processed entirely independently of each other.
1475 .next
1476 .cindex "routing" "loops in"
1477 .cindex "loop" "while routing"
1478 A router that accepts an address may assign it to a local or a remote
1479 transport. However, the transport is not run at this time. Instead, the address
1480 is placed on a list for the particular transport, which will be run later.
1481 Alternatively, the router may generate one or more new addresses (typically
1482 from alias, forward, or filter files). New addresses are fed back into this
1483 process from the top, but in order to avoid loops, a router ignores any address
1484 which has an identically-named ancestor that was processed by itself.
1485 .next
1486 When all the routing has been done, addresses that have been successfully
1487 handled are passed to their assigned transports. When local transports are
1488 doing real local deliveries, they handle only one address at a time, but if a
1489 local transport is being used as a pseudo-remote transport (for example, to
1490 collect batched SMTP messages for transmission by some other means) multiple
1491 addresses can be handled. Remote transports can always handle more than one
1492 address at a time, but can be configured not to do so, or to restrict multiple
1493 addresses to the same domain.
1494 .next
1495 Each local delivery to a file or a pipe runs in a separate process under a
1496 non-privileged uid, and these deliveries are run one at a time. Remote
1497 deliveries also run in separate processes, normally under a uid that is private
1498 to Exim (&"the Exim user"&), but in this case, several remote deliveries can be
1499 run in parallel. The maximum number of simultaneous remote deliveries for any
1500 one message is set by the &%remote_max_parallel%& option.
1501 The order in which deliveries are done is not defined, except that all local
1502 deliveries happen before any remote deliveries.
1503 .next
1504 .cindex "queue runner"
1505 When it encounters a local delivery during a queue run, Exim checks its retry
1506 database to see if there has been a previous temporary delivery failure for the
1507 address before running the local transport. If there was a previous failure,
1508 Exim does not attempt a new delivery until the retry time for the address is
1509 reached. However, this happens only for delivery attempts that are part of a
1510 queue run. Local deliveries are always attempted when delivery immediately
1511 follows message reception, even if retry times are set for them. This makes for
1512 better behaviour if one particular message is causing problems (for example,
1513 causing quota overflow, or provoking an error in a filter file).
1514 .next
1515 .cindex "delivery" "retry in remote transports"
1516 Remote transports do their own retry handling, since an address may be
1517 deliverable to one of a number of hosts, each of which may have a different
1518 retry time. If there have been previous temporary failures and no host has
1519 reached its retry time, no delivery is attempted, whether in a queue run or
1520 not. See chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& for details of retry strategies.
1521 .next
1522 If there were any permanent errors, a bounce message is returned to an
1523 appropriate address (the sender in the common case), with details of the error
1524 for each failing address. Exim can be configured to send copies of bounce
1525 messages to other addresses.
1526 .next
1527 .cindex "delivery" "deferral"
1528 If one or more addresses suffered a temporary failure, the message is left on
1529 the queue, to be tried again later. Delivery of these addresses is said to be
1530 &'deferred'&.
1531 .next
1532 When all the recipient addresses have either been delivered or bounced,
1533 handling of the message is complete. The spool files and message log are
1534 deleted, though the message log can optionally be preserved if required.
1535 .endlist
1536
1537
1538
1539
1540 .section "Retry mechanism" "SECID19"
1541 .cindex "delivery" "retry mechanism"
1542 .cindex "retry" "description of mechanism"
1543 .cindex "queue runner"
1544 Exim's mechanism for retrying messages that fail to get delivered at the first
1545 attempt is the queue runner process. You must either run an Exim daemon that
1546 uses the &%-q%& option with a time interval to start queue runners at regular
1547 intervals, or use some other means (such as &'cron'&) to start them. If you do
1548 not arrange for queue runners to be run, messages that fail temporarily at the
1549 first attempt will remain on your queue for ever. A queue runner process works
1550 its way through the queue, one message at a time, trying each delivery that has
1551 passed its retry time.
1552 You can run several queue runners at once.
1553
1554 Exim uses a set of configured rules to determine when next to retry the failing
1555 address (see chapter &<<CHAPretry>>&). These rules also specify when Exim
1556 should give up trying to deliver to the address, at which point it generates a
1557 bounce message. If no retry rules are set for a particular host, address, and
1558 error combination, no retries are attempted, and temporary errors are treated
1559 as permanent.
1560
1561
1562
1563 .section "Temporary delivery failure" "SECID20"
1564 .cindex "delivery" "temporary failure"
1565 There are many reasons why a message may not be immediately deliverable to a
1566 particular address. Failure to connect to a remote machine (because it, or the
1567 connection to it, is down) is one of the most common. Temporary failures may be
1568 detected during routing as well as during the transport stage of delivery.
1569 Local deliveries may be delayed if NFS files are unavailable, or if a mailbox
1570 is on a file system where the user is over quota. Exim can be configured to
1571 impose its own quotas on local mailboxes; where system quotas are set they will
1572 also apply.
1573
1574 If a host is unreachable for a period of time, a number of messages may be
1575 waiting for it by the time it recovers, and sending them in a single SMTP
1576 connection is clearly beneficial. Whenever a delivery to a remote host is
1577 deferred,
1578 .cindex "hints database"
1579 Exim makes a note in its hints database, and whenever a successful
1580 SMTP delivery has happened, it looks to see if any other messages are waiting
1581 for the same host. If any are found, they are sent over the same SMTP
1582 connection, subject to a configuration limit as to the maximum number in any
1583 one connection.
1584
1585
1586
1587 .section "Permanent delivery failure" "SECID21"
1588 .cindex "delivery" "permanent failure"
1589 .cindex "bounce message" "when generated"
1590 When a message cannot be delivered to some or all of its intended recipients, a
1591 bounce message is generated. Temporary delivery failures turn into permanent
1592 errors when their timeout expires. All the addresses that fail in a given
1593 delivery attempt are listed in a single message. If the original message has
1594 many recipients, it is possible for some addresses to fail in one delivery
1595 attempt and others to fail subsequently, giving rise to more than one bounce
1596 message. The wording of bounce messages can be customized by the administrator.
1597 See chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>& for details.
1598
1599 .cindex "&'X-Failed-Recipients:'& header line"
1600 Bounce messages contain an &'X-Failed-Recipients:'& header line that lists the
1601 failed addresses, for the benefit of programs that try to analyse such messages
1602 automatically.
1603
1604 .cindex "bounce message" "recipient of"
1605 A bounce message is normally sent to the sender of the original message, as
1606 obtained from the message's envelope. For incoming SMTP messages, this is the
1607 address given in the MAIL command. However, when an address is expanded via a
1608 forward or alias file, an alternative address can be specified for delivery
1609 failures of the generated addresses. For a mailing list expansion (see section
1610 &<<SECTmailinglists>>&) it is common to direct bounce messages to the manager
1611 of the list.
1612
1613
1614
1615 .section "Failures to deliver bounce messages" "SECID22"
1616 .cindex "bounce message" "failure to deliver"
1617 If a bounce message (either locally generated or received from a remote host)
1618 itself suffers a permanent delivery failure, the message is left on the queue,
1619 but it is frozen, awaiting the attention of an administrator. There are options
1620 that can be used to make Exim discard such failed messages, or to keep them
1621 for only a short time (see &%timeout_frozen_after%& and
1622 &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&).
1623
1624
1625
1626
1627
1628 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
1629 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
1630
1631 .chapter "Building and installing Exim" "CHID3"
1632 .scindex IIDbuex "building Exim"
1633
1634 .section "Unpacking" "SECID23"
1635 Exim is distributed as a gzipped or bzipped tar file which, when unpacked,
1636 creates a directory with the name of the current release (for example,
1637 &_exim-&version()_&) into which the following files are placed:
1638
1639 .table2 140pt
1640 .irow &_ACKNOWLEDGMENTS_& "contains some acknowledgments"
1641 .irow &_CHANGES_& "contains a reference to where changes are &&&
1642 documented"
1643 .irow &_LICENCE_& "the GNU General Public Licence"
1644 .irow &_Makefile_& "top-level make file"
1645 .irow &_NOTICE_& "conditions for the use of Exim"
1646 .irow &_README_& "list of files, directories and simple build &&&
1647 instructions"
1648 .endtable
1649
1650 Other files whose names begin with &_README_& may also be present. The
1651 following subdirectories are created:
1652
1653 .table2 140pt
1654 .irow &_Local_& "an empty directory for local configuration files"
1655 .irow &_OS_& "OS-specific files"
1656 .irow &_doc_& "documentation files"
1657 .irow &_exim_monitor_& "source files for the Exim monitor"
1658 .irow &_scripts_& "scripts used in the build process"
1659 .irow &_src_& "remaining source files"
1660 .irow &_util_& "independent utilities"
1661 .endtable
1662
1663 The main utility programs are contained in the &_src_& directory, and are built
1664 with the Exim binary. The &_util_& directory contains a few optional scripts
1665 that may be useful to some sites.
1666
1667
1668 .section "Multiple machine architectures and operating systems" "SECID24"
1669 .cindex "building Exim" "multiple OS/architectures"
1670 The building process for Exim is arranged to make it easy to build binaries for
1671 a number of different architectures and operating systems from the same set of
1672 source files. Compilation does not take place in the &_src_& directory.
1673 Instead, a &'build directory'& is created for each architecture and operating
1674 system.
1675 .cindex "symbolic link" "to build directory"
1676 Symbolic links to the sources are installed in this directory, which is where
1677 the actual building takes place. In most cases, Exim can discover the machine
1678 architecture and operating system for itself, but the defaults can be
1679 overridden if necessary.
1680
1681
1682 .section "PCRE library" "SECTpcre"
1683 .cindex "PCRE library"
1684 Exim no longer has an embedded PCRE library as the vast majority of
1685 modern systems include PCRE as a system library, although you may need
1686 to install the PCRE or PCRE development package for your operating
1687 system. If your system has a normal PCRE installation the Exim build
1688 process will need no further configuration. If the library or the
1689 headers are in an unusual location you will need to either set the PCRE_LIBS
1690 and INCLUDE directives appropriately,
1691 or set PCRE_CONFIG=yes to use the installed &(pcre-config)& command.
1692 If your operating system has no
1693 PCRE support then you will need to obtain and build the current PCRE
1694 from &url(ftp://ftp.csx.cam.ac.uk/pub/software/programming/pcre/).
1695 More information on PCRE is available at &url(http://www.pcre.org/).
1696
1697 .section "DBM libraries" "SECTdb"
1698 .cindex "DBM libraries" "discussion of"
1699 .cindex "hints database" "DBM files used for"
1700 Even if you do not use any DBM files in your configuration, Exim still needs a
1701 DBM library in order to operate, because it uses indexed files for its hints
1702 databases. Unfortunately, there are a number of DBM libraries in existence, and
1703 different operating systems often have different ones installed.
1704
1705 .cindex "Solaris" "DBM library for"
1706 .cindex "IRIX, DBM library for"
1707 .cindex "BSD, DBM library for"
1708 .cindex "Linux, DBM library for"
1709 If you are using Solaris, IRIX, one of the modern BSD systems, or a modern
1710 Linux distribution, the DBM configuration should happen automatically, and you
1711 may be able to ignore this section. Otherwise, you may have to learn more than
1712 you would like about DBM libraries from what follows.
1713
1714 .cindex "&'ndbm'& DBM library"
1715 Licensed versions of Unix normally contain a library of DBM functions operating
1716 via the &'ndbm'& interface, and this is what Exim expects by default. Free
1717 versions of Unix seem to vary in what they contain as standard. In particular,
1718 some early versions of Linux have no default DBM library, and different
1719 distributors have chosen to bundle different libraries with their packaged
1720 versions. However, the more recent releases seem to have standardized on the
1721 Berkeley DB library.
1722
1723 Different DBM libraries have different conventions for naming the files they
1724 use. When a program opens a file called &_dbmfile_&, there are several
1725 possibilities:
1726
1727 .olist
1728 A traditional &'ndbm'& implementation, such as that supplied as part of
1729 Solaris, operates on two files called &_dbmfile.dir_& and &_dbmfile.pag_&.
1730 .next
1731 .cindex "&'gdbm'& DBM library"
1732 The GNU library, &'gdbm'&, operates on a single file. If used via its &'ndbm'&
1733 compatibility interface it makes two different hard links to it with names
1734 &_dbmfile.dir_& and &_dbmfile.pag_&, but if used via its native interface, the
1735 file name is used unmodified.
1736 .next
1737 .cindex "Berkeley DB library"
1738 The Berkeley DB package, if called via its &'ndbm'& compatibility interface,
1739 operates on a single file called &_dbmfile.db_&, but otherwise looks to the
1740 programmer exactly the same as the traditional &'ndbm'& implementation.
1741 .next
1742 If the Berkeley package is used in its native mode, it operates on a single
1743 file called &_dbmfile_&; the programmer's interface is somewhat different to
1744 the traditional &'ndbm'& interface.
1745 .next
1746 To complicate things further, there are several very different versions of the
1747 Berkeley DB package. Version 1.85 was stable for a very long time, releases
1748 2.&'x'& and 3.&'x'& were current for a while, but the latest versions are now
1749 numbered 4.&'x'&. Maintenance of some of the earlier releases has ceased. All
1750 versions of Berkeley DB can be obtained from
1751 &url(http://www.sleepycat.com/).
1752 .next
1753 .cindex "&'tdb'& DBM library"
1754 Yet another DBM library, called &'tdb'&, is available from
1755 &url(http://download.sourceforge.net/tdb). It has its own interface, and also
1756 operates on a single file.
1757 .endlist
1758
1759 .cindex "USE_DB"
1760 .cindex "DBM libraries" "configuration for building"
1761 Exim and its utilities can be compiled to use any of these interfaces. In order
1762 to use any version of the Berkeley DB package in native mode, you must set
1763 USE_DB in an appropriate configuration file (typically
1764 &_Local/Makefile_&). For example:
1765 .code
1766 USE_DB=yes
1767 .endd
1768 Similarly, for gdbm you set USE_GDBM, and for tdb you set USE_TDB. An
1769 error is diagnosed if you set more than one of these.
1770
1771 At the lowest level, the build-time configuration sets none of these options,
1772 thereby assuming an interface of type (1). However, some operating system
1773 configuration files (for example, those for the BSD operating systems and
1774 Linux) assume type (4) by setting USE_DB as their default, and the
1775 configuration files for Cygwin set USE_GDBM. Anything you set in
1776 &_Local/Makefile_&, however, overrides these system defaults.
1777
1778 As well as setting USE_DB, USE_GDBM, or USE_TDB, it may also be
1779 necessary to set DBMLIB, to cause inclusion of the appropriate library, as
1780 in one of these lines:
1781 .code
1782 DBMLIB = -ldb
1783 DBMLIB = -ltdb
1784 .endd
1785 Settings like that will work if the DBM library is installed in the standard
1786 place. Sometimes it is not, and the library's header file may also not be in
1787 the default path. You may need to set INCLUDE to specify where the header
1788 file is, and to specify the path to the library more fully in DBMLIB, as in
1789 this example:
1790 .code
1791 INCLUDE=-I/usr/local/include/db-4.1
1792 DBMLIB=/usr/local/lib/db-4.1/libdb.a
1793 .endd
1794 There is further detailed discussion about the various DBM libraries in the
1795 file &_doc/dbm.discuss.txt_& in the Exim distribution.
1796
1797
1798
1799 .section "Pre-building configuration" "SECID25"
1800 .cindex "building Exim" "pre-building configuration"
1801 .cindex "configuration for building Exim"
1802 .cindex "&_Local/Makefile_&"
1803 .cindex "&_src/EDITME_&"
1804 Before building Exim, a local configuration file that specifies options
1805 independent of any operating system has to be created with the name
1806 &_Local/Makefile_&. A template for this file is supplied as the file
1807 &_src/EDITME_&, and it contains full descriptions of all the option settings
1808 therein. These descriptions are therefore not repeated here. If you are
1809 building Exim for the first time, the simplest thing to do is to copy
1810 &_src/EDITME_& to &_Local/Makefile_&, then read it and edit it appropriately.
1811
1812 There are three settings that you must supply, because Exim will not build
1813 without them. They are the location of the run time configuration file
1814 (CONFIGURE_FILE), the directory in which Exim binaries will be installed
1815 (BIN_DIRECTORY), and the identity of the Exim user (EXIM_USER and
1816 maybe EXIM_GROUP as well). The value of CONFIGURE_FILE can in fact be
1817 a colon-separated list of file names; Exim uses the first of them that exists.
1818
1819 There are a few other parameters that can be specified either at build time or
1820 at run time, to enable the same binary to be used on a number of different
1821 machines. However, if the locations of Exim's spool directory and log file
1822 directory (if not within the spool directory) are fixed, it is recommended that
1823 you specify them in &_Local/Makefile_& instead of at run time, so that errors
1824 detected early in Exim's execution (such as a malformed configuration file) can
1825 be logged.
1826
1827 .cindex "content scanning" "specifying at build time"
1828 Exim's interfaces for calling virus and spam scanning software directly from
1829 access control lists are not compiled by default. If you want to include these
1830 facilities, you need to set
1831 .code
1832 WITH_CONTENT_SCAN=yes
1833 .endd
1834 in your &_Local/Makefile_&. For details of the facilities themselves, see
1835 chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
1836
1837
1838 .cindex "&_Local/eximon.conf_&"
1839 .cindex "&_exim_monitor/EDITME_&"
1840 If you are going to build the Exim monitor, a similar configuration process is
1841 required. The file &_exim_monitor/EDITME_& must be edited appropriately for
1842 your installation and saved under the name &_Local/eximon.conf_&. If you are
1843 happy with the default settings described in &_exim_monitor/EDITME_&,
1844 &_Local/eximon.conf_& can be empty, but it must exist.
1845
1846 This is all the configuration that is needed in straightforward cases for known
1847 operating systems. However, the building process is set up so that it is easy
1848 to override options that are set by default or by operating-system-specific
1849 configuration files, for example to change the name of the C compiler, which
1850 defaults to &%gcc%&. See section &<<SECToverride>>& below for details of how to
1851 do this.
1852
1853
1854
1855 .section "Support for iconv()" "SECID26"
1856 .cindex "&[iconv()]& support"
1857 .cindex "RFC 2047"
1858 The contents of header lines in messages may be encoded according to the rules
1859 described RFC 2047. This makes it possible to transmit characters that are not
1860 in the ASCII character set, and to label them as being in a particular
1861 character set. When Exim is inspecting header lines by means of the &%$h_%&
1862 mechanism, it decodes them, and translates them into a specified character set
1863 (default ISO-8859-1). The translation is possible only if the operating system
1864 supports the &[iconv()]& function.
1865
1866 However, some of the operating systems that supply &[iconv()]& do not support
1867 very many conversions. The GNU &%libiconv%& library (available from
1868 &url(http://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv/)) can be installed on such
1869 systems to remedy this deficiency, as well as on systems that do not supply
1870 &[iconv()]& at all. After installing &%libiconv%&, you should add
1871 .code
1872 HAVE_ICONV=yes
1873 .endd
1874 to your &_Local/Makefile_& and rebuild Exim.
1875
1876
1877
1878 .section "Including TLS/SSL encryption support" "SECTinctlsssl"
1879 .cindex "TLS" "including support for TLS"
1880 .cindex "encryption" "including support for"
1881 .cindex "SUPPORT_TLS"
1882 .cindex "OpenSSL" "building Exim with"
1883 .cindex "GnuTLS" "building Exim with"
1884 Exim can be built to support encrypted SMTP connections, using the STARTTLS
1885 command as per RFC 2487. It can also support legacy clients that expect to
1886 start a TLS session immediately on connection to a non-standard port (see the
1887 &%tls_on_connect_ports%& runtime option and the &%-tls-on-connect%& command
1888 line option).
1889
1890 If you want to build Exim with TLS support, you must first install either the
1891 OpenSSL or GnuTLS library. There is no cryptographic code in Exim itself for
1892 implementing SSL.
1893
1894 If OpenSSL is installed, you should set
1895 .code
1896 SUPPORT_TLS=yes
1897 TLS_LIBS=-lssl -lcrypto
1898 .endd
1899 in &_Local/Makefile_&. You may also need to specify the locations of the
1900 OpenSSL library and include files. For example:
1901 .code
1902 SUPPORT_TLS=yes
1903 TLS_LIBS=-L/usr/local/openssl/lib -lssl -lcrypto
1904 TLS_INCLUDE=-I/usr/local/openssl/include/
1905 .endd
1906 .cindex "pkg-config" "OpenSSL"
1907 If you have &'pkg-config'& available, then instead you can just use:
1908 .code
1909 SUPPORT_TLS=yes
1910 USE_OPENSSL_PC=openssl
1911 .endd
1912 .cindex "USE_GNUTLS"
1913 If GnuTLS is installed, you should set
1914 .code
1915 SUPPORT_TLS=yes
1916 USE_GNUTLS=yes
1917 TLS_LIBS=-lgnutls -ltasn1 -lgcrypt
1918 .endd
1919 in &_Local/Makefile_&, and again you may need to specify the locations of the
1920 library and include files. For example:
1921 .code
1922 SUPPORT_TLS=yes
1923 USE_GNUTLS=yes
1924 TLS_LIBS=-L/usr/gnu/lib -lgnutls -ltasn1 -lgcrypt
1925 TLS_INCLUDE=-I/usr/gnu/include
1926 .endd
1927 .cindex "pkg-config" "GnuTLS"
1928 If you have &'pkg-config'& available, then instead you can just use:
1929 .code
1930 SUPPORT_TLS=yes
1931 USE_GNUTLS=yes
1932 USE_GNUTLS_PC=gnutls
1933 .endd
1934
1935 You do not need to set TLS_INCLUDE if the relevant directory is already
1936 specified in INCLUDE. Details of how to configure Exim to make use of TLS are
1937 given in chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&.
1938
1939
1940
1941
1942 .section "Use of tcpwrappers" "SECID27"
1943
1944 .cindex "tcpwrappers, building Exim to support"
1945 .cindex "USE_TCP_WRAPPERS"
1946 .cindex "TCP_WRAPPERS_DAEMON_NAME"
1947 .cindex "tcp_wrappers_daemon_name"
1948 Exim can be linked with the &'tcpwrappers'& library in order to check incoming
1949 SMTP calls using the &'tcpwrappers'& control files. This may be a convenient
1950 alternative to Exim's own checking facilities for installations that are
1951 already making use of &'tcpwrappers'& for other purposes. To do this, you
1952 should set USE_TCP_WRAPPERS in &_Local/Makefile_&, arrange for the file
1953 &_tcpd.h_& to be available at compile time, and also ensure that the library
1954 &_libwrap.a_& is available at link time, typically by including &%-lwrap%& in
1955 EXTRALIBS_EXIM. For example, if &'tcpwrappers'& is installed in &_/usr/local_&,
1956 you might have
1957 .code
1958 USE_TCP_WRAPPERS=yes
1959 CFLAGS=-O -I/usr/local/include
1960 EXTRALIBS_EXIM=-L/usr/local/lib -lwrap
1961 .endd
1962 in &_Local/Makefile_&. The daemon name to use in the &'tcpwrappers'& control
1963 files is &"exim"&. For example, the line
1964 .code
1965 exim : LOCAL 192.168.1. .friendly.domain.example
1966 .endd
1967 in your &_/etc/hosts.allow_& file allows connections from the local host, from
1968 the subnet 192.168.1.0/24, and from all hosts in &'friendly.domain.example'&.
1969 All other connections are denied. The daemon name used by &'tcpwrappers'&
1970 can be changed at build time by setting TCP_WRAPPERS_DAEMON_NAME in
1971 &_Local/Makefile_&, or by setting tcp_wrappers_daemon_name in the
1972 configure file. Consult the &'tcpwrappers'& documentation for
1973 further details.
1974
1975
1976 .section "Including support for IPv6" "SECID28"
1977 .cindex "IPv6" "including support for"
1978 Exim contains code for use on systems that have IPv6 support. Setting
1979 &`HAVE_IPV6=YES`& in &_Local/Makefile_& causes the IPv6 code to be included;
1980 it may also be necessary to set IPV6_INCLUDE and IPV6_LIBS on systems
1981 where the IPv6 support is not fully integrated into the normal include and
1982 library files.
1983
1984 Two different types of DNS record for handling IPv6 addresses have been
1985 defined. AAAA records (analogous to A records for IPv4) are in use, and are
1986 currently seen as the mainstream. Another record type called A6 was proposed
1987 as better than AAAA because it had more flexibility. However, it was felt to be
1988 over-complex, and its status was reduced to &"experimental"&. It is not known
1989 if anyone is actually using A6 records. Exim has support for A6 records, but
1990 this is included only if you set &`SUPPORT_A6=YES`& in &_Local/Makefile_&. The
1991 support has not been tested for some time.
1992
1993
1994
1995 .section "Dynamically loaded lookup module support" "SECTdynamicmodules"
1996 .cindex "lookup modules"
1997 .cindex "dynamic modules"
1998 .cindex ".so building"
1999 On some platforms, Exim supports not compiling all lookup types directly into
2000 the main binary, instead putting some into external modules which can be loaded
2001 on demand.
2002 This permits packagers to build Exim with support for lookups with extensive
2003 library dependencies without requiring all users to install all of those
2004 dependencies.
2005 Most, but not all, lookup types can be built this way.
2006
2007 Set &`LOOKUP_MODULE_DIR`& to the directory into which the modules will be
2008 installed; Exim will only load modules from that directory, as a security
2009 measure. You will need to set &`CFLAGS_DYNAMIC`& if not already defined
2010 for your OS; see &_OS/Makefile-Linux_& for an example.
2011 Some other requirements for adjusting &`EXTRALIBS`& may also be necessary,
2012 see &_src/EDITME_& for details.
2013
2014 Then, for each module to be loaded dynamically, define the relevant
2015 &`LOOKUP_`&<&'lookup_type'&> flags to have the value "2" instead of "yes".
2016 For example, this will build in lsearch but load sqlite and mysql support
2017 on demand:
2018 .code
2019 LOOKUP_LSEARCH=yes
2020 LOOKUP_SQLITE=2
2021 LOOKUP_MYSQL=2
2022 .endd
2023
2024
2025 .section "The building process" "SECID29"
2026 .cindex "build directory"
2027 Once &_Local/Makefile_& (and &_Local/eximon.conf_&, if required) have been
2028 created, run &'make'& at the top level. It determines the architecture and
2029 operating system types, and creates a build directory if one does not exist.
2030 For example, on a Sun system running Solaris 8, the directory
2031 &_build-SunOS5-5.8-sparc_& is created.
2032 .cindex "symbolic link" "to source files"
2033 Symbolic links to relevant source files are installed in the build directory.
2034
2035 &*Warning*&: The &%-j%& (parallel) flag must not be used with &'make'&; the
2036 building process fails if it is set.
2037
2038 If this is the first time &'make'& has been run, it calls a script that builds
2039 a make file inside the build directory, using the configuration files from the
2040 &_Local_& directory. The new make file is then passed to another instance of
2041 &'make'&. This does the real work, building a number of utility scripts, and
2042 then compiling and linking the binaries for the Exim monitor (if configured), a
2043 number of utility programs, and finally Exim itself. The command &`make
2044 makefile`& can be used to force a rebuild of the make file in the build
2045 directory, should this ever be necessary.
2046
2047 If you have problems building Exim, check for any comments there may be in the
2048 &_README_& file concerning your operating system, and also take a look at the
2049 FAQ, where some common problems are covered.
2050
2051
2052
2053 .section 'Output from &"make"&' "SECID283"
2054 The output produced by the &'make'& process for compile lines is often very
2055 unreadable, because these lines can be very long. For this reason, the normal
2056 output is suppressed by default, and instead output similar to that which
2057 appears when compiling the 2.6 Linux kernel is generated: just a short line for
2058 each module that is being compiled or linked. However, it is still possible to
2059 get the full output, by calling &'make'& like this:
2060 .code
2061 FULLECHO='' make -e
2062 .endd
2063 The value of FULLECHO defaults to &"@"&, the flag character that suppresses
2064 command reflection in &'make'&. When you ask for the full output, it is
2065 given in addition to the short output.
2066
2067
2068
2069 .section "Overriding build-time options for Exim" "SECToverride"
2070 .cindex "build-time options, overriding"
2071 The main make file that is created at the beginning of the building process
2072 consists of the concatenation of a number of files which set configuration
2073 values, followed by a fixed set of &'make'& instructions. If a value is set
2074 more than once, the last setting overrides any previous ones. This provides a
2075 convenient way of overriding defaults. The files that are concatenated are, in
2076 order:
2077 .display
2078 &_OS/Makefile-Default_&
2079 &_OS/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>
2080 &_Local/Makefile_&
2081 &_Local/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>
2082 &_Local/Makefile-_&<&'archtype'&>
2083 &_Local/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>-<&'archtype'&>
2084 &_OS/Makefile-Base_&
2085 .endd
2086 .cindex "&_Local/Makefile_&"
2087 .cindex "building Exim" "operating system type"
2088 .cindex "building Exim" "architecture type"
2089 where <&'ostype'&> is the operating system type and <&'archtype'&> is the
2090 architecture type. &_Local/Makefile_& is required to exist, and the building
2091 process fails if it is absent. The other three &_Local_& files are optional,
2092 and are often not needed.
2093
2094 The values used for <&'ostype'&> and <&'archtype'&> are obtained from scripts
2095 called &_scripts/os-type_& and &_scripts/arch-type_& respectively. If either of
2096 the environment variables EXIM_OSTYPE or EXIM_ARCHTYPE is set, their
2097 values are used, thereby providing a means of forcing particular settings.
2098 Otherwise, the scripts try to get values from the &%uname%& command. If this
2099 fails, the shell variables OSTYPE and ARCHTYPE are inspected. A number
2100 of &'ad hoc'& transformations are then applied, to produce the standard names
2101 that Exim expects. You can run these scripts directly from the shell in order
2102 to find out what values are being used on your system.
2103
2104
2105 &_OS/Makefile-Default_& contains comments about the variables that are set
2106 therein. Some (but not all) are mentioned below. If there is something that
2107 needs changing, review the contents of this file and the contents of the make
2108 file for your operating system (&_OS/Makefile-<ostype>_&) to see what the
2109 default values are.
2110
2111
2112 .cindex "building Exim" "overriding default settings"
2113 If you need to change any of the values that are set in &_OS/Makefile-Default_&
2114 or in &_OS/Makefile-<ostype>_&, or to add any new definitions, you do not
2115 need to change the original files. Instead, you should make the changes by
2116 putting the new values in an appropriate &_Local_& file. For example,
2117 .cindex "Tru64-Unix build-time settings"
2118 when building Exim in many releases of the Tru64-Unix (formerly Digital UNIX,
2119 formerly DEC-OSF1) operating system, it is necessary to specify that the C
2120 compiler is called &'cc'& rather than &'gcc'&. Also, the compiler must be
2121 called with the option &%-std1%&, to make it recognize some of the features of
2122 Standard C that Exim uses. (Most other compilers recognize Standard C by
2123 default.) To do this, you should create a file called &_Local/Makefile-OSF1_&
2124 containing the lines
2125 .code
2126 CC=cc
2127 CFLAGS=-std1
2128 .endd
2129 If you are compiling for just one operating system, it may be easier to put
2130 these lines directly into &_Local/Makefile_&.
2131
2132 Keeping all your local configuration settings separate from the distributed
2133 files makes it easy to transfer them to new versions of Exim simply by copying
2134 the contents of the &_Local_& directory.
2135
2136
2137 .cindex "NIS lookup type" "including support for"
2138 .cindex "NIS+ lookup type" "including support for"
2139 .cindex "LDAP" "including support for"
2140 .cindex "lookup" "inclusion in binary"
2141 Exim contains support for doing LDAP, NIS, NIS+, and other kinds of file
2142 lookup, but not all systems have these components installed, so the default is
2143 not to include the relevant code in the binary. All the different kinds of file
2144 and database lookup that Exim supports are implemented as separate code modules
2145 which are included only if the relevant compile-time options are set. In the
2146 case of LDAP, NIS, and NIS+, the settings for &_Local/Makefile_& are:
2147 .code
2148 LOOKUP_LDAP=yes
2149 LOOKUP_NIS=yes
2150 LOOKUP_NISPLUS=yes
2151 .endd
2152 and similar settings apply to the other lookup types. They are all listed in
2153 &_src/EDITME_&. In many cases the relevant include files and interface
2154 libraries need to be installed before compiling Exim.
2155 .cindex "cdb" "including support for"
2156 However, there are some optional lookup types (such as cdb) for which
2157 the code is entirely contained within Exim, and no external include
2158 files or libraries are required. When a lookup type is not included in the
2159 binary, attempts to configure Exim to use it cause run time configuration
2160 errors.
2161
2162 .cindex "pkg-config" "lookups"
2163 .cindex "pkg-config" "authenticators"
2164 Many systems now use a tool called &'pkg-config'& to encapsulate information
2165 about how to compile against a library; Exim has some initial support for
2166 being able to use pkg-config for lookups and authenticators. For any given
2167 makefile variable which starts &`LOOKUP_`& or &`AUTH_`&, you can add a new
2168 variable with the &`_PC`& suffix in the name and assign as the value the
2169 name of the package to be queried. The results of querying via the
2170 &'pkg-config'& command will be added to the appropriate Makefile variables
2171 with &`+=`& directives, so your version of &'make'& will need to support that
2172 syntax. For instance:
2173 .code
2174 LOOKUP_SQLITE=yes
2175 LOOKUP_SQLITE_PC=sqlite3
2176 AUTH_GSASL=yes
2177 AUTH_GSASL_PC=libgsasl
2178 AUTH_HEIMDAL_GSSAPI=yes
2179 AUTH_HEIMDAL_GSSAPI_PC=heimdal-gssapi
2180 .endd
2181
2182 .cindex "Perl" "including support for"
2183 Exim can be linked with an embedded Perl interpreter, allowing Perl
2184 subroutines to be called during string expansion. To enable this facility,
2185 .code
2186 EXIM_PERL=perl.o
2187 .endd
2188 must be defined in &_Local/Makefile_&. Details of this facility are given in
2189 chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&.
2190
2191 .cindex "X11 libraries, location of"
2192 The location of the X11 libraries is something that varies a lot between
2193 operating systems, and there may be different versions of X11 to cope
2194 with. Exim itself makes no use of X11, but if you are compiling the Exim
2195 monitor, the X11 libraries must be available.
2196 The following three variables are set in &_OS/Makefile-Default_&:
2197 .code
2198 X11=/usr/X11R6
2199 XINCLUDE=-I$(X11)/include
2200 XLFLAGS=-L$(X11)/lib
2201 .endd
2202 These are overridden in some of the operating-system configuration files. For
2203 example, in &_OS/Makefile-SunOS5_& there is
2204 .code
2205 X11=/usr/openwin
2206 XINCLUDE=-I$(X11)/include
2207 XLFLAGS=-L$(X11)/lib -R$(X11)/lib
2208 .endd
2209 If you need to override the default setting for your operating system, place a
2210 definition of all three of these variables into your
2211 &_Local/Makefile-<ostype>_& file.
2212
2213 .cindex "EXTRALIBS"
2214 If you need to add any extra libraries to the link steps, these can be put in a
2215 variable called EXTRALIBS, which appears in all the link commands, but by
2216 default is not defined. In contrast, EXTRALIBS_EXIM is used only on the
2217 command for linking the main Exim binary, and not for any associated utilities.
2218
2219 .cindex "DBM libraries" "configuration for building"
2220 There is also DBMLIB, which appears in the link commands for binaries that
2221 use DBM functions (see also section &<<SECTdb>>&). Finally, there is
2222 EXTRALIBS_EXIMON, which appears only in the link step for the Exim monitor
2223 binary, and which can be used, for example, to include additional X11
2224 libraries.
2225
2226 .cindex "configuration file" "editing"
2227 The make file copes with rebuilding Exim correctly if any of the configuration
2228 files are edited. However, if an optional configuration file is deleted, it is
2229 necessary to touch the associated non-optional file (that is,
2230 &_Local/Makefile_& or &_Local/eximon.conf_&) before rebuilding.
2231
2232
2233 .section "OS-specific header files" "SECID30"
2234 .cindex "&_os.h_&"
2235 .cindex "building Exim" "OS-specific C header files"
2236 The &_OS_& directory contains a number of files with names of the form
2237 &_os.h-<ostype>_&. These are system-specific C header files that should not
2238 normally need to be changed. There is a list of macro settings that are
2239 recognized in the file &_OS/os.configuring_&, which should be consulted if you
2240 are porting Exim to a new operating system.
2241
2242
2243
2244 .section "Overriding build-time options for the monitor" "SECID31"
2245 .cindex "building Eximon"
2246 A similar process is used for overriding things when building the Exim monitor,
2247 where the files that are involved are
2248 .display
2249 &_OS/eximon.conf-Default_&
2250 &_OS/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>
2251 &_Local/eximon.conf_&
2252 &_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>
2253 &_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'archtype'&>
2254 &_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>-<&'archtype'&>
2255 .endd
2256 .cindex "&_Local/eximon.conf_&"
2257 As with Exim itself, the final three files need not exist, and in this case the
2258 &_OS/eximon.conf-<ostype>_& file is also optional. The default values in
2259 &_OS/eximon.conf-Default_& can be overridden dynamically by setting environment
2260 variables of the same name, preceded by EXIMON_. For example, setting
2261 EXIMON_LOG_DEPTH in the environment overrides the value of
2262 LOG_DEPTH at run time.
2263 .ecindex IIDbuex
2264
2265
2266 .section "Installing Exim binaries and scripts" "SECID32"
2267 .cindex "installing Exim"
2268 .cindex "BIN_DIRECTORY"
2269 The command &`make install`& runs the &(exim_install)& script with no
2270 arguments. The script copies binaries and utility scripts into the directory
2271 whose name is specified by the BIN_DIRECTORY setting in &_Local/Makefile_&.
2272 .cindex "setuid" "installing Exim with"
2273 The install script copies files only if they are newer than the files they are
2274 going to replace. The Exim binary is required to be owned by root and have the
2275 &'setuid'& bit set, for normal configurations. Therefore, you must run &`make
2276 install`& as root so that it can set up the Exim binary in this way. However, in
2277 some special situations (for example, if a host is doing no local deliveries)
2278 it may be possible to run Exim without making the binary setuid root (see
2279 chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for details).
2280
2281 .cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
2282 Exim's run time configuration file is named by the CONFIGURE_FILE setting
2283 in &_Local/Makefile_&. If this names a single file, and the file does not
2284 exist, the default configuration file &_src/configure.default_& is copied there
2285 by the installation script. If a run time configuration file already exists, it
2286 is left alone. If CONFIGURE_FILE is a colon-separated list, naming several
2287 alternative files, no default is installed.
2288
2289 .cindex "system aliases file"
2290 .cindex "&_/etc/aliases_&"
2291 One change is made to the default configuration file when it is installed: the
2292 default configuration contains a router that references a system aliases file.
2293 The path to this file is set to the value specified by
2294 SYSTEM_ALIASES_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_& (&_/etc/aliases_& by default).
2295 If the system aliases file does not exist, the installation script creates it,
2296 and outputs a comment to the user.
2297
2298 The created file contains no aliases, but it does contain comments about the
2299 aliases a site should normally have. Mail aliases have traditionally been
2300 kept in &_/etc/aliases_&. However, some operating systems are now using
2301 &_/etc/mail/aliases_&. You should check if yours is one of these, and change
2302 Exim's configuration if necessary.
2303
2304 The default configuration uses the local host's name as the only local domain,
2305 and is set up to do local deliveries into the shared directory &_/var/mail_&,
2306 running as the local user. System aliases and &_.forward_& files in users' home
2307 directories are supported, but no NIS or NIS+ support is configured. Domains
2308 other than the name of the local host are routed using the DNS, with delivery
2309 over SMTP.
2310
2311 It is possible to install Exim for special purposes (such as building a binary
2312 distribution) in a private part of the file system. You can do this by a
2313 command such as
2314 .code
2315 make DESTDIR=/some/directory/ install
2316 .endd
2317 This has the effect of pre-pending the specified directory to all the file
2318 paths, except the name of the system aliases file that appears in the default
2319 configuration. (If a default alias file is created, its name &'is'& modified.)
2320 For backwards compatibility, ROOT is used if DESTDIR is not set,
2321 but this usage is deprecated.
2322
2323 .cindex "installing Exim" "what is not installed"
2324 Running &'make install'& does not copy the Exim 4 conversion script
2325 &'convert4r4'&. You will probably run this only once if you are
2326 upgrading from Exim 3. None of the documentation files in the &_doc_&
2327 directory are copied, except for the info files when you have set
2328 INFO_DIRECTORY, as described in section &<<SECTinsinfdoc>>& below.
2329
2330 For the utility programs, old versions are renamed by adding the suffix &_.O_&
2331 to their names. The Exim binary itself, however, is handled differently. It is
2332 installed under a name that includes the version number and the compile number,
2333 for example &_exim-&version()-1_&. The script then arranges for a symbolic link
2334 called &_exim_& to point to the binary. If you are updating a previous version
2335 of Exim, the script takes care to ensure that the name &_exim_& is never absent
2336 from the directory (as seen by other processes).
2337
2338 .cindex "installing Exim" "testing the script"
2339 If you want to see what the &'make install'& will do before running it for
2340 real, you can pass the &%-n%& option to the installation script by this
2341 command:
2342 .code
2343 make INSTALL_ARG=-n install
2344 .endd
2345 The contents of the variable INSTALL_ARG are passed to the installation
2346 script. You do not need to be root to run this test. Alternatively, you can run
2347 the installation script directly, but this must be from within the build
2348 directory. For example, from the top-level Exim directory you could use this
2349 command:
2350 .code
2351 (cd build-SunOS5-5.5.1-sparc; ../scripts/exim_install -n)
2352 .endd
2353 .cindex "installing Exim" "install script options"
2354 There are two other options that can be supplied to the installation script.
2355
2356 .ilist
2357 &%-no_chown%& bypasses the call to change the owner of the installed binary
2358 to root, and the call to make it a setuid binary.
2359 .next
2360 &%-no_symlink%& bypasses the setting up of the symbolic link &_exim_& to the
2361 installed binary.
2362 .endlist
2363
2364 INSTALL_ARG can be used to pass these options to the script. For example:
2365 .code
2366 make INSTALL_ARG=-no_symlink install
2367 .endd
2368 The installation script can also be given arguments specifying which files are
2369 to be copied. For example, to install just the Exim binary, and nothing else,
2370 without creating the symbolic link, you could use:
2371 .code
2372 make INSTALL_ARG='-no_symlink exim' install
2373 .endd
2374
2375
2376
2377 .section "Installing info documentation" "SECTinsinfdoc"
2378 .cindex "installing Exim" "&'info'& documentation"
2379 Not all systems use the GNU &'info'& system for documentation, and for this
2380 reason, the Texinfo source of Exim's documentation is not included in the main
2381 distribution. Instead it is available separately from the ftp site (see section
2382 &<<SECTavail>>&).
2383
2384 If you have defined INFO_DIRECTORY in &_Local/Makefile_& and the Texinfo
2385 source of the documentation is found in the source tree, running &`make
2386 install`& automatically builds the info files and installs them.
2387
2388
2389
2390 .section "Setting up the spool directory" "SECID33"
2391 .cindex "spool directory" "creating"
2392 When it starts up, Exim tries to create its spool directory if it does not
2393 exist. The Exim uid and gid are used for the owner and group of the spool
2394 directory. Sub-directories are automatically created in the spool directory as
2395 necessary.
2396
2397
2398
2399
2400 .section "Testing" "SECID34"
2401 .cindex "testing" "installation"
2402 Having installed Exim, you can check that the run time configuration file is
2403 syntactically valid by running the following command, which assumes that the
2404 Exim binary directory is within your PATH environment variable:
2405 .code
2406 exim -bV
2407 .endd
2408 If there are any errors in the configuration file, Exim outputs error messages.
2409 Otherwise it outputs the version number and build date,
2410 the DBM library that is being used, and information about which drivers and
2411 other optional code modules are included in the binary.
2412 Some simple routing tests can be done by using the address testing option. For
2413 example,
2414 .display
2415 &`exim -bt`& <&'local username'&>
2416 .endd
2417 should verify that it recognizes a local mailbox, and
2418 .display
2419 &`exim -bt`& <&'remote address'&>
2420 .endd
2421 a remote one. Then try getting it to deliver mail, both locally and remotely.
2422 This can be done by passing messages directly to Exim, without going through a
2423 user agent. For example:
2424 .code
2425 exim -v postmaster@your.domain.example
2426 From: user@your.domain.example
2427 To: postmaster@your.domain.example
2428 Subject: Testing Exim
2429
2430 This is a test message.
2431 ^D
2432 .endd
2433 The &%-v%& option causes Exim to output some verification of what it is doing.
2434 In this case you should see copies of three log lines, one for the message's
2435 arrival, one for its delivery, and one containing &"Completed"&.
2436
2437 .cindex "delivery" "problems with"
2438 If you encounter problems, look at Exim's log files (&'mainlog'& and
2439 &'paniclog'&) to see if there is any relevant information there. Another source
2440 of information is running Exim with debugging turned on, by specifying the
2441 &%-d%& option. If a message is stuck on Exim's spool, you can force a delivery
2442 with debugging turned on by a command of the form
2443 .display
2444 &`exim -d -M`& <&'exim-message-id'&>
2445 .endd
2446 You must be root or an &"admin user"& in order to do this. The &%-d%& option
2447 produces rather a lot of output, but you can cut this down to specific areas.
2448 For example, if you use &%-d-all+route%& only the debugging information
2449 relevant to routing is included. (See the &%-d%& option in chapter
2450 &<<CHAPcommandline>>& for more details.)
2451
2452 .cindex '&"sticky"& bit'
2453 .cindex "lock files"
2454 One specific problem that has shown up on some sites is the inability to do
2455 local deliveries into a shared mailbox directory, because it does not have the
2456 &"sticky bit"& set on it. By default, Exim tries to create a lock file before
2457 writing to a mailbox file, and if it cannot create the lock file, the delivery
2458 is deferred. You can get round this either by setting the &"sticky bit"& on the
2459 directory, or by setting a specific group for local deliveries and allowing
2460 that group to create files in the directory (see the comments above the
2461 &(local_delivery)& transport in the default configuration file). Another
2462 approach is to configure Exim not to use lock files, but just to rely on
2463 &[fcntl()]& locking instead. However, you should do this only if all user
2464 agents also use &[fcntl()]& locking. For further discussion of locking issues,
2465 see chapter &<<CHAPappendfile>>&.
2466
2467 One thing that cannot be tested on a system that is already running an MTA is
2468 the receipt of incoming SMTP mail on the standard SMTP port. However, the
2469 &%-oX%& option can be used to run an Exim daemon that listens on some other
2470 port, or &'inetd'& can be used to do this. The &%-bh%& option and the
2471 &'exim_checkaccess'& utility can be used to check out policy controls on
2472 incoming SMTP mail.
2473
2474 Testing a new version on a system that is already running Exim can most easily
2475 be done by building a binary with a different CONFIGURE_FILE setting. From
2476 within the run time configuration, all other file and directory names
2477 that Exim uses can be altered, in order to keep it entirely clear of the
2478 production version.
2479
2480
2481 .section "Replacing another MTA with Exim" "SECID35"
2482 .cindex "replacing another MTA"
2483 Building and installing Exim for the first time does not of itself put it in
2484 general use. The name by which the system's MTA is called by mail user agents
2485 is either &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&, or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& (depending on the
2486 operating system), and it is necessary to make this name point to the &'exim'&
2487 binary in order to get the user agents to pass messages to Exim. This is
2488 normally done by renaming any existing file and making &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&
2489 or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_&
2490 .cindex "symbolic link" "to &'exim'& binary"
2491 a symbolic link to the &'exim'& binary. It is a good idea to remove any setuid
2492 privilege and executable status from the old MTA. It is then necessary to stop
2493 and restart the mailer daemon, if one is running.
2494
2495 .cindex "FreeBSD, MTA indirection"
2496 .cindex "&_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_&"
2497 Some operating systems have introduced alternative ways of switching MTAs. For
2498 example, if you are running FreeBSD, you need to edit the file
2499 &_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_& instead of setting up a symbolic link as just
2500 described. A typical example of the contents of this file for running Exim is
2501 as follows:
2502 .code
2503 sendmail /usr/exim/bin/exim
2504 send-mail /usr/exim/bin/exim
2505 mailq /usr/exim/bin/exim -bp
2506 newaliases /usr/bin/true
2507 .endd
2508 Once you have set up the symbolic link, or edited &_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_&,
2509 your Exim installation is &"live"&. Check it by sending a message from your
2510 favourite user agent.
2511
2512 You should consider what to tell your users about the change of MTA. Exim may
2513 have different capabilities to what was previously running, and there are
2514 various operational differences such as the text of messages produced by
2515 command line options and in bounce messages. If you allow your users to make
2516 use of Exim's filtering capabilities, you should make the document entitled
2517 &'Exim's interface to mail filtering'& available to them.
2518
2519
2520
2521 .section "Upgrading Exim" "SECID36"
2522 .cindex "upgrading Exim"
2523 If you are already running Exim on your host, building and installing a new
2524 version automatically makes it available to MUAs, or any other programs that
2525 call the MTA directly. However, if you are running an Exim daemon, you do need
2526 to send it a HUP signal, to make it re-execute itself, and thereby pick up the
2527 new binary. You do not need to stop processing mail in order to install a new
2528 version of Exim. The install script does not modify an existing runtime
2529 configuration file.
2530
2531
2532
2533
2534 .section "Stopping the Exim daemon on Solaris" "SECID37"
2535 .cindex "Solaris" "stopping Exim on"
2536 The standard command for stopping the mailer daemon on Solaris is
2537 .code
2538 /etc/init.d/sendmail stop
2539 .endd
2540 If &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& has been turned into a symbolic link, this script
2541 fails to stop Exim because it uses the command &'ps -e'& and greps the output
2542 for the text &"sendmail"&; this is not present because the actual program name
2543 (that is, &"exim"&) is given by the &'ps'& command with these options. A
2544 solution is to replace the line that finds the process id with something like
2545 .code
2546 pid=`cat /var/spool/exim/exim-daemon.pid`
2547 .endd
2548 to obtain the daemon's pid directly from the file that Exim saves it in.
2549
2550 Note, however, that stopping the daemon does not &"stop Exim"&. Messages can
2551 still be received from local processes, and if automatic delivery is configured
2552 (the normal case), deliveries will still occur.
2553
2554
2555
2556
2557 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2558 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2559
2560 .chapter "The Exim command line" "CHAPcommandline"
2561 .scindex IIDclo1 "command line" "options"
2562 .scindex IIDclo2 "options" "command line"
2563 Exim's command line takes the standard Unix form of a sequence of options,
2564 each starting with a hyphen character, followed by a number of arguments. The
2565 options are compatible with the main options of Sendmail, and there are also
2566 some additional options, some of which are compatible with Smail 3. Certain
2567 combinations of options do not make sense, and provoke an error if used.
2568 The form of the arguments depends on which options are set.
2569
2570
2571 .section "Setting options by program name" "SECID38"
2572 .cindex "&'mailq'&"
2573 If Exim is called under the name &'mailq'&, it behaves as if the option &%-bp%&
2574 were present before any other options.
2575 The &%-bp%& option requests a listing of the contents of the mail queue on the
2576 standard output.
2577 This feature is for compatibility with some systems that contain a command of
2578 that name in one of the standard libraries, symbolically linked to
2579 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_&.
2580
2581 .cindex "&'rsmtp'&"
2582 If Exim is called under the name &'rsmtp'& it behaves as if the option &%-bS%&
2583 were present before any other options, for compatibility with Smail. The
2584 &%-bS%& option is used for reading in a number of messages in batched SMTP
2585 format.
2586
2587 .cindex "&'rmail'&"
2588 If Exim is called under the name &'rmail'& it behaves as if the &%-i%& and
2589 &%-oee%& options were present before any other options, for compatibility with
2590 Smail. The name &'rmail'& is used as an interface by some UUCP systems.
2591
2592 .cindex "&'runq'&"
2593 .cindex "queue runner"
2594 If Exim is called under the name &'runq'& it behaves as if the option &%-q%&
2595 were present before any other options, for compatibility with Smail. The &%-q%&
2596 option causes a single queue runner process to be started.
2597
2598 .cindex "&'newaliases'&"
2599 .cindex "alias file" "building"
2600 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "calling Exim as &'newaliases'&"
2601 If Exim is called under the name &'newaliases'& it behaves as if the option
2602 &%-bi%& were present before any other options, for compatibility with Sendmail.
2603 This option is used for rebuilding Sendmail's alias file. Exim does not have
2604 the concept of a single alias file, but can be configured to run a given
2605 command if called with the &%-bi%& option.
2606
2607
2608 .section "Trusted and admin users" "SECTtrustedadmin"
2609 Some Exim options are available only to &'trusted users'& and others are
2610 available only to &'admin users'&. In the description below, the phrases &"Exim
2611 user"& and &"Exim group"& mean the user and group defined by EXIM_USER and
2612 EXIM_GROUP in &_Local/Makefile_& or set by the &%exim_user%& and
2613 &%exim_group%& options. These do not necessarily have to use the name &"exim"&.
2614
2615 .ilist
2616 .cindex "trusted users" "definition of"
2617 .cindex "user" "trusted definition of"
2618 The trusted users are root, the Exim user, any user listed in the
2619 &%trusted_users%& configuration option, and any user whose current group or any
2620 supplementary group is one of those listed in the &%trusted_groups%&
2621 configuration option. Note that the Exim group is not automatically trusted.
2622
2623 .cindex '&"From"& line'
2624 .cindex "envelope sender"
2625 Trusted users are always permitted to use the &%-f%& option or a leading
2626 &"From&~"& line to specify the envelope sender of a message that is passed to
2627 Exim through the local interface (see the &%-bm%& and &%-f%& options below).
2628 See the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option for a way of permitting non-trusted
2629 users to set envelope senders.
2630
2631 .cindex "&'From:'& header line"
2632 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line"
2633 For a trusted user, there is never any check on the contents of the &'From:'&
2634 header line, and a &'Sender:'& line is never added. Furthermore, any existing
2635 &'Sender:'& line in incoming local (non-TCP/IP) messages is not removed.
2636
2637 Trusted users may also specify a host name, host address, interface address,
2638 protocol name, ident value, and authentication data when submitting a message
2639 locally. Thus, they are able to insert messages into Exim's queue locally that
2640 have the characteristics of messages received from a remote host. Untrusted
2641 users may in some circumstances use &%-f%&, but can never set the other values
2642 that are available to trusted users.
2643 .next
2644 .cindex "user" "admin definition of"
2645 .cindex "admin user" "definition of"
2646 The admin users are root, the Exim user, and any user that is a member of the
2647 Exim group or of any group listed in the &%admin_groups%& configuration option.
2648 The current group does not have to be one of these groups.
2649
2650 Admin users are permitted to list the queue, and to carry out certain
2651 operations on messages, for example, to force delivery failures. It is also
2652 necessary to be an admin user in order to see the full information provided by
2653 the Exim monitor, and full debugging output.
2654
2655 By default, the use of the &%-M%&, &%-q%&, &%-R%&, and &%-S%& options to cause
2656 Exim to attempt delivery of messages on its queue is restricted to admin users.
2657 However, this restriction can be relaxed by setting the &%prod_requires_admin%&
2658 option false (that is, specifying &%no_prod_requires_admin%&).
2659
2660 Similarly, the use of the &%-bp%& option to list all the messages in the queue
2661 is restricted to admin users unless &%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set
2662 false.
2663 .endlist
2664
2665
2666 &*Warning*&: If you configure your system so that admin users are able to
2667 edit Exim's configuration file, you are giving those users an easy way of
2668 getting root. There is further discussion of this issue at the start of chapter
2669 &<<CHAPconf>>&.
2670
2671
2672
2673
2674 .section "Command line options" "SECID39"
2675 Exim's command line options are described in alphabetical order below. If none
2676 of the options that specifies a specific action (such as starting the daemon or
2677 a queue runner, or testing an address, or receiving a message in a specific
2678 format, or listing the queue) are present, and there is at least one argument
2679 on the command line, &%-bm%& (accept a local message on the standard input,
2680 with the arguments specifying the recipients) is assumed. Otherwise, Exim
2681 outputs a brief message about itself and exits.
2682
2683 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2684 . Insert a stylized XML comment here, to identify the start of the command line
2685 . options. This is for the benefit of the Perl script that automatically
2686 . creates a man page for the options.
2687 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2688
2689 .literal xml
2690 <!-- === Start of command line options === -->
2691 .literal off
2692
2693
2694 .vlist
2695 .vitem &%--%&
2696 .oindex "--"
2697 .cindex "options" "command line; terminating"
2698 This is a pseudo-option whose only purpose is to terminate the options and
2699 therefore to cause subsequent command line items to be treated as arguments
2700 rather than options, even if they begin with hyphens.
2701
2702 .vitem &%--help%&
2703 .oindex "&%--help%&"
2704 This option causes Exim to output a few sentences stating what it is.
2705 The same output is generated if the Exim binary is called with no options and
2706 no arguments.
2707
2708 .vitem &%--version%&
2709 .oindex "&%--version%&"
2710 This option is an alias for &%-bV%& and causes version information to be
2711 displayed.
2712
2713 .vitem &%-Ac%& &&&
2714 &%-Am%&
2715 .oindex "&%-Ac%&"
2716 .oindex "&%-Am%&"
2717 These options are used by Sendmail for selecting configuration files and are
2718 ignored by Exim.
2719
2720 .vitem &%-B%&<&'type'&>
2721 .oindex "&%-B%&"
2722 .cindex "8-bit characters"
2723 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "8-bit characters"
2724 This is a Sendmail option for selecting 7 or 8 bit processing. Exim is 8-bit
2725 clean; it ignores this option.
2726
2727 .vitem &%-bd%&
2728 .oindex "&%-bd%&"
2729 .cindex "daemon"
2730 .cindex "SMTP" "listener"
2731 .cindex "queue runner"
2732 This option runs Exim as a daemon, awaiting incoming SMTP connections. Usually
2733 the &%-bd%& option is combined with the &%-q%&<&'time'&> option, to specify
2734 that the daemon should also initiate periodic queue runs.
2735
2736 The &%-bd%& option can be used only by an admin user. If either of the &%-d%&
2737 (debugging) or &%-v%& (verifying) options are set, the daemon does not
2738 disconnect from the controlling terminal. When running this way, it can be
2739 stopped by pressing ctrl-C.
2740
2741 By default, Exim listens for incoming connections to the standard SMTP port on
2742 all the host's running interfaces. However, it is possible to listen on other
2743 ports, on multiple ports, and only on specific interfaces. Chapter
2744 &<<CHAPinterfaces>>& contains a description of the options that control this.
2745
2746 When a listening daemon
2747 .cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
2748 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
2749 is started without the use of &%-oX%& (that is, without overriding the normal
2750 configuration), it writes its process id to a file called &_exim-daemon.pid_&
2751 in Exim's spool directory. This location can be overridden by setting
2752 PID_FILE_PATH in &_Local/Makefile_&. The file is written while Exim is still
2753 running as root.
2754
2755 When &%-oX%& is used on the command line to start a listening daemon, the
2756 process id is not written to the normal pid file path. However, &%-oP%& can be
2757 used to specify a path on the command line if a pid file is required.
2758
2759 The SIGHUP signal
2760 .cindex "SIGHUP"
2761 .cindex "daemon" "restarting"
2762 can be used to cause the daemon to re-execute itself. This should be done
2763 whenever Exim's configuration file, or any file that is incorporated into it by
2764 means of the &%.include%& facility, is changed, and also whenever a new version
2765 of Exim is installed. It is not necessary to do this when other files that are
2766 referenced from the configuration (for example, alias files) are changed,
2767 because these are reread each time they are used.
2768
2769 .vitem &%-bdf%&
2770 .oindex "&%-bdf%&"
2771 This option has the same effect as &%-bd%& except that it never disconnects
2772 from the controlling terminal, even when no debugging is specified.
2773
2774 .vitem &%-be%&
2775 .oindex "&%-be%&"
2776 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
2777 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
2778 Run Exim in expansion testing mode. Exim discards its root privilege, to
2779 prevent ordinary users from using this mode to read otherwise inaccessible
2780 files. If no arguments are given, Exim runs interactively, prompting for lines
2781 of data. Otherwise, it processes each argument in turn.
2782
2783 If Exim was built with USE_READLINE=yes in &_Local/Makefile_&, it tries
2784 to load the &%libreadline%& library dynamically whenever the &%-be%& option is
2785 used without command line arguments. If successful, it uses the &[readline()]&
2786 function, which provides extensive line-editing facilities, for reading the
2787 test data. A line history is supported.
2788
2789 Long expansion expressions can be split over several lines by using backslash
2790 continuations. As in Exim's run time configuration, white space at the start of
2791 continuation lines is ignored. Each argument or data line is passed through the
2792 string expansion mechanism, and the result is output. Variable values from the
2793 configuration file (for example, &$qualify_domain$&) are available, but no
2794 message-specific values (such as &$sender_domain$&) are set, because no message
2795 is being processed (but see &%-bem%& and &%-Mset%&).
2796
2797 &*Note*&: If you use this mechanism to test lookups, and you change the data
2798 files or databases you are using, you must exit and restart Exim before trying
2799 the same lookup again. Otherwise, because each Exim process caches the results
2800 of lookups, you will just get the same result as before.
2801
2802 .vitem &%-bem%&&~<&'filename'&>
2803 .oindex "&%-bem%&"
2804 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
2805 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
2806 This option operates like &%-be%& except that it must be followed by the name
2807 of a file. For example:
2808 .code
2809 exim -bem /tmp/testmessage
2810 .endd
2811 The file is read as a message (as if receiving a locally-submitted non-SMTP
2812 message) before any of the test expansions are done. Thus, message-specific
2813 variables such as &$message_size$& and &$header_from:$& are available. However,
2814 no &'Received:'& header is added to the message. If the &%-t%& option is set,
2815 recipients are read from the headers in the normal way, and are shown in the
2816 &$recipients$& variable. Note that recipients cannot be given on the command
2817 line, because further arguments are taken as strings to expand (just like
2818 &%-be%&).
2819
2820 .vitem &%-bF%&&~<&'filename'&>
2821 .oindex "&%-bF%&"
2822 .cindex "system filter" "testing"
2823 .cindex "testing" "system filter"
2824 This option is the same as &%-bf%& except that it assumes that the filter being
2825 tested is a system filter. The additional commands that are available only in
2826 system filters are recognized.
2827
2828 .vitem &%-bf%&&~<&'filename'&>
2829 .oindex "&%-bf%&"
2830 .cindex "filter" "testing"
2831 .cindex "testing" "filter file"
2832 .cindex "forward file" "testing"
2833 .cindex "testing" "forward file"
2834 .cindex "Sieve filter" "testing"
2835 This option runs Exim in user filter testing mode; the file is the filter file
2836 to be tested, and a test message must be supplied on the standard input. If
2837 there are no message-dependent tests in the filter, an empty file can be
2838 supplied.
2839
2840 If you want to test a system filter file, use &%-bF%& instead of &%-bf%&. You
2841 can use both &%-bF%& and &%-bf%& on the same command, in order to test a system
2842 filter and a user filter in the same run. For example:
2843 .code
2844 exim -bF /system/filter -bf /user/filter </test/message
2845 .endd
2846 This is helpful when the system filter adds header lines or sets filter
2847 variables that are used by the user filter.
2848
2849 If the test filter file does not begin with one of the special lines
2850 .code
2851 # Exim filter
2852 # Sieve filter
2853 .endd
2854 it is taken to be a normal &_.forward_& file, and is tested for validity under
2855 that interpretation. See sections &<<SECTitenonfilred>>& to
2856 &<<SECTspecitredli>>& for a description of the possible contents of non-filter
2857 redirection lists.
2858
2859 The result of an Exim command that uses &%-bf%&, provided no errors are
2860 detected, is a list of the actions that Exim would try to take if presented
2861 with the message for real. More details of filter testing are given in the
2862 separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&.
2863
2864 When testing a filter file,
2865 .cindex "&""From""& line"
2866 .cindex "envelope sender"
2867 .oindex "&%-f%&" "for filter testing"
2868 the envelope sender can be set by the &%-f%& option,
2869 or by a &"From&~"& line at the start of the test message. Various parameters
2870 that would normally be taken from the envelope recipient address of the message
2871 can be set by means of additional command line options (see the next four
2872 options).
2873
2874 .vitem &%-bfd%&&~<&'domain'&>
2875 .oindex "&%-bfd%&"
2876 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
2877 This sets the domain of the recipient address when a filter file is being
2878 tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is the value of
2879 &$qualify_domain$&.
2880
2881 .vitem &%-bfl%&&~<&'local&~part'&>
2882 .oindex "&%-bfl%&"
2883 This sets the local part of the recipient address when a filter file is being
2884 tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is the username of the
2885 process that calls Exim. A local part should be specified with any prefix or
2886 suffix stripped, because that is how it appears to the filter when a message is
2887 actually being delivered.
2888
2889 .vitem &%-bfp%&&~<&'prefix'&>
2890 .oindex "&%-bfp%&"
2891 This sets the prefix of the local part of the recipient address when a filter
2892 file is being tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is an empty
2893 prefix.
2894
2895 .vitem &%-bfs%&&~<&'suffix'&>
2896 .oindex "&%-bfs%&"
2897 This sets the suffix of the local part of the recipient address when a filter
2898 file is being tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is an empty
2899 suffix.
2900
2901 .vitem &%-bh%&&~<&'IP&~address'&>
2902 .oindex "&%-bh%&"
2903 .cindex "testing" "incoming SMTP"
2904 .cindex "SMTP" "testing incoming"
2905 .cindex "testing" "relay control"
2906 .cindex "relaying" "testing configuration"
2907 .cindex "policy control" "testing"
2908 .cindex "debugging" "&%-bh%& option"
2909 This option runs a fake SMTP session as if from the given IP address, using the
2910 standard input and output. The IP address may include a port number at the end,
2911 after a full stop. For example:
2912 .code
2913 exim -bh 10.9.8.7.1234
2914 exim -bh fe80::a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678
2915 .endd
2916 When an IPv6 address is given, it is converted into canonical form. In the case
2917 of the second example above, the value of &$sender_host_address$& after
2918 conversion to the canonical form is
2919 &`fe80:0000:0000:0a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678`&.
2920
2921 Comments as to what is going on are written to the standard error file. These
2922 include lines beginning with &"LOG"& for anything that would have been logged.
2923 This facility is provided for testing configuration options for incoming
2924 messages, to make sure they implement the required policy. For example, you can
2925 test your relay controls using &%-bh%&.
2926
2927 &*Warning 1*&:
2928 .cindex "RFC 1413"
2929 You can test features of the configuration that rely on ident (RFC 1413)
2930 information by using the &%-oMt%& option. However, Exim cannot actually perform
2931 an ident callout when testing using &%-bh%& because there is no incoming SMTP
2932 connection.
2933
2934 &*Warning 2*&: Address verification callouts (see section &<<SECTcallver>>&)
2935 are also skipped when testing using &%-bh%&. If you want these callouts to
2936 occur, use &%-bhc%& instead.
2937
2938 Messages supplied during the testing session are discarded, and nothing is
2939 written to any of the real log files. There may be pauses when DNS (and other)
2940 lookups are taking place, and of course these may time out. The &%-oMi%& option
2941 can be used to specify a specific IP interface and port if this is important,
2942 and &%-oMaa%& and &%-oMai%& can be used to set parameters as if the SMTP
2943 session were authenticated.
2944
2945 The &'exim_checkaccess'& utility is a &"packaged"& version of &%-bh%& whose
2946 output just states whether a given recipient address from a given host is
2947 acceptable or not. See section &<<SECTcheckaccess>>&.
2948
2949 Features such as authentication and encryption, where the client input is not
2950 plain text, cannot easily be tested with &%-bh%&. Instead, you should use a
2951 specialized SMTP test program such as
2952 &url(http://jetmore.org/john/code/#swaks,swaks).
2953
2954 .vitem &%-bhc%&&~<&'IP&~address'&>
2955 .oindex "&%-bhc%&"
2956 This option operates in the same way as &%-bh%&, except that address
2957 verification callouts are performed if required. This includes consulting and
2958 updating the callout cache database.
2959
2960 .vitem &%-bi%&
2961 .oindex "&%-bi%&"
2962 .cindex "alias file" "building"
2963 .cindex "building alias file"
2964 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-bi%& option"
2965 Sendmail interprets the &%-bi%& option as a request to rebuild its alias file.
2966 Exim does not have the concept of a single alias file, and so it cannot mimic
2967 this behaviour. However, calls to &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& with the &%-bi%& option
2968 tend to appear in various scripts such as NIS make files, so the option must be
2969 recognized.
2970
2971 If &%-bi%& is encountered, the command specified by the &%bi_command%&
2972 configuration option is run, under the uid and gid of the caller of Exim. If
2973 the &%-oA%& option is used, its value is passed to the command as an argument.
2974 The command set by &%bi_command%& may not contain arguments. The command can
2975 use the &'exim_dbmbuild'& utility, or some other means, to rebuild alias files
2976 if this is required. If the &%bi_command%& option is not set, calling Exim with
2977 &%-bi%& is a no-op.
2978
2979 . // Keep :help first, then the rest in alphabetical order
2980 .vitem &%-bI:help%&
2981 .oindex "&%-bI:help%&"
2982 .cindex "querying exim information"
2983 We shall provide various options starting &`-bI:`& for querying Exim for
2984 information. The output of many of these will be intended for machine
2985 consumption. This one is not. The &%-bI:help%& option asks Exim for a
2986 synopsis of supported options beginning &`-bI:`&. Use of any of these
2987 options shall cause Exim to exit after producing the requested output.
2988
2989 .vitem &%-bI:dscp%&
2990 .oindex "&%-bI:dscp%&"
2991 .cindex "DSCP" "values"
2992 This option causes Exim to emit an alphabetically sorted list of all
2993 recognised DSCP names.
2994
2995 .vitem &%-bI:sieve%&
2996 .oindex "&%-bI:sieve%&"
2997 .cindex "Sieve filter" "capabilities"
2998 This option causes Exim to emit an alphabetically sorted list of all supported
2999 Sieve protocol extensions on stdout, one per line. This is anticipated to be
3000 useful for ManageSieve (RFC 5804) implementations, in providing that protocol's
3001 &`SIEVE`& capability response line. As the precise list may depend upon
3002 compile-time build options, which this option will adapt to, this is the only
3003 way to guarantee a correct response.
3004
3005 .vitem &%-bm%&
3006 .oindex "&%-bm%&"
3007 .cindex "local message reception"
3008 This option runs an Exim receiving process that accepts an incoming,
3009 locally-generated message on the standard input. The recipients are given as the
3010 command arguments (except when &%-t%& is also present &-- see below). Each
3011 argument can be a comma-separated list of RFC 2822 addresses. This is the
3012 default option for selecting the overall action of an Exim call; it is assumed
3013 if no other conflicting option is present.
3014
3015 If any addresses in the message are unqualified (have no domain), they are
3016 qualified by the values of the &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%&
3017 options, as appropriate. The &%-bnq%& option (see below) provides a way of
3018 suppressing this for special cases.
3019
3020 Policy checks on the contents of local messages can be enforced by means of
3021 the non-SMTP ACL. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for details.
3022
3023 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bm%&"
3024 The return code is zero if the message is successfully accepted. Otherwise, the
3025 action is controlled by the &%-oe%&&'x'& option setting &-- see below.
3026
3027 The format
3028 .cindex "message" "format"
3029 .cindex "format" "message"
3030 .cindex "&""From""& line"
3031 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
3032 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
3033 of the message must be as defined in RFC 2822, except that, for
3034 compatibility with Sendmail and Smail, a line in one of the forms
3035 .code
3036 From sender Fri Jan 5 12:55 GMT 1997
3037 From sender Fri, 5 Jan 97 12:55:01
3038 .endd
3039 (with the weekday optional, and possibly with additional text after the date)
3040 is permitted to appear at the start of the message. There appears to be no
3041 authoritative specification of the format of this line. Exim recognizes it by
3042 matching against the regular expression defined by the &%uucp_from_pattern%&
3043 option, which can be changed if necessary.
3044
3045 .oindex "&%-f%&" "overriding &""From""& line"
3046 The specified sender is treated as if it were given as the argument to the
3047 &%-f%& option, but if a &%-f%& option is also present, its argument is used in
3048 preference to the address taken from the message. The caller of Exim must be a
3049 trusted user for the sender of a message to be set in this way.
3050
3051 .vitem &%-bmalware%&&~<&'filename'&>
3052 .oindex "&%-bmalware%&"
3053 .cindex "testing", "malware"
3054 .cindex "malware scan test"
3055 This debugging option causes Exim to scan the given file,
3056 using the malware scanning framework. The option of &%av_scanner%& influences
3057 this option, so if &%av_scanner%&'s value is dependent upon an expansion then
3058 the expansion should have defaults which apply to this invocation. ACLs are
3059 not invoked, so if &%av_scanner%& references an ACL variable then that variable
3060 will never be populated and &%-bmalware%& will fail.
3061
3062 Exim will have changed working directory before resolving the filename, so
3063 using fully qualified pathnames is advisable. Exim will be running as the Exim
3064 user when it tries to open the file, rather than as the invoking user.
3065 This option requires admin privileges.
3066
3067 The &%-bmalware%& option will not be extended to be more generally useful,
3068 there are better tools for file-scanning. This option exists to help
3069 administrators verify their Exim and AV scanner configuration.
3070
3071 .vitem &%-bnq%&
3072 .oindex "&%-bnq%&"
3073 .cindex "address qualification, suppressing"
3074 By default, Exim automatically qualifies unqualified addresses (those
3075 without domains) that appear in messages that are submitted locally (that
3076 is, not over TCP/IP). This qualification applies both to addresses in
3077 envelopes, and addresses in header lines. Sender addresses are qualified using
3078 &%qualify_domain%&, and recipient addresses using &%qualify_recipient%& (which
3079 defaults to the value of &%qualify_domain%&).
3080
3081 Sometimes, qualification is not wanted. For example, if &%-bS%& (batch SMTP) is
3082 being used to re-submit messages that originally came from remote hosts after
3083 content scanning, you probably do not want to qualify unqualified addresses in
3084 header lines. (Such lines will be present only if you have not enabled a header
3085 syntax check in the appropriate ACL.)
3086
3087 The &%-bnq%& option suppresses all qualification of unqualified addresses in
3088 messages that originate on the local host. When this is used, unqualified
3089 addresses in the envelope provoke errors (causing message rejection) and
3090 unqualified addresses in header lines are left alone.
3091
3092
3093 .vitem &%-bP%&
3094 .oindex "&%-bP%&"
3095 .cindex "configuration options" "extracting"
3096 .cindex "options" "configuration &-- extracting"
3097 If this option is given with no arguments, it causes the values of all Exim's
3098 main configuration options to be written to the standard output. The values
3099 of one or more specific options can be requested by giving their names as
3100 arguments, for example:
3101 .code
3102 exim -bP qualify_domain hold_domains
3103 .endd
3104 .cindex "hiding configuration option values"
3105 .cindex "configuration options" "hiding value of"
3106 .cindex "options" "hiding value of"
3107 However, any option setting that is preceded by the word &"hide"& in the
3108 configuration file is not shown in full, except to an admin user. For other
3109 users, the output is as in this example:
3110 .code
3111 mysql_servers = <value not displayable>
3112 .endd
3113 If &%configure_file%& is given as an argument, the name of the run time
3114 configuration file is output.
3115 If a list of configuration files was supplied, the value that is output here
3116 is the name of the file that was actually used.
3117
3118 .cindex "options" "hiding name of"
3119 If the &%-n%& flag is given, then for most modes of &%-bP%& operation the
3120 name will not be output.
3121
3122 .cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
3123 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
3124 If &%log_file_path%& or &%pid_file_path%& are given, the names of the
3125 directories where log files and daemon pid files are written are output,
3126 respectively. If these values are unset, log files are written in a
3127 sub-directory of the spool directory called &%log%&, and the pid file is
3128 written directly into the spool directory.
3129
3130 If &%-bP%& is followed by a name preceded by &`+`&, for example,
3131 .code
3132 exim -bP +local_domains
3133 .endd
3134 it searches for a matching named list of any type (domain, host, address, or
3135 local part) and outputs what it finds.
3136
3137 .cindex "options" "router &-- extracting"
3138 .cindex "options" "transport &-- extracting"
3139 .cindex "options" "authenticator &-- extracting"
3140 If one of the words &%router%&, &%transport%&, or &%authenticator%& is given,
3141 followed by the name of an appropriate driver instance, the option settings for
3142 that driver are output. For example:
3143 .code
3144 exim -bP transport local_delivery
3145 .endd
3146 The generic driver options are output first, followed by the driver's private
3147 options. A list of the names of drivers of a particular type can be obtained by
3148 using one of the words &%router_list%&, &%transport_list%&, or
3149 &%authenticator_list%&, and a complete list of all drivers with their option
3150 settings can be obtained by using &%routers%&, &%transports%&, or
3151 &%authenticators%&.
3152
3153 .cindex "options" "macro &-- extracting"
3154 If invoked by an admin user, then &%macro%&, &%macro_list%& and &%macros%&
3155 are available, similarly to the drivers. Because macros are sometimes used
3156 for storing passwords, this option is restricted.
3157 The output format is one item per line.
3158
3159 .vitem &%-bp%&
3160 .oindex "&%-bp%&"
3161 .cindex "queue" "listing messages on"
3162 .cindex "listing" "messages on the queue"
3163 This option requests a listing of the contents of the mail queue on the
3164 standard output. If the &%-bp%& option is followed by a list of message ids,
3165 just those messages are listed. By default, this option can be used only by an
3166 admin user. However, the &%queue_list_requires_admin%& option can be set false
3167 to allow any user to see the queue.
3168
3169 Each message on the queue is displayed as in the following example:
3170 .code
3171 25m 2.9K 0t5C6f-0000c8-00 <alice@wonderland.fict.example>
3172 red.king@looking-glass.fict.example
3173 <other addresses>
3174 .endd
3175 .cindex "message" "size in queue listing"
3176 .cindex "size" "of message"
3177 The first line contains the length of time the message has been on the queue
3178 (in this case 25 minutes), the size of the message (2.9K), the unique local
3179 identifier for the message, and the message sender, as contained in the
3180 envelope. For bounce messages, the sender address is empty, and appears as
3181 &"<>"&. If the message was submitted locally by an untrusted user who overrode
3182 the default sender address, the user's login name is shown in parentheses
3183 before the sender address.
3184
3185 .cindex "frozen messages" "in queue listing"
3186 If the message is frozen (attempts to deliver it are suspended) then the text
3187 &"*** frozen ***"& is displayed at the end of this line.
3188
3189 The recipients of the message (taken from the envelope, not the headers) are
3190 displayed on subsequent lines. Those addresses to which the message has already
3191 been delivered are marked with the letter D. If an original address gets
3192 expanded into several addresses via an alias or forward file, the original is
3193 displayed with a D only when deliveries for all of its child addresses are
3194 complete.
3195
3196
3197 .vitem &%-bpa%&
3198 .oindex "&%-bpa%&"
3199 This option operates like &%-bp%&, but in addition it shows delivered addresses
3200 that were generated from the original top level address(es) in each message by
3201 alias or forwarding operations. These addresses are flagged with &"+D"& instead
3202 of just &"D"&.
3203
3204
3205 .vitem &%-bpc%&
3206 .oindex "&%-bpc%&"
3207 .cindex "queue" "count of messages on"
3208 This option counts the number of messages on the queue, and writes the total
3209 to the standard output. It is restricted to admin users, unless
3210 &%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set false.
3211
3212
3213 .vitem &%-bpr%&
3214 .oindex "&%-bpr%&"
3215 This option operates like &%-bp%&, but the output is not sorted into
3216 chronological order of message arrival. This can speed it up when there are
3217 lots of messages on the queue, and is particularly useful if the output is
3218 going to be post-processed in a way that doesn't need the sorting.
3219
3220 .vitem &%-bpra%&
3221 .oindex "&%-bpra%&"
3222 This option is a combination of &%-bpr%& and &%-bpa%&.
3223
3224 .vitem &%-bpru%&
3225 .oindex "&%-bpru%&"
3226 This option is a combination of &%-bpr%& and &%-bpu%&.
3227
3228
3229 .vitem &%-bpu%&
3230 .oindex "&%-bpu%&"
3231 This option operates like &%-bp%& but shows only undelivered top-level
3232 addresses for each message displayed. Addresses generated by aliasing or
3233 forwarding are not shown, unless the message was deferred after processing by a
3234 router with the &%one_time%& option set.
3235
3236
3237 .vitem &%-brt%&
3238 .oindex "&%-brt%&"
3239 .cindex "testing" "retry configuration"
3240 .cindex "retry" "configuration testing"
3241 This option is for testing retry rules, and it must be followed by up to three
3242 arguments. It causes Exim to look for a retry rule that matches the values
3243 and to write it to the standard output. For example:
3244 .code
3245 exim -brt bach.comp.mus.example
3246 Retry rule: *.comp.mus.example F,2h,15m; F,4d,30m;
3247 .endd
3248 See chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& for a description of Exim's retry rules. The first
3249 argument, which is required, can be a complete address in the form
3250 &'local_part@domain'&, or it can be just a domain name. If the second argument
3251 contains a dot, it is interpreted as an optional second domain name; if no
3252 retry rule is found for the first argument, the second is tried. This ties in
3253 with Exim's behaviour when looking for retry rules for remote hosts &-- if no
3254 rule is found that matches the host, one that matches the mail domain is
3255 sought. Finally, an argument that is the name of a specific delivery error, as
3256 used in setting up retry rules, can be given. For example:
3257 .code
3258 exim -brt haydn.comp.mus.example quota_3d
3259 Retry rule: *@haydn.comp.mus.example quota_3d F,1h,15m
3260 .endd
3261
3262 .vitem &%-brw%&
3263 .oindex "&%-brw%&"
3264 .cindex "testing" "rewriting"
3265 .cindex "rewriting" "testing"
3266 This option is for testing address rewriting rules, and it must be followed by
3267 a single argument, consisting of either a local part without a domain, or a
3268 complete address with a fully qualified domain. Exim outputs how this address
3269 would be rewritten for each possible place it might appear. See chapter
3270 &<<CHAPrewrite>>& for further details.
3271
3272 .vitem &%-bS%&
3273 .oindex "&%-bS%&"
3274 .cindex "SMTP" "batched incoming"
3275 .cindex "batched SMTP input"
3276 This option is used for batched SMTP input, which is an alternative interface
3277 for non-interactive local message submission. A number of messages can be
3278 submitted in a single run. However, despite its name, this is not really SMTP
3279 input. Exim reads each message's envelope from SMTP commands on the standard
3280 input, but generates no responses. If the caller is trusted, or
3281 &%untrusted_set_sender%& is set, the senders in the SMTP MAIL commands are
3282 believed; otherwise the sender is always the caller of Exim.
3283
3284 The message itself is read from the standard input, in SMTP format (leading
3285 dots doubled), terminated by a line containing just a single dot. An error is
3286 provoked if the terminating dot is missing. A further message may then follow.
3287
3288 As for other local message submissions, the contents of incoming batch SMTP
3289 messages can be checked using the non-SMTP ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&).
3290 Unqualified addresses are automatically qualified using &%qualify_domain%& and
3291 &%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate, unless the &%-bnq%& option is used.
3292
3293 Some other SMTP commands are recognized in the input. HELO and EHLO act
3294 as RSET; VRFY, EXPN, ETRN, and HELP act as NOOP;
3295 QUIT quits, ignoring the rest of the standard input.
3296
3297 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bS%&"
3298 If any error is encountered, reports are written to the standard output and
3299 error streams, and Exim gives up immediately. The return code is 0 if no error
3300 was detected; it is 1 if one or more messages were accepted before the error
3301 was detected; otherwise it is 2.
3302
3303 More details of input using batched SMTP are given in section
3304 &<<SECTincomingbatchedSMTP>>&.
3305
3306 .vitem &%-bs%&
3307 .oindex "&%-bs%&"
3308 .cindex "SMTP" "local input"
3309 .cindex "local SMTP input"
3310 This option causes Exim to accept one or more messages by reading SMTP commands
3311 on the standard input, and producing SMTP replies on the standard output. SMTP
3312 policy controls, as defined in ACLs (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&) are applied.
3313 Some user agents use this interface as a way of passing locally-generated
3314 messages to the MTA.
3315
3316 In
3317 .cindex "sender" "source of"
3318 this usage, if the caller of Exim is trusted, or &%untrusted_set_sender%& is
3319 set, the senders of messages are taken from the SMTP MAIL commands.
3320 Otherwise the content of these commands is ignored and the sender is set up as
3321 the calling user. Unqualified addresses are automatically qualified using
3322 &%qualify_domain%& and &%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate, unless the
3323 &%-bnq%& option is used.
3324
3325 .cindex "inetd"
3326 The
3327 &%-bs%& option is also used to run Exim from &'inetd'&, as an alternative to
3328 using a listening daemon. Exim can distinguish the two cases by checking
3329 whether the standard input is a TCP/IP socket. When Exim is called from
3330 &'inetd'&, the source of the mail is assumed to be remote, and the comments
3331 above concerning senders and qualification do not apply. In this situation,
3332 Exim behaves in exactly the same way as it does when receiving a message via
3333 the listening daemon.
3334
3335 .vitem &%-bt%&
3336 .oindex "&%-bt%&"
3337 .cindex "testing" "addresses"
3338 .cindex "address" "testing"
3339 This option runs Exim in address testing mode, in which each argument is taken
3340 as a recipient address to be tested for deliverability. The results are
3341 written to the standard output. If a test fails, and the caller is not an admin
3342 user, no details of the failure are output, because these might contain
3343 sensitive information such as usernames and passwords for database lookups.
3344
3345 If no arguments are given, Exim runs in an interactive manner, prompting with a
3346 right angle bracket for addresses to be tested.
3347
3348 Unlike the &%-be%& test option, you cannot arrange for Exim to use the
3349 &[readline()]& function, because it is running as &'root'& and there are
3350 security issues.
3351
3352 Each address is handled as if it were the recipient address of a message
3353 (compare the &%-bv%& option). It is passed to the routers and the result is
3354 written to the standard output. However, any router that has
3355 &%no_address_test%& set is bypassed. This can make &%-bt%& easier to use for
3356 genuine routing tests if your first router passes everything to a scanner
3357 program.
3358
3359 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bt%&"
3360 The return code is 2 if any address failed outright; it is 1 if no address
3361 failed outright but at least one could not be resolved for some reason. Return
3362 code 0 is given only when all addresses succeed.
3363
3364 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
3365 &*Note*&: When actually delivering a message, Exim removes duplicate recipient
3366 addresses after routing is complete, so that only one delivery takes place.
3367 This does not happen when testing with &%-bt%&; the full results of routing are
3368 always shown.
3369
3370 &*Warning*&: &%-bt%& can only do relatively simple testing. If any of the
3371 routers in the configuration makes any tests on the sender address of a
3372 message,
3373 .oindex "&%-f%&" "for address testing"
3374 you can use the &%-f%& option to set an appropriate sender when running
3375 &%-bt%& tests. Without it, the sender is assumed to be the calling user at the
3376 default qualifying domain. However, if you have set up (for example) routers
3377 whose behaviour depends on the contents of an incoming message, you cannot test
3378 those conditions using &%-bt%&. The &%-N%& option provides a possible way of
3379 doing such tests.
3380
3381 .vitem &%-bV%&
3382 .oindex "&%-bV%&"
3383 .cindex "version number of Exim"
3384 This option causes Exim to write the current version number, compilation
3385 number, and compilation date of the &'exim'& binary to the standard output.
3386 It also lists the DBM library that is being used, the optional modules (such as
3387 specific lookup types), the drivers that are included in the binary, and the
3388 name of the run time configuration file that is in use.
3389
3390 As part of its operation, &%-bV%& causes Exim to read and syntax check its
3391 configuration file. However, this is a static check only. It cannot check
3392 values that are to be expanded. For example, although a misspelt ACL verb is
3393 detected, an error in the verb's arguments is not. You cannot rely on &%-bV%&
3394 alone to discover (for example) all the typos in the configuration; some
3395 realistic testing is needed. The &%-bh%& and &%-N%& options provide more
3396 dynamic testing facilities.
3397
3398 .vitem &%-bv%&
3399 .oindex "&%-bv%&"
3400 .cindex "verifying address" "using &%-bv%&"
3401 .cindex "address" "verification"
3402 This option runs Exim in address verification mode, in which each argument is
3403 taken as a recipient address to be verified by the routers. (This does
3404 not involve any verification callouts). During normal operation, verification
3405 happens mostly as a consequence processing a &%verify%& condition in an ACL
3406 (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). If you want to test an entire ACL, possibly
3407 including callouts, see the &%-bh%& and &%-bhc%& options.
3408
3409 If verification fails, and the caller is not an admin user, no details of the
3410 failure are output, because these might contain sensitive information such as
3411 usernames and passwords for database lookups.
3412
3413 If no arguments are given, Exim runs in an interactive manner, prompting with a
3414 right angle bracket for addresses to be verified.
3415
3416 Unlike the &%-be%& test option, you cannot arrange for Exim to use the
3417 &[readline()]& function, because it is running as &'exim'& and there are
3418 security issues.
3419
3420 Verification differs from address testing (the &%-bt%& option) in that routers
3421 that have &%no_verify%& set are skipped, and if the address is accepted by a
3422 router that has &%fail_verify%& set, verification fails. The address is
3423 verified as a recipient if &%-bv%& is used; to test verification for a sender
3424 address, &%-bvs%& should be used.
3425
3426 If the &%-v%& option is not set, the output consists of a single line for each
3427 address, stating whether it was verified or not, and giving a reason in the
3428 latter case. Without &%-v%&, generating more than one address by redirection
3429 causes verification to end successfully, without considering the generated
3430 addresses. However, if just one address is generated, processing continues,
3431 and the generated address must verify successfully for the overall verification
3432 to succeed.
3433
3434 When &%-v%& is set, more details are given of how the address has been handled,
3435 and in the case of address redirection, all the generated addresses are also
3436 considered. Verification may succeed for some and fail for others.
3437
3438 The
3439 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bv%&"
3440 return code is 2 if any address failed outright; it is 1 if no address
3441 failed outright but at least one could not be resolved for some reason. Return
3442 code 0 is given only when all addresses succeed.
3443
3444 If any of the routers in the configuration makes any tests on the sender
3445 address of a message, you should use the &%-f%& option to set an appropriate
3446 sender when running &%-bv%& tests. Without it, the sender is assumed to be the
3447 calling user at the default qualifying domain.
3448
3449 .vitem &%-bvs%&
3450 .oindex "&%-bvs%&"
3451 This option acts like &%-bv%&, but verifies the address as a sender rather
3452 than a recipient address. This affects any rewriting and qualification that
3453 might happen.
3454
3455 .vitem &%-bw%&
3456 .oindex "&%-bw%&"
3457 .cindex "daemon"
3458 .cindex "inetd"
3459 .cindex "inetd" "wait mode"
3460 This option runs Exim as a daemon, awaiting incoming SMTP connections,
3461 similarly to the &%-bd%& option. All port specifications on the command-line
3462 and in the configuration file are ignored. Queue-running may not be specified.
3463
3464 In this mode, Exim expects to be passed a socket as fd 0 (stdin) which is
3465 listening for connections. This permits the system to start up and have
3466 inetd (or equivalent) listen on the SMTP ports, starting an Exim daemon for
3467 each port only when the first connection is received.
3468
3469 If the option is given as &%-bw%&<&'time'&> then the time is a timeout, after
3470 which the daemon will exit, which should cause inetd to listen once more.
3471
3472 .vitem &%-C%&&~<&'filelist'&>
3473 .oindex "&%-C%&"
3474 .cindex "configuration file" "alternate"
3475 .cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
3476 .cindex "alternate configuration file"
3477 This option causes Exim to find the run time configuration file from the given
3478 list instead of from the list specified by the CONFIGURE_FILE
3479 compile-time setting. Usually, the list will consist of just a single file
3480 name, but it can be a colon-separated list of names. In this case, the first
3481 file that exists is used. Failure to open an existing file stops Exim from
3482 proceeding any further along the list, and an error is generated.
3483
3484 When this option is used by a caller other than root, and the list is different
3485 from the compiled-in list, Exim gives up its root privilege immediately, and
3486 runs with the real and effective uid and gid set to those of the caller.
3487 However, if a TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST file is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, that
3488 file contains a list of full pathnames, one per line, for configuration files
3489 which are trusted. Root privilege is retained for any configuration file so
3490 listed, as long as the caller is the Exim user (or the user specified in the
3491 CONFIGURE_OWNER option, if any), and as long as the configuration file is
3492 not writeable by inappropriate users or groups.
3493
3494 Leaving TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST unset precludes the possibility of testing a
3495 configuration using &%-C%& right through message reception and delivery,
3496 even if the caller is root. The reception works, but by that time, Exim is
3497 running as the Exim user, so when it re-executes to regain privilege for the
3498 delivery, the use of &%-C%& causes privilege to be lost. However, root can
3499 test reception and delivery using two separate commands (one to put a message
3500 on the queue, using &%-odq%&, and another to do the delivery, using &%-M%&).
3501
3502 If ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX is defined &_in Local/Makefile_&, it specifies a
3503 prefix string with which any file named in a &%-C%& command line option
3504 must start. In addition, the file name must not contain the sequence &`/../`&.
3505 However, if the value of the &%-C%& option is identical to the value of
3506 CONFIGURE_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_&, Exim ignores &%-C%& and proceeds as
3507 usual. There is no default setting for ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX; when it is
3508 unset, any file name can be used with &%-C%&.
3509
3510 ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX can be used to confine alternative configuration files
3511 to a directory to which only root has access. This prevents someone who has
3512 broken into the Exim account from running a privileged Exim with an arbitrary
3513 configuration file.
3514
3515 The &%-C%& facility is useful for ensuring that configuration files are
3516 syntactically correct, but cannot be used for test deliveries, unless the
3517 caller is privileged, or unless it is an exotic configuration that does not
3518 require privilege. No check is made on the owner or group of the files
3519 specified by this option.
3520
3521
3522 .vitem &%-D%&<&'macro'&>=<&'value'&>
3523 .oindex "&%-D%&"
3524 .cindex "macro" "setting on command line"
3525 This option can be used to override macro definitions in the configuration file
3526 (see section &<<SECTmacrodefs>>&). However, like &%-C%&, if it is used by an
3527 unprivileged caller, it causes Exim to give up its root privilege.
3528 If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, the use of &%-D%& is
3529 completely disabled, and its use causes an immediate error exit.
3530
3531 If WHITELIST_D_MACROS is defined in &_Local/Makefile_& then it should be a
3532 colon-separated list of macros which are considered safe and, if &%-D%& only
3533 supplies macros from this list, and the values are acceptable, then Exim will
3534 not give up root privilege if the caller is root, the Exim run-time user, or
3535 the CONFIGURE_OWNER, if set. This is a transition mechanism and is expected
3536 to be removed in the future. Acceptable values for the macros satisfy the
3537 regexp: &`^[A-Za-z0-9_/.-]*$`&
3538
3539 The entire option (including equals sign if present) must all be within one
3540 command line item. &%-D%& can be used to set the value of a macro to the empty
3541 string, in which case the equals sign is optional. These two commands are
3542 synonymous:
3543 .code
3544 exim -DABC ...
3545 exim -DABC= ...
3546 .endd
3547 To include spaces in a macro definition item, quotes must be used. If you use
3548 quotes, spaces are permitted around the macro name and the equals sign. For
3549 example:
3550 .code
3551 exim '-D ABC = something' ...
3552 .endd
3553 &%-D%& may be repeated up to 10 times on a command line.
3554
3555
3556 .vitem &%-d%&<&'debug&~options'&>
3557 .oindex "&%-d%&"
3558 .cindex "debugging" "list of selectors"
3559 .cindex "debugging" "&%-d%& option"
3560 This option causes debugging information to be written to the standard
3561 error stream. It is restricted to admin users because debugging output may show
3562 database queries that contain password information. Also, the details of users'
3563 filter files should be protected. If a non-admin user uses &%-d%&, Exim
3564 writes an error message to the standard error stream and exits with a non-zero
3565 return code.
3566
3567 When &%-d%& is used, &%-v%& is assumed. If &%-d%& is given on its own, a lot of
3568 standard debugging data is output. This can be reduced, or increased to include
3569 some more rarely needed information, by directly following &%-d%& with a string
3570 made up of names preceded by plus or minus characters. These add or remove sets
3571 of debugging data, respectively. For example, &%-d+filter%& adds filter
3572 debugging, whereas &%-d-all+filter%& selects only filter debugging. Note that
3573 no spaces are allowed in the debug setting. The available debugging categories
3574 are:
3575 .display
3576 &`acl `& ACL interpretation
3577 &`auth `& authenticators
3578 &`deliver `& general delivery logic
3579 &`dns `& DNS lookups (see also resolver)
3580 &`dnsbl `& DNS black list (aka RBL) code
3581 &`exec `& arguments for &[execv()]& calls
3582 &`expand `& detailed debugging for string expansions
3583 &`filter `& filter handling
3584 &`hints_lookup `& hints data lookups
3585 &`host_lookup `& all types of name-to-IP address handling
3586 &`ident `& ident lookup
3587 &`interface `& lists of local interfaces
3588 &`lists `& matching things in lists
3589 &`load `& system load checks
3590 &`local_scan `& can be used by &[local_scan()]& (see chapter &&&
3591 &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&)
3592 &`lookup `& general lookup code and all lookups
3593 &`memory `& memory handling
3594 &`pid `& add pid to debug output lines
3595 &`process_info `& setting info for the process log
3596 &`queue_run `& queue runs
3597 &`receive `& general message reception logic
3598 &`resolver `& turn on the DNS resolver's debugging output
3599 &`retry `& retry handling
3600 &`rewrite `& address rewriting
3601 &`route `& address routing
3602 &`timestamp `& add timestamp to debug output lines
3603 &`tls `& TLS logic
3604 &`transport `& transports
3605 &`uid `& changes of uid/gid and looking up uid/gid
3606 &`verify `& address verification logic
3607 &`all `& almost all of the above (see below), and also &%-v%&
3608 .endd
3609 The &`all`& option excludes &`memory`& when used as &`+all`&, but includes it
3610 for &`-all`&. The reason for this is that &`+all`& is something that people
3611 tend to use when generating debug output for Exim maintainers. If &`+memory`&
3612 is included, an awful lot of output that is very rarely of interest is
3613 generated, so it now has to be explicitly requested. However, &`-all`& does
3614 turn everything off.
3615
3616 .cindex "resolver, debugging output"
3617 .cindex "DNS resolver, debugging output"
3618 The &`resolver`& option produces output only if the DNS resolver was compiled
3619 with DEBUG enabled. This is not the case in some operating systems. Also,
3620 unfortunately, debugging output from the DNS resolver is written to stdout
3621 rather than stderr.
3622
3623 The default (&%-d%& with no argument) omits &`expand`&, &`filter`&,
3624 &`interface`&, &`load`&, &`memory`&, &`pid`&, &`resolver`&, and &`timestamp`&.
3625 However, the &`pid`& selector is forced when debugging is turned on for a
3626 daemon, which then passes it on to any re-executed Exims. Exim also
3627 automatically adds the pid to debug lines when several remote deliveries are
3628 run in parallel.
3629
3630 The &`timestamp`& selector causes the current time to be inserted at the start
3631 of all debug output lines. This can be useful when trying to track down delays
3632 in processing.
3633
3634 If the &%debug_print%& option is set in any driver, it produces output whenever
3635 any debugging is selected, or if &%-v%& is used.
3636
3637 .vitem &%-dd%&<&'debug&~options'&>
3638 .oindex "&%-dd%&"
3639 This option behaves exactly like &%-d%& except when used on a command that
3640 starts a daemon process. In that case, debugging is turned off for the
3641 subprocesses that the daemon creates. Thus, it is useful for monitoring the
3642 behaviour of the daemon without creating as much output as full debugging does.
3643
3644 .vitem &%-dropcr%&
3645 .oindex "&%-dropcr%&"
3646 This is an obsolete option that is now a no-op. It used to affect the way Exim
3647 handled CR and LF characters in incoming messages. What happens now is
3648 described in section &<<SECTlineendings>>&.
3649
3650 .vitem &%-E%&
3651 .oindex "&%-E%&"
3652 .cindex "bounce message" "generating"
3653 This option specifies that an incoming message is a locally-generated delivery
3654 failure report. It is used internally by Exim when handling delivery failures
3655 and is not intended for external use. Its only effect is to stop Exim
3656 generating certain messages to the postmaster, as otherwise message cascades
3657 could occur in some situations. As part of the same option, a message id may
3658 follow the characters &%-E%&. If it does, the log entry for the receipt of the
3659 new message contains the id, following &"R="&, as a cross-reference.
3660
3661 .vitem &%-e%&&'x'&
3662 .oindex "&%-e%&&'x'&"
3663 There are a number of Sendmail options starting with &%-oe%& which seem to be
3664 called by various programs without the leading &%o%& in the option. For
3665 example, the &%vacation%& program uses &%-eq%&. Exim treats all options of the
3666 form &%-e%&&'x'& as synonymous with the corresponding &%-oe%&&'x'& options.
3667
3668 .vitem &%-F%&&~<&'string'&>
3669 .oindex "&%-F%&"
3670 .cindex "sender" "name"
3671 .cindex "name" "of sender"
3672 This option sets the sender's full name for use when a locally-generated
3673 message is being accepted. In the absence of this option, the user's &'gecos'&
3674 entry from the password data is used. As users are generally permitted to alter
3675 their &'gecos'& entries, no security considerations are involved. White space
3676 between &%-F%& and the <&'string'&> is optional.
3677
3678 .vitem &%-f%&&~<&'address'&>
3679 .oindex "&%-f%&"
3680 .cindex "sender" "address"
3681 .cindex "address" "sender"
3682 .cindex "trusted users"
3683 .cindex "envelope sender"
3684 .cindex "user" "trusted"
3685 This option sets the address of the envelope sender of a locally-generated
3686 message (also known as the return path). The option can normally be used only
3687 by a trusted user, but &%untrusted_set_sender%& can be set to allow untrusted
3688 users to use it.
3689
3690 Processes running as root or the Exim user are always trusted. Other
3691 trusted users are defined by the &%trusted_users%& or &%trusted_groups%&
3692 options. In the absence of &%-f%&, or if the caller is not trusted, the sender
3693 of a local message is set to the caller's login name at the default qualify
3694 domain.
3695
3696 There is one exception to the restriction on the use of &%-f%&: an empty sender
3697 can be specified by any user, trusted or not, to create a message that can
3698 never provoke a bounce. An empty sender can be specified either as an empty
3699 string, or as a pair of angle brackets with nothing between them, as in these
3700 examples of shell commands:
3701 .code
3702 exim -f '<>' user@domain
3703 exim -f "" user@domain
3704 .endd
3705 In addition, the use of &%-f%& is not restricted when testing a filter file
3706 with &%-bf%& or when testing or verifying addresses using the &%-bt%& or
3707 &%-bv%& options.
3708
3709 Allowing untrusted users to change the sender address does not of itself make
3710 it possible to send anonymous mail. Exim still checks that the &'From:'& header
3711 refers to the local user, and if it does not, it adds a &'Sender:'& header,
3712 though this can be overridden by setting &%no_local_from_check%&.
3713
3714 White
3715 .cindex "&""From""& line"
3716 space between &%-f%& and the <&'address'&> is optional (that is, they can be
3717 given as two arguments or one combined argument). The sender of a
3718 locally-generated message can also be set (when permitted) by an initial
3719 &"From&~"& line in the message &-- see the description of &%-bm%& above &-- but
3720 if &%-f%& is also present, it overrides &"From&~"&.
3721
3722 .vitem &%-G%&
3723 .oindex "&%-G%&"
3724 .cindex "submission fixups, suppressing (command-line)"
3725 This option is equivalent to an ACL applying:
3726 .code
3727 control = suppress_local_fixups
3728 .endd
3729 for every message received. Note that Sendmail will complain about such
3730 bad formatting, where Exim silently just does not fix it up. This may change
3731 in future.
3732
3733 As this affects audit information, the caller must be a trusted user to use
3734 this option.
3735
3736 .vitem &%-h%&&~<&'number'&>
3737 .oindex "&%-h%&"
3738 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-h%& option ignored"
3739 This option is accepted for compatibility with Sendmail, but has no effect. (In
3740 Sendmail it overrides the &"hop count"& obtained by counting &'Received:'&
3741 headers.)
3742
3743 .vitem &%-i%&
3744 .oindex "&%-i%&"
3745 .cindex "Solaris" "&'mail'& command"
3746 .cindex "dot" "in incoming non-SMTP message"
3747 This option, which has the same effect as &%-oi%&, specifies that a dot on a
3748 line by itself should not terminate an incoming, non-SMTP message. I can find
3749 no documentation for this option in Solaris 2.4 Sendmail, but the &'mailx'&
3750 command in Solaris 2.4 uses it. See also &%-ti%&.
3751
3752 .vitem &%-L%&&~<&'tag'&>
3753 .oindex "&%-L%&"
3754 .cindex "syslog" "process name; set with flag"
3755 This option is equivalent to setting &%syslog_processname%& in the config
3756 file and setting &%log_file_path%& to &`syslog`&.
3757 Its use is restricted to administrators. The configuration file has to be
3758 read and parsed, to determine access rights, before this is set and takes
3759 effect, so early configuration file errors will not honour this flag.
3760
3761 The tag should not be longer than 32 characters.
3762
3763 .vitem &%-M%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3764 .oindex "&%-M%&"
3765 .cindex "forcing delivery"
3766 .cindex "delivery" "forcing attempt"
3767 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
3768 This option requests Exim to run a delivery attempt on each message in turn. If
3769 any of the messages are frozen, they are automatically thawed before the
3770 delivery attempt. The settings of &%queue_domains%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&,
3771 and &%hold_domains%& are ignored.
3772
3773 Retry
3774 .cindex "hints database" "overriding retry hints"
3775 hints for any of the addresses are overridden &-- Exim tries to deliver even if
3776 the normal retry time has not yet been reached. This option requires the caller
3777 to be an admin user. However, there is an option called &%prod_requires_admin%&
3778 which can be set false to relax this restriction (and also the same requirement
3779 for the &%-q%&, &%-R%&, and &%-S%& options).
3780
3781 The deliveries happen synchronously, that is, the original Exim process does
3782 not terminate until all the delivery attempts have finished. No output is
3783 produced unless there is a serious error. If you want to see what is happening,
3784 use the &%-v%& option as well, or inspect Exim's main log.
3785
3786 .vitem &%-Mar%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>&~<&'address'&>&~...
3787 .oindex "&%-Mar%&"
3788 .cindex "message" "adding recipients"
3789 .cindex "recipient" "adding"
3790 This option requests Exim to add the addresses to the list of recipients of the
3791 message (&"ar"& for &"add recipients"&). The first argument must be a message
3792 id, and the remaining ones must be email addresses. However, if the message is
3793 active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), it is not altered. This option
3794 can be used only by an admin user.
3795
3796 .vitem "&%-MC%&&~<&'transport'&>&~<&'hostname'&>&~<&'sequence&~number'&>&&&
3797 &~<&'message&~id'&>"
3798 .oindex "&%-MC%&"
3799 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
3800 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
3801 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
3802 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3803 by Exim to invoke another instance of itself to deliver a waiting message using
3804 an existing SMTP connection, which is passed as the standard input. Details are
3805 given in chapter &<<CHAPSMTP>>&. This must be the final option, and the caller
3806 must be root or the Exim user in order to use it.
3807
3808 .vitem &%-MCA%&
3809 .oindex "&%-MCA%&"
3810 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3811 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that the
3812 connection to the remote host has been authenticated.
3813
3814 .vitem &%-MCP%&
3815 .oindex "&%-MCP%&"
3816 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3817 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that the server to
3818 which Exim is connected supports pipelining.
3819
3820 .vitem &%-MCQ%&&~<&'process&~id'&>&~<&'pipe&~fd'&>
3821 .oindex "&%-MCQ%&"
3822 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3823 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option when the original delivery was
3824 started by a queue runner. It passes on the process id of the queue runner,
3825 together with the file descriptor number of an open pipe. Closure of the pipe
3826 signals the final completion of the sequence of processes that are passing
3827 messages through the same SMTP connection.
3828
3829 .vitem &%-MCS%&
3830 .oindex "&%-MCS%&"
3831 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3832 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option, and passes on the fact that the
3833 SMTP SIZE option should be used on messages delivered down the existing
3834 connection.
3835
3836 .vitem &%-MCT%&
3837 .oindex "&%-MCT%&"
3838 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3839 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option, and passes on the fact that the
3840 host to which Exim is connected supports TLS encryption.
3841
3842 .vitem &%-Mc%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3843 .oindex "&%-Mc%&"
3844 .cindex "hints database" "not overridden by &%-Mc%&"
3845 .cindex "delivery" "manually started &-- not forced"
3846 This option requests Exim to run a delivery attempt on each message in turn,
3847 but unlike the &%-M%& option, it does check for retry hints, and respects any
3848 that are found. This option is not very useful to external callers. It is
3849 provided mainly for internal use by Exim when it needs to re-invoke itself in
3850 order to regain root privilege for a delivery (see chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>&).
3851 However, &%-Mc%& can be useful when testing, in order to run a delivery that
3852 respects retry times and other options such as &%hold_domains%& that are
3853 overridden when &%-M%& is used. Such a delivery does not count as a queue run.
3854 If you want to run a specific delivery as if in a queue run, you should use
3855 &%-q%& with a message id argument. A distinction between queue run deliveries
3856 and other deliveries is made in one or two places.
3857
3858 .vitem &%-Mes%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>
3859 .oindex "&%-Mes%&"
3860 .cindex "message" "changing sender"
3861 .cindex "sender" "changing"
3862 This option requests Exim to change the sender address in the message to the
3863 given address, which must be a fully qualified address or &"<>"& (&"es"& for
3864 &"edit sender"&). There must be exactly two arguments. The first argument must
3865 be a message id, and the second one an email address. However, if the message
3866 is active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not altered.
3867 This option can be used only by an admin user.
3868
3869 .vitem &%-Mf%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3870 .oindex "&%-Mf%&"
3871 .cindex "freezing messages"
3872 .cindex "message" "manually freezing"
3873 This option requests Exim to mark each listed message as &"frozen"&. This
3874 prevents any delivery attempts taking place until the message is &"thawed"&,
3875 either manually or as a result of the &%auto_thaw%& configuration option.
3876 However, if any of the messages are active (in the middle of a delivery
3877 attempt), their status is not altered. This option can be used only by an admin
3878 user.
3879
3880 .vitem &%-Mg%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3881 .oindex "&%-Mg%&"
3882 .cindex "giving up on messages"
3883 .cindex "message" "abandoning delivery attempts"
3884 .cindex "delivery" "abandoning further attempts"
3885 This option requests Exim to give up trying to deliver the listed messages,
3886 including any that are frozen. However, if any of the messages are active,
3887 their status is not altered. For non-bounce messages, a delivery error message
3888 is sent to the sender, containing the text &"cancelled by administrator"&.
3889 Bounce messages are just discarded. This option can be used only by an admin
3890 user.
3891
3892 .vitem &%-Mmad%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3893 .oindex "&%-Mmad%&"
3894 .cindex "delivery" "cancelling all"
3895 This option requests Exim to mark all the recipient addresses in the messages
3896 as already delivered (&"mad"& for &"mark all delivered"&). However, if any
3897 message is active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not
3898 altered. This option can be used only by an admin user.
3899
3900 .vitem &%-Mmd%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>&~<&'address'&>&~...
3901 .oindex "&%-Mmd%&"
3902 .cindex "delivery" "cancelling by address"
3903 .cindex "recipient" "removing"
3904 .cindex "removing recipients"
3905 This option requests Exim to mark the given addresses as already delivered
3906 (&"md"& for &"mark delivered"&). The first argument must be a message id, and
3907 the remaining ones must be email addresses. These are matched to recipient
3908 addresses in the message in a case-sensitive manner. If the message is active
3909 (in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not altered. This option
3910 can be used only by an admin user.
3911
3912 .vitem &%-Mrm%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3913 .oindex "&%-Mrm%&"
3914 .cindex "removing messages"
3915 .cindex "abandoning mail"
3916 .cindex "message" "manually discarding"
3917 This option requests Exim to remove the given messages from the queue. No
3918 bounce messages are sent; each message is simply forgotten. However, if any of
3919 the messages are active, their status is not altered. This option can be used
3920 only by an admin user or by the user who originally caused the message to be
3921 placed on the queue.
3922
3923 .vitem &%-Mset%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3924 .oindex "&%-Mset%&
3925 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
3926 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
3927 This option is useful only in conjunction with &%-be%& (that is, when testing
3928 string expansions). Exim loads the given message from its spool before doing
3929 the test expansions, thus setting message-specific variables such as
3930 &$message_size$& and the header variables. The &$recipients$& variable is made
3931 available. This feature is provided to make it easier to test expansions that
3932 make use of these variables. However, this option can be used only by an admin
3933 user. See also &%-bem%&.
3934
3935 .vitem &%-Mt%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3936 .oindex "&%-Mt%&"
3937 .cindex "thawing messages"
3938 .cindex "unfreezing messages"
3939 .cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
3940 .cindex "message" "thawing frozen"
3941 This option requests Exim to &"thaw"& any of the listed messages that are
3942 &"frozen"&, so that delivery attempts can resume. However, if any of the
3943 messages are active, their status is not altered. This option can be used only
3944 by an admin user.
3945
3946 .vitem &%-Mvb%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3947 .oindex "&%-Mvb%&"
3948 .cindex "listing" "message body"
3949 .cindex "message" "listing body of"
3950 This option causes the contents of the message body (-D) spool file to be
3951 written to the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
3952
3953 .vitem &%-Mvc%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3954 .oindex "&%-Mvc%&"
3955 .cindex "message" "listing in RFC 2822 format"
3956 .cindex "listing" "message in RFC 2822 format"
3957 This option causes a copy of the complete message (header lines plus body) to
3958 be written to the standard output in RFC 2822 format. This option can be used
3959 only by an admin user.
3960
3961 .vitem &%-Mvh%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3962 .oindex "&%-Mvh%&"
3963 .cindex "listing" "message headers"
3964 .cindex "header lines" "listing"
3965 .cindex "message" "listing header lines"
3966 This option causes the contents of the message headers (-H) spool file to be
3967 written to the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
3968
3969 .vitem &%-Mvl%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3970 .oindex "&%-Mvl%&"
3971 .cindex "listing" "message log"
3972 .cindex "message" "listing message log"
3973 This option causes the contents of the message log spool file to be written to
3974 the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
3975
3976 .vitem &%-m%&
3977 .oindex "&%-m%&"
3978 This is apparently a synonym for &%-om%& that is accepted by Sendmail, so Exim
3979 treats it that way too.
3980
3981 .vitem &%-N%&
3982 .oindex "&%-N%&"
3983 .cindex "debugging" "&%-N%& option"
3984 .cindex "debugging" "suppressing delivery"
3985 This is a debugging option that inhibits delivery of a message at the transport
3986 level. It implies &%-v%&. Exim goes through many of the motions of delivery &--
3987 it just doesn't actually transport the message, but instead behaves as if it
3988 had successfully done so. However, it does not make any updates to the retry
3989 database, and the log entries for deliveries are flagged with &"*>"& rather
3990 than &"=>"&.
3991
3992 Because &%-N%& discards any message to which it applies, only root or the Exim
3993 user are allowed to use it with &%-bd%&, &%-q%&, &%-R%& or &%-M%&. In other
3994 words, an ordinary user can use it only when supplying an incoming message to
3995 which it will apply. Although transportation never fails when &%-N%& is set, an
3996 address may be deferred because of a configuration problem on a transport, or a
3997 routing problem. Once &%-N%& has been used for a delivery attempt, it sticks to
3998 the message, and applies to any subsequent delivery attempts that may happen
3999 for that message.
4000
4001 .vitem &%-n%&
4002 .oindex "&%-n%&"
4003 This option is interpreted by Sendmail to mean &"no aliasing"&.
4004 For normal modes of operation, it is ignored by Exim.
4005 When combined with &%-bP%& it suppresses the name of an option from being output.
4006
4007 .vitem &%-O%&&~<&'data'&>
4008 .oindex "&%-O%&"
4009 This option is interpreted by Sendmail to mean &`set option`&. It is ignored by
4010 Exim.
4011
4012 .vitem &%-oA%&&~<&'file&~name'&>
4013 .oindex "&%-oA%&"
4014 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-oA%& option"
4015 This option is used by Sendmail in conjunction with &%-bi%& to specify an
4016 alternative alias file name. Exim handles &%-bi%& differently; see the
4017 description above.
4018
4019 .vitem &%-oB%&&~<&'n'&>
4020 .oindex "&%-oB%&"
4021 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
4022 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
4023 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
4024 This is a debugging option which limits the maximum number of messages that can
4025 be delivered down one SMTP connection, overriding the value set in any &(smtp)&
4026 transport. If <&'n'&> is omitted, the limit is set to 1.
4027
4028 .vitem &%-odb%&
4029 .oindex "&%-odb%&"
4030 .cindex "background delivery"
4031 .cindex "delivery" "in the background"
4032 This option applies to all modes in which Exim accepts incoming messages,
4033 including the listening daemon. It requests &"background"& delivery of such
4034 messages, which means that the accepting process automatically starts a
4035 delivery process for each message received, but does not wait for the delivery
4036 processes to finish.
4037
4038 When all the messages have been received, the reception process exits,
4039 leaving the delivery processes to finish in their own time. The standard output
4040 and error streams are closed at the start of each delivery process.
4041 This is the default action if none of the &%-od%& options are present.
4042
4043 If one of the queueing options in the configuration file
4044 (&%queue_only%& or &%queue_only_file%&, for example) is in effect, &%-odb%&
4045 overrides it if &%queue_only_override%& is set true, which is the default
4046 setting. If &%queue_only_override%& is set false, &%-odb%& has no effect.
4047
4048 .vitem &%-odf%&
4049 .oindex "&%-odf%&"
4050 .cindex "foreground delivery"
4051 .cindex "delivery" "in the foreground"
4052 This option requests &"foreground"& (synchronous) delivery when Exim has
4053 accepted a locally-generated message. (For the daemon it is exactly the same as
4054 &%-odb%&.) A delivery process is automatically started to deliver the message,
4055 and Exim waits for it to complete before proceeding.
4056
4057 The original Exim reception process does not finish until the delivery
4058 process for the final message has ended. The standard error stream is left open
4059 during deliveries.
4060
4061 However, like &%-odb%&, this option has no effect if &%queue_only_override%& is
4062 false and one of the queueing options in the configuration file is in effect.
4063
4064 If there is a temporary delivery error during foreground delivery, the
4065 message is left on the queue for later delivery, and the original reception
4066 process exits. See chapter &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>& for a way of setting up a
4067 restricted configuration that never queues messages.
4068
4069
4070 .vitem &%-odi%&
4071 .oindex "&%-odi%&"
4072 This option is synonymous with &%-odf%&. It is provided for compatibility with
4073 Sendmail.
4074
4075 .vitem &%-odq%&
4076 .oindex "&%-odq%&"
4077 .cindex "non-immediate delivery"
4078 .cindex "delivery" "suppressing immediate"
4079 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
4080 This option applies to all modes in which Exim accepts incoming messages,
4081 including the listening daemon. It specifies that the accepting process should
4082 not automatically start a delivery process for each message received. Messages
4083 are placed on the queue, and remain there until a subsequent queue runner
4084 process encounters them. There are several configuration options (such as
4085 &%queue_only%&) that can be used to queue incoming messages under certain
4086 conditions. This option overrides all of them and also &%-odqs%&. It always
4087 forces queueing.
4088
4089 .vitem &%-odqs%&
4090 .oindex "&%-odqs%&"
4091 .cindex "SMTP" "delaying delivery"
4092 This option is a hybrid between &%-odb%&/&%-odi%& and &%-odq%&.
4093 However, like &%-odb%& and &%-odi%&, this option has no effect if
4094 &%queue_only_override%& is false and one of the queueing options in the
4095 configuration file is in effect.
4096
4097 When &%-odqs%& does operate, a delivery process is started for each incoming
4098 message, in the background by default, but in the foreground if &%-odi%& is
4099 also present. The recipient addresses are routed, and local deliveries are done
4100 in the normal way. However, if any SMTP deliveries are required, they are not
4101 done at this time, so the message remains on the queue until a subsequent queue
4102 runner process encounters it. Because routing was done, Exim knows which
4103 messages are waiting for which hosts, and so a number of messages for the same
4104 host can be sent in a single SMTP connection. The &%queue_smtp_domains%&
4105 configuration option has the same effect for specific domains. See also the
4106 &%-qq%& option.
4107
4108 .vitem &%-oee%&
4109 .oindex "&%-oee%&"
4110 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4111 If an error is detected while a non-SMTP message is being received (for
4112 example, a malformed address), the error is reported to the sender in a mail
4113 message.
4114
4115 .cindex "return code" "for &%-oee%&"
4116 Provided
4117 this error message is successfully sent, the Exim receiving process
4118 exits with a return code of zero. If not, the return code is 2 if the problem
4119 is that the original message has no recipients, or 1 for any other error.
4120 This is the default &%-oe%&&'x'& option if Exim is called as &'rmail'&.
4121
4122 .vitem &%-oem%&
4123 .oindex "&%-oem%&"
4124 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4125 .cindex "return code" "for &%-oem%&"
4126 This is the same as &%-oee%&, except that Exim always exits with a non-zero
4127 return code, whether or not the error message was successfully sent.
4128 This is the default &%-oe%&&'x'& option, unless Exim is called as &'rmail'&.
4129
4130 .vitem &%-oep%&
4131 .oindex "&%-oep%&"
4132 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4133 If an error is detected while a non-SMTP message is being received, the
4134 error is reported by writing a message to the standard error file (stderr).
4135 .cindex "return code" "for &%-oep%&"
4136 The return code is 1 for all errors.
4137
4138 .vitem &%-oeq%&
4139 .oindex "&%-oeq%&"
4140 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4141 This option is supported for compatibility with Sendmail, but has the same
4142 effect as &%-oep%&.
4143
4144 .vitem &%-oew%&
4145 .oindex "&%-oew%&"
4146 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4147 This option is supported for compatibility with Sendmail, but has the same
4148 effect as &%-oem%&.
4149
4150 .vitem &%-oi%&
4151 .oindex "&%-oi%&"
4152 .cindex "dot" "in incoming non-SMTP message"
4153 This option, which has the same effect as &%-i%&, specifies that a dot on a
4154 line by itself should not terminate an incoming, non-SMTP message. Otherwise, a
4155 single dot does terminate, though Exim does no special processing for other
4156 lines that start with a dot. This option is set by default if Exim is called as
4157 &'rmail'&. See also &%-ti%&.
4158
4159 .vitem &%-oitrue%&
4160 .oindex "&%-oitrue%&"
4161 This option is treated as synonymous with &%-oi%&.
4162
4163 .vitem &%-oMa%&&~<&'host&~address'&>
4164 .oindex "&%-oMa%&"
4165 .cindex "sender" "host address, specifying for local message"
4166 A number of options starting with &%-oM%& can be used to set values associated
4167 with remote hosts on locally-submitted messages (that is, messages not received
4168 over TCP/IP). These options can be used by any caller in conjunction with the
4169 &%-bh%&, &%-be%&, &%-bf%&, &%-bF%&, &%-bt%&, or &%-bv%& testing options. In
4170 other circumstances, they are ignored unless the caller is trusted.
4171
4172 The &%-oMa%& option sets the sender host address. This may include a port
4173 number at the end, after a full stop (period). For example:
4174 .code
4175 exim -bs -oMa 10.9.8.7.1234
4176 .endd
4177 An alternative syntax is to enclose the IP address in square brackets,
4178 followed by a colon and the port number:
4179 .code
4180 exim -bs -oMa [10.9.8.7]:1234
4181 .endd
4182 The IP address is placed in the &$sender_host_address$& variable, and the
4183 port, if present, in &$sender_host_port$&. If both &%-oMa%& and &%-bh%&
4184 are present on the command line, the sender host IP address is taken from
4185 whichever one is last.
4186
4187 .vitem &%-oMaa%&&~<&'name'&>
4188 .oindex "&%-oMaa%&"
4189 .cindex "authentication" "name, specifying for local message"
4190 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMaa%&
4191 option sets the value of &$sender_host_authenticated$& (the authenticator
4192 name). See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of SMTP authentication.
4193 This option can be used with &%-bh%& and &%-bs%& to set up an
4194 authenticated SMTP session without actually using the SMTP AUTH command.
4195
4196 .vitem &%-oMai%&&~<&'string'&>
4197 .oindex "&%-oMai%&"
4198 .cindex "authentication" "id, specifying for local message"
4199 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMai%&
4200 option sets the value of &$authenticated_id$& (the id that was authenticated).
4201 This overrides the default value (the caller's login id, except with &%-bh%&,
4202 where there is no default) for messages from local sources. See chapter
4203 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of authenticated ids.
4204
4205 .vitem &%-oMas%&&~<&'address'&>
4206 .oindex "&%-oMas%&"
4207 .cindex "authentication" "sender, specifying for local message"
4208 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMas%&
4209 option sets the authenticated sender value in &$authenticated_sender$&. It
4210 overrides the sender address that is created from the caller's login id for
4211 messages from local sources, except when &%-bh%& is used, when there is no
4212 default. For both &%-bh%& and &%-bs%&, an authenticated sender that is
4213 specified on a MAIL command overrides this value. See chapter
4214 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of authenticated senders.
4215
4216 .vitem &%-oMi%&&~<&'interface&~address'&>
4217 .oindex "&%-oMi%&"
4218 .cindex "interface" "address, specifying for local message"
4219 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMi%&
4220 option sets the IP interface address value. A port number may be included,
4221 using the same syntax as for &%-oMa%&. The interface address is placed in
4222 &$received_ip_address$& and the port number, if present, in &$received_port$&.
4223
4224 .vitem &%-oMr%&&~<&'protocol&~name'&>
4225 .oindex "&%-oMr%&"
4226 .cindex "protocol, specifying for local message"
4227 .vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
4228 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMr%&
4229 option sets the received protocol value that is stored in
4230 &$received_protocol$&. However, it does not apply (and is ignored) when &%-bh%&
4231 or &%-bs%& is used. For &%-bh%&, the protocol is forced to one of the standard
4232 SMTP protocol names (see the description of &$received_protocol$& in section
4233 &<<SECTexpvar>>&). For &%-bs%&, the protocol is always &"local-"& followed by
4234 one of those same names. For &%-bS%& (batched SMTP) however, the protocol can
4235 be set by &%-oMr%&.
4236
4237 .vitem &%-oMs%&&~<&'host&~name'&>
4238 .oindex "&%-oMs%&"
4239 .cindex "sender" "host name, specifying for local message"
4240 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMs%&
4241 option sets the sender host name in &$sender_host_name$&. When this option is
4242 present, Exim does not attempt to look up a host name from an IP address; it
4243 uses the name it is given.
4244
4245 .vitem &%-oMt%&&~<&'ident&~string'&>
4246 .oindex "&%-oMt%&"
4247 .cindex "sender" "ident string, specifying for local message"
4248 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMt%&
4249 option sets the sender ident value in &$sender_ident$&. The default setting for
4250 local callers is the login id of the calling process, except when &%-bh%& is
4251 used, when there is no default.
4252
4253 .vitem &%-om%&
4254 .oindex "&%-om%&"
4255 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-om%& option ignored"
4256 In Sendmail, this option means &"me too"&, indicating that the sender of a
4257 message should receive a copy of the message if the sender appears in an alias
4258 expansion. Exim always does this, so the option does nothing.
4259
4260 .vitem &%-oo%&
4261 .oindex "&%-oo%&"
4262 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-oo%& option ignored"
4263 This option is ignored. In Sendmail it specifies &"old style headers"&,
4264 whatever that means.
4265
4266 .vitem &%-oP%&&~<&'path'&>
4267 .oindex "&%-oP%&"
4268 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
4269 .cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
4270 This option is useful only in conjunction with &%-bd%& or &%-q%& with a time
4271 value. The option specifies the file to which the process id of the daemon is
4272 written. When &%-oX%& is used with &%-bd%&, or when &%-q%& with a time is used
4273 without &%-bd%&, this is the only way of causing Exim to write a pid file,
4274 because in those cases, the normal pid file is not used.
4275
4276 .vitem &%-or%&&~<&'time'&>
4277 .oindex "&%-or%&"
4278 .cindex "timeout" "for non-SMTP input"
4279 This option sets a timeout value for incoming non-SMTP messages. If it is not
4280 set, Exim will wait forever for the standard input. The value can also be set
4281 by the &%receive_timeout%& option. The format used for specifying times is
4282 described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&.
4283
4284 .vitem &%-os%&&~<&'time'&>
4285 .oindex "&%-os%&"
4286 .cindex "timeout" "for SMTP input"
4287 .cindex "SMTP" "input timeout"
4288 This option sets a timeout value for incoming SMTP messages. The timeout
4289 applies to each SMTP command and block of data. The value can also be set by
4290 the &%smtp_receive_timeout%& option; it defaults to 5 minutes. The format used
4291 for specifying times is described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&.
4292
4293 .vitem &%-ov%&
4294 .oindex "&%-ov%&"
4295 This option has exactly the same effect as &%-v%&.
4296
4297 .vitem &%-oX%&&~<&'number&~or&~string'&>
4298 .oindex "&%-oX%&"
4299 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
4300 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening interfaces"
4301 .cindex "port" "receiving TCP/IP"
4302 This option is relevant only when the &%-bd%& (start listening daemon) option
4303 is also given. It controls which ports and interfaces the daemon uses. Details
4304 of the syntax, and how it interacts with configuration file options, are given
4305 in chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>&. When &%-oX%& is used to start a daemon, no pid
4306 file is written unless &%-oP%& is also present to specify a pid file name.
4307
4308 .vitem &%-pd%&
4309 .oindex "&%-pd%&"
4310 .cindex "Perl" "starting the interpreter"
4311 This option applies when an embedded Perl interpreter is linked with Exim (see
4312 chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&). It overrides the setting of the &%perl_at_start%&
4313 option, forcing the starting of the interpreter to be delayed until it is
4314 needed.
4315
4316 .vitem &%-ps%&
4317 .oindex "&%-ps%&"
4318 .cindex "Perl" "starting the interpreter"
4319 This option applies when an embedded Perl interpreter is linked with Exim (see
4320 chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&). It overrides the setting of the &%perl_at_start%&
4321 option, forcing the starting of the interpreter to occur as soon as Exim is
4322 started.
4323
4324 .vitem &%-p%&<&'rval'&>:<&'sval'&>
4325 .oindex "&%-p%&"
4326 For compatibility with Sendmail, this option is equivalent to
4327 .display
4328 &`-oMr`& <&'rval'&> &`-oMs`& <&'sval'&>
4329 .endd
4330 It sets the incoming protocol and host name (for trusted callers). The
4331 host name and its colon can be omitted when only the protocol is to be set.
4332 Note the Exim already has two private options, &%-pd%& and &%-ps%&, that refer
4333 to embedded Perl. It is therefore impossible to set a protocol value of &`d`&
4334 or &`s`& using this option (but that does not seem a real limitation).
4335
4336 .vitem &%-q%&
4337 .oindex "&%-q%&"
4338 .cindex "queue runner" "starting manually"
4339 This option is normally restricted to admin users. However, there is a
4340 configuration option called &%prod_requires_admin%& which can be set false to
4341 relax this restriction (and also the same requirement for the &%-M%&, &%-R%&,
4342 and &%-S%& options).
4343
4344 .cindex "queue runner" "description of operation"
4345 The &%-q%& option starts one queue runner process. This scans the queue of
4346 waiting messages, and runs a delivery process for each one in turn. It waits
4347 for each delivery process to finish before starting the next one. A delivery
4348 process may not actually do any deliveries if the retry times for the addresses
4349 have not been reached. Use &%-qf%& (see below) if you want to override this.
4350
4351 If
4352 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
4353 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
4354 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
4355 the delivery process spawns other processes to deliver other messages down
4356 passed SMTP connections, the queue runner waits for these to finish before
4357 proceeding.
4358
4359 When all the queued messages have been considered, the original queue runner
4360 process terminates. In other words, a single pass is made over the waiting
4361 mail, one message at a time. Use &%-q%& with a time (see below) if you want
4362 this to be repeated periodically.
4363
4364 Exim processes the waiting messages in an unpredictable order. It isn't very
4365 random, but it is likely to be different each time, which is all that matters.
4366 If one particular message screws up a remote MTA, other messages to the same
4367 MTA have a chance of getting through if they get tried first.
4368
4369 It is possible to cause the messages to be processed in lexical message id
4370 order, which is essentially the order in which they arrived, by setting the
4371 &%queue_run_in_order%& option, but this is not recommended for normal use.
4372
4373 .vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&>
4374 The &%-q%& option may be followed by one or more flag letters that change its
4375 behaviour. They are all optional, but if more than one is present, they must
4376 appear in the correct order. Each flag is described in a separate item below.
4377
4378 .vitem &%-qq...%&
4379 .oindex "&%-qq%&"
4380 .cindex "queue" "double scanning"
4381 .cindex "queue" "routing"
4382 .cindex "routing" "whole queue before delivery"
4383 An option starting with &%-qq%& requests a two-stage queue run. In the first
4384 stage, the queue is scanned as if the &%queue_smtp_domains%& option matched
4385 every domain. Addresses are routed, local deliveries happen, but no remote
4386 transports are run.
4387
4388 .cindex "hints database" "remembering routing"
4389 The hints database that remembers which messages are waiting for specific hosts
4390 is updated, as if delivery to those hosts had been deferred. After this is
4391 complete, a second, normal queue scan happens, with routing and delivery taking
4392 place as normal. Messages that are routed to the same host should mostly be
4393 delivered down a single SMTP
4394 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
4395 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
4396 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
4397 connection because of the hints that were set up during the first queue scan.
4398 This option may be useful for hosts that are connected to the Internet
4399 intermittently.
4400
4401 .vitem &%-q[q]i...%&
4402 .oindex "&%-qi%&"
4403 .cindex "queue" "initial delivery"
4404 If the &'i'& flag is present, the queue runner runs delivery processes only for
4405 those messages that haven't previously been tried. (&'i'& stands for &"initial
4406 delivery"&.) This can be helpful if you are putting messages on the queue using
4407 &%-odq%& and want a queue runner just to process the new messages.
4408
4409 .vitem &%-q[q][i]f...%&
4410 .oindex "&%-qf%&"
4411 .cindex "queue" "forcing delivery"
4412 .cindex "delivery" "forcing in queue run"
4413 If one &'f'& flag is present, a delivery attempt is forced for each non-frozen
4414 message, whereas without &'f'& only those non-frozen addresses that have passed
4415 their retry times are tried.
4416
4417 .vitem &%-q[q][i]ff...%&
4418 .oindex "&%-qff%&"
4419 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
4420 If &'ff'& is present, a delivery attempt is forced for every message, whether
4421 frozen or not.
4422
4423 .vitem &%-q[q][i][f[f]]l%&
4424 .oindex "&%-ql%&"
4425 .cindex "queue" "local deliveries only"
4426 The &'l'& (the letter &"ell"&) flag specifies that only local deliveries are to
4427 be done. If a message requires any remote deliveries, it remains on the queue
4428 for later delivery.
4429
4430 .vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&>&~<&'start&~id'&>&~<&'end&~id'&>
4431 .cindex "queue" "delivering specific messages"
4432 When scanning the queue, Exim can be made to skip over messages whose ids are
4433 lexically less than a given value by following the &%-q%& option with a
4434 starting message id. For example:
4435 .code
4436 exim -q 0t5C6f-0000c8-00
4437 .endd
4438 Messages that arrived earlier than &`0t5C6f-0000c8-00`& are not inspected. If a
4439 second message id is given, messages whose ids are lexically greater than it
4440 are also skipped. If the same id is given twice, for example,
4441 .code
4442 exim -q 0t5C6f-0000c8-00 0t5C6f-0000c8-00
4443 .endd
4444 just one delivery process is started, for that message. This differs from
4445 &%-M%& in that retry data is respected, and it also differs from &%-Mc%& in
4446 that it counts as a delivery from a queue run. Note that the selection
4447 mechanism does not affect the order in which the messages are scanned. There
4448 are also other ways of selecting specific sets of messages for delivery in a
4449 queue run &-- see &%-R%& and &%-S%&.
4450
4451 .vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&><&'time'&>
4452 .cindex "queue runner" "starting periodically"
4453 .cindex "periodic queue running"
4454 When a time value is present, the &%-q%& option causes Exim to run as a daemon,
4455 starting a queue runner process at intervals specified by the given time value
4456 (whose format is described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&). This form of the
4457 &%-q%& option is commonly combined with the &%-bd%& option, in which case a
4458 single daemon process handles both functions. A common way of starting up a
4459 combined daemon at system boot time is to use a command such as
4460 .code
4461 /usr/exim/bin/exim -bd -q30m
4462 .endd
4463 Such a daemon listens for incoming SMTP calls, and also starts a queue runner
4464 process every 30 minutes.
4465
4466 When a daemon is started by &%-q%& with a time value, but without &%-bd%&, no
4467 pid file is written unless one is explicitly requested by the &%-oP%& option.
4468
4469 .vitem &%-qR%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4470 .oindex "&%-qR%&"
4471 This option is synonymous with &%-R%&. It is provided for Sendmail
4472 compatibility.
4473
4474 .vitem &%-qS%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4475 .oindex "&%-qS%&"
4476 This option is synonymous with &%-S%&.
4477
4478 .vitem &%-R%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4479 .oindex "&%-R%&"
4480 .cindex "queue runner" "for specific recipients"
4481 .cindex "delivery" "to given domain"
4482 .cindex "domain" "delivery to"
4483 The <&'rsflags'&> may be empty, in which case the white space before the string
4484 is optional, unless the string is &'f'&, &'ff'&, &'r'&, &'rf'&, or &'rff'&,
4485 which are the possible values for <&'rsflags'&>. White space is required if
4486 <&'rsflags'&> is not empty.
4487
4488 This option is similar to &%-q%& with no time value, that is, it causes Exim to
4489 perform a single queue run, except that, when scanning the messages on the
4490 queue, Exim processes only those that have at least one undelivered recipient
4491 address containing the given string, which is checked in a case-independent
4492 way. If the <&'rsflags'&> start with &'r'&, <&'string'&> is interpreted as a
4493 regular expression; otherwise it is a literal string.
4494
4495 If you want to do periodic queue runs for messages with specific recipients,
4496 you can combine &%-R%& with &%-q%& and a time value. For example:
4497 .code
4498 exim -q25m -R @special.domain.example
4499 .endd
4500 This example does a queue run for messages with recipients in the given domain
4501 every 25 minutes. Any additional flags that are specified with &%-q%& are
4502 applied to each queue run.
4503
4504 Once a message is selected for delivery by this mechanism, all its addresses
4505 are processed. For the first selected message, Exim overrides any retry
4506 information and forces a delivery attempt for each undelivered address. This
4507 means that if delivery of any address in the first message is successful, any
4508 existing retry information is deleted, and so delivery attempts for that
4509 address in subsequently selected messages (which are processed without forcing)
4510 will run. However, if delivery of any address does not succeed, the retry
4511 information is updated, and in subsequently selected messages, the failing
4512 address will be skipped.
4513
4514 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
4515 If the <&'rsflags'&> contain &'f'& or &'ff'&, the delivery forcing applies to
4516 all selected messages, not just the first; frozen messages are included when
4517 &'ff'& is present.
4518
4519 The &%-R%& option makes it straightforward to initiate delivery of all messages
4520 to a given domain after a host has been down for some time. When the SMTP
4521 command ETRN is accepted by its ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&), its default
4522 effect is to run Exim with the &%-R%& option, but it can be configured to run
4523 an arbitrary command instead.
4524
4525 .vitem &%-r%&
4526 .oindex "&%-r%&"
4527 This is a documented (for Sendmail) obsolete alternative name for &%-f%&.
4528
4529 .vitem &%-S%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4530 .oindex "&%-S%&"
4531 .cindex "delivery" "from given sender"
4532 .cindex "queue runner" "for specific senders"
4533 This option acts like &%-R%& except that it checks the string against each
4534 message's sender instead of against the recipients. If &%-R%& is also set, both
4535 conditions must be met for a message to be selected. If either of the options
4536 has &'f'& or &'ff'& in its flags, the associated action is taken.
4537
4538 .vitem &%-Tqt%&&~<&'times'&>
4539 .oindex "&%-Tqt%&"
4540 This is an option that is exclusively for use by the Exim testing suite. It is not
4541 recognized when Exim is run normally. It allows for the setting up of explicit
4542 &"queue times"& so that various warning/retry features can be tested.
4543
4544 .vitem &%-t%&
4545 .oindex "&%-t%&"
4546 .cindex "recipient" "extracting from header lines"
4547 .cindex "&'Bcc:'& header line"
4548 .cindex "&'Cc:'& header line"
4549 .cindex "&'To:'& header line"
4550 When Exim is receiving a locally-generated, non-SMTP message on its standard
4551 input, the &%-t%& option causes the recipients of the message to be obtained
4552 from the &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and &'Bcc:'& header lines in the message instead of
4553 from the command arguments. The addresses are extracted before any rewriting
4554 takes place and the &'Bcc:'& header line, if present, is then removed.
4555
4556 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-t%& option"
4557 If the command has any arguments, they specify addresses to which the message
4558 is &'not'& to be delivered. That is, the argument addresses are removed from
4559 the recipients list obtained from the headers. This is compatible with Smail 3
4560 and in accordance with the documented behaviour of several versions of
4561 Sendmail, as described in man pages on a number of operating systems (e.g.
4562 Solaris 8, IRIX 6.5, HP-UX 11). However, some versions of Sendmail &'add'&
4563 argument addresses to those obtained from the headers, and the O'Reilly
4564 Sendmail book documents it that way. Exim can be made to add argument addresses
4565 instead of subtracting them by setting the option
4566 &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& false.
4567
4568 .cindex "&%Resent-%& header lines" "with &%-t%&"
4569 If there are any &%Resent-%& header lines in the message, Exim extracts
4570 recipients from all &'Resent-To:'&, &'Resent-Cc:'&, and &'Resent-Bcc:'& header
4571 lines instead of from &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and &'Bcc:'&. This is for compatibility
4572 with Sendmail and other MTAs. (Prior to release 4.20, Exim gave an error if
4573 &%-t%& was used in conjunction with &%Resent-%& header lines.)
4574
4575 RFC 2822 talks about different sets of &%Resent-%& header lines (for when a
4576 message is resent several times). The RFC also specifies that they should be
4577 added at the front of the message, and separated by &'Received:'& lines. It is
4578 not at all clear how &%-t%& should operate in the present of multiple sets,
4579 nor indeed exactly what constitutes a &"set"&.
4580 In practice, it seems that MUAs do not follow the RFC. The &%Resent-%& lines
4581 are often added at the end of the header, and if a message is resent more than
4582 once, it is common for the original set of &%Resent-%& headers to be renamed as
4583 &%X-Resent-%& when a new set is added. This removes any possible ambiguity.
4584
4585 .vitem &%-ti%&
4586 .oindex "&%-ti%&"
4587 This option is exactly equivalent to &%-t%& &%-i%&. It is provided for
4588 compatibility with Sendmail.
4589
4590 .vitem &%-tls-on-connect%&
4591 .oindex "&%-tls-on-connect%&"
4592 .cindex "TLS" "use without STARTTLS"
4593 .cindex "TLS" "automatic start"
4594 This option is available when Exim is compiled with TLS support. It forces all
4595 incoming SMTP connections to behave as if the incoming port is listed in the
4596 &%tls_on_connect_ports%& option. See section &<<SECTsupobssmt>>& and chapter
4597 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
4598
4599
4600 .vitem &%-U%&
4601 .oindex "&%-U%&"
4602 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-U%& option ignored"
4603 Sendmail uses this option for &"initial message submission"&, and its
4604 documentation states that in future releases, it may complain about
4605 syntactically invalid messages rather than fixing them when this flag is not
4606 set. Exim ignores this option.
4607
4608 .vitem &%-v%&
4609 .oindex "&%-v%&"
4610 This option causes Exim to write information to the standard error stream,
4611 describing what it is doing. In particular, it shows the log lines for
4612 receiving and delivering a message, and if an SMTP connection is made, the SMTP
4613 dialogue is shown. Some of the log lines shown may not actually be written to
4614 the log if the setting of &%log_selector%& discards them. Any relevant
4615 selectors are shown with each log line. If none are shown, the logging is
4616 unconditional.
4617
4618 .vitem &%-x%&
4619 .oindex "&%-x%&"
4620 AIX uses &%-x%& for a private purpose (&"mail from a local mail program has
4621 National Language Support extended characters in the body of the mail item"&).
4622 It sets &%-x%& when calling the MTA from its &%mail%& command. Exim ignores
4623 this option.
4624
4625 .vitem &%-X%&&~<&'logfile'&>
4626 .oindex "&%-X%&"
4627 This option is interpreted by Sendmail to cause debug information to be sent
4628 to the named file. It is ignored by Exim.
4629 .endlist
4630
4631 .ecindex IIDclo1
4632 .ecindex IIDclo2
4633
4634
4635 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4636 . Insert a stylized DocBook comment here, to identify the end of the command
4637 . line options. This is for the benefit of the Perl script that automatically
4638 . creates a man page for the options.
4639 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4640
4641 .literal xml
4642 <!-- === End of command line options === -->
4643 .literal off
4644
4645
4646
4647
4648
4649 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4650 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4651
4652
4653 .chapter "The Exim run time configuration file" "CHAPconf" &&&
4654 "The runtime configuration file"
4655
4656 .cindex "run time configuration"
4657 .cindex "configuration file" "general description"
4658 .cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
4659 .cindex "configuration file" "errors in"
4660 .cindex "error" "in configuration file"
4661 .cindex "return code" "for bad configuration"
4662 Exim uses a single run time configuration file that is read whenever an Exim
4663 binary is executed. Note that in normal operation, this happens frequently,
4664 because Exim is designed to operate in a distributed manner, without central
4665 control.
4666
4667 If a syntax error is detected while reading the configuration file, Exim
4668 writes a message on the standard error, and exits with a non-zero return code.
4669 The message is also written to the panic log. &*Note*&: Only simple syntax
4670 errors can be detected at this time. The values of any expanded options are
4671 not checked until the expansion happens, even when the expansion does not
4672 actually alter the string.
4673
4674 The name of the configuration file is compiled into the binary for security
4675 reasons, and is specified by the CONFIGURE_FILE compilation option. In
4676 most configurations, this specifies a single file. However, it is permitted to
4677 give a colon-separated list of file names, in which case Exim uses the first
4678 existing file in the list.
4679
4680 .cindex "EXIM_USER"
4681 .cindex "EXIM_GROUP"
4682 .cindex "CONFIGURE_OWNER"
4683 .cindex "CONFIGURE_GROUP"
4684 .cindex "configuration file" "ownership"
4685 .cindex "ownership" "configuration file"
4686 The run time configuration file must be owned by root or by the user that is
4687 specified at compile time by the CONFIGURE_OWNER option (if set). The
4688 configuration file must not be world-writeable, or group-writeable unless its
4689 group is the root group or the one specified at compile time by the
4690 CONFIGURE_GROUP option.
4691
4692 &*Warning*&: In a conventional configuration, where the Exim binary is setuid
4693 to root, anybody who is able to edit the run time configuration file has an
4694 easy way to run commands as root. If you specify a user or group in the
4695 CONFIGURE_OWNER or CONFIGURE_GROUP options, then that user and/or any users
4696 who are members of that group will trivially be able to obtain root privileges.
4697
4698 Up to Exim version 4.72, the run time configuration file was also permitted to
4699 be writeable by the Exim user and/or group. That has been changed in Exim 4.73
4700 since it offered a simple privilege escalation for any attacker who managed to
4701 compromise the Exim user account.
4702
4703 A default configuration file, which will work correctly in simple situations,
4704 is provided in the file &_src/configure.default_&. If CONFIGURE_FILE
4705 defines just one file name, the installation process copies the default
4706 configuration to a new file of that name if it did not previously exist. If
4707 CONFIGURE_FILE is a list, no default is automatically installed. Chapter
4708 &<<CHAPdefconfil>>& is a &"walk-through"& discussion of the default
4709 configuration.
4710
4711
4712
4713 .section "Using a different configuration file" "SECID40"
4714 .cindex "configuration file" "alternate"
4715 A one-off alternate configuration can be specified by the &%-C%& command line
4716 option, which may specify a single file or a list of files. However, when
4717 &%-C%& is used, Exim gives up its root privilege, unless called by root (or
4718 unless the argument for &%-C%& is identical to the built-in value from
4719 CONFIGURE_FILE), or is listed in the TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST file and the caller
4720 is the Exim user or the user specified in the CONFIGURE_OWNER setting. &%-C%&
4721 is useful mainly for checking the syntax of configuration files before
4722 installing them. No owner or group checks are done on a configuration file
4723 specified by &%-C%&, if root privilege has been dropped.
4724
4725 Even the Exim user is not trusted to specify an arbitrary configuration file
4726 with the &%-C%& option to be used with root privileges, unless that file is
4727 listed in the TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST file. This locks out the possibility of
4728 testing a configuration using &%-C%& right through message reception and
4729 delivery, even if the caller is root. The reception works, but by that time,
4730 Exim is running as the Exim user, so when it re-execs to regain privilege for
4731 the delivery, the use of &%-C%& causes privilege to be lost. However, root
4732 can test reception and delivery using two separate commands (one to put a
4733 message on the queue, using &%-odq%&, and another to do the delivery, using
4734 &%-M%&).
4735
4736 If ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX is defined &_in Local/Makefile_&, it specifies a
4737 prefix string with which any file named in a &%-C%& command line option must
4738 start. In addition, the file name must not contain the sequence &"&`/../`&"&.
4739 There is no default setting for ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX; when it is unset, any file
4740 name can be used with &%-C%&.
4741
4742 One-off changes to a configuration can be specified by the &%-D%& command line
4743 option, which defines and overrides values for macros used inside the
4744 configuration file. However, like &%-C%&, the use of this option by a
4745 non-privileged user causes Exim to discard its root privilege.
4746 If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, the use of &%-D%& is
4747 completely disabled, and its use causes an immediate error exit.
4748
4749 The WHITELIST_D_MACROS option in &_Local/Makefile_& permits the binary builder
4750 to declare certain macro names trusted, such that root privilege will not
4751 necessarily be discarded.
4752 WHITELIST_D_MACROS defines a colon-separated list of macros which are
4753 considered safe and, if &%-D%& only supplies macros from this list, and the
4754 values are acceptable, then Exim will not give up root privilege if the caller
4755 is root, the Exim run-time user, or the CONFIGURE_OWNER, if set. This is a
4756 transition mechanism and is expected to be removed in the future. Acceptable
4757 values for the macros satisfy the regexp: &`^[A-Za-z0-9_/.-]*$`&
4758
4759 Some sites may wish to use the same Exim binary on different machines that
4760 share a file system, but to use different configuration files on each machine.
4761 If CONFIGURE_FILE_USE_NODE is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, Exim first
4762 looks for a file whose name is the configuration file name followed by a dot
4763 and the machine's node name, as obtained from the &[uname()]& function. If this
4764 file does not exist, the standard name is tried. This processing occurs for
4765 each file name in the list given by CONFIGURE_FILE or &%-C%&.
4766
4767 In some esoteric situations different versions of Exim may be run under
4768 different effective uids and the CONFIGURE_FILE_USE_EUID is defined to
4769 help with this. See the comments in &_src/EDITME_& for details.
4770
4771
4772
4773 .section "Configuration file format" "SECTconffilfor"
4774 .cindex "configuration file" "format of"
4775 .cindex "format" "configuration file"
4776 Exim's configuration file is divided into a number of different parts. General
4777 option settings must always appear at the start of the file. The other parts
4778 are all optional, and may appear in any order. Each part other than the first
4779 is introduced by the word &"begin"& followed by the name of the part. The
4780 optional parts are:
4781
4782 .ilist
4783 &'ACL'&: Access control lists for controlling incoming SMTP mail (see chapter
4784 &<<CHAPACL>>&).
4785 .next
4786 .cindex "AUTH" "configuration"
4787 &'authenticators'&: Configuration settings for the authenticator drivers. These
4788 are concerned with the SMTP AUTH command (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&).
4789 .next
4790 &'routers'&: Configuration settings for the router drivers. Routers process
4791 addresses and determine how the message is to be delivered (see chapters
4792 &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&&--&<<CHAPredirect>>&).
4793 .next
4794 &'transports'&: Configuration settings for the transport drivers. Transports
4795 define mechanisms for copying messages to destinations (see chapters
4796 &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&&--&<<CHAPsmtptrans>>&).
4797 .next
4798 &'retry'&: Retry rules, for use when a message cannot be delivered immediately.
4799 If there is no retry section, or if it is empty (that is, no retry rules are
4800 defined), Exim will not retry deliveries. In this situation, temporary errors
4801 are treated the same as permanent errors. Retry rules are discussed in chapter
4802 &<<CHAPretry>>&.
4803 .next
4804 &'rewrite'&: Global address rewriting rules, for use when a message arrives and
4805 when new addresses are generated during delivery. Rewriting is discussed in
4806 chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&.
4807 .next
4808 &'local_scan'&: Private options for the &[local_scan()]& function. If you
4809 want to use this feature, you must set
4810 .code
4811 LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
4812 .endd
4813 in &_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim. Details of the &[local_scan()]&
4814 facility are given in chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&.
4815 .endlist
4816
4817 .cindex "configuration file" "leading white space in"
4818 .cindex "configuration file" "trailing white space in"
4819 .cindex "white space" "in configuration file"
4820 Leading and trailing white space in configuration lines is always ignored.
4821
4822 Blank lines in the file, and lines starting with a # character (ignoring
4823 leading white space) are treated as comments and are ignored. &*Note*&: A
4824 # character other than at the beginning of a line is not treated specially,
4825 and does not introduce a comment.
4826
4827 Any non-comment line can be continued by ending it with a backslash. Note that
4828 the general rule for white space means that trailing white space after the
4829 backslash and leading white space at the start of continuation
4830 lines is ignored. Comment lines beginning with # (but not empty lines) may
4831 appear in the middle of a sequence of continuation lines.
4832
4833 A convenient way to create a configuration file is to start from the
4834 default, which is supplied in &_src/configure.default_&, and add, delete, or
4835 change settings as required.
4836
4837 The ACLs, retry rules, and rewriting rules have their own syntax which is
4838 described in chapters &<<CHAPACL>>&, &<<CHAPretry>>&, and &<<CHAPrewrite>>&,
4839 respectively. The other parts of the configuration file have some syntactic
4840 items in common, and these are described below, from section &<<SECTcos>>&
4841 onwards. Before that, the inclusion, macro, and conditional facilities are
4842 described.
4843
4844
4845
4846 .section "File inclusions in the configuration file" "SECID41"
4847 .cindex "inclusions in configuration file"
4848 .cindex "configuration file" "including other files"
4849 .cindex "&`.include`& in configuration file"
4850 .cindex "&`.include_if_exists`& in configuration file"
4851 You can include other files inside Exim's run time configuration file by
4852 using this syntax:
4853 .display
4854 &`.include`& <&'file name'&>
4855 &`.include_if_exists`& <&'file name'&>
4856 .endd
4857 on a line by itself. Double quotes round the file name are optional. If you use
4858 the first form, a configuration error occurs if the file does not exist; the
4859 second form does nothing for non-existent files. In all cases, an absolute file
4860 name is required.
4861
4862 Includes may be nested to any depth, but remember that Exim reads its
4863 configuration file often, so it is a good idea to keep them to a minimum.
4864 If you change the contents of an included file, you must HUP the daemon,
4865 because an included file is read only when the configuration itself is read.
4866
4867 The processing of inclusions happens early, at a physical line level, so, like
4868 comment lines, an inclusion can be used in the middle of an option setting,
4869 for example:
4870 .code
4871 hosts_lookup = a.b.c \
4872 .include /some/file
4873 .endd
4874 Include processing happens after macro processing (see below). Its effect is to
4875 process the lines of the included file as if they occurred inline where the
4876 inclusion appears.
4877
4878
4879
4880 .section "Macros in the configuration file" "SECTmacrodefs"
4881 .cindex "macro" "description of"
4882 .cindex "configuration file" "macros"
4883 If a line in the main part of the configuration (that is, before the first
4884 &"begin"& line) begins with an upper case letter, it is taken as a macro
4885 definition, and must be of the form
4886 .display
4887 <&'name'&> = <&'rest of line'&>
4888 .endd
4889 The name must consist of letters, digits, and underscores, and need not all be
4890 in upper case, though that is recommended. The rest of the line, including any
4891 continuations, is the replacement text, and has leading and trailing white
4892 space removed. Quotes are not removed. The replacement text can never end with
4893 a backslash character, but this doesn't seem to be a serious limitation.
4894
4895 Macros may also be defined between router, transport, authenticator, or ACL
4896 definitions. They may not, however, be defined within an individual driver or
4897 ACL, or in the &%local_scan%&, retry, or rewrite sections of the configuration.
4898
4899 .section "Macro substitution" "SECID42"
4900 Once a macro is defined, all subsequent lines in the file (and any included
4901 files) are scanned for the macro name; if there are several macros, the line is
4902 scanned for each in turn, in the order in which the macros are defined. The
4903 replacement text is not re-scanned for the current macro, though it is scanned
4904 for subsequently defined macros. For this reason, a macro name may not contain
4905 the name of a previously defined macro as a substring. You could, for example,
4906 define
4907 .display
4908 &`ABCD_XYZ = `&<&'something'&>
4909 &`ABCD = `&<&'something else'&>
4910 .endd
4911 but putting the definitions in the opposite order would provoke a configuration
4912 error. Macro expansion is applied to individual physical lines from the file,
4913 before checking for line continuation or file inclusion (see above). If a line
4914 consists solely of a macro name, and the expansion of the macro is empty, the
4915 line is ignored. A macro at the start of a line may turn the line into a
4916 comment line or a &`.include`& line.
4917
4918
4919 .section "Redefining macros" "SECID43"
4920 Once defined, the value of a macro can be redefined later in the configuration
4921 (or in an included file). Redefinition is specified by using &'=='& instead of
4922 &'='&. For example:
4923 .code
4924 MAC = initial value
4925 ...
4926 MAC == updated value
4927 .endd
4928 Redefinition does not alter the order in which the macros are applied to the
4929 subsequent lines of the configuration file. It is still the same order in which
4930 the macros were originally defined. All that changes is the macro's value.
4931 Redefinition makes it possible to accumulate values. For example:
4932 .code
4933 MAC = initial value
4934 ...
4935 MAC == MAC and something added
4936 .endd
4937 This can be helpful in situations where the configuration file is built
4938 from a number of other files.
4939
4940 .section "Overriding macro values" "SECID44"
4941 The values set for macros in the configuration file can be overridden by the
4942 &%-D%& command line option, but Exim gives up its root privilege when &%-D%& is
4943 used, unless called by root or the Exim user. A definition on the command line
4944 using the &%-D%& option causes all definitions and redefinitions within the
4945 file to be ignored.
4946
4947
4948
4949 .section "Example of macro usage" "SECID45"
4950 As an example of macro usage, consider a configuration where aliases are looked
4951 up in a MySQL database. It helps to keep the file less cluttered if long
4952 strings such as SQL statements are defined separately as macros, for example:
4953 .code
4954 ALIAS_QUERY = select mailbox from user where \
4955 login='${quote_mysql:$local_part}';
4956 .endd
4957 This can then be used in a &(redirect)& router setting like this:
4958 .code
4959 data = ${lookup mysql{ALIAS_QUERY}}
4960 .endd
4961 In earlier versions of Exim macros were sometimes used for domain, host, or
4962 address lists. In Exim 4 these are handled better by named lists &-- see
4963 section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&.
4964
4965
4966 .section "Conditional skips in the configuration file" "SECID46"
4967 .cindex "configuration file" "conditional skips"
4968 .cindex "&`.ifdef`&"
4969 You can use the directives &`.ifdef`&, &`.ifndef`&, &`.elifdef`&,
4970 &`.elifndef`&, &`.else`&, and &`.endif`& to dynamically include or exclude
4971 portions of the configuration file. The processing happens whenever the file is
4972 read (that is, when an Exim binary starts to run).
4973
4974 The implementation is very simple. Instances of the first four directives must
4975 be followed by text that includes the names of one or macros. The condition
4976 that is tested is whether or not any macro substitution has taken place in the
4977 line. Thus:
4978 .code
4979 .ifdef AAA
4980 message_size_limit = 50M
4981 .else
4982 message_size_limit = 100M
4983 .endif
4984 .endd
4985 sets a message size limit of 50M if the macro &`AAA`& is defined, and 100M
4986 otherwise. If there is more than one macro named on the line, the condition
4987 is true if any of them are defined. That is, it is an &"or"& condition. To
4988 obtain an &"and"& condition, you need to use nested &`.ifdef`&s.
4989
4990 Although you can use a macro expansion to generate one of these directives,
4991 it is not very useful, because the condition &"there was a macro substitution
4992 in this line"& will always be true.
4993
4994 Text following &`.else`& and &`.endif`& is ignored, and can be used as comment
4995 to clarify complicated nestings.
4996
4997
4998
4999 .section "Common option syntax" "SECTcos"
5000 .cindex "common option syntax"
5001 .cindex "syntax of common options"
5002 .cindex "configuration file" "common option syntax"
5003 For the main set of options, driver options, and &[local_scan()]& options,
5004 each setting is on a line by itself, and starts with a name consisting of
5005 lower-case letters and underscores. Many options require a data value, and in
5006 these cases the name must be followed by an equals sign (with optional white
5007 space) and then the value. For example:
5008 .code
5009 qualify_domain = mydomain.example.com
5010 .endd
5011 .cindex "hiding configuration option values"
5012 .cindex "configuration options" "hiding value of"
5013 .cindex "options" "hiding value of"
5014 Some option settings may contain sensitive data, for example, passwords for
5015 accessing databases. To stop non-admin users from using the &%-bP%& command
5016 line option to read these values, you can precede the option settings with the
5017 word &"hide"&. For example:
5018 .code
5019 hide mysql_servers = localhost/users/admin/secret-password
5020 .endd
5021 For non-admin users, such options are displayed like this:
5022 .code
5023 mysql_servers = <value not displayable>
5024 .endd
5025 If &"hide"& is used on a driver option, it hides the value of that option on
5026 all instances of the same driver.
5027
5028 The following sections describe the syntax used for the different data types
5029 that are found in option settings.
5030
5031
5032 .section "Boolean options" "SECID47"
5033 .cindex "format" "boolean"
5034 .cindex "boolean configuration values"
5035 .oindex "&%no_%&&'xxx'&"
5036 .oindex "&%not_%&&'xxx'&"
5037 Options whose type is given as boolean are on/off switches. There are two
5038 different ways of specifying such options: with and without a data value. If
5039 the option name is specified on its own without data, the switch is turned on;
5040 if it is preceded by &"no_"& or &"not_"& the switch is turned off. However,
5041 boolean options may be followed by an equals sign and one of the words
5042 &"true"&, &"false"&, &"yes"&, or &"no"&, as an alternative syntax. For example,
5043 the following two settings have exactly the same effect:
5044 .code
5045 queue_only
5046 queue_only = true
5047 .endd
5048 The following two lines also have the same (opposite) effect:
5049 .code
5050 no_queue_only
5051 queue_only = false
5052 .endd
5053 You can use whichever syntax you prefer.
5054
5055
5056
5057
5058 .section "Integer values" "SECID48"
5059 .cindex "integer configuration values"
5060 .cindex "format" "integer"
5061 If an option's type is given as &"integer"&, the value can be given in decimal,
5062 hexadecimal, or octal. If it starts with a digit greater than zero, a decimal
5063 number is assumed. Otherwise, it is treated as an octal number unless it starts
5064 with the characters &"0x"&, in which case the remainder is interpreted as a
5065 hexadecimal number.
5066
5067 If an integer value is followed by the letter K, it is multiplied by 1024; if
5068 it is followed by the letter M, it is multiplied by 1024x1024. When the values
5069 of integer option settings are output, values which are an exact multiple of
5070 1024 or 1024x1024 are sometimes, but not always, printed using the letters K
5071 and M. The printing style is independent of the actual input format that was
5072 used.
5073
5074
5075 .section "Octal integer values" "SECID49"
5076 .cindex "integer format"
5077 .cindex "format" "octal integer"
5078 If an option's type is given as &"octal integer"&, its value is always
5079 interpreted as an octal number, whether or not it starts with the digit zero.
5080 Such options are always output in octal.
5081
5082
5083 .section "Fixed point numbers" "SECID50"
5084 .cindex "fixed point configuration values"
5085 .cindex "format" "fixed point"
5086 If an option's type is given as &"fixed-point"&, its value must be a decimal
5087 integer, optionally followed by a decimal point and up to three further digits.
5088
5089
5090
5091 .section "Time intervals" "SECTtimeformat"
5092 .cindex "time interval" "specifying in configuration"
5093 .cindex "format" "time interval"
5094 A time interval is specified as a sequence of numbers, each followed by one of
5095 the following letters, with no intervening white space:
5096
5097 .table2 30pt
5098 .irow &%s%& seconds
5099 .irow &%m%& minutes
5100 .irow &%h%& hours
5101 .irow &%d%& days
5102 .irow &%w%& weeks
5103 .endtable
5104
5105 For example, &"3h50m"& specifies 3 hours and 50 minutes. The values of time
5106 intervals are output in the same format. Exim does not restrict the values; it
5107 is perfectly acceptable, for example, to specify &"90m"& instead of &"1h30m"&.
5108
5109
5110
5111 .section "String values" "SECTstrings"
5112 .cindex "string" "format of configuration values"
5113 .cindex "format" "string"
5114 If an option's type is specified as &"string"&, the value can be specified with
5115 or without double-quotes. If it does not start with a double-quote, the value
5116 consists of the remainder of the line plus any continuation lines, starting at
5117 the first character after any leading white space, with trailing white space
5118 removed, and with no interpretation of the characters in the string. Because
5119 Exim removes comment lines (those beginning with #) at an early stage, they can
5120 appear in the middle of a multi-line string. The following two settings are
5121 therefore equivalent:
5122 .code
5123 trusted_users = uucp:mail
5124 trusted_users = uucp:\
5125 # This comment line is ignored
5126 mail
5127 .endd
5128 .cindex "string" "quoted"
5129 .cindex "escape characters in quoted strings"
5130 If a string does start with a double-quote, it must end with a closing
5131 double-quote, and any backslash characters other than those used for line
5132 continuation are interpreted as escape characters, as follows:
5133
5134 .table2 100pt
5135 .irow &`\\`& "single backslash"
5136 .irow &`\n`& "newline"
5137 .irow &`\r`& "carriage return"
5138 .irow &`\t`& "tab"
5139 .irow "&`\`&<&'octal digits'&>" "up to 3 octal digits specify one character"
5140 .irow "&`\x`&<&'hex digits'&>" "up to 2 hexadecimal digits specify one &&&
5141 character"
5142 .endtable
5143
5144 If a backslash is followed by some other character, including a double-quote
5145 character, that character replaces the pair.
5146
5147 Quoting is necessary only if you want to make use of the backslash escapes to
5148 insert special characters, or if you need to specify a value with leading or
5149 trailing spaces. These cases are rare, so quoting is almost never needed in
5150 current versions of Exim. In versions of Exim before 3.14, quoting was required
5151 in order to continue lines, so you may come across older configuration files
5152 and examples that apparently quote unnecessarily.
5153
5154
5155 .section "Expanded strings" "SECID51"
5156 .cindex "expansion" "definition of"
5157 Some strings in the configuration file are subjected to &'string expansion'&,
5158 by which means various parts of the string may be changed according to the
5159 circumstances (see chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&). The input syntax for such strings
5160 is as just described; in particular, the handling of backslashes in quoted
5161 strings is done as part of the input process, before expansion takes place.
5162 However, backslash is also an escape character for the expander, so any
5163 backslashes that are required for that reason must be doubled if they are
5164 within a quoted configuration string.
5165
5166
5167 .section "User and group names" "SECID52"
5168 .cindex "user name" "format of"
5169 .cindex "format" "user name"
5170 .cindex "groups" "name format"
5171 .cindex "format" "group name"
5172 User and group names are specified as strings, using the syntax described
5173 above, but the strings are interpreted specially. A user or group name must
5174 either consist entirely of digits, or be a name that can be looked up using the
5175 &[getpwnam()]& or &[getgrnam()]& function, as appropriate.
5176
5177
5178 .section "List construction" "SECTlistconstruct"
5179 .cindex "list" "syntax of in configuration"
5180 .cindex "format" "list item in configuration"
5181 .cindex "string" "list, definition of"
5182 The data for some configuration options is a list of items, with colon as the
5183 default separator. Many of these options are shown with type &"string list"& in
5184 the descriptions later in this document. Others are listed as &"domain list"&,
5185 &"host list"&, &"address list"&, or &"local part list"&. Syntactically, they
5186 are all the same; however, those other than &"string list"& are subject to
5187 particular kinds of interpretation, as described in chapter
5188 &<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>&.
5189
5190 In all these cases, the entire list is treated as a single string as far as the
5191 input syntax is concerned. The &%trusted_users%& setting in section
5192 &<<SECTstrings>>& above is an example. If a colon is actually needed in an item
5193 in a list, it must be entered as two colons. Leading and trailing white space
5194 on each item in a list is ignored. This makes it possible to include items that
5195 start with a colon, and in particular, certain forms of IPv6 address. For
5196 example, the list
5197 .code
5198 local_interfaces = 127.0.0.1 : ::::1
5199 .endd
5200 contains two IP addresses, the IPv4 address 127.0.0.1 and the IPv6 address ::1.
5201
5202 &*Note*&: Although leading and trailing white space is ignored in individual
5203 list items, it is not ignored when parsing the list. The space after the first
5204 colon in the example above is necessary. If it were not there, the list would
5205 be interpreted as the two items 127.0.0.1:: and 1.
5206
5207 .section "Changing list separators" "SECID53"
5208 .cindex "list separator" "changing"
5209 .cindex "IPv6" "addresses in lists"
5210 Doubling colons in IPv6 addresses is an unwelcome chore, so a mechanism was
5211 introduced to allow the separator character to be changed. If a list begins
5212 with a left angle bracket, followed by any punctuation character, that
5213 character is used instead of colon as the list separator. For example, the list
5214 above can be rewritten to use a semicolon separator like this:
5215 .code
5216 local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; ::1
5217 .endd
5218 This facility applies to all lists, with the exception of the list in
5219 &%log_file_path%&. It is recommended that the use of non-colon separators be
5220 confined to circumstances where they really are needed.
5221
5222 .cindex "list separator" "newline as"
5223 .cindex "newline" "as list separator"
5224 It is also possible to use newline and other control characters (those with
5225 code values less than 32, plus DEL) as separators in lists. Such separators
5226 must be provided literally at the time the list is processed. For options that
5227 are string-expanded, you can write the separator using a normal escape
5228 sequence. This will be processed by the expander before the string is
5229 interpreted as a list. For example, if a newline-separated list of domains is
5230 generated by a lookup, you can process it directly by a line such as this:
5231 .code
5232 domains = <\n ${lookup mysql{.....}}
5233 .endd
5234 This avoids having to change the list separator in such data. You are unlikely
5235 to want to use a control character as a separator in an option that is not
5236 expanded, because the value is literal text. However, it can be done by giving
5237 the value in quotes. For example:
5238 .code
5239 local_interfaces = "<\n 127.0.0.1 \n ::1"
5240 .endd
5241 Unlike printing character separators, which can be included in list items by
5242 doubling, it is not possible to include a control character as data when it is
5243 set as the separator. Two such characters in succession are interpreted as
5244 enclosing an empty list item.
5245
5246
5247
5248 .section "Empty items in lists" "SECTempitelis"
5249 .cindex "list" "empty item in"
5250 An empty item at the end of a list is always ignored. In other words, trailing
5251 separator characters are ignored. Thus, the list in
5252 .code
5253 senders = user@domain :
5254 .endd
5255 contains only a single item. If you want to include an empty string as one item
5256 in a list, it must not be the last item. For example, this list contains three
5257 items, the second of which is empty:
5258 .code
5259 senders = user1@domain : : user2@domain
5260 .endd
5261 &*Note*&: There must be white space between the two colons, as otherwise they
5262 are interpreted as representing a single colon data character (and the list
5263 would then contain just one item). If you want to specify a list that contains
5264 just one, empty item, you can do it as in this example:
5265 .code
5266 senders = :
5267 .endd
5268 In this case, the first item is empty, and the second is discarded because it
5269 is at the end of the list.
5270
5271
5272
5273
5274 .section "Format of driver configurations" "SECTfordricon"
5275 .cindex "drivers" "configuration format"
5276 There are separate parts in the configuration for defining routers, transports,
5277 and authenticators. In each part, you are defining a number of driver
5278 instances, each with its own set of options. Each driver instance is defined by
5279 a sequence of lines like this:
5280 .display
5281 <&'instance name'&>:
5282 <&'option'&>
5283 ...
5284 <&'option'&>
5285 .endd
5286 In the following example, the instance name is &(localuser)&, and it is
5287 followed by three options settings:
5288 .code
5289 localuser:
5290 driver = accept
5291 check_local_user
5292 transport = local_delivery
5293 .endd
5294 For each driver instance, you specify which Exim code module it uses &-- by the
5295 setting of the &%driver%& option &-- and (optionally) some configuration
5296 settings. For example, in the case of transports, if you want a transport to
5297 deliver with SMTP you would use the &(smtp)& driver; if you want to deliver to
5298 a local file you would use the &(appendfile)& driver. Each of the drivers is
5299 described in detail in its own separate chapter later in this manual.
5300
5301 You can have several routers, transports, or authenticators that are based on
5302 the same underlying driver (each must have a different instance name).
5303
5304 The order in which routers are defined is important, because addresses are
5305 passed to individual routers one by one, in order. The order in which
5306 transports are defined does not matter at all. The order in which
5307 authenticators are defined is used only when Exim, as a client, is searching
5308 them to find one that matches an authentication mechanism offered by the
5309 server.
5310
5311 .cindex "generic options"
5312 .cindex "options" "generic &-- definition of"
5313 Within a driver instance definition, there are two kinds of option: &'generic'&
5314 and &'private'&. The generic options are those that apply to all drivers of the
5315 same type (that is, all routers, all transports or all authenticators). The
5316 &%driver%& option is a generic option that must appear in every definition.
5317 .cindex "private options"
5318 The private options are special for each driver, and none need appear, because
5319 they all have default values.
5320
5321 The options may appear in any order, except that the &%driver%& option must
5322 precede any private options, since these depend on the particular driver. For
5323 this reason, it is recommended that &%driver%& always be the first option.
5324
5325 Driver instance names, which are used for reference in log entries and
5326 elsewhere, can be any sequence of letters, digits, and underscores (starting
5327 with a letter) and must be unique among drivers of the same type. A router and
5328 a transport (for example) can each have the same name, but no two router
5329 instances can have the same name. The name of a driver instance should not be
5330 confused with the name of the underlying driver module. For example, the
5331 configuration lines:
5332 .code
5333 remote_smtp:
5334 driver = smtp
5335 .endd
5336 create an instance of the &(smtp)& transport driver whose name is
5337 &(remote_smtp)&. The same driver code can be used more than once, with
5338 different instance names and different option settings each time. A second
5339 instance of the &(smtp)& transport, with different options, might be defined
5340 thus:
5341 .code
5342 special_smtp:
5343 driver = smtp
5344 port = 1234
5345 command_timeout = 10s
5346 .endd
5347 The names &(remote_smtp)& and &(special_smtp)& would be used to reference
5348 these transport instances from routers, and these names would appear in log
5349 lines.
5350
5351 Comment lines may be present in the middle of driver specifications. The full
5352 list of option settings for any particular driver instance, including all the
5353 defaulted values, can be extracted by making use of the &%-bP%& command line
5354 option.
5355
5356
5357
5358
5359
5360
5361 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
5362 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
5363
5364 .chapter "The default configuration file" "CHAPdefconfil"
5365 .scindex IIDconfiwal "configuration file" "default &""walk through""&"
5366 .cindex "default" "configuration file &""walk through""&"
5367 The default configuration file supplied with Exim as &_src/configure.default_&
5368 is sufficient for a host with simple mail requirements. As an introduction to
5369 the way Exim is configured, this chapter &"walks through"& the default
5370 configuration, giving brief explanations of the settings. Detailed descriptions
5371 of the options are given in subsequent chapters. The default configuration file
5372 itself contains extensive comments about ways you might want to modify the
5373 initial settings. However, note that there are many options that are not
5374 mentioned at all in the default configuration.
5375
5376
5377
5378 .section "Main configuration settings" "SECTdefconfmain"
5379 The main (global) configuration option settings must always come first in the
5380 file. The first thing you'll see in the file, after some initial comments, is
5381 the line
5382 .code
5383 # primary_hostname =
5384 .endd
5385 This is a commented-out setting of the &%primary_hostname%& option. Exim needs
5386 to know the official, fully qualified name of your host, and this is where you
5387 can specify it. However, in most cases you do not need to set this option. When
5388 it is unset, Exim uses the &[uname()]& system function to obtain the host name.
5389
5390 The first three non-comment configuration lines are as follows:
5391 .code
5392 domainlist local_domains = @
5393 domainlist relay_to_domains =
5394 hostlist relay_from_hosts = 127.0.0.1
5395 .endd
5396 These are not, in fact, option settings. They are definitions of two named
5397 domain lists and one named host list. Exim allows you to give names to lists of
5398 domains, hosts, and email addresses, in order to make it easier to manage the
5399 configuration file (see section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&).
5400
5401 The first line defines a domain list called &'local_domains'&; this is used
5402 later in the configuration to identify domains that are to be delivered
5403 on the local host.
5404
5405 .cindex "@ in a domain list"
5406 There is just one item in this list, the string &"@"&. This is a special form
5407 of entry which means &"the name of the local host"&. Thus, if the local host is
5408 called &'a.host.example'&, mail to &'any.user@a.host.example'& is expected to
5409 be delivered locally. Because the local host's name is referenced indirectly,
5410 the same configuration file can be used on different hosts.
5411
5412 The second line defines a domain list called &'relay_to_domains'&, but the
5413 list itself is empty. Later in the configuration we will come to the part that
5414 controls mail relaying through the local host; it allows relaying to any
5415 domains in this list. By default, therefore, no relaying on the basis of a mail
5416 domain is permitted.
5417
5418 The third line defines a host list called &'relay_from_hosts'&. This list is
5419 used later in the configuration to permit relaying from any host or IP address
5420 that matches the list. The default contains just the IP address of the IPv4
5421 loopback interface, which means that processes on the local host are able to
5422 submit mail for relaying by sending it over TCP/IP to that interface. No other
5423 hosts are permitted to submit messages for relaying.
5424
5425 Just to be sure there's no misunderstanding: at this point in the configuration
5426 we aren't actually setting up any controls. We are just defining some domains
5427 and hosts that will be used in the controls that are specified later.
5428
5429 The next two configuration lines are genuine option settings:
5430 .code
5431 acl_smtp_rcpt = acl_check_rcpt
5432 acl_smtp_data = acl_check_data
5433 .endd
5434 These options specify &'Access Control Lists'& (ACLs) that are to be used
5435 during an incoming SMTP session for every recipient of a message (every RCPT
5436 command), and after the contents of the message have been received,
5437 respectively. The names of the lists are &'acl_check_rcpt'& and
5438 &'acl_check_data'&, and we will come to their definitions below, in the ACL
5439 section of the configuration. The RCPT ACL controls which recipients are
5440 accepted for an incoming message &-- if a configuration does not provide an ACL
5441 to check recipients, no SMTP mail can be accepted. The DATA ACL allows the
5442 contents of a message to be checked.
5443
5444 Two commented-out option settings are next:
5445 .code
5446 # av_scanner = clamd:/tmp/clamd
5447 # spamd_address = 127.0.0.1 783
5448 .endd
5449 These are example settings that can be used when Exim is compiled with the
5450 content-scanning extension. The first specifies the interface to the virus
5451 scanner, and the second specifies the interface to SpamAssassin. Further
5452 details are given in chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
5453
5454 Three more commented-out option settings follow:
5455 .code
5456 # tls_advertise_hosts = *
5457 # tls_certificate = /etc/ssl/exim.crt
5458 # tls_privatekey = /etc/ssl/exim.pem
5459 .endd
5460 These are example settings that can be used when Exim is compiled with
5461 support for TLS (aka SSL) as described in section &<<SECTinctlsssl>>&. The
5462 first one specifies the list of clients that are allowed to use TLS when
5463 connecting to this server; in this case the wildcard means all clients. The
5464 other options specify where Exim should find its TLS certificate and private
5465 key, which together prove the server's identity to any clients that connect.
5466 More details are given in chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&.
5467
5468 Another two commented-out option settings follow:
5469 .code
5470 # daemon_smtp_ports = 25 : 465 : 587
5471 # tls_on_connect_ports = 465
5472 .endd
5473 .cindex "port" "465 and 587"
5474 .cindex "port" "for message submission"
5475 .cindex "message" "submission, ports for"
5476 .cindex "ssmtp protocol"
5477 .cindex "smtps protocol"
5478 .cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
5479 .cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
5480 These options provide better support for roaming users who wish to use this
5481 server for message submission. They are not much use unless you have turned on
5482 TLS (as described in the previous paragraph) and authentication (about which
5483 more in section &<<SECTdefconfauth>>&). The usual SMTP port 25 is often blocked
5484 on end-user networks, so RFC 4409 specifies that message submission should use
5485 port 587 instead. However some software (notably Microsoft Outlook) cannot be
5486 configured to use port 587 correctly, so these settings also enable the
5487 non-standard &"smtps"& (aka &"ssmtp"&) port 465 (see section
5488 &<<SECTsupobssmt>>&).
5489
5490 Two more commented-out options settings follow:
5491 .code
5492 # qualify_domain =
5493 # qualify_recipient =
5494 .endd
5495 The first of these specifies a domain that Exim uses when it constructs a
5496 complete email address from a local login name. This is often needed when Exim
5497 receives a message from a local process. If you do not set &%qualify_domain%&,
5498 the value of &%primary_hostname%& is used. If you set both of these options,
5499 you can have different qualification domains for sender and recipient
5500 addresses. If you set only the first one, its value is used in both cases.
5501
5502 .cindex "domain literal" "recognizing format"
5503 The following line must be uncommented if you want Exim to recognize
5504 addresses of the form &'user@[10.11.12.13]'& that is, with a &"domain literal"&
5505 (an IP address within square brackets) instead of a named domain.
5506 .code
5507 # allow_domain_literals
5508 .endd
5509 The RFCs still require this form, but many people think that in the modern
5510 Internet it makes little sense to permit mail to be sent to specific hosts by
5511 quoting their IP addresses. This ancient format has been used by people who
5512 try to abuse hosts by using them for unwanted relaying. However, some
5513 people believe there are circumstances (for example, messages addressed to
5514 &'postmaster'&) where domain literals are still useful.
5515
5516 The next configuration line is a kind of trigger guard:
5517 .code
5518 never_users = root
5519 .endd
5520 It specifies that no delivery must ever be run as the root user. The normal
5521 convention is to set up &'root'& as an alias for the system administrator. This
5522 setting is a guard against slips in the configuration.
5523 The list of users specified by &%never_users%& is not, however, the complete
5524 list; the build-time configuration in &_Local/Makefile_& has an option called
5525 FIXED_NEVER_USERS specifying a list that cannot be overridden. The
5526 contents of &%never_users%& are added to this list. By default
5527 FIXED_NEVER_USERS also specifies root.
5528
5529 When a remote host connects to Exim in order to send mail, the only information
5530 Exim has about the host's identity is its IP address. The next configuration
5531 line,
5532 .code
5533 host_lookup = *
5534 .endd
5535 specifies that Exim should do a reverse DNS lookup on all incoming connections,
5536 in order to get a host name. This improves the quality of the logging
5537 information, but if you feel it is too expensive, you can remove it entirely,
5538 or restrict the lookup to hosts on &"nearby"& networks.
5539 Note that it is not always possible to find a host name from an IP address,
5540 because not all DNS reverse zones are maintained, and sometimes DNS servers are
5541 unreachable.
5542
5543 The next two lines are concerned with &'ident'& callbacks, as defined by RFC
5544 1413 (hence their names):
5545 .code
5546 rfc1413_hosts = *
5547 rfc1413_query_timeout = 5s
5548 .endd
5549 These settings cause Exim to make ident callbacks for all incoming SMTP calls.
5550 You can limit the hosts to which these calls are made, or change the timeout
5551 that is used. If you set the timeout to zero, all ident calls are disabled.
5552 Although they are cheap and can provide useful information for tracing problem
5553 messages, some hosts and firewalls have problems with ident calls. This can
5554 result in a timeout instead of an immediate refused connection, leading to
5555 delays on starting up an incoming SMTP session.
5556
5557 When Exim receives messages over SMTP connections, it expects all addresses to
5558 be fully qualified with a domain, as required by the SMTP definition. However,
5559 if you are running a server to which simple clients submit messages, you may
5560 find that they send unqualified addresses. The two commented-out options:
5561 .code
5562 # sender_unqualified_hosts =
5563 # recipient_unqualified_hosts =
5564 .endd
5565 show how you can specify hosts that are permitted to send unqualified sender
5566 and recipient addresses, respectively.
5567
5568 The &%percent_hack_domains%& option is also commented out:
5569 .code
5570 # percent_hack_domains =
5571 .endd
5572 It provides a list of domains for which the &"percent hack"& is to operate.
5573 This is an almost obsolete form of explicit email routing. If you do not know
5574 anything about it, you can safely ignore this topic.
5575
5576 The last two settings in the main part of the default configuration are
5577 concerned with messages that have been &"frozen"& on Exim's queue. When a
5578 message is frozen, Exim no longer continues to try to deliver it. Freezing
5579 occurs when a bounce message encounters a permanent failure because the sender
5580 address of the original message that caused the bounce is invalid, so the
5581 bounce cannot be delivered. This is probably the most common case, but there
5582 are also other conditions that cause freezing, and frozen messages are not
5583 always bounce messages.
5584 .code
5585 ignore_bounce_errors_after = 2d
5586 timeout_frozen_after = 7d
5587 .endd
5588 The first of these options specifies that failing bounce messages are to be
5589 discarded after 2 days on the queue. The second specifies that any frozen
5590 message (whether a bounce message or not) is to be timed out (and discarded)
5591 after a week. In this configuration, the first setting ensures that no failing
5592 bounce message ever lasts a week.
5593
5594
5595
5596 .section "ACL configuration" "SECID54"
5597 .cindex "default" "ACLs"
5598 .cindex "&ACL;" "default configuration"
5599 In the default configuration, the ACL section follows the main configuration.
5600 It starts with the line
5601 .code
5602 begin acl
5603 .endd
5604 and it contains the definitions of two ACLs, called &'acl_check_rcpt'& and
5605 &'acl_check_data'&, that were referenced in the settings of &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&
5606 and &%acl_smtp_data%& above.
5607
5608 .cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
5609 The first ACL is used for every RCPT command in an incoming SMTP message. Each
5610 RCPT command specifies one of the message's recipients. The ACL statements
5611 are considered in order, until the recipient address is either accepted or
5612 rejected. The RCPT command is then accepted or rejected, according to the
5613 result of the ACL processing.
5614 .code
5615 acl_check_rcpt:
5616 .endd
5617 This line, consisting of a name terminated by a colon, marks the start of the
5618 ACL, and names it.
5619 .code
5620 accept hosts = :
5621 .endd
5622 This ACL statement accepts the recipient if the sending host matches the list.
5623 But what does that strange list mean? It doesn't actually contain any host
5624 names or IP addresses. The presence of the colon puts an empty item in the
5625 list; Exim matches this only if the incoming message did not come from a remote
5626 host, because in that case, the remote hostname is empty. The colon is
5627 important. Without it, the list itself is empty, and can never match anything.
5628
5629 What this statement is doing is to accept unconditionally all recipients in
5630 messages that are submitted by SMTP from local processes using the standard
5631 input and output (that is, not using TCP/IP). A number of MUAs operate in this
5632 manner.
5633 .code
5634 deny message = Restricted characters in address
5635 domains = +local_domains
5636 local_parts = ^[.] : ^.*[@%!/|]
5637
5638 deny message = Restricted characters in address
5639 domains = !+local_domains
5640 local_parts = ^[./|] : ^.*[@%!] : ^.*/\\.\\./
5641 .endd
5642 These statements are concerned with local parts that contain any of the
5643 characters &"@"&, &"%"&, &"!"&, &"/"&, &"|"&, or dots in unusual places.
5644 Although these characters are entirely legal in local parts (in the case of
5645 &"@"& and leading dots, only if correctly quoted), they do not commonly occur
5646 in Internet mail addresses.
5647
5648 The first three have in the past been associated with explicitly routed
5649 addresses (percent is still sometimes used &-- see the &%percent_hack_domains%&
5650 option). Addresses containing these characters are regularly tried by spammers
5651 in an attempt to bypass relaying restrictions, and also by open relay testing
5652 programs. Unless you really need them it is safest to reject these characters
5653 at this early stage. This configuration is heavy-handed in rejecting these
5654 characters for all messages it accepts from remote hosts. This is a deliberate
5655 policy of being as safe as possible.
5656
5657 The first rule above is stricter, and is applied to messages that are addressed
5658 to one of the local domains handled by this host. This is implemented by the
5659 first condition, which restricts it to domains that are listed in the
5660 &'local_domains'& domain list. The &"+"& character is used to indicate a
5661 reference to a named list. In this configuration, there is just one domain in
5662 &'local_domains'&, but in general there may be many.
5663
5664 The second condition on the first statement uses two regular expressions to
5665 block local parts that begin with a dot or contain &"@"&, &"%"&, &"!"&, &"/"&,
5666 or &"|"&. If you have local accounts that include these characters, you will
5667 have to modify this rule.
5668
5669 Empty components (two dots in a row) are not valid in RFC 2822, but Exim
5670 allows them because they have been encountered in practice. (Consider the
5671 common convention of local parts constructed as
5672 &"&'first-initial.second-initial.family-name'&"& when applied to someone like
5673 the author of Exim, who has no second initial.) However, a local part starting
5674 with a dot or containing &"/../"& can cause trouble if it is used as part of a
5675 file name (for example, for a mailing list). This is also true for local parts
5676 that contain slashes. A pipe symbol can also be troublesome if the local part
5677 is incorporated unthinkingly into a shell command line.
5678
5679 The second rule above applies to all other domains, and is less strict. This
5680 allows your own users to send outgoing messages to sites that use slashes
5681 and vertical bars in their local parts. It blocks local parts that begin
5682 with a dot, slash, or vertical bar, but allows these characters within the
5683 local part. However, the sequence &"/../"& is barred. The use of &"@"&, &"%"&,
5684 and &"!"& is blocked, as before. The motivation here is to prevent your users
5685 (or your users' viruses) from mounting certain kinds of attack on remote sites.
5686 .code
5687 accept local_parts = postmaster
5688 domains = +local_domains
5689 .endd
5690 This statement, which has two conditions, accepts an incoming address if the
5691 local part is &'postmaster'& and the domain is one of those listed in the
5692 &'local_domains'& domain list. The &"+"& character is used to indicate a
5693 reference to a named list. In this configuration, there is just one domain in
5694 &'local_domains'&, but in general there may be many.
5695
5696 The presence of this statement means that mail to postmaster is never blocked
5697 by any of the subsequent tests. This can be helpful while sorting out problems
5698 in cases where the subsequent tests are incorrectly denying access.
5699 .code
5700 require verify = sender
5701 .endd
5702 This statement requires the sender address to be verified before any subsequent
5703 ACL statement can be used. If verification fails, the incoming recipient
5704 address is refused. Verification consists of trying to route the address, to
5705 see if a bounce message could be delivered to it. In the case of remote
5706 addresses, basic verification checks only the domain, but &'callouts'& can be
5707 used for more verification if required. Section &<<SECTaddressverification>>&
5708 discusses the details of address verification.
5709 .code
5710 accept hosts = +relay_from_hosts
5711 control = submission
5712 .endd
5713 This statement accepts the address if the message is coming from one of the
5714 hosts that are defined as being allowed to relay through this host. Recipient
5715 verification is omitted here, because in many cases the clients are dumb MUAs
5716 that do not cope well with SMTP error responses. For the same reason, the
5717 second line specifies &"submission mode"& for messages that are accepted. This
5718 is described in detail in section &<<SECTsubmodnon>>&; it causes Exim to fix
5719 messages that are deficient in some way, for example, because they lack a
5720 &'Date:'& header line. If you are actually relaying out from MTAs, you should
5721 probably add recipient verification here, and disable submission mode.
5722 .code
5723 accept authenticated = *
5724 control = submission
5725 .endd
5726 This statement accepts the address if the client host has authenticated itself.
5727 Submission mode is again specified, on the grounds that such messages are most
5728 likely to come from MUAs. The default configuration does not define any
5729 authenticators, though it does include some nearly complete commented-out
5730 examples described in &<<SECTdefconfauth>>&. This means that no client can in
5731 fact authenticate until you complete the authenticator definitions.
5732 .code
5733 require message = relay not permitted
5734 domains = +local_domains : +relay_to_domains
5735 .endd
5736 This statement rejects the address if its domain is neither a local domain nor
5737 one of the domains for which this host is a relay.
5738 .code
5739 require verify = recipient
5740 .endd
5741 This statement requires the recipient address to be verified; if verification
5742 fails, the address is rejected.
5743 .code
5744 # deny message = rejected because $sender_host_address \
5745 # is in a black list at $dnslist_domain\n\
5746 # $dnslist_text
5747 # dnslists = black.list.example
5748 #
5749 # warn dnslists = black.list.example
5750 # add_header = X-Warning: $sender_host_address is in \
5751 # a black list at $dnslist_domain
5752 # log_message = found in $dnslist_domain
5753 .endd
5754 These commented-out lines are examples of how you could configure Exim to check
5755 sending hosts against a DNS black list. The first statement rejects messages
5756 from blacklisted hosts, whereas the second just inserts a warning header
5757 line.
5758 .code
5759 # require verify = csa
5760 .endd
5761 This commented-out line is an example of how you could turn on client SMTP
5762 authorization (CSA) checking. Such checks do DNS lookups for special SRV
5763 records.
5764 .code
5765 accept
5766 .endd
5767 The final statement in the first ACL unconditionally accepts any recipient
5768 address that has successfully passed all the previous tests.
5769 .code
5770 acl_check_data:
5771 .endd
5772 This line marks the start of the second ACL, and names it. Most of the contents
5773 of this ACL are commented out:
5774 .code
5775 # deny malware = *
5776 # message = This message contains a virus \
5777 # ($malware_name).
5778 .endd
5779 These lines are examples of how to arrange for messages to be scanned for
5780 viruses when Exim has been compiled with the content-scanning extension, and a
5781 suitable virus scanner is installed. If the message is found to contain a
5782 virus, it is rejected with the given custom error message.
5783 .code
5784 # warn spam = nobody
5785 # message = X-Spam_score: $spam_score\n\
5786 # X-Spam_score_int: $spam_score_int\n\
5787 # X-Spam_bar: $spam_bar\n\
5788 # X-Spam_report: $spam_report
5789 .endd
5790 These lines are an example of how to arrange for messages to be scanned by
5791 SpamAssassin when Exim has been compiled with the content-scanning extension,
5792 and SpamAssassin has been installed. The SpamAssassin check is run with
5793 &`nobody`& as its user parameter, and the results are added to the message as a
5794 series of extra header line. In this case, the message is not rejected,
5795 whatever the spam score.
5796 .code
5797 accept
5798 .endd
5799 This final line in the DATA ACL accepts the message unconditionally.
5800
5801
5802 .section "Router configuration" "SECID55"
5803 .cindex "default" "routers"
5804 .cindex "routers" "default"
5805 The router configuration comes next in the default configuration, introduced
5806 by the line
5807 .code
5808 begin routers
5809 .endd
5810 Routers are the modules in Exim that make decisions about where to send
5811 messages. An address is passed to each router in turn, until it is either
5812 accepted, or failed. This means that the order in which you define the routers
5813 matters. Each router is fully described in its own chapter later in this
5814 manual. Here we give only brief overviews.
5815 .code
5816 # domain_literal:
5817 # driver = ipliteral
5818 # domains = !+local_domains
5819 # transport = remote_smtp
5820 .endd
5821 .cindex "domain literal" "default router"
5822 This router is commented out because the majority of sites do not want to
5823 support domain literal addresses (those of the form &'user@[10.9.8.7]'&). If
5824 you uncomment this router, you also need to uncomment the setting of
5825 &%allow_domain_literals%& in the main part of the configuration.
5826 .code
5827 dnslookup:
5828 driver = dnslookup
5829 domains = ! +local_domains
5830 transport = remote_smtp
5831 ignore_target_hosts = 0.0.0.0 : 127.0.0.0/8
5832 no_more
5833 .endd
5834 The first uncommented router handles addresses that do not involve any local
5835 domains. This is specified by the line
5836 .code
5837 domains = ! +local_domains
5838 .endd
5839 The &%domains%& option lists the domains to which this router applies, but the
5840 exclamation mark is a negation sign, so the router is used only for domains
5841 that are not in the domain list called &'local_domains'& (which was defined at
5842 the start of the configuration). The plus sign before &'local_domains'&
5843 indicates that it is referring to a named list. Addresses in other domains are
5844 passed on to the following routers.
5845
5846 The name of the router driver is &(dnslookup)&,
5847 and is specified by the &%driver%& option. Do not be confused by the fact that
5848 the name of this router instance is the same as the name of the driver. The
5849 instance name is arbitrary, but the name set in the &%driver%& option must be
5850 one of the driver modules that is in the Exim binary.
5851
5852 The &(dnslookup)& router routes addresses by looking up their domains in the
5853 DNS in order to obtain a list of hosts to which the address is routed. If the
5854 router succeeds, the address is queued for the &(remote_smtp)& transport, as
5855 specified by the &%transport%& option. If the router does not find the domain
5856 in the DNS, no further routers are tried because of the &%no_more%& setting, so
5857 the address fails and is bounced.
5858
5859 The &%ignore_target_hosts%& option specifies a list of IP addresses that are to
5860 be entirely ignored. This option is present because a number of cases have been
5861 encountered where MX records in the DNS point to host names
5862 whose IP addresses are 0.0.0.0 or are in the 127 subnet (typically 127.0.0.1).
5863 Completely ignoring these IP addresses causes Exim to fail to route the
5864 email address, so it bounces. Otherwise, Exim would log a routing problem, and
5865 continue to try to deliver the message periodically until the address timed
5866 out.
5867 .code
5868 system_aliases:
5869 driver = redirect
5870 allow_fail
5871 allow_defer
5872 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/aliases}}
5873 # user = exim
5874 file_transport = address_file
5875 pipe_transport = address_pipe
5876 .endd
5877 Control reaches this and subsequent routers only for addresses in the local
5878 domains. This router checks to see whether the local part is defined as an
5879 alias in the &_/etc/aliases_& file, and if so, redirects it according to the
5880 data that it looks up from that file. If no data is found for the local part,
5881 the value of the &%data%& option is empty, causing the address to be passed to
5882 the next router.
5883
5884 &_/etc/aliases_& is a conventional name for the system aliases file that is
5885 often used. That is why it is referenced by from the default configuration
5886 file. However, you can change this by setting SYSTEM_ALIASES_FILE in
5887 &_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim.
5888 .code
5889 userforward:
5890 driver = redirect
5891 check_local_user
5892 # local_part_suffix = +* : -*
5893 # local_part_suffix_optional
5894 file = $home/.forward
5895 # allow_filter
5896 no_verify
5897 no_expn
5898 check_ancestor
5899 file_transport = address_file
5900 pipe_transport = address_pipe
5901 reply_transport = address_reply
5902 .endd
5903 This is the most complicated router in the default configuration. It is another
5904 redirection router, but this time it is looking for forwarding data set up by
5905 individual users. The &%check_local_user%& setting specifies a check that the
5906 local part of the address is the login name of a local user. If it is not, the
5907 router is skipped. The two commented options that follow &%check_local_user%&,
5908 namely:
5909 .code
5910 # local_part_suffix = +* : -*
5911 # local_part_suffix_optional
5912 .endd
5913 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
5914 show how you can specify the recognition of local part suffixes. If the first
5915 is uncommented, a suffix beginning with either a plus or a minus sign, followed
5916 by any sequence of characters, is removed from the local part and placed in the
5917 variable &$local_part_suffix$&. The second suffix option specifies that the
5918 presence of a suffix in the local part is optional. When a suffix is present,
5919 the check for a local login uses the local part with the suffix removed.
5920
5921 When a local user account is found, the file called &_.forward_& in the user's
5922 home directory is consulted. If it does not exist, or is empty, the router
5923 declines. Otherwise, the contents of &_.forward_& are interpreted as
5924 redirection data (see chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>& for more details).
5925
5926 .cindex "Sieve filter" "enabling in default router"
5927 Traditional &_.forward_& files contain just a list of addresses, pipes, or
5928 files. Exim supports this by default. However, if &%allow_filter%& is set (it
5929 is commented out by default), the contents of the file are interpreted as a set
5930 of Exim or Sieve filtering instructions, provided the file begins with &"#Exim
5931 filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"&, respectively. User filtering is discussed in the
5932 separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&.
5933
5934 The &%no_verify%& and &%no_expn%& options mean that this router is skipped when
5935 verifying addresses, or when running as a consequence of an SMTP EXPN command.
5936 There are two reasons for doing this:
5937
5938 .olist
5939 Whether or not a local user has a &_.forward_& file is not really relevant when
5940 checking an address for validity; it makes sense not to waste resources doing
5941 unnecessary work.
5942 .next
5943 More importantly, when Exim is verifying addresses or handling an EXPN
5944 command during an SMTP session, it is running as the Exim user, not as root.
5945 The group is the Exim group, and no additional groups are set up.
5946 It may therefore not be possible for Exim to read users' &_.forward_& files at
5947 this time.
5948 .endlist
5949
5950 The setting of &%check_ancestor%& prevents the router from generating a new
5951 address that is the same as any previous address that was redirected. (This
5952 works round a problem concerning a bad interaction between aliasing and
5953 forwarding &-- see section &<<SECTredlocmai>>&).
5954
5955 The final three option settings specify the transports that are to be used when
5956 forwarding generates a direct delivery to a file, or to a pipe, or sets up an
5957 auto-reply, respectively. For example, if a &_.forward_& file contains
5958 .code
5959 a.nother@elsewhere.example, /home/spqr/archive
5960 .endd
5961 the delivery to &_/home/spqr/archive_& is done by running the &%address_file%&
5962 transport.
5963 .code
5964 localuser:
5965 driver = accept
5966 check_local_user
5967 # local_part_suffix = +* : -*
5968 # local_part_suffix_optional
5969 transport = local_delivery
5970 .endd
5971 The final router sets up delivery into local mailboxes, provided that the local
5972 part is the name of a local login, by accepting the address and assigning it to
5973 the &(local_delivery)& transport. Otherwise, we have reached the end of the
5974 routers, so the address is bounced. The commented suffix settings fulfil the
5975 same purpose as they do for the &(userforward)& router.
5976
5977
5978 .section "Transport configuration" "SECID56"
5979 .cindex "default" "transports"
5980 .cindex "transports" "default"
5981 Transports define mechanisms for actually delivering messages. They operate
5982 only when referenced from routers, so the order in which they are defined does
5983 not matter. The transports section of the configuration starts with
5984 .code
5985 begin transports
5986 .endd
5987 One remote transport and four local transports are defined.
5988 .code
5989 remote_smtp:
5990 driver = smtp
5991 .endd
5992 This transport is used for delivering messages over SMTP connections. All its
5993 options are defaulted. The list of remote hosts comes from the router.
5994 .code
5995 local_delivery:
5996 driver = appendfile
5997 file = /var/mail/$local_part
5998 delivery_date_add
5999 envelope_to_add
6000 return_path_add
6001 # group = mail
6002 # mode = 0660
6003 .endd
6004 This &(appendfile)& transport is used for local delivery to user mailboxes in
6005 traditional BSD mailbox format. By default it runs under the uid and gid of the
6006 local user, which requires the sticky bit to be set on the &_/var/mail_&
6007 directory. Some systems use the alternative approach of running mail deliveries
6008 under a particular group instead of using the sticky bit. The commented options
6009 show how this can be done.
6010
6011 Exim adds three headers to the message as it delivers it: &'Delivery-date:'&,
6012 &'Envelope-to:'& and &'Return-path:'&. This action is requested by the three
6013 similarly-named options above.
6014 .code
6015 address_pipe:
6016 driver = pipe
6017 return_output
6018 .endd
6019 This transport is used for handling deliveries to pipes that are generated by
6020 redirection (aliasing or users' &_.forward_& files). The &%return_output%&
6021 option specifies that any output generated by the pipe is to be returned to the
6022 sender.
6023 .code
6024 address_file:
6025 driver = appendfile
6026 delivery_date_add
6027 envelope_to_add
6028 return_path_add
6029 .endd
6030 This transport is used for handling deliveries to files that are generated by
6031 redirection. The name of the file is not specified in this instance of
6032 &(appendfile)&, because it comes from the &(redirect)& router.
6033 .code
6034 address_reply:
6035 driver = autoreply
6036 .endd
6037 This transport is used for handling automatic replies generated by users'
6038 filter files.
6039
6040
6041
6042 .section "Default retry rule" "SECID57"
6043 .cindex "retry" "default rule"
6044 .cindex "default" "retry rule"
6045 The retry section of the configuration file contains rules which affect the way
6046 Exim retries deliveries that cannot be completed at the first attempt. It is
6047 introduced by the line
6048 .code
6049 begin retry
6050 .endd
6051 In the default configuration, there is just one rule, which applies to all
6052 errors:
6053 .code
6054 * * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,4d,6h
6055 .endd
6056 This causes any temporarily failing address to be retried every 15 minutes for
6057 2 hours, then at intervals starting at one hour and increasing by a factor of
6058 1.5 until 16 hours have passed, then every 6 hours up to 4 days. If an address
6059 is not delivered after 4 days of temporary failure, it is bounced.
6060
6061 If the retry section is removed from the configuration, or is empty (that is,
6062 if no retry rules are defined), Exim will not retry deliveries. This turns
6063 temporary errors into permanent errors.
6064
6065
6066 .section "Rewriting configuration" "SECID58"
6067 The rewriting section of the configuration, introduced by
6068 .code
6069 begin rewrite
6070 .endd
6071 contains rules for rewriting addresses in messages as they arrive. There are no
6072 rewriting rules in the default configuration file.
6073
6074
6075
6076 .section "Authenticators configuration" "SECTdefconfauth"
6077 .cindex "AUTH" "configuration"
6078 The authenticators section of the configuration, introduced by
6079 .code
6080 begin authenticators
6081 .endd
6082 defines mechanisms for the use of the SMTP AUTH command. The default
6083 configuration file contains two commented-out example authenticators
6084 which support plaintext username/password authentication using the
6085 standard PLAIN mechanism and the traditional but non-standard LOGIN
6086 mechanism, with Exim acting as the server. PLAIN and LOGIN are enough
6087 to support most MUA software.
6088
6089 The example PLAIN authenticator looks like this:
6090 .code
6091 #PLAIN:
6092 # driver = plaintext
6093 # server_set_id = $auth2
6094 # server_prompts = :
6095 # server_condition = Authentication is not yet configured
6096 # server_advertise_condition = ${if def:tls_in_cipher }
6097 .endd
6098 And the example LOGIN authenticator looks like this:
6099 .code
6100 #LOGIN:
6101 # driver = plaintext
6102 # server_set_id = $auth1
6103 # server_prompts = <| Username: | Password:
6104 # server_condition = Authentication is not yet configured
6105 # server_advertise_condition = ${if def:tls_in_cipher }
6106 .endd
6107
6108 The &%server_set_id%& option makes Exim remember the authenticated username
6109 in &$authenticated_id$&, which can be used later in ACLs or routers. The
6110 &%server_prompts%& option configures the &(plaintext)& authenticator so
6111 that it implements the details of the specific authentication mechanism,
6112 i.e. PLAIN or LOGIN. The &%server_advertise_condition%& setting controls
6113 when Exim offers authentication to clients; in the examples, this is only
6114 when TLS or SSL has been started, so to enable the authenticators you also
6115 need to add support for TLS as described in section &<<SECTdefconfmain>>&.
6116
6117 The &%server_condition%& setting defines how to verify that the username and
6118 password are correct. In the examples it just produces an error message.
6119 To make the authenticators work, you can use a string expansion
6120 expression like one of the examples in chapter &<<CHAPplaintext>>&.
6121
6122 Beware that the sequence of the parameters to PLAIN and LOGIN differ; the
6123 usercode and password are in different positions.
6124 Chapter &<<CHAPplaintext>>& covers both.
6125
6126 .ecindex IIDconfiwal
6127
6128
6129
6130 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6131 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6132
6133 .chapter "Regular expressions" "CHAPregexp"
6134
6135 .cindex "regular expressions" "library"
6136 .cindex "PCRE"
6137 Exim supports the use of regular expressions in many of its options. It
6138 uses the PCRE regular expression library; this provides regular expression
6139 matching that is compatible with Perl 5. The syntax and semantics of
6140 regular expressions is discussed in many Perl reference books, and also in
6141 Jeffrey Friedl's &'Mastering Regular Expressions'&, which is published by
6142 O'Reilly (see &url(http://www.oreilly.com/catalog/regex2/)).
6143
6144 The documentation for the syntax and semantics of the regular expressions that
6145 are supported by PCRE is included in the PCRE distribution, and no further
6146 description is included here. The PCRE functions are called from Exim using
6147 the default option settings (that is, with no PCRE options set), except that
6148 the PCRE_CASELESS option is set when the matching is required to be
6149 case-insensitive.
6150
6151 In most cases, when a regular expression is required in an Exim configuration,
6152 it has to start with a circumflex, in order to distinguish it from plain text
6153 or an &"ends with"& wildcard. In this example of a configuration setting, the
6154 second item in the colon-separated list is a regular expression.
6155 .code
6156 domains = a.b.c : ^\\d{3} : *.y.z : ...
6157 .endd
6158 The doubling of the backslash is required because of string expansion that
6159 precedes interpretation &-- see section &<<SECTlittext>>& for more discussion
6160 of this issue, and a way of avoiding the need for doubling backslashes. The
6161 regular expression that is eventually used in this example contains just one
6162 backslash. The circumflex is included in the regular expression, and has the
6163 normal effect of &"anchoring"& it to the start of the string that is being
6164 matched.
6165
6166 There are, however, two cases where a circumflex is not required for the
6167 recognition of a regular expression: these are the &%match%& condition in a
6168 string expansion, and the &%matches%& condition in an Exim filter file. In
6169 these cases, the relevant string is always treated as a regular expression; if
6170 it does not start with a circumflex, the expression is not anchored, and can
6171 match anywhere in the subject string.
6172
6173 In all cases, if you want a regular expression to match at the end of a string,
6174 you must code the $ metacharacter to indicate this. For example:
6175 .code
6176 domains = ^\\d{3}\\.example
6177 .endd
6178 matches the domain &'123.example'&, but it also matches &'123.example.com'&.
6179 You need to use:
6180 .code
6181 domains = ^\\d{3}\\.example\$
6182 .endd
6183 if you want &'example'& to be the top-level domain. The backslash before the
6184 $ is needed because string expansion also interprets dollar characters.
6185
6186
6187
6188 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6189 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6190
6191 .chapter "File and database lookups" "CHAPfdlookup"
6192 .scindex IIDfidalo1 "file" "lookups"
6193 .scindex IIDfidalo2 "database" "lookups"
6194 .cindex "lookup" "description of"
6195 Exim can be configured to look up data in files or databases as it processes
6196 messages. Two different kinds of syntax are used:
6197
6198 .olist
6199 A string that is to be expanded may contain explicit lookup requests. These
6200 cause parts of the string to be replaced by data that is obtained from the
6201 lookup. Lookups of this type are conditional expansion items. Different results
6202 can be defined for the cases of lookup success and failure. See chapter
6203 &<<CHAPexpand>>&, where string expansions are described in detail.
6204 .next
6205 Lists of domains, hosts, and email addresses can contain lookup requests as a
6206 way of avoiding excessively long linear lists. In this case, the data that is
6207 returned by the lookup is often (but not always) discarded; whether the lookup
6208 succeeds or fails is what really counts. These kinds of list are described in
6209 chapter &<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>&.
6210 .endlist
6211
6212 String expansions, lists, and lookups interact with each other in such a way
6213 that there is no order in which to describe any one of them that does not
6214 involve references to the others. Each of these three chapters makes more sense
6215 if you have read the other two first. If you are reading this for the first
6216 time, be aware that some of it will make a lot more sense after you have read
6217 chapters &<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>& and &<<CHAPexpand>>&.
6218
6219 .section "Examples of different lookup syntax" "SECID60"
6220 It is easy to confuse the two different kinds of lookup, especially as the
6221 lists that may contain the second kind are always expanded before being
6222 processed as lists. Therefore, they may also contain lookups of the first kind.
6223 Be careful to distinguish between the following two examples:
6224 .code
6225 domains = ${lookup{$sender_host_address}lsearch{/some/file}}
6226 domains = lsearch;/some/file
6227 .endd
6228 The first uses a string expansion, the result of which must be a domain list.
6229 No strings have been specified for a successful or a failing lookup; the
6230 defaults in this case are the looked-up data and an empty string, respectively.
6231 The expansion takes place before the string is processed as a list, and the
6232 file that is searched could contain lines like this:
6233 .code
6234 192.168.3.4: domain1:domain2:...
6235 192.168.1.9: domain3:domain4:...
6236 .endd
6237 When the lookup succeeds, the result of the expansion is a list of domains (and
6238 possibly other types of item that are allowed in domain lists).
6239
6240 In the second example, the lookup is a single item in a domain list. It causes
6241 Exim to use a lookup to see if the domain that is being processed can be found
6242 in the file. The file could contains lines like this:
6243 .code
6244 domain1:
6245 domain2:
6246 .endd
6247 Any data that follows the keys is not relevant when checking that the domain
6248 matches the list item.
6249
6250 It is possible, though no doubt confusing, to use both kinds of lookup at once.
6251 Consider a file containing lines like this:
6252 .code
6253 192.168.5.6: lsearch;/another/file
6254 .endd
6255 If the value of &$sender_host_address$& is 192.168.5.6, expansion of the
6256 first &%domains%& setting above generates the second setting, which therefore
6257 causes a second lookup to occur.
6258
6259 The rest of this chapter describes the different lookup types that are
6260 available. Any of them can be used in any part of the configuration where a
6261 lookup is permitted.
6262
6263
6264 .section "Lookup types" "SECID61"
6265 .cindex "lookup" "types of"
6266 .cindex "single-key lookup" "definition of"
6267 Two different types of data lookup are implemented:
6268
6269 .ilist
6270 The &'single-key'& type requires the specification of a file in which to look,
6271 and a single key to search for. The key must be a non-empty string for the
6272 lookup to succeed. The lookup type determines how the file is searched.
6273 .next
6274 .cindex "query-style lookup" "definition of"
6275 The &'query-style'& type accepts a generalized database query. No particular
6276 key value is assumed by Exim for query-style lookups. You can use whichever
6277 Exim variables you need to construct the database query.
6278 .endlist
6279
6280 The code for each lookup type is in a separate source file that is included in
6281 the binary of Exim only if the corresponding compile-time option is set. The
6282 default settings in &_src/EDITME_& are:
6283 .code
6284 LOOKUP_DBM=yes
6285 LOOKUP_LSEARCH=yes
6286 .endd
6287 which means that only linear searching and DBM lookups are included by default.
6288 For some types of lookup (e.g. SQL databases), you need to install appropriate
6289 libraries and header files before building Exim.
6290
6291
6292
6293
6294 .section "Single-key lookup types" "SECTsinglekeylookups"
6295 .cindex "lookup" "single-key types"
6296 .cindex "single-key lookup" "list of types"
6297 The following single-key lookup types are implemented:
6298
6299 .ilist
6300 .cindex "cdb" "description of"
6301 .cindex "lookup" "cdb"
6302 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6303 &(cdb)&: The given file is searched as a Constant DataBase file, using the key
6304 string without a terminating binary zero. The cdb format is designed for
6305 indexed files that are read frequently and never updated, except by total
6306 re-creation. As such, it is particularly suitable for large files containing
6307 aliases or other indexed data referenced by an MTA. Information about cdb can
6308 be found in several places:
6309 .display
6310 &url(http://www.pobox.com/~djb/cdb.html)
6311 &url(ftp://ftp.corpit.ru/pub/tinycdb/)
6312 &url(http://packages.debian.org/stable/utils/freecdb.html)
6313 .endd
6314 A cdb distribution is not needed in order to build Exim with cdb support,
6315 because the code for reading cdb files is included directly in Exim itself.
6316 However, no means of building or testing cdb files is provided with Exim, so
6317 you need to obtain a cdb distribution in order to do this.
6318 .next
6319 .cindex "DBM" "lookup type"
6320 .cindex "lookup" "dbm"
6321 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6322 &(dbm)&: Calls to DBM library functions are used to extract data from the given
6323 DBM file by looking up the record with the given key. A terminating binary
6324 zero is included in the key that is passed to the DBM library. See section
6325 &<<SECTdb>>& for a discussion of DBM libraries.
6326
6327 .cindex "Berkeley DB library" "file format"
6328 For all versions of Berkeley DB, Exim uses the DB_HASH style of database
6329 when building DBM files using the &%exim_dbmbuild%& utility. However, when
6330 using Berkeley DB versions 3 or 4, it opens existing databases for reading with
6331 the DB_UNKNOWN option. This enables it to handle any of the types of database
6332 that the library supports, and can be useful for accessing DBM files created by
6333 other applications. (For earlier DB versions, DB_HASH is always used.)
6334 .next
6335 .cindex "lookup" "dbmjz"
6336 .cindex "lookup" "dbm &-- embedded NULs"
6337 .cindex "sasldb2"
6338 .cindex "dbmjz lookup type"
6339 &(dbmjz)&: This is the same as &(dbm)&, except that the lookup key is
6340 interpreted as an Exim list; the elements of the list are joined together with
6341 ASCII NUL characters to form the lookup key. An example usage would be to
6342 authenticate incoming SMTP calls using the passwords from Cyrus SASL's
6343 &_/etc/sasldb2_& file with the &(gsasl)& authenticator or Exim's own
6344 &(cram_md5)& authenticator.
6345 .next
6346 .cindex "lookup" "dbmnz"
6347 .cindex "lookup" "dbm &-- terminating zero"
6348 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6349 .cindex "Courier"
6350 .cindex "&_/etc/userdbshadow.dat_&"
6351 .cindex "dbmnz lookup type"
6352 &(dbmnz)&: This is the same as &(dbm)&, except that a terminating binary zero
6353 is not included in the key that is passed to the DBM library. You may need this
6354 if you want to look up data in files that are created by or shared with some
6355 other application that does not use terminating zeros. For example, you need to
6356 use &(dbmnz)& rather than &(dbm)& if you want to authenticate incoming SMTP
6357 calls using the passwords from Courier's &_/etc/userdbshadow.dat_& file. Exim's
6358 utility program for creating DBM files (&'exim_dbmbuild'&) includes the zeros
6359 by default, but has an option to omit them (see section &<<SECTdbmbuild>>&).
6360 .next
6361 .cindex "lookup" "dsearch"
6362 .cindex "dsearch lookup type"
6363 &(dsearch)&: The given file must be a directory; this is searched for an entry
6364 whose name is the key by calling the &[lstat()]& function. The key may not
6365 contain any forward slash characters. If &[lstat()]& succeeds, the result of
6366 the lookup is the name of the entry, which may be a file, directory,
6367 symbolic link, or any other kind of directory entry. An example of how this
6368 lookup can be used to support virtual domains is given in section
6369 &<<SECTvirtualdomains>>&.
6370 .next
6371 .cindex "lookup" "iplsearch"
6372 .cindex "iplsearch lookup type"
6373 &(iplsearch)&: The given file is a text file containing keys and data. A key is
6374 terminated by a colon or white space or the end of the line. The keys in the
6375 file must be IP addresses, or IP addresses with CIDR masks. Keys that involve
6376 IPv6 addresses must be enclosed in quotes to prevent the first internal colon
6377 being interpreted as a key terminator. For example:
6378 .code
6379 1.2.3.4: data for 1.2.3.4
6380 192.168.0.0/16: data for 192.168.0.0/16
6381 "abcd::cdab": data for abcd::cdab
6382 "abcd:abcd::/32" data for abcd:abcd::/32
6383 .endd
6384 The key for an &(iplsearch)& lookup must be an IP address (without a mask). The
6385 file is searched linearly, using the CIDR masks where present, until a matching
6386 key is found. The first key that matches is used; there is no attempt to find a
6387 &"best"& match. Apart from the way the keys are matched, the processing for
6388 &(iplsearch)& is the same as for &(lsearch)&.
6389
6390 &*Warning 1*&: Unlike most other single-key lookup types, a file of data for
6391 &(iplsearch)& can &'not'& be turned into a DBM or cdb file, because those
6392 lookup types support only literal keys.
6393
6394 &*Warning 2*&: In a host list, you must always use &(net-iplsearch)& so that
6395 the implicit key is the host's IP address rather than its name (see section
6396 &<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&).
6397 .next
6398 .cindex "linear search"
6399 .cindex "lookup" "lsearch"
6400 .cindex "lsearch lookup type"
6401 .cindex "case sensitivity" "in lsearch lookup"
6402 &(lsearch)&: The given file is a text file that is searched linearly for a
6403 line beginning with the search key, terminated by a colon or white space or the
6404 end of the line. The search is case-insensitive; that is, upper and lower case
6405 letters are treated as the same. The first occurrence of the key that is found
6406 in the file is used.
6407
6408 White space between the key and the colon is permitted. The remainder of the
6409 line, with leading and trailing white space removed, is the data. This can be
6410 continued onto subsequent lines by starting them with any amount of white
6411 space, but only a single space character is included in the data at such a
6412 junction. If the data begins with a colon, the key must be terminated by a
6413 colon, for example:
6414 .code
6415 baduser: :fail:
6416 .endd
6417 Empty lines and lines beginning with # are ignored, even if they occur in the
6418 middle of an item. This is the traditional textual format of alias files. Note
6419 that the keys in an &(lsearch)& file are literal strings. There is no
6420 wildcarding of any kind.
6421
6422 .cindex "lookup" "lsearch &-- colons in keys"
6423 .cindex "white space" "in lsearch key"
6424 In most &(lsearch)& files, keys are not required to contain colons or #
6425 characters, or white space. However, if you need this feature, it is available.
6426 If a key begins with a doublequote character, it is terminated only by a
6427 matching quote (or end of line), and the normal escaping rules apply to its
6428 contents (see section &<<SECTstrings>>&). An optional colon is permitted after
6429 quoted keys (exactly as for unquoted keys). There is no special handling of
6430 quotes for the data part of an &(lsearch)& line.
6431
6432 .next
6433 .cindex "NIS lookup type"
6434 .cindex "lookup" "NIS"
6435 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6436 &(nis)&: The given file is the name of a NIS map, and a NIS lookup is done with
6437 the given key, without a terminating binary zero. There is a variant called
6438 &(nis0)& which does include the terminating binary zero in the key. This is
6439 reportedly needed for Sun-style alias files. Exim does not recognize NIS
6440 aliases; the full map names must be used.
6441
6442 .next
6443 .cindex "wildlsearch lookup type"
6444 .cindex "lookup" "wildlsearch"
6445 .cindex "nwildlsearch lookup type"
6446 .cindex "lookup" "nwildlsearch"
6447 &(wildlsearch)& or &(nwildlsearch)&: These search a file linearly, like
6448 &(lsearch)&, but instead of being interpreted as a literal string, each key in
6449 the file may be wildcarded. The difference between these two lookup types is
6450 that for &(wildlsearch)&, each key in the file is string-expanded before being
6451 used, whereas for &(nwildlsearch)&, no expansion takes place.
6452
6453 .cindex "case sensitivity" "in (n)wildlsearch lookup"
6454 Like &(lsearch)&, the testing is done case-insensitively. However, keys in the
6455 file that are regular expressions can be made case-sensitive by the use of
6456 &`(-i)`& within the pattern. The following forms of wildcard are recognized:
6457
6458 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
6459 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left.
6460
6461 .olist
6462 The string may begin with an asterisk to mean &"ends with"&. For example:
6463 .code
6464 *.a.b.c data for anything.a.b.c
6465 *fish data for anythingfish
6466 .endd
6467 .next
6468 The string may begin with a circumflex to indicate a regular expression. For
6469 example, for &(wildlsearch)&:
6470 .code
6471 ^\N\d+\.a\.b\N data for <digits>.a.b
6472 .endd
6473 Note the use of &`\N`& to disable expansion of the contents of the regular
6474 expression. If you are using &(nwildlsearch)&, where the keys are not
6475 string-expanded, the equivalent entry is:
6476 .code
6477 ^\d+\.a\.b data for <digits>.a.b
6478 .endd
6479 The case-insensitive flag is set at the start of compiling the regular
6480 expression, but it can be turned off by using &`(-i)`& at an appropriate point.
6481 For example, to make the entire pattern case-sensitive:
6482 .code
6483 ^(?-i)\d+\.a\.b data for <digits>.a.b
6484 .endd
6485
6486 If the regular expression contains white space or colon characters, you must
6487 either quote it (see &(lsearch)& above), or represent these characters in other
6488 ways. For example, &`\s`& can be used for white space and &`\x3A`& for a
6489 colon. This may be easier than quoting, because if you quote, you have to
6490 escape all the backslashes inside the quotes.
6491
6492 &*Note*&: It is not possible to capture substrings in a regular expression
6493 match for later use, because the results of all lookups are cached. If a lookup
6494 is repeated, the result is taken from the cache, and no actual pattern matching
6495 takes place. The values of all the numeric variables are unset after a
6496 &((n)wildlsearch)& match.
6497
6498 .next
6499 Although I cannot see it being of much use, the general matching function that
6500 is used to implement &((n)wildlsearch)& means that the string may begin with a
6501 lookup name terminated by a semicolon, and followed by lookup data. For
6502 example:
6503 .code
6504 cdb;/some/file data for keys that match the file
6505 .endd
6506 The data that is obtained from the nested lookup is discarded.
6507 .endlist olist
6508
6509 Keys that do not match any of these patterns are interpreted literally. The
6510 continuation rules for the data are the same as for &(lsearch)&, and keys may
6511 be followed by optional colons.
6512
6513 &*Warning*&: Unlike most other single-key lookup types, a file of data for
6514 &((n)wildlsearch)& can &'not'& be turned into a DBM or cdb file, because those
6515 lookup types support only literal keys.
6516 .endlist ilist
6517
6518
6519 .section "Query-style lookup types" "SECID62"
6520 .cindex "lookup" "query-style types"
6521 .cindex "query-style lookup" "list of types"
6522 The supported query-style lookup types are listed below. Further details about
6523 many of them are given in later sections.
6524
6525 .ilist
6526 .cindex "DNS" "as a lookup type"
6527 .cindex "lookup" "DNS"
6528 &(dnsdb)&: This does a DNS search for one or more records whose domain names
6529 are given in the supplied query. The resulting data is the contents of the
6530 records. See section &<<SECTdnsdb>>&.
6531 .next
6532 .cindex "InterBase lookup type"
6533 .cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
6534 &(ibase)&: This does a lookup in an InterBase database.
6535 .next
6536 .cindex "LDAP" "lookup type"
6537 .cindex "lookup" "LDAP"
6538 &(ldap)&: This does an LDAP lookup using a query in the form of a URL, and
6539 returns attributes from a single entry. There is a variant called &(ldapm)&
6540 that permits values from multiple entries to be returned. A third variant
6541 called &(ldapdn)& returns the Distinguished Name of a single entry instead of
6542 any attribute values. See section &<<SECTldap>>&.
6543 .next
6544 .cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
6545 .cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
6546 &(mysql)&: The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to a
6547 MySQL database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
6548 .next
6549 .cindex "NIS+ lookup type"
6550 .cindex "lookup" "NIS+"
6551 &(nisplus)&: This does a NIS+ lookup using a query that can specify the name of
6552 the field to be returned. See section &<<SECTnisplus>>&.
6553 .next
6554 .cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
6555 .cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
6556 &(oracle)&: The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to an
6557 Oracle database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
6558 .next
6559 .cindex "lookup" "passwd"
6560 .cindex "passwd lookup type"
6561 .cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&"
6562 &(passwd)& is a query-style lookup with queries that are just user names. The
6563 lookup calls &[getpwnam()]& to interrogate the system password data, and on
6564 success, the result string is the same as you would get from an &(lsearch)&
6565 lookup on a traditional &_/etc/passwd file_&, though with &`*`& for the
6566 password value. For example:
6567 .code
6568 *:42:42:King Rat:/home/kr:/bin/bash
6569 .endd
6570 .next
6571 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
6572 .cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
6573 &(pgsql)&: The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to a
6574 PostgreSQL database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
6575
6576 .next
6577 .cindex "sqlite lookup type"
6578 .cindex "lookup" "sqlite"
6579 &(sqlite)&: The format of the query is a file name followed by an SQL statement
6580 that is passed to an SQLite database. See section &<<SECTsqlite>>&.
6581
6582 .next
6583 &(testdb)&: This is a lookup type that is used for testing Exim. It is
6584 not likely to be useful in normal operation.
6585 .next
6586 .cindex "whoson lookup type"
6587 .cindex "lookup" "whoson"
6588 &(whoson)&: &'Whoson'& (&url(http://whoson.sourceforge.net)) is a protocol that
6589 allows a server to check whether a particular (dynamically allocated) IP
6590 address is currently allocated to a known (trusted) user and, optionally, to
6591 obtain the identity of the said user. For SMTP servers, &'Whoson'& was popular
6592 at one time for &"POP before SMTP"& authentication, but that approach has been
6593 superseded by SMTP authentication. In Exim, &'Whoson'& can be used to implement
6594 &"POP before SMTP"& checking using ACL statements such as
6595 .code
6596 require condition = \
6597 ${lookup whoson {$sender_host_address}{yes}{no}}
6598 .endd
6599 The query consists of a single IP address. The value returned is the name of
6600 the authenticated user, which is stored in the variable &$value$&. However, in
6601 this example, the data in &$value$& is not used; the result of the lookup is
6602 one of the fixed strings &"yes"& or &"no"&.
6603 .endlist
6604
6605
6606
6607 .section "Temporary errors in lookups" "SECID63"
6608 .cindex "lookup" "temporary error in"
6609 Lookup functions can return temporary error codes if the lookup cannot be
6610 completed. For example, an SQL or LDAP database might be unavailable. For this
6611 reason, it is not advisable to use a lookup that might do this for critical
6612 options such as a list of local domains.
6613
6614 When a lookup cannot be completed in a router or transport, delivery
6615 of the message (to the relevant address) is deferred, as for any other
6616 temporary error. In other circumstances Exim may assume the lookup has failed,
6617 or may give up altogether.
6618
6619
6620
6621 .section "Default values in single-key lookups" "SECTdefaultvaluelookups"
6622 .cindex "wildcard lookups"
6623 .cindex "lookup" "default values"
6624 .cindex "lookup" "wildcard"
6625 .cindex "lookup" "* added to type"
6626 .cindex "default" "in single-key lookups"
6627 In this context, a &"default value"& is a value specified by the administrator
6628 that is to be used if a lookup fails.
6629
6630 &*Note:*& This section applies only to single-key lookups. For query-style
6631 lookups, the facilities of the query language must be used. An attempt to
6632 specify a default for a query-style lookup provokes an error.
6633
6634 If &"*"& is added to a single-key lookup type (for example, &%lsearch*%&)
6635 and the initial lookup fails, the key &"*"& is looked up in the file to
6636 provide a default value. See also the section on partial matching below.
6637
6638 .cindex "*@ with single-key lookup"
6639 .cindex "lookup" "*@ added to type"
6640 .cindex "alias file" "per-domain default"
6641 Alternatively, if &"*@"& is added to a single-key lookup type (for example
6642 &%dbm*@%&) then, if the initial lookup fails and the key contains an @
6643 character, a second lookup is done with everything before the last @ replaced
6644 by *. This makes it possible to provide per-domain defaults in alias files
6645 that include the domains in the keys. If the second lookup fails (or doesn't
6646 take place because there is no @ in the key), &"*"& is looked up.
6647 For example, a &(redirect)& router might contain:
6648 .code
6649 data = ${lookup{$local_part@$domain}lsearch*@{/etc/mix-aliases}}
6650 .endd
6651 Suppose the address that is being processed is &'jane@eyre.example'&. Exim
6652 looks up these keys, in this order:
6653 .code
6654 jane@eyre.example
6655 *@eyre.example
6656 *
6657 .endd
6658 The data is taken from whichever key it finds first. &*Note*&: In an
6659 &(lsearch)& file, this does not mean the first of these keys in the file. A
6660 complete scan is done for each key, and only if it is not found at all does
6661 Exim move on to try the next key.
6662
6663
6664
6665 .section "Partial matching in single-key lookups" "SECTpartiallookup"
6666 .cindex "partial matching"
6667 .cindex "wildcard lookups"
6668 .cindex "lookup" "partial matching"
6669 .cindex "lookup" "wildcard"
6670 .cindex "asterisk" "in search type"
6671 The normal operation of a single-key lookup is to search the file for an exact
6672 match with the given key. However, in a number of situations where domains are
6673 being looked up, it is useful to be able to do partial matching. In this case,
6674 information in the file that has a key starting with &"*."& is matched by any
6675 domain that ends with the components that follow the full stop. For example, if
6676 a key in a DBM file is
6677 .code
6678 *.dates.fict.example
6679 .endd
6680 then when partial matching is enabled this is matched by (amongst others)
6681 &'2001.dates.fict.example'& and &'1984.dates.fict.example'&. It is also matched
6682 by &'dates.fict.example'&, if that does not appear as a separate key in the
6683 file.
6684
6685 &*Note*&: Partial matching is not available for query-style lookups. It is
6686 also not available for any lookup items in address lists (see section
6687 &<<SECTaddresslist>>&).
6688
6689 Partial matching is implemented by doing a series of separate lookups using
6690 keys constructed by modifying the original subject key. This means that it can
6691 be used with any of the single-key lookup types, provided that
6692 partial matching keys
6693 beginning with a special prefix (default &"*."&) are included in the data file.
6694 Keys in the file that do not begin with the prefix are matched only by
6695 unmodified subject keys when partial matching is in use.
6696
6697 Partial matching is requested by adding the string &"partial-"& to the front of
6698 the name of a single-key lookup type, for example, &%partial-dbm%&. When this
6699 is done, the subject key is first looked up unmodified; if that fails, &"*."&
6700 is added at the start of the subject key, and it is looked up again. If that
6701 fails, further lookups are tried with dot-separated components removed from the
6702 start of the subject key, one-by-one, and &"*."& added on the front of what
6703 remains.
6704
6705 A minimum number of two non-* components are required. This can be adjusted
6706 by including a number before the hyphen in the search type. For example,
6707 &%partial3-lsearch%& specifies a minimum of three non-* components in the
6708 modified keys. Omitting the number is equivalent to &"partial2-"&. If the
6709 subject key is &'2250.dates.fict.example'& then the following keys are looked
6710 up when the minimum number of non-* components is two:
6711 .code
6712 2250.dates.fict.example
6713 *.2250.dates.fict.example
6714 *.dates.fict.example
6715 *.fict.example
6716 .endd
6717 As soon as one key in the sequence is successfully looked up, the lookup
6718 finishes.
6719
6720 .cindex "lookup" "partial matching &-- changing prefix"
6721 .cindex "prefix" "for partial matching"
6722 The use of &"*."& as the partial matching prefix is a default that can be
6723 changed. The motivation for this feature is to allow Exim to operate with file
6724 formats that are used by other MTAs. A different prefix can be supplied in
6725 parentheses instead of the hyphen after &"partial"&. For example:
6726 .code
6727 domains = partial(.)lsearch;/some/file
6728 .endd
6729 In this example, if the domain is &'a.b.c'&, the sequence of lookups is
6730 &`a.b.c`&, &`.a.b.c`&, and &`.b.c`& (the default minimum of 2 non-wild
6731 components is unchanged). The prefix may consist of any punctuation characters
6732 other than a closing parenthesis. It may be empty, for example:
6733 .code
6734 domains = partial1()cdb;/some/file
6735 .endd
6736 For this example, if the domain is &'a.b.c'&, the sequence of lookups is
6737 &`a.b.c`&, &`b.c`&, and &`c`&.
6738
6739 If &"partial0"& is specified, what happens at the end (when the lookup with
6740 just one non-wild component has failed, and the original key is shortened right
6741 down to the null string) depends on the prefix:
6742
6743 .ilist
6744 If the prefix has zero length, the whole lookup fails.
6745 .next
6746 If the prefix has length 1, a lookup for just the prefix is done. For
6747 example, the final lookup for &"partial0(.)"& is for &`.`& alone.
6748 .next
6749 Otherwise, if the prefix ends in a dot, the dot is removed, and the
6750 remainder is looked up. With the default prefix, therefore, the final lookup is
6751 for &"*"& on its own.
6752 .next
6753 Otherwise, the whole prefix is looked up.
6754 .endlist
6755
6756
6757 If the search type ends in &"*"& or &"*@"& (see section
6758 &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>& above), the search for an ultimate default that
6759 this implies happens after all partial lookups have failed. If &"partial0"& is
6760 specified, adding &"*"& to the search type has no effect with the default
6761 prefix, because the &"*"& key is already included in the sequence of partial
6762 lookups. However, there might be a use for lookup types such as
6763 &"partial0(.)lsearch*"&.
6764
6765 The use of &"*"& in lookup partial matching differs from its use as a wildcard
6766 in domain lists and the like. Partial matching works only in terms of
6767 dot-separated components; a key such as &`*fict.example`&
6768 in a database file is useless, because the asterisk in a partial matching
6769 subject key is always followed by a dot.
6770
6771
6772
6773
6774 .section "Lookup caching" "SECID64"
6775 .cindex "lookup" "caching"
6776 .cindex "caching" "lookup data"
6777 Exim caches all lookup results in order to avoid needless repetition of
6778 lookups. However, because (apart from the daemon) Exim operates as a collection
6779 of independent, short-lived processes, this caching applies only within a
6780 single Exim process. There is no inter-process lookup caching facility.
6781
6782 For single-key lookups, Exim keeps the relevant files open in case there is
6783 another lookup that needs them. In some types of configuration this can lead to
6784 many files being kept open for messages with many recipients. To avoid hitting
6785 the operating system limit on the number of simultaneously open files, Exim
6786 closes the least recently used file when it needs to open more files than its
6787 own internal limit, which can be changed via the &%lookup_open_max%& option.
6788
6789 The single-key lookup files are closed and the lookup caches are flushed at
6790 strategic points during delivery &-- for example, after all routing is
6791 complete.
6792
6793
6794
6795
6796 .section "Quoting lookup data" "SECID65"
6797 .cindex "lookup" "quoting"
6798 .cindex "quoting" "in lookups"
6799 When data from an incoming message is included in a query-style lookup, there
6800 is the possibility of special characters in the data messing up the syntax of
6801 the query. For example, a NIS+ query that contains
6802 .code
6803 [name=$local_part]
6804 .endd
6805 will be broken if the local part happens to contain a closing square bracket.
6806 For NIS+, data can be enclosed in double quotes like this:
6807 .code
6808 [name="$local_part"]
6809 .endd
6810 but this still leaves the problem of a double quote in the data. The rule for
6811 NIS+ is that double quotes must be doubled. Other lookup types have different
6812 rules, and to cope with the differing requirements, an expansion operator
6813 of the following form is provided:
6814 .code
6815 ${quote_<lookup-type>:<string>}
6816 .endd
6817 For example, the safest way to write the NIS+ query is
6818 .code
6819 [name="${quote_nisplus:$local_part}"]
6820 .endd
6821 See chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>& for full coverage of string expansions. The quote
6822 operator can be used for all lookup types, but has no effect for single-key
6823 lookups, since no quoting is ever needed in their key strings.
6824
6825
6826
6827
6828 .section "More about dnsdb" "SECTdnsdb"
6829 .cindex "dnsdb lookup"
6830 .cindex "lookup" "dnsdb"
6831 .cindex "DNS" "as a lookup type"
6832 The &(dnsdb)& lookup type uses the DNS as its database. A simple query consists
6833 of a record type and a domain name, separated by an equals sign. For example,
6834 an expansion string could contain:
6835 .code
6836 ${lookup dnsdb{mx=a.b.example}{$value}fail}
6837 .endd
6838 If the lookup succeeds, the result is placed in &$value$&, which in this case
6839 is used on its own as the result. If the lookup does not succeed, the
6840 &`fail`& keyword causes a &'forced expansion failure'& &-- see section
6841 &<<SECTforexpfai>>& for an explanation of what this means.
6842
6843 The supported DNS record types are A, CNAME, MX, NS, PTR, SPF, SRV, and TXT,
6844 and, when Exim is compiled with IPv6 support, AAAA (and A6 if that is also
6845 configured). If no type is given, TXT is assumed. When the type is PTR,
6846 the data can be an IP address, written as normal; inversion and the addition of
6847 &%in-addr.arpa%& or &%ip6.arpa%& happens automatically. For example:
6848 .code
6849 ${lookup dnsdb{ptr=192.168.4.5}{$value}fail}
6850 .endd
6851 If the data for a PTR record is not a syntactically valid IP address, it is not
6852 altered and nothing is added.
6853
6854 .cindex "MX record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
6855 .cindex "SRV record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
6856 For an MX lookup, both the preference value and the host name are returned for
6857 each record, separated by a space. For an SRV lookup, the priority, weight,
6858 port, and host name are returned for each record, separated by spaces.
6859
6860 For any record type, if multiple records are found (or, for A6 lookups, if a
6861 single record leads to multiple addresses), the data is returned as a
6862 concatenation, with newline as the default separator. The order, of course,
6863 depends on the DNS resolver. You can specify a different separator character
6864 between multiple records by putting a right angle-bracket followed immediately
6865 by the new separator at the start of the query. For example:
6866 .code
6867 ${lookup dnsdb{>: a=host1.example}}
6868 .endd
6869 It is permitted to specify a space as the separator character. Further
6870 white space is ignored.
6871
6872 .cindex "TXT record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
6873 .cindex "SPF record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
6874 For TXT records with multiple items of data, only the first item is returned,
6875 unless a separator for them is specified using a comma after the separator
6876 character followed immediately by the TXT record item separator. To concatenate
6877 items without a separator, use a semicolon instead. For SPF records the
6878 default behaviour is to concatenate multiple items without using a separator.
6879 .code
6880 ${lookup dnsdb{>\n,: txt=a.b.example}}
6881 ${lookup dnsdb{>\n; txt=a.b.example}}
6882 ${lookup dnsdb{spf=example.org}}
6883 .endd
6884 It is permitted to specify a space as the separator character. Further
6885 white space is ignored.
6886
6887 .section "Pseudo dnsdb record types" "SECID66"
6888 .cindex "MX record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
6889 By default, both the preference value and the host name are returned for
6890 each MX record, separated by a space. If you want only host names, you can use
6891 the pseudo-type MXH:
6892 .code
6893 ${lookup dnsdb{mxh=a.b.example}}
6894 .endd
6895 In this case, the preference values are omitted, and just the host names are
6896 returned.
6897
6898 .cindex "name server for enclosing domain"
6899 Another pseudo-type is ZNS (for &"zone NS"&). It performs a lookup for NS
6900 records on the given domain, but if none are found, it removes the first
6901 component of the domain name, and tries again. This process continues until NS
6902 records are found or there are no more components left (or there is a DNS
6903 error). In other words, it may return the name servers for a top-level domain,
6904 but it never returns the root name servers. If there are no NS records for the
6905 top-level domain, the lookup fails. Consider these examples:
6906 .code
6907 ${lookup dnsdb{zns=xxx.quercite.com}}
6908 ${lookup dnsdb{zns=xxx.edu}}
6909 .endd
6910 Assuming that in each case there are no NS records for the full domain name,
6911 the first returns the name servers for &%quercite.com%&, and the second returns
6912 the name servers for &%edu%&.
6913
6914 You should be careful about how you use this lookup because, unless the
6915 top-level domain does not exist, the lookup always returns some host names. The
6916 sort of use to which this might be put is for seeing if the name servers for a
6917 given domain are on a blacklist. You can probably assume that the name servers
6918 for the high-level domains such as &%com%& or &%co.uk%& are not going to be on
6919 such a list.
6920
6921 .cindex "CSA" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
6922 A third pseudo-type is CSA (Client SMTP Authorization). This looks up SRV
6923 records according to the CSA rules, which are described in section
6924 &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&. Although &(dnsdb)& supports SRV lookups directly, this is
6925 not sufficient because of the extra parent domain search behaviour of CSA. The
6926 result of a successful lookup such as:
6927 .code
6928 ${lookup dnsdb {csa=$sender_helo_name}}
6929 .endd
6930 has two space-separated fields: an authorization code and a target host name.
6931 The authorization code can be &"Y"& for yes, &"N"& for no, &"X"& for explicit
6932 authorization required but absent, or &"?"& for unknown.
6933
6934 .cindex "A+" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
6935 The pseudo-type A+ performs an A6 lookup (if configured) followed by an AAAA
6936 and then an A lookup. All results are returned; defer processing
6937 (see below) is handled separately for each lookup. Example:
6938 .code
6939 ${lookup dnsdb {>; a+=$sender_helo_name}}
6940 .endd
6941
6942
6943 .section "Multiple dnsdb lookups" "SECID67"
6944 In the previous sections, &(dnsdb)& lookups for a single domain are described.
6945 However, you can specify a list of domains or IP addresses in a single
6946 &(dnsdb)& lookup. The list is specified in the normal Exim way, with colon as
6947 the default separator, but with the ability to change this. For example:
6948 .code
6949 ${lookup dnsdb{one.domain.com:two.domain.com}}
6950 ${lookup dnsdb{a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
6951 ${lookup dnsdb{ptr = <; 1.2.3.4 ; 4.5.6.8}}
6952 .endd
6953 In order to retain backwards compatibility, there is one special case: if
6954 the lookup type is PTR and no change of separator is specified, Exim looks
6955 to see if the rest of the string is precisely one IPv6 address. In this
6956 case, it does not treat it as a list.
6957
6958 The data from each lookup is concatenated, with newline separators by default,
6959 in the same way that multiple DNS records for a single item are handled. A
6960 different separator can be specified, as described above.
6961
6962 The &(dnsdb)& lookup fails only if all the DNS lookups fail. If there is a
6963 temporary DNS error for any of them, the behaviour is controlled by
6964 an optional keyword followed by a comma that may appear before the record
6965 type. The possible keywords are &"defer_strict"&, &"defer_never"&, and
6966 &"defer_lax"&. With &"strict"& behaviour, any temporary DNS error causes the
6967 whole lookup to defer. With &"never"& behaviour, a temporary DNS error is
6968 ignored, and the behaviour is as if the DNS lookup failed to find anything.
6969 With &"lax"& behaviour, all the queries are attempted, but a temporary DNS
6970 error causes the whole lookup to defer only if none of the other lookups
6971 succeed. The default is &"lax"&, so the following lookups are equivalent:
6972 .code
6973 ${lookup dnsdb{defer_lax,a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
6974 ${lookup dnsdb{a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
6975 .endd
6976 Thus, in the default case, as long as at least one of the DNS lookups
6977 yields some data, the lookup succeeds.
6978
6979
6980
6981
6982 .section "More about LDAP" "SECTldap"
6983 .cindex "LDAP" "lookup, more about"
6984 .cindex "lookup" "LDAP"
6985 .cindex "Solaris" "LDAP"
6986 The original LDAP implementation came from the University of Michigan; this has
6987 become &"Open LDAP"&, and there are now two different releases. Another
6988 implementation comes from Netscape, and Solaris 7 and subsequent releases
6989 contain inbuilt LDAP support. Unfortunately, though these are all compatible at
6990 the lookup function level, their error handling is different. For this reason
6991 it is necessary to set a compile-time variable when building Exim with LDAP, to
6992 indicate which LDAP library is in use. One of the following should appear in
6993 your &_Local/Makefile_&:
6994 .code
6995 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=UMICHIGAN
6996 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=OPENLDAP1
6997 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=OPENLDAP2
6998 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=NETSCAPE
6999 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=SOLARIS
7000 .endd
7001 If LDAP_LIB_TYPE is not set, Exim assumes &`OPENLDAP1`&, which has the
7002 same interface as the University of Michigan version.
7003
7004 There are three LDAP lookup types in Exim. These behave slightly differently in
7005 the way they handle the results of a query:
7006
7007 .ilist
7008 &(ldap)& requires the result to contain just one entry; if there are more, it
7009 gives an error.
7010 .next
7011 &(ldapdn)& also requires the result to contain just one entry, but it is the
7012 Distinguished Name that is returned rather than any attribute values.
7013 .next
7014 &(ldapm)& permits the result to contain more than one entry; the attributes
7015 from all of them are returned.
7016 .endlist
7017
7018
7019 For &(ldap)& and &(ldapm)&, if a query finds only entries with no attributes,
7020 Exim behaves as if the entry did not exist, and the lookup fails. The format of
7021 the data returned by a successful lookup is described in the next section.
7022 First we explain how LDAP queries are coded.
7023
7024
7025 .section "Format of LDAP queries" "SECTforldaque"
7026 .cindex "LDAP" "query format"
7027 An LDAP query takes the form of a URL as defined in RFC 2255. For example, in
7028 the configuration of a &(redirect)& router one might have this setting:
7029 .code
7030 data = ${lookup ldap \
7031 {ldap:///cn=$local_part,o=University%20of%20Cambridge,\
7032 c=UK?mailbox?base?}}
7033 .endd
7034 .cindex "LDAP" "with TLS"
7035 The URL may begin with &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`& if your LDAP library supports
7036 secure (encrypted) LDAP connections. The second of these ensures that an
7037 encrypted TLS connection is used.
7038
7039 With sufficiently modern LDAP libraries, Exim supports forcing TLS over regular
7040 LDAP connections, rather than the SSL-on-connect &`ldaps`&.
7041 See the &%ldap_start_tls%& option.
7042
7043
7044 .section "LDAP quoting" "SECID68"
7045 .cindex "LDAP" "quoting"
7046 Two levels of quoting are required in LDAP queries, the first for LDAP itself
7047 and the second because the LDAP query is represented as a URL. Furthermore,
7048 within an LDAP query, two different kinds of quoting are required. For this
7049 reason, there are two different LDAP-specific quoting operators.
7050
7051 The &%quote_ldap%& operator is designed for use on strings that are part of
7052 filter specifications. Conceptually, it first does the following conversions on
7053 the string:
7054 .code
7055 * => \2A
7056 ( => \28
7057 ) => \29
7058 \ => \5C
7059 .endd
7060 in accordance with RFC 2254. The resulting string is then quoted according
7061 to the rules for URLs, that is, all non-alphanumeric characters except
7062 .code
7063 ! $ ' - . _ ( ) * +
7064 .endd
7065 are converted to their hex values, preceded by a percent sign. For example:
7066 .code
7067 ${quote_ldap: a(bc)*, a<yz>; }
7068 .endd
7069 yields
7070 .code
7071 %20a%5C28bc%5C29%5C2A%2C%20a%3Cyz%3E%3B%20
7072 .endd
7073 Removing the URL quoting, this is (with a leading and a trailing space):
7074 .code
7075 a\28bc\29\2A, a<yz>;
7076 .endd
7077 The &%quote_ldap_dn%& operator is designed for use on strings that are part of
7078 base DN specifications in queries. Conceptually, it first converts the string
7079 by inserting a backslash in front of any of the following characters:
7080 .code
7081 , + " \ < > ;
7082 .endd
7083 It also inserts a backslash before any leading spaces or # characters, and
7084 before any trailing spaces. (These rules are in RFC 2253.) The resulting string
7085 is then quoted according to the rules for URLs. For example:
7086 .code
7087 ${quote_ldap_dn: a(bc)*, a<yz>; }
7088 .endd
7089 yields
7090 .code
7091 %5C%20a(bc)*%5C%2C%20a%5C%3Cyz%5C%3E%5C%3B%5C%20
7092 .endd
7093 Removing the URL quoting, this is (with a trailing space):
7094 .code
7095 \ a(bc)*\, a\<yz\>\;\
7096 .endd
7097 There are some further comments about quoting in the section on LDAP
7098 authentication below.
7099
7100
7101 .section "LDAP connections" "SECID69"
7102 .cindex "LDAP" "connections"
7103 The connection to an LDAP server may either be over TCP/IP, or, when OpenLDAP
7104 is in use, via a Unix domain socket. The example given above does not specify
7105 an LDAP server. A server that is reached by TCP/IP can be specified in a query
7106 by starting it with
7107 .code
7108 ldap://<hostname>:<port>/...
7109 .endd
7110 If the port (and preceding colon) are omitted, the standard LDAP port (389) is
7111 used. When no server is specified in a query, a list of default servers is
7112 taken from the &%ldap_default_servers%& configuration option. This supplies a
7113 colon-separated list of servers which are tried in turn until one successfully
7114 handles a query, or there is a serious error. Successful handling either
7115 returns the requested data, or indicates that it does not exist. Serious errors
7116 are syntactical, or multiple values when only a single value is expected.
7117 Errors which cause the next server to be tried are connection failures, bind
7118 failures, and timeouts.
7119
7120 For each server name in the list, a port number can be given. The standard way
7121 of specifying a host and port is to use a colon separator (RFC 1738). Because
7122 &%ldap_default_servers%& is a colon-separated list, such colons have to be
7123 doubled. For example
7124 .code
7125 ldap_default_servers = ldap1.example.com::145:ldap2.example.com
7126 .endd
7127 If &%ldap_default_servers%& is unset, a URL with no server name is passed
7128 to the LDAP library with no server name, and the library's default (normally
7129 the local host) is used.
7130
7131 If you are using the OpenLDAP library, you can connect to an LDAP server using
7132 a Unix domain socket instead of a TCP/IP connection. This is specified by using
7133 &`ldapi`& instead of &`ldap`& in LDAP queries. What follows here applies only
7134 to OpenLDAP. If Exim is compiled with a different LDAP library, this feature is
7135 not available.
7136
7137 For this type of connection, instead of a host name for the server, a pathname
7138 for the socket is required, and the port number is not relevant. The pathname
7139 can be specified either as an item in &%ldap_default_servers%&, or inline in
7140 the query. In the former case, you can have settings such as
7141 .code
7142 ldap_default_servers = /tmp/ldap.sock : backup.ldap.your.domain
7143 .endd
7144 When the pathname is given in the query, you have to escape the slashes as
7145 &`%2F`& to fit in with the LDAP URL syntax. For example:
7146 .code
7147 ${lookup ldap {ldapi://%2Ftmp%2Fldap.sock/o=...
7148 .endd
7149 When Exim processes an LDAP lookup and finds that the &"hostname"& is really
7150 a pathname, it uses the Unix domain socket code, even if the query actually
7151 specifies &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`&. In particular, no encryption is used for a
7152 socket connection. This behaviour means that you can use a setting of
7153 &%ldap_default_servers%& such as in the example above with traditional &`ldap`&
7154 or &`ldaps`& queries, and it will work. First, Exim tries a connection via
7155 the Unix domain socket; if that fails, it tries a TCP/IP connection to the
7156 backup host.
7157
7158 If an explicit &`ldapi`& type is given in a query when a host name is
7159 specified, an error is diagnosed. However, if there are more items in
7160 &%ldap_default_servers%&, they are tried. In other words:
7161
7162 .ilist
7163 Using a pathname with &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`& forces the use of the Unix domain
7164 interface.
7165 .next
7166 Using &`ldapi`& with a host name causes an error.
7167 .endlist
7168
7169
7170 Using &`ldapi`& with no host or path in the query, and no setting of
7171 &%ldap_default_servers%&, does whatever the library does by default.
7172
7173
7174
7175 .section "LDAP authentication and control information" "SECID70"
7176 .cindex "LDAP" "authentication"
7177 The LDAP URL syntax provides no way of passing authentication and other control
7178 information to the server. To make this possible, the URL in an LDAP query may
7179 be preceded by any number of <&'name'&>=<&'value'&> settings, separated by
7180 spaces. If a value contains spaces it must be enclosed in double quotes, and
7181 when double quotes are used, backslash is interpreted in the usual way inside
7182 them. The following names are recognized:
7183 .display
7184 &`DEREFERENCE`& set the dereferencing parameter
7185 &`NETTIME `& set a timeout for a network operation
7186 &`USER `& set the DN, for authenticating the LDAP bind
7187 &`PASS `& set the password, likewise
7188 &`REFERRALS `& set the referrals parameter
7189 &`SIZE `& set the limit for the number of entries returned
7190 &`TIME `& set the maximum waiting time for a query
7191 .endd
7192 The value of the DEREFERENCE parameter must be one of the words &"never"&,
7193 &"searching"&, &"finding"&, or &"always"&. The value of the REFERRALS parameter
7194 must be &"follow"& (the default) or &"nofollow"&. The latter stops the LDAP
7195 library from trying to follow referrals issued by the LDAP server.
7196
7197 The name CONNECT is an obsolete name for NETTIME, retained for
7198 backwards compatibility. This timeout (specified as a number of seconds) is
7199 enforced from the client end for operations that can be carried out over a
7200 network. Specifically, it applies to network connections and calls to the
7201 &'ldap_result()'& function. If the value is greater than zero, it is used if
7202 LDAP_OPT_NETWORK_TIMEOUT is defined in the LDAP headers (OpenLDAP), or
7203 if LDAP_X_OPT_CONNECT_TIMEOUT is defined in the LDAP headers (Netscape
7204 SDK 4.1). A value of zero forces an explicit setting of &"no timeout"& for
7205 Netscape SDK; for OpenLDAP no action is taken.
7206
7207 The TIME parameter (also a number of seconds) is passed to the server to
7208 set a server-side limit on the time taken to complete a search.
7209
7210
7211 Here is an example of an LDAP query in an Exim lookup that uses some of these
7212 values. This is a single line, folded to fit on the page:
7213 .code
7214 ${lookup ldap
7215 {user="cn=manager,o=University of Cambridge,c=UK" pass=secret
7216 ldap:///o=University%20of%20Cambridge,c=UK?sn?sub?(cn=foo)}
7217 {$value}fail}
7218 .endd
7219 The encoding of spaces as &`%20`& is a URL thing which should not be done for
7220 any of the auxiliary data. Exim configuration settings that include lookups
7221 which contain password information should be preceded by &"hide"& to prevent
7222 non-admin users from using the &%-bP%& option to see their values.
7223
7224 The auxiliary data items may be given in any order. The default is no
7225 connection timeout (the system timeout is used), no user or password, no limit
7226 on the number of entries returned, and no time limit on queries.
7227
7228 When a DN is quoted in the USER= setting for LDAP authentication, Exim
7229 removes any URL quoting that it may contain before passing it LDAP. Apparently
7230 some libraries do this for themselves, but some do not. Removing the URL
7231 quoting has two advantages:
7232
7233 .ilist
7234 It makes it possible to use the same &%quote_ldap_dn%& expansion for USER=
7235 DNs as with DNs inside actual queries.
7236 .next
7237 It permits spaces inside USER= DNs.
7238 .endlist
7239
7240 For example, a setting such as
7241 .code
7242 USER=cn=${quote_ldap_dn:$1}
7243 .endd
7244 should work even if &$1$& contains spaces.
7245
7246 Expanded data for the PASS= value should be quoted using the &%quote%&
7247 expansion operator, rather than the LDAP quote operators. The only reason this
7248 field needs quoting is to ensure that it conforms to the Exim syntax, which
7249 does not allow unquoted spaces. For example:
7250 .code
7251 PASS=${quote:$3}
7252 .endd
7253 The LDAP authentication mechanism can be used to check passwords as part of
7254 SMTP authentication. See the &%ldapauth%& expansion string condition in chapter
7255 &<<CHAPexpand>>&.
7256
7257
7258
7259 .section "Format of data returned by LDAP" "SECID71"
7260 .cindex "LDAP" "returned data formats"
7261 The &(ldapdn)& lookup type returns the Distinguished Name from a single entry
7262 as a sequence of values, for example
7263 .code
7264 cn=manager, o=University of Cambridge, c=UK
7265 .endd
7266 The &(ldap)& lookup type generates an error if more than one entry matches the
7267 search filter, whereas &(ldapm)& permits this case, and inserts a newline in
7268 the result between the data from different entries. It is possible for multiple
7269 values to be returned for both &(ldap)& and &(ldapm)&, but in the former case
7270 you know that whatever values are returned all came from a single entry in the
7271 directory.
7272
7273 In the common case where you specify a single attribute in your LDAP query, the
7274 result is not quoted, and does not contain the attribute name. If the attribute
7275 has multiple values, they are separated by commas.
7276
7277 If you specify multiple attributes, the result contains space-separated, quoted
7278 strings, each preceded by the attribute name and an equals sign. Within the
7279 quotes, the quote character, backslash, and newline are escaped with
7280 backslashes, and commas are used to separate multiple values for the attribute.
7281 Apart from the escaping, the string within quotes takes the same form as the
7282 output when a single attribute is requested. Specifying no attributes is the
7283 same as specifying all of an entry's attributes.
7284
7285 Here are some examples of the output format. The first line of each pair is an
7286 LDAP query, and the second is the data that is returned. The attribute called
7287 &%attr1%& has two values, whereas &%attr2%& has only one value:
7288 .code
7289 ldap:///o=base?attr1?sub?(uid=fred)
7290 value1.1, value1.2
7291
7292 ldap:///o=base?attr2?sub?(uid=fred)
7293 value two
7294
7295 ldap:///o=base?attr1,attr2?sub?(uid=fred)
7296 attr1="value1.1, value1.2" attr2="value two"
7297
7298 ldap:///o=base??sub?(uid=fred)
7299 objectClass="top" attr1="value1.1, value1.2" attr2="value two"
7300 .endd
7301 The &%extract%& operator in string expansions can be used to pick out
7302 individual fields from data that consists of &'key'&=&'value'& pairs. You can
7303 make use of Exim's &%-be%& option to run expansion tests and thereby check the
7304 results of LDAP lookups.
7305
7306
7307
7308
7309 .section "More about NIS+" "SECTnisplus"
7310 .cindex "NIS+ lookup type"
7311 .cindex "lookup" "NIS+"
7312 NIS+ queries consist of a NIS+ &'indexed name'& followed by an optional colon
7313 and field name. If this is given, the result of a successful query is the
7314 contents of the named field; otherwise the result consists of a concatenation
7315 of &'field-name=field-value'& pairs, separated by spaces. Empty values and
7316 values containing spaces are quoted. For example, the query
7317 .code
7318 [name=mg1456],passwd.org_dir
7319 .endd
7320 might return the string
7321 .code
7322 name=mg1456 passwd="" uid=999 gid=999 gcos="Martin Guerre"
7323 home=/home/mg1456 shell=/bin/bash shadow=""
7324 .endd
7325 (split over two lines here to fit on the page), whereas
7326 .code
7327 [name=mg1456],passwd.org_dir:gcos
7328 .endd
7329 would just return
7330 .code
7331 Martin Guerre
7332 .endd
7333 with no quotes. A NIS+ lookup fails if NIS+ returns more than one table entry
7334 for the given indexed key. The effect of the &%quote_nisplus%& expansion
7335 operator is to double any quote characters within the text.
7336
7337
7338
7339 .section "SQL lookups" "SECTsql"
7340 .cindex "SQL lookup types"
7341 .cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
7342 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
7343 .cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
7344 .cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
7345 .cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
7346 .cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
7347 .cindex "InterBase lookup type"
7348 .cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
7349 Exim can support lookups in InterBase, MySQL, Oracle, PostgreSQL, and SQLite
7350 databases. Queries for these databases contain SQL statements, so an example
7351 might be
7352 .code
7353 ${lookup mysql{select mailbox from users where id='userx'}\
7354 {$value}fail}
7355 .endd
7356 If the result of the query contains more than one field, the data for each
7357 field in the row is returned, preceded by its name, so the result of
7358 .code
7359 ${lookup pgsql{select home,name from users where id='userx'}\
7360 {$value}}
7361 .endd
7362 might be
7363 .code
7364 home=/home/userx name="Mister X"
7365 .endd
7366 Empty values and values containing spaces are double quoted, with embedded
7367 quotes escaped by a backslash. If the result of the query contains just one
7368 field, the value is passed back verbatim, without a field name, for example:
7369 .code
7370 Mister X
7371 .endd
7372 If the result of the query yields more than one row, it is all concatenated,
7373 with a newline between the data for each row.
7374
7375
7376 .section "More about MySQL, PostgreSQL, Oracle, and InterBase" "SECID72"
7377 .cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
7378 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
7379 .cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
7380 .cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
7381 .cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
7382 .cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
7383 .cindex "InterBase lookup type"
7384 .cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
7385 If any MySQL, PostgreSQL, Oracle, or InterBase lookups are used, the
7386 &%mysql_servers%&, &%pgsql_servers%&, &%oracle_servers%&, or &%ibase_servers%&
7387 option (as appropriate) must be set to a colon-separated list of server
7388 information.
7389 (For MySQL and PostgreSQL only, the global option need not be set if all
7390 queries contain their own server information &-- see section
7391 &<<SECTspeserque>>&.) Each item in the list is a slash-separated list of four
7392 items: host name, database name, user name, and password. In the case of
7393 Oracle, the host name field is used for the &"service name"&, and the database
7394 name field is not used and should be empty. For example:
7395 .code
7396 hide oracle_servers = oracle.plc.example//userx/abcdwxyz
7397 .endd
7398 Because password data is sensitive, you should always precede the setting with
7399 &"hide"&, to prevent non-admin users from obtaining the setting via the &%-bP%&
7400 option. Here is an example where two MySQL servers are listed:
7401 .code
7402 hide mysql_servers = localhost/users/root/secret:\
7403 otherhost/users/root/othersecret
7404 .endd
7405 For MySQL and PostgreSQL, a host may be specified as <&'name'&>:<&'port'&> but
7406 because this is a colon-separated list, the colon has to be doubled. For each
7407 query, these parameter groups are tried in order until a connection is made and
7408 a query is successfully processed. The result of a query may be that no data is
7409 found, but that is still a successful query. In other words, the list of
7410 servers provides a backup facility, not a list of different places to look.
7411
7412 The &%quote_mysql%&, &%quote_pgsql%&, and &%quote_oracle%& expansion operators
7413 convert newline, tab, carriage return, and backspace to \n, \t, \r, and \b
7414 respectively, and the characters single-quote, double-quote, and backslash
7415 itself are escaped with backslashes. The &%quote_pgsql%& expansion operator, in
7416 addition, escapes the percent and underscore characters. This cannot be done
7417 for MySQL because these escapes are not recognized in contexts where these
7418 characters are not special.
7419
7420 .section "Specifying the server in the query" "SECTspeserque"
7421 For MySQL and PostgreSQL lookups (but not currently for Oracle and InterBase),
7422 it is possible to specify a list of servers with an individual query. This is
7423 done by starting the query with
7424 .display
7425 &`servers=`&&'server1:server2:server3:...'&&`;`&
7426 .endd
7427 Each item in the list may take one of two forms:
7428 .olist
7429 If it contains no slashes it is assumed to be just a host name. The appropriate
7430 global option (&%mysql_servers%& or &%pgsql_servers%&) is searched for a host
7431 of the same name, and the remaining parameters (database, user, password) are
7432 taken from there.
7433 .next
7434 If it contains any slashes, it is taken as a complete parameter set.
7435 .endlist
7436 The list of servers is used in exactly the same way as the global list.
7437 Once a connection to a server has happened and a query has been
7438 successfully executed, processing of the lookup ceases.
7439
7440 This feature is intended for use in master/slave situations where updates
7441 are occurring and you want to update the master rather than a slave. If the
7442 master is in the list as a backup for reading, you might have a global setting
7443 like this:
7444 .code
7445 mysql_servers = slave1/db/name/pw:\
7446 slave2/db/name/pw:\
7447 master/db/name/pw
7448 .endd
7449 In an updating lookup, you could then write:
7450 .code
7451 ${lookup mysql{servers=master; UPDATE ...} }
7452 .endd
7453 That query would then be sent only to the master server. If, on the other hand,
7454 the master is not to be used for reading, and so is not present in the global
7455 option, you can still update it by a query of this form:
7456 .code
7457 ${lookup pgsql{servers=master/db/name/pw; UPDATE ...} }
7458 .endd
7459
7460
7461 .section "Special MySQL features" "SECID73"
7462 For MySQL, an empty host name or the use of &"localhost"& in &%mysql_servers%&
7463 causes a connection to the server on the local host by means of a Unix domain
7464 socket. An alternate socket can be specified in parentheses. The full syntax of
7465 each item in &%mysql_servers%& is:
7466 .display
7467 <&'hostname'&>::<&'port'&>(<&'socket name'&>)/<&'database'&>/&&&
7468 <&'user'&>/<&'password'&>
7469 .endd
7470 Any of the three sub-parts of the first field can be omitted. For normal use on
7471 the local host it can be left blank or set to just &"localhost"&.
7472
7473 No database need be supplied &-- but if it is absent here, it must be given in
7474 the queries.
7475
7476 If a MySQL query is issued that does not request any data (an insert, update,
7477 or delete command), the result of the lookup is the number of rows affected.
7478
7479 &*Warning*&: This can be misleading. If an update does not actually change
7480 anything (for example, setting a field to the value it already has), the result
7481 is zero because no rows are affected.
7482
7483
7484 .section "Special PostgreSQL features" "SECID74"
7485 PostgreSQL lookups can also use Unix domain socket connections to the database.
7486 This is usually faster and costs less CPU time than a TCP/IP connection.
7487 However it can be used only if the mail server runs on the same machine as the
7488 database server. A configuration line for PostgreSQL via Unix domain sockets
7489 looks like this:
7490 .code
7491 hide pgsql_servers = (/tmp/.s.PGSQL.5432)/db/user/password : ...
7492 .endd
7493 In other words, instead of supplying a host name, a path to the socket is
7494 given. The path name is enclosed in parentheses so that its slashes aren't
7495 visually confused with the delimiters for the other server parameters.
7496
7497 If a PostgreSQL query is issued that does not request any data (an insert,
7498 update, or delete command), the result of the lookup is the number of rows
7499 affected.
7500
7501 .section "More about SQLite" "SECTsqlite"
7502 .cindex "lookup" "SQLite"
7503 .cindex "sqlite lookup type"
7504 SQLite is different to the other SQL lookups because a file name is required in
7505 addition to the SQL query. An SQLite database is a single file, and there is no
7506 daemon as in the other SQL databases. The interface to Exim requires the name
7507 of the file, as an absolute path, to be given at the start of the query. It is
7508 separated from the query by white space. This means that the path name cannot
7509 contain white space. Here is a lookup expansion example:
7510 .code
7511 ${lookup sqlite {/some/thing/sqlitedb \
7512 select name from aliases where id='userx';}}
7513 .endd
7514 In a list, the syntax is similar. For example:
7515 .code
7516 domainlist relay_to_domains = sqlite;/some/thing/sqlitedb \
7517 select * from relays where ip='$sender_host_address';
7518 .endd
7519 The only character affected by the &%quote_sqlite%& operator is a single
7520 quote, which it doubles.
7521
7522 The SQLite library handles multiple simultaneous accesses to the database
7523 internally. Multiple readers are permitted, but only one process can
7524 update at once. Attempts to access the database while it is being updated
7525 are rejected after a timeout period, during which the SQLite library
7526 waits for the lock to be released. In Exim, the default timeout is set
7527 to 5 seconds, but it can be changed by means of the &%sqlite_lock_timeout%&
7528 option.
7529 .ecindex IIDfidalo1
7530 .ecindex IIDfidalo2
7531
7532
7533 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
7534 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
7535
7536 .chapter "Domain, host, address, and local part lists" &&&
7537 "CHAPdomhosaddlists" &&&
7538 "Domain, host, and address lists"
7539 .scindex IIDdohoadli "lists of domains; hosts; etc."
7540 A number of Exim configuration options contain lists of domains, hosts,
7541 email addresses, or local parts. For example, the &%hold_domains%& option
7542 contains a list of domains whose delivery is currently suspended. These lists
7543 are also used as data in ACL statements (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&), and as
7544 arguments to expansion conditions such as &%match_domain%&.
7545
7546 Each item in one of these lists is a pattern to be matched against a domain,
7547 host, email address, or local part, respectively. In the sections below, the
7548 different types of pattern for each case are described, but first we cover some
7549 general facilities that apply to all four kinds of list.
7550
7551
7552
7553 .section "Expansion of lists" "SECID75"
7554 .cindex "expansion" "of lists"
7555 Each list is expanded as a single string before it is used. The result of
7556 expansion must be a list, possibly containing empty items, which is split up
7557 into separate items for matching. By default, colon is the separator character,
7558 but this can be varied if necessary. See sections &<<SECTlistconstruct>>& and
7559 &<<SECTempitelis>>& for details of the list syntax; the second of these
7560 discusses the way to specify empty list items.
7561
7562
7563 If the string expansion is forced to fail, Exim behaves as if the item it is
7564 testing (domain, host, address, or local part) is not in the list. Other
7565 expansion failures cause temporary errors.
7566
7567 If an item in a list is a regular expression, backslashes, dollars and possibly
7568 other special characters in the expression must be protected against
7569 misinterpretation by the string expander. The easiest way to do this is to use
7570 the &`\N`& expansion feature to indicate that the contents of the regular
7571 expression should not be expanded. For example, in an ACL you might have:
7572 .code
7573 deny senders = \N^\d{8}\w@.*\.baddomain\.example$\N : \
7574 ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/badsenders/bydomain}}
7575 .endd
7576 The first item is a regular expression that is protected from expansion by
7577 &`\N`&, whereas the second uses the expansion to obtain a list of unwanted
7578 senders based on the receiving domain.
7579
7580
7581
7582
7583 .section "Negated items in lists" "SECID76"
7584 .cindex "list" "negation"
7585 .cindex "negation" "in lists"
7586 Items in a list may be positive or negative. Negative items are indicated by a
7587 leading exclamation mark, which may be followed by optional white space. A list
7588 defines a set of items (domains, etc). When Exim processes one of these lists,
7589 it is trying to find out whether a domain, host, address, or local part
7590 (respectively) is in the set that is defined by the list. It works like this:
7591
7592 The list is scanned from left to right. If a positive item is matched, the
7593 subject that is being checked is in the set; if a negative item is matched, the
7594 subject is not in the set. If the end of the list is reached without the
7595 subject having matched any of the patterns, it is in the set if the last item
7596 was a negative one, but not if it was a positive one. For example, the list in
7597 .code
7598 domainlist relay_to_domains = !a.b.c : *.b.c
7599 .endd
7600 matches any domain ending in &'.b.c'& except for &'a.b.c'&. Domains that match
7601 neither &'a.b.c'& nor &'*.b.c'& do not match, because the last item in the
7602 list is positive. However, if the setting were
7603 .code
7604 domainlist relay_to_domains = !a.b.c
7605 .endd
7606 then all domains other than &'a.b.c'& would match because the last item in the
7607 list is negative. In other words, a list that ends with a negative item behaves
7608 as if it had an extra item &`:*`& on the end.
7609
7610 Another way of thinking about positive and negative items in lists is to read
7611 the connector as &"or"& after a positive item and as &"and"& after a negative
7612 item.
7613
7614
7615
7616 .section "File names in lists" "SECTfilnamlis"
7617 .cindex "list" "file name in"
7618 If an item in a domain, host, address, or local part list is an absolute file
7619 name (beginning with a slash character), each line of the file is read and
7620 processed as if it were an independent item in the list, except that further
7621 file names are not allowed,
7622 and no expansion of the data from the file takes place.
7623 Empty lines in the file are ignored, and the file may also contain comment
7624 lines:
7625
7626 .ilist
7627 For domain and host lists, if a # character appears anywhere in a line of the
7628 file, it and all following characters are ignored.
7629 .next
7630 Because local parts may legitimately contain # characters, a comment in an
7631 address list or local part list file is recognized only if # is preceded by
7632 white space or the start of the line. For example:
7633 .code
7634 not#comment@x.y.z # but this is a comment
7635 .endd
7636 .endlist
7637
7638 Putting a file name in a list has the same effect as inserting each line of the
7639 file as an item in the list (blank lines and comments excepted). However, there
7640 is one important difference: the file is read each time the list is processed,
7641 so if its contents vary over time, Exim's behaviour changes.
7642
7643 If a file name is preceded by an exclamation mark, the sense of any match
7644 within the file is inverted. For example, if
7645 .code
7646 hold_domains = !/etc/nohold-domains
7647 .endd
7648 and the file contains the lines
7649 .code
7650 !a.b.c
7651 *.b.c
7652 .endd
7653 then &'a.b.c'& is in the set of domains defined by &%hold_domains%&, whereas
7654 any domain matching &`*.b.c`& is not.
7655
7656
7657
7658 .section "An lsearch file is not an out-of-line list" "SECID77"
7659 As will be described in the sections that follow, lookups can be used in lists
7660 to provide indexed methods of checking list membership. There has been some
7661 confusion about the way &(lsearch)& lookups work in lists. Because
7662 an &(lsearch)& file contains plain text and is scanned sequentially, it is
7663 sometimes thought that it is allowed to contain wild cards and other kinds of
7664 non-constant pattern. This is not the case. The keys in an &(lsearch)& file are
7665 always fixed strings, just as for any other single-key lookup type.
7666
7667 If you want to use a file to contain wild-card patterns that form part of a
7668 list, just give the file name on its own, without a search type, as described
7669 in the previous section. You could also use the &(wildlsearch)& or
7670 &(nwildlsearch)&, but there is no advantage in doing this.
7671
7672
7673
7674
7675 .section "Named lists" "SECTnamedlists"
7676 .cindex "named lists"
7677 .cindex "list" "named"
7678 A list of domains, hosts, email addresses, or local parts can be given a name
7679 which is then used to refer to the list elsewhere in the configuration. This is
7680 particularly convenient if the same list is required in several different
7681 places. It also allows lists to be given meaningful names, which can improve
7682 the readability of the configuration. For example, it is conventional to define
7683 a domain list called &'local_domains'& for all the domains that are handled
7684 locally on a host, using a configuration line such as
7685 .code
7686 domainlist local_domains = localhost:my.dom.example
7687 .endd
7688 Named lists are referenced by giving their name preceded by a plus sign, so,
7689 for example, a router that is intended to handle local domains would be
7690 configured with the line
7691 .code
7692 domains = +local_domains
7693 .endd
7694 The first router in a configuration is often one that handles all domains
7695 except the local ones, using a configuration with a negated item like this:
7696 .code
7697 dnslookup:
7698 driver = dnslookup
7699 domains = ! +local_domains
7700 transport = remote_smtp
7701 no_more
7702 .endd
7703 The four kinds of named list are created by configuration lines starting with
7704 the words &%domainlist%&, &%hostlist%&, &%addresslist%&, or &%localpartlist%&,
7705 respectively. Then there follows the name that you are defining, followed by an
7706 equals sign and the list itself. For example:
7707 .code
7708 hostlist relay_from_hosts = 192.168.23.0/24 : my.friend.example
7709 addresslist bad_senders = cdb;/etc/badsenders
7710 .endd
7711 A named list may refer to other named lists:
7712 .code
7713 domainlist dom1 = first.example : second.example
7714 domainlist dom2 = +dom1 : third.example
7715 domainlist dom3 = fourth.example : +dom2 : fifth.example
7716 .endd
7717 &*Warning*&: If the last item in a referenced list is a negative one, the
7718 effect may not be what you intended, because the negation does not propagate
7719 out to the higher level. For example, consider:
7720 .code
7721 domainlist dom1 = !a.b
7722 domainlist dom2 = +dom1 : *.b
7723 .endd
7724 The second list specifies &"either in the &%dom1%& list or &'*.b'&"&. The first
7725 list specifies just &"not &'a.b'&"&, so the domain &'x.y'& matches it. That
7726 means it matches the second list as well. The effect is not the same as
7727 .code
7728 domainlist dom2 = !a.b : *.b
7729 .endd
7730 where &'x.y'& does not match. It's best to avoid negation altogether in
7731 referenced lists if you can.
7732
7733 Named lists may have a performance advantage. When Exim is routing an
7734 address or checking an incoming message, it caches the result of tests on named
7735 lists. So, if you have a setting such as
7736 .code
7737 domains = +local_domains
7738 .endd
7739 on several of your routers
7740 or in several ACL statements,
7741 the actual test is done only for the first one. However, the caching works only
7742 if there are no expansions within the list itself or any sublists that it
7743 references. In other words, caching happens only for lists that are known to be
7744 the same each time they are referenced.
7745
7746 By default, there may be up to 16 named lists of each type. This limit can be
7747 extended by changing a compile-time variable. The use of domain and host lists
7748 is recommended for concepts such as local domains, relay domains, and relay
7749 hosts. The default configuration is set up like this.
7750
7751
7752
7753 .section "Named lists compared with macros" "SECID78"
7754 .cindex "list" "named compared with macro"
7755 .cindex "macro" "compared with named list"
7756 At first sight, named lists might seem to be no different from macros in the
7757 configuration file. However, macros are just textual substitutions. If you
7758 write
7759 .code
7760 ALIST = host1 : host2
7761 auth_advertise_hosts = !ALIST
7762 .endd
7763 it probably won't do what you want, because that is exactly the same as
7764 .code
7765 auth_advertise_hosts = !host1 : host2
7766 .endd
7767 Notice that the second host name is not negated. However, if you use a host
7768 list, and write
7769 .code
7770 hostlist alist = host1 : host2
7771 auth_advertise_hosts = ! +alist
7772 .endd
7773 the negation applies to the whole list, and so that is equivalent to
7774 .code
7775 auth_advertise_hosts = !host1 : !host2
7776 .endd
7777
7778
7779 .section "Named list caching" "SECID79"
7780 .cindex "list" "caching of named"
7781 .cindex "caching" "named lists"
7782 While processing a message, Exim caches the result of checking a named list if
7783 it is sure that the list is the same each time. In practice, this means that
7784 the cache operates only if the list contains no $ characters, which guarantees
7785 that it will not change when it is expanded. Sometimes, however, you may have
7786 an expanded list that you know will be the same each time within a given
7787 message. For example:
7788 .code
7789 domainlist special_domains = \
7790 ${lookup{$sender_host_address}cdb{/some/file}}
7791 .endd
7792 This provides a list of domains that depends only on the sending host's IP
7793 address. If this domain list is referenced a number of times (for example,
7794 in several ACL lines, or in several routers) the result of the check is not
7795 cached by default, because Exim does not know that it is going to be the
7796 same list each time.
7797
7798 By appending &`_cache`& to &`domainlist`& you can tell Exim to go ahead and
7799 cache the result anyway. For example:
7800 .code
7801 domainlist_cache special_domains = ${lookup{...
7802 .endd
7803 If you do this, you should be absolutely sure that caching is going to do
7804 the right thing in all cases. When in doubt, leave it out.
7805
7806
7807
7808 .section "Domain lists" "SECTdomainlist"
7809 .cindex "domain list" "patterns for"
7810 .cindex "list" "domain list"
7811 Domain lists contain patterns that are to be matched against a mail domain.
7812 The following types of item may appear in domain lists:
7813
7814 .ilist
7815 .cindex "primary host name"
7816 .cindex "host name" "matched in domain list"
7817 .oindex "&%primary_hostname%&"
7818 .cindex "domain list" "matching primary host name"
7819 .cindex "@ in a domain list"
7820 If a pattern consists of a single @ character, it matches the local host name,
7821 as set by the &%primary_hostname%& option (or defaulted). This makes it
7822 possible to use the same configuration file on several different hosts that
7823 differ only in their names.
7824 .next
7825 .cindex "@[] in a domain list"
7826 .cindex "domain list" "matching local IP interfaces"
7827 .cindex "domain literal"
7828 If a pattern consists of the string &`@[]`& it matches an IP address enclosed
7829 in square brackets (as in an email address that contains a domain literal), but
7830 only if that IP address is recognized as local for email routing purposes. The
7831 &%local_interfaces%& and &%extra_local_interfaces%& options can be used to
7832 control which of a host's several IP addresses are treated as local.
7833 In today's Internet, the use of domain literals is controversial.
7834 .next
7835 .cindex "@mx_any"
7836 .cindex "@mx_primary"
7837 .cindex "@mx_secondary"
7838 .cindex "domain list" "matching MX pointers to local host"
7839 If a pattern consists of the string &`@mx_any`& it matches any domain that
7840 has an MX record pointing to the local host or to any host that is listed in
7841 .oindex "&%hosts_treat_as_local%&"
7842 &%hosts_treat_as_local%&. The items &`@mx_primary`& and &`@mx_secondary`&
7843 are similar, except that the first matches only when a primary MX target is the
7844 local host, and the second only when no primary MX target is the local host,
7845 but a secondary MX target is. &"Primary"& means an MX record with the lowest
7846 preference value &-- there may of course be more than one of them.
7847
7848 The MX lookup that takes place when matching a pattern of this type is
7849 performed with the resolver options for widening names turned off. Thus, for
7850 example, a single-component domain will &'not'& be expanded by adding the
7851 resolver's default domain. See the &%qualify_single%& and &%search_parents%&
7852 options of the &(dnslookup)& router for a discussion of domain widening.
7853
7854 Sometimes you may want to ignore certain IP addresses when using one of these
7855 patterns. You can specify this by following the pattern with &`/ignore=`&<&'ip
7856 list'&>, where <&'ip list'&> is a list of IP addresses. These addresses are
7857 ignored when processing the pattern (compare the &%ignore_target_hosts%& option
7858 on a router). For example:
7859 .code
7860 domains = @mx_any/ignore=127.0.0.1
7861 .endd
7862 This example matches any domain that has an MX record pointing to one of
7863 the local host's IP addresses other than 127.0.0.1.
7864
7865 The list of IP addresses is in fact processed by the same code that processes
7866 host lists, so it may contain CIDR-coded network specifications and it may also
7867 contain negative items.
7868
7869 Because the list of IP addresses is a sublist within a domain list, you have to
7870 be careful about delimiters if there is more than one address. Like any other
7871 list, the default delimiter can be changed. Thus, you might have:
7872 .code
7873 domains = @mx_any/ignore=<;127.0.0.1;0.0.0.0 : \
7874 an.other.domain : ...
7875 .endd
7876 so that the sublist uses semicolons for delimiters. When IPv6 addresses are
7877 involved, it is easiest to change the delimiter for the main list as well:
7878 .code
7879 domains = <? @mx_any/ignore=<;127.0.0.1;::1 ? \
7880 an.other.domain ? ...
7881 .endd
7882 .next
7883 .cindex "asterisk" "in domain list"
7884 .cindex "domain list" "asterisk in"
7885 .cindex "domain list" "matching &""ends with""&"
7886 If a pattern starts with an asterisk, the remaining characters of the pattern
7887 are compared with the terminating characters of the domain. The use of &"*"& in
7888 domain lists differs from its use in partial matching lookups. In a domain
7889 list, the character following the asterisk need not be a dot, whereas partial
7890 matching works only in terms of dot-separated components. For example, a domain
7891 list item such as &`*key.ex`& matches &'donkey.ex'& as well as
7892 &'cipher.key.ex'&.
7893
7894 .next
7895 .cindex "regular expressions" "in domain list"
7896 .cindex "domain list" "matching regular expression"
7897 If a pattern starts with a circumflex character, it is treated as a regular
7898 expression, and matched against the domain using a regular expression matching
7899 function. The circumflex is treated as part of the regular expression.
7900 Email domains are case-independent, so this regular expression match is by
7901 default case-independent, but you can make it case-dependent by starting it
7902 with &`(?-i)`&. References to descriptions of the syntax of regular expressions
7903 are given in chapter &<<CHAPregexp>>&.
7904
7905 &*Warning*&: Because domain lists are expanded before being processed, you
7906 must escape any backslash and dollar characters in the regular expression, or
7907 use the special &`\N`& sequence (see chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&) to specify that
7908 it is not to be expanded (unless you really do want to build a regular
7909 expression by expansion, of course).
7910 .next
7911 .cindex "lookup" "in domain list"
7912 .cindex "domain list" "matching by lookup"
7913 If a pattern starts with the name of a single-key lookup type followed by a
7914 semicolon (for example, &"dbm;"& or &"lsearch;"&), the remainder of the pattern
7915 must be a file name in a suitable format for the lookup type. For example, for
7916 &"cdb;"& it must be an absolute path:
7917 .code
7918 domains = cdb;/etc/mail/local_domains.cdb
7919 .endd
7920 The appropriate type of lookup is done on the file using the domain name as the
7921 key. In most cases, the data that is looked up is not used; Exim is interested
7922 only in whether or not the key is present in the file. However, when a lookup
7923 is used for the &%domains%& option on a router
7924 or a &%domains%& condition in an ACL statement, the data is preserved in the
7925 &$domain_data$& variable and can be referred to in other router options or
7926 other statements in the same ACL.
7927
7928 .next
7929 Any of the single-key lookup type names may be preceded by
7930 &`partial`&<&'n'&>&`-`&, where the <&'n'&> is optional, for example,
7931 .code
7932 domains = partial-dbm;/partial/domains
7933 .endd
7934 This causes partial matching logic to be invoked; a description of how this
7935 works is given in section &<<SECTpartiallookup>>&.
7936
7937 .next
7938 .cindex "asterisk" "in lookup type"
7939 Any of the single-key lookup types may be followed by an asterisk. This causes
7940 a default lookup for a key consisting of a single asterisk to be done if the
7941 original lookup fails. This is not a useful feature when using a domain list to
7942 select particular domains (because any domain would match), but it might have
7943 value if the result of the lookup is being used via the &$domain_data$&
7944 expansion variable.
7945 .next
7946 If the pattern starts with the name of a query-style lookup type followed by a
7947 semicolon (for example, &"nisplus;"& or &"ldap;"&), the remainder of the
7948 pattern must be an appropriate query for the lookup type, as described in
7949 chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. For example:
7950 .code
7951 hold_domains = mysql;select domain from holdlist \
7952 where domain = '${quote_mysql:$domain}';
7953 .endd
7954 In most cases, the data that is looked up is not used (so for an SQL query, for
7955 example, it doesn't matter what field you select). Exim is interested only in
7956 whether or not the query succeeds. However, when a lookup is used for the
7957 &%domains%& option on a router, the data is preserved in the &$domain_data$&
7958 variable and can be referred to in other options.
7959 .next
7960 .cindex "domain list" "matching literal domain name"
7961 If none of the above cases apply, a caseless textual comparison is made
7962 between the pattern and the domain.
7963 .endlist
7964
7965 Here is an example that uses several different kinds of pattern:
7966 .code
7967 domainlist funny_domains = \
7968 @ : \
7969 lib.unseen.edu : \
7970 *.foundation.fict.example : \
7971 \N^[1-2]\d{3}\.fict\.example$\N : \
7972 partial-dbm;/opt/data/penguin/book : \
7973 nis;domains.byname : \
7974 nisplus;[name=$domain,status=local],domains.org_dir
7975 .endd
7976 There are obvious processing trade-offs among the various matching modes. Using
7977 an asterisk is faster than a regular expression, and listing a few names
7978 explicitly probably is too. The use of a file or database lookup is expensive,
7979 but may be the only option if hundreds of names are required. Because the
7980 patterns are tested in order, it makes sense to put the most commonly matched
7981 patterns earlier.
7982
7983
7984
7985 .section "Host lists" "SECThostlist"
7986 .cindex "host list" "patterns in"
7987 .cindex "list" "host list"
7988 Host lists are used to control what remote hosts are allowed to do. For
7989 example, some hosts may be allowed to use the local host as a relay, and some
7990 may be permitted to use the SMTP ETRN command. Hosts can be identified in
7991 two different ways, by name or by IP address. In a host list, some types of
7992 pattern are matched to a host name, and some are matched to an IP address.
7993 You need to be particularly careful with this when single-key lookups are
7994 involved, to ensure that the right value is being used as the key.
7995
7996
7997 .section "Special host list patterns" "SECID80"
7998 .cindex "empty item in hosts list"
7999 .cindex "host list" "empty string in"
8000 If a host list item is the empty string, it matches only when no remote host is
8001 involved. This is the case when a message is being received from a local
8002 process using SMTP on the standard input, that is, when a TCP/IP connection is
8003 not used.
8004
8005 .cindex "asterisk" "in host list"
8006 The special pattern &"*"& in a host list matches any host or no host. Neither
8007 the IP address nor the name is actually inspected.
8008
8009
8010
8011 .section "Host list patterns that match by IP address" "SECThoslispatip"
8012 .cindex "host list" "matching IP addresses"
8013 If an IPv4 host calls an IPv6 host and the call is accepted on an IPv6 socket,
8014 the incoming address actually appears in the IPv6 host as
8015 &`::ffff:`&<&'v4address'&>. When such an address is tested against a host
8016 list, it is converted into a traditional IPv4 address first. (Not all operating
8017 systems accept IPv4 calls on IPv6 sockets, as there have been some security
8018 concerns.)
8019
8020 The following types of pattern in a host list check the remote host by
8021 inspecting its IP address:
8022
8023 .ilist
8024 If the pattern is a plain domain name (not a regular expression, not starting
8025 with *, not a lookup of any kind), Exim calls the operating system function
8026 to find the associated IP address(es). Exim uses the newer
8027 &[getipnodebyname()]& function when available, otherwise &[gethostbyname()]&.
8028 This typically causes a forward DNS lookup of the name. The result is compared
8029 with the IP address of the subject host.
8030
8031 If there is a temporary problem (such as a DNS timeout) with the host name
8032 lookup, a temporary error occurs. For example, if the list is being used in an
8033 ACL condition, the ACL gives a &"defer"& response, usually leading to a
8034 temporary SMTP error code. If no IP address can be found for the host name,
8035 what happens is described in section &<<SECTbehipnot>>& below.
8036
8037 .next
8038 .cindex "@ in a host list"
8039 If the pattern is &"@"&, the primary host name is substituted and used as a
8040 domain name, as just described.
8041
8042 .next
8043 If the pattern is an IP address, it is matched against the IP address of the
8044 subject host. IPv4 addresses are given in the normal &"dotted-quad"& notation.
8045 IPv6 addresses can be given in colon-separated format, but the colons have to
8046 be doubled so as not to be taken as item separators when the default list
8047 separator is used. IPv6 addresses are recognized even when Exim is compiled
8048 without IPv6 support. This means that if they appear in a host list on an
8049 IPv4-only host, Exim will not treat them as host names. They are just addresses
8050 that can never match a client host.
8051
8052 .next
8053 .cindex "@[] in a host list"
8054 If the pattern is &"@[]"&, it matches the IP address of any IP interface on
8055 the local host. For example, if the local host is an IPv4 host with one
8056 interface address 10.45.23.56, these two ACL statements have the same effect:
8057 .code
8058 accept hosts = 127.0.0.1 : 10.45.23.56
8059 accept hosts = @[]
8060 .endd
8061 .next
8062 .cindex "CIDR notation"
8063 If the pattern is an IP address followed by a slash and a mask length (for
8064 example 10.11.42.0/24), it is matched against the IP address of the subject
8065 host under the given mask. This allows, an entire network of hosts to be
8066 included (or excluded) by a single item. The mask uses CIDR notation; it
8067 specifies the number of address bits that must match, starting from the most
8068 significant end of the address.
8069
8070 &*Note*&: The mask is &'not'& a count of addresses, nor is it the high number
8071 of a range of addresses. It is the number of bits in the network portion of the
8072 address. The above example specifies a 24-bit netmask, so it matches all 256
8073 addresses in the 10.11.42.0 network. An item such as
8074 .code
8075 192.168.23.236/31
8076 .endd
8077 matches just two addresses, 192.168.23.236 and 192.168.23.237. A mask value of
8078 32 for an IPv4 address is the same as no mask at all; just a single address
8079 matches.
8080
8081 Here is another example which shows an IPv4 and an IPv6 network:
8082 .code
8083 recipient_unqualified_hosts = 192.168.0.0/16: \
8084 3ffe::ffff::836f::::/48
8085 .endd
8086 The doubling of list separator characters applies only when these items
8087 appear inline in a host list. It is not required when indirecting via a file.
8088 For example:
8089 .code
8090 recipient_unqualified_hosts = /opt/exim/unqualnets
8091 .endd
8092 could make use of a file containing
8093 .code
8094 172.16.0.0/12
8095 3ffe:ffff:836f::/48
8096 .endd
8097 to have exactly the same effect as the previous example. When listing IPv6
8098 addresses inline, it is usually more convenient to use the facility for
8099 changing separator characters. This list contains the same two networks:
8100 .code
8101 recipient_unqualified_hosts = <; 172.16.0.0/12; \
8102 3ffe:ffff:836f::/48
8103 .endd
8104 The separator is changed to semicolon by the leading &"<;"& at the start of the
8105 list.
8106 .endlist
8107
8108
8109
8110 .section "Host list patterns for single-key lookups by host address" &&&
8111 "SECThoslispatsikey"
8112 .cindex "host list" "lookup of IP address"
8113 When a host is to be identified by a single-key lookup of its complete IP
8114 address, the pattern takes this form:
8115 .display
8116 &`net-<`&&'single-key-search-type'&&`>;<`&&'search-data'&&`>`&
8117 .endd
8118 For example:
8119 .code
8120 hosts_lookup = net-cdb;/hosts-by-ip.db
8121 .endd
8122 The text form of the IP address of the subject host is used as the lookup key.
8123 IPv6 addresses are converted to an unabbreviated form, using lower case
8124 letters, with dots as separators because colon is the key terminator in
8125 &(lsearch)& files. [Colons can in fact be used in keys in &(lsearch)& files by
8126 quoting the keys, but this is a facility that was added later.] The data
8127 returned by the lookup is not used.
8128
8129 .cindex "IP address" "masking"
8130 .cindex "host list" "masked IP address"
8131 Single-key lookups can also be performed using masked IP addresses, using
8132 patterns of this form:
8133 .display
8134 &`net<`&&'number'&&`>-<`&&'single-key-search-type'&&`>;<`&&'search-data'&&`>`&
8135 .endd
8136 For example:
8137 .code
8138 net24-dbm;/networks.db
8139 .endd
8140 The IP address of the subject host is masked using <&'number'&> as the mask
8141 length. A textual string is constructed from the masked value, followed by the
8142 mask, and this is used as the lookup key. For example, if the host's IP address
8143 is 192.168.34.6, the key that is looked up for the above example is
8144 &"192.168.34.0/24"&.
8145
8146 When an IPv6 address is converted to a string, dots are normally used instead
8147 of colons, so that keys in &(lsearch)& files need not contain colons (which
8148 terminate &(lsearch)& keys). This was implemented some time before the ability
8149 to quote keys was made available in &(lsearch)& files. However, the more
8150 recently implemented &(iplsearch)& files do require colons in IPv6 keys
8151 (notated using the quoting facility) so as to distinguish them from IPv4 keys.
8152 For this reason, when the lookup type is &(iplsearch)&, IPv6 addresses are
8153 converted using colons and not dots. In all cases, full, unabbreviated IPv6
8154 addresses are always used.
8155
8156 Ideally, it would be nice to tidy up this anomalous situation by changing to
8157 colons in all cases, given that quoting is now available for &(lsearch)&.
8158 However, this would be an incompatible change that might break some existing
8159 configurations.
8160
8161 &*Warning*&: Specifying &%net32-%& (for an IPv4 address) or &%net128-%& (for an
8162 IPv6 address) is not the same as specifying just &%net-%& without a number. In
8163 the former case the key strings include the mask value, whereas in the latter
8164 case the IP address is used on its own.
8165
8166
8167
8168 .section "Host list patterns that match by host name" "SECThoslispatnam"
8169 .cindex "host" "lookup failures"
8170 .cindex "unknown host name"
8171 .cindex "host list" "matching host name"
8172 There are several types of pattern that require Exim to know the name of the
8173 remote host. These are either wildcard patterns or lookups by name. (If a
8174 complete hostname is given without any wildcarding, it is used to find an IP
8175 address to match against, as described in section &<<SECThoslispatip>>&
8176 above.)
8177
8178 If the remote host name is not already known when Exim encounters one of these
8179 patterns, it has to be found from the IP address.
8180 Although many sites on the Internet are conscientious about maintaining reverse
8181 DNS data for their hosts, there are also many that do not do this.
8182 Consequently, a name cannot always be found, and this may lead to unwanted
8183 effects. Take care when configuring host lists with wildcarded name patterns.
8184 Consider what will happen if a name cannot be found.
8185
8186 Because of the problems of determining host names from IP addresses, matching
8187 against host names is not as common as matching against IP addresses.
8188
8189 By default, in order to find a host name, Exim first does a reverse DNS lookup;
8190 if no name is found in the DNS, the system function (&[gethostbyaddr()]& or
8191 &[getipnodebyaddr()]& if available) is tried. The order in which these lookups
8192 are done can be changed by setting the &%host_lookup_order%& option. For
8193 security, once Exim has found one or more names, it looks up the IP addresses
8194 for these names and compares them with the IP address that it started with.
8195 Only those names whose IP addresses match are accepted. Any other names are
8196 discarded. If no names are left, Exim behaves as if the host name cannot be
8197 found. In the most common case there is only one name and one IP address.
8198
8199 There are some options that control what happens if a host name cannot be
8200 found. These are described in section &<<SECTbehipnot>>& below.
8201
8202 .cindex "host" "alias for"
8203 .cindex "alias for host"
8204 As a result of aliasing, hosts may have more than one name. When processing any
8205 of the following types of pattern, all the host's names are checked:
8206
8207 .ilist
8208 .cindex "asterisk" "in host list"
8209 If a pattern starts with &"*"& the remainder of the item must match the end of
8210 the host name. For example, &`*.b.c`& matches all hosts whose names end in
8211 &'.b.c'&. This special simple form is provided because this is a very common
8212 requirement. Other kinds of wildcarding require the use of a regular
8213 expression.
8214 .next
8215 .cindex "regular expressions" "in host list"
8216 .cindex "host list" "regular expression in"
8217 If the item starts with &"^"& it is taken to be a regular expression which is
8218 matched against the host name. Host names are case-independent, so this regular
8219 expression match is by default case-independent, but you can make it
8220 case-dependent by starting it with &`(?-i)`&. References to descriptions of the
8221 syntax of regular expressions are given in chapter &<<CHAPregexp>>&. For
8222 example,
8223 .code
8224 ^(a|b)\.c\.d$
8225 .endd
8226 is a regular expression that matches either of the two hosts &'a.c.d'& or
8227 &'b.c.d'&. When a regular expression is used in a host list, you must take care
8228 that backslash and dollar characters are not misinterpreted as part of the
8229 string expansion. The simplest way to do this is to use &`\N`& to mark that
8230 part of the string as non-expandable. For example:
8231 .code
8232 sender_unqualified_hosts = \N^(a|b)\.c\.d$\N : ....
8233 .endd
8234 &*Warning*&: If you want to match a complete host name, you must include the
8235 &`$`& terminating metacharacter in the regular expression, as in the above
8236 example. Without it, a match at the start of the host name is all that is
8237 required.
8238 .endlist
8239
8240
8241
8242
8243 .section "Behaviour when an IP address or name cannot be found" "SECTbehipnot"
8244 .cindex "host" "lookup failures, permanent"
8245 While processing a host list, Exim may need to look up an IP address from a
8246 name (see section &<<SECThoslispatip>>&), or it may need to look up a host name
8247 from an IP address (see section &<<SECThoslispatnam>>&). In either case, the
8248 behaviour when it fails to find the information it is seeking is the same.
8249
8250 &*Note*&: This section applies to permanent lookup failures. It does &'not'&
8251 apply to temporary DNS errors, whose handling is described in the next section.
8252
8253 .cindex "&`+include_unknown`&"
8254 .cindex "&`+ignore_unknown`&"
8255 Exim parses a host list from left to right. If it encounters a permanent
8256 lookup failure in any item in the host list before it has found a match,
8257 Exim treats it as a failure and the default behavior is as if the host
8258 does not match the list. This may not always be what you want to happen.
8259 To change Exim's behaviour, the special items &`+include_unknown`& or
8260 &`+ignore_unknown`& may appear in the list (at top level &-- they are
8261 not recognized in an indirected file).
8262
8263 .ilist
8264 If any item that follows &`+include_unknown`& requires information that
8265 cannot found, Exim behaves as if the host does match the list. For example,
8266 .code
8267 host_reject_connection = +include_unknown:*.enemy.ex
8268 .endd
8269 rejects connections from any host whose name matches &`*.enemy.ex`&, and also
8270 any hosts whose name it cannot find.
8271
8272 .next
8273 If any item that follows &`+ignore_unknown`& requires information that cannot
8274 be found, Exim ignores that item and proceeds to the rest of the list. For
8275 example:
8276 .code
8277 accept hosts = +ignore_unknown : friend.example : \
8278 192.168.4.5
8279 .endd
8280 accepts from any host whose name is &'friend.example'& and from 192.168.4.5,
8281 whether or not its host name can be found. Without &`+ignore_unknown`&, if no
8282 name can be found for 192.168.4.5, it is rejected.
8283 .endlist
8284
8285 Both &`+include_unknown`& and &`+ignore_unknown`& may appear in the same
8286 list. The effect of each one lasts until the next, or until the end of the
8287 list.
8288
8289 To explain the host/ip processing logic a different way for the same ACL:
8290
8291 .ilist
8292 If you have name lookups or wildcarded host names and
8293 IP addresses in the same host list, you should normally put the IP
8294 addresses first. For example, in an ACL you could have:
8295 .code
8296 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7 : *.friend.example
8297 .endd
8298 The reason you normally would order it this way lies in the
8299 left-to-right way that Exim processes lists. It can test IP addresses
8300 without doing any DNS lookups, but when it reaches an item that requires
8301 a host name, it fails if it cannot find a host name to compare with the
8302 pattern. If the above list is given in the opposite order, the
8303 &%accept%& statement fails for a host whose name cannot be found, even
8304 if its IP address is 10.9.8.7.
8305
8306 .next
8307 If you really do want to do the name check first, and still recognize the IP
8308 address, you can rewrite the ACL like this:
8309 .code
8310 accept hosts = *.friend.example
8311 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7
8312 .endd
8313 If the first &%accept%& fails, Exim goes on to try the second one. See chapter
8314 &<<CHAPACL>>& for details of ACLs. Alternatively, you can use
8315 &`+ignore_unknown`&, which was discussed in depth in the first example in
8316 this section.
8317 .endlist
8318
8319
8320
8321 .section "Temporary DNS errors when looking up host information" &&&
8322 "SECTtemdnserr"
8323 .cindex "host" "lookup failures, temporary"
8324 .cindex "&`+include_defer`&"
8325 .cindex "&`+ignore_defer`&"
8326 A temporary DNS lookup failure normally causes a defer action (except when
8327 &%dns_again_means_nonexist%& converts it into a permanent error). However,
8328 host lists can include &`+ignore_defer`& and &`+include_defer`&, analagous to
8329 &`+ignore_unknown`& and &`+include_unknown`&, as described in the previous
8330 section. These options should be used with care, probably only in non-critical
8331 host lists such as whitelists.
8332
8333
8334
8335 .section "Host list patterns for single-key lookups by host name" &&&
8336 "SECThoslispatnamsk"
8337 .cindex "unknown host name"
8338 .cindex "host list" "matching host name"
8339 If a pattern is of the form
8340 .display
8341 <&'single-key-search-type'&>;<&'search-data'&>
8342 .endd
8343 for example
8344 .code
8345 dbm;/host/accept/list
8346 .endd
8347 a single-key lookup is performed, using the host name as its key. If the
8348 lookup succeeds, the host matches the item. The actual data that is looked up
8349 is not used.
8350
8351 &*Reminder*&: With this kind of pattern, you must have host &'names'& as
8352 keys in the file, not IP addresses. If you want to do lookups based on IP
8353 addresses, you must precede the search type with &"net-"& (see section
8354 &<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&). There is, however, no reason why you could not use
8355 two items in the same list, one doing an address lookup and one doing a name
8356 lookup, both using the same file.
8357
8358
8359
8360 .section "Host list patterns for query-style lookups" "SECID81"
8361 If a pattern is of the form
8362 .display
8363 <&'query-style-search-type'&>;<&'query'&>
8364 .endd
8365 the query is obeyed, and if it succeeds, the host matches the item. The actual
8366 data that is looked up is not used. The variables &$sender_host_address$& and
8367 &$sender_host_name$& can be used in the query. For example:
8368 .code
8369 hosts_lookup = pgsql;\
8370 select ip from hostlist where ip='$sender_host_address'
8371 .endd
8372 The value of &$sender_host_address$& for an IPv6 address contains colons. You
8373 can use the &%sg%& expansion item to change this if you need to. If you want to
8374 use masked IP addresses in database queries, you can use the &%mask%& expansion
8375 operator.
8376
8377 If the query contains a reference to &$sender_host_name$&, Exim automatically
8378 looks up the host name if it has not already done so. (See section
8379 &<<SECThoslispatnam>>& for comments on finding host names.)
8380
8381 Historical note: prior to release 4.30, Exim would always attempt to find a
8382 host name before running the query, unless the search type was preceded by
8383 &`net-`&. This is no longer the case. For backwards compatibility, &`net-`& is
8384 still recognized for query-style lookups, but its presence or absence has no
8385 effect. (Of course, for single-key lookups, &`net-`& &'is'& important.
8386 See section &<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&.)
8387
8388
8389
8390 .section "Mixing wildcarded host names and addresses in host lists" &&&
8391 "SECTmixwilhos"
8392 .cindex "host list" "mixing names and addresses in"
8393 If you have name lookups or wildcarded host names and IP addresses in the same
8394 host list, you should normally put the IP addresses first. For example, in an
8395 ACL you could have:
8396 .code
8397 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7 : *.friend.example
8398 .endd
8399 The reason for this lies in the left-to-right way that Exim processes lists.
8400 It can test IP addresses without doing any DNS lookups, but when it reaches an
8401 item that requires a host name, it fails if it cannot find a host name to
8402 compare with the pattern. If the above list is given in the opposite order, the
8403 &%accept%& statement fails for a host whose name cannot be found, even if its
8404 IP address is 10.9.8.7.
8405
8406 If you really do want to do the name check first, and still recognize the IP
8407 address, you can rewrite the ACL like this:
8408 .code
8409 accept hosts = *.friend.example
8410 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7
8411 .endd
8412 If the first &%accept%& fails, Exim goes on to try the second one. See chapter
8413 &<<CHAPACL>>& for details of ACLs.
8414
8415
8416
8417
8418
8419 .section "Address lists" "SECTaddresslist"
8420 .cindex "list" "address list"
8421 .cindex "address list" "empty item"
8422 .cindex "address list" "patterns"
8423 Address lists contain patterns that are matched against mail addresses. There
8424 is one special case to be considered: the sender address of a bounce message is
8425 always empty. You can test for this by providing an empty item in an address
8426 list. For example, you can set up a router to process bounce messages by
8427 using this option setting:
8428 .code
8429 senders = :
8430 .endd
8431 The presence of the colon creates an empty item. If you do not provide any
8432 data, the list is empty and matches nothing. The empty sender can also be
8433 detected by a regular expression that matches an empty string,
8434 and by a query-style lookup that succeeds when &$sender_address$& is empty.
8435
8436 Non-empty items in an address list can be straightforward email addresses. For
8437 example:
8438 .code
8439 senders = jbc@askone.example : hs@anacreon.example
8440 .endd
8441 A certain amount of wildcarding is permitted. If a pattern contains an @
8442 character, but is not a regular expression and does not begin with a
8443 semicolon-terminated lookup type (described below), the local part of the
8444 subject address is compared with the local part of the pattern, which may start
8445 with an asterisk. If the local parts match, the domain is checked in exactly
8446 the same way as for a pattern in a domain list. For example, the domain can be
8447 wildcarded, refer to a named list, or be a lookup:
8448 .code
8449 deny senders = *@*.spamming.site:\
8450 *@+hostile_domains:\
8451 bozo@partial-lsearch;/list/of/dodgy/sites:\
8452 *@dbm;/bad/domains.db
8453 .endd
8454 .cindex "local part" "starting with !"
8455 .cindex "address list" "local part starting with !"
8456 If a local part that begins with an exclamation mark is required, it has to be
8457 specified using a regular expression, because otherwise the exclamation mark is
8458 treated as a sign of negation, as is standard in lists.
8459
8460 If a non-empty pattern that is not a regular expression or a lookup does not
8461 contain an @ character, it is matched against the domain part of the subject
8462 address. The only two formats that are recognized this way are a literal
8463 domain, or a domain pattern that starts with *. In both these cases, the effect
8464 is the same as if &`*@`& preceded the pattern. For example:
8465 .code
8466 deny senders = enemy.domain : *.enemy.domain
8467 .endd
8468
8469 The following kinds of more complicated address list pattern can match any
8470 address, including the empty address that is characteristic of bounce message
8471 senders:
8472
8473 .ilist
8474 .cindex "regular expressions" "in address list"
8475 .cindex "address list" "regular expression in"
8476 If (after expansion) a pattern starts with &"^"&, a regular expression match is
8477 done against the complete address, with the pattern as the regular expression.
8478 You must take care that backslash and dollar characters are not misinterpreted
8479 as part of the string expansion. The simplest way to do this is to use &`\N`&
8480 to mark that part of the string as non-expandable. For example:
8481 .code
8482 deny senders = \N^.*this.*@example\.com$\N : \
8483 \N^\d{8}.+@spamhaus.example$\N : ...
8484 .endd
8485 The &`\N`& sequences are removed by the expansion, so these items do indeed
8486 start with &"^"& by the time they are being interpreted as address patterns.
8487
8488 .next
8489 .cindex "address list" "lookup for complete address"
8490 Complete addresses can be looked up by using a pattern that starts with a
8491 lookup type terminated by a semicolon, followed by the data for the lookup. For
8492 example:
8493 .code
8494 deny senders = cdb;/etc/blocked.senders : \
8495 mysql;select address from blocked where \
8496 address='${quote_mysql:$sender_address}'
8497 .endd
8498 Both query-style and single-key lookup types can be used. For a single-key
8499 lookup type, Exim uses the complete address as the key. However, empty keys are
8500 not supported for single-key lookups, so a match against the empty address
8501 always fails. This restriction does not apply to query-style lookups.
8502
8503 Partial matching for single-key lookups (section &<<SECTpartiallookup>>&)
8504 cannot be used, and is ignored if specified, with an entry being written to the
8505 panic log.
8506 .cindex "*@ with single-key lookup"
8507 However, you can configure lookup defaults, as described in section
8508 &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>&, but this is useful only for the &"*@"& type of
8509 default. For example, with this lookup:
8510 .code
8511 accept senders = lsearch*@;/some/file
8512 .endd
8513 the file could contains lines like this:
8514 .code
8515 user1@domain1.example
8516 *@domain2.example
8517 .endd
8518 and for the sender address &'nimrod@jaeger.example'&, the sequence of keys
8519 that are tried is:
8520 .code
8521 nimrod@jaeger.example
8522 *@jaeger.example
8523 *
8524 .endd
8525 &*Warning 1*&: Do not include a line keyed by &"*"& in the file, because that
8526 would mean that every address matches, thus rendering the test useless.
8527
8528 &*Warning 2*&: Do not confuse these two kinds of item:
8529 .code
8530 deny recipients = dbm*@;/some/file
8531 deny recipients = *@dbm;/some/file
8532 .endd
8533 The first does a whole address lookup, with defaulting, as just described,
8534 because it starts with a lookup type. The second matches the local part and
8535 domain independently, as described in a bullet point below.
8536 .endlist
8537
8538
8539 The following kinds of address list pattern can match only non-empty addresses.
8540 If the subject address is empty, a match against any of these pattern types
8541 always fails.
8542
8543
8544 .ilist
8545 .cindex "@@ with single-key lookup"
8546 .cindex "address list" "@@ lookup type"
8547 .cindex "address list" "split local part and domain"
8548 If a pattern starts with &"@@"& followed by a single-key lookup item
8549 (for example, &`@@lsearch;/some/file`&), the address that is being checked is
8550 split into a local part and a domain. The domain is looked up in the file. If
8551 it is not found, there is no match. If it is found, the data that is looked up
8552 from the file is treated as a colon-separated list of local part patterns, each
8553 of which is matched against the subject local part in turn.
8554
8555 .cindex "asterisk" "in address list"
8556 The lookup may be a partial one, and/or one involving a search for a default
8557 keyed by &"*"& (see section &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>&). The local part
8558 patterns that are looked up can be regular expressions or begin with &"*"&, or
8559 even be further lookups. They may also be independently negated. For example,
8560 with
8561 .code
8562 deny senders = @@dbm;/etc/reject-by-domain
8563 .endd
8564 the data from which the DBM file is built could contain lines like
8565 .code
8566 baddomain.com: !postmaster : *
8567 .endd
8568 to reject all senders except &%postmaster%& from that domain.
8569
8570 .cindex "local part" "starting with !"
8571 If a local part that actually begins with an exclamation mark is required, it
8572 has to be specified using a regular expression. In &(lsearch)& files, an entry
8573 may be split over several lines by indenting the second and subsequent lines,
8574 but the separating colon must still be included at line breaks. White space
8575 surrounding the colons is ignored. For example:
8576 .code
8577 aol.com: spammer1 : spammer2 : ^[0-9]+$ :
8578 spammer3 : spammer4
8579 .endd
8580 As in all colon-separated lists in Exim, a colon can be included in an item by
8581 doubling.
8582
8583 If the last item in the list starts with a right angle-bracket, the remainder
8584 of the item is taken as a new key to look up in order to obtain a continuation
8585 list of local parts. The new key can be any sequence of characters. Thus one
8586 might have entries like
8587 .code
8588 aol.com: spammer1 : spammer 2 : >*
8589 xyz.com: spammer3 : >*
8590 *: ^\d{8}$
8591 .endd
8592 in a file that was searched with &%@@dbm*%&, to specify a match for 8-digit
8593 local parts for all domains, in addition to the specific local parts listed for
8594 each domain. Of course, using this feature costs another lookup each time a
8595 chain is followed, but the effort needed to maintain the data is reduced.
8596
8597 .cindex "loop" "in lookups"
8598 It is possible to construct loops using this facility, and in order to catch
8599 them, the chains may be no more than fifty items long.
8600
8601 .next
8602 The @@<&'lookup'&> style of item can also be used with a query-style
8603 lookup, but in this case, the chaining facility is not available. The lookup
8604 can only return a single list of local parts.
8605 .endlist
8606
8607 &*Warning*&: There is an important difference between the address list items
8608 in these two examples:
8609 .code
8610 senders = +my_list
8611 senders = *@+my_list
8612 .endd
8613 In the first one, &`my_list`& is a named address list, whereas in the second
8614 example it is a named domain list.
8615
8616
8617
8618
8619 .section "Case of letters in address lists" "SECTcasletadd"
8620 .cindex "case of local parts"
8621 .cindex "address list" "case forcing"
8622 .cindex "case forcing in address lists"
8623 Domains in email addresses are always handled caselessly, but for local parts
8624 case may be significant on some systems (see &%caseful_local_part%& for how
8625 Exim deals with this when routing addresses). However, RFC 2505 (&'Anti-Spam
8626 Recommendations for SMTP MTAs'&) suggests that matching of addresses to
8627 blocking lists should be done in a case-independent manner. Since most address
8628 lists in Exim are used for this kind of control, Exim attempts to do this by
8629 default.
8630
8631 The domain portion of an address is always lowercased before matching it to an
8632 address list. The local part is lowercased by default, and any string
8633 comparisons that take place are done caselessly. This means that the data in
8634 the address list itself, in files included as plain file names, and in any file
8635 that is looked up using the &"@@"& mechanism, can be in any case. However, the
8636 keys in files that are looked up by a search type other than &(lsearch)& (which
8637 works caselessly) must be in lower case, because these lookups are not
8638 case-independent.
8639
8640 .cindex "&`+caseful`&"
8641 To allow for the possibility of caseful address list matching, if an item in
8642 an address list is the string &"+caseful"&, the original case of the local
8643 part is restored for any comparisons that follow, and string comparisons are no
8644 longer case-independent. This does not affect the domain, which remains in
8645 lower case. However, although independent matches on the domain alone are still
8646 performed caselessly, regular expressions that match against an entire address
8647 become case-sensitive after &"+caseful"& has been seen.
8648
8649
8650
8651 .section "Local part lists" "SECTlocparlis"
8652 .cindex "list" "local part list"
8653 .cindex "local part" "list"
8654 Case-sensitivity in local part lists is handled in the same way as for address
8655 lists, as just described. The &"+caseful"& item can be used if required. In a
8656 setting of the &%local_parts%& option in a router with &%caseful_local_part%&
8657 set false, the subject is lowercased and the matching is initially
8658 case-insensitive. In this case, &"+caseful"& will restore case-sensitive
8659 matching in the local part list, but not elsewhere in the router. If
8660 &%caseful_local_part%& is set true in a router, matching in the &%local_parts%&
8661 option is case-sensitive from the start.
8662
8663 If a local part list is indirected to a file (see section &<<SECTfilnamlis>>&),
8664 comments are handled in the same way as address lists &-- they are recognized
8665 only if the # is preceded by white space or the start of the line.
8666 Otherwise, local part lists are matched in the same way as domain lists, except
8667 that the special items that refer to the local host (&`@`&, &`@[]`&,
8668 &`@mx_any`&, &`@mx_primary`&, and &`@mx_secondary`&) are not recognized.
8669 Refer to section &<<SECTdomainlist>>& for details of the other available item
8670 types.
8671 .ecindex IIDdohoadli
8672
8673
8674
8675
8676 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
8677 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
8678
8679 .chapter "String expansions" "CHAPexpand"
8680 .scindex IIDstrexp "expansion" "of strings"
8681 Many strings in Exim's run time configuration are expanded before use. Some of
8682 them are expanded every time they are used; others are expanded only once.
8683
8684 When a string is being expanded it is copied verbatim from left to right except
8685 when a dollar or backslash character is encountered. A dollar specifies the
8686 start of a portion of the string that is interpreted and replaced as described
8687 below in section &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& onwards. Backslash is used as an
8688 escape character, as described in the following section.
8689
8690 Whether a string is expanded depends upon the context. Usually this is solely
8691 dependent upon the option for which a value is sought; in this documentation,
8692 options for which string expansion is performed are marked with &dagger; after
8693 the data type. ACL rules always expand strings. A couple of expansion
8694 conditions do not expand some of the brace-delimited branches, for security
8695 reasons.
8696
8697
8698
8699 .section "Literal text in expanded strings" "SECTlittext"
8700 .cindex "expansion" "including literal text"
8701 An uninterpreted dollar can be included in an expanded string by putting a
8702 backslash in front of it. A backslash can be used to prevent any special
8703 character being treated specially in an expansion, including backslash itself.
8704 If the string appears in quotes in the configuration file, two backslashes are
8705 required because the quotes themselves cause interpretation of backslashes when
8706 the string is read in (see section &<<SECTstrings>>&).
8707
8708 .cindex "expansion" "non-expandable substrings"
8709 A portion of the string can specified as non-expandable by placing it between
8710 two occurrences of &`\N`&. This is particularly useful for protecting regular
8711 expressions, which often contain backslashes and dollar signs. For example:
8712 .code
8713 deny senders = \N^\d{8}[a-z]@some\.site\.example$\N
8714 .endd
8715 On encountering the first &`\N`&, the expander copies subsequent characters
8716 without interpretation until it reaches the next &`\N`& or the end of the
8717 string.
8718
8719
8720
8721 .section "Character escape sequences in expanded strings" "SECID82"
8722 .cindex "expansion" "escape sequences"
8723 A backslash followed by one of the letters &"n"&, &"r"&, or &"t"& in an
8724 expanded string is recognized as an escape sequence for the character newline,
8725 carriage return, or tab, respectively. A backslash followed by up to three
8726 octal digits is recognized as an octal encoding for a single character, and a
8727 backslash followed by &"x"& and up to two hexadecimal digits is a hexadecimal
8728 encoding.
8729
8730 These escape sequences are also recognized in quoted strings when they are read
8731 in. Their interpretation in expansions as well is useful for unquoted strings,
8732 and for other cases such as looked-up strings that are then expanded.
8733
8734
8735 .section "Testing string expansions" "SECID83"
8736 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
8737 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
8738 .oindex "&%-be%&"
8739 Many expansions can be tested by calling Exim with the &%-be%& option. This
8740 takes the command arguments, or lines from the standard input if there are no
8741 arguments, runs them through the string expansion code, and writes the results
8742 to the standard output. Variables based on configuration values are set up, but
8743 since no message is being processed, variables such as &$local_part$& have no
8744 value. Nevertheless the &%-be%& option can be useful for checking out file and
8745 database lookups, and the use of expansion operators such as &%sg%&, &%substr%&
8746 and &%nhash%&.
8747
8748 Exim gives up its root privilege when it is called with the &%-be%& option, and
8749 instead runs under the uid and gid it was called with, to prevent users from
8750 using &%-be%& for reading files to which they do not have access.
8751
8752 .oindex "&%-bem%&"
8753 If you want to test expansions that include variables whose values are taken
8754 from a message, there are two other options that can be used. The &%-bem%&
8755 option is like &%-be%& except that it is followed by a file name. The file is
8756 read as a message before doing the test expansions. For example:
8757 .code
8758 exim -bem /tmp/test.message '$h_subject:'
8759 .endd
8760 The &%-Mset%& option is used in conjunction with &%-be%& and is followed by an
8761 Exim message identifier. For example:
8762 .code
8763 exim -be -Mset 1GrA8W-0004WS-LQ '$recipients'
8764 .endd
8765 This loads the message from Exim's spool before doing the test expansions, and
8766 is therefore restricted to admin users.
8767
8768
8769 .section "Forced expansion failure" "SECTforexpfai"
8770 .cindex "expansion" "forced failure"
8771 A number of expansions that are described in the following section have
8772 alternative &"true"& and &"false"& substrings, enclosed in brace characters
8773 (which are sometimes called &"curly brackets"&). Which of the two strings is
8774 used depends on some condition that is evaluated as part of the expansion. If,
8775 instead of a &"false"& substring, the word &"fail"& is used (not in braces),
8776 the entire string expansion fails in a way that can be detected by the code
8777 that requested the expansion. This is called &"forced expansion failure"&, and
8778 its consequences depend on the circumstances. In some cases it is no different
8779 from any other expansion failure, but in others a different action may be
8780 taken. Such variations are mentioned in the documentation of the option that is
8781 being expanded.
8782
8783
8784
8785
8786 .section "Expansion items" "SECTexpansionitems"
8787 The following items are recognized in expanded strings. White space may be used
8788 between sub-items that are keywords or substrings enclosed in braces inside an
8789 outer set of braces, to improve readability. &*Warning*&: Within braces,
8790 white space is significant.
8791
8792 .vlist
8793 .vitem &*$*&<&'variable&~name'&>&~or&~&*${*&<&'variable&~name'&>&*}*&
8794 .cindex "expansion" "variables"
8795 Substitute the contents of the named variable, for example:
8796 .code
8797 $local_part
8798 ${domain}
8799 .endd
8800 The second form can be used to separate the name from subsequent alphanumeric
8801 characters. This form (using braces) is available only for variables; it does
8802 &'not'& apply to message headers. The names of the variables are given in
8803 section &<<SECTexpvar>>& below. If the name of a non-existent variable is
8804 given, the expansion fails.
8805
8806 .vitem &*${*&<&'op'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
8807 .cindex "expansion" "operators"
8808 The string is first itself expanded, and then the operation specified by
8809 <&'op'&> is applied to it. For example:
8810 .code
8811 ${lc:$local_part}
8812 .endd
8813 The string starts with the first character after the colon, which may be
8814 leading white space. A list of operators is given in section &<<SECTexpop>>&
8815 below. The operator notation is used for simple expansion items that have just
8816 one argument, because it reduces the number of braces and therefore makes the
8817 string easier to understand.
8818
8819 .vitem &*$bheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&*$bh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&
8820 This item inserts &"basic"& header lines. It is described with the &%header%&
8821 expansion item below.
8822
8823
8824 .vitem "&*${acl{*&<&'name'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}...}*&"
8825 .cindex "expansion" "calling an acl"
8826 .cindex "&%acl%&" "call from expansion"
8827 The name and zero to nine argument strings are first expanded separately. The expanded
8828 arguments are assigned to the variables &$acl_arg1$& to &$acl_arg9$& in order.
8829 Any unused are made empty. The variable &$acl_narg$& is set to the number of
8830 arguments. The named ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&) is called
8831 and may use the variables; if another acl expansion is used the values
8832 are restored after it returns. If the ACL sets
8833 a value using a "message =" modifier and returns accept or deny, the value becomes
8834 the result of the expansion.
8835 If no message is set and the ACL returns accept or deny
8836 the expansion result is an empty string.
8837 If the ACL returns defer the result is a forced-fail. Otherwise the expansion fails.
8838
8839
8840 .vitem "&*${dlfunc{*&<&'file'&>&*}{*&<&'function'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}&&&
8841 {*&<&'arg'&>&*}...}*&"
8842 .cindex &%dlfunc%&
8843 This expansion dynamically loads and then calls a locally-written C function.
8844 This functionality is available only if Exim is compiled with
8845 .code
8846 EXPAND_DLFUNC=yes
8847 .endd
8848 set in &_Local/Makefile_&. Once loaded, Exim remembers the dynamically loaded
8849 object so that it doesn't reload the same object file in the same Exim process
8850 (but of course Exim does start new processes frequently).
8851
8852 There may be from zero to eight arguments to the function. When compiling
8853 a local function that is to be called in this way, &_local_scan.h_& should be
8854 included. The Exim variables and functions that are defined by that API
8855 are also available for dynamically loaded functions. The function itself
8856 must have the following type:
8857 .code
8858 int dlfunction(uschar **yield, int argc, uschar *argv[])
8859 .endd
8860 Where &`uschar`& is a typedef for &`unsigned char`& in &_local_scan.h_&. The
8861 function should return one of the following values:
8862
8863 &`OK`&: Success. The string that is placed in the variable &'yield'& is put
8864 into the expanded string that is being built.
8865
8866 &`FAIL`&: A non-forced expansion failure occurs, with the error message taken
8867 from &'yield'&, if it is set.
8868
8869 &`FAIL_FORCED`&: A forced expansion failure occurs, with the error message
8870 taken from &'yield'& if it is set.
8871
8872 &`ERROR`&: Same as &`FAIL`&, except that a panic log entry is written.
8873
8874 When compiling a function that is to be used in this way with gcc,
8875 you need to add &%-shared%& to the gcc command. Also, in the Exim build-time
8876 configuration, you must add &%-export-dynamic%& to EXTRALIBS.
8877
8878 .vitem "&*${extract{*&<&'key'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}&&&
8879 {*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
8880 .cindex "expansion" "extracting substrings by key"
8881 .cindex "&%extract%&" "substrings by key"
8882 The key and <&'string1'&> are first expanded separately. Leading and trailing
8883 white space is removed from the key (but not from any of the strings). The key
8884 must not consist entirely of digits. The expanded <&'string1'&> must be of the
8885 form:
8886 .display
8887 <&'key1'&> = <&'value1'&> <&'key2'&> = <&'value2'&> ...
8888 .endd
8889 .vindex "&$value$&"
8890 where the equals signs and spaces (but not both) are optional. If any of the
8891 values contain white space, they must be enclosed in double quotes, and any
8892 values that are enclosed in double quotes are subject to escape processing as
8893 described in section &<<SECTstrings>>&. The expanded <&'string1'&> is searched
8894 for the value that corresponds to the key. The search is case-insensitive. If
8895 the key is found, <&'string2'&> is expanded, and replaces the whole item;
8896 otherwise <&'string3'&> is used. During the expansion of <&'string2'&> the
8897 variable &$value$& contains the value that has been extracted. Afterwards, it
8898 is restored to any previous value it might have had.
8899
8900 If {<&'string3'&>} is omitted, the item is replaced by an empty string if the
8901 key is not found. If {<&'string2'&>} is also omitted, the value that was
8902 extracted is used. Thus, for example, these two expansions are identical, and
8903 yield &"2001"&:
8904 .code
8905 ${extract{gid}{uid=1984 gid=2001}}
8906 ${extract{gid}{uid=1984 gid=2001}{$value}}
8907 .endd
8908 Instead of {<&'string3'&>} the word &"fail"& (not in curly brackets) can
8909 appear, for example:
8910 .code
8911 ${extract{Z}{A=... B=...}{$value} fail }
8912 .endd
8913 This forces an expansion failure (see section &<<SECTforexpfai>>&);
8914 {<&'string2'&>} must be present for &"fail"& to be recognized.
8915
8916
8917 .vitem "&*${extract{*&<&'number'&>&*}{*&<&'separators'&>&*}&&&
8918 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
8919 .cindex "expansion" "extracting substrings by number"
8920 .cindex "&%extract%&" "substrings by number"
8921 The <&'number'&> argument must consist entirely of decimal digits,
8922 apart from leading and trailing white space, which is ignored.
8923 This is what distinguishes this form of &%extract%& from the previous kind. It
8924 behaves in the same way, except that, instead of extracting a named field, it
8925 extracts from <&'string1'&> the field whose number is given as the first
8926 argument. You can use &$value$& in <&'string2'&> or &`fail`& instead of
8927 <&'string3'&> as before.
8928
8929 The fields in the string are separated by any one of the characters in the
8930 separator string. These may include space or tab characters.
8931 The first field is numbered one. If the number is negative, the fields are
8932 counted from the end of the string, with the rightmost one numbered -1. If the
8933 number given is zero, the entire string is returned. If the modulus of the
8934 number is greater than the number of fields in the string, the result is the
8935 expansion of <&'string3'&>, or the empty string if <&'string3'&> is not
8936 provided. For example:
8937 .code
8938 ${extract{2}{:}{x:42:99:& Mailer::/bin/bash}}
8939 .endd
8940 yields &"42"&, and
8941 .code
8942 ${extract{-4}{:}{x:42:99:& Mailer::/bin/bash}}
8943 .endd
8944 yields &"99"&. Two successive separators mean that the field between them is
8945 empty (for example, the fifth field above).
8946
8947
8948 .vitem &*${filter{*&<&'string'&>&*}{*&<&'condition'&>&*}}*&
8949 .cindex "list" "selecting by condition"
8950 .cindex "expansion" "selecting from list by condition"
8951 .vindex "&$item$&"
8952 After expansion, <&'string'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
8953 default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way. For each item
8954 in this list, its value is place in &$item$&, and then the condition is
8955 evaluated. If the condition is true, &$item$& is added to the output as an
8956 item in a new list; if the condition is false, the item is discarded. The
8957 separator used for the output list is the same as the one used for the
8958 input, but a separator setting is not included in the output. For example:
8959 .code
8960 ${filter{a:b:c}{!eq{$item}{b}}
8961 .endd
8962 yields &`a:c`&. At the end of the expansion, the value of &$item$& is restored
8963 to what it was before. See also the &*map*& and &*reduce*& expansion items.
8964
8965
8966 .vitem &*${hash{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
8967 .cindex "hash function" "textual"
8968 .cindex "expansion" "textual hash"
8969 This is a textual hashing function, and was the first to be implemented in
8970 early versions of Exim. In current releases, there are other hashing functions
8971 (numeric, MD5, and SHA-1), which are described below.
8972
8973 The first two strings, after expansion, must be numbers. Call them <&'m'&> and
8974 <&'n'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is, if
8975 <&'string1'&> and <&'string2'&> do not change when they are expanded, you can
8976 use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
8977 .code
8978 ${hash_<n>_<m>:<string>}
8979 .endd
8980 The second number is optional (in both notations). If <&'n'&> is greater than
8981 or equal to the length of the string, the expansion item returns the string.
8982 Otherwise it computes a new string of length <&'n'&> by applying a hashing
8983 function to the string. The new string consists of characters taken from the
8984 first <&'m'&> characters of the string
8985 .code
8986 abcdefghijklmnopqrstuvwxyzABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQWRSTUVWXYZ0123456789
8987 .endd
8988 If <&'m'&> is not present the value 26 is used, so that only lower case
8989 letters appear. For example:
8990 .display
8991 &`$hash{3}{monty}} `& yields &`jmg`&
8992 &`$hash{5}{monty}} `& yields &`monty`&
8993 &`$hash{4}{62}{monty python}}`& yields &`fbWx`&
8994 .endd
8995
8996 .vitem "&*$header_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
8997 &*$h_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&" &&&
8998 "&*$bheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
8999 &*$bh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&" &&&
9000 "&*$rheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
9001 &*$rh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&"
9002 .cindex "expansion" "header insertion"
9003 .vindex "&$header_$&"
9004 .vindex "&$bheader_$&"
9005 .vindex "&$rheader_$&"
9006 .cindex "header lines" "in expansion strings"
9007 .cindex "header lines" "character sets"
9008 .cindex "header lines" "decoding"
9009 Substitute the contents of the named message header line, for example
9010 .code
9011 $header_reply-to:
9012 .endd
9013 The newline that terminates a header line is not included in the expansion, but
9014 internal newlines (caused by splitting the header line over several physical
9015 lines) may be present.
9016
9017 The difference between &%rheader%&, &%bheader%&, and &%header%& is in the way
9018 the data in the header line is interpreted.
9019
9020 .ilist
9021 .cindex "white space" "in header lines"
9022 &%rheader%& gives the original &"raw"& content of the header line, with no
9023 processing at all, and without the removal of leading and trailing white space.
9024
9025 .next
9026 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in header lines"
9027 &%bheader%& removes leading and trailing white space, and then decodes base64
9028 or quoted-printable MIME &"words"& within the header text, but does no
9029 character set translation. If decoding of what looks superficially like a MIME
9030 &"word"& fails, the raw string is returned. If decoding
9031 .cindex "binary zero" "in header line"
9032 produces a binary zero character, it is replaced by a question mark &-- this is
9033 what Exim does for binary zeros that are actually received in header lines.
9034
9035 .next
9036 &%header%& tries to translate the string as decoded by &%bheader%& to a
9037 standard character set. This is an attempt to produce the same string as would
9038 be displayed on a user's MUA. If translation fails, the &%bheader%& string is
9039 returned. Translation is attempted only on operating systems that support the
9040 &[iconv()]& function. This is indicated by the compile-time macro HAVE_ICONV in
9041 a system Makefile or in &_Local/Makefile_&.
9042 .endlist ilist
9043
9044 In a filter file, the target character set for &%header%& can be specified by a
9045 command of the following form:
9046 .code
9047 headers charset "UTF-8"
9048 .endd
9049 This command affects all references to &$h_$& (or &$header_$&) expansions in
9050 subsequently obeyed filter commands. In the absence of this command, the target
9051 character set in a filter is taken from the setting of the &%headers_charset%&
9052 option in the runtime configuration. The value of this option defaults to the
9053 value of HEADERS_CHARSET in &_Local/Makefile_&. The ultimate default is
9054 ISO-8859-1.
9055
9056 Header names follow the syntax of RFC 2822, which states that they may contain
9057 any printing characters except space and colon. Consequently, curly brackets
9058 &'do not'& terminate header names, and should not be used to enclose them as
9059 if they were variables. Attempting to do so causes a syntax error.
9060
9061 Only header lines that are common to all copies of a message are visible to
9062 this mechanism. These are the original header lines that are received with the
9063 message, and any that are added by an ACL statement or by a system
9064 filter. Header lines that are added to a particular copy of a message by a
9065 router or transport are not accessible.
9066
9067 For incoming SMTP messages, no header lines are visible in ACLs that are obeyed
9068 before the DATA ACL, because the header structure is not set up until the
9069 message is received. Header lines that are added in a RCPT ACL (for example)
9070 are saved until the message's incoming header lines are available, at which
9071 point they are added. When a DATA ACL is running, however, header lines added
9072 by earlier ACLs are visible.
9073
9074 Upper case and lower case letters are synonymous in header names. If the
9075 following character is white space, the terminating colon may be omitted, but
9076 this is not recommended, because you may then forget it when it is needed. When
9077 white space terminates the header name, it is included in the expanded string.
9078 If the message does not contain the given header, the expansion item is
9079 replaced by an empty string. (See the &%def%& condition in section
9080 &<<SECTexpcond>>& for a means of testing for the existence of a header.)
9081
9082 If there is more than one header with the same name, they are all concatenated
9083 to form the substitution string, up to a maximum length of 64K. Unless
9084 &%rheader%& is being used, leading and trailing white space is removed from
9085 each header before concatenation, and a completely empty header is ignored. A
9086 newline character is then inserted between non-empty headers, but there is no
9087 newline at the very end. For the &%header%& and &%bheader%& expansion, for
9088 those headers that contain lists of addresses, a comma is also inserted at the
9089 junctions between headers. This does not happen for the &%rheader%& expansion.
9090
9091
9092 .vitem &*${hmac{*&<&'hashname'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}{*&<&'string'&>&*}}*&
9093 .cindex "expansion" "hmac hashing"
9094 .cindex &%hmac%&
9095 This function uses cryptographic hashing (either MD5 or SHA-1) to convert a
9096 shared secret and some text into a message authentication code, as specified in
9097 RFC 2104. This differs from &`${md5:secret_text...}`& or
9098 &`${sha1:secret_text...}`& in that the hmac step adds a signature to the
9099 cryptographic hash, allowing for authentication that is not possible with MD5
9100 or SHA-1 alone. The hash name must expand to either &`md5`& or &`sha1`& at
9101 present. For example:
9102 .code
9103 ${hmac{md5}{somesecret}{$primary_hostname $tod_log}}
9104 .endd
9105 For the hostname &'mail.example.com'& and time 2002-10-17 11:30:59, this
9106 produces:
9107 .code
9108 dd97e3ba5d1a61b5006108f8c8252953
9109 .endd
9110 As an example of how this might be used, you might put in the main part of
9111 an Exim configuration:
9112 .code
9113 SPAMSCAN_SECRET=cohgheeLei2thahw
9114 .endd
9115 In a router or a transport you could then have:
9116 .code
9117 headers_add = \
9118 X-Spam-Scanned: ${primary_hostname} ${message_exim_id} \
9119 ${hmac{md5}{SPAMSCAN_SECRET}\
9120 {${primary_hostname},${message_exim_id},$h_message-id:}}
9121 .endd
9122 Then given a message, you can check where it was scanned by looking at the
9123 &'X-Spam-Scanned:'& header line. If you know the secret, you can check that
9124 this header line is authentic by recomputing the authentication code from the
9125 host name, message ID and the &'Message-id:'& header line. This can be done
9126 using Exim's &%-be%& option, or by other means, for example by using the
9127 &'hmac_md5_hex()'& function in Perl.
9128
9129
9130 .vitem &*${if&~*&<&'condition'&>&*&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
9131 .cindex "expansion" "conditional"
9132 .cindex "&%if%&, expansion item"
9133 If <&'condition'&> is true, <&'string1'&> is expanded and replaces the whole
9134 item; otherwise <&'string2'&> is used. The available conditions are described
9135 in section &<<SECTexpcond>>& below. For example:
9136 .code
9137 ${if eq {$local_part}{postmaster} {yes}{no} }
9138 .endd
9139 The second string need not be present; if it is not and the condition is not
9140 true, the item is replaced with nothing. Alternatively, the word &"fail"& may
9141 be present instead of the second string (without any curly brackets). In this
9142 case, the expansion is forced to fail if the condition is not true (see section
9143 &<<SECTforexpfai>>&).
9144
9145 If both strings are omitted, the result is the string &`true`& if the condition
9146 is true, and the empty string if the condition is false. This makes it less
9147 cumbersome to write custom ACL and router conditions. For example, instead of
9148 .code
9149 condition = ${if >{$acl_m4}{3}{true}{false}}
9150 .endd
9151 you can use
9152 .code
9153 condition = ${if >{$acl_m4}{3}}
9154 .endd
9155
9156 .vitem &*${length{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
9157 .cindex "expansion" "string truncation"
9158 .cindex "&%length%& expansion item"
9159 The &%length%& item is used to extract the initial portion of a string. Both
9160 strings are expanded, and the first one must yield a number, <&'n'&>, say. If
9161 you are using a fixed value for the number, that is, if <&'string1'&> does not
9162 change when expanded, you can use the simpler operator notation that avoids
9163 some of the braces:
9164 .code
9165 ${length_<n>:<string>}
9166 .endd
9167 The result of this item is either the first <&'n'&> characters or the whole
9168 of <&'string2'&>, whichever is the shorter. Do not confuse &%length%& with
9169 &%strlen%&, which gives the length of a string.
9170
9171
9172 .vitem "&*${lookup{*&<&'key'&>&*}&~*&<&'search&~type'&>&*&~&&&
9173 {*&<&'file'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
9174 This is the first of one of two different types of lookup item, which are both
9175 described in the next item.
9176
9177 .vitem "&*${lookup&~*&<&'search&~type'&>&*&~{*&<&'query'&>&*}&~&&&
9178 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
9179 .cindex "expansion" "lookup in"
9180 .cindex "file" "lookups"
9181 .cindex "lookup" "in expanded string"
9182 The two forms of lookup item specify data lookups in files and databases, as
9183 discussed in chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. The first form is used for single-key
9184 lookups, and the second is used for query-style lookups. The <&'key'&>,
9185 <&'file'&>, and <&'query'&> strings are expanded before use.
9186
9187 If there is any white space in a lookup item which is part of a filter command,
9188 a retry or rewrite rule, a routing rule for the &(manualroute)& router, or any
9189 other place where white space is significant, the lookup item must be enclosed
9190 in double quotes. The use of data lookups in users' filter files may be locked
9191 out by the system administrator.
9192
9193 .vindex "&$value$&"
9194 If the lookup succeeds, <&'string1'&> is expanded and replaces the entire item.
9195 During its expansion, the variable &$value$& contains the data returned by the
9196 lookup. Afterwards it reverts to the value it had previously (at the outer
9197 level it is empty). If the lookup fails, <&'string2'&> is expanded and replaces
9198 the entire item. If {<&'string2'&>} is omitted, the replacement is the empty
9199 string on failure. If <&'string2'&> is provided, it can itself be a nested
9200 lookup, thus providing a mechanism for looking up a default value when the
9201 original lookup fails.
9202
9203 If a nested lookup is used as part of <&'string1'&>, &$value$& contains the
9204 data for the outer lookup while the parameters of the second lookup are
9205 expanded, and also while <&'string2'&> of the second lookup is expanded, should
9206 the second lookup fail. Instead of {<&'string2'&>} the word &"fail"& can
9207 appear, and in this case, if the lookup fails, the entire expansion is forced
9208 to fail (see section &<<SECTforexpfai>>&). If both {<&'string1'&>} and
9209 {<&'string2'&>} are omitted, the result is the looked up value in the case of a
9210 successful lookup, and nothing in the case of failure.
9211
9212 For single-key lookups, the string &"partial"& is permitted to precede the
9213 search type in order to do partial matching, and * or *@ may follow a search
9214 type to request default lookups if the key does not match (see sections
9215 &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>& and &<<SECTpartiallookup>>& for details).
9216
9217 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in lookup expansion"
9218 If a partial search is used, the variables &$1$& and &$2$& contain the wild
9219 and non-wild parts of the key during the expansion of the replacement text.
9220 They return to their previous values at the end of the lookup item.
9221
9222 This example looks up the postmaster alias in the conventional alias file:
9223 .code
9224 ${lookup {postmaster} lsearch {/etc/aliases} {$value}}
9225 .endd
9226 This example uses NIS+ to look up the full name of the user corresponding to
9227 the local part of an address, forcing the expansion to fail if it is not found:
9228 .code
9229 ${lookup nisplus {[name=$local_part],passwd.org_dir:gcos} \
9230 {$value}fail}
9231 .endd
9232
9233
9234 .vitem &*${map{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
9235 .cindex "expansion" "list creation"
9236 .vindex "&$item$&"
9237 After expansion, <&'string1'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
9238 default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way. For each item
9239 in this list, its value is place in &$item$&, and then <&'string2'&> is
9240 expanded and added to the output as an item in a new list. The separator used
9241 for the output list is the same as the one used for the input, but a separator
9242 setting is not included in the output. For example:
9243 .code
9244 ${map{a:b:c}{[$item]}} ${map{<- x-y-z}{($item)}}
9245 .endd
9246 expands to &`[a]:[b]:[c] (x)-(y)-(z)`&. At the end of the expansion, the
9247 value of &$item$& is restored to what it was before. See also the &*filter*&
9248 and &*reduce*& expansion items.
9249
9250 .vitem &*${nhash{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
9251 .cindex "expansion" "numeric hash"
9252 .cindex "hash function" "numeric"
9253 The three strings are expanded; the first two must yield numbers. Call them
9254 <&'n'&> and <&'m'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is,
9255 if <&'string1'&> and <&'string2'&> do not change when they are expanded, you
9256 can use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
9257 .code
9258 ${nhash_<n>_<m>:<string>}
9259 .endd
9260 The second number is optional (in both notations). If there is only one number,
9261 the result is a number in the range 0&--<&'n'&>-1. Otherwise, the string is
9262 processed by a div/mod hash function that returns two numbers, separated by a
9263 slash, in the ranges 0 to <&'n'&>-1 and 0 to <&'m'&>-1, respectively. For
9264 example,
9265 .code
9266 ${nhash{8}{64}{supercalifragilisticexpialidocious}}
9267 .endd
9268 returns the string &"6/33"&.
9269
9270
9271
9272 .vitem &*${perl{*&<&'subroutine'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}...}*&
9273 .cindex "Perl" "use in expanded string"
9274 .cindex "expansion" "calling Perl from"
9275 This item is available only if Exim has been built to include an embedded Perl
9276 interpreter. The subroutine name and the arguments are first separately
9277 expanded, and then the Perl subroutine is called with those arguments. No
9278 additional arguments need be given; the maximum number permitted, including the
9279 name of the subroutine, is nine.
9280
9281 The return value of the subroutine is inserted into the expanded string, unless
9282 the return value is &%undef%&. In that case, the expansion fails in the same
9283 way as an explicit &"fail"& on a lookup item. The return value is a scalar.
9284 Whatever you return is evaluated in a scalar context. For example, if you
9285 return the name of a Perl vector, the return value is the size of the vector,
9286 not its contents.
9287
9288 If the subroutine exits by calling Perl's &%die%& function, the expansion fails
9289 with the error message that was passed to &%die%&. More details of the embedded
9290 Perl facility are given in chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&.
9291
9292 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_perl%& which locks
9293 out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
9294
9295
9296 .vitem &*${prvs{*&<&'address'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}{*&<&'keynumber'&>&*}}*&
9297 .cindex "&%prvs%& expansion item"
9298 The first argument is a complete email address and the second is secret
9299 keystring. The third argument, specifying a key number, is optional. If absent,
9300 it defaults to 0. The result of the expansion is a prvs-signed email address,
9301 to be typically used with the &%return_path%& option on an &(smtp)& transport
9302 as part of a bounce address tag validation (BATV) scheme. For more discussion
9303 and an example, see section &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
9304
9305 .vitem "&*${prvscheck{*&<&'address'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}&&&
9306 {*&<&'string'&>&*}}*&"
9307 .cindex "&%prvscheck%& expansion item"
9308 This expansion item is the complement of the &%prvs%& item. It is used for
9309 checking prvs-signed addresses. If the expansion of the first argument does not
9310 yield a syntactically valid prvs-signed address, the whole item expands to the
9311 empty string. When the first argument does expand to a syntactically valid
9312 prvs-signed address, the second argument is expanded, with the prvs-decoded
9313 version of the address and the key number extracted from the address in the
9314 variables &$prvscheck_address$& and &$prvscheck_keynum$&, respectively.
9315
9316 These two variables can be used in the expansion of the second argument to
9317 retrieve the secret. The validity of the prvs-signed address is then checked
9318 against the secret. The result is stored in the variable &$prvscheck_result$&,
9319 which is empty for failure or &"1"& for success.
9320
9321 The third argument is optional; if it is missing, it defaults to an empty
9322 string. This argument is now expanded. If the result is an empty string, the
9323 result of the expansion is the decoded version of the address. This is the case
9324 whether or not the signature was valid. Otherwise, the result of the expansion
9325 is the expansion of the third argument.
9326
9327 All three variables can be used in the expansion of the third argument.
9328 However, once the expansion is complete, only &$prvscheck_result$& remains set.
9329 For more discussion and an example, see section &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
9330
9331 .vitem &*${readfile{*&<&'file&~name'&>&*}{*&<&'eol&~string'&>&*}}*&
9332 .cindex "expansion" "inserting an entire file"
9333 .cindex "file" "inserting into expansion"
9334 .cindex "&%readfile%& expansion item"
9335 The file name and end-of-line string are first expanded separately. The file is
9336 then read, and its contents replace the entire item. All newline characters in
9337 the file are replaced by the end-of-line string if it is present. Otherwise,
9338 newlines are left in the string.
9339 String expansion is not applied to the contents of the file. If you want this,
9340 you must wrap the item in an &%expand%& operator. If the file cannot be read,
9341 the string expansion fails.
9342
9343 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_readfile%& which
9344 locks out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
9345
9346
9347
9348 .vitem "&*${readsocket{*&<&'name'&>&*}{*&<&'request'&>&*}&&&
9349 {*&<&'timeout'&>&*}{*&<&'eol&~string'&>&*}{*&<&'fail&~string'&>&*}}*&"
9350 .cindex "expansion" "inserting from a socket"
9351 .cindex "socket, use of in expansion"
9352 .cindex "&%readsocket%& expansion item"
9353 This item inserts data from a Unix domain or Internet socket into the expanded
9354 string. The minimal way of using it uses just two arguments, as in these
9355 examples:
9356 .code
9357 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}}
9358 ${readsocket{inet:some.host:1234}{request string}}
9359 .endd
9360 For a Unix domain socket, the first substring must be the path to the socket.
9361 For an Internet socket, the first substring must contain &`inet:`& followed by
9362 a host name or IP address, followed by a colon and a port, which can be a
9363 number or the name of a TCP port in &_/etc/services_&. An IP address may
9364 optionally be enclosed in square brackets. This is best for IPv6 addresses. For
9365 example:
9366 .code
9367 ${readsocket{inet:[::1]:1234}{request string}}
9368 .endd
9369 Only a single host name may be given, but if looking it up yields more than
9370 one IP address, they are each tried in turn until a connection is made. For
9371 both kinds of socket, Exim makes a connection, writes the request string
9372 (unless it is an empty string) and reads from the socket until an end-of-file
9373 is read. A timeout of 5 seconds is applied. Additional, optional arguments
9374 extend what can be done. Firstly, you can vary the timeout. For example:
9375 .code
9376 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}{3s}}
9377 .endd
9378 A fourth argument allows you to change any newlines that are in the data
9379 that is read, in the same way as for &%readfile%& (see above). This example
9380 turns them into spaces:
9381 .code
9382 ${readsocket{inet:127.0.0.1:3294}{request string}{3s}{ }}
9383 .endd
9384 As with all expansions, the substrings are expanded before the processing
9385 happens. Errors in these sub-expansions cause the expansion to fail. In
9386 addition, the following errors can occur:
9387
9388 .ilist
9389 Failure to create a socket file descriptor;
9390 .next
9391 Failure to connect the socket;
9392 .next
9393 Failure to write the request string;
9394 .next
9395 Timeout on reading from the socket.
9396 .endlist
9397
9398 By default, any of these errors causes the expansion to fail. However, if
9399 you supply a fifth substring, it is expanded and used when any of the above
9400 errors occurs. For example:
9401 .code
9402 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}{3s}{\n}\
9403 {socket failure}}
9404 .endd
9405 You can test for the existence of a Unix domain socket by wrapping this
9406 expansion in &`${if exists`&, but there is a race condition between that test
9407 and the actual opening of the socket, so it is safer to use the fifth argument
9408 if you want to be absolutely sure of avoiding an expansion error for a
9409 non-existent Unix domain socket, or a failure to connect to an Internet socket.
9410
9411 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_readsocket%& which
9412 locks out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
9413
9414
9415 .vitem &*${reduce{*&<&'string1'&>}{<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
9416 .cindex "expansion" "reducing a list to a scalar"
9417 .cindex "list" "reducing to a scalar"
9418 .vindex "&$value$&"
9419 .vindex "&$item$&"
9420 This operation reduces a list to a single, scalar string. After expansion,
9421 <&'string1'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by default, but the
9422 separator can be changed in the usual way. Then <&'string2'&> is expanded and
9423 assigned to the &$value$& variable. After this, each item in the <&'string1'&>
9424 list is assigned to &$item$& in turn, and <&'string3'&> is expanded for each of
9425 them. The result of that expansion is assigned to &$value$& before the next
9426 iteration. When the end of the list is reached, the final value of &$value$& is
9427 added to the expansion output. The &*reduce*& expansion item can be used in a
9428 number of ways. For example, to add up a list of numbers:
9429 .code
9430 ${reduce {<, 1,2,3}{0}{${eval:$value+$item}}}
9431 .endd
9432 The result of that expansion would be &`6`&. The maximum of a list of numbers
9433 can be found:
9434 .code
9435 ${reduce {3:0:9:4:6}{0}{${if >{$item}{$value}{$item}{$value}}}}
9436 .endd
9437 At the end of a &*reduce*& expansion, the values of &$item$& and &$value$& are
9438 restored to what they were before. See also the &*filter*& and &*map*&
9439 expansion items.
9440
9441 .vitem &*$rheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&*$rh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&
9442 This item inserts &"raw"& header lines. It is described with the &%header%&
9443 expansion item above.
9444
9445 .vitem "&*${run{*&<&'command'&>&*&~*&<&'args'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}&&&
9446 {*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
9447 .cindex "expansion" "running a command"
9448 .cindex "&%run%& expansion item"
9449 The command and its arguments are first expanded separately, and then the
9450 command is run in a separate process, but under the same uid and gid. As in
9451 other command executions from Exim, a shell is not used by default. If you want
9452 a shell, you must explicitly code it.
9453
9454 The standard input for the command exists, but is empty. The standard output
9455 and standard error are set to the same file descriptor.
9456 .cindex "return code" "from &%run%& expansion"
9457 .vindex "&$value$&"
9458 If the command succeeds (gives a zero return code) <&'string1'&> is expanded
9459 and replaces the entire item; during this expansion, the standard output/error
9460 from the command is in the variable &$value$&. If the command fails,
9461 <&'string2'&>, if present, is expanded and used. Once again, during the
9462 expansion, the standard output/error from the command is in the variable
9463 &$value$&.
9464
9465 If <&'string2'&> is absent, the result is empty. Alternatively, <&'string2'&>
9466 can be the word &"fail"& (not in braces) to force expansion failure if the
9467 command does not succeed. If both strings are omitted, the result is contents
9468 of the standard output/error on success, and nothing on failure.
9469
9470 .vindex "&$run_in_acl$&"
9471 The standard output/error of the command is put in the variable &$value$&.
9472 In this ACL example, the output of a command is logged for the admin to
9473 troubleshoot:
9474 .code
9475 warn condition = ${run{/usr/bin/id}{yes}{no}}
9476 log_message = Output of id: $value
9477 .endd
9478 If the command requires shell idioms, such as the > redirect operator, the
9479 shell must be invoked directly, such as with:
9480 .code
9481 ${run{/bin/bash -c "/usr/bin/id >/tmp/id"}{yes}{yes}}
9482 .endd
9483
9484 .vindex "&$runrc$&"
9485 The return code from the command is put in the variable &$runrc$&, and this
9486 remains set afterwards, so in a filter file you can do things like this:
9487 .code
9488 if "${run{x y z}{}}$runrc" is 1 then ...
9489 elif $runrc is 2 then ...
9490 ...
9491 endif
9492 .endd
9493 If execution of the command fails (for example, the command does not exist),
9494 the return code is 127 &-- the same code that shells use for non-existent
9495 commands.
9496
9497 &*Warning*&: In a router or transport, you cannot assume the order in which
9498 option values are expanded, except for those preconditions whose order of
9499 testing is documented. Therefore, you cannot reliably expect to set &$runrc$&
9500 by the expansion of one option, and use it in another.
9501
9502 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_run%& which locks
9503 out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
9504
9505
9506 .vitem &*${sg{*&<&'subject'&>&*}{*&<&'regex'&>&*}{*&<&'replacement'&>&*}}*&
9507 .cindex "expansion" "string substitution"
9508 .cindex "&%sg%& expansion item"
9509 This item works like Perl's substitution operator (s) with the global (/g)
9510 option; hence its name. However, unlike the Perl equivalent, Exim does not
9511 modify the subject string; instead it returns the modified string for insertion
9512 into the overall expansion. The item takes three arguments: the subject string,
9513 a regular expression, and a substitution string. For example:
9514 .code
9515 ${sg{abcdefabcdef}{abc}{xyz}}
9516 .endd
9517 yields &"xyzdefxyzdef"&. Because all three arguments are expanded before use,
9518 if any $ or \ characters are required in the regular expression or in the
9519 substitution string, they have to be escaped. For example:
9520 .code
9521 ${sg{abcdef}{^(...)(...)\$}{\$2\$1}}
9522 .endd
9523 yields &"defabc"&, and
9524 .code
9525 ${sg{1=A 4=D 3=C}{\N(\d+)=\N}{K\$1=}}
9526 .endd
9527 yields &"K1=A K4=D K3=C"&. Note the use of &`\N`& to protect the contents of
9528 the regular expression from string expansion.
9529
9530
9531
9532 .vitem &*${substr{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
9533 .cindex "&%substr%& expansion item"
9534 .cindex "substring extraction"
9535 .cindex "expansion" "substring extraction"
9536 The three strings are expanded; the first two must yield numbers. Call them
9537 <&'n'&> and <&'m'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is,
9538 if <&'string1'&> and <&'string2'&> do not change when they are expanded, you
9539 can use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
9540 .code
9541 ${substr_<n>_<m>:<string>}
9542 .endd
9543 The second number is optional (in both notations).
9544 If it is absent in the simpler format, the preceding underscore must also be
9545 omitted.
9546
9547 The &%substr%& item can be used to extract more general substrings than
9548 &%length%&. The first number, <&'n'&>, is a starting offset, and <&'m'&> is the
9549 length required. For example
9550 .code
9551 ${substr{3}{2}{$local_part}}
9552 .endd
9553 If the starting offset is greater than the string length the result is the
9554 null string; if the length plus starting offset is greater than the string
9555 length, the result is the right-hand part of the string, starting from the
9556 given offset. The first character in the string has offset zero.
9557
9558 The &%substr%& expansion item can take negative offset values to count
9559 from the right-hand end of its operand. The last character is offset -1, the
9560 second-last is offset -2, and so on. Thus, for example,
9561 .code
9562 ${substr{-5}{2}{1234567}}
9563 .endd
9564 yields &"34"&. If the absolute value of a negative offset is greater than the
9565 length of the string, the substring starts at the beginning of the string, and
9566 the length is reduced by the amount of overshoot. Thus, for example,
9567 .code
9568 ${substr{-5}{2}{12}}
9569 .endd
9570 yields an empty string, but
9571 .code
9572 ${substr{-3}{2}{12}}
9573 .endd
9574 yields &"1"&.
9575
9576 When the second number is omitted from &%substr%&, the remainder of the string
9577 is taken if the offset is positive. If it is negative, all characters in the
9578 string preceding the offset point are taken. For example, an offset of -1 and
9579 no length, as in these semantically identical examples:
9580 .code
9581 ${substr_-1:abcde}
9582 ${substr{-1}{abcde}}
9583 .endd
9584 yields all but the last character of the string, that is, &"abcd"&.
9585
9586
9587
9588 .vitem "&*${tr{*&<&'subject'&>&*}{*&<&'characters'&>&*}&&&
9589 {*&<&'replacements'&>&*}}*&"
9590 .cindex "expansion" "character translation"
9591 .cindex "&%tr%& expansion item"
9592 This item does single-character translation on its subject string. The second
9593 argument is a list of characters to be translated in the subject string. Each
9594 matching character is replaced by the corresponding character from the
9595 replacement list. For example
9596 .code
9597 ${tr{abcdea}{ac}{13}}
9598 .endd
9599 yields &`1b3de1`&. If there are duplicates in the second character string, the
9600 last occurrence is used. If the third string is shorter than the second, its
9601 last character is replicated. However, if it is empty, no translation takes
9602 place.
9603 .endlist
9604
9605
9606
9607 .section "Expansion operators" "SECTexpop"
9608 .cindex "expansion" "operators"
9609 For expansion items that perform transformations on a single argument string,
9610 the &"operator"& notation is used because it is simpler and uses fewer braces.
9611 The substring is first expanded before the operation is applied to it. The
9612 following operations can be performed:
9613
9614 .vlist
9615 .vitem &*${address:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9616 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2822 address handling"
9617 .cindex "&%address%& expansion item"
9618 The string is interpreted as an RFC 2822 address, as it might appear in a
9619 header line, and the effective address is extracted from it. If the string does
9620 not parse successfully, the result is empty.
9621
9622
9623 .vitem &*${addresses:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9624 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2822 address handling"
9625 .cindex "&%addresses%& expansion item"
9626 The string (after expansion) is interpreted as a list of addresses in RFC
9627 2822 format, such as can be found in a &'To:'& or &'Cc:'& header line. The
9628 operative address (&'local-part@domain'&) is extracted from each item, and the
9629 result of the expansion is a colon-separated list, with appropriate
9630 doubling of colons should any happen to be present in the email addresses.
9631 Syntactically invalid RFC2822 address items are omitted from the output.
9632
9633 It is possible to specify a character other than colon for the output
9634 separator by starting the string with > followed by the new separator
9635 character. For example:
9636 .code
9637 ${addresses:>& Chief <ceo@up.stairs>, sec@base.ment (dogsbody)}
9638 .endd
9639 expands to &`ceo@up.stairs&&sec@base.ment`&. Compare the &*address*& (singular)
9640 expansion item, which extracts the working address from a single RFC2822
9641 address. See the &*filter*&, &*map*&, and &*reduce*& items for ways of
9642 processing lists.
9643
9644 To clarify "list of addresses in RFC 2822 format" mentioned above, Exim follows
9645 a strict interpretation of header line formatting. Exim parses the bare,
9646 unquoted portion of an email address and if it finds a comma, treats it as an
9647 email address seperator. For the example header line:
9648 .code
9649 From: =?iso-8859-2?Q?Last=2C_First?= <user@example.com>
9650 .endd
9651 The first example below demonstrates that Q-encoded email addresses are parsed
9652 properly if it is given the raw header (in this example, &`$rheader_from:`&).
9653 It does not see the comma because it's still encoded as "=2C". The second
9654 example below is passed the contents of &`$header_from:`&, meaning it gets
9655 de-mimed. Exim sees the decoded "," so it treats it as &*two*& email addresses.
9656 The third example shows that the presence of a comma is skipped when it is
9657 quoted.
9658 .code
9659 # exim -be '${addresses:From: \
9660 =?iso-8859-2?Q?Last=2C_First?= <user@example.com>}'
9661 user@example.com
9662 # exim -be '${addresses:From: Last, First <user@example.com>}'
9663 Last:user@example.com
9664 # exim -be '${addresses:From: "Last, First" <user@example.com>}'
9665 user@example.com
9666 .endd
9667
9668 .vitem &*${base62:*&<&'digits'&>&*}*&
9669 .cindex "&%base62%& expansion item"
9670 .cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 62"
9671 The string must consist entirely of decimal digits. The number is converted to
9672 base 62 and output as a string of six characters, including leading zeros. In
9673 the few operating environments where Exim uses base 36 instead of base 62 for
9674 its message identifiers (because those systems do not have case-sensitive file
9675 names), base 36 is used by this operator, despite its name. &*Note*&: Just to
9676 be absolutely clear: this is &'not'& base64 encoding.
9677
9678 .vitem &*${base62d:*&<&'base-62&~digits'&>&*}*&
9679 .cindex "&%base62d%& expansion item"
9680 .cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 62"
9681 The string must consist entirely of base-62 digits, or, in operating
9682 environments where Exim uses base 36 instead of base 62 for its message
9683 identifiers, base-36 digits. The number is converted to decimal and output as a
9684 string.
9685
9686
9687 .vitem &*${domain:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9688 .cindex "domain" "extraction"
9689 .cindex "expansion" "domain extraction"
9690 The string is interpreted as an RFC 2822 address and the domain is extracted
9691 from it. If the string does not parse successfully, the result is empty.
9692
9693
9694 .vitem &*${escape:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9695 .cindex "expansion" "escaping non-printing characters"
9696 .cindex "&%escape%& expansion item"
9697 If the string contains any non-printing characters, they are converted to
9698 escape sequences starting with a backslash. Whether characters with the most
9699 significant bit set (so-called &"8-bit characters"&) count as printing or not
9700 is controlled by the &%print_topbitchars%& option.
9701
9702
9703 .vitem &*${eval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&&~and&~&*${eval10:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9704 .cindex "expansion" "expression evaluation"
9705 .cindex "expansion" "arithmetic expression"
9706 .cindex "&%eval%& expansion item"
9707 These items supports simple arithmetic and bitwise logical operations in
9708 expansion strings. The string (after expansion) must be a conventional
9709 arithmetic expression, but it is limited to basic arithmetic operators, bitwise
9710 logical operators, and parentheses. All operations are carried out using
9711 integer arithmetic. The operator priorities are as follows (the same as in the
9712 C programming language):
9713 .table2 70pt 300pt
9714 .irow &'highest:'& "not (~), negate (-)"
9715 .irow "" "multiply (*), divide (/), remainder (%)"
9716 .irow "" "plus (+), minus (-)"
9717 .irow "" "shift-left (<<), shift-right (>>)"
9718 .irow "" "and (&&)"
9719 .irow "" "xor (^)"
9720 .irow &'lowest:'& "or (|)"
9721 .endtable
9722 Binary operators with the same priority are evaluated from left to right. White
9723 space is permitted before or after operators.
9724
9725 For &%eval%&, numbers may be decimal, octal (starting with &"0"&) or
9726 hexadecimal (starting with &"0x"&). For &%eval10%&, all numbers are taken as
9727 decimal, even if they start with a leading zero; hexadecimal numbers are not
9728 permitted. This can be useful when processing numbers extracted from dates or
9729 times, which often do have leading zeros.
9730
9731 A number may be followed by &"K"&, &"M"& or &"G"& to multiply it by 1024, 1024*1024
9732 or 1024*1024*1024,
9733 respectively. Negative numbers are supported. The result of the computation is
9734 a decimal representation of the answer (without &"K"&, &"M"& or &"G"&). For example:
9735
9736 .display
9737 &`${eval:1+1} `& yields 2
9738 &`${eval:1+2*3} `& yields 7
9739 &`${eval:(1+2)*3} `& yields 9
9740 &`${eval:2+42%5} `& yields 4
9741 &`${eval:0xc&amp;5} `& yields 4
9742 &`${eval:0xc|5} `& yields 13
9743 &`${eval:0xc^5} `& yields 9
9744 &`${eval:0xc>>1} `& yields 6
9745 &`${eval:0xc<<1} `& yields 24
9746 &`${eval:~255&amp;0x1234} `& yields 4608
9747 &`${eval:-(~255&amp;0x1234)} `& yields -4608
9748 .endd
9749
9750 As a more realistic example, in an ACL you might have
9751 .code
9752 deny message = Too many bad recipients
9753 condition = \
9754 ${if and { \
9755 {>{$rcpt_count}{10}} \
9756 { \
9757 < \
9758 {$recipients_count} \
9759 {${eval:$rcpt_count/2}} \
9760 } \
9761 }{yes}{no}}
9762 .endd
9763 The condition is true if there have been more than 10 RCPT commands and
9764 fewer than half of them have resulted in a valid recipient.
9765
9766
9767 .vitem &*${expand:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9768 .cindex "expansion" "re-expansion of substring"
9769 The &%expand%& operator causes a string to be expanded for a second time. For
9770 example,
9771 .code
9772 ${expand:${lookup{$domain}dbm{/some/file}{$value}}}
9773 .endd
9774 first looks up a string in a file while expanding the operand for &%expand%&,
9775 and then re-expands what it has found.
9776
9777
9778 .vitem &*${from_utf8:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9779 .cindex "Unicode"
9780 .cindex "UTF-8" "conversion from"
9781 .cindex "expansion" "UTF-8 conversion"
9782 .cindex "&%from_utf8%& expansion item"
9783 The world is slowly moving towards Unicode, although there are no standards for
9784 email yet. However, other applications (including some databases) are starting
9785 to store data in Unicode, using UTF-8 encoding. This operator converts from a
9786 UTF-8 string to an ISO-8859-1 string. UTF-8 code values greater than 255 are
9787 converted to underscores. The input must be a valid UTF-8 string. If it is not,
9788 the result is an undefined sequence of bytes.
9789
9790 Unicode code points with values less than 256 are compatible with ASCII and
9791 ISO-8859-1 (also known as Latin-1).
9792 For example, character 169 is the copyright symbol in both cases, though the
9793 way it is encoded is different. In UTF-8, more than one byte is needed for
9794 characters with code values greater than 127, whereas ISO-8859-1 is a
9795 single-byte encoding (but thereby limited to 256 characters). This makes
9796 translation from UTF-8 to ISO-8859-1 straightforward.
9797
9798
9799 .vitem &*${hash_*&<&'n'&>&*_*&<&'m'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9800 .cindex "hash function" "textual"
9801 .cindex "expansion" "textual hash"
9802 The &%hash%& operator is a simpler interface to the hashing function that can
9803 be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to strings that
9804 change when expanded). The effect is the same as
9805 .code
9806 ${hash{<n>}{<m>}{<string>}}
9807 .endd
9808 See the description of the general &%hash%& item above for details. The
9809 abbreviation &%h%& can be used when &%hash%& is used as an operator.
9810
9811
9812
9813 .vitem &*${hex2b64:*&<&'hexstring'&>&*}*&
9814 .cindex "base64 encoding" "conversion from hex"
9815 .cindex "expansion" "hex to base64"
9816 .cindex "&%hex2b64%& expansion item"
9817 This operator converts a hex string into one that is base64 encoded. This can
9818 be useful for processing the output of the MD5 and SHA-1 hashing functions.
9819
9820
9821
9822 .vitem &*${hexquote:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9823 .cindex "quoting" "hex-encoded unprintable characters"
9824 .cindex "&%hexquote%& expansion item"
9825 This operator converts non-printable characters in a string into a hex
9826 escape form. Byte values between 33 (!) and 126 (~) inclusive are left
9827 as is, and other byte values are converted to &`\xNN`&, for example a
9828 byte value 127 is converted to &`\x7f`&.
9829
9830
9831 .vitem &*${lc:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9832 .cindex "case forcing in strings"
9833 .cindex "string" "case forcing"
9834 .cindex "lower casing"
9835 .cindex "expansion" "case forcing"
9836 .cindex "&%lc%& expansion item"
9837 This forces the letters in the string into lower-case, for example:
9838 .code
9839 ${lc:$local_part}
9840 .endd
9841
9842 .vitem &*${length_*&<&'number'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9843 .cindex "expansion" "string truncation"
9844 .cindex "&%length%& expansion item"
9845 The &%length%& operator is a simpler interface to the &%length%& function that
9846 can be used when the parameter is a fixed number (as opposed to a string that
9847 changes when expanded). The effect is the same as
9848 .code
9849 ${length{<number>}{<string>}}
9850 .endd
9851 See the description of the general &%length%& item above for details. Note that
9852 &%length%& is not the same as &%strlen%&. The abbreviation &%l%& can be used
9853 when &%length%& is used as an operator.
9854
9855
9856 .vitem &*${listcount:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9857 .cindex "expansion" "list item count"
9858 .cindex "list" "item count"
9859 .cindex "list" "count of items"
9860 .cindex "&%listcount%& expansion item"
9861 The string is interpreted as a list and the number of items is returned.
9862
9863
9864 .vitem &*${listnamed:*&<&'name'&>&*}*&&~and&~&*${listnamed_*&<&'type'&>&*:*&<&'name'&>&*}*&
9865 .cindex "expansion" "named list"
9866 .cindex "&%listnamed%& expansion item"
9867 The name is interpreted as a named list and the content of the list is returned,
9868 expanding any referenced lists, re-quoting as needed for colon-separation.
9869 If the optional type is given it must be one of "a", "d", "h" or "l"
9870 and selects address-, domain-, host- or localpart- lists to search among respectively.
9871 Otherwise all types are searched in an undefined order and the first
9872 matching list is returned.
9873
9874
9875 .vitem &*${local_part:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9876 .cindex "expansion" "local part extraction"
9877 .cindex "&%local_part%& expansion item"
9878 The string is interpreted as an RFC 2822 address and the local part is
9879 extracted from it. If the string does not parse successfully, the result is
9880 empty.
9881
9882
9883 .vitem &*${mask:*&<&'IP&~address'&>&*/*&<&'bit&~count'&>&*}*&
9884 .cindex "masked IP address"
9885 .cindex "IP address" "masking"
9886 .cindex "CIDR notation"
9887 .cindex "expansion" "IP address masking"
9888 .cindex "&%mask%& expansion item"
9889 If the form of the string to be operated on is not an IP address followed by a
9890 slash and an integer (that is, a network address in CIDR notation), the
9891 expansion fails. Otherwise, this operator converts the IP address to binary,
9892 masks off the least significant bits according to the bit count, and converts
9893 the result back to text, with mask appended. For example,
9894 .code
9895 ${mask:10.111.131.206/28}
9896 .endd
9897 returns the string &"10.111.131.192/28"&. Since this operation is expected to
9898 be mostly used for looking up masked addresses in files, the result for an IPv6
9899 address uses dots to separate components instead of colons, because colon
9900 terminates a key string in lsearch files. So, for example,
9901 .code
9902 ${mask:3ffe:ffff:836f:0a00:000a:0800:200a:c031/99}
9903 .endd
9904 returns the string
9905 .code
9906 3ffe.ffff.836f.0a00.000a.0800.2000.0000/99
9907 .endd
9908 Letters in IPv6 addresses are always output in lower case.
9909
9910
9911 .vitem &*${md5:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9912 .cindex "MD5 hash"
9913 .cindex "expansion" "MD5 hash"
9914 .cindex "&%md5%& expansion item"
9915 The &%md5%& operator computes the MD5 hash value of the string, and returns it
9916 as a 32-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in lower case.
9917
9918
9919 .vitem &*${nhash_*&<&'n'&>&*_*&<&'m'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9920 .cindex "expansion" "numeric hash"
9921 .cindex "hash function" "numeric"
9922 The &%nhash%& operator is a simpler interface to the numeric hashing function
9923 that can be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to
9924 strings that change when expanded). The effect is the same as
9925 .code
9926 ${nhash{<n>}{<m>}{<string>}}
9927 .endd
9928 See the description of the general &%nhash%& item above for details.
9929
9930
9931 .vitem &*${quote:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9932 .cindex "quoting" "in string expansions"
9933 .cindex "expansion" "quoting"
9934 .cindex "&%quote%& expansion item"
9935 The &%quote%& operator puts its argument into double quotes if it
9936 is an empty string or
9937 contains anything other than letters, digits, underscores, dots, and hyphens.
9938 Any occurrences of double quotes and backslashes are escaped with a backslash.
9939 Newlines and carriage returns are converted to &`\n`& and &`\r`&,
9940 respectively For example,
9941 .code
9942 ${quote:ab"*"cd}
9943 .endd
9944 becomes
9945 .code
9946 "ab\"*\"cd"
9947 .endd
9948 The place where this is useful is when the argument is a substitution from a
9949 variable or a message header.
9950
9951 .vitem &*${quote_local_part:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9952 .cindex "&%quote_local_part%& expansion item"
9953 This operator is like &%quote%&, except that it quotes the string only if
9954 required to do so by the rules of RFC 2822 for quoting local parts. For
9955 example, a plus sign would not cause quoting (but it would for &%quote%&).
9956 If you are creating a new email address from the contents of &$local_part$&
9957 (or any other unknown data), you should always use this operator.
9958
9959
9960 .vitem &*${quote_*&<&'lookup-type'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9961 .cindex "quoting" "lookup-specific"
9962 This operator applies lookup-specific quoting rules to the string. Each
9963 query-style lookup type has its own quoting rules which are described with
9964 the lookups in chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. For example,
9965 .code
9966 ${quote_ldap:two * two}
9967 .endd
9968 returns
9969 .code
9970 two%20%5C2A%20two
9971 .endd
9972 For single-key lookup types, no quoting is ever necessary and this operator
9973 yields an unchanged string.
9974
9975
9976 .vitem &*${randint:*&<&'n'&>&*}*&
9977 .cindex "random number"
9978 This operator returns a somewhat random number which is less than the
9979 supplied number and is at least 0. The quality of this randomness depends
9980 on how Exim was built; the values are not suitable for keying material.
9981 If Exim is linked against OpenSSL then RAND_pseudo_bytes() is used.
9982 If Exim is linked against GnuTLS then gnutls_rnd(GNUTLS_RND_NONCE) is used,
9983 for versions of GnuTLS with that function.
9984 Otherwise, the implementation may be arc4random(), random() seeded by
9985 srandomdev() or srandom(), or a custom implementation even weaker than
9986 random().
9987
9988
9989 .vitem &*${reverse_ip:*&<&'ipaddr'&>&*}*&
9990 .cindex "expansion" "IP address"
9991 This operator reverses an IP address; for IPv4 addresses, the result is in
9992 dotted-quad decimal form, while for IPv6 addreses the result is in
9993 dotted-nibble hexadecimal form. In both cases, this is the "natural" form
9994 for DNS. For example,
9995 .code
9996 ${reverse_ip:192.0.2.4}
9997 ${reverse_ip:2001:0db8:c42:9:1:abcd:192.0.2.127}
9998 .endd
9999 returns
10000 .code
10001 4.2.0.192
10002 f.7.2.0.0.0.0.c.d.c.b.a.1.0.0.0.9.0.0.0.2.4.c.0.8.b.d.0.1.0.0.2
10003 .endd
10004
10005
10006 .vitem &*${rfc2047:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10007 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2047"
10008 .cindex "RFC 2047" "expansion operator"
10009 .cindex "&%rfc2047%& expansion item"
10010 This operator encodes text according to the rules of RFC 2047. This is an
10011 encoding that is used in header lines to encode non-ASCII characters. It is
10012 assumed that the input string is in the encoding specified by the
10013 &%headers_charset%& option, which defaults to ISO-8859-1. If the string
10014 contains only characters in the range 33&--126, and no instances of the
10015 characters
10016 .code
10017 ? = ( ) < > @ , ; : \ " . [ ] _
10018 .endd
10019 it is not modified. Otherwise, the result is the RFC 2047 encoding of the
10020 string, using as many &"encoded words"& as necessary to encode all the
10021 characters.
10022
10023
10024 .vitem &*${rfc2047d:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10025 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2047"
10026 .cindex "RFC 2047" "decoding"
10027 .cindex "&%rfc2047d%& expansion item"
10028 This operator decodes strings that are encoded as per RFC 2047. Binary zero
10029 bytes are replaced by question marks. Characters are converted into the
10030 character set defined by &%headers_charset%&. Overlong RFC 2047 &"words"& are
10031 not recognized unless &%check_rfc2047_length%& is set false.
10032
10033 &*Note*&: If you use &%$header%&_&'xxx'&&*:*& (or &%$h%&_&'xxx'&&*:*&) to
10034 access a header line, RFC 2047 decoding is done automatically. You do not need
10035 to use this operator as well.
10036
10037
10038
10039 .vitem &*${rxquote:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10040 .cindex "quoting" "in regular expressions"
10041 .cindex "regular expressions" "quoting"
10042 .cindex "&%rxquote%& expansion item"
10043 The &%rxquote%& operator inserts a backslash before any non-alphanumeric
10044 characters in its argument. This is useful when substituting the values of
10045 variables or headers inside regular expressions.
10046
10047
10048 .vitem &*${sha1:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10049 .cindex "SHA-1 hash"
10050 .cindex "expansion" "SHA-1 hashing"
10051 .cindex "&%sha2%& expansion item"
10052 The &%sha1%& operator computes the SHA-1 hash value of the string, and returns
10053 it as a 40-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in upper case.
10054
10055
10056 .vitem &*${stat:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10057 .cindex "expansion" "statting a file"
10058 .cindex "file" "extracting characteristics"
10059 .cindex "&%stat%& expansion item"
10060 The string, after expansion, must be a file path. A call to the &[stat()]&
10061 function is made for this path. If &[stat()]& fails, an error occurs and the
10062 expansion fails. If it succeeds, the data from the stat replaces the item, as a
10063 series of <&'name'&>=<&'value'&> pairs, where the values are all numerical,
10064 except for the value of &"smode"&. The names are: &"mode"& (giving the mode as
10065 a 4-digit octal number), &"smode"& (giving the mode in symbolic format as a
10066 10-character string, as for the &'ls'& command), &"inode"&, &"device"&,
10067 &"links"&, &"uid"&, &"gid"&, &"size"&, &"atime"&, &"mtime"&, and &"ctime"&. You
10068 can extract individual fields using the &%extract%& expansion item.
10069
10070 The use of the &%stat%& expansion in users' filter files can be locked out by
10071 the system administrator. &*Warning*&: The file size may be incorrect on 32-bit
10072 systems for files larger than 2GB.
10073
10074 .vitem &*${str2b64:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10075 .cindex "expansion" "base64 encoding"
10076 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in string expansion"
10077 .cindex "&%str2b64%& expansion item"
10078 This operator converts a string into one that is base64 encoded.
10079
10080
10081
10082 .vitem &*${strlen:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10083 .cindex "expansion" "string length"
10084 .cindex "string" "length in expansion"
10085 .cindex "&%strlen%& expansion item"
10086 The item is replace by the length of the expanded string, expressed as a
10087 decimal number. &*Note*&: Do not confuse &%strlen%& with &%length%&.
10088
10089
10090 .vitem &*${substr_*&<&'start'&>&*_*&<&'length'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10091 .cindex "&%substr%& expansion item"
10092 .cindex "substring extraction"
10093 .cindex "expansion" "substring expansion"
10094 The &%substr%& operator is a simpler interface to the &%substr%& function that
10095 can be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to strings
10096 that change when expanded). The effect is the same as
10097 .code
10098 ${substr{<start>}{<length>}{<string>}}
10099 .endd
10100 See the description of the general &%substr%& item above for details. The
10101 abbreviation &%s%& can be used when &%substr%& is used as an operator.
10102
10103 .vitem &*${time_eval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10104 .cindex "&%time_eval%& expansion item"
10105 .cindex "time interval" "decoding"
10106 This item converts an Exim time interval such as &`2d4h5m`& into a number of
10107 seconds.
10108
10109 .vitem &*${time_interval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10110 .cindex "&%time_interval%& expansion item"
10111 .cindex "time interval" "formatting"
10112 The argument (after sub-expansion) must be a sequence of decimal digits that
10113 represents an interval of time as a number of seconds. It is converted into a
10114 number of larger units and output in Exim's normal time format, for example,
10115 &`1w3d4h2m6s`&.
10116
10117 .vitem &*${uc:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10118 .cindex "case forcing in strings"
10119 .cindex "string" "case forcing"
10120 .cindex "upper casing"
10121 .cindex "expansion" "case forcing"
10122 .cindex "&%uc%& expansion item"
10123 This forces the letters in the string into upper-case.
10124 .endlist
10125
10126
10127
10128
10129
10130
10131 .section "Expansion conditions" "SECTexpcond"
10132 .scindex IIDexpcond "expansion" "conditions"
10133 The following conditions are available for testing by the &%${if%& construct
10134 while expanding strings:
10135
10136 .vlist
10137 .vitem &*!*&<&'condition'&>
10138 .cindex "expansion" "negating a condition"
10139 .cindex "negation" "in expansion condition"
10140 Preceding any condition with an exclamation mark negates the result of the
10141 condition.
10142
10143 .vitem <&'symbolic&~operator'&>&~&*{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10144 .cindex "numeric comparison"
10145 .cindex "expansion" "numeric comparison"
10146 There are a number of symbolic operators for doing numeric comparisons. They
10147 are:
10148 .display
10149 &`= `& equal
10150 &`== `& equal
10151 &`> `& greater
10152 &`>= `& greater or equal
10153 &`< `& less
10154 &`<= `& less or equal
10155 .endd
10156 For example:
10157 .code
10158 ${if >{$message_size}{10M} ...
10159 .endd
10160 Note that the general negation operator provides for inequality testing. The
10161 two strings must take the form of optionally signed decimal integers,
10162 optionally followed by one of the letters &"K"&, &"M"& or &"G"& (in either upper or
10163 lower case), signifying multiplication by 1024, 1024*1024 or 1024*1024*1024, respectively.
10164 As a special case, the numerical value of an empty string is taken as
10165 zero.
10166
10167 In all cases, a relative comparator OP is testing if <&'string1'&> OP
10168 <&'string2'&>; the above example is checking if &$message_size$& is larger than
10169 10M, not if 10M is larger than &$message_size$&.
10170
10171
10172 .vitem &*acl&~{{*&<&'name'&>&*}{*&<&'arg1'&>&*}&&&
10173 {*&<&'arg2'&>&*}...}*&
10174 .cindex "expansion" "calling an acl"
10175 .cindex "&%acl%&" "expansion condition"
10176 The name and zero to nine argument strings are first expanded separately. The expanded
10177 arguments are assigned to the variables &$acl_arg1$& to &$acl_arg9$& in order.
10178 Any unused are made empty. The variable &$acl_narg$& is set to the number of
10179 arguments. The named ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&) is called
10180 and may use the variables; if another acl expansion is used the values
10181 are restored after it returns. If the ACL sets
10182 a value using a "message =" modifier the variable $value becomes
10183 the result of the expansion, otherwise it is empty.
10184 If the ACL returns accept the condition is true; if deny, false.
10185 If the ACL returns defer the result is a forced-fail.
10186
10187 .vitem &*bool&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10188 .cindex "expansion" "boolean parsing"
10189 .cindex "&%bool%& expansion condition"
10190 This condition turns a string holding a true or false representation into
10191 a boolean state. It parses &"true"&, &"false"&, &"yes"& and &"no"&
10192 (case-insensitively); also positive integer numbers map to true if non-zero,
10193 false if zero.
10194 An empty string is treated as false.
10195 Leading and trailing whitespace is ignored;
10196 thus a string consisting only of whitespace is false.
10197 All other string values will result in expansion failure.
10198
10199 When combined with ACL variables, this expansion condition will let you
10200 make decisions in one place and act on those decisions in another place.
10201 For example:
10202 .code
10203 ${if bool{$acl_m_privileged_sender} ...
10204 .endd
10205
10206
10207 .vitem &*bool_lax&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10208 .cindex "expansion" "boolean parsing"
10209 .cindex "&%bool_lax%& expansion condition"
10210 Like &%bool%&, this condition turns a string into a boolean state. But
10211 where &%bool%& accepts a strict set of strings, &%bool_lax%& uses the same
10212 loose definition that the Router &%condition%& option uses. The empty string
10213 and the values &"false"&, &"no"& and &"0"& map to false, all others map to
10214 true. Leading and trailing whitespace is ignored.
10215
10216 Note that where &"bool{00}"& is false, &"bool_lax{00}"& is true.
10217
10218 .vitem &*crypteq&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10219 .cindex "expansion" "encrypted comparison"
10220 .cindex "encrypted strings, comparing"
10221 .cindex "&%crypteq%& expansion condition"
10222 This condition is included in the Exim binary if it is built to support any
10223 authentication mechanisms (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&). Otherwise, it is
10224 necessary to define SUPPORT_CRYPTEQ in &_Local/Makefile_& to get &%crypteq%&
10225 included in the binary.
10226
10227 The &%crypteq%& condition has two arguments. The first is encrypted and
10228 compared against the second, which is already encrypted. The second string may
10229 be in the LDAP form for storing encrypted strings, which starts with the
10230 encryption type in curly brackets, followed by the data. If the second string
10231 does not begin with &"{"& it is assumed to be encrypted with &[crypt()]& or
10232 &[crypt16()]& (see below), since such strings cannot begin with &"{"&.
10233 Typically this will be a field from a password file. An example of an encrypted
10234 string in LDAP form is:
10235 .code
10236 {md5}CY9rzUYh03PK3k6DJie09g==
10237 .endd
10238 If such a string appears directly in an expansion, the curly brackets have to
10239 be quoted, because they are part of the expansion syntax. For example:
10240 .code
10241 ${if crypteq {test}{\{md5\}CY9rzUYh03PK3k6DJie09g==}{yes}{no}}
10242 .endd
10243 The following encryption types (whose names are matched case-independently) are
10244 supported:
10245
10246 .ilist
10247 .cindex "MD5 hash"
10248 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in encrypted password"
10249 &%{md5}%& computes the MD5 digest of the first string, and expresses this as
10250 printable characters to compare with the remainder of the second string. If the
10251 length of the comparison string is 24, Exim assumes that it is base64 encoded
10252 (as in the above example). If the length is 32, Exim assumes that it is a
10253 hexadecimal encoding of the MD5 digest. If the length not 24 or 32, the
10254 comparison fails.
10255
10256 .next
10257 .cindex "SHA-1 hash"
10258 &%{sha1}%& computes the SHA-1 digest of the first string, and expresses this as
10259 printable characters to compare with the remainder of the second string. If the
10260 length of the comparison string is 28, Exim assumes that it is base64 encoded.
10261 If the length is 40, Exim assumes that it is a hexadecimal encoding of the
10262 SHA-1 digest. If the length is not 28 or 40, the comparison fails.
10263
10264 .next
10265 .cindex "&[crypt()]&"
10266 &%{crypt}%& calls the &[crypt()]& function, which traditionally used to use
10267 only the first eight characters of the password. However, in modern operating
10268 systems this is no longer true, and in many cases the entire password is used,
10269 whatever its length.
10270
10271 .next
10272 .cindex "&[crypt16()]&"
10273 &%{crypt16}%& calls the &[crypt16()]& function, which was originally created to
10274 use up to 16 characters of the password in some operating systems. Again, in
10275 modern operating systems, more characters may be used.
10276 .endlist
10277 Exim has its own version of &[crypt16()]&, which is just a double call to
10278 &[crypt()]&. For operating systems that have their own version, setting
10279 HAVE_CRYPT16 in &_Local/Makefile_& when building Exim causes it to use the
10280 operating system version instead of its own. This option is set by default in
10281 the OS-dependent &_Makefile_& for those operating systems that are known to
10282 support &[crypt16()]&.
10283
10284 Some years after Exim's &[crypt16()]& was implemented, a user discovered that
10285 it was not using the same algorithm as some operating systems' versions. It
10286 turns out that as well as &[crypt16()]& there is a function called
10287 &[bigcrypt()]& in some operating systems. This may or may not use the same
10288 algorithm, and both of them may be different to Exim's built-in &[crypt16()]&.
10289
10290 However, since there is now a move away from the traditional &[crypt()]&
10291 functions towards using SHA1 and other algorithms, tidying up this area of
10292 Exim is seen as very low priority.
10293
10294 If you do not put a encryption type (in curly brackets) in a &%crypteq%&
10295 comparison, the default is usually either &`{crypt}`& or &`{crypt16}`&, as
10296 determined by the setting of DEFAULT_CRYPT in &_Local/Makefile_&. The default
10297 default is &`{crypt}`&. Whatever the default, you can always use either
10298 function by specifying it explicitly in curly brackets.
10299
10300 .vitem &*def:*&<&'variable&~name'&>
10301 .cindex "expansion" "checking for empty variable"
10302 .cindex "&%def%& expansion condition"
10303 The &%def%& condition must be followed by the name of one of the expansion
10304 variables defined in section &<<SECTexpvar>>&. The condition is true if the
10305 variable does not contain the empty string. For example:
10306 .code
10307 ${if def:sender_ident {from $sender_ident}}
10308 .endd
10309 Note that the variable name is given without a leading &%$%& character. If the
10310 variable does not exist, the expansion fails.
10311
10312 .vitem "&*def:header_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~&~or&~&&&
10313 &~&*def:h_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&"
10314 .cindex "expansion" "checking header line existence"
10315 This condition is true if a message is being processed and the named header
10316 exists in the message. For example,
10317 .code
10318 ${if def:header_reply-to:{$h_reply-to:}{$h_from:}}
10319 .endd
10320 &*Note*&: No &%$%& appears before &%header_%& or &%h_%& in the condition, and
10321 the header name must be terminated by a colon if white space does not follow.
10322
10323 .vitem &*eq&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
10324 &*eqi&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10325 .cindex "string" "comparison"
10326 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
10327 .cindex "&%eq%& expansion condition"
10328 .cindex "&%eqi%& expansion condition"
10329 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the two
10330 resulting strings are identical. For &%eq%& the comparison includes the case of
10331 letters, whereas for &%eqi%& the comparison is case-independent.
10332
10333 .vitem &*exists&~{*&<&'file&~name'&>&*}*&
10334 .cindex "expansion" "file existence test"
10335 .cindex "file" "existence test"
10336 .cindex "&%exists%&, expansion condition"
10337 The substring is first expanded and then interpreted as an absolute path. The
10338 condition is true if the named file (or directory) exists. The existence test
10339 is done by calling the &[stat()]& function. The use of the &%exists%& test in
10340 users' filter files may be locked out by the system administrator.
10341
10342 .vitem &*first_delivery*&
10343 .cindex "delivery" "first"
10344 .cindex "first delivery"
10345 .cindex "expansion" "first delivery test"
10346 .cindex "&%first_delivery%& expansion condition"
10347 This condition, which has no data, is true during a message's first delivery
10348 attempt. It is false during any subsequent delivery attempts.
10349
10350
10351 .vitem "&*forall{*&<&'a list'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&" &&&
10352 "&*forany{*&<&'a list'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&"
10353 .cindex "list" "iterative conditions"
10354 .cindex "expansion" "&*forall*& condition"
10355 .cindex "expansion" "&*forany*& condition"
10356 .vindex "&$item$&"
10357 These conditions iterate over a list. The first argument is expanded to form
10358 the list. By default, the list separator is a colon, but it can be changed by
10359 the normal method. The second argument is interpreted as a condition that is to
10360 be applied to each item in the list in turn. During the interpretation of the
10361 condition, the current list item is placed in a variable called &$item$&.
10362 .ilist
10363 For &*forany*&, interpretation stops if the condition is true for any item, and
10364 the result of the whole condition is true. If the condition is false for all
10365 items in the list, the overall condition is false.
10366 .next
10367 For &*forall*&, interpretation stops if the condition is false for any item,
10368 and the result of the whole condition is false. If the condition is true for
10369 all items in the list, the overall condition is true.
10370 .endlist
10371 Note that negation of &*forany*& means that the condition must be false for all
10372 items for the overall condition to succeed, and negation of &*forall*& means
10373 that the condition must be false for at least one item. In this example, the
10374 list separator is changed to a comma:
10375 .code
10376 ${if forany{<, $recipients}{match{$item}{^user3@}}{yes}{no}}
10377 .endd
10378 The value of &$item$& is saved and restored while &*forany*& or &*forall*& is
10379 being processed, to enable these expansion items to be nested.
10380
10381 To scan a named list, expand it with the &*listnamed*& operator.
10382
10383
10384 .vitem &*ge&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
10385 &*gei&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10386 .cindex "string" "comparison"
10387 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
10388 .cindex "&%ge%& expansion condition"
10389 .cindex "&%gei%& expansion condition"
10390 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
10391 string is lexically greater than or equal to the second string. For &%ge%& the
10392 comparison includes the case of letters, whereas for &%gei%& the comparison is
10393 case-independent.
10394
10395 .vitem &*gt&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
10396 &*gti&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10397 .cindex "string" "comparison"
10398 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
10399 .cindex "&%gt%& expansion condition"
10400 .cindex "&%gti%& expansion condition"
10401 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
10402 string is lexically greater than the second string. For &%gt%& the comparison
10403 includes the case of letters, whereas for &%gti%& the comparison is
10404 case-independent.
10405
10406 .vitem &*inlist&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
10407 &*inlisti&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10408 .cindex "string" "comparison"
10409 .cindex "list" "iterative conditions"
10410 Both strings are expanded; the second string is treated as a list of simple
10411 strings; if the first string is a member of the second, then the condition
10412 is true.
10413
10414 These are simpler to use versions of the more powerful &*forany*& condition.
10415 Examples, and the &*forany*& equivalents:
10416 .code
10417 ${if inlist{needle}{foo:needle:bar}}
10418 ${if forany{foo:needle:bar}{eq{$item}{needle}}}
10419 ${if inlisti{Needle}{fOo:NeeDLE:bAr}}
10420 ${if forany{fOo:NeeDLE:bAr}{eqi{$item}{Needle}}}
10421 .endd
10422
10423 .vitem &*isip&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
10424 &*isip4&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
10425 &*isip6&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10426 .cindex "IP address" "testing string format"
10427 .cindex "string" "testing for IP address"
10428 .cindex "&%isip%& expansion condition"
10429 .cindex "&%isip4%& expansion condition"
10430 .cindex "&%isip6%& expansion condition"
10431 The substring is first expanded, and then tested to see if it has the form of
10432 an IP address. Both IPv4 and IPv6 addresses are valid for &%isip%&, whereas
10433 &%isip4%& and &%isip6%& test specifically for IPv4 or IPv6 addresses.
10434
10435 For an IPv4 address, the test is for four dot-separated components, each of
10436 which consists of from one to three digits. For an IPv6 address, up to eight
10437 colon-separated components are permitted, each containing from one to four
10438 hexadecimal digits. There may be fewer than eight components if an empty
10439 component (adjacent colons) is present. Only one empty component is permitted.
10440
10441 &*Note*&: The checks are just on the form of the address; actual numerical
10442 values are not considered. Thus, for example, 999.999.999.999 passes the IPv4
10443 check. The main use of these tests is to distinguish between IP addresses and
10444 host names, or between IPv4 and IPv6 addresses. For example, you could use
10445 .code
10446 ${if isip4{$sender_host_address}...
10447 .endd
10448 to test which IP version an incoming SMTP connection is using.
10449
10450 .vitem &*ldapauth&~{*&<&'ldap&~query'&>&*}*&
10451 .cindex "LDAP" "use for authentication"
10452 .cindex "expansion" "LDAP authentication test"
10453 .cindex "&%ldapauth%& expansion condition"
10454 This condition supports user authentication using LDAP. See section
10455 &<<SECTldap>>& for details of how to use LDAP in lookups and the syntax of
10456 queries. For this use, the query must contain a user name and password. The
10457 query itself is not used, and can be empty. The condition is true if the
10458 password is not empty, and the user name and password are accepted by the LDAP
10459 server. An empty password is rejected without calling LDAP because LDAP binds
10460 with an empty password are considered anonymous regardless of the username, and
10461 will succeed in most configurations. See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details
10462 of SMTP authentication, and chapter &<<CHAPplaintext>>& for an example of how
10463 this can be used.
10464
10465
10466 .vitem &*le&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
10467 &*lei&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10468 .cindex "string" "comparison"
10469 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
10470 .cindex "&%le%& expansion condition"
10471 .cindex "&%lei%& expansion condition"
10472 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
10473 string is lexically less than or equal to the second string. For &%le%& the
10474 comparison includes the case of letters, whereas for &%lei%& the comparison is
10475 case-independent.
10476
10477 .vitem &*lt&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
10478 &*lti&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10479 .cindex "string" "comparison"
10480 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
10481 .cindex "&%lt%& expansion condition"
10482 .cindex "&%lti%& expansion condition"
10483 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
10484 string is lexically less than the second string. For &%lt%& the comparison
10485 includes the case of letters, whereas for &%lti%& the comparison is
10486 case-independent.
10487
10488
10489 .vitem &*match&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10490 .cindex "expansion" "regular expression comparison"
10491 .cindex "regular expressions" "match in expanded string"
10492 .cindex "&%match%& expansion condition"
10493 The two substrings are first expanded. The second is then treated as a regular
10494 expression and applied to the first. Because of the pre-expansion, if the
10495 regular expression contains dollar, or backslash characters, they must be
10496 escaped. Care must also be taken if the regular expression contains braces
10497 (curly brackets). A closing brace must be escaped so that it is not taken as a
10498 premature termination of <&'string2'&>. The easiest approach is to use the
10499 &`\N`& feature to disable expansion of the regular expression.
10500 For example,
10501 .code
10502 ${if match {$local_part}{\N^\d{3}\N} ...
10503 .endd
10504 If the whole expansion string is in double quotes, further escaping of
10505 backslashes is also required.
10506
10507 The condition is true if the regular expression match succeeds.
10508 The regular expression is not required to begin with a circumflex
10509 metacharacter, but if there is no circumflex, the expression is not anchored,
10510 and it may match anywhere in the subject, not just at the start. If you want
10511 the pattern to match at the end of the subject, you must include the &`$`&
10512 metacharacter at an appropriate point.
10513
10514 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%if%& expansion"
10515 At the start of an &%if%& expansion the values of the numeric variable
10516 substitutions &$1$& etc. are remembered. Obeying a &%match%& condition that
10517 succeeds causes them to be reset to the substrings of that condition and they
10518 will have these values during the expansion of the success string. At the end
10519 of the &%if%& expansion, the previous values are restored. After testing a
10520 combination of conditions using &%or%&, the subsequent values of the numeric
10521 variables are those of the condition that succeeded.
10522
10523 .vitem &*match_address&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10524 .cindex "&%match_address%& expansion condition"
10525 See &*match_local_part*&.
10526
10527 .vitem &*match_domain&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10528 .cindex "&%match_domain%& expansion condition"
10529 See &*match_local_part*&.
10530
10531 .vitem &*match_ip&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10532 .cindex "&%match_ip%& expansion condition"
10533 This condition matches an IP address to a list of IP address patterns. It must
10534 be followed by two argument strings. The first (after expansion) must be an IP
10535 address or an empty string. The second (not expanded) is a restricted host
10536 list that can match only an IP address, not a host name. For example:
10537 .code
10538 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{1.2.3.4:5.6.7.8}{...}{...}}
10539 .endd
10540 The specific types of host list item that are permitted in the list are:
10541
10542 .ilist
10543 An IP address, optionally with a CIDR mask.
10544 .next
10545 A single asterisk, which matches any IP address.
10546 .next
10547 An empty item, which matches only if the IP address is empty. This could be
10548 useful for testing for a locally submitted message or one from specific hosts
10549 in a single test such as
10550 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
10551 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left. This comment applies to
10552 . ==== the use of xmlto plus fop. There's no problem when formatting with
10553 . ==== sdop, with or without the extra indent.
10554 .code
10555 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{:4.3.2.1:...}{...}{...}}
10556 .endd
10557 where the first item in the list is the empty string.
10558 .next
10559 The item @[] matches any of the local host's interface addresses.
10560 .next
10561 Single-key lookups are assumed to be like &"net-"& style lookups in host lists,
10562 even if &`net-`& is not specified. There is never any attempt to turn the IP
10563 address into a host name. The most common type of linear search for
10564 &*match_ip*& is likely to be &*iplsearch*&, in which the file can contain CIDR
10565 masks. For example:
10566 .code
10567 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{iplsearch;/some/file}...
10568 .endd
10569 It is of course possible to use other kinds of lookup, and in such a case, you
10570 do need to specify the &`net-`& prefix if you want to specify a specific
10571 address mask, for example:
10572 .code
10573 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{net24-dbm;/some/file}...
10574 .endd
10575 However, unless you are combining a &%match_ip%& condition with others, it is
10576 just as easy to use the fact that a lookup is itself a condition, and write:
10577 .code
10578 ${lookup{${mask:$sender_host_address/24}}dbm{/a/file}...
10579 .endd
10580 .endlist ilist
10581
10582 Note that <&'string2'&> is not itself subject to string expansion, unless
10583 Exim was built with the EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS option.
10584
10585 Consult section &<<SECThoslispatip>>& for further details of these patterns.
10586
10587 .vitem &*match_local_part&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10588 .cindex "domain list" "in expansion condition"
10589 .cindex "address list" "in expansion condition"
10590 .cindex "local part" "list, in expansion condition"
10591 .cindex "&%match_local_part%& expansion condition"
10592 This condition, together with &%match_address%& and &%match_domain%&, make it
10593 possible to test domain, address, and local part lists within expansions. Each
10594 condition requires two arguments: an item and a list to match. A trivial
10595 example is:
10596 .code
10597 ${if match_domain{a.b.c}{x.y.z:a.b.c:p.q.r}{yes}{no}}
10598 .endd
10599 In each case, the second argument may contain any of the allowable items for a
10600 list of the appropriate type. Also, because the second argument (after
10601 expansion) is a standard form of list, it is possible to refer to a named list.
10602 Thus, you can use conditions like this:
10603 .code
10604 ${if match_domain{$domain}{+local_domains}{...
10605 .endd
10606 .cindex "&`+caseful`&"
10607 For address lists, the matching starts off caselessly, but the &`+caseful`&
10608 item can be used, as in all address lists, to cause subsequent items to
10609 have their local parts matched casefully. Domains are always matched
10610 caselessly.
10611
10612 Note that <&'string2'&> is not itself subject to string expansion, unless
10613 Exim was built with the EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS option.
10614
10615 &*Note*&: Host lists are &'not'& supported in this way. This is because
10616 hosts have two identities: a name and an IP address, and it is not clear
10617 how to specify cleanly how such a test would work. However, IP addresses can be
10618 matched using &%match_ip%&.
10619
10620 .vitem &*pam&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*:*&<&'string2'&>&*:...}*&
10621 .cindex "PAM authentication"
10622 .cindex "AUTH" "with PAM"
10623 .cindex "Solaris" "PAM support"
10624 .cindex "expansion" "PAM authentication test"
10625 .cindex "&%pam%& expansion condition"
10626 &'Pluggable Authentication Modules'&
10627 (&url(http://www.kernel.org/pub/linux/libs/pam/)) are a facility that is
10628 available in the latest releases of Solaris and in some GNU/Linux
10629 distributions. The Exim support, which is intended for use in conjunction with
10630 the SMTP AUTH command, is available only if Exim is compiled with
10631 .code
10632 SUPPORT_PAM=yes
10633 .endd
10634 in &_Local/Makefile_&. You probably need to add &%-lpam%& to EXTRALIBS, and
10635 in some releases of GNU/Linux &%-ldl%& is also needed.
10636
10637 The argument string is first expanded, and the result must be a
10638 colon-separated list of strings. Leading and trailing white space is ignored.
10639 The PAM module is initialized with the service name &"exim"& and the user name
10640 taken from the first item in the colon-separated data string (<&'string1'&>).
10641 The remaining items in the data string are passed over in response to requests
10642 from the authentication function. In the simple case there will only be one
10643 request, for a password, so the data consists of just two strings.
10644
10645 There can be problems if any of the strings are permitted to contain colon
10646 characters. In the usual way, these have to be doubled to avoid being taken as
10647 separators. If the data is being inserted from a variable, the &%sg%& expansion
10648 item can be used to double any existing colons. For example, the configuration
10649 of a LOGIN authenticator might contain this setting:
10650 .code
10651 server_condition = ${if pam{$auth1:${sg{$auth2}{:}{::}}}}
10652 .endd
10653 For a PLAIN authenticator you could use:
10654 .code
10655 server_condition = ${if pam{$auth2:${sg{$auth3}{:}{::}}}}
10656 .endd
10657 In some operating systems, PAM authentication can be done only from a process
10658 running as root. Since Exim is running as the Exim user when receiving
10659 messages, this means that PAM cannot be used directly in those systems.
10660 A patched version of the &'pam_unix'& module that comes with the
10661 Linux PAM package is available from &url(http://www.e-admin.de/pam_exim/).
10662 The patched module allows one special uid/gid combination, in addition to root,
10663 to authenticate. If you build the patched module to allow the Exim user and
10664 group, PAM can then be used from an Exim authenticator.
10665
10666
10667 .vitem &*pwcheck&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*:*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10668 .cindex "&'pwcheck'& daemon"
10669 .cindex "Cyrus"
10670 .cindex "expansion" "&'pwcheck'& authentication test"
10671 .cindex "&%pwcheck%& expansion condition"
10672 This condition supports user authentication using the Cyrus &'pwcheck'& daemon.
10673 This is one way of making it possible for passwords to be checked by a process
10674 that is not running as root. &*Note*&: The use of &'pwcheck'& is now
10675 deprecated. Its replacement is &'saslauthd'& (see below).
10676
10677 The pwcheck support is not included in Exim by default. You need to specify
10678 the location of the pwcheck daemon's socket in &_Local/Makefile_& before
10679 building Exim. For example:
10680 .code
10681 CYRUS_PWCHECK_SOCKET=/var/pwcheck/pwcheck
10682 .endd
10683 You do not need to install the full Cyrus software suite in order to use
10684 the pwcheck daemon. You can compile and install just the daemon alone
10685 from the Cyrus SASL library. Ensure that &'exim'& is the only user that has
10686 access to the &_/var/pwcheck_& directory.
10687
10688 The &%pwcheck%& condition takes one argument, which must be the user name and
10689 password, separated by a colon. For example, in a LOGIN authenticator
10690 configuration, you might have this:
10691 .code
10692 server_condition = ${if pwcheck{$auth1:$auth2}}
10693 .endd
10694 Again, for a PLAIN authenticator configuration, this would be:
10695 .code
10696 server_condition = ${if pwcheck{$auth2:$auth3}}
10697 .endd
10698 .vitem &*queue_running*&
10699 .cindex "queue runner" "detecting when delivering from"
10700 .cindex "expansion" "queue runner test"
10701 .cindex "&%queue_running%& expansion condition"
10702 This condition, which has no data, is true during delivery attempts that are
10703 initiated by queue runner processes, and false otherwise.
10704
10705
10706 .vitem &*radius&~{*&<&'authentication&~string'&>&*}*&
10707 .cindex "Radius"
10708 .cindex "expansion" "Radius authentication"
10709 .cindex "&%radius%& expansion condition"
10710 Radius authentication (RFC 2865) is supported in a similar way to PAM. You must
10711 set RADIUS_CONFIG_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_& to specify the location of
10712 the Radius client configuration file in order to build Exim with Radius
10713 support.
10714
10715 With just that one setting, Exim expects to be linked with the &%radiusclient%&
10716 library, using the original API. If you are using release 0.4.0 or later of
10717 this library, you need to set
10718 .code
10719 RADIUS_LIB_TYPE=RADIUSCLIENTNEW
10720 .endd
10721 in &_Local/Makefile_& when building Exim. You can also link Exim with the
10722 &%libradius%& library that comes with FreeBSD. To do this, set
10723 .code
10724 RADIUS_LIB_TYPE=RADLIB
10725 .endd
10726 in &_Local/Makefile_&, in addition to setting RADIUS_CONFIGURE_FILE.
10727 You may also have to supply a suitable setting in EXTRALIBS so that the
10728 Radius library can be found when Exim is linked.
10729
10730 The string specified by RADIUS_CONFIG_FILE is expanded and passed to the
10731 Radius client library, which calls the Radius server. The condition is true if
10732 the authentication is successful. For example:
10733 .code
10734 server_condition = ${if radius{<arguments>}}
10735 .endd
10736
10737
10738 .vitem "&*saslauthd&~{{*&<&'user'&>&*}{*&<&'password'&>&*}&&&
10739 {*&<&'service'&>&*}{*&<&'realm'&>&*}}*&"
10740 .cindex "&'saslauthd'& daemon"
10741 .cindex "Cyrus"
10742 .cindex "expansion" "&'saslauthd'& authentication test"
10743 .cindex "&%saslauthd%& expansion condition"
10744 This condition supports user authentication using the Cyrus &'saslauthd'&
10745 daemon. This replaces the older &'pwcheck'& daemon, which is now deprecated.
10746 Using this daemon is one way of making it possible for passwords to be checked
10747 by a process that is not running as root.
10748
10749 The saslauthd support is not included in Exim by default. You need to specify
10750 the location of the saslauthd daemon's socket in &_Local/Makefile_& before
10751 building Exim. For example:
10752 .code
10753 CYRUS_SASLAUTHD_SOCKET=/var/state/saslauthd/mux
10754 .endd
10755 You do not need to install the full Cyrus software suite in order to use
10756 the saslauthd daemon. You can compile and install just the daemon alone
10757 from the Cyrus SASL library.
10758
10759 Up to four arguments can be supplied to the &%saslauthd%& condition, but only
10760 two are mandatory. For example:
10761 .code
10762 server_condition = ${if saslauthd{{$auth1}{$auth2}}}
10763 .endd
10764 The service and the realm are optional (which is why the arguments are enclosed
10765 in their own set of braces). For details of the meaning of the service and
10766 realm, and how to run the daemon, consult the Cyrus documentation.
10767 .endlist vlist
10768
10769
10770
10771 .section "Combining expansion conditions" "SECID84"
10772 .cindex "expansion" "combining conditions"
10773 Several conditions can be tested at once by combining them using the &%and%&
10774 and &%or%& combination conditions. Note that &%and%& and &%or%& are complete
10775 conditions on their own, and precede their lists of sub-conditions. Each
10776 sub-condition must be enclosed in braces within the overall braces that contain
10777 the list. No repetition of &%if%& is used.
10778
10779
10780 .vlist
10781 .vitem &*or&~{{*&<&'cond1'&>&*}{*&<&'cond2'&>&*}...}*&
10782 .cindex "&""or""& expansion condition"
10783 .cindex "expansion" "&""or""& of conditions"
10784 The sub-conditions are evaluated from left to right. The condition is true if
10785 any one of the sub-conditions is true.
10786 For example,
10787 .code
10788 ${if or {{eq{$local_part}{spqr}}{eq{$domain}{testing.com}}}...
10789 .endd
10790 When a true sub-condition is found, the following ones are parsed but not
10791 evaluated. If there are several &"match"& sub-conditions the values of the
10792 numeric variables afterwards are taken from the first one that succeeds.
10793
10794 .vitem &*and&~{{*&<&'cond1'&>&*}{*&<&'cond2'&>&*}...}*&
10795 .cindex "&""and""& expansion condition"
10796 .cindex "expansion" "&""and""& of conditions"
10797 The sub-conditions are evaluated from left to right. The condition is true if
10798 all of the sub-conditions are true. If there are several &"match"&
10799 sub-conditions, the values of the numeric variables afterwards are taken from
10800 the last one. When a false sub-condition is found, the following ones are
10801 parsed but not evaluated.
10802 .endlist
10803 .ecindex IIDexpcond
10804
10805
10806
10807
10808 .section "Expansion variables" "SECTexpvar"
10809 .cindex "expansion" "variables, list of"
10810 This section contains an alphabetical list of all the expansion variables. Some
10811 of them are available only when Exim is compiled with specific options such as
10812 support for TLS or the content scanning extension.
10813
10814 .vlist
10815 .vitem "&$0$&, &$1$&, etc"
10816 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)"
10817 When a &%match%& expansion condition succeeds, these variables contain the
10818 captured substrings identified by the regular expression during subsequent
10819 processing of the success string of the containing &%if%& expansion item.
10820 However, they do not retain their values afterwards; in fact, their previous
10821 values are restored at the end of processing an &%if%& item. The numerical
10822 variables may also be set externally by some other matching process which
10823 precedes the expansion of the string. For example, the commands available in
10824 Exim filter files include an &%if%& command with its own regular expression
10825 matching condition.
10826
10827 .vitem "&$acl_c...$&"
10828 Values can be placed in these variables by the &%set%& modifier in an ACL. They
10829 can be given any name that starts with &$acl_c$& and is at least six characters
10830 long, but the sixth character must be either a digit or an underscore. For
10831 example: &$acl_c5$&, &$acl_c_mycount$&. The values of the &$acl_c...$&
10832 variables persist throughout the lifetime of an SMTP connection. They can be
10833 used to pass information between ACLs and between different invocations of the
10834 same ACL. When a message is received, the values of these variables are saved
10835 with the message, and can be accessed by filters, routers, and transports
10836 during subsequent delivery.
10837
10838 .vitem "&$acl_m...$&"
10839 These variables are like the &$acl_c...$& variables, except that their values
10840 are reset after a message has been received. Thus, if several messages are
10841 received in one SMTP connection, &$acl_m...$& values are not passed on from one
10842 message to the next, as &$acl_c...$& values are. The &$acl_m...$& variables are
10843 also reset by MAIL, RSET, EHLO, HELO, and after starting a TLS session. When a
10844 message is received, the values of these variables are saved with the message,
10845 and can be accessed by filters, routers, and transports during subsequent
10846 delivery.
10847
10848 .vitem &$acl_verify_message$&
10849 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
10850 After an address verification has failed, this variable contains the failure
10851 message. It retains its value for use in subsequent modifiers. The message can
10852 be preserved by coding like this:
10853 .code
10854 warn !verify = sender
10855 set acl_m0 = $acl_verify_message
10856 .endd
10857 You can use &$acl_verify_message$& during the expansion of the &%message%& or
10858 &%log_message%& modifiers, to include information about the verification
10859 failure.
10860
10861 .vitem &$address_data$&
10862 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
10863 This variable is set by means of the &%address_data%& option in routers. The
10864 value then remains with the address while it is processed by subsequent routers
10865 and eventually a transport. If the transport is handling multiple addresses,
10866 the value from the first address is used. See chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&
10867 for more details. &*Note*&: The contents of &$address_data$& are visible in
10868 user filter files.
10869
10870 If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify
10871 a recipient address, the final value is still in the variable for subsequent
10872 conditions and modifiers of the ACL statement. If routing the address caused it
10873 to be redirected to just one address, the child address is also routed as part
10874 of the verification, and in this case the final value of &$address_data$& is
10875 from the child's routing.
10876
10877 If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify a
10878 sender address, the final value is also preserved, but this time in
10879 &$sender_address_data$&, to distinguish it from data from a recipient
10880 address.
10881
10882 In both cases (recipient and sender verification), the value does not persist
10883 after the end of the current ACL statement. If you want to preserve
10884 these values for longer, you can save them in ACL variables.
10885
10886 .vitem &$address_file$&
10887 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
10888 When, as a result of aliasing, forwarding, or filtering, a message is directed
10889 to a specific file, this variable holds the name of the file when the transport
10890 is running. At other times, the variable is empty. For example, using the
10891 default configuration, if user &%r2d2%& has a &_.forward_& file containing
10892 .code
10893 /home/r2d2/savemail
10894 .endd
10895 then when the &(address_file)& transport is running, &$address_file$&
10896 contains the text string &`/home/r2d2/savemail`&.
10897 .cindex "Sieve filter" "value of &$address_file$&"
10898 For Sieve filters, the value may be &"inbox"& or a relative folder name. It is
10899 then up to the transport configuration to generate an appropriate absolute path
10900 to the relevant file.
10901
10902 .vitem &$address_pipe$&
10903 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
10904 When, as a result of aliasing or forwarding, a message is directed to a pipe,
10905 this variable holds the pipe command when the transport is running.
10906
10907 .vitem "&$auth1$& &-- &$auth3$&"
10908 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
10909 These variables are used in SMTP authenticators (see chapters
10910 &<<CHAPplaintext>>&&--&<<CHAPspa>>&). Elsewhere, they are empty.
10911
10912 .vitem &$authenticated_id$&
10913 .cindex "authentication" "id"
10914 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
10915 When a server successfully authenticates a client it may be configured to
10916 preserve some of the authentication information in the variable
10917 &$authenticated_id$& (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&). For example, a
10918 user/password authenticator configuration might preserve the user name for use
10919 in the routers. Note that this is not the same information that is saved in
10920 &$sender_host_authenticated$&.
10921 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP connection)
10922 the value of &$authenticated_id$& is normally the login name of the calling
10923 process. However, a trusted user can override this by means of the &%-oMai%&
10924 command line option.
10925
10926 .vitem &$authenticated_fail_id$&
10927 .cindex "authentication" "fail" "id"
10928 .vindex "&$authenticated_fail_id$&"
10929 When an authentication attempt fails, the variable &$authenticated_fail_id$&
10930 will contain the failed authentication id. If more than one authentication
10931 id is attempted, it will contain only the last one. The variable is
10932 available for processing in the ACL's, generally the quit or notquit ACL.
10933 A message to a local recipient could still be accepted without requiring
10934 authentication, which means this variable could also be visible in all of
10935 the ACL's as well.
10936
10937
10938 .vitem &$authenticated_sender$&
10939 .cindex "sender" "authenticated"
10940 .cindex "authentication" "sender"
10941 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
10942 .vindex "&$authenticated_sender$&"
10943 When acting as a server, Exim takes note of the AUTH= parameter on an incoming
10944 SMTP MAIL command if it believes the sender is sufficiently trusted, as
10945 described in section &<<SECTauthparamail>>&. Unless the data is the string
10946 &"<>"&, it is set as the authenticated sender of the message, and the value is
10947 available during delivery in the &$authenticated_sender$& variable. If the
10948 sender is not trusted, Exim accepts the syntax of AUTH=, but ignores the data.
10949
10950 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
10951 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP connection), the
10952 value of &$authenticated_sender$& is an address constructed from the login
10953 name of the calling process and &$qualify_domain$&, except that a trusted user
10954 can override this by means of the &%-oMas%& command line option.
10955
10956
10957 .vitem &$authentication_failed$&
10958 .cindex "authentication" "failure"
10959 .vindex "&$authentication_failed$&"
10960 This variable is set to &"1"& in an Exim server if a client issues an AUTH
10961 command that does not succeed. Otherwise it is set to &"0"&. This makes it
10962 possible to distinguish between &"did not try to authenticate"&
10963 (&$sender_host_authenticated$& is empty and &$authentication_failed$& is set to
10964 &"0"&) and &"tried to authenticate but failed"& (&$sender_host_authenticated$&
10965 is empty and &$authentication_failed$& is set to &"1"&). Failure includes any
10966 negative response to an AUTH command, including (for example) an attempt to use
10967 an undefined mechanism.
10968
10969 .vitem &$av_failed$&
10970 .cindex "content scanning" "AV scanner failure"
10971 This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning
10972 extension. It is set to &"0"& by default, but will be set to &"1"& if any
10973 problem occurs with the virus scanner (specified by &%av_scanner%&) during
10974 the ACL malware condition.
10975
10976 .vitem &$body_linecount$&
10977 .cindex "message body" "line count"
10978 .cindex "body of message" "line count"
10979 .vindex "&$body_linecount$&"
10980 When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
10981 number of lines in the message's body. See also &$message_linecount$&.
10982
10983 .vitem &$body_zerocount$&
10984 .cindex "message body" "binary zero count"
10985 .cindex "body of message" "binary zero count"
10986 .cindex "binary zero" "in message body"
10987 .vindex "&$body_zerocount$&"
10988 When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
10989 number of binary zero bytes (ASCII NULs) in the message's body.
10990
10991 .vitem &$bounce_recipient$&
10992 .vindex "&$bounce_recipient$&"
10993 This is set to the recipient address of a bounce message while Exim is creating
10994 it. It is useful if a customized bounce message text file is in use (see
10995 chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&).
10996
10997 .vitem &$bounce_return_size_limit$&
10998 .vindex "&$bounce_return_size_limit$&"
10999 This contains the value set in the &%bounce_return_size_limit%& option, rounded
11000 up to a multiple of 1000. It is useful when a customized error message text
11001 file is in use (see chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&).
11002
11003 .vitem &$caller_gid$&
11004 .cindex "gid (group id)" "caller"
11005 .vindex "&$caller_gid$&"
11006 The real group id under which the process that called Exim was running. This is
11007 not the same as the group id of the originator of a message (see
11008 &$originator_gid$&). If Exim re-execs itself, this variable in the new
11009 incarnation normally contains the Exim gid.
11010
11011 .vitem &$caller_uid$&
11012 .cindex "uid (user id)" "caller"
11013 .vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
11014 The real user id under which the process that called Exim was running. This is
11015 not the same as the user id of the originator of a message (see
11016 &$originator_uid$&). If Exim re-execs itself, this variable in the new
11017 incarnation normally contains the Exim uid.
11018
11019 .vitem &$compile_date$&
11020 .vindex "&$compile_date$&"
11021 The date on which the Exim binary was compiled.
11022
11023 .vitem &$compile_number$&
11024 .vindex "&$compile_number$&"
11025 The building process for Exim keeps a count of the number
11026 of times it has been compiled. This serves to distinguish different
11027 compilations of the same version of the program.
11028
11029 .vitem &$demime_errorlevel$&
11030 .vindex "&$demime_errorlevel$&"
11031 This variable is available when Exim is compiled with
11032 the content-scanning extension and the obsolete &%demime%& condition. For
11033 details, see section &<<SECTdemimecond>>&.
11034
11035 .vitem &$demime_reason$&
11036 .vindex "&$demime_reason$&"
11037 This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the
11038 content-scanning extension and the obsolete &%demime%& condition. For details,
11039 see section &<<SECTdemimecond>>&.
11040
11041 .vitem &$dnslist_domain$& &&&
11042 &$dnslist_matched$& &&&
11043 &$dnslist_text$& &&&
11044 &$dnslist_value$&
11045 .vindex "&$dnslist_domain$&"
11046 .vindex "&$dnslist_matched$&"
11047 .vindex "&$dnslist_text$&"
11048 .vindex "&$dnslist_value$&"
11049 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
11050 When a DNS (black) list lookup succeeds, these variables are set to contain
11051 the following data from the lookup: the list's domain name, the key that was
11052 looked up, the contents of any associated TXT record, and the value from the
11053 main A record. See section &<<SECID204>>& for more details.
11054
11055 .vitem &$domain$&
11056 .vindex "&$domain$&"
11057 When an address is being routed, or delivered on its own, this variable
11058 contains the domain. Uppercase letters in the domain are converted into lower
11059 case for &$domain$&.
11060
11061 Global address rewriting happens when a message is received, so the value of
11062 &$domain$& during routing and delivery is the value after rewriting. &$domain$&
11063 is set during user filtering, but not during system filtering, because a
11064 message may have many recipients and the system filter is called just once.
11065
11066 When more than one address is being delivered at once (for example, several
11067 RCPT commands in one SMTP delivery), &$domain$& is set only if they all
11068 have the same domain. Transports can be restricted to handling only one domain
11069 at a time if the value of &$domain$& is required at transport time &-- this is
11070 the default for local transports. For further details of the environment in
11071 which local transports are run, see chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
11072
11073 .oindex "&%delay_warning_condition%&"
11074 At the end of a delivery, if all deferred addresses have the same domain, it is
11075 set in &$domain$& during the expansion of &%delay_warning_condition%&.
11076
11077 The &$domain$& variable is also used in some other circumstances:
11078
11079 .ilist
11080 When an ACL is running for a RCPT command, &$domain$& contains the domain of
11081 the recipient address. The domain of the &'sender'& address is in
11082 &$sender_address_domain$& at both MAIL time and at RCPT time. &$domain$& is not
11083 normally set during the running of the MAIL ACL. However, if the sender address
11084 is verified with a callout during the MAIL ACL, the sender domain is placed in
11085 &$domain$& during the expansions of &%hosts%&, &%interface%&, and &%port%& in
11086 the &(smtp)& transport.
11087
11088 .next
11089 When a rewrite item is being processed (see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&),
11090 &$domain$& contains the domain portion of the address that is being rewritten;
11091 it can be used in the expansion of the replacement address, for example, to
11092 rewrite domains by file lookup.
11093
11094 .next
11095 With one important exception, whenever a domain list is being scanned,
11096 &$domain$& contains the subject domain. &*Exception*&: When a domain list in
11097 a &%sender_domains%& condition in an ACL is being processed, the subject domain
11098 is in &$sender_address_domain$& and not in &$domain$&. It works this way so
11099 that, in a RCPT ACL, the sender domain list can be dependent on the
11100 recipient domain (which is what is in &$domain$& at this time).
11101
11102 .next
11103 .cindex "ETRN" "value of &$domain$&"
11104 .oindex "&%smtp_etrn_command%&"
11105 When the &%smtp_etrn_command%& option is being expanded, &$domain$& contains
11106 the complete argument of the ETRN command (see section &<<SECTETRN>>&).
11107 .endlist
11108
11109
11110 .vitem &$domain_data$&
11111 .vindex "&$domain_data$&"
11112 When the &%domains%& option on a router matches a domain by
11113 means of a lookup, the data read by the lookup is available during the running
11114 of the router as &$domain_data$&. In addition, if the driver routes the
11115 address to a transport, the value is available in that transport. If the
11116 transport is handling multiple addresses, the value from the first address is
11117 used.
11118
11119 &$domain_data$& is also set when the &%domains%& condition in an ACL matches a
11120 domain by means of a lookup. The data read by the lookup is available during
11121 the rest of the ACL statement. In all other situations, this variable expands
11122 to nothing.
11123
11124 .vitem &$exim_gid$&
11125 .vindex "&$exim_gid$&"
11126 This variable contains the numerical value of the Exim group id.
11127
11128 .vitem &$exim_path$&
11129 .vindex "&$exim_path$&"
11130 This variable contains the path to the Exim binary.
11131
11132 .vitem &$exim_uid$&
11133 .vindex "&$exim_uid$&"
11134 This variable contains the numerical value of the Exim user id.
11135
11136 .vitem &$found_extension$&
11137 .vindex "&$found_extension$&"
11138 This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the
11139 content-scanning extension and the obsolete &%demime%& condition. For details,
11140 see section &<<SECTdemimecond>>&.
11141
11142 .vitem &$header_$&<&'name'&>
11143 This is not strictly an expansion variable. It is expansion syntax for
11144 inserting the message header line with the given name. Note that the name must
11145 be terminated by colon or white space, because it may contain a wide variety of
11146 characters. Note also that braces must &'not'& be used.
11147
11148 .vitem &$headers_added$&
11149 .vindex "&$headers_added$&"
11150 Within an ACL this variable contains the headers added so far by
11151 the ACL modifier add_header (section &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&).
11152 The headers are a newline-separated list.
11153
11154 .vitem &$home$&
11155 .vindex "&$home$&"
11156 When the &%check_local_user%& option is set for a router, the user's home
11157 directory is placed in &$home$& when the check succeeds. In particular, this
11158 means it is set during the running of users' filter files. A router may also
11159 explicitly set a home directory for use by a transport; this can be overridden
11160 by a setting on the transport itself.
11161
11162 When running a filter test via the &%-bf%& option, &$home$& is set to the value
11163 of the environment variable HOME.
11164
11165 .vitem &$host$&
11166 .vindex "&$host$&"
11167 If a router assigns an address to a transport (any transport), and passes a
11168 list of hosts with the address, the value of &$host$& when the transport starts
11169 to run is the name of the first host on the list. Note that this applies both
11170 to local and remote transports.
11171
11172 .cindex "transport" "filter"
11173 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
11174 For the &(smtp)& transport, if there is more than one host, the value of
11175 &$host$& changes as the transport works its way through the list. In
11176 particular, when the &(smtp)& transport is expanding its options for encryption
11177 using TLS, or for specifying a transport filter (see chapter
11178 &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&), &$host$& contains the name of the host to which it
11179 is connected.
11180
11181 When used in the client part of an authenticator configuration (see chapter
11182 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&), &$host$& contains the name of the server to which the
11183 client is connected.
11184
11185
11186 .vitem &$host_address$&
11187 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
11188 This variable is set to the remote host's IP address whenever &$host$& is set
11189 for a remote connection. It is also set to the IP address that is being checked
11190 when the &%ignore_target_hosts%& option is being processed.
11191
11192 .vitem &$host_data$&
11193 .vindex "&$host_data$&"
11194 If a &%hosts%& condition in an ACL is satisfied by means of a lookup, the
11195 result of the lookup is made available in the &$host_data$& variable. This
11196 allows you, for example, to do things like this:
11197 .code
11198 deny hosts = net-lsearch;/some/file
11199 message = $host_data
11200 .endd
11201 .vitem &$host_lookup_deferred$&
11202 .cindex "host name" "lookup, failure of"
11203 .vindex "&$host_lookup_deferred$&"
11204 This variable normally contains &"0"&, as does &$host_lookup_failed$&. When a
11205 message comes from a remote host and there is an attempt to look up the host's
11206 name from its IP address, and the attempt is not successful, one of these
11207 variables is set to &"1"&.
11208
11209 .ilist
11210 If the lookup receives a definite negative response (for example, a DNS lookup
11211 succeeded, but no records were found), &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&.
11212
11213 .next
11214 If there is any kind of problem during the lookup, such that Exim cannot
11215 tell whether or not the host name is defined (for example, a timeout for a DNS
11216 lookup), &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to &"1"&.
11217 .endlist ilist
11218
11219 Looking up a host's name from its IP address consists of more than just a
11220 single reverse lookup. Exim checks that a forward lookup of at least one of the
11221 names it receives from a reverse lookup yields the original IP address. If this
11222 is not the case, Exim does not accept the looked up name(s), and
11223 &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&. Thus, being able to find a name from an
11224 IP address (for example, the existence of a PTR record in the DNS) is not
11225 sufficient on its own for the success of a host name lookup. If the reverse
11226 lookup succeeds, but there is a lookup problem such as a timeout when checking
11227 the result, the name is not accepted, and &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to
11228 &"1"&. See also &$sender_host_name$&.
11229
11230 .vitem &$host_lookup_failed$&
11231 .vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
11232 See &$host_lookup_deferred$&.
11233
11234
11235 .vitem &$inode$&
11236 .vindex "&$inode$&"
11237 The only time this variable is set is while expanding the &%directory_file%&
11238 option in the &(appendfile)& transport. The variable contains the inode number
11239 of the temporary file which is about to be renamed. It can be used to construct
11240 a unique name for the file.
11241
11242 .vitem &$interface_address$&
11243 .vindex "&$interface_address$&"
11244 This is an obsolete name for &$received_ip_address$&.
11245
11246 .vitem &$interface_port$&
11247 .vindex "&$interface_port$&"
11248 This is an obsolete name for &$received_port$&.
11249
11250 .vitem &$item$&
11251 .vindex "&$item$&"
11252 This variable is used during the expansion of &*forall*& and &*forany*&
11253 conditions (see section &<<SECTexpcond>>&), and &*filter*&, &*map*&, and
11254 &*reduce*& items (see section &<<SECTexpcond>>&). In other circumstances, it is
11255 empty.
11256
11257 .vitem &$ldap_dn$&
11258 .vindex "&$ldap_dn$&"
11259 This variable, which is available only when Exim is compiled with LDAP support,
11260 contains the DN from the last entry in the most recently successful LDAP
11261 lookup.
11262
11263 .vitem &$load_average$&
11264 .vindex "&$load_average$&"
11265 This variable contains the system load average, multiplied by 1000 so that it
11266 is an integer. For example, if the load average is 0.21, the value of the
11267 variable is 210. The value is recomputed every time the variable is referenced.
11268
11269 .vitem &$local_part$&
11270 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
11271 When an address is being routed, or delivered on its own, this
11272 variable contains the local part. When a number of addresses are being
11273 delivered together (for example, multiple RCPT commands in an SMTP
11274 session), &$local_part$& is not set.
11275
11276 Global address rewriting happens when a message is received, so the value of
11277 &$local_part$& during routing and delivery is the value after rewriting.
11278 &$local_part$& is set during user filtering, but not during system filtering,
11279 because a message may have many recipients and the system filter is called just
11280 once.
11281
11282 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
11283 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
11284 If a local part prefix or suffix has been recognized, it is not included in the
11285 value of &$local_part$& during routing and subsequent delivery. The values of
11286 any prefix or suffix are in &$local_part_prefix$& and
11287 &$local_part_suffix$&, respectively.
11288
11289 When a message is being delivered to a file, pipe, or autoreply transport as a
11290 result of aliasing or forwarding, &$local_part$& is set to the local part of
11291 the parent address, not to the file name or command (see &$address_file$& and
11292 &$address_pipe$&).
11293
11294 When an ACL is running for a RCPT command, &$local_part$& contains the
11295 local part of the recipient address.
11296
11297 When a rewrite item is being processed (see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&),
11298 &$local_part$& contains the local part of the address that is being rewritten;
11299 it can be used in the expansion of the replacement address, for example.
11300
11301 In all cases, all quoting is removed from the local part. For example, for both
11302 the addresses
11303 .code
11304 "abc:xyz"@test.example
11305 abc\:xyz@test.example
11306 .endd
11307 the value of &$local_part$& is
11308 .code
11309 abc:xyz
11310 .endd
11311 If you use &$local_part$& to create another address, you should always wrap it
11312 inside a quoting operator. For example, in a &(redirect)& router you could
11313 have:
11314 .code
11315 data = ${quote_local_part:$local_part}@new.domain.example
11316 .endd
11317 &*Note*&: The value of &$local_part$& is normally lower cased. If you want
11318 to process local parts in a case-dependent manner in a router, you can set the
11319 &%caseful_local_part%& option (see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&).
11320
11321 .vitem &$local_part_data$&
11322 .vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
11323 When the &%local_parts%& option on a router matches a local part by means of a
11324 lookup, the data read by the lookup is available during the running of the
11325 router as &$local_part_data$&. In addition, if the driver routes the address
11326 to a transport, the value is available in that transport. If the transport is
11327 handling multiple addresses, the value from the first address is used.
11328
11329 &$local_part_data$& is also set when the &%local_parts%& condition in an ACL
11330 matches a local part by means of a lookup. The data read by the lookup is
11331 available during the rest of the ACL statement. In all other situations, this
11332 variable expands to nothing.
11333
11334 .vitem &$local_part_prefix$&
11335 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
11336 When an address is being routed or delivered, and a
11337 specific prefix for the local part was recognized, it is available in this
11338 variable, having been removed from &$local_part$&.
11339
11340 .vitem &$local_part_suffix$&
11341 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
11342 When an address is being routed or delivered, and a
11343 specific suffix for the local part was recognized, it is available in this
11344 variable, having been removed from &$local_part$&.
11345
11346 .vitem &$local_scan_data$&
11347 .vindex "&$local_scan_data$&"
11348 This variable contains the text returned by the &[local_scan()]& function when
11349 a message is received. See chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>& for more details.
11350
11351 .vitem &$local_user_gid$&
11352 .vindex "&$local_user_gid$&"
11353 See &$local_user_uid$&.
11354
11355 .vitem &$local_user_uid$&
11356 .vindex "&$local_user_uid$&"
11357 This variable and &$local_user_gid$& are set to the uid and gid after the
11358 &%check_local_user%& router precondition succeeds. This means that their values
11359 are available for the remaining preconditions (&%senders%&, &%require_files%&,
11360 and &%condition%&), for the &%address_data%& expansion, and for any
11361 router-specific expansions. At all other times, the values in these variables
11362 are &`(uid_t)(-1)`& and &`(gid_t)(-1)`&, respectively.
11363
11364 .vitem &$localhost_number$&
11365 .vindex "&$localhost_number$&"
11366 This contains the expanded value of the
11367 &%localhost_number%& option. The expansion happens after the main options have
11368 been read.
11369
11370 .vitem &$log_inodes$&
11371 .vindex "&$log_inodes$&"
11372 The number of free inodes in the disk partition where Exim's
11373 log files are being written. The value is recalculated whenever the variable is
11374 referenced. If the relevant file system does not have the concept of inodes,
11375 the value of is -1. See also the &%check_log_inodes%& option.
11376
11377 .vitem &$log_space$&
11378 .vindex "&$log_space$&"
11379 The amount of free space (as a number of kilobytes) in the disk
11380 partition where Exim's log files are being written. The value is recalculated
11381 whenever the variable is referenced. If the operating system does not have the
11382 ability to find the amount of free space (only true for experimental systems),
11383 the space value is -1. See also the &%check_log_space%& option.
11384
11385
11386 .vitem &$mailstore_basename$&
11387 .vindex "&$mailstore_basename$&"
11388 This variable is set only when doing deliveries in &"mailstore"& format in the
11389 &(appendfile)& transport. During the expansion of the &%mailstore_prefix%&,
11390 &%mailstore_suffix%&, &%message_prefix%&, and &%message_suffix%& options, it
11391 contains the basename of the files that are being written, that is, the name
11392 without the &".tmp"&, &".env"&, or &".msg"& suffix. At all other times, this
11393 variable is empty.
11394
11395 .vitem &$malware_name$&
11396 .vindex "&$malware_name$&"
11397 This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the
11398 content-scanning extension. It is set to the name of the virus that was found
11399 when the ACL &%malware%& condition is true (see section &<<SECTscanvirus>>&).
11400
11401 .vitem &$max_received_linelength$&
11402 .vindex "&$max_received_linelength$&"
11403 .cindex "maximum" "line length"
11404 .cindex "line length" "maximum"
11405 This variable contains the number of bytes in the longest line that was
11406 received as part of the message, not counting the line termination
11407 character(s).
11408
11409 .vitem &$message_age$&
11410 .cindex "message" "age of"
11411 .vindex "&$message_age$&"
11412 This variable is set at the start of a delivery attempt to contain the number
11413 of seconds since the message was received. It does not change during a single
11414 delivery attempt.
11415
11416 .vitem &$message_body$&
11417 .cindex "body of message" "expansion variable"
11418 .cindex "message body" "in expansion"
11419 .cindex "binary zero" "in message body"
11420 .vindex "&$message_body$&"
11421 .oindex "&%message_body_visible%&"
11422 This variable contains the initial portion of a message's body while it is
11423 being delivered, and is intended mainly for use in filter files. The maximum
11424 number of characters of the body that are put into the variable is set by the
11425 &%message_body_visible%& configuration option; the default is 500.
11426
11427 .oindex "&%message_body_newlines%&"
11428 By default, newlines are converted into spaces in &$message_body$&, to make it
11429 easier to search for phrases that might be split over a line break. However,
11430 this can be disabled by setting &%message_body_newlines%& to be true. Binary
11431 zeros are always converted into spaces.
11432
11433 .vitem &$message_body_end$&
11434 .cindex "body of message" "expansion variable"
11435 .cindex "message body" "in expansion"
11436 .vindex "&$message_body_end$&"
11437 This variable contains the final portion of a message's
11438 body while it is being delivered. The format and maximum size are as for
11439 &$message_body$&.
11440
11441 .vitem &$message_body_size$&
11442 .cindex "body of message" "size"
11443 .cindex "message body" "size"
11444 .vindex "&$message_body_size$&"
11445 When a message is being delivered, this variable contains the size of the body
11446 in bytes. The count starts from the character after the blank line that
11447 separates the body from the header. Newlines are included in the count. See
11448 also &$message_size$&, &$body_linecount$&, and &$body_zerocount$&.
11449
11450 .vitem &$message_exim_id$&
11451 .vindex "&$message_exim_id$&"
11452 When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
11453 unique message id that is generated and used by Exim to identify the message.
11454 An id is not created for a message until after its header has been successfully
11455 received. &*Note*&: This is &'not'& the contents of the &'Message-ID:'& header
11456 line; it is the local id that Exim assigns to the message, for example:
11457 &`1BXTIK-0001yO-VA`&.
11458
11459 .vitem &$message_headers$&
11460 .vindex &$message_headers$&
11461 This variable contains a concatenation of all the header lines when a message
11462 is being processed, except for lines added by routers or transports. The header
11463 lines are separated by newline characters. Their contents are decoded in the
11464 same way as a header line that is inserted by &%bheader%&.
11465
11466 .vitem &$message_headers_raw$&
11467 .vindex &$message_headers_raw$&
11468 This variable is like &$message_headers$& except that no processing of the
11469 contents of header lines is done.
11470
11471 .vitem &$message_id$&
11472 This is an old name for &$message_exim_id$&, which is now deprecated.
11473
11474 .vitem &$message_linecount$&
11475 .vindex "&$message_linecount$&"
11476 This variable contains the total number of lines in the header and body of the
11477 message. Compare &$body_linecount$&, which is the count for the body only.
11478 During the DATA and content-scanning ACLs, &$message_linecount$& contains the
11479 number of lines received. Before delivery happens (that is, before filters,
11480 routers, and transports run) the count is increased to include the
11481 &'Received:'& header line that Exim standardly adds, and also any other header
11482 lines that are added by ACLs. The blank line that separates the message header
11483 from the body is not counted.
11484
11485 As with the special case of &$message_size$&, during the expansion of the
11486 appendfile transport's maildir_tag option in maildir format, the value of
11487 &$message_linecount$& is the precise size of the number of newlines in the
11488 file that has been written (minus one for the blank line between the
11489 header and the body).
11490
11491 Here is an example of the use of this variable in a DATA ACL:
11492 .code
11493 deny message = Too many lines in message header
11494 condition = \
11495 ${if <{250}{${eval:$message_linecount - $body_linecount}}}
11496 .endd
11497 In the MAIL and RCPT ACLs, the value is zero because at that stage the
11498 message has not yet been received.
11499
11500 .vitem &$message_size$&
11501 .cindex "size" "of message"
11502 .cindex "message" "size"
11503 .vindex "&$message_size$&"
11504 When a message is being processed, this variable contains its size in bytes. In
11505 most cases, the size includes those headers that were received with the
11506 message, but not those (such as &'Envelope-to:'&) that are added to individual
11507 deliveries as they are written. However, there is one special case: during the
11508 expansion of the &%maildir_tag%& option in the &(appendfile)& transport while
11509 doing a delivery in maildir format, the value of &$message_size$& is the
11510 precise size of the file that has been written. See also
11511 &$message_body_size$&, &$body_linecount$&, and &$body_zerocount$&.
11512
11513 .cindex "RCPT" "value of &$message_size$&"
11514 While running a per message ACL (mail/rcpt/predata), &$message_size$&
11515 contains the size supplied on the MAIL command, or -1 if no size was given. The
11516 value may not, of course, be truthful.
11517
11518 .vitem &$mime_$&&'xxx'&
11519 A number of variables whose names start with &$mime$& are
11520 available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning extension. For
11521 details, see section &<<SECTscanmimepart>>&.
11522
11523 .vitem "&$n0$& &-- &$n9$&"
11524 These variables are counters that can be incremented by means
11525 of the &%add%& command in filter files.
11526
11527 .vitem &$original_domain$&
11528 .vindex "&$domain$&"
11529 .vindex "&$original_domain$&"
11530 When a top-level address is being processed for delivery, this contains the
11531 same value as &$domain$&. However, if a &"child"& address (for example,
11532 generated by an alias, forward, or filter file) is being processed, this
11533 variable contains the domain of the original address (lower cased). This
11534 differs from &$parent_domain$& only when there is more than one level of
11535 aliasing or forwarding. When more than one address is being delivered in a
11536 single transport run, &$original_domain$& is not set.
11537
11538 If a new address is created by means of a &%deliver%& command in a system
11539 filter, it is set up with an artificial &"parent"& address. This has the local
11540 part &'system-filter'& and the default qualify domain.
11541
11542 .vitem &$original_local_part$&
11543 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
11544 .vindex "&$original_local_part$&"
11545 When a top-level address is being processed for delivery, this contains the
11546 same value as &$local_part$&, unless a prefix or suffix was removed from the
11547 local part, because &$original_local_part$& always contains the full local
11548 part. When a &"child"& address (for example, generated by an alias, forward, or
11549 filter file) is being processed, this variable contains the full local part of
11550 the original address.
11551
11552 If the router that did the redirection processed the local part
11553 case-insensitively, the value in &$original_local_part$& is in lower case.
11554 This variable differs from &$parent_local_part$& only when there is more than
11555 one level of aliasing or forwarding. When more than one address is being
11556 delivered in a single transport run, &$original_local_part$& is not set.
11557
11558 If a new address is created by means of a &%deliver%& command in a system
11559 filter, it is set up with an artificial &"parent"& address. This has the local
11560 part &'system-filter'& and the default qualify domain.
11561
11562 .vitem &$originator_gid$&
11563 .cindex "gid (group id)" "of originating user"
11564 .cindex "sender" "gid"
11565 .vindex "&$caller_gid$&"
11566 .vindex "&$originator_gid$&"
11567 This variable contains the value of &$caller_gid$& that was set when the
11568 message was received. For messages received via the command line, this is the
11569 gid of the sending user. For messages received by SMTP over TCP/IP, this is
11570 normally the gid of the Exim user.
11571
11572 .vitem &$originator_uid$&
11573 .cindex "uid (user id)" "of originating user"
11574 .cindex "sender" "uid"
11575 .vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
11576 .vindex "&$originaltor_uid$&"
11577 The value of &$caller_uid$& that was set when the message was received. For
11578 messages received via the command line, this is the uid of the sending user.
11579 For messages received by SMTP over TCP/IP, this is normally the uid of the Exim
11580 user.
11581
11582 .vitem &$parent_domain$&
11583 .vindex "&$parent_domain$&"
11584 This variable is similar to &$original_domain$& (see
11585 above), except that it refers to the immediately preceding parent address.
11586
11587 .vitem &$parent_local_part$&
11588 .vindex "&$parent_local_part$&"
11589 This variable is similar to &$original_local_part$&
11590 (see above), except that it refers to the immediately preceding parent address.
11591
11592 .vitem &$pid$&
11593 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of current process"
11594 .vindex "&$pid$&"
11595 This variable contains the current process id.
11596
11597 .vitem &$pipe_addresses$&
11598 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
11599 .cindex "transport" "filter"
11600 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
11601 This is not an expansion variable, but is mentioned here because the string
11602 &`$pipe_addresses`& is handled specially in the command specification for the
11603 &(pipe)& transport (chapter &<<CHAPpipetransport>>&) and in transport filters
11604 (described under &%transport_filter%& in chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
11605 It cannot be used in general expansion strings, and provokes an &"unknown
11606 variable"& error if encountered.
11607
11608 .vitem &$primary_hostname$&
11609 .vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
11610 This variable contains the value set by &%primary_hostname%& in the
11611 configuration file, or read by the &[uname()]& function. If &[uname()]& returns
11612 a single-component name, Exim calls &[gethostbyname()]& (or
11613 &[getipnodebyname()]& where available) in an attempt to acquire a fully
11614 qualified host name. See also &$smtp_active_hostname$&.
11615
11616
11617 .vitem &$prvscheck_address$&
11618 This variable is used in conjunction with the &%prvscheck%& expansion item,
11619 which is described in sections &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& and
11620 &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
11621
11622 .vitem &$prvscheck_keynum$&
11623 This variable is used in conjunction with the &%prvscheck%& expansion item,
11624 which is described in sections &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& and
11625 &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
11626
11627 .vitem &$prvscheck_result$&
11628 This variable is used in conjunction with the &%prvscheck%& expansion item,
11629 which is described in sections &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& and
11630 &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
11631
11632 .vitem &$qualify_domain$&
11633 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
11634 The value set for the &%qualify_domain%& option in the configuration file.
11635
11636 .vitem &$qualify_recipient$&
11637 .vindex "&$qualify_recipient$&"
11638 The value set for the &%qualify_recipient%& option in the configuration file,
11639 or if not set, the value of &$qualify_domain$&.
11640
11641 .vitem &$rcpt_count$&
11642 .vindex "&$rcpt_count$&"
11643 When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
11644 RCPT commands received for the current message. If this variable is used in a
11645 RCPT ACL, its value includes the current command.
11646
11647 .vitem &$rcpt_defer_count$&
11648 .vindex "&$rcpt_defer_count$&"
11649 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "count of"
11650 When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
11651 RCPT commands in the current message that have previously been rejected with a
11652 temporary (4&'xx'&) response.
11653
11654 .vitem &$rcpt_fail_count$&
11655 .vindex "&$rcpt_fail_count$&"
11656 When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
11657 RCPT commands in the current message that have previously been rejected with a
11658 permanent (5&'xx'&) response.
11659
11660 .vitem &$received_count$&
11661 .vindex "&$received_count$&"
11662 This variable contains the number of &'Received:'& header lines in the message,
11663 including the one added by Exim (so its value is always greater than zero). It
11664 is available in the DATA ACL, the non-SMTP ACL, and while routing and
11665 delivering.
11666
11667 .vitem &$received_for$&
11668 .vindex "&$received_for$&"
11669 If there is only a single recipient address in an incoming message, this
11670 variable contains that address when the &'Received:'& header line is being
11671 built. The value is copied after recipient rewriting has happened, but before
11672 the &[local_scan()]& function is run.
11673
11674 .vitem &$received_ip_address$&
11675 .vindex "&$received_ip_address$&"
11676 As soon as an Exim server starts processing an incoming TCP/IP connection, this
11677 variable is set to the address of the local IP interface, and &$received_port$&
11678 is set to the local port number. (The remote IP address and port are in
11679 &$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_host_port$&.) When testing with &%-bh%&,
11680 the port value is -1 unless it has been set using the &%-oMi%& command line
11681 option.
11682
11683 As well as being useful in ACLs (including the &"connect"& ACL), these variable
11684 could be used, for example, to make the file name for a TLS certificate depend
11685 on which interface and/or port is being used for the incoming connection. The
11686 values of &$received_ip_address$& and &$received_port$& are saved with any
11687 messages that are received, thus making these variables available at delivery
11688 time.
11689
11690 &*Note:*& There are no equivalent variables for outgoing connections, because
11691 the values are unknown (unless they are explicitly set by options of the
11692 &(smtp)& transport).
11693
11694 .vitem &$received_port$&
11695 .vindex "&$received_port$&"
11696 See &$received_ip_address$&.
11697
11698 .vitem &$received_protocol$&
11699 .vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
11700 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the name of the
11701 protocol by which it was received. Most of the names used by Exim are defined
11702 by RFCs 821, 2821, and 3848. They start with &"smtp"& (the client used HELO) or
11703 &"esmtp"& (the client used EHLO). This can be followed by &"s"& for secure
11704 (encrypted) and/or &"a"& for authenticated. Thus, for example, if the protocol
11705 is set to &"esmtpsa"&, the message was received over an encrypted SMTP
11706 connection and the client was successfully authenticated.
11707
11708 Exim uses the protocol name &"smtps"& for the case when encryption is
11709 automatically set up on connection without the use of STARTTLS (see
11710 &%tls_on_connect_ports%&), and the client uses HELO to initiate the
11711 encrypted SMTP session. The name &"smtps"& is also used for the rare situation
11712 where the client initially uses EHLO, sets up an encrypted connection using
11713 STARTTLS, and then uses HELO afterwards.
11714
11715 The &%-oMr%& option provides a way of specifying a custom protocol name for
11716 messages that are injected locally by trusted callers. This is commonly used to
11717 identify messages that are being re-injected after some kind of scanning.
11718
11719 .vitem &$received_time$&
11720 .vindex "&$received_time$&"
11721 This variable contains the date and time when the current message was received,
11722 as a number of seconds since the start of the Unix epoch.
11723
11724 .vitem &$recipient_data$&
11725 .vindex "&$recipient_data$&"
11726 This variable is set after an indexing lookup success in an ACL &%recipients%&
11727 condition. It contains the data from the lookup, and the value remains set
11728 until the next &%recipients%& test. Thus, you can do things like this:
11729 .display
11730 &`require recipients = cdb*@;/some/file`&
11731 &`deny `&&'some further test involving'& &`$recipient_data`&
11732 .endd
11733 &*Warning*&: This variable is set only when a lookup is used as an indexing
11734 method in the address list, using the semicolon syntax as in the example above.
11735 The variable is not set for a lookup that is used as part of the string
11736 expansion that all such lists undergo before being interpreted.
11737
11738 .vitem &$recipient_verify_failure$&
11739 .vindex "&$recipient_verify_failure$&"
11740 In an ACL, when a recipient verification fails, this variable contains
11741 information about the failure. It is set to one of the following words:
11742
11743 .ilist
11744 &"qualify"&: The address was unqualified (no domain), and the message
11745 was neither local nor came from an exempted host.
11746
11747 .next
11748 &"route"&: Routing failed.
11749
11750 .next
11751 &"mail"&: Routing succeeded, and a callout was attempted; rejection occurred at
11752 or before the MAIL command (that is, on initial connection, HELO, or
11753 MAIL).
11754
11755 .next
11756 &"recipient"&: The RCPT command in a callout was rejected.
11757 .next
11758
11759 &"postmaster"&: The postmaster check in a callout was rejected.
11760 .endlist
11761
11762 The main use of this variable is expected to be to distinguish between
11763 rejections of MAIL and rejections of RCPT.
11764
11765 .vitem &$recipients$&
11766 .vindex "&$recipients$&"
11767 This variable contains a list of envelope recipients for a message. A comma and
11768 a space separate the addresses in the replacement text. However, the variable
11769 is not generally available, to prevent exposure of Bcc recipients in
11770 unprivileged users' filter files. You can use &$recipients$& only in these
11771 cases:
11772
11773 .olist
11774 In a system filter file.
11775 .next
11776 In the ACLs associated with the DATA command and with non-SMTP messages, that
11777 is, the ACLs defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&, &%acl_smtp_data%&,
11778 &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_not_smtp_start%&, &%acl_not_smtp%&, and
11779 &%acl_not_smtp_mime%&.
11780 .next
11781 From within a &[local_scan()]& function.
11782 .endlist
11783
11784
11785 .vitem &$recipients_count$&
11786 .vindex "&$recipients_count$&"
11787 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the number of
11788 envelope recipients that came with the message. Duplicates are not excluded
11789 from the count. While a message is being received over SMTP, the number
11790 increases for each accepted recipient. It can be referenced in an ACL.
11791
11792
11793 .vitem &$regex_match_string$&
11794 .vindex "&$regex_match_string$&"
11795 This variable is set to contain the matching regular expression after a
11796 &%regex%& ACL condition has matched (see section &<<SECTscanregex>>&).
11797
11798
11799 .vitem &$reply_address$&
11800 .vindex "&$reply_address$&"
11801 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the contents of the
11802 &'Reply-To:'& header line if one exists and it is not empty, or otherwise the
11803 contents of the &'From:'& header line. Apart from the removal of leading
11804 white space, the value is not processed in any way. In particular, no RFC 2047
11805 decoding or character code translation takes place.
11806
11807 .vitem &$return_path$&
11808 .vindex "&$return_path$&"
11809 When a message is being delivered, this variable contains the return path &--
11810 the sender field that will be sent as part of the envelope. It is not enclosed
11811 in <> characters. At the start of routing an address, &$return_path$& has the
11812 same value as &$sender_address$&, but if, for example, an incoming message to a
11813 mailing list has been expanded by a router which specifies a different address
11814 for bounce messages, &$return_path$& subsequently contains the new bounce
11815 address, whereas &$sender_address$& always contains the original sender address
11816 that was received with the message. In other words, &$sender_address$& contains
11817 the incoming envelope sender, and &$return_path$& contains the outgoing
11818 envelope sender.
11819
11820 .vitem &$return_size_limit$&
11821 .vindex "&$return_size_limit$&"
11822 This is an obsolete name for &$bounce_return_size_limit$&.
11823
11824 .vitem &$router_name$&
11825 .cindex "router" "name"
11826 .cindex "name" "of router"
11827 .vindex "&$router_name$&"
11828 During the running of a router this variable contains its name.
11829
11830 .vitem &$runrc$&
11831 .cindex "return code" "from &%run%& expansion"
11832 .vindex "&$runrc$&"
11833 This variable contains the return code from a command that is run by the
11834 &%${run...}%& expansion item. &*Warning*&: In a router or transport, you cannot
11835 assume the order in which option values are expanded, except for those
11836 preconditions whose order of testing is documented. Therefore, you cannot
11837 reliably expect to set &$runrc$& by the expansion of one option, and use it in
11838 another.
11839
11840 .vitem &$self_hostname$&
11841 .oindex "&%self%&" "value of host name"
11842 .vindex "&$self_hostname$&"
11843 When an address is routed to a supposedly remote host that turns out to be the
11844 local host, what happens is controlled by the &%self%& generic router option.
11845 One of its values causes the address to be passed to another router. When this
11846 happens, &$self_hostname$& is set to the name of the local host that the
11847 original router encountered. In other circumstances its contents are null.
11848
11849 .vitem &$sender_address$&
11850 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
11851 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the sender's address
11852 that was received in the message's envelope. The case of letters in the address
11853 is retained, in both the local part and the domain. For bounce messages, the
11854 value of this variable is the empty string. See also &$return_path$&.
11855
11856 .vitem &$sender_address_data$&
11857 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
11858 .vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
11859 If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify a
11860 sender address, the final value is preserved in &$sender_address_data$&, to
11861 distinguish it from data from a recipient address. The value does not persist
11862 after the end of the current ACL statement. If you want to preserve it for
11863 longer, you can save it in an ACL variable.
11864
11865 .vitem &$sender_address_domain$&
11866 .vindex "&$sender_address_domain$&"
11867 The domain portion of &$sender_address$&.
11868
11869 .vitem &$sender_address_local_part$&
11870 .vindex "&$sender_address_local_part$&"
11871 The local part portion of &$sender_address$&.
11872
11873 .vitem &$sender_data$&
11874 .vindex "&$sender_data$&"
11875 This variable is set after a lookup success in an ACL &%senders%& condition or
11876 in a router &%senders%& option. It contains the data from the lookup, and the
11877 value remains set until the next &%senders%& test. Thus, you can do things like
11878 this:
11879 .display
11880 &`require senders = cdb*@;/some/file`&
11881 &`deny `&&'some further test involving'& &`$sender_data`&
11882 .endd
11883 &*Warning*&: This variable is set only when a lookup is used as an indexing
11884 method in the address list, using the semicolon syntax as in the example above.
11885 The variable is not set for a lookup that is used as part of the string
11886 expansion that all such lists undergo before being interpreted.
11887
11888 .vitem &$sender_fullhost$&
11889 .vindex "&$sender_fullhost$&"
11890 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the host
11891 name and IP address in a single string. It ends with the IP address in square
11892 brackets, followed by a colon and a port number if the logging of ports is
11893 enabled. The format of the rest of the string depends on whether the host
11894 issued a HELO or EHLO SMTP command, and whether the host name was verified by
11895 looking up its IP address. (Looking up the IP address can be forced by the
11896 &%host_lookup%& option, independent of verification.) A plain host name at the
11897 start of the string is a verified host name; if this is not present,
11898 verification either failed or was not requested. A host name in parentheses is
11899 the argument of a HELO or EHLO command. This is omitted if it is identical to
11900 the verified host name or to the host's IP address in square brackets.
11901
11902 .vitem &$sender_helo_name$&
11903 .vindex "&$sender_helo_name$&"
11904 When a message is received from a remote host that has issued a HELO or EHLO
11905 command, the argument of that command is placed in this variable. It is also
11906 set if HELO or EHLO is used when a message is received using SMTP locally via
11907 the &%-bs%& or &%-bS%& options.
11908
11909 .vitem &$sender_host_address$&
11910 .vindex "&$sender_host_address$&"
11911 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains that
11912 host's IP address. For locally submitted messages, it is empty.
11913
11914 .vitem &$sender_host_authenticated$&
11915 .vindex "&$sender_host_authenticated$&"
11916 This variable contains the name (not the public name) of the authenticator
11917 driver that successfully authenticated the client from which the message was
11918 received. It is empty if there was no successful authentication. See also
11919 &$authenticated_id$&.
11920
11921 .vitem &$sender_host_dnssec$&
11922 .vindex "&$sender_host_dnssec$&"
11923 If &$sender_host_name$& has been populated (by reference, &%hosts_lookup%& or
11924 otherwise) then this boolean will have been set true if, and only if, the
11925 resolver library states that the reverse DNS was authenticated data. At all
11926 other times, this variable is false.
11927
11928 It is likely that you will need to coerce DNSSEC support on in the resolver
11929 library, by setting:
11930 .code
11931 dns_use_dnssec = 1
11932 .endd
11933
11934 Exim does not perform DNSSEC validation itself, instead leaving that to a
11935 validating resolver (eg, unbound, or bind with suitable configuration).
11936
11937 Exim does not (currently) check to see if the forward DNS was also secured
11938 with DNSSEC, only the reverse DNS.
11939
11940 If you have changed &%host_lookup_order%& so that &`bydns`& is not the first
11941 mechanism in the list, then this variable will be false.
11942
11943
11944 .vitem &$sender_host_name$&
11945 .vindex "&$sender_host_name$&"
11946 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the
11947 host's name as obtained by looking up its IP address. For messages received by
11948 other means, this variable is empty.
11949
11950 .vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
11951 If the host name has not previously been looked up, a reference to
11952 &$sender_host_name$& triggers a lookup (for messages from remote hosts).
11953 A looked up name is accepted only if it leads back to the original IP address
11954 via a forward lookup. If either the reverse or the forward lookup fails to find
11955 any data, or if the forward lookup does not yield the original IP address,
11956 &$sender_host_name$& remains empty, and &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&.
11957
11958 .vindex "&$host_lookup_deferred$&"
11959 However, if either of the lookups cannot be completed (for example, there is a
11960 DNS timeout), &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to &"1"&, and
11961 &$host_lookup_failed$& remains set to &"0"&.
11962
11963 Once &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&, Exim does not try to look up the
11964 host name again if there is a subsequent reference to &$sender_host_name$&
11965 in the same Exim process, but it does try again if &$host_lookup_deferred$&
11966 is set to &"1"&.
11967
11968 Exim does not automatically look up every calling host's name. If you want
11969 maximum efficiency, you should arrange your configuration so that it avoids
11970 these lookups altogether. The lookup happens only if one or more of the
11971 following are true:
11972
11973 .ilist
11974 A string containing &$sender_host_name$& is expanded.
11975 .next
11976 The calling host matches the list in &%host_lookup%&. In the default
11977 configuration, this option is set to *, so it must be changed if lookups are
11978 to be avoided. (In the code, the default for &%host_lookup%& is unset.)
11979 .next
11980 Exim needs the host name in order to test an item in a host list. The items
11981 that require this are described in sections &<<SECThoslispatnam>>& and
11982 &<<SECThoslispatnamsk>>&.
11983 .next
11984 The calling host matches &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& or &%helo_verify_hosts%&.
11985 In this case, the host name is required to compare with the name quoted in any
11986 EHLO or HELO commands that the client issues.
11987 .next
11988 The remote host issues a EHLO or HELO command that quotes one of the
11989 domains in &%helo_lookup_domains%&. The default value of this option is
11990 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
11991 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left.
11992 .code
11993 helo_lookup_domains = @ : @[]
11994 .endd
11995 which causes a lookup if a remote host (incorrectly) gives the server's name or
11996 IP address in an EHLO or HELO command.
11997 .endlist
11998
11999
12000 .vitem &$sender_host_port$&
12001 .vindex "&$sender_host_port$&"
12002 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the port
12003 number that was used on the remote host.
12004
12005 .vitem &$sender_ident$&
12006 .vindex "&$sender_ident$&"
12007 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the
12008 identification received in response to an RFC 1413 request. When a message has
12009 been received locally, this variable contains the login name of the user that
12010 called Exim.
12011
12012 .vitem &$sender_rate_$&&'xxx'&
12013 A number of variables whose names begin &$sender_rate_$& are set as part of the
12014 &%ratelimit%& ACL condition. Details are given in section
12015 &<<SECTratelimiting>>&.
12016
12017 .vitem &$sender_rcvhost$&
12018 .cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
12019 .cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
12020 .vindex "&$sender_rcvhost$&"
12021 This is provided specifically for use in &'Received:'& headers. It starts with
12022 either the verified host name (as obtained from a reverse DNS lookup) or, if
12023 there is no verified host name, the IP address in square brackets. After that
12024 there may be text in parentheses. When the first item is a verified host name,
12025 the first thing in the parentheses is the IP address in square brackets,
12026 followed by a colon and a port number if port logging is enabled. When the
12027 first item is an IP address, the port is recorded as &"port=&'xxxx'&"& inside
12028 the parentheses.
12029
12030 There may also be items of the form &"helo=&'xxxx'&"& if HELO or EHLO
12031 was used and its argument was not identical to the real host name or IP
12032 address, and &"ident=&'xxxx'&"& if an RFC 1413 ident string is available. If
12033 all three items are present in the parentheses, a newline and tab are inserted
12034 into the string, to improve the formatting of the &'Received:'& header.
12035
12036 .vitem &$sender_verify_failure$&
12037 .vindex "&$sender_verify_failure$&"
12038 In an ACL, when a sender verification fails, this variable contains information
12039 about the failure. The details are the same as for
12040 &$recipient_verify_failure$&.
12041
12042 .vitem &$sending_ip_address$&
12043 .vindex "&$sending_ip_address$&"
12044 This variable is set whenever an outgoing SMTP connection to another host has
12045 been set up. It contains the IP address of the local interface that is being
12046 used. This is useful if a host that has more than one IP address wants to take
12047 on different personalities depending on which one is being used. For incoming
12048 connections, see &$received_ip_address$&.
12049
12050 .vitem &$sending_port$&
12051 .vindex "&$sending_port$&"
12052 This variable is set whenever an outgoing SMTP connection to another host has
12053 been set up. It contains the local port that is being used. For incoming
12054 connections, see &$received_port$&.
12055
12056 .vitem &$smtp_active_hostname$&
12057 .vindex "&$smtp_active_hostname$&"
12058 During an incoming SMTP session, this variable contains the value of the active
12059 host name, as specified by the &%smtp_active_hostname%& option. The value of
12060 &$smtp_active_hostname$& is saved with any message that is received, so its
12061 value can be consulted during routing and delivery.
12062
12063 .vitem &$smtp_command$&
12064 .vindex "&$smtp_command$&"
12065 During the processing of an incoming SMTP command, this variable contains the
12066 entire command. This makes it possible to distinguish between HELO and EHLO in
12067 the HELO ACL, and also to distinguish between commands such as these:
12068 .code
12069 MAIL FROM:<>
12070 MAIL FROM: <>
12071 .endd
12072 For a MAIL command, extra parameters such as SIZE can be inspected. For a RCPT
12073 command, the address in &$smtp_command$& is the original address before any
12074 rewriting, whereas the values in &$local_part$& and &$domain$& are taken from
12075 the address after SMTP-time rewriting.
12076
12077 .vitem &$smtp_command_argument$&
12078 .cindex "SMTP" "command, argument for"
12079 .vindex "&$smtp_command_argument$&"
12080 While an ACL is running to check an SMTP command, this variable contains the
12081 argument, that is, the text that follows the command name, with leading white
12082 space removed. Following the introduction of &$smtp_command$&, this variable is
12083 somewhat redundant, but is retained for backwards compatibility.
12084
12085 .vitem &$smtp_count_at_connection_start$&
12086 .vindex "&$smtp_count_at_connection_start$&"
12087 This variable is set greater than zero only in processes spawned by the Exim
12088 daemon for handling incoming SMTP connections. The name is deliberately long,
12089 in order to emphasize what the contents are. When the daemon accepts a new
12090 connection, it increments this variable. A copy of the variable is passed to
12091 the child process that handles the connection, but its value is fixed, and
12092 never changes. It is only an approximation of how many incoming connections
12093 there actually are, because many other connections may come and go while a
12094 single connection is being processed. When a child process terminates, the
12095 daemon decrements its copy of the variable.
12096
12097 .vitem "&$sn0$& &-- &$sn9$&"
12098 These variables are copies of the values of the &$n0$& &-- &$n9$& accumulators
12099 that were current at the end of the system filter file. This allows a system
12100 filter file to set values that can be tested in users' filter files. For
12101 example, a system filter could set a value indicating how likely it is that a
12102 message is junk mail.
12103
12104 .vitem &$spam_$&&'xxx'&
12105 A number of variables whose names start with &$spam$& are available when Exim
12106 is compiled with the content-scanning extension. For details, see section
12107 &<<SECTscanspamass>>&.
12108
12109
12110 .vitem &$spool_directory$&
12111 .vindex "&$spool_directory$&"
12112 The name of Exim's spool directory.
12113
12114 .vitem &$spool_inodes$&
12115 .vindex "&$spool_inodes$&"
12116 The number of free inodes in the disk partition where Exim's spool files are
12117 being written. The value is recalculated whenever the variable is referenced.
12118 If the relevant file system does not have the concept of inodes, the value of
12119 is -1. See also the &%check_spool_inodes%& option.
12120
12121 .vitem &$spool_space$&
12122 .vindex "&$spool_space$&"
12123 The amount of free space (as a number of kilobytes) in the disk partition where
12124 Exim's spool files are being written. The value is recalculated whenever the
12125 variable is referenced. If the operating system does not have the ability to
12126 find the amount of free space (only true for experimental systems), the space
12127 value is -1. For example, to check in an ACL that there is at least 50
12128 megabytes free on the spool, you could write:
12129 .code
12130 condition = ${if > {$spool_space}{50000}}
12131 .endd
12132 See also the &%check_spool_space%& option.
12133
12134
12135 .vitem &$thisaddress$&
12136 .vindex "&$thisaddress$&"
12137 This variable is set only during the processing of the &%foranyaddress%&
12138 command in a filter file. Its use is explained in the description of that
12139 command, which can be found in the separate document entitled &'Exim's
12140 interfaces to mail filtering'&.
12141
12142 .vitem &$tls_in_bits$&
12143 .vindex "&$tls_in_bits$&"
12144 Contains an approximation of the TLS cipher's bit-strength
12145 on the inbound connection; the meaning of
12146 this depends upon the TLS implementation used.
12147 If TLS has not been negotiated, the value will be 0.
12148 The value of this is automatically fed into the Cyrus SASL authenticator
12149 when acting as a server, to specify the "external SSF" (a SASL term).
12150
12151 The deprecated &$tls_bits$& variable refers to the inbound side
12152 except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
12153 the outbound.
12154
12155 .vitem &$tls_out_bits$&
12156 .vindex "&$tls_out_bits$&"
12157 Contains an approximation of the TLS cipher's bit-strength
12158 on an outbound SMTP connection; the meaning of
12159 this depends upon the TLS implementation used.
12160 If TLS has not been negotiated, the value will be 0.
12161
12162 .vitem &$tls_in_certificate_verified$&
12163 .vindex "&$tls_in_certificate_verified$&"
12164 This variable is set to &"1"& if a TLS certificate was verified when the
12165 message was received, and &"0"& otherwise.
12166
12167 The deprecated &$tls_certificate_verfied$& variable refers to the inbound side
12168 except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
12169 the outbound.
12170
12171 .vitem &$tls_out_certificate_verified$&
12172 .vindex "&$tls_out_certificate_verified$&"
12173 This variable is set to &"1"& if a TLS certificate was verified when an
12174 outbound SMTP connection was made,
12175 and &"0"& otherwise.
12176
12177 .vitem &$tls_in_cipher$&
12178 .vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
12179 .vindex "&$tls_cipher$&"
12180 When a message is received from a remote host over an encrypted SMTP
12181 connection, this variable is set to the cipher suite that was negotiated, for
12182 example DES-CBC3-SHA. In other circumstances, in particular, for message
12183 received over unencrypted connections, the variable is empty. Testing
12184 &$tls_cipher$& for emptiness is one way of distinguishing between encrypted and
12185 non-encrypted connections during ACL processing.
12186
12187 The deprecated &$tls_cipher$& variable is the same as &$tls_in_cipher$& during message reception,
12188 but in the context of an outward SMTP delivery taking place via the &(smtp)& transport
12189 becomes the same as &$tls_out_cipher$&.
12190
12191 .vitem &$tls_out_cipher$&
12192 .vindex "&$tls_out_cipher$&"
12193 This variable is
12194 cleared before any outgoing SMTP connection is made,
12195 and then set to the outgoing cipher suite if one is negotiated. See chapter
12196 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS support and chapter &<<CHAPsmtptrans>>& for
12197 details of the &(smtp)& transport.
12198
12199 .vitem &$tls_in_peerdn$&
12200 .vindex "&$tls_in_peerdn$&"
12201 .vindex "&$tls_peerdn$&"
12202 When a message is received from a remote host over an encrypted SMTP
12203 connection, and Exim is configured to request a certificate from the client,
12204 the value of the Distinguished Name of the certificate is made available in the
12205 &$tls_in_peerdn$& during subsequent processing.
12206
12207 The deprecated &$tls_peerdn$& variable refers to the inbound side
12208 except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
12209 the outbound.
12210
12211 .vitem &$tls_out_peerdn$&
12212 .vindex "&$tls_out_peerdn$&"
12213 When a message is being delivered to a remote host over an encrypted SMTP
12214 connection, and Exim is configured to request a certificate from the server,
12215 the value of the Distinguished Name of the certificate is made available in the
12216 &$tls_out_peerdn$& during subsequent processing.
12217
12218 .vitem &$tls_in_sni$&
12219 .vindex "&$tls_in_sni$&"
12220 .vindex "&$tls_sni$&"
12221 .cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
12222 When a TLS session is being established, if the client sends the Server
12223 Name Indication extension, the value will be placed in this variable.
12224 If the variable appears in &%tls_certificate%& then this option and
12225 some others, described in &<<SECTtlssni>>&,
12226 will be re-expanded early in the TLS session, to permit
12227 a different certificate to be presented (and optionally a different key to be
12228 used) to the client, based upon the value of the SNI extension.
12229
12230 The deprecated &$tls_sni$& variable refers to the inbound side
12231 except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
12232 the outbound.
12233
12234 .vitem &$tls_out_sni$&
12235 .vindex "&$tls_out_sni$&"
12236 .cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
12237 During outbound
12238 SMTP deliveries, this variable reflects the value of the &%tls_sni%& option on
12239 the transport.
12240
12241 .vitem &$tod_bsdinbox$&
12242 .vindex "&$tod_bsdinbox$&"
12243 The time of day and the date, in the format required for BSD-style mailbox
12244 files, for example: Thu Oct 17 17:14:09 1995.
12245
12246 .vitem &$tod_epoch$&
12247 .vindex "&$tod_epoch$&"
12248 The time and date as a number of seconds since the start of the Unix epoch.
12249
12250 .vitem &$tod_epoch_l$&
12251 .vindex "&$tod_epoch_l$&"
12252 The time and date as a number of microseconds since the start of the Unix epoch.
12253
12254 .vitem &$tod_full$&
12255 .vindex "&$tod_full$&"
12256 A full version of the time and date, for example: Wed, 16 Oct 1995 09:51:40
12257 +0100. The timezone is always given as a numerical offset from UTC, with
12258 positive values used for timezones that are ahead (east) of UTC, and negative
12259 values for those that are behind (west).
12260
12261 .vitem &$tod_log$&
12262 .vindex "&$tod_log$&"
12263 The time and date in the format used for writing Exim's log files, for example:
12264 1995-10-12 15:32:29, but without a timezone.
12265
12266 .vitem &$tod_logfile$&
12267 .vindex "&$tod_logfile$&"
12268 This variable contains the date in the format yyyymmdd. This is the format that
12269 is used for datestamping log files when &%log_file_path%& contains the &`%D`&
12270 flag.
12271
12272 .vitem &$tod_zone$&
12273 .vindex "&$tod_zone$&"
12274 This variable contains the numerical value of the local timezone, for example:
12275 -0500.
12276
12277 .vitem &$tod_zulu$&
12278 .vindex "&$tod_zulu$&"
12279 This variable contains the UTC date and time in &"Zulu"& format, as specified
12280 by ISO 8601, for example: 20030221154023Z.
12281
12282 .vitem &$transport_name$&
12283 .cindex "transport" "name"
12284 .cindex "name" "of transport"
12285 .vindex "&$transport_name$&"
12286 During the running of a transport, this variable contains its name.
12287
12288 .vitem &$value$&
12289 .vindex "&$value$&"
12290 This variable contains the result of an expansion lookup, extraction operation,
12291 or external command, as described above. It is also used during a
12292 &*reduce*& expansion.
12293
12294 .vitem &$version_number$&
12295 .vindex "&$version_number$&"
12296 The version number of Exim.
12297
12298 .vitem &$warn_message_delay$&
12299 .vindex "&$warn_message_delay$&"
12300 This variable is set only during the creation of a message warning about a
12301 delivery delay. Details of its use are explained in section &<<SECTcustwarn>>&.
12302
12303 .vitem &$warn_message_recipients$&
12304 .vindex "&$warn_message_recipients$&"
12305 This variable is set only during the creation of a message warning about a
12306 delivery delay. Details of its use are explained in section &<<SECTcustwarn>>&.
12307 .endlist
12308 .ecindex IIDstrexp
12309
12310
12311
12312 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
12313 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
12314
12315 .chapter "Embedded Perl" "CHAPperl"
12316 .scindex IIDperl "Perl" "calling from Exim"
12317 Exim can be built to include an embedded Perl interpreter. When this is done,
12318 Perl subroutines can be called as part of the string expansion process. To make
12319 use of the Perl support, you need version 5.004 or later of Perl installed on
12320 your system. To include the embedded interpreter in the Exim binary, include
12321 the line
12322 .code
12323 EXIM_PERL = perl.o
12324 .endd
12325 in your &_Local/Makefile_& and then build Exim in the normal way.
12326
12327
12328 .section "Setting up so Perl can be used" "SECID85"
12329 .oindex "&%perl_startup%&"
12330 Access to Perl subroutines is via a global configuration option called
12331 &%perl_startup%& and an expansion string operator &%${perl ...}%&. If there is
12332 no &%perl_startup%& option in the Exim configuration file then no Perl
12333 interpreter is started and there is almost no overhead for Exim (since none of
12334 the Perl library will be paged in unless used). If there is a &%perl_startup%&
12335 option then the associated value is taken to be Perl code which is executed in
12336 a newly created Perl interpreter.
12337
12338 The value of &%perl_startup%& is not expanded in the Exim sense, so you do not
12339 need backslashes before any characters to escape special meanings. The option
12340 should usually be something like
12341 .code
12342 perl_startup = do '/etc/exim.pl'
12343 .endd
12344 where &_/etc/exim.pl_& is Perl code which defines any subroutines you want to
12345 use from Exim. Exim can be configured either to start up a Perl interpreter as
12346 soon as it is entered, or to wait until the first time it is needed. Starting
12347 the interpreter at the beginning ensures that it is done while Exim still has
12348 its setuid privilege, but can impose an unnecessary overhead if Perl is not in
12349 fact used in a particular run. Also, note that this does not mean that Exim is
12350 necessarily running as root when Perl is called at a later time. By default,
12351 the interpreter is started only when it is needed, but this can be changed in
12352 two ways:
12353
12354 .ilist
12355 .oindex "&%perl_at_start%&"
12356 Setting &%perl_at_start%& (a boolean option) in the configuration requests
12357 a startup when Exim is entered.
12358 .next
12359 The command line option &%-ps%& also requests a startup when Exim is entered,
12360 overriding the setting of &%perl_at_start%&.
12361 .endlist
12362
12363 There is also a command line option &%-pd%& (for delay) which suppresses the
12364 initial startup, even if &%perl_at_start%& is set.
12365
12366
12367 .section "Calling Perl subroutines" "SECID86"
12368 When the configuration file includes a &%perl_startup%& option you can make use
12369 of the string expansion item to call the Perl subroutines that are defined
12370 by the &%perl_startup%& code. The operator is used in any of the following
12371 forms:
12372 .code
12373 ${perl{foo}}
12374 ${perl{foo}{argument}}
12375 ${perl{foo}{argument1}{argument2} ... }
12376 .endd
12377 which calls the subroutine &%foo%& with the given arguments. A maximum of eight
12378 arguments may be passed. Passing more than this results in an expansion failure
12379 with an error message of the form
12380 .code
12381 Too many arguments passed to Perl subroutine "foo" (max is 8)
12382 .endd
12383 The return value of the Perl subroutine is evaluated in a scalar context before
12384 it is passed back to Exim to be inserted into the expanded string. If the
12385 return value is &'undef'&, the expansion is forced to fail in the same way as
12386 an explicit &"fail"& on an &%if%& or &%lookup%& item. If the subroutine aborts
12387 by obeying Perl's &%die%& function, the expansion fails with the error message
12388 that was passed to &%die%&.
12389
12390
12391 .section "Calling Exim functions from Perl" "SECID87"
12392 Within any Perl code called from Exim, the function &'Exim::expand_string()'&
12393 is available to call back into Exim's string expansion function. For example,
12394 the Perl code
12395 .code
12396 my $lp = Exim::expand_string('$local_part');
12397 .endd
12398 makes the current Exim &$local_part$& available in the Perl variable &$lp$&.
12399 Note those are single quotes and not double quotes to protect against
12400 &$local_part$& being interpolated as a Perl variable.
12401
12402 If the string expansion is forced to fail by a &"fail"& item, the result of
12403 &'Exim::expand_string()'& is &%undef%&. If there is a syntax error in the
12404 expansion string, the Perl call from the original expansion string fails with
12405 an appropriate error message, in the same way as if &%die%& were used.
12406
12407 .cindex "debugging" "from embedded Perl"
12408 .cindex "log" "writing from embedded Perl"
12409 Two other Exim functions are available for use from within Perl code.
12410 &'Exim::debug_write()'& writes a string to the standard error stream if Exim's
12411 debugging is enabled. If you want a newline at the end, you must supply it.
12412 &'Exim::log_write()'& writes a string to Exim's main log, adding a leading
12413 timestamp. In this case, you should not supply a terminating newline.
12414
12415
12416 .section "Use of standard output and error by Perl" "SECID88"
12417 .cindex "Perl" "standard output and error"
12418 You should not write to the standard error or output streams from within your
12419 Perl code, as it is not defined how these are set up. In versions of Exim
12420 before 4.50, it is possible for the standard output or error to refer to the
12421 SMTP connection during message reception via the daemon. Writing to this stream
12422 is certain to cause chaos. From Exim 4.50 onwards, the standard output and
12423 error streams are connected to &_/dev/null_& in the daemon. The chaos is
12424 avoided, but the output is lost.
12425
12426 .cindex "Perl" "use of &%warn%&"
12427 The Perl &%warn%& statement writes to the standard error stream by default.
12428 Calls to &%warn%& may be embedded in Perl modules that you use, but over which
12429 you have no control. When Exim starts up the Perl interpreter, it arranges for
12430 output from the &%warn%& statement to be written to the Exim main log. You can
12431 change this by including appropriate Perl magic somewhere in your Perl code.
12432 For example, to discard &%warn%& output completely, you need this:
12433 .code
12434 $SIG{__WARN__} = sub { };
12435 .endd
12436 Whenever a &%warn%& is obeyed, the anonymous subroutine is called. In this
12437 example, the code for the subroutine is empty, so it does nothing, but you can
12438 include any Perl code that you like. The text of the &%warn%& message is passed
12439 as the first subroutine argument.
12440 .ecindex IIDperl
12441
12442
12443 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
12444 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
12445
12446 .chapter "Starting the daemon and the use of network interfaces" &&&
12447 "CHAPinterfaces" &&&
12448 "Starting the daemon"
12449 .cindex "daemon" "starting"
12450 .cindex "interface" "listening"
12451 .cindex "network interface"
12452 .cindex "interface" "network"
12453 .cindex "IP address" "for listening"
12454 .cindex "daemon" "listening IP addresses"
12455 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening interfaces"
12456 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
12457 A host that is connected to a TCP/IP network may have one or more physical
12458 hardware network interfaces. Each of these interfaces may be configured as one
12459 or more &"logical"& interfaces, which are the entities that a program actually
12460 works with. Each of these logical interfaces is associated with an IP address.
12461 In addition, TCP/IP software supports &"loopback"& interfaces (127.0.0.1 in
12462 IPv4 and ::1 in IPv6), which do not use any physical hardware. Exim requires
12463 knowledge about the host's interfaces for use in three different circumstances:
12464
12465 .olist
12466 When a listening daemon is started, Exim needs to know which interfaces
12467 and ports to listen on.
12468 .next
12469 When Exim is routing an address, it needs to know which IP addresses
12470 are associated with local interfaces. This is required for the correct
12471 processing of MX lists by removing the local host and others with the
12472 same or higher priority values. Also, Exim needs to detect cases
12473 when an address is routed to an IP address that in fact belongs to the
12474 local host. Unless the &%self%& router option or the &%allow_localhost%&
12475 option of the smtp transport is set (as appropriate), this is treated
12476 as an error situation.
12477 .next
12478 When Exim connects to a remote host, it may need to know which interface to use
12479 for the outgoing connection.
12480 .endlist
12481
12482
12483 Exim's default behaviour is likely to be appropriate in the vast majority
12484 of cases. If your host has only one interface, and you want all its IP
12485 addresses to be treated in the same way, and you are using only the
12486 standard SMTP port, you should not need to take any special action. The
12487 rest of this chapter does not apply to you.
12488
12489 In a more complicated situation you may want to listen only on certain
12490 interfaces, or on different ports, and for this reason there are a number of
12491 options that can be used to influence Exim's behaviour. The rest of this
12492 chapter describes how they operate.
12493
12494 When a message is received over TCP/IP, the interface and port that were
12495 actually used are set in &$received_ip_address$& and &$received_port$&.
12496
12497
12498
12499 .section "Starting a listening daemon" "SECID89"
12500 When a listening daemon is started (by means of the &%-bd%& command line
12501 option), the interfaces and ports on which it listens are controlled by the
12502 following options:
12503
12504 .ilist
12505 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& contains a list of default ports. (For backward
12506 compatibility, this option can also be specified in the singular.)
12507 .next
12508 &%local_interfaces%& contains list of interface IP addresses on which to
12509 listen. Each item may optionally also specify a port.
12510 .endlist
12511
12512 The default list separator in both cases is a colon, but this can be changed as
12513 described in section &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&. When IPv6 addresses are involved,
12514 it is usually best to change the separator to avoid having to double all the
12515 colons. For example:
12516 .code
12517 local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; \
12518 192.168.23.65 ; \
12519 ::1 ; \
12520 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061
12521 .endd
12522 There are two different formats for specifying a port along with an IP address
12523 in &%local_interfaces%&:
12524
12525 .olist
12526 The port is added onto the address with a dot separator. For example, to listen
12527 on port 1234 on two different IP addresses:
12528 .code
12529 local_interfaces = <; 192.168.23.65.1234 ; \
12530 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061.1234
12531 .endd
12532 .next
12533 The IP address is enclosed in square brackets, and the port is added
12534 with a colon separator, for example:
12535 .code
12536 local_interfaces = <; [192.168.23.65]:1234 ; \
12537 [3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061]:1234
12538 .endd
12539 .endlist
12540
12541 When a port is not specified, the value of &%daemon_smtp_ports%& is used. The
12542 default setting contains just one port:
12543 .code
12544 daemon_smtp_ports = smtp
12545 .endd
12546 If more than one port is listed, each interface that does not have its own port
12547 specified listens on all of them. Ports that are listed in
12548 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& can be identified either by name (defined in
12549 &_/etc/services_&) or by number. However, when ports are given with individual
12550 IP addresses in &%local_interfaces%&, only numbers (not names) can be used.
12551
12552
12553
12554 .section "Special IP listening addresses" "SECID90"
12555 The addresses 0.0.0.0 and ::0 are treated specially. They are interpreted
12556 as &"all IPv4 interfaces"& and &"all IPv6 interfaces"&, respectively. In each
12557 case, Exim tells the TCP/IP stack to &"listen on all IPv&'x'& interfaces"&
12558 instead of setting up separate listening sockets for each interface. The
12559 default value of &%local_interfaces%& is
12560 .code
12561 local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0
12562 .endd
12563 when Exim is built without IPv6 support; otherwise it is:
12564 .code
12565 local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
12566 .endd
12567 Thus, by default, Exim listens on all available interfaces, on the SMTP port.
12568
12569
12570
12571 .section "Overriding local_interfaces and daemon_smtp_ports" "SECID91"
12572 The &%-oX%& command line option can be used to override the values of
12573 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& and/or &%local_interfaces%& for a particular daemon
12574 instance. Another way of doing this would be to use macros and the &%-D%&
12575 option. However, &%-oX%& can be used by any admin user, whereas modification of
12576 the runtime configuration by &%-D%& is allowed only when the caller is root or
12577 exim.
12578
12579 The value of &%-oX%& is a list of items. The default colon separator can be
12580 changed in the usual way if required. If there are any items that do not
12581 contain dots or colons (that is, are not IP addresses), the value of
12582 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& is replaced by the list of those items. If there are any
12583 items that do contain dots or colons, the value of &%local_interfaces%& is
12584 replaced by those items. Thus, for example,
12585 .code
12586 -oX 1225
12587 .endd
12588 overrides &%daemon_smtp_ports%&, but leaves &%local_interfaces%& unchanged,
12589 whereas
12590 .code
12591 -oX 192.168.34.5.1125
12592 .endd
12593 overrides &%local_interfaces%&, leaving &%daemon_smtp_ports%& unchanged.
12594 (However, since &%local_interfaces%& now contains no items without ports, the
12595 value of &%daemon_smtp_ports%& is no longer relevant in this example.)
12596
12597
12598
12599 .section "Support for the obsolete SSMTP (or SMTPS) protocol" "SECTsupobssmt"
12600 .cindex "ssmtp protocol"
12601 .cindex "smtps protocol"
12602 .cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
12603 .cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
12604 Exim supports the obsolete SSMTP protocol (also known as SMTPS) that was used
12605 before the STARTTLS command was standardized for SMTP. Some legacy clients
12606 still use this protocol. If the &%tls_on_connect_ports%& option is set to a
12607 list of port numbers, connections to those ports must use SSMTP. The most
12608 common use of this option is expected to be
12609 .code
12610 tls_on_connect_ports = 465
12611 .endd
12612 because 465 is the usual port number used by the legacy clients. There is also
12613 a command line option &%-tls-on-connect%&, which forces all ports to behave in
12614 this way when a daemon is started.
12615
12616 &*Warning*&: Setting &%tls_on_connect_ports%& does not of itself cause the
12617 daemon to listen on those ports. You must still specify them in
12618 &%daemon_smtp_ports%&, &%local_interfaces%&, or the &%-oX%& option. (This is
12619 because &%tls_on_connect_ports%& applies to &%inetd%& connections as well as to
12620 connections via the daemon.)
12621
12622
12623
12624
12625 .section "IPv6 address scopes" "SECID92"
12626 .cindex "IPv6" "address scopes"
12627 IPv6 addresses have &"scopes"&, and a host with multiple hardware interfaces
12628 can, in principle, have the same link-local IPv6 address on different
12629 interfaces. Thus, additional information is needed, over and above the IP
12630 address, to distinguish individual interfaces. A convention of using a
12631 percent sign followed by something (often the interface name) has been
12632 adopted in some cases, leading to addresses like this:
12633 .code
12634 fe80::202:b3ff:fe03:45c1%eth0
12635 .endd
12636 To accommodate this usage, a percent sign followed by an arbitrary string is
12637 allowed at the end of an IPv6 address. By default, Exim calls &[getaddrinfo()]&
12638 to convert a textual IPv6 address for actual use. This function recognizes the
12639 percent convention in operating systems that support it, and it processes the
12640 address appropriately. Unfortunately, some older libraries have problems with
12641 &[getaddrinfo()]&. If
12642 .code
12643 IPV6_USE_INET_PTON=yes
12644 .endd
12645 is set in &_Local/Makefile_& (or an OS-dependent Makefile) when Exim is built,
12646 Exim uses &'inet_pton()'& to convert a textual IPv6 address for actual use,
12647 instead of &[getaddrinfo()]&. (Before version 4.14, it always used this
12648 function.) Of course, this means that the additional functionality of
12649 &[getaddrinfo()]& &-- recognizing scoped addresses &-- is lost.
12650
12651 .section "Disabling IPv6" "SECID93"
12652 .cindex "IPv6" "disabling"
12653 Sometimes it happens that an Exim binary that was compiled with IPv6 support is
12654 run on a host whose kernel does not support IPv6. The binary will fall back to
12655 using IPv4, but it may waste resources looking up AAAA records, and trying to
12656 connect to IPv6 addresses, causing delays to mail delivery. If you set the
12657 .oindex "&%disable_ipv6%&"
12658 &%disable_ipv6%& option true, even if the Exim binary has IPv6 support, no IPv6
12659 activities take place. AAAA records are never looked up, and any IPv6 addresses
12660 that are listed in &%local_interfaces%&, data for the &(manualroute)& router,
12661 etc. are ignored. If IP literals are enabled, the &(ipliteral)& router declines
12662 to handle IPv6 literal addresses.
12663
12664 On the other hand, when IPv6 is in use, there may be times when you want to
12665 disable it for certain hosts or domains. You can use the &%dns_ipv4_lookup%&
12666 option to globally suppress the lookup of AAAA records for specified domains,
12667 and you can use the &%ignore_target_hosts%& generic router option to ignore
12668 IPv6 addresses in an individual router.
12669
12670
12671
12672 .section "Examples of starting a listening daemon" "SECID94"
12673 The default case in an IPv6 environment is
12674 .code
12675 daemon_smtp_ports = smtp
12676 local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
12677 .endd
12678 This specifies listening on the smtp port on all IPv6 and IPv4 interfaces.
12679 Either one or two sockets may be used, depending on the characteristics of
12680 the TCP/IP stack. (This is complicated and messy; for more information,
12681 read the comments in the &_daemon.c_& source file.)
12682
12683 To specify listening on ports 25 and 26 on all interfaces:
12684 .code
12685 daemon_smtp_ports = 25 : 26
12686 .endd
12687 (leaving &%local_interfaces%& at the default setting) or, more explicitly:
12688 .code
12689 local_interfaces = <; ::0.25 ; ::0.26 \
12690 0.0.0.0.25 ; 0.0.0.0.26
12691 .endd
12692 To listen on the default port on all IPv4 interfaces, and on port 26 on the
12693 IPv4 loopback address only:
12694 .code
12695 local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0 : 127.0.0.1.26
12696 .endd
12697 To specify listening on the default port on specific interfaces only:
12698 .code
12699 local_interfaces = 10.0.0.67 : 192.168.34.67
12700 .endd
12701 &*Warning*&: Such a setting excludes listening on the loopback interfaces.
12702
12703
12704
12705 .section "Recognizing the local host" "SECTreclocipadd"
12706 The &%local_interfaces%& option is also used when Exim needs to determine
12707 whether or not an IP address refers to the local host. That is, the IP
12708 addresses of all the interfaces on which a daemon is listening are always
12709 treated as local.
12710
12711 For this usage, port numbers in &%local_interfaces%& are ignored. If either of
12712 the items 0.0.0.0 or ::0 are encountered, Exim gets a complete list of
12713 available interfaces from the operating system, and extracts the relevant
12714 (that is, IPv4 or IPv6) addresses to use for checking.
12715
12716 Some systems set up large numbers of virtual interfaces in order to provide
12717 many virtual web servers. In this situation, you may want to listen for
12718 email on only a few of the available interfaces, but nevertheless treat all
12719 interfaces as local when routing. You can do this by setting
12720 &%extra_local_interfaces%& to a list of IP addresses, possibly including the
12721 &"all"& wildcard values. These addresses are recognized as local, but are not
12722 used for listening. Consider this example:
12723 .code
12724 local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; ::1 ; \
12725 192.168.53.235 ; \
12726 3ffe:2101:12:1:a00:20ff:fe86:a061
12727
12728 extra_local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
12729 .endd
12730 The daemon listens on the loopback interfaces and just one IPv4 and one IPv6
12731 address, but all available interface addresses are treated as local when
12732 Exim is routing.
12733
12734 In some environments the local host name may be in an MX list, but with an IP
12735 address that is not assigned to any local interface. In other cases it may be
12736 desirable to treat other host names as if they referred to the local host. Both
12737 these cases can be handled by setting the &%hosts_treat_as_local%& option.
12738 This contains host names rather than IP addresses. When a host is referenced
12739 during routing, either via an MX record or directly, it is treated as the local
12740 host if its name matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, or if any of its IP
12741 addresses match &%local_interfaces%& or &%extra_local_interfaces%&.
12742
12743
12744
12745 .section "Delivering to a remote host" "SECID95"
12746 Delivery to a remote host is handled by the smtp transport. By default, it
12747 allows the system's TCP/IP functions to choose which interface to use (if
12748 there is more than one) when connecting to a remote host. However, the
12749 &%interface%& option can be set to specify which interface is used. See the
12750 description of the smtp transport in chapter &<<CHAPsmtptrans>>& for more
12751 details.
12752
12753
12754
12755
12756 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
12757 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
12758
12759 .chapter "Main configuration" "CHAPmainconfig"
12760 .scindex IIDconfima "configuration file" "main section"
12761 .scindex IIDmaiconf "main configuration"
12762 The first part of the run time configuration file contains three types of item:
12763
12764 .ilist
12765 Macro definitions: These lines start with an upper case letter. See section
12766 &<<SECTmacrodefs>>& for details of macro processing.
12767 .next
12768 Named list definitions: These lines start with one of the words &"domainlist"&,
12769 &"hostlist"&, &"addresslist"&, or &"localpartlist"&. Their use is described in
12770 section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&.
12771 .next
12772 Main configuration settings: Each setting occupies one line of the file
12773 (with possible continuations). If any setting is preceded by the word
12774 &"hide"&, the &%-bP%& command line option displays its value to admin users
12775 only. See section &<<SECTcos>>& for a description of the syntax of these option
12776 settings.
12777 .endlist
12778
12779 This chapter specifies all the main configuration options, along with their
12780 types and default values. For ease of finding a particular option, they appear
12781 in alphabetical order in section &<<SECTalomo>>& below. However, because there
12782 are now so many options, they are first listed briefly in functional groups, as
12783 an aid to finding the name of the option you are looking for. Some options are
12784 listed in more than one group.
12785
12786 .section "Miscellaneous" "SECID96"
12787 .table2
12788 .row &%bi_command%& "to run for &%-bi%& command line option"
12789 .row &%disable_ipv6%& "do no IPv6 processing"
12790 .row &%keep_malformed%& "for broken files &-- should not happen"
12791 .row &%localhost_number%& "for unique message ids in clusters"
12792 .row &%message_body_newlines%& "retain newlines in &$message_body$&"
12793 .row &%message_body_visible%& "how much to show in &$message_body$&"
12794 .row &%mua_wrapper%& "run in &""MUA wrapper""& mode"
12795 .row &%print_topbitchars%& "top-bit characters are printing"
12796 .row &%timezone%& "force time zone"
12797 .endtable
12798
12799
12800 .section "Exim parameters" "SECID97"
12801 .table2
12802 .row &%exim_group%& "override compiled-in value"
12803 .row &%exim_path%& "override compiled-in value"
12804 .row &%exim_user%& "override compiled-in value"
12805 .row &%primary_hostname%& "default from &[uname()]&"
12806 .row &%split_spool_directory%& "use multiple directories"
12807 .row &%spool_directory%& "override compiled-in value"
12808 .endtable
12809
12810
12811
12812 .section "Privilege controls" "SECID98"
12813 .table2
12814 .row &%admin_groups%& "groups that are Exim admin users"
12815 .row &%deliver_drop_privilege%& "drop root for delivery processes"
12816 .row &%local_from_check%& "insert &'Sender:'& if necessary"
12817 .row &%local_from_prefix%& "for testing &'From:'& for local sender"
12818 .row &%local_from_suffix%& "for testing &'From:'& for local sender"
12819 .row &%local_sender_retain%& "keep &'Sender:'& from untrusted user"
12820 .row &%never_users%& "do not run deliveries as these"
12821 .row &%prod_requires_admin%& "forced delivery requires admin user"
12822 .row &%queue_list_requires_admin%& "queue listing requires admin user"
12823 .row &%trusted_groups%& "groups that are trusted"
12824 .row &%trusted_users%& "users that are trusted"
12825 .endtable
12826
12827
12828
12829 .section "Logging" "SECID99"
12830 .table2
12831 .row &%hosts_connection_nolog%& "exemption from connect logging"
12832 .row &%log_file_path%& "override compiled-in value"
12833 .row &%log_selector%& "set/unset optional logging"
12834 .row &%log_timezone%& "add timezone to log lines"
12835 .row &%message_logs%& "create per-message logs"
12836 .row &%preserve_message_logs%& "after message completion"
12837 .row &%process_log_path%& "for SIGUSR1 and &'exiwhat'&"
12838 .row &%syslog_duplication%& "controls duplicate log lines on syslog"
12839 .row &%syslog_facility%& "set syslog &""facility""& field"
12840 .row &%syslog_processname%& "set syslog &""ident""& field"
12841 .row &%syslog_timestamp%& "timestamp syslog lines"
12842 .row &%write_rejectlog%& "control use of message log"
12843 .endtable
12844
12845
12846
12847 .section "Frozen messages" "SECID100"
12848 .table2
12849 .row &%auto_thaw%& "sets time for retrying frozen messages"
12850 .row &%freeze_tell%& "send message when freezing"
12851 .row &%move_frozen_messages%& "to another directory"
12852 .row &%timeout_frozen_after%& "keep frozen messages only so long"
12853 .endtable
12854
12855
12856
12857 .section "Data lookups" "SECID101"
12858 .table2
12859 .row &%ibase_servers%& "InterBase servers"
12860 .row &%ldap_ca_cert_dir%& "dir of CA certs to verify LDAP server's"
12861 .row &%ldap_ca_cert_file%& "file of CA certs to verify LDAP server's"
12862 .row &%ldap_cert_file%& "client cert file for LDAP"
12863 .row &%ldap_cert_key%& "client key file for LDAP"
12864 .row &%ldap_cipher_suite%& "TLS negotiation preference control"
12865 .row &%ldap_default_servers%& "used if no server in query"
12866 .row &%ldap_require_cert%& "action to take without LDAP server cert"
12867 .row &%ldap_start_tls%& "require TLS within LDAP"
12868 .row &%ldap_version%& "set protocol version"
12869 .row &%lookup_open_max%& "lookup files held open"
12870 .row &%mysql_servers%& "default MySQL servers"
12871 .row &%oracle_servers%& "Oracle servers"
12872 .row &%pgsql_servers%& "default PostgreSQL servers"
12873 .row &%sqlite_lock_timeout%& "as it says"
12874 .endtable
12875
12876
12877
12878 .section "Message ids" "SECID102"
12879 .table2
12880 .row &%message_id_header_domain%& "used to build &'Message-ID:'& header"
12881 .row &%message_id_header_text%& "ditto"
12882 .endtable
12883
12884
12885
12886 .section "Embedded Perl Startup" "SECID103"
12887 .table2
12888 .row &%perl_at_start%& "always start the interpreter"
12889 .row &%perl_startup%& "code to obey when starting Perl"
12890 .endtable
12891
12892
12893
12894 .section "Daemon" "SECID104"
12895 .table2
12896 .row &%daemon_smtp_ports%& "default ports"
12897 .row &%daemon_startup_retries%& "number of times to retry"
12898 .row &%daemon_startup_sleep%& "time to sleep between tries"
12899 .row &%extra_local_interfaces%& "not necessarily listened on"
12900 .row &%local_interfaces%& "on which to listen, with optional ports"
12901 .row &%pid_file_path%& "override compiled-in value"
12902 .row &%queue_run_max%& "maximum simultaneous queue runners"
12903 .endtable
12904
12905
12906
12907 .section "Resource control" "SECID105"
12908 .table2
12909 .row &%check_log_inodes%& "before accepting a message"
12910 .row &%check_log_space%& "before accepting a message"
12911 .row &%check_spool_inodes%& "before accepting a message"
12912 .row &%check_spool_space%& "before accepting a message"
12913 .row &%deliver_queue_load_max%& "no queue deliveries if load high"
12914 .row &%queue_only_load%& "queue incoming if load high"
12915 .row &%queue_only_load_latch%& "don't re-evaluate load for each message"
12916 .row &%queue_run_max%& "maximum simultaneous queue runners"
12917 .row &%remote_max_parallel%& "parallel SMTP delivery per message"
12918 .row &%smtp_accept_max%& "simultaneous incoming connections"
12919 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& "non-mail commands"
12920 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%& "hosts to which the limit applies"
12921 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_connection%& "messages per connection"
12922 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& "connections from one host"
12923 .row &%smtp_accept_queue%& "queue mail if more connections"
12924 .row &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& "queue if more messages per &&&
12925 connection"
12926 .row &%smtp_accept_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if more connections"
12927 .row &%smtp_check_spool_space%& "from SIZE on MAIL command"
12928 .row &%smtp_connect_backlog%& "passed to TCP/IP stack"
12929 .row &%smtp_load_reserve%& "SMTP from reserved hosts if load high"
12930 .row &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& "these are the reserve hosts"
12931 .endtable
12932
12933
12934
12935 .section "Policy controls" "SECID106"
12936 .table2
12937 .row &%acl_not_smtp%& "ACL for non-SMTP messages"
12938 .row &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& "ACL for non-SMTP MIME parts"
12939 .row &%acl_not_smtp_start%& "ACL for start of non-SMTP message"
12940 .row &%acl_smtp_auth%& "ACL for AUTH"
12941 .row &%acl_smtp_connect%& "ACL for connection"
12942 .row &%acl_smtp_data%& "ACL for DATA"
12943 .row &%acl_smtp_dkim%& "ACL for DKIM verification"
12944 .row &%acl_smtp_etrn%& "ACL for ETRN"
12945 .row &%acl_smtp_expn%& "ACL for EXPN"
12946 .row &%acl_smtp_helo%& "ACL for EHLO or HELO"
12947 .row &%acl_smtp_mail%& "ACL for MAIL"
12948 .row &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& "ACL for AUTH on MAIL command"
12949 .row &%acl_smtp_mime%& "ACL for MIME parts"
12950 .row &%acl_smtp_predata%& "ACL for start of data"
12951 .row &%acl_smtp_quit%& "ACL for QUIT"
12952 .row &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& "ACL for RCPT"
12953 .row &%acl_smtp_starttls%& "ACL for STARTTLS"
12954 .row &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& "ACL for VRFY"
12955 .row &%av_scanner%& "specify virus scanner"
12956 .row &%check_rfc2047_length%& "check length of RFC 2047 &""encoded &&&
12957 words""&"
12958 .row &%dns_csa_search_limit%& "control CSA parent search depth"
12959 .row &%dns_csa_use_reverse%& "en/disable CSA IP reverse search"
12960 .row &%header_maxsize%& "total size of message header"
12961 .row &%header_line_maxsize%& "individual header line limit"
12962 .row &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& "allow syntactic junk from these hosts"
12963 .row &%helo_allow_chars%& "allow illegal chars in HELO names"
12964 .row &%helo_lookup_domains%& "lookup hostname for these HELO names"
12965 .row &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& "HELO soft-checked for these hosts"
12966 .row &%helo_verify_hosts%& "HELO hard-checked for these hosts"
12967 .row &%host_lookup%& "host name looked up for these hosts"
12968 .row &%host_lookup_order%& "order of DNS and local name lookups"
12969 .row &%host_reject_connection%& "reject connection from these hosts"
12970 .row &%hosts_treat_as_local%& "useful in some cluster configurations"
12971 .row &%local_scan_timeout%& "timeout for &[local_scan()]&"
12972 .row &%message_size_limit%& "for all messages"
12973 .row &%percent_hack_domains%& "recognize %-hack for these domains"
12974 .row &%spamd_address%& "set interface to SpamAssassin"
12975 .row &%strict_acl_vars%& "object to unset ACL variables"
12976 .endtable
12977
12978
12979
12980 .section "Callout cache" "SECID107"
12981 .table2
12982 .row &%callout_domain_negative_expire%& "timeout for negative domain cache &&&
12983 item"
12984 .row &%callout_domain_positive_expire%& "timeout for positive domain cache &&&
12985 item"
12986 .row &%callout_negative_expire%& "timeout for negative address cache item"
12987 .row &%callout_positive_expire%& "timeout for positive address cache item"
12988 .row &%callout_random_local_part%& "string to use for &""random""& testing"
12989 .endtable
12990
12991
12992
12993 .section "TLS" "SECID108"
12994 .table2
12995 .row &%gnutls_compat_mode%& "use GnuTLS compatibility mode"
12996 .row &%gnutls_allow_auto_pkcs11%& "allow GnuTLS to autoload PKCS11 modules"
12997 .row &%openssl_options%& "adjust OpenSSL compatibility options"
12998 .row &%tls_advertise_hosts%& "advertise TLS to these hosts"
12999 .row &%tls_certificate%& "location of server certificate"
13000 .row &%tls_crl%& "certificate revocation list"
13001 .row &%tls_dh_max_bits%& "clamp D-H bit count suggestion"
13002 .row &%tls_dhparam%& "DH parameters for server"
13003 .row &%tls_on_connect_ports%& "specify SSMTP (SMTPS) ports"
13004 .row &%tls_privatekey%& "location of server private key"
13005 .row &%tls_remember_esmtp%& "don't reset after starting TLS"
13006 .row &%tls_require_ciphers%& "specify acceptable ciphers"
13007 .row &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& "try to verify client certificate"
13008 .row &%tls_verify_certificates%& "expected client certificates"
13009 .row &%tls_verify_hosts%& "insist on client certificate verify"
13010 .endtable
13011
13012
13013
13014 .section "Local user handling" "SECID109"
13015 .table2
13016 .row &%finduser_retries%& "useful in NIS environments"
13017 .row &%gecos_name%& "used when creating &'Sender:'&"
13018 .row &%gecos_pattern%& "ditto"
13019 .row &%max_username_length%& "for systems that truncate"
13020 .row &%unknown_login%& "used when no login name found"
13021 .row &%unknown_username%& "ditto"
13022 .row &%uucp_from_pattern%& "for recognizing &""From ""& lines"
13023 .row &%uucp_from_sender%& "ditto"
13024 .endtable
13025
13026
13027
13028 .section "All incoming messages (SMTP and non-SMTP)" "SECID110"
13029 .table2
13030 .row &%header_maxsize%& "total size of message header"
13031 .row &%header_line_maxsize%& "individual header line limit"
13032 .row &%message_size_limit%& "applies to all messages"
13033 .row &%percent_hack_domains%& "recognize %-hack for these domains"
13034 .row &%received_header_text%& "expanded to make &'Received:'&"
13035 .row &%received_headers_max%& "for mail loop detection"
13036 .row &%recipients_max%& "limit per message"
13037 .row &%recipients_max_reject%& "permanently reject excess recipients"
13038 .endtable
13039
13040
13041
13042
13043 .section "Non-SMTP incoming messages" "SECID111"
13044 .table2
13045 .row &%receive_timeout%& "for non-SMTP messages"
13046 .endtable
13047
13048
13049
13050
13051
13052 .section "Incoming SMTP messages" "SECID112"
13053 See also the &'Policy controls'& section above.
13054
13055 .table2
13056 .row &%host_lookup%& "host name looked up for these hosts"
13057 .row &%host_lookup_order%& "order of DNS and local name lookups"
13058 .row &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& "may send unqualified recipients"
13059 .row &%rfc1413_hosts%& "make ident calls to these hosts"
13060 .row &%rfc1413_query_timeout%& "zero disables ident calls"
13061 .row &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& "may send unqualified senders"
13062 .row &%smtp_accept_keepalive%& "some TCP/IP magic"
13063 .row &%smtp_accept_max%& "simultaneous incoming connections"
13064 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& "non-mail commands"
13065 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%& "hosts to which the limit applies"
13066 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_connection%& "messages per connection"
13067 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& "connections from one host"
13068 .row &%smtp_accept_queue%& "queue mail if more connections"
13069 .row &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& "queue if more messages per &&&
13070 connection"
13071 .row &%smtp_accept_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if more connections"
13072 .row &%smtp_active_hostname%& "host name to use in messages"
13073 .row &%smtp_banner%& "text for welcome banner"
13074 .row &%smtp_check_spool_space%& "from SIZE on MAIL command"
13075 .row &%smtp_connect_backlog%& "passed to TCP/IP stack"
13076 .row &%smtp_enforce_sync%& "of SMTP command/responses"
13077 .row &%smtp_etrn_command%& "what to run for ETRN"
13078 .row &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& "only one at once"
13079 .row &%smtp_load_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if this load"
13080 .row &%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& "before dropping connection"
13081 .row &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& "apply ratelimiting to these hosts"
13082 .row &%smtp_ratelimit_mail%& "ratelimit for MAIL commands"
13083 .row &%smtp_ratelimit_rcpt%& "ratelimit for RCPT commands"
13084 .row &%smtp_receive_timeout%& "per command or data line"
13085 .row &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& "these are the reserve hosts"
13086 .row &%smtp_return_error_details%& "give detail on rejections"
13087 .endtable
13088
13089
13090
13091 .section "SMTP extensions" "SECID113"
13092 .table2
13093 .row &%accept_8bitmime%& "advertise 8BITMIME"
13094 .row &%auth_advertise_hosts%& "advertise AUTH to these hosts"
13095 .row &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& "allow &""From ""& from these hosts"
13096 .row &%ignore_fromline_local%& "allow &""From ""& from local SMTP"
13097 .row &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%& "advertise pipelining to these hosts"
13098 .row &%tls_advertise_hosts%& "advertise TLS to these hosts"
13099 .endtable
13100
13101
13102
13103 .section "Processing messages" "SECID114"
13104 .table2
13105 .row &%allow_domain_literals%& "recognize domain literal syntax"
13106 .row &%allow_mx_to_ip%& "allow MX to point to IP address"
13107 .row &%allow_utf8_domains%& "in addresses"
13108 .row &%check_rfc2047_length%& "check length of RFC 2047 &""encoded &&&
13109 words""&"
13110 .row &%delivery_date_remove%& "from incoming messages"
13111 .row &%envelope_to_remove%& "from incoming messages"
13112 .row &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& "affects &%-t%& processing"
13113 .row &%headers_charset%& "default for translations"
13114 .row &%qualify_domain%& "default for senders"
13115 .row &%qualify_recipient%& "default for recipients"
13116 .row &%return_path_remove%& "from incoming messages"
13117 .row &%strip_excess_angle_brackets%& "in addresses"
13118 .row &%strip_trailing_dot%& "at end of addresses"
13119 .row &%untrusted_set_sender%& "untrusted can set envelope sender"
13120 .endtable
13121
13122
13123
13124 .section "System filter" "SECID115"
13125 .table2
13126 .row &%system_filter%& "locate system filter"
13127 .row &%system_filter_directory_transport%& "transport for delivery to a &&&
13128 directory"
13129 .row &%system_filter_file_transport%& "transport for delivery to a file"
13130 .row &%system_filter_group%& "group for filter running"
13131 .row &%system_filter_pipe_transport%& "transport for delivery to a pipe"
13132 .row &%system_filter_reply_transport%& "transport for autoreply delivery"
13133 .row &%system_filter_user%& "user for filter running"
13134 .endtable
13135
13136
13137
13138 .section "Routing and delivery" "SECID116"
13139 .table2
13140 .row &%disable_ipv6%& "do no IPv6 processing"
13141 .row &%dns_again_means_nonexist%& "for broken domains"
13142 .row &%dns_check_names_pattern%& "pre-DNS syntax check"
13143 .row &%dns_ipv4_lookup%& "only v4 lookup for these domains"
13144 .row &%dns_retrans%& "parameter for resolver"
13145 .row &%dns_retry%& "parameter for resolver"
13146 .row &%dns_use_dnssec%& "parameter for resolver"
13147 .row &%dns_use_edns0%& "parameter for resolver"
13148 .row &%hold_domains%& "hold delivery for these domains"
13149 .row &%local_interfaces%& "for routing checks"
13150 .row &%queue_domains%& "no immediate delivery for these"
13151 .row &%queue_only%& "no immediate delivery at all"
13152 .row &%queue_only_file%& "no immediate delivery if file exists"
13153 .row &%queue_only_load%& "no immediate delivery if load is high"
13154 .row &%queue_only_load_latch%& "don't re-evaluate load for each message"
13155 .row &%queue_only_override%& "allow command line to override"
13156 .row &%queue_run_in_order%& "order of arrival"
13157 .row &%queue_run_max%& "of simultaneous queue runners"
13158 .row &%queue_smtp_domains%& "no immediate SMTP delivery for these"
13159 .row &%remote_max_parallel%& "parallel SMTP delivery per message"
13160 .row &%remote_sort_domains%& "order of remote deliveries"
13161 .row &%retry_data_expire%& "timeout for retry data"
13162 .row &%retry_interval_max%& "safety net for retry rules"
13163 .endtable
13164
13165
13166
13167 .section "Bounce and warning messages" "SECID117"
13168 .table2
13169 .row &%bounce_message_file%& "content of bounce"
13170 .row &%bounce_message_text%& "content of bounce"
13171 .row &%bounce_return_body%& "include body if returning message"
13172 .row &%bounce_return_message%& "include original message in bounce"
13173 .row &%bounce_return_size_limit%& "limit on returned message"
13174 .row &%bounce_sender_authentication%& "send authenticated sender with bounce"
13175 .row &%dsn_from%& "set &'From:'& contents in bounces"
13176 .row &%errors_copy%& "copy bounce messages"
13177 .row &%errors_reply_to%& "&'Reply-to:'& in bounces"
13178 .row &%delay_warning%& "time schedule"
13179 .row &%delay_warning_condition%& "condition for warning messages"
13180 .row &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%& "discard undeliverable bounces"
13181 .row &%smtp_return_error_details%& "give detail on rejections"
13182 .row &%warn_message_file%& "content of warning message"
13183 .endtable
13184
13185
13186
13187 .section "Alphabetical list of main options" "SECTalomo"
13188 Those options that undergo string expansion before use are marked with
13189 &dagger;.
13190
13191 .option accept_8bitmime main boolean true
13192 .cindex "8BITMIME"
13193 .cindex "8-bit characters"
13194 .cindex "log" "selectors"
13195 .cindex "log" "8BITMIME"
13196 This option causes Exim to send 8BITMIME in its response to an SMTP
13197 EHLO command, and to accept the BODY= parameter on MAIL commands.
13198 However, though Exim is 8-bit clean, it is not a protocol converter, and it
13199 takes no steps to do anything special with messages received by this route.
13200
13201 Historically Exim kept this option off by default, but the maintainers
13202 feel that in today's Internet, this causes more problems than it solves.
13203 It now defaults to true.
13204 A more detailed analysis of the issues is provided by Dan Bernstein:
13205 .display
13206 &url(http://cr.yp.to/smtp/8bitmime.html)
13207 .endd
13208
13209 To log received 8BITMIME status use
13210 .code
13211 log_selector = +8bitmime
13212 .endd
13213
13214 .option acl_not_smtp main string&!! unset
13215 .cindex "&ACL;" "for non-SMTP messages"
13216 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
13217 This option defines the ACL that is run when a non-SMTP message has been
13218 read and is on the point of being accepted. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for
13219 further details.
13220
13221 .option acl_not_smtp_mime main string&!! unset
13222 This option defines the ACL that is run for individual MIME parts of non-SMTP
13223 messages. It operates in exactly the same way as &%acl_smtp_mime%& operates for
13224 SMTP messages.
13225
13226 .option acl_not_smtp_start main string&!! unset
13227 .cindex "&ACL;" "at start of non-SMTP message"
13228 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
13229 This option defines the ACL that is run before Exim starts reading a
13230 non-SMTP message. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13231
13232 .option acl_smtp_auth main string&!! unset
13233 .cindex "&ACL;" "setting up for SMTP commands"
13234 .cindex "AUTH" "ACL for"
13235 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP AUTH command is
13236 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13237
13238 .option acl_smtp_connect main string&!! unset
13239 .cindex "&ACL;" "on SMTP connection"
13240 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP connection is received.
13241 See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13242
13243 .option acl_smtp_data main string&!! unset
13244 .cindex "DATA" "ACL for"
13245 This option defines the ACL that is run after an SMTP DATA command has been
13246 processed and the message itself has been received, but before the final
13247 acknowledgment is sent. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13248
13249 .option acl_smtp_etrn main string&!! unset
13250 .cindex "ETRN" "ACL for"
13251 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP ETRN command is
13252 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13253
13254 .option acl_smtp_expn main string&!! unset
13255 .cindex "EXPN" "ACL for"
13256 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP EXPN command is
13257 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13258
13259 .option acl_smtp_helo main string&!! unset
13260 .cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
13261 .cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
13262 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP EHLO or HELO
13263 command is received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13264
13265
13266 .option acl_smtp_mail main string&!! unset
13267 .cindex "MAIL" "ACL for"
13268 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP MAIL command is
13269 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13270
13271 .option acl_smtp_mailauth main string&!! unset
13272 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
13273 This option defines the ACL that is run when there is an AUTH parameter on
13274 a MAIL command. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for details of ACLs, and chapter
13275 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
13276
13277 .option acl_smtp_mime main string&!! unset
13278 .cindex "MIME content scanning" "ACL for"
13279 This option is available when Exim is built with the content-scanning
13280 extension. It defines the ACL that is run for each MIME part in a message. See
13281 section &<<SECTscanmimepart>>& for details.
13282
13283 .option acl_smtp_predata main string&!! unset
13284 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP DATA command is
13285 received, before the message itself is received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for
13286 further details.
13287
13288 .option acl_smtp_quit main string&!! unset
13289 .cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
13290 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP QUIT command is
13291 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13292
13293 .option acl_smtp_rcpt main string&!! unset
13294 .cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
13295 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP RCPT command is
13296 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13297
13298 .option acl_smtp_starttls main string&!! unset
13299 .cindex "STARTTLS, ACL for"
13300 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP STARTTLS command is
13301 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13302
13303 .option acl_smtp_vrfy main string&!! unset
13304 .cindex "VRFY" "ACL for"
13305 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP VRFY command is
13306 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13307
13308 .option admin_groups main "string list&!!" unset
13309 .cindex "admin user"
13310 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If the
13311 current group or any of the supplementary groups of an Exim caller is in this
13312 colon-separated list, the caller has admin privileges. If all your system
13313 programmers are in a specific group, for example, you can give them all Exim
13314 admin privileges by putting that group in &%admin_groups%&. However, this does
13315 not permit them to read Exim's spool files (whose group owner is the Exim gid).
13316 To permit this, you have to add individuals to the Exim group.
13317
13318 .option allow_domain_literals main boolean false
13319 .cindex "domain literal"
13320 If this option is set, the RFC 2822 domain literal format is permitted in
13321 email addresses. The option is not set by default, because the domain literal
13322 format is not normally required these days, and few people know about it. It
13323 has, however, been exploited by mail abusers.
13324
13325 Unfortunately, it seems that some DNS black list maintainers are using this
13326 format to report black listing to postmasters. If you want to accept messages
13327 addressed to your hosts by IP address, you need to set
13328 &%allow_domain_literals%& true, and also to add &`@[]`& to the list of local
13329 domains (defined in the named domain list &%local_domains%& in the default
13330 configuration). This &"magic string"& matches the domain literal form of all
13331 the local host's IP addresses.
13332
13333
13334 .option allow_mx_to_ip main boolean false
13335 .cindex "MX record" "pointing to IP address"
13336 It appears that more and more DNS zone administrators are breaking the rules
13337 and putting domain names that look like IP addresses on the right hand side of
13338 MX records. Exim follows the rules and rejects this, giving an error message
13339 that explains the mis-configuration. However, some other MTAs support this
13340 practice, so to avoid &"Why can't Exim do this?"& complaints,
13341 &%allow_mx_to_ip%& exists, in order to enable this heinous activity. It is not
13342 recommended, except when you have no other choice.
13343
13344 .option allow_utf8_domains main boolean false
13345 .cindex "domain" "UTF-8 characters in"
13346 .cindex "UTF-8" "in domain name"
13347 Lots of discussion is going on about internationalized domain names. One
13348 camp is strongly in favour of just using UTF-8 characters, and it seems
13349 that at least two other MTAs permit this. This option allows Exim users to
13350 experiment if they wish.
13351
13352 If it is set true, Exim's domain parsing function allows valid
13353 UTF-8 multicharacters to appear in domain name components, in addition to
13354 letters, digits, and hyphens. However, just setting this option is not
13355 enough; if you want to look up these domain names in the DNS, you must also
13356 adjust the value of &%dns_check_names_pattern%& to match the extended form. A
13357 suitable setting is:
13358 .code
13359 dns_check_names_pattern = (?i)^(?>(?(1)\.|())[a-z0-9\xc0-\xff]\
13360 (?>[-a-z0-9\x80-\xff]*[a-z0-9\x80-\xbf])?)+$
13361 .endd
13362 Alternatively, you can just disable this feature by setting
13363 .code
13364 dns_check_names_pattern =
13365 .endd
13366 That is, set the option to an empty string so that no check is done.
13367
13368
13369 .option auth_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
13370 .cindex "authentication" "advertising"
13371 .cindex "AUTH" "advertising"
13372 If any server authentication mechanisms are configured, Exim advertises them in
13373 response to an EHLO command only if the calling host matches this list.
13374 Otherwise, Exim does not advertise AUTH.
13375 Exim does not accept AUTH commands from clients to which it has not
13376 advertised the availability of AUTH. The advertising of individual
13377 authentication mechanisms can be controlled by the use of the
13378 &%server_advertise_condition%& generic authenticator option on the individual
13379 authenticators. See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for further details.
13380
13381 Certain mail clients (for example, Netscape) require the user to provide a name
13382 and password for authentication if AUTH is advertised, even though it may
13383 not be needed (the host may accept messages from hosts on its local LAN without
13384 authentication, for example). The &%auth_advertise_hosts%& option can be used
13385 to make these clients more friendly by excluding them from the set of hosts to
13386 which Exim advertises AUTH.
13387
13388 .cindex "AUTH" "advertising when encrypted"
13389 If you want to advertise the availability of AUTH only when the connection
13390 is encrypted using TLS, you can make use of the fact that the value of this
13391 option is expanded, with a setting like this:
13392 .code
13393 auth_advertise_hosts = ${if eq{$tls_in_cipher}{}{}{*}}
13394 .endd
13395 .vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
13396 If &$tls_in_cipher$& is empty, the session is not encrypted, and the result of
13397 the expansion is empty, thus matching no hosts. Otherwise, the result of the
13398 expansion is *, which matches all hosts.
13399
13400
13401 .option auto_thaw main time 0s
13402 .cindex "thawing messages"
13403 .cindex "unfreezing messages"
13404 If this option is set to a time greater than zero, a queue runner will try a
13405 new delivery attempt on any frozen message, other than a bounce message, if
13406 this much time has passed since it was frozen. This may result in the message
13407 being re-frozen if nothing has changed since the last attempt. It is a way of
13408 saying &"keep on trying, even though there are big problems"&.
13409
13410 &*Note*&: This is an old option, which predates &%timeout_frozen_after%& and
13411 &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&. It is retained for compatibility, but it is not
13412 thought to be very useful any more, and its use should probably be avoided.
13413
13414
13415 .option av_scanner main string "see below"
13416 This option is available if Exim is built with the content-scanning extension.
13417 It specifies which anti-virus scanner to use. The default value is:
13418 .code
13419 sophie:/var/run/sophie
13420 .endd
13421 If the value of &%av_scanner%& starts with a dollar character, it is expanded
13422 before use. See section &<<SECTscanvirus>>& for further details.
13423
13424
13425 .option bi_command main string unset
13426 .oindex "&%-bi%&"
13427 This option supplies the name of a command that is run when Exim is called with
13428 the &%-bi%& option (see chapter &<<CHAPcommandline>>&). The string value is
13429 just the command name, it is not a complete command line. If an argument is
13430 required, it must come from the &%-oA%& command line option.
13431
13432
13433 .option bounce_message_file main string unset
13434 .cindex "bounce message" "customizing"
13435 .cindex "customizing" "bounce message"
13436 This option defines a template file containing paragraphs of text to be used
13437 for constructing bounce messages. Details of the file's contents are given in
13438 chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&. See also &%warn_message_file%&.
13439
13440
13441 .option bounce_message_text main string unset
13442 When this option is set, its contents are included in the default bounce
13443 message immediately after &"This message was created automatically by mail
13444 delivery software."& It is not used if &%bounce_message_file%& is set.
13445
13446 .option bounce_return_body main boolean true
13447 .cindex "bounce message" "including body"
13448 This option controls whether the body of an incoming message is included in a
13449 bounce message when &%bounce_return_message%& is true. The default setting
13450 causes the entire message, both header and body, to be returned (subject to the
13451 value of &%bounce_return_size_limit%&). If this option is false, only the
13452 message header is included. In the case of a non-SMTP message containing an
13453 error that is detected during reception, only those header lines preceding the
13454 point at which the error was detected are returned.
13455 .cindex "bounce message" "including original"
13456
13457 .option bounce_return_message main boolean true
13458 If this option is set false, none of the original message is included in
13459 bounce messages generated by Exim. See also &%bounce_return_size_limit%& and
13460 &%bounce_return_body%&.
13461
13462
13463 .option bounce_return_size_limit main integer 100K
13464 .cindex "size" "of bounce, limit"
13465 .cindex "bounce message" "size limit"
13466 .cindex "limit" "bounce message size"
13467 This option sets a limit in bytes on the size of messages that are returned to
13468 senders as part of bounce messages when &%bounce_return_message%& is true. The
13469 limit should be less than the value of the global &%message_size_limit%& and of
13470 any &%message_size_limit%& settings on transports, to allow for the bounce text
13471 that Exim generates. If this option is set to zero there is no limit.
13472
13473 When the body of any message that is to be included in a bounce message is
13474 greater than the limit, it is truncated, and a comment pointing this out is
13475 added at the top. The actual cutoff may be greater than the value given, owing
13476 to the use of buffering for transferring the message in chunks (typically 8K in
13477 size). The idea is to save bandwidth on those undeliverable 15-megabyte
13478 messages.
13479
13480 .option bounce_sender_authentication main string unset
13481 .cindex "bounce message" "sender authentication"
13482 .cindex "authentication" "bounce message"
13483 .cindex "AUTH" "on bounce message"
13484 This option provides an authenticated sender address that is sent with any
13485 bounce messages generated by Exim that are sent over an authenticated SMTP
13486 connection. A typical setting might be:
13487 .code
13488 bounce_sender_authentication = mailer-daemon@my.domain.example
13489 .endd
13490 which would cause bounce messages to be sent using the SMTP command:
13491 .code
13492 MAIL FROM:<> AUTH=mailer-daemon@my.domain.example
13493 .endd
13494 The value of &%bounce_sender_authentication%& must always be a complete email
13495 address.
13496
13497 .option callout_domain_negative_expire main time 3h
13498 .cindex "caching" "callout timeouts"
13499 .cindex "callout" "caching timeouts"
13500 This option specifies the expiry time for negative callout cache data for a
13501 domain. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
13502 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
13503
13504
13505 .option callout_domain_positive_expire main time 7d
13506 This option specifies the expiry time for positive callout cache data for a
13507 domain. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
13508 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
13509
13510
13511 .option callout_negative_expire main time 2h
13512 This option specifies the expiry time for negative callout cache data for an
13513 address. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
13514 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
13515
13516
13517 .option callout_positive_expire main time 24h
13518 This option specifies the expiry time for positive callout cache data for an
13519 address. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
13520 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
13521
13522
13523 .option callout_random_local_part main string&!! "see below"
13524 This option defines the &"random"& local part that can be used as part of
13525 callout verification. The default value is
13526 .code
13527 $primary_hostname-$tod_epoch-testing
13528 .endd
13529 See section &<<CALLaddparcall>>& for details of how this value is used.
13530
13531
13532 .option check_log_inodes main integer 0
13533 See &%check_spool_space%& below.
13534
13535
13536 .option check_log_space main integer 0
13537 See &%check_spool_space%& below.
13538
13539 .oindex "&%check_rfc2047_length%&"
13540 .cindex "RFC 2047" "disabling length check"
13541 .option check_rfc2047_length main boolean true
13542 RFC 2047 defines a way of encoding non-ASCII characters in headers using a
13543 system of &"encoded words"&. The RFC specifies a maximum length for an encoded
13544 word; strings to be encoded that exceed this length are supposed to use
13545 multiple encoded words. By default, Exim does not recognize encoded words that
13546 exceed the maximum length. However, it seems that some software, in violation
13547 of the RFC, generates overlong encoded words. If &%check_rfc2047_length%& is
13548 set false, Exim recognizes encoded words of any length.
13549
13550
13551 .option check_spool_inodes main integer 0
13552 See &%check_spool_space%& below.
13553
13554
13555 .option check_spool_space main integer 0
13556 .cindex "checking disk space"
13557 .cindex "disk space, checking"
13558 .cindex "spool directory" "checking space"
13559 The four &%check_...%& options allow for checking of disk resources before a
13560 message is accepted.
13561
13562 .vindex "&$log_inodes$&"
13563 .vindex "&$log_space$&"
13564 .vindex "&$spool_inodes$&"
13565 .vindex "&$spool_space$&"
13566 When any of these options are set, they apply to all incoming messages. If you
13567 want to apply different checks to different kinds of message, you can do so by
13568 testing the variables &$log_inodes$&, &$log_space$&, &$spool_inodes$&, and
13569 &$spool_space$& in an ACL with appropriate additional conditions.
13570
13571
13572 &%check_spool_space%& and &%check_spool_inodes%& check the spool partition if
13573 either value is greater than zero, for example:
13574 .code
13575 check_spool_space = 10M
13576 check_spool_inodes = 100
13577 .endd
13578 The spool partition is the one that contains the directory defined by
13579 SPOOL_DIRECTORY in &_Local/Makefile_&. It is used for holding messages in
13580 transit.
13581
13582 &%check_log_space%& and &%check_log_inodes%& check the partition in which log
13583 files are written if either is greater than zero. These should be set only if
13584 &%log_file_path%& and &%spool_directory%& refer to different partitions.
13585
13586 If there is less space or fewer inodes than requested, Exim refuses to accept
13587 incoming mail. In the case of SMTP input this is done by giving a 452 temporary
13588 error response to the MAIL command. If ESMTP is in use and there was a
13589 SIZE parameter on the MAIL command, its value is added to the
13590 &%check_spool_space%& value, and the check is performed even if
13591 &%check_spool_space%& is zero, unless &%no_smtp_check_spool_space%& is set.
13592
13593 The values for &%check_spool_space%& and &%check_log_space%& are held as a
13594 number of kilobytes. If a non-multiple of 1024 is specified, it is rounded up.
13595
13596 For non-SMTP input and for batched SMTP input, the test is done at start-up; on
13597 failure a message is written to stderr and Exim exits with a non-zero code, as
13598 it obviously cannot send an error message of any kind.
13599
13600 .option daemon_smtp_ports main string &`smtp`&
13601 .cindex "port" "for daemon"
13602 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
13603 This option specifies one or more default SMTP ports on which the Exim daemon
13604 listens. See chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>& for details of how it is used. For
13605 backward compatibility, &%daemon_smtp_port%& (singular) is a synonym.
13606
13607 .option daemon_startup_retries main integer 9
13608 .cindex "daemon startup, retrying"
13609 This option, along with &%daemon_startup_sleep%&, controls the retrying done by
13610 the daemon at startup when it cannot immediately bind a listening socket
13611 (typically because the socket is already in use): &%daemon_startup_retries%&
13612 defines the number of retries after the first failure, and
13613 &%daemon_startup_sleep%& defines the length of time to wait between retries.
13614
13615 .option daemon_startup_sleep main time 30s
13616 See &%daemon_startup_retries%&.
13617
13618 .option delay_warning main "time list" 24h
13619 .cindex "warning of delay"
13620 .cindex "delay warning, specifying"
13621 When a message is delayed, Exim sends a warning message to the sender at
13622 intervals specified by this option. The data is a colon-separated list of times
13623 after which to send warning messages. If the value of the option is an empty
13624 string or a zero time, no warnings are sent. Up to 10 times may be given. If a
13625 message has been on the queue for longer than the last time, the last interval
13626 between the times is used to compute subsequent warning times. For example,
13627 with
13628 .code
13629 delay_warning = 4h:8h:24h
13630 .endd
13631 the first message is sent after 4 hours, the second after 8 hours, and
13632 the third one after 24 hours. After that, messages are sent every 16 hours,
13633 because that is the interval between the last two times on the list. If you set
13634 just one time, it specifies the repeat interval. For example, with:
13635 .code
13636 delay_warning = 6h
13637 .endd
13638 messages are repeated every six hours. To stop warnings after a given time, set
13639 a very large time at the end of the list. For example:
13640 .code
13641 delay_warning = 2h:12h:99d
13642 .endd
13643
13644 .option delay_warning_condition main string&!! "see below"
13645 .vindex "&$domain$&"
13646 The string is expanded at the time a warning message might be sent. If all the
13647 deferred addresses have the same domain, it is set in &$domain$& during the
13648 expansion. Otherwise &$domain$& is empty. If the result of the expansion is a
13649 forced failure, an empty string, or a string matching any of &"0"&, &"no"& or
13650 &"false"& (the comparison being done caselessly) then the warning message is
13651 not sent. The default is:
13652 .code
13653 delay_warning_condition = ${if or {\
13654 { !eq{$h_list-id:$h_list-post:$h_list-subscribe:}{} }\
13655 { match{$h_precedence:}{(?i)bulk|list|junk} }\
13656 { match{$h_auto-submitted:}{(?i)auto-generated|auto-replied} }\
13657 } {no}{yes}}
13658 .endd
13659 This suppresses the sending of warnings for messages that contain &'List-ID:'&,
13660 &'List-Post:'&, or &'List-Subscribe:'& headers, or have &"bulk"&, &"list"& or
13661 &"junk"& in a &'Precedence:'& header, or have &"auto-generated"& or
13662 &"auto-replied"& in an &'Auto-Submitted:'& header.
13663
13664 .option deliver_drop_privilege main boolean false
13665 .cindex "unprivileged delivery"
13666 .cindex "delivery" "unprivileged"
13667 If this option is set true, Exim drops its root privilege at the start of a
13668 delivery process, and runs as the Exim user throughout. This severely restricts
13669 the kinds of local delivery that are possible, but is viable in certain types
13670 of configuration. There is a discussion about the use of root privilege in
13671 chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>&.
13672
13673 .option deliver_queue_load_max main fixed-point unset
13674 .cindex "load average"
13675 .cindex "queue runner" "abandoning"
13676 When this option is set, a queue run is abandoned if the system load average
13677 becomes greater than the value of the option. The option has no effect on
13678 ancient operating systems on which Exim cannot determine the load average.
13679 See also &%queue_only_load%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%&.
13680
13681
13682 .option delivery_date_remove main boolean true
13683 .cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
13684 Exim's transports have an option for adding a &'Delivery-date:'& header to a
13685 message when it is delivered, in exactly the same way as &'Return-path:'& is
13686 handled. &'Delivery-date:'& records the actual time of delivery. Such headers
13687 should not be present in incoming messages, and this option causes them to be
13688 removed at the time the message is received, to avoid any problems that might
13689 occur when a delivered message is subsequently sent on to some other recipient.
13690
13691 .option disable_fsync main boolean false
13692 .cindex "&[fsync()]&, disabling"
13693 This option is available only if Exim was built with the compile-time option
13694 ENABLE_DISABLE_FSYNC. When this is not set, a reference to &%disable_fsync%& in
13695 a runtime configuration generates an &"unknown option"& error. You should not
13696 build Exim with ENABLE_DISABLE_FSYNC or set &%disable_fsync%& unless you
13697 really, really, really understand what you are doing. &'No pre-compiled
13698 distributions of Exim should ever make this option available.'&
13699
13700 When &%disable_fsync%& is set true, Exim no longer calls &[fsync()]& to force
13701 updated files' data to be written to disc before continuing. Unexpected events
13702 such as crashes and power outages may cause data to be lost or scrambled.
13703 Here be Dragons. &*Beware.*&
13704
13705
13706 .option disable_ipv6 main boolean false
13707 .cindex "IPv6" "disabling"
13708 If this option is set true, even if the Exim binary has IPv6 support, no IPv6
13709 activities take place. AAAA records are never looked up, and any IPv6 addresses
13710 that are listed in &%local_interfaces%&, data for the &%manualroute%& router,
13711 etc. are ignored. If IP literals are enabled, the &(ipliteral)& router declines
13712 to handle IPv6 literal addresses.
13713
13714
13715 .option dns_again_means_nonexist main "domain list&!!" unset
13716 .cindex "DNS" "&""try again""& response; overriding"
13717 DNS lookups give a &"try again"& response for the DNS errors
13718 &"non-authoritative host not found"& and &"SERVERFAIL"&. This can cause Exim to
13719 keep trying to deliver a message, or to give repeated temporary errors to
13720 incoming mail. Sometimes the effect is caused by a badly set up name server and
13721 may persist for a long time. If a domain which exhibits this problem matches
13722 anything in &%dns_again_means_nonexist%&, it is treated as if it did not exist.
13723 This option should be used with care. You can make it apply to reverse lookups
13724 by a setting such as this:
13725 .code
13726 dns_again_means_nonexist = *.in-addr.arpa
13727 .endd
13728 This option applies to all DNS lookups that Exim does. It also applies when the
13729 &[gethostbyname()]& or &[getipnodebyname()]& functions give temporary errors,
13730 since these are most likely to be caused by DNS lookup problems. The
13731 &(dnslookup)& router has some options of its own for controlling what happens
13732 when lookups for MX or SRV records give temporary errors. These more specific
13733 options are applied after this global option.
13734
13735 .option dns_check_names_pattern main string "see below"
13736 .cindex "DNS" "pre-check of name syntax"
13737 When this option is set to a non-empty string, it causes Exim to check domain
13738 names for characters that are not allowed in host names before handing them to
13739 the DNS resolver, because some resolvers give temporary errors for names that
13740 contain unusual characters. If a domain name contains any unwanted characters,
13741 a &"not found"& result is forced, and the resolver is not called. The check is
13742 done by matching the domain name against a regular expression, which is the
13743 value of this option. The default pattern is
13744 .code
13745 dns_check_names_pattern = \
13746 (?i)^(?>(?(1)\.|())[^\W_](?>[a-z0-9/-]*[^\W_])?)+$
13747 .endd
13748 which permits only letters, digits, slashes, and hyphens in components, but
13749 they must start and end with a letter or digit. Slashes are not, in fact,
13750 permitted in host names, but they are found in certain NS records (which can be
13751 accessed in Exim by using a &%dnsdb%& lookup). If you set
13752 &%allow_utf8_domains%&, you must modify this pattern, or set the option to an
13753 empty string.
13754
13755 .option dns_csa_search_limit main integer 5
13756 This option controls the depth of parental searching for CSA SRV records in the
13757 DNS, as described in more detail in section &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
13758
13759 .option dns_csa_use_reverse main boolean true
13760 This option controls whether or not an IP address, given as a CSA domain, is
13761 reversed and looked up in the reverse DNS, as described in more detail in
13762 section &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
13763
13764 .option dns_ipv4_lookup main "domain list&!!" unset
13765 .cindex "IPv6" "DNS lookup for AAAA records"
13766 .cindex "DNS" "IPv6 lookup for AAAA records"
13767 When Exim is compiled with IPv6 support and &%disable_ipv6%& is not set, it
13768 looks for IPv6 address records (AAAA records) as well as IPv4 address records
13769 (A records) when trying to find IP addresses for hosts, unless the host's
13770 domain matches this list.
13771
13772 This is a fudge to help with name servers that give big delays or otherwise do
13773 not work for the AAAA record type. In due course, when the world's name
13774 servers have all been upgraded, there should be no need for this option.
13775
13776
13777 .option dns_retrans main time 0s
13778 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
13779 The options &%dns_retrans%& and &%dns_retry%& can be used to set the
13780 retransmission and retry parameters for DNS lookups. Values of zero (the
13781 defaults) leave the system default settings unchanged. The first value is the
13782 time between retries, and the second is the number of retries. It isn't
13783 totally clear exactly how these settings affect the total time a DNS lookup may
13784 take. I haven't found any documentation about timeouts on DNS lookups; these
13785 parameter values are available in the external resolver interface structure,
13786 but nowhere does it seem to describe how they are used or what you might want
13787 to set in them.
13788
13789
13790 .option dns_retry main integer 0
13791 See &%dns_retrans%& above.
13792
13793
13794 .option dns_use_dnssec main integer -1
13795 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
13796 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
13797 If this option is set to a non-negative number then Exim will initialise the
13798 DNS resolver library to either use or not use DNSSEC, overriding the system
13799 default. A value of 0 coerces DNSSEC off, a value of 1 coerces DNSSEC on.
13800
13801 If the resolver library does not support DNSSEC then this option has no effect.
13802
13803
13804 .option dns_use_edns0 main integer -1
13805 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
13806 .cindex "DNS" "EDNS0"
13807 If this option is set to a non-negative number then Exim will initialise the
13808 DNS resolver library to either use or not use EDNS0 extensions, overriding
13809 the system default. A value of 0 coerces EDNS0 off, a value of 1 coerces EDNS0
13810 on.
13811
13812 If the resolver library does not support EDNS0 then this option has no effect.
13813
13814
13815 .option drop_cr main boolean false
13816 This is an obsolete option that is now a no-op. It used to affect the way Exim
13817 handled CR and LF characters in incoming messages. What happens now is
13818 described in section &<<SECTlineendings>>&.
13819
13820 .option dsn_from main "string&!!" "see below"
13821 .cindex "&'From:'& header line" "in bounces"
13822 .cindex "bounce messages" "&'From:'& line, specifying"
13823 This option can be used to vary the contents of &'From:'& header lines in
13824 bounces and other automatically generated messages (&"Delivery Status
13825 Notifications"& &-- hence the name of the option). The default setting is:
13826 .code
13827 dsn_from = Mail Delivery System <Mailer-Daemon@$qualify_domain>
13828 .endd
13829 The value is expanded every time it is needed. If the expansion fails, a
13830 panic is logged, and the default value is used.
13831
13832 .option envelope_to_remove main boolean true
13833 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
13834 Exim's transports have an option for adding an &'Envelope-to:'& header to a
13835 message when it is delivered, in exactly the same way as &'Return-path:'& is
13836 handled. &'Envelope-to:'& records the original recipient address from the
13837 messages's envelope that caused the delivery to happen. Such headers should not
13838 be present in incoming messages, and this option causes them to be removed at
13839 the time the message is received, to avoid any problems that might occur when a
13840 delivered message is subsequently sent on to some other recipient.
13841
13842
13843 .option errors_copy main "string list&!!" unset
13844 .cindex "bounce message" "copy to other address"
13845 .cindex "copy of bounce message"
13846 Setting this option causes Exim to send bcc copies of bounce messages that it
13847 generates to other addresses. &*Note*&: This does not apply to bounce messages
13848 coming from elsewhere. The value of the option is a colon-separated list of
13849 items. Each item consists of a pattern, terminated by white space, followed by
13850 a comma-separated list of email addresses. If a pattern contains spaces, it
13851 must be enclosed in double quotes.
13852
13853 Each pattern is processed in the same way as a single item in an address list
13854 (see section &<<SECTaddresslist>>&). When a pattern matches the recipient of
13855 the bounce message, the message is copied to the addresses on the list. The
13856 items are scanned in order, and once a matching one is found, no further items
13857 are examined. For example:
13858 .code
13859 errors_copy = spqr@mydomain postmaster@mydomain.example :\
13860 rqps@mydomain hostmaster@mydomain.example,\
13861 postmaster@mydomain.example
13862 .endd
13863 .vindex "&$domain$&"
13864 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
13865 The address list is expanded before use. The expansion variables &$local_part$&
13866 and &$domain$& are set from the original recipient of the error message, and if
13867 there was any wildcard matching in the pattern, the expansion
13868 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%errors_copy%&"
13869 variables &$0$&, &$1$&, etc. are set in the normal way.
13870
13871
13872 .option errors_reply_to main string unset
13873 .cindex "bounce message" "&'Reply-to:'& in"
13874 By default, Exim's bounce and delivery warning messages contain the header line
13875 .display
13876 &`From: Mail Delivery System <Mailer-Daemon@`&&'qualify-domain'&&`>`&
13877 .endd
13878 .oindex &%quota_warn_message%&
13879 where &'qualify-domain'& is the value of the &%qualify_domain%& option.
13880 A warning message that is generated by the &%quota_warn_message%& option in an
13881 &(appendfile)& transport may contain its own &'From:'& header line that
13882 overrides the default.
13883
13884 Experience shows that people reply to bounce messages. If the
13885 &%errors_reply_to%& option is set, a &'Reply-To:'& header is added to bounce
13886 and warning messages. For example:
13887 .code
13888 errors_reply_to = postmaster@my.domain.example
13889 .endd
13890 The value of the option is not expanded. It must specify a valid RFC 2822
13891 address. However, if a warning message that is generated by the
13892 &%quota_warn_message%& option in an &(appendfile)& transport contain its
13893 own &'Reply-To:'& header line, the value of the &%errors_reply_to%& option is
13894 not used.
13895
13896
13897 .option exim_group main string "compile-time configured"
13898 .cindex "gid (group id)" "Exim's own"
13899 .cindex "Exim group"
13900 This option changes the gid under which Exim runs when it gives up root
13901 privilege. The default value is compiled into the binary. The value of this
13902 option is used only when &%exim_user%& is also set. Unless it consists entirely
13903 of digits, the string is looked up using &[getgrnam()]&, and failure causes a
13904 configuration error. See chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for a discussion of
13905 security issues.
13906
13907
13908 .option exim_path main string "see below"
13909 .cindex "Exim binary, path name"
13910 This option specifies the path name of the Exim binary, which is used when Exim
13911 needs to re-exec itself. The default is set up to point to the file &'exim'& in
13912 the directory configured at compile time by the BIN_DIRECTORY setting. It
13913 is necessary to change &%exim_path%& if, exceptionally, Exim is run from some
13914 other place.
13915 &*Warning*&: Do not use a macro to define the value of this option, because
13916 you will break those Exim utilities that scan the configuration file to find
13917 where the binary is. (They then use the &%-bP%& option to extract option
13918 settings such as the value of &%spool_directory%&.)
13919
13920
13921 .option exim_user main string "compile-time configured"
13922 .cindex "uid (user id)" "Exim's own"
13923 .cindex "Exim user"
13924 This option changes the uid under which Exim runs when it gives up root
13925 privilege. The default value is compiled into the binary. Ownership of the run
13926 time configuration file and the use of the &%-C%& and &%-D%& command line
13927 options is checked against the values in the binary, not what is set here.
13928
13929 Unless it consists entirely of digits, the string is looked up using
13930 &[getpwnam()]&, and failure causes a configuration error. If &%exim_group%& is
13931 not also supplied, the gid is taken from the result of &[getpwnam()]& if it is
13932 used. See chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for a discussion of security issues.
13933
13934
13935 .option extra_local_interfaces main "string list" unset
13936 This option defines network interfaces that are to be considered local when
13937 routing, but which are not used for listening by the daemon. See section
13938 &<<SECTreclocipadd>>& for details.
13939
13940
13941 . Allow this long option name to split; give it unsplit as a fifth argument
13942 . for the automatic .oindex that is generated by .option.
13943
13944 .option "extract_addresses_remove_ &~&~arguments" main boolean true &&&
13945 extract_addresses_remove_arguments
13946 .oindex "&%-t%&"
13947 .cindex "command line" "addresses with &%-t%&"
13948 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-t%& option"
13949 According to some Sendmail documentation (Sun, IRIX, HP-UX), if any addresses
13950 are present on the command line when the &%-t%& option is used to build an
13951 envelope from a message's &'To:'&, &'Cc:'& and &'Bcc:'& headers, the command
13952 line addresses are removed from the recipients list. This is also how Smail
13953 behaves. However, other Sendmail documentation (the O'Reilly book) states that
13954 command line addresses are added to those obtained from the header lines. When
13955 &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& is true (the default), Exim subtracts
13956 argument headers. If it is set false, Exim adds rather than removes argument
13957 addresses.
13958
13959
13960 .option finduser_retries main integer 0
13961 .cindex "NIS, retrying user lookups"
13962 On systems running NIS or other schemes in which user and group information is
13963 distributed from a remote system, there can be times when &[getpwnam()]& and
13964 related functions fail, even when given valid data, because things time out.
13965 Unfortunately these failures cannot be distinguished from genuine &"not found"&
13966 errors. If &%finduser_retries%& is set greater than zero, Exim will try that
13967 many extra times to find a user or a group, waiting for one second between
13968 retries.
13969
13970 .cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&" "multiple reading of"
13971 You should not set this option greater than zero if your user information is in
13972 a traditional &_/etc/passwd_& file, because it will cause Exim needlessly to
13973 search the file multiple times for non-existent users, and also cause delay.
13974
13975
13976
13977 .option freeze_tell main "string list, comma separated" unset
13978 .cindex "freezing messages" "sending a message when freezing"
13979 On encountering certain errors, or when configured to do so in a system filter,
13980 ACL, or special router, Exim freezes a message. This means that no further
13981 delivery attempts take place until an administrator thaws the message, or the
13982 &%auto_thaw%&, &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&, or &%timeout_frozen_after%&
13983 feature cause it to be processed. If &%freeze_tell%& is set, Exim generates a
13984 warning message whenever it freezes something, unless the message it is
13985 freezing is a locally-generated bounce message. (Without this exception there
13986 is the possibility of looping.) The warning message is sent to the addresses
13987 supplied as the comma-separated value of this option. If several of the
13988 message's addresses cause freezing, only a single message is sent. If the
13989 freezing was automatic, the reason(s) for freezing can be found in the message
13990 log. If you configure freezing in a filter or ACL, you must arrange for any
13991 logging that you require.
13992
13993
13994 .option gecos_name main string&!! unset
13995 .cindex "HP-UX"
13996 .cindex "&""gecos""& field, parsing"
13997 Some operating systems, notably HP-UX, use the &"gecos"& field in the system
13998 password file to hold other information in addition to users' real names. Exim
13999 looks up this field for use when it is creating &'Sender:'& or &'From:'&
14000 headers. If either &%gecos_pattern%& or &%gecos_name%& are unset, the contents
14001 of the field are used unchanged, except that, if an ampersand is encountered,
14002 it is replaced by the user's login name with the first character forced to
14003 upper case, since this is a convention that is observed on many systems.
14004
14005 When these options are set, &%gecos_pattern%& is treated as a regular
14006 expression that is to be applied to the field (again with && replaced by the
14007 login name), and if it matches, &%gecos_name%& is expanded and used as the
14008 user's name.
14009
14010 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%gecos_name%&"
14011 Numeric variables such as &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. can be used in the expansion to
14012 pick up sub-fields that were matched by the pattern. In HP-UX, where the user's
14013 name terminates at the first comma, the following can be used:
14014 .code
14015 gecos_pattern = ([^,]*)
14016 gecos_name = $1
14017 .endd
14018
14019 .option gecos_pattern main string unset
14020 See &%gecos_name%& above.
14021
14022
14023 .option gnutls_compat_mode main boolean unset
14024 This option controls whether GnuTLS is used in compatibility mode in an Exim
14025 server. This reduces security slightly, but improves interworking with older
14026 implementations of TLS.
14027
14028
14029 option gnutls_allow_auto_pkcs11 main boolean unset
14030 This option will let GnuTLS (2.12.0 or later) autoload PKCS11 modules with
14031 the p11-kit configuration files in &_/etc/pkcs11/modules/_&.
14032
14033 See
14034 &url(http://www.gnutls.org/manual/gnutls.html#Smart-cards-and-HSMs)
14035 for documentation.
14036
14037
14038
14039 .option headers_charset main string "see below"
14040 This option sets a default character set for translating from encoded MIME
14041 &"words"& in header lines, when referenced by an &$h_xxx$& expansion item. The
14042 default is the value of HEADERS_CHARSET in &_Local/Makefile_&. The
14043 ultimate default is ISO-8859-1. For more details see the description of header
14044 insertions in section &<<SECTexpansionitems>>&.
14045
14046
14047
14048 .option header_maxsize main integer "see below"
14049 .cindex "header section" "maximum size of"
14050 .cindex "limit" "size of message header section"
14051 This option controls the overall maximum size of a message's header
14052 section. The default is the value of HEADER_MAXSIZE in
14053 &_Local/Makefile_&; the default for that is 1M. Messages with larger header
14054 sections are rejected.
14055
14056
14057 .option header_line_maxsize main integer 0
14058 .cindex "header lines" "maximum size of"
14059 .cindex "limit" "size of one header line"
14060 This option limits the length of any individual header line in a message, after
14061 all the continuations have been joined together. Messages with individual
14062 header lines that are longer than the limit are rejected. The default value of
14063 zero means &"no limit"&.
14064
14065
14066
14067
14068 .option helo_accept_junk_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
14069 .cindex "HELO" "accepting junk data"
14070 .cindex "EHLO" "accepting junk data"
14071 Exim checks the syntax of HELO and EHLO commands for incoming SMTP
14072 mail, and gives an error response for invalid data. Unfortunately, there are
14073 some SMTP clients that send syntactic junk. They can be accommodated by setting
14074 this option. Note that this is a syntax check only. See &%helo_verify_hosts%&
14075 if you want to do semantic checking.
14076 See also &%helo_allow_chars%& for a way of extending the permitted character
14077 set.
14078
14079
14080 .option helo_allow_chars main string unset
14081 .cindex "HELO" "underscores in"
14082 .cindex "EHLO" "underscores in"
14083 .cindex "underscore in EHLO/HELO"
14084 This option can be set to a string of rogue characters that are permitted in
14085 all EHLO and HELO names in addition to the standard letters, digits,
14086 hyphens, and dots. If you really must allow underscores, you can set
14087 .code
14088 helo_allow_chars = _
14089 .endd
14090 Note that the value is one string, not a list.
14091
14092
14093 .option helo_lookup_domains main "domain list&!!" &`@:@[]`&
14094 .cindex "HELO" "forcing reverse lookup"
14095 .cindex "EHLO" "forcing reverse lookup"
14096 If the domain given by a client in a HELO or EHLO command matches this
14097 list, a reverse lookup is done in order to establish the host's true name. The
14098 default forces a lookup if the client host gives the server's name or any of
14099 its IP addresses (in brackets), something that broken clients have been seen to
14100 do.
14101
14102
14103 .option helo_try_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
14104 .cindex "HELO verifying" "optional"
14105 .cindex "EHLO" "verifying, optional"
14106 By default, Exim just checks the syntax of HELO and EHLO commands (see
14107 &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& and &%helo_allow_chars%&). However, some sites like
14108 to do more extensive checking of the data supplied by these commands. The ACL
14109 condition &`verify = helo`& is provided to make this possible.
14110 Formerly, it was necessary also to set this option (&%helo_try_verify_hosts%&)
14111 to force the check to occur. From release 4.53 onwards, this is no longer
14112 necessary. If the check has not been done before &`verify = helo`& is
14113 encountered, it is done at that time. Consequently, this option is obsolete.
14114 Its specification is retained here for backwards compatibility.
14115
14116 When an EHLO or HELO command is received, if the calling host matches
14117 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&, Exim checks that the host name given in the HELO or
14118 EHLO command either:
14119
14120 .ilist
14121 is an IP literal matching the calling address of the host, or
14122 .next
14123 .cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
14124 .cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
14125 matches the host name that Exim obtains by doing a reverse lookup of the
14126 calling host address, or
14127 .next
14128 when looked up using &[gethostbyname()]& (or &[getipnodebyname()]& when
14129 available) yields the calling host address.
14130 .endlist
14131
14132 However, the EHLO or HELO command is not rejected if any of the checks
14133 fail. Processing continues, but the result of the check is remembered, and can
14134 be detected later in an ACL by the &`verify = helo`& condition.
14135
14136 .option helo_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
14137 .cindex "HELO verifying" "mandatory"
14138 .cindex "EHLO" "verifying, mandatory"
14139 Like &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&, this option is obsolete, and retained only for
14140 backwards compatibility. For hosts that match this option, Exim checks the host
14141 name given in the HELO or EHLO in the same way as for
14142 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&. If the check fails, the HELO or EHLO command is
14143 rejected with a 550 error, and entries are written to the main and reject logs.
14144 If a MAIL command is received before EHLO or HELO, it is rejected with a 503
14145 error.
14146
14147 .option hold_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
14148 .cindex "domain" "delaying delivery"
14149 .cindex "delivery" "delaying certain domains"
14150 This option allows mail for particular domains to be held on the queue
14151 manually. The option is overridden if a message delivery is forced with the
14152 &%-M%&, &%-qf%&, &%-Rf%& or &%-Sf%& options, and also while testing or
14153 verifying addresses using &%-bt%& or &%-bv%&. Otherwise, if a domain matches an
14154 item in &%hold_domains%&, no routing or delivery for that address is done, and
14155 it is deferred every time the message is looked at.
14156
14157 This option is intended as a temporary operational measure for delaying the
14158 delivery of mail while some problem is being sorted out, or some new
14159 configuration tested. If you just want to delay the processing of some
14160 domains until a queue run occurs, you should use &%queue_domains%& or
14161 &%queue_smtp_domains%&, not &%hold_domains%&.
14162
14163 A setting of &%hold_domains%& does not override Exim's code for removing
14164 messages from the queue if they have been there longer than the longest retry
14165 time in any retry rule. If you want to hold messages for longer than the normal
14166 retry times, insert a dummy retry rule with a long retry time.
14167
14168
14169 .option host_lookup main "host list&!!" unset
14170 .cindex "host name" "lookup, forcing"
14171 Exim does not look up the name of a calling host from its IP address unless it
14172 is required to compare against some host list, or the host matches
14173 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& or &%helo_verify_hosts%&, or the host matches this
14174 option (which normally contains IP addresses rather than host names). The
14175 default configuration file contains
14176 .code
14177 host_lookup = *
14178 .endd
14179 which causes a lookup to happen for all hosts. If the expense of these lookups
14180 is felt to be too great, the setting can be changed or removed.
14181
14182 After a successful reverse lookup, Exim does a forward lookup on the name it
14183 has obtained, to verify that it yields the IP address that it started with. If
14184 this check fails, Exim behaves as if the name lookup failed.
14185
14186 .vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
14187 .vindex "&$sender_host_name$&"
14188 After any kind of failure, the host name (in &$sender_host_name$&) remains
14189 unset, and &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to the string &"1"&. See also
14190 &%dns_again_means_nonexist%&, &%helo_lookup_domains%&, and
14191 &`verify = reverse_host_lookup`& in ACLs.
14192
14193
14194 .option host_lookup_order main "string list" &`bydns:byaddr`&
14195 This option specifies the order of different lookup methods when Exim is trying
14196 to find a host name from an IP address. The default is to do a DNS lookup
14197 first, and then to try a local lookup (using &[gethostbyaddr()]& or equivalent)
14198 if that fails. You can change the order of these lookups, or omit one entirely,
14199 if you want.
14200
14201 &*Warning*&: The &"byaddr"& method does not always yield aliases when there are
14202 multiple PTR records in the DNS and the IP address is not listed in
14203 &_/etc/hosts_&. Different operating systems give different results in this
14204 case. That is why the default tries a DNS lookup first.
14205
14206
14207
14208 .option host_reject_connection main "host list&!!" unset
14209 .cindex "host" "rejecting connections from"
14210 If this option is set, incoming SMTP calls from the hosts listed are rejected
14211 as soon as the connection is made.
14212 This option is obsolete, and retained only for backward compatibility, because
14213 nowadays the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_connect%& can also reject incoming
14214 connections immediately.
14215
14216 The ability to give an immediate rejection (either by this option or using an
14217 ACL) is provided for use in unusual cases. Many hosts will just try again,
14218 sometimes without much delay. Normally, it is better to use an ACL to reject
14219 incoming messages at a later stage, such as after RCPT commands. See
14220 chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&.
14221
14222
14223 .option hosts_connection_nolog main "host list&!!" unset
14224 .cindex "host" "not logging connections from"
14225 This option defines a list of hosts for which connection logging does not
14226 happen, even though the &%smtp_connection%& log selector is set. For example,
14227 you might want not to log SMTP connections from local processes, or from
14228 127.0.0.1, or from your local LAN. This option is consulted in the main loop of
14229 the daemon; you should therefore strive to restrict its value to a short inline
14230 list of IP addresses and networks. To disable logging SMTP connections from
14231 local processes, you must create a host list with an empty item. For example:
14232 .code
14233 hosts_connection_nolog = :
14234 .endd
14235 If the &%smtp_connection%& log selector is not set, this option has no effect.
14236
14237
14238
14239 .option hosts_treat_as_local main "domain list&!!" unset
14240 .cindex "local host" "domains treated as"
14241 .cindex "host" "treated as local"
14242 If this option is set, any host names that match the domain list are treated as
14243 if they were the local host when Exim is scanning host lists obtained from MX
14244 records
14245 or other sources. Note that the value of this option is a domain list, not a
14246 host list, because it is always used to check host names, not IP addresses.
14247
14248 This option also applies when Exim is matching the special items
14249 &`@mx_any`&, &`@mx_primary`&, and &`@mx_secondary`& in a domain list (see
14250 section &<<SECTdomainlist>>&), and when checking the &%hosts%& option in the
14251 &(smtp)& transport for the local host (see the &%allow_localhost%& option in
14252 that transport). See also &%local_interfaces%&, &%extra_local_interfaces%&, and
14253 chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>&, which contains a discussion about local network
14254 interfaces and recognizing the local host.
14255
14256
14257 .option ibase_servers main "string list" unset
14258 .cindex "InterBase" "server list"
14259 This option provides a list of InterBase servers and associated connection data,
14260 to be used in conjunction with &(ibase)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&).
14261 The option is available only if Exim has been built with InterBase support.
14262
14263
14264
14265 .option ignore_bounce_errors_after main time 10w
14266 .cindex "bounce message" "discarding"
14267 .cindex "discarding bounce message"
14268 This option affects the processing of bounce messages that cannot be delivered,
14269 that is, those that suffer a permanent delivery failure. (Bounce messages that
14270 suffer temporary delivery failures are of course retried in the usual way.)
14271
14272 After a permanent delivery failure, bounce messages are frozen,
14273 because there is no sender to whom they can be returned. When a frozen bounce
14274 message has been on the queue for more than the given time, it is unfrozen at
14275 the next queue run, and a further delivery is attempted. If delivery fails
14276 again, the bounce message is discarded. This makes it possible to keep failed
14277 bounce messages around for a shorter time than the normal maximum retry time
14278 for frozen messages. For example,
14279 .code
14280 ignore_bounce_errors_after = 12h
14281 .endd
14282 retries failed bounce message deliveries after 12 hours, discarding any further
14283 failures. If the value of this option is set to a zero time period, bounce
14284 failures are discarded immediately. Setting a very long time (as in the default
14285 value) has the effect of disabling this option. For ways of automatically
14286 dealing with other kinds of frozen message, see &%auto_thaw%& and
14287 &%timeout_frozen_after%&.
14288
14289
14290 .option ignore_fromline_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
14291 .cindex "&""From""& line"
14292 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
14293 Some broken SMTP clients insist on sending a UUCP-like &"From&~"& line before
14294 the headers of a message. By default this is treated as the start of the
14295 message's body, which means that any following headers are not recognized as
14296 such. Exim can be made to ignore it by setting &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& to
14297 match those hosts that insist on sending it. If the sender is actually a local
14298 process rather than a remote host, and is using &%-bs%& to inject the messages,
14299 &%ignore_fromline_local%& must be set to achieve this effect.
14300
14301
14302 .option ignore_fromline_local main boolean false
14303 See &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& above.
14304
14305
14306 .option keep_malformed main time 4d
14307 This option specifies the length of time to keep messages whose spool files
14308 have been corrupted in some way. This should, of course, never happen. At the
14309 next attempt to deliver such a message, it gets removed. The incident is
14310 logged.
14311
14312
14313 .option ldap_ca_cert_dir main string unset
14314 .cindex "LDAP", "TLS CA certificate directory"
14315 This option indicates which directory contains CA certificates for verifying
14316 a TLS certificate presented by an LDAP server.
14317 While Exim does not provide a default value, your SSL library may.
14318 Analogous to &%tls_verify_certificates%& but as a client-side option for LDAP
14319 and constrained to be a directory.
14320
14321
14322 .option ldap_ca_cert_file main string unset
14323 .cindex "LDAP", "TLS CA certificate file"
14324 This option indicates which file contains CA certificates for verifying
14325 a TLS certificate presented by an LDAP server.
14326 While Exim does not provide a default value, your SSL library may.
14327 Analogous to &%tls_verify_certificates%& but as a client-side option for LDAP
14328 and constrained to be a file.
14329
14330
14331 .option ldap_cert_file main string unset
14332 .cindex "LDAP" "TLS client certificate file"
14333 This option indicates which file contains an TLS client certificate which
14334 Exim should present to the LDAP server during TLS negotiation.
14335 Should be used together with &%ldap_cert_key%&.
14336
14337
14338 .option ldap_cert_key main string unset
14339 .cindex "LDAP" "TLS client key file"
14340 This option indicates which file contains the secret/private key to use
14341 to prove identity to the LDAP server during TLS negotiation.
14342 Should be used together with &%ldap_cert_file%&, which contains the
14343 identity to be proven.
14344
14345
14346 .option ldap_cipher_suite main string unset
14347 .cindex "LDAP" "TLS cipher suite"
14348 This controls the TLS cipher-suite negotiation during TLS negotiation with
14349 the LDAP server. See &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& for more details of the format of
14350 cipher-suite options with OpenSSL (as used by LDAP client libraries).
14351
14352
14353 .option ldap_default_servers main "string list" unset
14354 .cindex "LDAP" "default servers"
14355 This option provides a list of LDAP servers which are tried in turn when an
14356 LDAP query does not contain a server. See section &<<SECTforldaque>>& for
14357 details of LDAP queries. This option is available only when Exim has been built
14358 with LDAP support.
14359
14360
14361 .option ldap_require_cert main string unset.
14362 .cindex "LDAP" "policy for LDAP server TLS cert presentation"
14363 This should be one of the values "hard", "demand", "allow", "try" or "never".
14364 A value other than one of these is interpreted as "never".
14365 See the entry "TLS_REQCERT" in your system man page for ldap.conf(5).
14366 Although Exim does not set a default, the LDAP library probably defaults
14367 to hard/demand.
14368
14369
14370 .option ldap_start_tls main boolean false
14371 .cindex "LDAP" "whether or not to negotiate TLS"
14372 If set, Exim will attempt to negotiate TLS with the LDAP server when
14373 connecting on a regular LDAP port. This is the LDAP equivalent of SMTP's
14374 "STARTTLS". This is distinct from using "ldaps", which is the LDAP form
14375 of SSL-on-connect.
14376 In the event of failure to negotiate TLS, the action taken is controlled
14377 by &%ldap_require_cert%&.
14378
14379
14380 .option ldap_version main integer unset
14381 .cindex "LDAP" "protocol version, forcing"
14382 This option can be used to force Exim to set a specific protocol version for
14383 LDAP. If it option is unset, it is shown by the &%-bP%& command line option as
14384 -1. When this is the case, the default is 3 if LDAP_VERSION3 is defined in
14385 the LDAP headers; otherwise it is 2. This option is available only when Exim
14386 has been built with LDAP support.
14387
14388
14389
14390 .option local_from_check main boolean true
14391 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line" "disabling addition of"
14392 .cindex "&'From:'& header line" "disabling checking of"
14393 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP/IP connection) by
14394 an untrusted user, Exim removes any existing &'Sender:'& header line, and
14395 checks that the &'From:'& header line matches the login of the calling user and
14396 the domain specified by &%qualify_domain%&.
14397
14398 &*Note*&: An unqualified address (no domain) in the &'From:'& header in a
14399 locally submitted message is automatically qualified by Exim, unless the
14400 &%-bnq%& command line option is used.
14401
14402 You can use &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%& to permit affixes
14403 on the local part. If the &'From:'& header line does not match, Exim adds a
14404 &'Sender:'& header with an address constructed from the calling user's login
14405 and the default qualify domain.
14406
14407 If &%local_from_check%& is set false, the &'From:'& header check is disabled,
14408 and no &'Sender:'& header is ever added. If, in addition, you want to retain
14409 &'Sender:'& header lines supplied by untrusted users, you must also set
14410 &%local_sender_retain%& to be true.
14411
14412 .cindex "envelope sender"
14413 These options affect only the header lines in the message. The envelope sender
14414 is still forced to be the login id at the qualify domain unless
14415 &%untrusted_set_sender%& permits the user to supply an envelope sender.
14416
14417 For messages received over TCP/IP, an ACL can specify &"submission mode"& to
14418 request similar header line checking. See section &<<SECTthesenhea>>&, which
14419 has more details about &'Sender:'& processing.
14420
14421
14422
14423
14424 .option local_from_prefix main string unset
14425 When Exim checks the &'From:'& header line of locally submitted messages for
14426 matching the login id (see &%local_from_check%& above), it can be configured to
14427 ignore certain prefixes and suffixes in the local part of the address. This is
14428 done by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and/or &%local_from_suffix%& to
14429 appropriate lists, in the same form as the &%local_part_prefix%& and
14430 &%local_part_suffix%& router options (see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&). For
14431 example, if
14432 .code
14433 local_from_prefix = *-
14434 .endd
14435 is set, a &'From:'& line containing
14436 .code
14437 From: anything-user@your.domain.example
14438 .endd
14439 will not cause a &'Sender:'& header to be added if &'user@your.domain.example'&
14440 matches the actual sender address that is constructed from the login name and
14441 qualify domain.
14442
14443
14444 .option local_from_suffix main string unset
14445 See &%local_from_prefix%& above.
14446
14447
14448 .option local_interfaces main "string list" "see below"
14449 This option controls which network interfaces are used by the daemon for
14450 listening; they are also used to identify the local host when routing. Chapter
14451 &<<CHAPinterfaces>>& contains a full description of this option and the related
14452 options &%daemon_smtp_ports%&, &%extra_local_interfaces%&,
14453 &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, and &%tls_on_connect_ports%&. The default value for
14454 &%local_interfaces%& is
14455 .code
14456 local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0
14457 .endd
14458 when Exim is built without IPv6 support; otherwise it is
14459 .code
14460 local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
14461 .endd
14462
14463 .option local_scan_timeout main time 5m
14464 .cindex "timeout" "for &[local_scan()]& function"
14465 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "timeout"
14466 This timeout applies to the &[local_scan()]& function (see chapter
14467 &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&). Zero means &"no timeout"&. If the timeout is exceeded,
14468 the incoming message is rejected with a temporary error if it is an SMTP
14469 message. For a non-SMTP message, the message is dropped and Exim ends with a
14470 non-zero code. The incident is logged on the main and reject logs.
14471
14472
14473
14474 .option local_sender_retain main boolean false
14475 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line" "retaining from local submission"
14476 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP/IP connection) by
14477 an untrusted user, Exim removes any existing &'Sender:'& header line. If you
14478 do not want this to happen, you must set &%local_sender_retain%&, and you must
14479 also set &%local_from_check%& to be false (Exim will complain if you do not).
14480 See also the ACL modifier &`control = suppress_local_fixups`&. Section
14481 &<<SECTthesenhea>>& has more details about &'Sender:'& processing.
14482
14483
14484
14485
14486 .option localhost_number main string&!! unset
14487 .cindex "host" "locally unique number for"
14488 .cindex "message ids" "with multiple hosts"
14489 .vindex "&$localhost_number$&"
14490 Exim's message ids are normally unique only within the local host. If
14491 uniqueness among a set of hosts is required, each host must set a different
14492 value for the &%localhost_number%& option. The string is expanded immediately
14493 after reading the configuration file (so that a number can be computed from the
14494 host name, for example) and the result of the expansion must be a number in the
14495 range 0&--16 (or 0&--10 on operating systems with case-insensitive file
14496 systems). This is available in subsequent string expansions via the variable
14497 &$localhost_number$&. When &%localhost_number is set%&, the final two
14498 characters of the message id, instead of just being a fractional part of the
14499 time, are computed from the time and the local host number as described in
14500 section &<<SECTmessiden>>&.
14501
14502
14503
14504 .option log_file_path main "string list&!!" "set at compile time"
14505 .cindex "log" "file path for"
14506 This option sets the path which is used to determine the names of Exim's log
14507 files, or indicates that logging is to be to syslog, or both. It is expanded
14508 when Exim is entered, so it can, for example, contain a reference to the host
14509 name. If no specific path is set for the log files at compile or run time, they
14510 are written in a sub-directory called &_log_& in Exim's spool directory.
14511 Chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& contains further details about Exim's logging, and
14512 section &<<SECTwhelogwri>>& describes how the contents of &%log_file_path%& are
14513 used. If this string is fixed at your installation (contains no expansion
14514 variables) it is recommended that you do not set this option in the
14515 configuration file, but instead supply the path using LOG_FILE_PATH in
14516 &_Local/Makefile_& so that it is available to Exim for logging errors detected
14517 early on &-- in particular, failure to read the configuration file.
14518
14519
14520 .option log_selector main string unset
14521 .cindex "log" "selectors"
14522 This option can be used to reduce or increase the number of things that Exim
14523 writes to its log files. Its argument is made up of names preceded by plus or
14524 minus characters. For example:
14525 .code
14526 log_selector = +arguments -retry_defer
14527 .endd
14528 A list of possible names and what they control is given in the chapter on
14529 logging, in section &<<SECTlogselector>>&.
14530
14531
14532 .option log_timezone main boolean false
14533 .cindex "log" "timezone for entries"
14534 .vindex "&$tod_log$&"
14535 .vindex "&$tod_zone$&"
14536 By default, the timestamps on log lines are in local time without the
14537 timezone. This means that if your timezone changes twice a year, the timestamps
14538 in log lines are ambiguous for an hour when the clocks go back. One way of
14539 avoiding this problem is to set the timezone to UTC. An alternative is to set
14540 &%log_timezone%& true. This turns on the addition of the timezone offset to
14541 timestamps in log lines. Turning on this option can add quite a lot to the size
14542 of log files because each line is extended by 6 characters. Note that the
14543 &$tod_log$& variable contains the log timestamp without the zone, but there is
14544 another variable called &$tod_zone$& that contains just the timezone offset.
14545
14546
14547 .option lookup_open_max main integer 25
14548 .cindex "too many open files"
14549 .cindex "open files, too many"
14550 .cindex "file" "too many open"
14551 .cindex "lookup" "maximum open files"
14552 .cindex "limit" "open files for lookups"
14553 This option limits the number of simultaneously open files for single-key
14554 lookups that use regular files (that is, &(lsearch)&, &(dbm)&, and &(cdb)&).
14555 Exim normally keeps these files open during routing, because often the same
14556 file is required several times. If the limit is reached, Exim closes the least
14557 recently used file. Note that if you are using the &'ndbm'& library, it
14558 actually opens two files for each logical DBM database, though it still counts
14559 as one for the purposes of &%lookup_open_max%&. If you are getting &"too many
14560 open files"& errors with NDBM, you need to reduce the value of
14561 &%lookup_open_max%&.
14562
14563
14564 .option max_username_length main integer 0
14565 .cindex "length of login name"
14566 .cindex "user name" "maximum length"
14567 .cindex "limit" "user name length"
14568 Some operating systems are broken in that they truncate long arguments to
14569 &[getpwnam()]& to eight characters, instead of returning &"no such user"&. If
14570 this option is set greater than zero, any attempt to call &[getpwnam()]& with
14571 an argument that is longer behaves as if &[getpwnam()]& failed.
14572
14573
14574 .option message_body_newlines main bool false
14575 .cindex "message body" "newlines in variables"
14576 .cindex "newline" "in message body variables"
14577 .vindex "&$message_body$&"
14578 .vindex "&$message_body_end$&"
14579 By default, newlines in the message body are replaced by spaces when setting
14580 the &$message_body$& and &$message_body_end$& expansion variables. If this
14581 option is set true, this no longer happens.
14582
14583
14584 .option message_body_visible main integer 500
14585 .cindex "body of message" "visible size"
14586 .cindex "message body" "visible size"
14587 .vindex "&$message_body$&"
14588 .vindex "&$message_body_end$&"
14589 This option specifies how much of a message's body is to be included in the
14590 &$message_body$& and &$message_body_end$& expansion variables.
14591
14592
14593 .option message_id_header_domain main string&!! unset
14594 .cindex "&'Message-ID:'& header line"
14595 If this option is set, the string is expanded and used as the right hand side
14596 (domain) of the &'Message-ID:'& header that Exim creates if a
14597 locally-originated incoming message does not have one. &"Locally-originated"&
14598 means &"not received over TCP/IP."&
14599 Otherwise, the primary host name is used.
14600 Only letters, digits, dot and hyphen are accepted; any other characters are
14601 replaced by hyphens. If the expansion is forced to fail, or if the result is an
14602 empty string, the option is ignored.
14603
14604
14605 .option message_id_header_text main string&!! unset
14606 If this variable is set, the string is expanded and used to augment the text of
14607 the &'Message-id:'& header that Exim creates if a locally-originated incoming
14608 message does not have one. The text of this header is required by RFC 2822 to
14609 take the form of an address. By default, Exim uses its internal message id as
14610 the local part, and the primary host name as the domain. If this option is set,
14611 it is expanded, and provided the expansion is not forced to fail, and does not
14612 yield an empty string, the result is inserted into the header immediately
14613 before the @, separated from the internal message id by a dot. Any characters
14614 that are illegal in an address are automatically converted into hyphens. This
14615 means that variables such as &$tod_log$& can be used, because the spaces and
14616 colons will become hyphens.
14617
14618
14619 .option message_logs main boolean true
14620 .cindex "message logs" "disabling"
14621 .cindex "log" "message log; disabling"
14622 If this option is turned off, per-message log files are not created in the
14623 &_msglog_& spool sub-directory. This reduces the amount of disk I/O required by
14624 Exim, by reducing the number of files involved in handling a message from a
14625 minimum of four (header spool file, body spool file, delivery journal, and
14626 per-message log) to three. The other major I/O activity is Exim's main log,
14627 which is not affected by this option.
14628
14629
14630 .option message_size_limit main string&!! 50M
14631 .cindex "message" "size limit"
14632 .cindex "limit" "message size"
14633 .cindex "size" "of message, limit"
14634 This option limits the maximum size of message that Exim will process. The
14635 value is expanded for each incoming connection so, for example, it can be made
14636 to depend on the IP address of the remote host for messages arriving via
14637 TCP/IP. After expansion, the value must be a sequence of decimal digits,
14638 optionally followed by K or M.
14639
14640 &*Note*&: This limit cannot be made to depend on a message's sender or any
14641 other properties of an individual message, because it has to be advertised in
14642 the server's response to EHLO. String expansion failure causes a temporary
14643 error. A value of zero means no limit, but its use is not recommended. See also
14644 &%bounce_return_size_limit%&.
14645
14646 Incoming SMTP messages are failed with a 552 error if the limit is
14647 exceeded; locally-generated messages either get a stderr message or a delivery
14648 failure message to the sender, depending on the &%-oe%& setting. Rejection of
14649 an oversized message is logged in both the main and the reject logs. See also
14650 the generic transport option &%message_size_limit%&, which limits the size of
14651 message that an individual transport can process.
14652
14653 If you use a virus-scanner and set this option to to a value larger than the
14654 maximum size that your virus-scanner is configured to support, you may get
14655 failures triggered by large mails. The right size to configure for the
14656 virus-scanner depends upon what data is passed and the options in use but it's
14657 probably safest to just set it to a little larger than this value. Eg, with a
14658 default Exim message size of 50M and a default ClamAV StreamMaxLength of 10M,
14659 some problems may result.
14660
14661 A value of 0 will disable size limit checking; Exim will still advertise the
14662 SIZE extension in an EHLO response, but without a limit, so as to permit
14663 SMTP clients to still indicate the message size along with the MAIL verb.
14664
14665
14666 .option move_frozen_messages main boolean false
14667 .cindex "frozen messages" "moving"
14668 This option, which is available only if Exim has been built with the setting
14669 .code
14670 SUPPORT_MOVE_FROZEN_MESSAGES=yes
14671 .endd
14672 in &_Local/Makefile_&, causes frozen messages and their message logs to be
14673 moved from the &_input_& and &_msglog_& directories on the spool to &_Finput_&
14674 and &_Fmsglog_&, respectively. There is currently no support in Exim or the
14675 standard utilities for handling such moved messages, and they do not show up in
14676 lists generated by &%-bp%& or by the Exim monitor.
14677
14678
14679 .option mua_wrapper main boolean false
14680 Setting this option true causes Exim to run in a very restrictive mode in which
14681 it passes messages synchronously to a smart host. Chapter &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&
14682 contains a full description of this facility.
14683
14684
14685
14686 .option mysql_servers main "string list" unset
14687 .cindex "MySQL" "server list"
14688 This option provides a list of MySQL servers and associated connection data, to
14689 be used in conjunction with &(mysql)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&). The
14690 option is available only if Exim has been built with MySQL support.
14691
14692
14693 .option never_users main "string list&!!" unset
14694 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. Local
14695 message deliveries are normally run in processes that are setuid to the
14696 recipient, and remote deliveries are normally run under Exim's own uid and gid.
14697 It is usually desirable to prevent any deliveries from running as root, as a
14698 safety precaution.
14699
14700 When Exim is built, an option called FIXED_NEVER_USERS can be set to a
14701 list of users that must not be used for local deliveries. This list is fixed in
14702 the binary and cannot be overridden by the configuration file. By default, it
14703 contains just the single user name &"root"&. The &%never_users%& runtime option
14704 can be used to add more users to the fixed list.
14705
14706 If a message is to be delivered as one of the users on the fixed list or the
14707 &%never_users%& list, an error occurs, and delivery is deferred. A common
14708 example is
14709 .code
14710 never_users = root:daemon:bin
14711 .endd
14712 Including root is redundant if it is also on the fixed list, but it does no
14713 harm. This option overrides the &%pipe_as_creator%& option of the &(pipe)&
14714 transport driver.
14715
14716
14717 .option openssl_options main "string list" "+no_sslv2"
14718 .cindex "OpenSSL "compatibility options"
14719 This option allows an administrator to adjust the SSL options applied
14720 by OpenSSL to connections. It is given as a space-separated list of items,
14721 each one to be +added or -subtracted from the current value.
14722
14723 This option is only available if Exim is built against OpenSSL. The values
14724 available for this option vary according to the age of your OpenSSL install.
14725 The &"all"& value controls a subset of flags which are available, typically
14726 the bug workaround options. The &'SSL_CTX_set_options'& man page will
14727 list the values known on your system and Exim should support all the
14728 &"bug workaround"& options and many of the &"modifying"& options. The Exim
14729 names lose the leading &"SSL_OP_"& and are lower-cased.
14730
14731 Note that adjusting the options can have severe impact upon the security of
14732 SSL as used by Exim. It is possible to disable safety checks and shoot
14733 yourself in the foot in various unpleasant ways. This option should not be
14734 adjusted lightly. An unrecognised item will be detected at startup, by
14735 invoking Exim with the &%-bV%& flag.
14736
14737 Historical note: prior to release 4.80, Exim defaulted this value to
14738 "+dont_insert_empty_fragments", which may still be needed for compatibility
14739 with some clients, but which lowers security by increasing exposure to
14740 some now infamous attacks.
14741
14742 An example:
14743 .code
14744 # Make both old MS and old Eudora happy:
14745 openssl_options = -all +microsoft_big_sslv3_buffer \
14746 +dont_insert_empty_fragments
14747 .endd
14748
14749 Possible options may include:
14750 .ilist
14751 &`all`&
14752 .next
14753 &`allow_unsafe_legacy_renegotiation`&
14754 .next
14755 &`cipher_server_preference`&
14756 .next
14757 &`dont_insert_empty_fragments`&
14758 .next
14759 &`ephemeral_rsa`&
14760 .next
14761 &`legacy_server_connect`&
14762 .next
14763 &`microsoft_big_sslv3_buffer`&
14764 .next
14765 &`microsoft_sess_id_bug`&
14766 .next
14767 &`msie_sslv2_rsa_padding`&
14768 .next
14769 &`netscape_challenge_bug`&
14770 .next
14771 &`netscape_reuse_cipher_change_bug`&
14772 .next
14773 &`no_compression`&
14774 .next
14775 &`no_session_resumption_on_renegotiation`&
14776 .next
14777 &`no_sslv2`&
14778 .next
14779 &`no_sslv3`&
14780 .next
14781 &`no_ticket`&
14782 .next
14783 &`no_tlsv1`&
14784 .next
14785 &`no_tlsv1_1`&
14786 .next
14787 &`no_tlsv1_2`&
14788 .next
14789 &`safari_ecdhe_ecdsa_bug`&
14790 .next
14791 &`single_dh_use`&
14792 .next
14793 &`single_ecdh_use`&
14794 .next
14795 &`ssleay_080_client_dh_bug`&
14796 .next
14797 &`sslref2_reuse_cert_type_bug`&
14798 .next
14799 &`tls_block_padding_bug`&
14800 .next
14801 &`tls_d5_bug`&
14802 .next
14803 &`tls_rollback_bug`&
14804 .endlist
14805
14806 As an aside, the &`safari_ecdhe_ecdsa_bug`& item is a misnomer and affects
14807 all clients connecting using the MacOS SecureTransport TLS facility prior
14808 to MacOS 10.8.4, including email clients. If you see old MacOS clients failing
14809 to negotiate TLS then this option value might help, provided that your OpenSSL
14810 release is new enough to contain this work-around. This may be a situation
14811 where you have to upgrade OpenSSL to get buggy clients working.
14812
14813
14814 .option oracle_servers main "string list" unset
14815 .cindex "Oracle" "server list"
14816 This option provides a list of Oracle servers and associated connection data,
14817 to be used in conjunction with &(oracle)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&).
14818 The option is available only if Exim has been built with Oracle support.
14819
14820
14821 .option percent_hack_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
14822 .cindex "&""percent hack""&"
14823 .cindex "source routing" "in email address"
14824 .cindex "address" "source-routed"
14825 The &"percent hack"& is the convention whereby a local part containing a
14826 percent sign is re-interpreted as a new email address, with the percent
14827 replaced by @. This is sometimes called &"source routing"&, though that term is
14828 also applied to RFC 2822 addresses that begin with an @ character. If this
14829 option is set, Exim implements the percent facility for those domains listed,
14830 but no others. This happens before an incoming SMTP address is tested against
14831 an ACL.
14832
14833 &*Warning*&: The &"percent hack"& has often been abused by people who are
14834 trying to get round relaying restrictions. For this reason, it is best avoided
14835 if at all possible. Unfortunately, a number of less security-conscious MTAs
14836 implement it unconditionally. If you are running Exim on a gateway host, and
14837 routing mail through to internal MTAs without processing the local parts, it is
14838 a good idea to reject recipient addresses with percent characters in their
14839 local parts. Exim's default configuration does this.
14840
14841
14842 .option perl_at_start main boolean false
14843 This option is available only when Exim is built with an embedded Perl
14844 interpreter. See chapter &<<CHAPperl>>& for details of its use.
14845
14846
14847 .option perl_startup main string unset
14848 This option is available only when Exim is built with an embedded Perl
14849 interpreter. See chapter &<<CHAPperl>>& for details of its use.
14850
14851
14852 .option pgsql_servers main "string list" unset
14853 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type" "server list"
14854 This option provides a list of PostgreSQL servers and associated connection
14855 data, to be used in conjunction with &(pgsql)& lookups (see section
14856 &<<SECID72>>&). The option is available only if Exim has been built with
14857 PostgreSQL support.
14858
14859
14860 .option pid_file_path main string&!! "set at compile time"
14861 .cindex "daemon" "pid file path"
14862 .cindex "pid file, path for"
14863 This option sets the name of the file to which the Exim daemon writes its
14864 process id. The string is expanded, so it can contain, for example, references
14865 to the host name:
14866 .code
14867 pid_file_path = /var/log/$primary_hostname/exim.pid
14868 .endd
14869 If no path is set, the pid is written to the file &_exim-daemon.pid_& in Exim's
14870 spool directory.
14871 The value set by the option can be overridden by the &%-oP%& command line
14872 option. A pid file is not written if a &"non-standard"& daemon is run by means
14873 of the &%-oX%& option, unless a path is explicitly supplied by &%-oP%&.
14874
14875
14876 .option pipelining_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
14877 .cindex "PIPELINING" "suppressing advertising"
14878 This option can be used to suppress the advertisement of the SMTP
14879 PIPELINING extension to specific hosts. See also the &*no_pipelining*&
14880 control in section &<<SECTcontrols>>&. When PIPELINING is not advertised and
14881 &%smtp_enforce_sync%& is true, an Exim server enforces strict synchronization
14882 for each SMTP command and response. When PIPELINING is advertised, Exim assumes
14883 that clients will use it; &"out of order"& commands that are &"expected"& do
14884 not count as protocol errors (see &%smtp_max_synprot_errors%&).
14885
14886
14887 .option preserve_message_logs main boolean false
14888 .cindex "message logs" "preserving"
14889 If this option is set, message log files are not deleted when messages are
14890 completed. Instead, they are moved to a sub-directory of the spool directory
14891 called &_msglog.OLD_&, where they remain available for statistical or debugging
14892 purposes. This is a dangerous option to set on systems with any appreciable
14893 volume of mail. Use with care!
14894
14895
14896 .option primary_hostname main string "see below"
14897 .cindex "name" "of local host"
14898 .cindex "host" "name of local"
14899 .cindex "local host" "name of"
14900 .vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
14901 This specifies the name of the current host. It is used in the default EHLO or
14902 HELO command for outgoing SMTP messages (changeable via the &%helo_data%&
14903 option in the &(smtp)& transport), and as the default for &%qualify_domain%&.
14904 The value is also used by default in some SMTP response messages from an Exim
14905 server. This can be changed dynamically by setting &%smtp_active_hostname%&.
14906
14907 If &%primary_hostname%& is not set, Exim calls &[uname()]& to find the host
14908 name. If this fails, Exim panics and dies. If the name returned by &[uname()]&
14909 contains only one component, Exim passes it to &[gethostbyname()]& (or
14910 &[getipnodebyname()]& when available) in order to obtain the fully qualified
14911 version. The variable &$primary_hostname$& contains the host name, whether set
14912 explicitly by this option, or defaulted.
14913
14914
14915 .option print_topbitchars main boolean false
14916 .cindex "printing characters"
14917 .cindex "8-bit characters"
14918 By default, Exim considers only those characters whose codes lie in the range
14919 32&--126 to be printing characters. In a number of circumstances (for example,
14920 when writing log entries) non-printing characters are converted into escape
14921 sequences, primarily to avoid messing up the layout. If &%print_topbitchars%&
14922 is set, code values of 128 and above are also considered to be printing
14923 characters.
14924
14925 This option also affects the header syntax checks performed by the
14926 &(autoreply)& transport, and whether Exim uses RFC 2047 encoding of
14927 the user's full name when constructing From: and Sender: addresses (as
14928 described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&). Setting this option can cause
14929 Exim to generate eight bit message headers that do not conform to the
14930 standards.
14931
14932
14933 .option process_log_path main string unset
14934 .cindex "process log path"
14935 .cindex "log" "process log"
14936 .cindex "&'exiwhat'&"
14937 This option sets the name of the file to which an Exim process writes its
14938 &"process log"& when sent a USR1 signal. This is used by the &'exiwhat'&
14939 utility script. If this option is unset, the file called &_exim-process.info_&
14940 in Exim's spool directory is used. The ability to specify the name explicitly
14941 can be useful in environments where two different Exims are running, using
14942 different spool directories.
14943
14944
14945 .option prod_requires_admin main boolean true
14946 .oindex "&%-M%&"
14947 .oindex "&%-R%&"
14948 .oindex "&%-q%&"
14949 The &%-M%&, &%-R%&, and &%-q%& command-line options require the caller to be an
14950 admin user unless &%prod_requires_admin%& is set false. See also
14951 &%queue_list_requires_admin%&.
14952
14953
14954 .option qualify_domain main string "see below"
14955 .cindex "domain" "for qualifying addresses"
14956 .cindex "address" "qualification"
14957 This option specifies the domain name that is added to any envelope sender
14958 addresses that do not have a domain qualification. It also applies to
14959 recipient addresses if &%qualify_recipient%& is not set. Unqualified addresses
14960 are accepted by default only for locally-generated messages. Qualification is
14961 also applied to addresses in header lines such as &'From:'& and &'To:'& for
14962 locally-generated messages, unless the &%-bnq%& command line option is used.
14963
14964 Messages from external sources must always contain fully qualified addresses,
14965 unless the sending host matches &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or
14966 &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& (as appropriate), in which case incoming
14967 addresses are qualified with &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%& as
14968 necessary. Internally, Exim always works with fully qualified envelope
14969 addresses. If &%qualify_domain%& is not set, it defaults to the
14970 &%primary_hostname%& value.
14971
14972
14973 .option qualify_recipient main string "see below"
14974 This option allows you to specify a different domain for qualifying recipient
14975 addresses to the one that is used for senders. See &%qualify_domain%& above.
14976
14977
14978
14979 .option queue_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
14980 .cindex "domain" "specifying non-immediate delivery"
14981 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
14982 .cindex "message" "queueing certain domains"
14983 This option lists domains for which immediate delivery is not required.
14984 A delivery process is started whenever a message is received, but only those
14985 domains that do not match are processed. All other deliveries wait until the
14986 next queue run. See also &%hold_domains%& and &%queue_smtp_domains%&.
14987
14988
14989 .option queue_list_requires_admin main boolean true
14990 .oindex "&%-bp%&"
14991 The &%-bp%& command-line option, which lists the messages that are on the
14992 queue, requires the caller to be an admin user unless
14993 &%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set false. See also &%prod_requires_admin%&.
14994
14995
14996 .option queue_only main boolean false
14997 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
14998 .cindex "message" "queueing unconditionally"
14999 If &%queue_only%& is set, a delivery process is not automatically started
15000 whenever a message is received. Instead, the message waits on the queue for the
15001 next queue run. Even if &%queue_only%& is false, incoming messages may not get
15002 delivered immediately when certain conditions (such as heavy load) occur.
15003
15004 The &%-odq%& command line has the same effect as &%queue_only%&. The &%-odb%&
15005 and &%-odi%& command line options override &%queue_only%& unless
15006 &%queue_only_override%& is set false. See also &%queue_only_file%&,
15007 &%queue_only_load%&, and &%smtp_accept_queue%&.
15008
15009
15010 .option queue_only_file main string unset
15011 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
15012 .cindex "message" "queueing by file existence"
15013 This option can be set to a colon-separated list of absolute path names, each
15014 one optionally preceded by &"smtp"&. When Exim is receiving a message,
15015 it tests for the existence of each listed path using a call to &[stat()]&. For
15016 each path that exists, the corresponding queueing option is set.
15017 For paths with no prefix, &%queue_only%& is set; for paths prefixed by
15018 &"smtp"&, &%queue_smtp_domains%& is set to match all domains. So, for example,
15019 .code
15020 queue_only_file = smtp/some/file
15021 .endd
15022 causes Exim to behave as if &%queue_smtp_domains%& were set to &"*"& whenever
15023 &_/some/file_& exists.
15024
15025
15026 .option queue_only_load main fixed-point unset
15027 .cindex "load average"
15028 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
15029 .cindex "message" "queueing by load"
15030 If the system load average is higher than this value, incoming messages from
15031 all sources are queued, and no automatic deliveries are started. If this
15032 happens during local or remote SMTP input, all subsequent messages received on
15033 the same SMTP connection are queued by default, whatever happens to the load in
15034 the meantime, but this can be changed by setting &%queue_only_load_latch%&
15035 false.
15036
15037 Deliveries will subsequently be performed by queue runner processes. This
15038 option has no effect on ancient operating systems on which Exim cannot
15039 determine the load average. See also &%deliver_queue_load_max%& and
15040 &%smtp_load_reserve%&.
15041
15042
15043 .option queue_only_load_latch main boolean true
15044 .cindex "load average" "re-evaluating per message"
15045 When this option is true (the default), once one message has been queued
15046 because the load average is higher than the value set by &%queue_only_load%&,
15047 all subsequent messages received on the same SMTP connection are also queued.
15048 This is a deliberate choice; even though the load average may fall below the
15049 threshold, it doesn't seem right to deliver later messages on the same
15050 connection when not delivering earlier ones. However, there are special
15051 circumstances such as very long-lived connections from scanning appliances
15052 where this is not the best strategy. In such cases, &%queue_only_load_latch%&
15053 should be set false. This causes the value of the load average to be
15054 re-evaluated for each message.
15055
15056
15057 .option queue_only_override main boolean true
15058 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
15059 When this option is true, the &%-od%&&'x'& command line options override the
15060 setting of &%queue_only%& or &%queue_only_file%& in the configuration file. If
15061 &%queue_only_override%& is set false, the &%-od%&&'x'& options cannot be used
15062 to override; they are accepted, but ignored.
15063
15064
15065 .option queue_run_in_order main boolean false
15066 .cindex "queue runner" "processing messages in order"
15067 If this option is set, queue runs happen in order of message arrival instead of
15068 in an arbitrary order. For this to happen, a complete list of the entire queue
15069 must be set up before the deliveries start. When the queue is all held in a
15070 single directory (the default), a single list is created for both the ordered
15071 and the non-ordered cases. However, if &%split_spool_directory%& is set, a
15072 single list is not created when &%queue_run_in_order%& is false. In this case,
15073 the sub-directories are processed one at a time (in a random order), and this
15074 avoids setting up one huge list for the whole queue. Thus, setting
15075 &%queue_run_in_order%& with &%split_spool_directory%& may degrade performance
15076 when the queue is large, because of the extra work in setting up the single,
15077 large list. In most situations, &%queue_run_in_order%& should not be set.
15078
15079
15080
15081 .option queue_run_max main integer 5
15082 .cindex "queue runner" "maximum number of"
15083 This controls the maximum number of queue runner processes that an Exim daemon
15084 can run simultaneously. This does not mean that it starts them all at once,
15085 but rather that if the maximum number are still running when the time comes to
15086 start another one, it refrains from starting another one. This can happen with
15087 very large queues and/or very sluggish deliveries. This option does not,
15088 however, interlock with other processes, so additional queue runners can be
15089 started by other means, or by killing and restarting the daemon.
15090
15091 Setting this option to zero does not suppress queue runs; rather, it disables
15092 the limit, allowing any number of simultaneous queue runner processes to be
15093 run. If you do not want queue runs to occur, omit the &%-q%&&'xx'& setting on
15094 the daemon's command line.
15095
15096 .option queue_smtp_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
15097 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
15098 .cindex "message" "queueing remote deliveries"
15099 When this option is set, a delivery process is started whenever a message is
15100 received, routing is performed, and local deliveries take place.
15101 However, if any SMTP deliveries are required for domains that match
15102 &%queue_smtp_domains%&, they are not immediately delivered, but instead the
15103 message waits on the queue for the next queue run. Since routing of the message
15104 has taken place, Exim knows to which remote hosts it must be delivered, and so
15105 when the queue run happens, multiple messages for the same host are delivered
15106 over a single SMTP connection. The &%-odqs%& command line option causes all
15107 SMTP deliveries to be queued in this way, and is equivalent to setting
15108 &%queue_smtp_domains%& to &"*"&. See also &%hold_domains%& and
15109 &%queue_domains%&.
15110
15111
15112 .option receive_timeout main time 0s
15113 .cindex "timeout" "for non-SMTP input"
15114 This option sets the timeout for accepting a non-SMTP message, that is, the
15115 maximum time that Exim waits when reading a message on the standard input. If
15116 the value is zero, it will wait for ever. This setting is overridden by the
15117 &%-or%& command line option. The timeout for incoming SMTP messages is
15118 controlled by &%smtp_receive_timeout%&.
15119
15120 .option received_header_text main string&!! "see below"
15121 .cindex "customizing" "&'Received:'& header"
15122 .cindex "&'Received:'& header line" "customizing"
15123 This string defines the contents of the &'Received:'& message header that is
15124 added to each message, except for the timestamp, which is automatically added
15125 on at the end (preceded by a semicolon). The string is expanded each time it is
15126 used. If the expansion yields an empty string, no &'Received:'& header line is
15127 added to the message. Otherwise, the string should start with the text
15128 &"Received:"& and conform to the RFC 2822 specification for &'Received:'&
15129 header lines. The default setting is:
15130
15131 .code
15132 received_header_text = Received: \
15133 ${if def:sender_rcvhost {from $sender_rcvhost\n\t}\
15134 {${if def:sender_ident \
15135 {from ${quote_local_part:$sender_ident} }}\
15136 ${if def:sender_helo_name {(helo=$sender_helo_name)\n\t}}}}\
15137 by $primary_hostname \
15138 ${if def:received_protocol {with $received_protocol}} \
15139 ${if def:tls_in_cipher {($tls_in_cipher)\n\t}}\
15140 (Exim $version_number)\n\t\
15141 ${if def:sender_address \
15142 {(envelope-from <$sender_address>)\n\t}}\
15143 id $message_exim_id\
15144 ${if def:received_for {\n\tfor $received_for}}
15145 .endd
15146
15147 The reference to the TLS cipher is omitted when Exim is built without TLS
15148 support. The use of conditional expansions ensures that this works for both
15149 locally generated messages and messages received from remote hosts, giving
15150 header lines such as the following:
15151 .code
15152 Received: from scrooge.carol.example ([192.168.12.25] ident=root)
15153 by marley.carol.example with esmtp (Exim 4.00)
15154 (envelope-from <bob@carol.example>)
15155 id 16IOWa-00019l-00
15156 for chas@dickens.example; Tue, 25 Dec 2001 14:43:44 +0000
15157 Received: by scrooge.carol.example with local (Exim 4.00)
15158 id 16IOWW-000083-00; Tue, 25 Dec 2001 14:43:41 +0000
15159 .endd
15160 Until the body of the message has been received, the timestamp is the time when
15161 the message started to be received. Once the body has arrived, and all policy
15162 checks have taken place, the timestamp is updated to the time at which the
15163 message was accepted.
15164
15165
15166 .option received_headers_max main integer 30
15167 .cindex "loop" "prevention"
15168 .cindex "mail loop prevention"
15169 .cindex "&'Received:'& header line" "counting"
15170 When a message is to be delivered, the number of &'Received:'& headers is
15171 counted, and if it is greater than this parameter, a mail loop is assumed to
15172 have occurred, the delivery is abandoned, and an error message is generated.
15173 This applies to both local and remote deliveries.
15174
15175
15176 .option recipient_unqualified_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15177 .cindex "unqualified addresses"
15178 .cindex "host" "unqualified addresses from"
15179 This option lists those hosts from which Exim is prepared to accept unqualified
15180 recipient addresses in message envelopes. The addresses are made fully
15181 qualified by the addition of the &%qualify_recipient%& value. This option also
15182 affects message header lines. Exim does not reject unqualified recipient
15183 addresses in headers, but it qualifies them only if the message came from a
15184 host that matches &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&,
15185 or if the message was submitted locally (not using TCP/IP), and the &%-bnq%&
15186 option was not set.
15187
15188
15189 .option recipients_max main integer 0
15190 .cindex "limit" "number of recipients"
15191 .cindex "recipient" "maximum number"
15192 If this option is set greater than zero, it specifies the maximum number of
15193 original recipients for any message. Additional recipients that are generated
15194 by aliasing or forwarding do not count. SMTP messages get a 452 response for
15195 all recipients over the limit; earlier recipients are delivered as normal.
15196 Non-SMTP messages with too many recipients are failed, and no deliveries are
15197 done.
15198
15199 .cindex "RCPT" "maximum number of incoming"
15200 &*Note*&: The RFCs specify that an SMTP server should accept at least 100
15201 RCPT commands in a single message.
15202
15203
15204 .option recipients_max_reject main boolean false
15205 If this option is set true, Exim rejects SMTP messages containing too many
15206 recipients by giving 552 errors to the surplus RCPT commands, and a 554
15207 error to the eventual DATA command. Otherwise (the default) it gives a 452
15208 error to the surplus RCPT commands and accepts the message on behalf of the
15209 initial set of recipients. The remote server should then re-send the message
15210 for the remaining recipients at a later time.
15211
15212
15213 .option remote_max_parallel main integer 2
15214 .cindex "delivery" "parallelism for remote"
15215 This option controls parallel delivery of one message to a number of remote
15216 hosts. If the value is less than 2, parallel delivery is disabled, and Exim
15217 does all the remote deliveries for a message one by one. Otherwise, if a single
15218 message has to be delivered to more than one remote host, or if several copies
15219 have to be sent to the same remote host, up to &%remote_max_parallel%&
15220 deliveries are done simultaneously. If more than &%remote_max_parallel%&
15221 deliveries are required, the maximum number of processes are started, and as
15222 each one finishes, another is begun. The order of starting processes is the
15223 same as if sequential delivery were being done, and can be controlled by the
15224 &%remote_sort_domains%& option. If parallel delivery takes place while running
15225 with debugging turned on, the debugging output from each delivery process is
15226 tagged with its process id.
15227
15228 This option controls only the maximum number of parallel deliveries for one
15229 message in one Exim delivery process. Because Exim has no central queue
15230 manager, there is no way of controlling the total number of simultaneous
15231 deliveries if the configuration allows a delivery attempt as soon as a message
15232 is received.
15233
15234 .cindex "number of deliveries"
15235 .cindex "delivery" "maximum number of"
15236 If you want to control the total number of deliveries on the system, you
15237 need to set the &%queue_only%& option. This ensures that all incoming messages
15238 are added to the queue without starting a delivery process. Then set up an Exim
15239 daemon to start queue runner processes at appropriate intervals (probably
15240 fairly often, for example, every minute), and limit the total number of queue
15241 runners by setting the &%queue_run_max%& parameter. Because each queue runner
15242 delivers only one message at a time, the maximum number of deliveries that can
15243 then take place at once is &%queue_run_max%& multiplied by
15244 &%remote_max_parallel%&.
15245
15246 If it is purely remote deliveries you want to control, use
15247 &%queue_smtp_domains%& instead of &%queue_only%&. This has the added benefit of
15248 doing the SMTP routing before queueing, so that several messages for the same
15249 host will eventually get delivered down the same connection.
15250
15251
15252 .option remote_sort_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
15253 .cindex "sorting remote deliveries"
15254 .cindex "delivery" "sorting remote"
15255 When there are a number of remote deliveries for a message, they are sorted by
15256 domain into the order given by this list. For example,
15257 .code
15258 remote_sort_domains = *.cam.ac.uk:*.uk
15259 .endd
15260 would attempt to deliver to all addresses in the &'cam.ac.uk'& domain first,
15261 then to those in the &%uk%& domain, then to any others.
15262
15263
15264 .option retry_data_expire main time 7d
15265 .cindex "hints database" "data expiry"
15266 This option sets a &"use before"& time on retry information in Exim's hints
15267 database. Any older retry data is ignored. This means that, for example, once a
15268 host has not been tried for 7 days, Exim behaves as if it has no knowledge of
15269 past failures.
15270
15271
15272 .option retry_interval_max main time 24h
15273 .cindex "retry" "limit on interval"
15274 .cindex "limit" "on retry interval"
15275 Chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& describes Exim's mechanisms for controlling the
15276 intervals between delivery attempts for messages that cannot be delivered
15277 straight away. This option sets an overall limit to the length of time between
15278 retries. It cannot be set greater than 24 hours; any attempt to do so forces
15279 the default value.
15280
15281
15282 .option return_path_remove main boolean true
15283 .cindex "&'Return-path:'& header line" "removing"
15284 RFC 2821, section 4.4, states that an SMTP server must insert a
15285 &'Return-path:'& header line into a message when it makes a &"final delivery"&.
15286 The &'Return-path:'& header preserves the sender address as received in the
15287 MAIL command. This description implies that this header should not be present
15288 in an incoming message. If &%return_path_remove%& is true, any existing
15289 &'Return-path:'& headers are removed from messages at the time they are
15290 received. Exim's transports have options for adding &'Return-path:'& headers at
15291 the time of delivery. They are normally used only for final local deliveries.
15292
15293
15294 .option return_size_limit main integer 100K
15295 This option is an obsolete synonym for &%bounce_return_size_limit%&.
15296
15297
15298 .option rfc1413_hosts main "host list&!!" *
15299 .cindex "RFC 1413"
15300 .cindex "host" "for RFC 1413 calls"
15301 RFC 1413 identification calls are made to any client host which matches an item
15302 in the list.
15303
15304 .option rfc1413_query_timeout main time 5s
15305 .cindex "RFC 1413" "query timeout"
15306 .cindex "timeout" "for RFC 1413 call"
15307 This sets the timeout on RFC 1413 identification calls. If it is set to zero,
15308 no RFC 1413 calls are ever made.
15309
15310
15311 .option sender_unqualified_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15312 .cindex "unqualified addresses"
15313 .cindex "host" "unqualified addresses from"
15314 This option lists those hosts from which Exim is prepared to accept unqualified
15315 sender addresses. The addresses are made fully qualified by the addition of
15316 &%qualify_domain%&. This option also affects message header lines. Exim does
15317 not reject unqualified addresses in headers that contain sender addresses, but
15318 it qualifies them only if the message came from a host that matches
15319 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%&, or if the message was submitted locally (not
15320 using TCP/IP), and the &%-bnq%& option was not set.
15321
15322
15323 .option smtp_accept_keepalive main boolean true
15324 .cindex "keepalive" "on incoming connection"
15325 This option controls the setting of the SO_KEEPALIVE option on incoming
15326 TCP/IP socket connections. When set, it causes the kernel to probe idle
15327 connections periodically, by sending packets with &"old"& sequence numbers. The
15328 other end of the connection should send an acknowledgment if the connection is
15329 still okay or a reset if the connection has been aborted. The reason for doing
15330 this is that it has the beneficial effect of freeing up certain types of
15331 connection that can get stuck when the remote host is disconnected without
15332 tidying up the TCP/IP call properly. The keepalive mechanism takes several
15333 hours to detect unreachable hosts.
15334
15335
15336
15337 .option smtp_accept_max main integer 20
15338 .cindex "limit" "incoming SMTP connections"
15339 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming connection count"
15340 .cindex "inetd"
15341 This option specifies the maximum number of simultaneous incoming SMTP calls
15342 that Exim will accept. It applies only to the listening daemon; there is no
15343 control (in Exim) when incoming SMTP is being handled by &'inetd'&. If the
15344 value is set to zero, no limit is applied. However, it is required to be
15345 non-zero if either &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& or &%smtp_accept_queue%& is
15346 set. See also &%smtp_accept_reserve%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%&.
15347
15348 A new SMTP connection is immediately rejected if the &%smtp_accept_max%& limit
15349 has been reached. If not, Exim first checks &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%&. If
15350 that limit has not been reached for the client host, &%smtp_accept_reserve%&
15351 and &%smtp_load_reserve%& are then checked before accepting the connection.
15352
15353
15354 .option smtp_accept_max_nonmail main integer 10
15355 .cindex "limit" "non-mail SMTP commands"
15356 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting non-mail commands"
15357 Exim counts the number of &"non-mail"& commands in an SMTP session, and drops
15358 the connection if there are too many. This option defines &"too many"&. The
15359 check catches some denial-of-service attacks, repeated failing AUTHs, or a mad
15360 client looping sending EHLO, for example. The check is applied only if the
15361 client host matches &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%&.
15362
15363 When a new message is expected, one occurrence of RSET is not counted. This
15364 allows a client to send one RSET between messages (this is not necessary,
15365 but some clients do it). Exim also allows one uncounted occurrence of HELO
15366 or EHLO, and one occurrence of STARTTLS between messages. After
15367 starting up a TLS session, another EHLO is expected, and so it too is not
15368 counted. The first occurrence of AUTH in a connection, or immediately
15369 following STARTTLS is not counted. Otherwise, all commands other than
15370 MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and QUIT are counted.
15371
15372
15373 .option smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts main "host list&!!" *
15374 You can control which hosts are subject to the &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%&
15375 check by setting this option. The default value makes it apply to all hosts. By
15376 changing the value, you can exclude any badly-behaved hosts that you have to
15377 live with.
15378
15379
15380 . Allow this long option name to split; give it unsplit as a fifth argument
15381 . for the automatic .oindex that is generated by .option.
15382 . We insert " &~&~" which is both pretty nasty visually and results in
15383 . non-searchable text. HowItWorks.txt mentions an option for inserting
15384 . zero-width-space, which would be nicer visually and results in (at least)
15385 . html that Firefox will split on when it's forced to reflow (rather than
15386 . inserting a horizontal scrollbar). However, the text is still not
15387 . searchable. NM changed this occurrence for bug 1197 to no longer allow
15388 . the option name to split.
15389
15390 .option "smtp_accept_max_per_connection" main integer 1000 &&&
15391 smtp_accept_max_per_connection
15392 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting incoming message count"
15393 .cindex "limit" "messages per SMTP connection"
15394 The value of this option limits the number of MAIL commands that Exim is
15395 prepared to accept over a single SMTP connection, whether or not each command
15396 results in the transfer of a message. After the limit is reached, a 421
15397 response is given to subsequent MAIL commands. This limit is a safety
15398 precaution against a client that goes mad (incidents of this type have been
15399 seen).
15400
15401
15402 .option smtp_accept_max_per_host main string&!! unset
15403 .cindex "limit" "SMTP connections from one host"
15404 .cindex "host" "limiting SMTP connections from"
15405 This option restricts the number of simultaneous IP connections from a single
15406 host (strictly, from a single IP address) to the Exim daemon. The option is
15407 expanded, to enable different limits to be applied to different hosts by
15408 reference to &$sender_host_address$&. Once the limit is reached, additional
15409 connection attempts from the same host are rejected with error code 421. This
15410 is entirely independent of &%smtp_accept_reserve%&. The option's default value
15411 of zero imposes no limit. If this option is set greater than zero, it is
15412 required that &%smtp_accept_max%& be non-zero.
15413
15414 &*Warning*&: When setting this option you should not use any expansion
15415 constructions that take an appreciable amount of time. The expansion and test
15416 happen in the main daemon loop, in order to reject additional connections
15417 without forking additional processes (otherwise a denial-of-service attack
15418 could cause a vast number or processes to be created). While the daemon is
15419 doing this processing, it cannot accept any other incoming connections.
15420
15421
15422
15423 .option smtp_accept_queue main integer 0
15424 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming connection count"
15425 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
15426 .cindex "message" "queueing by SMTP connection count"
15427 If the number of simultaneous incoming SMTP connections being handled via the
15428 listening daemon exceeds this value, messages received by SMTP are just placed
15429 on the queue; no delivery processes are started automatically. The count is
15430 fixed at the start of an SMTP connection. It cannot be updated in the
15431 subprocess that receives messages, and so the queueing or not queueing applies
15432 to all messages received in the same connection.
15433
15434 A value of zero implies no limit, and clearly any non-zero value is useful only
15435 if it is less than the &%smtp_accept_max%& value (unless that is zero). See
15436 also &%queue_only%&, &%queue_only_load%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&, and the
15437 various &%-od%&&'x'& command line options.
15438
15439
15440 . See the comment on smtp_accept_max_per_connection
15441
15442 .option "smtp_accept_queue_per_connection" main integer 10 &&&
15443 smtp_accept_queue_per_connection
15444 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
15445 .cindex "message" "queueing by message count"
15446 This option limits the number of delivery processes that Exim starts
15447 automatically when receiving messages via SMTP, whether via the daemon or by
15448 the use of &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&. If the value of the option is greater than zero,
15449 and the number of messages received in a single SMTP session exceeds this
15450 number, subsequent messages are placed on the queue, but no delivery processes
15451 are started. This helps to limit the number of Exim processes when a server
15452 restarts after downtime and there is a lot of mail waiting for it on other
15453 systems. On large systems, the default should probably be increased, and on
15454 dial-in client systems it should probably be set to zero (that is, disabled).
15455
15456
15457 .option smtp_accept_reserve main integer 0
15458 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming call count"
15459 .cindex "host" "reserved"
15460 When &%smtp_accept_max%& is set greater than zero, this option specifies a
15461 number of SMTP connections that are reserved for connections from the hosts
15462 that are specified in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&. The value set in
15463 &%smtp_accept_max%& includes this reserve pool. The specified hosts are not
15464 restricted to this number of connections; the option specifies a minimum number
15465 of connection slots for them, not a maximum. It is a guarantee that this group
15466 of hosts can always get at least &%smtp_accept_reserve%& connections. However,
15467 the limit specified by &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& is still applied to each
15468 individual host.
15469
15470 For example, if &%smtp_accept_max%& is set to 50 and &%smtp_accept_reserve%& is
15471 set to 5, once there are 45 active connections (from any hosts), new
15472 connections are accepted only from hosts listed in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&,
15473 provided the other criteria for acceptance are met.
15474
15475
15476 .option smtp_active_hostname main string&!! unset
15477 .cindex "host" "name in SMTP responses"
15478 .cindex "SMTP" "host name in responses"
15479 .vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
15480 This option is provided for multi-homed servers that want to masquerade as
15481 several different hosts. At the start of an incoming SMTP connection, its value
15482 is expanded and used instead of the value of &$primary_hostname$& in SMTP
15483 responses. For example, it is used as domain name in the response to an
15484 incoming HELO or EHLO command.
15485
15486 .vindex "&$smtp_active_hostname$&"
15487 The active hostname is placed in the &$smtp_active_hostname$& variable, which
15488 is saved with any messages that are received. It is therefore available for use
15489 in routers and transports when the message is later delivered.
15490
15491 If this option is unset, or if its expansion is forced to fail, or if the
15492 expansion results in an empty string, the value of &$primary_hostname$& is
15493 used. Other expansion failures cause a message to be written to the main and
15494 panic logs, and the SMTP command receives a temporary error. Typically, the
15495 value of &%smtp_active_hostname%& depends on the incoming interface address.
15496 For example:
15497 .code
15498 smtp_active_hostname = ${if eq{$received_ip_address}{10.0.0.1}\
15499 {cox.mydomain}{box.mydomain}}
15500 .endd
15501
15502 Although &$smtp_active_hostname$& is primarily concerned with incoming
15503 messages, it is also used as the default for HELO commands in callout
15504 verification if there is no remote transport from which to obtain a
15505 &%helo_data%& value.
15506
15507 .option smtp_banner main string&!! "see below"
15508 .cindex "SMTP" "welcome banner"
15509 .cindex "banner for SMTP"
15510 .cindex "welcome banner for SMTP"
15511 .cindex "customizing" "SMTP banner"
15512 This string, which is expanded every time it is used, is output as the initial
15513 positive response to an SMTP connection. The default setting is:
15514 .code
15515 smtp_banner = $smtp_active_hostname ESMTP Exim \
15516 $version_number $tod_full
15517 .endd
15518 Failure to expand the string causes a panic error. If you want to create a
15519 multiline response to the initial SMTP connection, use &"\n"& in the string at
15520 appropriate points, but not at the end. Note that the 220 code is not included
15521 in this string. Exim adds it automatically (several times in the case of a
15522 multiline response).
15523
15524
15525 .option smtp_check_spool_space main boolean true
15526 .cindex "checking disk space"
15527 .cindex "disk space, checking"
15528 .cindex "spool directory" "checking space"
15529 When this option is set, if an incoming SMTP session encounters the SIZE
15530 option on a MAIL command, it checks that there is enough space in the
15531 spool directory's partition to accept a message of that size, while still
15532 leaving free the amount specified by &%check_spool_space%& (even if that value
15533 is zero). If there isn't enough space, a temporary error code is returned.
15534
15535
15536 .option smtp_connect_backlog main integer 20
15537 .cindex "connection backlog"
15538 .cindex "SMTP" "connection backlog"
15539 .cindex "backlog of connections"
15540 This option specifies a maximum number of waiting SMTP connections. Exim passes
15541 this value to the TCP/IP system when it sets up its listener. Once this number
15542 of connections are waiting for the daemon's attention, subsequent connection
15543 attempts are refused at the TCP/IP level. At least, that is what the manuals
15544 say; in some circumstances such connection attempts have been observed to time
15545 out instead. For large systems it is probably a good idea to increase the
15546 value (to 50, say). It also gives some protection against denial-of-service
15547 attacks by SYN flooding.
15548
15549
15550 .option smtp_enforce_sync main boolean true
15551 .cindex "SMTP" "synchronization checking"
15552 .cindex "synchronization checking in SMTP"
15553 The SMTP protocol specification requires the client to wait for a response from
15554 the server at certain points in the dialogue. Without PIPELINING these
15555 synchronization points are after every command; with PIPELINING they are
15556 fewer, but they still exist.
15557
15558 Some spamming sites send out a complete set of SMTP commands without waiting
15559 for any response. Exim protects against this by rejecting a message if the
15560 client has sent further input when it should not have. The error response &"554
15561 SMTP synchronization error"& is sent, and the connection is dropped. Testing
15562 for this error cannot be perfect because of transmission delays (unexpected
15563 input may be on its way but not yet received when Exim checks). However, it
15564 does detect many instances.
15565
15566 The check can be globally disabled by setting &%smtp_enforce_sync%& false.
15567 If you want to disable the check selectively (for example, only for certain
15568 hosts), you can do so by an appropriate use of a &%control%& modifier in an ACL
15569 (see section &<<SECTcontrols>>&). See also &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&.
15570
15571
15572
15573 .option smtp_etrn_command main string&!! unset
15574 .cindex "ETRN" "command to be run"
15575 .vindex "&$domain$&"
15576 If this option is set, the given command is run whenever an SMTP ETRN
15577 command is received from a host that is permitted to issue such commands (see
15578 chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). The string is split up into separate arguments which
15579 are independently expanded. The expansion variable &$domain$& is set to the
15580 argument of the ETRN command, and no syntax checking is done on it. For
15581 example:
15582 .code
15583 smtp_etrn_command = /etc/etrn_command $domain \
15584 $sender_host_address
15585 .endd
15586 A new process is created to run the command, but Exim does not wait for it to
15587 complete. Consequently, its status cannot be checked. If the command cannot be
15588 run, a line is written to the panic log, but the ETRN caller still receives
15589 a 250 success response. Exim is normally running under its own uid when
15590 receiving SMTP, so it is not possible for it to change the uid before running
15591 the command.
15592
15593
15594 .option smtp_etrn_serialize main boolean true
15595 .cindex "ETRN" "serializing"
15596 When this option is set, it prevents the simultaneous execution of more than
15597 one identical command as a result of ETRN in an SMTP connection. See
15598 section &<<SECTETRN>>& for details.
15599
15600
15601 .option smtp_load_reserve main fixed-point unset
15602 .cindex "load average"
15603 If the system load average ever gets higher than this, incoming SMTP calls are
15604 accepted only from those hosts that match an entry in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&.
15605 If &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& is not set, no incoming SMTP calls are accepted when
15606 the load is over the limit. The option has no effect on ancient operating
15607 systems on which Exim cannot determine the load average. See also
15608 &%deliver_queue_load_max%& and &%queue_only_load%&.
15609
15610
15611
15612 .option smtp_max_synprot_errors main integer 3
15613 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting syntax and protocol errors"
15614 .cindex "limit" "SMTP syntax and protocol errors"
15615 Exim rejects SMTP commands that contain syntax or protocol errors. In
15616 particular, a syntactically invalid email address, as in this command:
15617 .code
15618 RCPT TO:<abc xyz@a.b.c>
15619 .endd
15620 causes immediate rejection of the command, before any other tests are done.
15621 (The ACL cannot be run if there is no valid address to set up for it.) An
15622 example of a protocol error is receiving RCPT before MAIL. If there are
15623 too many syntax or protocol errors in one SMTP session, the connection is
15624 dropped. The limit is set by this option.
15625
15626 .cindex "PIPELINING" "expected errors"
15627 When the PIPELINING extension to SMTP is in use, some protocol errors are
15628 &"expected"&, for instance, a RCPT command after a rejected MAIL command.
15629 Exim assumes that PIPELINING will be used if it advertises it (see
15630 &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&), and in this situation, &"expected"& errors do
15631 not count towards the limit.
15632
15633
15634
15635 .option smtp_max_unknown_commands main integer 3
15636 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting unknown commands"
15637 .cindex "limit" "unknown SMTP commands"
15638 If there are too many unrecognized commands in an incoming SMTP session, an
15639 Exim server drops the connection. This is a defence against some kinds of abuse
15640 that subvert web
15641 clients
15642 into making connections to SMTP ports; in these circumstances, a number of
15643 non-SMTP command lines are sent first.
15644
15645
15646
15647 .option smtp_ratelimit_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15648 .cindex "SMTP" "rate limiting"
15649 .cindex "limit" "rate of message arrival"
15650 .cindex "RCPT" "rate limiting"
15651 Some sites find it helpful to be able to limit the rate at which certain hosts
15652 can send them messages, and the rate at which an individual message can specify
15653 recipients.
15654
15655 Exim has two rate-limiting facilities. This section describes the older
15656 facility, which can limit rates within a single connection. The newer
15657 &%ratelimit%& ACL condition can limit rates across all connections. See section
15658 &<<SECTratelimiting>>& for details of the newer facility.
15659
15660 When a host matches &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%&, the values of
15661 &%smtp_ratelimit_mail%& and &%smtp_ratelimit_rcpt%& are used to control the
15662 rate of acceptance of MAIL and RCPT commands in a single SMTP session,
15663 respectively. Each option, if set, must contain a set of four comma-separated
15664 values:
15665
15666 .ilist
15667 A threshold, before which there is no rate limiting.
15668 .next
15669 An initial time delay. Unlike other times in Exim, numbers with decimal
15670 fractional parts are allowed here.
15671 .next
15672 A factor by which to increase the delay each time.
15673 .next
15674 A maximum value for the delay. This should normally be less than 5 minutes,
15675 because after that time, the client is liable to timeout the SMTP command.
15676 .endlist
15677
15678 For example, these settings have been used successfully at the site which
15679 first suggested this feature, for controlling mail from their customers:
15680 .code
15681 smtp_ratelimit_mail = 2,0.5s,1.05,4m
15682 smtp_ratelimit_rcpt = 4,0.25s,1.015,4m
15683 .endd
15684 The first setting specifies delays that are applied to MAIL commands after
15685 two have been received over a single connection. The initial delay is 0.5
15686 seconds, increasing by a factor of 1.05 each time. The second setting applies
15687 delays to RCPT commands when more than four occur in a single message.
15688
15689
15690 .option smtp_ratelimit_mail main string unset
15691 See &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& above.
15692
15693
15694 .option smtp_ratelimit_rcpt main string unset
15695 See &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& above.
15696
15697
15698 .option smtp_receive_timeout main time 5m
15699 .cindex "timeout" "for SMTP input"
15700 .cindex "SMTP" "input timeout"
15701 This sets a timeout value for SMTP reception. It applies to all forms of SMTP
15702 input, including batch SMTP. If a line of input (either an SMTP command or a
15703 data line) is not received within this time, the SMTP connection is dropped and
15704 the message is abandoned.
15705 A line is written to the log containing one of the following messages:
15706 .code
15707 SMTP command timeout on connection from...
15708 SMTP data timeout on connection from...
15709 .endd
15710 The former means that Exim was expecting to read an SMTP command; the latter
15711 means that it was in the DATA phase, reading the contents of a message.
15712
15713
15714 .oindex "&%-os%&"
15715 The value set by this option can be overridden by the
15716 &%-os%& command-line option. A setting of zero time disables the timeout, but
15717 this should never be used for SMTP over TCP/IP. (It can be useful in some cases
15718 of local input using &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&.) For non-SMTP input, the reception
15719 timeout is controlled by &%receive_timeout%& and &%-or%&.
15720
15721
15722 .option smtp_reserve_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15723 This option defines hosts for which SMTP connections are reserved; see
15724 &%smtp_accept_reserve%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%& above.
15725
15726
15727 .option smtp_return_error_details main boolean false
15728 .cindex "SMTP" "details policy failures"
15729 .cindex "policy control" "rejection, returning details"
15730 In the default state, Exim uses bland messages such as
15731 &"Administrative prohibition"& when it rejects SMTP commands for policy
15732 reasons. Many sysadmins like this because it gives away little information
15733 to spammers. However, some other sysadmins who are applying strict checking
15734 policies want to give out much fuller information about failures. Setting
15735 &%smtp_return_error_details%& true causes Exim to be more forthcoming. For
15736 example, instead of &"Administrative prohibition"&, it might give:
15737 .code
15738 550-Rejected after DATA: '>' missing at end of address:
15739 550 failing address in "From" header is: <user@dom.ain
15740 .endd
15741
15742 .option spamd_address main string "see below"
15743 This option is available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning
15744 extension. It specifies how Exim connects to SpamAssassin's &%spamd%& daemon.
15745 The default value is
15746 .code
15747 127.0.0.1 783
15748 .endd
15749 See section &<<SECTscanspamass>>& for more details.
15750
15751
15752
15753 .option split_spool_directory main boolean false
15754 .cindex "multiple spool directories"
15755 .cindex "spool directory" "split"
15756 .cindex "directories, multiple"
15757 If this option is set, it causes Exim to split its input directory into 62
15758 subdirectories, each with a single alphanumeric character as its name. The
15759 sixth character of the message id is used to allocate messages to
15760 subdirectories; this is the least significant base-62 digit of the time of
15761 arrival of the message.
15762
15763 Splitting up the spool in this way may provide better performance on systems
15764 where there are long mail queues, by reducing the number of files in any one
15765 directory. The msglog directory is also split up in a similar way to the input
15766 directory; however, if &%preserve_message_logs%& is set, all old msglog files
15767 are still placed in the single directory &_msglog.OLD_&.
15768
15769 It is not necessary to take any special action for existing messages when
15770 changing &%split_spool_directory%&. Exim notices messages that are in the
15771 &"wrong"& place, and continues to process them. If the option is turned off
15772 after a period of being on, the subdirectories will eventually empty and be
15773 automatically deleted.
15774
15775 When &%split_spool_directory%& is set, the behaviour of queue runner processes
15776 changes. Instead of creating a list of all messages in the queue, and then
15777 trying to deliver each one in turn, it constructs a list of those in one
15778 sub-directory and tries to deliver them, before moving on to the next
15779 sub-directory. The sub-directories are processed in a random order. This
15780 spreads out the scanning of the input directories, and uses less memory. It is
15781 particularly beneficial when there are lots of messages on the queue. However,
15782 if &%queue_run_in_order%& is set, none of this new processing happens. The
15783 entire queue has to be scanned and sorted before any deliveries can start.
15784
15785
15786 .option spool_directory main string&!! "set at compile time"
15787 .cindex "spool directory" "path to"
15788 This defines the directory in which Exim keeps its spool, that is, the messages
15789 it is waiting to deliver. The default value is taken from the compile-time
15790 configuration setting, if there is one. If not, this option must be set. The
15791 string is expanded, so it can contain, for example, a reference to
15792 &$primary_hostname$&.
15793
15794 If the spool directory name is fixed on your installation, it is recommended
15795 that you set it at build time rather than from this option, particularly if the
15796 log files are being written to the spool directory (see &%log_file_path%&).
15797 Otherwise log files cannot be used for errors that are detected early on, such
15798 as failures in the configuration file.
15799
15800 By using this option to override the compiled-in path, it is possible to run
15801 tests of Exim without using the standard spool.
15802
15803 .option sqlite_lock_timeout main time 5s
15804 .cindex "sqlite lookup type" "lock timeout"
15805 This option controls the timeout that the &(sqlite)& lookup uses when trying to
15806 access an SQLite database. See section &<<SECTsqlite>>& for more details.
15807
15808 .option strict_acl_vars main boolean false
15809 .cindex "&ACL;" "variables, handling unset"
15810 This option controls what happens if a syntactically valid but undefined ACL
15811 variable is referenced. If it is false (the default), an empty string
15812 is substituted; if it is true, an error is generated. See section
15813 &<<SECTaclvariables>>& for details of ACL variables.
15814
15815 .option strip_excess_angle_brackets main boolean false
15816 .cindex "angle brackets, excess"
15817 If this option is set, redundant pairs of angle brackets round &"route-addr"&
15818 items in addresses are stripped. For example, &'<<xxx@a.b.c.d>>'& is
15819 treated as &'<xxx@a.b.c.d>'&. If this is in the envelope and the message is
15820 passed on to another MTA, the excess angle brackets are not passed on. If this
15821 option is not set, multiple pairs of angle brackets cause a syntax error.
15822
15823
15824 .option strip_trailing_dot main boolean false
15825 .cindex "trailing dot on domain"
15826 .cindex "dot" "trailing on domain"
15827 If this option is set, a trailing dot at the end of a domain in an address is
15828 ignored. If this is in the envelope and the message is passed on to another
15829 MTA, the dot is not passed on. If this option is not set, a dot at the end of a
15830 domain causes a syntax error.
15831 However, addresses in header lines are checked only when an ACL requests header
15832 syntax checking.
15833
15834
15835 .option syslog_duplication main boolean true
15836 .cindex "syslog" "duplicate log lines; suppressing"
15837 When Exim is logging to syslog, it writes the log lines for its three
15838 separate logs at different syslog priorities so that they can in principle
15839 be separated on the logging hosts. Some installations do not require this
15840 separation, and in those cases, the duplication of certain log lines is a
15841 nuisance. If &%syslog_duplication%& is set false, only one copy of any
15842 particular log line is written to syslog. For lines that normally go to
15843 both the main log and the reject log, the reject log version (possibly
15844 containing message header lines) is written, at LOG_NOTICE priority.
15845 Lines that normally go to both the main and the panic log are written at
15846 the LOG_ALERT priority.
15847
15848
15849 .option syslog_facility main string unset
15850 .cindex "syslog" "facility; setting"
15851 This option sets the syslog &"facility"& name, used when Exim is logging to
15852 syslog. The value must be one of the strings &"mail"&, &"user"&, &"news"&,
15853 &"uucp"&, &"daemon"&, or &"local&'x'&"& where &'x'& is a digit between 0 and 7.
15854 If this option is unset, &"mail"& is used. See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for
15855 details of Exim's logging.
15856
15857
15858
15859 .option syslog_processname main string &`exim`&
15860 .cindex "syslog" "process name; setting"
15861 This option sets the syslog &"ident"& name, used when Exim is logging to
15862 syslog. The value must be no longer than 32 characters. See chapter
15863 &<<CHAPlog>>& for details of Exim's logging.
15864
15865
15866
15867 .option syslog_timestamp main boolean true
15868 .cindex "syslog" "timestamps"
15869 If &%syslog_timestamp%& is set false, the timestamps on Exim's log lines are
15870 omitted when these lines are sent to syslog. See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for
15871 details of Exim's logging.
15872
15873
15874 .option system_filter main string&!! unset
15875 .cindex "filter" "system filter"
15876 .cindex "system filter" "specifying"
15877 .cindex "Sieve filter" "not available for system filter"
15878 This option specifies an Exim filter file that is applied to all messages at
15879 the start of each delivery attempt, before any routing is done. System filters
15880 must be Exim filters; they cannot be Sieve filters. If the system filter
15881 generates any deliveries to files or pipes, or any new mail messages, the
15882 appropriate &%system_filter_..._transport%& option(s) must be set, to define
15883 which transports are to be used. Details of this facility are given in chapter
15884 &<<CHAPsystemfilter>>&.
15885
15886
15887 .option system_filter_directory_transport main string&!! unset
15888 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
15889 This sets the name of the transport driver that is to be used when the
15890 &%save%& command in a system message filter specifies a path ending in &"/"&,
15891 implying delivery of each message into a separate file in some directory.
15892 During the delivery, the variable &$address_file$& contains the path name.
15893
15894
15895 .option system_filter_file_transport main string&!! unset
15896 .cindex "file" "transport for system filter"
15897 This sets the name of the transport driver that is to be used when the &%save%&
15898 command in a system message filter specifies a path not ending in &"/"&. During
15899 the delivery, the variable &$address_file$& contains the path name.
15900
15901 .option system_filter_group main string unset
15902 .cindex "gid (group id)" "system filter"
15903 This option is used only when &%system_filter_user%& is also set. It sets the
15904 gid under which the system filter is run, overriding any gid that is associated
15905 with the user. The value may be numerical or symbolic.
15906
15907 .option system_filter_pipe_transport main string&!! unset
15908 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "for system filter"
15909 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
15910 This specifies the transport driver that is to be used when a &%pipe%& command
15911 is used in a system filter. During the delivery, the variable &$address_pipe$&
15912 contains the pipe command.
15913
15914
15915 .option system_filter_reply_transport main string&!! unset
15916 .cindex "&(autoreply)& transport" "for system filter"
15917 This specifies the transport driver that is to be used when a &%mail%& command
15918 is used in a system filter.
15919
15920
15921 .option system_filter_user main string unset
15922 .cindex "uid (user id)" "system filter"
15923 If this option is set to root, the system filter is run in the main Exim
15924 delivery process, as root. Otherwise, the system filter runs in a separate
15925 process, as the given user, defaulting to the Exim run-time user.
15926 Unless the string consists entirely of digits, it
15927 is looked up in the password data. Failure to find the named user causes a
15928 configuration error. The gid is either taken from the password data, or
15929 specified by &%system_filter_group%&. When the uid is specified numerically,
15930 &%system_filter_group%& is required to be set.
15931
15932 If the system filter generates any pipe, file, or reply deliveries, the uid
15933 under which the filter is run is used when transporting them, unless a
15934 transport option overrides.
15935
15936
15937 .option tcp_nodelay main boolean true
15938 .cindex "daemon" "TCP_NODELAY on sockets"
15939 .cindex "Nagle algorithm"
15940 .cindex "TCP_NODELAY on listening sockets"
15941 If this option is set false, it stops the Exim daemon setting the
15942 TCP_NODELAY option on its listening sockets. Setting TCP_NODELAY
15943 turns off the &"Nagle algorithm"&, which is a way of improving network
15944 performance in interactive (character-by-character) situations. Turning it off
15945 should improve Exim's performance a bit, so that is what happens by default.
15946 However, it appears that some broken clients cannot cope, and time out. Hence
15947 this option. It affects only those sockets that are set up for listening by the
15948 daemon. Sockets created by the smtp transport for delivering mail always set
15949 TCP_NODELAY.
15950
15951
15952 .option timeout_frozen_after main time 0s
15953 .cindex "frozen messages" "timing out"
15954 .cindex "timeout" "frozen messages"
15955 If &%timeout_frozen_after%& is set to a time greater than zero, a frozen
15956 message of any kind that has been on the queue for longer than the given time
15957 is automatically cancelled at the next queue run. If the frozen message is a
15958 bounce message, it is just discarded; otherwise, a bounce is sent to the
15959 sender, in a similar manner to cancellation by the &%-Mg%& command line option.
15960 If you want to timeout frozen bounce messages earlier than other kinds of
15961 frozen message, see &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&.
15962
15963 &*Note:*& the default value of zero means no timeouts; with this setting,
15964 frozen messages remain on the queue forever (except for any frozen bounce
15965 messages that are released by &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&).
15966
15967
15968 .option timezone main string unset
15969 .cindex "timezone, setting"
15970 The value of &%timezone%& is used to set the environment variable TZ while
15971 running Exim (if it is different on entry). This ensures that all timestamps
15972 created by Exim are in the required timezone. If you want all your timestamps
15973 to be in UTC (aka GMT) you should set
15974 .code
15975 timezone = UTC
15976 .endd
15977 The default value is taken from TIMEZONE_DEFAULT in &_Local/Makefile_&,
15978 or, if that is not set, from the value of the TZ environment variable when Exim
15979 is built. If &%timezone%& is set to the empty string, either at build or run
15980 time, any existing TZ variable is removed from the environment when Exim
15981 runs. This is appropriate behaviour for obtaining wall-clock time on some, but
15982 unfortunately not all, operating systems.
15983
15984
15985 .option tls_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15986 .cindex "TLS" "advertising"
15987 .cindex "encryption" "on SMTP connection"
15988 .cindex "SMTP" "encrypted connection"
15989 When Exim is built with support for TLS encrypted connections, the availability
15990 of the STARTTLS command to set up an encrypted session is advertised in
15991 response to EHLO only to those client hosts that match this option. See
15992 chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of Exim's support for TLS.
15993
15994
15995 .option tls_certificate main string&!! unset
15996 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate; location of"
15997 .cindex "certificate" "server, location of"
15998 The value of this option is expanded, and must then be the absolute path to a
15999 file which contains the server's certificates. The server's private key is also
16000 assumed to be in this file if &%tls_privatekey%& is unset. See chapter
16001 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
16002
16003 &*Note*&: The certificates defined by this option are used only when Exim is
16004 receiving incoming messages as a server. If you want to supply certificates for
16005 use when sending messages as a client, you must set the &%tls_certificate%&
16006 option in the relevant &(smtp)& transport.
16007
16008 If the option contains &$tls_out_sni$& and Exim is built against OpenSSL, then
16009 if the OpenSSL build supports TLS extensions and the TLS client sends the
16010 Server Name Indication extension, then this option and others documented in
16011 &<<SECTtlssni>>& will be re-expanded.
16012
16013 .option tls_crl main string&!! unset
16014 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate revocation list"
16015 .cindex "certificate" "revocation list for server"
16016 This option specifies a certificate revocation list. The expanded value must
16017 be the name of a file that contains a CRL in PEM format.
16018
16019 See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for discussion of when this option might be re-expanded.
16020
16021
16022 .option tls_dh_max_bits main integer 2236
16023 .cindex "TLS" "D-H bit count"
16024 The number of bits used for Diffie-Hellman key-exchange may be suggested by
16025 the chosen TLS library. That value might prove to be too high for
16026 interoperability. This option provides a maximum clamp on the value
16027 suggested, trading off security for interoperability.
16028
16029 The value must be at least 1024.
16030
16031 The value 2236 was chosen because, at time of adding the option, it was the
16032 hard-coded maximum value supported by the NSS cryptographic library, as used
16033 by Thunderbird, while GnuTLS was suggesting 2432 bits as normal.
16034
16035 If you prefer more security and are willing to break some clients, raise this
16036 number.
16037
16038 Note that the value passed to GnuTLS for *generating* a new prime may be a
16039 little less than this figure, because GnuTLS is inexact and may produce a
16040 larger prime than requested.
16041
16042
16043 .option tls_dhparam main string&!! unset
16044 .cindex "TLS" "D-H parameters for server"
16045 The value of this option is expanded and indicates the source of DH parameters
16046 to be used by Exim.
16047
16048 If it is a filename starting with a &`/`&, then it names a file from which DH
16049 parameters should be loaded. If the file exists, it should hold a PEM-encoded
16050 PKCS#3 representation of the DH prime. If the file does not exist, for
16051 OpenSSL it is an error. For GnuTLS, Exim will attempt to create the file and
16052 fill it with a generated DH prime. For OpenSSL, if the DH bit-count from
16053 loading the file is greater than &%tls_dh_max_bits%& then it will be ignored,
16054 and treated as though the &%tls_dhparam%& were set to "none".
16055
16056 If this option expands to the string "none", then no DH parameters will be
16057 loaded by Exim.
16058
16059 If this option expands to the string "historic" and Exim is using GnuTLS, then
16060 Exim will attempt to load a file from inside the spool directory. If the file
16061 does not exist, Exim will attempt to create it.
16062 See section &<<SECTgnutlsparam>>& for further details.
16063
16064 If Exim is using OpenSSL and this option is empty or unset, then Exim will load
16065 a default DH prime; the default is the 2048 bit prime described in section
16066 2.2 of RFC 5114, "2048-bit MODP Group with 224-bit Prime Order Subgroup", which
16067 in IKE is assigned number 23.
16068
16069 Otherwise, the option must expand to the name used by Exim for any of a number
16070 of DH primes specified in RFC 2409, RFC 3526 and RFC 5114. As names, Exim uses
16071 "ike" followed by the number used by IKE, of "default" which corresponds to
16072 "ike23".
16073
16074 The available primes are:
16075 &`ike1`&, &`ike2`&, &`ike5`&,
16076 &`ike14`&, &`ike15`&, &`ike16`&, &`ike17`&, &`ike18`&,
16077 &`ike22`&, &`ike23`& (aka &`default`&) and &`ike24`&.
16078
16079 Some of these will be too small to be accepted by clients.
16080 Some may be too large to be accepted by clients.
16081
16082 The TLS protocol does not negotiate an acceptable size for this; clients tend
16083 to hard-drop connections if what is offered by the server is unacceptable,
16084 whether too large or too small, and there's no provision for the client to
16085 tell the server what these constraints are. Thus, as a server operator, you
16086 need to make an educated guess as to what is most likely to work for your
16087 userbase.
16088
16089 Some known size constraints suggest that a bit-size in the range 2048 to 2236
16090 is most likely to maximise interoperability. The upper bound comes from
16091 applications using the Mozilla Network Security Services (NSS) library, which
16092 used to set its &`DH_MAX_P_BITS`& upper-bound to 2236. This affects many
16093 mail user agents (MUAs). The lower bound comes from Debian installs of Exim4
16094 prior to the 4.80 release, as Debian used to patch Exim to raise the minimum
16095 acceptable bound from 1024 to 2048.
16096
16097
16098 .option tls_on_connect_ports main "string list" unset
16099 This option specifies a list of incoming SSMTP (aka SMTPS) ports that should
16100 operate the obsolete SSMTP (SMTPS) protocol, where a TLS session is immediately
16101 set up without waiting for the client to issue a STARTTLS command. For
16102 further details, see section &<<SECTsupobssmt>>&.
16103
16104
16105
16106 .option tls_privatekey main string&!! unset
16107 .cindex "TLS" "server private key; location of"
16108 The value of this option is expanded, and must then be the absolute path to a
16109 file which contains the server's private key. If this option is unset, or if
16110 the expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string, the private
16111 key is assumed to be in the same file as the server's certificates. See chapter
16112 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
16113
16114 See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for discussion of when this option might be re-expanded.
16115
16116
16117 .option tls_remember_esmtp main boolean false
16118 .cindex "TLS" "esmtp state; remembering"
16119 .cindex "TLS" "broken clients"
16120 If this option is set true, Exim violates the RFCs by remembering that it is in
16121 &"esmtp"& state after successfully negotiating a TLS session. This provides
16122 support for broken clients that fail to send a new EHLO after starting a
16123 TLS session.
16124
16125
16126 .option tls_require_ciphers main string&!! unset
16127 .cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers"
16128 .cindex "cipher" "requiring specific"
16129 This option controls which ciphers can be used for incoming TLS connections.
16130 The &(smtp)& transport has an option of the same name for controlling outgoing
16131 connections. This option is expanded for each connection, so can be varied for
16132 different clients if required. The value of this option must be a list of
16133 permitted cipher suites. The OpenSSL and GnuTLS libraries handle cipher control
16134 in somewhat different ways. If GnuTLS is being used, the client controls the
16135 preference order of the available ciphers. Details are given in sections
16136 &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&.
16137
16138
16139 .option tls_try_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
16140 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
16141 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
16142 See &%tls_verify_hosts%& below.
16143
16144
16145 .option tls_verify_certificates main string&!! unset
16146 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
16147 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
16148 The value of this option is expanded, and must then be the absolute path to
16149 a file containing permitted certificates for clients that
16150 match &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&. Alternatively, if you
16151 are using OpenSSL, you can set &%tls_verify_certificates%& to the name of a
16152 directory containing certificate files. This does not work with GnuTLS; the
16153 option must be set to the name of a single file if you are using GnuTLS.
16154
16155 These certificates should be for the certificate authorities trusted, rather
16156 than the public cert of individual clients. With both OpenSSL and GnuTLS, if
16157 the value is a file then the certificates are sent by Exim as a server to
16158 connecting clients, defining the list of accepted certificate authorities.
16159 Thus the values defined should be considered public data. To avoid this,
16160 use OpenSSL with a directory.
16161
16162 See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for discussion of when this option might be re-expanded.
16163
16164 A forced expansion failure or setting to an empty string is equivalent to
16165 being unset.
16166
16167
16168 .option tls_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
16169 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
16170 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
16171 This option, along with &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&, controls the checking of
16172 certificates from clients. The expected certificates are defined by
16173 &%tls_verify_certificates%&, which must be set. A configuration error occurs if
16174 either &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& is set and
16175 &%tls_verify_certificates%& is not set.
16176
16177 Any client that matches &%tls_verify_hosts%& is constrained by
16178 &%tls_verify_certificates%&. When the client initiates a TLS session, it must
16179 present one of the listed certificates. If it does not, the connection is
16180 aborted. &*Warning*&: Including a host in &%tls_verify_hosts%& does not require
16181 the host to use TLS. It can still send SMTP commands through unencrypted
16182 connections. Forcing a client to use TLS has to be done separately using an
16183 ACL to reject inappropriate commands when the connection is not encrypted.
16184
16185 A weaker form of checking is provided by &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&. If a client
16186 matches this option (but not &%tls_verify_hosts%&), Exim requests a
16187 certificate and checks it against &%tls_verify_certificates%&, but does not
16188 abort the connection if there is no certificate or if it does not match. This
16189 state can be detected in an ACL, which makes it possible to implement policies
16190 such as &"accept for relay only if a verified certificate has been received,
16191 but accept for local delivery if encrypted, even without a verified
16192 certificate"&.
16193
16194 Client hosts that match neither of these lists are not asked to present
16195 certificates.
16196
16197
16198 .option trusted_groups main "string list&!!" unset
16199 .cindex "trusted groups"
16200 .cindex "groups" "trusted"
16201 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If this
16202 option is set, any process that is running in one of the listed groups, or
16203 which has one of them as a supplementary group, is trusted. The groups can be
16204 specified numerically or by name. See section &<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for
16205 details of what trusted callers are permitted to do. If neither
16206 &%trusted_groups%& nor &%trusted_users%& is set, only root and the Exim user
16207 are trusted.
16208
16209 .option trusted_users main "string list&!!" unset
16210 .cindex "trusted users"
16211 .cindex "user" "trusted"
16212 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If this
16213 option is set, any process that is running as one of the listed users is
16214 trusted. The users can be specified numerically or by name. See section
16215 &<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for details of what trusted callers are permitted to do.
16216 If neither &%trusted_groups%& nor &%trusted_users%& is set, only root and the
16217 Exim user are trusted.
16218
16219 .option unknown_login main string&!! unset
16220 .cindex "uid (user id)" "unknown caller"
16221 .vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
16222 This is a specialized feature for use in unusual configurations. By default, if
16223 the uid of the caller of Exim cannot be looked up using &[getpwuid()]&, Exim
16224 gives up. The &%unknown_login%& option can be used to set a login name to be
16225 used in this circumstance. It is expanded, so values like &%user$caller_uid%&
16226 can be set. When &%unknown_login%& is used, the value of &%unknown_username%&
16227 is used for the user's real name (gecos field), unless this has been set by the
16228 &%-F%& option.
16229
16230 .option unknown_username main string unset
16231 See &%unknown_login%&.
16232
16233 .option untrusted_set_sender main "address list&!!" unset
16234 .cindex "trusted users"
16235 .cindex "sender" "setting by untrusted user"
16236 .cindex "untrusted user setting sender"
16237 .cindex "user" "untrusted setting sender"
16238 .cindex "envelope sender"
16239 When an untrusted user submits a message to Exim using the standard input, Exim
16240 normally creates an envelope sender address from the user's login and the
16241 default qualification domain. Data from the &%-f%& option (for setting envelope
16242 senders on non-SMTP messages) or the SMTP MAIL command (if &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&
16243 is used) is ignored.
16244
16245 However, untrusted users are permitted to set an empty envelope sender address,
16246 to declare that a message should never generate any bounces. For example:
16247 .code
16248 exim -f '<>' user@domain.example
16249 .endd
16250 .vindex "&$sender_ident$&"
16251 The &%untrusted_set_sender%& option allows you to permit untrusted users to set
16252 other envelope sender addresses in a controlled way. When it is set, untrusted
16253 users are allowed to set envelope sender addresses that match any of the
16254 patterns in the list. Like all address lists, the string is expanded. The
16255 identity of the user is in &$sender_ident$&, so you can, for example, restrict
16256 users to setting senders that start with their login ids
16257 followed by a hyphen
16258 by a setting like this:
16259 .code
16260 untrusted_set_sender = ^$sender_ident-
16261 .endd
16262 If you want to allow untrusted users to set envelope sender addresses without
16263 restriction, you can use
16264 .code
16265 untrusted_set_sender = *
16266 .endd
16267 The &%untrusted_set_sender%& option applies to all forms of local input, but
16268 only to the setting of the envelope sender. It does not permit untrusted users
16269 to use the other options which trusted user can use to override message
16270 parameters. Furthermore, it does not stop Exim from removing an existing
16271 &'Sender:'& header in the message, or from adding a &'Sender:'& header if
16272 necessary. See &%local_sender_retain%& and &%local_from_check%& for ways of
16273 overriding these actions. The handling of the &'Sender:'& header is also
16274 described in section &<<SECTthesenhea>>&.
16275
16276 The log line for a message's arrival shows the envelope sender following
16277 &"<="&. For local messages, the user's login always follows, after &"U="&. In
16278 &%-bp%& displays, and in the Exim monitor, if an untrusted user sets an
16279 envelope sender address, the user's login is shown in parentheses after the
16280 sender address.
16281
16282
16283 .option uucp_from_pattern main string "see below"
16284 .cindex "&""From""& line"
16285 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
16286 Some applications that pass messages to an MTA via a command line interface use
16287 an initial line starting with &"From&~"& to pass the envelope sender. In
16288 particular, this is used by UUCP software. Exim recognizes such a line by means
16289 of a regular expression that is set in &%uucp_from_pattern%&. When the pattern
16290 matches, the sender address is constructed by expanding the contents of
16291 &%uucp_from_sender%&, provided that the caller of Exim is a trusted user. The
16292 default pattern recognizes lines in the following two forms:
16293 .code
16294 From ph10 Fri Jan 5 12:35 GMT 1996
16295 From ph10 Fri, 7 Jan 97 14:00:00 GMT
16296 .endd
16297 The pattern can be seen by running
16298 .code
16299 exim -bP uucp_from_pattern
16300 .endd
16301 It checks only up to the hours and minutes, and allows for a 2-digit or 4-digit
16302 year in the second case. The first word after &"From&~"& is matched in the
16303 regular expression by a parenthesized subpattern. The default value for
16304 &%uucp_from_sender%& is &"$1"&, which therefore just uses this first word
16305 (&"ph10"& in the example above) as the message's sender. See also
16306 &%ignore_fromline_hosts%&.
16307
16308
16309 .option uucp_from_sender main string&!! &`$1`&
16310 See &%uucp_from_pattern%& above.
16311
16312
16313 .option warn_message_file main string unset
16314 .cindex "warning of delay" "customizing the message"
16315 .cindex "customizing" "warning message"
16316 This option defines a template file containing paragraphs of text to be used
16317 for constructing the warning message which is sent by Exim when a message has
16318 been on the queue for a specified amount of time, as specified by
16319 &%delay_warning%&. Details of the file's contents are given in chapter
16320 &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&. See also &%bounce_message_file%&.
16321
16322
16323 .option write_rejectlog main boolean true
16324 .cindex "reject log" "disabling"
16325 If this option is set false, Exim no longer writes anything to the reject log.
16326 See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for details of what Exim writes to its logs.
16327 .ecindex IIDconfima
16328 .ecindex IIDmaiconf
16329
16330
16331
16332
16333 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
16334 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
16335
16336 .chapter "Generic options for routers" "CHAProutergeneric"
16337 .scindex IIDgenoprou1 "options" "generic; for routers"
16338 .scindex IIDgenoprou2 "generic options" "router"
16339 This chapter describes the generic options that apply to all routers.
16340 Those that are preconditions are marked with &Dagger; in the &"use"& field.
16341
16342 For a general description of how a router operates, see sections
16343 &<<SECTrunindrou>>& and &<<SECTrouprecon>>&. The latter specifies the order in
16344 which the preconditions are tested. The order of expansion of the options that
16345 provide data for a transport is: &%errors_to%&, &%headers_add%&,
16346 &%headers_remove%&, &%transport%&.
16347
16348
16349
16350 .option address_data routers string&!! unset
16351 .cindex "router" "data attached to address"
16352 The string is expanded just before the router is run, that is, after all the
16353 precondition tests have succeeded. If the expansion is forced to fail, the
16354 router declines, the value of &%address_data%& remains unchanged, and the
16355 &%more%& option controls what happens next. Other expansion failures cause
16356 delivery of the address to be deferred.
16357
16358 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
16359 When the expansion succeeds, the value is retained with the address, and can be
16360 accessed using the variable &$address_data$& in the current router, subsequent
16361 routers, and the eventual transport.
16362
16363 &*Warning*&: If the current or any subsequent router is a &(redirect)& router
16364 that runs a user's filter file, the contents of &$address_data$& are accessible
16365 in the filter. This is not normally a problem, because such data is usually
16366 either not confidential or it &"belongs"& to the current user, but if you do
16367 put confidential data into &$address_data$& you need to remember this point.
16368
16369 Even if the router declines or passes, the value of &$address_data$& remains
16370 with the address, though it can be changed by another &%address_data%& setting
16371 on a subsequent router. If a router generates child addresses, the value of
16372 &$address_data$& propagates to them. This also applies to the special kind of
16373 &"child"& that is generated by a router with the &%unseen%& option.
16374
16375 The idea of &%address_data%& is that you can use it to look up a lot of data
16376 for the address once, and then pick out parts of the data later. For example,
16377 you could use a single LDAP lookup to return a string of the form
16378 .code
16379 uid=1234 gid=5678 mailbox=/mail/xyz forward=/home/xyz/.forward
16380 .endd
16381 In the transport you could pick out the mailbox by a setting such as
16382 .code
16383 file = ${extract{mailbox}{$address_data}}
16384 .endd
16385 This makes the configuration file less messy, and also reduces the number of
16386 lookups (though Exim does cache lookups).
16387
16388 .vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
16389 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
16390 The &%address_data%& facility is also useful as a means of passing information
16391 from one router to another, and from a router to a transport. In addition, if
16392 &$address_data$& is set by a router when verifying a recipient address from an
16393 ACL, it remains available for use in the rest of the ACL statement. After
16394 verifying a sender, the value is transferred to &$sender_address_data$&.
16395
16396
16397
16398 .option address_test routers&!? boolean true
16399 .oindex "&%-bt%&"
16400 .cindex "router" "skipping when address testing"
16401 If this option is set false, the router is skipped when routing is being tested
16402 by means of the &%-bt%& command line option. This can be a convenience when
16403 your first router sends messages to an external scanner, because it saves you
16404 having to set the &"already scanned"& indicator when testing real address
16405 routing.
16406
16407
16408
16409 .option cannot_route_message routers string&!! unset
16410 .cindex "router" "customizing &""cannot route""& message"
16411 .cindex "customizing" "&""cannot route""& message"
16412 This option specifies a text message that is used when an address cannot be
16413 routed because Exim has run out of routers. The default message is
16414 &"Unrouteable address"&. This option is useful only on routers that have
16415 &%more%& set false, or on the very last router in a configuration, because the
16416 value that is used is taken from the last router that is considered. This
16417 includes a router that is skipped because its preconditions are not met, as
16418 well as a router that declines. For example, using the default configuration,
16419 you could put:
16420 .code
16421 cannot_route_message = Remote domain not found in DNS
16422 .endd
16423 on the first router, which is a &(dnslookup)& router with &%more%& set false,
16424 and
16425 .code
16426 cannot_route_message = Unknown local user
16427 .endd
16428 on the final router that checks for local users. If string expansion fails for
16429 this option, the default message is used. Unless the expansion failure was
16430 explicitly forced, a message about the failure is written to the main and panic
16431 logs, in addition to the normal message about the routing failure.
16432
16433
16434 .option caseful_local_part routers boolean false
16435 .cindex "case of local parts"
16436 .cindex "router" "case of local parts"
16437 By default, routers handle the local parts of addresses in a case-insensitive
16438 manner, though the actual case is preserved for transmission with the message.
16439 If you want the case of letters to be significant in a router, you must set
16440 this option true. For individual router options that contain address or local
16441 part lists (for example, &%local_parts%&), case-sensitive matching can be
16442 turned on by &"+caseful"& as a list item. See section &<<SECTcasletadd>>& for
16443 more details.
16444
16445 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
16446 .vindex "&$original_local_part$&"
16447 .vindex "&$parent_local_part$&"
16448 The value of the &$local_part$& variable is forced to lower case while a
16449 router is running unless &%caseful_local_part%& is set. When a router assigns
16450 an address to a transport, the value of &$local_part$& when the transport runs
16451 is the same as it was in the router. Similarly, when a router generates child
16452 addresses by aliasing or forwarding, the values of &$original_local_part$&
16453 and &$parent_local_part$& are those that were used by the redirecting router.
16454
16455 This option applies to the processing of an address by a router. When a
16456 recipient address is being processed in an ACL, there is a separate &%control%&
16457 modifier that can be used to specify case-sensitive processing within the ACL
16458 (see section &<<SECTcontrols>>&).
16459
16460
16461
16462 .option check_local_user routers&!? boolean false
16463 .cindex "local user, checking in router"
16464 .cindex "router" "checking for local user"
16465 .cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&"
16466 .vindex "&$home$&"
16467 When this option is true, Exim checks that the local part of the recipient
16468 address (with affixes removed if relevant) is the name of an account on the
16469 local system. The check is done by calling the &[getpwnam()]& function rather
16470 than trying to read &_/etc/passwd_& directly. This means that other methods of
16471 holding password data (such as NIS) are supported. If the local part is a local
16472 user, &$home$& is set from the password data, and can be tested in other
16473 preconditions that are evaluated after this one (the order of evaluation is
16474 given in section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). However, the value of &$home$& can be
16475 overridden by &%router_home_directory%&. If the local part is not a local user,
16476 the router is skipped.
16477
16478 If you want to check that the local part is either the name of a local user
16479 or matches something else, you cannot combine &%check_local_user%& with a
16480 setting of &%local_parts%&, because that specifies the logical &'and'& of the
16481 two conditions. However, you can use a &(passwd)& lookup in a &%local_parts%&
16482 setting to achieve this. For example:
16483 .code
16484 local_parts = passwd;$local_part : lsearch;/etc/other/users
16485 .endd
16486 Note, however, that the side effects of &%check_local_user%& (such as setting
16487 up a home directory) do not occur when a &(passwd)& lookup is used in a
16488 &%local_parts%& (or any other) precondition.
16489
16490
16491
16492 .option condition routers&!? string&!! unset
16493 .cindex "router" "customized precondition"
16494 This option specifies a general precondition test that has to succeed for the
16495 router to be called. The &%condition%& option is the last precondition to be
16496 evaluated (see section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). The string is expanded, and if the
16497 result is a forced failure, or an empty string, or one of the strings &"0"& or
16498 &"no"& or &"false"& (checked without regard to the case of the letters), the
16499 router is skipped, and the address is offered to the next one.
16500
16501 If the result is any other value, the router is run (as this is the last
16502 precondition to be evaluated, all the other preconditions must be true).
16503
16504 This option is unusual in that multiple &%condition%& options may be present.
16505 All &%condition%& options must succeed.
16506
16507 The &%condition%& option provides a means of applying custom conditions to the
16508 running of routers. Note that in the case of a simple conditional expansion,
16509 the default expansion values are exactly what is wanted. For example:
16510 .code
16511 condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}}
16512 .endd
16513 Because of the default behaviour of the string expansion, this is equivalent to
16514 .code
16515 condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}{true}{}}
16516 .endd
16517
16518 A multiple condition example, which succeeds:
16519 .code
16520 condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}}
16521 condition = ${if !eq{${lc:$local_part}}{postmaster}}
16522 condition = foobar
16523 .endd
16524
16525 If the expansion fails (other than forced failure) delivery is deferred. Some
16526 of the other precondition options are common special cases that could in fact
16527 be specified using &%condition%&.
16528
16529
16530 .option debug_print routers string&!! unset
16531 .cindex "testing" "variables in drivers"
16532 If this option is set and debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%& command line
16533 option) or in address-testing mode (see the &%-bt%& command line option),
16534 the string is expanded and included in the debugging output.
16535 If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
16536 output, and Exim carries on processing.
16537 This option is provided to help with checking out the values of variables and
16538 so on when debugging router configurations. For example, if a &%condition%&
16539 option appears not to be working, &%debug_print%& can be used to output the
16540 variables it references. The output happens after checks for &%domains%&,
16541 &%local_parts%&, and &%check_local_user%& but before any other preconditions
16542 are tested. A newline is added to the text if it does not end with one.
16543 The variable &$router_name$& contains the name of the router.
16544
16545
16546
16547 .option disable_logging routers boolean false
16548 If this option is set true, nothing is logged for any routing errors
16549 or for any deliveries caused by this router. You should not set this option
16550 unless you really, really know what you are doing. See also the generic
16551 transport option of the same name.
16552
16553
16554 .option domains routers&!? "domain list&!!" unset
16555 .cindex "router" "restricting to specific domains"
16556 .vindex "&$domain_data$&"
16557 If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the current domain matches
16558 the list. If the match is achieved by means of a file lookup, the data that the
16559 lookup returned for the domain is placed in &$domain_data$& for use in string
16560 expansions of the driver's private options. See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for
16561 a list of the order in which preconditions are evaluated.
16562
16563
16564
16565 .option driver routers string unset
16566 This option must always be set. It specifies which of the available routers is
16567 to be used.
16568
16569
16570
16571 .option errors_to routers string&!! unset
16572 .cindex "envelope sender"
16573 .cindex "router" "changing address for errors"
16574 If a router successfully handles an address, it may assign the address to a
16575 transport for delivery or it may generate child addresses. In both cases, if
16576 there is a delivery problem during later processing, the resulting bounce
16577 message is sent to the address that results from expanding this string,
16578 provided that the address verifies successfully. The &%errors_to%& option is
16579 expanded before &%headers_add%&, &%headers_remove%&, and &%transport%&.
16580
16581 The &%errors_to%& setting associated with an address can be overridden if it
16582 subsequently passes through other routers that have their own &%errors_to%&
16583 settings, or if the message is delivered by a transport with a &%return_path%&
16584 setting.
16585
16586 If &%errors_to%& is unset, or the expansion is forced to fail, or the result of
16587 the expansion fails to verify, the errors address associated with the incoming
16588 address is used. At top level, this is the envelope sender. A non-forced
16589 expansion failure causes delivery to be deferred.
16590
16591 If an address for which &%errors_to%& has been set ends up being delivered over
16592 SMTP, the envelope sender for that delivery is the &%errors_to%& value, so that
16593 any bounces that are generated by other MTAs on the delivery route are also
16594 sent there. You can set &%errors_to%& to the empty string by either of these
16595 settings:
16596 .code
16597 errors_to =
16598 errors_to = ""
16599 .endd
16600 An expansion item that yields an empty string has the same effect. If you do
16601 this, a locally detected delivery error for addresses processed by this router
16602 no longer gives rise to a bounce message; the error is discarded. If the
16603 address is delivered to a remote host, the return path is set to &`<>`&, unless
16604 overridden by the &%return_path%& option on the transport.
16605
16606 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
16607 If for some reason you want to discard local errors, but use a non-empty
16608 MAIL command for remote delivery, you can preserve the original return
16609 path in &$address_data$& in the router, and reinstate it in the transport by
16610 setting &%return_path%&.
16611
16612 The most common use of &%errors_to%& is to direct mailing list bounces to the
16613 manager of the list, as described in section &<<SECTmailinglists>>&, or to
16614 implement VERP (Variable Envelope Return Paths) (see section &<<SECTverp>>&).
16615
16616
16617
16618 .option expn routers&!? boolean true
16619 .cindex "address" "testing"
16620 .cindex "testing" "addresses"
16621 .cindex "EXPN" "router skipping"
16622 .cindex "router" "skipping for EXPN"
16623 If this option is turned off, the router is skipped when testing an address
16624 as a result of processing an SMTP EXPN command. You might, for example,
16625 want to turn it off on a router for users' &_.forward_& files, while leaving it
16626 on for the system alias file.
16627 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
16628 are evaluated.
16629
16630 The use of the SMTP EXPN command is controlled by an ACL (see chapter
16631 &<<CHAPACL>>&). When Exim is running an EXPN command, it is similar to testing
16632 an address with &%-bt%&. Compare VRFY, whose counterpart is &%-bv%&.
16633
16634
16635
16636 .option fail_verify routers boolean false
16637 .cindex "router" "forcing verification failure"
16638 Setting this option has the effect of setting both &%fail_verify_sender%& and
16639 &%fail_verify_recipient%& to the same value.
16640
16641
16642
16643 .option fail_verify_recipient routers boolean false
16644 If this option is true and an address is accepted by this router when
16645 verifying a recipient, verification fails.
16646
16647
16648
16649 .option fail_verify_sender routers boolean false
16650 If this option is true and an address is accepted by this router when
16651 verifying a sender, verification fails.
16652
16653
16654
16655 .option fallback_hosts routers "string list" unset
16656 .cindex "router" "fallback hosts"
16657 .cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on router"
16658 String expansion is not applied to this option. The argument must be a
16659 colon-separated list of host names or IP addresses. The list separator can be
16660 changed (see section &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&), and a port can be specified with
16661 each name or address. In fact, the format of each item is exactly the same as
16662 defined for the list of hosts in a &(manualroute)& router (see section
16663 &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&).
16664
16665 If a router queues an address for a remote transport, this host list is
16666 associated with the address, and used instead of the transport's fallback host
16667 list. If &%hosts_randomize%& is set on the transport, the order of the list is
16668 randomized for each use. See the &%fallback_hosts%& option of the &(smtp)&
16669 transport for further details.
16670
16671
16672 .option group routers string&!! "see below"
16673 .cindex "gid (group id)" "local delivery"
16674 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
16675 .cindex "transport" "local"
16676 .cindex "router" "setting group"
16677 When a router queues an address for a transport, and the transport does not
16678 specify a group, the group given here is used when running the delivery
16679 process.
16680 The group may be specified numerically or by name. If expansion fails, the
16681 error is logged and delivery is deferred.
16682 The default is unset, unless &%check_local_user%& is set, when the default
16683 is taken from the password information. See also &%initgroups%& and &%user%&
16684 and the discussion in chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
16685
16686
16687
16688 .option headers_add routers string&!! unset
16689 .cindex "header lines" "adding"
16690 .cindex "router" "adding header lines"
16691 This option specifies a string of text that is expanded at routing time, and
16692 associated with any addresses that are accepted by the router. However, this
16693 option has no effect when an address is just being verified. The way in which
16694 the text is used to add header lines at transport time is described in section
16695 &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. New header lines are not actually added until the
16696 message is in the process of being transported. This means that references to
16697 header lines in string expansions in the transport's configuration do not
16698 &"see"& the added header lines.
16699
16700 The &%headers_add%& option is expanded after &%errors_to%&, but before
16701 &%headers_remove%& and &%transport%&. If the expanded string is empty, or if
16702 the expansion is forced to fail, the option has no effect. Other expansion
16703 failures are treated as configuration errors.
16704
16705 Unlike most options, &%headers_add%& can be specified multiple times
16706 for a router; all listed headers are added.
16707
16708 &*Warning 1*&: The &%headers_add%& option cannot be used for a &(redirect)&
16709 router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
16710
16711 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
16712 .oindex "&%unseen%&"
16713 &*Warning 2*&: If the &%unseen%& option is set on the router, all header
16714 additions are deleted when the address is passed on to subsequent routers.
16715 For a &%redirect%& router, if a generated address is the same as the incoming
16716 address, this can lead to duplicate addresses with different header
16717 modifications. Exim does not do duplicate deliveries (except, in certain
16718 circumstances, to pipes -- see section &<<SECTdupaddr>>&), but it is undefined
16719 which of the duplicates is discarded, so this ambiguous situation should be
16720 avoided. The &%repeat_use%& option of the &%redirect%& router may be of help.
16721
16722
16723
16724 .option headers_remove routers string&!! unset
16725 .cindex "header lines" "removing"
16726 .cindex "router" "removing header lines"
16727 This option specifies a string of text that is expanded at routing time, and
16728 associated with any addresses that are accepted by the router. However, this
16729 option has no effect when an address is just being verified. The way in which
16730 the text is used to remove header lines at transport time is described in
16731 section &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Header lines are not actually removed until
16732 the message is in the process of being transported. This means that references
16733 to header lines in string expansions in the transport's configuration still
16734 &"see"& the original header lines.
16735
16736 The &%headers_remove%& option is expanded after &%errors_to%& and
16737 &%headers_add%&, but before &%transport%&. If the expansion is forced to fail,
16738 the option has no effect. Other expansion failures are treated as configuration
16739 errors.
16740
16741 Unlike most options, &%headers_remove%& can be specified multiple times
16742 for a router; all listed headers are removed.
16743
16744 &*Warning 1*&: The &%headers_remove%& option cannot be used for a &(redirect)&
16745 router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
16746
16747 &*Warning 2*&: If the &%unseen%& option is set on the router, all header
16748 removal requests are deleted when the address is passed on to subsequent
16749 routers, and this can lead to problems with duplicates -- see the similar
16750 warning for &%headers_add%& above.
16751
16752
16753 .option ignore_target_hosts routers "host list&!!" unset
16754 .cindex "IP address" "discarding"
16755 .cindex "router" "discarding IP addresses"
16756 Although this option is a host list, it should normally contain IP address
16757 entries rather than names. If any host that is looked up by the router has an
16758 IP address that matches an item in this list, Exim behaves as if that IP
16759 address did not exist. This option allows you to cope with rogue DNS entries
16760 like
16761 .code
16762 remote.domain.example. A 127.0.0.1
16763 .endd
16764 by setting
16765 .code
16766 ignore_target_hosts = 127.0.0.1
16767 .endd
16768 on the relevant router. If all the hosts found by a &(dnslookup)& router are
16769 discarded in this way, the router declines. In a conventional configuration, an
16770 attempt to mail to such a domain would normally provoke the &"unrouteable
16771 domain"& error, and an attempt to verify an address in the domain would fail.
16772 Similarly, if &%ignore_target_hosts%& is set on an &(ipliteral)& router, the
16773 router declines if presented with one of the listed addresses.
16774
16775 You can use this option to disable the use of IPv4 or IPv6 for mail delivery by
16776 means of the first or the second of the following settings, respectively:
16777 .code
16778 ignore_target_hosts = 0.0.0.0/0
16779 ignore_target_hosts = <; 0::0/0
16780 .endd
16781 The pattern in the first line matches all IPv4 addresses, whereas the pattern
16782 in the second line matches all IPv6 addresses.
16783
16784 This option may also be useful for ignoring link-local and site-local IPv6
16785 addresses. Because, like all host lists, the value of &%ignore_target_hosts%&
16786 is expanded before use as a list, it is possible to make it dependent on the
16787 domain that is being routed.
16788
16789 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
16790 During its expansion, &$host_address$& is set to the IP address that is being
16791 checked.
16792
16793 .option initgroups routers boolean false
16794 .cindex "additional groups"
16795 .cindex "groups" "additional"
16796 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
16797 .cindex "transport" "local"
16798 If the router queues an address for a transport, and this option is true, and
16799 the uid supplied by the router is not overridden by the transport, the
16800 &[initgroups()]& function is called when running the transport to ensure that
16801 any additional groups associated with the uid are set up. See also &%group%&
16802 and &%user%& and the discussion in chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
16803
16804
16805
16806 .option local_part_prefix routers&!? "string list" unset
16807 .cindex "router" "prefix for local part"
16808 .cindex "prefix" "for local part, used in router"
16809 If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the local part starts with
16810 one of the given strings, or &%local_part_prefix_optional%& is true. See
16811 section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions are
16812 evaluated.
16813
16814 The list is scanned from left to right, and the first prefix that matches is
16815 used. A limited form of wildcard is available; if the prefix begins with an
16816 asterisk, it matches the longest possible sequence of arbitrary characters at
16817 the start of the local part. An asterisk should therefore always be followed by
16818 some character that does not occur in normal local parts.
16819 .cindex "multiple mailboxes"
16820 .cindex "mailbox" "multiple"
16821 Wildcarding can be used to set up multiple user mailboxes, as described in
16822 section &<<SECTmulbox>>&.
16823
16824 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
16825 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
16826 During the testing of the &%local_parts%& option, and while the router is
16827 running, the prefix is removed from the local part, and is available in the
16828 expansion variable &$local_part_prefix$&. When a message is being delivered, if
16829 the router accepts the address, this remains true during subsequent delivery by
16830 a transport. In particular, the local part that is transmitted in the RCPT
16831 command for LMTP, SMTP, and BSMTP deliveries has the prefix removed by default.
16832 This behaviour can be overridden by setting &%rcpt_include_affixes%& true on
16833 the relevant transport.
16834
16835 When an address is being verified, &%local_part_prefix%& affects only the
16836 behaviour of the router. If the callout feature of verification is in use, this
16837 means that the full address, including the prefix, will be used during the
16838 callout.
16839
16840 The prefix facility is commonly used to handle local parts of the form
16841 &%owner-something%&. Another common use is to support local parts of the form
16842 &%real-username%& to bypass a user's &_.forward_& file &-- helpful when trying
16843 to tell a user their forwarding is broken &-- by placing a router like this one
16844 immediately before the router that handles &_.forward_& files:
16845 .code
16846 real_localuser:
16847 driver = accept
16848 local_part_prefix = real-
16849 check_local_user
16850 transport = local_delivery
16851 .endd
16852 For security, it would probably be a good idea to restrict the use of this
16853 router to locally-generated messages, using a condition such as this:
16854 .code
16855 condition = ${if match {$sender_host_address}\
16856 {\N^(|127\.0\.0\.1)$\N}}
16857 .endd
16858
16859 If both &%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& are set for a router,
16860 both conditions must be met if not optional. Care must be taken if wildcards
16861 are used in both a prefix and a suffix on the same router. Different
16862 separator characters must be used to avoid ambiguity.
16863
16864
16865 .option local_part_prefix_optional routers boolean false
16866 See &%local_part_prefix%& above.
16867
16868
16869
16870 .option local_part_suffix routers&!? "string list" unset
16871 .cindex "router" "suffix for local part"
16872 .cindex "suffix for local part" "used in router"
16873 This option operates in the same way as &%local_part_prefix%&, except that the
16874 local part must end (rather than start) with the given string, the
16875 &%local_part_suffix_optional%& option determines whether the suffix is
16876 mandatory, and the wildcard * character, if present, must be the last
16877 character of the suffix. This option facility is commonly used to handle local
16878 parts of the form &%something-request%& and multiple user mailboxes of the form
16879 &%username-foo%&.
16880
16881
16882 .option local_part_suffix_optional routers boolean false
16883 See &%local_part_suffix%& above.
16884
16885
16886
16887 .option local_parts routers&!? "local part list&!!" unset
16888 .cindex "router" "restricting to specific local parts"
16889 .cindex "local part" "checking in router"
16890 The router is run only if the local part of the address matches the list.
16891 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
16892 are evaluated, and
16893 section &<<SECTlocparlis>>& for a discussion of local part lists. Because the
16894 string is expanded, it is possible to make it depend on the domain, for
16895 example:
16896 .code
16897 local_parts = dbm;/usr/local/specials/$domain
16898 .endd
16899 .vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
16900 If the match is achieved by a lookup, the data that the lookup returned
16901 for the local part is placed in the variable &$local_part_data$& for use in
16902 expansions of the router's private options. You might use this option, for
16903 example, if you have a large number of local virtual domains, and you want to
16904 send all postmaster mail to the same place without having to set up an alias in
16905 each virtual domain:
16906 .code
16907 postmaster:
16908 driver = redirect
16909 local_parts = postmaster
16910 data = postmaster@real.domain.example
16911 .endd
16912
16913
16914 .option log_as_local routers boolean "see below"
16915 .cindex "log" "delivery line"
16916 .cindex "delivery" "log line format"
16917 Exim has two logging styles for delivery, the idea being to make local
16918 deliveries stand out more visibly from remote ones. In the &"local"& style, the
16919 recipient address is given just as the local part, without a domain. The use of
16920 this style is controlled by this option. It defaults to true for the &(accept)&
16921 router, and false for all the others. This option applies only when a
16922 router assigns an address to a transport. It has no effect on routers that
16923 redirect addresses.
16924
16925
16926
16927 .option more routers boolean&!! true
16928 The result of string expansion for this option must be a valid boolean value,
16929 that is, one of the strings &"yes"&, &"no"&, &"true"&, or &"false"&. Any other
16930 result causes an error, and delivery is deferred. If the expansion is forced to
16931 fail, the default value for the option (true) is used. Other failures cause
16932 delivery to be deferred.
16933
16934 If this option is set false, and the router declines to handle the address, no
16935 further routers are tried, routing fails, and the address is bounced.
16936 .oindex "&%self%&"
16937 However, if the router explicitly passes an address to the following router by
16938 means of the setting
16939 .code
16940 self = pass
16941 .endd
16942 or otherwise, the setting of &%more%& is ignored. Also, the setting of &%more%&
16943 does not affect the behaviour if one of the precondition tests fails. In that
16944 case, the address is always passed to the next router.
16945
16946 Note that &%address_data%& is not considered to be a precondition. If its
16947 expansion is forced to fail, the router declines, and the value of &%more%&
16948 controls what happens next.
16949
16950
16951 .option pass_on_timeout routers boolean false
16952 .cindex "timeout" "of router"
16953 .cindex "router" "timeout"
16954 If a router times out during a host lookup, it normally causes deferral of the
16955 address. If &%pass_on_timeout%& is set, the address is passed on to the next
16956 router, overriding &%no_more%&. This may be helpful for systems that are
16957 intermittently connected to the Internet, or those that want to pass to a smart
16958 host any messages that cannot immediately be delivered.
16959
16960 There are occasional other temporary errors that can occur while doing DNS
16961 lookups. They are treated in the same way as a timeout, and this option
16962 applies to all of them.
16963
16964
16965
16966 .option pass_router routers string unset
16967 .cindex "router" "go to after &""pass""&"
16968 Routers that recognize the generic &%self%& option (&(dnslookup)&,
16969 &(ipliteral)&, and &(manualroute)&) are able to return &"pass"&, forcing
16970 routing to continue, and overriding a false setting of &%more%&. When one of
16971 these routers returns &"pass"&, the address is normally handed on to the next
16972 router in sequence. This can be changed by setting &%pass_router%& to the name
16973 of another router. However (unlike &%redirect_router%&) the named router must
16974 be below the current router, to avoid loops. Note that this option applies only
16975 to the special case of &"pass"&. It does not apply when a router returns
16976 &"decline"& because it cannot handle an address.
16977
16978
16979
16980 .option redirect_router routers string unset
16981 .cindex "router" "start at after redirection"
16982 Sometimes an administrator knows that it is pointless to reprocess addresses
16983 generated from alias or forward files with the same router again. For
16984 example, if an alias file translates real names into login ids there is no
16985 point searching the alias file a second time, especially if it is a large file.
16986
16987 The &%redirect_router%& option can be set to the name of any router instance.
16988 It causes the routing of any generated addresses to start at the named router
16989 instead of at the first router. This option has no effect if the router in
16990 which it is set does not generate new addresses.
16991
16992
16993
16994 .option require_files routers&!? "string list&!!" unset
16995 .cindex "file" "requiring for router"
16996 .cindex "router" "requiring file existence"
16997 This option provides a general mechanism for predicating the running of a
16998 router on the existence or non-existence of certain files or directories.
16999 Before running a router, as one of its precondition tests, Exim works its way
17000 through the &%require_files%& list, expanding each item separately.
17001
17002 Because the list is split before expansion, any colons in expansion items must
17003 be doubled, or the facility for using a different list separator must be used.
17004 If any expansion is forced to fail, the item is ignored. Other expansion
17005 failures cause routing of the address to be deferred.
17006
17007 If any expanded string is empty, it is ignored. Otherwise, except as described
17008 below, each string must be a fully qualified file path, optionally preceded by
17009 &"!"&. The paths are passed to the &[stat()]& function to test for the
17010 existence of the files or directories. The router is skipped if any paths not
17011 preceded by &"!"& do not exist, or if any paths preceded by &"!"& do exist.
17012
17013 .cindex "NFS"
17014 If &[stat()]& cannot determine whether a file exists or not, delivery of
17015 the message is deferred. This can happen when NFS-mounted filesystems are
17016 unavailable.
17017
17018 This option is checked after the &%domains%&, &%local_parts%&, and &%senders%&
17019 options, so you cannot use it to check for the existence of a file in which to
17020 look up a domain, local part, or sender. (See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a
17021 full list of the order in which preconditions are evaluated.) However, as
17022 these options are all expanded, you can use the &%exists%& expansion condition
17023 to make such tests. The &%require_files%& option is intended for checking files
17024 that the router may be going to use internally, or which are needed by a
17025 transport (for example &_.procmailrc_&).
17026
17027 During delivery, the &[stat()]& function is run as root, but there is a
17028 facility for some checking of the accessibility of a file by another user.
17029 This is not a proper permissions check, but just a &"rough"& check that
17030 operates as follows:
17031
17032 If an item in a &%require_files%& list does not contain any forward slash
17033 characters, it is taken to be the user (and optional group, separated by a
17034 comma) to be checked for subsequent files in the list. If no group is specified
17035 but the user is specified symbolically, the gid associated with the uid is
17036 used. For example:
17037 .code
17038 require_files = mail:/some/file
17039 require_files = $local_part:$home/.procmailrc
17040 .endd
17041 If a user or group name in a &%require_files%& list does not exist, the
17042 &%require_files%& condition fails.
17043
17044 Exim performs the check by scanning along the components of the file path, and
17045 checking the access for the given uid and gid. It checks for &"x"& access on
17046 directories, and &"r"& access on the final file. Note that this means that file
17047 access control lists, if the operating system has them, are ignored.
17048
17049 &*Warning 1*&: When the router is being run to verify addresses for an
17050 incoming SMTP message, Exim is not running as root, but under its own uid. This
17051 may affect the result of a &%require_files%& check. In particular, &[stat()]&
17052 may yield the error EACCES (&"Permission denied"&). This means that the Exim
17053 user is not permitted to read one of the directories on the file's path.
17054
17055 &*Warning 2*&: Even when Exim is running as root while delivering a message,
17056 &[stat()]& can yield EACCES for a file in an NFS directory that is mounted
17057 without root access. In this case, if a check for access by a particular user
17058 is requested, Exim creates a subprocess that runs as that user, and tries the
17059 check again in that process.
17060
17061 The default action for handling an unresolved EACCES is to consider it to
17062 be caused by a configuration error, and routing is deferred because the
17063 existence or non-existence of the file cannot be determined. However, in some
17064 circumstances it may be desirable to treat this condition as if the file did
17065 not exist. If the file name (or the exclamation mark that precedes the file
17066 name for non-existence) is preceded by a plus sign, the EACCES error is treated
17067 as if the file did not exist. For example:
17068 .code
17069 require_files = +/some/file
17070 .endd
17071 If the router is not an essential part of verification (for example, it
17072 handles users' &_.forward_& files), another solution is to set the &%verify%&
17073 option false so that the router is skipped when verifying.
17074
17075
17076
17077 .option retry_use_local_part routers boolean "see below"
17078 .cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
17079 .cindex "local part" "in retry keys"
17080 When a delivery suffers a temporary routing failure, a retry record is created
17081 in Exim's hints database. For addresses whose routing depends only on the
17082 domain, the key for the retry record should not involve the local part, but for
17083 other addresses, both the domain and the local part should be included.
17084 Usually, remote routing is of the former kind, and local routing is of the
17085 latter kind.
17086
17087 This option controls whether the local part is used to form the key for retry
17088 hints for addresses that suffer temporary errors while being handled by this
17089 router. The default value is true for any router that has &%check_local_user%&
17090 set, and false otherwise. Note that this option does not apply to hints keys
17091 for transport delays; they are controlled by a generic transport option of the
17092 same name.
17093
17094 The setting of &%retry_use_local_part%& applies only to the router on which it
17095 appears. If the router generates child addresses, they are routed
17096 independently; this setting does not become attached to them.
17097
17098
17099
17100 .option router_home_directory routers string&!! unset
17101 .cindex "router" "home directory for"
17102 .cindex "home directory" "for router"
17103 .vindex "&$home$&"
17104 This option sets a home directory for use while the router is running. (Compare
17105 &%transport_home_directory%&, which sets a home directory for later
17106 transporting.) In particular, if used on a &(redirect)& router, this option
17107 sets a value for &$home$& while a filter is running. The value is expanded;
17108 forced expansion failure causes the option to be ignored &-- other failures
17109 cause the router to defer.
17110
17111 Expansion of &%router_home_directory%& happens immediately after the
17112 &%check_local_user%& test (if configured), before any further expansions take
17113 place.
17114 (See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
17115 are evaluated.)
17116 While the router is running, &%router_home_directory%& overrides the value of
17117 &$home$& that came from &%check_local_user%&.
17118
17119 When a router accepts an address and assigns it to a local transport (including
17120 the cases when a &(redirect)& router generates a pipe, file, or autoreply
17121 delivery), the home directory setting for the transport is taken from the first
17122 of these values that is set:
17123
17124 .ilist
17125 The &%home_directory%& option on the transport;
17126 .next
17127 The &%transport_home_directory%& option on the router;
17128 .next
17129 The password data if &%check_local_user%& is set on the router;
17130 .next
17131 The &%router_home_directory%& option on the router.
17132 .endlist
17133
17134 In other words, &%router_home_directory%& overrides the password data for the
17135 router, but not for the transport.
17136
17137
17138
17139 .option self routers string freeze
17140 .cindex "MX record" "pointing to local host"
17141 .cindex "local host" "MX pointing to"
17142 This option applies to those routers that use a recipient address to find a
17143 list of remote hosts. Currently, these are the &(dnslookup)&, &(ipliteral)&,
17144 and &(manualroute)& routers.
17145 Certain configurations of the &(queryprogram)& router can also specify a list
17146 of remote hosts.
17147 Usually such routers are configured to send the message to a remote host via an
17148 &(smtp)& transport. The &%self%& option specifies what happens when the first
17149 host on the list turns out to be the local host.
17150 The way in which Exim checks for the local host is described in section
17151 &<<SECTreclocipadd>>&.
17152
17153 Normally this situation indicates either an error in Exim's configuration (for
17154 example, the router should be configured not to process this domain), or an
17155 error in the DNS (for example, the MX should not point to this host). For this
17156 reason, the default action is to log the incident, defer the address, and
17157 freeze the message. The following alternatives are provided for use in special
17158 cases:
17159
17160 .vlist
17161 .vitem &%defer%&
17162 Delivery of the message is tried again later, but the message is not frozen.
17163
17164 .vitem "&%reroute%&: <&'domain'&>"
17165 The domain is changed to the given domain, and the address is passed back to
17166 be reprocessed by the routers. No rewriting of headers takes place. This
17167 behaviour is essentially a redirection.
17168
17169 .vitem "&%reroute: rewrite:%& <&'domain'&>"
17170 The domain is changed to the given domain, and the address is passed back to be
17171 reprocessed by the routers. Any headers that contain the original domain are
17172 rewritten.
17173
17174 .vitem &%pass%&
17175 .oindex "&%more%&"
17176 .vindex "&$self_hostname$&"
17177 The router passes the address to the next router, or to the router named in the
17178 &%pass_router%& option if it is set. This overrides &%no_more%&. During
17179 subsequent routing and delivery, the variable &$self_hostname$& contains the
17180 name of the local host that the router encountered. This can be used to
17181 distinguish between different cases for hosts with multiple names. The
17182 combination
17183 .code
17184 self = pass
17185 no_more
17186 .endd
17187 ensures that only those addresses that routed to the local host are passed on.
17188 Without &%no_more%&, addresses that were declined for other reasons would also
17189 be passed to the next router.
17190
17191 .vitem &%fail%&
17192 Delivery fails and an error report is generated.
17193
17194 .vitem &%send%&
17195 .cindex "local host" "sending to"
17196 The anomaly is ignored and the address is queued for the transport. This
17197 setting should be used with extreme caution. For an &(smtp)& transport, it
17198 makes sense only in cases where the program that is listening on the SMTP port
17199 is not this version of Exim. That is, it must be some other MTA, or Exim with a
17200 different configuration file that handles the domain in another way.
17201 .endlist
17202
17203
17204
17205 .option senders routers&!? "address list&!!" unset
17206 .cindex "router" "checking senders"
17207 If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the message's sender
17208 address matches something on the list.
17209 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
17210 are evaluated.
17211
17212 There are issues concerning verification when the running of routers is
17213 dependent on the sender. When Exim is verifying the address in an &%errors_to%&
17214 setting, it sets the sender to the null string. When using the &%-bt%& option
17215 to check a configuration file, it is necessary also to use the &%-f%& option to
17216 set an appropriate sender. For incoming mail, the sender is unset when
17217 verifying the sender, but is available when verifying any recipients. If the
17218 SMTP VRFY command is enabled, it must be used after MAIL if the sender address
17219 matters.
17220
17221
17222 .option translate_ip_address routers string&!! unset
17223 .cindex "IP address" "translating"
17224 .cindex "packet radio"
17225 .cindex "router" "IP address translation"
17226 There exist some rare networking situations (for example, packet radio) where
17227 it is helpful to be able to translate IP addresses generated by normal routing
17228 mechanisms into other IP addresses, thus performing a kind of manual IP
17229 routing. This should be done only if the normal IP routing of the TCP/IP stack
17230 is inadequate or broken. Because this is an extremely uncommon requirement, the
17231 code to support this option is not included in the Exim binary unless
17232 SUPPORT_TRANSLATE_IP_ADDRESS=yes is set in &_Local/Makefile_&.
17233
17234 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
17235 The &%translate_ip_address%& string is expanded for every IP address generated
17236 by the router, with the generated address set in &$host_address$&. If the
17237 expansion is forced to fail, no action is taken.
17238 For any other expansion error, delivery of the message is deferred.
17239 If the result of the expansion is an IP address, that replaces the original
17240 address; otherwise the result is assumed to be a host name &-- this is looked
17241 up using &[gethostbyname()]& (or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available) to
17242 produce one or more replacement IP addresses. For example, to subvert all IP
17243 addresses in some specific networks, this could be added to a router:
17244 .code
17245 translate_ip_address = \
17246 ${lookup{${mask:$host_address/26}}lsearch{/some/file}\
17247 {$value}fail}}
17248 .endd
17249 The file would contain lines like
17250 .code
17251 10.2.3.128/26 some.host
17252 10.8.4.34/26 10.44.8.15
17253 .endd
17254 You should not make use of this facility unless you really understand what you
17255 are doing.
17256
17257
17258
17259 .option transport routers string&!! unset
17260 This option specifies the transport to be used when a router accepts an address
17261 and sets it up for delivery. A transport is never needed if a router is used
17262 only for verification. The value of the option is expanded at routing time,
17263 after the expansion of &%errors_to%&, &%headers_add%&, and &%headers_remove%&,
17264 and result must be the name of one of the configured transports. If it is not,
17265 delivery is deferred.
17266
17267 The &%transport%& option is not used by the &(redirect)& router, but it does
17268 have some private options that set up transports for pipe and file deliveries
17269 (see chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>&).
17270
17271
17272
17273 .option transport_current_directory routers string&!! unset
17274 .cindex "current directory for local transport"
17275 This option associates a current directory with any address that is routed
17276 to a local transport. This can happen either because a transport is
17277 explicitly configured for the router, or because it generates a delivery to a
17278 file or a pipe. During the delivery process (that is, at transport time), this
17279 option string is expanded and is set as the current directory, unless
17280 overridden by a setting on the transport.
17281 If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
17282 logged, and delivery is deferred.
17283 See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for details of the local delivery
17284 environment.
17285
17286
17287
17288
17289 .option transport_home_directory routers string&!! "see below"
17290 .cindex "home directory" "for local transport"
17291 This option associates a home directory with any address that is routed to a
17292 local transport. This can happen either because a transport is explicitly
17293 configured for the router, or because it generates a delivery to a file or a
17294 pipe. During the delivery process (that is, at transport time), the option
17295 string is expanded and is set as the home directory, unless overridden by a
17296 setting of &%home_directory%& on the transport.
17297 If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
17298 logged, and delivery is deferred.
17299
17300 If the transport does not specify a home directory, and
17301 &%transport_home_directory%& is not set for the router, the home directory for
17302 the transport is taken from the password data if &%check_local_user%& is set for
17303 the router. Otherwise it is taken from &%router_home_directory%& if that option
17304 is set; if not, no home directory is set for the transport.
17305
17306 See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for further details of the local delivery
17307 environment.
17308
17309
17310
17311
17312 .option unseen routers boolean&!! false
17313 .cindex "router" "carrying on after success"
17314 The result of string expansion for this option must be a valid boolean value,
17315 that is, one of the strings &"yes"&, &"no"&, &"true"&, or &"false"&. Any other
17316 result causes an error, and delivery is deferred. If the expansion is forced to
17317 fail, the default value for the option (false) is used. Other failures cause
17318 delivery to be deferred.
17319
17320 When this option is set true, routing does not cease if the router accepts the
17321 address. Instead, a copy of the incoming address is passed to the next router,
17322 overriding a false setting of &%more%&. There is little point in setting
17323 &%more%& false if &%unseen%& is always true, but it may be useful in cases when
17324 the value of &%unseen%& contains expansion items (and therefore, presumably, is
17325 sometimes true and sometimes false).
17326
17327 .cindex "copy of message (&%unseen%& option)"
17328 Setting the &%unseen%& option has a similar effect to the &%unseen%& command
17329 qualifier in filter files. It can be used to cause copies of messages to be
17330 delivered to some other destination, while also carrying out a normal delivery.
17331 In effect, the current address is made into a &"parent"& that has two children
17332 &-- one that is delivered as specified by this router, and a clone that goes on
17333 to be routed further. For this reason, &%unseen%& may not be combined with the
17334 &%one_time%& option in a &(redirect)& router.
17335
17336 &*Warning*&: Header lines added to the address (or specified for removal) by
17337 this router or by previous routers affect the &"unseen"& copy of the message
17338 only. The clone that continues to be processed by further routers starts with
17339 no added headers and none specified for removal. For a &%redirect%& router, if
17340 a generated address is the same as the incoming address, this can lead to
17341 duplicate addresses with different header modifications. Exim does not do
17342 duplicate deliveries (except, in certain circumstances, to pipes -- see section
17343 &<<SECTdupaddr>>&), but it is undefined which of the duplicates is discarded,
17344 so this ambiguous situation should be avoided. The &%repeat_use%& option of the
17345 &%redirect%& router may be of help.
17346
17347 Unlike the handling of header modifications, any data that was set by the
17348 &%address_data%& option in the current or previous routers &'is'& passed on to
17349 subsequent routers.
17350
17351
17352 .option user routers string&!! "see below"
17353 .cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
17354 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
17355 .cindex "transport" "local"
17356 .cindex "router" "user for filter processing"
17357 .cindex "filter" "user for processing"
17358 When a router queues an address for a transport, and the transport does not
17359 specify a user, the user given here is used when running the delivery process.
17360 The user may be specified numerically or by name. If expansion fails, the
17361 error is logged and delivery is deferred.
17362 This user is also used by the &(redirect)& router when running a filter file.
17363 The default is unset, except when &%check_local_user%& is set. In this case,
17364 the default is taken from the password information. If the user is specified as
17365 a name, and &%group%& is not set, the group associated with the user is used.
17366 See also &%initgroups%& and &%group%& and the discussion in chapter
17367 &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
17368
17369
17370
17371 .option verify routers&!? boolean true
17372 Setting this option has the effect of setting &%verify_sender%& and
17373 &%verify_recipient%& to the same value.
17374
17375
17376 .option verify_only routers&!? boolean false
17377 .cindex "EXPN" "with &%verify_only%&"
17378 .oindex "&%-bv%&"
17379 .cindex "router" "used only when verifying"
17380 If this option is set, the router is used only when verifying an address,
17381 delivering in cutthrough mode or
17382 testing with the &%-bv%& option, not when actually doing a delivery, testing
17383 with the &%-bt%& option, or running the SMTP EXPN command. It can be further
17384 restricted to verifying only senders or recipients by means of
17385 &%verify_sender%& and &%verify_recipient%&.
17386
17387 &*Warning*&: When the router is being run to verify addresses for an incoming
17388 SMTP message, Exim is not running as root, but under its own uid. If the router
17389 accesses any files, you need to make sure that they are accessible to the Exim
17390 user or group.
17391
17392
17393 .option verify_recipient routers&!? boolean true
17394 If this option is false, the router is skipped when verifying recipient
17395 addresses,
17396 delivering in cutthrough mode
17397 or testing recipient verification using &%-bv%&.
17398 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
17399 are evaluated.
17400
17401
17402 .option verify_sender routers&!? boolean true
17403 If this option is false, the router is skipped when verifying sender addresses
17404 or testing sender verification using &%-bvs%&.
17405 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
17406 are evaluated.
17407 .ecindex IIDgenoprou1
17408 .ecindex IIDgenoprou2
17409
17410
17411
17412
17413
17414
17415 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
17416 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
17417
17418 .chapter "The accept router" "CHID4"
17419 .cindex "&(accept)& router"
17420 .cindex "routers" "&(accept)&"
17421 The &(accept)& router has no private options of its own. Unless it is being
17422 used purely for verification (see &%verify_only%&) a transport is required to
17423 be defined by the generic &%transport%& option. If the preconditions that are
17424 specified by generic options are met, the router accepts the address and queues
17425 it for the given transport. The most common use of this router is for setting
17426 up deliveries to local mailboxes. For example:
17427 .code
17428 localusers:
17429 driver = accept
17430 domains = mydomain.example
17431 check_local_user
17432 transport = local_delivery
17433 .endd
17434 The &%domains%& condition in this example checks the domain of the address, and
17435 &%check_local_user%& checks that the local part is the login of a local user.
17436 When both preconditions are met, the &(accept)& router runs, and queues the
17437 address for the &(local_delivery)& transport.
17438
17439
17440
17441
17442
17443
17444 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
17445 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
17446
17447 .chapter "The dnslookup router" "CHAPdnslookup"
17448 .scindex IIDdnsrou1 "&(dnslookup)& router"
17449 .scindex IIDdnsrou2 "routers" "&(dnslookup)&"
17450 The &(dnslookup)& router looks up the hosts that handle mail for the
17451 recipient's domain in the DNS. A transport must always be set for this router,
17452 unless &%verify_only%& is set.
17453
17454 If SRV support is configured (see &%check_srv%& below), Exim first searches for
17455 SRV records. If none are found, or if SRV support is not configured,
17456 MX records are looked up. If no MX records exist, address records are sought.
17457 However, &%mx_domains%& can be set to disable the direct use of address
17458 records.
17459
17460 MX records of equal priority are sorted by Exim into a random order. Exim then
17461 looks for address records for the host names obtained from MX or SRV records.
17462 When a host has more than one IP address, they are sorted into a random order,
17463 except that IPv6 addresses are always sorted before IPv4 addresses. If all the
17464 IP addresses found are discarded by a setting of the &%ignore_target_hosts%&
17465 generic option, the router declines.
17466
17467 Unless they have the highest priority (lowest MX value), MX records that point
17468 to the local host, or to any host name that matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&,
17469 are discarded, together with any other MX records of equal or lower priority.
17470
17471 .cindex "MX record" "pointing to local host"
17472 .cindex "local host" "MX pointing to"
17473 .oindex "&%self%&" "in &(dnslookup)& router"
17474 If the host pointed to by the highest priority MX record, or looked up as an
17475 address record, is the local host, or matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, what
17476 happens is controlled by the generic &%self%& option.
17477
17478
17479 .section "Problems with DNS lookups" "SECTprowitdnsloo"
17480 There have been problems with DNS servers when SRV records are looked up.
17481 Some mis-behaving servers return a DNS error or timeout when a non-existent
17482 SRV record is sought. Similar problems have in the past been reported for
17483 MX records. The global &%dns_again_means_nonexist%& option can help with this
17484 problem, but it is heavy-handed because it is a global option.
17485
17486 For this reason, there are two options, &%srv_fail_domains%& and
17487 &%mx_fail_domains%&, that control what happens when a DNS lookup in a
17488 &(dnslookup)& router results in a DNS failure or a &"try again"& response. If
17489 an attempt to look up an SRV or MX record causes one of these results, and the
17490 domain matches the relevant list, Exim behaves as if the DNS had responded &"no
17491 such record"&. In the case of an SRV lookup, this means that the router
17492 proceeds to look for MX records; in the case of an MX lookup, it proceeds to
17493 look for A or AAAA records, unless the domain matches &%mx_domains%&, in which
17494 case routing fails.
17495
17496
17497 .section "Declining addresses by dnslookup" "SECTdnslookupdecline"
17498 .cindex "&(dnslookup)& router" "declines"
17499 There are a few cases where a &(dnslookup)& router will decline to accept
17500 an address; if such a router is expected to handle "all remaining non-local
17501 domains", then it is important to set &%no_more%&.
17502
17503 Reasons for a &(dnslookup)& router to decline currently include:
17504 .ilist
17505 The domain does not exist in DNS
17506 .next
17507 The domain exists but the MX record's host part is just "."; this is a common
17508 convention (borrowed from SRV) used to indicate that there is no such service
17509 for this domain and to not fall back to trying A/AAAA records.
17510 .next
17511 Ditto, but for SRV records, when &%check_srv%& is set on this router.
17512 .next
17513 MX record points to a non-existent host.
17514 .next
17515 MX record points to an IP address and the main section option
17516 &%allow_mx_to_ip%& is not set.
17517 .next
17518 MX records exist and point to valid hosts, but all hosts resolve only to
17519 addresses blocked by the &%ignore_target_hosts%& generic option on this router.
17520 .next
17521 The domain is not syntactically valid (see also &%allow_utf8_domains%& and
17522 &%dns_check_names_pattern%& for handling one variant of this)
17523 .next
17524 &%check_secondary_mx%& is set on this router but the local host can
17525 not be found in the MX records (see below)
17526 .endlist
17527
17528
17529
17530
17531 .section "Private options for dnslookup" "SECID118"
17532 .cindex "options" "&(dnslookup)& router"
17533 The private options for the &(dnslookup)& router are as follows:
17534
17535 .option check_secondary_mx dnslookup boolean false
17536 .cindex "MX record" "checking for secondary"
17537 If this option is set, the router declines unless the local host is found in
17538 (and removed from) the list of hosts obtained by MX lookup. This can be used to
17539 process domains for which the local host is a secondary mail exchanger
17540 differently to other domains. The way in which Exim decides whether a host is
17541 the local host is described in section &<<SECTreclocipadd>>&.
17542
17543
17544 .option check_srv dnslookup string&!! unset
17545 .cindex "SRV record" "enabling use of"
17546 The &(dnslookup)& router supports the use of SRV records (see RFC 2782) in
17547 addition to MX and address records. The support is disabled by default. To
17548 enable SRV support, set the &%check_srv%& option to the name of the service
17549 required. For example,
17550 .code
17551 check_srv = smtp
17552 .endd
17553 looks for SRV records that refer to the normal smtp service. The option is
17554 expanded, so the service name can vary from message to message or address
17555 to address. This might be helpful if SRV records are being used for a
17556 submission service. If the expansion is forced to fail, the &%check_srv%&
17557 option is ignored, and the router proceeds to look for MX records in the
17558 normal way.
17559
17560 When the expansion succeeds, the router searches first for SRV records for
17561 the given service (it assumes TCP protocol). A single SRV record with a
17562 host name that consists of just a single dot indicates &"no such service for
17563 this domain"&; if this is encountered, the router declines. If other kinds of
17564 SRV record are found, they are used to construct a host list for delivery
17565 according to the rules of RFC 2782. MX records are not sought in this case.
17566
17567 When no SRV records are found, MX records (and address records) are sought in
17568 the traditional way. In other words, SRV records take precedence over MX
17569 records, just as MX records take precedence over address records. Note that
17570 this behaviour is not sanctioned by RFC 2782, though a previous draft RFC
17571 defined it. It is apparently believed that MX records are sufficient for email
17572 and that SRV records should not be used for this purpose. However, SRV records
17573 have an additional &"weight"& feature which some people might find useful when
17574 trying to split an SMTP load between hosts of different power.
17575
17576 See section &<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& above for a discussion of Exim's behaviour
17577 when there is a DNS lookup error.
17578
17579
17580
17581 .option mx_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
17582 .cindex "MX record" "required to exist"
17583 .cindex "SRV record" "required to exist"
17584 A domain that matches &%mx_domains%& is required to have either an MX or an SRV
17585 record in order to be recognized. (The name of this option could be improved.)
17586 For example, if all the mail hosts in &'fict.example'& are known to have MX
17587 records, except for those in &'discworld.fict.example'&, you could use this
17588 setting:
17589 .code
17590 mx_domains = ! *.discworld.fict.example : *.fict.example
17591 .endd
17592 This specifies that messages addressed to a domain that matches the list but
17593 has no MX record should be bounced immediately instead of being routed using
17594 the address record.
17595
17596
17597 .option mx_fail_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
17598 If the DNS lookup for MX records for one of the domains in this list causes a
17599 DNS lookup error, Exim behaves as if no MX records were found. See section
17600 &<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& for more discussion.
17601
17602
17603
17604
17605 .option qualify_single dnslookup boolean true
17606 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
17607 .cindex "DNS" "qualifying single-component names"
17608 When this option is true, the resolver option RES_DEFNAMES is set for DNS
17609 lookups. Typically, but not standardly, this causes the resolver to qualify
17610 single-component names with the default domain. For example, on a machine
17611 called &'dictionary.ref.example'&, the domain &'thesaurus'& would be changed to
17612 &'thesaurus.ref.example'& inside the resolver. For details of what your
17613 resolver actually does, consult your man pages for &'resolver'& and
17614 &'resolv.conf'&.
17615
17616
17617
17618 .option rewrite_headers dnslookup boolean true
17619 .cindex "rewriting" "header lines"
17620 .cindex "header lines" "rewriting"
17621 If the domain name in the address that is being processed is not fully
17622 qualified, it may be expanded to its full form by a DNS lookup. For example, if
17623 an address is specified as &'dormouse@teaparty'&, the domain might be
17624 expanded to &'teaparty.wonderland.fict.example'&. Domain expansion can also
17625 occur as a result of setting the &%widen_domains%& option. If
17626 &%rewrite_headers%& is true, all occurrences of the abbreviated domain name in
17627 any &'Bcc:'&, &'Cc:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-to:'&, &'Sender:'&, and &'To:'&
17628 header lines of the message are rewritten with the full domain name.
17629
17630 This option should be turned off only when it is known that no message is
17631 ever going to be sent outside an environment where the abbreviation makes
17632 sense.
17633
17634 When an MX record is looked up in the DNS and matches a wildcard record, name
17635 servers normally return a record containing the name that has been looked up,
17636 making it impossible to detect whether a wildcard was present or not. However,
17637 some name servers have recently been seen to return the wildcard entry. If the
17638 name returned by a DNS lookup begins with an asterisk, it is not used for
17639 header rewriting.
17640
17641
17642 .option same_domain_copy_routing dnslookup boolean false
17643 .cindex "address" "copying routing"
17644 Addresses with the same domain are normally routed by the &(dnslookup)& router
17645 to the same list of hosts. However, this cannot be presumed, because the router
17646 options and preconditions may refer to the local part of the address. By
17647 default, therefore, Exim routes each address in a message independently. DNS
17648 servers run caches, so repeated DNS lookups are not normally expensive, and in
17649 any case, personal messages rarely have more than a few recipients.
17650
17651 If you are running mailing lists with large numbers of subscribers at the same
17652 domain, and you are using a &(dnslookup)& router which is independent of the
17653 local part, you can set &%same_domain_copy_routing%& to bypass repeated DNS
17654 lookups for identical domains in one message. In this case, when &(dnslookup)&
17655 routes an address to a remote transport, any other unrouted addresses in the
17656 message that have the same domain are automatically given the same routing
17657 without processing them independently,
17658 provided the following conditions are met:
17659
17660 .ilist
17661 No router that processed the address specified &%headers_add%& or
17662 &%headers_remove%&.
17663 .next
17664 The router did not change the address in any way, for example, by &"widening"&
17665 the domain.
17666 .endlist
17667
17668
17669
17670
17671 .option search_parents dnslookup boolean false
17672 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
17673 When this option is true, the resolver option RES_DNSRCH is set for DNS
17674 lookups. This is different from the &%qualify_single%& option in that it
17675 applies to domains containing dots. Typically, but not standardly, it causes
17676 the resolver to search for the name in the current domain and in parent
17677 domains. For example, on a machine in the &'fict.example'& domain, if looking
17678 up &'teaparty.wonderland'& failed, the resolver would try
17679 &'teaparty.wonderland.fict.example'&. For details of what your resolver
17680 actually does, consult your man pages for &'resolver'& and &'resolv.conf'&.
17681
17682 Setting this option true can cause problems in domains that have a wildcard MX
17683 record, because any domain that does not have its own MX record matches the
17684 local wildcard.
17685
17686
17687
17688 .option srv_fail_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
17689 If the DNS lookup for SRV records for one of the domains in this list causes a
17690 DNS lookup error, Exim behaves as if no SRV records were found. See section
17691 &<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& for more discussion.
17692
17693
17694
17695
17696 .option widen_domains dnslookup "string list" unset
17697 .cindex "domain" "partial; widening"
17698 If a DNS lookup fails and this option is set, each of its strings in turn is
17699 added onto the end of the domain, and the lookup is tried again. For example,
17700 if
17701 .code
17702 widen_domains = fict.example:ref.example
17703 .endd
17704 is set and a lookup of &'klingon.dictionary'& fails,
17705 &'klingon.dictionary.fict.example'& is looked up, and if this fails,
17706 &'klingon.dictionary.ref.example'& is tried. Note that the &%qualify_single%&
17707 and &%search_parents%& options can cause some widening to be undertaken inside
17708 the DNS resolver. &%widen_domains%& is not applied to sender addresses
17709 when verifying, unless &%rewrite_headers%& is false (not the default).
17710
17711
17712 .section "Effect of qualify_single and search_parents" "SECID119"
17713 When a domain from an envelope recipient is changed by the resolver as a result
17714 of the &%qualify_single%& or &%search_parents%& options, Exim rewrites the
17715 corresponding address in the message's header lines unless &%rewrite_headers%&
17716 is set false. Exim then re-routes the address, using the full domain.
17717
17718 These two options affect only the DNS lookup that takes place inside the router
17719 for the domain of the address that is being routed. They do not affect lookups
17720 such as that implied by
17721 .code
17722 domains = @mx_any
17723 .endd
17724 that may happen while processing a router precondition before the router is
17725 entered. No widening ever takes place for these lookups.
17726 .ecindex IIDdnsrou1
17727 .ecindex IIDdnsrou2
17728
17729
17730
17731
17732
17733
17734
17735
17736
17737 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
17738 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
17739
17740 .chapter "The ipliteral router" "CHID5"
17741 .cindex "&(ipliteral)& router"
17742 .cindex "domain literal" "routing"
17743 .cindex "routers" "&(ipliteral)&"
17744 This router has no private options. Unless it is being used purely for
17745 verification (see &%verify_only%&) a transport is required to be defined by the
17746 generic &%transport%& option. The router accepts the address if its domain part
17747 takes the form of an RFC 2822 domain literal. For example, the &(ipliteral)&
17748 router handles the address
17749 .code
17750 root@[192.168.1.1]
17751 .endd
17752 by setting up delivery to the host with that IP address. IPv4 domain literals
17753 consist of an IPv4 address enclosed in square brackets. IPv6 domain literals
17754 are similar, but the address is preceded by &`ipv6:`&. For example:
17755 .code
17756 postmaster@[ipv6:fe80::a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678]
17757 .endd
17758 Exim allows &`ipv4:`& before IPv4 addresses, for consistency, and on the
17759 grounds that sooner or later somebody will try it.
17760
17761 .oindex "&%self%&" "in &(ipliteral)& router"
17762 If the IP address matches something in &%ignore_target_hosts%&, the router
17763 declines. If an IP literal turns out to refer to the local host, the generic
17764 &%self%& option determines what happens.
17765
17766 The RFCs require support for domain literals; however, their use is
17767 controversial in today's Internet. If you want to use this router, you must
17768 also set the main configuration option &%allow_domain_literals%&. Otherwise,
17769 Exim will not recognize the domain literal syntax in addresses.
17770
17771
17772
17773 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
17774 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
17775
17776 .chapter "The iplookup router" "CHID6"
17777 .cindex "&(iplookup)& router"
17778 .cindex "routers" "&(iplookup)&"
17779 The &(iplookup)& router was written to fulfil a specific requirement in
17780 Cambridge University (which in fact no longer exists). For this reason, it is
17781 not included in the binary of Exim by default. If you want to include it, you
17782 must set
17783 .code
17784 ROUTER_IPLOOKUP=yes
17785 .endd
17786 in your &_Local/Makefile_& configuration file.
17787
17788 The &(iplookup)& router routes an address by sending it over a TCP or UDP
17789 connection to one or more specific hosts. The host can then return the same or
17790 a different address &-- in effect rewriting the recipient address in the
17791 message's envelope. The new address is then passed on to subsequent routers. If
17792 this process fails, the address can be passed on to other routers, or delivery
17793 can be deferred. Since &(iplookup)& is just a rewriting router, a transport
17794 must not be specified for it.
17795
17796 .cindex "options" "&(iplookup)& router"
17797 .option hosts iplookup string unset
17798 This option must be supplied. Its value is a colon-separated list of host
17799 names. The hosts are looked up using &[gethostbyname()]&
17800 (or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available)
17801 and are tried in order until one responds to the query. If none respond, what
17802 happens is controlled by &%optional%&.
17803
17804
17805 .option optional iplookup boolean false
17806 If &%optional%& is true, if no response is obtained from any host, the address
17807 is passed to the next router, overriding &%no_more%&. If &%optional%& is false,
17808 delivery to the address is deferred.
17809
17810
17811 .option port iplookup integer 0
17812 .cindex "port" "&(iplookup)& router"
17813 This option must be supplied. It specifies the port number for the TCP or UDP
17814 call.
17815
17816
17817 .option protocol iplookup string udp
17818 This option can be set to &"udp"& or &"tcp"& to specify which of the two
17819 protocols is to be used.
17820
17821
17822 .option query iplookup string&!! "see below"
17823 This defines the content of the query that is sent to the remote hosts. The
17824 default value is:
17825 .code
17826 $local_part@$domain $local_part@$domain
17827 .endd
17828 The repetition serves as a way of checking that a response is to the correct
17829 query in the default case (see &%response_pattern%& below).
17830
17831
17832 .option reroute iplookup string&!! unset
17833 If this option is not set, the rerouted address is precisely the byte string
17834 returned by the remote host, up to the first white space, if any. If set, the
17835 string is expanded to form the rerouted address. It can include parts matched
17836 in the response by &%response_pattern%& by means of numeric variables such as
17837 &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. The variable &$0$& refers to the entire input string,
17838 whether or not a pattern is in use. In all cases, the rerouted address must end
17839 up in the form &'local_part@domain'&.
17840
17841
17842 .option response_pattern iplookup string unset
17843 This option can be set to a regular expression that is applied to the string
17844 returned from the remote host. If the pattern does not match the response, the
17845 router declines. If &%response_pattern%& is not set, no checking of the
17846 response is done, unless the query was defaulted, in which case there is a
17847 check that the text returned after the first white space is the original
17848 address. This checks that the answer that has been received is in response to
17849 the correct question. For example, if the response is just a new domain, the
17850 following could be used:
17851 .code
17852 response_pattern = ^([^@]+)$
17853 reroute = $local_part@$1
17854 .endd
17855
17856 .option timeout iplookup time 5s
17857 This specifies the amount of time to wait for a response from the remote
17858 machine. The same timeout is used for the &[connect()]& function for a TCP
17859 call. It does not apply to UDP.
17860
17861
17862
17863
17864 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
17865 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
17866
17867 .chapter "The manualroute router" "CHID7"
17868 .scindex IIDmanrou1 "&(manualroute)& router"
17869 .scindex IIDmanrou2 "routers" "&(manualroute)&"
17870 .cindex "domain" "manually routing"
17871 The &(manualroute)& router is so-called because it provides a way of manually
17872 routing an address according to its domain. It is mainly used when you want to
17873 route addresses to remote hosts according to your own rules, bypassing the
17874 normal DNS routing that looks up MX records. However, &(manualroute)& can also
17875 route to local transports, a facility that may be useful if you want to save
17876 messages for dial-in hosts in local files.
17877
17878 The &(manualroute)& router compares a list of domain patterns with the domain
17879 it is trying to route. If there is no match, the router declines. Each pattern
17880 has associated with it a list of hosts and some other optional data, which may
17881 include a transport. The combination of a pattern and its data is called a
17882 &"routing rule"&. For patterns that do not have an associated transport, the
17883 generic &%transport%& option must specify a transport, unless the router is
17884 being used purely for verification (see &%verify_only%&).
17885
17886 .vindex "&$host$&"
17887 In the case of verification, matching the domain pattern is sufficient for the
17888 router to accept the address. When actually routing an address for delivery,
17889 an address that matches a domain pattern is queued for the associated
17890 transport. If the transport is not a local one, a host list must be associated
17891 with the pattern; IP addresses are looked up for the hosts, and these are
17892 passed to the transport along with the mail address. For local transports, a
17893 host list is optional. If it is present, it is passed in &$host$& as a single
17894 text string.
17895
17896 The list of routing rules can be provided as an inline string in
17897 &%route_list%&, or the data can be obtained by looking up the domain in a file
17898 or database by setting &%route_data%&. Only one of these settings may appear in
17899 any one instance of &(manualroute)&. The format of routing rules is described
17900 below, following the list of private options.
17901
17902
17903 .section "Private options for manualroute" "SECTprioptman"
17904
17905 .cindex "options" "&(manualroute)& router"
17906 The private options for the &(manualroute)& router are as follows:
17907
17908 .option host_all_ignored manualroute string defer
17909 See &%host_find_failed%&.
17910
17911 .option host_find_failed manualroute string freeze
17912 This option controls what happens when &(manualroute)& tries to find an IP
17913 address for a host, and the host does not exist. The option can be set to one
17914 of the following values:
17915 .code
17916 decline
17917 defer
17918 fail
17919 freeze
17920 ignore
17921 pass
17922 .endd
17923 The default (&"freeze"&) assumes that this state is a serious configuration
17924 error. The difference between &"pass"& and &"decline"& is that the former
17925 forces the address to be passed to the next router (or the router defined by
17926 &%pass_router%&),
17927 .oindex "&%more%&"
17928 overriding &%no_more%&, whereas the latter passes the address to the next
17929 router only if &%more%& is true.
17930
17931 The value &"ignore"& causes Exim to completely ignore a host whose IP address
17932 cannot be found. If all the hosts in the list are ignored, the behaviour is
17933 controlled by the &%host_all_ignored%& option. This takes the same values
17934 as &%host_find_failed%&, except that it cannot be set to &"ignore"&.
17935
17936 The &%host_find_failed%& option applies only to a definite &"does not exist"&
17937 state; if a host lookup gets a temporary error, delivery is deferred unless the
17938 generic &%pass_on_timeout%& option is set.
17939
17940
17941 .option hosts_randomize manualroute boolean false
17942 .cindex "randomized host list"
17943 .cindex "host" "list of; randomized"
17944 If this option is set, the order of the items in a host list in a routing rule
17945 is randomized each time the list is used, unless an option in the routing rule
17946 overrides (see below). Randomizing the order of a host list can be used to do
17947 crude load sharing. However, if more than one mail address is routed by the
17948 same router to the same host list, the host lists are considered to be the same
17949 (even though they may be randomized into different orders) for the purpose of
17950 deciding whether to batch the deliveries into a single SMTP transaction.
17951
17952 When &%hosts_randomize%& is true, a host list may be split
17953 into groups whose order is separately randomized. This makes it possible to
17954 set up MX-like behaviour. The boundaries between groups are indicated by an
17955 item that is just &`+`& in the host list. For example:
17956 .code
17957 route_list = * host1:host2:host3:+:host4:host5
17958 .endd
17959 The order of the first three hosts and the order of the last two hosts is
17960 randomized for each use, but the first three always end up before the last two.
17961 If &%hosts_randomize%& is not set, a &`+`& item in the list is ignored. If a
17962 randomized host list is passed to an &(smtp)& transport that also has
17963 &%hosts_randomize set%&, the list is not re-randomized.
17964
17965
17966 .option route_data manualroute string&!! unset
17967 If this option is set, it must expand to yield the data part of a routing rule.
17968 Typically, the expansion string includes a lookup based on the domain. For
17969 example:
17970 .code
17971 route_data = ${lookup{$domain}dbm{/etc/routes}}
17972 .endd
17973 If the expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string, the
17974 router declines. Other kinds of expansion failure cause delivery to be
17975 deferred.
17976
17977
17978 .option route_list manualroute "string list" unset
17979 This string is a list of routing rules, in the form defined below. Note that,
17980 unlike most string lists, the items are separated by semicolons. This is so
17981 that they may contain colon-separated host lists.
17982
17983
17984 .option same_domain_copy_routing manualroute boolean false
17985 .cindex "address" "copying routing"
17986 Addresses with the same domain are normally routed by the &(manualroute)&
17987 router to the same list of hosts. However, this cannot be presumed, because the
17988 router options and preconditions may refer to the local part of the address. By
17989 default, therefore, Exim routes each address in a message independently. DNS
17990 servers run caches, so repeated DNS lookups are not normally expensive, and in
17991 any case, personal messages rarely have more than a few recipients.
17992
17993 If you are running mailing lists with large numbers of subscribers at the same
17994 domain, and you are using a &(manualroute)& router which is independent of the
17995 local part, you can set &%same_domain_copy_routing%& to bypass repeated DNS
17996 lookups for identical domains in one message. In this case, when
17997 &(manualroute)& routes an address to a remote transport, any other unrouted
17998 addresses in the message that have the same domain are automatically given the
17999 same routing without processing them independently. However, this is only done
18000 if &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& are unset.
18001
18002
18003
18004
18005 .section "Routing rules in route_list" "SECID120"
18006 The value of &%route_list%& is a string consisting of a sequence of routing
18007 rules, separated by semicolons. If a semicolon is needed in a rule, it can be
18008 entered as two semicolons. Alternatively, the list separator can be changed as
18009 described (for colon-separated lists) in section &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&.
18010 Empty rules are ignored. The format of each rule is
18011 .display
18012 <&'domain pattern'&> <&'list of hosts'&> <&'options'&>
18013 .endd
18014 The following example contains two rules, each with a simple domain pattern and
18015 no options:
18016 .code
18017 route_list = \
18018 dict.ref.example mail-1.ref.example:mail-2.ref.example ; \
18019 thes.ref.example mail-3.ref.example:mail-4.ref.example
18020 .endd
18021 The three parts of a rule are separated by white space. The pattern and the
18022 list of hosts can be enclosed in quotes if necessary, and if they are, the
18023 usual quoting rules apply. Each rule in a &%route_list%& must start with a
18024 single domain pattern, which is the only mandatory item in the rule. The
18025 pattern is in the same format as one item in a domain list (see section
18026 &<<SECTdomainlist>>&),
18027 except that it may not be the name of an interpolated file.
18028 That is, it may be wildcarded, or a regular expression, or a file or database
18029 lookup (with semicolons doubled, because of the use of semicolon as a separator
18030 in a &%route_list%&).
18031
18032 The rules in &%route_list%& are searched in order until one of the patterns
18033 matches the domain that is being routed. The list of hosts and then options are
18034 then used as described below. If there is no match, the router declines. When
18035 &%route_list%& is set, &%route_data%& must not be set.
18036
18037
18038
18039 .section "Routing rules in route_data" "SECID121"
18040 The use of &%route_list%& is convenient when there are only a small number of
18041 routing rules. For larger numbers, it is easier to use a file or database to
18042 hold the routing information, and use the &%route_data%& option instead.
18043 The value of &%route_data%& is a list of hosts, followed by (optional) options.
18044 Most commonly, &%route_data%& is set as a string that contains an
18045 expansion lookup. For example, suppose we place two routing rules in a file
18046 like this:
18047 .code
18048 dict.ref.example: mail-1.ref.example:mail-2.ref.example
18049 thes.ref.example: mail-3.ref.example:mail-4.ref.example
18050 .endd
18051 This data can be accessed by setting
18052 .code
18053 route_data = ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/the/file/name}}
18054 .endd
18055 Failure of the lookup results in an empty string, causing the router to
18056 decline. However, you do not have to use a lookup in &%route_data%&. The only
18057 requirement is that the result of expanding the string is a list of hosts,
18058 possibly followed by options, separated by white space. The list of hosts must
18059 be enclosed in quotes if it contains white space.
18060
18061
18062
18063
18064 .section "Format of the list of hosts" "SECID122"
18065 A list of hosts, whether obtained via &%route_data%& or &%route_list%&, is
18066 always separately expanded before use. If the expansion fails, the router
18067 declines. The result of the expansion must be a colon-separated list of names
18068 and/or IP addresses, optionally also including ports. The format of each item
18069 in the list is described in the next section. The list separator can be changed
18070 as described in section &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&.
18071
18072 If the list of hosts was obtained from a &%route_list%& item, the following
18073 variables are set during its expansion:
18074
18075 .ilist
18076 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(manualroute)& router"
18077 If the domain was matched against a regular expression, the numeric variables
18078 &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. may be set. For example:
18079 .code
18080 route_list = ^domain(\d+) host-$1.text.example
18081 .endd
18082 .next
18083 &$0$& is always set to the entire domain.
18084 .next
18085 &$1$& is also set when partial matching is done in a file lookup.
18086
18087 .next
18088 .vindex "&$value$&"
18089 If the pattern that matched the domain was a lookup item, the data that was
18090 looked up is available in the expansion variable &$value$&. For example:
18091 .code
18092 route_list = lsearch;;/some/file.routes $value
18093 .endd
18094 .endlist
18095
18096 Note the doubling of the semicolon in the pattern that is necessary because
18097 semicolon is the default route list separator.
18098
18099
18100
18101 .section "Format of one host item" "SECTformatonehostitem"
18102 Each item in the list of hosts is either a host name or an IP address,
18103 optionally with an attached port number. When no port is given, an IP address
18104 is not enclosed in brackets. When a port is specified, it overrides the port
18105 specification on the transport. The port is separated from the name or address
18106 by a colon. This leads to some complications:
18107
18108 .ilist
18109 Because colon is the default separator for the list of hosts, either
18110 the colon that specifies a port must be doubled, or the list separator must
18111 be changed. The following two examples have the same effect:
18112 .code
18113 route_list = * "host1.tld::1225 : host2.tld::1226"
18114 route_list = * "<+ host1.tld:1225 + host2.tld:1226"
18115 .endd
18116 .next
18117 When IPv6 addresses are involved, it gets worse, because they contain
18118 colons of their own. To make this case easier, it is permitted to
18119 enclose an IP address (either v4 or v6) in square brackets if a port
18120 number follows. For example:
18121 .code
18122 route_list = * "</ [10.1.1.1]:1225 / [::1]:1226"
18123 .endd
18124 .endlist
18125
18126 .section "How the list of hosts is used" "SECThostshowused"
18127 When an address is routed to an &(smtp)& transport by &(manualroute)&, each of
18128 the hosts is tried, in the order specified, when carrying out the SMTP
18129 delivery. However, the order can be changed by setting the &%hosts_randomize%&
18130 option, either on the router (see section &<<SECTprioptman>>& above), or on the
18131 transport.
18132
18133 Hosts may be listed by name or by IP address. An unadorned name in the list of
18134 hosts is interpreted as a host name. A name that is followed by &`/MX`& is
18135 interpreted as an indirection to a sublist of hosts obtained by looking up MX
18136 records in the DNS. For example:
18137 .code
18138 route_list = * x.y.z:p.q.r/MX:e.f.g
18139 .endd
18140 If this feature is used with a port specifier, the port must come last. For
18141 example:
18142 .code
18143 route_list = * dom1.tld/mx::1225
18144 .endd
18145 If the &%hosts_randomize%& option is set, the order of the items in the list is
18146 randomized before any lookups are done. Exim then scans the list; for any name
18147 that is not followed by &`/MX`& it looks up an IP address. If this turns out to
18148 be an interface on the local host and the item is not the first in the list,
18149 Exim discards it and any subsequent items. If it is the first item, what
18150 happens is controlled by the
18151 .oindex "&%self%&" "in &(manualroute)& router"
18152 &%self%& option of the router.
18153
18154 A name on the list that is followed by &`/MX`& is replaced with the list of
18155 hosts obtained by looking up MX records for the name. This is always a DNS
18156 lookup; the &%bydns%& and &%byname%& options (see section &<<SECThowoptused>>&
18157 below) are not relevant here. The order of these hosts is determined by the
18158 preference values in the MX records, according to the usual rules. Because
18159 randomizing happens before the MX lookup, it does not affect the order that is
18160 defined by MX preferences.
18161
18162 If the local host is present in the sublist obtained from MX records, but is
18163 not the most preferred host in that list, it and any equally or less
18164 preferred hosts are removed before the sublist is inserted into the main list.
18165
18166 If the local host is the most preferred host in the MX list, what happens
18167 depends on where in the original list of hosts the &`/MX`& item appears. If it
18168 is not the first item (that is, there are previous hosts in the main list),
18169 Exim discards this name and any subsequent items in the main list.
18170
18171 If the MX item is first in the list of hosts, and the local host is the
18172 most preferred host, what happens is controlled by the &%self%& option of the
18173 router.
18174
18175 DNS failures when lookup up the MX records are treated in the same way as DNS
18176 failures when looking up IP addresses: &%pass_on_timeout%& and
18177 &%host_find_failed%& are used when relevant.
18178
18179 The generic &%ignore_target_hosts%& option applies to all hosts in the list,
18180 whether obtained from an MX lookup or not.
18181
18182
18183
18184 .section "How the options are used" "SECThowoptused"
18185 The options are a sequence of words; in practice no more than three are ever
18186 present. One of the words can be the name of a transport; this overrides the
18187 &%transport%& option on the router for this particular routing rule only. The
18188 other words (if present) control randomization of the list of hosts on a
18189 per-rule basis, and how the IP addresses of the hosts are to be found when
18190 routing to a remote transport. These options are as follows:
18191
18192 .ilist
18193 &%randomize%&: randomize the order of the hosts in this list, overriding the
18194 setting of &%hosts_randomize%& for this routing rule only.
18195 .next
18196 &%no_randomize%&: do not randomize the order of the hosts in this list,
18197 overriding the setting of &%hosts_randomize%& for this routing rule only.
18198 .next
18199 &%byname%&: use &[getipnodebyname()]& (&[gethostbyname()]& on older systems) to
18200 find IP addresses. This function may ultimately cause a DNS lookup, but it may
18201 also look in &_/etc/hosts_& or other sources of information.
18202 .next
18203 &%bydns%&: look up address records for the hosts directly in the DNS; fail if
18204 no address records are found. If there is a temporary DNS error (such as a
18205 timeout), delivery is deferred.
18206 .endlist
18207
18208 For example:
18209 .code
18210 route_list = domain1 host1:host2:host3 randomize bydns;\
18211 domain2 host4:host5
18212 .endd
18213 If neither &%byname%& nor &%bydns%& is given, Exim behaves as follows: First, a
18214 DNS lookup is done. If this yields anything other than HOST_NOT_FOUND, that
18215 result is used. Otherwise, Exim goes on to try a call to &[getipnodebyname()]&
18216 or &[gethostbyname()]&, and the result of the lookup is the result of that
18217 call.
18218
18219 &*Warning*&: It has been discovered that on some systems, if a DNS lookup
18220 called via &[getipnodebyname()]& times out, HOST_NOT_FOUND is returned
18221 instead of TRY_AGAIN. That is why the default action is to try a DNS
18222 lookup first. Only if that gives a definite &"no such host"& is the local
18223 function called.
18224
18225
18226
18227 If no IP address for a host can be found, what happens is controlled by the
18228 &%host_find_failed%& option.
18229
18230 .vindex "&$host$&"
18231 When an address is routed to a local transport, IP addresses are not looked up.
18232 The host list is passed to the transport in the &$host$& variable.
18233
18234
18235
18236 .section "Manualroute examples" "SECID123"
18237 In some of the examples that follow, the presence of the &%remote_smtp%&
18238 transport, as defined in the default configuration file, is assumed:
18239
18240 .ilist
18241 .cindex "smart host" "example router"
18242 The &(manualroute)& router can be used to forward all external mail to a
18243 &'smart host'&. If you have set up, in the main part of the configuration, a
18244 named domain list that contains your local domains, for example:
18245 .code
18246 domainlist local_domains = my.domain.example
18247 .endd
18248 You can arrange for all other domains to be routed to a smart host by making
18249 your first router something like this:
18250 .code
18251 smart_route:
18252 driver = manualroute
18253 domains = !+local_domains
18254 transport = remote_smtp
18255 route_list = * smarthost.ref.example
18256 .endd
18257 This causes all non-local addresses to be sent to the single host
18258 &'smarthost.ref.example'&. If a colon-separated list of smart hosts is given,
18259 they are tried in order
18260 (but you can use &%hosts_randomize%& to vary the order each time).
18261 Another way of configuring the same thing is this:
18262 .code
18263 smart_route:
18264 driver = manualroute
18265 transport = remote_smtp
18266 route_list = !+local_domains smarthost.ref.example
18267 .endd
18268 There is no difference in behaviour between these two routers as they stand.
18269 However, they behave differently if &%no_more%& is added to them. In the first
18270 example, the router is skipped if the domain does not match the &%domains%&
18271 precondition; the following router is always tried. If the router runs, it
18272 always matches the domain and so can never decline. Therefore, &%no_more%&
18273 would have no effect. In the second case, the router is never skipped; it
18274 always runs. However, if it doesn't match the domain, it declines. In this case
18275 &%no_more%& would prevent subsequent routers from running.
18276
18277 .next
18278 .cindex "mail hub example"
18279 A &'mail hub'& is a host which receives mail for a number of domains via MX
18280 records in the DNS and delivers it via its own private routing mechanism. Often
18281 the final destinations are behind a firewall, with the mail hub being the one
18282 machine that can connect to machines both inside and outside the firewall. The
18283 &(manualroute)& router is usually used on a mail hub to route incoming messages
18284 to the correct hosts. For a small number of domains, the routing can be inline,
18285 using the &%route_list%& option, but for a larger number a file or database
18286 lookup is easier to manage.
18287
18288 If the domain names are in fact the names of the machines to which the mail is
18289 to be sent by the mail hub, the configuration can be quite simple. For
18290 example:
18291 .code
18292 hub_route:
18293 driver = manualroute
18294 transport = remote_smtp
18295 route_list = *.rhodes.tvs.example $domain
18296 .endd
18297 This configuration routes domains that match &`*.rhodes.tvs.example`& to hosts
18298 whose names are the same as the mail domains. A similar approach can be taken
18299 if the host name can be obtained from the domain name by a string manipulation
18300 that the expansion facilities can handle. Otherwise, a lookup based on the
18301 domain can be used to find the host:
18302 .code
18303 through_firewall:
18304 driver = manualroute
18305 transport = remote_smtp
18306 route_data = ${lookup {$domain} cdb {/internal/host/routes}}
18307 .endd
18308 The result of the lookup must be the name or IP address of the host (or
18309 hosts) to which the address is to be routed. If the lookup fails, the route
18310 data is empty, causing the router to decline. The address then passes to the
18311 next router.
18312
18313 .next
18314 .cindex "batched SMTP output example"
18315 .cindex "SMTP" "batched outgoing; example"
18316 You can use &(manualroute)& to deliver messages to pipes or files in batched
18317 SMTP format for onward transportation by some other means. This is one way of
18318 storing mail for a dial-up host when it is not connected. The route list entry
18319 can be as simple as a single domain name in a configuration like this:
18320 .code
18321 save_in_file:
18322 driver = manualroute
18323 transport = batchsmtp_appendfile
18324 route_list = saved.domain.example
18325 .endd
18326 though often a pattern is used to pick up more than one domain. If there are
18327 several domains or groups of domains with different transport requirements,
18328 different transports can be listed in the routing information:
18329 .code
18330 save_in_file:
18331 driver = manualroute
18332 route_list = \
18333 *.saved.domain1.example $domain batch_appendfile; \
18334 *.saved.domain2.example \
18335 ${lookup{$domain}dbm{/domain2/hosts}{$value}fail} \
18336 batch_pipe
18337 .endd
18338 .vindex "&$domain$&"
18339 .vindex "&$host$&"
18340 The first of these just passes the domain in the &$host$& variable, which
18341 doesn't achieve much (since it is also in &$domain$&), but the second does a
18342 file lookup to find a value to pass, causing the router to decline to handle
18343 the address if the lookup fails.
18344
18345 .next
18346 .cindex "UUCP" "example of router for"
18347 Routing mail directly to UUCP software is a specific case of the use of
18348 &(manualroute)& in a gateway to another mail environment. This is an example of
18349 one way it can be done:
18350 .code
18351 # Transport
18352 uucp:
18353 driver = pipe
18354 user = nobody
18355 command = /usr/local/bin/uux -r - \
18356 ${substr_-5:$host}!rmail ${local_part}
18357 return_fail_output = true
18358
18359 # Router
18360 uucphost:
18361 transport = uucp
18362 driver = manualroute
18363 route_data = \
18364 ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/usr/local/exim/uucphosts}}
18365 .endd
18366 The file &_/usr/local/exim/uucphosts_& contains entries like
18367 .code
18368 darksite.ethereal.example: darksite.UUCP
18369 .endd
18370 It can be set up more simply without adding and removing &".UUCP"& but this way
18371 makes clear the distinction between the domain name
18372 &'darksite.ethereal.example'& and the UUCP host name &'darksite'&.
18373 .endlist
18374 .ecindex IIDmanrou1
18375 .ecindex IIDmanrou2
18376
18377
18378
18379
18380
18381
18382
18383
18384 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18385 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18386
18387 .chapter "The queryprogram router" "CHAPdriverlast"
18388 .scindex IIDquerou1 "&(queryprogram)& router"
18389 .scindex IIDquerou2 "routers" "&(queryprogram)&"
18390 .cindex "routing" "by external program"
18391 The &(queryprogram)& router routes an address by running an external command
18392 and acting on its output. This is an expensive way to route, and is intended
18393 mainly for use in lightly-loaded systems, or for performing experiments.
18394 However, if it is possible to use the precondition options (&%domains%&,
18395 &%local_parts%&, etc) to skip this router for most addresses, it could sensibly
18396 be used in special cases, even on a busy host. There are the following private
18397 options:
18398 .cindex "options" "&(queryprogram)& router"
18399
18400 .option command queryprogram string&!! unset
18401 This option must be set. It specifies the command that is to be run. The
18402 command is split up into a command name and arguments, and then each is
18403 expanded separately (exactly as for a &(pipe)& transport, described in chapter
18404 &<<CHAPpipetransport>>&).
18405
18406
18407 .option command_group queryprogram string unset
18408 .cindex "gid (group id)" "in &(queryprogram)& router"
18409 This option specifies a gid to be set when running the command while routing an
18410 address for deliver. It must be set if &%command_user%& specifies a numerical
18411 uid. If it begins with a digit, it is interpreted as the numerical value of the
18412 gid. Otherwise it is looked up using &[getgrnam()]&.
18413
18414
18415 .option command_user queryprogram string unset
18416 .cindex "uid (user id)" "for &(queryprogram)&"
18417 This option must be set. It specifies the uid which is set when running the
18418 command while routing an address for delivery. If the value begins with a digit,
18419 it is interpreted as the numerical value of the uid. Otherwise, it is looked up
18420 using &[getpwnam()]& to obtain a value for the uid and, if &%command_group%& is
18421 not set, a value for the gid also.
18422
18423 &*Warning:*& Changing uid and gid is possible only when Exim is running as
18424 root, which it does during a normal delivery in a conventional configuration.
18425 However, when an address is being verified during message reception, Exim is
18426 usually running as the Exim user, not as root. If the &(queryprogram)& router
18427 is called from a non-root process, Exim cannot change uid or gid before running
18428 the command. In this circumstance the command runs under the current uid and
18429 gid.
18430
18431
18432 .option current_directory queryprogram string /
18433 This option specifies an absolute path which is made the current directory
18434 before running the command.
18435
18436
18437 .option timeout queryprogram time 1h
18438 If the command does not complete within the timeout period, its process group
18439 is killed and the message is frozen. A value of zero time specifies no
18440 timeout.
18441
18442
18443 The standard output of the command is connected to a pipe, which is read when
18444 the command terminates. It should consist of a single line of output,
18445 containing up to five fields, separated by white space. The maximum length of
18446 the line is 1023 characters. Longer lines are silently truncated. The first
18447 field is one of the following words (case-insensitive):
18448
18449 .ilist
18450 &'Accept'&: routing succeeded; the remaining fields specify what to do (see
18451 below).
18452 .next
18453 &'Decline'&: the router declines; pass the address to the next router, unless
18454 &%no_more%& is set.
18455 .next
18456 &'Fail'&: routing failed; do not pass the address to any more routers. Any
18457 subsequent text on the line is an error message. If the router is run as part
18458 of address verification during an incoming SMTP message, the message is
18459 included in the SMTP response.
18460 .next
18461 &'Defer'&: routing could not be completed at this time; try again later. Any
18462 subsequent text on the line is an error message which is logged. It is not
18463 included in any SMTP response.
18464 .next
18465 &'Freeze'&: the same as &'defer'&, except that the message is frozen.
18466 .next
18467 &'Pass'&: pass the address to the next router (or the router specified by
18468 &%pass_router%&), overriding &%no_more%&.
18469 .next
18470 &'Redirect'&: the message is redirected. The remainder of the line is a list of
18471 new addresses, which are routed independently, starting with the first router,
18472 or the router specified by &%redirect_router%&, if set.
18473 .endlist
18474
18475 When the first word is &'accept'&, the remainder of the line consists of a
18476 number of keyed data values, as follows (split into two lines here, to fit on
18477 the page):
18478 .code
18479 ACCEPT TRANSPORT=<transport> HOSTS=<list of hosts>
18480 LOOKUP=byname|bydns DATA=<text>
18481 .endd
18482 The data items can be given in any order, and all are optional. If no transport
18483 is included, the transport specified by the generic &%transport%& option is
18484 used. The list of hosts and the lookup type are needed only if the transport is
18485 an &(smtp)& transport that does not itself supply a list of hosts.
18486
18487 The format of the list of hosts is the same as for the &(manualroute)& router.
18488 As well as host names and IP addresses with optional port numbers, as described
18489 in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&, it may contain names followed by
18490 &`/MX`& to specify sublists of hosts that are obtained by looking up MX records
18491 (see section &<<SECThostshowused>>&).
18492
18493 If the lookup type is not specified, Exim behaves as follows when trying to
18494 find an IP address for each host: First, a DNS lookup is done. If this yields
18495 anything other than HOST_NOT_FOUND, that result is used. Otherwise, Exim
18496 goes on to try a call to &[getipnodebyname()]& or &[gethostbyname()]&, and the
18497 result of the lookup is the result of that call.
18498
18499 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
18500 If the DATA field is set, its value is placed in the &$address_data$&
18501 variable. For example, this return line
18502 .code
18503 accept hosts=x1.y.example:x2.y.example data="rule1"
18504 .endd
18505 routes the address to the default transport, passing a list of two hosts. When
18506 the transport runs, the string &"rule1"& is in &$address_data$&.
18507 .ecindex IIDquerou1
18508 .ecindex IIDquerou2
18509
18510
18511
18512
18513 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18514 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18515
18516 .chapter "The redirect router" "CHAPredirect"
18517 .scindex IIDredrou1 "&(redirect)& router"
18518 .scindex IIDredrou2 "routers" "&(redirect)&"
18519 .cindex "alias file" "in a &(redirect)& router"
18520 .cindex "address redirection" "&(redirect)& router"
18521 The &(redirect)& router handles several kinds of address redirection. Its most
18522 common uses are for resolving local part aliases from a central alias file
18523 (usually called &_/etc/aliases_&) and for handling users' personal &_.forward_&
18524 files, but it has many other potential uses. The incoming address can be
18525 redirected in several different ways:
18526
18527 .ilist
18528 It can be replaced by one or more new addresses which are themselves routed
18529 independently.
18530 .next
18531 It can be routed to be delivered to a given file or directory.
18532 .next
18533 It can be routed to be delivered to a specified pipe command.
18534 .next
18535 It can cause an automatic reply to be generated.
18536 .next
18537 It can be forced to fail, optionally with a custom error message.
18538 .next
18539 It can be temporarily deferred, optionally with a custom message.
18540 .next
18541 It can be discarded.
18542 .endlist
18543
18544 The generic &%transport%& option must not be set for &(redirect)& routers.
18545 However, there are some private options which define transports for delivery to
18546 files and pipes, and for generating autoreplies. See the &%file_transport%&,
18547 &%pipe_transport%& and &%reply_transport%& descriptions below.
18548
18549
18550
18551 .section "Redirection data" "SECID124"
18552 The router operates by interpreting a text string which it obtains either by
18553 expanding the contents of the &%data%& option, or by reading the entire
18554 contents of a file whose name is given in the &%file%& option. These two
18555 options are mutually exclusive. The first is commonly used for handling system
18556 aliases, in a configuration like this:
18557 .code
18558 system_aliases:
18559 driver = redirect
18560 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/aliases}}
18561 .endd
18562 If the lookup fails, the expanded string in this example is empty. When the
18563 expansion of &%data%& results in an empty string, the router declines. A forced
18564 expansion failure also causes the router to decline; other expansion failures
18565 cause delivery to be deferred.
18566
18567 A configuration using &%file%& is commonly used for handling users'
18568 &_.forward_& files, like this:
18569 .code
18570 userforward:
18571 driver = redirect
18572 check_local_user
18573 file = $home/.forward
18574 no_verify
18575 .endd
18576 If the file does not exist, or causes no action to be taken (for example, it is
18577 empty or consists only of comments), the router declines. &*Warning*&: This
18578 is not the case when the file contains syntactically valid items that happen to
18579 yield empty addresses, for example, items containing only RFC 2822 address
18580 comments.
18581
18582
18583
18584 .section "Forward files and address verification" "SECID125"
18585 .cindex "address redirection" "while verifying"
18586 It is usual to set &%no_verify%& on &(redirect)& routers which handle users'
18587 &_.forward_& files, as in the example above. There are two reasons for this:
18588
18589 .ilist
18590 When Exim is receiving an incoming SMTP message from a remote host, it is
18591 running under the Exim uid, not as root. Exim is unable to change uid to read
18592 the file as the user, and it may not be able to read it as the Exim user. So in
18593 practice the router may not be able to operate.
18594 .next
18595 However, even when the router can operate, the existence of a &_.forward_& file
18596 is unimportant when verifying an address. What should be checked is whether the
18597 local part is a valid user name or not. Cutting out the redirection processing
18598 saves some resources.
18599 .endlist
18600
18601
18602
18603
18604
18605
18606 .section "Interpreting redirection data" "SECID126"
18607 .cindex "Sieve filter" "specifying in redirection data"
18608 .cindex "filter" "specifying in redirection data"
18609 The contents of the data string, whether obtained from &%data%& or &%file%&,
18610 can be interpreted in two different ways:
18611
18612 .ilist
18613 If the &%allow_filter%& option is set true, and the data begins with the text
18614 &"#Exim filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"&, it is interpreted as a list of
18615 &'filtering'& instructions in the form of an Exim or Sieve filter file,
18616 respectively. Details of the syntax and semantics of filter files are described
18617 in a separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&; this
18618 document is intended for use by end users.
18619 .next
18620 Otherwise, the data must be a comma-separated list of redirection items, as
18621 described in the next section.
18622 .endlist
18623
18624 When a message is redirected to a file (a &"mail folder"&), the file name given
18625 in a non-filter redirection list must always be an absolute path. A filter may
18626 generate a relative path &-- how this is handled depends on the transport's
18627 configuration. See section &<<SECTfildiropt>>& for a discussion of this issue
18628 for the &(appendfile)& transport.
18629
18630
18631
18632 .section "Items in a non-filter redirection list" "SECTitenonfilred"
18633 .cindex "address redirection" "non-filter list items"
18634 When the redirection data is not an Exim or Sieve filter, for example, if it
18635 comes from a conventional alias or forward file, it consists of a list of
18636 addresses, file names, pipe commands, or certain special items (see section
18637 &<<SECTspecitredli>>& below). The special items can be individually enabled or
18638 disabled by means of options whose names begin with &%allow_%& or &%forbid_%&,
18639 depending on their default values. The items in the list are separated by
18640 commas or newlines.
18641 If a comma is required in an item, the entire item must be enclosed in double
18642 quotes.
18643
18644 Lines starting with a # character are comments, and are ignored, and # may
18645 also appear following a comma, in which case everything between the # and the
18646 next newline character is ignored.
18647
18648 If an item is entirely enclosed in double quotes, these are removed. Otherwise
18649 double quotes are retained because some forms of mail address require their use
18650 (but never to enclose the entire address). In the following description,
18651 &"item"& refers to what remains after any surrounding double quotes have been
18652 removed.
18653
18654 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
18655 &*Warning*&: If you use an Exim expansion to construct a redirection address,
18656 and the expansion contains a reference to &$local_part$&, you should make use
18657 of the &%quote_local_part%& expansion operator, in case the local part contains
18658 special characters. For example, to redirect all mail for the domain
18659 &'obsolete.example'&, retaining the existing local part, you could use this
18660 setting:
18661 .code
18662 data = ${quote_local_part:$local_part}@newdomain.example
18663 .endd
18664
18665
18666 .section "Redirecting to a local mailbox" "SECTredlocmai"
18667 .cindex "routing" "loops in"
18668 .cindex "loop" "while routing, avoidance of"
18669 .cindex "address redirection" "to local mailbox"
18670 A redirection item may safely be the same as the address currently under
18671 consideration. This does not cause a routing loop, because a router is
18672 automatically skipped if any ancestor of the address that is being processed
18673 is the same as the current address and was processed by the current router.
18674 Such an address is therefore passed to the following routers, so it is handled
18675 as if there were no redirection. When making this loop-avoidance test, the
18676 complete local part, including any prefix or suffix, is used.
18677
18678 .cindex "address redirection" "local part without domain"
18679 Specifying the same local part without a domain is a common usage in personal
18680 filter files when the user wants to have messages delivered to the local
18681 mailbox and also forwarded elsewhere. For example, the user whose login is
18682 &'cleo'& might have a &_.forward_& file containing this:
18683 .code
18684 cleo, cleopatra@egypt.example
18685 .endd
18686 .cindex "backslash in alias file"
18687 .cindex "alias file" "backslash in"
18688 For compatibility with other MTAs, such unqualified local parts may be
18689 preceded by &"\"&, but this is not a requirement for loop prevention. However,
18690 it does make a difference if more than one domain is being handled
18691 synonymously.
18692
18693 If an item begins with &"\"& and the rest of the item parses as a valid RFC
18694 2822 address that does not include a domain, the item is qualified using the
18695 domain of the incoming address. In the absence of a leading &"\"&, unqualified
18696 addresses are qualified using the value in &%qualify_recipient%&, but you can
18697 force the incoming domain to be used by setting &%qualify_preserve_domain%&.
18698
18699 Care must be taken if there are alias names for local users.
18700 Consider an MTA handling a single local domain where the system alias file
18701 contains:
18702 .code
18703 Sam.Reman: spqr
18704 .endd
18705 Now suppose that Sam (whose login id is &'spqr'&) wants to save copies of
18706 messages in the local mailbox, and also forward copies elsewhere. He creates
18707 this forward file:
18708 .code
18709 Sam.Reman, spqr@reme.elsewhere.example
18710 .endd
18711 With these settings, an incoming message addressed to &'Sam.Reman'& fails. The
18712 &(redirect)& router for system aliases does not process &'Sam.Reman'& the
18713 second time round, because it has previously routed it,
18714 and the following routers presumably cannot handle the alias. The forward file
18715 should really contain
18716 .code
18717 spqr, spqr@reme.elsewhere.example
18718 .endd
18719 but because this is such a common error, the &%check_ancestor%& option (see
18720 below) exists to provide a way to get round it. This is normally set on a
18721 &(redirect)& router that is handling users' &_.forward_& files.
18722
18723
18724
18725 .section "Special items in redirection lists" "SECTspecitredli"
18726 In addition to addresses, the following types of item may appear in redirection
18727 lists (that is, in non-filter redirection data):
18728
18729 .ilist
18730 .cindex "pipe" "in redirection list"
18731 .cindex "address redirection" "to pipe"
18732 An item is treated as a pipe command if it begins with &"|"& and does not parse
18733 as a valid RFC 2822 address that includes a domain. A transport for running the
18734 command must be specified by the &%pipe_transport%& option.
18735 Normally, either the router or the transport specifies a user and a group under
18736 which to run the delivery. The default is to use the Exim user and group.
18737
18738 Single or double quotes can be used for enclosing the individual arguments of
18739 the pipe command; no interpretation of escapes is done for single quotes. If
18740 the command contains a comma character, it is necessary to put the whole item
18741 in double quotes, for example:
18742 .code
18743 "|/some/command ready,steady,go"
18744 .endd
18745 since items in redirection lists are terminated by commas. Do not, however,
18746 quote just the command. An item such as
18747 .code
18748 |"/some/command ready,steady,go"
18749 .endd
18750 is interpreted as a pipe with a rather strange command name, and no arguments.
18751
18752 Note that the above example assumes that the text comes from a lookup source
18753 of some sort, so that the quotes are part of the data. If composing a
18754 redirect router with a &%data%& option directly specifying this command, the
18755 quotes will be used by the configuration parser to define the extent of one
18756 string, but will not be passed down into the redirect router itself. There
18757 are two main approaches to get around this: escape quotes to be part of the
18758 data itself, or avoid using this mechanism and instead create a custom
18759 transport with the &%command%& option set and reference that transport from
18760 an &%accept%& router.
18761
18762 .next
18763 .cindex "file" "in redirection list"
18764 .cindex "address redirection" "to file"
18765 An item is interpreted as a path name if it begins with &"/"& and does not
18766 parse as a valid RFC 2822 address that includes a domain. For example,
18767 .code
18768 /home/world/minbari
18769 .endd
18770 is treated as a file name, but
18771 .code
18772 /s=molari/o=babylon/@x400gate.way
18773 .endd
18774 is treated as an address. For a file name, a transport must be specified using
18775 the &%file_transport%& option. However, if the generated path name ends with a
18776 forward slash character, it is interpreted as a directory name rather than a
18777 file name, and &%directory_transport%& is used instead.
18778
18779 Normally, either the router or the transport specifies a user and a group under
18780 which to run the delivery. The default is to use the Exim user and group.
18781
18782 .cindex "&_/dev/null_&"
18783 However, if a redirection item is the path &_/dev/null_&, delivery to it is
18784 bypassed at a high level, and the log entry shows &"**bypassed**"&
18785 instead of a transport name. In this case the user and group are not used.
18786
18787 .next
18788 .cindex "included address list"
18789 .cindex "address redirection" "included external list"
18790 If an item is of the form
18791 .code
18792 :include:<path name>
18793 .endd
18794 a list of further items is taken from the given file and included at that
18795 point. &*Note*&: Such a file can not be a filter file; it is just an
18796 out-of-line addition to the list. The items in the included list are separated
18797 by commas or newlines and are not subject to expansion. If this is the first
18798 item in an alias list in an &(lsearch)& file, a colon must be used to terminate
18799 the alias name. This example is incorrect:
18800 .code
18801 list1 :include:/opt/lists/list1
18802 .endd
18803 It must be given as
18804 .code
18805 list1: :include:/opt/lists/list1
18806 .endd
18807 .next
18808 .cindex "address redirection" "to black hole"
18809 Sometimes you want to throw away mail to a particular local part. Making the
18810 &%data%& option expand to an empty string does not work, because that causes
18811 the router to decline. Instead, the alias item
18812 .cindex "black hole"
18813 .cindex "abandoning mail"
18814 &':blackhole:'& can be used. It does what its name implies. No delivery is
18815 done, and no error message is generated. This has the same effect as specifing
18816 &_/dev/null_& as a destination, but it can be independently disabled.
18817
18818 &*Warning*&: If &':blackhole:'& appears anywhere in a redirection list, no
18819 delivery is done for the original local part, even if other redirection items
18820 are present. If you are generating a multi-item list (for example, by reading a
18821 database) and need the ability to provide a no-op item, you must use
18822 &_/dev/null_&.
18823
18824 .next
18825 .cindex "delivery" "forcing failure"
18826 .cindex "delivery" "forcing deferral"
18827 .cindex "failing delivery" "forcing"
18828 .cindex "deferred delivery, forcing"
18829 .cindex "customizing" "failure message"
18830 An attempt to deliver a particular address can be deferred or forced to fail by
18831 redirection items of the form
18832 .code
18833 :defer:
18834 :fail:
18835 .endd
18836 respectively. When a redirection list contains such an item, it applies
18837 to the entire redirection; any other items in the list are ignored. Any
18838 text following &':fail:'& or &':defer:'& is placed in the error text
18839 associated with the failure. For example, an alias file might contain:
18840 .code
18841 X.Employee: :fail: Gone away, no forwarding address
18842 .endd
18843 In the case of an address that is being verified from an ACL or as the subject
18844 of a
18845 .cindex "VRFY" "error text, display of"
18846 VRFY command, the text is included in the SMTP error response by
18847 default.
18848 .cindex "EXPN" "error text, display of"
18849 The text is not included in the response to an EXPN command. In non-SMTP cases
18850 the text is included in the error message that Exim generates.
18851
18852 .cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
18853 By default, Exim sends a 451 SMTP code for a &':defer:'&, and 550 for
18854 &':fail:'&. However, if the message starts with three digits followed by a
18855 space, optionally followed by an extended code of the form &'n.n.n'&, also
18856 followed by a space, and the very first digit is the same as the default error
18857 code, the code from the message is used instead. If the very first digit is
18858 incorrect, a panic error is logged, and the default code is used. You can
18859 suppress the use of the supplied code in a redirect router by setting the
18860 &%forbid_smtp_code%& option true. In this case, any SMTP code is quietly
18861 ignored.
18862
18863 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
18864 In an ACL, an explicitly provided message overrides the default, but the
18865 default message is available in the variable &$acl_verify_message$& and can
18866 therefore be included in a custom message if this is desired.
18867
18868 Normally the error text is the rest of the redirection list &-- a comma does
18869 not terminate it &-- but a newline does act as a terminator. Newlines are not
18870 normally present in alias expansions. In &(lsearch)& lookups they are removed
18871 as part of the continuation process, but they may exist in other kinds of
18872 lookup and in &':include:'& files.
18873
18874 During routing for message delivery (as opposed to verification), a redirection
18875 containing &':fail:'& causes an immediate failure of the incoming address,
18876 whereas &':defer:'& causes the message to remain on the queue so that a
18877 subsequent delivery attempt can happen at a later time. If an address is
18878 deferred for too long, it will ultimately fail, because the normal retry
18879 rules still apply.
18880
18881 .next
18882 .cindex "alias file" "exception to default"
18883 Sometimes it is useful to use a single-key search type with a default (see
18884 chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&) to look up aliases. However, there may be a need
18885 for exceptions to the default. These can be handled by aliasing them to
18886 &':unknown:'&. This differs from &':fail:'& in that it causes the &(redirect)&
18887 router to decline, whereas &':fail:'& forces routing to fail. A lookup which
18888 results in an empty redirection list has the same effect.
18889 .endlist
18890
18891
18892 .section "Duplicate addresses" "SECTdupaddr"
18893 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
18894 .cindex "address duplicate, discarding"
18895 .cindex "pipe" "duplicated"
18896 Exim removes duplicate addresses from the list to which it is delivering, so as
18897 to deliver just one copy to each address. This does not apply to deliveries
18898 routed to pipes by different immediate parent addresses, but an indirect
18899 aliasing scheme of the type
18900 .code
18901 pipe: |/some/command $local_part
18902 localpart1: pipe
18903 localpart2: pipe
18904 .endd
18905 does not work with a message that is addressed to both local parts, because
18906 when the second is aliased to the intermediate local part &"pipe"& it gets
18907 discarded as being the same as a previously handled address. However, a scheme
18908 such as
18909 .code
18910 localpart1: |/some/command $local_part
18911 localpart2: |/some/command $local_part
18912 .endd
18913 does result in two different pipe deliveries, because the immediate parents of
18914 the pipes are distinct.
18915
18916
18917
18918 .section "Repeated redirection expansion" "SECID128"
18919 .cindex "repeated redirection expansion"
18920 .cindex "address redirection" "repeated for each delivery attempt"
18921 When a message cannot be delivered to all of its recipients immediately,
18922 leading to two or more delivery attempts, redirection expansion is carried out
18923 afresh each time for those addresses whose children were not all previously
18924 delivered. If redirection is being used as a mailing list, this can lead to new
18925 members of the list receiving copies of old messages. The &%one_time%& option
18926 can be used to avoid this.
18927
18928
18929 .section "Errors in redirection lists" "SECID129"
18930 .cindex "address redirection" "errors"
18931 If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set, a malformed address that causes a parsing
18932 error is skipped, and an entry is written to the main log. This may be useful
18933 for mailing lists that are automatically managed. Otherwise, if an error is
18934 detected while generating the list of new addresses, the original address is
18935 deferred. See also &%syntax_errors_to%&.
18936
18937
18938
18939 .section "Private options for the redirect router" "SECID130"
18940
18941 .cindex "options" "&(redirect)& router"
18942 The private options for the &(redirect)& router are as follows:
18943
18944
18945 .option allow_defer redirect boolean false
18946 Setting this option allows the use of &':defer:'& in non-filter redirection
18947 data, or the &%defer%& command in an Exim filter file.
18948
18949
18950 .option allow_fail redirect boolean false
18951 .cindex "failing delivery" "from filter"
18952 If this option is true, the &':fail:'& item can be used in a redirection list,
18953 and the &%fail%& command may be used in an Exim filter file.
18954
18955
18956 .option allow_filter redirect boolean false
18957 .cindex "filter" "enabling use of"
18958 .cindex "Sieve filter" "enabling use of"
18959 Setting this option allows Exim to interpret redirection data that starts with
18960 &"#Exim filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"& as a set of filtering instructions. There
18961 are some features of Exim filter files that some administrators may wish to
18962 lock out; see the &%forbid_filter_%&&'xxx'& options below.
18963
18964 It is also possible to lock out Exim filters or Sieve filters while allowing
18965 the other type; see &%forbid_exim_filter%& and &%forbid_sieve_filter%&.
18966
18967
18968 The filter is run using the uid and gid set by the generic &%user%& and
18969 &%group%& options. These take their defaults from the password data if
18970 &%check_local_user%& is set, so in the normal case of users' personal filter
18971 files, the filter is run as the relevant user. When &%allow_filter%& is set
18972 true, Exim insists that either &%check_local_user%& or &%user%& is set.
18973
18974
18975
18976 .option allow_freeze redirect boolean false
18977 .cindex "freezing messages" "allowing in filter"
18978 Setting this option allows the use of the &%freeze%& command in an Exim filter.
18979 This command is more normally encountered in system filters, and is disabled by
18980 default for redirection filters because it isn't something you usually want to
18981 let ordinary users do.
18982
18983
18984
18985 .option check_ancestor redirect boolean false
18986 This option is concerned with handling generated addresses that are the same
18987 as some address in the list of redirection ancestors of the current address.
18988 Although it is turned off by default in the code, it is set in the default
18989 configuration file for handling users' &_.forward_& files. It is recommended
18990 for this use of the &(redirect)& router.
18991
18992 When &%check_ancestor%& is set, if a generated address (including the domain)
18993 is the same as any ancestor of the current address, it is replaced by a copy of
18994 the current address. This helps in the case where local part A is aliased to B,
18995 and B has a &_.forward_& file pointing back to A. For example, within a single
18996 domain, the local part &"Joe.Bloggs"& is aliased to &"jb"& and
18997 &_&~jb/.forward_& contains:
18998 .code
18999 \Joe.Bloggs, <other item(s)>
19000 .endd
19001 Without the &%check_ancestor%& setting, either local part (&"jb"& or
19002 &"joe.bloggs"&) gets processed once by each router and so ends up as it was
19003 originally. If &"jb"& is the real mailbox name, mail to &"jb"& gets delivered
19004 (having been turned into &"joe.bloggs"& by the &_.forward_& file and back to
19005 &"jb"& by the alias), but mail to &"joe.bloggs"& fails. Setting
19006 &%check_ancestor%& on the &(redirect)& router that handles the &_.forward_&
19007 file prevents it from turning &"jb"& back into &"joe.bloggs"& when that was the
19008 original address. See also the &%repeat_use%& option below.
19009
19010
19011 .option check_group redirect boolean "see below"
19012 When the &%file%& option is used, the group owner of the file is checked only
19013 when this option is set. The permitted groups are those listed in the
19014 &%owngroups%& option, together with the user's default group if
19015 &%check_local_user%& is set. If the file has the wrong group, routing is
19016 deferred. The default setting for this option is true if &%check_local_user%&
19017 is set and the &%modemask%& option permits the group write bit, or if the
19018 &%owngroups%& option is set. Otherwise it is false, and no group check occurs.
19019
19020
19021
19022 .option check_owner redirect boolean "see below"
19023 When the &%file%& option is used, the owner of the file is checked only when
19024 this option is set. If &%check_local_user%& is set, the local user is
19025 permitted; otherwise the owner must be one of those listed in the &%owners%&
19026 option. The default value for this option is true if &%check_local_user%& or
19027 &%owners%& is set. Otherwise the default is false, and no owner check occurs.
19028
19029
19030 .option data redirect string&!! unset
19031 This option is mutually exclusive with &%file%&. One or other of them must be
19032 set, but not both. The contents of &%data%& are expanded, and then used as the
19033 list of forwarding items, or as a set of filtering instructions. If the
19034 expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string or a string that
19035 has no effect (consists entirely of comments), the router declines.
19036
19037 When filtering instructions are used, the string must begin with &"#Exim
19038 filter"&, and all comments in the string, including this initial one, must be
19039 terminated with newline characters. For example:
19040 .code
19041 data = #Exim filter\n\
19042 if $h_to: contains Exim then save $home/mail/exim endif
19043 .endd
19044 If you are reading the data from a database where newlines cannot be included,
19045 you can use the &${sg}$& expansion item to turn the escape string of your
19046 choice into a newline.
19047
19048
19049 .option directory_transport redirect string&!! unset
19050 A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a directory when a path name
19051 ending with a slash is specified as a new &"address"&. The transport used is
19052 specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a
19053 configured transport. This should normally be an &(appendfile)& transport.
19054
19055
19056 .option file redirect string&!! unset
19057 This option specifies the name of a file that contains the redirection data. It
19058 is mutually exclusive with the &%data%& option. The string is expanded before
19059 use; if the expansion is forced to fail, the router declines. Other expansion
19060 failures cause delivery to be deferred. The result of a successful expansion
19061 must be an absolute path. The entire file is read and used as the redirection
19062 data. If the data is an empty string or a string that has no effect (consists
19063 entirely of comments), the router declines.
19064
19065 .cindex "NFS" "checking for file existence"
19066 If the attempt to open the file fails with a &"does not exist"& error, Exim
19067 runs a check on the containing directory,
19068 unless &%ignore_enotdir%& is true (see below).
19069 If the directory does not appear to exist, delivery is deferred. This can
19070 happen when users' &_.forward_& files are in NFS-mounted directories, and there
19071 is a mount problem. If the containing directory does exist, but the file does
19072 not, the router declines.
19073
19074
19075 .option file_transport redirect string&!! unset
19076 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
19077 A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a file when a path name not
19078 ending in a slash is specified as a new &"address"&. The transport used is
19079 specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a
19080 configured transport. This should normally be an &(appendfile)& transport. When
19081 it is running, the file name is in &$address_file$&.
19082
19083
19084 .option filter_prepend_home redirect boolean true
19085 When this option is true, if a &(save)& command in an Exim filter specifies a
19086 relative path, and &$home$& is defined, it is automatically prepended to the
19087 relative path. If this option is set false, this action does not happen. The
19088 relative path is then passed to the transport unmodified.
19089
19090
19091 .option forbid_blackhole redirect boolean false
19092 If this option is true, the &':blackhole:'& item may not appear in a
19093 redirection list.
19094
19095
19096 .option forbid_exim_filter redirect boolean false
19097 If this option is set true, only Sieve filters are permitted when
19098 &%allow_filter%& is true.
19099
19100
19101
19102
19103 .option forbid_file redirect boolean false
19104 .cindex "delivery" "to file; forbidding"
19105 .cindex "Sieve filter" "forbidding delivery to a file"
19106 .cindex "Sieve filter" "&""keep""& facility; disabling"
19107 If this option is true, this router may not generate a new address that
19108 specifies delivery to a local file or directory, either from a filter or from a
19109 conventional forward file. This option is forced to be true if &%one_time%& is
19110 set. It applies to Sieve filters as well as to Exim filters, but if true, it
19111 locks out the Sieve's &"keep"& facility.
19112
19113
19114 .option forbid_filter_dlfunc redirect boolean false
19115 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
19116 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filters are not allowed to
19117 make use of the &%dlfunc%& expansion facility to run dynamically loaded
19118 functions.
19119
19120 .option forbid_filter_existstest redirect boolean false
19121 .cindex "expansion" "statting a file"
19122 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filters are not allowed to
19123 make use of the &%exists%& condition or the &%stat%& expansion item.
19124
19125 .option forbid_filter_logwrite redirect boolean false
19126 If this option is true, use of the logging facility in Exim filters is not
19127 permitted. Logging is in any case available only if the filter is being run
19128 under some unprivileged uid (which is normally the case for ordinary users'
19129 &_.forward_& files).
19130
19131
19132 .option forbid_filter_lookup redirect boolean false
19133 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
19134 to make use of &%lookup%& items.
19135
19136
19137 .option forbid_filter_perl redirect boolean false
19138 This option has an effect only if Exim is built with embedded Perl support. If
19139 it is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed to make use
19140 of the embedded Perl support.
19141
19142
19143 .option forbid_filter_readfile redirect boolean false
19144 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
19145 to make use of &%readfile%& items.
19146
19147
19148 .option forbid_filter_readsocket redirect boolean false
19149 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
19150 to make use of &%readsocket%& items.
19151
19152
19153 .option forbid_filter_reply redirect boolean false
19154 If this option is true, this router may not generate an automatic reply
19155 message. Automatic replies can be generated only from Exim or Sieve filter
19156 files, not from traditional forward files. This option is forced to be true if
19157 &%one_time%& is set.
19158
19159
19160 .option forbid_filter_run redirect boolean false
19161 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
19162 to make use of &%run%& items.
19163
19164
19165 .option forbid_include redirect boolean false
19166 If this option is true, items of the form
19167 .code
19168 :include:<path name>
19169 .endd
19170 are not permitted in non-filter redirection lists.
19171
19172
19173 .option forbid_pipe redirect boolean false
19174 .cindex "delivery" "to pipe; forbidding"
19175 If this option is true, this router may not generate a new address which
19176 specifies delivery to a pipe, either from an Exim filter or from a conventional
19177 forward file. This option is forced to be true if &%one_time%& is set.
19178
19179
19180 .option forbid_sieve_filter redirect boolean false
19181 If this option is set true, only Exim filters are permitted when
19182 &%allow_filter%& is true.
19183
19184
19185 .cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
19186 .option forbid_smtp_code redirect boolean false
19187 If this option is set true, any SMTP error codes that are present at the start
19188 of messages specified for &`:defer:`& or &`:fail:`& are quietly ignored, and
19189 the default codes (451 and 550, respectively) are always used.
19190
19191
19192
19193
19194 .option hide_child_in_errmsg redirect boolean false
19195 .cindex "bounce message" "redirection details; suppressing"
19196 If this option is true, it prevents Exim from quoting a child address if it
19197 generates a bounce or delay message for it. Instead it says &"an address
19198 generated from <&'the top level address'&>"&. Of course, this applies only to
19199 bounces generated locally. If a message is forwarded to another host, &'its'&
19200 bounce may well quote the generated address.
19201
19202
19203 .option ignore_eacces redirect boolean false
19204 .cindex "EACCES"
19205 If this option is set and an attempt to open a redirection file yields the
19206 EACCES error (permission denied), the &(redirect)& router behaves as if the
19207 file did not exist.
19208
19209
19210 .option ignore_enotdir redirect boolean false
19211 .cindex "ENOTDIR"
19212 If this option is set and an attempt to open a redirection file yields the
19213 ENOTDIR error (something on the path is not a directory), the &(redirect)&
19214 router behaves as if the file did not exist.
19215
19216 Setting &%ignore_enotdir%& has another effect as well: When a &(redirect)&
19217 router that has the &%file%& option set discovers that the file does not exist
19218 (the ENOENT error), it tries to &[stat()]& the parent directory, as a check
19219 against unmounted NFS directories. If the parent can not be statted, delivery
19220 is deferred. However, it seems wrong to do this check when &%ignore_enotdir%&
19221 is set, because that option tells Exim to ignore &"something on the path is not
19222 a directory"& (the ENOTDIR error). This is a confusing area, because it seems
19223 that some operating systems give ENOENT where others give ENOTDIR.
19224
19225
19226
19227 .option include_directory redirect string unset
19228 If this option is set, the path names of any &':include:'& items in a
19229 redirection list must start with this directory.
19230
19231
19232 .option modemask redirect "octal integer" 022
19233 This specifies mode bits which must not be set for a file specified by the
19234 &%file%& option. If any of the forbidden bits are set, delivery is deferred.
19235
19236
19237 .option one_time redirect boolean false
19238 .cindex "one-time aliasing/forwarding expansion"
19239 .cindex "alias file" "one-time expansion"
19240 .cindex "forward file" "one-time expansion"
19241 .cindex "mailing lists" "one-time expansion"
19242 .cindex "address redirection" "one-time expansion"
19243 Sometimes the fact that Exim re-evaluates aliases and reprocesses redirection
19244 files each time it tries to deliver a message causes a problem when one or more
19245 of the generated addresses fails be delivered at the first attempt. The problem
19246 is not one of duplicate delivery &-- Exim is clever enough to handle that &--
19247 but of what happens when the redirection list changes during the time that the
19248 message is on Exim's queue. This is particularly true in the case of mailing
19249 lists, where new subscribers might receive copies of messages that were posted
19250 before they subscribed.
19251
19252 If &%one_time%& is set and any addresses generated by the router fail to
19253 deliver at the first attempt, the failing addresses are added to the message as
19254 &"top level"& addresses, and the parent address that generated them is marked
19255 &"delivered"&. Thus, redirection does not happen again at the next delivery
19256 attempt.
19257
19258 &*Warning 1*&: Any header line addition or removal that is specified by this
19259 router would be lost if delivery did not succeed at the first attempt. For this
19260 reason, the &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& generic options are not
19261 permitted when &%one_time%& is set.
19262
19263 &*Warning 2*&: To ensure that the router generates only addresses (as opposed
19264 to pipe or file deliveries or auto-replies) &%forbid_file%&, &%forbid_pipe%&,
19265 and &%forbid_filter_reply%& are forced to be true when &%one_time%& is set.
19266
19267 &*Warning 3*&: The &%unseen%& generic router option may not be set with
19268 &%one_time%&.
19269
19270 The original top-level address is remembered with each of the generated
19271 addresses, and is output in any log messages. However, any intermediate parent
19272 addresses are not recorded. This makes a difference to the log only if
19273 &%all_parents%& log selector is set. It is expected that &%one_time%& will
19274 typically be used for mailing lists, where there is normally just one level of
19275 expansion.
19276
19277
19278 .option owners redirect "string list" unset
19279 .cindex "ownership" "alias file"
19280 .cindex "ownership" "forward file"
19281 .cindex "alias file" "ownership"
19282 .cindex "forward file" "ownership"
19283 This specifies a list of permitted owners for the file specified by &%file%&.
19284 This list is in addition to the local user when &%check_local_user%& is set.
19285 See &%check_owner%& above.
19286
19287
19288 .option owngroups redirect "string list" unset
19289 This specifies a list of permitted groups for the file specified by &%file%&.
19290 The list is in addition to the local user's primary group when
19291 &%check_local_user%& is set. See &%check_group%& above.
19292
19293
19294 .option pipe_transport redirect string&!! unset
19295 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
19296 A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a pipe when a string
19297 starting with a vertical bar character is specified as a new &"address"&. The
19298 transport used is specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the
19299 name of a configured transport. This should normally be a &(pipe)& transport.
19300 When the transport is run, the pipe command is in &$address_pipe$&.
19301
19302
19303 .option qualify_domain redirect string&!! unset
19304 .vindex "&$qualify_recipient$&"
19305 If this option is set, and an unqualified address (one without a domain) is
19306 generated, and that address would normally be qualified by the global setting
19307 in &%qualify_recipient%&, it is instead qualified with the domain specified by
19308 expanding this string. If the expansion fails, the router declines. If you want
19309 to revert to the default, you can have the expansion generate
19310 &$qualify_recipient$&.
19311
19312 This option applies to all unqualified addresses generated by Exim filters,
19313 but for traditional &_.forward_& files, it applies only to addresses that are
19314 not preceded by a backslash. Sieve filters cannot generate unqualified
19315 addresses.
19316
19317 .option qualify_preserve_domain redirect boolean false
19318 .cindex "domain" "in redirection; preserving"
19319 .cindex "preserving domain in redirection"
19320 .cindex "address redirection" "domain; preserving"
19321 If this option is set, the router's local &%qualify_domain%& option must not be
19322 set (a configuration error occurs if it is). If an unqualified address (one
19323 without a domain) is generated, it is qualified with the domain of the parent
19324 address (the immediately preceding ancestor) instead of the global
19325 &%qualify_recipient%& value. In the case of a traditional &_.forward_& file,
19326 this applies whether or not the address is preceded by a backslash.
19327
19328
19329 .option repeat_use redirect boolean true
19330 If this option is set false, the router is skipped for a child address that has
19331 any ancestor that was routed by this router. This test happens before any of
19332 the other preconditions are tested. Exim's default anti-looping rules skip
19333 only when the ancestor is the same as the current address. See also
19334 &%check_ancestor%& above and the generic &%redirect_router%& option.
19335
19336
19337 .option reply_transport redirect string&!! unset
19338 A &(redirect)& router sets up an automatic reply when a &%mail%& or
19339 &%vacation%& command is used in a filter file. The transport used is specified
19340 by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a configured
19341 transport. This should normally be an &(autoreply)& transport. Other transports
19342 are unlikely to do anything sensible or useful.
19343
19344
19345 .option rewrite redirect boolean true
19346 .cindex "address redirection" "disabling rewriting"
19347 If this option is set false, addresses generated by the router are not
19348 subject to address rewriting. Otherwise, they are treated like new addresses
19349 and are rewritten according to the global rewriting rules.
19350
19351
19352 .option sieve_subaddress redirect string&!! unset
19353 The value of this option is passed to a Sieve filter to specify the
19354 :subaddress part of an address.
19355
19356 .option sieve_useraddress redirect string&!! unset
19357 The value of this option is passed to a Sieve filter to specify the :user part
19358 of an address. However, if it is unset, the entire original local part
19359 (including any prefix or suffix) is used for :user.
19360
19361
19362 .option sieve_vacation_directory redirect string&!! unset
19363 .cindex "Sieve filter" "vacation directory"
19364 To enable the &"vacation"& extension for Sieve filters, you must set
19365 &%sieve_vacation_directory%& to the directory where vacation databases are held
19366 (do not put anything else in that directory), and ensure that the
19367 &%reply_transport%& option refers to an &(autoreply)& transport. Each user
19368 needs their own directory; Exim will create it if necessary.
19369
19370
19371
19372 .option skip_syntax_errors redirect boolean false
19373 .cindex "forward file" "broken"
19374 .cindex "address redirection" "broken files"
19375 .cindex "alias file" "broken"
19376 .cindex "broken alias or forward files"
19377 .cindex "ignoring faulty addresses"
19378 .cindex "skipping faulty addresses"
19379 .cindex "error" "skipping bad syntax"
19380 If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set, syntactically malformed addresses in
19381 non-filter redirection data are skipped, and each failing address is logged. If
19382 &%syntax_errors_to%& is set, a message is sent to the address it defines,
19383 giving details of the failures. If &%syntax_errors_text%& is set, its contents
19384 are expanded and placed at the head of the error message generated by
19385 &%syntax_errors_to%&. Usually it is appropriate to set &%syntax_errors_to%& to
19386 be the same address as the generic &%errors_to%& option. The
19387 &%skip_syntax_errors%& option is often used when handling mailing lists.
19388
19389 If all the addresses in a redirection list are skipped because of syntax
19390 errors, the router declines to handle the original address, and it is passed to
19391 the following routers.
19392
19393 If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set when an Exim filter is interpreted, any syntax
19394 error in the filter causes filtering to be abandoned without any action being
19395 taken. The incident is logged, and the router declines to handle the address,
19396 so it is passed to the following routers.
19397
19398 .cindex "Sieve filter" "syntax errors in"
19399 Syntax errors in a Sieve filter file cause the &"keep"& action to occur. This
19400 action is specified by RFC 3028. The values of &%skip_syntax_errors%&,
19401 &%syntax_errors_to%&, and &%syntax_errors_text%& are not used.
19402
19403 &%skip_syntax_errors%& can be used to specify that errors in users' forward
19404 lists or filter files should not prevent delivery. The &%syntax_errors_to%&
19405 option, used with an address that does not get redirected, can be used to
19406 notify users of these errors, by means of a router like this:
19407 .code
19408 userforward:
19409 driver = redirect
19410 allow_filter
19411 check_local_user
19412 file = $home/.forward
19413 file_transport = address_file
19414 pipe_transport = address_pipe
19415 reply_transport = address_reply
19416 no_verify
19417 skip_syntax_errors
19418 syntax_errors_to = real-$local_part@$domain
19419 syntax_errors_text = \
19420 This is an automatically generated message. An error has\n\
19421 been found in your .forward file. Details of the error are\n\
19422 reported below. While this error persists, you will receive\n\
19423 a copy of this message for every message that is addressed\n\
19424 to you. If your .forward file is a filter file, or if it is\n\
19425 a non-filter file containing no valid forwarding addresses,\n\
19426 a copy of each incoming message will be put in your normal\n\
19427 mailbox. If a non-filter file contains at least one valid\n\
19428 forwarding address, forwarding to the valid addresses will\n\
19429 happen, and those will be the only deliveries that occur.
19430 .endd
19431 You also need a router to ensure that local addresses that are prefixed by
19432 &`real-`& are recognized, but not forwarded or filtered. For example, you could
19433 put this immediately before the &(userforward)& router:
19434 .code
19435 real_localuser:
19436 driver = accept
19437 check_local_user
19438 local_part_prefix = real-
19439 transport = local_delivery
19440 .endd
19441 For security, it would probably be a good idea to restrict the use of this
19442 router to locally-generated messages, using a condition such as this:
19443 .code
19444 condition = ${if match {$sender_host_address}\
19445 {\N^(|127\.0\.0\.1)$\N}}
19446 .endd
19447
19448
19449 .option syntax_errors_text redirect string&!! unset
19450 See &%skip_syntax_errors%& above.
19451
19452
19453 .option syntax_errors_to redirect string unset
19454 See &%skip_syntax_errors%& above.
19455 .ecindex IIDredrou1
19456 .ecindex IIDredrou2
19457
19458
19459
19460
19461
19462
19463 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19464 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19465
19466 .chapter "Environment for running local transports" "CHAPenvironment" &&&
19467 "Environment for local transports"
19468 .scindex IIDenvlotra1 "local transports" "environment for"
19469 .scindex IIDenvlotra2 "environment for local transports"
19470 .scindex IIDenvlotra3 "transport" "local; environment for"
19471 Local transports handle deliveries to files and pipes. (The &(autoreply)&
19472 transport can be thought of as similar to a pipe.) Exim always runs transports
19473 in subprocesses, under specified uids and gids. Typical deliveries to local
19474 mailboxes run under the uid and gid of the local user.
19475
19476 Exim also sets a specific current directory while running the transport; for
19477 some transports a home directory setting is also relevant. The &(pipe)&
19478 transport is the only one that sets up environment variables; see section
19479 &<<SECTpipeenv>>& for details.
19480
19481 The values used for the uid, gid, and the directories may come from several
19482 different places. In many cases, the router that handles the address associates
19483 settings with that address as a result of its &%check_local_user%&, &%group%&,
19484 or &%user%& options. However, values may also be given in the transport's own
19485 configuration, and these override anything that comes from the router.
19486
19487
19488
19489 .section "Concurrent deliveries" "SECID131"
19490 .cindex "concurrent deliveries"
19491 .cindex "simultaneous deliveries"
19492 If two different messages for the same local recipient arrive more or less
19493 simultaneously, the two delivery processes are likely to run concurrently. When
19494 the &(appendfile)& transport is used to write to a file, Exim applies locking
19495 rules to stop concurrent processes from writing to the same file at the same
19496 time.
19497
19498 However, when you use a &(pipe)& transport, it is up to you to arrange any
19499 locking that is needed. Here is a silly example:
19500 .code
19501 my_transport:
19502 driver = pipe
19503 command = /bin/sh -c 'cat >>/some/file'
19504 .endd
19505 This is supposed to write the message at the end of the file. However, if two
19506 messages arrive at the same time, the file will be scrambled. You can use the
19507 &%exim_lock%& utility program (see section &<<SECTmailboxmaint>>&) to lock a
19508 file using the same algorithm that Exim itself uses.
19509
19510
19511
19512
19513 .section "Uids and gids" "SECTenvuidgid"
19514 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
19515 .cindex "transport" "local; uid and gid"
19516 All transports have the options &%group%& and &%user%&. If &%group%& is set, it
19517 overrides any group that the router set in the address, even if &%user%& is not
19518 set for the transport. This makes it possible, for example, to run local mail
19519 delivery under the uid of the recipient (set by the router), but in a special
19520 group (set by the transport). For example:
19521 .code
19522 # Routers ...
19523 # User/group are set by check_local_user in this router
19524 local_users:
19525 driver = accept
19526 check_local_user
19527 transport = group_delivery
19528
19529 # Transports ...
19530 # This transport overrides the group
19531 group_delivery:
19532 driver = appendfile
19533 file = /var/spool/mail/$local_part
19534 group = mail
19535 .endd
19536 If &%user%& is set for a transport, its value overrides what is set in the
19537 address by the router. If &%user%& is non-numeric and &%group%& is not set, the
19538 gid associated with the user is used. If &%user%& is numeric, &%group%& must be
19539 set.
19540
19541 .oindex "&%initgroups%&"
19542 When the uid is taken from the transport's configuration, the &[initgroups()]&
19543 function is called for the groups associated with that uid if the
19544 &%initgroups%& option is set for the transport. When the uid is not specified
19545 by the transport, but is associated with the address by a router, the option
19546 for calling &[initgroups()]& is taken from the router configuration.
19547
19548 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "uid for"
19549 The &(pipe)& transport contains the special option &%pipe_as_creator%&. If this
19550 is set and &%user%& is not set, the uid of the process that called Exim to
19551 receive the message is used, and if &%group%& is not set, the corresponding
19552 original gid is also used.
19553
19554 This is the detailed preference order for obtaining a gid; the first of the
19555 following that is set is used:
19556
19557 .ilist
19558 A &%group%& setting of the transport;
19559 .next
19560 A &%group%& setting of the router;
19561 .next
19562 A gid associated with a user setting of the router, either as a result of
19563 &%check_local_user%& or an explicit non-numeric &%user%& setting;
19564 .next
19565 The group associated with a non-numeric &%user%& setting of the transport;
19566 .next
19567 In a &(pipe)& transport, the creator's gid if &%deliver_as_creator%& is set and
19568 the uid is the creator's uid;
19569 .next
19570 The Exim gid if the Exim uid is being used as a default.
19571 .endlist
19572
19573 If, for example, the user is specified numerically on the router and there are
19574 no group settings, no gid is available. In this situation, an error occurs.
19575 This is different for the uid, for which there always is an ultimate default.
19576 The first of the following that is set is used:
19577
19578 .ilist
19579 A &%user%& setting of the transport;
19580 .next
19581 In a &(pipe)& transport, the creator's uid if &%deliver_as_creator%& is set;
19582 .next
19583 A &%user%& setting of the router;
19584 .next
19585 A &%check_local_user%& setting of the router;
19586 .next
19587 The Exim uid.
19588 .endlist
19589
19590 Of course, an error will still occur if the uid that is chosen is on the
19591 &%never_users%& list.
19592
19593
19594
19595
19596
19597 .section "Current and home directories" "SECID132"
19598 .cindex "current directory for local transport"
19599 .cindex "home directory" "for local transport"
19600 .cindex "transport" "local; home directory for"
19601 .cindex "transport" "local; current directory for"
19602 Routers may set current and home directories for local transports by means of
19603 the &%transport_current_directory%& and &%transport_home_directory%& options.
19604 However, if the transport's &%current_directory%& or &%home_directory%& options
19605 are set, they override the router's values. In detail, the home directory
19606 for a local transport is taken from the first of these values that is set:
19607
19608 .ilist
19609 The &%home_directory%& option on the transport;
19610 .next
19611 The &%transport_home_directory%& option on the router;
19612 .next
19613 The password data if &%check_local_user%& is set on the router;
19614 .next
19615 The &%router_home_directory%& option on the router.
19616 .endlist
19617
19618 The current directory is taken from the first of these values that is set:
19619
19620 .ilist
19621 The &%current_directory%& option on the transport;
19622 .next
19623 The &%transport_current_directory%& option on the router.
19624 .endlist
19625
19626
19627 If neither the router nor the transport sets a current directory, Exim uses the
19628 value of the home directory, if it is set. Otherwise it sets the current
19629 directory to &_/_& before running a local transport.
19630
19631
19632
19633 .section "Expansion variables derived from the address" "SECID133"
19634 .vindex "&$domain$&"
19635 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
19636 .vindex "&$original_domain$&"
19637 Normally a local delivery is handling a single address, and in that case the
19638 variables such as &$domain$& and &$local_part$& are set during local
19639 deliveries. However, in some circumstances more than one address may be handled
19640 at once (for example, while writing batch SMTP for onward transmission by some
19641 other means). In this case, the variables associated with the local part are
19642 never set, &$domain$& is set only if all the addresses have the same domain,
19643 and &$original_domain$& is never set.
19644 .ecindex IIDenvlotra1
19645 .ecindex IIDenvlotra2
19646 .ecindex IIDenvlotra3
19647
19648
19649
19650
19651
19652
19653
19654 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19655 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19656
19657 .chapter "Generic options for transports" "CHAPtransportgeneric"
19658 .scindex IIDgenoptra1 "generic options" "transport"
19659 .scindex IIDgenoptra2 "options" "generic; for transports"
19660 .scindex IIDgenoptra3 "transport" "generic options for"
19661 The following generic options apply to all transports:
19662
19663
19664 .option body_only transports boolean false
19665 .cindex "transport" "body only"
19666 .cindex "message" "transporting body only"
19667 .cindex "body of message" "transporting"
19668 If this option is set, the message's headers are not transported. It is
19669 mutually exclusive with &%headers_only%&. If it is used with the &(appendfile)&
19670 or &(pipe)& transports, the settings of &%message_prefix%& and
19671 &%message_suffix%& should be checked, because this option does not
19672 automatically suppress them.
19673
19674
19675 .option current_directory transports string&!! unset
19676 .cindex "transport" "current directory for"
19677 This specifies the current directory that is to be set while running the
19678 transport, overriding any value that may have been set by the router.
19679 If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
19680 logged, and delivery is deferred.
19681
19682
19683 .option disable_logging transports boolean false
19684 If this option is set true, nothing is logged for any
19685 deliveries by the transport or for any
19686 transport errors. You should not set this option unless you really, really know
19687 what you are doing.
19688
19689
19690 .option debug_print transports string&!! unset
19691 .cindex "testing" "variables in drivers"
19692 If this option is set and debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%& command line
19693 option), the string is expanded and included in the debugging output when the
19694 transport is run.
19695 If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
19696 output, and Exim carries on processing.
19697 This facility is provided to help with checking out the values of variables and
19698 so on when debugging driver configurations. For example, if a &%headers_add%&
19699 option is not working properly, &%debug_print%& could be used to output the
19700 variables it references. A newline is added to the text if it does not end with
19701 one.
19702 The variables &$transport_name$& and &$router_name$& contain the name of the
19703 transport and the router that called it.
19704
19705 .option delivery_date_add transports boolean false
19706 .cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
19707 If this option is true, a &'Delivery-date:'& header is added to the message.
19708 This gives the actual time the delivery was made. As this is not a standard
19709 header, Exim has a configuration option (&%delivery_date_remove%&) which
19710 requests its removal from incoming messages, so that delivered messages can
19711 safely be resent to other recipients.
19712
19713
19714 .option driver transports string unset
19715 This specifies which of the available transport drivers is to be used.
19716 There is no default, and this option must be set for every transport.
19717
19718
19719 .option envelope_to_add transports boolean false
19720 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
19721 If this option is true, an &'Envelope-to:'& header is added to the message.
19722 This gives the original address(es) in the incoming envelope that caused this
19723 delivery to happen. More than one address may be present if the transport is
19724 configured to handle several addresses at once, or if more than one original
19725 address was redirected to the same final address. As this is not a standard
19726 header, Exim has a configuration option (&%envelope_to_remove%&) which requests
19727 its removal from incoming messages, so that delivered messages can safely be
19728 resent to other recipients.
19729
19730
19731 .option group transports string&!! "Exim group"
19732 .cindex "transport" "group; specifying"
19733 This option specifies a gid for running the transport process, overriding any
19734 value that the router supplies, and also overriding any value associated with
19735 &%user%& (see below).
19736
19737
19738 .option headers_add transports string&!! unset
19739 .cindex "header lines" "adding in transport"
19740 .cindex "transport" "header lines; adding"
19741 This option specifies a string of text that is expanded and added to the header
19742 portion of a message as it is transported, as described in section
19743 &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Additional header lines can also be specified by
19744 routers. If the result of the expansion is an empty string, or if the expansion
19745 is forced to fail, no action is taken. Other expansion failures are treated as
19746 errors and cause the delivery to be deferred.
19747
19748 Unlike most options, &%headers_add%& can be specified multiple times
19749 for a transport; all listed headers are added.
19750
19751
19752 .option headers_only transports boolean false
19753 .cindex "transport" "header lines only"
19754 .cindex "message" "transporting headers only"
19755 .cindex "header lines" "transporting"
19756 If this option is set, the message's body is not transported. It is mutually
19757 exclusive with &%body_only%&. If it is used with the &(appendfile)& or &(pipe)&
19758 transports, the settings of &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& should be
19759 checked, since this option does not automatically suppress them.
19760
19761
19762 .option headers_remove transports string&!! unset
19763 .cindex "header lines" "removing"
19764 .cindex "transport" "header lines; removing"
19765 This option specifies a string that is expanded into a list of header names;
19766 these headers are omitted from the message as it is transported, as described
19767 in section &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Header removal can also be specified by
19768 routers. If the result of the expansion is an empty string, or if the expansion
19769 is forced to fail, no action is taken. Other expansion failures are treated as
19770 errors and cause the delivery to be deferred.
19771
19772 Unlike most options, &%headers_remove%& can be specified multiple times
19773 for a router; all listed headers are added.
19774
19775
19776
19777 .option headers_rewrite transports string unset
19778 .cindex "transport" "header lines; rewriting"
19779 .cindex "rewriting" "at transport time"
19780 This option allows addresses in header lines to be rewritten at transport time,
19781 that is, as the message is being copied to its destination. The contents of the
19782 option are a colon-separated list of rewriting rules. Each rule is in exactly
19783 the same form as one of the general rewriting rules that are applied when a
19784 message is received. These are described in chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&. For
19785 example,
19786 .code
19787 headers_rewrite = a@b c@d f : \
19788 x@y w@z
19789 .endd
19790 changes &'a@b'& into &'c@d'& in &'From:'& header lines, and &'x@y'& into
19791 &'w@z'& in all address-bearing header lines. The rules are applied to the
19792 header lines just before they are written out at transport time, so they affect
19793 only those copies of the message that pass through the transport. However, only
19794 the message's original header lines, and any that were added by a system
19795 filter, are rewritten. If a router or transport adds header lines, they are not
19796 affected by this option. These rewriting rules are &'not'& applied to the
19797 envelope. You can change the return path using &%return_path%&, but you cannot
19798 change envelope recipients at this time.
19799
19800
19801 .option home_directory transports string&!! unset
19802 .cindex "transport" "home directory for"
19803 .vindex "&$home$&"
19804 This option specifies a home directory setting for a local transport,
19805 overriding any value that may be set by the router. The home directory is
19806 placed in &$home$& while expanding the transport's private options. It is also
19807 used as the current directory if no current directory is set by the
19808 &%current_directory%& option on the transport or the
19809 &%transport_current_directory%& option on the router. If the expansion fails
19810 for any reason, including forced failure, an error is logged, and delivery is
19811 deferred.
19812
19813
19814 .option initgroups transports boolean false
19815 .cindex "additional groups"
19816 .cindex "groups" "additional"
19817 .cindex "transport" "group; additional"
19818 If this option is true and the uid for the delivery process is provided by the
19819 transport, the &[initgroups()]& function is called when running the transport
19820 to ensure that any additional groups associated with the uid are set up.
19821
19822
19823 .option message_size_limit transports string&!! 0
19824 .cindex "limit" "message size per transport"
19825 .cindex "size" "of message, limit"
19826 .cindex "transport" "message size; limiting"
19827 This option controls the size of messages passed through the transport. It is
19828 expanded before use; the result of the expansion must be a sequence of decimal
19829 digits, optionally followed by K or M. If the expansion fails for any reason,
19830 including forced failure, or if the result is not of the required form,
19831 delivery is deferred. If the value is greater than zero and the size of a
19832 message exceeds this limit, the address is failed. If there is any chance that
19833 the resulting bounce message could be routed to the same transport, you should
19834 ensure that &%return_size_limit%& is less than the transport's
19835 &%message_size_limit%&, as otherwise the bounce message will fail to get
19836 delivered.
19837
19838
19839
19840 .option rcpt_include_affixes transports boolean false
19841 .cindex "prefix" "for local part, including in envelope"
19842 .cindex "suffix for local part" "including in envelope"
19843 .cindex "local part" "prefix"
19844 .cindex "local part" "suffix"
19845 When this option is false (the default), and an address that has had any
19846 affixes (prefixes or suffixes) removed from the local part is delivered by any
19847 form of SMTP or LMTP, the affixes are not included. For example, if a router
19848 that contains
19849 .code
19850 local_part_prefix = *-
19851 .endd
19852 routes the address &'abc-xyz@some.domain'& to an SMTP transport, the envelope
19853 is delivered with
19854 .code
19855 RCPT TO:<xyz@some.domain>
19856 .endd
19857 This is also the case when an ACL-time callout is being used to verify a
19858 recipient address. However, if &%rcpt_include_affixes%& is set true, the
19859 whole local part is included in the RCPT command. This option applies to BSMTP
19860 deliveries by the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports as well as to the
19861 &(lmtp)& and &(smtp)& transports.
19862
19863
19864 .option retry_use_local_part transports boolean "see below"
19865 .cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
19866 When a delivery suffers a temporary failure, a retry record is created
19867 in Exim's hints database. For remote deliveries, the key for the retry record
19868 is based on the name and/or IP address of the failing remote host. For local
19869 deliveries, the key is normally the entire address, including both the local
19870 part and the domain. This is suitable for most common cases of local delivery
19871 temporary failure &-- for example, exceeding a mailbox quota should delay only
19872 deliveries to that mailbox, not to the whole domain.
19873
19874 However, in some special cases you may want to treat a temporary local delivery
19875 as a failure associated with the domain, and not with a particular local part.
19876 (For example, if you are storing all mail for some domain in files.) You can do
19877 this by setting &%retry_use_local_part%& false.
19878
19879 For all the local transports, its default value is true. For remote transports,
19880 the default value is false for tidiness, but changing the value has no effect
19881 on a remote transport in the current implementation.
19882
19883
19884 .option return_path transports string&!! unset
19885 .cindex "envelope sender"
19886 .cindex "transport" "return path; changing"
19887 .cindex "return path" "changing in transport"
19888 If this option is set, the string is expanded at transport time and replaces
19889 the existing return path (envelope sender) value in the copy of the message
19890 that is being delivered. An empty return path is permitted. This feature is
19891 designed for remote deliveries, where the value of this option is used in the
19892 SMTP MAIL command. If you set &%return_path%& for a local transport, the
19893 only effect is to change the address that is placed in the &'Return-path:'&
19894 header line, if one is added to the message (see the next option).
19895
19896 &*Note:*& A changed return path is not logged unless you add
19897 &%return_path_on_delivery%& to the log selector.
19898
19899 .vindex "&$return_path$&"
19900 The expansion can refer to the existing value via &$return_path$&. This is
19901 either the message's envelope sender, or an address set by the
19902 &%errors_to%& option on a router. If the expansion is forced to fail, no
19903 replacement occurs; if it fails for another reason, delivery is deferred. This
19904 option can be used to support VERP (Variable Envelope Return Paths) &-- see
19905 section &<<SECTverp>>&.
19906
19907 &*Note*&: If a delivery error is detected locally, including the case when a
19908 remote server rejects a message at SMTP time, the bounce message is not sent to
19909 the value of this option. It is sent to the previously set errors address.
19910 This defaults to the incoming sender address, but can be changed by setting
19911 &%errors_to%& in a router.
19912
19913
19914
19915 .option return_path_add transports boolean false
19916 .cindex "&'Return-path:'& header line"
19917 If this option is true, a &'Return-path:'& header is added to the message.
19918 Although the return path is normally available in the prefix line of BSD
19919 mailboxes, this is commonly not displayed by MUAs, and so the user does not
19920 have easy access to it.
19921
19922 RFC 2821 states that the &'Return-path:'& header is added to a message &"when
19923 the delivery SMTP server makes the final delivery"&. This implies that this
19924 header should not be present in incoming messages. Exim has a configuration
19925 option, &%return_path_remove%&, which requests removal of this header from
19926 incoming messages, so that delivered messages can safely be resent to other
19927 recipients.
19928
19929
19930 .option shadow_condition transports string&!! unset
19931 See &%shadow_transport%& below.
19932
19933
19934 .option shadow_transport transports string unset
19935 .cindex "shadow transport"
19936 .cindex "transport" "shadow"
19937 A local transport may set the &%shadow_transport%& option to the name of
19938 another local transport. Shadow remote transports are not supported.
19939
19940 Whenever a delivery to the main transport succeeds, and either
19941 &%shadow_condition%& is unset, or its expansion does not result in the empty
19942 string or one of the strings &"0"& or &"no"& or &"false"&, the message is also
19943 passed to the shadow transport, with the same delivery address or addresses. If
19944 expansion fails, no action is taken except that non-forced expansion failures
19945 cause a log line to be written.
19946
19947 The result of the shadow transport is discarded and does not affect the
19948 subsequent processing of the message. Only a single level of shadowing is
19949 provided; the &%shadow_transport%& option is ignored on any transport when it
19950 is running as a shadow. Options concerned with output from pipes are also
19951 ignored. The log line for the successful delivery has an item added on the end,
19952 of the form
19953 .code
19954 ST=<shadow transport name>
19955 .endd
19956 If the shadow transport did not succeed, the error message is put in
19957 parentheses afterwards. Shadow transports can be used for a number of different
19958 purposes, including keeping more detailed log information than Exim normally
19959 provides, and implementing automatic acknowledgment policies based on message
19960 headers that some sites insist on.
19961
19962
19963 .option transport_filter transports string&!! unset
19964 .cindex "transport" "filter"
19965 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
19966 This option sets up a filtering (in the Unix shell sense) process for messages
19967 at transport time. It should not be confused with mail filtering as set up by
19968 individual users or via a system filter.
19969
19970 When the message is about to be written out, the command specified by
19971 &%transport_filter%& is started up in a separate, parallel process, and
19972 the entire message, including the header lines, is passed to it on its standard
19973 input (this in fact is done from a third process, to avoid deadlock). The
19974 command must be specified as an absolute path.
19975
19976 The lines of the message that are written to the transport filter are
19977 terminated by newline (&"\n"&). The message is passed to the filter before any
19978 SMTP-specific processing, such as turning &"\n"& into &"\r\n"& and escaping
19979 lines beginning with a dot, and also before any processing implied by the
19980 settings of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& in the &(appendfile)& or
19981 &(pipe)& transports.
19982
19983 The standard error for the filter process is set to the same destination as its
19984 standard output; this is read and written to the message's ultimate
19985 destination. The process that writes the message to the filter, the
19986 filter itself, and the original process that reads the result and delivers it
19987 are all run in parallel, like a shell pipeline.
19988
19989 The filter can perform any transformations it likes, but of course should take
19990 care not to break RFC 2822 syntax. Exim does not check the result, except to
19991 test for a final newline when SMTP is in use. All messages transmitted over
19992 SMTP must end with a newline, so Exim supplies one if it is missing.
19993
19994 .cindex "content scanning" "per user"
19995 A transport filter can be used to provide content-scanning on a per-user basis
19996 at delivery time if the only required effect of the scan is to modify the
19997 message. For example, a content scan could insert a new header line containing
19998 a spam score. This could be interpreted by a filter in the user's MUA. It is
19999 not possible to discard a message at this stage.
20000
20001 .cindex "SMTP" "SIZE"
20002 A problem might arise if the filter increases the size of a message that is
20003 being sent down an SMTP connection. If the receiving SMTP server has indicated
20004 support for the SIZE parameter, Exim will have sent the size of the message
20005 at the start of the SMTP session. If what is actually sent is substantially
20006 more, the server might reject the message. This can be worked round by setting
20007 the &%size_addition%& option on the &(smtp)& transport, either to allow for
20008 additions to the message, or to disable the use of SIZE altogether.
20009
20010 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
20011 The value of the &%transport_filter%& option is the command string for starting
20012 the filter, which is run directly from Exim, not under a shell. The string is
20013 parsed by Exim in the same way as a command string for the &(pipe)& transport:
20014 Exim breaks it up into arguments and then expands each argument separately (see
20015 section &<<SECThowcommandrun>>&). Any kind of expansion failure causes delivery
20016 to be deferred. The special argument &$pipe_addresses$& is replaced by a number
20017 of arguments, one for each address that applies to this delivery. (This isn't
20018 an ideal name for this feature here, but as it was already implemented for the
20019 &(pipe)& transport, it seemed sensible not to change it.)
20020
20021 .vindex "&$host$&"
20022 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
20023 The expansion variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are available when the
20024 transport is a remote one. They contain the name and IP address of the host to
20025 which the message is being sent. For example:
20026 .code
20027 transport_filter = /some/directory/transport-filter.pl \
20028 $host $host_address $sender_address $pipe_addresses
20029 .endd
20030
20031 Two problems arise if you want to use more complicated expansion items to
20032 generate transport filter commands, both of which due to the fact that the
20033 command is split up &'before'& expansion.
20034 .ilist
20035 If an expansion item contains white space, you must quote it, so that it is all
20036 part of the same command item. If the entire option setting is one such
20037 expansion item, you have to take care what kind of quoting you use. For
20038 example:
20039 .code
20040 transport_filter = '/bin/cmd${if eq{$host}{a.b.c}{1}{2}}'
20041 .endd
20042 This runs the command &(/bin/cmd1)& if the host name is &'a.b.c'&, and
20043 &(/bin/cmd2)& otherwise. If double quotes had been used, they would have been
20044 stripped by Exim when it read the option's value. When the value is used, if
20045 the single quotes were missing, the line would be split into two items,
20046 &`/bin/cmd${if`& and &`eq{$host}{a.b.c}{1}{2}`&, and an error would occur when
20047 Exim tried to expand the first one.
20048 .next
20049 Except for the special case of &$pipe_addresses$& that is mentioned above, an
20050 expansion cannot generate multiple arguments, or a command name followed by
20051 arguments. Consider this example:
20052 .code
20053 transport_filter = ${lookup{$host}lsearch{/a/file}\
20054 {$value}{/bin/cat}}
20055 .endd
20056 The result of the lookup is interpreted as the name of the command, even
20057 if it contains white space. The simplest way round this is to use a shell:
20058 .code
20059 transport_filter = /bin/sh -c ${lookup{$host}lsearch{/a/file}\
20060 {$value}{/bin/cat}}
20061 .endd
20062 .endlist
20063
20064 The filter process is run under the same uid and gid as the normal delivery.
20065 For remote deliveries this is the Exim uid/gid by default. The command should
20066 normally yield a zero return code. Transport filters are not supposed to fail.
20067 A non-zero code is taken to mean that the transport filter encountered some
20068 serious problem. Delivery of the message is deferred; the message remains on
20069 the queue and is tried again later. It is not possible to cause a message to be
20070 bounced from a transport filter.
20071
20072 If a transport filter is set on an autoreply transport, the original message is
20073 passed through the filter as it is being copied into the newly generated
20074 message, which happens if the &%return_message%& option is set.
20075
20076
20077 .option transport_filter_timeout transports time 5m
20078 .cindex "transport" "filter, timeout"
20079 When Exim is reading the output of a transport filter, it applies a timeout
20080 that can be set by this option. Exceeding the timeout is normally treated as a
20081 temporary delivery failure. However, if a transport filter is used with a
20082 &(pipe)& transport, a timeout in the transport filter is treated in the same
20083 way as a timeout in the pipe command itself. By default, a timeout is a hard
20084 error, but if the &(pipe)& transport's &%timeout_defer%& option is set true, it
20085 becomes a temporary error.
20086
20087
20088 .option user transports string&!! "Exim user"
20089 .cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
20090 .cindex "transport" "user, specifying"
20091 This option specifies the user under whose uid the delivery process is to be
20092 run, overriding any uid that may have been set by the router. If the user is
20093 given as a name, the uid is looked up from the password data, and the
20094 associated group is taken as the value of the gid to be used if the &%group%&
20095 option is not set.
20096
20097 For deliveries that use local transports, a user and group are normally
20098 specified explicitly or implicitly (for example, as a result of
20099 &%check_local_user%&) by the router or transport.
20100
20101 .cindex "hints database" "access by remote transport"
20102 For remote transports, you should leave this option unset unless you really are
20103 sure you know what you are doing. When a remote transport is running, it needs
20104 to be able to access Exim's hints databases, because each host may have its own
20105 retry data.
20106 .ecindex IIDgenoptra1
20107 .ecindex IIDgenoptra2
20108 .ecindex IIDgenoptra3
20109
20110
20111
20112
20113
20114
20115 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20116 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20117
20118 .chapter "Address batching in local transports" "CHAPbatching" &&&
20119 "Address batching"
20120 .cindex "transport" "local; address batching in"
20121 The only remote transport (&(smtp)&) is normally configured to handle more than
20122 one address at a time, so that when several addresses are routed to the same
20123 remote host, just one copy of the message is sent. Local transports, however,
20124 normally handle one address at a time. That is, a separate instance of the
20125 transport is run for each address that is routed to the transport. A separate
20126 copy of the message is delivered each time.
20127
20128 .cindex "batched local delivery"
20129 .oindex "&%batch_max%&"
20130 .oindex "&%batch_id%&"
20131 In special cases, it may be desirable to handle several addresses at once in a
20132 local transport, for example:
20133
20134 .ilist
20135 In an &(appendfile)& transport, when storing messages in files for later
20136 delivery by some other means, a single copy of the message with multiple
20137 recipients saves space.
20138 .next
20139 In an &(lmtp)& transport, when delivering over &"local SMTP"& to some process,
20140 a single copy saves time, and is the normal way LMTP is expected to work.
20141 .next
20142 In a &(pipe)& transport, when passing the message
20143 to a scanner program or
20144 to some other delivery mechanism such as UUCP, multiple recipients may be
20145 acceptable.
20146 .endlist
20147
20148 These three local transports all have the same options for controlling multiple
20149 (&"batched"&) deliveries, namely &%batch_max%& and &%batch_id%&. To save
20150 repeating the information for each transport, these options are described here.
20151
20152 The &%batch_max%& option specifies the maximum number of addresses that can be
20153 delivered together in a single run of the transport. Its default value is one
20154 (no batching). When more than one address is routed to a transport that has a
20155 &%batch_max%& value greater than one, the addresses are delivered in a batch
20156 (that is, in a single run of the transport with multiple recipients), subject
20157 to certain conditions:
20158
20159 .ilist
20160 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
20161 If any of the transport's options contain a reference to &$local_part$&, no
20162 batching is possible.
20163 .next
20164 .vindex "&$domain$&"
20165 If any of the transport's options contain a reference to &$domain$&, only
20166 addresses with the same domain are batched.
20167 .next
20168 .cindex "customizing" "batching condition"
20169 If &%batch_id%& is set, it is expanded for each address, and only those
20170 addresses with the same expanded value are batched. This allows you to specify
20171 customized batching conditions. Failure of the expansion for any reason,
20172 including forced failure, disables batching, but it does not stop the delivery
20173 from taking place.
20174 .next
20175 Batched addresses must also have the same errors address (where to send
20176 delivery errors), the same header additions and removals, the same user and
20177 group for the transport, and if a host list is present, the first host must
20178 be the same.
20179 .endlist
20180
20181 In the case of the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports, batching applies
20182 both when the file or pipe command is specified in the transport, and when it
20183 is specified by a &(redirect)& router, but all the batched addresses must of
20184 course be routed to the same file or pipe command. These two transports have an
20185 option called &%use_bsmtp%&, which causes them to deliver the message in
20186 &"batched SMTP"& format, with the envelope represented as SMTP commands. The
20187 &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& options are forced to the values
20188 .code
20189 check_string = "."
20190 escape_string = ".."
20191 .endd
20192 when batched SMTP is in use. A full description of the batch SMTP mechanism is
20193 given in section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&. The &(lmtp)& transport does not have a
20194 &%use_bsmtp%& option, because it always delivers using the SMTP protocol.
20195
20196 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
20197 If the generic &%envelope_to_add%& option is set for a batching transport, the
20198 &'Envelope-to:'& header that is added to the message contains all the addresses
20199 that are being processed together. If you are using a batching &(appendfile)&
20200 transport without &%use_bsmtp%&, the only way to preserve the recipient
20201 addresses is to set the &%envelope_to_add%& option.
20202
20203 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "with multiple addresses"
20204 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
20205 If you are using a &(pipe)& transport without BSMTP, and setting the
20206 transport's &%command%& option, you can include &$pipe_addresses$& as part of
20207 the command. This is not a true variable; it is a bit of magic that causes each
20208 of the recipient addresses to be inserted into the command as a separate
20209 argument. This provides a way of accessing all the addresses that are being
20210 delivered in the batch. &*Note:*& This is not possible for pipe commands that
20211 are specified by a &(redirect)& router.
20212
20213
20214
20215
20216 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20217 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20218
20219 .chapter "The appendfile transport" "CHAPappendfile"
20220 .scindex IIDapptra1 "&(appendfile)& transport"
20221 .scindex IIDapptra2 "transports" "&(appendfile)&"
20222 .cindex "directory creation"
20223 .cindex "creating directories"
20224 The &(appendfile)& transport delivers a message by appending it to an existing
20225 file, or by creating an entirely new file in a specified directory. Single
20226 files to which messages are appended can be in the traditional Unix mailbox
20227 format, or optionally in the MBX format supported by the Pine MUA and
20228 University of Washington IMAP daemon, &'inter alia'&. When each message is
20229 being delivered as a separate file, &"maildir"& format can optionally be used
20230 to give added protection against failures that happen part-way through the
20231 delivery. A third form of separate-file delivery known as &"mailstore"& is also
20232 supported. For all file formats, Exim attempts to create as many levels of
20233 directory as necessary, provided that &%create_directory%& is set.
20234
20235 The code for the optional formats is not included in the Exim binary by
20236 default. It is necessary to set SUPPORT_MBX, SUPPORT_MAILDIR and/or
20237 SUPPORT_MAILSTORE in &_Local/Makefile_& to have the appropriate code
20238 included.
20239
20240 .cindex "quota" "system"
20241 Exim recognizes system quota errors, and generates an appropriate message. Exim
20242 also supports its own quota control within the transport, for use when the
20243 system facility is unavailable or cannot be used for some reason.
20244
20245 If there is an error while appending to a file (for example, quota exceeded or
20246 partition filled), Exim attempts to reset the file's length and last
20247 modification time back to what they were before. If there is an error while
20248 creating an entirely new file, the new file is removed.
20249
20250 Before appending to a file, a number of security checks are made, and the
20251 file is locked. A detailed description is given below, after the list of
20252 private options.
20253
20254 The &(appendfile)& transport is most commonly used for local deliveries to
20255 users' mailboxes. However, it can also be used as a pseudo-remote transport for
20256 putting messages into files for remote delivery by some means other than Exim.
20257 &"Batch SMTP"& format is often used in this case (see the &%use_bsmtp%&
20258 option).
20259
20260
20261
20262 .section "The file and directory options" "SECTfildiropt"
20263 The &%file%& option specifies a single file, to which the message is appended;
20264 the &%directory%& option specifies a directory, in which a new file containing
20265 the message is created. Only one of these two options can be set, and for
20266 normal deliveries to mailboxes, one of them &'must'& be set.
20267
20268 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
20269 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
20270 However, &(appendfile)& is also used for delivering messages to files or
20271 directories whose names (or parts of names) are obtained from alias,
20272 forwarding, or filtering operations (for example, a &%save%& command in a
20273 user's Exim filter). When such a transport is running, &$local_part$& contains
20274 the local part that was aliased or forwarded, and &$address_file$& contains the
20275 name (or partial name) of the file or directory generated by the redirection
20276 operation. There are two cases:
20277
20278 .ilist
20279 If neither &%file%& nor &%directory%& is set, the redirection operation
20280 must specify an absolute path (one that begins with &`/`&). This is the most
20281 common case when users with local accounts use filtering to sort mail into
20282 different folders. See for example, the &(address_file)& transport in the
20283 default configuration. If the path ends with a slash, it is assumed to be the
20284 name of a directory. A delivery to a directory can also be forced by setting
20285 &%maildir_format%& or &%mailstore_format%&.
20286 .next
20287 If &%file%& or &%directory%& is set for a delivery from a redirection, it is
20288 used to determine the file or directory name for the delivery. Normally, the
20289 contents of &$address_file$& are used in some way in the string expansion.
20290 .endlist
20291
20292
20293 .cindex "Sieve filter" "configuring &(appendfile)&"
20294 .cindex "Sieve filter" "relative mailbox path handling"
20295 As an example of the second case, consider an environment where users do not
20296 have home directories. They may be permitted to use Exim filter commands of the
20297 form:
20298 .code
20299 save folder23
20300 .endd
20301 or Sieve filter commands of the form:
20302 .code
20303 require "fileinto";
20304 fileinto "folder23";
20305 .endd
20306 In this situation, the expansion of &%file%& or &%directory%& in the transport
20307 must transform the relative path into an appropriate absolute file name. In the
20308 case of Sieve filters, the name &'inbox'& must be handled. It is the name that
20309 is used as a result of a &"keep"& action in the filter. This example shows one
20310 way of handling this requirement:
20311 .code
20312 file = ${if eq{$address_file}{inbox} \
20313 {/var/mail/$local_part} \
20314 {${if eq{${substr_0_1:$address_file}}{/} \
20315 {$address_file} \
20316 {$home/mail/$address_file} \
20317 }} \
20318 }
20319 .endd
20320 With this setting of &%file%&, &'inbox'& refers to the standard mailbox
20321 location, absolute paths are used without change, and other folders are in the
20322 &_mail_& directory within the home directory.
20323
20324 &*Note 1*&: While processing an Exim filter, a relative path such as
20325 &_folder23_& is turned into an absolute path if a home directory is known to
20326 the router. In particular, this is the case if &%check_local_user%& is set. If
20327 you want to prevent this happening at routing time, you can set
20328 &%router_home_directory%& empty. This forces the router to pass the relative
20329 path to the transport.
20330
20331 &*Note 2*&: An absolute path in &$address_file$& is not treated specially;
20332 the &%file%& or &%directory%& option is still used if it is set.
20333
20334
20335
20336
20337 .section "Private options for appendfile" "SECID134"
20338 .cindex "options" "&(appendfile)& transport"
20339
20340
20341
20342 .option allow_fifo appendfile boolean false
20343 .cindex "fifo (named pipe)"
20344 .cindex "named pipe (fifo)"
20345 .cindex "pipe" "named (fifo)"
20346 Setting this option permits delivery to named pipes (FIFOs) as well as to
20347 regular files. If no process is reading the named pipe at delivery time, the
20348 delivery is deferred.
20349
20350
20351 .option allow_symlink appendfile boolean false
20352 .cindex "symbolic link" "to mailbox"
20353 .cindex "mailbox" "symbolic link"
20354 By default, &(appendfile)& will not deliver if the path name for the file is
20355 that of a symbolic link. Setting this option relaxes that constraint, but there
20356 are security issues involved in the use of symbolic links. Be sure you know
20357 what you are doing if you set this. Details of exactly what this option affects
20358 are included in the discussion which follows this list of options.
20359
20360
20361 .option batch_id appendfile string&!! unset
20362 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
20363 However, batching is automatically disabled for &(appendfile)& deliveries that
20364 happen as a result of forwarding or aliasing or other redirection directly to a
20365 file.
20366
20367
20368 .option batch_max appendfile integer 1
20369 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
20370
20371
20372 .option check_group appendfile boolean false
20373 When this option is set, the group owner of the file defined by the &%file%&
20374 option is checked to see that it is the same as the group under which the
20375 delivery process is running. The default setting is false because the default
20376 file mode is 0600, which means that the group is irrelevant.
20377
20378
20379 .option check_owner appendfile boolean true
20380 When this option is set, the owner of the file defined by the &%file%& option
20381 is checked to ensure that it is the same as the user under which the delivery
20382 process is running.
20383
20384
20385 .option check_string appendfile string "see below"
20386 .cindex "&""From""& line"
20387 As &(appendfile)& writes the message, the start of each line is tested for
20388 matching &%check_string%&, and if it does, the initial matching characters are
20389 replaced by the contents of &%escape_string%&. The value of &%check_string%& is
20390 a literal string, not a regular expression, and the case of any letters it
20391 contains is significant.
20392
20393 If &%use_bsmtp%& is set the values of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%&
20394 are forced to &"."& and &".."& respectively, and any settings in the
20395 configuration are ignored. Otherwise, they default to &"From&~"& and
20396 &">From&~"& when the &%file%& option is set, and unset when any of the
20397 &%directory%&, &%maildir%&, or &%mailstore%& options are set.
20398
20399 The default settings, along with &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%&, are
20400 suitable for traditional &"BSD"& mailboxes, where a line beginning with
20401 &"From&~"& indicates the start of a new message. All four options need changing
20402 if another format is used. For example, to deliver to mailboxes in MMDF format:
20403 .cindex "MMDF format mailbox"
20404 .cindex "mailbox" "MMDF format"
20405 .code
20406 check_string = "\1\1\1\1\n"
20407 escape_string = "\1\1\1\1 \n"
20408 message_prefix = "\1\1\1\1\n"
20409 message_suffix = "\1\1\1\1\n"
20410 .endd
20411 .option create_directory appendfile boolean true
20412 .cindex "directory creation"
20413 When this option is true, Exim attempts to create any missing superior
20414 directories for the file that it is about to write. A created directory's mode
20415 is given by the &%directory_mode%& option.
20416
20417 The group ownership of a newly created directory is highly dependent on the
20418 operating system (and possibly the file system) that is being used. For
20419 example, in Solaris, if the parent directory has the setgid bit set, its group
20420 is propagated to the child; if not, the currently set group is used. However,
20421 in FreeBSD, the parent's group is always used.
20422
20423
20424
20425 .option create_file appendfile string anywhere
20426 This option constrains the location of files and directories that are created
20427 by this transport. It applies to files defined by the &%file%& option and
20428 directories defined by the &%directory%& option. In the case of maildir
20429 delivery, it applies to the top level directory, not the maildir directories
20430 beneath.
20431
20432 The option must be set to one of the words &"anywhere"&, &"inhome"&, or
20433 &"belowhome"&. In the second and third cases, a home directory must have been
20434 set for the transport. This option is not useful when an explicit file name is
20435 given for normal mailbox deliveries. It is intended for the case when file
20436 names are generated from users' &_.forward_& files. These are usually handled
20437 by an &(appendfile)& transport called &%address_file%&. See also
20438 &%file_must_exist%&.
20439
20440
20441 .option directory appendfile string&!! unset
20442 This option is mutually exclusive with the &%file%& option, but one of &%file%&
20443 or &%directory%& must be set, unless the delivery is the direct result of a
20444 redirection (see section &<<SECTfildiropt>>&).
20445
20446 When &%directory%& is set, the string is expanded, and the message is delivered
20447 into a new file or files in or below the given directory, instead of being
20448 appended to a single mailbox file. A number of different formats are provided
20449 (see &%maildir_format%& and &%mailstore_format%&), and see section
20450 &<<SECTopdir>>& for further details of this form of delivery.
20451
20452
20453 .option directory_file appendfile string&!! "see below"
20454 .cindex "base62"
20455 .vindex "&$inode$&"
20456 When &%directory%& is set, but neither &%maildir_format%& nor
20457 &%mailstore_format%& is set, &(appendfile)& delivers each message into a file
20458 whose name is obtained by expanding this string. The default value is:
20459 .code
20460 q${base62:$tod_epoch}-$inode
20461 .endd
20462 This generates a unique name from the current time, in base 62 form, and the
20463 inode of the file. The variable &$inode$& is available only when expanding this
20464 option.
20465
20466
20467 .option directory_mode appendfile "octal integer" 0700
20468 If &(appendfile)& creates any directories as a result of the
20469 &%create_directory%& option, their mode is specified by this option.
20470
20471
20472 .option escape_string appendfile string "see description"
20473 See &%check_string%& above.
20474
20475
20476 .option file appendfile string&!! unset
20477 This option is mutually exclusive with the &%directory%& option, but one of
20478 &%file%& or &%directory%& must be set, unless the delivery is the direct result
20479 of a redirection (see section &<<SECTfildiropt>>&). The &%file%& option
20480 specifies a single file, to which the message is appended. One or more of
20481 &%use_fcntl_lock%&, &%use_flock_lock%&, or &%use_lockfile%& must be set with
20482 &%file%&.
20483
20484 .cindex "NFS" "lock file"
20485 .cindex "locking files"
20486 .cindex "lock files"
20487 If you are using more than one host to deliver over NFS into the same
20488 mailboxes, you should always use lock files.
20489
20490 The string value is expanded for each delivery, and must yield an absolute
20491 path. The most common settings of this option are variations on one of these
20492 examples:
20493 .code
20494 file = /var/spool/mail/$local_part
20495 file = /home/$local_part/inbox
20496 file = $home/inbox
20497 .endd
20498 .cindex "&""sticky""& bit"
20499 In the first example, all deliveries are done into the same directory. If Exim
20500 is configured to use lock files (see &%use_lockfile%& below) it must be able to
20501 create a file in the directory, so the &"sticky"& bit must be turned on for
20502 deliveries to be possible, or alternatively the &%group%& option can be used to
20503 run the delivery under a group id which has write access to the directory.
20504
20505
20506
20507 .option file_format appendfile string unset
20508 .cindex "file" "mailbox; checking existing format"
20509 This option requests the transport to check the format of an existing file
20510 before adding to it. The check consists of matching a specific string at the
20511 start of the file. The value of the option consists of an even number of
20512 colon-separated strings. The first of each pair is the test string, and the
20513 second is the name of a transport. If the transport associated with a matched
20514 string is not the current transport, control is passed over to the other
20515 transport. For example, suppose the standard &(local_delivery)& transport has
20516 this added to it:
20517 .code
20518 file_format = "From : local_delivery :\
20519 \1\1\1\1\n : local_mmdf_delivery"
20520 .endd
20521 Mailboxes that begin with &"From"& are still handled by this transport, but if
20522 a mailbox begins with four binary ones followed by a newline, control is passed
20523 to a transport called &%local_mmdf_delivery%&, which presumably is configured
20524 to do the delivery in MMDF format. If a mailbox does not exist or is empty, it
20525 is assumed to match the current transport. If the start of a mailbox doesn't
20526 match any string, or if the transport named for a given string is not defined,
20527 delivery is deferred.
20528
20529
20530 .option file_must_exist appendfile boolean false
20531 If this option is true, the file specified by the &%file%& option must exist.
20532 A temporary error occurs if it does not, causing delivery to be deferred.
20533 If this option is false, the file is created if it does not exist.
20534
20535
20536 .option lock_fcntl_timeout appendfile time 0s
20537 .cindex "timeout" "mailbox locking"
20538 .cindex "mailbox" "locking, blocking and non-blocking"
20539 .cindex "locking files"
20540 By default, the &(appendfile)& transport uses non-blocking calls to &[fcntl()]&
20541 when locking an open mailbox file. If the call fails, the delivery process
20542 sleeps for &%lock_interval%& and tries again, up to &%lock_retries%& times.
20543 Non-blocking calls are used so that the file is not kept open during the wait
20544 for the lock; the reason for this is to make it as safe as possible for
20545 deliveries over NFS in the case when processes might be accessing an NFS
20546 mailbox without using a lock file. This should not be done, but
20547 misunderstandings and hence misconfigurations are not unknown.
20548
20549 On a busy system, however, the performance of a non-blocking lock approach is
20550 not as good as using a blocking lock with a timeout. In this case, the waiting
20551 is done inside the system call, and Exim's delivery process acquires the lock
20552 and can proceed as soon as the previous lock holder releases it.
20553
20554 If &%lock_fcntl_timeout%& is set to a non-zero time, blocking locks, with that
20555 timeout, are used. There may still be some retrying: the maximum number of
20556 retries is
20557 .code
20558 (lock_retries * lock_interval) / lock_fcntl_timeout
20559 .endd
20560 rounded up to the next whole number. In other words, the total time during
20561 which &(appendfile)& is trying to get a lock is roughly the same, unless
20562 &%lock_fcntl_timeout%& is set very large.
20563
20564 You should consider setting this option if you are getting a lot of delayed
20565 local deliveries because of errors of the form
20566 .code
20567 failed to lock mailbox /some/file (fcntl)
20568 .endd
20569
20570 .option lock_flock_timeout appendfile time 0s
20571 This timeout applies to file locking when using &[flock()]& (see
20572 &%use_flock%&); the timeout operates in a similar manner to
20573 &%lock_fcntl_timeout%&.
20574
20575
20576 .option lock_interval appendfile time 3s
20577 This specifies the time to wait between attempts to lock the file. See below
20578 for details of locking.
20579
20580
20581 .option lock_retries appendfile integer 10
20582 This specifies the maximum number of attempts to lock the file. A value of zero
20583 is treated as 1. See below for details of locking.
20584
20585
20586 .option lockfile_mode appendfile "octal integer" 0600
20587 This specifies the mode of the created lock file, when a lock file is being
20588 used (see &%use_lockfile%& and &%use_mbx_lock%&).
20589
20590
20591 .option lockfile_timeout appendfile time 30m
20592 .cindex "timeout" "mailbox locking"
20593 When a lock file is being used (see &%use_lockfile%&), if a lock file already
20594 exists and is older than this value, it is assumed to have been left behind by
20595 accident, and Exim attempts to remove it.
20596
20597
20598 .option mailbox_filecount appendfile string&!! unset
20599 .cindex "mailbox" "specifying size of"
20600 .cindex "size" "of mailbox"
20601 If this option is set, it is expanded, and the result is taken as the current
20602 number of files in the mailbox. It must be a decimal number, optionally
20603 followed by K or M. This provides a way of obtaining this information from an
20604 external source that maintains the data.
20605
20606
20607 .option mailbox_size appendfile string&!! unset
20608 .cindex "mailbox" "specifying size of"
20609 .cindex "size" "of mailbox"
20610 If this option is set, it is expanded, and the result is taken as the current
20611 size the mailbox. It must be a decimal number, optionally followed by K or M.
20612 This provides a way of obtaining this information from an external source that
20613 maintains the data. This is likely to be helpful for maildir deliveries where
20614 it is computationally expensive to compute the size of a mailbox.
20615
20616
20617
20618 .option maildir_format appendfile boolean false
20619 .cindex "maildir format" "specifying"
20620 If this option is set with the &%directory%& option, the delivery is into a new
20621 file, in the &"maildir"& format that is used by other mail software. When the
20622 transport is activated directly from a &(redirect)& router (for example, the
20623 &(address_file)& transport in the default configuration), setting
20624 &%maildir_format%& causes the path received from the router to be treated as a
20625 directory, whether or not it ends with &`/`&. This option is available only if
20626 SUPPORT_MAILDIR is present in &_Local/Makefile_&. See section
20627 &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below for further details.
20628
20629
20630 .option maildir_quota_directory_regex appendfile string "See below"
20631 .cindex "maildir format" "quota; directories included in"
20632 .cindex "quota" "maildir; directories included in"
20633 This option is relevant only when &%maildir_use_size_file%& is set. It defines
20634 a regular expression for specifying directories, relative to the quota
20635 directory (see &%quota_directory%&), that should be included in the quota
20636 calculation. The default value is:
20637 .code
20638 maildir_quota_directory_regex = ^(?:cur|new|\..*)$
20639 .endd
20640 This includes the &_cur_& and &_new_& directories, and any maildir++ folders
20641 (directories whose names begin with a dot). If you want to exclude the
20642 &_Trash_&
20643 folder from the count (as some sites do), you need to change this setting to
20644 .code
20645 maildir_quota_directory_regex = ^(?:cur|new|\.(?!Trash).*)$
20646 .endd
20647 This uses a negative lookahead in the regular expression to exclude the
20648 directory whose name is &_.Trash_&. When a directory is excluded from quota
20649 calculations, quota processing is bypassed for any messages that are delivered
20650 directly into that directory.
20651
20652
20653 .option maildir_retries appendfile integer 10
20654 This option specifies the number of times to retry when writing a file in
20655 &"maildir"& format. See section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below.
20656
20657
20658 .option maildir_tag appendfile string&!! unset
20659 This option applies only to deliveries in maildir format, and is described in
20660 section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below.
20661
20662
20663 .option maildir_use_size_file appendfile&!! boolean false
20664 .cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirsize_& file"
20665 The result of string expansion for this option must be a valid boolean value.
20666 If it is true, it enables support for &_maildirsize_& files. Exim
20667 creates a &_maildirsize_& file in a maildir if one does not exist, taking the
20668 quota from the &%quota%& option of the transport. If &%quota%& is unset, the
20669 value is zero. See &%maildir_quota_directory_regex%& above and section
20670 &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below for further details.
20671
20672 .option maildirfolder_create_regex appendfile string unset
20673 .cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirfolder_& file"
20674 .cindex "&_maildirfolder_&, creating"
20675 The value of this option is a regular expression. If it is unset, it has no
20676 effect. Otherwise, before a maildir delivery takes place, the pattern is
20677 matched against the name of the maildir directory, that is, the directory
20678 containing the &_new_& and &_tmp_& subdirectories that will be used for the
20679 delivery. If there is a match, Exim checks for the existence of a file called
20680 &_maildirfolder_& in the directory, and creates it if it does not exist.
20681 See section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& for more details.
20682
20683
20684 .option mailstore_format appendfile boolean false
20685 .cindex "mailstore format" "specifying"
20686 If this option is set with the &%directory%& option, the delivery is into two
20687 new files in &"mailstore"& format. The option is available only if
20688 SUPPORT_MAILSTORE is present in &_Local/Makefile_&. See section &<<SECTopdir>>&
20689 below for further details.
20690
20691
20692 .option mailstore_prefix appendfile string&!! unset
20693 This option applies only to deliveries in mailstore format, and is described in
20694 section &<<SECTopdir>>& below.
20695
20696
20697 .option mailstore_suffix appendfile string&!! unset
20698 This option applies only to deliveries in mailstore format, and is described in
20699 section &<<SECTopdir>>& below.
20700
20701
20702 .option mbx_format appendfile boolean false
20703 .cindex "locking files"
20704 .cindex "file" "locking"
20705 .cindex "file" "MBX format"
20706 .cindex "MBX format, specifying"
20707 This option is available only if Exim has been compiled with SUPPORT_MBX
20708 set in &_Local/Makefile_&. If &%mbx_format%& is set with the &%file%& option,
20709 the message is appended to the mailbox file in MBX format instead of
20710 traditional Unix format. This format is supported by Pine4 and its associated
20711 IMAP and POP daemons, by means of the &'c-client'& library that they all use.
20712
20713 &*Note*&: The &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options are not
20714 automatically changed by the use of &%mbx_format%&. They should normally be set
20715 empty when using MBX format, so this option almost always appears in this
20716 combination:
20717 .code
20718 mbx_format = true
20719 message_prefix =
20720 message_suffix =
20721 .endd
20722 If none of the locking options are mentioned in the configuration,
20723 &%use_mbx_lock%& is assumed and the other locking options default to false. It
20724 is possible to specify the other kinds of locking with &%mbx_format%&, but
20725 &%use_fcntl_lock%& and &%use_mbx_lock%& are mutually exclusive. MBX locking
20726 interworks with &'c-client'&, providing for shared access to the mailbox. It
20727 should not be used if any program that does not use this form of locking is
20728 going to access the mailbox, nor should it be used if the mailbox file is NFS
20729 mounted, because it works only when the mailbox is accessed from a single host.
20730
20731 If you set &%use_fcntl_lock%& with an MBX-format mailbox, you cannot use
20732 the standard version of &'c-client'&, because as long as it has a mailbox open
20733 (this means for the whole of a Pine or IMAP session), Exim will not be able to
20734 append messages to it.
20735
20736
20737 .option message_prefix appendfile string&!! "see below"
20738 .cindex "&""From""& line"
20739 The string specified here is expanded and output at the start of every message.
20740 The default is unset unless &%file%& is specified and &%use_bsmtp%& is not set,
20741 in which case it is:
20742 .code
20743 message_prefix = "From ${if def:return_path{$return_path}\
20744 {MAILER-DAEMON}} $tod_bsdinbox\n"
20745 .endd
20746 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
20747 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_prefix%&.
20748
20749 .option message_suffix appendfile string&!! "see below"
20750 The string specified here is expanded and output at the end of every message.
20751 The default is unset unless &%file%& is specified and &%use_bsmtp%& is not set,
20752 in which case it is a single newline character. The suffix can be suppressed by
20753 setting
20754 .code
20755 message_suffix =
20756 .endd
20757 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
20758 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_suffix%&.
20759
20760 .option mode appendfile "octal integer" 0600
20761 If the output file is created, it is given this mode. If it already exists and
20762 has wider permissions, they are reduced to this mode. If it has narrower
20763 permissions, an error occurs unless &%mode_fail_narrower%& is false. However,
20764 if the delivery is the result of a &%save%& command in a filter file specifying
20765 a particular mode, the mode of the output file is always forced to take that
20766 value, and this option is ignored.
20767
20768
20769 .option mode_fail_narrower appendfile boolean true
20770 This option applies in the case when an existing mailbox file has a narrower
20771 mode than that specified by the &%mode%& option. If &%mode_fail_narrower%& is
20772 true, the delivery is deferred (&"mailbox has the wrong mode"&); otherwise Exim
20773 continues with the delivery attempt, using the existing mode of the file.
20774
20775
20776 .option notify_comsat appendfile boolean false
20777 If this option is true, the &'comsat'& daemon is notified after every
20778 successful delivery to a user mailbox. This is the daemon that notifies logged
20779 on users about incoming mail.
20780
20781
20782 .option quota appendfile string&!! unset
20783 .cindex "quota" "imposed by Exim"
20784 This option imposes a limit on the size of the file to which Exim is appending,
20785 or to the total space used in the directory tree when the &%directory%& option
20786 is set. In the latter case, computation of the space used is expensive, because
20787 all the files in the directory (and any sub-directories) have to be
20788 individually inspected and their sizes summed. (See &%quota_size_regex%& and
20789 &%maildir_use_size_file%& for ways to avoid this in environments where users
20790 have no shell access to their mailboxes).
20791
20792 As there is no interlock against two simultaneous deliveries into a
20793 multi-file mailbox, it is possible for the quota to be overrun in this case.
20794 For single-file mailboxes, of course, an interlock is a necessity.
20795
20796 A file's size is taken as its &'used'& value. Because of blocking effects, this
20797 may be a lot less than the actual amount of disk space allocated to the file.
20798 If the sizes of a number of files are being added up, the rounding effect can
20799 become quite noticeable, especially on systems that have large block sizes.
20800 Nevertheless, it seems best to stick to the &'used'& figure, because this is
20801 the obvious value which users understand most easily.
20802
20803 The value of the option is expanded, and must then be a numerical value
20804 (decimal point allowed), optionally followed by one of the letters K, M, or G,
20805 for kilobytes, megabytes, or gigabytes. If Exim is running on a system with
20806 large file support (Linux and FreeBSD have this), mailboxes larger than 2G can
20807 be handled.
20808
20809 &*Note*&: A value of zero is interpreted as &"no quota"&.
20810
20811 The expansion happens while Exim is running as root, before it changes uid for
20812 the delivery. This means that files that are inaccessible to the end user can
20813 be used to hold quota values that are looked up in the expansion. When delivery
20814 fails because this quota is exceeded, the handling of the error is as for
20815 system quota failures.
20816
20817 By default, Exim's quota checking mimics system quotas, and restricts the
20818 mailbox to the specified maximum size, though the value is not accurate to the
20819 last byte, owing to separator lines and additional headers that may get added
20820 during message delivery. When a mailbox is nearly full, large messages may get
20821 refused even though small ones are accepted, because the size of the current
20822 message is added to the quota when the check is made. This behaviour can be
20823 changed by setting &%quota_is_inclusive%& false. When this is done, the check
20824 for exceeding the quota does not include the current message. Thus, deliveries
20825 continue until the quota has been exceeded; thereafter, no further messages are
20826 delivered. See also &%quota_warn_threshold%&.
20827
20828
20829 .option quota_directory appendfile string&!! unset
20830 This option defines the directory to check for quota purposes when delivering
20831 into individual files. The default is the delivery directory, or, if a file
20832 called &_maildirfolder_& exists in a maildir directory, the parent of the
20833 delivery directory.
20834
20835
20836 .option quota_filecount appendfile string&!! 0
20837 This option applies when the &%directory%& option is set. It limits the total
20838 number of files in the directory (compare the inode limit in system quotas). It
20839 can only be used if &%quota%& is also set. The value is expanded; an expansion
20840 failure causes delivery to be deferred. A value of zero is interpreted as
20841 &"no quota"&.
20842
20843
20844 .option quota_is_inclusive appendfile boolean true
20845 See &%quota%& above.
20846
20847
20848 .option quota_size_regex appendfile string unset
20849 This option applies when one of the delivery modes that writes a separate file
20850 for each message is being used. When Exim wants to find the size of one of
20851 these files in order to test the quota, it first checks &%quota_size_regex%&.
20852 If this is set to a regular expression that matches the file name, and it
20853 captures one string, that string is interpreted as a representation of the
20854 file's size. The value of &%quota_size_regex%& is not expanded.
20855
20856 This feature is useful only when users have no shell access to their mailboxes
20857 &-- otherwise they could defeat the quota simply by renaming the files. This
20858 facility can be used with maildir deliveries, by setting &%maildir_tag%& to add
20859 the file length to the file name. For example:
20860 .code
20861 maildir_tag = ,S=$message_size
20862 quota_size_regex = ,S=(\d+)
20863 .endd
20864 An alternative to &$message_size$& is &$message_linecount$&, which contains the
20865 number of lines in the message.
20866
20867 The regular expression should not assume that the length is at the end of the
20868 file name (even though &%maildir_tag%& puts it there) because maildir MUAs
20869 sometimes add other information onto the ends of message file names.
20870
20871 Section &<<SECID136>>& contains further information.
20872
20873
20874 .option quota_warn_message appendfile string&!! "see below"
20875 See below for the use of this option. If it is not set when
20876 &%quota_warn_threshold%& is set, it defaults to
20877 .code
20878 quota_warn_message = "\
20879 To: $local_part@$domain\n\
20880 Subject: Your mailbox\n\n\
20881 This message is automatically created \
20882 by mail delivery software.\n\n\
20883 The size of your mailbox has exceeded \
20884 a warning threshold that is\n\
20885 set by the system administrator.\n"
20886 .endd
20887
20888
20889 .option quota_warn_threshold appendfile string&!! 0
20890 .cindex "quota" "warning threshold"
20891 .cindex "mailbox" "size warning"
20892 .cindex "size" "of mailbox"
20893 This option is expanded in the same way as &%quota%& (see above). If the
20894 resulting value is greater than zero, and delivery of the message causes the
20895 size of the file or total space in the directory tree to cross the given
20896 threshold, a warning message is sent. If &%quota%& is also set, the threshold
20897 may be specified as a percentage of it by following the value with a percent
20898 sign. For example:
20899 .code
20900 quota = 10M
20901 quota_warn_threshold = 75%
20902 .endd
20903 If &%quota%& is not set, a setting of &%quota_warn_threshold%& that ends with a
20904 percent sign is ignored.
20905
20906 The warning message itself is specified by the &%quota_warn_message%& option,
20907 and it must start with a &'To:'& header line containing the recipient(s) of the
20908 warning message. These do not necessarily have to include the recipient(s) of
20909 the original message. A &'Subject:'& line should also normally be supplied. You
20910 can include any other header lines that you want. If you do not include a
20911 &'From:'& line, the default is:
20912 .code
20913 From: Mail Delivery System <mailer-daemon@$qualify_domain_sender>
20914 .endd
20915 .oindex &%errors_reply_to%&
20916 If you supply a &'Reply-To:'& line, it overrides the global &%errors_reply_to%&
20917 option.
20918
20919 The &%quota%& option does not have to be set in order to use this option; they
20920 are independent of one another except when the threshold is specified as a
20921 percentage.
20922
20923
20924 .option use_bsmtp appendfile boolean false
20925 .cindex "envelope sender"
20926 If this option is set true, &(appendfile)& writes messages in &"batch SMTP"&
20927 format, with the envelope sender and recipient(s) included as SMTP commands. If
20928 you want to include a leading HELO command with such messages, you can do
20929 so by setting the &%message_prefix%& option. See section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&
20930 for details of batch SMTP.
20931
20932
20933 .option use_crlf appendfile boolean false
20934 .cindex "carriage return"
20935 .cindex "linefeed"
20936 This option causes lines to be terminated with the two-character CRLF sequence
20937 (carriage return, linefeed) instead of just a linefeed character. In the case
20938 of batched SMTP, the byte sequence written to the file is then an exact image
20939 of what would be sent down a real SMTP connection.
20940
20941 &*Note:*& The contents of the &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options
20942 (which are used to supply the traditional &"From&~"& and blank line separators
20943 in Berkeley-style mailboxes) are written verbatim, so must contain their own
20944 carriage return characters if these are needed. In cases where these options
20945 have non-empty defaults, the values end with a single linefeed, so they must be
20946 changed to end with &`\r\n`& if &%use_crlf%& is set.
20947
20948
20949 .option use_fcntl_lock appendfile boolean "see below"
20950 This option controls the use of the &[fcntl()]& function to lock a file for
20951 exclusive use when a message is being appended. It is set by default unless
20952 &%use_flock_lock%& is set. Otherwise, it should be turned off only if you know
20953 that all your MUAs use lock file locking. When both &%use_fcntl_lock%& and
20954 &%use_flock_lock%& are unset, &%use_lockfile%& must be set.
20955
20956
20957 .option use_flock_lock appendfile boolean false
20958 This option is provided to support the use of &[flock()]& for file locking, for
20959 the few situations where it is needed. Most modern operating systems support
20960 &[fcntl()]& and &[lockf()]& locking, and these two functions interwork with
20961 each other. Exim uses &[fcntl()]& locking by default.
20962
20963 This option is required only if you are using an operating system where
20964 &[flock()]& is used by programs that access mailboxes (typically MUAs), and
20965 where &[flock()]& does not correctly interwork with &[fcntl()]&. You can use
20966 both &[fcntl()]& and &[flock()]& locking simultaneously if you want.
20967
20968 .cindex "Solaris" "&[flock()]& support"
20969 Not all operating systems provide &[flock()]&. Some versions of Solaris do not
20970 have it (and some, I think, provide a not quite right version built on top of
20971 &[lockf()]&). If the OS does not have &[flock()]&, Exim will be built without
20972 the ability to use it, and any attempt to do so will cause a configuration
20973 error.
20974
20975 &*Warning*&: &[flock()]& locks do not work on NFS files (unless &[flock()]&
20976 is just being mapped onto &[fcntl()]& by the OS).
20977
20978
20979 .option use_lockfile appendfile boolean "see below"
20980 If this option is turned off, Exim does not attempt to create a lock file when
20981 appending to a mailbox file. In this situation, the only locking is by
20982 &[fcntl()]&. You should only turn &%use_lockfile%& off if you are absolutely
20983 sure that every MUA that is ever going to look at your users' mailboxes uses
20984 &[fcntl()]& rather than a lock file, and even then only when you are not
20985 delivering over NFS from more than one host.
20986
20987 .cindex "NFS" "lock file"
20988 In order to append to an NFS file safely from more than one host, it is
20989 necessary to take out a lock &'before'& opening the file, and the lock file
20990 achieves this. Otherwise, even with &[fcntl()]& locking, there is a risk of
20991 file corruption.
20992
20993 The &%use_lockfile%& option is set by default unless &%use_mbx_lock%& is set.
20994 It is not possible to turn both &%use_lockfile%& and &%use_fcntl_lock%& off,
20995 except when &%mbx_format%& is set.
20996
20997
20998 .option use_mbx_lock appendfile boolean "see below"
20999 This option is available only if Exim has been compiled with SUPPORT_MBX
21000 set in &_Local/Makefile_&. Setting the option specifies that special MBX
21001 locking rules be used. It is set by default if &%mbx_format%& is set and none
21002 of the locking options are mentioned in the configuration. The locking rules
21003 are the same as are used by the &'c-client'& library that underlies Pine and
21004 the IMAP4 and POP daemons that come with it (see the discussion below). The
21005 rules allow for shared access to the mailbox. However, this kind of locking
21006 does not work when the mailbox is NFS mounted.
21007
21008 You can set &%use_mbx_lock%& with either (or both) of &%use_fcntl_lock%& and
21009 &%use_flock_lock%& to control what kind of locking is used in implementing the
21010 MBX locking rules. The default is to use &[fcntl()]& if &%use_mbx_lock%& is set
21011 without &%use_fcntl_lock%& or &%use_flock_lock%&.
21012
21013
21014
21015
21016 .section "Operational details for appending" "SECTopappend"
21017 .cindex "appending to a file"
21018 .cindex "file" "appending"
21019 Before appending to a file, the following preparations are made:
21020
21021 .ilist
21022 If the name of the file is &_/dev/null_&, no action is taken, and a success
21023 return is given.
21024
21025 .next
21026 .cindex "directory creation"
21027 If any directories on the file's path are missing, Exim creates them if the
21028 &%create_directory%& option is set. A created directory's mode is given by the
21029 &%directory_mode%& option.
21030
21031 .next
21032 If &%file_format%& is set, the format of an existing file is checked. If this
21033 indicates that a different transport should be used, control is passed to that
21034 transport.
21035
21036 .next
21037 .cindex "file" "locking"
21038 .cindex "locking files"
21039 .cindex "NFS" "lock file"
21040 If &%use_lockfile%& is set, a lock file is built in a way that will work
21041 reliably over NFS, as follows:
21042
21043 .olist
21044 Create a &"hitching post"& file whose name is that of the lock file with the
21045 current time, primary host name, and process id added, by opening for writing
21046 as a new file. If this fails with an access error, delivery is deferred.
21047 .next
21048 Close the hitching post file, and hard link it to the lock file name.
21049 .next
21050 If the call to &[link()]& succeeds, creation of the lock file has succeeded.
21051 Unlink the hitching post name.
21052 .next
21053 Otherwise, use &[stat()]& to get information about the hitching post file, and
21054 then unlink hitching post name. If the number of links is exactly two, creation
21055 of the lock file succeeded but something (for example, an NFS server crash and
21056 restart) caused this fact not to be communicated to the &[link()]& call.
21057 .next
21058 If creation of the lock file failed, wait for &%lock_interval%& and try again,
21059 up to &%lock_retries%& times. However, since any program that writes to a
21060 mailbox should complete its task very quickly, it is reasonable to time out old
21061 lock files that are normally the result of user agent and system crashes. If an
21062 existing lock file is older than &%lockfile_timeout%& Exim attempts to unlink
21063 it before trying again.
21064 .endlist olist
21065
21066 .next
21067 A call is made to &[lstat()]& to discover whether the main file exists, and if
21068 so, what its characteristics are. If &[lstat()]& fails for any reason other
21069 than non-existence, delivery is deferred.
21070
21071 .next
21072 .cindex "symbolic link" "to mailbox"
21073 .cindex "mailbox" "symbolic link"
21074 If the file does exist and is a symbolic link, delivery is deferred, unless the
21075 &%allow_symlink%& option is set, in which case the ownership of the link is
21076 checked, and then &[stat()]& is called to find out about the real file, which
21077 is then subjected to the checks below. The check on the top-level link
21078 ownership prevents one user creating a link for another's mailbox in a sticky
21079 directory, though allowing symbolic links in this case is definitely not a good
21080 idea. If there is a chain of symbolic links, the intermediate ones are not
21081 checked.
21082
21083 .next
21084 If the file already exists but is not a regular file, or if the file's owner
21085 and group (if the group is being checked &-- see &%check_group%& above) are
21086 different from the user and group under which the delivery is running,
21087 delivery is deferred.
21088
21089 .next
21090 If the file's permissions are more generous than specified, they are reduced.
21091 If they are insufficient, delivery is deferred, unless &%mode_fail_narrower%&
21092 is set false, in which case the delivery is tried using the existing
21093 permissions.
21094
21095 .next
21096 The file's inode number is saved, and the file is then opened for appending.
21097 If this fails because the file has vanished, &(appendfile)& behaves as if it
21098 hadn't existed (see below). For any other failures, delivery is deferred.
21099
21100 .next
21101 If the file is opened successfully, check that the inode number hasn't
21102 changed, that it is still a regular file, and that the owner and permissions
21103 have not changed. If anything is wrong, defer delivery and freeze the message.
21104
21105 .next
21106 If the file did not exist originally, defer delivery if the &%file_must_exist%&
21107 option is set. Otherwise, check that the file is being created in a permitted
21108 directory if the &%create_file%& option is set (deferring on failure), and then
21109 open for writing as a new file, with the O_EXCL and O_CREAT options,
21110 except when dealing with a symbolic link (the &%allow_symlink%& option must be
21111 set). In this case, which can happen if the link points to a non-existent file,
21112 the file is opened for writing using O_CREAT but not O_EXCL, because
21113 that prevents link following.
21114
21115 .next
21116 .cindex "loop" "while file testing"
21117 If opening fails because the file exists, obey the tests given above for
21118 existing files. However, to avoid looping in a situation where the file is
21119 being continuously created and destroyed, the exists/not-exists loop is broken
21120 after 10 repetitions, and the message is then frozen.
21121
21122 .next
21123 If opening fails with any other error, defer delivery.
21124
21125 .next
21126 .cindex "file" "locking"
21127 .cindex "locking files"
21128 Once the file is open, unless both &%use_fcntl_lock%& and &%use_flock_lock%&
21129 are false, it is locked using &[fcntl()]& or &[flock()]& or both. If
21130 &%use_mbx_lock%& is false, an exclusive lock is requested in each case.
21131 However, if &%use_mbx_lock%& is true, Exim takes out a shared lock on the open
21132 file, and an exclusive lock on the file whose name is
21133 .code
21134 /tmp/.<device-number>.<inode-number>
21135 .endd
21136 using the device and inode numbers of the open mailbox file, in accordance with
21137 the MBX locking rules. This file is created with a mode that is specified by
21138 the &%lockfile_mode%& option.
21139
21140 If Exim fails to lock the file, there are two possible courses of action,
21141 depending on the value of the locking timeout. This is obtained from
21142 &%lock_fcntl_timeout%& or &%lock_flock_timeout%&, as appropriate.
21143
21144 If the timeout value is zero, the file is closed, Exim waits for
21145 &%lock_interval%&, and then goes back and re-opens the file as above and tries
21146 to lock it again. This happens up to &%lock_retries%& times, after which the
21147 delivery is deferred.
21148
21149 If the timeout has a value greater than zero, blocking calls to &[fcntl()]& or
21150 &[flock()]& are used (with the given timeout), so there has already been some
21151 waiting involved by the time locking fails. Nevertheless, Exim does not give up
21152 immediately. It retries up to
21153 .code
21154 (lock_retries * lock_interval) / <timeout>
21155 .endd
21156 times (rounded up).
21157 .endlist
21158
21159 At the end of delivery, Exim closes the file (which releases the &[fcntl()]&
21160 and/or &[flock()]& locks) and then deletes the lock file if one was created.
21161
21162
21163 .section "Operational details for delivery to a new file" "SECTopdir"
21164 .cindex "delivery" "to single file"
21165 .cindex "&""From""& line"
21166 When the &%directory%& option is set instead of &%file%&, each message is
21167 delivered into a newly-created file or set of files. When &(appendfile)& is
21168 activated directly from a &(redirect)& router, neither &%file%& nor
21169 &%directory%& is normally set, because the path for delivery is supplied by the
21170 router. (See for example, the &(address_file)& transport in the default
21171 configuration.) In this case, delivery is to a new file if either the path name
21172 ends in &`/`&, or the &%maildir_format%& or &%mailstore_format%& option is set.
21173
21174 No locking is required while writing the message to a new file, so the various
21175 locking options of the transport are ignored. The &"From"& line that by default
21176 separates messages in a single file is not normally needed, nor is the escaping
21177 of message lines that start with &"From"&, and there is no need to ensure a
21178 newline at the end of each message. Consequently, the default values for
21179 &%check_string%&, &%message_prefix%&, and &%message_suffix%& are all unset when
21180 any of &%directory%&, &%maildir_format%&, or &%mailstore_format%& is set.
21181
21182 If Exim is required to check a &%quota%& setting, it adds up the sizes of all
21183 the files in the delivery directory by default. However, you can specify a
21184 different directory by setting &%quota_directory%&. Also, for maildir
21185 deliveries (see below) the &_maildirfolder_& convention is honoured.
21186
21187
21188 .cindex "maildir format"
21189 .cindex "mailstore format"
21190 There are three different ways in which delivery to individual files can be
21191 done, controlled by the settings of the &%maildir_format%& and
21192 &%mailstore_format%& options. Note that code to support maildir or mailstore
21193 formats is not included in the binary unless SUPPORT_MAILDIR or
21194 SUPPORT_MAILSTORE, respectively, is set in &_Local/Makefile_&.
21195
21196 .cindex "directory creation"
21197 In all three cases an attempt is made to create the directory and any necessary
21198 sub-directories if they do not exist, provided that the &%create_directory%&
21199 option is set (the default). The location of a created directory can be
21200 constrained by setting &%create_file%&. A created directory's mode is given by
21201 the &%directory_mode%& option. If creation fails, or if the
21202 &%create_directory%& option is not set when creation is required, delivery is
21203 deferred.
21204
21205
21206
21207 .section "Maildir delivery" "SECTmaildirdelivery"
21208 .cindex "maildir format" "description of"
21209 If the &%maildir_format%& option is true, Exim delivers each message by writing
21210 it to a file whose name is &_tmp/<stime>.H<mtime>P<pid>.<host>_& in the
21211 directory that is defined by the &%directory%& option (the &"delivery
21212 directory"&). If the delivery is successful, the file is renamed into the
21213 &_new_& subdirectory.
21214
21215 In the file name, <&'stime'&> is the current time of day in seconds, and
21216 <&'mtime'&> is the microsecond fraction of the time. After a maildir delivery,
21217 Exim checks that the time-of-day clock has moved on by at least one microsecond
21218 before terminating the delivery process. This guarantees uniqueness for the
21219 file name. However, as a precaution, Exim calls &[stat()]& for the file before
21220 opening it. If any response other than ENOENT (does not exist) is given,
21221 Exim waits 2 seconds and tries again, up to &%maildir_retries%& times.
21222
21223 Before Exim carries out a maildir delivery, it ensures that subdirectories
21224 called &_new_&, &_cur_&, and &_tmp_& exist in the delivery directory. If they
21225 do not exist, Exim tries to create them and any superior directories in their
21226 path, subject to the &%create_directory%& and &%create_file%& options. If the
21227 &%maildirfolder_create_regex%& option is set, and the regular expression it
21228 contains matches the delivery directory, Exim also ensures that a file called
21229 &_maildirfolder_& exists in the delivery directory. If a missing directory or
21230 &_maildirfolder_& file cannot be created, delivery is deferred.
21231
21232 These features make it possible to use Exim to create all the necessary files
21233 and directories in a maildir mailbox, including subdirectories for maildir++
21234 folders. Consider this example:
21235 .code
21236 maildir_format = true
21237 directory = /var/mail/$local_part\
21238 ${if eq{$local_part_suffix}{}{}\
21239 {/.${substr_1:$local_part_suffix}}}
21240 maildirfolder_create_regex = /\.[^/]+$
21241 .endd
21242 If &$local_part_suffix$& is empty (there was no suffix for the local part),
21243 delivery is into a toplevel maildir with a name like &_/var/mail/pimbo_& (for
21244 the user called &'pimbo'&). The pattern in &%maildirfolder_create_regex%& does
21245 not match this name, so Exim will not look for or create the file
21246 &_/var/mail/pimbo/maildirfolder_&, though it will create
21247 &_/var/mail/pimbo/{cur,new,tmp}_& if necessary.
21248
21249 However, if &$local_part_suffix$& contains &`-eximusers`& (for example),
21250 delivery is into the maildir++ folder &_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers_&, which
21251 does match &%maildirfolder_create_regex%&. In this case, Exim will create
21252 &_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers/maildirfolder_& as well as the three maildir
21253 directories &_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers/{cur,new,tmp}_&.
21254
21255 &*Warning:*& Take care when setting &%maildirfolder_create_regex%& that it does
21256 not inadvertently match the toplevel maildir directory, because a
21257 &_maildirfolder_& file at top level would completely break quota calculations.
21258
21259 .cindex "quota" "in maildir delivery"
21260 .cindex "maildir++"
21261 If Exim is required to check a &%quota%& setting before a maildir delivery, and
21262 &%quota_directory%& is not set, it looks for a file called &_maildirfolder_& in
21263 the maildir directory (alongside &_new_&, &_cur_&, &_tmp_&). If this exists,
21264 Exim assumes the directory is a maildir++ folder directory, which is one level
21265 down from the user's top level mailbox directory. This causes it to start at
21266 the parent directory instead of the current directory when calculating the
21267 amount of space used.
21268
21269 One problem with delivering into a multi-file mailbox is that it is
21270 computationally expensive to compute the size of the mailbox for quota
21271 checking. Various approaches have been taken to reduce the amount of work
21272 needed. The next two sections describe two of them. A third alternative is to
21273 use some external process for maintaining the size data, and use the expansion
21274 of the &%mailbox_size%& option as a way of importing it into Exim.
21275
21276
21277
21278
21279 .section "Using tags to record message sizes" "SECID135"
21280 If &%maildir_tag%& is set, the string is expanded for each delivery.
21281 When the maildir file is renamed into the &_new_& sub-directory, the
21282 tag is added to its name. However, if adding the tag takes the length of the
21283 name to the point where the test &[stat()]& call fails with ENAMETOOLONG,
21284 the tag is dropped and the maildir file is created with no tag.
21285
21286
21287 .vindex "&$message_size$&"
21288 Tags can be used to encode the size of files in their names; see
21289 &%quota_size_regex%& above for an example. The expansion of &%maildir_tag%&
21290 happens after the message has been written. The value of the &$message_size$&
21291 variable is set to the number of bytes actually written. If the expansion is
21292 forced to fail, the tag is ignored, but a non-forced failure causes delivery to
21293 be deferred. The expanded tag may contain any printing characters except &"/"&.
21294 Non-printing characters in the string are ignored; if the resulting string is
21295 empty, it is ignored. If it starts with an alphanumeric character, a leading
21296 colon is inserted; this default has not proven to be the path that popular
21297 maildir implementations have chosen (but changing it in Exim would break
21298 backwards compatibility).
21299
21300 For one common implementation, you might set:
21301 .code
21302 maildir_tag = ,S=${message_size}
21303 .endd
21304 but you should check the documentation of the other software to be sure.
21305
21306 It is advisable to also set &%quota_size_regex%& when setting &%maildir_tag%&
21307 as this allows Exim to extract the size from your tag, instead of having to
21308 &[stat()]& each message file.
21309
21310
21311 .section "Using a maildirsize file" "SECID136"
21312 .cindex "quota" "in maildir delivery"
21313 .cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirsize_& file"
21314 If &%maildir_use_size_file%& is true, Exim implements the maildir++ rules for
21315 storing quota and message size information in a file called &_maildirsize_&
21316 within the toplevel maildir directory. If this file does not exist, Exim
21317 creates it, setting the quota from the &%quota%& option of the transport. If
21318 the maildir directory itself does not exist, it is created before any attempt
21319 to write a &_maildirsize_& file.
21320
21321 The &_maildirsize_& file is used to hold information about the sizes of
21322 messages in the maildir, thus speeding up quota calculations. The quota value
21323 in the file is just a cache; if the quota is changed in the transport, the new
21324 value overrides the cached value when the next message is delivered. The cache
21325 is maintained for the benefit of other programs that access the maildir and
21326 need to know the quota.
21327
21328 If the &%quota%& option in the transport is unset or zero, the &_maildirsize_&
21329 file is maintained (with a zero quota setting), but no quota is imposed.
21330
21331 A regular expression is available for controlling which directories in the
21332 maildir participate in quota calculations when a &_maildirsizefile_& is in use.
21333 See the description of the &%maildir_quota_directory_regex%& option above for
21334 details.
21335
21336
21337 .section "Mailstore delivery" "SECID137"
21338 .cindex "mailstore format" "description of"
21339 If the &%mailstore_format%& option is true, each message is written as two
21340 files in the given directory. A unique base name is constructed from the
21341 message id and the current delivery process, and the files that are written use
21342 this base name plus the suffixes &_.env_& and &_.msg_&. The &_.env_& file
21343 contains the message's envelope, and the &_.msg_& file contains the message
21344 itself. The base name is placed in the variable &$mailstore_basename$&.
21345
21346 During delivery, the envelope is first written to a file with the suffix
21347 &_.tmp_&. The &_.msg_& file is then written, and when it is complete, the
21348 &_.tmp_& file is renamed as the &_.env_& file. Programs that access messages in
21349 mailstore format should wait for the presence of both a &_.msg_& and a &_.env_&
21350 file before accessing either of them. An alternative approach is to wait for
21351 the absence of a &_.tmp_& file.
21352
21353 The envelope file starts with any text defined by the &%mailstore_prefix%&
21354 option, expanded and terminated by a newline if there isn't one. Then follows
21355 the sender address on one line, then all the recipient addresses, one per line.
21356 There can be more than one recipient only if the &%batch_max%& option is set
21357 greater than one. Finally, &%mailstore_suffix%& is expanded and the result
21358 appended to the file, followed by a newline if it does not end with one.
21359
21360 If expansion of &%mailstore_prefix%& or &%mailstore_suffix%& ends with a forced
21361 failure, it is ignored. Other expansion errors are treated as serious
21362 configuration errors, and delivery is deferred. The variable
21363 &$mailstore_basename$& is available for use during these expansions.
21364
21365
21366 .section "Non-special new file delivery" "SECID138"
21367 If neither &%maildir_format%& nor &%mailstore_format%& is set, a single new
21368 file is created directly in the named directory. For example, when delivering
21369 messages into files in batched SMTP format for later delivery to some host (see
21370 section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&), a setting such as
21371 .code
21372 directory = /var/bsmtp/$host
21373 .endd
21374 might be used. A message is written to a file with a temporary name, which is
21375 then renamed when the delivery is complete. The final name is obtained by
21376 expanding the contents of the &%directory_file%& option.
21377 .ecindex IIDapptra1
21378 .ecindex IIDapptra2
21379
21380
21381
21382
21383
21384
21385 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21386 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21387
21388 .chapter "The autoreply transport" "CHID8"
21389 .scindex IIDauttra1 "transports" "&(autoreply)&"
21390 .scindex IIDauttra2 "&(autoreply)& transport"
21391 The &(autoreply)& transport is not a true transport in that it does not cause
21392 the message to be transmitted. Instead, it generates a new mail message as an
21393 automatic reply to the incoming message. &'References:'& and
21394 &'Auto-Submitted:'& header lines are included. These are constructed according
21395 to the rules in RFCs 2822 and 3834, respectively.
21396
21397 If the router that passes the message to this transport does not have the
21398 &%unseen%& option set, the original message (for the current recipient) is not
21399 delivered anywhere. However, when the &%unseen%& option is set on the router
21400 that passes the message to this transport, routing of the address continues, so
21401 another router can set up a normal message delivery.
21402
21403
21404 The &(autoreply)& transport is usually run as the result of mail filtering, a
21405 &"vacation"& message being the standard example. However, it can also be run
21406 directly from a router like any other transport. To reduce the possibility of
21407 message cascades, messages created by the &(autoreply)& transport always have
21408 empty envelope sender addresses, like bounce messages.
21409
21410 The parameters of the message to be sent can be specified in the configuration
21411 by options described below. However, these are used only when the address
21412 passed to the transport does not contain its own reply information. When the
21413 transport is run as a consequence of a
21414 &%mail%&
21415 or &%vacation%& command in a filter file, the parameters of the message are
21416 supplied by the filter, and passed with the address. The transport's options
21417 that define the message are then ignored (so they are not usually set in this
21418 case). The message is specified entirely by the filter or by the transport; it
21419 is never built from a mixture of options. However, the &%file_optional%&,
21420 &%mode%&, and &%return_message%& options apply in all cases.
21421
21422 &(Autoreply)& is implemented as a local transport. When used as a result of a
21423 command in a user's filter file, &(autoreply)& normally runs under the uid and
21424 gid of the user, and with appropriate current and home directories (see chapter
21425 &<<CHAPenvironment>>&).
21426
21427 There is a subtle difference between routing a message to a &(pipe)& transport
21428 that generates some text to be returned to the sender, and routing it to an
21429 &(autoreply)& transport. This difference is noticeable only if more than one
21430 address from the same message is so handled. In the case of a pipe, the
21431 separate outputs from the different addresses are gathered up and returned to
21432 the sender in a single message, whereas if &(autoreply)& is used, a separate
21433 message is generated for each address that is passed to it.
21434
21435 Non-printing characters are not permitted in the header lines generated for the
21436 message that &(autoreply)& creates, with the exception of newlines that are
21437 immediately followed by white space. If any non-printing characters are found,
21438 the transport defers.
21439 Whether characters with the top bit set count as printing characters or not is
21440 controlled by the &%print_topbitchars%& global option.
21441
21442 If any of the generic options for manipulating headers (for example,
21443 &%headers_add%&) are set on an &(autoreply)& transport, they apply to the copy
21444 of the original message that is included in the generated message when
21445 &%return_message%& is set. They do not apply to the generated message itself.
21446
21447 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
21448 If the &(autoreply)& transport receives return code 2 from Exim when it submits
21449 the message, indicating that there were no recipients, it does not treat this
21450 as an error. This means that autoreplies sent to &$sender_address$& when this
21451 is empty (because the incoming message is a bounce message) do not cause
21452 problems. They are just discarded.
21453
21454
21455
21456 .section "Private options for autoreply" "SECID139"
21457 .cindex "options" "&(autoreply)& transport"
21458
21459 .option bcc autoreply string&!! unset
21460 This specifies the addresses that are to receive &"blind carbon copies"& of the
21461 message when the message is specified by the transport.
21462
21463
21464 .option cc autoreply string&!! unset
21465 This specifies recipients of the message and the contents of the &'Cc:'& header
21466 when the message is specified by the transport.
21467
21468
21469 .option file autoreply string&!! unset
21470 The contents of the file are sent as the body of the message when the message
21471 is specified by the transport. If both &%file%& and &%text%& are set, the text
21472 string comes first.
21473
21474
21475 .option file_expand autoreply boolean false
21476 If this is set, the contents of the file named by the &%file%& option are
21477 subjected to string expansion as they are added to the message.
21478
21479
21480 .option file_optional autoreply boolean false
21481 If this option is true, no error is generated if the file named by the &%file%&
21482 option or passed with the address does not exist or cannot be read.
21483
21484
21485 .option from autoreply string&!! unset
21486 This specifies the contents of the &'From:'& header when the message is
21487 specified by the transport.
21488
21489
21490 .option headers autoreply string&!! unset
21491 This specifies additional RFC 2822 headers that are to be added to the message
21492 when the message is specified by the transport. Several can be given by using
21493 &"\n"& to separate them. There is no check on the format.
21494
21495
21496 .option log autoreply string&!! unset
21497 This option names a file in which a record of every message sent is logged when
21498 the message is specified by the transport.
21499
21500
21501 .option mode autoreply "octal integer" 0600
21502 If either the log file or the &"once"& file has to be created, this mode is
21503 used.
21504
21505
21506 .option never_mail autoreply "address list&!!" unset
21507 If any run of the transport creates a message with a recipient that matches any
21508 item in the list, that recipient is quietly discarded. If all recipients are
21509 discarded, no message is created. This applies both when the recipients are
21510 generated by a filter and when they are specified in the transport.
21511
21512
21513
21514 .option once autoreply string&!! unset
21515 This option names a file or DBM database in which a record of each &'To:'&
21516 recipient is kept when the message is specified by the transport. &*Note*&:
21517 This does not apply to &'Cc:'& or &'Bcc:'& recipients.
21518
21519 If &%once%& is unset, or is set to an empty string, the message is always sent.
21520 By default, if &%once%& is set to a non-empty file name, the message
21521 is not sent if a potential recipient is already listed in the database.
21522 However, if the &%once_repeat%& option specifies a time greater than zero, the
21523 message is sent if that much time has elapsed since a message was last sent to
21524 this recipient. A setting of zero time for &%once_repeat%& (the default)
21525 prevents a message from being sent a second time &-- in this case, zero means
21526 infinity.
21527
21528 If &%once_file_size%& is zero, a DBM database is used to remember recipients,
21529 and it is allowed to grow as large as necessary. If &%once_file_size%& is set
21530 greater than zero, it changes the way Exim implements the &%once%& option.
21531 Instead of using a DBM file to record every recipient it sends to, it uses a
21532 regular file, whose size will never get larger than the given value.
21533
21534 In the file, Exim keeps a linear list of recipient addresses and the times at
21535 which they were sent messages. If the file is full when a new address needs to
21536 be added, the oldest address is dropped. If &%once_repeat%& is not set, this
21537 means that a given recipient may receive multiple messages, but at
21538 unpredictable intervals that depend on the rate of turnover of addresses in the
21539 file. If &%once_repeat%& is set, it specifies a maximum time between repeats.
21540
21541
21542 .option once_file_size autoreply integer 0
21543 See &%once%& above.
21544
21545
21546 .option once_repeat autoreply time&!! 0s
21547 See &%once%& above.
21548 After expansion, the value of this option must be a valid time value.
21549
21550
21551 .option reply_to autoreply string&!! unset
21552 This specifies the contents of the &'Reply-To:'& header when the message is
21553 specified by the transport.
21554
21555
21556 .option return_message autoreply boolean false
21557 If this is set, a copy of the original message is returned with the new
21558 message, subject to the maximum size set in the &%return_size_limit%& global
21559 configuration option.
21560
21561
21562 .option subject autoreply string&!! unset
21563 This specifies the contents of the &'Subject:'& header when the message is
21564 specified by the transport. It is tempting to quote the original subject in
21565 automatic responses. For example:
21566 .code
21567 subject = Re: $h_subject:
21568 .endd
21569 There is a danger in doing this, however. It may allow a third party to
21570 subscribe your users to an opt-in mailing list, provided that the list accepts
21571 bounce messages as subscription confirmations. Well-managed lists require a
21572 non-bounce message to confirm a subscription, so the danger is relatively
21573 small.
21574
21575
21576
21577 .option text autoreply string&!! unset
21578 This specifies a single string to be used as the body of the message when the
21579 message is specified by the transport. If both &%text%& and &%file%& are set,
21580 the text comes first.
21581
21582
21583 .option to autoreply string&!! unset
21584 This specifies recipients of the message and the contents of the &'To:'& header
21585 when the message is specified by the transport.
21586 .ecindex IIDauttra1
21587 .ecindex IIDauttra2
21588
21589
21590
21591
21592 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21593 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21594
21595 .chapter "The lmtp transport" "CHAPLMTP"
21596 .cindex "transports" "&(lmtp)&"
21597 .cindex "&(lmtp)& transport"
21598 .cindex "LMTP" "over a pipe"
21599 .cindex "LMTP" "over a socket"
21600 The &(lmtp)& transport runs the LMTP protocol (RFC 2033) over a pipe to a
21601 specified command
21602 or by interacting with a Unix domain socket.
21603 This transport is something of a cross between the &(pipe)& and &(smtp)&
21604 transports. Exim also has support for using LMTP over TCP/IP; this is
21605 implemented as an option for the &(smtp)& transport. Because LMTP is expected
21606 to be of minority interest, the default build-time configure in &_src/EDITME_&
21607 has it commented out. You need to ensure that
21608 .code
21609 TRANSPORT_LMTP=yes
21610 .endd
21611 .cindex "options" "&(lmtp)& transport"
21612 is present in your &_Local/Makefile_& in order to have the &(lmtp)& transport
21613 included in the Exim binary. The private options of the &(lmtp)& transport are
21614 as follows:
21615
21616 .option batch_id lmtp string&!! unset
21617 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
21618
21619
21620 .option batch_max lmtp integer 1
21621 This limits the number of addresses that can be handled in a single delivery.
21622 Most LMTP servers can handle several addresses at once, so it is normally a
21623 good idea to increase this value. See the description of local delivery
21624 batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
21625
21626
21627 .option command lmtp string&!! unset
21628 This option must be set if &%socket%& is not set. The string is a command which
21629 is run in a separate process. It is split up into a command name and list of
21630 arguments, each of which is separately expanded (so expansion cannot change the
21631 number of arguments). The command is run directly, not via a shell. The message
21632 is passed to the new process using the standard input and output to operate the
21633 LMTP protocol.
21634
21635 .option ignore_quota lmtp boolean false
21636 .cindex "LMTP" "ignoring quota errors"
21637 If this option is set true, the string &`IGNOREQUOTA`& is added to RCPT
21638 commands, provided that the LMTP server has advertised support for IGNOREQUOTA
21639 in its response to the LHLO command.
21640
21641 .option socket lmtp string&!! unset
21642 This option must be set if &%command%& is not set. The result of expansion must
21643 be the name of a Unix domain socket. The transport connects to the socket and
21644 delivers the message to it using the LMTP protocol.
21645
21646
21647 .option timeout lmtp time 5m
21648 The transport is aborted if the created process or Unix domain socket does not
21649 respond to LMTP commands or message input within this timeout. Delivery
21650 is deferred, and will be tried again later. Here is an example of a typical
21651 LMTP transport:
21652 .code
21653 lmtp:
21654 driver = lmtp
21655 command = /some/local/lmtp/delivery/program
21656 batch_max = 20
21657 user = exim
21658 .endd
21659 This delivers up to 20 addresses at a time, in a mixture of domains if
21660 necessary, running as the user &'exim'&.
21661
21662
21663
21664 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21665 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21666
21667 .chapter "The pipe transport" "CHAPpipetransport"
21668 .scindex IIDpiptra1 "transports" "&(pipe)&"
21669 .scindex IIDpiptra2 "&(pipe)& transport"
21670 The &(pipe)& transport is used to deliver messages via a pipe to a command
21671 running in another process. One example is the use of &(pipe)& as a
21672 pseudo-remote transport for passing messages to some other delivery mechanism
21673 (such as UUCP). Another is the use by individual users to automatically process
21674 their incoming messages. The &(pipe)& transport can be used in one of the
21675 following ways:
21676
21677 .ilist
21678 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
21679 A router routes one address to a transport in the normal way, and the
21680 transport is configured as a &(pipe)& transport. In this case, &$local_part$&
21681 contains the local part of the address (as usual), and the command that is run
21682 is specified by the &%command%& option on the transport.
21683 .next
21684 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
21685 If the &%batch_max%& option is set greater than 1 (the default is 1), the
21686 transport can handle more than one address in a single run. In this case, when
21687 more than one address is routed to the transport, &$local_part$& is not set
21688 (because it is not unique). However, the pseudo-variable &$pipe_addresses$&
21689 (described in section &<<SECThowcommandrun>>& below) contains all the addresses
21690 that are routed to the transport.
21691 .next
21692 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
21693 A router redirects an address directly to a pipe command (for example, from an
21694 alias or forward file). In this case, &$address_pipe$& contains the text of the
21695 pipe command, and the &%command%& option on the transport is ignored unless
21696 &%force_command%& is set. If only one address is being transported
21697 (&%batch_max%& is not greater than one, or only one address was redirected to
21698 this pipe command), &$local_part$& contains the local part that was redirected.
21699 .endlist
21700
21701
21702 The &(pipe)& transport is a non-interactive delivery method. Exim can also
21703 deliver messages over pipes using the LMTP interactive protocol. This is
21704 implemented by the &(lmtp)& transport.
21705
21706 In the case when &(pipe)& is run as a consequence of an entry in a local user's
21707 &_.forward_& file, the command runs under the uid and gid of that user. In
21708 other cases, the uid and gid have to be specified explicitly, either on the
21709 transport or on the router that handles the address. Current and &"home"&
21710 directories are also controllable. See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for
21711 details of the local delivery environment and chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&
21712 for a discussion of local delivery batching.
21713
21714
21715 .section "Concurrent delivery" "SECID140"
21716 If two messages arrive at almost the same time, and both are routed to a pipe
21717 delivery, the two pipe transports may be run concurrently. You must ensure that
21718 any pipe commands you set up are robust against this happening. If the commands
21719 write to a file, the &%exim_lock%& utility might be of use.
21720
21721
21722
21723
21724 .section "Returned status and data" "SECID141"
21725 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "returned data"
21726 If the command exits with a non-zero return code, the delivery is deemed to
21727 have failed, unless either the &%ignore_status%& option is set (in which case
21728 the return code is treated as zero), or the return code is one of those listed
21729 in the &%temp_errors%& option, which are interpreted as meaning &"try again
21730 later"&. In this case, delivery is deferred. Details of a permanent failure are
21731 logged, but are not included in the bounce message, which merely contains
21732 &"local delivery failed"&.
21733
21734 If the command exits on a signal and the &%freeze_signal%& option is set then
21735 the message will be frozen in the queue. If that option is not set, a bounce
21736 will be sent as normal.
21737
21738 If the return code is greater than 128 and the command being run is a shell
21739 script, it normally means that the script was terminated by a signal whose
21740 value is the return code minus 128. The &%freeze_signal%& option does not
21741 apply in this case.
21742
21743 If Exim is unable to run the command (that is, if &[execve()]& fails), the
21744 return code is set to 127. This is the value that a shell returns if it is
21745 asked to run a non-existent command. The wording for the log line suggests that
21746 a non-existent command may be the problem.
21747
21748 The &%return_output%& option can affect the result of a pipe delivery. If it is
21749 set and the command produces any output on its standard output or standard
21750 error streams, the command is considered to have failed, even if it gave a zero
21751 return code or if &%ignore_status%& is set. The output from the command is
21752 included as part of the bounce message. The &%return_fail_output%& option is
21753 similar, except that output is returned only when the command exits with a
21754 failure return code, that is, a value other than zero or a code that matches
21755 &%temp_errors%&.
21756
21757
21758
21759 .section "How the command is run" "SECThowcommandrun"
21760 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "path for command"
21761 The command line is (by default) broken down into a command name and arguments
21762 by the &(pipe)& transport itself. The &%allow_commands%& and
21763 &%restrict_to_path%& options can be used to restrict the commands that may be
21764 run.
21765
21766 .cindex "quoting" "in pipe command"
21767 Unquoted arguments are delimited by white space. If an argument appears in
21768 double quotes, backslash is interpreted as an escape character in the usual
21769 way. If an argument appears in single quotes, no escaping is done.
21770
21771 String expansion is applied to the command line except when it comes from a
21772 traditional &_.forward_& file (commands from a filter file are expanded). The
21773 expansion is applied to each argument in turn rather than to the whole line.
21774 For this reason, any string expansion item that contains white space must be
21775 quoted so as to be contained within a single argument. A setting such as
21776 .code
21777 command = /some/path ${if eq{$local_part}{postmaster}{xx}{yy}}
21778 .endd
21779 will not work, because the expansion item gets split between several
21780 arguments. You have to write
21781 .code
21782 command = /some/path "${if eq{$local_part}{postmaster}{xx}{yy}}"
21783 .endd
21784 to ensure that it is all in one argument. The expansion is done in this way,
21785 argument by argument, so that the number of arguments cannot be changed as a
21786 result of expansion, and quotes or backslashes in inserted variables do not
21787 interact with external quoting. However, this leads to problems if you want to
21788 generate multiple arguments (or the command name plus arguments) from a single
21789 expansion. In this situation, the simplest solution is to use a shell. For
21790 example:
21791 .code
21792 command = /bin/sh -c ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/some/file}}
21793 .endd
21794
21795 .cindex "transport" "filter"
21796 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
21797 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
21798 Special handling takes place when an argument consists of precisely the text
21799 &`$pipe_addresses`&. This is not a general expansion variable; the only
21800 place this string is recognized is when it appears as an argument for a pipe or
21801 transport filter command. It causes each address that is being handled to be
21802 inserted in the argument list at that point &'as a separate argument'&. This
21803 avoids any problems with spaces or shell metacharacters, and is of use when a
21804 &(pipe)& transport is handling groups of addresses in a batch.
21805
21806 If &%force_command%& is enabled on the transport, Special handling takes place
21807 for an argument that consists of precisely the text &`$address_pipe`&. It
21808 is handled similarly to &$pipe_addresses$& above. It is expanded and each
21809 argument is inserted in the argument list at that point
21810 &'as a separate argument'&. The &`$address_pipe`& item does not need to be
21811 the only item in the argument; in fact, if it were then &%force_command%&
21812 should behave as a no-op. Rather, it should be used to adjust the command
21813 run while preserving the argument vector separation.
21814
21815 After splitting up into arguments and expansion, the resulting command is run
21816 in a subprocess directly from the transport, &'not'& under a shell. The
21817 message that is being delivered is supplied on the standard input, and the
21818 standard output and standard error are both connected to a single pipe that is
21819 read by Exim. The &%max_output%& option controls how much output the command
21820 may produce, and the &%return_output%& and &%return_fail_output%& options
21821 control what is done with it.
21822
21823 Not running the command under a shell (by default) lessens the security risks
21824 in cases when a command from a user's filter file is built out of data that was
21825 taken from an incoming message. If a shell is required, it can of course be
21826 explicitly specified as the command to be run. However, there are circumstances
21827 where existing commands (for example, in &_.forward_& files) expect to be run
21828 under a shell and cannot easily be modified. To allow for these cases, there is
21829 an option called &%use_shell%&, which changes the way the &(pipe)& transport
21830 works. Instead of breaking up the command line as just described, it expands it
21831 as a single string and passes the result to &_/bin/sh_&. The
21832 &%restrict_to_path%& option and the &$pipe_addresses$& facility cannot be used
21833 with &%use_shell%&, and the whole mechanism is inherently less secure.
21834
21835
21836
21837 .section "Environment variables" "SECTpipeenv"
21838 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "environment for command"
21839 .cindex "environment for pipe transport"
21840 The environment variables listed below are set up when the command is invoked.
21841 This list is a compromise for maximum compatibility with other MTAs. Note that
21842 the &%environment%& option can be used to add additional variables to this
21843 environment.
21844 .display
21845 &`DOMAIN `& the domain of the address
21846 &`HOME `& the home directory, if set
21847 &`HOST `& the host name when called from a router (see below)
21848 &`LOCAL_PART `& see below
21849 &`LOCAL_PART_PREFIX `& see below
21850 &`LOCAL_PART_SUFFIX `& see below
21851 &`LOGNAME `& see below
21852 &`MESSAGE_ID `& Exim's local ID for the message
21853 &`PATH `& as specified by the &%path%& option below
21854 &`QUALIFY_DOMAIN `& the sender qualification domain
21855 &`RECIPIENT `& the complete recipient address
21856 &`SENDER `& the sender of the message (empty if a bounce)
21857 &`SHELL `& &`/bin/sh`&
21858 &`TZ `& the value of the &%timezone%& option, if set
21859 &`USER `& see below
21860 .endd
21861 When a &(pipe)& transport is called directly from (for example) an &(accept)&
21862 router, LOCAL_PART is set to the local part of the address. When it is
21863 called as a result of a forward or alias expansion, LOCAL_PART is set to
21864 the local part of the address that was expanded. In both cases, any affixes are
21865 removed from the local part, and made available in LOCAL_PART_PREFIX and
21866 LOCAL_PART_SUFFIX, respectively. LOGNAME and USER are set to the
21867 same value as LOCAL_PART for compatibility with other MTAs.
21868
21869 .cindex "HOST"
21870 HOST is set only when a &(pipe)& transport is called from a router that
21871 associates hosts with an address, typically when using &(pipe)& as a
21872 pseudo-remote transport. HOST is set to the first host name specified by
21873 the router.
21874
21875 .cindex "HOME"
21876 If the transport's generic &%home_directory%& option is set, its value is used
21877 for the HOME environment variable. Otherwise, a home directory may be set
21878 by the router's &%transport_home_directory%& option, which defaults to the
21879 user's home directory if &%check_local_user%& is set.
21880
21881
21882 .section "Private options for pipe" "SECID142"
21883 .cindex "options" "&(pipe)& transport"
21884
21885
21886
21887 .option allow_commands pipe "string list&!!" unset
21888 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "permitted commands"
21889 The string is expanded, and is then interpreted as a colon-separated list of
21890 permitted commands. If &%restrict_to_path%& is not set, the only commands
21891 permitted are those in the &%allow_commands%& list. They need not be absolute
21892 paths; the &%path%& option is still used for relative paths. If
21893 &%restrict_to_path%& is set with &%allow_commands%&, the command must either be
21894 in the &%allow_commands%& list, or a name without any slashes that is found on
21895 the path. In other words, if neither &%allow_commands%& nor
21896 &%restrict_to_path%& is set, there is no restriction on the command, but
21897 otherwise only commands that are permitted by one or the other are allowed. For
21898 example, if
21899 .code
21900 allow_commands = /usr/bin/vacation
21901 .endd
21902 and &%restrict_to_path%& is not set, the only permitted command is
21903 &_/usr/bin/vacation_&. The &%allow_commands%& option may not be set if
21904 &%use_shell%& is set.
21905
21906
21907 .option batch_id pipe string&!! unset
21908 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
21909
21910
21911 .option batch_max pipe integer 1
21912 This limits the number of addresses that can be handled in a single delivery.
21913 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
21914
21915
21916 .option check_string pipe string unset
21917 As &(pipe)& writes the message, the start of each line is tested for matching
21918 &%check_string%&, and if it does, the initial matching characters are replaced
21919 by the contents of &%escape_string%&, provided both are set. The value of
21920 &%check_string%& is a literal string, not a regular expression, and the case of
21921 any letters it contains is significant. When &%use_bsmtp%& is set, the contents
21922 of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& are forced to values that implement
21923 the SMTP escaping protocol. Any settings made in the configuration file are
21924 ignored.
21925
21926
21927 .option command pipe string&!! unset
21928 This option need not be set when &(pipe)& is being used to deliver to pipes
21929 obtained directly from address redirections. In other cases, the option must be
21930 set, to provide a command to be run. It need not yield an absolute path (see
21931 the &%path%& option below). The command is split up into separate arguments by
21932 Exim, and each argument is separately expanded, as described in section
21933 &<<SECThowcommandrun>>& above.
21934
21935
21936 .option environment pipe string&!! unset
21937 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "environment for command"
21938 .cindex "environment for &(pipe)& transport"
21939 This option is used to add additional variables to the environment in which the
21940 command runs (see section &<<SECTpipeenv>>& for the default list). Its value is
21941 a string which is expanded, and then interpreted as a colon-separated list of
21942 environment settings of the form <&'name'&>=<&'value'&>.
21943
21944
21945 .option escape_string pipe string unset
21946 See &%check_string%& above.
21947
21948
21949 .option freeze_exec_fail pipe boolean false
21950 .cindex "exec failure"
21951 .cindex "failure of exec"
21952 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "failure of exec"
21953 Failure to exec the command in a pipe transport is by default treated like
21954 any other failure while running the command. However, if &%freeze_exec_fail%&
21955 is set, failure to exec is treated specially, and causes the message to be
21956 frozen, whatever the setting of &%ignore_status%&.
21957
21958
21959 .option freeze_signal pipe boolean false
21960 .cindex "signal exit"
21961 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport", "signal exit"
21962 Normally if the process run by a command in a pipe transport exits on a signal,
21963 a bounce message is sent. If &%freeze_signal%& is set, the message will be
21964 frozen in Exim's queue instead.
21965
21966
21967 .option force_command pipe boolean false
21968 .cindex "force command"
21969 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport", "force command"
21970 Normally when a router redirects an address directly to a pipe command
21971 the &%command%& option on the transport is ignored. If &%force_command%&
21972 is set, the &%command%& option will used. This is especially
21973 useful for forcing a wrapper or additional argument to be added to the
21974 command. For example:
21975 .code
21976 command = /usr/bin/remote_exec myhost -- $address_pipe
21977 force_command
21978 .endd
21979
21980 Note that &$address_pipe$& is handled specially in &%command%& when
21981 &%force_command%& is set, expanding out to the original argument vector as
21982 separate items, similarly to a Unix shell &`"$@"`& construct.
21983
21984 .option ignore_status pipe boolean false
21985 If this option is true, the status returned by the subprocess that is set up to
21986 run the command is ignored, and Exim behaves as if zero had been returned.
21987 Otherwise, a non-zero status or termination by signal causes an error return
21988 from the transport unless the status value is one of those listed in
21989 &%temp_errors%&; these cause the delivery to be deferred and tried again later.
21990
21991 &*Note*&: This option does not apply to timeouts, which do not return a status.
21992 See the &%timeout_defer%& option for how timeouts are handled.
21993
21994 .option log_defer_output pipe boolean false
21995 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "logging output"
21996 If this option is set, and the status returned by the command is
21997 one of the codes listed in &%temp_errors%& (that is, delivery was deferred),
21998 and any output was produced, the first line of it is written to the main log.
21999
22000
22001 .option log_fail_output pipe boolean false
22002 If this option is set, and the command returns any output, and also ends with a
22003 return code that is neither zero nor one of the return codes listed in
22004 &%temp_errors%& (that is, the delivery failed), the first line of output is
22005 written to the main log. This option and &%log_output%& are mutually exclusive.
22006 Only one of them may be set.
22007
22008
22009
22010 .option log_output pipe boolean false
22011 If this option is set and the command returns any output, the first line of
22012 output is written to the main log, whatever the return code. This option and
22013 &%log_fail_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one of them may be set.
22014
22015
22016
22017 .option max_output pipe integer 20K
22018 This specifies the maximum amount of output that the command may produce on its
22019 standard output and standard error file combined. If the limit is exceeded, the
22020 process running the command is killed. This is intended as a safety measure to
22021 catch runaway processes. The limit is applied independently of the settings of
22022 the options that control what is done with such output (for example,
22023 &%return_output%&). Because of buffering effects, the amount of output may
22024 exceed the limit by a small amount before Exim notices.
22025
22026
22027 .option message_prefix pipe string&!! "see below"
22028 The string specified here is expanded and output at the start of every message.
22029 The default is unset if &%use_bsmtp%& is set. Otherwise it is
22030 .code
22031 message_prefix = \
22032 From ${if def:return_path{$return_path}{MAILER-DAEMON}}\
22033 ${tod_bsdinbox}\n
22034 .endd
22035 .cindex "Cyrus"
22036 .cindex "&%tmail%&"
22037 .cindex "&""From""& line"
22038 This is required by the commonly used &_/usr/bin/vacation_& program.
22039 However, it must &'not'& be present if delivery is to the Cyrus IMAP server,
22040 or to the &%tmail%& local delivery agent. The prefix can be suppressed by
22041 setting
22042 .code
22043 message_prefix =
22044 .endd
22045 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
22046 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_prefix%&.
22047
22048
22049 .option message_suffix pipe string&!! "see below"
22050 The string specified here is expanded and output at the end of every message.
22051 The default is unset if &%use_bsmtp%& is set. Otherwise it is a single newline.
22052 The suffix can be suppressed by setting
22053 .code
22054 message_suffix =
22055 .endd
22056 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
22057 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_suffix%&.
22058
22059
22060 .option path pipe string "see below"
22061 This option specifies the string that is set up in the PATH environment
22062 variable of the subprocess. The default is:
22063 .code
22064 /bin:/usr/bin
22065 .endd
22066 If the &%command%& option does not yield an absolute path name, the command is
22067 sought in the PATH directories, in the usual way. &*Warning*&: This does not
22068 apply to a command specified as a transport filter.
22069
22070
22071 .option permit_coredump pipe boolean false
22072 Normally Exim inhibits core-dumps during delivery. If you have a need to get
22073 a core-dump of a pipe command, enable this command. This enables core-dumps
22074 during delivery and affects both the Exim binary and the pipe command run.
22075 It is recommended that this option remain off unless and until you have a need
22076 for it and that this only be enabled when needed, as the risk of excessive
22077 resource consumption can be quite high. Note also that Exim is typically
22078 installed as a setuid binary and most operating systems will inhibit coredumps
22079 of these by default, so further OS-specific action may be required.
22080
22081
22082 .option pipe_as_creator pipe boolean false
22083 .cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
22084 If the generic &%user%& option is not set and this option is true, the delivery
22085 process is run under the uid that was in force when Exim was originally called
22086 to accept the message. If the group id is not otherwise set (via the generic
22087 &%group%& option), the gid that was in force when Exim was originally called to
22088 accept the message is used.
22089
22090
22091 .option restrict_to_path pipe boolean false
22092 When this option is set, any command name not listed in &%allow_commands%& must
22093 contain no slashes. The command is searched for only in the directories listed
22094 in the &%path%& option. This option is intended for use in the case when a pipe
22095 command has been generated from a user's &_.forward_& file. This is usually
22096 handled by a &(pipe)& transport called &%address_pipe%&.
22097
22098
22099 .option return_fail_output pipe boolean false
22100 If this option is true, and the command produced any output and ended with a
22101 return code other than zero or one of the codes listed in &%temp_errors%& (that
22102 is, the delivery failed), the output is returned in the bounce message.
22103 However, if the message has a null sender (that is, it is itself a bounce
22104 message), output from the command is discarded. This option and
22105 &%return_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one of them may be set.
22106
22107
22108
22109 .option return_output pipe boolean false
22110 If this option is true, and the command produced any output, the delivery is
22111 deemed to have failed whatever the return code from the command, and the output
22112 is returned in the bounce message. Otherwise, the output is just discarded.
22113 However, if the message has a null sender (that is, it is a bounce message),
22114 output from the command is always discarded, whatever the setting of this
22115 option. This option and &%return_fail_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one
22116 of them may be set.
22117
22118
22119
22120 .option temp_errors pipe "string list" "see below"
22121 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "temporary failure"
22122 This option contains either a colon-separated list of numbers, or a single
22123 asterisk. If &%ignore_status%& is false
22124 and &%return_output%& is not set,
22125 and the command exits with a non-zero return code, the failure is treated as
22126 temporary and the delivery is deferred if the return code matches one of the
22127 numbers, or if the setting is a single asterisk. Otherwise, non-zero return
22128 codes are treated as permanent errors. The default setting contains the codes
22129 defined by EX_TEMPFAIL and EX_CANTCREAT in &_sysexits.h_&. If Exim is
22130 compiled on a system that does not define these macros, it assumes values of 75
22131 and 73, respectively.
22132
22133
22134 .option timeout pipe time 1h
22135 If the command fails to complete within this time, it is killed. This normally
22136 causes the delivery to fail (but see &%timeout_defer%&). A zero time interval
22137 specifies no timeout. In order to ensure that any subprocesses created by the
22138 command are also killed, Exim makes the initial process a process group leader,
22139 and kills the whole process group on a timeout. However, this can be defeated
22140 if one of the processes starts a new process group.
22141
22142 .option timeout_defer pipe boolean false
22143 A timeout in a &(pipe)& transport, either in the command that the transport
22144 runs, or in a transport filter that is associated with it, is by default
22145 treated as a hard error, and the delivery fails. However, if &%timeout_defer%&
22146 is set true, both kinds of timeout become temporary errors, causing the
22147 delivery to be deferred.
22148
22149 .option umask pipe "octal integer" 022
22150 This specifies the umask setting for the subprocess that runs the command.
22151
22152
22153 .option use_bsmtp pipe boolean false
22154 .cindex "envelope sender"
22155 If this option is set true, the &(pipe)& transport writes messages in &"batch
22156 SMTP"& format, with the envelope sender and recipient(s) included as SMTP
22157 commands. If you want to include a leading HELO command with such messages,
22158 you can do so by setting the &%message_prefix%& option. See section
22159 &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>& for details of batch SMTP.
22160
22161 .option use_classresources pipe boolean false
22162 .cindex "class resources (BSD)"
22163 This option is available only when Exim is running on FreeBSD, NetBSD, or
22164 BSD/OS. If it is set true, the &[setclassresources()]& function is used to set
22165 resource limits when a &(pipe)& transport is run to perform a delivery. The
22166 limits for the uid under which the pipe is to run are obtained from the login
22167 class database.
22168
22169
22170 .option use_crlf pipe boolean false
22171 .cindex "carriage return"
22172 .cindex "linefeed"
22173 This option causes lines to be terminated with the two-character CRLF sequence
22174 (carriage return, linefeed) instead of just a linefeed character. In the case
22175 of batched SMTP, the byte sequence written to the pipe is then an exact image
22176 of what would be sent down a real SMTP connection.
22177
22178 The contents of the &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options are
22179 written verbatim, so must contain their own carriage return characters if these
22180 are needed. When &%use_bsmtp%& is not set, the default values for both
22181 &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& end with a single linefeed, so their
22182 values must be changed to end with &`\r\n`& if &%use_crlf%& is set.
22183
22184
22185 .option use_shell pipe boolean false
22186 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
22187 If this option is set, it causes the command to be passed to &_/bin/sh_&
22188 instead of being run directly from the transport, as described in section
22189 &<<SECThowcommandrun>>&. This is less secure, but is needed in some situations
22190 where the command is expected to be run under a shell and cannot easily be
22191 modified. The &%allow_commands%& and &%restrict_to_path%& options, and the
22192 &`$pipe_addresses`& facility are incompatible with &%use_shell%&. The
22193 command is expanded as a single string, and handed to &_/bin/sh_& as data for
22194 its &%-c%& option.
22195
22196
22197
22198 .section "Using an external local delivery agent" "SECID143"
22199 .cindex "local delivery" "using an external agent"
22200 .cindex "&'procmail'&"
22201 .cindex "external local delivery"
22202 .cindex "delivery" "&'procmail'&"
22203 .cindex "delivery" "by external agent"
22204 The &(pipe)& transport can be used to pass all messages that require local
22205 delivery to a separate local delivery agent such as &%procmail%&. When doing
22206 this, care must be taken to ensure that the pipe is run under an appropriate
22207 uid and gid. In some configurations one wants this to be a uid that is trusted
22208 by the delivery agent to supply the correct sender of the message. It may be
22209 necessary to recompile or reconfigure the delivery agent so that it trusts an
22210 appropriate user. The following is an example transport and router
22211 configuration for &%procmail%&:
22212 .code
22213 # transport
22214 procmail_pipe:
22215 driver = pipe
22216 command = /usr/local/bin/procmail -d $local_part
22217 return_path_add
22218 delivery_date_add
22219 envelope_to_add
22220 check_string = "From "
22221 escape_string = ">From "
22222 umask = 077
22223 user = $local_part
22224 group = mail
22225
22226 # router
22227 procmail:
22228 driver = accept
22229 check_local_user
22230 transport = procmail_pipe
22231 .endd
22232 In this example, the pipe is run as the local user, but with the group set to
22233 &'mail'&. An alternative is to run the pipe as a specific user such as &'mail'&
22234 or &'exim'&, but in this case you must arrange for &%procmail%& to trust that
22235 user to supply a correct sender address. If you do not specify either a
22236 &%group%& or a &%user%& option, the pipe command is run as the local user. The
22237 home directory is the user's home directory by default.
22238
22239 &*Note*&: The command that the pipe transport runs does &'not'& begin with
22240 .code
22241 IFS=" "
22242 .endd
22243 as shown in some &%procmail%& documentation, because Exim does not by default
22244 use a shell to run pipe commands.
22245
22246 .cindex "Cyrus"
22247 The next example shows a transport and a router for a system where local
22248 deliveries are handled by the Cyrus IMAP server.
22249 .code
22250 # transport
22251 local_delivery_cyrus:
22252 driver = pipe
22253 command = /usr/cyrus/bin/deliver \
22254 -m ${substr_1:$local_part_suffix} -- $local_part
22255 user = cyrus
22256 group = mail
22257 return_output
22258 log_output
22259 message_prefix =
22260 message_suffix =
22261
22262 # router
22263 local_user_cyrus:
22264 driver = accept
22265 check_local_user
22266 local_part_suffix = .*
22267 transport = local_delivery_cyrus
22268 .endd
22269 Note the unsetting of &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%&, and the use of
22270 &%return_output%& to cause any text written by Cyrus to be returned to the
22271 sender.
22272 .ecindex IIDpiptra1
22273 .ecindex IIDpiptra2
22274
22275
22276 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22277 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22278
22279 .chapter "The smtp transport" "CHAPsmtptrans"
22280 .scindex IIDsmttra1 "transports" "&(smtp)&"
22281 .scindex IIDsmttra2 "&(smtp)& transport"
22282 The &(smtp)& transport delivers messages over TCP/IP connections using the SMTP
22283 or LMTP protocol. The list of hosts to try can either be taken from the address
22284 that is being processed (having been set up by the router), or specified
22285 explicitly for the transport. Timeout and retry processing (see chapter
22286 &<<CHAPretry>>&) is applied to each IP address independently.
22287
22288
22289 .section "Multiple messages on a single connection" "SECID144"
22290 The sending of multiple messages over a single TCP/IP connection can arise in
22291 two ways:
22292
22293 .ilist
22294 If a message contains more than &%max_rcpt%& (see below) addresses that are
22295 routed to the same host, more than one copy of the message has to be sent to
22296 that host. In this situation, multiple copies may be sent in a single run of
22297 the &(smtp)& transport over a single TCP/IP connection. (What Exim actually
22298 does when it has too many addresses to send in one message also depends on the
22299 value of the global &%remote_max_parallel%& option. Details are given in
22300 section &<<SECToutSMTPTCP>>&.)
22301 .next
22302 .cindex "hints database" "remembering routing"
22303 When a message has been successfully delivered over a TCP/IP connection, Exim
22304 looks in its hints database to see if there are any other messages awaiting a
22305 connection to the same host. If there are, a new delivery process is started
22306 for one of them, and the current TCP/IP connection is passed on to it. The new
22307 process may in turn send multiple copies and possibly create yet another
22308 process.
22309 .endlist
22310
22311
22312 For each copy sent over the same TCP/IP connection, a sequence counter is
22313 incremented, and if it ever gets to the value of &%connection_max_messages%&,
22314 no further messages are sent over that connection.
22315
22316
22317
22318 .section "Use of the $host and $host_address variables" "SECID145"
22319 .vindex "&$host$&"
22320 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
22321 At the start of a run of the &(smtp)& transport, the values of &$host$& and
22322 &$host_address$& are the name and IP address of the first host on the host list
22323 passed by the router. However, when the transport is about to connect to a
22324 specific host, and while it is connected to that host, &$host$& and
22325 &$host_address$& are set to the values for that host. These are the values
22326 that are in force when the &%helo_data%&, &%hosts_try_auth%&, &%interface%&,
22327 &%serialize_hosts%&, and the various TLS options are expanded.
22328
22329
22330 .section "Use of $tls_cipher and $tls_peerdn" "usecippeer"
22331 .vindex &$tls_bits$&
22332 .vindex &$tls_cipher$&
22333 .vindex &$tls_peerdn$&
22334 .vindex &$tls_sni$&
22335 At the start of a run of the &(smtp)& transport, the values of &$tls_bits$&,
22336 &$tls_cipher$&, &$tls_peerdn$& and &$tls_sni$&
22337 are the values that were set when the message was received.
22338 These are the values that are used for options that are expanded before any
22339 SMTP connections are made. Just before each connection is made, these four
22340 variables are emptied. If TLS is subsequently started, they are set to the
22341 appropriate values for the outgoing connection, and these are the values that
22342 are in force when any authenticators are run and when the
22343 &%authenticated_sender%& option is expanded.
22344
22345 These variables are deprecated in favour of &$tls_in_cipher$& et. al.
22346 and will be removed in a future release.
22347
22348
22349 .section "Private options for smtp" "SECID146"
22350 .cindex "options" "&(smtp)& transport"
22351 The private options of the &(smtp)& transport are as follows:
22352
22353
22354 .option address_retry_include_sender smtp boolean true
22355 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "retrying after"
22356 When an address is delayed because of a 4&'xx'& response to a RCPT command, it
22357 is the combination of sender and recipient that is delayed in subsequent queue
22358 runs until the retry time is reached. You can delay the recipient without
22359 reference to the sender (which is what earlier versions of Exim did), by
22360 setting &%address_retry_include_sender%& false. However, this can lead to
22361 problems with servers that regularly issue 4&'xx'& responses to RCPT commands.
22362
22363 .option allow_localhost smtp boolean false
22364 .cindex "local host" "sending to"
22365 .cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on transport"
22366 When a host specified in &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& (see below) turns out
22367 to be the local host, or is listed in &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, delivery is
22368 deferred by default. However, if &%allow_localhost%& is set, Exim goes on to do
22369 the delivery anyway. This should be used only in special cases when the
22370 configuration ensures that no looping will result (for example, a differently
22371 configured Exim is listening on the port to which the message is sent).
22372
22373
22374 .option authenticated_sender smtp string&!! unset
22375 .cindex "Cyrus"
22376 When Exim has authenticated as a client, or if &%authenticated_sender_force%&
22377 is true, this option sets a value for the AUTH= item on outgoing MAIL commands,
22378 overriding any existing authenticated sender value. If the string expansion is
22379 forced to fail, the option is ignored. Other expansion failures cause delivery
22380 to be deferred. If the result of expansion is an empty string, that is also
22381 ignored.
22382
22383 The expansion happens after the outgoing connection has been made and TLS
22384 started, if required. This means that the &$host$&, &$host_address$&,
22385 &$tls_out_cipher$&, and &$tls_out_peerdn$& variables are set according to the
22386 particular connection.
22387
22388 If the SMTP session is not authenticated, the expansion of
22389 &%authenticated_sender%& still happens (and can cause the delivery to be
22390 deferred if it fails), but no AUTH= item is added to MAIL commands
22391 unless &%authenticated_sender_force%& is true.
22392
22393 This option allows you to use the &(smtp)& transport in LMTP mode to
22394 deliver mail to Cyrus IMAP and provide the proper local part as the
22395 &"authenticated sender"&, via a setting such as:
22396 .code
22397 authenticated_sender = $local_part
22398 .endd
22399 This removes the need for IMAP subfolders to be assigned special ACLs to
22400 allow direct delivery to those subfolders.
22401
22402 Because of expected uses such as that just described for Cyrus (when no
22403 domain is involved), there is no checking on the syntax of the provided
22404 value.
22405
22406
22407 .option authenticated_sender_force smtp boolean false
22408 If this option is set true, the &%authenticated_sender%& option's value
22409 is used for the AUTH= item on outgoing MAIL commands, even if Exim has not
22410 authenticated as a client.
22411
22412
22413 .option command_timeout smtp time 5m
22414 This sets a timeout for receiving a response to an SMTP command that has been
22415 sent out. It is also used when waiting for the initial banner line from the
22416 remote host. Its value must not be zero.
22417
22418
22419 .option connect_timeout smtp time 5m
22420 This sets a timeout for the &[connect()]& function, which sets up a TCP/IP call
22421 to a remote host. A setting of zero allows the system timeout (typically
22422 several minutes) to act. To have any effect, the value of this option must be
22423 less than the system timeout. However, it has been observed that on some
22424 systems there is no system timeout, which is why the default value for this
22425 option is 5 minutes, a value recommended by RFC 1123.
22426
22427
22428 .option connection_max_messages smtp integer 500
22429 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
22430 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
22431 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
22432 This controls the maximum number of separate message deliveries that are sent
22433 over a single TCP/IP connection. If the value is zero, there is no limit.
22434 For testing purposes, this value can be overridden by the &%-oB%& command line
22435 option.
22436
22437
22438 .option data_timeout smtp time 5m
22439 This sets a timeout for the transmission of each block in the data portion of
22440 the message. As a result, the overall timeout for a message depends on the size
22441 of the message. Its value must not be zero. See also &%final_timeout%&.
22442
22443
22444 .option delay_after_cutoff smtp boolean true
22445 This option controls what happens when all remote IP addresses for a given
22446 domain have been inaccessible for so long that they have passed their retry
22447 cutoff times.
22448
22449 In the default state, if the next retry time has not been reached for any of
22450 them, the address is bounced without trying any deliveries. In other words,
22451 Exim delays retrying an IP address after the final cutoff time until a new
22452 retry time is reached, and can therefore bounce an address without ever trying
22453 a delivery, when machines have been down for a long time. Some people are
22454 unhappy at this prospect, so...
22455
22456 If &%delay_after_cutoff%& is set false, Exim behaves differently. If all IP
22457 addresses are past their final cutoff time, Exim tries to deliver to those
22458 IP addresses that have not been tried since the message arrived. If there are
22459 none, of if they all fail, the address is bounced. In other words, it does not
22460 delay when a new message arrives, but immediately tries those expired IP
22461 addresses that haven't been tried since the message arrived. If there is a
22462 continuous stream of messages for the dead hosts, unsetting
22463 &%delay_after_cutoff%& means that there will be many more attempts to deliver
22464 to them.
22465
22466
22467 .option dns_qualify_single smtp boolean true
22468 If the &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& option is being used,
22469 and the &%gethostbyname%& option is false,
22470 the RES_DEFNAMES resolver option is set. See the &%qualify_single%& option
22471 in chapter &<<CHAPdnslookup>>& for more details.
22472
22473
22474 .option dns_search_parents smtp boolean false
22475 If the &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& option is being used, and the
22476 &%gethostbyname%& option is false, the RES_DNSRCH resolver option is set.
22477 See the &%search_parents%& option in chapter &<<CHAPdnslookup>>& for more
22478 details.
22479
22480
22481 .option dscp smtp string&!! unset
22482 .cindex "DCSP" "outbound"
22483 This option causes the DSCP value associated with a socket to be set to one
22484 of a number of fixed strings or to numeric value.
22485 The &%-bI:dscp%& option may be used to ask Exim which names it knows of.
22486 Common values include &`throughput`&, &`mincost`&, and on newer systems
22487 &`ef`&, &`af41`&, etc. Numeric values may be in the range 0 to 0x3F.
22488
22489 The outbound packets from Exim will be marked with this value in the header
22490 (for IPv4, the TOS field; for IPv6, the TCLASS field); there is no guarantee
22491 that these values will have any effect, not be stripped by networking
22492 equipment, or do much of anything without cooperation with your Network
22493 Engineer and those of all network operators between the source and destination.
22494
22495
22496 .option fallback_hosts smtp "string list" unset
22497 .cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on transport"
22498 String expansion is not applied to this option. The argument must be a
22499 colon-separated list of host names or IP addresses, optionally also including
22500 port numbers, though the separator can be changed, as described in section
22501 &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&. Each individual item in the list is the same as an
22502 item in a &%route_list%& setting for the &(manualroute)& router, as described
22503 in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&.
22504
22505 Fallback hosts can also be specified on routers, which associate them with the
22506 addresses they process. As for the &%hosts%& option without &%hosts_override%&,
22507 &%fallback_hosts%& specified on the transport is used only if the address does
22508 not have its own associated fallback host list. Unlike &%hosts%&, a setting of
22509 &%fallback_hosts%& on an address is not overridden by &%hosts_override%&.
22510 However, &%hosts_randomize%& does apply to fallback host lists.
22511
22512 If Exim is unable to deliver to any of the hosts for a particular address, and
22513 the errors are not permanent rejections, the address is put on a separate
22514 transport queue with its host list replaced by the fallback hosts, unless the
22515 address was routed via MX records and the current host was in the original MX
22516 list. In that situation, the fallback host list is not used.
22517
22518 Once normal deliveries are complete, the fallback queue is delivered by
22519 re-running the same transports with the new host lists. If several failing
22520 addresses have the same fallback hosts (and &%max_rcpt%& permits it), a single
22521 copy of the message is sent.
22522
22523 The resolution of the host names on the fallback list is controlled by the
22524 &%gethostbyname%& option, as for the &%hosts%& option. Fallback hosts apply
22525 both to cases when the host list comes with the address and when it is taken
22526 from &%hosts%&. This option provides a &"use a smart host only if delivery
22527 fails"& facility.
22528
22529
22530 .option final_timeout smtp time 10m
22531 This is the timeout that applies while waiting for the response to the final
22532 line containing just &"."& that terminates a message. Its value must not be
22533 zero.
22534
22535 .option gethostbyname smtp boolean false
22536 If this option is true when the &%hosts%& and/or &%fallback_hosts%& options are
22537 being used, names are looked up using &[gethostbyname()]&
22538 (or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available)
22539 instead of using the DNS. Of course, that function may in fact use the DNS, but
22540 it may also consult other sources of information such as &_/etc/hosts_&.
22541
22542 .option gnutls_compat_mode smtp boolean unset
22543 This option controls whether GnuTLS is used in compatibility mode in an Exim
22544 server. This reduces security slightly, but improves interworking with older
22545 implementations of TLS.
22546
22547 .option helo_data smtp string&!! "see below"
22548 .cindex "HELO" "argument, setting"
22549 .cindex "EHLO" "argument, setting"
22550 .cindex "LHLO argument setting"
22551 The value of this option is expanded after a connection to a another host has
22552 been set up. The result is used as the argument for the EHLO, HELO, or LHLO
22553 command that starts the outgoing SMTP or LMTP session. The default value of the
22554 option is:
22555 .code
22556 $primary_hostname
22557 .endd
22558 During the expansion, the variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are set to
22559 the identity of the remote host, and the variables &$sending_ip_address$& and
22560 &$sending_port$& are set to the local IP address and port number that are being
22561 used. These variables can be used to generate different values for different
22562 servers or different local IP addresses. For example, if you want the string
22563 that is used for &%helo_data%& to be obtained by a DNS lookup of the outgoing
22564 interface address, you could use this:
22565 .code
22566 helo_data = ${lookup dnsdb{ptr=$sending_ip_address}{$value}\
22567 {$primary_hostname}}
22568 .endd
22569 The use of &%helo_data%& applies both to sending messages and when doing
22570 callouts.
22571
22572 .option hosts smtp "string list&!!" unset
22573 Hosts are associated with an address by a router such as &(dnslookup)&, which
22574 finds the hosts by looking up the address domain in the DNS, or by
22575 &(manualroute)&, which has lists of hosts in its configuration. However,
22576 email addresses can be passed to the &(smtp)& transport by any router, and not
22577 all of them can provide an associated list of hosts.
22578
22579 The &%hosts%& option specifies a list of hosts to be used if the address being
22580 processed does not have any hosts associated with it. The hosts specified by
22581 &%hosts%& are also used, whether or not the address has its own hosts, if
22582 &%hosts_override%& is set.
22583
22584 The string is first expanded, before being interpreted as a colon-separated
22585 list of host names or IP addresses, possibly including port numbers. The
22586 separator may be changed to something other than colon, as described in section
22587 &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&. Each individual item in the list is the same as an
22588 item in a &%route_list%& setting for the &(manualroute)& router, as described
22589 in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&. However, note that the &`/MX`& facility
22590 of the &(manualroute)& router is not available here.
22591
22592 If the expansion fails, delivery is deferred. Unless the failure was caused by
22593 the inability to complete a lookup, the error is logged to the panic log as
22594 well as the main log. Host names are looked up either by searching directly for
22595 address records in the DNS or by calling &[gethostbyname()]& (or
22596 &[getipnodebyname()]& when available), depending on the setting of the
22597 &%gethostbyname%& option. When Exim is compiled with IPv6 support, if a host
22598 that is looked up in the DNS has both IPv4 and IPv6 addresses, both types of
22599 address are used.
22600
22601 During delivery, the hosts are tried in order, subject to their retry status,
22602 unless &%hosts_randomize%& is set.
22603
22604
22605 .option hosts_avoid_esmtp smtp "host list&!!" unset
22606 .cindex "ESMTP, avoiding use of"
22607 .cindex "HELO" "forcing use of"
22608 .cindex "EHLO" "avoiding use of"
22609 .cindex "PIPELINING" "avoiding the use of"
22610 This option is for use with broken hosts that announce ESMTP facilities (for
22611 example, PIPELINING) and then fail to implement them properly. When a host
22612 matches &%hosts_avoid_esmtp%&, Exim sends HELO rather than EHLO at the
22613 start of the SMTP session. This means that it cannot use any of the ESMTP
22614 facilities such as AUTH, PIPELINING, SIZE, and STARTTLS.
22615
22616
22617 .option hosts_avoid_pipelining smtp "host list&!!" unset
22618 .cindex "PIPELINING" "avoiding the use of"
22619 Exim will not use the SMTP PIPELINING extension when delivering to any host
22620 that matches this list, even if the server host advertises PIPELINING support.
22621
22622
22623 .option hosts_avoid_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
22624 .cindex "TLS" "avoiding for certain hosts"
22625 Exim will not try to start a TLS session when delivering to any host that
22626 matches this list. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
22627
22628 .option hosts_verify_avoid_tls smtp "host list&!!" *
22629 .cindex "TLS" "avoiding for certain hosts"
22630 Exim will not try to start a TLS session for a verify callout,
22631 or when delivering in cutthrough mode,
22632 to any host that matches this list.
22633 Note that the default is to not use TLS.
22634
22635
22636 .option hosts_max_try smtp integer 5
22637 .cindex "host" "maximum number to try"
22638 .cindex "limit" "number of hosts tried"
22639 .cindex "limit" "number of MX tried"
22640 .cindex "MX record" "maximum tried"
22641 This option limits the number of IP addresses that are tried for any one
22642 delivery in cases where there are temporary delivery errors. Section
22643 &<<SECTvalhosmax>>& describes in detail how the value of this option is used.
22644
22645
22646 .option hosts_max_try_hardlimit smtp integer 50
22647 This is an additional check on the maximum number of IP addresses that Exim
22648 tries for any one delivery. Section &<<SECTvalhosmax>>& describes its use and
22649 why it exists.
22650
22651
22652
22653 .option hosts_nopass_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
22654 .cindex "TLS" "passing connection"
22655 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
22656 .cindex "TLS" "multiple message deliveries"
22657 For any host that matches this list, a connection on which a TLS session has
22658 been started will not be passed to a new delivery process for sending another
22659 message on the same connection. See section &<<SECTmulmessam>>& for an
22660 explanation of when this might be needed.
22661
22662
22663 .option hosts_override smtp boolean false
22664 If this option is set and the &%hosts%& option is also set, any hosts that are
22665 attached to the address are ignored, and instead the hosts specified by the
22666 &%hosts%& option are always used. This option does not apply to
22667 &%fallback_hosts%&.
22668
22669
22670 .option hosts_randomize smtp boolean false
22671 .cindex "randomized host list"
22672 .cindex "host" "list of; randomized"
22673 .cindex "fallback" "randomized hosts"
22674 If this option is set, and either the list of hosts is taken from the
22675 &%hosts%& or the &%fallback_hosts%& option, or the hosts supplied by the router
22676 were not obtained from MX records (this includes fallback hosts from the
22677 router), and were not randomized by the router, the order of trying the hosts
22678 is randomized each time the transport runs. Randomizing the order of a host
22679 list can be used to do crude load sharing.
22680
22681 When &%hosts_randomize%& is true, a host list may be split into groups whose
22682 order is separately randomized. This makes it possible to set up MX-like
22683 behaviour. The boundaries between groups are indicated by an item that is just
22684 &`+`& in the host list. For example:
22685 .code
22686 hosts = host1:host2:host3:+:host4:host5
22687 .endd
22688 The order of the first three hosts and the order of the last two hosts is
22689 randomized for each use, but the first three always end up before the last two.
22690 If &%hosts_randomize%& is not set, a &`+`& item in the list is ignored.
22691
22692 .option hosts_require_auth smtp "host list&!!" unset
22693 .cindex "authentication" "required by client"
22694 This option provides a list of servers for which authentication must succeed
22695 before Exim will try to transfer a message. If authentication fails for
22696 servers which are not in this list, Exim tries to send unauthenticated. If
22697 authentication fails for one of these servers, delivery is deferred. This
22698 temporary error is detectable in the retry rules, so it can be turned into a
22699 hard failure if required. See also &%hosts_try_auth%&, and chapter
22700 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
22701
22702
22703 .option hosts_require_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
22704 .cindex "TLS" "requiring for certain servers"
22705 Exim will insist on using a TLS session when delivering to any host that
22706 matches this list. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
22707 &*Note*&: This option affects outgoing mail only. To insist on TLS for
22708 incoming messages, use an appropriate ACL.
22709
22710 .option hosts_try_auth smtp "host list&!!" unset
22711 .cindex "authentication" "optional in client"
22712 This option provides a list of servers to which, provided they announce
22713 authentication support, Exim will attempt to authenticate as a client when it
22714 connects. If authentication fails, Exim will try to transfer the message
22715 unauthenticated. See also &%hosts_require_auth%&, and chapter
22716 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
22717
22718 .option interface smtp "string list&!!" unset
22719 .cindex "bind IP address"
22720 .cindex "IP address" "binding"
22721 .vindex "&$host$&"
22722 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
22723 This option specifies which interface to bind to when making an outgoing SMTP
22724 call. The value is an IP address, not an interface name such as
22725 &`eth0`&. Do not confuse this with the interface address that was used when a
22726 message was received, which is in &$received_ip_address$&, formerly known as
22727 &$interface_address$&. The name was changed to minimize confusion with the
22728 outgoing interface address. There is no variable that contains an outgoing
22729 interface address because, unless it is set by this option, its value is
22730 unknown.
22731
22732 During the expansion of the &%interface%& option the variables &$host$& and
22733 &$host_address$& refer to the host to which a connection is about to be made
22734 during the expansion of the string. Forced expansion failure, or an empty
22735 string result causes the option to be ignored. Otherwise, after expansion, the
22736 string must be a list of IP addresses, colon-separated by default, but the
22737 separator can be changed in the usual way. For example:
22738 .code
22739 interface = <; 192.168.123.123 ; 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061
22740 .endd
22741 The first interface of the correct type (IPv4 or IPv6) is used for the outgoing
22742 connection. If none of them are the correct type, the option is ignored. If
22743 &%interface%& is not set, or is ignored, the system's IP functions choose which
22744 interface to use if the host has more than one.
22745
22746
22747 .option keepalive smtp boolean true
22748 .cindex "keepalive" "on outgoing connection"
22749 This option controls the setting of SO_KEEPALIVE on outgoing TCP/IP socket
22750 connections. When set, it causes the kernel to probe idle connections
22751 periodically, by sending packets with &"old"& sequence numbers. The other end
22752 of the connection should send a acknowledgment if the connection is still okay
22753 or a reset if the connection has been aborted. The reason for doing this is
22754 that it has the beneficial effect of freeing up certain types of connection
22755 that can get stuck when the remote host is disconnected without tidying up the
22756 TCP/IP call properly. The keepalive mechanism takes several hours to detect
22757 unreachable hosts.
22758
22759
22760 .option lmtp_ignore_quota smtp boolean false
22761 .cindex "LMTP" "ignoring quota errors"
22762 If this option is set true when the &%protocol%& option is set to &"lmtp"&, the
22763 string &`IGNOREQUOTA`& is added to RCPT commands, provided that the LMTP server
22764 has advertised support for IGNOREQUOTA in its response to the LHLO command.
22765
22766 .option max_rcpt smtp integer 100
22767 .cindex "RCPT" "maximum number of outgoing"
22768 This option limits the number of RCPT commands that are sent in a single
22769 SMTP message transaction. Each set of addresses is treated independently, and
22770 so can cause parallel connections to the same host if &%remote_max_parallel%&
22771 permits this.
22772
22773
22774 .option multi_domain smtp boolean true
22775 .vindex "&$domain$&"
22776 When this option is set, the &(smtp)& transport can handle a number of
22777 addresses containing a mixture of different domains provided they all resolve
22778 to the same list of hosts. Turning the option off restricts the transport to
22779 handling only one domain at a time. This is useful if you want to use
22780 &$domain$& in an expansion for the transport, because it is set only when there
22781 is a single domain involved in a remote delivery.
22782
22783
22784 .option port smtp string&!! "see below"
22785 .cindex "port" "sending TCP/IP"
22786 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting outgoing port"
22787 This option specifies the TCP/IP port on the server to which Exim connects.
22788 &*Note:*& Do not confuse this with the port that was used when a message was
22789 received, which is in &$received_port$&, formerly known as &$interface_port$&.
22790 The name was changed to minimize confusion with the outgoing port. There is no
22791 variable that contains an outgoing port.
22792
22793 If the value of this option begins with a digit it is taken as a port number;
22794 otherwise it is looked up using &[getservbyname()]&. The default value is
22795 normally &"smtp"&, but if &%protocol%& is set to &"lmtp"&, the default is
22796 &"lmtp"&. If the expansion fails, or if a port number cannot be found, delivery
22797 is deferred.
22798
22799
22800
22801 .option protocol smtp string smtp
22802 .cindex "LMTP" "over TCP/IP"
22803 .cindex "ssmtp protocol" "outbound"
22804 .cindex "TLS" "SSL-on-connect outbound"
22805 .vindex "&$port$&"
22806 If this option is set to &"lmtp"& instead of &"smtp"&, the default value for
22807 the &%port%& option changes to &"lmtp"&, and the transport operates the LMTP
22808 protocol (RFC 2033) instead of SMTP. This protocol is sometimes used for local
22809 deliveries into closed message stores. Exim also has support for running LMTP
22810 over a pipe to a local process &-- see chapter &<<CHAPLMTP>>&.
22811
22812 If this option is set to &"smtps"&, the default vaule for the &%port%& option
22813 changes to &"smtps"&, and the transport initiates TLS immediately after
22814 connecting, as an outbound SSL-on-connect, instead of using STARTTLS to upgrade.
22815 The Internet standards bodies strongly discourage use of this mode.
22816
22817
22818 .option retry_include_ip_address smtp boolean true
22819 Exim normally includes both the host name and the IP address in the key it
22820 constructs for indexing retry data after a temporary delivery failure. This
22821 means that when one of several IP addresses for a host is failing, it gets
22822 tried periodically (controlled by the retry rules), but use of the other IP
22823 addresses is not affected.
22824
22825 However, in some dialup environments hosts are assigned a different IP address
22826 each time they connect. In this situation the use of the IP address as part of
22827 the retry key leads to undesirable behaviour. Setting this option false causes
22828 Exim to use only the host name. This should normally be done on a separate
22829 instance of the &(smtp)& transport, set up specially to handle the dialup
22830 hosts.
22831
22832
22833 .option serialize_hosts smtp "host list&!!" unset
22834 .cindex "serializing connections"
22835 .cindex "host" "serializing connections"
22836 Because Exim operates in a distributed manner, if several messages for the same
22837 host arrive at around the same time, more than one simultaneous connection to
22838 the remote host can occur. This is not usually a problem except when there is a
22839 slow link between the hosts. In that situation it may be helpful to restrict
22840 Exim to one connection at a time. This can be done by setting
22841 &%serialize_hosts%& to match the relevant hosts.
22842
22843 .cindex "hints database" "serializing deliveries to a host"
22844 Exim implements serialization by means of a hints database in which a record is
22845 written whenever a process connects to one of the restricted hosts. The record
22846 is deleted when the connection is completed. Obviously there is scope for
22847 records to get left lying around if there is a system or program crash. To
22848 guard against this, Exim ignores any records that are more than six hours old.
22849
22850 If you set up this kind of serialization, you should also arrange to delete the
22851 relevant hints database whenever your system reboots. The names of the files
22852 start with &_misc_& and they are kept in the &_spool/db_& directory. There
22853 may be one or two files, depending on the type of DBM in use. The same files
22854 are used for ETRN serialization.
22855
22856
22857 .option size_addition smtp integer 1024
22858 .cindex "SMTP" "SIZE"
22859 .cindex "message" "size issue for transport filter"
22860 .cindex "size" "of message"
22861 .cindex "transport" "filter"
22862 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
22863 If a remote SMTP server indicates that it supports the SIZE option of the
22864 MAIL command, Exim uses this to pass over the message size at the start of
22865 an SMTP transaction. It adds the value of &%size_addition%& to the value it
22866 sends, to allow for headers and other text that may be added during delivery by
22867 configuration options or in a transport filter. It may be necessary to increase
22868 this if a lot of text is added to messages.
22869
22870 Alternatively, if the value of &%size_addition%& is set negative, it disables
22871 the use of the SIZE option altogether.
22872
22873
22874 .option tls_certificate smtp string&!! unset
22875 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate, location of"
22876 .cindex "certificate" "client, location of"
22877 .vindex "&$host$&"
22878 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
22879 The value of this option must be the absolute path to a file which contains the
22880 client's certificate, for possible use when sending a message over an encrypted
22881 connection. The values of &$host$& and &$host_address$& are set to the name and
22882 address of the server during the expansion. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for
22883 details of TLS.
22884
22885 &*Note*&: This option must be set if you want Exim to be able to use a TLS
22886 certificate when sending messages as a client. The global option of the same
22887 name specifies the certificate for Exim as a server; it is not automatically
22888 assumed that the same certificate should be used when Exim is operating as a
22889 client.
22890
22891
22892 .option tls_crl smtp string&!! unset
22893 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate revocation list"
22894 .cindex "certificate" "revocation list for client"
22895 This option specifies a certificate revocation list. The expanded value must
22896 be the name of a file that contains a CRL in PEM format.
22897
22898
22899 .option tls_dh_min_bits smtp integer 1024
22900 .cindex "TLS" "Diffie-Hellman minimum acceptable size"
22901 When establishing a TLS session, if a ciphersuite which uses Diffie-Hellman
22902 key agreement is negotiated, the server will provide a large prime number
22903 for use. This option establishes the minimum acceptable size of that number.
22904 If the parameter offered by the server is too small, then the TLS handshake
22905 will fail.
22906
22907 Only supported when using GnuTLS.
22908
22909
22910 .option tls_privatekey smtp string&!! unset
22911 .cindex "TLS" "client private key, location of"
22912 .vindex "&$host$&"
22913 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
22914 The value of this option must be the absolute path to a file which contains the
22915 client's private key. This is used when sending a message over an encrypted
22916 connection using a client certificate. The values of &$host$& and
22917 &$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
22918 expansion. If this option is unset, or the expansion is forced to fail, or the
22919 result is an empty string, the private key is assumed to be in the same file as
22920 the certificate. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
22921
22922
22923 .option tls_require_ciphers smtp string&!! unset
22924 .cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers"
22925 .cindex "cipher" "requiring specific"
22926 .vindex "&$host$&"
22927 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
22928 The value of this option must be a list of permitted cipher suites, for use
22929 when setting up an outgoing encrypted connection. (There is a global option of
22930 the same name for controlling incoming connections.) The values of &$host$& and
22931 &$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
22932 expansion. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS; note that this option
22933 is used in different ways by OpenSSL and GnuTLS (see sections
22934 &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&). For GnuTLS, the order of the
22935 ciphers is a preference order.
22936
22937
22938
22939 .option tls_sni smtp string&!! unset
22940 .cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
22941 .vindex "&$tls_sni$&"
22942 If this option is set then it sets the $tls_out_sni variable and causes any
22943 TLS session to pass this value as the Server Name Indication extension to
22944 the remote side, which can be used by the remote side to select an appropriate
22945 certificate and private key for the session.
22946
22947 See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for more information.
22948
22949 Note that for OpenSSL, this feature requires a build of OpenSSL that supports
22950 TLS extensions.
22951
22952
22953
22954
22955 .option tls_tempfail_tryclear smtp boolean true
22956 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "to STARTTLS"
22957 When the server host is not in &%hosts_require_tls%&, and there is a problem in
22958 setting up a TLS session, this option determines whether or not Exim should try
22959 to deliver the message unencrypted. If it is set false, delivery to the
22960 current host is deferred; if there are other hosts, they are tried. If this
22961 option is set true, Exim attempts to deliver unencrypted after a 4&'xx'&
22962 response to STARTTLS. Also, if STARTTLS is accepted, but the subsequent
22963 TLS negotiation fails, Exim closes the current connection (because it is in an
22964 unknown state), opens a new one to the same host, and then tries the delivery
22965 in clear.
22966
22967
22968 .option tls_verify_certificates smtp string&!! unset
22969 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate verification"
22970 .cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
22971 .vindex "&$host$&"
22972 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
22973 The value of this option must be the absolute path to a file containing
22974 permitted server certificates, for use when setting up an encrypted connection.
22975 Alternatively, if you are using OpenSSL, you can set
22976 &%tls_verify_certificates%& to the name of a directory containing certificate
22977 files. This does not work with GnuTLS; the option must be set to the name of a
22978 single file if you are using GnuTLS. The values of &$host$& and
22979 &$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
22980 expansion of this option. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
22981
22982
22983
22984
22985 .section "How the limits for the number of hosts to try are used" &&&
22986 "SECTvalhosmax"
22987 .cindex "host" "maximum number to try"
22988 .cindex "limit" "hosts; maximum number tried"
22989 There are two options that are concerned with the number of hosts that are
22990 tried when an SMTP delivery takes place. They are &%hosts_max_try%& and
22991 &%hosts_max_try_hardlimit%&.
22992
22993
22994 The &%hosts_max_try%& option limits the number of hosts that are tried
22995 for a single delivery. However, despite the term &"host"& in its name, the
22996 option actually applies to each IP address independently. In other words, a
22997 multihomed host is treated as several independent hosts, just as it is for
22998 retrying.
22999
23000 Many of the larger ISPs have multiple MX records which often point to
23001 multihomed hosts. As a result, a list of a dozen or more IP addresses may be
23002 created as a result of routing one of these domains.
23003
23004 Trying every single IP address on such a long list does not seem sensible; if
23005 several at the top of the list fail, it is reasonable to assume there is some
23006 problem that is likely to affect all of them. Roughly speaking, the value of
23007 &%hosts_max_try%& is the maximum number that are tried before deferring the
23008 delivery. However, the logic cannot be quite that simple.
23009
23010 Firstly, IP addresses that are skipped because their retry times have not
23011 arrived do not count, and in addition, addresses that are past their retry
23012 limits are also not counted, even when they are tried. This means that when
23013 some IP addresses are past their retry limits, more than the value of
23014 &%hosts_max_retry%& may be tried. The reason for this behaviour is to ensure
23015 that all IP addresses are considered before timing out an email address (but
23016 see below for an exception).
23017
23018 Secondly, when the &%hosts_max_try%& limit is reached, Exim looks down the host
23019 list to see if there is a subsequent host with a different (higher valued) MX.
23020 If there is, that host is considered next, and the current IP address is used
23021 but not counted. This behaviour helps in the case of a domain with a retry rule
23022 that hardly ever delays any hosts, as is now explained:
23023
23024 Consider the case of a long list of hosts with one MX value, and a few with a
23025 higher MX value. If &%hosts_max_try%& is small (the default is 5) only a few
23026 hosts at the top of the list are tried at first. With the default retry rule,
23027 which specifies increasing retry times, the higher MX hosts are eventually
23028 tried when those at the top of the list are skipped because they have not
23029 reached their retry times.
23030
23031 However, it is common practice to put a fixed short retry time on domains for
23032 large ISPs, on the grounds that their servers are rarely down for very long.
23033 Unfortunately, these are exactly the domains that tend to resolve to long lists
23034 of hosts. The short retry time means that the lowest MX hosts are tried every
23035 time. The attempts may be in a different order because of random sorting, but
23036 without the special MX check, the higher MX hosts would never be tried until
23037 all the lower MX hosts had timed out (which might be several days), because
23038 there are always some lower MX hosts that have reached their retry times. With
23039 the special check, Exim considers at least one IP address from each MX value at
23040 every delivery attempt, even if the &%hosts_max_try%& limit has already been
23041 reached.
23042
23043 The above logic means that &%hosts_max_try%& is not a hard limit, and in
23044 particular, Exim normally eventually tries all the IP addresses before timing
23045 out an email address. When &%hosts_max_try%& was implemented, this seemed a
23046 reasonable thing to do. Recently, however, some lunatic DNS configurations have
23047 been set up with hundreds of IP addresses for some domains. It can
23048 take a very long time indeed for an address to time out in these cases.
23049
23050 The &%hosts_max_try_hardlimit%& option was added to help with this problem.
23051 Exim never tries more than this number of IP addresses; if it hits this limit
23052 and they are all timed out, the email address is bounced, even though not all
23053 possible IP addresses have been tried.
23054 .ecindex IIDsmttra1
23055 .ecindex IIDsmttra2
23056
23057
23058
23059
23060
23061 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23062 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23063
23064 .chapter "Address rewriting" "CHAPrewrite"
23065 .scindex IIDaddrew "rewriting" "addresses"
23066 There are some circumstances in which Exim automatically rewrites domains in
23067 addresses. The two most common are when an address is given without a domain
23068 (referred to as an &"unqualified address"&) or when an address contains an
23069 abbreviated domain that is expanded by DNS lookup.
23070
23071 Unqualified envelope addresses are accepted only for locally submitted
23072 messages, or for messages that are received from hosts matching
23073 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&, as
23074 appropriate. Unqualified addresses in header lines are qualified if they are in
23075 locally submitted messages, or messages from hosts that are permitted to send
23076 unqualified envelope addresses. Otherwise, unqualified addresses in header
23077 lines are neither qualified nor rewritten.
23078
23079 One situation in which Exim does &'not'& automatically rewrite a domain is
23080 when it is the name of a CNAME record in the DNS. The older RFCs suggest that
23081 such a domain should be rewritten using the &"canonical"& name, and some MTAs
23082 do this. The new RFCs do not contain this suggestion.
23083
23084
23085 .section "Explicitly configured address rewriting" "SECID147"
23086 This chapter describes the rewriting rules that can be used in the
23087 main rewrite section of the configuration file, and also in the generic
23088 &%headers_rewrite%& option that can be set on any transport.
23089
23090 Some people believe that configured address rewriting is a Mortal Sin.
23091 Others believe that life is not possible without it. Exim provides the
23092 facility; you do not have to use it.
23093
23094 The main rewriting rules that appear in the &"rewrite"& section of the
23095 configuration file are applied to addresses in incoming messages, both envelope
23096 addresses and addresses in header lines. Each rule specifies the types of
23097 address to which it applies.
23098
23099 Whether or not addresses in header lines are rewritten depends on the origin of
23100 the headers and the type of rewriting. Global rewriting, that is, rewriting
23101 rules from the rewrite section of the configuration file, is applied only to
23102 those headers that were received with the message. Header lines that are added
23103 by ACLs or by a system filter or by individual routers or transports (which
23104 are specific to individual recipient addresses) are not rewritten by the global
23105 rules.
23106
23107 Rewriting at transport time, by means of the &%headers_rewrite%& option,
23108 applies all headers except those added by routers and transports. That is, as
23109 well as the headers that were received with the message, it also applies to
23110 headers that were added by an ACL or a system filter.
23111
23112
23113 In general, rewriting addresses from your own system or domain has some
23114 legitimacy. Rewriting other addresses should be done only with great care and
23115 in special circumstances. The author of Exim believes that rewriting should be
23116 used sparingly, and mainly for &"regularizing"& addresses in your own domains.
23117 Although it can sometimes be used as a routing tool, this is very strongly
23118 discouraged.
23119
23120 There are two commonly encountered circumstances where rewriting is used, as
23121 illustrated by these examples:
23122
23123 .ilist
23124 The company whose domain is &'hitch.fict.example'& has a number of hosts that
23125 exchange mail with each other behind a firewall, but there is only a single
23126 gateway to the outer world. The gateway rewrites &'*.hitch.fict.example'& as
23127 &'hitch.fict.example'& when sending mail off-site.
23128 .next
23129 A host rewrites the local parts of its own users so that, for example,
23130 &'fp42@hitch.fict.example'& becomes &'Ford.Prefect@hitch.fict.example'&.
23131 .endlist
23132
23133
23134
23135 .section "When does rewriting happen?" "SECID148"
23136 .cindex "rewriting" "timing of"
23137 .cindex "&ACL;" "rewriting addresses in"
23138 Configured address rewriting can take place at several different stages of a
23139 message's processing.
23140
23141 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
23142 At the start of an ACL for MAIL, the sender address may have been rewritten
23143 by a special SMTP-time rewrite rule (see section &<<SECTrewriteS>>&), but no
23144 ordinary rewrite rules have yet been applied. If, however, the sender address
23145 is verified in the ACL, it is rewritten before verification, and remains
23146 rewritten thereafter. The subsequent value of &$sender_address$& is the
23147 rewritten address. This also applies if sender verification happens in a
23148 RCPT ACL. Otherwise, when the sender address is not verified, it is
23149 rewritten as soon as a message's header lines have been received.
23150
23151 .vindex "&$domain$&"
23152 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
23153 Similarly, at the start of an ACL for RCPT, the current recipient's address
23154 may have been rewritten by a special SMTP-time rewrite rule, but no ordinary
23155 rewrite rules have yet been applied to it. However, the behaviour is different
23156 from the sender address when a recipient is verified. The address is rewritten
23157 for the verification, but the rewriting is not remembered at this stage. The
23158 value of &$local_part$& and &$domain$& after verification are always the same
23159 as they were before (that is, they contain the unrewritten &-- except for
23160 SMTP-time rewriting &-- address).
23161
23162 As soon as a message's header lines have been received, all the envelope
23163 recipient addresses are permanently rewritten, and rewriting is also applied to
23164 the addresses in the header lines (if configured). This happens before adding
23165 any header lines that were specified in MAIL or RCPT ACLs, and
23166 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "address rewriting; timing of"
23167 before the DATA ACL and &[local_scan()]& functions are run.
23168
23169 When an address is being routed, either for delivery or for verification,
23170 rewriting is applied immediately to child addresses that are generated by
23171 redirection, unless &%no_rewrite%& is set on the router.
23172
23173 .cindex "envelope sender" "rewriting at transport time"
23174 .cindex "rewriting" "at transport time"
23175 .cindex "header lines" "rewriting at transport time"
23176 At transport time, additional rewriting of addresses in header lines can be
23177 specified by setting the generic &%headers_rewrite%& option on a transport.
23178 This option contains rules that are identical in form to those in the rewrite
23179 section of the configuration file. They are applied to the original message
23180 header lines and any that were added by ACLs or a system filter. They are not
23181 applied to header lines that are added by routers or the transport.
23182
23183 The outgoing envelope sender can be rewritten by means of the &%return_path%&
23184 transport option. However, it is not possible to rewrite envelope recipients at
23185 transport time.
23186
23187
23188
23189
23190 .section "Testing the rewriting rules that apply on input" "SECID149"
23191 .cindex "rewriting" "testing"
23192 .cindex "testing" "rewriting"
23193 Exim's input rewriting configuration appears in a part of the run time
23194 configuration file headed by &"begin rewrite"&. It can be tested by the
23195 &%-brw%& command line option. This takes an address (which can be a full RFC
23196 2822 address) as its argument. The output is a list of how the address would be
23197 transformed by the rewriting rules for each of the different places it might
23198 appear in an incoming message, that is, for each different header and for the
23199 envelope sender and recipient fields. For example,
23200 .code
23201 exim -brw ph10@exim.workshop.example
23202 .endd
23203 might produce the output
23204 .code
23205 sender: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
23206 from: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
23207 to: ph10@exim.workshop.example
23208 cc: ph10@exim.workshop.example
23209 bcc: ph10@exim.workshop.example
23210 reply-to: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
23211 env-from: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
23212 env-to: ph10@exim.workshop.example
23213 .endd
23214 which shows that rewriting has been set up for that address when used in any of
23215 the source fields, but not when it appears as a recipient address. At the
23216 present time, there is no equivalent way of testing rewriting rules that are
23217 set for a particular transport.
23218
23219
23220 .section "Rewriting rules" "SECID150"
23221 .cindex "rewriting" "rules"
23222 The rewrite section of the configuration file consists of lines of rewriting
23223 rules in the form
23224 .display
23225 <&'source pattern'&> <&'replacement'&> <&'flags'&>
23226 .endd
23227 Rewriting rules that are specified for the &%headers_rewrite%& generic
23228 transport option are given as a colon-separated list. Each item in the list
23229 takes the same form as a line in the main rewriting configuration (except that
23230 any colons must be doubled, of course).
23231
23232 The formats of source patterns and replacement strings are described below.
23233 Each is terminated by white space, unless enclosed in double quotes, in which
23234 case normal quoting conventions apply inside the quotes. The flags are single
23235 characters which may appear in any order. Spaces and tabs between them are
23236 ignored.
23237
23238 For each address that could potentially be rewritten, the rules are scanned in
23239 order, and replacements for the address from earlier rules can themselves be
23240 replaced by later rules (but see the &"q"& and &"R"& flags).
23241
23242 The order in which addresses are rewritten is undefined, may change between
23243 releases, and must not be relied on, with one exception: when a message is
23244 received, the envelope sender is always rewritten first, before any header
23245 lines are rewritten. For example, the replacement string for a rewrite of an
23246 address in &'To:'& must not assume that the message's address in &'From:'& has
23247 (or has not) already been rewritten. However, a rewrite of &'From:'& may assume
23248 that the envelope sender has already been rewritten.
23249
23250 .vindex "&$domain$&"
23251 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
23252 The variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$& can be used in the replacement
23253 string to refer to the address that is being rewritten. Note that lookup-driven
23254 rewriting can be done by a rule of the form
23255 .code
23256 *@* ${lookup ...
23257 .endd
23258 where the lookup key uses &$1$& and &$2$& or &$local_part$& and &$domain$& to
23259 refer to the address that is being rewritten.
23260
23261
23262 .section "Rewriting patterns" "SECID151"
23263 .cindex "rewriting" "patterns"
23264 .cindex "address list" "in a rewriting pattern"
23265 The source pattern in a rewriting rule is any item which may appear in an
23266 address list (see section &<<SECTaddresslist>>&). It is in fact processed as a
23267 single-item address list, which means that it is expanded before being tested
23268 against the address. As always, if you use a regular expression as a pattern,
23269 you must take care to escape dollar and backslash characters, or use the &`\N`&
23270 facility to suppress string expansion within the regular expression.
23271
23272 Domains in patterns should be given in lower case. Local parts in patterns are
23273 case-sensitive. If you want to do case-insensitive matching of local parts, you
23274 can use a regular expression that starts with &`^(?i)`&.
23275
23276 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in rewriting rules"
23277 After matching, the numerical variables &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. may be set,
23278 depending on the type of match which occurred. These can be used in the
23279 replacement string to insert portions of the incoming address. &$0$& always
23280 refers to the complete incoming address. When a regular expression is used, the
23281 numerical variables are set from its capturing subexpressions. For other types
23282 of pattern they are set as follows:
23283
23284 .ilist
23285 If a local part or domain starts with an asterisk, the numerical variables
23286 refer to the character strings matched by asterisks, with &$1$& associated with
23287 the first asterisk, and &$2$& with the second, if present. For example, if the
23288 pattern
23289 .code
23290 *queen@*.fict.example
23291 .endd
23292 is matched against the address &'hearts-queen@wonderland.fict.example'& then
23293 .code
23294 $0 = hearts-queen@wonderland.fict.example
23295 $1 = hearts-
23296 $2 = wonderland
23297 .endd
23298 Note that if the local part does not start with an asterisk, but the domain
23299 does, it is &$1$& that contains the wild part of the domain.
23300
23301 .next
23302 If the domain part of the pattern is a partial lookup, the wild and fixed parts
23303 of the domain are placed in the next available numerical variables. Suppose,
23304 for example, that the address &'foo@bar.baz.example'& is processed by a
23305 rewriting rule of the form
23306 .display
23307 &`*@partial-dbm;/some/dbm/file`& <&'replacement string'&>
23308 .endd
23309 and the key in the file that matches the domain is &`*.baz.example`&. Then
23310 .code
23311 $1 = foo
23312 $2 = bar
23313 $3 = baz.example
23314 .endd
23315 If the address &'foo@baz.example'& is looked up, this matches the same
23316 wildcard file entry, and in this case &$2$& is set to the empty string, but
23317 &$3$& is still set to &'baz.example'&. If a non-wild key is matched in a
23318 partial lookup, &$2$& is again set to the empty string and &$3$& is set to the
23319 whole domain. For non-partial domain lookups, no numerical variables are set.
23320 .endlist
23321
23322
23323 .section "Rewriting replacements" "SECID152"
23324 .cindex "rewriting" "replacements"
23325 If the replacement string for a rule is a single asterisk, addresses that
23326 match the pattern and the flags are &'not'& rewritten, and no subsequent
23327 rewriting rules are scanned. For example,
23328 .code
23329 hatta@lookingglass.fict.example * f
23330 .endd
23331 specifies that &'hatta@lookingglass.fict.example'& is never to be rewritten in
23332 &'From:'& headers.
23333
23334 .vindex "&$domain$&"
23335 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
23336 If the replacement string is not a single asterisk, it is expanded, and must
23337 yield a fully qualified address. Within the expansion, the variables
23338 &$local_part$& and &$domain$& refer to the address that is being rewritten.
23339 Any letters they contain retain their original case &-- they are not lower
23340 cased. The numerical variables are set up according to the type of pattern that
23341 matched the address, as described above. If the expansion is forced to fail by
23342 the presence of &"fail"& in a conditional or lookup item, rewriting by the
23343 current rule is abandoned, but subsequent rules may take effect. Any other
23344 expansion failure causes the entire rewriting operation to be abandoned, and an
23345 entry written to the panic log.
23346
23347
23348
23349 .section "Rewriting flags" "SECID153"
23350 There are three different kinds of flag that may appear on rewriting rules:
23351
23352 .ilist
23353 Flags that specify which headers and envelope addresses to rewrite: E, F, T, b,
23354 c, f, h, r, s, t.
23355 .next
23356 A flag that specifies rewriting at SMTP time: S.
23357 .next
23358 Flags that control the rewriting process: Q, q, R, w.
23359 .endlist
23360
23361 For rules that are part of the &%headers_rewrite%& generic transport option,
23362 E, F, T, and S are not permitted.
23363
23364
23365
23366 .section "Flags specifying which headers and envelope addresses to rewrite" &&&
23367 "SECID154"
23368 .cindex "rewriting" "flags"
23369 If none of the following flag letters, nor the &"S"& flag (see section
23370 &<<SECTrewriteS>>&) are present, a main rewriting rule applies to all headers
23371 and to both the sender and recipient fields of the envelope, whereas a
23372 transport-time rewriting rule just applies to all headers. Otherwise, the
23373 rewriting rule is skipped unless the relevant addresses are being processed.
23374 .display
23375 &`E`& rewrite all envelope fields
23376 &`F`& rewrite the envelope From field
23377 &`T`& rewrite the envelope To field
23378 &`b`& rewrite the &'Bcc:'& header
23379 &`c`& rewrite the &'Cc:'& header
23380 &`f`& rewrite the &'From:'& header
23381 &`h`& rewrite all headers
23382 &`r`& rewrite the &'Reply-To:'& header
23383 &`s`& rewrite the &'Sender:'& header
23384 &`t`& rewrite the &'To:'& header
23385 .endd
23386 "All headers" means all of the headers listed above that can be selected
23387 individually, plus their &'Resent-'& versions. It does not include
23388 other headers such as &'Subject:'& etc.
23389
23390 You should be particularly careful about rewriting &'Sender:'& headers, and
23391 restrict this to special known cases in your own domains.
23392
23393
23394 .section "The SMTP-time rewriting flag" "SECTrewriteS"
23395 .cindex "SMTP" "rewriting malformed addresses"
23396 .cindex "RCPT" "rewriting argument of"
23397 .cindex "MAIL" "rewriting argument of"
23398 The rewrite flag &"S"& specifies a rewrite of incoming envelope addresses at
23399 SMTP time, as soon as an address is received in a MAIL or RCPT command, and
23400 before any other processing; even before syntax checking. The pattern is
23401 required to be a regular expression, and it is matched against the whole of the
23402 data for the command, including any surrounding angle brackets.
23403
23404 .vindex "&$domain$&"
23405 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
23406 This form of rewrite rule allows for the handling of addresses that are not
23407 compliant with RFCs 2821 and 2822 (for example, &"bang paths"& in batched SMTP
23408 input). Because the input is not required to be a syntactically valid address,
23409 the variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$& are not available during the
23410 expansion of the replacement string. The result of rewriting replaces the
23411 original address in the MAIL or RCPT command.
23412
23413
23414 .section "Flags controlling the rewriting process" "SECID155"
23415 There are four flags which control the way the rewriting process works. These
23416 take effect only when a rule is invoked, that is, when the address is of the
23417 correct type (matches the flags) and matches the pattern:
23418
23419 .ilist
23420 If the &"Q"& flag is set on a rule, the rewritten address is permitted to be an
23421 unqualified local part. It is qualified with &%qualify_recipient%&. In the
23422 absence of &"Q"& the rewritten address must always include a domain.
23423 .next
23424 If the &"q"& flag is set on a rule, no further rewriting rules are considered,
23425 even if no rewriting actually takes place because of a &"fail"& in the
23426 expansion. The &"q"& flag is not effective if the address is of the wrong type
23427 (does not match the flags) or does not match the pattern.
23428 .next
23429 The &"R"& flag causes a successful rewriting rule to be re-applied to the new
23430 address, up to ten times. It can be combined with the &"q"& flag, to stop
23431 rewriting once it fails to match (after at least one successful rewrite).
23432 .next
23433 .cindex "rewriting" "whole addresses"
23434 When an address in a header is rewritten, the rewriting normally applies only
23435 to the working part of the address, with any comments and RFC 2822 &"phrase"&
23436 left unchanged. For example, rewriting might change
23437 .code
23438 From: Ford Prefect <fp42@restaurant.hitch.fict.example>
23439 .endd
23440 into
23441 .code
23442 From: Ford Prefect <prefectf@hitch.fict.example>
23443 .endd
23444 .cindex "RFC 2047"
23445 Sometimes there is a need to replace the whole address item, and this can be
23446 done by adding the flag letter &"w"& to a rule. If this is set on a rule that
23447 causes an address in a header line to be rewritten, the entire address is
23448 replaced, not just the working part. The replacement must be a complete RFC
23449 2822 address, including the angle brackets if necessary. If text outside angle
23450 brackets contains a character whose value is greater than 126 or less than 32
23451 (except for tab), the text is encoded according to RFC 2047. The character set
23452 is taken from &%headers_charset%&, which defaults to ISO-8859-1.
23453
23454 When the &"w"& flag is set on a rule that causes an envelope address to be
23455 rewritten, all but the working part of the replacement address is discarded.
23456 .endlist
23457
23458
23459 .section "Rewriting examples" "SECID156"
23460 Here is an example of the two common rewriting paradigms:
23461 .code
23462 *@*.hitch.fict.example $1@hitch.fict.example
23463 *@hitch.fict.example ${lookup{$1}dbm{/etc/realnames}\
23464 {$value}fail}@hitch.fict.example bctfrF
23465 .endd
23466 Note the use of &"fail"& in the lookup expansion in the second rule, forcing
23467 the string expansion to fail if the lookup does not succeed. In this context it
23468 has the effect of leaving the original address unchanged, but Exim goes on to
23469 consider subsequent rewriting rules, if any, because the &"q"& flag is not
23470 present in that rule. An alternative to &"fail"& would be to supply &$1$&
23471 explicitly, which would cause the rewritten address to be the same as before,
23472 at the cost of a small bit of processing. Not supplying either of these is an
23473 error, since the rewritten address would then contain no local part.
23474
23475 The first example above replaces the domain with a superior, more general
23476 domain. This may not be desirable for certain local parts. If the rule
23477 .code
23478 root@*.hitch.fict.example *
23479 .endd
23480 were inserted before the first rule, rewriting would be suppressed for the
23481 local part &'root'& at any domain ending in &'hitch.fict.example'&.
23482
23483 Rewriting can be made conditional on a number of tests, by making use of
23484 &${if$& in the expansion item. For example, to apply a rewriting rule only to
23485 messages that originate outside the local host:
23486 .code
23487 *@*.hitch.fict.example "${if !eq {$sender_host_address}{}\
23488 {$1@hitch.fict.example}fail}"
23489 .endd
23490 The replacement string is quoted in this example because it contains white
23491 space.
23492
23493 .cindex "rewriting" "bang paths"
23494 .cindex "bang paths" "rewriting"
23495 Exim does not handle addresses in the form of &"bang paths"&. If it sees such
23496 an address it treats it as an unqualified local part which it qualifies with
23497 the local qualification domain (if the source of the message is local or if the
23498 remote host is permitted to send unqualified addresses). Rewriting can
23499 sometimes be used to handle simple bang paths with a fixed number of
23500 components. For example, the rule
23501 .code
23502 \N^([^!]+)!(.*)@your.domain.example$\N $2@$1
23503 .endd
23504 rewrites a two-component bang path &'host.name!user'& as the domain address
23505 &'user@host.name'&. However, there is a security implication in using this as
23506 a global rewriting rule for envelope addresses. It can provide a backdoor
23507 method for using your system as a relay, because the incoming addresses appear
23508 to be local. If the bang path addresses are received via SMTP, it is safer to
23509 use the &"S"& flag to rewrite them as they are received, so that relay checking
23510 can be done on the rewritten addresses.
23511 .ecindex IIDaddrew
23512
23513
23514
23515
23516
23517 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23518 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23519
23520 .chapter "Retry configuration" "CHAPretry"
23521 .scindex IIDretconf1 "retry" "configuration, description of"
23522 .scindex IIDregconf2 "configuration file" "retry section"
23523 The &"retry"& section of the runtime configuration file contains a list of
23524 retry rules that control how often Exim tries to deliver messages that cannot
23525 be delivered at the first attempt. If there are no retry rules (the section is
23526 empty or not present), there are no retries. In this situation, temporary
23527 errors are treated as permanent. The default configuration contains a single,
23528 general-purpose retry rule (see section &<<SECID57>>&). The &%-brt%& command
23529 line option can be used to test which retry rule will be used for a given
23530 address, domain and error.
23531
23532 The most common cause of retries is temporary failure to deliver to a remote
23533 host because the host is down, or inaccessible because of a network problem.
23534 Exim's retry processing in this case is applied on a per-host (strictly, per IP
23535 address) basis, not on a per-message basis. Thus, if one message has recently
23536 been delayed, delivery of a new message to the same host is not immediately
23537 tried, but waits for the host's retry time to arrive. If the &%retry_defer%&
23538 log selector is set, the message
23539 .cindex "retry" "time not reached"
23540 &"retry time not reached"& is written to the main log whenever a delivery is
23541 skipped for this reason. Section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>& contains more details of
23542 the handling of errors during remote deliveries.
23543
23544 Retry processing applies to routing as well as to delivering, except as covered
23545 in the next paragraph. The retry rules do not distinguish between these
23546 actions. It is not possible, for example, to specify different behaviour for
23547 failures to route the domain &'snark.fict.example'& and failures to deliver to
23548 the host &'snark.fict.example'&. I didn't think anyone would ever need this
23549 added complication, so did not implement it. However, although they share the
23550 same retry rule, the actual retry times for routing and transporting a given
23551 domain are maintained independently.
23552
23553 When a delivery is not part of a queue run (typically an immediate delivery on
23554 receipt of a message), the routers are always run, and local deliveries are
23555 always attempted, even if retry times are set for them. This makes for better
23556 behaviour if one particular message is causing problems (for example, causing
23557 quota overflow, or provoking an error in a filter file). If such a delivery
23558 suffers a temporary failure, the retry data is updated as normal, and
23559 subsequent delivery attempts from queue runs occur only when the retry time for
23560 the local address is reached.
23561
23562 .section "Changing retry rules" "SECID157"
23563 If you change the retry rules in your configuration, you should consider
23564 whether or not to delete the retry data that is stored in Exim's spool area in
23565 files with names like &_db/retry_&. Deleting any of Exim's hints files is
23566 always safe; that is why they are called &"hints"&.
23567
23568 The hints retry data contains suggested retry times based on the previous
23569 rules. In the case of a long-running problem with a remote host, it might
23570 record the fact that the host has timed out. If your new rules increase the
23571 timeout time for such a host, you should definitely remove the old retry data
23572 and let Exim recreate it, based on the new rules. Otherwise Exim might bounce
23573 messages that it should now be retaining.
23574
23575
23576
23577 .section "Format of retry rules" "SECID158"
23578 .cindex "retry" "rules"
23579 Each retry rule occupies one line and consists of three or four parts,
23580 separated by white space: a pattern, an error name, an optional list of sender
23581 addresses, and a list of retry parameters. The pattern and sender lists must be
23582 enclosed in double quotes if they contain white space. The rules are searched
23583 in order until one is found where the pattern, error name, and sender list (if
23584 present) match the failing host or address, the error that occurred, and the
23585 message's sender, respectively.
23586
23587
23588 The pattern is any single item that may appear in an address list (see section
23589 &<<SECTaddresslist>>&). It is in fact processed as a one-item address list,
23590 which means that it is expanded before being tested against the address that
23591 has been delayed. A negated address list item is permitted. Address
23592 list processing treats a plain domain name as if it were preceded by &"*@"&,
23593 which makes it possible for many retry rules to start with just a domain. For
23594 example,
23595 .code
23596 lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
23597 .endd
23598 provides a rule for any address in the &'lookingglass.fict.example'& domain,
23599 whereas
23600 .code
23601 alice@lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
23602 .endd
23603 applies only to temporary failures involving the local part &%alice%&.
23604 In practice, almost all rules start with a domain name pattern without a local
23605 part.
23606
23607 .cindex "regular expressions" "in retry rules"
23608 &*Warning*&: If you use a regular expression in a retry rule pattern, it
23609 must match a complete address, not just a domain, because that is how regular
23610 expressions work in address lists.
23611 .display
23612 &`^\Nxyz\d+\.abc\.example$\N * G,1h,10m,2`& &%Wrong%&
23613 &`^\N[^@]+@xyz\d+\.abc\.example$\N * G,1h,10m,2`& &%Right%&
23614 .endd
23615
23616
23617 .section "Choosing which retry rule to use for address errors" "SECID159"
23618 When Exim is looking for a retry rule after a routing attempt has failed (for
23619 example, after a DNS timeout), each line in the retry configuration is tested
23620 against the complete address only if &%retry_use_local_part%& is set for the
23621 router. Otherwise, only the domain is used, except when matching against a
23622 regular expression, when the local part of the address is replaced with &"*"&.
23623 A domain on its own can match a domain pattern, or a pattern that starts with
23624 &"*@"&. By default, &%retry_use_local_part%& is true for routers where
23625 &%check_local_user%& is true, and false for other routers.
23626
23627 Similarly, when Exim is looking for a retry rule after a local delivery has
23628 failed (for example, after a mailbox full error), each line in the retry
23629 configuration is tested against the complete address only if
23630 &%retry_use_local_part%& is set for the transport (it defaults true for all
23631 local transports).
23632
23633 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "retry rules for"
23634 However, when Exim is looking for a retry rule after a remote delivery attempt
23635 suffers an address error (a 4&'xx'& SMTP response for a recipient address), the
23636 whole address is always used as the key when searching the retry rules. The
23637 rule that is found is used to create a retry time for the combination of the
23638 failing address and the message's sender. It is the combination of sender and
23639 recipient that is delayed in subsequent queue runs until its retry time is
23640 reached. You can delay the recipient without regard to the sender by setting
23641 &%address_retry_include_sender%& false in the &(smtp)& transport but this can
23642 lead to problems with servers that regularly issue 4&'xx'& responses to RCPT
23643 commands.
23644
23645
23646
23647 .section "Choosing which retry rule to use for host and message errors" &&&
23648 "SECID160"
23649 For a temporary error that is not related to an individual address (for
23650 example, a connection timeout), each line in the retry configuration is checked
23651 twice. First, the name of the remote host is used as a domain name (preceded by
23652 &"*@"& when matching a regular expression). If this does not match the line,
23653 the domain from the email address is tried in a similar fashion. For example,
23654 suppose the MX records for &'a.b.c.example'& are
23655 .code
23656 a.b.c.example MX 5 x.y.z.example
23657 MX 6 p.q.r.example
23658 MX 7 m.n.o.example
23659 .endd
23660 and the retry rules are
23661 .code
23662 p.q.r.example * F,24h,30m;
23663 a.b.c.example * F,4d,45m;
23664 .endd
23665 and a delivery to the host &'x.y.z.example'& suffers a connection failure. The
23666 first rule matches neither the host nor the domain, so Exim looks at the second
23667 rule. This does not match the host, but it does match the domain, so it is used
23668 to calculate the retry time for the host &'x.y.z.example'&. Meanwhile, Exim
23669 tries to deliver to &'p.q.r.example'&. If this also suffers a host error, the
23670 first retry rule is used, because it matches the host.
23671
23672 In other words, temporary failures to deliver to host &'p.q.r.example'& use the
23673 first rule to determine retry times, but for all the other hosts for the domain
23674 &'a.b.c.example'&, the second rule is used. The second rule is also used if
23675 routing to &'a.b.c.example'& suffers a temporary failure.
23676
23677 &*Note*&: The host name is used when matching the patterns, not its IP address.
23678 However, if a message is routed directly to an IP address without the use of a
23679 host name, for example, if a &(manualroute)& router contains a setting such as:
23680 .code
23681 route_list = *.a.example 192.168.34.23
23682 .endd
23683 then the &"host name"& that is used when searching for a retry rule is the
23684 textual form of the IP address.
23685
23686 .section "Retry rules for specific errors" "SECID161"
23687 .cindex "retry" "specific errors; specifying"
23688 The second field in a retry rule is the name of a particular error, or an
23689 asterisk, which matches any error. The errors that can be tested for are:
23690
23691 .vlist
23692 .vitem &%auth_failed%&
23693 Authentication failed when trying to send to a host in the
23694 &%hosts_require_auth%& list in an &(smtp)& transport.
23695
23696 .vitem &%data_4xx%&
23697 A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing DATA command, either immediately
23698 after the command, or after sending the message's data.
23699
23700 .vitem &%mail_4xx%&
23701 A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing MAIL command.
23702
23703 .vitem &%rcpt_4xx%&
23704 A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing RCPT command.
23705 .endlist
23706
23707 For the three 4&'xx'& errors, either the first or both of the x's can be given
23708 as specific digits, for example: &`mail_45x`& or &`rcpt_436`&. For example, to
23709 recognize 452 errors given to RCPT commands for addresses in a certain domain,
23710 and have retries every ten minutes with a one-hour timeout, you could set up a
23711 retry rule of this form:
23712 .code
23713 the.domain.name rcpt_452 F,1h,10m
23714 .endd
23715 These errors apply to both outgoing SMTP (the &(smtp)& transport) and outgoing
23716 LMTP (either the &(lmtp)& transport, or the &(smtp)& transport in LMTP mode).
23717
23718 .vlist
23719 .vitem &%lost_connection%&
23720 A server unexpectedly closed the SMTP connection. There may, of course,
23721 legitimate reasons for this (host died, network died), but if it repeats a lot
23722 for the same host, it indicates something odd.
23723
23724 .vitem &%refused_MX%&
23725 A connection to a host obtained from an MX record was refused.
23726
23727 .vitem &%refused_A%&
23728 A connection to a host not obtained from an MX record was refused.
23729
23730 .vitem &%refused%&
23731 A connection was refused.
23732
23733 .vitem &%timeout_connect_MX%&
23734 A connection attempt to a host obtained from an MX record timed out.
23735
23736 .vitem &%timeout_connect_A%&
23737 A connection attempt to a host not obtained from an MX record timed out.
23738
23739 .vitem &%timeout_connect%&
23740 A connection attempt timed out.
23741
23742 .vitem &%timeout_MX%&
23743 There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session with a host
23744 obtained from an MX record.
23745
23746 .vitem &%timeout_A%&
23747 There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session with a host not
23748 obtained from an MX record.
23749
23750 .vitem &%timeout%&
23751 There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session.
23752
23753 .vitem &%tls_required%&
23754 The server was required to use TLS (it matched &%hosts_require_tls%& in the
23755 &(smtp)& transport), but either did not offer TLS, or it responded with 4&'xx'&
23756 to STARTTLS, or there was a problem setting up the TLS connection.
23757
23758 .vitem &%quota%&
23759 A mailbox quota was exceeded in a local delivery by the &(appendfile)&
23760 transport.
23761
23762 .vitem &%quota_%&<&'time'&>
23763 .cindex "quota" "error testing in retry rule"
23764 .cindex "retry" "quota error testing"
23765 A mailbox quota was exceeded in a local delivery by the &(appendfile)&
23766 transport, and the mailbox has not been accessed for <&'time'&>. For example,
23767 &'quota_4d'& applies to a quota error when the mailbox has not been accessed
23768 for four days.
23769 .endlist
23770
23771 .cindex "mailbox" "time of last read"
23772 The idea of &%quota_%&<&'time'&> is to make it possible to have shorter
23773 timeouts when the mailbox is full and is not being read by its owner. Ideally,
23774 it should be based on the last time that the user accessed the mailbox.
23775 However, it is not always possible to determine this. Exim uses the following
23776 heuristic rules:
23777
23778 .ilist
23779 If the mailbox is a single file, the time of last access (the &"atime"&) is
23780 used. As no new messages are being delivered (because the mailbox is over
23781 quota), Exim does not access the file, so this is the time of last user access.
23782 .next
23783 .cindex "maildir format" "time of last read"
23784 For a maildir delivery, the time of last modification of the &_new_&
23785 subdirectory is used. As the mailbox is over quota, no new files are created in
23786 the &_new_& subdirectory, because no new messages are being delivered. Any
23787 change to the &_new_& subdirectory is therefore assumed to be the result of an
23788 MUA moving a new message to the &_cur_& directory when it is first read. The
23789 time that is used is therefore the last time that the user read a new message.
23790 .next
23791 For other kinds of multi-file mailbox, the time of last access cannot be
23792 obtained, so a retry rule that uses this type of error field is never matched.
23793 .endlist
23794
23795 The quota errors apply both to system-enforced quotas and to Exim's own quota
23796 mechanism in the &(appendfile)& transport. The &'quota'& error also applies
23797 when a local delivery is deferred because a partition is full (the ENOSPC
23798 error).
23799
23800
23801
23802 .section "Retry rules for specified senders" "SECID162"
23803 .cindex "retry" "rules; sender-specific"
23804 You can specify retry rules that apply only when the failing message has a
23805 specific sender. In particular, this can be used to define retry rules that
23806 apply only to bounce messages. The third item in a retry rule can be of this
23807 form:
23808 .display
23809 &`senders=`&<&'address list'&>
23810 .endd
23811 The retry timings themselves are then the fourth item. For example:
23812 .code
23813 * rcpt_4xx senders=: F,1h,30m
23814 .endd
23815 matches recipient 4&'xx'& errors for bounce messages sent to any address at any
23816 host. If the address list contains white space, it must be enclosed in quotes.
23817 For example:
23818 .code
23819 a.domain rcpt_452 senders="xb.dom : yc.dom" G,8h,10m,1.5
23820 .endd
23821 &*Warning*&: This facility can be unhelpful if it is used for host errors
23822 (which do not depend on the recipient). The reason is that the sender is used
23823 only to match the retry rule. Once the rule has been found for a host error,
23824 its contents are used to set a retry time for the host, and this will apply to
23825 all messages, not just those with specific senders.
23826
23827 When testing retry rules using &%-brt%&, you can supply a sender using the
23828 &%-f%& command line option, like this:
23829 .code
23830 exim -f "" -brt user@dom.ain
23831 .endd
23832 If you do not set &%-f%& with &%-brt%&, a retry rule that contains a senders
23833 list is never matched.
23834
23835
23836
23837
23838
23839 .section "Retry parameters" "SECID163"
23840 .cindex "retry" "parameters in rules"
23841 The third (or fourth, if a senders list is present) field in a retry rule is a
23842 sequence of retry parameter sets, separated by semicolons. Each set consists of
23843 .display
23844 <&'letter'&>,<&'cutoff time'&>,<&'arguments'&>
23845 .endd
23846 The letter identifies the algorithm for computing a new retry time; the cutoff
23847 time is the time beyond which this algorithm no longer applies, and the
23848 arguments vary the algorithm's action. The cutoff time is measured from the
23849 time that the first failure for the domain (combined with the local part if
23850 relevant) was detected, not from the time the message was received.
23851
23852 .cindex "retry" "algorithms"
23853 .cindex "retry" "fixed intervals"
23854 .cindex "retry" "increasing intervals"
23855 .cindex "retry" "random intervals"
23856 The available algorithms are:
23857
23858 .ilist
23859 &'F'&: retry at fixed intervals. There is a single time parameter specifying
23860 the interval.
23861 .next
23862 &'G'&: retry at geometrically increasing intervals. The first argument
23863 specifies a starting value for the interval, and the second a multiplier, which
23864 is used to increase the size of the interval at each retry.
23865 .next
23866 &'H'&: retry at randomized intervals. The arguments are as for &'G'&. For each
23867 retry, the previous interval is multiplied by the factor in order to get a
23868 maximum for the next interval. The minimum interval is the first argument of
23869 the parameter, and an actual interval is chosen randomly between them. Such a
23870 rule has been found to be helpful in cluster configurations when all the
23871 members of the cluster restart at once, and may therefore synchronize their
23872 queue processing times.
23873 .endlist
23874
23875 When computing the next retry time, the algorithm definitions are scanned in
23876 order until one whose cutoff time has not yet passed is reached. This is then
23877 used to compute a new retry time that is later than the current time. In the
23878 case of fixed interval retries, this simply means adding the interval to the
23879 current time. For geometrically increasing intervals, retry intervals are
23880 computed from the rule's parameters until one that is greater than the previous
23881 interval is found. The main configuration variable
23882 .cindex "limit" "retry interval"
23883 .cindex "retry" "interval, maximum"
23884 .oindex "&%retry_interval_max%&"
23885 &%retry_interval_max%& limits the maximum interval between retries. It
23886 cannot be set greater than &`24h`&, which is its default value.
23887
23888 A single remote domain may have a number of hosts associated with it, and each
23889 host may have more than one IP address. Retry algorithms are selected on the
23890 basis of the domain name, but are applied to each IP address independently. If,
23891 for example, a host has two IP addresses and one is unusable, Exim will
23892 generate retry times for it and will not try to use it until its next retry
23893 time comes. Thus the good IP address is likely to be tried first most of the
23894 time.
23895
23896 .cindex "hints database" "use for retrying"
23897 Retry times are hints rather than promises. Exim does not make any attempt to
23898 run deliveries exactly at the computed times. Instead, a queue runner process
23899 starts delivery processes for delayed messages periodically, and these attempt
23900 new deliveries only for those addresses that have passed their next retry time.
23901 If a new message arrives for a deferred address, an immediate delivery attempt
23902 occurs only if the address has passed its retry time. In the absence of new
23903 messages, the minimum time between retries is the interval between queue runner
23904 processes. There is not much point in setting retry times of five minutes if
23905 your queue runners happen only once an hour, unless there are a significant
23906 number of incoming messages (which might be the case on a system that is
23907 sending everything to a smart host, for example).
23908
23909 The data in the retry hints database can be inspected by using the
23910 &'exim_dumpdb'& or &'exim_fixdb'& utility programs (see chapter
23911 &<<CHAPutils>>&). The latter utility can also be used to change the data. The
23912 &'exinext'& utility script can be used to find out what the next retry times
23913 are for the hosts associated with a particular mail domain, and also for local
23914 deliveries that have been deferred.
23915
23916
23917 .section "Retry rule examples" "SECID164"
23918 Here are some example retry rules:
23919 .code
23920 alice@wonderland.fict.example quota_5d F,7d,3h
23921 wonderland.fict.example quota_5d
23922 wonderland.fict.example * F,1h,15m; G,2d,1h,2;
23923 lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
23924 * refused_A F,2h,20m;
23925 * * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,5d,8h
23926 .endd
23927 The first rule sets up special handling for mail to
23928 &'alice@wonderland.fict.example'& when there is an over-quota error and the
23929 mailbox has not been read for at least 5 days. Retries continue every three
23930 hours for 7 days. The second rule handles over-quota errors for all other local
23931 parts at &'wonderland.fict.example'&; the absence of a local part has the same
23932 effect as supplying &"*@"&. As no retry algorithms are supplied, messages that
23933 fail are bounced immediately if the mailbox has not been read for at least 5
23934 days.
23935
23936 The third rule handles all other errors at &'wonderland.fict.example'&; retries
23937 happen every 15 minutes for an hour, then with geometrically increasing
23938 intervals until two days have passed since a delivery first failed. After the
23939 first hour there is a delay of one hour, then two hours, then four hours, and
23940 so on (this is a rather extreme example).
23941
23942 The fourth rule controls retries for the domain &'lookingglass.fict.example'&.
23943 They happen every 30 minutes for 24 hours only. The remaining two rules handle
23944 all other domains, with special action for connection refusal from hosts that
23945 were not obtained from an MX record.
23946
23947 The final rule in a retry configuration should always have asterisks in the
23948 first two fields so as to provide a general catch-all for any addresses that do
23949 not have their own special handling. This example tries every 15 minutes for 2
23950 hours, then with intervals starting at one hour and increasing by a factor of
23951 1.5 up to 16 hours, then every 8 hours up to 5 days.
23952
23953
23954
23955 .section "Timeout of retry data" "SECID165"
23956 .cindex "timeout" "of retry data"
23957 .oindex "&%retry_data_expire%&"
23958 .cindex "hints database" "data expiry"
23959 .cindex "retry" "timeout of data"
23960 Exim timestamps the data that it writes to its retry hints database. When it
23961 consults the data during a delivery it ignores any that is older than the value
23962 set in &%retry_data_expire%& (default 7 days). If, for example, a host hasn't
23963 been tried for 7 days, Exim will try to deliver to it immediately a message
23964 arrives, and if that fails, it will calculate a retry time as if it were
23965 failing for the first time.
23966
23967 This improves the behaviour for messages routed to rarely-used hosts such as MX
23968 backups. If such a host was down at one time, and happens to be down again when
23969 Exim tries a month later, using the old retry data would imply that it had been
23970 down all the time, which is not a justified assumption.
23971
23972 If a host really is permanently dead, this behaviour causes a burst of retries
23973 every now and again, but only if messages routed to it are rare. If there is a
23974 message at least once every 7 days the retry data never expires.
23975
23976
23977
23978
23979 .section "Long-term failures" "SECID166"
23980 .cindex "delivery failure, long-term"
23981 .cindex "retry" "after long-term failure"
23982 Special processing happens when an email address has been failing for so long
23983 that the cutoff time for the last algorithm is reached. For example, using the
23984 default retry rule:
23985 .code
23986 * * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,4d,6h
23987 .endd
23988 the cutoff time is four days. Reaching the retry cutoff is independent of how
23989 long any specific message has been failing; it is the length of continuous
23990 failure for the recipient address that counts.
23991
23992 When the cutoff time is reached for a local delivery, or for all the IP
23993 addresses associated with a remote delivery, a subsequent delivery failure
23994 causes Exim to give up on the address, and a bounce message is generated.
23995 In order to cater for new messages that use the failing address, a next retry
23996 time is still computed from the final algorithm, and is used as follows:
23997
23998 For local deliveries, one delivery attempt is always made for any subsequent
23999 messages. If this delivery fails, the address fails immediately. The
24000 post-cutoff retry time is not used.
24001
24002 If the delivery is remote, there are two possibilities, controlled by the
24003 .oindex "&%delay_after_cutoff%&"
24004 &%delay_after_cutoff%& option of the &(smtp)& transport. The option is true by
24005 default. Until the post-cutoff retry time for one of the IP addresses is
24006 reached, the failing email address is bounced immediately, without a delivery
24007 attempt taking place. After that time, one new delivery attempt is made to
24008 those IP addresses that are past their retry times, and if that still fails,
24009 the address is bounced and new retry times are computed.
24010
24011 In other words, when all the hosts for a given email address have been failing
24012 for a long time, Exim bounces rather then defers until one of the hosts' retry
24013 times is reached. Then it tries once, and bounces if that attempt fails. This
24014 behaviour ensures that few resources are wasted in repeatedly trying to deliver
24015 to a broken destination, but if the host does recover, Exim will eventually
24016 notice.
24017
24018 If &%delay_after_cutoff%& is set false, Exim behaves differently. If all IP
24019 addresses are past their final cutoff time, Exim tries to deliver to those IP
24020 addresses that have not been tried since the message arrived. If there are
24021 no suitable IP addresses, or if they all fail, the address is bounced. In other
24022 words, it does not delay when a new message arrives, but tries the expired
24023 addresses immediately, unless they have been tried since the message arrived.
24024 If there is a continuous stream of messages for the failing domains, setting
24025 &%delay_after_cutoff%& false means that there will be many more attempts to
24026 deliver to permanently failing IP addresses than when &%delay_after_cutoff%& is
24027 true.
24028
24029 .section "Deliveries that work intermittently" "SECID167"
24030 .cindex "retry" "intermittently working deliveries"
24031 Some additional logic is needed to cope with cases where a host is
24032 intermittently available, or when a message has some attribute that prevents
24033 its delivery when others to the same address get through. In this situation,
24034 because some messages are successfully delivered, the &"retry clock"& for the
24035 host or address keeps getting reset by the successful deliveries, and so
24036 failing messages remain on the queue for ever because the cutoff time is never
24037 reached.
24038
24039 Two exceptional actions are applied to prevent this happening. The first
24040 applies to errors that are related to a message rather than a remote host.
24041 Section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>& has a discussion of the different kinds of error;
24042 examples of message-related errors are 4&'xx'& responses to MAIL or DATA
24043 commands, and quota failures. For this type of error, if a message's arrival
24044 time is earlier than the &"first failed"& time for the error, the earlier time
24045 is used when scanning the retry rules to decide when to try next and when to
24046 time out the address.
24047
24048 The exceptional second action applies in all cases. If a message has been on
24049 the queue for longer than the cutoff time of any applicable retry rule for a
24050 given address, a delivery is attempted for that address, even if it is not yet
24051 time, and if this delivery fails, the address is timed out. A new retry time is
24052 not computed in this case, so that other messages for the same address are
24053 considered immediately.
24054 .ecindex IIDretconf1
24055 .ecindex IIDregconf2
24056
24057
24058
24059
24060
24061
24062 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24063 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24064
24065 .chapter "SMTP authentication" "CHAPSMTPAUTH"
24066 .scindex IIDauthconf1 "SMTP" "authentication configuration"
24067 .scindex IIDauthconf2 "authentication"
24068 The &"authenticators"& section of Exim's run time configuration is concerned
24069 with SMTP authentication. This facility is an extension to the SMTP protocol,
24070 described in RFC 2554, which allows a client SMTP host to authenticate itself
24071 to a server. This is a common way for a server to recognize clients that are
24072 permitted to use it as a relay. SMTP authentication is not of relevance to the
24073 transfer of mail between servers that have no managerial connection with each
24074 other.
24075
24076 .cindex "AUTH" "description of"
24077 Very briefly, the way SMTP authentication works is as follows:
24078
24079 .ilist
24080 The server advertises a number of authentication &'mechanisms'& in response to
24081 the client's EHLO command.
24082 .next
24083 The client issues an AUTH command, naming a specific mechanism. The command
24084 may, optionally, contain some authentication data.
24085 .next
24086 The server may issue one or more &'challenges'&, to which the client must send
24087 appropriate responses. In simple authentication mechanisms, the challenges are
24088 just prompts for user names and passwords. The server does not have to issue
24089 any challenges &-- in some mechanisms the relevant data may all be transmitted
24090 with the AUTH command.
24091 .next
24092 The server either accepts or denies authentication.
24093 .next
24094 If authentication succeeds, the client may optionally make use of the AUTH
24095 option on the MAIL command to pass an authenticated sender in subsequent
24096 mail transactions. Authentication lasts for the remainder of the SMTP
24097 connection.
24098 .next
24099 If authentication fails, the client may give up, or it may try a different
24100 authentication mechanism, or it may try transferring mail over the
24101 unauthenticated connection.
24102 .endlist
24103
24104 If you are setting up a client, and want to know which authentication
24105 mechanisms the server supports, you can use Telnet to connect to port 25 (the
24106 SMTP port) on the server, and issue an EHLO command. The response to this
24107 includes the list of supported mechanisms. For example:
24108 .display
24109 &`$ `&&*&`telnet server.example 25`&*&
24110 &`Trying 192.168.34.25...`&
24111 &`Connected to server.example.`&
24112 &`Escape character is &#x0027;^]&#x0027;.`&
24113 &`220 server.example ESMTP Exim 4.20 ...`&
24114 &*&`ehlo client.example`&*&
24115 &`250-server.example Hello client.example [10.8.4.5]`&
24116 &`250-SIZE 52428800`&
24117 &`250-PIPELINING`&
24118 &`250-AUTH PLAIN`&
24119 &`250 HELP`&
24120 .endd
24121 The second-last line of this example output shows that the server supports
24122 authentication using the PLAIN mechanism. In Exim, the different authentication
24123 mechanisms are configured by specifying &'authenticator'& drivers. Like the
24124 routers and transports, which authenticators are included in the binary is
24125 controlled by build-time definitions. The following are currently available,
24126 included by setting
24127 .code
24128 AUTH_CRAM_MD5=yes
24129 AUTH_CYRUS_SASL=yes
24130 AUTH_DOVECOT=yes
24131 AUTH_GSASL=yes
24132 AUTH_HEIMDAL_GSSAPI=yes
24133 AUTH_PLAINTEXT=yes
24134 AUTH_SPA=yes
24135 .endd
24136 in &_Local/Makefile_&, respectively. The first of these supports the CRAM-MD5
24137 authentication mechanism (RFC 2195), and the second provides an interface to
24138 the Cyrus SASL authentication library.
24139 The third is an interface to Dovecot's authentication system, delegating the
24140 work via a socket interface.
24141 The fourth provides an interface to the GNU SASL authentication library, which
24142 provides mechanisms but typically not data sources.
24143 The fifth provides direct access to Heimdal GSSAPI, geared for Kerberos, but
24144 supporting setting a server keytab.
24145 The sixth can be configured to support
24146 the PLAIN authentication mechanism (RFC 2595) or the LOGIN mechanism, which is
24147 not formally documented, but used by several MUAs. The seventh authenticator
24148 supports Microsoft's &'Secure Password Authentication'& mechanism.
24149
24150 The authenticators are configured using the same syntax as other drivers (see
24151 section &<<SECTfordricon>>&). If no authenticators are required, no
24152 authentication section need be present in the configuration file. Each
24153 authenticator can in principle have both server and client functions. When Exim
24154 is receiving SMTP mail, it is acting as a server; when it is sending out
24155 messages over SMTP, it is acting as a client. Authenticator configuration
24156 options are provided for use in both these circumstances.
24157
24158 To make it clear which options apply to which situation, the prefixes
24159 &%server_%& and &%client_%& are used on option names that are specific to
24160 either the server or the client function, respectively. Server and client
24161 functions are disabled if none of their options are set. If an authenticator is
24162 to be used for both server and client functions, a single definition, using
24163 both sets of options, is required. For example:
24164 .code
24165 cram:
24166 driver = cram_md5
24167 public_name = CRAM-MD5
24168 server_secret = ${if eq{$auth1}{ph10}{secret1}fail}
24169 client_name = ph10
24170 client_secret = secret2
24171 .endd
24172 The &%server_%& option is used when Exim is acting as a server, and the
24173 &%client_%& options when it is acting as a client.
24174
24175 Descriptions of the individual authenticators are given in subsequent chapters.
24176 The remainder of this chapter covers the generic options for the
24177 authenticators, followed by general discussion of the way authentication works
24178 in Exim.
24179
24180 &*Beware:*& the meaning of &$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, ... varies on a per-driver and
24181 per-mechanism basis. Please read carefully to determine which variables hold
24182 account labels such as usercodes and which hold passwords or other
24183 authenticating data.
24184
24185 Note that some mechanisms support two different identifiers for accounts: the
24186 &'authentication id'& and the &'authorization id'&. The contractions &'authn'&
24187 and &'authz'& are commonly encountered. The American spelling is standard here.
24188 Conceptually, authentication data such as passwords are tied to the identifier
24189 used to authenticate; servers may have rules to permit one user to act as a
24190 second user, so that after login the session is treated as though that second
24191 user had logged in. That second user is the &'authorization id'&. A robust
24192 configuration might confirm that the &'authz'& field is empty or matches the
24193 &'authn'& field. Often this is just ignored. The &'authn'& can be considered
24194 as verified data, the &'authz'& as an unverified request which the server might
24195 choose to honour.
24196
24197 A &'realm'& is a text string, typically a domain name, presented by a server
24198 to a client to help it select an account and credentials to use. In some
24199 mechanisms, the client and server provably agree on the realm, but clients
24200 typically can not treat the realm as secure data to be blindly trusted.
24201
24202
24203
24204 .section "Generic options for authenticators" "SECID168"
24205 .cindex "authentication" "generic options"
24206 .cindex "options" "generic; for authenticators"
24207
24208 .option client_condition authenticators string&!! unset
24209 When Exim is authenticating as a client, it skips any authenticator whose
24210 &%client_condition%& expansion yields &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&. This can be
24211 used, for example, to skip plain text authenticators when the connection is not
24212 encrypted by a setting such as:
24213 .code
24214 client_condition = ${if !eq{$tls_out_cipher}{}}
24215 .endd
24216
24217
24218 .option client_set_id authenticators string&!! unset
24219 When client authentication succeeds, this condition is expanded; the
24220 result is used in the log lines for outbound messasges.
24221 Typically it will be the user name used for authentication.
24222
24223
24224 .option driver authenticators string unset
24225 This option must always be set. It specifies which of the available
24226 authenticators is to be used.
24227
24228
24229 .option public_name authenticators string unset
24230 This option specifies the name of the authentication mechanism that the driver
24231 implements, and by which it is known to the outside world. These names should
24232 contain only upper case letters, digits, underscores, and hyphens (RFC 2222),
24233 but Exim in fact matches them caselessly. If &%public_name%& is not set, it
24234 defaults to the driver's instance name.
24235
24236
24237 .option server_advertise_condition authenticators string&!! unset
24238 When a server is about to advertise an authentication mechanism, the condition
24239 is expanded. If it yields the empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, the
24240 mechanism is not advertised.
24241 If the expansion fails, the mechanism is not advertised. If the failure was not
24242 forced, and was not caused by a lookup defer, the incident is logged.
24243 See section &<<SECTauthexiser>>& below for further discussion.
24244
24245
24246 .option server_condition authenticators string&!! unset
24247 This option must be set for a &%plaintext%& server authenticator, where it
24248 is used directly to control authentication. See section &<<SECTplainserver>>&
24249 for details.
24250
24251 For the &(gsasl)& authenticator, this option is required for various
24252 mechanisms; see chapter &<<CHAPgsasl>>& for details.
24253
24254 For the other authenticators, &%server_condition%& can be used as an additional
24255 authentication or authorization mechanism that is applied after the other
24256 authenticator conditions succeed. If it is set, it is expanded when the
24257 authenticator would otherwise return a success code. If the expansion is forced
24258 to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion failure causes a temporary
24259 error code to be returned. If the result of a successful expansion is an empty
24260 string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, authentication fails. If the result of the
24261 expansion is &"1"&, &"yes"&, or &"true"&, authentication succeeds. For any
24262 other result, a temporary error code is returned, with the expanded string as
24263 the error text.
24264
24265
24266 .option server_debug_print authenticators string&!! unset
24267 If this option is set and authentication debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%&
24268 command line option), the string is expanded and included in the debugging
24269 output when the authenticator is run as a server. This can help with checking
24270 out the values of variables.
24271 If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
24272 output, and Exim carries on processing.
24273
24274
24275 .option server_set_id authenticators string&!! unset
24276 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
24277 When an Exim server successfully authenticates a client, this string is
24278 expanded using data from the authentication, and preserved for any incoming
24279 messages in the variable &$authenticated_id$&. It is also included in the log
24280 lines for incoming messages. For example, a user/password authenticator
24281 configuration might preserve the user name that was used to authenticate, and
24282 refer to it subsequently during delivery of the message.
24283 If expansion fails, the option is ignored.
24284
24285
24286 .option server_mail_auth_condition authenticators string&!! unset
24287 This option allows a server to discard authenticated sender addresses supplied
24288 as part of MAIL commands in SMTP connections that are authenticated by the
24289 driver on which &%server_mail_auth_condition%& is set. The option is not used
24290 as part of the authentication process; instead its (unexpanded) value is
24291 remembered for later use.
24292 How it is used is described in the following section.
24293
24294
24295
24296
24297
24298 .section "The AUTH parameter on MAIL commands" "SECTauthparamail"
24299 .cindex "authentication" "sender; authenticated"
24300 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
24301 When a client supplied an AUTH= item on a MAIL command, Exim applies
24302 the following checks before accepting it as the authenticated sender of the
24303 message:
24304
24305 .ilist
24306 If the connection is not using extended SMTP (that is, HELO was used rather
24307 than EHLO), the use of AUTH= is a syntax error.
24308 .next
24309 If the value of the AUTH= parameter is &"<>"&, it is ignored.
24310 .next
24311 .vindex "&$authenticated_sender$&"
24312 If &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& is defined, the ACL it specifies is run. While it is
24313 running, the value of &$authenticated_sender$& is set to the value obtained
24314 from the AUTH= parameter. If the ACL does not yield &"accept"&, the value of
24315 &$authenticated_sender$& is deleted. The &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& ACL may not
24316 return &"drop"& or &"discard"&. If it defers, a temporary error code (451) is
24317 given for the MAIL command.
24318 .next
24319 If &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& is not defined, the value of the AUTH= parameter
24320 is accepted and placed in &$authenticated_sender$& only if the client has
24321 authenticated.
24322 .next
24323 If the AUTH= value was accepted by either of the two previous rules, and
24324 the client has authenticated, and the authenticator has a setting for the
24325 &%server_mail_auth_condition%&, the condition is checked at this point. The
24326 valued that was saved from the authenticator is expanded. If the expansion
24327 fails, or yields an empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, the value of
24328 &$authenticated_sender$& is deleted. If the expansion yields any other value,
24329 the value of &$authenticated_sender$& is retained and passed on with the
24330 message.
24331 .endlist
24332
24333
24334 When &$authenticated_sender$& is set for a message, it is passed on to other
24335 hosts to which Exim authenticates as a client. Do not confuse this value with
24336 &$authenticated_id$&, which is a string obtained from the authentication
24337 process, and which is not usually a complete email address.
24338
24339 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
24340 Whenever an AUTH= value is ignored, the incident is logged. The ACL for
24341 MAIL, if defined, is run after AUTH= is accepted or ignored. It can
24342 therefore make use of &$authenticated_sender$&. The converse is not true: the
24343 value of &$sender_address$& is not yet set up when the &%acl_smtp_mailauth%&
24344 ACL is run.
24345
24346
24347
24348 .section "Authentication on an Exim server" "SECTauthexiser"
24349 .cindex "authentication" "on an Exim server"
24350 When Exim receives an EHLO command, it advertises the public names of those
24351 authenticators that are configured as servers, subject to the following
24352 conditions:
24353
24354 .ilist
24355 The client host must match &%auth_advertise_hosts%& (default *).
24356 .next
24357 It the &%server_advertise_condition%& option is set, its expansion must not
24358 yield the empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&.
24359 .endlist
24360
24361 The order in which the authenticators are defined controls the order in which
24362 the mechanisms are advertised.
24363
24364 Some mail clients (for example, some versions of Netscape) require the user to
24365 provide a name and password for authentication whenever AUTH is advertised,
24366 even though authentication may not in fact be needed (for example, Exim may be
24367 set up to allow unconditional relaying from the client by an IP address check).
24368 You can make such clients more friendly by not advertising AUTH to them.
24369 For example, if clients on the 10.9.8.0/24 network are permitted (by the ACL
24370 that runs for RCPT) to relay without authentication, you should set
24371 .code
24372 auth_advertise_hosts = ! 10.9.8.0/24
24373 .endd
24374 so that no authentication mechanisms are advertised to them.
24375
24376 The &%server_advertise_condition%& controls the advertisement of individual
24377 authentication mechanisms. For example, it can be used to restrict the
24378 advertisement of a particular mechanism to encrypted connections, by a setting
24379 such as:
24380 .code
24381 server_advertise_condition = ${if eq{$tls_in_cipher}{}{no}{yes}}
24382 .endd
24383 .vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
24384 If the session is encrypted, &$tls_in_cipher$& is not empty, and so the expansion
24385 yields &"yes"&, which allows the advertisement to happen.
24386
24387 When an Exim server receives an AUTH command from a client, it rejects it
24388 immediately if AUTH was not advertised in response to an earlier EHLO
24389 command. This is the case if
24390
24391 .ilist
24392 The client host does not match &%auth_advertise_hosts%&; or
24393 .next
24394 No authenticators are configured with server options; or
24395 .next
24396 Expansion of &%server_advertise_condition%& blocked the advertising of all the
24397 server authenticators.
24398 .endlist
24399
24400
24401 Otherwise, Exim runs the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_auth%& in order
24402 to decide whether to accept the command. If &%acl_smtp_auth%& is not set,
24403 AUTH is accepted from any client host.
24404
24405 If AUTH is not rejected by the ACL, Exim searches its configuration for a
24406 server authentication mechanism that was advertised in response to EHLO and
24407 that matches the one named in the AUTH command. If it finds one, it runs
24408 the appropriate authentication protocol, and authentication either succeeds or
24409 fails. If there is no matching advertised mechanism, the AUTH command is
24410 rejected with a 504 error.
24411
24412 .vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
24413 .vindex "&$sender_host_authenticated$&"
24414 When a message is received from an authenticated host, the value of
24415 &$received_protocol$& is set to &"esmtpa"& or &"esmtpsa"& instead of &"esmtp"&
24416 or &"esmtps"&, and &$sender_host_authenticated$& contains the name (not the
24417 public name) of the authenticator driver that successfully authenticated the
24418 client from which the message was received. This variable is empty if there was
24419 no successful authentication.
24420
24421
24422
24423
24424 .section "Testing server authentication" "SECID169"
24425 .cindex "authentication" "testing a server"
24426 .cindex "AUTH" "testing a server"
24427 .cindex "base64 encoding" "creating authentication test data"
24428 Exim's &%-bh%& option can be useful for testing server authentication
24429 configurations. The data for the AUTH command has to be sent using base64
24430 encoding. A quick way to produce such data for testing is the following Perl
24431 script:
24432 .code
24433 use MIME::Base64;
24434 printf ("%s", encode_base64(eval "\"$ARGV[0]\""));
24435 .endd
24436 .cindex "binary zero" "in authentication data"
24437 This interprets its argument as a Perl string, and then encodes it. The
24438 interpretation as a Perl string allows binary zeros, which are required for
24439 some kinds of authentication, to be included in the data. For example, a
24440 command line to run this script on such data might be
24441 .code
24442 encode '\0user\0password'
24443 .endd
24444 Note the use of single quotes to prevent the shell interpreting the
24445 backslashes, so that they can be interpreted by Perl to specify characters
24446 whose code value is zero.
24447
24448 &*Warning 1*&: If either of the user or password strings starts with an octal
24449 digit, you must use three zeros instead of one after the leading backslash. If
24450 you do not, the octal digit that starts your string will be incorrectly
24451 interpreted as part of the code for the first character.
24452
24453 &*Warning 2*&: If there are characters in the strings that Perl interprets
24454 specially, you must use a Perl escape to prevent them being misinterpreted. For
24455 example, a command such as
24456 .code
24457 encode '\0user@domain.com\0pas$$word'
24458 .endd
24459 gives an incorrect answer because of the unescaped &"@"& and &"$"& characters.
24460
24461 If you have the &%mimencode%& command installed, another way to do produce
24462 base64-encoded strings is to run the command
24463 .code
24464 echo -e -n `\0user\0password' | mimencode
24465 .endd
24466 The &%-e%& option of &%echo%& enables the interpretation of backslash escapes
24467 in the argument, and the &%-n%& option specifies no newline at the end of its
24468 output. However, not all versions of &%echo%& recognize these options, so you
24469 should check your version before relying on this suggestion.
24470
24471
24472
24473 .section "Authentication by an Exim client" "SECID170"
24474 .cindex "authentication" "on an Exim client"
24475 The &(smtp)& transport has two options called &%hosts_require_auth%& and
24476 &%hosts_try_auth%&. When the &(smtp)& transport connects to a server that
24477 announces support for authentication, and the host matches an entry in either
24478 of these options, Exim (as a client) tries to authenticate as follows:
24479
24480 .ilist
24481 For each authenticator that is configured as a client, in the order in which
24482 they are defined in the configuration, it searches the authentication
24483 mechanisms announced by the server for one whose name matches the public name
24484 of the authenticator.
24485 .next
24486 .vindex "&$host$&"
24487 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
24488 When it finds one that matches, it runs the authenticator's client code. The
24489 variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are available for any string expansions
24490 that the client might do. They are set to the server's name and IP address. If
24491 any expansion is forced to fail, the authentication attempt is abandoned, and
24492 Exim moves on to the next authenticator. Otherwise an expansion failure causes
24493 delivery to be deferred.
24494 .next
24495 If the result of the authentication attempt is a temporary error or a timeout,
24496 Exim abandons trying to send the message to the host for the moment. It will
24497 try again later. If there are any backup hosts available, they are tried in the
24498 usual way.
24499 .next
24500 If the response to authentication is a permanent error (5&'xx'& code), Exim
24501 carries on searching the list of authenticators and tries another one if
24502 possible. If all authentication attempts give permanent errors, or if there are
24503 no attempts because no mechanisms match (or option expansions force failure),
24504 what happens depends on whether the host matches &%hosts_require_auth%& or
24505 &%hosts_try_auth%&. In the first case, a temporary error is generated, and
24506 delivery is deferred. The error can be detected in the retry rules, and thereby
24507 turned into a permanent error if you wish. In the second case, Exim tries to
24508 deliver the message unauthenticated.
24509 .endlist
24510
24511 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
24512 When Exim has authenticated itself to a remote server, it adds the AUTH
24513 parameter to the MAIL commands it sends, if it has an authenticated sender for
24514 the message. If the message came from a remote host, the authenticated sender
24515 is the one that was receiving on an incoming MAIL command, provided that the
24516 incoming connection was authenticated and the &%server_mail_auth%& condition
24517 allowed the authenticated sender to be retained. If a local process calls Exim
24518 to send a message, the sender address that is built from the login name and
24519 &%qualify_domain%& is treated as authenticated. However, if the
24520 &%authenticated_sender%& option is set on the &(smtp)& transport, it overrides
24521 the authenticated sender that was received with the message.
24522 .ecindex IIDauthconf1
24523 .ecindex IIDauthconf2
24524
24525
24526
24527
24528
24529
24530 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24531 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24532
24533 .chapter "The plaintext authenticator" "CHAPplaintext"
24534 .scindex IIDplaiauth1 "&(plaintext)& authenticator"
24535 .scindex IIDplaiauth2 "authenticators" "&(plaintext)&"
24536 The &(plaintext)& authenticator can be configured to support the PLAIN and
24537 LOGIN authentication mechanisms, both of which transfer authentication data as
24538 plain (unencrypted) text (though base64 encoded). The use of plain text is a
24539 security risk; you are strongly advised to insist on the use of SMTP encryption
24540 (see chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&) if you use the PLAIN or LOGIN mechanisms. If you do
24541 use unencrypted plain text, you should not use the same passwords for SMTP
24542 connections as you do for login accounts.
24543
24544 .section "Plaintext options" "SECID171"
24545 .cindex "options" "&(plaintext)& authenticator (server)"
24546 When configured as a server, &(plaintext)& uses the following options:
24547
24548 .option server_condition authenticators string&!! unset
24549 This is actually a global authentication option, but it must be set in order to
24550 configure the &(plaintext)& driver as a server. Its use is described below.
24551
24552 .option server_prompts plaintext string&!! unset
24553 The contents of this option, after expansion, must be a colon-separated list of
24554 prompt strings. If expansion fails, a temporary authentication rejection is
24555 given.
24556
24557 .section "Using plaintext in a server" "SECTplainserver"
24558 .cindex "AUTH" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
24559 .cindex "binary zero" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
24560 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" &&&
24561 "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
24562 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
24563 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
24564
24565 When running as a server, &(plaintext)& performs the authentication test by
24566 expanding a string. The data sent by the client with the AUTH command, or in
24567 response to subsequent prompts, is base64 encoded, and so may contain any byte
24568 values when decoded. If any data is supplied with the command, it is treated as
24569 a list of strings, separated by NULs (binary zeros), the first three of which
24570 are placed in the expansion variables &$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, and &$auth3$&
24571 (neither LOGIN nor PLAIN uses more than three strings).
24572
24573 For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the values are also placed in
24574 the expansion variables &$1$&, &$2$&, and &$3$&. However, the use of these
24575 variables for this purpose is now deprecated, as it can lead to confusion in
24576 string expansions that also use them for other things.
24577
24578 If there are more strings in &%server_prompts%& than the number of strings
24579 supplied with the AUTH command, the remaining prompts are used to obtain more
24580 data. Each response from the client may be a list of NUL-separated strings.
24581
24582 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
24583 Once a sufficient number of data strings have been received,
24584 &%server_condition%& is expanded. If the expansion is forced to fail,
24585 authentication fails. Any other expansion failure causes a temporary error code
24586 to be returned. If the result of a successful expansion is an empty string,
24587 &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, authentication fails. If the result of the
24588 expansion is &"1"&, &"yes"&, or &"true"&, authentication succeeds and the
24589 generic &%server_set_id%& option is expanded and saved in &$authenticated_id$&.
24590 For any other result, a temporary error code is returned, with the expanded
24591 string as the error text
24592
24593 &*Warning*&: If you use a lookup in the expansion to find the user's
24594 password, be sure to make the authentication fail if the user is unknown.
24595 There are good and bad examples at the end of the next section.
24596
24597
24598
24599 .section "The PLAIN authentication mechanism" "SECID172"
24600 .cindex "PLAIN authentication mechanism"
24601 .cindex "authentication" "PLAIN mechanism"
24602 .cindex "binary zero" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
24603 The PLAIN authentication mechanism (RFC 2595) specifies that three strings be
24604 sent as one item of data (that is, one combined string containing two NUL
24605 separators). The data is sent either as part of the AUTH command, or
24606 subsequently in response to an empty prompt from the server.
24607
24608 The second and third strings are a user name and a corresponding password.
24609 Using a single fixed user name and password as an example, this could be
24610 configured as follows:
24611 .code
24612 fixed_plain:
24613 driver = plaintext
24614 public_name = PLAIN
24615 server_prompts = :
24616 server_condition = \
24617 ${if and {{eq{$auth2}{username}}{eq{$auth3}{mysecret}}}}
24618 server_set_id = $auth2
24619 .endd
24620 Note that the default result strings from &%if%& (&"true"& or an empty string)
24621 are exactly what we want here, so they need not be specified. Obviously, if the
24622 password contains expansion-significant characters such as dollar, backslash,
24623 or closing brace, they have to be escaped.
24624
24625 The &%server_prompts%& setting specifies a single, empty prompt (empty items at
24626 the end of a string list are ignored). If all the data comes as part of the
24627 AUTH command, as is commonly the case, the prompt is not used. This
24628 authenticator is advertised in the response to EHLO as
24629 .code
24630 250-AUTH PLAIN
24631 .endd
24632 and a client host can authenticate itself by sending the command
24633 .code
24634 AUTH PLAIN AHVzZXJuYW1lAG15c2VjcmV0
24635 .endd
24636 As this contains three strings (more than the number of prompts), no further
24637 data is required from the client. Alternatively, the client may just send
24638 .code
24639 AUTH PLAIN
24640 .endd
24641 to initiate authentication, in which case the server replies with an empty
24642 prompt. The client must respond with the combined data string.
24643
24644 The data string is base64 encoded, as required by the RFC. This example,
24645 when decoded, is <&'NUL'&>&`username`&<&'NUL'&>&`mysecret`&, where <&'NUL'&>
24646 represents a zero byte. This is split up into three strings, the first of which
24647 is empty. The &%server_condition%& option in the authenticator checks that the
24648 second two are &`username`& and &`mysecret`& respectively.
24649
24650 Having just one fixed user name and password, as in this example, is not very
24651 realistic, though for a small organization with only a handful of
24652 authenticating clients it could make sense.
24653
24654 A more sophisticated instance of this authenticator could use the user name in
24655 &$auth2$& to look up a password in a file or database, and maybe do an encrypted
24656 comparison (see &%crypteq%& in chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&). Here is a example of
24657 this approach, where the passwords are looked up in a DBM file. &*Warning*&:
24658 This is an incorrect example:
24659 .code
24660 server_condition = \
24661 ${if eq{$auth3}{${lookup{$auth2}dbm{/etc/authpwd}}}}
24662 .endd
24663 The expansion uses the user name (&$auth2$&) as the key to look up a password,
24664 which it then compares to the supplied password (&$auth3$&). Why is this example
24665 incorrect? It works fine for existing users, but consider what happens if a
24666 non-existent user name is given. The lookup fails, but as no success/failure
24667 strings are given for the lookup, it yields an empty string. Thus, to defeat
24668 the authentication, all a client has to do is to supply a non-existent user
24669 name and an empty password. The correct way of writing this test is:
24670 .code
24671 server_condition = ${lookup{$auth2}dbm{/etc/authpwd}\
24672 {${if eq{$value}{$auth3}}} {false}}
24673 .endd
24674 In this case, if the lookup succeeds, the result is checked; if the lookup
24675 fails, &"false"& is returned and authentication fails. If &%crypteq%& is being
24676 used instead of &%eq%&, the first example is in fact safe, because &%crypteq%&
24677 always fails if its second argument is empty. However, the second way of
24678 writing the test makes the logic clearer.
24679
24680
24681 .section "The LOGIN authentication mechanism" "SECID173"
24682 .cindex "LOGIN authentication mechanism"
24683 .cindex "authentication" "LOGIN mechanism"
24684 The LOGIN authentication mechanism is not documented in any RFC, but is in use
24685 in a number of programs. No data is sent with the AUTH command. Instead, a
24686 user name and password are supplied separately, in response to prompts. The
24687 plaintext authenticator can be configured to support this as in this example:
24688 .code
24689 fixed_login:
24690 driver = plaintext
24691 public_name = LOGIN
24692 server_prompts = User Name : Password
24693 server_condition = \
24694 ${if and {{eq{$auth1}{username}}{eq{$auth2}{mysecret}}}}
24695 server_set_id = $auth1
24696 .endd
24697 Because of the way plaintext operates, this authenticator accepts data supplied
24698 with the AUTH command (in contravention of the specification of LOGIN), but
24699 if the client does not supply it (as is the case for LOGIN clients), the prompt
24700 strings are used to obtain two data items.
24701
24702 Some clients are very particular about the precise text of the prompts. For
24703 example, Outlook Express is reported to recognize only &"Username:"& and
24704 &"Password:"&. Here is an example of a LOGIN authenticator that uses those
24705 strings. It uses the &%ldapauth%& expansion condition to check the user
24706 name and password by binding to an LDAP server:
24707 .code
24708 login:
24709 driver = plaintext
24710 public_name = LOGIN
24711 server_prompts = Username:: : Password::
24712 server_condition = ${if and{{ \
24713 !eq{}{$auth1} }{ \
24714 ldapauth{\
24715 user="uid=${quote_ldap_dn:$auth1},ou=people,o=example.org" \
24716 pass=${quote:$auth2} \
24717 ldap://ldap.example.org/} }} }
24718 server_set_id = uid=$auth1,ou=people,o=example.org
24719 .endd
24720 We have to check that the username is not empty before using it, because LDAP
24721 does not permit empty DN components. We must also use the &%quote_ldap_dn%&
24722 operator to correctly quote the DN for authentication. However, the basic
24723 &%quote%& operator, rather than any of the LDAP quoting operators, is the
24724 correct one to use for the password, because quoting is needed only to make
24725 the password conform to the Exim syntax. At the LDAP level, the password is an
24726 uninterpreted string.
24727
24728
24729 .section "Support for different kinds of authentication" "SECID174"
24730 A number of string expansion features are provided for the purpose of
24731 interfacing to different ways of user authentication. These include checking
24732 traditionally encrypted passwords from &_/etc/passwd_& (or equivalent), PAM,
24733 Radius, &%ldapauth%&, &'pwcheck'&, and &'saslauthd'&. For details see section
24734 &<<SECTexpcond>>&.
24735
24736
24737
24738
24739 .section "Using plaintext in a client" "SECID175"
24740 .cindex "options" "&(plaintext)& authenticator (client)"
24741 The &(plaintext)& authenticator has two client options:
24742
24743 .option client_ignore_invalid_base64 plaintext boolean false
24744 If the client receives a server prompt that is not a valid base64 string,
24745 authentication is abandoned by default. However, if this option is set true,
24746 the error in the challenge is ignored and the client sends the response as
24747 usual.
24748
24749 .option client_send plaintext string&!! unset
24750 The string is a colon-separated list of authentication data strings. Each
24751 string is independently expanded before being sent to the server. The first
24752 string is sent with the AUTH command; any more strings are sent in response
24753 to prompts from the server. Before each string is expanded, the value of the
24754 most recent prompt is placed in the next &$auth$&<&'n'&> variable, starting
24755 with &$auth1$& for the first prompt. Up to three prompts are stored in this
24756 way. Thus, the prompt that is received in response to sending the first string
24757 (with the AUTH command) can be used in the expansion of the second string, and
24758 so on. If an invalid base64 string is received when
24759 &%client_ignore_invalid_base64%& is set, an empty string is put in the
24760 &$auth$&<&'n'&> variable.
24761
24762 &*Note*&: You cannot use expansion to create multiple strings, because
24763 splitting takes priority and happens first.
24764
24765 Because the PLAIN authentication mechanism requires NUL (binary zero) bytes in
24766 the data, further processing is applied to each string before it is sent. If
24767 there are any single circumflex characters in the string, they are converted to
24768 NULs. Should an actual circumflex be required as data, it must be doubled in
24769 the string.
24770
24771 This is an example of a client configuration that implements the PLAIN
24772 authentication mechanism with a fixed user name and password:
24773 .code
24774 fixed_plain:
24775 driver = plaintext
24776 public_name = PLAIN
24777 client_send = ^username^mysecret
24778 .endd
24779 The lack of colons means that the entire text is sent with the AUTH
24780 command, with the circumflex characters converted to NULs. A similar example
24781 that uses the LOGIN mechanism is:
24782 .code
24783 fixed_login:
24784 driver = plaintext
24785 public_name = LOGIN
24786 client_send = : username : mysecret
24787 .endd
24788 The initial colon means that the first string is empty, so no data is sent with
24789 the AUTH command itself. The remaining strings are sent in response to
24790 prompts.
24791 .ecindex IIDplaiauth1
24792 .ecindex IIDplaiauth2
24793
24794
24795
24796
24797 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24798 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24799
24800 .chapter "The cram_md5 authenticator" "CHID9"
24801 .scindex IIDcramauth1 "&(cram_md5)& authenticator"
24802 .scindex IIDcramauth2 "authenticators" "&(cram_md5)&"
24803 .cindex "CRAM-MD5 authentication mechanism"
24804 .cindex "authentication" "CRAM-MD5 mechanism"
24805 The CRAM-MD5 authentication mechanism is described in RFC 2195. The server
24806 sends a challenge string to the client, and the response consists of a user
24807 name and the CRAM-MD5 digest of the challenge string combined with a secret
24808 string (password) which is known to both server and client. Thus, the secret
24809 is not sent over the network as plain text, which makes this authenticator more
24810 secure than &(plaintext)&. However, the downside is that the secret has to be
24811 available in plain text at either end.
24812
24813
24814 .section "Using cram_md5 as a server" "SECID176"
24815 .cindex "options" "&(cram_md5)& authenticator (server)"
24816 This authenticator has one server option, which must be set to configure the
24817 authenticator as a server:
24818
24819 .option server_secret cram_md5 string&!! unset
24820 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(cram_md5)& authenticator"
24821 When the server receives the client's response, the user name is placed in
24822 the expansion variable &$auth1$&, and &%server_secret%& is expanded to
24823 obtain the password for that user. The server then computes the CRAM-MD5 digest
24824 that the client should have sent, and checks that it received the correct
24825 string. If the expansion of &%server_secret%& is forced to fail, authentication
24826 fails. If the expansion fails for some other reason, a temporary error code is
24827 returned to the client.
24828
24829 For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the user name is also placed
24830 in &$1$&. However, the use of this variables for this purpose is now
24831 deprecated, as it can lead to confusion in string expansions that also use
24832 numeric variables for other things.
24833
24834 For example, the following authenticator checks that the user name given by the
24835 client is &"ph10"&, and if so, uses &"secret"& as the password. For any other
24836 user name, authentication fails.
24837 .code
24838 fixed_cram:
24839 driver = cram_md5
24840 public_name = CRAM-MD5
24841 server_secret = ${if eq{$auth1}{ph10}{secret}fail}
24842 server_set_id = $auth1
24843 .endd
24844 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
24845 If authentication succeeds, the setting of &%server_set_id%& preserves the user
24846 name in &$authenticated_id$&. A more typical configuration might look up the
24847 secret string in a file, using the user name as the key. For example:
24848 .code
24849 lookup_cram:
24850 driver = cram_md5
24851 public_name = CRAM-MD5
24852 server_secret = ${lookup{$auth1}lsearch{/etc/authpwd}\
24853 {$value}fail}
24854 server_set_id = $auth1
24855 .endd
24856 Note that this expansion explicitly forces failure if the lookup fails
24857 because &$auth1$& contains an unknown user name.
24858
24859 As another example, if you wish to re-use a Cyrus SASL sasldb2 file without
24860 using the relevant libraries, you need to know the realm to specify in the
24861 lookup and then ask for the &"userPassword"& attribute for that user in that
24862 realm, with:
24863 .code
24864 cyrusless_crammd5:
24865 driver = cram_md5
24866 public_name = CRAM-MD5
24867 server_secret = ${lookup{$auth1:mail.example.org:userPassword}\
24868 dbmjz{/etc/sasldb2}}
24869 server_set_id = $auth1
24870 .endd
24871
24872 .section "Using cram_md5 as a client" "SECID177"
24873 .cindex "options" "&(cram_md5)& authenticator (client)"
24874 When used as a client, the &(cram_md5)& authenticator has two options:
24875
24876
24877
24878 .option client_name cram_md5 string&!! "the primary host name"
24879 This string is expanded, and the result used as the user name data when
24880 computing the response to the server's challenge.
24881
24882
24883 .option client_secret cram_md5 string&!! unset
24884 This option must be set for the authenticator to work as a client. Its value is
24885 expanded and the result used as the secret string when computing the response.
24886
24887
24888 .vindex "&$host$&"
24889 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
24890 Different user names and secrets can be used for different servers by referring
24891 to &$host$& or &$host_address$& in the options. Forced failure of either
24892 expansion string is treated as an indication that this authenticator is not
24893 prepared to handle this case. Exim moves on to the next configured client
24894 authenticator. Any other expansion failure causes Exim to give up trying to
24895 send the message to the current server.
24896
24897 A simple example configuration of a &(cram_md5)& authenticator, using fixed
24898 strings, is:
24899 .code
24900 fixed_cram:
24901 driver = cram_md5
24902 public_name = CRAM-MD5
24903 client_name = ph10
24904 client_secret = secret
24905 .endd
24906 .ecindex IIDcramauth1
24907 .ecindex IIDcramauth2
24908
24909
24910
24911 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24912 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24913
24914 .chapter "The cyrus_sasl authenticator" "CHID10"
24915 .scindex IIDcyrauth1 "&(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator"
24916 .scindex IIDcyrauth2 "authenticators" "&(cyrus_sasl)&"
24917 .cindex "Cyrus" "SASL library"
24918 .cindex "Kerberos"
24919 The code for this authenticator was provided by Matthew Byng-Maddick of A L
24920 Digital Ltd (&url(http://www.aldigital.co.uk)).
24921
24922 The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator provides server support for the Cyrus SASL
24923 library implementation of the RFC 2222 (&"Simple Authentication and Security
24924 Layer"&). This library supports a number of authentication mechanisms,
24925 including PLAIN and LOGIN, but also several others that Exim does not support
24926 directly. In particular, there is support for Kerberos authentication.
24927
24928 The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator provides a gatewaying mechanism directly to
24929 the Cyrus interface, so if your Cyrus library can do, for example, CRAM-MD5,
24930 then so can the &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator. By default it uses the public
24931 name of the driver to determine which mechanism to support.
24932
24933 Where access to some kind of secret file is required, for example in GSSAPI
24934 or CRAM-MD5, it is worth noting that the authenticator runs as the Exim
24935 user, and that the Cyrus SASL library has no way of escalating privileges
24936 by default. You may also find you need to set environment variables,
24937 depending on the driver you are using.
24938
24939 The application name provided by Exim is &"exim"&, so various SASL options may
24940 be set in &_exim.conf_& in your SASL directory. If you are using GSSAPI for
24941 Kerberos, note that because of limitations in the GSSAPI interface,
24942 changing the server keytab might need to be communicated down to the Kerberos
24943 layer independently. The mechanism for doing so is dependent upon the Kerberos
24944 implementation.
24945
24946 For example, for older releases of Heimdal, the environment variable KRB5_KTNAME
24947 may be set to point to an alternative keytab file. Exim will pass this
24948 variable through from its own inherited environment when started as root or the
24949 Exim user. The keytab file needs to be readable by the Exim user.
24950 With newer releases of Heimdal, a setuid Exim may cause Heimdal to discard the
24951 environment variable. In practice, for those releases, the Cyrus authenticator
24952 is not a suitable interface for GSSAPI (Kerberos) support. Instead, consider
24953 the &(heimdal_gssapi)& authenticator, described in chapter &<<CHAPheimdalgss>>&
24954
24955
24956 .section "Using cyrus_sasl as a server" "SECID178"
24957 The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator has four private options. It puts the username
24958 (on a successful authentication) into &$auth1$&. For compatibility with
24959 previous releases of Exim, the username is also placed in &$1$&. However, the
24960 use of this variable for this purpose is now deprecated, as it can lead to
24961 confusion in string expansions that also use numeric variables for other
24962 things.
24963
24964
24965 .option server_hostname cyrus_sasl string&!! "see below"
24966 This option selects the hostname that is used when communicating with the
24967 library. The default value is &`$primary_hostname`&. It is up to the underlying
24968 SASL plug-in what it does with this data.
24969
24970
24971 .option server_mech cyrus_sasl string "see below"
24972 This option selects the authentication mechanism this driver should use. The
24973 default is the value of the generic &%public_name%& option. This option allows
24974 you to use a different underlying mechanism from the advertised name. For
24975 example:
24976 .code
24977 sasl:
24978 driver = cyrus_sasl
24979 public_name = X-ANYTHING
24980 server_mech = CRAM-MD5
24981 server_set_id = $auth1
24982 .endd
24983
24984 .option server_realm cyrus_sasl string&!! unset
24985 This specifies the SASL realm that the server claims to be in.
24986
24987
24988 .option server_service cyrus_sasl string &`smtp`&
24989 This is the SASL service that the server claims to implement.
24990
24991
24992 For straightforward cases, you do not need to set any of the authenticator's
24993 private options. All you need to do is to specify an appropriate mechanism as
24994 the public name. Thus, if you have a SASL library that supports CRAM-MD5 and
24995 PLAIN, you could have two authenticators as follows:
24996 .code
24997 sasl_cram_md5:
24998 driver = cyrus_sasl
24999 public_name = CRAM-MD5
25000 server_set_id = $auth1
25001
25002 sasl_plain:
25003 driver = cyrus_sasl
25004 public_name = PLAIN
25005 server_set_id = $auth2
25006 .endd
25007 Cyrus SASL does implement the LOGIN authentication method, even though it is
25008 not a standard method. It is disabled by default in the source distribution,
25009 but it is present in many binary distributions.
25010 .ecindex IIDcyrauth1
25011 .ecindex IIDcyrauth2
25012
25013
25014
25015
25016 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25017 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25018 .chapter "The dovecot authenticator" "CHAPdovecot"
25019 .scindex IIDdcotauth1 "&(dovecot)& authenticator"
25020 .scindex IIDdcotauth2 "authenticators" "&(dovecot)&"
25021 This authenticator is an interface to the authentication facility of the
25022 Dovecot POP/IMAP server, which can support a number of authentication methods.
25023 If you are using Dovecot to authenticate POP/IMAP clients, it might be helpful
25024 to use the same mechanisms for SMTP authentication. This is a server
25025 authenticator only. There is only one option:
25026
25027 .option server_socket dovecot string unset
25028
25029 This option must specify the socket that is the interface to Dovecot
25030 authentication. The &%public_name%& option must specify an authentication
25031 mechanism that Dovecot is configured to support. You can have several
25032 authenticators for different mechanisms. For example:
25033 .code
25034 dovecot_plain:
25035 driver = dovecot
25036 public_name = PLAIN
25037 server_socket = /var/run/dovecot/auth-client
25038 server_set_id = $auth2
25039
25040 dovecot_ntlm:
25041 driver = dovecot
25042 public_name = NTLM
25043 server_socket = /var/run/dovecot/auth-client
25044 server_set_id = $auth1
25045 .endd
25046 If the SMTP connection is encrypted, or if &$sender_host_address$& is equal to
25047 &$received_ip_address$& (that is, the connection is local), the &"secured"&
25048 option is passed in the Dovecot authentication command. If, for a TLS
25049 connection, a client certificate has been verified, the &"valid-client-cert"&
25050 option is passed. When authentication succeeds, the identity of the user
25051 who authenticated is placed in &$auth1$&.
25052 .ecindex IIDdcotauth1
25053 .ecindex IIDdcotauth2
25054
25055
25056 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25057 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25058 .chapter "The gsasl authenticator" "CHAPgsasl"
25059 .scindex IIDgsaslauth1 "&(gsasl)& authenticator"
25060 .scindex IIDgsaslauth2 "authenticators" "&(gsasl)&"
25061 .cindex "authentication" "GNU SASL"
25062 .cindex "authentication" "SASL"
25063 .cindex "authentication" "EXTERNAL"
25064 .cindex "authentication" "ANONYMOUS"
25065 .cindex "authentication" "PLAIN"
25066 .cindex "authentication" "LOGIN"
25067 .cindex "authentication" "DIGEST-MD5"
25068 .cindex "authentication" "CRAM-MD5"
25069 .cindex "authentication" "SCRAM-SHA-1"
25070 The &(gsasl)& authenticator provides server integration for the GNU SASL
25071 library and the mechanisms it provides. This is new as of the 4.80 release
25072 and there are a few areas where the library does not let Exim smoothly
25073 scale to handle future authentication mechanisms, so no guarantee can be
25074 made that any particular new authentication mechanism will be supported
25075 without code changes in Exim.
25076
25077
25078 .option server_channelbinding gsasl boolean false
25079 Some authentication mechanisms are able to use external context at both ends
25080 of the session to bind the authentication to that context, and fail the
25081 authentication process if that context differs. Specifically, some TLS
25082 ciphersuites can provide identifying information about the cryptographic
25083 context.
25084
25085 This means that certificate identity and verification becomes a non-issue,
25086 as a man-in-the-middle attack will cause the correct client and server to
25087 see different identifiers and authentication will fail.
25088
25089 This is currently only supported when using the GnuTLS library. This is
25090 only usable by mechanisms which support "channel binding"; at time of
25091 writing, that's the SCRAM family.
25092
25093 This defaults off to ensure smooth upgrade across Exim releases, in case
25094 this option causes some clients to start failing. Some future release
25095 of Exim may switch the default to be true.
25096
25097
25098 .option server_hostname gsasl string&!! "see below"
25099 This option selects the hostname that is used when communicating with the
25100 library. The default value is &`$primary_hostname`&.
25101 Some mechanisms will use this data.
25102
25103
25104 .option server_mech gsasl string "see below"
25105 This option selects the authentication mechanism this driver should use. The
25106 default is the value of the generic &%public_name%& option. This option allows
25107 you to use a different underlying mechanism from the advertised name. For
25108 example:
25109 .code
25110 sasl:
25111 driver = gsasl
25112 public_name = X-ANYTHING
25113 server_mech = CRAM-MD5
25114 server_set_id = $auth1
25115 .endd
25116
25117
25118 .option server_password gsasl string&!! unset
25119 Various mechanisms need access to the cleartext password on the server, so
25120 that proof-of-possession can be demonstrated on the wire, without sending
25121 the password itself.
25122
25123 The data available for lookup varies per mechanism.
25124 In all cases, &$auth1$& is set to the &'authentication id'&.
25125 The &$auth2$& variable will always be the &'authorization id'& (&'authz'&)
25126 if available, else the empty string.
25127 The &$auth3$& variable will always be the &'realm'& if available,
25128 else the empty string.
25129
25130 A forced failure will cause authentication to defer.
25131
25132 If using this option, it may make sense to set the &%server_condition%&
25133 option to be simply "true".
25134
25135
25136 .option server_realm gsasl string&!! unset
25137 This specifies the SASL realm that the server claims to be in.
25138 Some mechanisms will use this data.
25139
25140
25141 .option server_scram_iter gsasl string&!! unset
25142 This option provides data for the SCRAM family of mechanisms.
25143 &$auth1$& is not available at evaluation time.
25144 (This may change, as we receive feedback on use)
25145
25146
25147 .option server_scram_salt gsasl string&!! unset
25148 This option provides data for the SCRAM family of mechanisms.
25149 &$auth1$& is not available at evaluation time.
25150 (This may change, as we receive feedback on use)
25151
25152
25153 .option server_service gsasl string &`smtp`&
25154 This is the SASL service that the server claims to implement.
25155 Some mechanisms will use this data.
25156
25157
25158 .section "&(gsasl)& auth variables" "SECTgsaslauthvar"
25159 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
25160 These may be set when evaluating specific options, as detailed above.
25161 They will also be set when evaluating &%server_condition%&.
25162
25163 Unless otherwise stated below, the &(gsasl)& integration will use the following
25164 meanings for these variables:
25165
25166 .ilist
25167 .vindex "&$auth1$&"
25168 &$auth1$&: the &'authentication id'&
25169 .next
25170 .vindex "&$auth2$&"
25171 &$auth2$&: the &'authorization id'&
25172 .next
25173 .vindex "&$auth3$&"
25174 &$auth3$&: the &'realm'&
25175 .endlist
25176
25177 On a per-mechanism basis:
25178
25179 .ilist
25180 .cindex "authentication" "EXTERNAL"
25181 EXTERNAL: only &$auth1$& is set, to the possibly empty &'authorization id'&;
25182 the &%server_condition%& option must be present.
25183 .next
25184 .cindex "authentication" "ANONYMOUS"
25185 ANONYMOUS: only &$auth1$& is set, to the possibly empty &'anonymous token'&;
25186 the &%server_condition%& option must be present.
25187 .next
25188 .cindex "authentication" "GSSAPI"
25189 GSSAPI: &$auth1$& will be set to the &'GSSAPI Display Name'&;
25190 &$auth2$& will be set to the &'authorization id'&,
25191 the &%server_condition%& option must be present.
25192 .endlist
25193
25194 An &'anonymous token'& is something passed along as an unauthenticated
25195 identifier; this is analogous to FTP anonymous authentication passing an
25196 email address, or software-identifier@, as the "password".
25197
25198
25199 An example showing the password having the realm specified in the callback
25200 and demonstrating a Cyrus SASL to GSASL migration approach is:
25201 .code
25202 gsasl_cyrusless_crammd5:
25203 driver = gsasl
25204 public_name = CRAM-MD5
25205 server_realm = imap.example.org
25206 server_password = ${lookup{$auth1:$auth3:userPassword}\
25207 dbmjz{/etc/sasldb2}{$value}fail}
25208 server_set_id = ${quote:$auth1}
25209 server_condition = yes
25210 .endd
25211
25212
25213 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25214 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25215
25216 .chapter "The heimdal_gssapi authenticator" "CHAPheimdalgss"
25217 .scindex IIDheimdalgssauth1 "&(heimdal_gssapi)& authenticator"
25218 .scindex IIDheimdalgssauth2 "authenticators" "&(heimdal_gssapi)&"
25219 .cindex "authentication" "GSSAPI"
25220 .cindex "authentication" "Kerberos"
25221 The &(heimdal_gssapi)& authenticator provides server integration for the
25222 Heimdal GSSAPI/Kerberos library, permitting Exim to set a keytab pathname
25223 reliably.
25224
25225 .option server_hostname heimdal_gssapi string&!! "see below"
25226 This option selects the hostname that is used, with &%server_service%&,
25227 for constructing the GSS server name, as a &'GSS_C_NT_HOSTBASED_SERVICE'&
25228 identifier. The default value is &`$primary_hostname`&.
25229
25230 .option server_keytab heimdal_gssapi string&!! unset
25231 If set, then Heimdal will not use the system default keytab (typically
25232 &_/etc/krb5.keytab_&) but instead the pathname given in this option.
25233 The value should be a pathname, with no &"file:"& prefix.
25234
25235 .option server_service heimdal_gssapi string&!! "smtp"
25236 This option specifies the service identifier used, in conjunction with
25237 &%server_hostname%&, for building the identifer for finding credentials
25238 from the keytab.
25239
25240
25241 .section "&(heimdal_gssapi)& auth variables" "SECTheimdalgssauthvar"
25242 Beware that these variables will typically include a realm, thus will appear
25243 to be roughly like an email address already. The &'authzid'& in &$auth2$& is
25244 not verified, so a malicious client can set it to anything.
25245
25246 The &$auth1$& field should be safely trustable as a value from the Key
25247 Distribution Center. Note that these are not quite email addresses.
25248 Each identifier is for a role, and so the left-hand-side may include a
25249 role suffix. For instance, &"joe/admin@EXAMPLE.ORG"&.
25250
25251 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
25252 .ilist
25253 .vindex "&$auth1$&"
25254 &$auth1$&: the &'authentication id'&, set to the GSS Display Name.
25255 .next
25256 .vindex "&$auth2$&"
25257 &$auth2$&: the &'authorization id'&, sent within SASL encapsulation after
25258 authentication. If that was empty, this will also be set to the
25259 GSS Display Name.
25260 .endlist
25261
25262
25263 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25264 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25265
25266 .chapter "The spa authenticator" "CHAPspa"
25267 .scindex IIDspaauth1 "&(spa)& authenticator"
25268 .scindex IIDspaauth2 "authenticators" "&(spa)&"
25269 .cindex "authentication" "Microsoft Secure Password"
25270 .cindex "authentication" "NTLM"
25271 .cindex "Microsoft Secure Password Authentication"
25272 .cindex "NTLM authentication"
25273 The &(spa)& authenticator provides client support for Microsoft's &'Secure
25274 Password Authentication'& mechanism,
25275 which is also sometimes known as NTLM (NT LanMan). The code for client side of
25276 this authenticator was contributed by Marc Prud'hommeaux, and much of it is
25277 taken from the Samba project (&url(http://www.samba.org)). The code for the
25278 server side was subsequently contributed by Tom Kistner. The mechanism works as
25279 follows:
25280
25281 .ilist
25282 After the AUTH command has been accepted, the client sends an SPA
25283 authentication request based on the user name and optional domain.
25284 .next
25285 The server sends back a challenge.
25286 .next
25287 The client builds a challenge response which makes use of the user's password
25288 and sends it to the server, which then accepts or rejects it.
25289 .endlist
25290
25291 Encryption is used to protect the password in transit.
25292
25293
25294
25295 .section "Using spa as a server" "SECID179"
25296 .cindex "options" "&(spa)& authenticator (server)"
25297 The &(spa)& authenticator has just one server option:
25298
25299 .option server_password spa string&!! unset
25300 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(spa)& authenticator"
25301 This option is expanded, and the result must be the cleartext password for the
25302 authenticating user, whose name is at this point in &$auth1$&. For
25303 compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the user name is also placed in
25304 &$1$&. However, the use of this variable for this purpose is now deprecated, as
25305 it can lead to confusion in string expansions that also use numeric variables
25306 for other things. For example:
25307 .code
25308 spa:
25309 driver = spa
25310 public_name = NTLM
25311 server_password = \
25312 ${lookup{$auth1}lsearch{/etc/exim/spa_clearpass}{$value}fail}
25313 .endd
25314 If the expansion is forced to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion
25315 failure causes a temporary error code to be returned.
25316
25317
25318
25319
25320
25321 .section "Using spa as a client" "SECID180"
25322 .cindex "options" "&(spa)& authenticator (client)"
25323 The &(spa)& authenticator has the following client options:
25324
25325
25326
25327 .option client_domain spa string&!! unset
25328 This option specifies an optional domain for the authentication.
25329
25330
25331 .option client_password spa string&!! unset
25332 This option specifies the user's password, and must be set.
25333
25334
25335 .option client_username spa string&!! unset
25336 This option specifies the user name, and must be set. Here is an example of a
25337 configuration of this authenticator for use with the mail servers at
25338 &'msn.com'&:
25339 .code
25340 msn:
25341 driver = spa
25342 public_name = MSN
25343 client_username = msn/msn_username
25344 client_password = msn_plaintext_password
25345 client_domain = DOMAIN_OR_UNSET
25346 .endd
25347 .ecindex IIDspaauth1
25348 .ecindex IIDspaauth2
25349
25350
25351
25352
25353
25354 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25355 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25356
25357 .chapter "Encrypted SMTP connections using TLS/SSL" "CHAPTLS" &&&
25358 "Encrypted SMTP connections"
25359 .scindex IIDencsmtp1 "encryption" "on SMTP connection"
25360 .scindex IIDencsmtp2 "SMTP" "encryption"
25361 .cindex "TLS" "on SMTP connection"
25362 .cindex "OpenSSL"
25363 .cindex "GnuTLS"
25364 Support for TLS (Transport Layer Security), formerly known as SSL (Secure
25365 Sockets Layer), is implemented by making use of the OpenSSL library or the
25366 GnuTLS library (Exim requires GnuTLS release 1.0 or later). There is no
25367 cryptographic code in the Exim distribution itself for implementing TLS. In
25368 order to use this feature you must install OpenSSL or GnuTLS, and then build a
25369 version of Exim that includes TLS support (see section &<<SECTinctlsssl>>&).
25370 You also need to understand the basic concepts of encryption at a managerial
25371 level, and in particular, the way that public keys, private keys, and
25372 certificates are used.
25373
25374 RFC 3207 defines how SMTP connections can make use of encryption. Once a
25375 connection is established, the client issues a STARTTLS command. If the
25376 server accepts this, the client and the server negotiate an encryption
25377 mechanism. If the negotiation succeeds, the data that subsequently passes
25378 between them is encrypted.
25379
25380 Exim's ACLs can detect whether the current SMTP session is encrypted or not,
25381 and if so, what cipher suite is in use, whether the client supplied a
25382 certificate, and whether or not that certificate was verified. This makes it
25383 possible for an Exim server to deny or accept certain commands based on the
25384 encryption state.
25385
25386 &*Warning*&: Certain types of firewall and certain anti-virus products can
25387 disrupt TLS connections. You need to turn off SMTP scanning for these products
25388 in order to get TLS to work.
25389
25390
25391
25392 .section "Support for the legacy &""ssmtp""& (aka &""smtps""&) protocol" &&&
25393 "SECID284"
25394 .cindex "ssmtp protocol"
25395 .cindex "smtps protocol"
25396 .cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
25397 .cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
25398 Early implementations of encrypted SMTP used a different TCP port from normal
25399 SMTP, and expected an encryption negotiation to start immediately, instead of
25400 waiting for a STARTTLS command from the client using the standard SMTP
25401 port. The protocol was called &"ssmtp"& or &"smtps"&, and port 465 was
25402 allocated for this purpose.
25403
25404 This approach was abandoned when encrypted SMTP was standardized, but there are
25405 still some legacy clients that use it. Exim supports these clients by means of
25406 the &%tls_on_connect_ports%& global option. Its value must be a list of port
25407 numbers; the most common use is expected to be:
25408 .code
25409 tls_on_connect_ports = 465
25410 .endd
25411 The port numbers specified by this option apply to all SMTP connections, both
25412 via the daemon and via &'inetd'&. You still need to specify all the ports that
25413 the daemon uses (by setting &%daemon_smtp_ports%& or &%local_interfaces%& or
25414 the &%-oX%& command line option) because &%tls_on_connect_ports%& does not add
25415 an extra port &-- rather, it specifies different behaviour on a port that is
25416 defined elsewhere.
25417
25418 There is also a &%-tls-on-connect%& command line option. This overrides
25419 &%tls_on_connect_ports%&; it forces the legacy behaviour for all ports.
25420
25421
25422
25423
25424
25425
25426 .section "OpenSSL vs GnuTLS" "SECTopenvsgnu"
25427 .cindex "TLS" "OpenSSL &'vs'& GnuTLS"
25428 The first TLS support in Exim was implemented using OpenSSL. Support for GnuTLS
25429 followed later, when the first versions of GnuTLS were released. To build Exim
25430 to use GnuTLS, you need to set
25431 .code
25432 USE_GNUTLS=yes
25433 .endd
25434 in Local/Makefile, in addition to
25435 .code
25436 SUPPORT_TLS=yes
25437 .endd
25438 You must also set TLS_LIBS and TLS_INCLUDE appropriately, so that the
25439 include files and libraries for GnuTLS can be found.
25440
25441 There are some differences in usage when using GnuTLS instead of OpenSSL:
25442
25443 .ilist
25444 The &%tls_verify_certificates%& option must contain the name of a file, not the
25445 name of a directory (for OpenSSL it can be either).
25446 .next
25447 The default value for &%tls_dhparam%& differs for historical reasons.
25448 .next
25449 .vindex "&$tls_in_peerdn$&"
25450 .vindex "&$tls_out_peerdn$&"
25451 Distinguished Name (DN) strings reported by the OpenSSL library use a slash for
25452 separating fields; GnuTLS uses commas, in accordance with RFC 2253. This
25453 affects the value of the &$tls_in_peerdn$& and &$tls_out_peerdn$& variables.
25454 .next
25455 OpenSSL identifies cipher suites using hyphens as separators, for example:
25456 DES-CBC3-SHA. GnuTLS historically used underscores, for example:
25457 RSA_ARCFOUR_SHA. What is more, OpenSSL complains if underscores are present
25458 in a cipher list. To make life simpler, Exim changes underscores to hyphens
25459 for OpenSSL and passes the string unchanged to GnuTLS (expecting the library
25460 to handle its own older variants) when processing lists of cipher suites in the
25461 &%tls_require_ciphers%& options (the global option and the &(smtp)& transport
25462 option).
25463 .next
25464 The &%tls_require_ciphers%& options operate differently, as described in the
25465 sections &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&.
25466 .next
25467 The &%tls_dh_min_bits%& SMTP transport option is only honoured by GnuTLS.
25468 When using OpenSSL, this option is ignored.
25469 (If an API is found to let OpenSSL be configured in this way,
25470 let the Exim Maintainers know and we'll likely use it).
25471 .next
25472 Some other recently added features may only be available in one or the other.
25473 This should be documented with the feature. If the documentation does not
25474 explicitly state that the feature is infeasible in the other TLS
25475 implementation, then patches are welcome.
25476 .endlist
25477
25478
25479 .section "GnuTLS parameter computation" "SECTgnutlsparam"
25480 This section only applies if &%tls_dhparam%& is set to &`historic`& or to
25481 an explicit path; if the latter, then the text about generation still applies,
25482 but not the chosen filename.
25483 By default, as of Exim 4.80 a hard-coded D-H prime is used.
25484 See the documentation of &%tls_dhparam%& for more information.
25485
25486 GnuTLS uses D-H parameters that may take a substantial amount of time
25487 to compute. It is unreasonable to re-compute them for every TLS session.
25488 Therefore, Exim keeps this data in a file in its spool directory, called
25489 &_gnutls-params-NNNN_& for some value of NNNN, corresponding to the number
25490 of bits requested.
25491 The file is owned by the Exim user and is readable only by
25492 its owner. Every Exim process that start up GnuTLS reads the D-H
25493 parameters from this file. If the file does not exist, the first Exim process
25494 that needs it computes the data and writes it to a temporary file which is
25495 renamed once it is complete. It does not matter if several Exim processes do
25496 this simultaneously (apart from wasting a few resources). Once a file is in
25497 place, new Exim processes immediately start using it.
25498
25499 For maximum security, the parameters that are stored in this file should be
25500 recalculated periodically, the frequency depending on your paranoia level.
25501 If you are avoiding using the fixed D-H primes published in RFCs, then you
25502 are concerned about some advanced attacks and will wish to do this; if you do
25503 not regenerate then you might as well stick to the standard primes.
25504
25505 Arranging this is easy in principle; just delete the file when you want new
25506 values to be computed. However, there may be a problem. The calculation of new
25507 parameters needs random numbers, and these are obtained from &_/dev/random_&.
25508 If the system is not very active, &_/dev/random_& may delay returning data
25509 until enough randomness (entropy) is available. This may cause Exim to hang for
25510 a substantial amount of time, causing timeouts on incoming connections.
25511
25512 The solution is to generate the parameters externally to Exim. They are stored
25513 in &_gnutls-params-N_& in PEM format, which means that they can be
25514 generated externally using the &(certtool)& command that is part of GnuTLS.
25515
25516 To replace the parameters with new ones, instead of deleting the file
25517 and letting Exim re-create it, you can generate new parameters using
25518 &(certtool)& and, when this has been done, replace Exim's cache file by
25519 renaming. The relevant commands are something like this:
25520 .code
25521 # ls
25522 [ look for file; assume gnutls-params-2236 is the most recent ]
25523 # rm -f new-params
25524 # touch new-params
25525 # chown exim:exim new-params
25526 # chmod 0600 new-params
25527 # certtool --generate-dh-params --bits 2236 >>new-params
25528 # openssl dhparam -noout -text -in new-params | head
25529 [ check the first line, make sure it's not more than 2236;
25530 if it is, then go back to the start ("rm") and repeat
25531 until the size generated is at most the size requested ]
25532 # chmod 0400 new-params
25533 # mv new-params gnutls-params-2236
25534 .endd
25535 If Exim never has to generate the parameters itself, the possibility of
25536 stalling is removed.
25537
25538 The filename changed in Exim 4.80, to gain the -bits suffix. The value which
25539 Exim will choose depends upon the version of GnuTLS in use. For older GnuTLS,
25540 the value remains hard-coded in Exim as 1024. As of GnuTLS 2.12.x, there is
25541 a way for Exim to ask for the "normal" number of bits for D-H public-key usage,
25542 and Exim does so. This attempt to remove Exim from TLS policy decisions
25543 failed, as GnuTLS 2.12 returns a value higher than the current hard-coded limit
25544 of the NSS library. Thus Exim gains the &%tls_dh_max_bits%& global option,
25545 which applies to all D-H usage, client or server. If the value returned by
25546 GnuTLS is greater than &%tls_dh_max_bits%& then the value will be clamped down
25547 to &%tls_dh_max_bits%&. The default value has been set at the current NSS
25548 limit, which is still much higher than Exim historically used.
25549
25550 The filename and bits used will change as the GnuTLS maintainers change the
25551 value for their parameter &`GNUTLS_SEC_PARAM_NORMAL`&, as clamped by
25552 &%tls_dh_max_bits%&. At the time of writing (mid 2012), GnuTLS 2.12 recommends
25553 2432 bits, while NSS is limited to 2236 bits.
25554
25555 In fact, the requested value will be *lower* than &%tls_dh_max_bits%&, to
25556 increase the chance of the generated prime actually being within acceptable
25557 bounds, as GnuTLS has been observed to overshoot. Note the check step in the
25558 procedure above. There is no sane procedure available to Exim to double-check
25559 the size of the generated prime, so it might still be too large.
25560
25561
25562 .section "Requiring specific ciphers in OpenSSL" "SECTreqciphssl"
25563 .cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers (OpenSSL)"
25564 .oindex "&%tls_require_ciphers%&" "OpenSSL"
25565 There is a function in the OpenSSL library that can be passed a list of cipher
25566 suites before the cipher negotiation takes place. This specifies which ciphers
25567 are acceptable. The list is colon separated and may contain names like
25568 DES-CBC3-SHA. Exim passes the expanded value of &%tls_require_ciphers%&
25569 directly to this function call.
25570 Many systems will install the OpenSSL manual-pages, so you may have
25571 &'ciphers(1)'& available to you.
25572 The following quotation from the OpenSSL
25573 documentation specifies what forms of item are allowed in the cipher string:
25574
25575 .ilist
25576 It can consist of a single cipher suite such as RC4-SHA.
25577 .next
25578 It can represent a list of cipher suites containing a certain algorithm,
25579 or cipher suites of a certain type. For example SHA1 represents all
25580 ciphers suites using the digest algorithm SHA1 and SSLv3 represents all
25581 SSL v3 algorithms.
25582 .next
25583 Lists of cipher suites can be combined in a single cipher string using
25584 the + character. This is used as a logical and operation. For example
25585 SHA1+DES represents all cipher suites containing the SHA1 and the DES
25586 algorithms.
25587 .endlist
25588
25589 Each cipher string can be optionally preceded by one of the characters &`!`&,
25590 &`-`& or &`+`&.
25591 .ilist
25592 If &`!`& is used, the ciphers are permanently deleted from the list. The
25593 ciphers deleted can never reappear in the list even if they are explicitly
25594 stated.
25595 .next
25596 If &`-`& is used, the ciphers are deleted from the list, but some or all
25597 of the ciphers can be added again by later options.
25598 .next
25599 If &`+`& is used, the ciphers are moved to the end of the list. This
25600 option does not add any new ciphers; it just moves matching existing ones.
25601 .endlist
25602
25603 If none of these characters is present, the string is interpreted as
25604 a list of ciphers to be appended to the current preference list. If the list
25605 includes any ciphers already present they will be ignored: that is, they will
25606 not be moved to the end of the list.
25607 .endlist
25608
25609 The OpenSSL &'ciphers(1)'& command may be used to test the results of a given
25610 string:
25611 .code
25612 # note single-quotes to get ! past any shell history expansion
25613 $ openssl ciphers 'HIGH:!MD5:!SHA1'
25614 .endd
25615
25616 This example will let the library defaults be permitted on the MX port, where
25617 there's probably no identity verification anyway, but ups the ante on the
25618 submission ports where the administrator might have some influence on the
25619 choice of clients used:
25620 .code
25621 # OpenSSL variant; see man ciphers(1)
25622 tls_require_ciphers = ${if =={$received_port}{25}\
25623 {DEFAULT}\
25624 {HIGH:!MD5:!SHA1}}
25625 .endd
25626
25627
25628
25629 .section "Requiring specific ciphers or other parameters in GnuTLS" &&&
25630 "SECTreqciphgnu"
25631 .cindex "GnuTLS" "specifying parameters for"
25632 .cindex "TLS" "specifying ciphers (GnuTLS)"
25633 .cindex "TLS" "specifying key exchange methods (GnuTLS)"
25634 .cindex "TLS" "specifying MAC algorithms (GnuTLS)"
25635 .cindex "TLS" "specifying protocols (GnuTLS)"
25636 .cindex "TLS" "specifying priority string (GnuTLS)"
25637 .oindex "&%tls_require_ciphers%&" "GnuTLS"
25638 The GnuTLS library allows the caller to provide a "priority string", documented
25639 as part of the &[gnutls_priority_init]& function. This is very similar to the
25640 ciphersuite specification in OpenSSL.
25641
25642 The &%tls_require_ciphers%& option is treated as the GnuTLS priority string.
25643
25644 The &%tls_require_ciphers%& option is available both as an global option,
25645 controlling how Exim behaves as a server, and also as an option of the
25646 &(smtp)& transport, controlling how Exim behaves as a client. In both cases
25647 the value is string expanded. The resulting string is not an Exim list and
25648 the string is given to the GnuTLS library, so that Exim does not need to be
25649 aware of future feature enhancements of GnuTLS.
25650
25651 Documentation of the strings accepted may be found in the GnuTLS manual, under
25652 "Priority strings". This is online as
25653 &url(http://www.gnutls.org/manual/html_node/Priority-Strings.html),
25654 but beware that this relates to GnuTLS 3, which may be newer than the version
25655 installed on your system. If you are using GnuTLS 3,
25656 &url(http://www.gnutls.org/manual/gnutls.html#Listing-the-ciphersuites-in-a-priority-string, then the example code)
25657 on that site can be used to test a given string.
25658
25659 Prior to Exim 4.80, an older API of GnuTLS was used, and Exim supported three
25660 additional options, "&%gnutls_require_kx%&", "&%gnutls_require_mac%&" and
25661 "&%gnutls_require_protocols%&". &%tls_require_ciphers%& was an Exim list.
25662
25663 This example will let the library defaults be permitted on the MX port, where
25664 there's probably no identity verification anyway, and lowers security further
25665 by increasing compatibility; but this ups the ante on the submission ports
25666 where the administrator might have some influence on the choice of clients
25667 used:
25668 .code
25669 # GnuTLS variant
25670 tls_require_ciphers = ${if =={$received_port}{25}\
25671 {NORMAL:%COMPAT}\
25672 {SECURE128}}
25673 .endd
25674
25675
25676 .section "Configuring an Exim server to use TLS" "SECID182"
25677 .cindex "TLS" "configuring an Exim server"
25678 When Exim has been built with TLS support, it advertises the availability of
25679 the STARTTLS command to client hosts that match &%tls_advertise_hosts%&,
25680 but not to any others. The default value of this option is unset, which means
25681 that STARTTLS is not advertised at all. This default is chosen because you
25682 need to set some other options in order to make TLS available, and also it is
25683 sensible for systems that want to use TLS only as a client.
25684
25685 If a client issues a STARTTLS command and there is some configuration
25686 problem in the server, the command is rejected with a 454 error. If the client
25687 persists in trying to issue SMTP commands, all except QUIT are rejected
25688 with the error
25689 .code
25690 554 Security failure
25691 .endd
25692 If a STARTTLS command is issued within an existing TLS session, it is
25693 rejected with a 554 error code.
25694
25695 To enable TLS operations on a server, you must set &%tls_advertise_hosts%& to
25696 match some hosts. You can, of course, set it to * to match all hosts.
25697 However, this is not all you need to do. TLS sessions to a server won't work
25698 without some further configuration at the server end.
25699
25700 It is rumoured that all existing clients that support TLS/SSL use RSA
25701 encryption. To make this work you need to set, in the server,
25702 .code
25703 tls_certificate = /some/file/name
25704 tls_privatekey = /some/file/name
25705 .endd
25706 These options are, in fact, expanded strings, so you can make them depend on
25707 the identity of the client that is connected if you wish. The first file
25708 contains the server's X509 certificate, and the second contains the private key
25709 that goes with it. These files need to be readable by the Exim user, and must
25710 always be given as full path names. They can be the same file if both the
25711 certificate and the key are contained within it. If &%tls_privatekey%& is not
25712 set, or if its expansion is forced to fail or results in an empty string, this
25713 is assumed to be the case. The certificate file may also contain intermediate
25714 certificates that need to be sent to the client to enable it to authenticate
25715 the server's certificate.
25716
25717 If you do not understand about certificates and keys, please try to find a
25718 source of this background information, which is not Exim-specific. (There are a
25719 few comments below in section &<<SECTcerandall>>&.)
25720
25721 &*Note*&: These options do not apply when Exim is operating as a client &--
25722 they apply only in the case of a server. If you need to use a certificate in an
25723 Exim client, you must set the options of the same names in an &(smtp)&
25724 transport.
25725
25726 With just these options, an Exim server will be able to use TLS. It does not
25727 require the client to have a certificate (but see below for how to insist on
25728 this). There is one other option that may be needed in other situations. If
25729 .code
25730 tls_dhparam = /some/file/name
25731 .endd
25732 is set, the SSL library is initialized for the use of Diffie-Hellman ciphers
25733 with the parameters contained in the file.
25734 Set this to &`none`& to disable use of DH entirely, by making no prime
25735 available:
25736 .code
25737 tls_dhparam = none
25738 .endd
25739 This may also be set to a string identifying a standard prime to be used for
25740 DH; if it is set to &`default`& or, for OpenSSL, is unset, then the prime
25741 used is &`ike23`&. There are a few standard primes available, see the
25742 documentation for &%tls_dhparam%& for the complete list.
25743
25744 See the command
25745 .code
25746 openssl dhparam
25747 .endd
25748 for a way of generating file data.
25749
25750 The strings supplied for these three options are expanded every time a client
25751 host connects. It is therefore possible to use different certificates and keys
25752 for different hosts, if you so wish, by making use of the client's IP address
25753 in &$sender_host_address$& to control the expansion. If a string expansion is
25754 forced to fail, Exim behaves as if the option is not set.
25755
25756 .cindex "cipher" "logging"
25757 .cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
25758 .vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
25759 The variable &$tls_in_cipher$& is set to the cipher suite that was negotiated for
25760 an incoming TLS connection. It is included in the &'Received:'& header of an
25761 incoming message (by default &-- you can, of course, change this), and it is
25762 also included in the log line that records a message's arrival, keyed by
25763 &"X="&, unless the &%tls_cipher%& log selector is turned off. The &%encrypted%&
25764 condition can be used to test for specific cipher suites in ACLs.
25765
25766 Once TLS has been established, the ACLs that run for subsequent SMTP commands
25767 can check the name of the cipher suite and vary their actions accordingly. The
25768 cipher suite names vary, depending on which TLS library is being used. For
25769 example, OpenSSL uses the name DES-CBC3-SHA for the cipher suite which in other
25770 contexts is known as TLS_RSA_WITH_3DES_EDE_CBC_SHA. Check the OpenSSL or GnuTLS
25771 documentation for more details.
25772
25773 For outgoing SMTP deliveries, &$tls_out_cipher$& is used and logged
25774 (again depending on the &%tls_cipher%& log selector).
25775
25776
25777 .section "Requesting and verifying client certificates" "SECID183"
25778 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
25779 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
25780 If you want an Exim server to request a certificate when negotiating a TLS
25781 session with a client, you must set either &%tls_verify_hosts%& or
25782 &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&. You can, of course, set either of them to * to
25783 apply to all TLS connections. For any host that matches one of these options,
25784 Exim requests a certificate as part of the setup of the TLS session. The
25785 contents of the certificate are verified by comparing it with a list of
25786 expected certificates. These must be available in a file or,
25787 for OpenSSL only (not GnuTLS), a directory, identified by
25788 &%tls_verify_certificates%&.
25789
25790 A file can contain multiple certificates, concatenated end to end. If a
25791 directory is used
25792 (OpenSSL only),
25793 each certificate must be in a separate file, with a name (or a symbolic link)
25794 of the form <&'hash'&>.0, where <&'hash'&> is a hash value constructed from the
25795 certificate. You can compute the relevant hash by running the command
25796 .code
25797 openssl x509 -hash -noout -in /cert/file
25798 .endd
25799 where &_/cert/file_& contains a single certificate.
25800
25801 The difference between &%tls_verify_hosts%& and &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& is
25802 what happens if the client does not supply a certificate, or if the certificate
25803 does not match any of the certificates in the collection named by
25804 &%tls_verify_certificates%&. If the client matches &%tls_verify_hosts%&, the
25805 attempt to set up a TLS session is aborted, and the incoming connection is
25806 dropped. If the client matches &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&, the (encrypted) SMTP
25807 session continues. ACLs that run for subsequent SMTP commands can detect the
25808 fact that no certificate was verified, and vary their actions accordingly. For
25809 example, you can insist on a certificate before accepting a message for
25810 relaying, but not when the message is destined for local delivery.
25811
25812 .vindex "&$tls_in_peerdn$&"
25813 When a client supplies a certificate (whether it verifies or not), the value of
25814 the Distinguished Name of the certificate is made available in the variable
25815 &$tls_in_peerdn$& during subsequent processing of the message.
25816
25817 .cindex "log" "distinguished name"
25818 Because it is often a long text string, it is not included in the log line or
25819 &'Received:'& header by default. You can arrange for it to be logged, keyed by
25820 &"DN="&, by setting the &%tls_peerdn%& log selector, and you can use
25821 &%received_header_text%& to change the &'Received:'& header. When no
25822 certificate is supplied, &$tls_in_peerdn$& is empty.
25823
25824
25825 .section "Revoked certificates" "SECID184"
25826 .cindex "TLS" "revoked certificates"
25827 .cindex "revocation list"
25828 .cindex "certificate" "revocation list"
25829 Certificate issuing authorities issue Certificate Revocation Lists (CRLs) when
25830 certificates are revoked. If you have such a list, you can pass it to an Exim
25831 server using the global option called &%tls_crl%& and to an Exim client using
25832 an identically named option for the &(smtp)& transport. In each case, the value
25833 of the option is expanded and must then be the name of a file that contains a
25834 CRL in PEM format.
25835
25836
25837 .section "Configuring an Exim client to use TLS" "SECID185"
25838 .cindex "cipher" "logging"
25839 .cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
25840 .cindex "log" "distinguished name"
25841 .cindex "TLS" "configuring an Exim client"
25842 The &%tls_cipher%& and &%tls_peerdn%& log selectors apply to outgoing SMTP
25843 deliveries as well as to incoming, the latter one causing logging of the
25844 server certificate's DN. The remaining client configuration for TLS is all
25845 within the &(smtp)& transport.
25846
25847 It is not necessary to set any options to have TLS work in the &(smtp)&
25848 transport. If Exim is built with TLS support, and TLS is advertised by a
25849 server, the &(smtp)& transport always tries to start a TLS session. However,
25850 this can be prevented by setting &%hosts_avoid_tls%& (an option of the
25851 transport) to a list of server hosts for which TLS should not be used.
25852
25853 If you do not want Exim to attempt to send messages unencrypted when an attempt
25854 to set up an encrypted connection fails in any way, you can set
25855 &%hosts_require_tls%& to a list of hosts for which encryption is mandatory. For
25856 those hosts, delivery is always deferred if an encrypted connection cannot be
25857 set up. If there are any other hosts for the address, they are tried in the
25858 usual way.
25859
25860 When the server host is not in &%hosts_require_tls%&, Exim may try to deliver
25861 the message unencrypted. It always does this if the response to STARTTLS is
25862 a 5&'xx'& code. For a temporary error code, or for a failure to negotiate a TLS
25863 session after a success response code, what happens is controlled by the
25864 &%tls_tempfail_tryclear%& option of the &(smtp)& transport. If it is false,
25865 delivery to this host is deferred, and other hosts (if available) are tried. If
25866 it is true, Exim attempts to deliver unencrypted after a 4&'xx'& response to
25867 STARTTLS, and if STARTTLS is accepted, but the subsequent TLS
25868 negotiation fails, Exim closes the current connection (because it is in an
25869 unknown state), opens a new one to the same host, and then tries the delivery
25870 unencrypted.
25871
25872 The &%tls_certificate%& and &%tls_privatekey%& options of the &(smtp)&
25873 transport provide the client with a certificate, which is passed to the server
25874 if it requests it. If the server is Exim, it will request a certificate only if
25875 &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& matches the client.
25876
25877 If the &%tls_verify_certificates%& option is set on the &(smtp)& transport, it
25878 must name a file or,
25879 for OpenSSL only (not GnuTLS), a directory, that contains a collection of
25880 expected server certificates. The client verifies the server's certificate
25881 against this collection, taking into account any revoked certificates that are
25882 in the list defined by &%tls_crl%&.
25883
25884 If
25885 &%tls_require_ciphers%& is set on the &(smtp)& transport, it must contain a
25886 list of permitted cipher suites. If either of these checks fails, delivery to
25887 the current host is abandoned, and the &(smtp)& transport tries to deliver to
25888 alternative hosts, if any.
25889
25890 &*Note*&:
25891 These options must be set in the &(smtp)& transport for Exim to use TLS when it
25892 is operating as a client. Exim does not assume that a server certificate (set
25893 by the global options of the same name) should also be used when operating as a
25894 client.
25895
25896 .vindex "&$host$&"
25897 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
25898 All the TLS options in the &(smtp)& transport are expanded before use, with
25899 &$host$& and &$host_address$& containing the name and address of the server to
25900 which the client is connected. Forced failure of an expansion causes Exim to
25901 behave as if the relevant option were unset.
25902
25903 .vindex &$tls_out_bits$&
25904 .vindex &$tls_out_cipher$&
25905 .vindex &$tls_out_peerdn$&
25906 .vindex &$tls_out_sni$&
25907 Before an SMTP connection is established, the
25908 &$tls_out_bits$&, &$tls_out_cipher$&, &$tls_out_peerdn$& and &$tls_out_sni$&
25909 variables are emptied. (Until the first connection, they contain the values
25910 that were set when the message was received.) If STARTTLS is subsequently
25911 successfully obeyed, these variables are set to the relevant values for the
25912 outgoing connection.
25913
25914
25915
25916 .section "Use of TLS Server Name Indication" "SECTtlssni"
25917 .cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
25918 .vindex "&$tls_in_sni$&"
25919 .oindex "&%tls_in_sni%&"
25920 With TLS1.0 or above, there is an extension mechanism by which extra
25921 information can be included at various points in the protocol. One of these
25922 extensions, documented in RFC 6066 (and before that RFC 4366) is
25923 &"Server Name Indication"&, commonly &"SNI"&. This extension is sent by the
25924 client in the initial handshake, so that the server can examine the servername
25925 within and possibly choose to use different certificates and keys (and more)
25926 for this session.
25927
25928 This is analagous to HTTP's &"Host:"& header, and is the main mechanism by
25929 which HTTPS-enabled web-sites can be virtual-hosted, many sites to one IP
25930 address.
25931
25932 With SMTP to MX, there are the same problems here as in choosing the identity
25933 against which to validate a certificate: you can't rely on insecure DNS to
25934 provide the identity which you then cryptographically verify. So this will
25935 be of limited use in that environment.
25936
25937 With SMTP to Submission, there is a well-defined hostname which clients are
25938 connecting to and can validate certificates against. Thus clients &*can*&
25939 choose to include this information in the TLS negotiation. If this becomes
25940 wide-spread, then hosters can choose to present different certificates to
25941 different clients. Or even negotiate different cipher suites.
25942
25943 The &%tls_sni%& option on an SMTP transport is an expanded string; the result,
25944 if not empty, will be sent on a TLS session as part of the handshake. There's
25945 nothing more to it. Choosing a sensible value not derived insecurely is the
25946 only point of caution. The &$tls_out_sni$& variable will be set to this string
25947 for the lifetime of the client connection (including during authentication).
25948
25949 Except during SMTP client sessions, if &$tls_in_sni$& is set then it is a string
25950 received from a client.
25951 It can be logged with the &%log_selector%& item &`+tls_sni`&.
25952
25953 If the string &`tls_in_sni`& appears in the main section's &%tls_certificate%&
25954 option (prior to expansion) then the following options will be re-expanded
25955 during TLS session handshake, to permit alternative values to be chosen:
25956
25957 .ilist
25958 .vindex "&%tls_certificate%&"
25959 &%tls_certificate%&
25960 .next
25961 .vindex "&%tls_crl%&"
25962 &%tls_crl%&
25963 .next
25964 .vindex "&%tls_privatekey%&"
25965 &%tls_privatekey%&
25966 .next
25967 .vindex "&%tls_verify_certificates%&"
25968 &%tls_verify_certificates%&
25969 .endlist
25970
25971 Great care should be taken to deal with matters of case, various injection
25972 attacks in the string (&`../`& or SQL), and ensuring that a valid filename
25973 can always be referenced; it is important to remember that &$tls_sni$& is
25974 arbitrary unverified data provided prior to authentication.
25975
25976 The Exim developers are proceeding cautiously and so far no other TLS options
25977 are re-expanded.
25978
25979 When Exim is built againt OpenSSL, OpenSSL must have been built with support
25980 for TLS Extensions. This holds true for OpenSSL 1.0.0+ and 0.9.8+ with
25981 enable-tlsext in EXTRACONFIGURE. If you invoke &(openssl s_client -h)& and
25982 see &`-servername`& in the output, then OpenSSL has support.
25983
25984 When Exim is built against GnuTLS, SNI support is available as of GnuTLS
25985 0.5.10. (Its presence predates the current API which Exim uses, so if Exim
25986 built, then you have SNI support).
25987
25988
25989
25990 .section "Multiple messages on the same encrypted TCP/IP connection" &&&
25991 "SECTmulmessam"
25992 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries with TLS"
25993 .cindex "TLS" "multiple message deliveries"
25994 Exim sends multiple messages down the same TCP/IP connection by starting up
25995 an entirely new delivery process for each message, passing the socket from
25996 one process to the next. This implementation does not fit well with the use
25997 of TLS, because there is quite a lot of state information associated with a TLS
25998 connection, not just a socket identification. Passing all the state information
25999 to a new process is not feasible. Consequently, Exim shuts down an existing TLS
26000 session before passing the socket to a new process. The new process may then
26001 try to start a new TLS session, and if successful, may try to re-authenticate
26002 if AUTH is in use, before sending the next message.
26003
26004 The RFC is not clear as to whether or not an SMTP session continues in clear
26005 after TLS has been shut down, or whether TLS may be restarted again later, as
26006 just described. However, if the server is Exim, this shutdown and
26007 reinitialization works. It is not known which (if any) other servers operate
26008 successfully if the client closes a TLS session and continues with unencrypted
26009 SMTP, but there are certainly some that do not work. For such servers, Exim
26010 should not pass the socket to another process, because the failure of the
26011 subsequent attempt to use it would cause Exim to record a temporary host error,
26012 and delay other deliveries to that host.
26013
26014 To test for this case, Exim sends an EHLO command to the server after
26015 closing down the TLS session. If this fails in any way, the connection is
26016 closed instead of being passed to a new delivery process, but no retry
26017 information is recorded.
26018
26019 There is also a manual override; you can set &%hosts_nopass_tls%& on the
26020 &(smtp)& transport to match those hosts for which Exim should not pass
26021 connections to new processes if TLS has been used.
26022
26023
26024
26025
26026 .section "Certificates and all that" "SECTcerandall"
26027 .cindex "certificate" "references to discussion"
26028 In order to understand fully how TLS works, you need to know about
26029 certificates, certificate signing, and certificate authorities. This is not the
26030 place to give a tutorial, especially as I do not know very much about it
26031 myself. Some helpful introduction can be found in the FAQ for the SSL addition
26032 to Apache, currently at
26033 .display
26034 &url(http://www.modssl.org/docs/2.7/ssl_faq.html#ToC24)
26035 .endd
26036 Other parts of the &'modssl'& documentation are also helpful, and have
26037 links to further files.
26038 Eric Rescorla's book, &'SSL and TLS'&, published by Addison-Wesley (ISBN
26039 0-201-61598-3), contains both introductory and more in-depth descriptions.
26040 Some sample programs taken from the book are available from
26041 .display
26042 &url(http://www.rtfm.com/openssl-examples/)
26043 .endd
26044
26045
26046 .section "Certificate chains" "SECID186"
26047 The file named by &%tls_certificate%& may contain more than one
26048 certificate. This is useful in the case where the certificate that is being
26049 sent is validated by an intermediate certificate which the other end does
26050 not have. Multiple certificates must be in the correct order in the file.
26051 First the host's certificate itself, then the first intermediate
26052 certificate to validate the issuer of the host certificate, then the next
26053 intermediate certificate to validate the issuer of the first intermediate
26054 certificate, and so on, until finally (optionally) the root certificate.
26055 The root certificate must already be trusted by the recipient for
26056 validation to succeed, of course, but if it's not preinstalled, sending the
26057 root certificate along with the rest makes it available for the user to
26058 install if the receiving end is a client MUA that can interact with a user.
26059
26060 Note that certificates using MD5 are unlikely to work on today's Internet;
26061 even if your libraries allow loading them for use in Exim when acting as a
26062 server, increasingly clients will not accept such certificates. The error
26063 diagnostics in such a case can be frustratingly vague.
26064
26065
26066
26067 .section "Self-signed certificates" "SECID187"
26068 .cindex "certificate" "self-signed"
26069 You can create a self-signed certificate using the &'req'& command provided
26070 with OpenSSL, like this:
26071 . ==== Do not shorten the duration here without reading and considering
26072 . ==== the text below. Please leave it at 9999 days.
26073 .code
26074 openssl req -x509 -newkey rsa:1024 -keyout file1 -out file2 \
26075 -days 9999 -nodes
26076 .endd
26077 &_file1_& and &_file2_& can be the same file; the key and the certificate are
26078 delimited and so can be identified independently. The &%-days%& option
26079 specifies a period for which the certificate is valid. The &%-nodes%& option is
26080 important: if you do not set it, the key is encrypted with a passphrase
26081 that you are prompted for, and any use that is made of the key causes more
26082 prompting for the passphrase. This is not helpful if you are going to use
26083 this certificate and key in an MTA, where prompting is not possible.
26084
26085 . ==== I expect to still be working 26 years from now. The less technical
26086 . ==== debt I create, in terms of storing up trouble for my later years, the
26087 . ==== happier I will be then. We really have reached the point where we
26088 . ==== should start, at the very least, provoking thought and making folks
26089 . ==== pause before proceeding, instead of leaving all the fixes until two
26090 . ==== years before 2^31 seconds after the 1970 Unix epoch.
26091 . ==== -pdp, 2012
26092 NB: we are now past the point where 9999 days takes us past the 32-bit Unix
26093 epoch. If your system uses unsigned time_t (most do) and is 32-bit, then
26094 the above command might produce a date in the past. Think carefully about
26095 the lifetime of the systems you're deploying, and either reduce the duration
26096 of the certificate or reconsider your platform deployment. (At time of
26097 writing, reducing the duration is the most likely choice, but the inexorable
26098 progression of time takes us steadily towards an era where this will not
26099 be a sensible resolution).
26100
26101 A self-signed certificate made in this way is sufficient for testing, and
26102 may be adequate for all your requirements if you are mainly interested in
26103 encrypting transfers, and not in secure identification.
26104
26105 However, many clients require that the certificate presented by the server be a
26106 user (also called &"leaf"& or &"site"&) certificate, and not a self-signed
26107 certificate. In this situation, the self-signed certificate described above
26108 must be installed on the client host as a trusted root &'certification
26109 authority'& (CA), and the certificate used by Exim must be a user certificate
26110 signed with that self-signed certificate.
26111
26112 For information on creating self-signed CA certificates and using them to sign
26113 user certificates, see the &'General implementation overview'& chapter of the
26114 Open-source PKI book, available online at
26115 &url(http://ospkibook.sourceforge.net/).
26116 .ecindex IIDencsmtp1
26117 .ecindex IIDencsmtp2
26118
26119
26120
26121 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26122 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26123
26124 .chapter "Access control lists" "CHAPACL"
26125 .scindex IIDacl "&ACL;" "description"
26126 .cindex "control of incoming mail"
26127 .cindex "message" "controlling incoming"
26128 .cindex "policy control" "access control lists"
26129 Access Control Lists (ACLs) are defined in a separate section of the run time
26130 configuration file, headed by &"begin acl"&. Each ACL definition starts with a
26131 name, terminated by a colon. Here is a complete ACL section that contains just
26132 one very small ACL:
26133 .code
26134 begin acl
26135 small_acl:
26136 accept hosts = one.host.only
26137 .endd
26138 You can have as many lists as you like in the ACL section, and the order in
26139 which they appear does not matter. The lists are self-terminating.
26140
26141 The majority of ACLs are used to control Exim's behaviour when it receives
26142 certain SMTP commands. This applies both to incoming TCP/IP connections, and
26143 when a local process submits a message using SMTP by specifying the &%-bs%&
26144 option. The most common use is for controlling which recipients are accepted
26145 in incoming messages. In addition, you can define an ACL that is used to check
26146 local non-SMTP messages. The default configuration file contains an example of
26147 a realistic ACL for checking RCPT commands. This is discussed in chapter
26148 &<<CHAPdefconfil>>&.
26149
26150
26151 .section "Testing ACLs" "SECID188"
26152 The &%-bh%& command line option provides a way of testing your ACL
26153 configuration locally by running a fake SMTP session with which you interact.
26154 The host &'relay-test.mail-abuse.org'& provides a service for checking your
26155 relaying configuration (see section &<<SECTcheralcon>>& for more details).
26156
26157
26158
26159 .section "Specifying when ACLs are used" "SECID189"
26160 .cindex "&ACL;" "options for specifying"
26161 In order to cause an ACL to be used, you have to name it in one of the relevant
26162 options in the main part of the configuration. These options are:
26163 .cindex "AUTH" "ACL for"
26164 .cindex "DATA" "ACLs for"
26165 .cindex "ETRN" "ACL for"
26166 .cindex "EXPN" "ACL for"
26167 .cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
26168 .cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
26169 .cindex "MAIL" "ACL for"
26170 .cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
26171 .cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
26172 .cindex "STARTTLS, ACL for"
26173 .cindex "VRFY" "ACL for"
26174 .cindex "SMTP" "connection, ACL for"
26175 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
26176 .cindex "MIME content scanning" "ACL for"
26177
26178 .table2 140pt
26179 .irow &%acl_not_smtp%& "ACL for non-SMTP messages"
26180 .irow &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& "ACL for non-SMTP MIME parts"
26181 .irow &%acl_not_smtp_start%& "ACL at start of non-SMTP message"
26182 .irow &%acl_smtp_auth%& "ACL for AUTH"
26183 .irow &%acl_smtp_connect%& "ACL for start of SMTP connection"
26184 .irow &%acl_smtp_data%& "ACL after DATA is complete"
26185 .irow &%acl_smtp_etrn%& "ACL for ETRN"
26186 .irow &%acl_smtp_expn%& "ACL for EXPN"
26187 .irow &%acl_smtp_helo%& "ACL for HELO or EHLO"
26188 .irow &%acl_smtp_mail%& "ACL for MAIL"
26189 .irow &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& "ACL for the AUTH parameter of MAIL"
26190 .irow &%acl_smtp_mime%& "ACL for content-scanning MIME parts"
26191 .irow &%acl_smtp_notquit%& "ACL for non-QUIT terminations"
26192 .irow &%acl_smtp_predata%& "ACL at start of DATA command"
26193 .irow &%acl_smtp_quit%& "ACL for QUIT"
26194 .irow &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& "ACL for RCPT"
26195 .irow &%acl_smtp_starttls%& "ACL for STARTTLS"
26196 .irow &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& "ACL for VRFY"
26197 .endtable
26198
26199 For example, if you set
26200 .code
26201 acl_smtp_rcpt = small_acl
26202 .endd
26203 the little ACL defined above is used whenever Exim receives a RCPT command
26204 in an SMTP dialogue. The majority of policy tests on incoming messages can be
26205 done when RCPT commands arrive. A rejection of RCPT should cause the
26206 sending MTA to give up on the recipient address contained in the RCPT
26207 command, whereas rejection at other times may cause the client MTA to keep on
26208 trying to deliver the message. It is therefore recommended that you do as much
26209 testing as possible at RCPT time.
26210
26211
26212 .section "The non-SMTP ACLs" "SECID190"
26213 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
26214 The non-SMTP ACLs apply to all non-interactive incoming messages, that is, they
26215 apply to batched SMTP as well as to non-SMTP messages. (Batched SMTP is not
26216 really SMTP.) Many of the ACL conditions (for example, host tests, and tests on
26217 the state of the SMTP connection such as encryption and authentication) are not
26218 relevant and are forbidden in these ACLs. However, the sender and recipients
26219 are known, so the &%senders%& and &%sender_domains%& conditions and the
26220 &$sender_address$& and &$recipients$& variables can be used. Variables such as
26221 &$authenticated_sender$& are also available. You can specify added header lines
26222 in any of these ACLs.
26223
26224 The &%acl_not_smtp_start%& ACL is run right at the start of receiving a
26225 non-SMTP message, before any of the message has been read. (This is the
26226 analogue of the &%acl_smtp_predata%& ACL for SMTP input.) In the case of
26227 batched SMTP input, it runs after the DATA command has been reached. The
26228 result of this ACL is ignored; it cannot be used to reject a message. If you
26229 really need to, you could set a value in an ACL variable here and reject based
26230 on that in the &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL. However, this ACL can be used to set
26231 controls, and in particular, it can be used to set
26232 .code
26233 control = suppress_local_fixups
26234 .endd
26235 This cannot be used in the other non-SMTP ACLs because by the time they are
26236 run, it is too late.
26237
26238 The &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& ACL is available only when Exim is compiled with the
26239 content-scanning extension. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
26240
26241 The &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL is run just before the &[local_scan()]& function. Any
26242 kind of rejection is treated as permanent, because there is no way of sending a
26243 temporary error for these kinds of message.
26244
26245
26246 .section "The SMTP connect ACL" "SECID191"
26247 .cindex "SMTP" "connection, ACL for"
26248 .oindex &%smtp_banner%&
26249 The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_connect%& happens at the start of an SMTP
26250 session, after the test specified by &%host_reject_connection%& (which is now
26251 an anomaly) and any TCP Wrappers testing (if configured). If the connection is
26252 accepted by an &%accept%& verb that has a &%message%& modifier, the contents of
26253 the message override the banner message that is otherwise specified by the
26254 &%smtp_banner%& option.
26255
26256
26257 .section "The EHLO/HELO ACL" "SECID192"
26258 .cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
26259 .cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
26260 The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_helo%& happens when the client issues an
26261 EHLO or HELO command, after the tests specified by &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%&,
26262 &%helo_allow_chars%&, &%helo_verify_hosts%&, and &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&.
26263 Note that a client may issue more than one EHLO or HELO command in an SMTP
26264 session, and indeed is required to issue a new EHLO or HELO after successfully
26265 setting up encryption following a STARTTLS command.
26266
26267 If the command is accepted by an &%accept%& verb that has a &%message%&
26268 modifier, the message may not contain more than one line (it will be truncated
26269 at the first newline and a panic logged if it does). Such a message cannot
26270 affect the EHLO options that are listed on the second and subsequent lines of
26271 an EHLO response.
26272
26273
26274 .section "The DATA ACLs" "SECID193"
26275 .cindex "DATA" "ACLs for"
26276 Two ACLs are associated with the DATA command, because it is two-stage
26277 command, with two responses being sent to the client.
26278 When the DATA command is received, the ACL defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&
26279 is obeyed. This gives you control after all the RCPT commands, but before
26280 the message itself is received. It offers the opportunity to give a negative
26281 response to the DATA command before the data is transmitted. Header lines
26282 added by MAIL or RCPT ACLs are not visible at this time, but any that
26283 are defined here are visible when the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL is run.
26284
26285 You cannot test the contents of the message, for example, to verify addresses
26286 in the headers, at RCPT time or when the DATA command is received. Such
26287 tests have to appear in the ACL that is run after the message itself has been
26288 received, before the final response to the DATA command is sent. This is
26289 the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%&, which is the second ACL that is
26290 associated with the DATA command.
26291
26292 For both of these ACLs, it is not possible to reject individual recipients. An
26293 error response rejects the entire message. Unfortunately, it is known that some
26294 MTAs do not treat hard (5&'xx'&) responses to the DATA command (either
26295 before or after the data) correctly &-- they keep the message on their queues
26296 and try again later, but that is their problem, though it does waste some of
26297 your resources.
26298
26299 The &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL is run after both the &%acl_smtp_dkim%& and
26300 the &%acl_smtp_mime%& ACLs.
26301
26302 .section "The SMTP DKIM ACL" "SECTDKIMACL"
26303 The &%acl_smtp_dkim%& ACL is available only when Exim is compiled with DKIM support
26304 enabled (which is the default).
26305
26306 The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_dkim%& happens after a message has been
26307 received, and is executed for each DKIM signature found in a message. If not
26308 otherwise specified, the default action is to accept.
26309
26310 This ACL is evaluated before &%acl_smtp_mime%& and &%acl_smtp_data%&.
26311
26312 For details on the operation of DKIM, see chapter &<<CHAPdkim>>&.
26313
26314
26315 .section "The SMTP MIME ACL" "SECID194"
26316 The &%acl_smtp_mime%& option is available only when Exim is compiled with the
26317 content-scanning extension. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
26318
26319 This ACL is evaluated after &%acl_smtp_dkim%& but before &%acl_smtp_data%&.
26320
26321
26322 .section "The QUIT ACL" "SECTQUITACL"
26323 .cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
26324 The ACL for the SMTP QUIT command is anomalous, in that the outcome of the ACL
26325 does not affect the response code to QUIT, which is always 221. Thus, the ACL
26326 does not in fact control any access. For this reason, the only verbs that are
26327 permitted are &%accept%& and &%warn%&.
26328
26329 This ACL can be used for tasks such as custom logging at the end of an SMTP
26330 session. For example, you can use ACL variables in other ACLs to count
26331 messages, recipients, etc., and log the totals at QUIT time using one or
26332 more &%logwrite%& modifiers on a &%warn%& verb.
26333
26334 &*Warning*&: Only the &$acl_c$&&'x'& variables can be used for this, because
26335 the &$acl_m$&&'x'& variables are reset at the end of each incoming message.
26336
26337 You do not need to have a final &%accept%&, but if you do, you can use a
26338 &%message%& modifier to specify custom text that is sent as part of the 221
26339 response to QUIT.
26340
26341 This ACL is run only for a &"normal"& QUIT. For certain kinds of disastrous
26342 failure (for example, failure to open a log file, or when Exim is bombing out
26343 because it has detected an unrecoverable error), all SMTP commands from the
26344 client are given temporary error responses until QUIT is received or the
26345 connection is closed. In these special cases, the QUIT ACL does not run.
26346
26347
26348 .section "The not-QUIT ACL" "SECTNOTQUITACL"
26349 .vindex &$acl_smtp_notquit$&
26350 The not-QUIT ACL, specified by &%acl_smtp_notquit%&, is run in most cases when
26351 an SMTP session ends without sending QUIT. However, when Exim itself is in bad
26352 trouble, such as being unable to write to its log files, this ACL is not run,
26353 because it might try to do things (such as write to log files) that make the
26354 situation even worse.
26355
26356 Like the QUIT ACL, this ACL is provided to make it possible to do customized
26357 logging or to gather statistics, and its outcome is ignored. The &%delay%&
26358 modifier is forbidden in this ACL, and the only permitted verbs are &%accept%&
26359 and &%warn%&.
26360
26361 .vindex &$smtp_notquit_reason$&
26362 When the not-QUIT ACL is running, the variable &$smtp_notquit_reason$& is set
26363 to a string that indicates the reason for the termination of the SMTP
26364 connection. The possible values are:
26365 .table2
26366 .irow &`acl-drop`& "Another ACL issued a &%drop%& command"
26367 .irow &`bad-commands`& "Too many unknown or non-mail commands"
26368 .irow &`command-timeout`& "Timeout while reading SMTP commands"
26369 .irow &`connection-lost`& "The SMTP connection has been lost"
26370 .irow &`data-timeout`& "Timeout while reading message data"
26371 .irow &`local-scan-error`& "The &[local_scan()]& function crashed"
26372 .irow &`local-scan-timeout`& "The &[local_scan()]& function timed out"
26373 .irow &`signal-exit`& "SIGTERM or SIGINT"
26374 .irow &`synchronization-error`& "SMTP synchronization error"
26375 .irow &`tls-failed`& "TLS failed to start"
26376 .endtable
26377 In most cases when an SMTP connection is closed without having received QUIT,
26378 Exim sends an SMTP response message before actually closing the connection.
26379 With the exception of the &`acl-drop`& case, the default message can be
26380 overridden by the &%message%& modifier in the not-QUIT ACL. In the case of a
26381 &%drop%& verb in another ACL, it is the message from the other ACL that is
26382 used.
26383
26384
26385 .section "Finding an ACL to use" "SECID195"
26386 .cindex "&ACL;" "finding which to use"
26387 The value of an &%acl_smtp_%&&'xxx'& option is expanded before use, so
26388 you can use different ACLs in different circumstances. For example,
26389 .code
26390 acl_smtp_rcpt = ${if ={25}{$interface_port} \
26391 {acl_check_rcpt} {acl_check_rcpt_submit} }
26392 .endd
26393 In the default configuration file there are some example settings for
26394 providing an RFC 4409 message submission service on port 587 and a
26395 non-standard &"smtps"& service on port 465. You can use a string
26396 expansion like this to choose an ACL for MUAs on these ports which is
26397 more appropriate for this purpose than the default ACL on port 25.
26398
26399 The expanded string does not have to be the name of an ACL in the
26400 configuration file; there are other possibilities. Having expanded the
26401 string, Exim searches for an ACL as follows:
26402
26403 .ilist
26404 If the string begins with a slash, Exim uses it as a file name, and reads its
26405 contents as an ACL. The lines are processed in the same way as lines in the
26406 Exim configuration file. In particular, continuation lines are supported, blank
26407 lines are ignored, as are lines whose first non-whitespace character is &"#"&.
26408 If the file does not exist or cannot be read, an error occurs (typically
26409 causing a temporary failure of whatever caused the ACL to be run). For example:
26410 .code
26411 acl_smtp_data = /etc/acls/\
26412 ${lookup{$sender_host_address}lsearch\
26413 {/etc/acllist}{$value}{default}}
26414 .endd
26415 This looks up an ACL file to use on the basis of the host's IP address, falling
26416 back to a default if the lookup fails. If an ACL is successfully read from a
26417 file, it is retained in memory for the duration of the Exim process, so that it
26418 can be re-used without having to re-read the file.
26419 .next
26420 If the string does not start with a slash, and does not contain any spaces,
26421 Exim searches the ACL section of the configuration for an ACL whose name
26422 matches the string.
26423 .next
26424 If no named ACL is found, or if the string contains spaces, Exim parses
26425 the string as an inline ACL. This can save typing in cases where you just
26426 want to have something like
26427 .code
26428 acl_smtp_vrfy = accept
26429 .endd
26430 in order to allow free use of the VRFY command. Such a string may contain
26431 newlines; it is processed in the same way as an ACL that is read from a file.
26432 .endlist
26433
26434
26435
26436
26437 .section "ACL return codes" "SECID196"
26438 .cindex "&ACL;" "return codes"
26439 Except for the QUIT ACL, which does not affect the SMTP return code (see
26440 section &<<SECTQUITACL>>& above), the result of running an ACL is either
26441 &"accept"& or &"deny"&, or, if some test cannot be completed (for example, if a
26442 database is down), &"defer"&. These results cause 2&'xx'&, 5&'xx'&, and 4&'xx'&
26443 return codes, respectively, to be used in the SMTP dialogue. A fourth return,
26444 &"error"&, occurs when there is an error such as invalid syntax in the ACL.
26445 This also causes a 4&'xx'& return code.
26446
26447 For the non-SMTP ACL, &"defer"& and &"error"& are treated in the same way as
26448 &"deny"&, because there is no mechanism for passing temporary errors to the
26449 submitters of non-SMTP messages.
26450
26451
26452 ACLs that are relevant to message reception may also return &"discard"&. This
26453 has the effect of &"accept"&, but causes either the entire message or an
26454 individual recipient address to be discarded. In other words, it is a
26455 blackholing facility. Use it with care.
26456
26457 If the ACL for MAIL returns &"discard"&, all recipients are discarded, and no
26458 ACL is run for subsequent RCPT commands. The effect of &"discard"& in a
26459 RCPT ACL is to discard just the one recipient address. If there are no
26460 recipients left when the message's data is received, the DATA ACL is not
26461 run. A &"discard"& return from the DATA or the non-SMTP ACL discards all the
26462 remaining recipients. The &"discard"& return is not permitted for the
26463 &%acl_smtp_predata%& ACL.
26464
26465
26466 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "when all recipients discarded"
26467 The &[local_scan()]& function is always run, even if there are no remaining
26468 recipients; it may create new recipients.
26469
26470
26471
26472 .section "Unset ACL options" "SECID197"
26473 .cindex "&ACL;" "unset options"
26474 The default actions when any of the &%acl_%&&'xxx'& options are unset are not
26475 all the same. &*Note*&: These defaults apply only when the relevant ACL is
26476 not defined at all. For any defined ACL, the default action when control
26477 reaches the end of the ACL statements is &"deny"&.
26478
26479 For &%acl_smtp_quit%& and &%acl_not_smtp_start%& there is no default because
26480 these two are ACLs that are used only for their side effects. They cannot be
26481 used to accept or reject anything.
26482
26483 For &%acl_not_smtp%&, &%acl_smtp_auth%&, &%acl_smtp_connect%&,
26484 &%acl_smtp_data%&, &%acl_smtp_helo%&, &%acl_smtp_mail%&, &%acl_smtp_mailauth%&,
26485 &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&, and &%acl_smtp_starttls%&, the action
26486 when the ACL is not defined is &"accept"&.
26487
26488 For the others (&%acl_smtp_etrn%&, &%acl_smtp_expn%&, &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, and
26489 &%acl_smtp_vrfy%&), the action when the ACL is not defined is &"deny"&.
26490 This means that &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& must be defined in order to receive any
26491 messages over an SMTP connection. For an example, see the ACL in the default
26492 configuration file.
26493
26494
26495
26496
26497 .section "Data for message ACLs" "SECID198"
26498 .cindex "&ACL;" "data for message ACL"
26499 .vindex &$domain$&
26500 .vindex &$local_part$&
26501 .vindex &$sender_address$&
26502 .vindex &$sender_host_address$&
26503 .vindex &$smtp_command$&
26504 When a MAIL or RCPT ACL, or either of the DATA ACLs, is running, the variables
26505 that contain information about the host and the message's sender (for example,
26506 &$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_address$&) are set, and can be used in ACL
26507 statements. In the case of RCPT (but not MAIL or DATA), &$domain$& and
26508 &$local_part$& are set from the argument address. The entire SMTP command
26509 is available in &$smtp_command$&.
26510
26511 When an ACL for the AUTH parameter of MAIL is running, the variables that
26512 contain information about the host are set, but &$sender_address$& is not yet
26513 set. Section &<<SECTauthparamail>>& contains a discussion of this parameter and
26514 how it is used.
26515
26516 .vindex "&$message_size$&"
26517 The &$message_size$& variable is set to the value of the SIZE parameter on
26518 the MAIL command at MAIL, RCPT and pre-data time, or to -1 if
26519 that parameter is not given. The value is updated to the true message size by
26520 the time the final DATA ACL is run (after the message data has been
26521 received).
26522
26523 .vindex "&$rcpt_count$&"
26524 .vindex "&$recipients_count$&"
26525 The &$rcpt_count$& variable increases by one for each RCPT command received.
26526 The &$recipients_count$& variable increases by one each time a RCPT command is
26527 accepted, so while an ACL for RCPT is being processed, it contains the number
26528 of previously accepted recipients. At DATA time (for both the DATA ACLs),
26529 &$rcpt_count$& contains the total number of RCPT commands, and
26530 &$recipients_count$& contains the total number of accepted recipients.
26531
26532
26533
26534
26535
26536 .section "Data for non-message ACLs" "SECTdatfornon"
26537 .cindex "&ACL;" "data for non-message ACL"
26538 .vindex &$smtp_command_argument$&
26539 .vindex &$smtp_command$&
26540 When an ACL is being run for AUTH, EHLO, ETRN, EXPN, HELO, STARTTLS, or VRFY,
26541 the remainder of the SMTP command line is placed in &$smtp_command_argument$&,
26542 and the entire SMTP command is available in &$smtp_command$&.
26543 These variables can be tested using a &%condition%& condition. For example,
26544 here is an ACL for use with AUTH, which insists that either the session is
26545 encrypted, or the CRAM-MD5 authentication method is used. In other words, it
26546 does not permit authentication methods that use cleartext passwords on
26547 unencrypted connections.
26548 .code
26549 acl_check_auth:
26550 accept encrypted = *
26551 accept condition = ${if eq{${uc:$smtp_command_argument}}\
26552 {CRAM-MD5}}
26553 deny message = TLS encryption or CRAM-MD5 required
26554 .endd
26555 (Another way of applying this restriction is to arrange for the authenticators
26556 that use cleartext passwords not to be advertised when the connection is not
26557 encrypted. You can use the generic &%server_advertise_condition%& authenticator
26558 option to do this.)
26559
26560
26561
26562 .section "Format of an ACL" "SECID199"
26563 .cindex "&ACL;" "format of"
26564 .cindex "&ACL;" "verbs, definition of"
26565 An individual ACL consists of a number of statements. Each statement starts
26566 with a verb, optionally followed by a number of conditions and &"modifiers"&.
26567 Modifiers can change the way the verb operates, define error and log messages,
26568 set variables, insert delays, and vary the processing of accepted messages.
26569
26570 If all the conditions are met, the verb is obeyed. The same condition may be
26571 used (with different arguments) more than once in the same statement. This
26572 provides a means of specifying an &"and"& conjunction between conditions. For
26573 example:
26574 .code
26575 deny dnslists = list1.example
26576 dnslists = list2.example
26577 .endd
26578 If there are no conditions, the verb is always obeyed. Exim stops evaluating
26579 the conditions and modifiers when it reaches a condition that fails. What
26580 happens then depends on the verb (and in one case, on a special modifier). Not
26581 all the conditions make sense at every testing point. For example, you cannot
26582 test a sender address in the ACL that is run for a VRFY command.
26583
26584
26585 .section "ACL verbs" "SECID200"
26586 The ACL verbs are as follows:
26587
26588 .ilist
26589 .cindex "&%accept%& ACL verb"
26590 &%accept%&: If all the conditions are met, the ACL returns &"accept"&. If any
26591 of the conditions are not met, what happens depends on whether &%endpass%&
26592 appears among the conditions (for syntax see below). If the failing condition
26593 is before &%endpass%&, control is passed to the next ACL statement; if it is
26594 after &%endpass%&, the ACL returns &"deny"&. Consider this statement, used to
26595 check a RCPT command:
26596 .code
26597 accept domains = +local_domains
26598 endpass
26599 verify = recipient
26600 .endd
26601 If the recipient domain does not match the &%domains%& condition, control
26602 passes to the next statement. If it does match, the recipient is verified, and
26603 the command is accepted if verification succeeds. However, if verification
26604 fails, the ACL yields &"deny"&, because the failing condition is after
26605 &%endpass%&.
26606
26607 The &%endpass%& feature has turned out to be confusing to many people, so its
26608 use is not recommended nowadays. It is always possible to rewrite an ACL so
26609 that &%endpass%& is not needed, and it is no longer used in the default
26610 configuration.
26611
26612 .cindex "&%message%& ACL modifier" "with &%accept%&"
26613 If a &%message%& modifier appears on an &%accept%& statement, its action
26614 depends on whether or not &%endpass%& is present. In the absence of &%endpass%&
26615 (when an &%accept%& verb either accepts or passes control to the next
26616 statement), &%message%& can be used to vary the message that is sent when an
26617 SMTP command is accepted. For example, in a RCPT ACL you could have:
26618 .display
26619 &`accept `&<&'some conditions'&>
26620 &` message = OK, I will allow you through today`&
26621 .endd
26622 You can specify an SMTP response code, optionally followed by an &"extended
26623 response code"& at the start of the message, but the first digit must be the
26624 same as would be sent by default, which is 2 for an &%accept%& verb.
26625
26626 If &%endpass%& is present in an &%accept%& statement, &%message%& specifies
26627 an error message that is used when access is denied. This behaviour is retained
26628 for backward compatibility, but current &"best practice"& is to avoid the use
26629 of &%endpass%&.
26630
26631
26632 .next
26633 .cindex "&%defer%& ACL verb"
26634 &%defer%&: If all the conditions are true, the ACL returns &"defer"& which, in
26635 an SMTP session, causes a 4&'xx'& response to be given. For a non-SMTP ACL,
26636 &%defer%& is the same as &%deny%&, because there is no way of sending a
26637 temporary error. For a RCPT command, &%defer%& is much the same as using a
26638 &(redirect)& router and &`:defer:`& while verifying, but the &%defer%& verb can
26639 be used in any ACL, and even for a recipient it might be a simpler approach.
26640
26641
26642 .next
26643 .cindex "&%deny%& ACL verb"
26644 &%deny%&: If all the conditions are met, the ACL returns &"deny"&. If any of
26645 the conditions are not met, control is passed to the next ACL statement. For
26646 example,
26647 .code
26648 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
26649 .endd
26650 rejects commands from hosts that are on a DNS black list.
26651
26652
26653 .next
26654 .cindex "&%discard%& ACL verb"
26655 &%discard%&: This verb behaves like &%accept%&, except that it returns
26656 &"discard"& from the ACL instead of &"accept"&. It is permitted only on ACLs
26657 that are concerned with receiving messages. When all the conditions are true,
26658 the sending entity receives a &"success"& response. However, &%discard%& causes
26659 recipients to be discarded. If it is used in an ACL for RCPT, just the one
26660 recipient is discarded; if used for MAIL, DATA or in the non-SMTP ACL, all the
26661 message's recipients are discarded. Recipients that are discarded before DATA
26662 do not appear in the log line when the &%received_recipients%& log selector is set.
26663
26664 If the &%log_message%& modifier is set when &%discard%& operates,
26665 its contents are added to the line that is automatically written to the log.
26666 The &%message%& modifier operates exactly as it does for &%accept%&.
26667
26668
26669 .next
26670 .cindex "&%drop%& ACL verb"
26671 &%drop%&: This verb behaves like &%deny%&, except that an SMTP connection is
26672 forcibly closed after the 5&'xx'& error message has been sent. For example:
26673 .code
26674 drop message = I don't take more than 20 RCPTs
26675 condition = ${if > {$rcpt_count}{20}}
26676 .endd
26677 There is no difference between &%deny%& and &%drop%& for the connect-time ACL.
26678 The connection is always dropped after sending a 550 response.
26679
26680 .next
26681 .cindex "&%require%& ACL verb"
26682 &%require%&: If all the conditions are met, control is passed to the next ACL
26683 statement. If any of the conditions are not met, the ACL returns &"deny"&. For
26684 example, when checking a RCPT command,
26685 .code
26686 require message = Sender did not verify
26687 verify = sender
26688 .endd
26689 passes control to subsequent statements only if the message's sender can be
26690 verified. Otherwise, it rejects the command. Note the positioning of the
26691 &%message%& modifier, before the &%verify%& condition. The reason for this is
26692 discussed in section &<<SECTcondmodproc>>&.
26693
26694 .next
26695 .cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb"
26696 &%warn%&: If all the conditions are true, a line specified by the
26697 &%log_message%& modifier is written to Exim's main log. Control always passes
26698 to the next ACL statement. If any condition is false, the log line is not
26699 written. If an identical log line is requested several times in the same
26700 message, only one copy is actually written to the log. If you want to force
26701 duplicates to be written, use the &%logwrite%& modifier instead.
26702
26703 If &%log_message%& is not present, a &%warn%& verb just checks its conditions
26704 and obeys any &"immediate"& modifiers (such as &%control%&, &%set%&,
26705 &%logwrite%&, &%add_header%&, and &%remove_header%&) that appear before the
26706 first failing condition. There is more about adding header lines in section
26707 &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&.
26708
26709 If any condition on a &%warn%& statement cannot be completed (that is, there is
26710 some sort of defer), the log line specified by &%log_message%& is not written.
26711 This does not include the case of a forced failure from a lookup, which
26712 is considered to be a successful completion. After a defer, no further
26713 conditions or modifiers in the &%warn%& statement are processed. The incident
26714 is logged, and the ACL continues to be processed, from the next statement
26715 onwards.
26716
26717
26718 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
26719 When one of the &%warn%& conditions is an address verification that fails, the
26720 text of the verification failure message is in &$acl_verify_message$&. If you
26721 want this logged, you must set it up explicitly. For example:
26722 .code
26723 warn !verify = sender
26724 log_message = sender verify failed: $acl_verify_message
26725 .endd
26726 .endlist
26727
26728 At the end of each ACL there is an implicit unconditional &%deny%&.
26729
26730 As you can see from the examples above, the conditions and modifiers are
26731 written one to a line, with the first one on the same line as the verb, and
26732 subsequent ones on following lines. If you have a very long condition, you can
26733 continue it onto several physical lines by the usual backslash continuation
26734 mechanism. It is conventional to align the conditions vertically.
26735
26736
26737
26738 .section "ACL variables" "SECTaclvariables"
26739 .cindex "&ACL;" "variables"
26740 There are some special variables that can be set during ACL processing. They
26741 can be used to pass information between different ACLs, different invocations
26742 of the same ACL in the same SMTP connection, and between ACLs and the routers,
26743 transports, and filters that are used to deliver a message. The names of these
26744 variables must begin with &$acl_c$& or &$acl_m$&, followed either by a digit or
26745 an underscore, but the remainder of the name can be any sequence of
26746 alphanumeric characters and underscores that you choose. There is no limit on
26747 the number of ACL variables. The two sets act as follows:
26748 .ilist
26749 The values of those variables whose names begin with &$acl_c$& persist
26750 throughout an SMTP connection. They are never reset. Thus, a value that is set
26751 while receiving one message is still available when receiving the next message
26752 on the same SMTP connection.
26753 .next
26754 The values of those variables whose names begin with &$acl_m$& persist only
26755 while a message is being received. They are reset afterwards. They are also
26756 reset by MAIL, RSET, EHLO, HELO, and after starting up a TLS session.
26757 .endlist
26758
26759 When a message is accepted, the current values of all the ACL variables are
26760 preserved with the message and are subsequently made available at delivery
26761 time. The ACL variables are set by a modifier called &%set%&. For example:
26762 .code
26763 accept hosts = whatever
26764 set acl_m4 = some value
26765 accept authenticated = *
26766 set acl_c_auth = yes
26767 .endd
26768 &*Note*&: A leading dollar sign is not used when naming a variable that is to
26769 be set. If you want to set a variable without taking any action, you can use a
26770 &%warn%& verb without any other modifiers or conditions.
26771
26772 .oindex &%strict_acl_vars%&
26773 What happens if a syntactically valid but undefined ACL variable is
26774 referenced depends on the setting of the &%strict_acl_vars%& option. If it is
26775 false (the default), an empty string is substituted; if it is true, an
26776 error is generated.
26777
26778 Versions of Exim before 4.64 have a limited set of numbered variables, but
26779 their names are compatible, so there is no problem with upgrading.
26780
26781
26782 .section "Condition and modifier processing" "SECTcondmodproc"
26783 .cindex "&ACL;" "conditions; processing"
26784 .cindex "&ACL;" "modifiers; processing"
26785 An exclamation mark preceding a condition negates its result. For example:
26786 .code
26787 deny domains = *.dom.example
26788 !verify = recipient
26789 .endd
26790 causes the ACL to return &"deny"& if the recipient domain ends in
26791 &'dom.example'& and the recipient address cannot be verified. Sometimes
26792 negation can be used on the right-hand side of a condition. For example, these
26793 two statements are equivalent:
26794 .code
26795 deny hosts = !192.168.3.4
26796 deny !hosts = 192.168.3.4
26797 .endd
26798 However, for many conditions (&%verify%& being a good example), only left-hand
26799 side negation of the whole condition is possible.
26800
26801 The arguments of conditions and modifiers are expanded. A forced failure
26802 of an expansion causes a condition to be ignored, that is, it behaves as if the
26803 condition is true. Consider these two statements:
26804 .code
26805 accept senders = ${lookup{$host_name}lsearch\
26806 {/some/file}{$value}fail}
26807 accept senders = ${lookup{$host_name}lsearch\
26808 {/some/file}{$value}{}}
26809 .endd
26810 Each attempts to look up a list of acceptable senders. If the lookup succeeds,
26811 the returned list is searched, but if the lookup fails the behaviour is
26812 different in the two cases. The &%fail%& in the first statement causes the
26813 condition to be ignored, leaving no further conditions. The &%accept%& verb
26814 therefore succeeds. The second statement, however, generates an empty list when
26815 the lookup fails. No sender can match an empty list, so the condition fails,
26816 and therefore the &%accept%& also fails.
26817
26818 ACL modifiers appear mixed in with conditions in ACL statements. Some of them
26819 specify actions that are taken as the conditions for a statement are checked;
26820 others specify text for messages that are used when access is denied or a
26821 warning is generated. The &%control%& modifier affects the way an incoming
26822 message is handled.
26823
26824 The positioning of the modifiers in an ACL statement is important, because the
26825 processing of a verb ceases as soon as its outcome is known. Only those
26826 modifiers that have already been encountered will take effect. For example,
26827 consider this use of the &%message%& modifier:
26828 .code
26829 require message = Can't verify sender
26830 verify = sender
26831 message = Can't verify recipient
26832 verify = recipient
26833 message = This message cannot be used
26834 .endd
26835 If sender verification fails, Exim knows that the result of the statement is
26836 &"deny"&, so it goes no further. The first &%message%& modifier has been seen,
26837 so its text is used as the error message. If sender verification succeeds, but
26838 recipient verification fails, the second message is used. If recipient
26839 verification succeeds, the third message becomes &"current"&, but is never used
26840 because there are no more conditions to cause failure.
26841
26842 For the &%deny%& verb, on the other hand, it is always the last &%message%&
26843 modifier that is used, because all the conditions must be true for rejection to
26844 happen. Specifying more than one &%message%& modifier does not make sense, and
26845 the message can even be specified after all the conditions. For example:
26846 .code
26847 deny hosts = ...
26848 !senders = *@my.domain.example
26849 message = Invalid sender from client host
26850 .endd
26851 The &"deny"& result does not happen until the end of the statement is reached,
26852 by which time Exim has set up the message.
26853
26854
26855
26856 .section "ACL modifiers" "SECTACLmodi"
26857 .cindex "&ACL;" "modifiers; list of"
26858 The ACL modifiers are as follows:
26859
26860 .vlist
26861 .vitem &*add_header*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
26862 This modifier specifies one or more header lines that are to be added to an
26863 incoming message, assuming, of course, that the message is ultimately
26864 accepted. For details, see section &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&.
26865
26866 .vitem &*continue*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
26867 .cindex "&%continue%& ACL modifier"
26868 .cindex "database" "updating in ACL"
26869 This modifier does nothing of itself, and processing of the ACL always
26870 continues with the next condition or modifier. The value of &%continue%& is in
26871 the side effects of expanding its argument. Typically this could be used to
26872 update a database. It is really just a syntactic tidiness, to avoid having to
26873 write rather ugly lines like this:
26874 .display
26875 &`condition = ${if eq{0}{`&<&'some expansion'&>&`}{true}{true}}`&
26876 .endd
26877 Instead, all you need is
26878 .display
26879 &`continue = `&<&'some expansion'&>
26880 .endd
26881
26882 .vitem &*control*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
26883 .cindex "&%control%& ACL modifier"
26884 This modifier affects the subsequent processing of the SMTP connection or of an
26885 incoming message that is accepted. The effect of the first type of control
26886 lasts for the duration of the connection, whereas the effect of the second type
26887 lasts only until the current message has been received. The message-specific
26888 controls always apply to the whole message, not to individual recipients,
26889 even if the &%control%& modifier appears in a RCPT ACL.
26890
26891 As there are now quite a few controls that can be applied, they are described
26892 separately in section &<<SECTcontrols>>&. The &%control%& modifier can be used
26893 in several different ways. For example:
26894
26895 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
26896 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left. That comment applies only
26897 . ==== when xmlto and fop are used; formatting with sdop gets it right either
26898 . ==== way.
26899
26900 .ilist
26901 It can be at the end of an &%accept%& statement:
26902 .code
26903 accept ...some conditions
26904 control = queue_only
26905 .endd
26906 In this case, the control is applied when this statement yields &"accept"&, in
26907 other words, when the conditions are all true.
26908
26909 .next
26910 It can be in the middle of an &%accept%& statement:
26911 .code
26912 accept ...some conditions...
26913 control = queue_only
26914 ...some more conditions...
26915 .endd
26916 If the first set of conditions are true, the control is applied, even if the
26917 statement does not accept because one of the second set of conditions is false.
26918 In this case, some subsequent statement must yield &"accept"& for the control
26919 to be relevant.
26920
26921 .next
26922 It can be used with &%warn%& to apply the control, leaving the
26923 decision about accepting or denying to a subsequent verb. For
26924 example:
26925 .code
26926 warn ...some conditions...
26927 control = freeze
26928 accept ...
26929 .endd
26930 This example of &%warn%& does not contain &%message%&, &%log_message%&, or
26931 &%logwrite%&, so it does not add anything to the message and does not write a
26932 log entry.
26933
26934 .next
26935 If you want to apply a control unconditionally, you can use it with a
26936 &%require%& verb. For example:
26937 .code
26938 require control = no_multiline_responses
26939 .endd
26940 .endlist
26941
26942 .vitem &*delay*&&~=&~<&'time'&>
26943 .cindex "&%delay%& ACL modifier"
26944 .oindex "&%-bh%&"
26945 This modifier may appear in any ACL except notquit. It causes Exim to wait for
26946 the time interval before proceeding. However, when testing Exim using the
26947 &%-bh%& option, the delay is not actually imposed (an appropriate message is
26948 output instead). The time is given in the usual Exim notation, and the delay
26949 happens as soon as the modifier is processed. In an SMTP session, pending
26950 output is flushed before the delay is imposed.
26951
26952 Like &%control%&, &%delay%& can be used with &%accept%& or &%deny%&, for
26953 example:
26954 .code
26955 deny ...some conditions...
26956 delay = 30s
26957 .endd
26958 The delay happens if all the conditions are true, before the statement returns
26959 &"deny"&. Compare this with:
26960 .code
26961 deny delay = 30s
26962 ...some conditions...
26963 .endd
26964 which waits for 30s before processing the conditions. The &%delay%& modifier
26965 can also be used with &%warn%& and together with &%control%&:
26966 .code
26967 warn ...some conditions...
26968 delay = 2m
26969 control = freeze
26970 accept ...
26971 .endd
26972
26973 If &%delay%& is encountered when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in use,
26974 responses to several commands are no longer buffered and sent in one packet (as
26975 they would normally be) because all output is flushed before imposing the
26976 delay. This optimization is disabled so that a number of small delays do not
26977 appear to the client as one large aggregated delay that might provoke an
26978 unwanted timeout. You can, however, disable output flushing for &%delay%& by
26979 using a &%control%& modifier to set &%no_delay_flush%&.
26980
26981
26982 .vitem &*endpass*&
26983 .cindex "&%endpass%& ACL modifier"
26984 This modifier, which has no argument, is recognized only in &%accept%& and
26985 &%discard%& statements. It marks the boundary between the conditions whose
26986 failure causes control to pass to the next statement, and the conditions whose
26987 failure causes the ACL to return &"deny"&. This concept has proved to be
26988 confusing to some people, so the use of &%endpass%& is no longer recommended as
26989 &"best practice"&. See the description of &%accept%& above for more details.
26990
26991
26992 .vitem &*log_message*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
26993 .cindex "&%log_message%& ACL modifier"
26994 This modifier sets up a message that is used as part of the log message if the
26995 ACL denies access or a &%warn%& statement's conditions are true. For example:
26996 .code
26997 require log_message = wrong cipher suite $tls_in_cipher
26998 encrypted = DES-CBC3-SHA
26999 .endd
27000 &%log_message%& is also used when recipients are discarded by &%discard%&. For
27001 example:
27002 .display
27003 &`discard `&<&'some conditions'&>
27004 &` log_message = Discarded $local_part@$domain because...`&
27005 .endd
27006 When access is denied, &%log_message%& adds to any underlying error message
27007 that may exist because of a condition failure. For example, while verifying a
27008 recipient address, a &':fail:'& redirection might have already set up a
27009 message.
27010
27011 The message may be defined before the conditions to which it applies, because
27012 the string expansion does not happen until Exim decides that access is to be
27013 denied. This means that any variables that are set by the condition are
27014 available for inclusion in the message. For example, the &$dnslist_$&<&'xxx'&>
27015 variables are set after a DNS black list lookup succeeds. If the expansion of
27016 &%log_message%& fails, or if the result is an empty string, the modifier is
27017 ignored.
27018
27019 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
27020 If you want to use a &%warn%& statement to log the result of an address
27021 verification, you can use &$acl_verify_message$& to include the verification
27022 error message.
27023
27024 If &%log_message%& is used with a &%warn%& statement, &"Warning:"& is added to
27025 the start of the logged message. If the same warning log message is requested
27026 more than once while receiving a single email message, only one copy is
27027 actually logged. If you want to log multiple copies, use &%logwrite%& instead
27028 of &%log_message%&. In the absence of &%log_message%& and &%logwrite%&, nothing
27029 is logged for a successful &%warn%& statement.
27030
27031 If &%log_message%& is not present and there is no underlying error message (for
27032 example, from the failure of address verification), but &%message%& is present,
27033 the &%message%& text is used for logging rejections. However, if any text for
27034 logging contains newlines, only the first line is logged. In the absence of
27035 both &%log_message%& and &%message%&, a default built-in message is used for
27036 logging rejections.
27037
27038
27039 .vitem "&*log_reject_target*&&~=&~<&'log name list'&>"
27040 .cindex "&%log_reject_target%& ACL modifier"
27041 .cindex "logging in ACL" "specifying which log"
27042 This modifier makes it possible to specify which logs are used for messages
27043 about ACL rejections. Its argument is a colon-separated list of words that can
27044 be &"main"&, &"reject"&, or &"panic"&. The default is &`main:reject`&. The list
27045 may be empty, in which case a rejection is not logged at all. For example, this
27046 ACL fragment writes no logging information when access is denied:
27047 .display
27048 &`deny `&<&'some conditions'&>
27049 &` log_reject_target =`&
27050 .endd
27051 This modifier can be used in SMTP and non-SMTP ACLs. It applies to both
27052 permanent and temporary rejections. Its effect lasts for the rest of the
27053 current ACL.
27054
27055
27056 .vitem &*logwrite*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
27057 .cindex "&%logwrite%& ACL modifier"
27058 .cindex "logging in ACL" "immediate"
27059 This modifier writes a message to a log file as soon as it is encountered when
27060 processing an ACL. (Compare &%log_message%&, which, except in the case of
27061 &%warn%& and &%discard%&, is used only if the ACL statement denies
27062 access.) The &%logwrite%& modifier can be used to log special incidents in
27063 ACLs. For example:
27064 .display
27065 &`accept `&<&'some special conditions'&>
27066 &` control = freeze`&
27067 &` logwrite = froze message because ...`&
27068 .endd
27069 By default, the message is written to the main log. However, it may begin
27070 with a colon, followed by a comma-separated list of log names, and then
27071 another colon, to specify exactly which logs are to be written. For
27072 example:
27073 .code
27074 logwrite = :main,reject: text for main and reject logs
27075 logwrite = :panic: text for panic log only
27076 .endd
27077
27078
27079 .vitem &*message*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
27080 .cindex "&%message%& ACL modifier"
27081 This modifier sets up a text string that is expanded and used as a response
27082 message when an ACL statement terminates the ACL with an &"accept"&, &"deny"&,
27083 or &"defer"& response. (In the case of the &%accept%& and &%discard%& verbs,
27084 there is some complication if &%endpass%& is involved; see the description of
27085 &%accept%& for details.)
27086
27087 The expansion of the message happens at the time Exim decides that the ACL is
27088 to end, not at the time it processes &%message%&. If the expansion fails, or
27089 generates an empty string, the modifier is ignored. Here is an example where
27090 &%message%& must be specified first, because the ACL ends with a rejection if
27091 the &%hosts%& condition fails:
27092 .code
27093 require message = Host not recognized
27094 hosts = 10.0.0.0/8
27095 .endd
27096 (Once a condition has failed, no further conditions or modifiers are
27097 processed.)
27098
27099 .cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
27100 .oindex "&%smtp_banner%&
27101 For ACLs that are triggered by SMTP commands, the message is returned as part
27102 of the SMTP response. The use of &%message%& with &%accept%& (or &%discard%&)
27103 is meaningful only for SMTP, as no message is returned when a non-SMTP message
27104 is accepted. In the case of the connect ACL, accepting with a message modifier
27105 overrides the value of &%smtp_banner%&. For the EHLO/HELO ACL, a customized
27106 accept message may not contain more than one line (otherwise it will be
27107 truncated at the first newline and a panic logged), and it cannot affect the
27108 EHLO options.
27109
27110 When SMTP is involved, the message may begin with an overriding response code,
27111 consisting of three digits optionally followed by an &"extended response code"&
27112 of the form &'n.n.n'&, each code being followed by a space. For example:
27113 .code
27114 deny message = 599 1.2.3 Host not welcome
27115 hosts = 192.168.34.0/24
27116 .endd
27117 The first digit of the supplied response code must be the same as would be sent
27118 by default. A panic occurs if it is not. Exim uses a 550 code when it denies
27119 access, but for the predata ACL, note that the default success code is 354, not
27120 2&'xx'&.
27121
27122 Notwithstanding the previous paragraph, for the QUIT ACL, unlike the others,
27123 the message modifier cannot override the 221 response code.
27124
27125 The text in a &%message%& modifier is literal; any quotes are taken as
27126 literals, but because the string is expanded, backslash escapes are processed
27127 anyway. If the message contains newlines, this gives rise to a multi-line SMTP
27128 response.
27129
27130 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
27131 If &%message%& is used on a statement that verifies an address, the message
27132 specified overrides any message that is generated by the verification process.
27133 However, the original message is available in the variable
27134 &$acl_verify_message$&, so you can incorporate it into your message if you
27135 wish. In particular, if you want the text from &%:fail:%& items in &(redirect)&
27136 routers to be passed back as part of the SMTP response, you should either not
27137 use a &%message%& modifier, or make use of &$acl_verify_message$&.
27138
27139 For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, a &%message%& modifier that
27140 is used with a &%warn%& verb behaves in a similar way to the &%add_header%&
27141 modifier, but this usage is now deprecated. However, &%message%& acts only when
27142 all the conditions are true, wherever it appears in an ACL command, whereas
27143 &%add_header%& acts as soon as it is encountered. If &%message%& is used with
27144 &%warn%& in an ACL that is not concerned with receiving a message, it has no
27145 effect.
27146
27147
27148 .vitem &*remove_header*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
27149 This modifier specifies one or more header names in a colon-separated list
27150 that are to be removed from an incoming message, assuming, of course, that
27151 the message is ultimately accepted. For details, see section &<<SECTremoveheadacl>>&.
27152
27153
27154 .vitem &*set*&&~<&'acl_name'&>&~=&~<&'value'&>
27155 .cindex "&%set%& ACL modifier"
27156 This modifier puts a value into one of the ACL variables (see section
27157 &<<SECTaclvariables>>&).
27158
27159
27160 .vitem &*udpsend*&&~=&~<&'parameters'&>
27161 This modifier sends a UDP packet, for purposes such as statistics
27162 collection or behaviour monitoring. The parameters are expanded, and
27163 the result of the expansion must be a colon-separated list consisting
27164 of a destination server, port number, and the packet contents. The
27165 server can be specified as a host name or IPv4 or IPv6 address. The
27166 separator can be changed with the usual angle bracket syntax. For
27167 example, you might want to collect information on which hosts connect
27168 when:
27169 .code
27170 udpsend = <; 2001:dB8::dead:beef ; 1234 ;\
27171 $tod_zulu $sender_host_address
27172 .endd
27173 .endlist
27174
27175
27176
27177
27178 .section "Use of the control modifier" "SECTcontrols"
27179 .cindex "&%control%& ACL modifier"
27180 The &%control%& modifier supports the following settings:
27181
27182 .vlist
27183 .vitem &*control&~=&~allow_auth_unadvertised*&
27184 This modifier allows a client host to use the SMTP AUTH command even when it
27185 has not been advertised in response to EHLO. Furthermore, because there are
27186 apparently some really broken clients that do this, Exim will accept AUTH after
27187 HELO (rather than EHLO) when this control is set. It should be used only if you
27188 really need it, and you should limit its use to those broken clients that do
27189 not work without it. For example:
27190 .code
27191 warn hosts = 192.168.34.25
27192 control = allow_auth_unadvertised
27193 .endd
27194 Normally, when an Exim server receives an AUTH command, it checks the name of
27195 the authentication mechanism that is given in the command to ensure that it
27196 matches an advertised mechanism. When this control is set, the check that a
27197 mechanism has been advertised is bypassed. Any configured mechanism can be used
27198 by the client. This control is permitted only in the connection and HELO ACLs.
27199
27200
27201 .vitem &*control&~=&~caseful_local_part*& &&&
27202 &*control&~=&~caselower_local_part*&
27203 .cindex "&ACL;" "case of local part in"
27204 .cindex "case of local parts"
27205 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
27206 These two controls are permitted only in the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&
27207 (that is, during RCPT processing). By default, the contents of &$local_part$&
27208 are lower cased before ACL processing. If &"caseful_local_part"& is specified,
27209 any uppercase letters in the original local part are restored in &$local_part$&
27210 for the rest of the ACL, or until a control that sets &"caselower_local_part"&
27211 is encountered.
27212
27213 These controls affect only the current recipient. Moreover, they apply only to
27214 local part handling that takes place directly in the ACL (for example, as a key
27215 in lookups). If a test to verify the recipient is obeyed, the case-related
27216 handling of the local part during the verification is controlled by the router
27217 configuration (see the &%caseful_local_part%& generic router option).
27218
27219 This facility could be used, for example, to add a spam score to local parts
27220 containing upper case letters. For example, using &$acl_m4$& to accumulate the
27221 spam score:
27222 .code
27223 warn control = caseful_local_part
27224 set acl_m4 = ${eval:\
27225 $acl_m4 + \
27226 ${if match{$local_part}{[A-Z]}{1}{0}}\
27227 }
27228 control = caselower_local_part
27229 .endd
27230 Notice that we put back the lower cased version afterwards, assuming that
27231 is what is wanted for subsequent tests.
27232
27233
27234 .vitem &*control&~=&~cutthrough_delivery*&
27235 .cindex "&ACL;" "cutthrough routing"
27236 .cindex "cutthrough" "requesting"
27237 This option requests delivery be attempted while the item is being received.
27238 It is usable in the RCPT ACL and valid only for single-recipient mails forwarded
27239 from one SMTP connection to another. If a recipient-verify callout connection is
27240 requested in the same ACL it is held open and used for the data, otherwise one is made
27241 after the ACL completes.
27242 Note that routers are used in verify mode.
27243
27244 Should the ultimate destination system positively accept or reject the mail,
27245 a corresponding indication is given to the source system and nothing is queued.
27246 If there is a temporary error the item is queued for later delivery in the
27247 usual fashion. If the item is successfully delivered in cutthrough mode the log line
27248 is tagged with ">>" rather than "=>" and appears before the acceptance "<="
27249 line.
27250
27251 Delivery in this mode avoids the generation of a bounce mail to a (possibly faked)
27252 sender when the destination system is doing content-scan based rejection.
27253
27254
27255 .vitem &*control&~=&~debug/*&<&'options'&>
27256 .cindex "&ACL;" "enabling debug logging"
27257 .cindex "debugging" "enabling from an ACL"
27258 This control turns on debug logging, almost as though Exim had been invoked
27259 with &`-d`&, with the output going to a new logfile, by default called
27260 &'debuglog'&. The filename can be adjusted with the &'tag'& option, which
27261 may access any variables already defined. The logging may be adjusted with
27262 the &'opts'& option, which takes the same values as the &`-d`& command-line
27263 option. Some examples (which depend on variables that don't exist in all
27264 contexts):
27265 .code
27266 control = debug
27267 control = debug/tag=.$sender_host_address
27268 control = debug/opts=+expand+acl
27269 control = debug/tag=.$message_exim_id/opts=+expand
27270 .endd
27271
27272
27273 .vitem &*control&~=&~dkim_disable_verify*&
27274 .cindex "disable DKIM verify"
27275 .cindex "DKIM" "disable verify"
27276 This control turns off DKIM verification processing entirely. For details on
27277 the operation and configuration of DKIM, see chapter &<<CHAPdkim>>&.
27278
27279
27280 .vitem &*control&~=&~dscp/*&<&'value'&>
27281 .cindex "&ACL;" "setting DSCP value"
27282 .cindex "DSCP" "inbound"
27283 This option causes the DSCP value associated with the socket for the inbound
27284 connection to be adjusted to a given value, given as one of a number of fixed
27285 strings or to numeric value.
27286 The &%-bI:dscp%& option may be used to ask Exim which names it knows of.
27287 Common values include &`throughput`&, &`mincost`&, and on newer systems
27288 &`ef`&, &`af41`&, etc. Numeric values may be in the range 0 to 0x3F.
27289
27290 The outbound packets from Exim will be marked with this value in the header
27291 (for IPv4, the TOS field; for IPv6, the TCLASS field); there is no guarantee
27292 that these values will have any effect, not be stripped by networking
27293 equipment, or do much of anything without cooperation with your Network
27294 Engineer and those of all network operators between the source and destination.
27295
27296
27297 .vitem &*control&~=&~enforce_sync*& &&&
27298 &*control&~=&~no_enforce_sync*&
27299 .cindex "SMTP" "synchronization checking"
27300 .cindex "synchronization checking in SMTP"
27301 These controls make it possible to be selective about when SMTP synchronization
27302 is enforced. The global option &%smtp_enforce_sync%& specifies the initial
27303 state of the switch (it is true by default). See the description of this option
27304 in chapter &<<CHAPmainconfig>>& for details of SMTP synchronization checking.
27305
27306 The effect of these two controls lasts for the remainder of the SMTP
27307 connection. They can appear in any ACL except the one for the non-SMTP
27308 messages. The most straightforward place to put them is in the ACL defined by
27309 &%acl_smtp_connect%&, which is run at the start of an incoming SMTP connection,
27310 before the first synchronization check. The expected use is to turn off the
27311 synchronization checks for badly-behaved hosts that you nevertheless need to
27312 work with.
27313
27314
27315 .vitem &*control&~=&~fakedefer/*&<&'message'&>
27316 .cindex "fake defer"
27317 .cindex "defer, fake"
27318 This control works in exactly the same way as &%fakereject%& (described below)
27319 except that it causes an SMTP 450 response after the message data instead of a
27320 550 response. You must take care when using &%fakedefer%& because it causes the
27321 messages to be duplicated when the sender retries. Therefore, you should not
27322 use &%fakedefer%& if the message is to be delivered normally.
27323
27324 .vitem &*control&~=&~fakereject/*&<&'message'&>
27325 .cindex "fake rejection"
27326 .cindex "rejection, fake"
27327 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, and DATA ACLs, in other
27328 words, only when an SMTP message is being received. If Exim accepts the
27329 message, instead the final 250 response, a 550 rejection message is sent.
27330 However, Exim proceeds to deliver the message as normal. The control applies
27331 only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in
27332 the same SMTP connection.
27333
27334 The text for the 550 response is taken from the &%control%& modifier. If no
27335 message is supplied, the following is used:
27336 .code
27337 550-Your message has been rejected but is being
27338 550-kept for evaluation.
27339 550-If it was a legitimate message, it may still be
27340 550 delivered to the target recipient(s).
27341 .endd
27342 This facility should be used with extreme caution.
27343
27344 .vitem &*control&~=&~freeze*&
27345 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing in ACL"
27346 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and non-SMTP ACLs, in
27347 other words, only when a message is being received. If the message is accepted,
27348 it is placed on Exim's queue and frozen. The control applies only to the
27349 current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in the same
27350 SMTP connection.
27351
27352 This modifier can optionally be followed by &`/no_tell`&. If the global option
27353 &%freeze_tell%& is set, it is ignored for the current message (that is, nobody
27354 is told about the freezing), provided all the &*control=freeze*& modifiers that
27355 are obeyed for the current message have the &`/no_tell`& option.
27356
27357 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_delay_flush*&
27358 .cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for delay"
27359 Exim normally flushes SMTP output before implementing a delay in an ACL, to
27360 avoid unexpected timeouts in clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in
27361 use. This control, as long as it is encountered before the &%delay%& modifier,
27362 disables such output flushing.
27363
27364 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_callout_flush*&
27365 .cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for callout"
27366 Exim normally flushes SMTP output before performing a callout in an ACL, to
27367 avoid unexpected timeouts in clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in
27368 use. This control, as long as it is encountered before the &%verify%& condition
27369 that causes the callout, disables such output flushing.
27370
27371 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_mbox_unspool*&
27372 This control is available when Exim is compiled with the content scanning
27373 extension. Content scanning may require a copy of the current message, or parts
27374 of it, to be written in &"mbox format"& to a spool file, for passing to a virus
27375 or spam scanner. Normally, such copies are deleted when they are no longer
27376 needed. If this control is set, the copies are not deleted. The control applies
27377 only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in
27378 the same SMTP connection. It is provided for debugging purposes and is unlikely
27379 to be useful in production.
27380
27381 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_multiline_responses*&
27382 .cindex "multiline responses, suppressing"
27383 This control is permitted for any ACL except the one for non-SMTP messages.
27384 It seems that there are broken clients in use that cannot handle multiline
27385 SMTP responses, despite the fact that RFC 821 defined them over 20 years ago.
27386
27387 If this control is set, multiline SMTP responses from ACL rejections are
27388 suppressed. One way of doing this would have been to put out these responses as
27389 one long line. However, RFC 2821 specifies a maximum of 512 bytes per response
27390 (&"use multiline responses for more"& it says &-- ha!), and some of the
27391 responses might get close to that. So this facility, which is after all only a
27392 sop to broken clients, is implemented by doing two very easy things:
27393
27394 .ilist
27395 Extra information that is normally output as part of a rejection caused by
27396 sender verification failure is omitted. Only the final line (typically &"sender
27397 verification failed"&) is sent.
27398 .next
27399 If a &%message%& modifier supplies a multiline response, only the first
27400 line is output.
27401 .endlist
27402
27403 The setting of the switch can, of course, be made conditional on the
27404 calling host. Its effect lasts until the end of the SMTP connection.
27405
27406 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_pipelining*&
27407 .cindex "PIPELINING" "suppressing advertising"
27408 This control turns off the advertising of the PIPELINING extension to SMTP in
27409 the current session. To be useful, it must be obeyed before Exim sends its
27410 response to an EHLO command. Therefore, it should normally appear in an ACL
27411 controlled by &%acl_smtp_connect%& or &%acl_smtp_helo%&. See also
27412 &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&.
27413
27414 .vitem &*control&~=&~queue_only*&
27415 .oindex "&%queue_only%&"
27416 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
27417 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and non-SMTP ACLs, in
27418 other words, only when a message is being received. If the message is accepted,
27419 it is placed on Exim's queue and left there for delivery by a subsequent queue
27420 runner. No immediate delivery process is started. In other words, it has the
27421 effect as the &%queue_only%& global option. However, the control applies only
27422 to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in the
27423 same SMTP connection.
27424
27425 .vitem &*control&~=&~submission/*&<&'options'&>
27426 .cindex "message" "submission"
27427 .cindex "submission mode"
27428 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, and start of data ACLs (the
27429 latter is the one defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&). Setting it tells Exim that
27430 the current message is a submission from a local MUA. In this case, Exim
27431 operates in &"submission mode"&, and applies certain fixups to the message if
27432 necessary. For example, it adds a &'Date:'& header line if one is not present.
27433 This control is not permitted in the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL, because that is too
27434 late (the message has already been created).
27435
27436 Chapter &<<CHAPmsgproc>>& describes the processing that Exim applies to
27437 messages. Section &<<SECTsubmodnon>>& covers the processing that happens in
27438 submission mode; the available options for this control are described there.
27439 The control applies only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones
27440 that may be received in the same SMTP connection.
27441
27442 .vitem &*control&~=&~suppress_local_fixups*&
27443 .cindex "submission fixups, suppressing"
27444 This control applies to locally submitted (non TCP/IP) messages, and is the
27445 complement of &`control = submission`&. It disables the fixups that are
27446 normally applied to locally-submitted messages. Specifically:
27447
27448 .ilist
27449 Any &'Sender:'& header line is left alone (in this respect, it is a
27450 dynamic version of &%local_sender_retain%&).
27451 .next
27452 No &'Message-ID:'&, &'From:'&, or &'Date:'& header lines are added.
27453 .next
27454 There is no check that &'From:'& corresponds to the actual sender.
27455 .endlist ilist
27456
27457 This control may be useful when a remotely-originated message is accepted,
27458 passed to some scanning program, and then re-submitted for delivery. It can be
27459 used only in the &%acl_smtp_mail%&, &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&,
27460 and &%acl_not_smtp_start%& ACLs, because it has to be set before the message's
27461 data is read.
27462
27463 &*Note:*& This control applies only to the current message, not to any others
27464 that are being submitted at the same time using &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&.
27465 .endlist vlist
27466
27467
27468 .section "Summary of message fixup control" "SECTsummesfix"
27469 All four possibilities for message fixups can be specified:
27470
27471 .ilist
27472 Locally submitted, fixups applied: the default.
27473 .next
27474 Locally submitted, no fixups applied: use
27475 &`control = suppress_local_fixups`&.
27476 .next
27477 Remotely submitted, no fixups applied: the default.
27478 .next
27479 Remotely submitted, fixups applied: use &`control = submission`&.
27480 .endlist
27481
27482
27483
27484 .section "Adding header lines in ACLs" "SECTaddheadacl"
27485 .cindex "header lines" "adding in an ACL"
27486 .cindex "header lines" "position of added lines"
27487 .cindex "&%add_header%& ACL modifier"
27488 The &%add_header%& modifier can be used to add one or more extra header lines
27489 to an incoming message, as in this example:
27490 .code
27491 warn dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
27492 dialup.mail-abuse.org
27493 add_header = X-blacklisted-at: $dnslist_domain
27494 .endd
27495 The &%add_header%& modifier is permitted in the MAIL, RCPT, PREDATA, DATA,
27496 MIME, and non-SMTP ACLs (in other words, those that are concerned with
27497 receiving a message). The message must ultimately be accepted for
27498 &%add_header%& to have any significant effect. You can use &%add_header%& with
27499 any ACL verb, including &%deny%& (though this is potentially useful only in a
27500 RCPT ACL).
27501
27502 Leading and trailing newlines are removed from
27503 the data for the &%add_header%& modifier; if it then
27504 contains one or more newlines that
27505 are not followed by a space or a tab, it is assumed to contain multiple header
27506 lines. Each one is checked for valid syntax; &`X-ACL-Warn:`& is added to the
27507 front of any line that is not a valid header line.
27508
27509 Added header lines are accumulated during the MAIL, RCPT, and predata ACLs.
27510 They are added to the message before processing the DATA and MIME ACLs.
27511 However, if an identical header line is requested more than once, only one copy
27512 is actually added to the message. Further header lines may be accumulated
27513 during the DATA and MIME ACLs, after which they are added to the message, again
27514 with duplicates suppressed. Thus, it is possible to add two identical header
27515 lines to an SMTP message, but only if one is added before DATA and one after.
27516 In the case of non-SMTP messages, new headers are accumulated during the
27517 non-SMTP ACLs, and are added to the message after all the ACLs have run. If a
27518 message is rejected after DATA or by the non-SMTP ACL, all added header lines
27519 are included in the entry that is written to the reject log.
27520
27521 .cindex "header lines" "added; visibility of"
27522 Header lines are not visible in string expansions
27523 of message headers
27524 until they are added to the
27525 message. It follows that header lines defined in the MAIL, RCPT, and predata
27526 ACLs are not visible until the DATA ACL and MIME ACLs are run. Similarly,
27527 header lines that are added by the DATA or MIME ACLs are not visible in those
27528 ACLs. Because of this restriction, you cannot use header lines as a way of
27529 passing data between (for example) the MAIL and RCPT ACLs. If you want to do
27530 this, you can use ACL variables, as described in section
27531 &<<SECTaclvariables>>&.
27532
27533 The list of headers yet to be added is given by the &%$headers_added%& variable.
27534
27535 The &%add_header%& modifier acts immediately as it is encountered during the
27536 processing of an ACL. Notice the difference between these two cases:
27537 .display
27538 &`accept add_header = ADDED: some text`&
27539 &` `&<&'some condition'&>
27540
27541 &`accept `&<&'some condition'&>
27542 &` add_header = ADDED: some text`&
27543 .endd
27544 In the first case, the header line is always added, whether or not the
27545 condition is true. In the second case, the header line is added only if the
27546 condition is true. Multiple occurrences of &%add_header%& may occur in the same
27547 ACL statement. All those that are encountered before a condition fails are
27548 honoured.
27549
27550 .cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb"
27551 For compatibility with previous versions of Exim, a &%message%& modifier for a
27552 &%warn%& verb acts in the same way as &%add_header%&, except that it takes
27553 effect only if all the conditions are true, even if it appears before some of
27554 them. Furthermore, only the last occurrence of &%message%& is honoured. This
27555 usage of &%message%& is now deprecated. If both &%add_header%& and &%message%&
27556 are present on a &%warn%& verb, both are processed according to their
27557 specifications.
27558
27559 By default, new header lines are added to a message at the end of the existing
27560 header lines. However, you can specify that any particular header line should
27561 be added right at the start (before all the &'Received:'& lines), immediately
27562 after the first block of &'Received:'& lines, or immediately before any line
27563 that is not a &'Received:'& or &'Resent-something:'& header.
27564
27565 This is done by specifying &":at_start:"&, &":after_received:"&, or
27566 &":at_start_rfc:"& (or, for completeness, &":at_end:"&) before the text of the
27567 header line, respectively. (Header text cannot start with a colon, as there has
27568 to be a header name first.) For example:
27569 .code
27570 warn add_header = \
27571 :after_received:X-My-Header: something or other...
27572 .endd
27573 If more than one header line is supplied in a single &%add_header%& modifier,
27574 each one is treated independently and can therefore be placed differently. If
27575 you add more than one line at the start, or after the Received: block, they end
27576 up in reverse order.
27577
27578 &*Warning*&: This facility currently applies only to header lines that are
27579 added in an ACL. It does NOT work for header lines that are added in a
27580 system filter or in a router or transport.
27581
27582
27583
27584 .section "Removing header lines in ACLs" "SECTremoveheadacl"
27585 .cindex "header lines" "removing in an ACL"
27586 .cindex "header lines" "position of removed lines"
27587 .cindex "&%remove_header%& ACL modifier"
27588 The &%remove_header%& modifier can be used to remove one or more header lines
27589 from an incoming message, as in this example:
27590 .code
27591 warn message = Remove internal headers
27592 remove_header = x-route-mail1 : x-route-mail2
27593 .endd
27594 The &%remove_header%& modifier is permitted in the MAIL, RCPT, PREDATA, DATA,
27595 MIME, and non-SMTP ACLs (in other words, those that are concerned with
27596 receiving a message). The message must ultimately be accepted for
27597 &%remove_header%& to have any significant effect. You can use &%remove_header%&
27598 with any ACL verb, including &%deny%&, though this is really not useful for
27599 any verb that doesn't result in a delivered message.
27600
27601 More than one header can be removed at the same time by using a colon separated
27602 list of header names. The header matching is case insensitive. Wildcards are
27603 not permitted, nor is list expansion performed, so you cannot use hostlists to
27604 create a list of headers, however both connection and message variable expansion
27605 are performed (&%$acl_c_*%& and &%$acl_m_*%&), illustrated in this example:
27606 .code
27607 warn hosts = +internal_hosts
27608 set acl_c_ihdrs = x-route-mail1 : x-route-mail2
27609 warn message = Remove internal headers
27610 remove_header = $acl_c_ihdrs
27611 .endd
27612 Removed header lines are accumulated during the MAIL, RCPT, and predata ACLs.
27613 They are removed from the message before processing the DATA and MIME ACLs.
27614 There is no harm in attempting to remove the same header twice nor is removing
27615 a non-existent header. Further header lines to be removed may be accumulated
27616 during the DATA and MIME ACLs, after which they are removed from the message,
27617 if present. In the case of non-SMTP messages, headers to be removed are
27618 accumulated during the non-SMTP ACLs, and are removed from the message after
27619 all the ACLs have run. If a message is rejected after DATA or by the non-SMTP
27620 ACL, there really is no effect because there is no logging of what headers
27621 would have been removed.
27622
27623 .cindex "header lines" "removed; visibility of"
27624 Header lines are not visible in string expansions until the DATA phase when it
27625 is received. Any header lines removed in the MAIL, RCPT, and predata ACLs are
27626 not visible in the DATA ACL and MIME ACLs. Similarly, header lines that are
27627 removed by the DATA or MIME ACLs are still visible in those ACLs. Because of
27628 this restriction, you cannot use header lines as a way of controlling data
27629 passed between (for example) the MAIL and RCPT ACLs. If you want to do this,
27630 you should instead use ACL variables, as described in section
27631 &<<SECTaclvariables>>&.
27632
27633 The &%remove_header%& modifier acts immediately as it is encountered during the
27634 processing of an ACL. Notice the difference between these two cases:
27635 .display
27636 &`accept remove_header = X-Internal`&
27637 &` `&<&'some condition'&>
27638
27639 &`accept `&<&'some condition'&>
27640 &` remove_header = X-Internal`&
27641 .endd
27642 In the first case, the header line is always removed, whether or not the
27643 condition is true. In the second case, the header line is removed only if the
27644 condition is true. Multiple occurrences of &%remove_header%& may occur in the
27645 same ACL statement. All those that are encountered before a condition fails
27646 are honoured.
27647
27648 &*Warning*&: This facility currently applies only to header lines that are
27649 present during ACL processing. It does NOT remove header lines that are added
27650 in a system filter or in a router or transport.
27651
27652
27653
27654
27655 .section "ACL conditions" "SECTaclconditions"
27656 .cindex "&ACL;" "conditions; list of"
27657 Some of the conditions listed in this section are available only when Exim is
27658 compiled with the content-scanning extension. They are included here briefly
27659 for completeness. More detailed descriptions can be found in the discussion on
27660 content scanning in chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
27661
27662 Not all conditions are relevant in all circumstances. For example, testing
27663 senders and recipients does not make sense in an ACL that is being run as the
27664 result of the arrival of an ETRN command, and checks on message headers can be
27665 done only in the ACLs specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& and &%acl_not_smtp%&. You
27666 can use the same condition (with different parameters) more than once in the
27667 same ACL statement. This provides a way of specifying an &"and"& conjunction.
27668 The conditions are as follows:
27669
27670
27671 .vlist
27672 .vitem &*acl&~=&~*&<&'name&~of&~acl&~or&~ACL&~string&~or&~file&~name&~'&>
27673 .cindex "&ACL;" "nested"
27674 .cindex "&ACL;" "indirect"
27675 .cindex "&ACL;" "arguments"
27676 .cindex "&%acl%& ACL condition"
27677 The possible values of the argument are the same as for the
27678 &%acl_smtp_%&&'xxx'& options. The named or inline ACL is run. If it returns
27679 &"accept"& the condition is true; if it returns &"deny"& the condition is
27680 false. If it returns &"defer"&, the current ACL returns &"defer"& unless the
27681 condition is on a &%warn%& verb. In that case, a &"defer"& return makes the
27682 condition false. This means that further processing of the &%warn%& verb
27683 ceases, but processing of the ACL continues.
27684
27685 If the argument is a named ACL, up to nine space-separated optional values
27686 can be appended; they appear within the called ACL in $acl_arg1 to $acl_arg9,
27687 and $acl_narg is set to the count of values.
27688 Previous values of these variables are restored after the call returns.
27689 The name and values are expanded separately.
27690
27691 If the nested &%acl%& returns &"drop"& and the outer condition denies access,
27692 the connection is dropped. If it returns &"discard"&, the verb must be
27693 &%accept%& or &%discard%&, and the action is taken immediately &-- no further
27694 conditions are tested.
27695
27696 ACLs may be nested up to 20 deep; the limit exists purely to catch runaway
27697 loops. This condition allows you to use different ACLs in different
27698 circumstances. For example, different ACLs can be used to handle RCPT commands
27699 for different local users or different local domains.
27700
27701 .vitem &*authenticated&~=&~*&<&'string&~list'&>
27702 .cindex "&%authenticated%& ACL condition"
27703 .cindex "authentication" "ACL checking"
27704 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing for authentication"
27705 If the SMTP connection is not authenticated, the condition is false. Otherwise,
27706 the name of the authenticator is tested against the list. To test for
27707 authentication by any authenticator, you can set
27708 .code
27709 authenticated = *
27710 .endd
27711
27712 .vitem &*condition&~=&~*&<&'string'&>
27713 .cindex "&%condition%& ACL condition"
27714 .cindex "customizing" "ACL condition"
27715 .cindex "&ACL;" "customized test"
27716 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing, customized"
27717 This feature allows you to make up custom conditions. If the result of
27718 expanding the string is an empty string, the number zero, or one of the strings
27719 &"no"& or &"false"&, the condition is false. If the result is any non-zero
27720 number, or one of the strings &"yes"& or &"true"&, the condition is true. For
27721 any other value, some error is assumed to have occurred, and the ACL returns
27722 &"defer"&. However, if the expansion is forced to fail, the condition is
27723 ignored. The effect is to treat it as true, whether it is positive or
27724 negative.
27725
27726 .vitem &*decode&~=&~*&<&'location'&>
27727 .cindex "&%decode%& ACL condition"
27728 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
27729 content-scanning extension, and it is allowed only in the ACL defined by
27730 &%acl_smtp_mime%&. It causes the current MIME part to be decoded into a file.
27731 If all goes well, the condition is true. It is false only if there are
27732 problems such as a syntax error or a memory shortage. For more details, see
27733 chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
27734
27735 .vitem &*demime&~=&~*&<&'extension&~list'&>
27736 .cindex "&%demime%& ACL condition"
27737 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
27738 content-scanning extension. Its use is described in section
27739 &<<SECTdemimecond>>&.
27740
27741 .vitem &*dnslists&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~domain&~names&~and&~other&~data'&>
27742 .cindex "&%dnslists%& ACL condition"
27743 .cindex "DNS list" "in ACL"
27744 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
27745 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a DNS list"
27746 This condition checks for entries in DNS black lists. These are also known as
27747 &"RBL lists"&, after the original Realtime Blackhole List, but note that the
27748 use of the lists at &'mail-abuse.org'& now carries a charge. There are too many
27749 different variants of this condition to describe briefly here. See sections
27750 &<<SECTmorednslists>>&&--&<<SECTmorednslistslast>>& for details.
27751
27752 .vitem &*domains&~=&~*&<&'domain&~list'&>
27753 .cindex "&%domains%& ACL condition"
27754 .cindex "domain" "ACL checking"
27755 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a recipient domain"
27756 .vindex "&$domain_data$&"
27757 This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It checks that the domain
27758 of the recipient address is in the domain list. If percent-hack processing is
27759 enabled, it is done before this test is done. If the check succeeds with a
27760 lookup, the result of the lookup is placed in &$domain_data$& until the next
27761 &%domains%& test.
27762
27763 &*Note carefully*& (because many people seem to fall foul of this): you cannot
27764 use &%domains%& in a DATA ACL.
27765
27766
27767 .vitem &*encrypted&~=&~*&<&'string&~list'&>
27768 .cindex "&%encrypted%& ACL condition"
27769 .cindex "encryption" "checking in an ACL"
27770 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing for encryption"
27771 If the SMTP connection is not encrypted, the condition is false. Otherwise, the
27772 name of the cipher suite in use is tested against the list. To test for
27773 encryption without testing for any specific cipher suite(s), set
27774 .code
27775 encrypted = *
27776 .endd
27777
27778
27779 .vitem &*hosts&~=&~*&<&'host&~list'&>
27780 .cindex "&%hosts%& ACL condition"
27781 .cindex "host" "ACL checking"
27782 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing the client host"
27783 This condition tests that the calling host matches the host list. If you have
27784 name lookups or wildcarded host names and IP addresses in the same host list,
27785 you should normally put the IP addresses first. For example, you could have:
27786 .code
27787 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7 : dbm;/etc/friendly/hosts
27788 .endd
27789 The lookup in this example uses the host name for its key. This is implied by
27790 the lookup type &"dbm"&. (For a host address lookup you would use &"net-dbm"&
27791 and it wouldn't matter which way round you had these two items.)
27792
27793 The reason for the problem with host names lies in the left-to-right way that
27794 Exim processes lists. It can test IP addresses without doing any DNS lookups,
27795 but when it reaches an item that requires a host name, it fails if it cannot
27796 find a host name to compare with the pattern. If the above list is given in the
27797 opposite order, the &%accept%& statement fails for a host whose name cannot be
27798 found, even if its IP address is 10.9.8.7.
27799
27800 If you really do want to do the name check first, and still recognize the IP
27801 address even if the name lookup fails, you can rewrite the ACL like this:
27802 .code
27803 accept hosts = dbm;/etc/friendly/hosts
27804 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7
27805 .endd
27806 The default action on failing to find the host name is to assume that the host
27807 is not in the list, so the first &%accept%& statement fails. The second
27808 statement can then check the IP address.
27809
27810 .vindex "&$host_data$&"
27811 If a &%hosts%& condition is satisfied by means of a lookup, the result
27812 of the lookup is made available in the &$host_data$& variable. This
27813 allows you, for example, to set up a statement like this:
27814 .code
27815 deny hosts = net-lsearch;/some/file
27816 message = $host_data
27817 .endd
27818 which gives a custom error message for each denied host.
27819
27820 .vitem &*local_parts&~=&~*&<&'local&~part&~list'&>
27821 .cindex "&%local_parts%& ACL condition"
27822 .cindex "local part" "ACL checking"
27823 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a local part"
27824 .vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
27825 This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It checks that the local
27826 part of the recipient address is in the list. If percent-hack processing is
27827 enabled, it is done before this test. If the check succeeds with a lookup, the
27828 result of the lookup is placed in &$local_part_data$&, which remains set until
27829 the next &%local_parts%& test.
27830
27831 .vitem &*malware&~=&~*&<&'option'&>
27832 .cindex "&%malware%& ACL condition"
27833 .cindex "&ACL;" "virus scanning"
27834 .cindex "&ACL;" "scanning for viruses"
27835 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
27836 content-scanning extension. It causes the incoming message to be scanned for
27837 viruses. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
27838
27839 .vitem &*mime_regex&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~regular&~expressions'&>
27840 .cindex "&%mime_regex%& ACL condition"
27841 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing by regex matching"
27842 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
27843 content-scanning extension, and it is allowed only in the ACL defined by
27844 &%acl_smtp_mime%&. It causes the current MIME part to be scanned for a match
27845 with any of the regular expressions. For details, see chapter
27846 &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
27847
27848 .vitem &*ratelimit&~=&~*&<&'parameters'&>
27849 .cindex "rate limiting"
27850 This condition can be used to limit the rate at which a user or host submits
27851 messages. Details are given in section &<<SECTratelimiting>>&.
27852
27853 .vitem &*recipients&~=&~*&<&'address&~list'&>
27854 .cindex "&%recipients%& ACL condition"
27855 .cindex "recipient" "ACL checking"
27856 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a recipient"
27857 This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It checks the entire
27858 recipient address against a list of recipients.
27859
27860 .vitem &*regex&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~regular&~expressions'&>
27861 .cindex "&%regex%& ACL condition"
27862 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing by regex matching"
27863 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
27864 content-scanning extension, and is available only in the DATA, MIME, and
27865 non-SMTP ACLs. It causes the incoming message to be scanned for a match with
27866 any of the regular expressions. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
27867
27868 .vitem &*sender_domains&~=&~*&<&'domain&~list'&>
27869 .cindex "&%sender_domains%& ACL condition"
27870 .cindex "sender" "ACL checking"
27871 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a sender domain"
27872 .vindex "&$domain$&"
27873 .vindex "&$sender_address_domain$&"
27874 This condition tests the domain of the sender of the message against the given
27875 domain list. &*Note*&: The domain of the sender address is in
27876 &$sender_address_domain$&. It is &'not'& put in &$domain$& during the testing
27877 of this condition. This is an exception to the general rule for testing domain
27878 lists. It is done this way so that, if this condition is used in an ACL for a
27879 RCPT command, the recipient's domain (which is in &$domain$&) can be used to
27880 influence the sender checking.
27881
27882 &*Warning*&: It is a bad idea to use this condition on its own as a control on
27883 relaying, because sender addresses are easily, and commonly, forged.
27884
27885 .vitem &*senders&~=&~*&<&'address&~list'&>
27886 .cindex "&%senders%& ACL condition"
27887 .cindex "sender" "ACL checking"
27888 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a sender"
27889 This condition tests the sender of the message against the given list. To test
27890 for a bounce message, which has an empty sender, set
27891 .code
27892 senders = :
27893 .endd
27894 &*Warning*&: It is a bad idea to use this condition on its own as a control on
27895 relaying, because sender addresses are easily, and commonly, forged.
27896
27897 .vitem &*spam&~=&~*&<&'username'&>
27898 .cindex "&%spam%& ACL condition"
27899 .cindex "&ACL;" "scanning for spam"
27900 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
27901 content-scanning extension. It causes the incoming message to be scanned by
27902 SpamAssassin. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
27903
27904 .vitem &*verify&~=&~certificate*&
27905 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
27906 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
27907 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
27908 .cindex "&ACL;" "certificate verification"
27909 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a TLS certificate"
27910 This condition is true in an SMTP session if the session is encrypted, and a
27911 certificate was received from the client, and the certificate was verified. The
27912 server requests a certificate only if the client matches &%tls_verify_hosts%&
27913 or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& (see chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&).
27914
27915 .vitem &*verify&~=&~csa*&
27916 .cindex "CSA verification"
27917 This condition checks whether the sending host (the client) is authorized to
27918 send email. Details of how this works are given in section
27919 &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
27920
27921 .vitem &*verify&~=&~header_sender/*&<&'options'&>
27922 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
27923 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying sender in the header"
27924 .cindex "header lines" "verifying the sender in"
27925 .cindex "sender" "verifying in header"
27926 .cindex "verifying" "sender in header"
27927 This condition is relevant only in an ACL that is run after a message has been
27928 received, that is, in an ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& or
27929 &%acl_not_smtp%&. It checks that there is a verifiable address in at least one
27930 of the &'Sender:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, or &'From:'& header lines. Such an address
27931 is loosely thought of as a &"sender"& address (hence the name of the test).
27932 However, an address that appears in one of these headers need not be an address
27933 that accepts bounce messages; only sender addresses in envelopes are required
27934 to accept bounces. Therefore, if you use the callout option on this check, you
27935 might want to arrange for a non-empty address in the MAIL command.
27936
27937 Details of address verification and the options are given later, starting at
27938 section &<<SECTaddressverification>>& (callouts are described in section
27939 &<<SECTcallver>>&). You can combine this condition with the &%senders%&
27940 condition to restrict it to bounce messages only:
27941 .code
27942 deny senders = :
27943 message = A valid sender header is required for bounces
27944 !verify = header_sender
27945 .endd
27946
27947 .vitem &*verify&~=&~header_syntax*&
27948 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
27949 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying header syntax"
27950 .cindex "header lines" "verifying syntax"
27951 .cindex "verifying" "header syntax"
27952 This condition is relevant only in an ACL that is run after a message has been
27953 received, that is, in an ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& or
27954 &%acl_not_smtp%&. It checks the syntax of all header lines that can contain
27955 lists of addresses (&'Sender:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&,
27956 and &'Bcc:'&). Unqualified addresses (local parts without domains) are
27957 permitted only in locally generated messages and from hosts that match
27958 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&, as
27959 appropriate.
27960
27961 Note that this condition is a syntax check only. However, a common spamming
27962 ploy used to be to send syntactically invalid headers such as
27963 .code
27964 To: @
27965 .endd
27966 and this condition can be used to reject such messages, though they are not as
27967 common as they used to be.
27968
27969 .vitem &*verify&~=&~helo*&
27970 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
27971 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying HELO/EHLO"
27972 .cindex "HELO" "verifying"
27973 .cindex "EHLO" "verifying"
27974 .cindex "verifying" "EHLO"
27975 .cindex "verifying" "HELO"
27976 This condition is true if a HELO or EHLO command has been received from the
27977 client host, and its contents have been verified. If there has been no previous
27978 attempt to verify the HELO/EHLO contents, it is carried out when this
27979 condition is encountered. See the description of the &%helo_verify_hosts%& and
27980 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& options for details of how to request verification
27981 independently of this condition.
27982
27983 For SMTP input that does not come over TCP/IP (the &%-bs%& command line
27984 option), this condition is always true.
27985
27986
27987 .vitem &*verify&~=&~not_blind*&
27988 .cindex "verifying" "not blind"
27989 .cindex "bcc recipients, verifying none"
27990 This condition checks that there are no blind (bcc) recipients in the message.
27991 Every envelope recipient must appear either in a &'To:'& header line or in a
27992 &'Cc:'& header line for this condition to be true. Local parts are checked
27993 case-sensitively; domains are checked case-insensitively. If &'Resent-To:'& or
27994 &'Resent-Cc:'& header lines exist, they are also checked. This condition can be
27995 used only in a DATA or non-SMTP ACL.
27996
27997 There are, of course, many legitimate messages that make use of blind (bcc)
27998 recipients. This check should not be used on its own for blocking messages.
27999
28000
28001 .vitem &*verify&~=&~recipient/*&<&'options'&>
28002 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
28003 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying recipient"
28004 .cindex "recipient" "verifying"
28005 .cindex "verifying" "recipient"
28006 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
28007 This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It verifies the current
28008 recipient. Details of address verification are given later, starting at section
28009 &<<SECTaddressverification>>&. After a recipient has been verified, the value
28010 of &$address_data$& is the last value that was set while routing the address.
28011 This applies even if the verification fails. When an address that is being
28012 verified is redirected to a single address, verification continues with the new
28013 address, and in that case, the subsequent value of &$address_data$& is the
28014 value for the child address.
28015
28016 .vitem &*verify&~=&~reverse_host_lookup*&
28017 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
28018 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying host reverse lookup"
28019 .cindex "host" "verifying reverse lookup"
28020 This condition ensures that a verified host name has been looked up from the IP
28021 address of the client host. (This may have happened already if the host name
28022 was needed for checking a host list, or if the host matched &%host_lookup%&.)
28023 Verification ensures that the host name obtained from a reverse DNS lookup, or
28024 one of its aliases, does, when it is itself looked up in the DNS, yield the
28025 original IP address.
28026
28027 If this condition is used for a locally generated message (that is, when there
28028 is no client host involved), it always succeeds.
28029
28030 .vitem &*verify&~=&~sender/*&<&'options'&>
28031 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
28032 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying sender"
28033 .cindex "sender" "verifying"
28034 .cindex "verifying" "sender"
28035 This condition is relevant only after a MAIL or RCPT command, or after a
28036 message has been received (the &%acl_smtp_data%& or &%acl_not_smtp%& ACLs). If
28037 the message's sender is empty (that is, this is a bounce message), the
28038 condition is true. Otherwise, the sender address is verified.
28039
28040 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
28041 .vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
28042 If there is data in the &$address_data$& variable at the end of routing, its
28043 value is placed in &$sender_address_data$& at the end of verification. This
28044 value can be used in subsequent conditions and modifiers in the same ACL
28045 statement. It does not persist after the end of the current statement. If you
28046 want to preserve the value for longer, you can save it in an ACL variable.
28047
28048 Details of verification are given later, starting at section
28049 &<<SECTaddressverification>>&. Exim caches the result of sender verification,
28050 to avoid doing it more than once per message.
28051
28052 .vitem &*verify&~=&~sender=*&<&'address'&>&*/*&<&'options'&>
28053 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
28054 This is a variation of the previous option, in which a modified address is
28055 verified as a sender.
28056 .endlist
28057
28058
28059
28060 .section "Using DNS lists" "SECTmorednslists"
28061 .cindex "DNS list" "in ACL"
28062 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
28063 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a DNS list"
28064 In its simplest form, the &%dnslists%& condition tests whether the calling host
28065 is on at least one of a number of DNS lists by looking up the inverted IP
28066 address in one or more DNS domains. (Note that DNS list domains are not mail
28067 domains, so the &`+`& syntax for named lists doesn't work - it is used for
28068 special options instead.) For example, if the calling host's IP
28069 address is 192.168.62.43, and the ACL statement is
28070 .code
28071 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org : \
28072 dialups.mail-abuse.org
28073 .endd
28074 the following records are looked up:
28075 .code
28076 43.62.168.192.blackholes.mail-abuse.org
28077 43.62.168.192.dialups.mail-abuse.org
28078 .endd
28079 As soon as Exim finds an existing DNS record, processing of the list stops.
28080 Thus, multiple entries on the list provide an &"or"& conjunction. If you want
28081 to test that a host is on more than one list (an &"and"& conjunction), you can
28082 use two separate conditions:
28083 .code
28084 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
28085 dnslists = dialups.mail-abuse.org
28086 .endd
28087 If a DNS lookup times out or otherwise fails to give a decisive answer, Exim
28088 behaves as if the host does not match the list item, that is, as if the DNS
28089 record does not exist. If there are further items in the DNS list, they are
28090 processed.
28091
28092 This is usually the required action when &%dnslists%& is used with &%deny%&
28093 (which is the most common usage), because it prevents a DNS failure from
28094 blocking mail. However, you can change this behaviour by putting one of the
28095 following special items in the list:
28096 .display
28097 &`+include_unknown `& behave as if the item is on the list
28098 &`+exclude_unknown `& behave as if the item is not on the list (default)
28099 &`+defer_unknown `& give a temporary error
28100 .endd
28101 .cindex "&`+include_unknown`&"
28102 .cindex "&`+exclude_unknown`&"
28103 .cindex "&`+defer_unknown`&"
28104 Each of these applies to any subsequent items on the list. For example:
28105 .code
28106 deny dnslists = +defer_unknown : foo.bar.example
28107 .endd
28108 Testing the list of domains stops as soon as a match is found. If you want to
28109 warn for one list and block for another, you can use two different statements:
28110 .code
28111 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
28112 warn message = X-Warn: sending host is on dialups list
28113 dnslists = dialups.mail-abuse.org
28114 .endd
28115 DNS list lookups are cached by Exim for the duration of the SMTP session,
28116 so a lookup based on the IP address is done at most once for any incoming
28117 connection. Exim does not share information between multiple incoming
28118 connections (but your local name server cache should be active).
28119
28120
28121
28122 .section "Specifying the IP address for a DNS list lookup" "SECID201"
28123 .cindex "DNS list" "keyed by explicit IP address"
28124 By default, the IP address that is used in a DNS list lookup is the IP address
28125 of the calling host. However, you can specify another IP address by listing it
28126 after the domain name, introduced by a slash. For example:
28127 .code
28128 deny dnslists = black.list.tld/192.168.1.2
28129 .endd
28130 This feature is not very helpful with explicit IP addresses; it is intended for
28131 use with IP addresses that are looked up, for example, the IP addresses of the
28132 MX hosts or nameservers of an email sender address. For an example, see section
28133 &<<SECTmulkeyfor>>& below.
28134
28135
28136
28137
28138 .section "DNS lists keyed on domain names" "SECID202"
28139 .cindex "DNS list" "keyed by domain name"
28140 There are some lists that are keyed on domain names rather than inverted IP
28141 addresses (see for example the &'domain based zones'& link at
28142 &url(http://www.rfc-ignorant.org/)). No reversing of components is used
28143 with these lists. You can change the name that is looked up in a DNS list by
28144 listing it after the domain name, introduced by a slash. For example,
28145 .code
28146 deny message = Sender's domain is listed at $dnslist_domain
28147 dnslists = dsn.rfc-ignorant.org/$sender_address_domain
28148 .endd
28149 This particular example is useful only in ACLs that are obeyed after the
28150 RCPT or DATA commands, when a sender address is available. If (for
28151 example) the message's sender is &'user@tld.example'& the name that is looked
28152 up by this example is
28153 .code
28154 tld.example.dsn.rfc-ignorant.org
28155 .endd
28156 A single &%dnslists%& condition can contain entries for both names and IP
28157 addresses. For example:
28158 .code
28159 deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
28160 dsn.rfc-ignorant.org/$sender_address_domain
28161 .endd
28162 The first item checks the sending host's IP address; the second checks a domain
28163 name. The whole condition is true if either of the DNS lookups succeeds.
28164
28165
28166
28167
28168 .section "Multiple explicit keys for a DNS list" "SECTmulkeyfor"
28169 .cindex "DNS list" "multiple keys for"
28170 The syntax described above for looking up explicitly-defined values (either
28171 names or IP addresses) in a DNS blacklist is a simplification. After the domain
28172 name for the DNS list, what follows the slash can in fact be a list of items.
28173 As with all lists in Exim, the default separator is a colon. However, because
28174 this is a sublist within the list of DNS blacklist domains, it is necessary
28175 either to double the separators like this:
28176 .code
28177 dnslists = black.list.tld/name.1::name.2
28178 .endd
28179 or to change the separator character, like this:
28180 .code
28181 dnslists = black.list.tld/<;name.1;name.2
28182 .endd
28183 If an item in the list is an IP address, it is inverted before the DNS
28184 blacklist domain is appended. If it is not an IP address, no inversion
28185 occurs. Consider this condition:
28186 .code
28187 dnslists = black.list.tld/<;192.168.1.2;a.domain
28188 .endd
28189 The DNS lookups that occur are:
28190 .code
28191 2.1.168.192.black.list.tld
28192 a.domain.black.list.tld
28193 .endd
28194 Once a DNS record has been found (that matches a specific IP return
28195 address, if specified &-- see section &<<SECTaddmatcon>>&), no further lookups
28196 are done. If there is a temporary DNS error, the rest of the sublist of domains
28197 or IP addresses is tried. A temporary error for the whole dnslists item occurs
28198 only if no other DNS lookup in this sublist succeeds. In other words, a
28199 successful lookup for any of the items in the sublist overrides a temporary
28200 error for a previous item.
28201
28202 The ability to supply a list of items after the slash is in some sense just a
28203 syntactic convenience. These two examples have the same effect:
28204 .code
28205 dnslists = black.list.tld/a.domain : black.list.tld/b.domain
28206 dnslists = black.list.tld/a.domain::b.domain
28207 .endd
28208 However, when the data for the list is obtained from a lookup, the second form
28209 is usually much more convenient. Consider this example:
28210 .code
28211 deny message = The mail servers for the domain \
28212 $sender_address_domain \
28213 are listed at $dnslist_domain ($dnslist_value); \
28214 see $dnslist_text.
28215 dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org/<|${lookup dnsdb {>|a=<|\
28216 ${lookup dnsdb {>|mxh=\
28217 $sender_address_domain} }} }
28218 .endd
28219 Note the use of &`>|`& in the dnsdb lookup to specify the separator for
28220 multiple DNS records. The inner dnsdb lookup produces a list of MX hosts
28221 and the outer dnsdb lookup finds the IP addresses for these hosts. The result
28222 of expanding the condition might be something like this:
28223 .code
28224 dnslists = sbl.spahmaus.org/<|192.168.2.3|192.168.5.6|...
28225 .endd
28226 Thus, this example checks whether or not the IP addresses of the sender
28227 domain's mail servers are on the Spamhaus black list.
28228
28229 The key that was used for a successful DNS list lookup is put into the variable
28230 &$dnslist_matched$& (see section &<<SECID204>>&).
28231
28232
28233
28234
28235 .section "Data returned by DNS lists" "SECID203"
28236 .cindex "DNS list" "data returned from"
28237 DNS lists are constructed using address records in the DNS. The original RBL
28238 just used the address 127.0.0.1 on the right hand side of each record, but the
28239 RBL+ list and some other lists use a number of values with different meanings.
28240 The values used on the RBL+ list are:
28241 .display
28242 127.1.0.1 RBL
28243 127.1.0.2 DUL
28244 127.1.0.3 DUL and RBL
28245 127.1.0.4 RSS
28246 127.1.0.5 RSS and RBL
28247 127.1.0.6 RSS and DUL
28248 127.1.0.7 RSS and DUL and RBL
28249 .endd
28250 Section &<<SECTaddmatcon>>& below describes how you can distinguish between
28251 different values. Some DNS lists may return more than one address record;
28252 see section &<<SECThanmuldnsrec>>& for details of how they are checked.
28253
28254
28255 .section "Variables set from DNS lists" "SECID204"
28256 .cindex "expansion" "variables, set from DNS list"
28257 .cindex "DNS list" "variables set from"
28258 .vindex "&$dnslist_domain$&"
28259 .vindex "&$dnslist_matched$&"
28260 .vindex "&$dnslist_text$&"
28261 .vindex "&$dnslist_value$&"
28262 When an entry is found in a DNS list, the variable &$dnslist_domain$& contains
28263 the name of the overall domain that matched (for example,
28264 &`spamhaus.example`&), &$dnslist_matched$& contains the key within that domain
28265 (for example, &`192.168.5.3`&), and &$dnslist_value$& contains the data from
28266 the DNS record. When the key is an IP address, it is not reversed in
28267 &$dnslist_matched$& (though it is, of course, in the actual lookup). In simple
28268 cases, for example:
28269 .code
28270 deny dnslists = spamhaus.example
28271 .endd
28272 the key is also available in another variable (in this case,
28273 &$sender_host_address$&). In more complicated cases, however, this is not true.
28274 For example, using a data lookup (as described in section &<<SECTmulkeyfor>>&)
28275 might generate a dnslists lookup like this:
28276 .code
28277 deny dnslists = spamhaus.example/<|192.168.1.2|192.168.6.7|...
28278 .endd
28279 If this condition succeeds, the value in &$dnslist_matched$& might be
28280 &`192.168.6.7`& (for example).
28281
28282 If more than one address record is returned by the DNS lookup, all the IP
28283 addresses are included in &$dnslist_value$&, separated by commas and spaces.
28284 The variable &$dnslist_text$& contains the contents of any associated TXT
28285 record. For lists such as RBL+ the TXT record for a merged entry is often not
28286 very meaningful. See section &<<SECTmordetinf>>& for a way of obtaining more
28287 information.
28288
28289 You can use the DNS list variables in &%message%& or &%log_message%& modifiers
28290 &-- although these appear before the condition in the ACL, they are not
28291 expanded until after it has failed. For example:
28292 .code
28293 deny hosts = !+local_networks
28294 message = $sender_host_address is listed \
28295 at $dnslist_domain
28296 dnslists = rbl-plus.mail-abuse.example
28297 .endd
28298
28299
28300
28301 .section "Additional matching conditions for DNS lists" "SECTaddmatcon"
28302 .cindex "DNS list" "matching specific returned data"
28303 You can add an equals sign and an IP address after a &%dnslists%& domain name
28304 in order to restrict its action to DNS records with a matching right hand side.
28305 For example,
28306 .code
28307 deny dnslists = rblplus.mail-abuse.org=127.0.0.2
28308 .endd
28309 rejects only those hosts that yield 127.0.0.2. Without this additional data,
28310 any address record is considered to be a match. For the moment, we assume
28311 that the DNS lookup returns just one record. Section &<<SECThanmuldnsrec>>&
28312 describes how multiple records are handled.
28313
28314 More than one IP address may be given for checking, using a comma as a
28315 separator. These are alternatives &-- if any one of them matches, the
28316 &%dnslists%& condition is true. For example:
28317 .code
28318 deny dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
28319 .endd
28320 If you want to specify a constraining address list and also specify names or IP
28321 addresses to be looked up, the constraining address list must be specified
28322 first. For example:
28323 .code
28324 deny dnslists = dsn.rfc-ignorant.org\
28325 =127.0.0.2/$sender_address_domain
28326 .endd
28327
28328 If the character &`&&`& is used instead of &`=`&, the comparison for each
28329 listed IP address is done by a bitwise &"and"& instead of by an equality test.
28330 In other words, the listed addresses are used as bit masks. The comparison is
28331 true if all the bits in the mask are present in the address that is being
28332 tested. For example:
28333 .code
28334 dnslists = a.b.c&0.0.0.3
28335 .endd
28336 matches if the address is &'x.x.x.'&3, &'x.x.x.'&7, &'x.x.x.'&11, etc. If you
28337 want to test whether one bit or another bit is present (as opposed to both
28338 being present), you must use multiple values. For example:
28339 .code
28340 dnslists = a.b.c&0.0.0.1,0.0.0.2
28341 .endd
28342 matches if the final component of the address is an odd number or two times
28343 an odd number.
28344
28345
28346
28347 .section "Negated DNS matching conditions" "SECID205"
28348 You can supply a negative list of IP addresses as part of a &%dnslists%&
28349 condition. Whereas
28350 .code
28351 deny dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
28352 .endd
28353 means &"deny if the host is in the black list at the domain &'a.b.c'& and the
28354 IP address yielded by the list is either 127.0.0.2 or 127.0.0.3"&,
28355 .code
28356 deny dnslists = a.b.c!=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
28357 .endd
28358 means &"deny if the host is in the black list at the domain &'a.b.c'& and the
28359 IP address yielded by the list is not 127.0.0.2 and not 127.0.0.3"&. In other
28360 words, the result of the test is inverted if an exclamation mark appears before
28361 the &`=`& (or the &`&&`&) sign.
28362
28363 &*Note*&: This kind of negation is not the same as negation in a domain,
28364 host, or address list (which is why the syntax is different).
28365
28366 If you are using just one list, the negation syntax does not gain you much. The
28367 previous example is precisely equivalent to
28368 .code
28369 deny dnslists = a.b.c
28370 !dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
28371 .endd
28372 However, if you are using multiple lists, the negation syntax is clearer.
28373 Consider this example:
28374 .code
28375 deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
28376 list.dsbl.org : \
28377 dnsbl.njabl.org!=127.0.0.3 : \
28378 relays.ordb.org
28379 .endd
28380 Using only positive lists, this would have to be:
28381 .code
28382 deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
28383 list.dsbl.org
28384 deny dnslists = dnsbl.njabl.org
28385 !dnslists = dnsbl.njabl.org=127.0.0.3
28386 deny dnslists = relays.ordb.org
28387 .endd
28388 which is less clear, and harder to maintain.
28389
28390
28391
28392
28393 .section "Handling multiple DNS records from a DNS list" "SECThanmuldnsrec"
28394 A DNS lookup for a &%dnslists%& condition may return more than one DNS record,
28395 thereby providing more than one IP address. When an item in a &%dnslists%& list
28396 is followed by &`=`& or &`&&`& and a list of IP addresses, in order to restrict
28397 the match to specific results from the DNS lookup, there are two ways in which
28398 the checking can be handled. For example, consider the condition:
28399 .code
28400 dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.1
28401 .endd
28402 What happens if the DNS lookup for the incoming IP address yields both
28403 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2 by means of two separate DNS records? Is the
28404 condition true because at least one given value was found, or is it false
28405 because at least one of the found values was not listed? And how does this
28406 affect negated conditions? Both possibilities are provided for with the help of
28407 additional separators &`==`& and &`=&&`&.
28408
28409 .ilist
28410 If &`=`& or &`&&`& is used, the condition is true if any one of the looked up
28411 IP addresses matches one of the listed addresses. For the example above, the
28412 condition is true because 127.0.0.1 matches.
28413 .next
28414 If &`==`& or &`=&&`& is used, the condition is true only if every one of the
28415 looked up IP addresses matches one of the listed addresses. If the condition is
28416 changed to:
28417 .code
28418 dnslists = a.b.c==127.0.0.1
28419 .endd
28420 and the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
28421 false because 127.0.0.2 is not listed. You would need to have:
28422 .code
28423 dnslists = a.b.c==127.0.0.1,127.0.0.2
28424 .endd
28425 for the condition to be true.
28426 .endlist
28427
28428 When &`!`& is used to negate IP address matching, it inverts the result, giving
28429 the precise opposite of the behaviour above. Thus:
28430 .ilist
28431 If &`!=`& or &`!&&`& is used, the condition is true if none of the looked up IP
28432 addresses matches one of the listed addresses. Consider:
28433 .code
28434 dnslists = a.b.c!&0.0.0.1
28435 .endd
28436 If the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
28437 false because 127.0.0.1 matches.
28438 .next
28439 If &`!==`& or &`!=&&`& is used, the condition is true if there is at least one
28440 looked up IP address that does not match. Consider:
28441 .code
28442 dnslists = a.b.c!=&0.0.0.1
28443 .endd
28444 If the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
28445 true, because 127.0.0.2 does not match. You would need to have:
28446 .code
28447 dnslists = a.b.c!=&0.0.0.1,0.0.0.2
28448 .endd
28449 for the condition to be false.
28450 .endlist
28451 When the DNS lookup yields only a single IP address, there is no difference
28452 between &`=`& and &`==`& and between &`&&`& and &`=&&`&.
28453
28454
28455
28456
28457 .section "Detailed information from merged DNS lists" "SECTmordetinf"
28458 .cindex "DNS list" "information from merged"
28459 When the facility for restricting the matching IP values in a DNS list is used,
28460 the text from the TXT record that is set in &$dnslist_text$& may not reflect
28461 the true reason for rejection. This happens when lists are merged and the IP
28462 address in the A record is used to distinguish them; unfortunately there is
28463 only one TXT record. One way round this is not to use merged lists, but that
28464 can be inefficient because it requires multiple DNS lookups where one would do
28465 in the vast majority of cases when the host of interest is not on any of the
28466 lists.
28467
28468 A less inefficient way of solving this problem is available. If
28469 two domain names, comma-separated, are given, the second is used first to
28470 do an initial check, making use of any IP value restrictions that are set.
28471 If there is a match, the first domain is used, without any IP value
28472 restrictions, to get the TXT record. As a byproduct of this, there is also
28473 a check that the IP being tested is indeed on the first list. The first
28474 domain is the one that is put in &$dnslist_domain$&. For example:
28475 .code
28476 reject message = \
28477 rejected because $sender_host_address is blacklisted \
28478 at $dnslist_domain\n$dnslist_text
28479 dnslists = \
28480 sbl.spamhaus.org,sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org=127.0.0.2 : \
28481 dul.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.10
28482 .endd
28483 For the first blacklist item, this starts by doing a lookup in
28484 &'sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org'& and testing for a 127.0.0.2 return. If there is a
28485 match, it then looks in &'sbl.spamhaus.org'&, without checking the return
28486 value, and as long as something is found, it looks for the corresponding TXT
28487 record. If there is no match in &'sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org'&, nothing more is done.
28488 The second blacklist item is processed similarly.
28489
28490 If you are interested in more than one merged list, the same list must be
28491 given several times, but because the results of the DNS lookups are cached,
28492 the DNS calls themselves are not repeated. For example:
28493 .code
28494 reject dnslists = \
28495 http.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.2 : \
28496 socks.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.3 : \
28497 misc.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.4 : \
28498 dul.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.10
28499 .endd
28500 In this case there is one lookup in &'dnsbl.sorbs.net'&, and if none of the IP
28501 values matches (or if no record is found), this is the only lookup that is
28502 done. Only if there is a match is one of the more specific lists consulted.
28503
28504
28505
28506 .section "DNS lists and IPv6" "SECTmorednslistslast"
28507 .cindex "IPv6" "DNS black lists"
28508 .cindex "DNS list" "IPv6 usage"
28509 If Exim is asked to do a dnslist lookup for an IPv6 address, it inverts it
28510 nibble by nibble. For example, if the calling host's IP address is
28511 3ffe:ffff:836f:0a00:000a:0800:200a:c031, Exim might look up
28512 .code
28513 1.3.0.c.a.0.0.2.0.0.8.0.a.0.0.0.0.0.a.0.f.6.3.8.
28514 f.f.f.f.e.f.f.3.blackholes.mail-abuse.org
28515 .endd
28516 (split over two lines here to fit on the page). Unfortunately, some of the DNS
28517 lists contain wildcard records, intended for IPv4, that interact badly with
28518 IPv6. For example, the DNS entry
28519 .code
28520 *.3.some.list.example. A 127.0.0.1
28521 .endd
28522 is probably intended to put the entire 3.0.0.0/8 IPv4 network on the list.
28523 Unfortunately, it also matches the entire 3::/4 IPv6 network.
28524
28525 You can exclude IPv6 addresses from DNS lookups by making use of a suitable
28526 &%condition%& condition, as in this example:
28527 .code
28528 deny condition = ${if isip4{$sender_host_address}}
28529 dnslists = some.list.example
28530 .endd
28531
28532 .section "Rate limiting incoming messages" "SECTratelimiting"
28533 .cindex "rate limiting" "client sending"
28534 .cindex "limiting client sending rates"
28535 .oindex "&%smtp_ratelimit_*%&"
28536 The &%ratelimit%& ACL condition can be used to measure and control the rate at
28537 which clients can send email. This is more powerful than the
28538 &%smtp_ratelimit_*%& options, because those options control the rate of
28539 commands in a single SMTP session only, whereas the &%ratelimit%& condition
28540 works across all connections (concurrent and sequential) from the same client
28541 host. The syntax of the &%ratelimit%& condition is:
28542 .display
28543 &`ratelimit =`& <&'m'&> &`/`& <&'p'&> &`/`& <&'options'&> &`/`& <&'key'&>
28544 .endd
28545 If the average client sending rate is less than &'m'& messages per time
28546 period &'p'& then the condition is false; otherwise it is true.
28547
28548 As a side-effect, the &%ratelimit%& condition sets the expansion variable
28549 &$sender_rate$& to the client's computed rate, &$sender_rate_limit$& to the
28550 configured value of &'m'&, and &$sender_rate_period$& to the configured value
28551 of &'p'&.
28552
28553 The parameter &'p'& is the smoothing time constant, in the form of an Exim
28554 time interval, for example, &`8h`& for eight hours. A larger time constant
28555 means that it takes Exim longer to forget a client's past behaviour. The
28556 parameter &'m'& is the maximum number of messages that a client is permitted to
28557 send in each time interval. It also specifies the number of messages permitted
28558 in a fast burst. By increasing both &'m'& and &'p'& but keeping &'m/p'&
28559 constant, you can allow a client to send more messages in a burst without
28560 changing its long-term sending rate limit. Conversely, if &'m'& and &'p'& are
28561 both small, messages must be sent at an even rate.
28562
28563 There is a script in &_util/ratelimit.pl_& which extracts sending rates from
28564 log files, to assist with choosing appropriate settings for &'m'& and &'p'&
28565 when deploying the &%ratelimit%& ACL condition. The script prints usage
28566 instructions when it is run with no arguments.
28567
28568 The key is used to look up the data for calculating the client's average
28569 sending rate. This data is stored in Exim's spool directory, alongside the
28570 retry and other hints databases. The default key is &$sender_host_address$&,
28571 which means Exim computes the sending rate of each client host IP address.
28572 By changing the key you can change how Exim identifies clients for the purpose
28573 of ratelimiting. For example, to limit the sending rate of each authenticated
28574 user, independent of the computer they are sending from, set the key to
28575 &$authenticated_id$&. You must ensure that the lookup key is meaningful; for
28576 example, &$authenticated_id$& is only meaningful if the client has
28577 authenticated (which you can check with the &%authenticated%& ACL condition).
28578
28579 The lookup key does not have to identify clients: If you want to limit the
28580 rate at which a recipient receives messages, you can use the key
28581 &`$local_part@$domain`& with the &%per_rcpt%& option (see below) in a RCPT
28582 ACL.
28583
28584 Each &%ratelimit%& condition can have up to four options. A &%per_*%& option
28585 specifies what Exim measures the rate of, for example messages or recipients
28586 or bytes. You can adjust the measurement using the &%unique=%& and/or
28587 &%count=%& options. You can also control when Exim updates the recorded rate
28588 using a &%strict%&, &%leaky%&, or &%readonly%& option. The options are
28589 separated by a slash, like the other parameters. They may appear in any order.
28590
28591 Internally, Exim appends the smoothing constant &'p'& onto the lookup key with
28592 any options that alter the meaning of the stored data. The limit &'m'& is not
28593 stored, so you can alter the configured maximum rate and Exim will still
28594 remember clients' past behaviour. If you change the &%per_*%& mode or add or
28595 remove the &%unique=%& option, the lookup key changes so Exim will forget past
28596 behaviour. The lookup key is not affected by changes to the update mode and
28597 the &%count=%& option.
28598
28599
28600 .section "Ratelimit options for what is being measured" "ratoptmea"
28601 .cindex "rate limiting" "per_* options"
28602 The &%per_conn%& option limits the client's connection rate. It is not
28603 normally used in the &%acl_not_smtp%&, &%acl_not_smtp_mime%&, or
28604 &%acl_not_smtp_start%& ACLs.
28605
28606 The &%per_mail%& option limits the client's rate of sending messages. This is
28607 the default if none of the &%per_*%& options is specified. It can be used in
28608 &%acl_smtp_mail%&, &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&, &%acl_smtp_mime%&,
28609 &%acl_smtp_data%&, or &%acl_not_smtp%&.
28610
28611 The &%per_byte%& option limits the sender's email bandwidth. It can be used in
28612 the same ACLs as the &%per_mail%& option, though it is best to use this option
28613 in the &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_smtp_data%& or &%acl_not_smtp%& ACLs; if it is
28614 used in an earlier ACL, Exim relies on the SIZE parameter given by the client
28615 in its MAIL command, which may be inaccurate or completely missing. You can
28616 follow the limit &'m'& in the configuration with K, M, or G to specify limits
28617 in kilobytes, megabytes, or gigabytes, respectively.
28618
28619 The &%per_rcpt%& option causes Exim to limit the rate at which recipients are
28620 accepted. It can be used in the &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&,
28621 &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_smtp_data%&, or &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& ACLs. In
28622 &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& the rate is updated one recipient at a time; in the other
28623 ACLs the rate is updated with the total recipient count in one go. Note that
28624 in either case the rate limiting engine will see a message with many
28625 recipients as a large high-speed burst.
28626
28627 The &%per_addr%& option is like the &%per_rcpt%& option, except it counts the
28628 number of different recipients that the client has sent messages to in the
28629 last time period. That is, if the client repeatedly sends messages to the same
28630 recipient, its measured rate is not increased. This option can only be used in
28631 &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&.
28632
28633 The &%per_cmd%& option causes Exim to recompute the rate every time the
28634 condition is processed. This can be used to limit the rate of any SMTP
28635 command. If it is used in multiple ACLs it can limit the aggregate rate of
28636 multiple different commands.
28637
28638 The &%count=%& option can be used to alter how much Exim adds to the client's
28639 measured rate. For example, the &%per_byte%& option is equivalent to
28640 &`per_mail/count=$message_size`&. If there is no &%count=%& option, Exim
28641 increases the measured rate by one (except for the &%per_rcpt%& option in ACLs
28642 other than &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&). The count does not have to be an integer.
28643
28644 The &%unique=%& option is described in section &<<ratoptuniq>>& below.
28645
28646
28647 .section "Ratelimit update modes" "ratoptupd"
28648 .cindex "rate limiting" "reading data without updating"
28649 You can specify one of three options with the &%ratelimit%& condition to
28650 control when its database is updated. This section describes the &%readonly%&
28651 mode, and the next section describes the &%strict%& and &%leaky%& modes.
28652
28653 If the &%ratelimit%& condition is used in &%readonly%& mode, Exim looks up a
28654 previously-computed rate to check against the limit.
28655
28656 For example, you can test the client's sending rate and deny it access (when
28657 it is too fast) in the connect ACL. If the client passes this check then it
28658 can go on to send a message, in which case its recorded rate will be updated
28659 in the MAIL ACL. Subsequent connections from the same client will check this
28660 new rate.
28661 .code
28662 acl_check_connect:
28663 deny ratelimit = 100 / 5m / readonly
28664 log_message = RATE CHECK: $sender_rate/$sender_rate_period \
28665 (max $sender_rate_limit)
28666 # ...
28667 acl_check_mail:
28668 warn ratelimit = 100 / 5m / strict
28669 log_message = RATE UPDATE: $sender_rate/$sender_rate_period \
28670 (max $sender_rate_limit)
28671 .endd
28672
28673 If Exim encounters multiple &%ratelimit%& conditions with the same key when
28674 processing a message then it may increase the client's measured rate more than
28675 it should. For example, this will happen if you check the &%per_rcpt%& option
28676 in both &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& and &%acl_smtp_data%&. However it's OK to check the
28677 same &%ratelimit%& condition multiple times in the same ACL. You can avoid any
28678 multiple update problems by using the &%readonly%& option on later ratelimit
28679 checks.
28680
28681 The &%per_*%& options described above do not make sense in some ACLs. If you
28682 use a &%per_*%& option in an ACL where it is not normally permitted then the
28683 update mode defaults to &%readonly%& and you cannot specify the &%strict%& or
28684 &%leaky%& modes. In other ACLs the default update mode is &%leaky%& (see the
28685 next section) so you must specify the &%readonly%& option explicitly.
28686
28687
28688 .section "Ratelimit options for handling fast clients" "ratoptfast"
28689 .cindex "rate limiting" "strict and leaky modes"
28690 If a client's average rate is greater than the maximum, the rate limiting
28691 engine can react in two possible ways, depending on the presence of the
28692 &%strict%& or &%leaky%& update modes. This is independent of the other
28693 counter-measures (such as rejecting the message) that may be specified by the
28694 rest of the ACL.
28695
28696 The &%leaky%& (default) option means that the client's recorded rate is not
28697 updated if it is above the limit. The effect of this is that Exim measures the
28698 client's average rate of successfully sent email, which cannot be greater than
28699 the maximum allowed. If the client is over the limit it may suffer some
28700 counter-measures (as specified in the ACL), but it will still be able to send
28701 email at the configured maximum rate, whatever the rate of its attempts. This
28702 is generally the better choice if you have clients that retry automatically.
28703 For example, it does not prevent a sender with an over-aggressive retry rate
28704 from getting any email through.
28705
28706 The &%strict%& option means that the client's recorded rate is always
28707 updated. The effect of this is that Exim measures the client's average rate
28708 of attempts to send email, which can be much higher than the maximum it is
28709 actually allowed. If the client is over the limit it may be subjected to
28710 counter-measures by the ACL. It must slow down and allow sufficient time to
28711 pass that its computed rate falls below the maximum before it can send email
28712 again. The time (the number of smoothing periods) it must wait and not
28713 attempt to send mail can be calculated with this formula:
28714 .code
28715 ln(peakrate/maxrate)
28716 .endd
28717
28718
28719 .section "Limiting the rate of different events" "ratoptuniq"
28720 .cindex "rate limiting" "counting unique events"
28721 The &%ratelimit%& &%unique=%& option controls a mechanism for counting the
28722 rate of different events. For example, the &%per_addr%& option uses this
28723 mechanism to count the number of different recipients that the client has
28724 sent messages to in the last time period; it is equivalent to
28725 &`per_rcpt/unique=$local_part@$domain`&. You could use this feature to
28726 measure the rate that a client uses different sender addresses with the
28727 options &`per_mail/unique=$sender_address`&.
28728
28729 For each &%ratelimit%& key Exim stores the set of &%unique=%& values that it
28730 has seen for that key. The whole set is thrown away when it is older than the
28731 rate smoothing period &'p'&, so each different event is counted at most once
28732 per period. In the &%leaky%& update mode, an event that causes the client to
28733 go over the limit is not added to the set, in the same way that the client's
28734 recorded rate is not updated in the same situation.
28735
28736 When you combine the &%unique=%& and &%readonly%& options, the specific
28737 &%unique=%& value is ignored, and Exim just retrieves the client's stored
28738 rate.
28739
28740 The &%unique=%& mechanism needs more space in the ratelimit database than the
28741 other &%ratelimit%& options in order to store the event set. The number of
28742 unique values is potentially as large as the rate limit, so the extra space
28743 required increases with larger limits.
28744
28745 The uniqueification is not perfect: there is a small probability that Exim
28746 will think a new event has happened before. If the sender's rate is less than
28747 the limit, Exim should be more than 99.9% correct. However in &%strict%& mode
28748 the measured rate can go above the limit, in which case Exim may under-count
28749 events by a significant margin. Fortunately, if the rate is high enough (2.7
28750 times the limit) that the false positive rate goes above 9%, then Exim will
28751 throw away the over-full event set before the measured rate falls below the
28752 limit. Therefore the only harm should be that exceptionally high sending rates
28753 are logged incorrectly; any countermeasures you configure will be as effective
28754 as intended.
28755
28756
28757 .section "Using rate limiting" "useratlim"
28758 Exim's other ACL facilities are used to define what counter-measures are taken
28759 when the rate limit is exceeded. This might be anything from logging a warning
28760 (for example, while measuring existing sending rates in order to define
28761 policy), through time delays to slow down fast senders, up to rejecting the
28762 message. For example:
28763 .code
28764 # Log all senders' rates
28765 warn ratelimit = 0 / 1h / strict
28766 log_message = Sender rate $sender_rate / $sender_rate_period
28767
28768 # Slow down fast senders; note the need to truncate $sender_rate
28769 # at the decimal point.
28770 warn ratelimit = 100 / 1h / per_rcpt / strict
28771 delay = ${eval: ${sg{$sender_rate}{[.].*}{}} - \
28772 $sender_rate_limit }s
28773
28774 # Keep authenticated users under control
28775 deny authenticated = *
28776 ratelimit = 100 / 1d / strict / $authenticated_id
28777
28778 # System-wide rate limit
28779 defer message = Sorry, too busy. Try again later.
28780 ratelimit = 10 / 1s / $primary_hostname
28781
28782 # Restrict incoming rate from each host, with a default
28783 # set using a macro and special cases looked up in a table.
28784 defer message = Sender rate exceeds $sender_rate_limit \
28785 messages per $sender_rate_period
28786 ratelimit = ${lookup {$sender_host_address} \
28787 cdb {DB/ratelimits.cdb} \
28788 {$value} {RATELIMIT} }
28789 .endd
28790 &*Warning*&: If you have a busy server with a lot of &%ratelimit%& tests,
28791 especially with the &%per_rcpt%& option, you may suffer from a performance
28792 bottleneck caused by locking on the ratelimit hints database. Apart from
28793 making your ACLs less complicated, you can reduce the problem by using a
28794 RAM disk for Exim's hints directory (usually &_/var/spool/exim/db/_&). However
28795 this means that Exim will lose its hints data after a reboot (including retry
28796 hints, the callout cache, and ratelimit data).
28797
28798
28799
28800 .section "Address verification" "SECTaddressverification"
28801 .cindex "verifying address" "options for"
28802 .cindex "policy control" "address verification"
28803 Several of the &%verify%& conditions described in section
28804 &<<SECTaclconditions>>& cause addresses to be verified. Section
28805 &<<SECTsenaddver>>& discusses the reporting of sender verification failures.
28806 The verification conditions can be followed by options that modify the
28807 verification process. The options are separated from the keyword and from each
28808 other by slashes, and some of them contain parameters. For example:
28809 .code
28810 verify = sender/callout
28811 verify = recipient/defer_ok/callout=10s,defer_ok
28812 .endd
28813 The first stage of address verification, which always happens, is to run the
28814 address through the routers, in &"verify mode"&. Routers can detect the
28815 difference between verification and routing for delivery, and their actions can
28816 be varied by a number of generic options such as &%verify%& and &%verify_only%&
28817 (see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&). If routing fails, verification fails.
28818 The available options are as follows:
28819
28820 .ilist
28821 If the &%callout%& option is specified, successful routing to one or more
28822 remote hosts is followed by a &"callout"& to those hosts as an additional
28823 check. Callouts and their sub-options are discussed in the next section.
28824 .next
28825 If there is a defer error while doing verification routing, the ACL
28826 normally returns &"defer"&. However, if you include &%defer_ok%& in the
28827 options, the condition is forced to be true instead. Note that this is a main
28828 verification option as well as a suboption for callouts.
28829 .next
28830 The &%no_details%& option is covered in section &<<SECTsenaddver>>&, which
28831 discusses the reporting of sender address verification failures.
28832 .next
28833 The &%success_on_redirect%& option causes verification always to succeed
28834 immediately after a successful redirection. By default, if a redirection
28835 generates just one address, that address is also verified. See further
28836 discussion in section &<<SECTredirwhilveri>>&.
28837 .endlist
28838
28839 .cindex "verifying address" "differentiating failures"
28840 .vindex "&$recipient_verify_failure$&"
28841 .vindex "&$sender_verify_failure$&"
28842 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
28843 After an address verification failure, &$acl_verify_message$& contains the
28844 error message that is associated with the failure. It can be preserved by
28845 coding like this:
28846 .code
28847 warn !verify = sender
28848 set acl_m0 = $acl_verify_message
28849 .endd
28850 If you are writing your own custom rejection message or log message when
28851 denying access, you can use this variable to include information about the
28852 verification failure.
28853
28854 In addition, &$sender_verify_failure$& or &$recipient_verify_failure$& (as
28855 appropriate) contains one of the following words:
28856
28857 .ilist
28858 &%qualify%&: The address was unqualified (no domain), and the message
28859 was neither local nor came from an exempted host.
28860 .next
28861 &%route%&: Routing failed.
28862 .next
28863 &%mail%&: Routing succeeded, and a callout was attempted; rejection
28864 occurred at or before the MAIL command (that is, on initial
28865 connection, HELO, or MAIL).
28866 .next
28867 &%recipient%&: The RCPT command in a callout was rejected.
28868 .next
28869 &%postmaster%&: The postmaster check in a callout was rejected.
28870 .endlist
28871
28872 The main use of these variables is expected to be to distinguish between
28873 rejections of MAIL and rejections of RCPT in callouts.
28874
28875
28876
28877
28878 .section "Callout verification" "SECTcallver"
28879 .cindex "verifying address" "by callout"
28880 .cindex "callout" "verification"
28881 .cindex "SMTP" "callout verification"
28882 For non-local addresses, routing verifies the domain, but is unable to do any
28883 checking of the local part. There are situations where some means of verifying
28884 the local part is desirable. One way this can be done is to make an SMTP
28885 &'callback'& to a delivery host for the sender address or a &'callforward'& to
28886 a subsequent host for a recipient address, to see if the host accepts the
28887 address. We use the term &'callout'& to cover both cases. Note that for a
28888 sender address, the callback is not to the client host that is trying to
28889 deliver the message, but to one of the hosts that accepts incoming mail for the
28890 sender's domain.
28891
28892 Exim does not do callouts by default. If you want them to happen, you must
28893 request them by setting appropriate options on the &%verify%& condition, as
28894 described below. This facility should be used with care, because it can add a
28895 lot of resource usage to the cost of verifying an address. However, Exim does
28896 cache the results of callouts, which helps to reduce the cost. Details of
28897 caching are in section &<<SECTcallvercache>>&.
28898
28899 Recipient callouts are usually used only between hosts that are controlled by
28900 the same administration. For example, a corporate gateway host could use
28901 callouts to check for valid recipients on an internal mailserver. A successful
28902 callout does not guarantee that a real delivery to the address would succeed;
28903 on the other hand, a failing callout does guarantee that a delivery would fail.
28904
28905 If the &%callout%& option is present on a condition that verifies an address, a
28906 second stage of verification occurs if the address is successfully routed to
28907 one or more remote hosts. The usual case is routing by a &(dnslookup)& or a
28908 &(manualroute)& router, where the router specifies the hosts. However, if a
28909 router that does not set up hosts routes to an &(smtp)& transport with a
28910 &%hosts%& setting, the transport's hosts are used. If an &(smtp)& transport has
28911 &%hosts_override%& set, its hosts are always used, whether or not the router
28912 supplies a host list.
28913
28914 The port that is used is taken from the transport, if it is specified and is a
28915 remote transport. (For routers that do verification only, no transport need be
28916 specified.) Otherwise, the default SMTP port is used. If a remote transport
28917 specifies an outgoing interface, this is used; otherwise the interface is not
28918 specified. Likewise, the text that is used for the HELO command is taken from
28919 the transport's &%helo_data%& option; if there is no transport, the value of
28920 &$smtp_active_hostname$& is used.
28921
28922 For a sender callout check, Exim makes SMTP connections to the remote hosts, to
28923 test whether a bounce message could be delivered to the sender address. The
28924 following SMTP commands are sent:
28925 .display
28926 &`HELO `&<&'local host name'&>
28927 &`MAIL FROM:<>`&
28928 &`RCPT TO:`&<&'the address to be tested'&>
28929 &`QUIT`&
28930 .endd
28931 LHLO is used instead of HELO if the transport's &%protocol%& option is
28932 set to &"lmtp"&.
28933
28934 The callout may use EHLO, AUTH and/or STARTTLS given appropriate option
28935 settings.
28936
28937 A recipient callout check is similar. By default, it also uses an empty address
28938 for the sender. This default is chosen because most hosts do not make use of
28939 the sender address when verifying a recipient. Using the same address means
28940 that a single cache entry can be used for each recipient. Some sites, however,
28941 do make use of the sender address when verifying. These are catered for by the
28942 &%use_sender%& and &%use_postmaster%& options, described in the next section.
28943
28944 If the response to the RCPT command is a 2&'xx'& code, the verification
28945 succeeds. If it is 5&'xx'&, the verification fails. For any other condition,
28946 Exim tries the next host, if any. If there is a problem with all the remote
28947 hosts, the ACL yields &"defer"&, unless the &%defer_ok%& parameter of the
28948 &%callout%& option is given, in which case the condition is forced to succeed.
28949
28950 .cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for callout"
28951 A callout may take a little time. For this reason, Exim normally flushes SMTP
28952 output before performing a callout in an ACL, to avoid unexpected timeouts in
28953 clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in use. The flushing can be
28954 disabled by using a &%control%& modifier to set &%no_callout_flush%&.
28955
28956
28957
28958
28959 .section "Additional parameters for callouts" "CALLaddparcall"
28960 .cindex "callout" "additional parameters for"
28961 The &%callout%& option can be followed by an equals sign and a number of
28962 optional parameters, separated by commas. For example:
28963 .code
28964 verify = recipient/callout=10s,defer_ok
28965 .endd
28966 The old syntax, which had &%callout_defer_ok%& and &%check_postmaster%& as
28967 separate verify options, is retained for backwards compatibility, but is now
28968 deprecated. The additional parameters for &%callout%& are as follows:
28969
28970
28971 .vlist
28972 .vitem <&'a&~time&~interval'&>
28973 .cindex "callout" "timeout, specifying"
28974 This specifies the timeout that applies for the callout attempt to each host.
28975 For example:
28976 .code
28977 verify = sender/callout=5s
28978 .endd
28979 The default is 30 seconds. The timeout is used for each response from the
28980 remote host. It is also used for the initial connection, unless overridden by
28981 the &%connect%& parameter.
28982
28983
28984 .vitem &*connect&~=&~*&<&'time&~interval'&>
28985 .cindex "callout" "connection timeout, specifying"
28986 This parameter makes it possible to set a different (usually smaller) timeout
28987 for making the SMTP connection. For example:
28988 .code
28989 verify = sender/callout=5s,connect=1s
28990 .endd
28991 If not specified, this timeout defaults to the general timeout value.
28992
28993 .vitem &*defer_ok*&
28994 .cindex "callout" "defer, action on"
28995 When this parameter is present, failure to contact any host, or any other kind
28996 of temporary error, is treated as success by the ACL. However, the cache is not
28997 updated in this circumstance.
28998
28999 .vitem &*fullpostmaster*&
29000 .cindex "callout" "full postmaster check"
29001 This operates like the &%postmaster%& option (see below), but if the check for
29002 &'postmaster@domain'& fails, it tries just &'postmaster'&, without a domain, in
29003 accordance with the specification in RFC 2821. The RFC states that the
29004 unqualified address &'postmaster'& should be accepted.
29005
29006
29007 .vitem &*mailfrom&~=&~*&<&'email&~address'&>
29008 .cindex "callout" "sender when verifying header"
29009 When verifying addresses in header lines using the &%header_sender%&
29010 verification option, Exim behaves by default as if the addresses are envelope
29011 sender addresses from a message. Callout verification therefore tests to see
29012 whether a bounce message could be delivered, by using an empty address in the
29013 MAIL command. However, it is arguable that these addresses might never be used
29014 as envelope senders, and could therefore justifiably reject bounce messages
29015 (empty senders). The &%mailfrom%& callout parameter allows you to specify what
29016 address to use in the MAIL command. For example:
29017 .code
29018 require verify = header_sender/callout=mailfrom=abcd@x.y.z
29019 .endd
29020 This parameter is available only for the &%header_sender%& verification option.
29021
29022
29023 .vitem &*maxwait&~=&~*&<&'time&~interval'&>
29024 .cindex "callout" "overall timeout, specifying"
29025 This parameter sets an overall timeout for performing a callout verification.
29026 For example:
29027 .code
29028 verify = sender/callout=5s,maxwait=30s
29029 .endd
29030 This timeout defaults to four times the callout timeout for individual SMTP
29031 commands. The overall timeout applies when there is more than one host that can
29032 be tried. The timeout is checked before trying the next host. This prevents
29033 very long delays if there are a large number of hosts and all are timing out
29034 (for example, when network connections are timing out).
29035
29036
29037 .vitem &*no_cache*&
29038 .cindex "callout" "cache, suppressing"
29039 .cindex "caching callout, suppressing"
29040 When this parameter is given, the callout cache is neither read nor updated.
29041
29042 .vitem &*postmaster*&
29043 .cindex "callout" "postmaster; checking"
29044 When this parameter is set, a successful callout check is followed by a similar
29045 check for the local part &'postmaster'& at the same domain. If this address is
29046 rejected, the callout fails (but see &%fullpostmaster%& above). The result of
29047 the postmaster check is recorded in a cache record; if it is a failure, this is
29048 used to fail subsequent callouts for the domain without a connection being
29049 made, until the cache record expires.
29050
29051 .vitem &*postmaster_mailfrom&~=&~*&<&'email&~address'&>
29052 The postmaster check uses an empty sender in the MAIL command by default.
29053 You can use this parameter to do a postmaster check using a different address.
29054 For example:
29055 .code
29056 require verify = sender/callout=postmaster_mailfrom=abc@x.y.z
29057 .endd
29058 If both &%postmaster%& and &%postmaster_mailfrom%& are present, the rightmost
29059 one overrides. The &%postmaster%& parameter is equivalent to this example:
29060 .code
29061 require verify = sender/callout=postmaster_mailfrom=
29062 .endd
29063 &*Warning*&: The caching arrangements for postmaster checking do not take
29064 account of the sender address. It is assumed that either the empty address or
29065 a fixed non-empty address will be used. All that Exim remembers is that the
29066 postmaster check for the domain succeeded or failed.
29067
29068
29069 .vitem &*random*&
29070 .cindex "callout" "&""random""& check"
29071 When this parameter is set, before doing the normal callout check, Exim does a
29072 check for a &"random"& local part at the same domain. The local part is not
29073 really random &-- it is defined by the expansion of the option
29074 &%callout_random_local_part%&, which defaults to
29075 .code
29076 $primary_hostname-$tod_epoch-testing
29077 .endd
29078 The idea here is to try to determine whether the remote host accepts all local
29079 parts without checking. If it does, there is no point in doing callouts for
29080 specific local parts. If the &"random"& check succeeds, the result is saved in
29081 a cache record, and used to force the current and subsequent callout checks to
29082 succeed without a connection being made, until the cache record expires.
29083
29084 .vitem &*use_postmaster*&
29085 .cindex "callout" "sender for recipient check"
29086 This parameter applies to recipient callouts only. For example:
29087 .code
29088 deny !verify = recipient/callout=use_postmaster
29089 .endd
29090 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
29091 It causes a non-empty postmaster address to be used in the MAIL command when
29092 performing the callout for the recipient, and also for a &"random"& check if
29093 that is configured. The local part of the address is &`postmaster`& and the
29094 domain is the contents of &$qualify_domain$&.
29095
29096 .vitem &*use_sender*&
29097 This option applies to recipient callouts only. For example:
29098 .code
29099 require verify = recipient/callout=use_sender
29100 .endd
29101 It causes the message's actual sender address to be used in the MAIL
29102 command when performing the callout, instead of an empty address. There is no
29103 need to use this option unless you know that the called hosts make use of the
29104 sender when checking recipients. If used indiscriminately, it reduces the
29105 usefulness of callout caching.
29106 .endlist
29107
29108 If you use any of the parameters that set a non-empty sender for the MAIL
29109 command (&%mailfrom%&, &%postmaster_mailfrom%&, &%use_postmaster%&, or
29110 &%use_sender%&), you should think about possible loops. Recipient checking is
29111 usually done between two hosts that are under the same management, and the host
29112 that receives the callouts is not normally configured to do callouts itself.
29113 Therefore, it is normally safe to use &%use_postmaster%& or &%use_sender%& in
29114 these circumstances.
29115
29116 However, if you use a non-empty sender address for a callout to an arbitrary
29117 host, there is the likelihood that the remote host will itself initiate a
29118 callout check back to your host. As it is checking what appears to be a message
29119 sender, it is likely to use an empty address in MAIL, thus avoiding a
29120 callout loop. However, to be on the safe side it would be best to set up your
29121 own ACLs so that they do not do sender verification checks when the recipient
29122 is the address you use for header sender or postmaster callout checking.
29123
29124 Another issue to think about when using non-empty senders for callouts is
29125 caching. When you set &%mailfrom%& or &%use_sender%&, the cache record is keyed
29126 by the sender/recipient combination; thus, for any given recipient, many more
29127 actual callouts are performed than when an empty sender or postmaster is used.
29128
29129
29130
29131
29132 .section "Callout caching" "SECTcallvercache"
29133 .cindex "hints database" "callout cache"
29134 .cindex "callout" "cache, description of"
29135 .cindex "caching" "callout"
29136 Exim caches the results of callouts in order to reduce the amount of resources
29137 used, unless you specify the &%no_cache%& parameter with the &%callout%&
29138 option. A hints database called &"callout"& is used for the cache. Two
29139 different record types are used: one records the result of a callout check for
29140 a specific address, and the other records information that applies to the
29141 entire domain (for example, that it accepts the local part &'postmaster'&).
29142
29143 When an original callout fails, a detailed SMTP error message is given about
29144 the failure. However, for subsequent failures use the cache data, this message
29145 is not available.
29146
29147 The expiry times for negative and positive address cache records are
29148 independent, and can be set by the global options &%callout_negative_expire%&
29149 (default 2h) and &%callout_positive_expire%& (default 24h), respectively.
29150
29151 If a host gives a negative response to an SMTP connection, or rejects any
29152 commands up to and including
29153 .code
29154 MAIL FROM:<>
29155 .endd
29156 (but not including the MAIL command with a non-empty address),
29157 any callout attempt is bound to fail. Exim remembers such failures in a
29158 domain cache record, which it uses to fail callouts for the domain without
29159 making new connections, until the domain record times out. There are two
29160 separate expiry times for domain cache records:
29161 &%callout_domain_negative_expire%& (default 3h) and
29162 &%callout_domain_positive_expire%& (default 7d).
29163
29164 Domain records expire when the negative expiry time is reached if callouts
29165 cannot be made for the domain, or if the postmaster check failed.
29166 Otherwise, they expire when the positive expiry time is reached. This
29167 ensures that, for example, a host that stops accepting &"random"& local parts
29168 will eventually be noticed.
29169
29170 The callout caching mechanism is based on the domain of the address that is
29171 being tested. If the domain routes to several hosts, it is assumed that their
29172 behaviour will be the same.
29173
29174
29175
29176 .section "Sender address verification reporting" "SECTsenaddver"
29177 .cindex "verifying" "suppressing error details"
29178 See section &<<SECTaddressverification>>& for a general discussion of
29179 verification. When sender verification fails in an ACL, the details of the
29180 failure are given as additional output lines before the 550 response to the
29181 relevant SMTP command (RCPT or DATA). For example, if sender callout is in use,
29182 you might see:
29183 .code
29184 MAIL FROM:<xyz@abc.example>
29185 250 OK
29186 RCPT TO:<pqr@def.example>
29187 550-Verification failed for <xyz@abc.example>
29188 550-Called: 192.168.34.43
29189 550-Sent: RCPT TO:<xyz@abc.example>
29190 550-Response: 550 Unknown local part xyz in <xyz@abc.example>
29191 550 Sender verification failed
29192 .endd
29193 If more than one RCPT command fails in the same way, the details are given
29194 only for the first of them. However, some administrators do not want to send
29195 out this much information. You can suppress the details by adding
29196 &`/no_details`& to the ACL statement that requests sender verification. For
29197 example:
29198 .code
29199 verify = sender/no_details
29200 .endd
29201
29202 .section "Redirection while verifying" "SECTredirwhilveri"
29203 .cindex "verifying" "redirection while"
29204 .cindex "address redirection" "while verifying"
29205 A dilemma arises when a local address is redirected by aliasing or forwarding
29206 during verification: should the generated addresses themselves be verified,
29207 or should the successful expansion of the original address be enough to verify
29208 it? By default, Exim takes the following pragmatic approach:
29209
29210 .ilist
29211 When an incoming address is redirected to just one child address, verification
29212 continues with the child address, and if that fails to verify, the original
29213 verification also fails.
29214 .next
29215 When an incoming address is redirected to more than one child address,
29216 verification does not continue. A success result is returned.
29217 .endlist
29218
29219 This seems the most reasonable behaviour for the common use of aliasing as a
29220 way of redirecting different local parts to the same mailbox. It means, for
29221 example, that a pair of alias entries of the form
29222 .code
29223 A.Wol: aw123
29224 aw123: :fail: Gone away, no forwarding address
29225 .endd
29226 work as expected, with both local parts causing verification failure. When a
29227 redirection generates more than one address, the behaviour is more like a
29228 mailing list, where the existence of the alias itself is sufficient for
29229 verification to succeed.
29230
29231 It is possible, however, to change the default behaviour so that all successful
29232 redirections count as successful verifications, however many new addresses are
29233 generated. This is specified by the &%success_on_redirect%& verification
29234 option. For example:
29235 .code
29236 require verify = recipient/success_on_redirect/callout=10s
29237 .endd
29238 In this example, verification succeeds if a router generates a new address, and
29239 the callout does not occur, because no address was routed to a remote host.
29240
29241 When verification is being tested via the &%-bv%& option, the treatment of
29242 redirections is as just described, unless the &%-v%& or any debugging option is
29243 also specified. In that case, full verification is done for every generated
29244 address and a report is output for each of them.
29245
29246
29247
29248 .section "Client SMTP authorization (CSA)" "SECTverifyCSA"
29249 .cindex "CSA" "verifying"
29250 Client SMTP Authorization is a system that allows a site to advertise
29251 which machines are and are not permitted to send email. This is done by placing
29252 special SRV records in the DNS; these are looked up using the client's HELO
29253 domain. At the time of writing, CSA is still an Internet Draft. Client SMTP
29254 Authorization checks in Exim are performed by the ACL condition:
29255 .code
29256 verify = csa
29257 .endd
29258 This fails if the client is not authorized. If there is a DNS problem, or if no
29259 valid CSA SRV record is found, or if the client is authorized, the condition
29260 succeeds. These three cases can be distinguished using the expansion variable
29261 &$csa_status$&, which can take one of the values &"fail"&, &"defer"&,
29262 &"unknown"&, or &"ok"&. The condition does not itself defer because that would
29263 be likely to cause problems for legitimate email.
29264
29265 The error messages produced by the CSA code include slightly more
29266 detail. If &$csa_status$& is &"defer"&, this may be because of problems
29267 looking up the CSA SRV record, or problems looking up the CSA target
29268 address record. There are four reasons for &$csa_status$& being &"fail"&:
29269
29270 .ilist
29271 The client's host name is explicitly not authorized.
29272 .next
29273 The client's IP address does not match any of the CSA target IP addresses.
29274 .next
29275 The client's host name is authorized but it has no valid target IP addresses
29276 (for example, the target's addresses are IPv6 and the client is using IPv4).
29277 .next
29278 The client's host name has no CSA SRV record but a parent domain has asserted
29279 that all subdomains must be explicitly authorized.
29280 .endlist
29281
29282 The &%csa%& verification condition can take an argument which is the domain to
29283 use for the DNS query. The default is:
29284 .code
29285 verify = csa/$sender_helo_name
29286 .endd
29287 This implementation includes an extension to CSA. If the query domain
29288 is an address literal such as [192.0.2.95], or if it is a bare IP
29289 address, Exim searches for CSA SRV records in the reverse DNS as if
29290 the HELO domain was (for example) &'95.2.0.192.in-addr.arpa'&. Therefore it is
29291 meaningful to say:
29292 .code
29293 verify = csa/$sender_host_address
29294 .endd
29295 In fact, this is the check that Exim performs if the client does not say HELO.
29296 This extension can be turned off by setting the main configuration option
29297 &%dns_csa_use_reverse%& to be false.
29298
29299 If a CSA SRV record is not found for the domain itself, a search
29300 is performed through its parent domains for a record which might be
29301 making assertions about subdomains. The maximum depth of this search is limited
29302 using the main configuration option &%dns_csa_search_limit%&, which is 5 by
29303 default. Exim does not look for CSA SRV records in a top level domain, so the
29304 default settings handle HELO domains as long as seven
29305 (&'hostname.five.four.three.two.one.com'&). This encompasses the vast majority
29306 of legitimate HELO domains.
29307
29308 The &'dnsdb'& lookup also has support for CSA. Although &'dnsdb'& also supports
29309 direct SRV lookups, this is not sufficient because of the extra parent domain
29310 search behaviour of CSA, and (as with PTR lookups) &'dnsdb'& also turns IP
29311 addresses into lookups in the reverse DNS space. The result of a successful
29312 lookup such as:
29313 .code
29314 ${lookup dnsdb {csa=$sender_helo_name}}
29315 .endd
29316 has two space-separated fields: an authorization code and a target host name.
29317 The authorization code can be &"Y"& for yes, &"N"& for no, &"X"& for explicit
29318 authorization required but absent, or &"?"& for unknown.
29319
29320
29321
29322
29323 .section "Bounce address tag validation" "SECTverifyPRVS"
29324 .cindex "BATV, verifying"
29325 Bounce address tag validation (BATV) is a scheme whereby the envelope senders
29326 of outgoing messages have a cryptographic, timestamped &"tag"& added to them.
29327 Genuine incoming bounce messages should therefore always be addressed to
29328 recipients that have a valid tag. This scheme is a way of detecting unwanted
29329 bounce messages caused by sender address forgeries (often called &"collateral
29330 spam"&), because the recipients of such messages do not include valid tags.
29331
29332 There are two expansion items to help with the implementation of the BATV
29333 &"prvs"& (private signature) scheme in an Exim configuration. This scheme signs
29334 the original envelope sender address by using a simple key to add a hash of the
29335 address and some time-based randomizing information. The &%prvs%& expansion
29336 item creates a signed address, and the &%prvscheck%& expansion item checks one.
29337 The syntax of these expansion items is described in section
29338 &<<SECTexpansionitems>>&.
29339
29340 As an example, suppose the secret per-address keys are stored in an MySQL
29341 database. A query to look up the key for an address could be defined as a macro
29342 like this:
29343 .code
29344 PRVSCHECK_SQL = ${lookup mysql{SELECT secret FROM batv_prvs \
29345 WHERE sender='${quote_mysql:$prvscheck_address}'\
29346 }{$value}}
29347 .endd
29348 Suppose also that the senders who make use of BATV are defined by an address
29349 list called &%batv_senders%&. Then, in the ACL for RCPT commands, you could
29350 use this:
29351 .code
29352 # Bounces: drop unsigned addresses for BATV senders
29353 deny message = This address does not send an unsigned reverse path
29354 senders = :
29355 recipients = +batv_senders
29356
29357 # Bounces: In case of prvs-signed address, check signature.
29358 deny message = Invalid reverse path signature.
29359 senders = :
29360 condition = ${prvscheck {$local_part@$domain}\
29361 {PRVSCHECK_SQL}{1}}
29362 !condition = $prvscheck_result
29363 .endd
29364 The first statement rejects recipients for bounce messages that are addressed
29365 to plain BATV sender addresses, because it is known that BATV senders do not
29366 send out messages with plain sender addresses. The second statement rejects
29367 recipients that are prvs-signed, but with invalid signatures (either because
29368 the key is wrong, or the signature has timed out).
29369
29370 A non-prvs-signed address is not rejected by the second statement, because the
29371 &%prvscheck%& expansion yields an empty string if its first argument is not a
29372 prvs-signed address, thus causing the &%condition%& condition to be false. If
29373 the first argument is a syntactically valid prvs-signed address, the yield is
29374 the third string (in this case &"1"&), whether or not the cryptographic and
29375 timeout checks succeed. The &$prvscheck_result$& variable contains the result
29376 of the checks (empty for failure, &"1"& for success).
29377
29378 There is one more issue you must consider when implementing prvs-signing:
29379 you have to ensure that the routers accept prvs-signed addresses and
29380 deliver them correctly. The easiest way to handle this is to use a &(redirect)&
29381 router to remove the signature with a configuration along these lines:
29382 .code
29383 batv_redirect:
29384 driver = redirect
29385 data = ${prvscheck {$local_part@$domain}{PRVSCHECK_SQL}}
29386 .endd
29387 This works because, if the third argument of &%prvscheck%& is empty, the result
29388 of the expansion of a prvs-signed address is the decoded value of the original
29389 address. This router should probably be the first of your routers that handles
29390 local addresses.
29391
29392 To create BATV-signed addresses in the first place, a transport of this form
29393 can be used:
29394 .code
29395 external_smtp_batv:
29396 driver = smtp
29397 return_path = ${prvs {$return_path} \
29398 {${lookup mysql{SELECT \
29399 secret FROM batv_prvs WHERE \
29400 sender='${quote_mysql:$sender_address}'} \
29401 {$value}fail}}}
29402 .endd
29403 If no key can be found for the existing return path, no signing takes place.
29404
29405
29406
29407 .section "Using an ACL to control relaying" "SECTrelaycontrol"
29408 .cindex "&ACL;" "relay control"
29409 .cindex "relaying" "control by ACL"
29410 .cindex "policy control" "relay control"
29411 An MTA is said to &'relay'& a message if it receives it from some host and
29412 delivers it directly to another host as a result of a remote address contained
29413 within it. Redirecting a local address via an alias or forward file and then
29414 passing the message on to another host is not relaying,
29415 .cindex "&""percent hack""&"
29416 but a redirection as a result of the &"percent hack"& is.
29417
29418 Two kinds of relaying exist, which are termed &"incoming"& and &"outgoing"&.
29419 A host which is acting as a gateway or an MX backup is concerned with incoming
29420 relaying from arbitrary hosts to a specific set of domains. On the other hand,
29421 a host which is acting as a smart host for a number of clients is concerned
29422 with outgoing relaying from those clients to the Internet at large. Often the
29423 same host is fulfilling both functions,
29424 . ///
29425 . as illustrated in the diagram below,
29426 . ///
29427 but in principle these two kinds of relaying are entirely independent. What is
29428 not wanted is the transmission of mail from arbitrary remote hosts through your
29429 system to arbitrary domains.
29430
29431
29432 You can implement relay control by means of suitable statements in the ACL that
29433 runs for each RCPT command. For convenience, it is often easiest to use
29434 Exim's named list facility to define the domains and hosts involved. For
29435 example, suppose you want to do the following:
29436
29437 .ilist
29438 Deliver a number of domains to mailboxes on the local host (or process them
29439 locally in some other way). Let's say these are &'my.dom1.example'& and
29440 &'my.dom2.example'&.
29441 .next
29442 Relay mail for a number of other domains for which you are the secondary MX.
29443 These might be &'friend1.example'& and &'friend2.example'&.
29444 .next
29445 Relay mail from the hosts on your local LAN, to whatever domains are involved.
29446 Suppose your LAN is 192.168.45.0/24.
29447 .endlist
29448
29449
29450 In the main part of the configuration, you put the following definitions:
29451 .code
29452 domainlist local_domains = my.dom1.example : my.dom2.example
29453 domainlist relay_to_domains = friend1.example : friend2.example
29454 hostlist relay_from_hosts = 192.168.45.0/24
29455 .endd
29456 Now you can use these definitions in the ACL that is run for every RCPT
29457 command:
29458 .code
29459 acl_check_rcpt:
29460 accept domains = +local_domains : +relay_to_domains
29461 accept hosts = +relay_from_hosts
29462 .endd
29463 The first statement accepts any RCPT command that contains an address in
29464 the local or relay domains. For any other domain, control passes to the second
29465 statement, which accepts the command only if it comes from one of the relay
29466 hosts. In practice, you will probably want to make your ACL more sophisticated
29467 than this, for example, by including sender and recipient verification. The
29468 default configuration includes a more comprehensive example, which is described
29469 in chapter &<<CHAPdefconfil>>&.
29470
29471
29472
29473 .section "Checking a relay configuration" "SECTcheralcon"
29474 .cindex "relaying" "checking control of"
29475 You can check the relay characteristics of your configuration in the same way
29476 that you can test any ACL behaviour for an incoming SMTP connection, by using
29477 the &%-bh%& option to run a fake SMTP session with which you interact.
29478
29479 For specifically testing for unwanted relaying, the host
29480 &'relay-test.mail-abuse.org'& provides a useful service. If you telnet to this
29481 host from the host on which Exim is running, using the normal telnet port, you
29482 will see a normal telnet connection message and then quite a long delay. Be
29483 patient. The remote host is making an SMTP connection back to your host, and
29484 trying a number of common probes to test for open relay vulnerability. The
29485 results of the tests will eventually appear on your terminal.
29486 .ecindex IIDacl
29487
29488
29489
29490 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
29491 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
29492
29493 .chapter "Content scanning at ACL time" "CHAPexiscan"
29494 .scindex IIDcosca "content scanning" "at ACL time"
29495 The extension of Exim to include content scanning at ACL time, formerly known
29496 as &"exiscan"&, was originally implemented as a patch by Tom Kistner. The code
29497 was integrated into the main source for Exim release 4.50, and Tom continues to
29498 maintain it. Most of the wording of this chapter is taken from Tom's
29499 specification.
29500
29501 It is also possible to scan the content of messages at other times. The
29502 &[local_scan()]& function (see chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&) allows for content
29503 scanning after all the ACLs have run. A transport filter can be used to scan
29504 messages at delivery time (see the &%transport_filter%& option, described in
29505 chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
29506
29507 If you want to include the ACL-time content-scanning features when you compile
29508 Exim, you need to arrange for WITH_CONTENT_SCAN to be defined in your
29509 &_Local/Makefile_&. When you do that, the Exim binary is built with:
29510
29511 .ilist
29512 Two additional ACLs (&%acl_smtp_mime%& and &%acl_not_smtp_mime%&) that are run
29513 for all MIME parts for SMTP and non-SMTP messages, respectively.
29514 .next
29515 Additional ACL conditions and modifiers: &%decode%&, &%malware%&,
29516 &%mime_regex%&, &%regex%&, and &%spam%&. These can be used in the ACL that is
29517 run at the end of message reception (the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL).
29518 .next
29519 An additional control feature (&"no_mbox_unspool"&) that saves spooled copies
29520 of messages, or parts of messages, for debugging purposes.
29521 .next
29522 Additional expansion variables that are set in the new ACL and by the new
29523 conditions.
29524 .next
29525 Two new main configuration options: &%av_scanner%& and &%spamd_address%&.
29526 .endlist
29527
29528 There is another content-scanning configuration option for &_Local/Makefile_&,
29529 called WITH_OLD_DEMIME. If this is set, the old, deprecated &%demime%& ACL
29530 condition is compiled, in addition to all the other content-scanning features.
29531
29532 Content-scanning is continually evolving, and new features are still being
29533 added. While such features are still unstable and liable to incompatible
29534 changes, they are made available in Exim by setting options whose names begin
29535 EXPERIMENTAL_ in &_Local/Makefile_&. Such features are not documented in
29536 this manual. You can find out about them by reading the file called
29537 &_doc/experimental.txt_&.
29538
29539 All the content-scanning facilities work on a MBOX copy of the message that is
29540 temporarily created in a file called:
29541 .display
29542 <&'spool_directory'&>&`/scan/`&<&'message_id'&>/<&'message_id'&>&`.eml`&
29543 .endd
29544 The &_.eml_& extension is a friendly hint to virus scanners that they can
29545 expect an MBOX-like structure inside that file. The file is created when the
29546 first content scanning facility is called. Subsequent calls to content
29547 scanning conditions open the same file again. The directory is recursively
29548 removed when the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL has finished running, unless
29549 .code
29550 control = no_mbox_unspool
29551 .endd
29552 has been encountered. When the MIME ACL decodes files, they are put into the
29553 same directory by default.
29554
29555
29556
29557 .section "Scanning for viruses" "SECTscanvirus"
29558 .cindex "virus scanning"
29559 .cindex "content scanning" "for viruses"
29560 .cindex "content scanning" "the &%malware%& condition"
29561 The &%malware%& ACL condition lets you connect virus scanner software to Exim.
29562 It supports a &"generic"& interface to scanners called via the shell, and
29563 specialized interfaces for &"daemon"& type virus scanners, which are resident
29564 in memory and thus are much faster.
29565
29566
29567 .oindex "&%av_scanner%&"
29568 You can set the &%av_scanner%& option in first part of the Exim configuration
29569 file to specify which scanner to use, together with any additional options that
29570 are needed. The basic syntax is as follows:
29571 .display
29572 &`av_scanner = <`&&'scanner-type'&&`>:<`&&'option1'&&`>:<`&&'option2'&&`>:[...]`&
29573 .endd
29574 If you do not set &%av_scanner%&, it defaults to
29575 .code
29576 av_scanner = sophie:/var/run/sophie
29577 .endd
29578 If the value of &%av_scanner%& starts with a dollar character, it is expanded
29579 before use.
29580 The usual list-parsing of the content (see &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&) applies.
29581 The following scanner types are supported in this release:
29582
29583 .vlist
29584 .vitem &%aveserver%&
29585 .cindex "virus scanners" "Kaspersky"
29586 This is the scanner daemon of Kaspersky Version 5. You can get a trial version
29587 at &url(http://www.kaspersky.com). This scanner type takes one option,
29588 which is the path to the daemon's UNIX socket. The default is shown in this
29589 example:
29590 .code
29591 av_scanner = aveserver:/var/run/aveserver
29592 .endd
29593
29594
29595 .vitem &%clamd%&
29596 .cindex "virus scanners" "clamd"
29597 This daemon-type scanner is GPL and free. You can get it at
29598 &url(http://www.clamav.net/). Some older versions of clamd do not seem to
29599 unpack MIME containers, so it used to be recommended to unpack MIME attachments
29600 in the MIME ACL. This no longer believed to be necessary. One option is
29601 required: either the path and name of a UNIX socket file, or a hostname or IP
29602 number, and a port, separated by space, as in the second of these examples:
29603 .code
29604 av_scanner = clamd:/opt/clamd/socket
29605 av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234
29606 av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234:local
29607 av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234 : 192.0.2.4 1234
29608 .endd
29609 If the value of av_scanner points to a UNIX socket file or contains the local
29610 keyword, then the ClamAV interface will pass a filename containing the data
29611 to be scanned, which will should normally result in less I/O happening and be
29612 more efficient. Normally in the TCP case, the data is streamed to ClamAV as
29613 Exim does not assume that there is a common filesystem with the remote host.
29614 There is an option WITH_OLD_CLAMAV_STREAM in &_src/EDITME_& available, should
29615 you be running a version of ClamAV prior to 0.95.
29616
29617 The final example shows that multiple TCP targets can be specified. Exim will
29618 randomly use one for each incoming email (i.e. it load balances them). Note
29619 that only TCP targets may be used if specifying a list of scanners; a UNIX
29620 socket cannot be mixed in with TCP targets. If one of the servers becomes
29621 unavailable, Exim will try the remaining one(s) until it finds one that works.
29622 When a clamd server becomes unreachable, Exim will log a message. Exim does
29623 not keep track of scanner state between multiple messages, and the scanner
29624 selection is random, so the message will get logged in the mainlog for each
29625 email that the down scanner gets chosen first (message wrapped to be readable):
29626 .code
29627 2013-10-09 14:30:39 1VTumd-0000Y8-BQ malware acl condition:
29628 clamd: connection to localhost, port 3310 failed
29629 (Connection refused)
29630 .endd
29631
29632 If the option is unset, the default is &_/tmp/clamd_&. Thanks to David Saez for
29633 contributing the code for this scanner.
29634
29635 .vitem &%cmdline%&
29636 .cindex "virus scanners" "command line interface"
29637 This is the keyword for the generic command line scanner interface. It can be
29638 used to attach virus scanners that are invoked from the shell. This scanner
29639 type takes 3 mandatory options:
29640
29641 .olist
29642 The full path and name of the scanner binary, with all command line options,
29643 and a placeholder (&`%s`&) for the directory to scan.
29644
29645 .next
29646 A regular expression to match against the STDOUT and STDERR output of the
29647 virus scanner. If the expression matches, a virus was found. You must make
29648 absolutely sure that this expression matches on &"virus found"&. This is called
29649 the &"trigger"& expression.
29650
29651 .next
29652 Another regular expression, containing exactly one pair of parentheses, to
29653 match the name of the virus found in the scanners output. This is called the
29654 &"name"& expression.
29655 .endlist olist
29656
29657 For example, Sophos Sweep reports a virus on a line like this:
29658 .code
29659 Virus 'W32/Magistr-B' found in file ./those.bat
29660 .endd
29661 For the trigger expression, we can match the phrase &"found in file"&. For the
29662 name expression, we want to extract the W32/Magistr-B string, so we can match
29663 for the single quotes left and right of it. Altogether, this makes the
29664 configuration setting:
29665 .code
29666 av_scanner = cmdline:\
29667 /path/to/sweep -ss -all -rec -archive %s:\
29668 found in file:'(.+)'
29669 .endd
29670 .vitem &%drweb%&
29671 .cindex "virus scanners" "DrWeb"
29672 The DrWeb daemon scanner (&url(http://www.sald.com/)) interface takes one
29673 argument, either a full path to a UNIX socket, or an IP address and port
29674 separated by white space, as in these examples:
29675 .code
29676 av_scanner = drweb:/var/run/drwebd.sock
29677 av_scanner = drweb:192.168.2.20 31337
29678 .endd
29679 If you omit the argument, the default path &_/usr/local/drweb/run/drwebd.sock_&
29680 is used. Thanks to Alex Miller for contributing the code for this scanner.
29681
29682 .vitem &%fsecure%&
29683 .cindex "virus scanners" "F-Secure"
29684 The F-Secure daemon scanner (&url(http://www.f-secure.com)) takes one
29685 argument which is the path to a UNIX socket. For example:
29686 .code
29687 av_scanner = fsecure:/path/to/.fsav
29688 .endd
29689 If no argument is given, the default is &_/var/run/.fsav_&. Thanks to Johan
29690 Thelmen for contributing the code for this scanner.
29691
29692 .vitem &%kavdaemon%&
29693 .cindex "virus scanners" "Kaspersky"
29694 This is the scanner daemon of Kaspersky Version 4. This version of the
29695 Kaspersky scanner is outdated. Please upgrade (see &%aveserver%& above). This
29696 scanner type takes one option, which is the path to the daemon's UNIX socket.
29697 For example:
29698 .code
29699 av_scanner = kavdaemon:/opt/AVP/AvpCtl
29700 .endd
29701 The default path is &_/var/run/AvpCtl_&.
29702
29703 .vitem &%mksd%&
29704 .cindex "virus scanners" "mksd"
29705 This is a daemon type scanner that is aimed mainly at Polish users, though some
29706 parts of documentation are now available in English. You can get it at
29707 &url(http://linux.mks.com.pl/). The only option for this scanner type is
29708 the maximum number of processes used simultaneously to scan the attachments,
29709 provided that the demime facility is employed and also provided that mksd has
29710 been run with at least the same number of child processes. For example:
29711 .code
29712 av_scanner = mksd:2
29713 .endd
29714 You can safely omit this option (the default value is 1).
29715
29716 .vitem &%sophie%&
29717 .cindex "virus scanners" "Sophos and Sophie"
29718 Sophie is a daemon that uses Sophos' &%libsavi%& library to scan for viruses.
29719 You can get Sophie at &url(http://www.clanfield.info/sophie/). The only option
29720 for this scanner type is the path to the UNIX socket that Sophie uses for
29721 client communication. For example:
29722 .code
29723 av_scanner = sophie:/tmp/sophie
29724 .endd
29725 The default path is &_/var/run/sophie_&, so if you are using this, you can omit
29726 the option.
29727 .endlist
29728
29729 When &%av_scanner%& is correctly set, you can use the &%malware%& condition in
29730 the DATA ACL. &*Note*&: You cannot use the &%malware%& condition in the MIME
29731 ACL.
29732
29733 The &%av_scanner%& option is expanded each time &%malware%& is called. This
29734 makes it possible to use different scanners. See further below for an example.
29735 The &%malware%& condition caches its results, so when you use it multiple times
29736 for the same message, the actual scanning process is only carried out once.
29737 However, using expandable items in &%av_scanner%& disables this caching, in
29738 which case each use of the &%malware%& condition causes a new scan of the
29739 message.
29740
29741 The &%malware%& condition takes a right-hand argument that is expanded before
29742 use. It can then be one of
29743
29744 .ilist
29745 &"true"&, &"*"&, or &"1"&, in which case the message is scanned for viruses.
29746 The condition succeeds if a virus was found, and fail otherwise. This is the
29747 recommended usage.
29748 .next
29749 &"false"& or &"0"& or an empty string, in which case no scanning is done and
29750 the condition fails immediately.
29751 .next
29752 A regular expression, in which case the message is scanned for viruses. The
29753 condition succeeds if a virus is found and its name matches the regular
29754 expression. This allows you to take special actions on certain types of virus.
29755 .endlist
29756
29757 You can append &`/defer_ok`& to the &%malware%& condition to accept messages
29758 even if there is a problem with the virus scanner. Otherwise, such a problem
29759 causes the ACL to defer.
29760
29761 .vindex "&$malware_name$&"
29762 When a virus is found, the condition sets up an expansion variable called
29763 &$malware_name$& that contains the name of the virus. You can use it in a
29764 &%message%& modifier that specifies the error returned to the sender, and/or in
29765 logging data.
29766
29767 If your virus scanner cannot unpack MIME and TNEF containers itself, you should
29768 use the &%demime%& condition (see section &<<SECTdemimecond>>&) before the
29769 &%malware%& condition.
29770
29771 Beware the interaction of Exim's &%message_size_limit%& with any size limits
29772 imposed by your anti-virus scanner.
29773
29774 Here is a very simple scanning example:
29775 .code
29776 deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
29777 demime = *
29778 malware = *
29779 .endd
29780 The next example accepts messages when there is a problem with the scanner:
29781 .code
29782 deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
29783 demime = *
29784 malware = */defer_ok
29785 .endd
29786 The next example shows how to use an ACL variable to scan with both sophie and
29787 aveserver. It assumes you have set:
29788 .code
29789 av_scanner = $acl_m0
29790 .endd
29791 in the main Exim configuration.
29792 .code
29793 deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
29794 set acl_m0 = sophie
29795 malware = *
29796
29797 deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
29798 set acl_m0 = aveserver
29799 malware = *
29800 .endd
29801
29802
29803 .section "Scanning with SpamAssassin" "SECTscanspamass"
29804 .cindex "content scanning" "for spam"
29805 .cindex "spam scanning"
29806 .cindex "SpamAssassin"
29807 The &%spam%& ACL condition calls SpamAssassin's &%spamd%& daemon to get a spam
29808 score and a report for the message. You can get SpamAssassin at
29809 &url(http://www.spamassassin.org), or, if you have a working Perl
29810 installation, you can use CPAN by running:
29811 .code
29812 perl -MCPAN -e 'install Mail::SpamAssassin'
29813 .endd
29814 SpamAssassin has its own set of configuration files. Please review its
29815 documentation to see how you can tweak it. The default installation should work
29816 nicely, however.
29817
29818 .oindex "&%spamd_address%&"
29819 After having installed and configured SpamAssassin, start the &%spamd%& daemon.
29820 By default, it listens on 127.0.0.1, TCP port 783. If you use another host or
29821 port for &%spamd%&, you must set the &%spamd_address%& option in the global
29822 part of the Exim configuration as follows (example):
29823 .code
29824 spamd_address = 192.168.99.45 387
29825 .endd
29826 You do not need to set this option if you use the default. As of version 2.60,
29827 &%spamd%& also supports communication over UNIX sockets. If you want to use
29828 these, supply &%spamd_address%& with an absolute file name instead of a
29829 address/port pair:
29830 .code
29831 spamd_address = /var/run/spamd_socket
29832 .endd
29833 You can have multiple &%spamd%& servers to improve scalability. These can
29834 reside on other hardware reachable over the network. To specify multiple
29835 &%spamd%& servers, put multiple address/port pairs in the &%spamd_address%&
29836 option, separated with colons:
29837 .code
29838 spamd_address = 192.168.2.10 783 : \
29839 192.168.2.11 783 : \
29840 192.168.2.12 783
29841 .endd
29842 Up to 32 &%spamd%& servers are supported. The servers are queried in a random
29843 fashion. When a server fails to respond to the connection attempt, all other
29844 servers are tried until one succeeds. If no server responds, the &%spam%&
29845 condition defers.
29846
29847 &*Warning*&: It is not possible to use the UNIX socket connection method with
29848 multiple &%spamd%& servers.
29849
29850 The &%spamd_address%& variable is expanded before use if it starts with
29851 a dollar sign. In this case, the expansion may return a string that is
29852 used as the list so that multiple spamd servers can be the result of an
29853 expansion.
29854
29855 .section "Calling SpamAssassin from an Exim ACL" "SECID206"
29856 Here is a simple example of the use of the &%spam%& condition in a DATA ACL:
29857 .code
29858 deny message = This message was classified as SPAM
29859 spam = joe
29860 .endd
29861 The right-hand side of the &%spam%& condition specifies a name. This is
29862 relevant if you have set up multiple SpamAssassin profiles. If you do not want
29863 to scan using a specific profile, but rather use the SpamAssassin system-wide
29864 default profile, you can scan for an unknown name, or simply use &"nobody"&.
29865 However, you must put something on the right-hand side.
29866
29867 The name allows you to use per-domain or per-user antispam profiles in
29868 principle, but this is not straightforward in practice, because a message may
29869 have multiple recipients, not necessarily all in the same domain. Because the
29870 &%spam%& condition has to be called from a DATA ACL in order to be able to
29871 read the contents of the message, the variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$&
29872 are not set.
29873
29874 The right-hand side of the &%spam%& condition is expanded before being used, so
29875 you can put lookups or conditions there. When the right-hand side evaluates to
29876 &"0"& or &"false"&, no scanning is done and the condition fails immediately.
29877
29878
29879 Scanning with SpamAssassin uses a lot of resources. If you scan every message,
29880 large ones may cause significant performance degradation. As most spam messages
29881 are quite small, it is recommended that you do not scan the big ones. For
29882 example:
29883 .code
29884 deny message = This message was classified as SPAM
29885 condition = ${if < {$message_size}{10K}}
29886 spam = nobody
29887 .endd
29888
29889 The &%spam%& condition returns true if the threshold specified in the user's
29890 SpamAssassin profile has been matched or exceeded. If you want to use the
29891 &%spam%& condition for its side effects (see the variables below), you can make
29892 it always return &"true"& by appending &`:true`& to the username.
29893
29894 .cindex "spam scanning" "returned variables"
29895 When the &%spam%& condition is run, it sets up a number of expansion
29896 variables. These variables are saved with the received message, thus they are
29897 available for use at delivery time.
29898
29899 .vlist
29900 .vitem &$spam_score$&
29901 The spam score of the message, for example &"3.4"& or &"30.5"&. This is useful
29902 for inclusion in log or reject messages.
29903
29904 .vitem &$spam_score_int$&
29905 The spam score of the message, multiplied by ten, as an integer value. For
29906 example &"34"& or &"305"&. It may appear to disagree with &$spam_score$&
29907 because &$spam_score$& is rounded and &$spam_score_int$& is truncated.
29908 The integer value is useful for numeric comparisons in conditions.
29909
29910 .vitem &$spam_bar$&
29911 A string consisting of a number of &"+"& or &"-"& characters, representing the
29912 integer part of the spam score value. A spam score of 4.4 would have a
29913 &$spam_bar$& value of &"++++"&. This is useful for inclusion in warning
29914 headers, since MUAs can match on such strings.
29915
29916 .vitem &$spam_report$&
29917 A multiline text table, containing the full SpamAssassin report for the
29918 message. Useful for inclusion in headers or reject messages.
29919 .endlist
29920
29921 The &%spam%& condition caches its results unless expansion in
29922 spamd_address was used. If you call it again with the same user name, it
29923 does not scan again, but rather returns the same values as before.
29924
29925 The &%spam%& condition returns DEFER if there is any error while running
29926 the message through SpamAssassin or if the expansion of spamd_address
29927 failed. If you want to treat DEFER as FAIL (to pass on to the next ACL
29928 statement block), append &`/defer_ok`& to the right-hand side of the
29929 spam condition, like this:
29930 .code
29931 deny message = This message was classified as SPAM
29932 spam = joe/defer_ok
29933 .endd
29934 This causes messages to be accepted even if there is a problem with &%spamd%&.
29935
29936 Here is a longer, commented example of the use of the &%spam%&
29937 condition:
29938 .code
29939 # put headers in all messages (no matter if spam or not)
29940 warn spam = nobody:true
29941 add_header = X-Spam-Score: $spam_score ($spam_bar)
29942 add_header = X-Spam-Report: $spam_report
29943
29944 # add second subject line with *SPAM* marker when message
29945 # is over threshold
29946 warn spam = nobody
29947 add_header = Subject: *SPAM* $h_Subject:
29948
29949 # reject spam at high scores (> 12)
29950 deny message = This message scored $spam_score spam points.
29951 spam = nobody:true
29952 condition = ${if >{$spam_score_int}{120}{1}{0}}
29953 .endd
29954
29955
29956
29957 .section "Scanning MIME parts" "SECTscanmimepart"
29958 .cindex "content scanning" "MIME parts"
29959 .cindex "MIME content scanning"
29960 .oindex "&%acl_smtp_mime%&"
29961 .oindex "&%acl_not_smtp_mime%&"
29962 The &%acl_smtp_mime%& global option specifies an ACL that is called once for
29963 each MIME part of an SMTP message, including multipart types, in the sequence
29964 of their position in the message. Similarly, the &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& option
29965 specifies an ACL that is used for the MIME parts of non-SMTP messages. These
29966 options may both refer to the same ACL if you want the same processing in both
29967 cases.
29968
29969 These ACLs are called (possibly many times) just before the &%acl_smtp_data%&
29970 ACL in the case of an SMTP message, or just before the &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL in
29971 the case of a non-SMTP message. However, a MIME ACL is called only if the
29972 message contains a &'Content-Type:'& header line. When a call to a MIME
29973 ACL does not yield &"accept"&, ACL processing is aborted and the appropriate
29974 result code is sent to the client. In the case of an SMTP message, the
29975 &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL is not called when this happens.
29976
29977 You cannot use the &%malware%& or &%spam%& conditions in a MIME ACL; these can
29978 only be used in the DATA or non-SMTP ACLs. However, you can use the &%regex%&
29979 condition to match against the raw MIME part. You can also use the
29980 &%mime_regex%& condition to match against the decoded MIME part (see section
29981 &<<SECTscanregex>>&).
29982
29983 At the start of a MIME ACL, a number of variables are set from the header
29984 information for the relevant MIME part. These are described below. The contents
29985 of the MIME part are not by default decoded into a disk file except for MIME
29986 parts whose content-type is &"message/rfc822"&. If you want to decode a MIME
29987 part into a disk file, you can use the &%decode%& condition. The general
29988 syntax is:
29989 .display
29990 &`decode = [/`&<&'path'&>&`/]`&<&'filename'&>
29991 .endd
29992 The right hand side is expanded before use. After expansion,
29993 the value can be:
29994
29995 .olist
29996 &"0"& or &"false"&, in which case no decoding is done.
29997 .next
29998 The string &"default"&. In that case, the file is put in the temporary
29999 &"default"& directory <&'spool_directory'&>&_/scan/_&<&'message_id'&>&_/_& with
30000 a sequential file name consisting of the message id and a sequence number. The
30001 full path and name is available in &$mime_decoded_filename$& after decoding.
30002 .next
30003 A full path name starting with a slash. If the full name is an existing
30004 directory, it is used as a replacement for the default directory. The filename
30005 is then sequentially assigned. If the path does not exist, it is used as
30006 the full path and file name.
30007 .next
30008 If the string does not start with a slash, it is used as the
30009 filename, and the default path is then used.
30010 .endlist
30011 The &%decode%& condition normally succeeds. It is only false for syntax
30012 errors or unusual circumstances such as memory shortages. You can easily decode
30013 a file with its original, proposed filename using
30014 .code
30015 decode = $mime_filename
30016 .endd
30017 However, you should keep in mind that &$mime_filename$& might contain
30018 anything. If you place files outside of the default path, they are not
30019 automatically unlinked.
30020
30021 For RFC822 attachments (these are messages attached to messages, with a
30022 content-type of &"message/rfc822"&), the ACL is called again in the same manner
30023 as for the primary message, only that the &$mime_is_rfc822$& expansion
30024 variable is set (see below). Attached messages are always decoded to disk
30025 before being checked, and the files are unlinked once the check is done.
30026
30027 The MIME ACL supports the &%regex%& and &%mime_regex%& conditions. These can be
30028 used to match regular expressions against raw and decoded MIME parts,
30029 respectively. They are described in section &<<SECTscanregex>>&.
30030
30031 .cindex "MIME content scanning" "returned variables"
30032 The following list describes all expansion variables that are
30033 available in the MIME ACL:
30034
30035 .vlist
30036 .vitem &$mime_boundary$&
30037 If the current part is a multipart (see &$mime_is_multipart$&) below, it should
30038 have a boundary string, which is stored in this variable. If the current part
30039 has no boundary parameter in the &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable
30040 contains the empty string.
30041
30042 .vitem &$mime_charset$&
30043 This variable contains the character set identifier, if one was found in the
30044 &'Content-Type:'& header. Examples for charset identifiers are:
30045 .code
30046 us-ascii
30047 gb2312 (Chinese)
30048 iso-8859-1
30049 .endd
30050 Please note that this value is not normalized, so you should do matches
30051 case-insensitively.
30052
30053 .vitem &$mime_content_description$&
30054 This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-Description:'&
30055 header. It can contain a human-readable description of the parts content. Some
30056 implementations repeat the filename for attachments here, but they are usually
30057 only used for display purposes.
30058
30059 .vitem &$mime_content_disposition$&
30060 This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-Disposition:'&
30061 header. You can expect strings like &"attachment"& or &"inline"& here.
30062
30063 .vitem &$mime_content_id$&
30064 This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-ID:'& header.
30065 This is a unique ID that can be used to reference a part from another part.
30066
30067 .vitem &$mime_content_size$&
30068 This variable is set only after the &%decode%& modifier (see above) has been
30069 successfully run. It contains the size of the decoded part in kilobytes. The
30070 size is always rounded up to full kilobytes, so only a completely empty part
30071 has a &$mime_content_size$& of zero.
30072
30073 .vitem &$mime_content_transfer_encoding$&
30074 This variable contains the normalized content of the
30075 &'Content-transfer-encoding:'& header. This is a symbolic name for an encoding
30076 type. Typical values are &"base64"& and &"quoted-printable"&.
30077
30078 .vitem &$mime_content_type$&
30079 If the MIME part has a &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable contains its
30080 value, lowercased, and without any options (like &"name"& or &"charset"&). Here
30081 are some examples of popular MIME types, as they may appear in this variable:
30082 .code
30083 text/plain
30084 text/html
30085 application/octet-stream
30086 image/jpeg
30087 audio/midi
30088 .endd
30089 If the MIME part has no &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable contains the
30090 empty string.
30091
30092 .vitem &$mime_decoded_filename$&
30093 This variable is set only after the &%decode%& modifier (see above) has been
30094 successfully run. It contains the full path and file name of the file
30095 containing the decoded data.
30096 .endlist
30097
30098 .cindex "RFC 2047"
30099 .vlist
30100 .vitem &$mime_filename$&
30101 This is perhaps the most important of the MIME variables. It contains a
30102 proposed filename for an attachment, if one was found in either the
30103 &'Content-Type:'& or &'Content-Disposition:'& headers. The filename will be
30104 RFC2047 decoded, but no additional sanity checks are done. If no filename was
30105 found, this variable contains the empty string.
30106
30107 .vitem &$mime_is_coverletter$&
30108 This variable attempts to differentiate the &"cover letter"& of an e-mail from
30109 attached data. It can be used to clamp down on flashy or unnecessarily encoded
30110 content in the cover letter, while not restricting attachments at all.
30111
30112 The variable contains 1 (true) for a MIME part believed to be part of the
30113 cover letter, and 0 (false) for an attachment. At present, the algorithm is as
30114 follows:
30115
30116 .olist
30117 The outermost MIME part of a message is always a cover letter.
30118
30119 .next
30120 If a multipart/alternative or multipart/related MIME part is a cover letter,
30121 so are all MIME subparts within that multipart.
30122
30123 .next
30124 If any other multipart is a cover letter, the first subpart is a cover letter,
30125 and the rest are attachments.
30126
30127 .next
30128 All parts contained within an attachment multipart are attachments.
30129 .endlist olist
30130
30131 As an example, the following will ban &"HTML mail"& (including that sent with
30132 alternative plain text), while allowing HTML files to be attached. HTML
30133 coverletter mail attached to non-HMTL coverletter mail will also be allowed:
30134 .code
30135 deny message = HTML mail is not accepted here
30136 !condition = $mime_is_rfc822
30137 condition = $mime_is_coverletter
30138 condition = ${if eq{$mime_content_type}{text/html}{1}{0}}
30139 .endd
30140 .vitem &$mime_is_multipart$&
30141 This variable has the value 1 (true) when the current part has the main type
30142 &"multipart"&, for example &"multipart/alternative"& or &"multipart/mixed"&.
30143 Since multipart entities only serve as containers for other parts, you may not
30144 want to carry out specific actions on them.
30145
30146 .vitem &$mime_is_rfc822$&
30147 This variable has the value 1 (true) if the current part is not a part of the
30148 checked message itself, but part of an attached message. Attached message
30149 decoding is fully recursive.
30150
30151 .vitem &$mime_part_count$&
30152 This variable is a counter that is raised for each processed MIME part. It
30153 starts at zero for the very first part (which is usually a multipart). The
30154 counter is per-message, so it is reset when processing RFC822 attachments (see
30155 &$mime_is_rfc822$&). The counter stays set after &%acl_smtp_mime%& is
30156 complete, so you can use it in the DATA ACL to determine the number of MIME
30157 parts of a message. For non-MIME messages, this variable contains the value -1.
30158 .endlist
30159
30160
30161
30162 .section "Scanning with regular expressions" "SECTscanregex"
30163 .cindex "content scanning" "with regular expressions"
30164 .cindex "regular expressions" "content scanning with"
30165 You can specify your own custom regular expression matches on the full body of
30166 the message, or on individual MIME parts.
30167
30168 The &%regex%& condition takes one or more regular expressions as arguments and
30169 matches them against the full message (when called in the DATA ACL) or a raw
30170 MIME part (when called in the MIME ACL). The &%regex%& condition matches
30171 linewise, with a maximum line length of 32K characters. That means you cannot
30172 have multiline matches with the &%regex%& condition.
30173
30174 The &%mime_regex%& condition can be called only in the MIME ACL. It matches up
30175 to 32K of decoded content (the whole content at once, not linewise). If the
30176 part has not been decoded with the &%decode%& modifier earlier in the ACL, it
30177 is decoded automatically when &%mime_regex%& is executed (using default path
30178 and filename values). If the decoded data is larger than 32K, only the first
30179 32K characters are checked.
30180
30181 The regular expressions are passed as a colon-separated list. To include a
30182 literal colon, you must double it. Since the whole right-hand side string is
30183 expanded before being used, you must also escape dollar signs and backslashes
30184 with more backslashes, or use the &`\N`& facility to disable expansion.
30185 Here is a simple example that contains two regular expressions:
30186 .code
30187 deny message = contains blacklisted regex ($regex_match_string)
30188 regex = [Mm]ortgage : URGENT BUSINESS PROPOSAL
30189 .endd
30190 The conditions returns true if any one of the regular expressions matches. The
30191 &$regex_match_string$& expansion variable is then set up and contains the
30192 matching regular expression.
30193
30194 &*Warning*&: With large messages, these conditions can be fairly
30195 CPU-intensive.
30196
30197
30198
30199
30200 .section "The demime condition" "SECTdemimecond"
30201 .cindex "content scanning" "MIME checking"
30202 .cindex "MIME content scanning"
30203 The &%demime%& ACL condition provides MIME unpacking, sanity checking and file
30204 extension blocking. It is usable only in the DATA and non-SMTP ACLs. The
30205 &%demime%& condition uses a simpler interface to MIME decoding than the MIME
30206 ACL functionality, but provides no additional facilities. Please note that this
30207 condition is deprecated and kept only for backward compatibility. You must set
30208 the WITH_OLD_DEMIME option in &_Local/Makefile_& at build time to be able to
30209 use the &%demime%& condition.
30210
30211 The &%demime%& condition unpacks MIME containers in the message. It detects
30212 errors in MIME containers and can match file extensions found in the message
30213 against a list. Using this facility produces files containing the unpacked MIME
30214 parts of the message in the temporary scan directory. If you do antivirus
30215 scanning, it is recommended that you use the &%demime%& condition before the
30216 antivirus (&%malware%&) condition.
30217
30218 On the right-hand side of the &%demime%& condition you can pass a
30219 colon-separated list of file extensions that it should match against. For
30220 example:
30221 .code
30222 deny message = Found blacklisted file attachment
30223 demime = vbs:com:bat:pif:prf:lnk
30224 .endd
30225 If one of the file extensions is found, the condition is true, otherwise it is
30226 false. If there is a temporary error while demimeing (for example, &"disk
30227 full"&), the condition defers, and the message is temporarily rejected (unless
30228 the condition is on a &%warn%& verb).
30229
30230 The right-hand side is expanded before being treated as a list, so you can have
30231 conditions and lookups there. If it expands to an empty string, &"false"&, or
30232 zero (&"0"&), no demimeing is done and the condition is false.
30233
30234 The &%demime%& condition set the following variables:
30235
30236 .vlist
30237 .vitem &$demime_errorlevel$&
30238 .vindex "&$demime_errorlevel$&"
30239 When an error is detected in a MIME container, this variable contains the
30240 severity of the error, as an integer number. The higher the value, the more
30241 severe the error (the current maximum value is 3). If this variable is unset or
30242 zero, no error occurred.
30243
30244 .vitem &$demime_reason$&
30245 .vindex "&$demime_reason$&"
30246 When &$demime_errorlevel$& is greater than zero, this variable contains a
30247 human-readable text string describing the MIME error that occurred.
30248 .endlist
30249
30250 .vlist
30251 .vitem &$found_extension$&
30252 .vindex "&$found_extension$&"
30253 When the &%demime%& condition is true, this variable contains the file
30254 extension it found.
30255 .endlist
30256
30257 Both &$demime_errorlevel$& and &$demime_reason$& are set by the first call of
30258 the &%demime%& condition, and are not changed on subsequent calls.
30259
30260 If you do not want to check for file extensions, but rather use the &%demime%&
30261 condition for unpacking or error checking purposes, pass &"*"& as the
30262 right-hand side value. Here is a more elaborate example of how to use this
30263 facility:
30264 .code
30265 # Reject messages with serious MIME container errors
30266 deny message = Found MIME error ($demime_reason).
30267 demime = *
30268 condition = ${if >{$demime_errorlevel}{2}{1}{0}}
30269
30270 # Reject known virus spreading file extensions.
30271 # Accepting these is pretty much braindead.
30272 deny message = contains $found_extension file (blacklisted).
30273 demime = com:vbs:bat:pif:scr
30274
30275 # Freeze .exe and .doc files. Postmaster can
30276 # examine them and eventually thaw them.
30277 deny log_message = Another $found_extension file.
30278 demime = exe:doc
30279 control = freeze
30280 .endd
30281 .ecindex IIDcosca
30282
30283
30284
30285
30286 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
30287 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
30288
30289 .chapter "Adding a local scan function to Exim" "CHAPlocalscan" &&&
30290 "Local scan function"
30291 .scindex IIDlosca "&[local_scan()]& function" "description of"
30292 .cindex "customizing" "input scan using C function"
30293 .cindex "policy control" "by local scan function"
30294 In these days of email worms, viruses, and ever-increasing spam, some sites
30295 want to apply a lot of checking to messages before accepting them.
30296
30297 The content scanning extension (chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&) has facilities for
30298 passing messages to external virus and spam scanning software. You can also do
30299 a certain amount in Exim itself through string expansions and the &%condition%&
30300 condition in the ACL that runs after the SMTP DATA command or the ACL for
30301 non-SMTP messages (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&), but this has its limitations.
30302
30303 To allow for further customization to a site's own requirements, there is the
30304 possibility of linking Exim with a private message scanning function, written
30305 in C. If you want to run code that is written in something other than C, you
30306 can of course use a little C stub to call it.
30307
30308 The local scan function is run once for every incoming message, at the point
30309 when Exim is just about to accept the message.
30310 It can therefore be used to control non-SMTP messages from local processes as
30311 well as messages arriving via SMTP.
30312
30313 Exim applies a timeout to calls of the local scan function, and there is an
30314 option called &%local_scan_timeout%& for setting it. The default is 5 minutes.
30315 Zero means &"no timeout"&.
30316 Exim also sets up signal handlers for SIGSEGV, SIGILL, SIGFPE, and SIGBUS
30317 before calling the local scan function, so that the most common types of crash
30318 are caught. If the timeout is exceeded or one of those signals is caught, the
30319 incoming message is rejected with a temporary error if it is an SMTP message.
30320 For a non-SMTP message, the message is dropped and Exim ends with a non-zero
30321 code. The incident is logged on the main and reject logs.
30322
30323
30324
30325 .section "Building Exim to use a local scan function" "SECID207"
30326 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "building Exim to use"
30327 To make use of the local scan function feature, you must tell Exim where your
30328 function is before building Exim, by setting LOCAL_SCAN_SOURCE in your
30329 &_Local/Makefile_&. A recommended place to put it is in the &_Local_&
30330 directory, so you might set
30331 .code
30332 LOCAL_SCAN_SOURCE=Local/local_scan.c
30333 .endd
30334 for example. The function must be called &[local_scan()]&. It is called by
30335 Exim after it has received a message, when the success return code is about to
30336 be sent. This is after all the ACLs have been run. The return code from your
30337 function controls whether the message is actually accepted or not. There is a
30338 commented template function (that just accepts the message) in the file
30339 _src/local_scan.c_.
30340
30341 If you want to make use of Exim's run time configuration file to set options
30342 for your &[local_scan()]& function, you must also set
30343 .code
30344 LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
30345 .endd
30346 in &_Local/Makefile_& (see section &<<SECTconoptloc>>& below).
30347
30348
30349
30350
30351 .section "API for local_scan()" "SECTapiforloc"
30352 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "API description"
30353 You must include this line near the start of your code:
30354 .code
30355 #include "local_scan.h"
30356 .endd
30357 This header file defines a number of variables and other values, and the
30358 prototype for the function itself. Exim is coded to use unsigned char values
30359 almost exclusively, and one of the things this header defines is a shorthand
30360 for &`unsigned char`& called &`uschar`&.
30361 It also contains the following macro definitions, to simplify casting character
30362 strings and pointers to character strings:
30363 .code
30364 #define CS (char *)
30365 #define CCS (const char *)
30366 #define CSS (char **)
30367 #define US (unsigned char *)
30368 #define CUS (const unsigned char *)
30369 #define USS (unsigned char **)
30370 .endd
30371 The function prototype for &[local_scan()]& is:
30372 .code
30373 extern int local_scan(int fd, uschar **return_text);
30374 .endd
30375 The arguments are as follows:
30376
30377 .ilist
30378 &%fd%& is a file descriptor for the file that contains the body of the message
30379 (the -D file). The file is open for reading and writing, but updating it is not
30380 recommended. &*Warning*&: You must &'not'& close this file descriptor.
30381
30382 The descriptor is positioned at character 19 of the file, which is the first
30383 character of the body itself, because the first 19 characters are the message
30384 id followed by &`-D`& and a newline. If you rewind the file, you should use the
30385 macro SPOOL_DATA_START_OFFSET to reset to the start of the data, just in
30386 case this changes in some future version.
30387 .next
30388 &%return_text%& is an address which you can use to return a pointer to a text
30389 string at the end of the function. The value it points to on entry is NULL.
30390 .endlist
30391
30392 The function must return an &%int%& value which is one of the following macros:
30393
30394 .vlist
30395 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT`&
30396 .vindex "&$local_scan_data$&"
30397 The message is accepted. If you pass back a string of text, it is saved with
30398 the message, and made available in the variable &$local_scan_data$&. No
30399 newlines are permitted (if there are any, they are turned into spaces) and the
30400 maximum length of text is 1000 characters.
30401
30402 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT_FREEZE`&
30403 This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT, except that the accepted message is
30404 queued without immediate delivery, and is frozen.
30405
30406 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT_QUEUE`&
30407 This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT, except that the accepted message is
30408 queued without immediate delivery.
30409
30410 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT`&
30411 The message is rejected; the returned text is used as an error message which is
30412 passed back to the sender and which is also logged. Newlines are permitted &--
30413 they cause a multiline response for SMTP rejections, but are converted to
30414 &`\n`& in log lines. If no message is given, &"Administrative prohibition"& is
30415 used.
30416
30417 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT`&
30418 The message is temporarily rejected; the returned text is used as an error
30419 message as for LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT. If no message is given, &"Temporary local
30420 problem"& is used.
30421
30422 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT_NOLOGHDR`&
30423 This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT, except that the header of the rejected
30424 message is not written to the reject log. It has the effect of unsetting the
30425 &%rejected_header%& log selector for just this rejection. If
30426 &%rejected_header%& is already unset (see the discussion of the
30427 &%log_selection%& option in section &<<SECTlogselector>>&), this code is the
30428 same as LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT.
30429
30430 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT_NOLOGHDR`&
30431 This code is a variation of LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT in the same way that
30432 LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT_NOLOGHDR is a variation of LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT.
30433 .endlist
30434
30435 If the message is not being received by interactive SMTP, rejections are
30436 reported by writing to &%stderr%& or by sending an email, as configured by the
30437 &%-oe%& command line options.
30438
30439
30440
30441 .section "Configuration options for local_scan()" "SECTconoptloc"
30442 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "configuration options"
30443 It is possible to have option settings in the main configuration file
30444 that set values in static variables in the &[local_scan()]& module. If you
30445 want to do this, you must have the line
30446 .code
30447 LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
30448 .endd
30449 in your &_Local/Makefile_& when you build Exim. (This line is in
30450 &_OS/Makefile-Default_&, commented out). Then, in the &[local_scan()]& source
30451 file, you must define static variables to hold the option values, and a table
30452 to define them.
30453
30454 The table must be a vector called &%local_scan_options%&, of type
30455 &`optionlist`&. Each entry is a triplet, consisting of a name, an option type,
30456 and a pointer to the variable that holds the value. The entries must appear in
30457 alphabetical order. Following &%local_scan_options%& you must also define a
30458 variable called &%local_scan_options_count%& that contains the number of
30459 entries in the table. Here is a short example, showing two kinds of option:
30460 .code
30461 static int my_integer_option = 42;
30462 static uschar *my_string_option = US"a default string";
30463
30464 optionlist local_scan_options[] = {
30465 { "my_integer", opt_int, &my_integer_option },
30466 { "my_string", opt_stringptr, &my_string_option }
30467 };
30468
30469 int local_scan_options_count =
30470 sizeof(local_scan_options)/sizeof(optionlist);
30471 .endd
30472 The values of the variables can now be changed from Exim's runtime
30473 configuration file by including a local scan section as in this example:
30474 .code
30475 begin local_scan
30476 my_integer = 99
30477 my_string = some string of text...
30478 .endd
30479 The available types of option data are as follows:
30480
30481 .vlist
30482 .vitem &*opt_bool*&
30483 This specifies a boolean (true/false) option. The address should point to a
30484 variable of type &`BOOL`&, which will be set to TRUE or FALSE, which are macros
30485 that are defined as &"1"& and &"0"&, respectively. If you want to detect
30486 whether such a variable has been set at all, you can initialize it to
30487 TRUE_UNSET. (BOOL variables are integers underneath, so can hold more than two
30488 values.)
30489
30490 .vitem &*opt_fixed*&
30491 This specifies a fixed point number, such as is used for load averages.
30492 The address should point to a variable of type &`int`&. The value is stored
30493 multiplied by 1000, so, for example, 1.4142 is truncated and stored as 1414.
30494
30495 .vitem &*opt_int*&
30496 This specifies an integer; the address should point to a variable of type
30497 &`int`&. The value may be specified in any of the integer formats accepted by
30498 Exim.
30499
30500 .vitem &*opt_mkint*&
30501 This is the same as &%opt_int%&, except that when such a value is output in a
30502 &%-bP%& listing, if it is an exact number of kilobytes or megabytes, it is
30503 printed with the suffix K or M.
30504
30505 .vitem &*opt_octint*&
30506 This also specifies an integer, but the value is always interpreted as an
30507 octal integer, whether or not it starts with the digit zero, and it is
30508 always output in octal.
30509
30510 .vitem &*opt_stringptr*&
30511 This specifies a string value; the address must be a pointer to a
30512 variable that points to a string (for example, of type &`uschar *`&).
30513
30514 .vitem &*opt_time*&
30515 This specifies a time interval value. The address must point to a variable of
30516 type &`int`&. The value that is placed there is a number of seconds.
30517 .endlist
30518
30519 If the &%-bP%& command line option is followed by &`local_scan`&, Exim prints
30520 out the values of all the &[local_scan()]& options.
30521
30522
30523
30524 .section "Available Exim variables" "SECID208"
30525 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "available Exim variables"
30526 The header &_local_scan.h_& gives you access to a number of C variables. These
30527 are the only ones that are guaranteed to be maintained from release to release.
30528 Note, however, that you can obtain the value of any Exim expansion variable,
30529 including &$recipients$&, by calling &'expand_string()'&. The exported
30530 C variables are as follows:
30531
30532 .vlist
30533 .vitem &*int&~body_linecount*&
30534 This variable contains the number of lines in the message's body.
30535
30536 .vitem &*int&~body_zerocount*&
30537 This variable contains the number of binary zero bytes in the message's body.
30538
30539 .vitem &*unsigned&~int&~debug_selector*&
30540 This variable is set to zero when no debugging is taking place. Otherwise, it
30541 is a bitmap of debugging selectors. Two bits are identified for use in
30542 &[local_scan()]&; they are defined as macros:
30543
30544 .ilist
30545 The &`D_v`& bit is set when &%-v%& was present on the command line. This is a
30546 testing option that is not privileged &-- any caller may set it. All the
30547 other selector bits can be set only by admin users.
30548
30549 .next
30550 The &`D_local_scan`& bit is provided for use by &[local_scan()]&; it is set
30551 by the &`+local_scan`& debug selector. It is not included in the default set
30552 of debugging bits.
30553 .endlist ilist
30554
30555 Thus, to write to the debugging output only when &`+local_scan`& has been
30556 selected, you should use code like this:
30557 .code
30558 if ((debug_selector & D_local_scan) != 0)
30559 debug_printf("xxx", ...);
30560 .endd
30561 .vitem &*uschar&~*expand_string_message*&
30562 After a failing call to &'expand_string()'& (returned value NULL), the
30563 variable &%expand_string_message%& contains the error message, zero-terminated.
30564
30565 .vitem &*header_line&~*header_list*&
30566 A pointer to a chain of header lines. The &%header_line%& structure is
30567 discussed below.
30568
30569 .vitem &*header_line&~*header_last*&
30570 A pointer to the last of the header lines.
30571
30572 .vitem &*uschar&~*headers_charset*&
30573 The value of the &%headers_charset%& configuration option.
30574
30575 .vitem &*BOOL&~host_checking*&
30576 This variable is TRUE during a host checking session that is initiated by the
30577 &%-bh%& command line option.
30578
30579 .vitem &*uschar&~*interface_address*&
30580 The IP address of the interface that received the message, as a string. This
30581 is NULL for locally submitted messages.
30582
30583 .vitem &*int&~interface_port*&
30584 The port on which this message was received. When testing with the &%-bh%&
30585 command line option, the value of this variable is -1 unless a port has been
30586 specified via the &%-oMi%& option.
30587
30588 .vitem &*uschar&~*message_id*&
30589 This variable contains Exim's message id for the incoming message (the value of
30590 &$message_exim_id$&) as a zero-terminated string.
30591
30592 .vitem &*uschar&~*received_protocol*&
30593 The name of the protocol by which the message was received.
30594
30595 .vitem &*int&~recipients_count*&
30596 The number of accepted recipients.
30597
30598 .vitem &*recipient_item&~*recipients_list*&
30599 .cindex "recipient" "adding in local scan"
30600 .cindex "recipient" "removing in local scan"
30601 The list of accepted recipients, held in a vector of length
30602 &%recipients_count%&. The &%recipient_item%& structure is discussed below. You
30603 can add additional recipients by calling &'receive_add_recipient()'& (see
30604 below). You can delete recipients by removing them from the vector and
30605 adjusting the value in &%recipients_count%&. In particular, by setting
30606 &%recipients_count%& to zero you remove all recipients. If you then return the
30607 value &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT`&, the message is accepted, but immediately
30608 blackholed. To replace the recipients, you can set &%recipients_count%& to zero
30609 and then call &'receive_add_recipient()'& as often as needed.
30610
30611 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_address*&
30612 The envelope sender address. For bounce messages this is the empty string.
30613
30614 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_address*&
30615 The IP address of the sending host, as a string. This is NULL for
30616 locally-submitted messages.
30617
30618 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_authenticated*&
30619 The name of the authentication mechanism that was used, or NULL if the message
30620 was not received over an authenticated SMTP connection.
30621
30622 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_name*&
30623 The name of the sending host, if known.
30624
30625 .vitem &*int&~sender_host_port*&
30626 The port on the sending host.
30627
30628 .vitem &*BOOL&~smtp_input*&
30629 This variable is TRUE for all SMTP input, including BSMTP.
30630
30631 .vitem &*BOOL&~smtp_batched_input*&
30632 This variable is TRUE for BSMTP input.
30633
30634 .vitem &*int&~store_pool*&
30635 The contents of this variable control which pool of memory is used for new
30636 requests. See section &<<SECTmemhanloc>>& for details.
30637 .endlist
30638
30639
30640 .section "Structure of header lines" "SECID209"
30641 The &%header_line%& structure contains the members listed below.
30642 You can add additional header lines by calling the &'header_add()'& function
30643 (see below). You can cause header lines to be ignored (deleted) by setting
30644 their type to *.
30645
30646
30647 .vlist
30648 .vitem &*struct&~header_line&~*next*&
30649 A pointer to the next header line, or NULL for the last line.
30650
30651 .vitem &*int&~type*&
30652 A code identifying certain headers that Exim recognizes. The codes are printing
30653 characters, and are documented in chapter &<<CHAPspool>>& of this manual.
30654 Notice in particular that any header line whose type is * is not transmitted
30655 with the message. This flagging is used for header lines that have been
30656 rewritten, or are to be removed (for example, &'Envelope-sender:'& header
30657 lines.) Effectively, * means &"deleted"&.
30658
30659 .vitem &*int&~slen*&
30660 The number of characters in the header line, including the terminating and any
30661 internal newlines.
30662
30663 .vitem &*uschar&~*text*&
30664 A pointer to the text of the header. It always ends with a newline, followed by
30665 a zero byte. Internal newlines are preserved.
30666 .endlist
30667
30668
30669
30670 .section "Structure of recipient items" "SECID210"
30671 The &%recipient_item%& structure contains these members:
30672
30673 .vlist
30674 .vitem &*uschar&~*address*&
30675 This is a pointer to the recipient address as it was received.
30676
30677 .vitem &*int&~pno*&
30678 This is used in later Exim processing when top level addresses are created by
30679 the &%one_time%& option. It is not relevant at the time &[local_scan()]& is run
30680 and must always contain -1 at this stage.
30681
30682 .vitem &*uschar&~*errors_to*&
30683 If this value is not NULL, bounce messages caused by failing to deliver to the
30684 recipient are sent to the address it contains. In other words, it overrides the
30685 envelope sender for this one recipient. (Compare the &%errors_to%& generic
30686 router option.) If a &[local_scan()]& function sets an &%errors_to%& field to
30687 an unqualified address, Exim qualifies it using the domain from
30688 &%qualify_recipient%&. When &[local_scan()]& is called, the &%errors_to%& field
30689 is NULL for all recipients.
30690 .endlist
30691
30692
30693
30694 .section "Available Exim functions" "SECID211"
30695 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "available Exim functions"
30696 The header &_local_scan.h_& gives you access to a number of Exim functions.
30697 These are the only ones that are guaranteed to be maintained from release to
30698 release:
30699
30700 .vlist
30701 .vitem "&*pid_t&~child_open(uschar&~**argv,&~uschar&~**envp,&~int&~newumask,&&&
30702 &~int&~*infdptr,&~int&~*outfdptr, &~&~BOOL&~make_leader)*&"
30703
30704 This function creates a child process that runs the command specified by
30705 &%argv%&. The environment for the process is specified by &%envp%&, which can
30706 be NULL if no environment variables are to be passed. A new umask is supplied
30707 for the process in &%newumask%&.
30708
30709 Pipes to the standard input and output of the new process are set up
30710 and returned to the caller via the &%infdptr%& and &%outfdptr%& arguments. The
30711 standard error is cloned to the standard output. If there are any file
30712 descriptors &"in the way"& in the new process, they are closed. If the final
30713 argument is TRUE, the new process is made into a process group leader.
30714
30715 The function returns the pid of the new process, or -1 if things go wrong.
30716
30717 .vitem &*int&~child_close(pid_t&~pid,&~int&~timeout)*&
30718 This function waits for a child process to terminate, or for a timeout (in
30719 seconds) to expire. A timeout value of zero means wait as long as it takes. The
30720 return value is as follows:
30721
30722 .ilist
30723 >= 0
30724
30725 The process terminated by a normal exit and the value is the process
30726 ending status.
30727
30728 .next
30729 < 0 and > &--256
30730
30731 The process was terminated by a signal and the value is the negation of the
30732 signal number.
30733
30734 .next
30735 &--256
30736
30737 The process timed out.
30738 .next
30739 &--257
30740
30741 The was some other error in wait(); &%errno%& is still set.
30742 .endlist
30743
30744 .vitem &*pid_t&~child_open_exim(int&~*fd)*&
30745 This function provide you with a means of submitting a new message to
30746 Exim. (Of course, you can also call &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& yourself if you
30747 want, but this packages it all up for you.) The function creates a pipe,
30748 forks a subprocess that is running
30749 .code
30750 exim -t -oem -oi -f <>
30751 .endd
30752 and returns to you (via the &`int *`& argument) a file descriptor for the pipe
30753 that is connected to the standard input. The yield of the function is the PID
30754 of the subprocess. You can then write a message to the file descriptor, with
30755 recipients in &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and/or &'Bcc:'& header lines.
30756
30757 When you have finished, call &'child_close()'& to wait for the process to
30758 finish and to collect its ending status. A timeout value of zero is usually
30759 fine in this circumstance. Unless you have made a mistake with the recipient
30760 addresses, you should get a return code of zero.
30761
30762
30763 .vitem &*pid_t&~child_open_exim2(int&~*fd,&~uschar&~*sender,&~uschar&~&&&
30764 *sender_authentication)*&
30765 This function is a more sophisticated version of &'child_open()'&. The command
30766 that it runs is:
30767 .display
30768 &`exim -t -oem -oi -f `&&'sender'&&` -oMas `&&'sender_authentication'&
30769 .endd
30770 The third argument may be NULL, in which case the &%-oMas%& option is omitted.
30771
30772
30773 .vitem &*void&~debug_printf(char&~*,&~...)*&
30774 This is Exim's debugging function, with arguments as for &'(printf()'&. The
30775 output is written to the standard error stream. If no debugging is selected,
30776 calls to &'debug_printf()'& have no effect. Normally, you should make calls
30777 conditional on the &`local_scan`& debug selector by coding like this:
30778 .code
30779 if ((debug_selector & D_local_scan) != 0)
30780 debug_printf("xxx", ...);
30781 .endd
30782
30783 .vitem &*uschar&~*expand_string(uschar&~*string)*&
30784 This is an interface to Exim's string expansion code. The return value is the
30785 expanded string, or NULL if there was an expansion failure.
30786 The C variable &%expand_string_message%& contains an error message after an
30787 expansion failure. If expansion does not change the string, the return value is
30788 the pointer to the input string. Otherwise, the return value points to a new
30789 block of memory that was obtained by a call to &'store_get()'&. See section
30790 &<<SECTmemhanloc>>& below for a discussion of memory handling.
30791
30792 .vitem &*void&~header_add(int&~type,&~char&~*format,&~...)*&
30793 This function allows you to an add additional header line at the end of the
30794 existing ones. The first argument is the type, and should normally be a space
30795 character. The second argument is a format string and any number of
30796 substitution arguments as for &[sprintf()]&. You may include internal newlines
30797 if you want, and you must ensure that the string ends with a newline.
30798
30799 .vitem "&*void&~header_add_at_position(BOOL&~after,&~uschar&~*name,&~&&&
30800 BOOL&~topnot,&~int&~type,&~char&~*format, &~&~...)*&"
30801 This function adds a new header line at a specified point in the header
30802 chain. The header itself is specified as for &'header_add()'&.
30803
30804 If &%name%& is NULL, the new header is added at the end of the chain if
30805 &%after%& is true, or at the start if &%after%& is false. If &%name%& is not
30806 NULL, the header lines are searched for the first non-deleted header that
30807 matches the name. If one is found, the new header is added before it if
30808 &%after%& is false. If &%after%& is true, the new header is added after the
30809 found header and any adjacent subsequent ones with the same name (even if
30810 marked &"deleted"&). If no matching non-deleted header is found, the &%topnot%&
30811 option controls where the header is added. If it is true, addition is at the
30812 top; otherwise at the bottom. Thus, to add a header after all the &'Received:'&
30813 headers, or at the top if there are no &'Received:'& headers, you could use
30814 .code
30815 header_add_at_position(TRUE, US"Received", TRUE,
30816 ' ', "X-xxx: ...");
30817 .endd
30818 Normally, there is always at least one non-deleted &'Received:'& header, but
30819 there may not be if &%received_header_text%& expands to an empty string.
30820
30821
30822 .vitem &*void&~header_remove(int&~occurrence,&~uschar&~*name)*&
30823 This function removes header lines. If &%occurrence%& is zero or negative, all
30824 occurrences of the header are removed. If occurrence is greater than zero, that
30825 particular instance of the header is removed. If no header(s) can be found that
30826 match the specification, the function does nothing.
30827
30828
30829 .vitem "&*BOOL&~header_testname(header_line&~*hdr,&~uschar&~*name,&~&&&
30830 int&~length,&~BOOL&~notdel)*&"
30831 This function tests whether the given header has the given name. It is not just
30832 a string comparison, because white space is permitted between the name and the
30833 colon. If the &%notdel%& argument is true, a false return is forced for all
30834 &"deleted"& headers; otherwise they are not treated specially. For example:
30835 .code
30836 if (header_testname(h, US"X-Spam", 6, TRUE)) ...
30837 .endd
30838 .vitem &*uschar&~*lss_b64encode(uschar&~*cleartext,&~int&~length)*&
30839 .cindex "base64 encoding" "functions for &[local_scan()]& use"
30840 This function base64-encodes a string, which is passed by address and length.
30841 The text may contain bytes of any value, including zero. The result is passed
30842 back in dynamic memory that is obtained by calling &'store_get()'&. It is
30843 zero-terminated.
30844
30845 .vitem &*int&~lss_b64decode(uschar&~*codetext,&~uschar&~**cleartext)*&
30846 This function decodes a base64-encoded string. Its arguments are a
30847 zero-terminated base64-encoded string and the address of a variable that is set
30848 to point to the result, which is in dynamic memory. The length of the decoded
30849 string is the yield of the function. If the input is invalid base64 data, the
30850 yield is -1. A zero byte is added to the end of the output string to make it
30851 easy to interpret as a C string (assuming it contains no zeros of its own). The
30852 added zero byte is not included in the returned count.
30853
30854 .vitem &*int&~lss_match_domain(uschar&~*domain,&~uschar&~*list)*&
30855 This function checks for a match in a domain list. Domains are always
30856 matched caselessly. The return value is one of the following:
30857 .display
30858 &`OK `& match succeeded
30859 &`FAIL `& match failed
30860 &`DEFER `& match deferred
30861 .endd
30862 DEFER is usually caused by some kind of lookup defer, such as the
30863 inability to contact a database.
30864
30865 .vitem "&*int&~lss_match_local_part(uschar&~*localpart,&~uschar&~*list,&~&&&
30866 BOOL&~caseless)*&"
30867 This function checks for a match in a local part list. The third argument
30868 controls case-sensitivity. The return values are as for
30869 &'lss_match_domain()'&.
30870
30871 .vitem "&*int&~lss_match_address(uschar&~*address,&~uschar&~*list,&~&&&
30872 BOOL&~caseless)*&"
30873 This function checks for a match in an address list. The third argument
30874 controls the case-sensitivity of the local part match. The domain is always
30875 matched caselessly. The return values are as for &'lss_match_domain()'&.
30876
30877 .vitem "&*int&~lss_match_host(uschar&~*host_name,&~uschar&~*host_address,&~&&&
30878 uschar&~*list)*&"
30879 This function checks for a match in a host list. The most common usage is
30880 expected to be
30881 .code
30882 lss_match_host(sender_host_name, sender_host_address, ...)
30883 .endd
30884 .vindex "&$sender_host_address$&"
30885 An empty address field matches an empty item in the host list. If the host name
30886 is NULL, the name corresponding to &$sender_host_address$& is automatically
30887 looked up if a host name is required to match an item in the list. The return
30888 values are as for &'lss_match_domain()'&, but in addition, &'lss_match_host()'&
30889 returns ERROR in the case when it had to look up a host name, but the lookup
30890 failed.
30891
30892 .vitem "&*void&~log_write(unsigned&~int&~selector,&~int&~which,&~char&~&&&
30893 *format,&~...)*&"
30894 This function writes to Exim's log files. The first argument should be zero (it
30895 is concerned with &%log_selector%&). The second argument can be &`LOG_MAIN`& or
30896 &`LOG_REJECT`& or &`LOG_PANIC`& or the inclusive &"or"& of any combination of
30897 them. It specifies to which log or logs the message is written. The remaining
30898 arguments are a format and relevant insertion arguments. The string should not
30899 contain any newlines, not even at the end.
30900
30901
30902 .vitem &*void&~receive_add_recipient(uschar&~*address,&~int&~pno)*&
30903 This function adds an additional recipient to the message. The first argument
30904 is the recipient address. If it is unqualified (has no domain), it is qualified
30905 with the &%qualify_recipient%& domain. The second argument must always be -1.
30906
30907 This function does not allow you to specify a private &%errors_to%& address (as
30908 described with the structure of &%recipient_item%& above), because it pre-dates
30909 the addition of that field to the structure. However, it is easy to add such a
30910 value afterwards. For example:
30911 .code
30912 receive_add_recipient(US"monitor@mydom.example", -1);
30913 recipients_list[recipients_count-1].errors_to =
30914 US"postmaster@mydom.example";
30915 .endd
30916
30917 .vitem &*BOOL&~receive_remove_recipient(uschar&~*recipient)*&
30918 This is a convenience function to remove a named recipient from the list of
30919 recipients. It returns true if a recipient was removed, and false if no
30920 matching recipient could be found. The argument must be a complete email
30921 address.
30922 .endlist
30923
30924
30925 .cindex "RFC 2047"
30926 .vlist
30927 .vitem "&*uschar&~rfc2047_decode(uschar&~*string,&~BOOL&~lencheck,&&&
30928 &~uschar&~*target,&~int&~zeroval,&~int&~*lenptr, &~&~uschar&~**error)*&"
30929 This function decodes strings that are encoded according to RFC 2047. Typically
30930 these are the contents of header lines. First, each &"encoded word"& is decoded
30931 from the Q or B encoding into a byte-string. Then, if provided with the name of
30932 a charset encoding, and if the &[iconv()]& function is available, an attempt is
30933 made to translate the result to the named character set. If this fails, the
30934 binary string is returned with an error message.
30935
30936 The first argument is the string to be decoded. If &%lencheck%& is TRUE, the
30937 maximum MIME word length is enforced. The third argument is the target
30938 encoding, or NULL if no translation is wanted.
30939
30940 .cindex "binary zero" "in RFC 2047 decoding"
30941 .cindex "RFC 2047" "binary zero in"
30942 If a binary zero is encountered in the decoded string, it is replaced by the
30943 contents of the &%zeroval%& argument. For use with Exim headers, the value must
30944 not be 0 because header lines are handled as zero-terminated strings.
30945
30946 The function returns the result of processing the string, zero-terminated; if
30947 &%lenptr%& is not NULL, the length of the result is set in the variable to
30948 which it points. When &%zeroval%& is 0, &%lenptr%& should not be NULL.
30949
30950 If an error is encountered, the function returns NULL and uses the &%error%&
30951 argument to return an error message. The variable pointed to by &%error%& is
30952 set to NULL if there is no error; it may be set non-NULL even when the function
30953 returns a non-NULL value if decoding was successful, but there was a problem
30954 with translation.
30955
30956
30957 .vitem &*int&~smtp_fflush(void)*&
30958 This function is used in conjunction with &'smtp_printf()'&, as described
30959 below.
30960
30961 .vitem &*void&~smtp_printf(char&~*,&~...)*&
30962 The arguments of this function are like &[printf()]&; it writes to the SMTP
30963 output stream. You should use this function only when there is an SMTP output
30964 stream, that is, when the incoming message is being received via interactive
30965 SMTP. This is the case when &%smtp_input%& is TRUE and &%smtp_batched_input%&
30966 is FALSE. If you want to test for an incoming message from another host (as
30967 opposed to a local process that used the &%-bs%& command line option), you can
30968 test the value of &%sender_host_address%&, which is non-NULL when a remote host
30969 is involved.
30970
30971 If an SMTP TLS connection is established, &'smtp_printf()'& uses the TLS
30972 output function, so it can be used for all forms of SMTP connection.
30973
30974 Strings that are written by &'smtp_printf()'& from within &[local_scan()]&
30975 must start with an appropriate response code: 550 if you are going to return
30976 LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT, 451 if you are going to return
30977 LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT, and 250 otherwise. Because you are writing the
30978 initial lines of a multi-line response, the code must be followed by a hyphen
30979 to indicate that the line is not the final response line. You must also ensure
30980 that the lines you write terminate with CRLF. For example:
30981 .code
30982 smtp_printf("550-this is some extra info\r\n");
30983 return LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT;
30984 .endd
30985 Note that you can also create multi-line responses by including newlines in
30986 the data returned via the &%return_text%& argument. The added value of using
30987 &'smtp_printf()'& is that, for instance, you could introduce delays between
30988 multiple output lines.
30989
30990 The &'smtp_printf()'& function does not return any error indication, because it
30991 does not automatically flush pending output, and therefore does not test
30992 the state of the stream. (In the main code of Exim, flushing and error
30993 detection is done when Exim is ready for the next SMTP input command.) If
30994 you want to flush the output and check for an error (for example, the
30995 dropping of a TCP/IP connection), you can call &'smtp_fflush()'&, which has no
30996 arguments. It flushes the output stream, and returns a non-zero value if there
30997 is an error.
30998
30999 .vitem &*void&~*store_get(int)*&
31000 This function accesses Exim's internal store (memory) manager. It gets a new
31001 chunk of memory whose size is given by the argument. Exim bombs out if it ever
31002 runs out of memory. See the next section for a discussion of memory handling.
31003
31004 .vitem &*void&~*store_get_perm(int)*&
31005 This function is like &'store_get()'&, but it always gets memory from the
31006 permanent pool. See the next section for a discussion of memory handling.
31007
31008 .vitem &*uschar&~*string_copy(uschar&~*string)*&
31009 See below.
31010
31011 .vitem &*uschar&~*string_copyn(uschar&~*string,&~int&~length)*&
31012 See below.
31013
31014 .vitem &*uschar&~*string_sprintf(char&~*format,&~...)*&
31015 These three functions create strings using Exim's dynamic memory facilities.
31016 The first makes a copy of an entire string. The second copies up to a maximum
31017 number of characters, indicated by the second argument. The third uses a format
31018 and insertion arguments to create a new string. In each case, the result is a
31019 pointer to a new string in the current memory pool. See the next section for
31020 more discussion.
31021 .endlist
31022
31023
31024
31025 .section "More about Exim's memory handling" "SECTmemhanloc"
31026 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "memory handling"
31027 No function is provided for freeing memory, because that is never needed.
31028 The dynamic memory that Exim uses when receiving a message is automatically
31029 recycled if another message is received by the same process (this applies only
31030 to incoming SMTP connections &-- other input methods can supply only one
31031 message at a time). After receiving the last message, a reception process
31032 terminates.
31033
31034 Because it is recycled, the normal dynamic memory cannot be used for holding
31035 data that must be preserved over a number of incoming messages on the same SMTP
31036 connection. However, Exim in fact uses two pools of dynamic memory; the second
31037 one is not recycled, and can be used for this purpose.
31038
31039 If you want to allocate memory that remains available for subsequent messages
31040 in the same SMTP connection, you should set
31041 .code
31042 store_pool = POOL_PERM
31043 .endd
31044 before calling the function that does the allocation. There is no need to
31045 restore the value if you do not need to; however, if you do want to revert to
31046 the normal pool, you can either restore the previous value of &%store_pool%& or
31047 set it explicitly to POOL_MAIN.
31048
31049 The pool setting applies to all functions that get dynamic memory, including
31050 &'expand_string()'&, &'store_get()'&, and the &'string_xxx()'& functions.
31051 There is also a convenience function called &'store_get_perm()'& that gets a
31052 block of memory from the permanent pool while preserving the value of
31053 &%store_pool%&.
31054 .ecindex IIDlosca
31055
31056
31057
31058
31059 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
31060 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
31061
31062 .chapter "System-wide message filtering" "CHAPsystemfilter"
31063 .scindex IIDsysfil1 "filter" "system filter"
31064 .scindex IIDsysfil2 "filtering all mail"
31065 .scindex IIDsysfil3 "system filter"
31066 The previous chapters (on ACLs and the local scan function) describe checks
31067 that can be applied to messages before they are accepted by a host. There is
31068 also a mechanism for checking messages once they have been received, but before
31069 they are delivered. This is called the &'system filter'&.
31070
31071 The system filter operates in a similar manner to users' filter files, but it
31072 is run just once per message (however many recipients the message has).
31073 It should not normally be used as a substitute for routing, because &%deliver%&
31074 commands in a system router provide new envelope recipient addresses.
31075 The system filter must be an Exim filter. It cannot be a Sieve filter.
31076
31077 The system filter is run at the start of a delivery attempt, before any routing
31078 is done. If a message fails to be completely delivered at the first attempt,
31079 the system filter is run again at the start of every retry.
31080 If you want your filter to do something only once per message, you can make use
31081 of the &%first_delivery%& condition in an &%if%& command in the filter to
31082 prevent it happening on retries.
31083
31084 .vindex "&$domain$&"
31085 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
31086 &*Warning*&: Because the system filter runs just once, variables that are
31087 specific to individual recipient addresses, such as &$local_part$& and
31088 &$domain$&, are not set, and the &"personal"& condition is not meaningful. If
31089 you want to run a centrally-specified filter for each recipient address
31090 independently, you can do so by setting up a suitable &(redirect)& router, as
31091 described in section &<<SECTperaddfil>>& below.
31092
31093
31094 .section "Specifying a system filter" "SECID212"
31095 .cindex "uid (user id)" "system filter"
31096 .cindex "gid (group id)" "system filter"
31097 The name of the file that contains the system filter must be specified by
31098 setting &%system_filter%&. If you want the filter to run under a uid and gid
31099 other than root, you must also set &%system_filter_user%& and
31100 &%system_filter_group%& as appropriate. For example:
31101 .code
31102 system_filter = /etc/mail/exim.filter
31103 system_filter_user = exim
31104 .endd
31105 If a system filter generates any deliveries directly to files or pipes (via the
31106 &%save%& or &%pipe%& commands), transports to handle these deliveries must be
31107 specified by setting &%system_filter_file_transport%& and
31108 &%system_filter_pipe_transport%&, respectively. Similarly,
31109 &%system_filter_reply_transport%& must be set to handle any messages generated
31110 by the &%reply%& command.
31111
31112
31113 .section "Testing a system filter" "SECID213"
31114 You can run simple tests of a system filter in the same way as for a user
31115 filter, but you should use &%-bF%& rather than &%-bf%&, so that features that
31116 are permitted only in system filters are recognized.
31117
31118 If you want to test the combined effect of a system filter and a user filter,
31119 you can use both &%-bF%& and &%-bf%& on the same command line.
31120
31121
31122
31123 .section "Contents of a system filter" "SECID214"
31124 The language used to specify system filters is the same as for users' filter
31125 files. It is described in the separate end-user document &'Exim's interface to
31126 mail filtering'&. However, there are some additional features that are
31127 available only in system filters; these are described in subsequent sections.
31128 If they are encountered in a user's filter file or when testing with &%-bf%&,
31129 they cause errors.
31130
31131 .cindex "frozen messages" "manual thaw; testing in filter"
31132 There are two special conditions which, though available in users' filter
31133 files, are designed for use in system filters. The condition &%first_delivery%&
31134 is true only for the first attempt at delivering a message, and
31135 &%manually_thawed%& is true only if the message has been frozen, and
31136 subsequently thawed by an admin user. An explicit forced delivery counts as a
31137 manual thaw, but thawing as a result of the &%auto_thaw%& setting does not.
31138
31139 &*Warning*&: If a system filter uses the &%first_delivery%& condition to
31140 specify an &"unseen"& (non-significant) delivery, and that delivery does not
31141 succeed, it will not be tried again.
31142 If you want Exim to retry an unseen delivery until it succeeds, you should
31143 arrange to set it up every time the filter runs.
31144
31145 When a system filter finishes running, the values of the variables &$n0$& &--
31146 &$n9$& are copied into &$sn0$& &-- &$sn9$& and are thereby made available to
31147 users' filter files. Thus a system filter can, for example, set up &"scores"&
31148 to which users' filter files can refer.
31149
31150
31151
31152 .section "Additional variable for system filters" "SECID215"
31153 .vindex "&$recipients$&"
31154 The expansion variable &$recipients$&, containing a list of all the recipients
31155 of the message (separated by commas and white space), is available in system
31156 filters. It is not available in users' filters for privacy reasons.
31157
31158
31159
31160 .section "Defer, freeze, and fail commands for system filters" "SECID216"
31161 .cindex "freezing messages"
31162 .cindex "message" "freezing"
31163 .cindex "message" "forced failure"
31164 .cindex "&%fail%&" "in system filter"
31165 .cindex "&%freeze%& in system filter"
31166 .cindex "&%defer%& in system filter"
31167 There are three extra commands (&%defer%&, &%freeze%& and &%fail%&) which are
31168 always available in system filters, but are not normally enabled in users'
31169 filters. (See the &%allow_defer%&, &%allow_freeze%& and &%allow_fail%& options
31170 for the &(redirect)& router.) These commands can optionally be followed by the
31171 word &%text%& and a string containing an error message, for example:
31172 .code
31173 fail text "this message looks like spam to me"
31174 .endd
31175 The keyword &%text%& is optional if the next character is a double quote.
31176
31177 The &%defer%& command defers delivery of the original recipients of the
31178 message. The &%fail%& command causes all the original recipients to be failed,
31179 and a bounce message to be created. The &%freeze%& command suspends all
31180 delivery attempts for the original recipients. In all cases, any new deliveries
31181 that are specified by the filter are attempted as normal after the filter has
31182 run.
31183
31184 The &%freeze%& command is ignored if the message has been manually unfrozen and
31185 not manually frozen since. This means that automatic freezing by a system
31186 filter can be used as a way of checking out suspicious messages. If a message
31187 is found to be all right, manually unfreezing it allows it to be delivered.
31188
31189 .cindex "log" "&%fail%& command log line"
31190 .cindex "&%fail%&" "log line; reducing"
31191 The text given with a fail command is used as part of the bounce message as
31192 well as being written to the log. If the message is quite long, this can fill
31193 up a lot of log space when such failures are common. To reduce the size of the
31194 log message, Exim interprets the text in a special way if it starts with the
31195 two characters &`<<`& and contains &`>>`& later. The text between these two
31196 strings is written to the log, and the rest of the text is used in the bounce
31197 message. For example:
31198 .code
31199 fail "<<filter test 1>>Your message is rejected \
31200 because it contains attachments that we are \
31201 not prepared to receive."
31202 .endd
31203
31204 .cindex "loop" "caused by &%fail%&"
31205 Take great care with the &%fail%& command when basing the decision to fail on
31206 the contents of the message, because the bounce message will of course include
31207 the contents of the original message and will therefore trigger the &%fail%&
31208 command again (causing a mail loop) unless steps are taken to prevent this.
31209 Testing the &%error_message%& condition is one way to prevent this. You could
31210 use, for example
31211 .code
31212 if $message_body contains "this is spam" and not error_message
31213 then fail text "spam is not wanted here" endif
31214 .endd
31215 though of course that might let through unwanted bounce messages. The
31216 alternative is clever checking of the body and/or headers to detect bounces
31217 generated by the filter.
31218
31219 The interpretation of a system filter file ceases after a
31220 &%defer%&,
31221 &%freeze%&, or &%fail%& command is obeyed. However, any deliveries that were
31222 set up earlier in the filter file are honoured, so you can use a sequence such
31223 as
31224 .code
31225 mail ...
31226 freeze
31227 .endd
31228 to send a specified message when the system filter is freezing (or deferring or
31229 failing) a message. The normal deliveries for the message do not, of course,
31230 take place.
31231
31232
31233
31234 .section "Adding and removing headers in a system filter" "SECTaddremheasys"
31235 .cindex "header lines" "adding; in system filter"
31236 .cindex "header lines" "removing; in system filter"
31237 .cindex "filter" "header lines; adding/removing"
31238 Two filter commands that are available only in system filters are:
31239 .code
31240 headers add <string>
31241 headers remove <string>
31242 .endd
31243 The argument for the &%headers add%& is a string that is expanded and then
31244 added to the end of the message's headers. It is the responsibility of the
31245 filter maintainer to make sure it conforms to RFC 2822 syntax. Leading white
31246 space is ignored, and if the string is otherwise empty, or if the expansion is
31247 forced to fail, the command has no effect.
31248
31249 You can use &"\n"& within the string, followed by white space, to specify
31250 continued header lines. More than one header may be added in one command by
31251 including &"\n"& within the string without any following white space. For
31252 example:
31253 .code
31254 headers add "X-header-1: ....\n \
31255 continuation of X-header-1 ...\n\
31256 X-header-2: ...."
31257 .endd
31258 Note that the header line continuation white space after the first newline must
31259 be placed before the backslash that continues the input string, because white
31260 space after input continuations is ignored.
31261
31262 The argument for &%headers remove%& is a colon-separated list of header names.
31263 This command applies only to those headers that are stored with the message;
31264 those that are added at delivery time (such as &'Envelope-To:'& and
31265 &'Return-Path:'&) cannot be removed by this means. If there is more than one
31266 header with the same name, they are all removed.
31267
31268 The &%headers%& command in a system filter makes an immediate change to the set
31269 of header lines that was received with the message (with possible additions
31270 from ACL processing). Subsequent commands in the system filter operate on the
31271 modified set, which also forms the basis for subsequent message delivery.
31272 Unless further modified during routing or transporting, this set of headers is
31273 used for all recipients of the message.
31274
31275 During routing and transporting, the variables that refer to the contents of
31276 header lines refer only to those lines that are in this set. Thus, header lines
31277 that are added by a system filter are visible to users' filter files and to all
31278 routers and transports. This contrasts with the manipulation of header lines by
31279 routers and transports, which is not immediate, but which instead is saved up
31280 until the message is actually being written (see section
31281 &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&).
31282
31283 If the message is not delivered at the first attempt, header lines that were
31284 added by the system filter are stored with the message, and so are still
31285 present at the next delivery attempt. Header lines that were removed are still
31286 present, but marked &"deleted"& so that they are not transported with the
31287 message. For this reason, it is usual to make the &%headers%& command
31288 conditional on &%first_delivery%& so that the set of header lines is not
31289 modified more than once.
31290
31291 Because header modification in a system filter acts immediately, you have to
31292 use an indirect approach if you want to modify the contents of a header line.
31293 For example:
31294 .code
31295 headers add "Old-Subject: $h_subject:"
31296 headers remove "Subject"
31297 headers add "Subject: new subject (was: $h_old-subject:)"
31298 headers remove "Old-Subject"
31299 .endd
31300
31301
31302
31303 .section "Setting an errors address in a system filter" "SECID217"
31304 .cindex "envelope sender"
31305 In a system filter, if a &%deliver%& command is followed by
31306 .code
31307 errors_to <some address>
31308 .endd
31309 in order to change the envelope sender (and hence the error reporting) for that
31310 delivery, any address may be specified. (In a user filter, only the current
31311 user's address can be set.) For example, if some mail is being monitored, you
31312 might use
31313 .code
31314 unseen deliver monitor@spying.example errors_to root@local.example
31315 .endd
31316 to take a copy which would not be sent back to the normal error reporting
31317 address if its delivery failed.
31318
31319
31320
31321 .section "Per-address filtering" "SECTperaddfil"
31322 .vindex "&$domain$&"
31323 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
31324 In contrast to the system filter, which is run just once per message for each
31325 delivery attempt, it is also possible to set up a system-wide filtering
31326 operation that runs once for each recipient address. In this case, variables
31327 such as &$local_part$& and &$domain$& can be used, and indeed, the choice of
31328 filter file could be made dependent on them. This is an example of a router
31329 which implements such a filter:
31330 .code
31331 central_filter:
31332 check_local_user
31333 driver = redirect
31334 domains = +local_domains
31335 file = /central/filters/$local_part
31336 no_verify
31337 allow_filter
31338 allow_freeze
31339 .endd
31340 The filter is run in a separate process under its own uid. Therefore, either
31341 &%check_local_user%& must be set (as above), in which case the filter is run as
31342 the local user, or the &%user%& option must be used to specify which user to
31343 use. If both are set, &%user%& overrides.
31344
31345 Care should be taken to ensure that none of the commands in the filter file
31346 specify a significant delivery if the message is to go on to be delivered to
31347 its intended recipient. The router will not then claim to have dealt with the
31348 address, so it will be passed on to subsequent routers to be delivered in the
31349 normal way.
31350 .ecindex IIDsysfil1
31351 .ecindex IIDsysfil2
31352 .ecindex IIDsysfil3
31353
31354
31355
31356
31357
31358
31359 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
31360 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
31361
31362 .chapter "Message processing" "CHAPmsgproc"
31363 .scindex IIDmesproc "message" "general processing"
31364 Exim performs various transformations on the sender and recipient addresses of
31365 all messages that it handles, and also on the messages' header lines. Some of
31366 these are optional and configurable, while others always take place. All of
31367 this processing, except rewriting as a result of routing, and the addition or
31368 removal of header lines while delivering, happens when a message is received,
31369 before it is placed on Exim's queue.
31370
31371 Some of the automatic processing takes place by default only for
31372 &"locally-originated"& messages. This adjective is used to describe messages
31373 that are not received over TCP/IP, but instead are passed to an Exim process on
31374 its standard input. This includes the interactive &"local SMTP"& case that is
31375 set up by the &%-bs%& command line option.
31376
31377 &*Note*&: Messages received over TCP/IP on the loopback interface (127.0.0.1
31378 or ::1) are not considered to be locally-originated. Exim does not treat the
31379 loopback interface specially in any way.
31380
31381 If you want the loopback interface to be treated specially, you must ensure
31382 that there are appropriate entries in your ACLs.
31383
31384
31385
31386
31387 .section "Submission mode for non-local messages" "SECTsubmodnon"
31388 .cindex "message" "submission"
31389 .cindex "submission mode"
31390 Processing that happens automatically for locally-originated messages (unless
31391 &%suppress_local_fixups%& is set) can also be requested for messages that are
31392 received over TCP/IP. The term &"submission mode"& is used to describe this
31393 state. Submission mode is set by the modifier
31394 .code
31395 control = submission
31396 .endd
31397 in a MAIL, RCPT, or pre-data ACL for an incoming message (see sections
31398 &<<SECTACLmodi>>& and &<<SECTcontrols>>&). This makes Exim treat the message as
31399 a local submission, and is normally used when the source of the message is
31400 known to be an MUA running on a client host (as opposed to an MTA). For
31401 example, to set submission mode for messages originating on the IPv4 loopback
31402 interface, you could include the following in the MAIL ACL:
31403 .code
31404 warn hosts = 127.0.0.1
31405 control = submission
31406 .endd
31407 .cindex "&%sender_retain%& submission option"
31408 There are some options that can be used when setting submission mode. A slash
31409 is used to separate options. For example:
31410 .code
31411 control = submission/sender_retain
31412 .endd
31413 Specifying &%sender_retain%& has the effect of setting &%local_sender_retain%&
31414 true and &%local_from_check%& false for the current incoming message. The first
31415 of these allows an existing &'Sender:'& header in the message to remain, and
31416 the second suppresses the check to ensure that &'From:'& matches the
31417 authenticated sender. With this setting, Exim still fixes up messages by adding
31418 &'Date:'& and &'Message-ID:'& header lines if they are missing, but makes no
31419 attempt to check sender authenticity in header lines.
31420
31421 When &%sender_retain%& is not set, a submission mode setting may specify a
31422 domain to be used when generating a &'From:'& or &'Sender:'& header line. For
31423 example:
31424 .code
31425 control = submission/domain=some.domain
31426 .endd
31427 The domain may be empty. How this value is used is described in sections
31428 &<<SECTthefrohea>>& and &<<SECTthesenhea>>&. There is also a &%name%& option
31429 that allows you to specify the user's full name for inclusion in a created
31430 &'Sender:'& or &'From:'& header line. For example:
31431 .code
31432 accept authenticated = *
31433 control = submission/domain=wonderland.example/\
31434 name=${lookup {$authenticated_id} \
31435 lsearch {/etc/exim/namelist}}
31436 .endd
31437 Because the name may contain any characters, including slashes, the &%name%&
31438 option must be given last. The remainder of the string is used as the name. For
31439 the example above, if &_/etc/exim/namelist_& contains:
31440 .code
31441 bigegg: Humpty Dumpty
31442 .endd
31443 then when the sender has authenticated as &'bigegg'&, the generated &'Sender:'&
31444 line would be:
31445 .code
31446 Sender: Humpty Dumpty <bigegg@wonderland.example>
31447 .endd
31448 .cindex "return path" "in submission mode"
31449 By default, submission mode forces the return path to the same address as is
31450 used to create the &'Sender:'& header. However, if &%sender_retain%& is
31451 specified, the return path is also left unchanged.
31452
31453 &*Note*&: The changes caused by submission mode take effect after the predata
31454 ACL. This means that any sender checks performed before the fix-ups use the
31455 untrusted sender address specified by the user, not the trusted sender address
31456 specified by submission mode. Although this might be slightly unexpected, it
31457 does mean that you can configure ACL checks to spot that a user is trying to
31458 spoof another's address.
31459
31460 .section "Line endings" "SECTlineendings"
31461 .cindex "line endings"
31462 .cindex "carriage return"
31463 .cindex "linefeed"
31464 RFC 2821 specifies that CRLF (two characters: carriage-return, followed by
31465 linefeed) is the line ending for messages transmitted over the Internet using
31466 SMTP over TCP/IP. However, within individual operating systems, different
31467 conventions are used. For example, Unix-like systems use just LF, but others
31468 use CRLF or just CR.
31469
31470 Exim was designed for Unix-like systems, and internally, it stores messages
31471 using the system's convention of a single LF as a line terminator. When
31472 receiving a message, all line endings are translated to this standard format.
31473 Originally, it was thought that programs that passed messages directly to an
31474 MTA within an operating system would use that system's convention. Experience
31475 has shown that this is not the case; for example, there are Unix applications
31476 that use CRLF in this circumstance. For this reason, and for compatibility with
31477 other MTAs, the way Exim handles line endings for all messages is now as
31478 follows:
31479
31480 .ilist
31481 LF not preceded by CR is treated as a line ending.
31482 .next
31483 CR is treated as a line ending; if it is immediately followed by LF, the LF
31484 is ignored.
31485 .next
31486 The sequence &"CR, dot, CR"& does not terminate an incoming SMTP message,
31487 nor a local message in the state where a line containing only a dot is a
31488 terminator.
31489 .next
31490 If a bare CR is encountered within a header line, an extra space is added after
31491 the line terminator so as not to end the header line. The reasoning behind this
31492 is that bare CRs in header lines are most likely either to be mistakes, or
31493 people trying to play silly games.
31494 .next
31495 If the first header line received in a message ends with CRLF, a subsequent
31496 bare LF in a header line is treated in the same way as a bare CR in a header
31497 line.
31498 .endlist
31499
31500
31501
31502
31503
31504 .section "Unqualified addresses" "SECID218"
31505 .cindex "unqualified addresses"
31506 .cindex "address" "qualification"
31507 By default, Exim expects every envelope address it receives from an external
31508 host to be fully qualified. Unqualified addresses cause negative responses to
31509 SMTP commands. However, because SMTP is used as a means of transporting
31510 messages from MUAs running on personal workstations, there is sometimes a
31511 requirement to accept unqualified addresses from specific hosts or IP networks.
31512
31513 Exim has two options that separately control which hosts may send unqualified
31514 sender or recipient addresses in SMTP commands, namely
31515 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& and &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&. In both
31516 cases, if an unqualified address is accepted, it is qualified by adding the
31517 value of &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate.
31518
31519 .oindex "&%qualify_domain%&"
31520 .oindex "&%qualify_recipient%&"
31521 Unqualified addresses in header lines are automatically qualified for messages
31522 that are locally originated, unless the &%-bnq%& option is given on the command
31523 line. For messages received over SMTP, unqualified addresses in header lines
31524 are qualified only if unqualified addresses are permitted in SMTP commands. In
31525 other words, such qualification is also controlled by
31526 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& and &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&,
31527
31528
31529
31530
31531 .section "The UUCP From line" "SECID219"
31532 .cindex "&""From""& line"
31533 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
31534 .cindex "sender" "address"
31535 .oindex "&%uucp_from_pattern%&"
31536 .oindex "&%uucp_from_sender%&"
31537 .cindex "envelope sender"
31538 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
31539 Messages that have come from UUCP (and some other applications) often begin
31540 with a line containing the envelope sender and a timestamp, following the word
31541 &"From"&. Examples of two common formats are:
31542 .code
31543 From a.oakley@berlin.mus Fri Jan 5 12:35 GMT 1996
31544 From f.butler@berlin.mus Fri, 7 Jan 97 14:00:00 GMT
31545 .endd
31546 This line precedes the RFC 2822 header lines. For compatibility with Sendmail,
31547 Exim recognizes such lines at the start of messages that are submitted to it
31548 via the command line (that is, on the standard input). It does not recognize
31549 such lines in incoming SMTP messages, unless the sending host matches
31550 &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& or the &%-bs%& option was used for a local message
31551 and &%ignore_fromline_local%& is set. The recognition is controlled by a
31552 regular expression that is defined by the &%uucp_from_pattern%& option, whose
31553 default value matches the two common cases shown above and puts the address
31554 that follows &"From"& into &$1$&.
31555
31556 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &""From ""& line handling"
31557 When the caller of Exim for a non-SMTP message that contains a &"From"& line is
31558 a trusted user, the message's sender address is constructed by expanding the
31559 contents of &%uucp_sender_address%&, whose default value is &"$1"&. This is
31560 then parsed as an RFC 2822 address. If there is no domain, the local part is
31561 qualified with &%qualify_domain%& unless it is the empty string. However, if
31562 the command line &%-f%& option is used, it overrides the &"From"& line.
31563
31564 If the caller of Exim is not trusted, the &"From"& line is recognized, but the
31565 sender address is not changed. This is also the case for incoming SMTP messages
31566 that are permitted to contain &"From"& lines.
31567
31568 Only one &"From"& line is recognized. If there is more than one, the second is
31569 treated as a data line that starts the body of the message, as it is not valid
31570 as a header line. This also happens if a &"From"& line is present in an
31571 incoming SMTP message from a source that is not permitted to send them.
31572
31573
31574
31575 .section "Resent- header lines" "SECID220"
31576 .cindex "&%Resent-%& header lines"
31577 RFC 2822 makes provision for sets of header lines starting with the string
31578 &`Resent-`& to be added to a message when it is resent by the original
31579 recipient to somebody else. These headers are &'Resent-Date:'&,
31580 &'Resent-From:'&, &'Resent-Sender:'&, &'Resent-To:'&, &'Resent-Cc:'&,
31581 &'Resent-Bcc:'& and &'Resent-Message-ID:'&. The RFC says:
31582
31583 .blockquote
31584 &'Resent fields are strictly informational. They MUST NOT be used in the normal
31585 processing of replies or other such automatic actions on messages.'&
31586 .endblockquote
31587
31588 This leaves things a bit vague as far as other processing actions such as
31589 address rewriting are concerned. Exim treats &%Resent-%& header lines as
31590 follows:
31591
31592 .ilist
31593 A &'Resent-From:'& line that just contains the login id of the submitting user
31594 is automatically rewritten in the same way as &'From:'& (see below).
31595 .next
31596 If there's a rewriting rule for a particular header line, it is also applied to
31597 &%Resent-%& header lines of the same type. For example, a rule that rewrites
31598 &'From:'& also rewrites &'Resent-From:'&.
31599 .next
31600 For local messages, if &'Sender:'& is removed on input, &'Resent-Sender:'& is
31601 also removed.
31602 .next
31603 For a locally-submitted message,
31604 if there are any &%Resent-%& header lines but no &'Resent-Date:'&,
31605 &'Resent-From:'&, or &'Resent-Message-Id:'&, they are added as necessary. It is
31606 the contents of &'Resent-Message-Id:'& (rather than &'Message-Id:'&) which are
31607 included in log lines in this case.
31608 .next
31609 The logic for adding &'Sender:'& is duplicated for &'Resent-Sender:'& when any
31610 &%Resent-%& header lines are present.
31611 .endlist
31612
31613
31614
31615
31616 .section "The Auto-Submitted: header line" "SECID221"
31617 Whenever Exim generates an autoreply, a bounce, or a delay warning message, it
31618 includes the header line:
31619 .code
31620 Auto-Submitted: auto-replied
31621 .endd
31622
31623 .section "The Bcc: header line" "SECID222"
31624 .cindex "&'Bcc:'& header line"
31625 If Exim is called with the &%-t%& option, to take recipient addresses from a
31626 message's header, it removes any &'Bcc:'& header line that may exist (after
31627 extracting its addresses). If &%-t%& is not present on the command line, any
31628 existing &'Bcc:'& is not removed.
31629
31630
31631 .section "The Date: header line" "SECID223"
31632 .cindex "&'Date:'& header line"
31633 If a locally-generated or submission-mode message has no &'Date:'& header line,
31634 Exim adds one, using the current date and time, unless the
31635 &%suppress_local_fixups%& control has been specified.
31636
31637 .section "The Delivery-date: header line" "SECID224"
31638 .cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
31639 .oindex "&%delivery_date_remove%&"
31640 &'Delivery-date:'& header lines are not part of the standard RFC 2822 header
31641 set. Exim can be configured to add them to the final delivery of messages. (See
31642 the generic &%delivery_date_add%& transport option.) They should not be present
31643 in messages in transit. If the &%delivery_date_remove%& configuration option is
31644 set (the default), Exim removes &'Delivery-date:'& header lines from incoming
31645 messages.
31646
31647
31648 .section "The Envelope-to: header line" "SECID225"
31649 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
31650 .oindex "&%envelope_to_remove%&"
31651 &'Envelope-to:'& header lines are not part of the standard RFC 2822 header set.
31652 Exim can be configured to add them to the final delivery of messages. (See the
31653 generic &%envelope_to_add%& transport option.) They should not be present in
31654 messages in transit. If the &%envelope_to_remove%& configuration option is set
31655 (the default), Exim removes &'Envelope-to:'& header lines from incoming
31656 messages.
31657
31658
31659 .section "The From: header line" "SECTthefrohea"
31660 .cindex "&'From:'& header line"
31661 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
31662 .cindex "message" "submission"
31663 .cindex "submission mode"
31664 If a submission-mode message does not contain a &'From:'& header line, Exim
31665 adds one if either of the following conditions is true:
31666
31667 .ilist
31668 The envelope sender address is not empty (that is, this is not a bounce
31669 message). The added header line copies the envelope sender address.
31670 .next
31671 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
31672 The SMTP session is authenticated and &$authenticated_id$& is not empty.
31673 .olist
31674 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
31675 If no domain is specified by the submission control, the local part is
31676 &$authenticated_id$& and the domain is &$qualify_domain$&.
31677 .next
31678 If a non-empty domain is specified by the submission control, the local
31679 part is &$authenticated_id$&, and the domain is the specified domain.
31680 .next
31681 If an empty domain is specified by the submission control,
31682 &$authenticated_id$& is assumed to be the complete address.
31683 .endlist
31684 .endlist
31685
31686 A non-empty envelope sender takes precedence.
31687
31688 If a locally-generated incoming message does not contain a &'From:'& header
31689 line, and the &%suppress_local_fixups%& control is not set, Exim adds one
31690 containing the sender's address. The calling user's login name and full name
31691 are used to construct the address, as described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&.
31692 They are obtained from the password data by calling &[getpwuid()]& (but see the
31693 &%unknown_login%& configuration option). The address is qualified with
31694 &%qualify_domain%&.
31695
31696 For compatibility with Sendmail, if an incoming, non-SMTP message has a
31697 &'From:'& header line containing just the unqualified login name of the calling
31698 user, this is replaced by an address containing the user's login name and full
31699 name as described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&.
31700
31701
31702 .section "The Message-ID: header line" "SECID226"
31703 .cindex "&'Message-ID:'& header line"
31704 .cindex "message" "submission"
31705 .oindex "&%message_id_header_text%&"
31706 If a locally-generated or submission-mode incoming message does not contain a
31707 &'Message-ID:'& or &'Resent-Message-ID:'& header line, and the
31708 &%suppress_local_fixups%& control is not set, Exim adds a suitable header line
31709 to the message. If there are any &'Resent-:'& headers in the message, it
31710 creates &'Resent-Message-ID:'&. The id is constructed from Exim's internal
31711 message id, preceded by the letter E to ensure it starts with a letter, and
31712 followed by @ and the primary host name. Additional information can be included
31713 in this header line by setting the &%message_id_header_text%& and/or
31714 &%message_id_header_domain%& options.
31715
31716
31717 .section "The Received: header line" "SECID227"
31718 .cindex "&'Received:'& header line"
31719 A &'Received:'& header line is added at the start of every message. The
31720 contents are defined by the &%received_header_text%& configuration option, and
31721 Exim automatically adds a semicolon and a timestamp to the configured string.
31722
31723 The &'Received:'& header is generated as soon as the message's header lines
31724 have been received. At this stage, the timestamp in the &'Received:'& header
31725 line is the time that the message started to be received. This is the value
31726 that is seen by the DATA ACL and by the &[local_scan()]& function.
31727
31728 Once a message is accepted, the timestamp in the &'Received:'& header line is
31729 changed to the time of acceptance, which is (apart from a small delay while the
31730 -H spool file is written) the earliest time at which delivery could start.
31731
31732
31733 .section "The References: header line" "SECID228"
31734 .cindex "&'References:'& header line"
31735 Messages created by the &(autoreply)& transport include a &'References:'&
31736 header line. This is constructed according to the rules that are described in
31737 section 3.64 of RFC 2822 (which states that replies should contain such a
31738 header line), and section 3.14 of RFC 3834 (which states that automatic
31739 responses are not different in this respect). However, because some mail
31740 processing software does not cope well with very long header lines, no more
31741 than 12 message IDs are copied from the &'References:'& header line in the
31742 incoming message. If there are more than 12, the first one and then the final
31743 11 are copied, before adding the message ID of the incoming message.
31744
31745
31746
31747 .section "The Return-path: header line" "SECID229"
31748 .cindex "&'Return-path:'& header line"
31749 .oindex "&%return_path_remove%&"
31750 &'Return-path:'& header lines are defined as something an MTA may insert when
31751 it does the final delivery of messages. (See the generic &%return_path_add%&
31752 transport option.) Therefore, they should not be present in messages in
31753 transit. If the &%return_path_remove%& configuration option is set (the
31754 default), Exim removes &'Return-path:'& header lines from incoming messages.
31755
31756
31757
31758 .section "The Sender: header line" "SECTthesenhea"
31759 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line"
31760 .cindex "message" "submission"
31761 For a locally-originated message from an untrusted user, Exim may remove an
31762 existing &'Sender:'& header line, and it may add a new one. You can modify
31763 these actions by setting the &%local_sender_retain%& option true, the
31764 &%local_from_check%& option false, or by using the &%suppress_local_fixups%&
31765 control setting.
31766
31767 When a local message is received from an untrusted user and
31768 &%local_from_check%& is true (the default), and the &%suppress_local_fixups%&
31769 control has not been set, a check is made to see if the address given in the
31770 &'From:'& header line is the correct (local) sender of the message. The address
31771 that is expected has the login name as the local part and the value of
31772 &%qualify_domain%& as the domain. Prefixes and suffixes for the local part can
31773 be permitted by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%&
31774 appropriately. If &'From:'& does not contain the correct sender, a &'Sender:'&
31775 line is added to the message.
31776
31777 If you set &%local_from_check%& false, this checking does not occur. However,
31778 the removal of an existing &'Sender:'& line still happens, unless you also set
31779 &%local_sender_retain%& to be true. It is not possible to set both of these
31780 options true at the same time.
31781
31782 .cindex "submission mode"
31783 By default, no processing of &'Sender:'& header lines is done for messages
31784 received over TCP/IP or for messages submitted by trusted users. However, when
31785 a message is received over TCP/IP in submission mode, and &%sender_retain%& is
31786 not specified on the submission control, the following processing takes place:
31787
31788 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
31789 First, any existing &'Sender:'& lines are removed. Then, if the SMTP session is
31790 authenticated, and &$authenticated_id$& is not empty, a sender address is
31791 created as follows:
31792
31793 .ilist
31794 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
31795 If no domain is specified by the submission control, the local part is
31796 &$authenticated_id$& and the domain is &$qualify_domain$&.
31797 .next
31798 If a non-empty domain is specified by the submission control, the local part
31799 is &$authenticated_id$&, and the domain is the specified domain.
31800 .next
31801 If an empty domain is specified by the submission control,
31802 &$authenticated_id$& is assumed to be the complete address.
31803 .endlist
31804
31805 This address is compared with the address in the &'From:'& header line. If they
31806 are different, a &'Sender:'& header line containing the created address is
31807 added. Prefixes and suffixes for the local part in &'From:'& can be permitted
31808 by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%& appropriately.
31809
31810 .cindex "return path" "created from &'Sender:'&"
31811 &*Note*&: Whenever a &'Sender:'& header line is created, the return path for
31812 the message (the envelope sender address) is changed to be the same address,
31813 except in the case of submission mode when &%sender_retain%& is specified.
31814
31815
31816
31817 .section "Adding and removing header lines in routers and transports" &&&
31818 "SECTheadersaddrem"
31819 .cindex "header lines" "adding; in router or transport"
31820 .cindex "header lines" "removing; in router or transport"
31821 When a message is delivered, the addition and removal of header lines can be
31822 specified in a system filter, or on any of the routers and transports that
31823 process the message. Section &<<SECTaddremheasys>>& contains details about
31824 modifying headers in a system filter. Header lines can also be added in an ACL
31825 as a message is received (see section &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&).
31826
31827 In contrast to what happens in a system filter, header modifications that are
31828 specified on routers and transports apply only to the particular recipient
31829 addresses that are being processed by those routers and transports. These
31830 changes do not actually take place until a copy of the message is being
31831 transported. Therefore, they do not affect the basic set of header lines, and
31832 they do not affect the values of the variables that refer to header lines.
31833
31834 &*Note*&: In particular, this means that any expansions in the configuration of
31835 the transport cannot refer to the modified header lines, because such
31836 expansions all occur before the message is actually transported.
31837
31838 For both routers and transports, the result of expanding a &%headers_add%&
31839 option must be in the form of one or more RFC 2822 header lines, separated by
31840 newlines (coded as &"\n"&). For example:
31841 .code
31842 headers_add = X-added-header: added by $primary_hostname\n\
31843 X-added-second: another added header line
31844 .endd
31845 Exim does not check the syntax of these added header lines.
31846
31847 Multiple &%headers_add%& options for a single router or transport can be
31848 specified; the values will be concatenated (with a separating newline
31849 added) before expansion.
31850
31851 The result of expanding &%headers_remove%& must consist of a colon-separated
31852 list of header names. This is confusing, because header names themselves are
31853 often terminated by colons. In this case, the colons are the list separators,
31854 not part of the names. For example:
31855 .code
31856 headers_remove = return-receipt-to:acknowledge-to
31857 .endd
31858
31859 Multiple &%headers_remove%& options for a single router or transport can be
31860 specified; the values will be concatenated (with a separating colon
31861 added) before expansion.
31862
31863 When &%headers_add%& or &%headers_remove%& is specified on a router, its value
31864 is expanded at routing time, and then associated with all addresses that are
31865 accepted by that router, and also with any new addresses that it generates. If
31866 an address passes through several routers as a result of aliasing or
31867 forwarding, the changes are cumulative.
31868
31869 .oindex "&%unseen%&"
31870 However, this does not apply to multiple routers that result from the use of
31871 the &%unseen%& option. Any header modifications that were specified by the
31872 &"unseen"& router or its predecessors apply only to the &"unseen"& delivery.
31873
31874 Addresses that end up with different &%headers_add%& or &%headers_remove%&
31875 settings cannot be delivered together in a batch, so a transport is always
31876 dealing with a set of addresses that have the same header-processing
31877 requirements.
31878
31879 The transport starts by writing the original set of header lines that arrived
31880 with the message, possibly modified by the system filter. As it writes out
31881 these lines, it consults the list of header names that were attached to the
31882 recipient address(es) by &%headers_remove%& options in routers, and it also
31883 consults the transport's own &%headers_remove%& option. Header lines whose
31884 names are on either of these lists are not written out. If there are multiple
31885 instances of any listed header, they are all skipped.
31886
31887 After the remaining original header lines have been written, new header
31888 lines that were specified by routers' &%headers_add%& options are written, in
31889 the order in which they were attached to the address. These are followed by any
31890 header lines specified by the transport's &%headers_add%& option.
31891
31892 This way of handling header line modifications in routers and transports has
31893 the following consequences:
31894
31895 .ilist
31896 The original set of header lines, possibly modified by the system filter,
31897 remains &"visible"&, in the sense that the &$header_$&&'xxx'& variables refer
31898 to it, at all times.
31899 .next
31900 Header lines that are added by a router's
31901 &%headers_add%& option are not accessible by means of the &$header_$&&'xxx'&
31902 expansion syntax in subsequent routers or the transport.
31903 .next
31904 Conversely, header lines that are specified for removal by &%headers_remove%&
31905 in a router remain visible to subsequent routers and the transport.
31906 .next
31907 Headers added to an address by &%headers_add%& in a router cannot be removed by
31908 a later router or by a transport.
31909 .next
31910 An added header can refer to the contents of an original header that is to be
31911 removed, even it has the same name as the added header. For example:
31912 .code
31913 headers_remove = subject
31914 headers_add = Subject: new subject (was: $h_subject:)
31915 .endd
31916 .endlist
31917
31918 &*Warning*&: The &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& options cannot be used
31919 for a &(redirect)& router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
31920
31921
31922
31923
31924
31925 .section "Constructed addresses" "SECTconstr"
31926 .cindex "address" "constructed"
31927 .cindex "constructed address"
31928 When Exim constructs a sender address for a locally-generated message, it uses
31929 the form
31930 .display
31931 <&'user name'&>&~&~<&'login'&&`@`&&'qualify_domain'&>
31932 .endd
31933 For example:
31934 .code
31935 Zaphod Beeblebrox <zaphod@end.univ.example>
31936 .endd
31937 The user name is obtained from the &%-F%& command line option if set, or
31938 otherwise by looking up the calling user by &[getpwuid()]& and extracting the
31939 &"gecos"& field from the password entry. If the &"gecos"& field contains an
31940 ampersand character, this is replaced by the login name with the first letter
31941 upper cased, as is conventional in a number of operating systems. See the
31942 &%gecos_name%& option for a way to tailor the handling of the &"gecos"& field.
31943 The &%unknown_username%& option can be used to specify user names in cases when
31944 there is no password file entry.
31945
31946 .cindex "RFC 2047"
31947 In all cases, the user name is made to conform to RFC 2822 by quoting all or
31948 parts of it if necessary. In addition, if it contains any non-printing
31949 characters, it is encoded as described in RFC 2047, which defines a way of
31950 including non-ASCII characters in header lines. The value of the
31951 &%headers_charset%& option specifies the name of the encoding that is used (the
31952 characters are assumed to be in this encoding). The setting of
31953 &%print_topbitchars%& controls whether characters with the top bit set (that
31954 is, with codes greater than 127) count as printing characters or not.
31955
31956
31957
31958 .section "Case of local parts" "SECID230"
31959 .cindex "case of local parts"
31960 .cindex "local part" "case of"
31961 RFC 2822 states that the case of letters in the local parts of addresses cannot
31962 be assumed to be non-significant. Exim preserves the case of local parts of
31963 addresses, but by default it uses a lower-cased form when it is routing,
31964 because on most Unix systems, usernames are in lower case and case-insensitive
31965 routing is required. However, any particular router can be made to use the
31966 original case for local parts by setting the &%caseful_local_part%& generic
31967 router option.
31968
31969 .cindex "mixed-case login names"
31970 If you must have mixed-case user names on your system, the best way to proceed,
31971 assuming you want case-independent handling of incoming email, is to set up
31972 your first router to convert incoming local parts in your domains to the
31973 correct case by means of a file lookup. For example:
31974 .code
31975 correct_case:
31976 driver = redirect
31977 domains = +local_domains
31978 data = ${lookup{$local_part}cdb\
31979 {/etc/usercased.cdb}{$value}fail}\
31980 @$domain
31981 .endd
31982 For this router, the local part is forced to lower case by the default action
31983 (&%caseful_local_part%& is not set). The lower-cased local part is used to look
31984 up a new local part in the correct case. If you then set &%caseful_local_part%&
31985 on any subsequent routers which process your domains, they will operate on
31986 local parts with the correct case in a case-sensitive manner.
31987
31988
31989
31990 .section "Dots in local parts" "SECID231"
31991 .cindex "dot" "in local part"
31992 .cindex "local part" "dots in"
31993 RFC 2822 forbids empty components in local parts. That is, an unquoted local
31994 part may not begin or end with a dot, nor have two consecutive dots in the
31995 middle. However, it seems that many MTAs do not enforce this, so Exim permits
31996 empty components for compatibility.
31997
31998
31999
32000 .section "Rewriting addresses" "SECID232"
32001 .cindex "rewriting" "addresses"
32002 Rewriting of sender and recipient addresses, and addresses in headers, can
32003 happen automatically, or as the result of configuration options, as described
32004 in chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&. The headers that may be affected by this are
32005 &'Bcc:'&, &'Cc:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, &'Sender:'&, and &'To:'&.
32006
32007 Automatic rewriting includes qualification, as mentioned above. The other case
32008 in which it can happen is when an incomplete non-local domain is given. The
32009 routing process may cause this to be expanded into the full domain name. For
32010 example, a header such as
32011 .code
32012 To: hare@teaparty
32013 .endd
32014 might get rewritten as
32015 .code
32016 To: hare@teaparty.wonderland.fict.example
32017 .endd
32018 Rewriting as a result of routing is the one kind of message processing that
32019 does not happen at input time, as it cannot be done until the address has
32020 been routed.
32021
32022 Strictly, one should not do &'any'& deliveries of a message until all its
32023 addresses have been routed, in case any of the headers get changed as a
32024 result of routing. However, doing this in practice would hold up many
32025 deliveries for unreasonable amounts of time, just because one address could not
32026 immediately be routed. Exim therefore does not delay other deliveries when
32027 routing of one or more addresses is deferred.
32028 .ecindex IIDmesproc
32029
32030
32031
32032 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
32033 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
32034
32035 .chapter "SMTP processing" "CHAPSMTP"
32036 .scindex IIDsmtpproc1 "SMTP" "processing details"
32037 .scindex IIDsmtpproc2 "LMTP" "processing details"
32038 Exim supports a number of different ways of using the SMTP protocol, and its
32039 LMTP variant, which is an interactive protocol for transferring messages into a
32040 closed mail store application. This chapter contains details of how SMTP is
32041 processed. For incoming mail, the following are available:
32042
32043 .ilist
32044 SMTP over TCP/IP (Exim daemon or &'inetd'&);
32045 .next
32046 SMTP over the standard input and output (the &%-bs%& option);
32047 .next
32048 Batched SMTP on the standard input (the &%-bS%& option).
32049 .endlist
32050
32051 For mail delivery, the following are available:
32052
32053 .ilist
32054 SMTP over TCP/IP (the &(smtp)& transport);
32055 .next
32056 LMTP over TCP/IP (the &(smtp)& transport with the &%protocol%& option set to
32057 &"lmtp"&);
32058 .next
32059 LMTP over a pipe to a process running in the local host (the &(lmtp)&
32060 transport);
32061 .next
32062 Batched SMTP to a file or pipe (the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports with
32063 the &%use_bsmtp%& option set).
32064 .endlist
32065
32066 &'Batched SMTP'& is the name for a process in which batches of messages are
32067 stored in or read from files (or pipes), in a format in which SMTP commands are
32068 used to contain the envelope information.
32069
32070
32071
32072 .section "Outgoing SMTP and LMTP over TCP/IP" "SECToutSMTPTCP"
32073 .cindex "SMTP" "outgoing over TCP/IP"
32074 .cindex "outgoing SMTP over TCP/IP"
32075 .cindex "LMTP" "over TCP/IP"
32076 .cindex "outgoing LMTP over TCP/IP"
32077 .cindex "EHLO"
32078 .cindex "HELO"
32079 .cindex "SIZE option on MAIL command"
32080 Outgoing SMTP and LMTP over TCP/IP is implemented by the &(smtp)& transport.
32081 The &%protocol%& option selects which protocol is to be used, but the actual
32082 processing is the same in both cases.
32083
32084 If, in response to its EHLO command, Exim is told that the SIZE
32085 parameter is supported, it adds SIZE=<&'n'&> to each subsequent MAIL
32086 command. The value of <&'n'&> is the message size plus the value of the
32087 &%size_addition%& option (default 1024) to allow for additions to the message
32088 such as per-transport header lines, or changes made in a
32089 .cindex "transport" "filter"
32090 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
32091 transport filter. If &%size_addition%& is set negative, the use of SIZE is
32092 suppressed.
32093
32094 If the remote server advertises support for PIPELINING, Exim uses the
32095 pipelining extension to SMTP (RFC 2197) to reduce the number of TCP/IP packets
32096 required for the transaction.
32097
32098 If the remote server advertises support for the STARTTLS command, and Exim
32099 was built to support TLS encryption, it tries to start a TLS session unless the
32100 server matches &%hosts_avoid_tls%&. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for more details.
32101 Either a match in that or &%hosts_verify_avoid_tls%& apply when the transport
32102 is called for verification.
32103
32104 If the remote server advertises support for the AUTH command, Exim scans
32105 the authenticators configuration for any suitable client settings, as described
32106 in chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&.
32107
32108 .cindex "carriage return"
32109 .cindex "linefeed"
32110 Responses from the remote host are supposed to be terminated by CR followed by
32111 LF. However, there are known to be hosts that do not send CR characters, so in
32112 order to be able to interwork with such hosts, Exim treats LF on its own as a
32113 line terminator.
32114
32115 If a message contains a number of different addresses, all those with the same
32116 characteristics (for example, the same envelope sender) that resolve to the
32117 same set of hosts, in the same order, are sent in a single SMTP transaction,
32118 even if they are for different domains, unless there are more than the setting
32119 of the &%max_rcpt%&s option in the &(smtp)& transport allows, in which case
32120 they are split into groups containing no more than &%max_rcpt%&s addresses
32121 each. If &%remote_max_parallel%& is greater than one, such groups may be sent
32122 in parallel sessions. The order of hosts with identical MX values is not
32123 significant when checking whether addresses can be batched in this way.
32124
32125 When the &(smtp)& transport suffers a temporary failure that is not
32126 message-related, Exim updates its transport-specific database, which contains
32127 records indexed by host name that remember which messages are waiting for each
32128 particular host. It also updates the retry database with new retry times.
32129
32130 .cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
32131 Exim's retry hints are based on host name plus IP address, so if one address of
32132 a multi-homed host is broken, it will soon be skipped most of the time.
32133 See the next section for more detail about error handling.
32134
32135 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
32136 .cindex "SMTP" "batching over TCP/IP"
32137 When a message is successfully delivered over a TCP/IP SMTP connection, Exim
32138 looks in the hints database for the transport to see if there are any queued
32139 messages waiting for the host to which it is connected. If it finds one, it
32140 creates a new Exim process using the &%-MC%& option (which can only be used by
32141 a process running as root or the Exim user) and passes the TCP/IP socket to it
32142 so that it can deliver another message using the same socket. The new process
32143 does only those deliveries that are routed to the connected host, and may in
32144 turn pass the socket on to a third process, and so on.
32145
32146 The &%connection_max_messages%& option of the &(smtp)& transport can be used to
32147 limit the number of messages sent down a single TCP/IP connection.
32148
32149 .cindex "asterisk" "after IP address"
32150 The second and subsequent messages delivered down an existing connection are
32151 identified in the main log by the addition of an asterisk after the closing
32152 square bracket of the IP address.
32153
32154
32155
32156
32157 .section "Errors in outgoing SMTP" "SECToutSMTPerr"
32158 .cindex "error" "in outgoing SMTP"
32159 .cindex "SMTP" "errors in outgoing"
32160 .cindex "host" "error"
32161 Three different kinds of error are recognized for outgoing SMTP: host errors,
32162 message errors, and recipient errors.
32163
32164 .vlist
32165 .vitem "&*Host errors*&"
32166 A host error is not associated with a particular message or with a
32167 particular recipient of a message. The host errors are:
32168
32169 .ilist
32170 Connection refused or timed out,
32171 .next
32172 Any error response code on connection,
32173 .next
32174 Any error response code to EHLO or HELO,
32175 .next
32176 Loss of connection at any time, except after &"."&,
32177 .next
32178 I/O errors at any time,
32179 .next
32180 Timeouts during the session, other than in response to MAIL, RCPT or
32181 the &"."& at the end of the data.
32182 .endlist ilist
32183
32184 For a host error, a permanent error response on connection, or in response to
32185 EHLO, causes all addresses routed to the host to be failed. Any other host
32186 error causes all addresses to be deferred, and retry data to be created for the
32187 host. It is not tried again, for any message, until its retry time arrives. If
32188 the current set of addresses are not all delivered in this run (to some
32189 alternative host), the message is added to the list of those waiting for this
32190 host, so if it is still undelivered when a subsequent successful delivery is
32191 made to the host, it will be sent down the same SMTP connection.
32192
32193 .vitem "&*Message errors*&"
32194 .cindex "message" "error"
32195 A message error is associated with a particular message when sent to a
32196 particular host, but not with a particular recipient of the message. The
32197 message errors are:
32198
32199 .ilist
32200 Any error response code to MAIL, DATA, or the &"."& that terminates
32201 the data,
32202 .next
32203 Timeout after MAIL,
32204 .next
32205 Timeout or loss of connection after the &"."& that terminates the data. A
32206 timeout after the DATA command itself is treated as a host error, as is loss of
32207 connection at any other time.
32208 .endlist ilist
32209
32210 For a message error, a permanent error response (5&'xx'&) causes all addresses
32211 to be failed, and a delivery error report to be returned to the sender. A
32212 temporary error response (4&'xx'&), or one of the timeouts, causes all
32213 addresses to be deferred. Retry data is not created for the host, but instead,
32214 a retry record for the combination of host plus message id is created. The
32215 message is not added to the list of those waiting for this host. This ensures
32216 that the failing message will not be sent to this host again until the retry
32217 time arrives. However, other messages that are routed to the host are not
32218 affected, so if it is some property of the message that is causing the error,
32219 it will not stop the delivery of other mail.
32220
32221 If the remote host specified support for the SIZE parameter in its response
32222 to EHLO, Exim adds SIZE=&'nnn'& to the MAIL command, so an
32223 over-large message will cause a message error because the error arrives as a
32224 response to MAIL.
32225
32226 .vitem "&*Recipient errors*&"
32227 .cindex "recipient" "error"
32228 A recipient error is associated with a particular recipient of a message. The
32229 recipient errors are:
32230
32231 .ilist
32232 Any error response to RCPT,
32233 .next
32234 Timeout after RCPT.
32235 .endlist
32236
32237 For a recipient error, a permanent error response (5&'xx'&) causes the
32238 recipient address to be failed, and a bounce message to be returned to the
32239 sender. A temporary error response (4&'xx'&) or a timeout causes the failing
32240 address to be deferred, and routing retry data to be created for it. This is
32241 used to delay processing of the address in subsequent queue runs, until its
32242 routing retry time arrives. This applies to all messages, but because it
32243 operates only in queue runs, one attempt will be made to deliver a new message
32244 to the failing address before the delay starts to operate. This ensures that,
32245 if the failure is really related to the message rather than the recipient
32246 (&"message too big for this recipient"& is a possible example), other messages
32247 have a chance of getting delivered. If a delivery to the address does succeed,
32248 the retry information gets cleared, so all stuck messages get tried again, and
32249 the retry clock is reset.
32250
32251 The message is not added to the list of those waiting for this host. Use of the
32252 host for other messages is unaffected, and except in the case of a timeout,
32253 other recipients are processed independently, and may be successfully delivered
32254 in the current SMTP session. After a timeout it is of course impossible to
32255 proceed with the session, so all addresses get deferred. However, those other
32256 than the one that failed do not suffer any subsequent retry delays. Therefore,
32257 if one recipient is causing trouble, the others have a chance of getting
32258 through when a subsequent delivery attempt occurs before the failing
32259 recipient's retry time.
32260 .endlist
32261
32262 In all cases, if there are other hosts (or IP addresses) available for the
32263 current set of addresses (for example, from multiple MX records), they are
32264 tried in this run for any undelivered addresses, subject of course to their
32265 own retry data. In other words, recipient error retry data does not take effect
32266 until the next delivery attempt.
32267
32268 Some hosts have been observed to give temporary error responses to every
32269 MAIL command at certain times (&"insufficient space"& has been seen). It
32270 would be nice if such circumstances could be recognized, and defer data for the
32271 host itself created, but this is not possible within the current Exim design.
32272 What actually happens is that retry data for every (host, message) combination
32273 is created.
32274
32275 The reason that timeouts after MAIL and RCPT are treated specially is that
32276 these can sometimes arise as a result of the remote host's verification
32277 procedures. Exim makes this assumption, and treats them as if a temporary error
32278 response had been received. A timeout after &"."& is treated specially because
32279 it is known that some broken implementations fail to recognize the end of the
32280 message if the last character of the last line is a binary zero. Thus, it is
32281 helpful to treat this case as a message error.
32282
32283 Timeouts at other times are treated as host errors, assuming a problem with the
32284 host, or the connection to it. If a timeout after MAIL, RCPT,
32285 or &"."& is really a connection problem, the assumption is that at the next try
32286 the timeout is likely to occur at some other point in the dialogue, causing it
32287 then to be treated as a host error.
32288
32289 There is experimental evidence that some MTAs drop the connection after the
32290 terminating &"."& if they do not like the contents of the message for some
32291 reason, in contravention of the RFC, which indicates that a 5&'xx'& response
32292 should be given. That is why Exim treats this case as a message rather than a
32293 host error, in order not to delay other messages to the same host.
32294
32295
32296
32297
32298 .section "Incoming SMTP messages over TCP/IP" "SECID233"
32299 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming over TCP/IP"
32300 .cindex "incoming SMTP over TCP/IP"
32301 .cindex "inetd"
32302 .cindex "daemon"
32303 Incoming SMTP messages can be accepted in one of two ways: by running a
32304 listening daemon, or by using &'inetd'&. In the latter case, the entry in
32305 &_/etc/inetd.conf_& should be like this:
32306 .code
32307 smtp stream tcp nowait exim /opt/exim/bin/exim in.exim -bs
32308 .endd
32309 Exim distinguishes between this case and the case of a locally running user
32310 agent using the &%-bs%& option by checking whether or not the standard input is
32311 a socket. When it is, either the port must be privileged (less than 1024), or
32312 the caller must be root or the Exim user. If any other user passes a socket
32313 with an unprivileged port number, Exim prints a message on the standard error
32314 stream and exits with an error code.
32315
32316 By default, Exim does not make a log entry when a remote host connects or
32317 disconnects (either via the daemon or &'inetd'&), unless the disconnection is
32318 unexpected. It can be made to write such log entries by setting the
32319 &%smtp_connection%& log selector.
32320
32321 .cindex "carriage return"
32322 .cindex "linefeed"
32323 Commands from the remote host are supposed to be terminated by CR followed by
32324 LF. However, there are known to be hosts that do not send CR characters. In
32325 order to be able to interwork with such hosts, Exim treats LF on its own as a
32326 line terminator.
32327 Furthermore, because common code is used for receiving messages from all
32328 sources, a CR on its own is also interpreted as a line terminator. However, the
32329 sequence &"CR, dot, CR"& does not terminate incoming SMTP data.
32330
32331 .cindex "EHLO" "invalid data"
32332 .cindex "HELO" "invalid data"
32333 One area that sometimes gives rise to problems concerns the EHLO or
32334 HELO commands. Some clients send syntactically invalid versions of these
32335 commands, which Exim rejects by default. (This is nothing to do with verifying
32336 the data that is sent, so &%helo_verify_hosts%& is not relevant.) You can tell
32337 Exim not to apply a syntax check by setting &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& to
32338 match the broken hosts that send invalid commands.
32339
32340 .cindex "SIZE option on MAIL command"
32341 .cindex "MAIL" "SIZE option"
32342 The amount of disk space available is checked whenever SIZE is received on
32343 a MAIL command, independently of whether &%message_size_limit%& or
32344 &%check_spool_space%& is configured, unless &%smtp_check_spool_space%& is set
32345 false. A temporary error is given if there is not enough space. If
32346 &%check_spool_space%& is set, the check is for that amount of space plus the
32347 value given with SIZE, that is, it checks that the addition of the incoming
32348 message will not reduce the space below the threshold.
32349
32350 When a message is successfully received, Exim includes the local message id in
32351 its response to the final &"."& that terminates the data. If the remote host
32352 logs this text it can help with tracing what has happened to a message.
32353
32354 The Exim daemon can limit the number of simultaneous incoming connections it is
32355 prepared to handle (see the &%smtp_accept_max%& option). It can also limit the
32356 number of simultaneous incoming connections from a single remote host (see the
32357 &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& option). Additional connection attempts are
32358 rejected using the SMTP temporary error code 421.
32359
32360 The Exim daemon does not rely on the SIGCHLD signal to detect when a
32361 subprocess has finished, as this can get lost at busy times. Instead, it looks
32362 for completed subprocesses every time it wakes up. Provided there are other
32363 things happening (new incoming calls, starts of queue runs), completed
32364 processes will be noticed and tidied away. On very quiet systems you may
32365 sometimes see a &"defunct"& Exim process hanging about. This is not a problem;
32366 it will be noticed when the daemon next wakes up.
32367
32368 When running as a daemon, Exim can reserve some SMTP slots for specific hosts,
32369 and can also be set up to reject SMTP calls from non-reserved hosts at times of
32370 high system load &-- for details see the &%smtp_accept_reserve%&,
32371 &%smtp_load_reserve%&, and &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& options. The load check
32372 applies in both the daemon and &'inetd'& cases.
32373
32374 Exim normally starts a delivery process for each message received, though this
32375 can be varied by means of the &%-odq%& command line option and the
32376 &%queue_only%&, &%queue_only_file%&, and &%queue_only_load%& options. The
32377 number of simultaneously running delivery processes started in this way from
32378 SMTP input can be limited by the &%smtp_accept_queue%& and
32379 &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& options. When either limit is reached,
32380 subsequently received messages are just put on the input queue without starting
32381 a delivery process.
32382
32383 The controls that involve counts of incoming SMTP calls (&%smtp_accept_max%&,
32384 &%smtp_accept_queue%&, &%smtp_accept_reserve%&) are not available when Exim is
32385 started up from the &'inetd'& daemon, because in that case each connection is
32386 handled by an entirely independent Exim process. Control by load average is,
32387 however, available with &'inetd'&.
32388
32389 Exim can be configured to verify addresses in incoming SMTP commands as they
32390 are received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for details. It can also be configured
32391 to rewrite addresses at this time &-- before any syntax checking is done. See
32392 section &<<SECTrewriteS>>&.
32393
32394 Exim can also be configured to limit the rate at which a client host submits
32395 MAIL and RCPT commands in a single SMTP session. See the
32396 &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& option.
32397
32398
32399
32400 .section "Unrecognized SMTP commands" "SECID234"
32401 .cindex "SMTP" "unrecognized commands"
32402 If Exim receives more than &%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& unrecognized SMTP
32403 commands during a single SMTP connection, it drops the connection after sending
32404 the error response to the last command. The default value for
32405 &%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& is 3. This is a defence against some kinds of
32406 abuse that subvert web servers into making connections to SMTP ports; in these
32407 circumstances, a number of non-SMTP lines are sent first.
32408
32409
32410 .section "Syntax and protocol errors in SMTP commands" "SECID235"
32411 .cindex "SMTP" "syntax errors"
32412 .cindex "SMTP" "protocol errors"
32413 A syntax error is detected if an SMTP command is recognized, but there is
32414 something syntactically wrong with its data, for example, a malformed email
32415 address in a RCPT command. Protocol errors include invalid command
32416 sequencing such as RCPT before MAIL. If Exim receives more than
32417 &%smtp_max_synprot_errors%& such commands during a single SMTP connection, it
32418 drops the connection after sending the error response to the last command. The
32419 default value for &%smtp_max_synprot_errors%& is 3. This is a defence against
32420 broken clients that loop sending bad commands (yes, it has been seen).
32421
32422
32423
32424 .section "Use of non-mail SMTP commands" "SECID236"
32425 .cindex "SMTP" "non-mail commands"
32426 The &"non-mail"& SMTP commands are those other than MAIL, RCPT, and
32427 DATA. Exim counts such commands, and drops the connection if there are too
32428 many of them in a single SMTP session. This action catches some
32429 denial-of-service attempts and things like repeated failing AUTHs, or a mad
32430 client looping sending EHLO. The global option &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%&
32431 defines what &"too many"& means. Its default value is 10.
32432
32433 When a new message is expected, one occurrence of RSET is not counted. This
32434 allows a client to send one RSET between messages (this is not necessary,
32435 but some clients do it). Exim also allows one uncounted occurrence of HELO
32436 or EHLO, and one occurrence of STARTTLS between messages. After
32437 starting up a TLS session, another EHLO is expected, and so it too is not
32438 counted.
32439
32440 The first occurrence of AUTH in a connection, or immediately following
32441 STARTTLS is also not counted. Otherwise, all commands other than MAIL,
32442 RCPT, DATA, and QUIT are counted.
32443
32444 You can control which hosts are subject to the limit set by
32445 &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& by setting
32446 &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%&. The default value is &`*`&, which makes
32447 the limit apply to all hosts. This option means that you can exclude any
32448 specific badly-behaved hosts that you have to live with.
32449
32450
32451
32452
32453 .section "The VRFY and EXPN commands" "SECID237"
32454 When Exim receives a VRFY or EXPN command on a TCP/IP connection, it
32455 runs the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& or &%acl_smtp_expn%& (as
32456 appropriate) in order to decide whether the command should be accepted or not.
32457 If no ACL is defined, the command is rejected.
32458
32459 .cindex "VRFY" "processing"
32460 When VRFY is accepted, it runs exactly the same code as when Exim is
32461 called with the &%-bv%& option.
32462
32463 .cindex "EXPN" "processing"
32464 When EXPN is accepted, a single-level expansion of the address is done.
32465 EXPN is treated as an &"address test"& (similar to the &%-bt%& option) rather
32466 than a verification (the &%-bv%& option). If an unqualified local part is given
32467 as the argument to EXPN, it is qualified with &%qualify_domain%&. Rejections
32468 of VRFY and EXPN commands are logged on the main and reject logs, and
32469 VRFY verification failures are logged on the main log for consistency with
32470 RCPT failures.
32471
32472
32473
32474 .section "The ETRN command" "SECTETRN"
32475 .cindex "ETRN" "processing"
32476 RFC 1985 describes an SMTP command called ETRN that is designed to
32477 overcome the security problems of the TURN command (which has fallen into
32478 disuse). When Exim receives an ETRN command on a TCP/IP connection, it runs
32479 the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_etrn%& in order to decide whether the command
32480 should be accepted or not. If no ACL is defined, the command is rejected.
32481
32482 The ETRN command is concerned with &"releasing"& messages that are awaiting
32483 delivery to certain hosts. As Exim does not organize its message queue by host,
32484 the only form of ETRN that is supported by default is the one where the
32485 text starts with the &"#"& prefix, in which case the remainder of the text is
32486 specific to the SMTP server. A valid ETRN command causes a run of Exim with
32487 the &%-R%& option to happen, with the remainder of the ETRN text as its
32488 argument. For example,
32489 .code
32490 ETRN #brigadoon
32491 .endd
32492 runs the command
32493 .code
32494 exim -R brigadoon
32495 .endd
32496 which causes a delivery attempt on all messages with undelivered addresses
32497 containing the text &"brigadoon"&. When &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& is set (the
32498 default), Exim prevents the simultaneous execution of more than one queue run
32499 for the same argument string as a result of an ETRN command. This stops
32500 a misbehaving client from starting more than one queue runner at once.
32501
32502 .cindex "hints database" "ETRN serialization"
32503 Exim implements the serialization by means of a hints database in which a
32504 record is written whenever a process is started by ETRN, and deleted when
32505 the process completes. However, Exim does not keep the SMTP session waiting for
32506 the ETRN process to complete. Once ETRN is accepted, the client is sent
32507 a &"success"& return code. Obviously there is scope for hints records to get
32508 left lying around if there is a system or program crash. To guard against this,
32509 Exim ignores any records that are more than six hours old.
32510
32511 .oindex "&%smtp_etrn_command%&"
32512 For more control over what ETRN does, the &%smtp_etrn_command%& option can
32513 used. This specifies a command that is run whenever ETRN is received,
32514 whatever the form of its argument. For
32515 example:
32516 .code
32517 smtp_etrn_command = /etc/etrn_command $domain \
32518 $sender_host_address
32519 .endd
32520 .vindex "&$domain$&"
32521 The string is split up into arguments which are independently expanded. The
32522 expansion variable &$domain$& is set to the argument of the ETRN command,
32523 and no syntax checking is done on the contents of this argument. Exim does not
32524 wait for the command to complete, so its status code is not checked. Exim runs
32525 under its own uid and gid when receiving incoming SMTP, so it is not possible
32526 for it to change them before running the command.
32527
32528
32529
32530 .section "Incoming local SMTP" "SECID238"
32531 .cindex "SMTP" "local incoming"
32532 Some user agents use SMTP to pass messages to their local MTA using the
32533 standard input and output, as opposed to passing the envelope on the command
32534 line and writing the message to the standard input. This is supported by the
32535 &%-bs%& option. This form of SMTP is handled in the same way as incoming
32536 messages over TCP/IP (including the use of ACLs), except that the envelope
32537 sender given in a MAIL command is ignored unless the caller is trusted. In
32538 an ACL you can detect this form of SMTP input by testing for an empty host
32539 identification. It is common to have this as the first line in the ACL that
32540 runs for RCPT commands:
32541 .code
32542 accept hosts = :
32543 .endd
32544 This accepts SMTP messages from local processes without doing any other tests.
32545
32546
32547
32548 .section "Outgoing batched SMTP" "SECTbatchSMTP"
32549 .cindex "SMTP" "batched outgoing"
32550 .cindex "batched SMTP output"
32551 Both the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports can be used for handling
32552 batched SMTP. Each has an option called &%use_bsmtp%& which causes messages to
32553 be output in BSMTP format. No SMTP responses are possible for this form of
32554 delivery. All it is doing is using SMTP commands as a way of transmitting the
32555 envelope along with the message.
32556
32557 The message is written to the file or pipe preceded by the SMTP commands
32558 MAIL and RCPT, and followed by a line containing a single dot. Lines in
32559 the message that start with a dot have an extra dot added. The SMTP command
32560 HELO is not normally used. If it is required, the &%message_prefix%& option
32561 can be used to specify it.
32562
32563 Because &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& are both local transports, they accept only
32564 one recipient address at a time by default. However, you can arrange for them
32565 to handle several addresses at once by setting the &%batch_max%& option. When
32566 this is done for BSMTP, messages may contain multiple RCPT commands. See
32567 chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>& for more details.
32568
32569 .vindex "&$host$&"
32570 When one or more addresses are routed to a BSMTP transport by a router that
32571 sets up a host list, the name of the first host on the list is available to the
32572 transport in the variable &$host$&. Here is an example of such a transport and
32573 router:
32574 .code
32575 begin routers
32576 route_append:
32577 driver = manualroute
32578 transport = smtp_appendfile
32579 route_list = domain.example batch.host.example
32580
32581 begin transports
32582 smtp_appendfile:
32583 driver = appendfile
32584 directory = /var/bsmtp/$host
32585 batch_max = 1000
32586 use_bsmtp
32587 user = exim
32588 .endd
32589 This causes messages addressed to &'domain.example'& to be written in BSMTP
32590 format to &_/var/bsmtp/batch.host.example_&, with only a single copy of each
32591 message (unless there are more than 1000 recipients).
32592
32593
32594
32595 .section "Incoming batched SMTP" "SECTincomingbatchedSMTP"
32596 .cindex "SMTP" "batched incoming"
32597 .cindex "batched SMTP input"
32598 The &%-bS%& command line option causes Exim to accept one or more messages by
32599 reading SMTP on the standard input, but to generate no responses. If the caller
32600 is trusted, the senders in the MAIL commands are believed; otherwise the
32601 sender is always the caller of Exim. Unqualified senders and receivers are not
32602 rejected (there seems little point) but instead just get qualified. HELO
32603 and EHLO act as RSET; VRFY, EXPN, ETRN and HELP, act
32604 as NOOP; QUIT quits.
32605
32606 Minimal policy checking is done for BSMTP input. Only the non-SMTP
32607 ACL is run in the same way as for non-SMTP local input.
32608
32609 If an error is detected while reading a message, including a missing &"."& at
32610 the end, Exim gives up immediately. It writes details of the error to the
32611 standard output in a stylized way that the calling program should be able to
32612 make some use of automatically, for example:
32613 .code
32614 554 Unexpected end of file
32615 Transaction started in line 10
32616 Error detected in line 14
32617 .endd
32618 It writes a more verbose version, for human consumption, to the standard error
32619 file, for example:
32620 .code
32621 An error was detected while processing a file of BSMTP input.
32622 The error message was:
32623
32624 501 '>' missing at end of address
32625
32626 The SMTP transaction started in line 10.
32627 The error was detected in line 12.
32628 The SMTP command at fault was:
32629
32630 rcpt to:<malformed@in.com.plete
32631
32632 1 previous message was successfully processed.
32633 The rest of the batch was abandoned.
32634 .endd
32635 The return code from Exim is zero only if there were no errors. It is 1 if some
32636 messages were accepted before an error was detected, and 2 if no messages were
32637 accepted.
32638 .ecindex IIDsmtpproc1
32639 .ecindex IIDsmtpproc2
32640
32641
32642
32643 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
32644 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
32645
32646 .chapter "Customizing bounce and warning messages" "CHAPemsgcust" &&&
32647 "Customizing messages"
32648 When a message fails to be delivered, or remains on the queue for more than a
32649 configured amount of time, Exim sends a message to the original sender, or
32650 to an alternative configured address. The text of these messages is built into
32651 the code of Exim, but it is possible to change it, either by adding a single
32652 string, or by replacing each of the paragraphs by text supplied in a file.
32653
32654 The &'From:'& and &'To:'& header lines are automatically generated; you can
32655 cause a &'Reply-To:'& line to be added by setting the &%errors_reply_to%&
32656 option. Exim also adds the line
32657 .code
32658 Auto-Submitted: auto-generated
32659 .endd
32660 to all warning and bounce messages,
32661
32662
32663 .section "Customizing bounce messages" "SECID239"
32664 .cindex "customizing" "bounce message"
32665 .cindex "bounce message" "customizing"
32666 If &%bounce_message_text%& is set, its contents are included in the default
32667 message immediately after &"This message was created automatically by mail
32668 delivery software."& The string is not expanded. It is not used if
32669 &%bounce_message_file%& is set.
32670
32671 When &%bounce_message_file%& is set, it must point to a template file for
32672 constructing error messages. The file consists of a series of text items,
32673 separated by lines consisting of exactly four asterisks. If the file cannot be
32674 opened, default text is used and a message is written to the main and panic
32675 logs. If any text item in the file is empty, default text is used for that
32676 item.
32677
32678 .vindex "&$bounce_recipient$&"
32679 .vindex "&$bounce_return_size_limit$&"
32680 Each item of text that is read from the file is expanded, and there are two
32681 expansion variables which can be of use here: &$bounce_recipient$& is set to
32682 the recipient of an error message while it is being created, and
32683 &$bounce_return_size_limit$& contains the value of the &%return_size_limit%&
32684 option, rounded to a whole number.
32685
32686 The items must appear in the file in the following order:
32687
32688 .ilist
32689 The first item is included in the headers, and should include at least a
32690 &'Subject:'& header. Exim does not check the syntax of these headers.
32691 .next
32692 The second item forms the start of the error message. After it, Exim lists the
32693 failing addresses with their error messages.
32694 .next
32695 The third item is used to introduce any text from pipe transports that is to be
32696 returned to the sender. It is omitted if there is no such text.
32697 .next
32698 The fourth item is used to introduce the copy of the message that is returned
32699 as part of the error report.
32700 .next
32701 The fifth item is added after the fourth one if the returned message is
32702 truncated because it is bigger than &%return_size_limit%&.
32703 .next
32704 The sixth item is added after the copy of the original message.
32705 .endlist
32706
32707 The default state (&%bounce_message_file%& unset) is equivalent to the
32708 following file, in which the sixth item is empty. The &'Subject:'& and some
32709 other lines have been split in order to fit them on the page:
32710 .code
32711 Subject: Mail delivery failed
32712 ${if eq{$sender_address}{$bounce_recipient}
32713 {: returning message to sender}}
32714 ****
32715 This message was created automatically by mail delivery software.
32716
32717 A message ${if eq{$sender_address}{$bounce_recipient}
32718 {that you sent }{sent by
32719
32720 <$sender_address>
32721
32722 }}could not be delivered to all of its recipients.
32723 This is a permanent error. The following address(es) failed:
32724 ****
32725 The following text was generated during the delivery attempt(s):
32726 ****
32727 ------ This is a copy of the message, including all the headers.
32728 ------
32729 ****
32730 ------ The body of the message is $message_size characters long;
32731 only the first
32732 ------ $bounce_return_size_limit or so are included here.
32733 ****
32734 .endd
32735 .section "Customizing warning messages" "SECTcustwarn"
32736 .cindex "customizing" "warning message"
32737 .cindex "warning of delay" "customizing the message"
32738 The option &%warn_message_file%& can be pointed at a template file for use when
32739 warnings about message delays are created. In this case there are only three
32740 text sections:
32741
32742 .ilist
32743 The first item is included in the headers, and should include at least a
32744 &'Subject:'& header. Exim does not check the syntax of these headers.
32745 .next
32746 The second item forms the start of the warning message. After it, Exim lists
32747 the delayed addresses.
32748 .next
32749 The third item then ends the message.
32750 .endlist
32751
32752 The default state is equivalent to the following file, except that some lines
32753 have been split here, in order to fit them on the page:
32754 .code
32755 Subject: Warning: message $message_exim_id delayed
32756 $warn_message_delay
32757 ****
32758 This message was created automatically by mail delivery software.
32759
32760 A message ${if eq{$sender_address}{$warn_message_recipients}
32761 {that you sent }{sent by
32762
32763 <$sender_address>
32764
32765 }}has not been delivered to all of its recipients after
32766 more than $warn_message_delay on the queue on $primary_hostname.
32767
32768 The message identifier is: $message_exim_id
32769 The subject of the message is: $h_subject
32770 The date of the message is: $h_date
32771
32772 The following address(es) have not yet been delivered:
32773 ****
32774 No action is required on your part. Delivery attempts will
32775 continue for some time, and this warning may be repeated at
32776 intervals if the message remains undelivered. Eventually the
32777 mail delivery software will give up, and when that happens,
32778 the message will be returned to you.
32779 .endd
32780 .vindex "&$warn_message_delay$&"
32781 .vindex "&$warn_message_recipients$&"
32782 However, in the default state the subject and date lines are omitted if no
32783 appropriate headers exist. During the expansion of this file,
32784 &$warn_message_delay$& is set to the delay time in one of the forms &"<&'n'&>
32785 minutes"& or &"<&'n'&> hours"&, and &$warn_message_recipients$& contains a list
32786 of recipients for the warning message. There may be more than one if there are
32787 multiple addresses with different &%errors_to%& settings on the routers that
32788 handled them.
32789
32790
32791
32792
32793 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
32794 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
32795
32796 .chapter "Some common configuration settings" "CHAPcomconreq"
32797 This chapter discusses some configuration settings that seem to be fairly
32798 common. More examples and discussion can be found in the Exim book.
32799
32800
32801
32802 .section "Sending mail to a smart host" "SECID240"
32803 .cindex "smart host" "example router"
32804 If you want to send all mail for non-local domains to a &"smart host"&, you
32805 should replace the default &(dnslookup)& router with a router which does the
32806 routing explicitly:
32807 .code
32808 send_to_smart_host:
32809 driver = manualroute
32810 route_list = !+local_domains smart.host.name
32811 transport = remote_smtp
32812 .endd
32813 You can use the smart host's IP address instead of the name if you wish.
32814 If you are using Exim only to submit messages to a smart host, and not for
32815 receiving incoming messages, you can arrange for it to do the submission
32816 synchronously by setting the &%mua_wrapper%& option (see chapter
32817 &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&).
32818
32819
32820
32821
32822 .section "Using Exim to handle mailing lists" "SECTmailinglists"
32823 .cindex "mailing lists"
32824 Exim can be used to run simple mailing lists, but for large and/or complicated
32825 requirements, the use of additional specialized mailing list software such as
32826 Majordomo or Mailman is recommended.
32827
32828 The &(redirect)& router can be used to handle mailing lists where each list
32829 is maintained in a separate file, which can therefore be managed by an
32830 independent manager. The &%domains%& router option can be used to run these
32831 lists in a separate domain from normal mail. For example:
32832 .code
32833 lists:
32834 driver = redirect
32835 domains = lists.example
32836 file = /usr/lists/$local_part
32837 forbid_pipe
32838 forbid_file
32839 errors_to = $local_part-request@lists.example
32840 no_more
32841 .endd
32842 This router is skipped for domains other than &'lists.example'&. For addresses
32843 in that domain, it looks for a file that matches the local part. If there is no
32844 such file, the router declines, but because &%no_more%& is set, no subsequent
32845 routers are tried, and so the whole delivery fails.
32846
32847 The &%forbid_pipe%& and &%forbid_file%& options prevent a local part from being
32848 expanded into a file name or a pipe delivery, which is usually inappropriate in
32849 a mailing list.
32850
32851 .oindex "&%errors_to%&"
32852 The &%errors_to%& option specifies that any delivery errors caused by addresses
32853 taken from a mailing list are to be sent to the given address rather than the
32854 original sender of the message. However, before acting on this, Exim verifies
32855 the error address, and ignores it if verification fails.
32856
32857 For example, using the configuration above, mail sent to
32858 &'dicts@lists.example'& is passed on to those addresses contained in
32859 &_/usr/lists/dicts_&, with error reports directed to
32860 &'dicts-request@lists.example'&, provided that this address can be verified.
32861 There could be a file called &_/usr/lists/dicts-request_& containing
32862 the address(es) of this particular list's manager(s), but other approaches,
32863 such as setting up an earlier router (possibly using the &%local_part_prefix%&
32864 or &%local_part_suffix%& options) to handle addresses of the form
32865 &%owner-%&&'xxx'& or &%xxx-%&&'request'&, are also possible.
32866
32867
32868
32869 .section "Syntax errors in mailing lists" "SECID241"
32870 .cindex "mailing lists" "syntax errors in"
32871 If an entry in redirection data contains a syntax error, Exim normally defers
32872 delivery of the original address. That means that a syntax error in a mailing
32873 list holds up all deliveries to the list. This may not be appropriate when a
32874 list is being maintained automatically from data supplied by users, and the
32875 addresses are not rigorously checked.
32876
32877 If the &%skip_syntax_errors%& option is set, the &(redirect)& router just skips
32878 entries that fail to parse, noting the incident in the log. If in addition
32879 &%syntax_errors_to%& is set to a verifiable address, a message is sent to it
32880 whenever a broken address is skipped. It is usually appropriate to set
32881 &%syntax_errors_to%& to the same address as &%errors_to%&.
32882
32883
32884
32885 .section "Re-expansion of mailing lists" "SECID242"
32886 .cindex "mailing lists" "re-expansion of"
32887 Exim remembers every individual address to which a message has been delivered,
32888 in order to avoid duplication, but it normally stores only the original
32889 recipient addresses with a message. If all the deliveries to a mailing list
32890 cannot be done at the first attempt, the mailing list is re-expanded when the
32891 delivery is next tried. This means that alterations to the list are taken into
32892 account at each delivery attempt, so addresses that have been added to
32893 the list since the message arrived will therefore receive a copy of the
32894 message, even though it pre-dates their subscription.
32895
32896 If this behaviour is felt to be undesirable, the &%one_time%& option can be set
32897 on the &(redirect)& router. If this is done, any addresses generated by the
32898 router that fail to deliver at the first attempt are added to the message as
32899 &"top level"& addresses, and the parent address that generated them is marked
32900 &"delivered"&. Thus, expansion of the mailing list does not happen again at the
32901 subsequent delivery attempts. The disadvantage of this is that if any of the
32902 failing addresses are incorrect, correcting them in the file has no effect on
32903 pre-existing messages.
32904
32905 The original top-level address is remembered with each of the generated
32906 addresses, and is output in any log messages. However, any intermediate parent
32907 addresses are not recorded. This makes a difference to the log only if the
32908 &%all_parents%& selector is set, but for mailing lists there is normally only
32909 one level of expansion anyway.
32910
32911
32912
32913 .section "Closed mailing lists" "SECID243"
32914 .cindex "mailing lists" "closed"
32915 The examples so far have assumed open mailing lists, to which anybody may
32916 send mail. It is also possible to set up closed lists, where mail is accepted
32917 from specified senders only. This is done by making use of the generic
32918 &%senders%& option to restrict the router that handles the list.
32919
32920 The following example uses the same file as a list of recipients and as a list
32921 of permitted senders. It requires three routers:
32922 .code
32923 lists_request:
32924 driver = redirect
32925 domains = lists.example
32926 local_part_suffix = -request
32927 file = /usr/lists/$local_part$local_part_suffix
32928 no_more
32929
32930 lists_post:
32931 driver = redirect
32932 domains = lists.example
32933 senders = ${if exists {/usr/lists/$local_part}\
32934 {lsearch;/usr/lists/$local_part}{*}}
32935 file = /usr/lists/$local_part
32936 forbid_pipe
32937 forbid_file
32938 errors_to = $local_part-request@lists.example
32939 no_more
32940
32941 lists_closed:
32942 driver = redirect
32943 domains = lists.example
32944 allow_fail
32945 data = :fail: $local_part@lists.example is a closed mailing list
32946 .endd
32947 All three routers have the same &%domains%& setting, so for any other domains,
32948 they are all skipped. The first router runs only if the local part ends in
32949 &%-request%&. It handles messages to the list manager(s) by means of an open
32950 mailing list.
32951
32952 The second router runs only if the &%senders%& precondition is satisfied. It
32953 checks for the existence of a list that corresponds to the local part, and then
32954 checks that the sender is on the list by means of a linear search. It is
32955 necessary to check for the existence of the file before trying to search it,
32956 because otherwise Exim thinks there is a configuration error. If the file does
32957 not exist, the expansion of &%senders%& is *, which matches all senders. This
32958 means that the router runs, but because there is no list, declines, and
32959 &%no_more%& ensures that no further routers are run. The address fails with an
32960 &"unrouteable address"& error.
32961
32962 The third router runs only if the second router is skipped, which happens when
32963 a mailing list exists, but the sender is not on it. This router forcibly fails
32964 the address, giving a suitable error message.
32965
32966
32967
32968
32969 .section "Variable Envelope Return Paths (VERP)" "SECTverp"
32970 .cindex "VERP"
32971 .cindex "Variable Envelope Return Paths"
32972 .cindex "envelope sender"
32973 Variable Envelope Return Paths &-- see &url(http://cr.yp.to/proto/verp.txt) &--
32974 are a way of helping mailing list administrators discover which subscription
32975 address is the cause of a particular delivery failure. The idea is to encode
32976 the original recipient address in the outgoing envelope sender address, so that
32977 if the message is forwarded by another host and then subsequently bounces, the
32978 original recipient can be extracted from the recipient address of the bounce.
32979
32980 .oindex &%errors_to%&
32981 .oindex &%return_path%&
32982 Envelope sender addresses can be modified by Exim using two different
32983 facilities: the &%errors_to%& option on a router (as shown in previous mailing
32984 list examples), or the &%return_path%& option on a transport. The second of
32985 these is effective only if the message is successfully delivered to another
32986 host; it is not used for errors detected on the local host (see the description
32987 of &%return_path%& in chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&). Here is an example
32988 of the use of &%return_path%& to implement VERP on an &(smtp)& transport:
32989 .code
32990 verp_smtp:
32991 driver = smtp
32992 max_rcpt = 1
32993 return_path = \
32994 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}\
32995 {$1-request+$local_part=$domain@your.dom.example}fail}
32996 .endd
32997 This has the effect of rewriting the return path (envelope sender) on outgoing
32998 SMTP messages, if the local part of the original return path ends in
32999 &"-request"&, and the domain is &'your.dom.example'&. The rewriting inserts the
33000 local part and domain of the recipient into the return path. Suppose, for
33001 example, that a message whose return path has been set to
33002 &'somelist-request@your.dom.example'& is sent to
33003 &'subscriber@other.dom.example'&. In the transport, the return path is
33004 rewritten as
33005 .code
33006 somelist-request+subscriber=other.dom.example@your.dom.example
33007 .endd
33008 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
33009 For this to work, you must tell Exim to send multiple copies of messages that
33010 have more than one recipient, so that each copy has just one recipient. This is
33011 achieved by setting &%max_rcpt%& to 1. Without this, a single copy of a message
33012 might be sent to several different recipients in the same domain, in which case
33013 &$local_part$& is not available in the transport, because it is not unique.
33014
33015 Unless your host is doing nothing but mailing list deliveries, you should
33016 probably use a separate transport for the VERP deliveries, so as not to use
33017 extra resources in making one-per-recipient copies for other deliveries. This
33018 can easily be done by expanding the &%transport%& option in the router:
33019 .code
33020 dnslookup:
33021 driver = dnslookup
33022 domains = ! +local_domains
33023 transport = \
33024 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}\
33025 {verp_smtp}{remote_smtp}}
33026 no_more
33027 .endd
33028 If you want to change the return path using &%errors_to%& in a router instead
33029 of using &%return_path%& in the transport, you need to set &%errors_to%& on all
33030 routers that handle mailing list addresses. This will ensure that all delivery
33031 errors, including those detected on the local host, are sent to the VERP
33032 address.
33033
33034 On a host that does no local deliveries and has no manual routing, only the
33035 &(dnslookup)& router needs to be changed. A special transport is not needed for
33036 SMTP deliveries. Every mailing list recipient has its own return path value,
33037 and so Exim must hand them to the transport one at a time. Here is an example
33038 of a &(dnslookup)& router that implements VERP:
33039 .code
33040 verp_dnslookup:
33041 driver = dnslookup
33042 domains = ! +local_domains
33043 transport = remote_smtp
33044 errors_to = \
33045 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}}
33046 {$1-request+$local_part=$domain@your.dom.example}fail}
33047 no_more
33048 .endd
33049 Before you start sending out messages with VERPed return paths, you must also
33050 configure Exim to accept the bounce messages that come back to those paths.
33051 Typically this is done by setting a &%local_part_suffix%& option for a
33052 router, and using this to route the messages to wherever you want to handle
33053 them.
33054
33055 The overhead incurred in using VERP depends very much on the size of the
33056 message, the number of recipient addresses that resolve to the same remote
33057 host, and the speed of the connection over which the message is being sent. If
33058 a lot of addresses resolve to the same host and the connection is slow, sending
33059 a separate copy of the message for each address may take substantially longer
33060 than sending a single copy with many recipients (for which VERP cannot be
33061 used).
33062
33063
33064
33065
33066
33067
33068 .section "Virtual domains" "SECTvirtualdomains"
33069 .cindex "virtual domains"
33070 .cindex "domain" "virtual"
33071 The phrase &'virtual domain'& is unfortunately used with two rather different
33072 meanings:
33073
33074 .ilist
33075 A domain for which there are no real mailboxes; all valid local parts are
33076 aliases for other email addresses. Common examples are organizational
33077 top-level domains and &"vanity"& domains.
33078 .next
33079 One of a number of independent domains that are all handled by the same host,
33080 with mailboxes on that host, but where the mailbox owners do not necessarily
33081 have login accounts on that host.
33082 .endlist
33083
33084 The first usage is probably more common, and does seem more &"virtual"& than
33085 the second. This kind of domain can be handled in Exim with a straightforward
33086 aliasing router. One approach is to create a separate alias file for each
33087 virtual domain. Exim can test for the existence of the alias file to determine
33088 whether the domain exists. The &(dsearch)& lookup type is useful here, leading
33089 to a router of this form:
33090 .code
33091 virtual:
33092 driver = redirect
33093 domains = dsearch;/etc/mail/virtual
33094 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/mail/virtual/$domain}}
33095 no_more
33096 .endd
33097 The &%domains%& option specifies that the router is to be skipped, unless there
33098 is a file in the &_/etc/mail/virtual_& directory whose name is the same as the
33099 domain that is being processed. When the router runs, it looks up the local
33100 part in the file to find a new address (or list of addresses). The &%no_more%&
33101 setting ensures that if the lookup fails (leading to &%data%& being an empty
33102 string), Exim gives up on the address without trying any subsequent routers.
33103
33104 This one router can handle all the virtual domains because the alias file names
33105 follow a fixed pattern. Permissions can be arranged so that appropriate people
33106 can edit the different alias files. A successful aliasing operation results in
33107 a new envelope recipient address, which is then routed from scratch.
33108
33109 The other kind of &"virtual"& domain can also be handled in a straightforward
33110 way. One approach is to create a file for each domain containing a list of
33111 valid local parts, and use it in a router like this:
33112 .code
33113 my_domains:
33114 driver = accept
33115 domains = dsearch;/etc/mail/domains
33116 local_parts = lsearch;/etc/mail/domains/$domain
33117 transport = my_mailboxes
33118 .endd
33119 The address is accepted if there is a file for the domain, and the local part
33120 can be found in the file. The &%domains%& option is used to check for the
33121 file's existence because &%domains%& is tested before the &%local_parts%&
33122 option (see section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). You cannot use &%require_files%&,
33123 because that option is tested after &%local_parts%&. The transport is as
33124 follows:
33125 .code
33126 my_mailboxes:
33127 driver = appendfile
33128 file = /var/mail/$domain/$local_part
33129 user = mail
33130 .endd
33131 This uses a directory of mailboxes for each domain. The &%user%& setting is
33132 required, to specify which uid is to be used for writing to the mailboxes.
33133
33134 The configuration shown here is just one example of how you might support this
33135 requirement. There are many other ways this kind of configuration can be set
33136 up, for example, by using a database instead of separate files to hold all the
33137 information about the domains.
33138
33139
33140
33141 .section "Multiple user mailboxes" "SECTmulbox"
33142 .cindex "multiple mailboxes"
33143 .cindex "mailbox" "multiple"
33144 .cindex "local part" "prefix"
33145 .cindex "local part" "suffix"
33146 Heavy email users often want to operate with multiple mailboxes, into which
33147 incoming mail is automatically sorted. A popular way of handling this is to
33148 allow users to use multiple sender addresses, so that replies can easily be
33149 identified. Users are permitted to add prefixes or suffixes to their local
33150 parts for this purpose. The wildcard facility of the generic router options
33151 &%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& can be used for this. For
33152 example, consider this router:
33153 .code
33154 userforward:
33155 driver = redirect
33156 check_local_user
33157 file = $home/.forward
33158 local_part_suffix = -*
33159 local_part_suffix_optional
33160 allow_filter
33161 .endd
33162 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
33163 It runs a user's &_.forward_& file for all local parts of the form
33164 &'username-*'&. Within the filter file the user can distinguish different
33165 cases by testing the variable &$local_part_suffix$&. For example:
33166 .code
33167 if $local_part_suffix contains -special then
33168 save /home/$local_part/Mail/special
33169 endif
33170 .endd
33171 If the filter file does not exist, or does not deal with such addresses, they
33172 fall through to subsequent routers, and, assuming no subsequent use of the
33173 &%local_part_suffix%& option is made, they presumably fail. Thus, users have
33174 control over which suffixes are valid.
33175
33176 Alternatively, a suffix can be used to trigger the use of a different
33177 &_.forward_& file &-- which is the way a similar facility is implemented in
33178 another MTA:
33179 .code
33180 userforward:
33181 driver = redirect
33182 check_local_user
33183 file = $home/.forward$local_part_suffix
33184 local_part_suffix = -*
33185 local_part_suffix_optional
33186 allow_filter
33187 .endd
33188 If there is no suffix, &_.forward_& is used; if the suffix is &'-special'&, for
33189 example, &_.forward-special_& is used. Once again, if the appropriate file
33190 does not exist, or does not deal with the address, it is passed on to
33191 subsequent routers, which could, if required, look for an unqualified
33192 &_.forward_& file to use as a default.
33193
33194
33195
33196 .section "Simplified vacation processing" "SECID244"
33197 .cindex "vacation processing"
33198 The traditional way of running the &'vacation'& program is for a user to set up
33199 a pipe command in a &_.forward_& file
33200 (see section &<<SECTspecitredli>>& for syntax details).
33201 This is prone to error by inexperienced users. There are two features of Exim
33202 that can be used to make this process simpler for users:
33203
33204 .ilist
33205 A local part prefix such as &"vacation-"& can be specified on a router which
33206 can cause the message to be delivered directly to the &'vacation'& program, or
33207 alternatively can use Exim's &(autoreply)& transport. The contents of a user's
33208 &_.forward_& file are then much simpler. For example:
33209 .code
33210 spqr, vacation-spqr
33211 .endd
33212 .next
33213 The &%require_files%& generic router option can be used to trigger a
33214 vacation delivery by checking for the existence of a certain file in the
33215 user's home directory. The &%unseen%& generic option should also be used, to
33216 ensure that the original delivery also proceeds. In this case, all the user has
33217 to do is to create a file called, say, &_.vacation_&, containing a vacation
33218 message.
33219 .endlist
33220
33221 Another advantage of both these methods is that they both work even when the
33222 use of arbitrary pipes by users is locked out.
33223
33224
33225
33226 .section "Taking copies of mail" "SECID245"
33227 .cindex "message" "copying every"
33228 Some installations have policies that require archive copies of all messages to
33229 be made. A single copy of each message can easily be taken by an appropriate
33230 command in a system filter, which could, for example, use a different file for
33231 each day's messages.
33232
33233 There is also a shadow transport mechanism that can be used to take copies of
33234 messages that are successfully delivered by local transports, one copy per
33235 delivery. This could be used, &'inter alia'&, to implement automatic
33236 notification of delivery by sites that insist on doing such things.
33237
33238
33239
33240 .section "Intermittently connected hosts" "SECID246"
33241 .cindex "intermittently connected hosts"
33242 It has become quite common (because it is cheaper) for hosts to connect to the
33243 Internet periodically rather than remain connected all the time. The normal
33244 arrangement is that mail for such hosts accumulates on a system that is
33245 permanently connected.
33246
33247 Exim was designed for use on permanently connected hosts, and so it is not
33248 particularly well-suited to use in an intermittently connected environment.
33249 Nevertheless there are some features that can be used.
33250
33251
33252 .section "Exim on the upstream server host" "SECID247"
33253 It is tempting to arrange for incoming mail for the intermittently connected
33254 host to remain on Exim's queue until the client connects. However, this
33255 approach does not scale very well. Two different kinds of waiting message are
33256 being mixed up in the same queue &-- those that cannot be delivered because of
33257 some temporary problem, and those that are waiting for their destination host
33258 to connect. This makes it hard to manage the queue, as well as wasting
33259 resources, because each queue runner scans the entire queue.
33260
33261 A better approach is to separate off those messages that are waiting for an
33262 intermittently connected host. This can be done by delivering these messages
33263 into local files in batch SMTP, &"mailstore"&, or other envelope-preserving
33264 format, from where they are transmitted by other software when their
33265 destination connects. This makes it easy to collect all the mail for one host
33266 in a single directory, and to apply local timeout rules on a per-message basis
33267 if required.
33268
33269 On a very small scale, leaving the mail on Exim's queue can be made to work. If
33270 you are doing this, you should configure Exim with a long retry period for the
33271 intermittent host. For example:
33272 .code
33273 cheshire.wonderland.fict.example * F,5d,24h
33274 .endd
33275 This stops a lot of failed delivery attempts from occurring, but Exim remembers
33276 which messages it has queued up for that host. Once the intermittent host comes
33277 online, forcing delivery of one message (either by using the &%-M%& or &%-R%&
33278 options, or by using the ETRN SMTP command (see section &<<SECTETRN>>&)
33279 causes all the queued up messages to be delivered, often down a single SMTP
33280 connection. While the host remains connected, any new messages get delivered
33281 immediately.
33282
33283 If the connecting hosts do not have fixed IP addresses, that is, if a host is
33284 issued with a different IP address each time it connects, Exim's retry
33285 mechanisms on the holding host get confused, because the IP address is normally
33286 used as part of the key string for holding retry information. This can be
33287 avoided by unsetting &%retry_include_ip_address%& on the &(smtp)& transport.
33288 Since this has disadvantages for permanently connected hosts, it is best to
33289 arrange a separate transport for the intermittently connected ones.
33290
33291
33292
33293 .section "Exim on the intermittently connected client host" "SECID248"
33294 The value of &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& should probably be
33295 increased, or even set to zero (that is, disabled) on the intermittently
33296 connected host, so that all incoming messages down a single connection get
33297 delivered immediately.
33298
33299 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
33300 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
33301 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
33302 Mail waiting to be sent from an intermittently connected host will probably
33303 not have been routed, because without a connection DNS lookups are not
33304 possible. This means that if a normal queue run is done at connection time,
33305 each message is likely to be sent in a separate SMTP session. This can be
33306 avoided by starting the queue run with a command line option beginning with
33307 &%-qq%& instead of &%-q%&. In this case, the queue is scanned twice. In the
33308 first pass, routing is done but no deliveries take place. The second pass is a
33309 normal queue run; since all the messages have been previously routed, those
33310 destined for the same host are likely to get sent as multiple deliveries in a
33311 single SMTP connection.
33312
33313
33314
33315 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
33316 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
33317
33318 .chapter "Using Exim as a non-queueing client" "CHAPnonqueueing" &&&
33319 "Exim as a non-queueing client"
33320 .cindex "client, non-queueing"
33321 .cindex "smart host" "suppressing queueing"
33322 On a personal computer, it is a common requirement for all
33323 email to be sent to a &"smart host"&. There are plenty of MUAs that can be
33324 configured to operate that way, for all the popular operating systems.
33325 However, there are some MUAs for Unix-like systems that cannot be so
33326 configured: they submit messages using the command line interface of
33327 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&. Furthermore, utility programs such as &'cron'& submit
33328 messages this way.
33329
33330 If the personal computer runs continuously, there is no problem, because it can
33331 run a conventional MTA that handles delivery to the smart host, and deal with
33332 any delays via its queueing mechanism. However, if the computer does not run
33333 continuously or runs different operating systems at different times, queueing
33334 email is not desirable.
33335
33336 There is therefore a requirement for something that can provide the
33337 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& interface but deliver messages to a smart host without
33338 any queueing or retrying facilities. Furthermore, the delivery to the smart
33339 host should be synchronous, so that if it fails, the sending MUA is immediately
33340 informed. In other words, we want something that extends an MUA that submits
33341 to a local MTA via the command line so that it behaves like one that submits
33342 to a remote smart host using TCP/SMTP.
33343
33344 There are a number of applications (for example, there is one called &'ssmtp'&)
33345 that do this job. However, people have found them to be lacking in various
33346 ways. For instance, you might want to allow aliasing and forwarding to be done
33347 before sending a message to the smart host.
33348
33349 Exim already had the necessary infrastructure for doing this job. Just a few
33350 tweaks were needed to make it behave as required, though it is somewhat of an
33351 overkill to use a fully-featured MTA for this purpose.
33352
33353 .oindex "&%mua_wrapper%&"
33354 There is a Boolean global option called &%mua_wrapper%&, defaulting false.
33355 Setting &%mua_wrapper%& true causes Exim to run in a special mode where it
33356 assumes that it is being used to &"wrap"& a command-line MUA in the manner
33357 just described. As well as setting &%mua_wrapper%&, you also need to provide a
33358 compatible router and transport configuration. Typically there will be just one
33359 router and one transport, sending everything to a smart host.
33360
33361 When run in MUA wrapping mode, the behaviour of Exim changes in the
33362 following ways:
33363
33364 .ilist
33365 A daemon cannot be run, nor will Exim accept incoming messages from &'inetd'&.
33366 In other words, the only way to submit messages is via the command line.
33367 .next
33368 Each message is synchronously delivered as soon as it is received (&%-odi%& is
33369 assumed). All queueing options (&%queue_only%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&,
33370 &%control%& in an ACL, etc.) are quietly ignored. The Exim reception process
33371 does not finish until the delivery attempt is complete. If the delivery is
33372 successful, a zero return code is given.
33373 .next
33374 Address redirection is permitted, but the final routing for all addresses must
33375 be to the same remote transport, and to the same list of hosts. Furthermore,
33376 the return address (envelope sender) must be the same for all recipients, as
33377 must any added or deleted header lines. In other words, it must be possible to
33378 deliver the message in a single SMTP transaction, however many recipients there
33379 are.
33380 .next
33381 If these conditions are not met, or if routing any address results in a
33382 failure or defer status, or if Exim is unable to deliver all the recipients
33383 successfully to one of the smart hosts, delivery of the entire message fails.
33384 .next
33385 Because no queueing is allowed, all failures are treated as permanent; there
33386 is no distinction between 4&'xx'& and 5&'xx'& SMTP response codes from the
33387 smart host. Furthermore, because only a single yes/no response can be given to
33388 the caller, it is not possible to deliver to some recipients and not others. If
33389 there is an error (temporary or permanent) for any recipient, all are failed.
33390 .next
33391 If more than one smart host is listed, Exim will try another host after a
33392 connection failure or a timeout, in the normal way. However, if this kind of
33393 failure happens for all the hosts, the delivery fails.
33394 .next
33395 When delivery fails, an error message is written to the standard error stream
33396 (as well as to Exim's log), and Exim exits to the caller with a return code
33397 value 1. The message is expunged from Exim's spool files. No bounce messages
33398 are ever generated.
33399 .next
33400 No retry data is maintained, and any retry rules are ignored.
33401 .next
33402 A number of Exim options are overridden: &%deliver_drop_privilege%& is forced
33403 true, &%max_rcpt%& in the &(smtp)& transport is forced to &"unlimited"&,
33404 &%remote_max_parallel%& is forced to one, and fallback hosts are ignored.
33405 .endlist
33406
33407 The overall effect is that Exim makes a single synchronous attempt to deliver
33408 the message, failing if there is any kind of problem. Because no local
33409 deliveries are done and no daemon can be run, Exim does not need root
33410 privilege. It should be possible to run it setuid to &'exim'& instead of setuid
33411 to &'root'&. See section &<<SECTrunexiwitpri>>& for a general discussion about
33412 the advantages and disadvantages of running without root privilege.
33413
33414
33415
33416
33417 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
33418 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
33419
33420 .chapter "Log files" "CHAPlog"
33421 .scindex IIDloggen "log" "general description"
33422 .cindex "log" "types of"
33423 Exim writes three different logs, referred to as the main log, the reject log,
33424 and the panic log:
33425
33426 .ilist
33427 .cindex "main log"
33428 The main log records the arrival of each message and each delivery in a single
33429 line in each case. The format is as compact as possible, in an attempt to keep
33430 down the size of log files. Two-character flag sequences make it easy to pick
33431 out these lines. A number of other events are recorded in the main log. Some of
33432 them are optional, in which case the &%log_selector%& option controls whether
33433 they are included or not. A Perl script called &'eximstats'&, which does simple
33434 analysis of main log files, is provided in the Exim distribution (see section
33435 &<<SECTmailstat>>&).
33436 .next
33437 .cindex "reject log"
33438 The reject log records information from messages that are rejected as a result
33439 of a configuration option (that is, for policy reasons).
33440 The first line of each rejection is a copy of the line that is also written to
33441 the main log. Then, if the message's header has been read at the time the log
33442 is written, its contents are written to this log. Only the original header
33443 lines are available; header lines added by ACLs are not logged. You can use the
33444 reject log to check that your policy controls are working correctly; on a busy
33445 host this may be easier than scanning the main log for rejection messages. You
33446 can suppress the writing of the reject log by setting &%write_rejectlog%&
33447 false.
33448 .next
33449 .cindex "panic log"
33450 .cindex "system log"
33451 When certain serious errors occur, Exim writes entries to its panic log. If the
33452 error is sufficiently disastrous, Exim bombs out afterwards. Panic log entries
33453 are usually written to the main log as well, but can get lost amid the mass of
33454 other entries. The panic log should be empty under normal circumstances. It is
33455 therefore a good idea to check it (or to have a &'cron'& script check it)
33456 regularly, in order to become aware of any problems. When Exim cannot open its
33457 panic log, it tries as a last resort to write to the system log (syslog). This
33458 is opened with LOG_PID+LOG_CONS and the facility code of LOG_MAIL. The
33459 message itself is written at priority LOG_CRIT.
33460 .endlist
33461
33462 Every log line starts with a timestamp, in the format shown in the following
33463 example. Note that many of the examples shown in this chapter are line-wrapped.
33464 In the log file, this would be all on one line:
33465 .code
33466 2001-09-16 16:09:47 SMTP connection from [127.0.0.1] closed
33467 by QUIT
33468 .endd
33469 By default, the timestamps are in the local timezone. There are two
33470 ways of changing this:
33471
33472 .ilist
33473 You can set the &%timezone%& option to a different time zone; in particular, if
33474 you set
33475 .code
33476 timezone = UTC
33477 .endd
33478 the timestamps will be in UTC (aka GMT).
33479 .next
33480 If you set &%log_timezone%& true, the time zone is added to the timestamp, for
33481 example:
33482 .code
33483 2003-04-25 11:17:07 +0100 Start queue run: pid=12762
33484 .endd
33485 .endlist
33486
33487 .cindex "log" "process ids in"
33488 .cindex "pid (process id)" "in log lines"
33489 Exim does not include its process id in log lines by default, but you can
33490 request that it does so by specifying the &`pid`& log selector (see section
33491 &<<SECTlogselector>>&). When this is set, the process id is output, in square
33492 brackets, immediately after the time and date.
33493
33494
33495
33496
33497 .section "Where the logs are written" "SECTwhelogwri"
33498 .cindex "log" "destination"
33499 .cindex "log" "to file"
33500 .cindex "log" "to syslog"
33501 .cindex "syslog"
33502 The logs may be written to local files, or to syslog, or both. However, it
33503 should be noted that many syslog implementations use UDP as a transport, and
33504 are therefore unreliable in the sense that messages are not guaranteed to
33505 arrive at the loghost, nor is the ordering of messages necessarily maintained.
33506 It has also been reported that on large log files (tens of megabytes) you may
33507 need to tweak syslog to prevent it syncing the file with each write &-- on
33508 Linux this has been seen to make syslog take 90% plus of CPU time.
33509
33510 The destination for Exim's logs is configured by setting LOG_FILE_PATH in
33511 &_Local/Makefile_& or by setting &%log_file_path%& in the run time
33512 configuration. This latter string is expanded, so it can contain, for example,
33513 references to the host name:
33514 .code
33515 log_file_path = /var/log/$primary_hostname/exim_%slog
33516 .endd
33517 It is generally advisable, however, to set the string in &_Local/Makefile_&
33518 rather than at run time, because then the setting is available right from the
33519 start of Exim's execution. Otherwise, if there's something it wants to log
33520 before it has read the configuration file (for example, an error in the
33521 configuration file) it will not use the path you want, and may not be able to
33522 log at all.
33523
33524 The value of LOG_FILE_PATH or &%log_file_path%& is a colon-separated
33525 list, currently limited to at most two items. This is one option where the
33526 facility for changing a list separator may not be used. The list must always be
33527 colon-separated. If an item in the list is &"syslog"& then syslog is used;
33528 otherwise the item must either be an absolute path, containing &`%s`& at the
33529 point where &"main"&, &"reject"&, or &"panic"& is to be inserted, or be empty,
33530 implying the use of a default path.
33531
33532 When Exim encounters an empty item in the list, it searches the list defined by
33533 LOG_FILE_PATH, and uses the first item it finds that is neither empty nor
33534 &"syslog"&. This means that an empty item in &%log_file_path%& can be used to
33535 mean &"use the path specified at build time"&. It no such item exists, log
33536 files are written in the &_log_& subdirectory of the spool directory. This is
33537 equivalent to the setting:
33538 .code
33539 log_file_path = $spool_directory/log/%slog
33540 .endd
33541 If you do not specify anything at build time or run time, that is where the
33542 logs are written.
33543
33544 A log file path may also contain &`%D`& or &`%M`& if datestamped log file names
33545 are in use &-- see section &<<SECTdatlogfil>>& below.
33546
33547 Here are some examples of possible settings:
33548 .display
33549 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=syslog `& syslog only
33550 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=:syslog `& syslog and default path
33551 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=syslog : /usr/log/exim_%s `& syslog and specified path
33552 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=/usr/log/exim_%s `& specified path only
33553 .endd
33554 If there are more than two paths in the list, the first is used and a panic
33555 error is logged.
33556
33557
33558
33559 .section "Logging to local files that are periodically &""cycled""&" "SECID285"
33560 .cindex "log" "cycling local files"
33561 .cindex "cycling logs"
33562 .cindex "&'exicyclog'&"
33563 .cindex "log" "local files; writing to"
33564 Some operating systems provide centralized and standardized methods for cycling
33565 log files. For those that do not, a utility script called &'exicyclog'& is
33566 provided (see section &<<SECTcyclogfil>>&). This renames and compresses the
33567 main and reject logs each time it is called. The maximum number of old logs to
33568 keep can be set. It is suggested this script is run as a daily &'cron'& job.
33569
33570 An Exim delivery process opens the main log when it first needs to write to it,
33571 and it keeps the file open in case subsequent entries are required &-- for
33572 example, if a number of different deliveries are being done for the same
33573 message. However, remote SMTP deliveries can take a long time, and this means
33574 that the file may be kept open long after it is renamed if &'exicyclog'& or
33575 something similar is being used to rename log files on a regular basis. To
33576 ensure that a switch of log files is noticed as soon as possible, Exim calls
33577 &[stat()]& on the main log's name before reusing an open file, and if the file
33578 does not exist, or its inode has changed, the old file is closed and Exim
33579 tries to open the main log from scratch. Thus, an old log file may remain open
33580 for quite some time, but no Exim processes should write to it once it has been
33581 renamed.
33582
33583
33584
33585 .section "Datestamped log files" "SECTdatlogfil"
33586 .cindex "log" "datestamped files"
33587 Instead of cycling the main and reject log files by renaming them
33588 periodically, some sites like to use files whose names contain a datestamp,
33589 for example, &_mainlog-20031225_&. The datestamp is in the form &_yyyymmdd_& or
33590 &_yyyymm_&. Exim has support for this way of working. It is enabled by setting
33591 the &%log_file_path%& option to a path that includes &`%D`& or &`%M`& at the
33592 point where the datestamp is required. For example:
33593 .code
33594 log_file_path = /var/spool/exim/log/%slog-%D
33595 log_file_path = /var/log/exim-%s-%D.log
33596 log_file_path = /var/spool/exim/log/%D-%slog
33597 log_file_path = /var/log/exim/%s.%M
33598 .endd
33599 As before, &`%s`& is replaced by &"main"& or &"reject"&; the following are
33600 examples of names generated by the above examples:
33601 .code
33602 /var/spool/exim/log/mainlog-20021225
33603 /var/log/exim-reject-20021225.log
33604 /var/spool/exim/log/20021225-mainlog
33605 /var/log/exim/main.200212
33606 .endd
33607 When this form of log file is specified, Exim automatically switches to new
33608 files at midnight. It does not make any attempt to compress old logs; you
33609 will need to write your own script if you require this. You should not
33610 run &'exicyclog'& with this form of logging.
33611
33612 The location of the panic log is also determined by &%log_file_path%&, but it
33613 is not datestamped, because rotation of the panic log does not make sense.
33614 When generating the name of the panic log, &`%D`& or &`%M`& are removed from
33615 the string. In addition, if it immediately follows a slash, a following
33616 non-alphanumeric character is removed; otherwise a preceding non-alphanumeric
33617 character is removed. Thus, the four examples above would give these panic
33618 log names:
33619 .code
33620 /var/spool/exim/log/paniclog
33621 /var/log/exim-panic.log
33622 /var/spool/exim/log/paniclog
33623 /var/log/exim/panic
33624 .endd
33625
33626
33627 .section "Logging to syslog" "SECID249"
33628 .cindex "log" "syslog; writing to"
33629 The use of syslog does not change what Exim logs or the format of its messages,
33630 except in one respect. If &%syslog_timestamp%& is set false, the timestamps on
33631 Exim's log lines are omitted when these lines are sent to syslog. Apart from
33632 that, the same strings are written to syslog as to log files. The syslog
33633 &"facility"& is set to LOG_MAIL, and the program name to &"exim"&
33634 by default, but you can change these by setting the &%syslog_facility%& and
33635 &%syslog_processname%& options, respectively. If Exim was compiled with
33636 SYSLOG_LOG_PID set in &_Local/Makefile_& (this is the default in
33637 &_src/EDITME_&), then, on systems that permit it (all except ULTRIX), the
33638 LOG_PID flag is set so that the &[syslog()]& call adds the pid as well as
33639 the time and host name to each line.
33640 The three log streams are mapped onto syslog priorities as follows:
33641
33642 .ilist
33643 &'mainlog'& is mapped to LOG_INFO
33644 .next
33645 &'rejectlog'& is mapped to LOG_NOTICE
33646 .next
33647 &'paniclog'& is mapped to LOG_ALERT
33648 .endlist
33649
33650 Many log lines are written to both &'mainlog'& and &'rejectlog'&, and some are
33651 written to both &'mainlog'& and &'paniclog'&, so there will be duplicates if
33652 these are routed by syslog to the same place. You can suppress this duplication
33653 by setting &%syslog_duplication%& false.
33654
33655 Exim's log lines can sometimes be very long, and some of its &'rejectlog'&
33656 entries contain multiple lines when headers are included. To cope with both
33657 these cases, entries written to syslog are split into separate &[syslog()]&
33658 calls at each internal newline, and also after a maximum of
33659 870 data characters. (This allows for a total syslog line length of 1024, when
33660 additions such as timestamps are added.) If you are running a syslog
33661 replacement that can handle lines longer than the 1024 characters allowed by
33662 RFC 3164, you should set
33663 .code
33664 SYSLOG_LONG_LINES=yes
33665 .endd
33666 in &_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim. That stops Exim from splitting long
33667 lines, but it still splits at internal newlines in &'reject'& log entries.
33668
33669 To make it easy to re-assemble split lines later, each component of a split
33670 entry starts with a string of the form [<&'n'&>/<&'m'&>] or [<&'n'&>\<&'m'&>]
33671 where <&'n'&> is the component number and <&'m'&> is the total number of
33672 components in the entry. The / delimiter is used when the line was split
33673 because it was too long; if it was split because of an internal newline, the \
33674 delimiter is used. For example, supposing the length limit to be 50 instead of
33675 870, the following would be the result of a typical rejection message to
33676 &'mainlog'& (LOG_INFO), each line in addition being preceded by the time, host
33677 name, and pid as added by syslog:
33678 .code
33679 [1/5] 2002-09-16 16:09:43 16RdAL-0006pc-00 rejected from
33680 [2/5] [127.0.0.1] (ph10): syntax error in 'From' header
33681 [3/5] when scanning for sender: missing or malformed lo
33682 [4/5] cal part in "<>" (envelope sender is <ph10@cam.exa
33683 [5/5] mple>)
33684 .endd
33685 The same error might cause the following lines to be written to &"rejectlog"&
33686 (LOG_NOTICE):
33687 .code
33688 [1/18] 2002-09-16 16:09:43 16RdAL-0006pc-00 rejected fro
33689 [2/18] m [127.0.0.1] (ph10): syntax error in 'From' head
33690 [3/18] er when scanning for sender: missing or malformed
33691 [4/18] local part in "<>" (envelope sender is <ph10@cam
33692 [5\18] .example>)
33693 [6\18] Recipients: ph10@some.domain.cam.example
33694 [7\18] P Received: from [127.0.0.1] (ident=ph10)
33695 [8\18] by xxxxx.cam.example with smtp (Exim 4.00)
33696 [9\18] id 16RdAL-0006pc-00
33697 [10/18] for ph10@cam.example; Mon, 16 Sep 2002 16:
33698 [11\18] 09:43 +0100
33699 [12\18] F From: <>
33700 [13\18] Subject: this is a test header
33701 [18\18] X-something: this is another header
33702 [15/18] I Message-Id: <E16RdAL-0006pc-00@xxxxx.cam.examp
33703 [16\18] le>
33704 [17\18] B Bcc:
33705 [18/18] Date: Mon, 16 Sep 2002 16:09:43 +0100
33706 .endd
33707 Log lines that are neither too long nor contain newlines are written to syslog
33708 without modification.
33709
33710 If only syslog is being used, the Exim monitor is unable to provide a log tail
33711 display, unless syslog is routing &'mainlog'& to a file on the local host and
33712 the environment variable EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH is set to tell the monitor
33713 where it is.
33714
33715
33716
33717 .section "Log line flags" "SECID250"
33718 One line is written to the main log for each message received, and for each
33719 successful, unsuccessful, and delayed delivery. These lines can readily be
33720 picked out by the distinctive two-character flags that immediately follow the
33721 timestamp. The flags are:
33722 .display
33723 &`<=`& message arrival
33724 &`=>`& normal message delivery
33725 &`->`& additional address in same delivery
33726 &`>>`& cutthrough message delivery
33727 &`*>`& delivery suppressed by &%-N%&
33728 &`**`& delivery failed; address bounced
33729 &`==`& delivery deferred; temporary problem
33730 .endd
33731
33732
33733 .section "Logging message reception" "SECID251"
33734 .cindex "log" "reception line"
33735 The format of the single-line entry in the main log that is written for every
33736 message received is shown in the basic example below, which is split over
33737 several lines in order to fit it on the page:
33738 .code
33739 2002-10-31 08:57:53 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 <= kryten@dwarf.fict.example
33740 H=mailer.fict.example [192.168.123.123] U=exim
33741 P=smtp S=5678 id=<incoming message id>
33742 .endd
33743 The address immediately following &"<="& is the envelope sender address. A
33744 bounce message is shown with the sender address &"<>"&, and if it is locally
33745 generated, this is followed by an item of the form
33746 .code
33747 R=<message id>
33748 .endd
33749 which is a reference to the message that caused the bounce to be sent.
33750
33751 .cindex "HELO"
33752 .cindex "EHLO"
33753 For messages from other hosts, the H and U fields identify the remote host and
33754 record the RFC 1413 identity of the user that sent the message, if one was
33755 received. The number given in square brackets is the IP address of the sending
33756 host. If there is a single, unparenthesized host name in the H field, as
33757 above, it has been verified to correspond to the IP address (see the
33758 &%host_lookup%& option). If the name is in parentheses, it was the name quoted
33759 by the remote host in the SMTP HELO or EHLO command, and has not been
33760 verified. If verification yields a different name to that given for HELO or
33761 EHLO, the verified name appears first, followed by the HELO or EHLO
33762 name in parentheses.
33763
33764 Misconfigured hosts (and mail forgers) sometimes put an IP address, with or
33765 without brackets, in the HELO or EHLO command, leading to entries in
33766 the log containing text like these examples:
33767 .code
33768 H=(10.21.32.43) [192.168.8.34]
33769 H=([10.21.32.43]) [192.168.8.34]
33770 .endd
33771 This can be confusing. Only the final address in square brackets can be relied
33772 on.
33773
33774 For locally generated messages (that is, messages not received over TCP/IP),
33775 the H field is omitted, and the U field contains the login name of the caller
33776 of Exim.
33777
33778 .cindex "authentication" "logging"
33779 .cindex "AUTH" "logging"
33780 For all messages, the P field specifies the protocol used to receive the
33781 message. This is the value that is stored in &$received_protocol$&. In the case
33782 of incoming SMTP messages, the value indicates whether or not any SMTP
33783 extensions (ESMTP), encryption, or authentication were used. If the SMTP
33784 session was encrypted, there is an additional X field that records the cipher
33785 suite that was used.
33786
33787 The protocol is set to &"esmtpsa"& or &"esmtpa"& for messages received from
33788 hosts that have authenticated themselves using the SMTP AUTH command. The first
33789 value is used when the SMTP connection was encrypted (&"secure"&). In this case
33790 there is an additional item A= followed by the name of the authenticator that
33791 was used. If an authenticated identification was set up by the authenticator's
33792 &%server_set_id%& option, this is logged too, separated by a colon from the
33793 authenticator name.
33794
33795 .cindex "size" "of message"
33796 The id field records the existing message id, if present. The size of the
33797 received message is given by the S field. When the message is delivered,
33798 headers may be removed or added, so that the size of delivered copies of the
33799 message may not correspond with this value (and indeed may be different to each
33800 other).
33801
33802 The &%log_selector%& option can be used to request the logging of additional
33803 data when a message is received. See section &<<SECTlogselector>>& below.
33804
33805
33806
33807 .section "Logging deliveries" "SECID252"
33808 .cindex "log" "delivery line"
33809 The format of the single-line entry in the main log that is written for every
33810 delivery is shown in one of the examples below, for local and remote
33811 deliveries, respectively. Each example has been split into two lines in order
33812 to fit it on the page:
33813 .code
33814 2002-10-31 08:59:13 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 => marv
33815 <marv@hitch.fict.example> R=localuser T=local_delivery
33816 2002-10-31 09:00:10 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 =>
33817 monk@holistic.fict.example R=dnslookup T=remote_smtp
33818 H=holistic.fict.example [192.168.234.234]
33819 .endd
33820 For ordinary local deliveries, the original address is given in angle brackets
33821 after the final delivery address, which might be a pipe or a file. If
33822 intermediate address(es) exist between the original and the final address, the
33823 last of these is given in parentheses after the final address. The R and T
33824 fields record the router and transport that were used to process the address.
33825
33826 If SMTP AUTH was used for the delivery there is an additional item A=
33827 followed by the name of the authenticator that was used.
33828 If an authenticated identification was set up by the authenticator's &%client_set_id%&
33829 option, this is logged too, separated by a colon from the authenticator name.
33830
33831 If a shadow transport was run after a successful local delivery, the log line
33832 for the successful delivery has an item added on the end, of the form
33833 .display
33834 &`ST=<`&&'shadow transport name'&&`>`&
33835 .endd
33836 If the shadow transport did not succeed, the error message is put in
33837 parentheses afterwards.
33838
33839 .cindex "asterisk" "after IP address"
33840 When more than one address is included in a single delivery (for example, two
33841 SMTP RCPT commands in one transaction) the second and subsequent addresses are
33842 flagged with &`->`& instead of &`=>`&. When two or more messages are delivered
33843 down a single SMTP connection, an asterisk follows the IP address in the log
33844 lines for the second and subsequent messages.
33845
33846 .cindex "delivery" "cutthrough; logging"
33847 .cindex "cutthrough" "logging"
33848 When delivery is done in cutthrough mode it is flagged with &`>>`& and the log
33849 line precedes the reception line, since cutthrough waits for a possible
33850 rejection from the destination in case it can reject the sourced item.
33851
33852 The generation of a reply message by a filter file gets logged as a
33853 &"delivery"& to the addressee, preceded by &">"&.
33854
33855 The &%log_selector%& option can be used to request the logging of additional
33856 data when a message is delivered. See section &<<SECTlogselector>>& below.
33857
33858
33859 .section "Discarded deliveries" "SECID253"
33860 .cindex "discarded messages"
33861 .cindex "message" "discarded"
33862 .cindex "delivery" "discarded; logging"
33863 When a message is discarded as a result of the command &"seen finish"& being
33864 obeyed in a filter file which generates no deliveries, a log entry of the form
33865 .code
33866 2002-12-10 00:50:49 16auJc-0001UB-00 => discarded
33867 <low.club@bridge.example> R=userforward
33868 .endd
33869 is written, to record why no deliveries are logged. When a message is discarded
33870 because it is aliased to &":blackhole:"& the log line is like this:
33871 .code
33872 1999-03-02 09:44:33 10HmaX-0005vi-00 => :blackhole:
33873 <hole@nowhere.example> R=blackhole_router
33874 .endd
33875
33876
33877 .section "Deferred deliveries" "SECID254"
33878 When a delivery is deferred, a line of the following form is logged:
33879 .code
33880 2002-12-19 16:20:23 16aiQz-0002Q5-00 == marvin@endrest.example
33881 R=dnslookup T=smtp defer (146): Connection refused
33882 .endd
33883 In the case of remote deliveries, the error is the one that was given for the
33884 last IP address that was tried. Details of individual SMTP failures are also
33885 written to the log, so the above line would be preceded by something like
33886 .code
33887 2002-12-19 16:20:23 16aiQz-0002Q5-00 Failed to connect to
33888 mail1.endrest.example [192.168.239.239]: Connection refused
33889 .endd
33890 When a deferred address is skipped because its retry time has not been reached,
33891 a message is written to the log, but this can be suppressed by setting an
33892 appropriate value in &%log_selector%&.
33893
33894
33895
33896 .section "Delivery failures" "SECID255"
33897 .cindex "delivery" "failure; logging"
33898 If a delivery fails because an address cannot be routed, a line of the
33899 following form is logged:
33900 .code
33901 1995-12-19 16:20:23 0tRiQz-0002Q5-00 ** jim@trek99.example
33902 <jim@trek99.example>: unknown mail domain
33903 .endd
33904 If a delivery fails at transport time, the router and transport are shown, and
33905 the response from the remote host is included, as in this example:
33906 .code
33907 2002-07-11 07:14:17 17SXDU-000189-00 ** ace400@pb.example
33908 R=dnslookup T=remote_smtp: SMTP error from remote mailer
33909 after pipelined RCPT TO:<ace400@pb.example>: host
33910 pbmail3.py.example [192.168.63.111]: 553 5.3.0
33911 <ace400@pb.example>...Addressee unknown
33912 .endd
33913 The word &"pipelined"& indicates that the SMTP PIPELINING extension was being
33914 used. See &%hosts_avoid_esmtp%& in the &(smtp)& transport for a way of
33915 disabling PIPELINING. The log lines for all forms of delivery failure are
33916 flagged with &`**`&.
33917
33918
33919
33920 .section "Fake deliveries" "SECID256"
33921 .cindex "delivery" "fake; logging"
33922 If a delivery does not actually take place because the &%-N%& option has been
33923 used to suppress it, a normal delivery line is written to the log, except that
33924 &"=>"& is replaced by &"*>"&.
33925
33926
33927
33928 .section "Completion" "SECID257"
33929 A line of the form
33930 .code
33931 2002-10-31 09:00:11 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 Completed
33932 .endd
33933 is written to the main log when a message is about to be removed from the spool
33934 at the end of its processing.
33935
33936
33937
33938
33939 .section "Summary of Fields in Log Lines" "SECID258"
33940 .cindex "log" "summary of fields"
33941 A summary of the field identifiers that are used in log lines is shown in
33942 the following table:
33943 .display
33944 &`A `& authenticator name (and optional id and sender)
33945 &`C `& SMTP confirmation on delivery
33946 &` `& command list for &"no mail in SMTP session"&
33947 &`CV `& certificate verification status
33948 &`D `& duration of &"no mail in SMTP session"&
33949 &`DN `& distinguished name from peer certificate
33950 &`DT `& on &`=>`& lines: time taken for a delivery
33951 &`F `& sender address (on delivery lines)
33952 &`H `& host name and IP address
33953 &`I `& local interface used
33954 &`id `& message id for incoming message
33955 &`P `& on &`<=`& lines: protocol used
33956 &` `& on &`=>`& and &`**`& lines: return path
33957 &`QT `& on &`=>`& lines: time spent on queue so far
33958 &` `& on &"Completed"& lines: time spent on queue
33959 &`R `& on &`<=`& lines: reference for local bounce
33960 &` `& on &`=>`& &`**`& and &`==`& lines: router name
33961 &`S `& size of message
33962 &`ST `& shadow transport name
33963 &`T `& on &`<=`& lines: message subject (topic)
33964 &` `& on &`=>`& &`**`& and &`==`& lines: transport name
33965 &`U `& local user or RFC 1413 identity
33966 &`X `& TLS cipher suite
33967 .endd
33968
33969
33970 .section "Other log entries" "SECID259"
33971 Various other types of log entry are written from time to time. Most should be
33972 self-explanatory. Among the more common are:
33973
33974 .ilist
33975 .cindex "retry" "time not reached"
33976 &'retry time not reached'&&~&~An address previously suffered a temporary error
33977 during routing or local delivery, and the time to retry has not yet arrived.
33978 This message is not written to an individual message log file unless it happens
33979 during the first delivery attempt.
33980 .next
33981 &'retry time not reached for any host'&&~&~An address previously suffered
33982 temporary errors during remote delivery, and the retry time has not yet arrived
33983 for any of the hosts to which it is routed.
33984 .next
33985 .cindex "spool directory" "file locked"
33986 &'spool file locked'&&~&~An attempt to deliver a message cannot proceed because
33987 some other Exim process is already working on the message. This can be quite
33988 common if queue running processes are started at frequent intervals. The
33989 &'exiwhat'& utility script can be used to find out what Exim processes are
33990 doing.
33991 .next
33992 .cindex "error" "ignored"
33993 &'error ignored'&&~&~There are several circumstances that give rise to this
33994 message:
33995 .olist
33996 Exim failed to deliver a bounce message whose age was greater than
33997 &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&. The bounce was discarded.
33998 .next
33999 A filter file set up a delivery using the &"noerror"& option, and the delivery
34000 failed. The delivery was discarded.
34001 .next
34002 A delivery set up by a router configured with
34003 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
34004 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left.
34005 .code
34006 errors_to = <>
34007 .endd
34008 failed. The delivery was discarded.
34009 .endlist olist
34010 .endlist ilist
34011
34012
34013
34014
34015
34016 .section "Reducing or increasing what is logged" "SECTlogselector"
34017 .cindex "log" "selectors"
34018 By setting the &%log_selector%& global option, you can disable some of Exim's
34019 default logging, or you can request additional logging. The value of
34020 &%log_selector%& is made up of names preceded by plus or minus characters. For
34021 example:
34022 .code
34023 log_selector = +arguments -retry_defer
34024 .endd
34025 The list of optional log items is in the following table, with the default
34026 selection marked by asterisks:
34027 .display
34028 &` 8bitmime `& received 8BITMIME status
34029 &`*acl_warn_skipped `& skipped &%warn%& statement in ACL
34030 &` address_rewrite `& address rewriting
34031 &` all_parents `& all parents in => lines
34032 &` arguments `& command line arguments
34033 &`*connection_reject `& connection rejections
34034 &`*delay_delivery `& immediate delivery delayed
34035 &` deliver_time `& time taken to perform delivery
34036 &` delivery_size `& add &`S=`&&'nnn'& to => lines
34037 &`*dnslist_defer `& defers of DNS list (aka RBL) lookups
34038 &`*etrn `& ETRN commands
34039 &`*host_lookup_failed `& as it says
34040 &` ident_timeout `& timeout for ident connection
34041 &` incoming_interface `& incoming interface on <= lines
34042 &` incoming_port `& incoming port on <= lines
34043 &`*lost_incoming_connection `& as it says (includes timeouts)
34044 &` outgoing_port `& add remote port to => lines
34045 &`*queue_run `& start and end queue runs
34046 &` queue_time `& time on queue for one recipient
34047 &` queue_time_overall `& time on queue for whole message
34048 &` pid `& Exim process id
34049 &` received_recipients `& recipients on <= lines
34050 &` received_sender `& sender on <= lines
34051 &`*rejected_header `& header contents on reject log
34052 &`*retry_defer `& &"retry time not reached"&
34053 &` return_path_on_delivery `& put return path on => and ** lines
34054 &` sender_on_delivery `& add sender to => lines
34055 &`*sender_verify_fail `& sender verification failures
34056 &`*size_reject `& rejection because too big
34057 &`*skip_delivery `& delivery skipped in a queue run
34058 &`*smtp_confirmation `& SMTP confirmation on => lines
34059 &` smtp_connection `& SMTP connections
34060 &` smtp_incomplete_transaction`& incomplete SMTP transactions
34061 &` smtp_mailauth `& AUTH argument to MAIL commands
34062 &` smtp_no_mail `& session with no MAIL commands
34063 &` smtp_protocol_error `& SMTP protocol errors
34064 &` smtp_syntax_error `& SMTP syntax errors
34065 &` subject `& contents of &'Subject:'& on <= lines
34066 &` tls_certificate_verified `& certificate verification status
34067 &`*tls_cipher `& TLS cipher suite on <= and => lines
34068 &` tls_peerdn `& TLS peer DN on <= and => lines
34069 &` tls_sni `& TLS SNI on <= lines
34070 &` unknown_in_list `& DNS lookup failed in list match
34071
34072 &` all `& all of the above
34073 .endd
34074 More details on each of these items follows:
34075
34076 .ilist
34077 .cindex "8BITMIME"
34078 .cindex "log" "8BITMIME"
34079 &%8bitmime%&: This causes Exim to log any 8BITMIME status of received messages,
34080 which may help in tracking down interoperability issues with ancient MTAs
34081 that are not 8bit clean. This is added to the &"<="& line, tagged with
34082 &`M8S=`& and a value of &`0`&, &`7`& or &`8`&, corresponding to "not given",
34083 &`7BIT`& and &`8BITMIME`& respectively.
34084 .next
34085 .cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb" "log when skipping"
34086 &%acl_warn_skipped%&: When an ACL &%warn%& statement is skipped because one of
34087 its conditions cannot be evaluated, a log line to this effect is written if
34088 this log selector is set.
34089 .next
34090 .cindex "log" "rewriting"
34091 .cindex "rewriting" "logging"
34092 &%address_rewrite%&: This applies both to global rewrites and per-transport
34093 rewrites, but not to rewrites in filters run as an unprivileged user (because
34094 such users cannot access the log).
34095 .next
34096 .cindex "log" "full parentage"
34097 &%all_parents%&: Normally only the original and final addresses are logged on
34098 delivery lines; with this selector, intermediate parents are given in
34099 parentheses between them.
34100 .next
34101 .cindex "log" "Exim arguments"
34102 .cindex "Exim arguments, logging"
34103 &%arguments%&: This causes Exim to write the arguments with which it was called
34104 to the main log, preceded by the current working directory. This is a debugging
34105 feature, added to make it easier to find out how certain MUAs call
34106 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&. The logging does not happen if Exim has given up root
34107 privilege because it was called with the &%-C%& or &%-D%& options. Arguments
34108 that are empty or that contain white space are quoted. Non-printing characters
34109 are shown as escape sequences. This facility cannot log unrecognized arguments,
34110 because the arguments are checked before the configuration file is read. The
34111 only way to log such cases is to interpose a script such as &_util/logargs.sh_&
34112 between the caller and Exim.
34113 .next
34114 .cindex "log" "connection rejections"
34115 &%connection_reject%&: A log entry is written whenever an incoming SMTP
34116 connection is rejected, for whatever reason.
34117 .next
34118 .cindex "log" "delayed delivery"
34119 .cindex "delayed delivery, logging"
34120 &%delay_delivery%&: A log entry is written whenever a delivery process is not
34121 started for an incoming message because the load is too high or too many
34122 messages were received on one connection. Logging does not occur if no delivery
34123 process is started because &%queue_only%& is set or &%-odq%& was used.
34124 .next
34125 .cindex "log" "delivery duration"
34126 &%deliver_time%&: For each delivery, the amount of real time it has taken to
34127 perform the actual delivery is logged as DT=<&'time'&>, for example, &`DT=1s`&.
34128 .next
34129 .cindex "log" "message size on delivery"
34130 .cindex "size" "of message"
34131 &%delivery_size%&: For each delivery, the size of message delivered is added to
34132 the &"=>"& line, tagged with S=.
34133 .next
34134 .cindex "log" "dnslist defer"
34135 .cindex "DNS list" "logging defer"
34136 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
34137 &%dnslist_defer%&: A log entry is written if an attempt to look up a host in a
34138 DNS black list suffers a temporary error.
34139 .next
34140 .cindex "log" "ETRN commands"
34141 .cindex "ETRN" "logging"
34142 &%etrn%&: Every valid ETRN command that is received is logged, before the ACL
34143 is run to determine whether or not it is actually accepted. An invalid ETRN
34144 command, or one received within a message transaction is not logged by this
34145 selector (see &%smtp_syntax_error%& and &%smtp_protocol_error%&).
34146 .next
34147 .cindex "log" "host lookup failure"
34148 &%host_lookup_failed%&: When a lookup of a host's IP addresses fails to find
34149 any addresses, or when a lookup of an IP address fails to find a host name, a
34150 log line is written. This logging does not apply to direct DNS lookups when
34151 routing email addresses, but it does apply to &"byname"& lookups.
34152 .next
34153 .cindex "log" "ident timeout"
34154 .cindex "RFC 1413" "logging timeout"
34155 &%ident_timeout%&: A log line is written whenever an attempt to connect to a
34156 client's ident port times out.
34157 .next
34158 .cindex "log" "incoming interface"
34159 .cindex "interface" "logging"
34160 &%incoming_interface%&: The interface on which a message was received is added
34161 to the &"<="& line as an IP address in square brackets, tagged by I= and
34162 followed by a colon and the port number. The local interface and port are also
34163 added to other SMTP log lines, for example &"SMTP connection from"&, and to
34164 rejection lines.
34165 .next
34166 .cindex "log" "incoming remote port"
34167 .cindex "port" "logging remote"
34168 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging incoming remote port"
34169 .vindex "&$sender_fullhost$&"
34170 .vindex "&$sender_rcvhost$&"
34171 &%incoming_port%&: The remote port number from which a message was received is
34172 added to log entries and &'Received:'& header lines, following the IP address
34173 in square brackets, and separated from it by a colon. This is implemented by
34174 changing the value that is put in the &$sender_fullhost$& and
34175 &$sender_rcvhost$& variables. Recording the remote port number has become more
34176 important with the widening use of NAT (see RFC 2505).
34177 .next
34178 .cindex "log" "dropped connection"
34179 &%lost_incoming_connection%&: A log line is written when an incoming SMTP
34180 connection is unexpectedly dropped.
34181 .next
34182 .cindex "log" "outgoing remote port"
34183 .cindex "port" "logging outgoint remote"
34184 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging ougtoing remote port"
34185 &%outgoing_port%&: The remote port number is added to delivery log lines (those
34186 containing => tags) following the IP address. This option is not included in
34187 the default setting, because for most ordinary configurations, the remote port
34188 number is always 25 (the SMTP port).
34189 .next
34190 .cindex "log" "process ids in"
34191 .cindex "pid (process id)" "in log lines"
34192 &%pid%&: The current process id is added to every log line, in square brackets,
34193 immediately after the time and date.
34194 .next
34195 .cindex "log" "queue run"
34196 .cindex "queue runner" "logging"
34197 &%queue_run%&: The start and end of every queue run are logged.
34198 .next
34199 .cindex "log" "queue time"
34200 &%queue_time%&: The amount of time the message has been in the queue on the
34201 local host is logged as QT=<&'time'&> on delivery (&`=>`&) lines, for example,
34202 &`QT=3m45s`&. The clock starts when Exim starts to receive the message, so it
34203 includes reception time as well as the delivery time for the current address.
34204 This means that it may be longer than the difference between the arrival and
34205 delivery log line times, because the arrival log line is not written until the
34206 message has been successfully received.
34207 .next
34208 &%queue_time_overall%&: The amount of time the message has been in the queue on
34209 the local host is logged as QT=<&'time'&> on &"Completed"& lines, for
34210 example, &`QT=3m45s`&. The clock starts when Exim starts to receive the
34211 message, so it includes reception time as well as the total delivery time.
34212 .next
34213 .cindex "log" "recipients"
34214 &%received_recipients%&: The recipients of a message are listed in the main log
34215 as soon as the message is received. The list appears at the end of the log line
34216 that is written when a message is received, preceded by the word &"for"&. The
34217 addresses are listed after they have been qualified, but before any rewriting
34218 has taken place.
34219 Recipients that were discarded by an ACL for MAIL or RCPT do not appear
34220 in the list.
34221 .next
34222 .cindex "log" "sender reception"
34223 &%received_sender%&: The unrewritten original sender of a message is added to
34224 the end of the log line that records the message's arrival, after the word
34225 &"from"& (before the recipients if &%received_recipients%& is also set).
34226 .next
34227 .cindex "log" "header lines for rejection"
34228 &%rejected_header%&: If a message's header has been received at the time a
34229 rejection is written to the reject log, the complete header is added to the
34230 log. Header logging can be turned off individually for messages that are
34231 rejected by the &[local_scan()]& function (see section &<<SECTapiforloc>>&).
34232 .next
34233 .cindex "log" "retry defer"
34234 &%retry_defer%&: A log line is written if a delivery is deferred because a
34235 retry time has not yet been reached. However, this &"retry time not reached"&
34236 message is always omitted from individual message logs after the first delivery
34237 attempt.
34238 .next
34239 .cindex "log" "return path"
34240 &%return_path_on_delivery%&: The return path that is being transmitted with
34241 the message is included in delivery and bounce lines, using the tag P=.
34242 This is omitted if no delivery actually happens, for example, if routing fails,
34243 or if delivery is to &_/dev/null_& or to &`:blackhole:`&.
34244 .next
34245 .cindex "log" "sender on delivery"
34246 &%sender_on_delivery%&: The message's sender address is added to every delivery
34247 and bounce line, tagged by F= (for &"from"&).
34248 This is the original sender that was received with the message; it is not
34249 necessarily the same as the outgoing return path.
34250 .next
34251 .cindex "log" "sender verify failure"
34252 &%sender_verify_fail%&: If this selector is unset, the separate log line that
34253 gives details of a sender verification failure is not written. Log lines for
34254 the rejection of SMTP commands contain just &"sender verify failed"&, so some
34255 detail is lost.
34256 .next
34257 .cindex "log" "size rejection"
34258 &%size_reject%&: A log line is written whenever a message is rejected because
34259 it is too big.
34260 .next
34261 .cindex "log" "frozen messages; skipped"
34262 .cindex "frozen messages" "logging skipping"
34263 &%skip_delivery%&: A log line is written whenever a message is skipped during a
34264 queue run because it is frozen or because another process is already delivering
34265 it.
34266 .cindex "&""spool file is locked""&"
34267 The message that is written is &"spool file is locked"&.
34268 .next
34269 .cindex "log" "smtp confirmation"
34270 .cindex "SMTP" "logging confirmation"
34271 &%smtp_confirmation%&: The response to the final &"."& in the SMTP dialogue for
34272 outgoing messages is added to delivery log lines in the form &`C=`&<&'text'&>.
34273 A number of MTAs (including Exim) return an identifying string in this
34274 response.
34275 .next
34276 .cindex "log" "SMTP connections"
34277 .cindex "SMTP" "logging connections"
34278 &%smtp_connection%&: A log line is written whenever an SMTP connection is
34279 established or closed, unless the connection is from a host that matches
34280 &%hosts_connection_nolog%&. (In contrast, &%lost_incoming_connection%& applies
34281 only when the closure is unexpected.) This applies to connections from local
34282 processes that use &%-bs%& as well as to TCP/IP connections. If a connection is
34283 dropped in the middle of a message, a log line is always written, whether or
34284 not this selector is set, but otherwise nothing is written at the start and end
34285 of connections unless this selector is enabled.
34286
34287 For TCP/IP connections to an Exim daemon, the current number of connections is
34288 included in the log message for each new connection, but note that the count is
34289 reset if the daemon is restarted.
34290 Also, because connections are closed (and the closure is logged) in
34291 subprocesses, the count may not include connections that have been closed but
34292 whose termination the daemon has not yet noticed. Thus, while it is possible to
34293 match up the opening and closing of connections in the log, the value of the
34294 logged counts may not be entirely accurate.
34295 .next
34296 .cindex "log" "SMTP transaction; incomplete"
34297 .cindex "SMTP" "logging incomplete transactions"
34298 &%smtp_incomplete_transaction%&: When a mail transaction is aborted by
34299 RSET, QUIT, loss of connection, or otherwise, the incident is logged,
34300 and the message sender plus any accepted recipients are included in the log
34301 line. This can provide evidence of dictionary attacks.
34302 .next
34303 .cindex "log" "non-MAIL SMTP sessions"
34304 .cindex "MAIL" "logging session without"
34305 &%smtp_no_mail%&: A line is written to the main log whenever an accepted SMTP
34306 connection terminates without having issued a MAIL command. This includes both
34307 the case when the connection is dropped, and the case when QUIT is used. It
34308 does not include cases where the connection is rejected right at the start (by
34309 an ACL, or because there are too many connections, or whatever). These cases
34310 already have their own log lines.
34311
34312 The log line that is written contains the identity of the client in the usual
34313 way, followed by D= and a time, which records the duration of the connection.
34314 If the connection was authenticated, this fact is logged exactly as it is for
34315 an incoming message, with an A= item. If the connection was encrypted, CV=,
34316 DN=, and X= items may appear as they do for an incoming message, controlled by
34317 the same logging options.
34318
34319 Finally, if any SMTP commands were issued during the connection, a C= item
34320 is added to the line, listing the commands that were used. For example,
34321 .code
34322 C=EHLO,QUIT
34323 .endd
34324 shows that the client issued QUIT straight after EHLO. If there were fewer
34325 than 20 commands, they are all listed. If there were more than 20 commands,
34326 the last 20 are listed, preceded by &"..."&. However, with the default
34327 setting of 10 for &%smtp_accep_max_nonmail%&, the connection will in any case
34328 have been aborted before 20 non-mail commands are processed.
34329 .next
34330 &%smtp_mailauth%&: A third subfield with the authenticated sender,
34331 colon-separated, is appended to the A= item for a message arrival or delivery
34332 log line, if an AUTH argument to the SMTP MAIL command (see &<<SECTauthparamail>>&)
34333 was accepted or used.
34334 .next
34335 .cindex "log" "SMTP protocol error"
34336 .cindex "SMTP" "logging protocol error"
34337 &%smtp_protocol_error%&: A log line is written for every SMTP protocol error
34338 encountered. Exim does not have perfect detection of all protocol errors
34339 because of transmission delays and the use of pipelining. If PIPELINING has
34340 been advertised to a client, an Exim server assumes that the client will use
34341 it, and therefore it does not count &"expected"& errors (for example, RCPT
34342 received after rejecting MAIL) as protocol errors.
34343 .next
34344 .cindex "SMTP" "logging syntax errors"
34345 .cindex "SMTP" "syntax errors; logging"
34346 .cindex "SMTP" "unknown command; logging"
34347 .cindex "log" "unknown SMTP command"
34348 .cindex "log" "SMTP syntax error"
34349 &%smtp_syntax_error%&: A log line is written for every SMTP syntax error
34350 encountered. An unrecognized command is treated as a syntax error. For an
34351 external connection, the host identity is given; for an internal connection
34352 using &%-bs%& the sender identification (normally the calling user) is given.
34353 .next
34354 .cindex "log" "subject"
34355 .cindex "subject, logging"
34356 &%subject%&: The subject of the message is added to the arrival log line,
34357 preceded by &"T="& (T for &"topic"&, since S is already used for &"size"&).
34358 Any MIME &"words"& in the subject are decoded. The &%print_topbitchars%& option
34359 specifies whether characters with values greater than 127 should be logged
34360 unchanged, or whether they should be rendered as escape sequences.
34361 .next
34362 .cindex "log" "certificate verification"
34363 &%tls_certificate_verified%&: An extra item is added to <= and => log lines
34364 when TLS is in use. The item is &`CV=yes`& if the peer's certificate was
34365 verified, and &`CV=no`& if not.
34366 .next
34367 .cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
34368 .cindex "TLS" "logging cipher"
34369 &%tls_cipher%&: When a message is sent or received over an encrypted
34370 connection, the cipher suite used is added to the log line, preceded by X=.
34371 .next
34372 .cindex "log" "TLS peer DN"
34373 .cindex "TLS" "logging peer DN"
34374 &%tls_peerdn%&: When a message is sent or received over an encrypted
34375 connection, and a certificate is supplied by the remote host, the peer DN is
34376 added to the log line, preceded by DN=.
34377 .next
34378 .cindex "log" "TLS SNI"
34379 .cindex "TLS" "logging SNI"
34380 &%tls_sni%&: When a message is received over an encrypted connection, and
34381 the remote host provided the Server Name Indication extension, the SNI is
34382 added to the log line, preceded by SNI=.
34383 .next
34384 .cindex "log" "DNS failure in list"
34385 &%unknown_in_list%&: This setting causes a log entry to be written when the
34386 result of a list match is failure because a DNS lookup failed.
34387 .endlist
34388
34389
34390 .section "Message log" "SECID260"
34391 .cindex "message" "log file for"
34392 .cindex "log" "message log; description of"
34393 .cindex "&_msglog_& directory"
34394 .oindex "&%preserve_message_logs%&"
34395 In addition to the general log files, Exim writes a log file for each message
34396 that it handles. The names of these per-message logs are the message ids, and
34397 they are kept in the &_msglog_& sub-directory of the spool directory. Each
34398 message log contains copies of the log lines that apply to the message. This
34399 makes it easier to inspect the status of an individual message without having
34400 to search the main log. A message log is deleted when processing of the message
34401 is complete, unless &%preserve_message_logs%& is set, but this should be used
34402 only with great care because they can fill up your disk very quickly.
34403
34404 On a heavily loaded system, it may be desirable to disable the use of
34405 per-message logs, in order to reduce disk I/O. This can be done by setting the
34406 &%message_logs%& option false.
34407 .ecindex IIDloggen
34408
34409
34410
34411
34412 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34413 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34414
34415 .chapter "Exim utilities" "CHAPutils"
34416 .scindex IIDutils "utilities"
34417 A number of utility scripts and programs are supplied with Exim and are
34418 described in this chapter. There is also the Exim Monitor, which is covered in
34419 the next chapter. The utilities described here are:
34420
34421 .itable none 0 0 3 7* left 15* left 40* left
34422 .irow &<<SECTfinoutwha>>& &'exiwhat'& &&&
34423 "list what Exim processes are doing"
34424 .irow &<<SECTgreptheque>>& &'exiqgrep'& "grep the queue"
34425 .irow &<<SECTsumtheque>>& &'exiqsumm'& "summarize the queue"
34426 .irow &<<SECTextspeinf>>& &'exigrep'& "search the main log"
34427 .irow &<<SECTexipick>>& &'exipick'& "select messages on &&&
34428 various criteria"
34429 .irow &<<SECTcyclogfil>>& &'exicyclog'& "cycle (rotate) log files"
34430 .irow &<<SECTmailstat>>& &'eximstats'& &&&
34431 "extract statistics from the log"
34432 .irow &<<SECTcheckaccess>>& &'exim_checkaccess'& &&&
34433 "check address acceptance from given IP"
34434 .irow &<<SECTdbmbuild>>& &'exim_dbmbuild'& "build a DBM file"
34435 .irow &<<SECTfinindret>>& &'exinext'& "extract retry information"
34436 .irow &<<SECThindatmai>>& &'exim_dumpdb'& "dump a hints database"
34437 .irow &<<SECThindatmai>>& &'exim_tidydb'& "clean up a hints database"
34438 .irow &<<SECThindatmai>>& &'exim_fixdb'& "patch a hints database"
34439 .irow &<<SECTmailboxmaint>>& &'exim_lock'& "lock a mailbox file"
34440 .endtable
34441
34442 Another utility that might be of use to sites with many MTAs is Tom Kistner's
34443 &'exilog'&. It provides log visualizations across multiple Exim servers. See
34444 &url(http://duncanthrax.net/exilog/) for details.
34445
34446
34447
34448
34449 .section "Finding out what Exim processes are doing (exiwhat)" "SECTfinoutwha"
34450 .cindex "&'exiwhat'&"
34451 .cindex "process, querying"
34452 .cindex "SIGUSR1"
34453 On operating systems that can restart a system call after receiving a signal
34454 (most modern OS), an Exim process responds to the SIGUSR1 signal by writing
34455 a line describing what it is doing to the file &_exim-process.info_& in the
34456 Exim spool directory. The &'exiwhat'& script sends the signal to all Exim
34457 processes it can find, having first emptied the file. It then waits for one
34458 second to allow the Exim processes to react before displaying the results. In
34459 order to run &'exiwhat'& successfully you have to have sufficient privilege to
34460 send the signal to the Exim processes, so it is normally run as root.
34461
34462 &*Warning*&: This is not an efficient process. It is intended for occasional
34463 use by system administrators. It is not sensible, for example, to set up a
34464 script that sends SIGUSR1 signals to Exim processes at short intervals.
34465
34466
34467 Unfortunately, the &'ps'& command that &'exiwhat'& uses to find Exim processes
34468 varies in different operating systems. Not only are different options used,
34469 but the format of the output is different. For this reason, there are some
34470 system configuration options that configure exactly how &'exiwhat'& works. If
34471 it doesn't seem to be working for you, check the following compile-time
34472 options:
34473 .display
34474 &`EXIWHAT_PS_CMD `& the command for running &'ps'&
34475 &`EXIWHAT_PS_ARG `& the argument for &'ps'&
34476 &`EXIWHAT_EGREP_ARG `& the argument for &'egrep'& to select from &'ps'& output
34477 &`EXIWHAT_KILL_ARG `& the argument for the &'kill'& command
34478 .endd
34479 An example of typical output from &'exiwhat'& is
34480 .code
34481 164 daemon: -q1h, listening on port 25
34482 10483 running queue: waiting for 0tAycK-0002ij-00 (10492)
34483 10492 delivering 0tAycK-0002ij-00 to mail.ref.example
34484 [10.19.42.42] (editor@ref.example)
34485 10592 handling incoming call from [192.168.243.242]
34486 10628 accepting a local non-SMTP message
34487 .endd
34488 The first number in the output line is the process number. The third line has
34489 been split here, in order to fit it on the page.
34490
34491
34492
34493 .section "Selective queue listing (exiqgrep)" "SECTgreptheque"
34494 .cindex "&'exiqgrep'&"
34495 .cindex "queue" "grepping"
34496 This utility is a Perl script contributed by Matt Hubbard. It runs
34497 .code
34498 exim -bpu
34499 .endd
34500 to obtain a queue listing with undelivered recipients only, and then greps the
34501 output to select messages that match given criteria. The following selection
34502 options are available:
34503
34504 .vlist
34505 .vitem &*-f*&&~<&'regex'&>
34506 Match the sender address using a case-insensitive search. The field that is
34507 tested is enclosed in angle brackets, so you can test for bounce messages with
34508 .code
34509 exiqgrep -f '^<>$'
34510 .endd
34511 .vitem &*-r*&&~<&'regex'&>
34512 Match a recipient address using a case-insensitve search. The field that is
34513 tested is not enclosed in angle brackets.
34514
34515 .vitem &*-s*&&~<&'regex'&>
34516 Match against the size field.
34517
34518 .vitem &*-y*&&~<&'seconds'&>
34519 Match messages that are younger than the given time.
34520
34521 .vitem &*-o*&&~<&'seconds'&>
34522 Match messages that are older than the given time.
34523
34524 .vitem &*-z*&
34525 Match only frozen messages.
34526
34527 .vitem &*-x*&
34528 Match only non-frozen messages.
34529 .endlist
34530
34531 The following options control the format of the output:
34532
34533 .vlist
34534 .vitem &*-c*&
34535 Display only the count of matching messages.
34536
34537 .vitem &*-l*&
34538 Long format &-- display the full message information as output by Exim. This is
34539 the default.
34540
34541 .vitem &*-i*&
34542 Display message ids only.
34543
34544 .vitem &*-b*&
34545 Brief format &-- one line per message.
34546
34547 .vitem &*-R*&
34548 Display messages in reverse order.
34549 .endlist
34550
34551 There is one more option, &%-h%&, which outputs a list of options.
34552
34553
34554
34555 .section "Summarizing the queue (exiqsumm)" "SECTsumtheque"
34556 .cindex "&'exiqsumm'&"
34557 .cindex "queue" "summary"
34558 The &'exiqsumm'& utility is a Perl script which reads the output of &`exim
34559 -bp`& and produces a summary of the messages on the queue. Thus, you use it by
34560 running a command such as
34561 .code
34562 exim -bp | exiqsumm
34563 .endd
34564 The output consists of one line for each domain that has messages waiting for
34565 it, as in the following example:
34566 .code
34567 3 2322 74m 66m msn.com.example
34568 .endd
34569 Each line lists the number of pending deliveries for a domain, their total
34570 volume, and the length of time that the oldest and the newest messages have
34571 been waiting. Note that the number of pending deliveries is greater than the
34572 number of messages when messages have more than one recipient.
34573
34574 A summary line is output at the end. By default the output is sorted on the
34575 domain name, but &'exiqsumm'& has the options &%-a%& and &%-c%&, which cause
34576 the output to be sorted by oldest message and by count of messages,
34577 respectively. There are also three options that split the messages for each
34578 domain into two or more subcounts: &%-b%& separates bounce messages, &%-f%&
34579 separates frozen messages, and &%-s%& separates messages according to their
34580 sender.
34581
34582 The output of &'exim -bp'& contains the original addresses in the message, so
34583 this also applies to the output from &'exiqsumm'&. No domains from addresses
34584 generated by aliasing or forwarding are included (unless the &%one_time%&
34585 option of the &(redirect)& router has been used to convert them into &"top
34586 level"& addresses).
34587
34588
34589
34590
34591 .section "Extracting specific information from the log (exigrep)" &&&
34592 "SECTextspeinf"
34593 .cindex "&'exigrep'&"
34594 .cindex "log" "extracts; grepping for"
34595 The &'exigrep'& utility is a Perl script that searches one or more main log
34596 files for entries that match a given pattern. When it finds a match, it
34597 extracts all the log entries for the relevant message, not just those that
34598 match the pattern. Thus, &'exigrep'& can extract complete log entries for a
34599 given message, or all mail for a given user, or for a given host, for example.
34600 The input files can be in Exim log format or syslog format.
34601 If a matching log line is not associated with a specific message, it is
34602 included in &'exigrep'&'s output without any additional lines. The usage is:
34603 .display
34604 &`exigrep [-t<`&&'n'&&`>] [-I] [-l] [-v] <`&&'pattern'&&`> [<`&&'log file'&&`>] ...`&
34605 .endd
34606 If no log file names are given on the command line, the standard input is read.
34607
34608 The &%-t%& argument specifies a number of seconds. It adds an additional
34609 condition for message selection. Messages that are complete are shown only if
34610 they spent more than <&'n'&> seconds on the queue.
34611
34612 By default, &'exigrep'& does case-insensitive matching. The &%-I%& option
34613 makes it case-sensitive. This may give a performance improvement when searching
34614 large log files. Without &%-I%&, the Perl pattern matches use Perl's &`/i`&
34615 option; with &%-I%& they do not. In both cases it is possible to change the
34616 case sensitivity within the pattern by using &`(?i)`& or &`(?-i)`&.
34617
34618 The &%-l%& option means &"literal"&, that is, treat all characters in the
34619 pattern as standing for themselves. Otherwise the pattern must be a Perl
34620 regular expression.
34621
34622 The &%-v%& option inverts the matching condition. That is, a line is selected
34623 if it does &'not'& match the pattern.
34624
34625 If the location of a &'zcat'& command is known from the definition of
34626 ZCAT_COMMAND in &_Local/Makefile_&, &'exigrep'& automatically passes any file
34627 whose name ends in COMPRESS_SUFFIX through &'zcat'& as it searches it.
34628
34629
34630 .section "Selecting messages by various criteria (exipick)" "SECTexipick"
34631 .cindex "&'exipick'&"
34632 John Jetmore's &'exipick'& utility is included in the Exim distribution. It
34633 lists messages from the queue according to a variety of criteria. For details
34634 of &'exipick'&'s facilities, visit the web page at
34635 &url(http://www.exim.org/eximwiki/ToolExipickManPage) or run &'exipick'& with
34636 the &%--help%& option.
34637
34638
34639 .section "Cycling log files (exicyclog)" "SECTcyclogfil"
34640 .cindex "log" "cycling local files"
34641 .cindex "cycling logs"
34642 .cindex "&'exicyclog'&"
34643 The &'exicyclog'& script can be used to cycle (rotate) &'mainlog'& and
34644 &'rejectlog'& files. This is not necessary if only syslog is being used, or if
34645 you are using log files with datestamps in their names (see section
34646 &<<SECTdatlogfil>>&). Some operating systems have their own standard mechanisms
34647 for log cycling, and these can be used instead of &'exicyclog'& if preferred.
34648 There are two command line options for &'exicyclog'&:
34649 .ilist
34650 &%-k%& <&'count'&> specifies the number of log files to keep, overriding the
34651 default that is set when Exim is built. The default default is 10.
34652 .next
34653 &%-l%& <&'path'&> specifies the log file path, in the same format as Exim's
34654 &%log_file_path%& option (for example, &`/var/log/exim_%slog`&), again
34655 overriding the script's default, which is to find the setting from Exim's
34656 configuration.
34657 .endlist
34658
34659 Each time &'exicyclog'& is run the file names get &"shuffled down"& by one. If
34660 the main log file name is &_mainlog_& (the default) then when &'exicyclog'& is
34661 run &_mainlog_& becomes &_mainlog.01_&, the previous &_mainlog.01_& becomes
34662 &_mainlog.02_& and so on, up to the limit that is set in the script or by the
34663 &%-k%& option. Log files whose numbers exceed the limit are discarded. Reject
34664 logs are handled similarly.
34665
34666 If the limit is greater than 99, the script uses 3-digit numbers such as
34667 &_mainlog.001_&, &_mainlog.002_&, etc. If you change from a number less than 99
34668 to one that is greater, or &'vice versa'&, you will have to fix the names of
34669 any existing log files.
34670
34671 If no &_mainlog_& file exists, the script does nothing. Files that &"drop off"&
34672 the end are deleted. All files with numbers greater than 01 are compressed,
34673 using a compression command which is configured by the COMPRESS_COMMAND
34674 setting in &_Local/Makefile_&. It is usual to run &'exicyclog'& daily from a
34675 root &%crontab%& entry of the form
34676 .code
34677 1 0 * * * su exim -c /usr/exim/bin/exicyclog
34678 .endd
34679 assuming you have used the name &"exim"& for the Exim user. You can run
34680 &'exicyclog'& as root if you wish, but there is no need.
34681
34682
34683
34684 .section "Mail statistics (eximstats)" "SECTmailstat"
34685 .cindex "statistics"
34686 .cindex "&'eximstats'&"
34687 A Perl script called &'eximstats'& is provided for extracting statistical
34688 information from log files. The output is either plain text, or HTML.
34689 Exim log files are also supported by the &'Lire'& system produced by the
34690 LogReport Foundation &url(http://www.logreport.org).
34691
34692 The &'eximstats'& script has been hacked about quite a bit over time. The
34693 latest version is the result of some extensive revision by Steve Campbell. A
34694 lot of information is given by default, but there are options for suppressing
34695 various parts of it. Following any options, the arguments to the script are a
34696 list of files, which should be main log files. For example:
34697 .code
34698 eximstats -nr /var/spool/exim/log/mainlog.01
34699 .endd
34700 By default, &'eximstats'& extracts information about the number and volume of
34701 messages received from or delivered to various hosts. The information is sorted
34702 both by message count and by volume, and the top fifty hosts in each category
34703 are listed on the standard output. Similar information, based on email
34704 addresses or domains instead of hosts can be requested by means of various
34705 options. For messages delivered and received locally, similar statistics are
34706 also produced per user.
34707
34708 The output also includes total counts and statistics about delivery errors, and
34709 histograms showing the number of messages received and deliveries made in each
34710 hour of the day. A delivery with more than one address in its envelope (for
34711 example, an SMTP transaction with more than one RCPT command) is counted
34712 as a single delivery by &'eximstats'&.
34713
34714 Though normally more deliveries than receipts are reported (as messages may
34715 have multiple recipients), it is possible for &'eximstats'& to report more
34716 messages received than delivered, even though the queue is empty at the start
34717 and end of the period in question. If an incoming message contains no valid
34718 recipients, no deliveries are recorded for it. A bounce message is handled as
34719 an entirely separate message.
34720
34721 &'eximstats'& always outputs a grand total summary giving the volume and number
34722 of messages received and deliveries made, and the number of hosts involved in
34723 each case. It also outputs the number of messages that were delayed (that is,
34724 not completely delivered at the first attempt), and the number that had at
34725 least one address that failed.
34726
34727 The remainder of the output is in sections that can be independently disabled
34728 or modified by various options. It consists of a summary of deliveries by
34729 transport, histograms of messages received and delivered per time interval
34730 (default per hour), information about the time messages spent on the queue,
34731 a list of relayed messages, lists of the top fifty sending hosts, local
34732 senders, destination hosts, and destination local users by count and by volume,
34733 and a list of delivery errors that occurred.
34734
34735 The relay information lists messages that were actually relayed, that is, they
34736 came from a remote host and were directly delivered to some other remote host,
34737 without being processed (for example, for aliasing or forwarding) locally.
34738
34739 There are quite a few options for &'eximstats'& to control exactly what it
34740 outputs. These are documented in the Perl script itself, and can be extracted
34741 by running the command &(perldoc)& on the script. For example:
34742 .code
34743 perldoc /usr/exim/bin/eximstats
34744 .endd
34745
34746 .section "Checking access policy (exim_checkaccess)" "SECTcheckaccess"
34747 .cindex "&'exim_checkaccess'&"
34748 .cindex "policy control" "checking access"
34749 .cindex "checking access"
34750 The &%-bh%& command line argument allows you to run a fake SMTP session with
34751 debugging output, in order to check what Exim is doing when it is applying
34752 policy controls to incoming SMTP mail. However, not everybody is sufficiently
34753 familiar with the SMTP protocol to be able to make full use of &%-bh%&, and
34754 sometimes you just want to answer the question &"Does this address have
34755 access?"& without bothering with any further details.
34756
34757 The &'exim_checkaccess'& utility is a &"packaged"& version of &%-bh%&. It takes
34758 two arguments, an IP address and an email address:
34759 .code
34760 exim_checkaccess 10.9.8.7 A.User@a.domain.example
34761 .endd
34762 The utility runs a call to Exim with the &%-bh%& option, to test whether the
34763 given email address would be accepted in a RCPT command in a TCP/IP
34764 connection from the host with the given IP address. The output of the utility
34765 is either the word &"accepted"&, or the SMTP error response, for example:
34766 .code
34767 Rejected:
34768 550 Relay not permitted
34769 .endd
34770 When running this test, the utility uses &`<>`& as the envelope sender address
34771 for the MAIL command, but you can change this by providing additional
34772 options. These are passed directly to the Exim command. For example, to specify
34773 that the test is to be run with the sender address &'himself@there.example'&
34774 you can use:
34775 .code
34776 exim_checkaccess 10.9.8.7 A.User@a.domain.example \
34777 -f himself@there.example
34778 .endd
34779 Note that these additional Exim command line items must be given after the two
34780 mandatory arguments.
34781
34782 Because the &%exim_checkaccess%& uses &%-bh%&, it does not perform callouts
34783 while running its checks. You can run checks that include callouts by using
34784 &%-bhc%&, but this is not yet available in a &"packaged"& form.
34785
34786
34787
34788 .section "Making DBM files (exim_dbmbuild)" "SECTdbmbuild"
34789 .cindex "DBM" "building dbm files"
34790 .cindex "building DBM files"
34791 .cindex "&'exim_dbmbuild'&"
34792 .cindex "lower casing"
34793 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
34794 The &'exim_dbmbuild'& program reads an input file containing keys and data in
34795 the format used by the &(lsearch)& lookup (see section
34796 &<<SECTsinglekeylookups>>&). It writes a DBM file using the lower-cased alias
34797 names as keys and the remainder of the information as data. The lower-casing
34798 can be prevented by calling the program with the &%-nolc%& option.
34799
34800 A terminating zero is included as part of the key string. This is expected by
34801 the &(dbm)& lookup type. However, if the option &%-nozero%& is given,
34802 &'exim_dbmbuild'& creates files without terminating zeroes in either the key
34803 strings or the data strings. The &(dbmnz)& lookup type can be used with such
34804 files.
34805
34806 The program requires two arguments: the name of the input file (which can be a
34807 single hyphen to indicate the standard input), and the name of the output file.
34808 It creates the output under a temporary name, and then renames it if all went
34809 well.
34810
34811 .cindex "USE_DB"
34812 If the native DB interface is in use (USE_DB is set in a compile-time
34813 configuration file &-- this is common in free versions of Unix) the two file
34814 names must be different, because in this mode the Berkeley DB functions create
34815 a single output file using exactly the name given. For example,
34816 .code
34817 exim_dbmbuild /etc/aliases /etc/aliases.db
34818 .endd
34819 reads the system alias file and creates a DBM version of it in
34820 &_/etc/aliases.db_&.
34821
34822 In systems that use the &'ndbm'& routines (mostly proprietary versions of
34823 Unix), two files are used, with the suffixes &_.dir_& and &_.pag_&. In this
34824 environment, the suffixes are added to the second argument of
34825 &'exim_dbmbuild'&, so it can be the same as the first. This is also the case
34826 when the Berkeley functions are used in compatibility mode (though this is not
34827 recommended), because in that case it adds a &_.db_& suffix to the file name.
34828
34829 If a duplicate key is encountered, the program outputs a warning, and when it
34830 finishes, its return code is 1 rather than zero, unless the &%-noduperr%&
34831 option is used. By default, only the first of a set of duplicates is used &--
34832 this makes it compatible with &(lsearch)& lookups. There is an option
34833 &%-lastdup%& which causes it to use the data for the last duplicate instead.
34834 There is also an option &%-nowarn%&, which stops it listing duplicate keys to
34835 &%stderr%&. For other errors, where it doesn't actually make a new file, the
34836 return code is 2.
34837
34838
34839
34840
34841 .section "Finding individual retry times (exinext)" "SECTfinindret"
34842 .cindex "retry" "times"
34843 .cindex "&'exinext'&"
34844 A utility called &'exinext'& (mostly a Perl script) provides the ability to
34845 fish specific information out of the retry database. Given a mail domain (or a
34846 complete address), it looks up the hosts for that domain, and outputs any retry
34847 information for the hosts or for the domain. At present, the retry information
34848 is obtained by running &'exim_dumpdb'& (see below) and post-processing the
34849 output. For example:
34850 .code
34851 $ exinext piglet@milne.fict.example
34852 kanga.milne.example:192.168.8.1 error 146: Connection refused
34853 first failed: 21-Feb-1996 14:57:34
34854 last tried: 21-Feb-1996 14:57:34
34855 next try at: 21-Feb-1996 15:02:34
34856 roo.milne.example:192.168.8.3 error 146: Connection refused
34857 first failed: 20-Jan-1996 13:12:08
34858 last tried: 21-Feb-1996 11:42:03
34859 next try at: 21-Feb-1996 19:42:03
34860 past final cutoff time
34861 .endd
34862 You can also give &'exinext'& a local part, without a domain, and it
34863 will give any retry information for that local part in your default domain.
34864 A message id can be used to obtain retry information pertaining to a specific
34865 message. This exists only when an attempt to deliver a message to a remote host
34866 suffers a message-specific error (see section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>&).
34867 &'exinext'& is not particularly efficient, but then it is not expected to be
34868 run very often.
34869
34870 The &'exinext'& utility calls Exim to find out information such as the location
34871 of the spool directory. The utility has &%-C%& and &%-D%& options, which are
34872 passed on to the &'exim'& commands. The first specifies an alternate Exim
34873 configuration file, and the second sets macros for use within the configuration
34874 file. These features are mainly to help in testing, but might also be useful in
34875 environments where more than one configuration file is in use.
34876
34877
34878
34879 .section "Hints database maintenance" "SECThindatmai"
34880 .cindex "hints database" "maintenance"
34881 .cindex "maintaining Exim's hints database"
34882 Three utility programs are provided for maintaining the DBM files that Exim
34883 uses to contain its delivery hint information. Each program requires two
34884 arguments. The first specifies the name of Exim's spool directory, and the
34885 second is the name of the database it is to operate on. These are as follows:
34886
34887 .ilist
34888 &'retry'&: the database of retry information
34889 .next
34890 &'wait-'&<&'transport name'&>: databases of information about messages waiting
34891 for remote hosts
34892 .next
34893 &'callout'&: the callout cache
34894 .next
34895 &'ratelimit'&: the data for implementing the ratelimit ACL condition
34896 .next
34897 &'misc'&: other hints data
34898 .endlist
34899
34900 The &'misc'& database is used for
34901
34902 .ilist
34903 Serializing ETRN runs (when &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& is set)
34904 .next
34905 Serializing delivery to a specific host (when &%serialize_hosts%& is set in an
34906 &(smtp)& transport)
34907 .endlist
34908
34909
34910
34911 .section "exim_dumpdb" "SECID261"
34912 .cindex "&'exim_dumpdb'&"
34913 The entire contents of a database are written to the standard output by the
34914 &'exim_dumpdb'& program, which has no options or arguments other than the
34915 spool and database names. For example, to dump the retry database:
34916 .code
34917 exim_dumpdb /var/spool/exim retry
34918 .endd
34919 Two lines of output are produced for each entry:
34920 .code
34921 T:mail.ref.example:192.168.242.242 146 77 Connection refused
34922 31-Oct-1995 12:00:12 02-Nov-1995 12:21:39 02-Nov-1995 20:21:39 *
34923 .endd
34924 The first item on the first line is the key of the record. It starts with one
34925 of the letters R, or T, depending on whether it refers to a routing or
34926 transport retry. For a local delivery, the next part is the local address; for
34927 a remote delivery it is the name of the remote host, followed by its failing IP
34928 address (unless &%retry_include_ip_address%& is set false on the &(smtp)&
34929 transport). If the remote port is not the standard one (port 25), it is added
34930 to the IP address. Then there follows an error code, an additional error code,
34931 and a textual description of the error.
34932
34933 The three times on the second line are the time of first failure, the time of
34934 the last delivery attempt, and the computed time for the next attempt. The line
34935 ends with an asterisk if the cutoff time for the last retry rule has been
34936 exceeded.
34937
34938 Each output line from &'exim_dumpdb'& for the &'wait-xxx'& databases
34939 consists of a host name followed by a list of ids for messages that are or were
34940 waiting to be delivered to that host. If there are a very large number for any
34941 one host, continuation records, with a sequence number added to the host name,
34942 may be seen. The data in these records is often out of date, because a message
34943 may be routed to several alternative hosts, and Exim makes no effort to keep
34944 cross-references.
34945
34946
34947
34948 .section "exim_tidydb" "SECID262"
34949 .cindex "&'exim_tidydb'&"
34950 The &'exim_tidydb'& utility program is used to tidy up the contents of a hints
34951 database. If run with no options, it removes all records that are more than 30
34952 days old. The age is calculated from the date and time that the record was last
34953 updated. Note that, in the case of the retry database, it is &'not'& the time
34954 since the first delivery failure. Information about a host that has been down
34955 for more than 30 days will remain in the database, provided that the record is
34956 updated sufficiently often.
34957
34958 The cutoff date can be altered by means of the &%-t%& option, which must be
34959 followed by a time. For example, to remove all records older than a week from
34960 the retry database:
34961 .code
34962 exim_tidydb -t 7d /var/spool/exim retry
34963 .endd
34964 Both the &'wait-xxx'& and &'retry'& databases contain items that involve
34965 message ids. In the former these appear as data in records keyed by host &--
34966 they were messages that were waiting for that host &-- and in the latter they
34967 are the keys for retry information for messages that have suffered certain
34968 types of error. When &'exim_tidydb'& is run, a check is made to ensure that
34969 message ids in database records are those of messages that are still on the
34970 queue. Message ids for messages that no longer exist are removed from
34971 &'wait-xxx'& records, and if this leaves any records empty, they are deleted.
34972 For the &'retry'& database, records whose keys are non-existent message ids are
34973 removed. The &'exim_tidydb'& utility outputs comments on the standard output
34974 whenever it removes information from the database.
34975
34976 Certain records are automatically removed by Exim when they are no longer
34977 needed, but others are not. For example, if all the MX hosts for a domain are
34978 down, a retry record is created for each one. If the primary MX host comes back
34979 first, its record is removed when Exim successfully delivers to it, but the
34980 records for the others remain because Exim has not tried to use those hosts.
34981
34982 It is important, therefore, to run &'exim_tidydb'& periodically on all the
34983 hints databases. You should do this at a quiet time of day, because it requires
34984 a database to be locked (and therefore inaccessible to Exim) while it does its
34985 work. Removing records from a DBM file does not normally make the file smaller,
34986 but all the common DBM libraries are able to re-use the space that is released.
34987 After an initial phase of increasing in size, the databases normally reach a
34988 point at which they no longer get any bigger, as long as they are regularly
34989 tidied.
34990
34991 &*Warning*&: If you never run &'exim_tidydb'&, the space used by the hints
34992 databases is likely to keep on increasing.
34993
34994
34995
34996
34997 .section "exim_fixdb" "SECID263"
34998 .cindex "&'exim_fixdb'&"
34999 The &'exim_fixdb'& program is a utility for interactively modifying databases.
35000 Its main use is for testing Exim, but it might also be occasionally useful for
35001 getting round problems in a live system. It has no options, and its interface
35002 is somewhat crude. On entry, it prompts for input with a right angle-bracket. A
35003 key of a database record can then be entered, and the data for that record is
35004 displayed.
35005
35006 If &"d"& is typed at the next prompt, the entire record is deleted. For all
35007 except the &'retry'& database, that is the only operation that can be carried
35008 out. For the &'retry'& database, each field is output preceded by a number, and
35009 data for individual fields can be changed by typing the field number followed
35010 by new data, for example:
35011 .code
35012 > 4 951102:1000
35013 .endd
35014 resets the time of the next delivery attempt. Time values are given as a
35015 sequence of digit pairs for year, month, day, hour, and minute. Colons can be
35016 used as optional separators.
35017
35018
35019
35020
35021 .section "Mailbox maintenance (exim_lock)" "SECTmailboxmaint"
35022 .cindex "mailbox" "maintenance"
35023 .cindex "&'exim_lock'&"
35024 .cindex "locking mailboxes"
35025 The &'exim_lock'& utility locks a mailbox file using the same algorithm as
35026 Exim. For a discussion of locking issues, see section &<<SECTopappend>>&.
35027 &'Exim_lock'& can be used to prevent any modification of a mailbox by Exim or
35028 a user agent while investigating a problem. The utility requires the name of
35029 the file as its first argument. If the locking is successful, the second
35030 argument is run as a command (using C's &[system()]& function); if there is no
35031 second argument, the value of the SHELL environment variable is used; if this
35032 is unset or empty, &_/bin/sh_& is run. When the command finishes, the mailbox
35033 is unlocked and the utility ends. The following options are available:
35034
35035 .vlist
35036 .vitem &%-fcntl%&
35037 Use &[fcntl()]& locking on the open mailbox.
35038
35039 .vitem &%-flock%&
35040 Use &[flock()]& locking on the open mailbox, provided the operating system
35041 supports it.
35042
35043 .vitem &%-interval%&
35044 This must be followed by a number, which is a number of seconds; it sets the
35045 interval to sleep between retries (default 3).
35046
35047 .vitem &%-lockfile%&
35048 Create a lock file before opening the mailbox.
35049
35050 .vitem &%-mbx%&
35051 Lock the mailbox using MBX rules.
35052
35053 .vitem &%-q%&
35054 Suppress verification output.
35055
35056 .vitem &%-retries%&
35057 This must be followed by a number; it sets the number of times to try to get
35058 the lock (default 10).
35059
35060 .vitem &%-restore_time%&
35061 This option causes &%exim_lock%& to restore the modified and read times to the
35062 locked file before exiting. This allows you to access a locked mailbox (for
35063 example, to take a backup copy) without disturbing the times that the user
35064 subsequently sees.
35065
35066 .vitem &%-timeout%&
35067 This must be followed by a number, which is a number of seconds; it sets a
35068 timeout to be used with a blocking &[fcntl()]& lock. If it is not set (the
35069 default), a non-blocking call is used.
35070
35071 .vitem &%-v%&
35072 Generate verbose output.
35073 .endlist
35074
35075 If none of &%-fcntl%&, &%-flock%&, &%-lockfile%& or &%-mbx%& are given, the
35076 default is to create a lock file and also to use &[fcntl()]& locking on the
35077 mailbox, which is the same as Exim's default. The use of &%-flock%& or
35078 &%-fcntl%& requires that the file be writeable; the use of &%-lockfile%&
35079 requires that the directory containing the file be writeable. Locking by lock
35080 file does not last for ever; Exim assumes that a lock file is expired if it is
35081 more than 30 minutes old.
35082
35083 The &%-mbx%& option can be used with either or both of &%-fcntl%& or
35084 &%-flock%&. It assumes &%-fcntl%& by default. MBX locking causes a shared lock
35085 to be taken out on the open mailbox, and an exclusive lock on the file
35086 &_/tmp/.n.m_& where &'n'& and &'m'& are the device number and inode
35087 number of the mailbox file. When the locking is released, if an exclusive lock
35088 can be obtained for the mailbox, the file in &_/tmp_& is deleted.
35089
35090 The default output contains verification of the locking that takes place. The
35091 &%-v%& option causes some additional information to be given. The &%-q%& option
35092 suppresses all output except error messages.
35093
35094 A command such as
35095 .code
35096 exim_lock /var/spool/mail/spqr
35097 .endd
35098 runs an interactive shell while the file is locked, whereas
35099 .display
35100 &`exim_lock -q /var/spool/mail/spqr <<End`&
35101 <&'some commands'&>
35102 &`End`&
35103 .endd
35104 runs a specific non-interactive sequence of commands while the file is locked,
35105 suppressing all verification output. A single command can be run by a command
35106 such as
35107 .code
35108 exim_lock -q /var/spool/mail/spqr \
35109 "cp /var/spool/mail/spqr /some/where"
35110 .endd
35111 Note that if a command is supplied, it must be entirely contained within the
35112 second argument &-- hence the quotes.
35113 .ecindex IIDutils
35114
35115
35116 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35117 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35118
35119 .chapter "The Exim monitor" "CHAPeximon"
35120 .scindex IIDeximon "Exim monitor" "description"
35121 .cindex "X-windows"
35122 .cindex "&'eximon'&"
35123 .cindex "Local/eximon.conf"
35124 .cindex "&_exim_monitor/EDITME_&"
35125 The Exim monitor is an application which displays in an X window information
35126 about the state of Exim's queue and what Exim is doing. An admin user can
35127 perform certain operations on messages from this GUI interface; however all
35128 such facilities are also available from the command line, and indeed, the
35129 monitor itself makes use of the command line to perform any actions requested.
35130
35131
35132
35133 .section "Running the monitor" "SECID264"
35134 The monitor is started by running the script called &'eximon'&. This is a shell
35135 script that sets up a number of environment variables, and then runs the
35136 binary called &_eximon.bin_&. The default appearance of the monitor window can
35137 be changed by editing the &_Local/eximon.conf_& file created by editing
35138 &_exim_monitor/EDITME_&. Comments in that file describe what the various
35139 parameters are for.
35140
35141 The parameters that get built into the &'eximon'& script can be overridden for
35142 a particular invocation by setting up environment variables of the same names,
35143 preceded by &`EXIMON_`&. For example, a shell command such as
35144 .code
35145 EXIMON_LOG_DEPTH=400 eximon
35146 .endd
35147 (in a Bourne-compatible shell) runs &'eximon'& with an overriding setting of
35148 the LOG_DEPTH parameter. If EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH is set in the environment, it
35149 overrides the Exim log file configuration. This makes it possible to have
35150 &'eximon'& tailing log data that is written to syslog, provided that MAIL.INFO
35151 syslog messages are routed to a file on the local host.
35152
35153 X resources can be used to change the appearance of the window in the normal
35154 way. For example, a resource setting of the form
35155 .code
35156 Eximon*background: gray94
35157 .endd
35158 changes the colour of the background to light grey rather than white. The
35159 stripcharts are drawn with both the data lines and the reference lines in
35160 black. This means that the reference lines are not visible when on top of the
35161 data. However, their colour can be changed by setting a resource called
35162 &"highlight"& (an odd name, but that's what the Athena stripchart widget uses).
35163 For example, if your X server is running Unix, you could set up lighter
35164 reference lines in the stripcharts by obeying
35165 .code
35166 xrdb -merge <<End
35167 Eximon*highlight: gray
35168 End
35169 .endd
35170 .cindex "admin user"
35171 In order to see the contents of messages on the queue, and to operate on them,
35172 &'eximon'& must either be run as root or by an admin user.
35173
35174 The command-line parameters of &'eximon'& are passed to &_eximon.bin_& and may
35175 contain X11 resource parameters interpreted by the X11 library. In addition,
35176 if the first parameter starts with the string "gdb" then it is removed and the
35177 binary is invoked under gdb (the parameter is used as the gdb command-name, so
35178 versioned variants of gdb can be invoked).
35179
35180 The monitor's window is divided into three parts. The first contains one or
35181 more stripcharts and two action buttons, the second contains a &"tail"& of the
35182 main log file, and the third is a display of the queue of messages awaiting
35183 delivery, with two more action buttons. The following sections describe these
35184 different parts of the display.
35185
35186
35187
35188
35189 .section "The stripcharts" "SECID265"
35190 .cindex "stripchart"
35191 The first stripchart is always a count of messages on the queue. Its name can
35192 be configured by setting QUEUE_STRIPCHART_NAME in the
35193 &_Local/eximon.conf_& file. The remaining stripcharts are defined in the
35194 configuration script by regular expression matches on log file entries, making
35195 it possible to display, for example, counts of messages delivered to certain
35196 hosts or using certain transports. The supplied defaults display counts of
35197 received and delivered messages, and of local and SMTP deliveries. The default
35198 period between stripchart updates is one minute; this can be adjusted by a
35199 parameter in the &_Local/eximon.conf_& file.
35200
35201 The stripchart displays rescale themselves automatically as the value they are
35202 displaying changes. There are always 10 horizontal lines in each chart; the
35203 title string indicates the value of each division when it is greater than one.
35204 For example, &"x2"& means that each division represents a value of 2.
35205
35206 It is also possible to have a stripchart which shows the percentage fullness of
35207 a particular disk partition, which is useful when local deliveries are confined
35208 to a single partition.
35209
35210 .cindex "&%statvfs%& function"
35211 This relies on the availability of the &[statvfs()]& function or equivalent in
35212 the operating system. Most, but not all versions of Unix that support Exim have
35213 this. For this particular stripchart, the top of the chart always represents
35214 100%, and the scale is given as &"x10%"&. This chart is configured by setting
35215 SIZE_STRIPCHART and (optionally) SIZE_STRIPCHART_NAME in the
35216 &_Local/eximon.conf_& file.
35217
35218
35219
35220
35221 .section "Main action buttons" "SECID266"
35222 .cindex "size" "of monitor window"
35223 .cindex "Exim monitor" "window size"
35224 .cindex "window size"
35225 Below the stripcharts there is an action button for quitting the monitor. Next
35226 to this is another button marked &"Size"&. They are placed here so that
35227 shrinking the window to its default minimum size leaves just the queue count
35228 stripchart and these two buttons visible. Pressing the &"Size"& button causes
35229 the window to expand to its maximum size, unless it is already at the maximum,
35230 in which case it is reduced to its minimum.
35231
35232 When expanding to the maximum, if the window cannot be fully seen where it
35233 currently is, it is moved back to where it was the last time it was at full
35234 size. When it is expanding from its minimum size, the old position is
35235 remembered, and next time it is reduced to the minimum it is moved back there.
35236
35237 The idea is that you can keep a reduced window just showing one or two
35238 stripcharts at a convenient place on your screen, easily expand it to show
35239 the full window when required, and just as easily put it back to what it was.
35240 The idea is copied from what the &'twm'& window manager does for its
35241 &'f.fullzoom'& action. The minimum size of the window can be changed by setting
35242 the MIN_HEIGHT and MIN_WIDTH values in &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
35243
35244 Normally, the monitor starts up with the window at its full size, but it can be
35245 built so that it starts up with the window at its smallest size, by setting
35246 START_SMALL=yes in &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
35247
35248
35249
35250 .section "The log display" "SECID267"
35251 .cindex "log" "tail of; in monitor"
35252 The second section of the window is an area in which a display of the tail of
35253 the main log is maintained.
35254 To save space on the screen, the timestamp on each log line is shortened by
35255 removing the date and, if &%log_timezone%& is set, the timezone.
35256 The log tail is not available when the only destination for logging data is
35257 syslog, unless the syslog lines are routed to a local file whose name is passed
35258 to &'eximon'& via the EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH environment variable.
35259
35260 The log sub-window has a scroll bar at its lefthand side which can be used to
35261 move back to look at earlier text, and the up and down arrow keys also have a
35262 scrolling effect. The amount of log that is kept depends on the setting of
35263 LOG_BUFFER in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, which specifies the amount of memory
35264 to use. When this is full, the earlier 50% of data is discarded &-- this is
35265 much more efficient than throwing it away line by line. The sub-window also has
35266 a horizontal scroll bar for accessing the ends of long log lines. This is the
35267 only means of horizontal scrolling; the right and left arrow keys are not
35268 available. Text can be cut from this part of the window using the mouse in the
35269 normal way. The size of this subwindow is controlled by parameters in the
35270 configuration file &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
35271
35272 Searches of the text in the log window can be carried out by means of the ^R
35273 and ^S keystrokes, which default to a reverse and a forward search,
35274 respectively. The search covers only the text that is displayed in the window.
35275 It cannot go further back up the log.
35276
35277 The point from which the search starts is indicated by a caret marker. This is
35278 normally at the end of the text in the window, but can be positioned explicitly
35279 by pointing and clicking with the left mouse button, and is moved automatically
35280 by a successful search. If new text arrives in the window when it is scrolled
35281 back, the caret remains where it is, but if the window is not scrolled back,
35282 the caret is moved to the end of the new text.
35283
35284 Pressing ^R or ^S pops up a window into which the search text can be typed.
35285 There are buttons for selecting forward or reverse searching, for carrying out
35286 the search, and for cancelling. If the &"Search"& button is pressed, the search
35287 happens and the window remains so that further searches can be done. If the
35288 &"Return"& key is pressed, a single search is done and the window is closed. If
35289 ^C is typed the search is cancelled.
35290
35291 The searching facility is implemented using the facilities of the Athena text
35292 widget. By default this pops up a window containing both &"search"& and
35293 &"replace"& options. In order to suppress the unwanted &"replace"& portion for
35294 eximon, a modified version of the &%TextPop%& widget is distributed with Exim.
35295 However, the linkers in BSDI and HP-UX seem unable to handle an externally
35296 provided version of &%TextPop%& when the remaining parts of the text widget
35297 come from the standard libraries. The compile-time option EXIMON_TEXTPOP can be
35298 unset to cut out the modified &%TextPop%&, making it possible to build Eximon
35299 on these systems, at the expense of having unwanted items in the search popup
35300 window.
35301
35302
35303
35304 .section "The queue display" "SECID268"
35305 .cindex "queue" "display in monitor"
35306 The bottom section of the monitor window contains a list of all messages that
35307 are on the queue, which includes those currently being received or delivered,
35308 as well as those awaiting delivery. The size of this subwindow is controlled by
35309 parameters in the configuration file &_Local/eximon.conf_&, and the frequency
35310 at which it is updated is controlled by another parameter in the same file &--
35311 the default is 5 minutes, since queue scans can be quite expensive. However,
35312 there is an &"Update"& action button just above the display which can be used
35313 to force an update of the queue display at any time.
35314
35315 When a host is down for some time, a lot of pending mail can build up for it,
35316 and this can make it hard to deal with other messages on the queue. To help
35317 with this situation there is a button next to &"Update"& called &"Hide"&. If
35318 pressed, a dialogue box called &"Hide addresses ending with"& is put up. If you
35319 type anything in here and press &"Return"&, the text is added to a chain of
35320 such texts, and if every undelivered address in a message matches at least one
35321 of the texts, the message is not displayed.
35322
35323 If there is an address that does not match any of the texts, all the addresses
35324 are displayed as normal. The matching happens on the ends of addresses so, for
35325 example, &'cam.ac.uk'& specifies all addresses in Cambridge, while
35326 &'xxx@foo.com.example'& specifies just one specific address. When any hiding
35327 has been set up, a button called &"Unhide"& is displayed. If pressed, it
35328 cancels all hiding. Also, to ensure that hidden messages do not get forgotten,
35329 a hide request is automatically cancelled after one hour.
35330
35331 While the dialogue box is displayed, you can't press any buttons or do anything
35332 else to the monitor window. For this reason, if you want to cut text from the
35333 queue display to use in the dialogue box, you have to do the cutting before
35334 pressing the &"Hide"& button.
35335
35336 The queue display contains, for each unhidden queued message, the length of
35337 time it has been on the queue, the size of the message, the message id, the
35338 message sender, and the first undelivered recipient, all on one line. If it is
35339 a bounce message, the sender is shown as &"<>"&. If there is more than one
35340 recipient to which the message has not yet been delivered, subsequent ones are
35341 listed on additional lines, up to a maximum configured number, following which
35342 an ellipsis is displayed. Recipients that have already received the message are
35343 not shown.
35344
35345 .cindex "frozen messages" "display"
35346 If a message is frozen, an asterisk is displayed at the left-hand side.
35347
35348 The queue display has a vertical scroll bar, and can also be scrolled by means
35349 of the arrow keys. Text can be cut from it using the mouse in the normal way.
35350 The text searching facilities, as described above for the log window, are also
35351 available, but the caret is always moved to the end of the text when the queue
35352 display is updated.
35353
35354
35355
35356 .section "The queue menu" "SECID269"
35357 .cindex "queue" "menu in monitor"
35358 If the &%shift%& key is held down and the left button is clicked when the mouse
35359 pointer is over the text for any message, an action menu pops up, and the first
35360 line of the queue display for the message is highlighted. This does not affect
35361 any selected text.
35362
35363 If you want to use some other event for popping up the menu, you can set the
35364 MENU_EVENT parameter in &_Local/eximon.conf_& to change the default, or
35365 set EXIMON_MENU_EVENT in the environment before starting the monitor. The
35366 value set in this parameter is a standard X event description. For example, to
35367 run eximon using &%ctrl%& rather than &%shift%& you could use
35368 .code
35369 EXIMON_MENU_EVENT='Ctrl<Btn1Down>' eximon
35370 .endd
35371 The title of the menu is the message id, and it contains entries which act as
35372 follows:
35373
35374 .ilist
35375 &'message log'&: The contents of the message log for the message are displayed
35376 in a new text window.
35377 .next
35378 &'headers'&: Information from the spool file that contains the envelope
35379 information and headers is displayed in a new text window. See chapter
35380 &<<CHAPspool>>& for a description of the format of spool files.
35381 .next
35382 &'body'&: The contents of the spool file containing the body of the message are
35383 displayed in a new text window. There is a default limit of 20,000 bytes to the
35384 amount of data displayed. This can be changed by setting the BODY_MAX
35385 option at compile time, or the EXIMON_BODY_MAX option at run time.
35386 .next
35387 &'deliver message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-M%& option to request
35388 delivery of the message. This causes an automatic thaw if the message is
35389 frozen. The &%-v%& option is also set, and the output from Exim is displayed in
35390 a new text window. The delivery is run in a separate process, to avoid holding
35391 up the monitor while the delivery proceeds.
35392 .next
35393 &'freeze message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mf%& option to request
35394 that the message be frozen.
35395 .next
35396 .cindex "thawing messages"
35397 .cindex "unfreezing messages"
35398 .cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
35399 &'thaw message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mt%& option to request
35400 that the message be thawed.
35401 .next
35402 .cindex "delivery" "forcing failure"
35403 &'give up on msg'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mg%& option to request
35404 that Exim gives up trying to deliver the message. A bounce message is generated
35405 for any remaining undelivered addresses.
35406 .next
35407 &'remove message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mrm%& option to request
35408 that the message be deleted from the system without generating a bounce
35409 message.
35410 .next
35411 &'add recipient'&: A dialog box is displayed into which a recipient address can
35412 be typed. If the address is not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter
35413 is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, the address is qualified with that domain.
35414 Otherwise it must be entered as a fully qualified address. Pressing RETURN
35415 causes a call to Exim to be made using the &%-Mar%& option to request that an
35416 additional recipient be added to the message, unless the entry box is empty, in
35417 which case no action is taken.
35418 .next
35419 &'mark delivered'&: A dialog box is displayed into which a recipient address
35420 can be typed. If the address is not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter
35421 is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, the address is qualified with that domain.
35422 Otherwise it must be entered as a fully qualified address. Pressing RETURN
35423 causes a call to Exim to be made using the &%-Mmd%& option to mark the given
35424 recipient address as already delivered, unless the entry box is empty, in which
35425 case no action is taken.
35426 .next
35427 &'mark all delivered'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mmad%& option to
35428 mark all recipient addresses as already delivered.
35429 .next
35430 &'edit sender'&: A dialog box is displayed initialized with the current
35431 sender's address. Pressing RETURN causes a call to Exim to be made using the
35432 &%-Mes%& option to replace the sender address, unless the entry box is empty,
35433 in which case no action is taken. If you want to set an empty sender (as in
35434 bounce messages), you must specify it as &"<>"&. Otherwise, if the address is
35435 not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&,
35436 the address is qualified with that domain.
35437 .endlist
35438
35439 When a delivery is forced, a window showing the &%-v%& output is displayed. In
35440 other cases when a call to Exim is made, if there is any output from Exim (in
35441 particular, if the command fails) a window containing the command and the
35442 output is displayed. Otherwise, the results of the action are normally apparent
35443 from the log and queue displays. However, if you set ACTION_OUTPUT=yes in
35444 &_Local/eximon.conf_&, a window showing the Exim command is always opened, even
35445 if no output is generated.
35446
35447 The queue display is automatically updated for actions such as freezing and
35448 thawing, unless ACTION_QUEUE_UPDATE=no has been set in
35449 &_Local/eximon.conf_&. In this case the &"Update"& button has to be used to
35450 force an update of the display after one of these actions.
35451
35452 In any text window that is displayed as result of a menu action, the normal
35453 cut-and-paste facility is available, and searching can be carried out using ^R
35454 and ^S, as described above for the log tail window.
35455 .ecindex IIDeximon
35456
35457
35458
35459
35460
35461 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35462 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35463
35464 .chapter "Security considerations" "CHAPsecurity"
35465 .scindex IIDsecurcon "security" "discussion of"
35466 This chapter discusses a number of issues concerned with security, some of
35467 which are also covered in other parts of this manual.
35468
35469 For reasons that this author does not understand, some people have promoted
35470 Exim as a &"particularly secure"& mailer. Perhaps it is because of the
35471 existence of this chapter in the documentation. However, the intent of the
35472 chapter is simply to describe the way Exim works in relation to certain
35473 security concerns, not to make any specific claims about the effectiveness of
35474 its security as compared with other MTAs.
35475
35476 What follows is a description of the way Exim is supposed to be. Best efforts
35477 have been made to try to ensure that the code agrees with the theory, but an
35478 absence of bugs can never be guaranteed. Any that are reported will get fixed
35479 as soon as possible.
35480
35481
35482 .section "Building a more &""hardened""& Exim" "SECID286"
35483 .cindex "security" "build-time features"
35484 There are a number of build-time options that can be set in &_Local/Makefile_&
35485 to create Exim binaries that are &"harder"& to attack, in particular by a rogue
35486 Exim administrator who does not have the root password, or by someone who has
35487 penetrated the Exim (but not the root) account. These options are as follows:
35488
35489 .ilist
35490 ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX can be set to a string that is required to match the
35491 start of any file names used with the &%-C%& option. When it is set, these file
35492 names are also not allowed to contain the sequence &"/../"&. (However, if the
35493 value of the &%-C%& option is identical to the value of CONFIGURE_FILE in
35494 &_Local/Makefile_&, Exim ignores &%-C%& and proceeds as usual.) There is no
35495 default setting for &%ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX%&.
35496
35497 If the permitted configuration files are confined to a directory to
35498 which only root has access, this guards against someone who has broken
35499 into the Exim account from running a privileged Exim with an arbitrary
35500 configuration file, and using it to break into other accounts.
35501 .next
35502
35503 If a non-trusted configuration file (i.e. not the default configuration file
35504 or one which is trusted by virtue of being listed in the TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST
35505 file) is specified with &%-C%&, or if macros are given with &%-D%& (but see
35506 the next item), then root privilege is retained only if the caller of Exim is
35507 root. This locks out the possibility of testing a configuration using &%-C%&
35508 right through message reception and delivery, even if the caller is root. The
35509 reception works, but by that time, Exim is running as the Exim user, so when
35510 it re-execs to regain privilege for the delivery, the use of &%-C%& causes
35511 privilege to be lost. However, root can test reception and delivery using two
35512 separate commands.
35513
35514 .next
35515 The WHITELIST_D_MACROS build option declares some macros to be safe to override
35516 with &%-D%& if the real uid is one of root, the Exim run-time user or the
35517 CONFIGURE_OWNER, if defined. The potential impact of this option is limited by
35518 requiring the run-time value supplied to &%-D%& to match a regex that errs on
35519 the restrictive side. Requiring build-time selection of safe macros is onerous
35520 but this option is intended solely as a transition mechanism to permit
35521 previously-working configurations to continue to work after release 4.73.
35522 .next
35523 If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined, the use of the &%-D%& command line option
35524 is disabled.
35525 .next
35526 FIXED_NEVER_USERS can be set to a colon-separated list of users that are
35527 never to be used for any deliveries. This is like the &%never_users%& runtime
35528 option, but it cannot be overridden; the runtime option adds additional users
35529 to the list. The default setting is &"root"&; this prevents a non-root user who
35530 is permitted to modify the runtime file from using Exim as a way to get root.
35531 .endlist
35532
35533
35534
35535 .section "Root privilege" "SECID270"
35536 .cindex "setuid"
35537 .cindex "root privilege"
35538 The Exim binary is normally setuid to root, which means that it gains root
35539 privilege (runs as root) when it starts execution. In some special cases (for
35540 example, when the daemon is not in use and there are no local deliveries), it
35541 may be possible to run Exim setuid to some user other than root. This is
35542 discussed in the next section. However, in most installations, root privilege
35543 is required for two things:
35544
35545 .ilist
35546 To set up a socket connected to the standard SMTP port (25) when initialising
35547 the listening daemon. If Exim is run from &'inetd'&, this privileged action is
35548 not required.
35549 .next
35550 To be able to change uid and gid in order to read users' &_.forward_& files and
35551 perform local deliveries as the receiving user or as specified in the
35552 configuration.
35553 .endlist
35554
35555 It is not necessary to be root to do any of the other things Exim does, such as
35556 receiving messages and delivering them externally over SMTP, and it is
35557 obviously more secure if Exim does not run as root except when necessary.
35558 For this reason, a user and group for Exim to use must be defined in
35559 &_Local/Makefile_&. These are known as &"the Exim user"& and &"the Exim
35560 group"&. Their values can be changed by the run time configuration, though this
35561 is not recommended. Often a user called &'exim'& is used, but some sites use
35562 &'mail'& or another user name altogether.
35563
35564 Exim uses &[setuid()]& whenever it gives up root privilege. This is a permanent
35565 abdication; the process cannot regain root afterwards. Prior to release 4.00,
35566 &[seteuid()]& was used in some circumstances, but this is no longer the case.
35567
35568 After a new Exim process has interpreted its command line options, it changes
35569 uid and gid in the following cases:
35570
35571 .ilist
35572 .oindex "&%-C%&"
35573 .oindex "&%-D%&"
35574 If the &%-C%& option is used to specify an alternate configuration file, or if
35575 the &%-D%& option is used to define macro values for the configuration, and the
35576 calling process is not running as root, the uid and gid are changed to those of
35577 the calling process.
35578 However, if DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, the &%-D%&
35579 option may not be used at all.
35580 If WHITELIST_D_MACROS is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, then some macro values
35581 can be supplied if the calling process is running as root, the Exim run-time
35582 user or CONFIGURE_OWNER, if defined.
35583 .next
35584 .oindex "&%-be%&"
35585 .oindex "&%-bf%&"
35586 .oindex "&%-bF%&"
35587 If the expansion test option (&%-be%&) or one of the filter testing options
35588 (&%-bf%& or &%-bF%&) are used, the uid and gid are changed to those of the
35589 calling process.
35590 .next
35591 If the process is not a daemon process or a queue runner process or a delivery
35592 process or a process for testing address routing (started with &%-bt%&), the
35593 uid and gid are changed to the Exim user and group. This means that Exim always
35594 runs under its own uid and gid when receiving messages. This also applies when
35595 testing address verification
35596 .oindex "&%-bv%&"
35597 .oindex "&%-bh%&"
35598 (the &%-bv%& option) and testing incoming message policy controls (the &%-bh%&
35599 option).
35600 .next
35601 For a daemon, queue runner, delivery, or address testing process, the uid
35602 remains as root at this stage, but the gid is changed to the Exim group.
35603 .endlist
35604
35605 The processes that initially retain root privilege behave as follows:
35606
35607 .ilist
35608 A daemon process changes the gid to the Exim group and the uid to the Exim
35609 user after setting up one or more listening sockets. The &[initgroups()]&
35610 function is called, so that if the Exim user is in any additional groups, they
35611 will be used during message reception.
35612 .next
35613 A queue runner process retains root privilege throughout its execution. Its
35614 job is to fork a controlled sequence of delivery processes.
35615 .next
35616 A delivery process retains root privilege throughout most of its execution,
35617 but any actual deliveries (that is, the transports themselves) are run in
35618 subprocesses which always change to a non-root uid and gid. For local
35619 deliveries this is typically the uid and gid of the owner of the mailbox; for
35620 remote deliveries, the Exim uid and gid are used. Once all the delivery
35621 subprocesses have been run, a delivery process changes to the Exim uid and gid
35622 while doing post-delivery tidying up such as updating the retry database and
35623 generating bounce and warning messages.
35624
35625 While the recipient addresses in a message are being routed, the delivery
35626 process runs as root. However, if a user's filter file has to be processed,
35627 this is done in a subprocess that runs under the individual user's uid and
35628 gid. A system filter is run as root unless &%system_filter_user%& is set.
35629 .next
35630 A process that is testing addresses (the &%-bt%& option) runs as root so that
35631 the routing is done in the same environment as a message delivery.
35632 .endlist
35633
35634
35635
35636
35637 .section "Running Exim without privilege" "SECTrunexiwitpri"
35638 .cindex "privilege, running without"
35639 .cindex "unprivileged running"
35640 .cindex "root privilege" "running without"
35641 Some installations like to run Exim in an unprivileged state for more of its
35642 operation, for added security. Support for this mode of operation is provided
35643 by the global option &%deliver_drop_privilege%&. When this is set, the uid and
35644 gid are changed to the Exim user and group at the start of a delivery process
35645 (and also queue runner and address testing processes). This means that address
35646 routing is no longer run as root, and the deliveries themselves cannot change
35647 to any other uid.
35648
35649 .cindex SIGHUP
35650 .cindex "daemon" "restarting"
35651 Leaving the binary setuid to root, but setting &%deliver_drop_privilege%& means
35652 that the daemon can still be started in the usual way, and it can respond
35653 correctly to SIGHUP because the re-invocation regains root privilege.
35654
35655 An alternative approach is to make Exim setuid to the Exim user and also setgid
35656 to the Exim group. If you do this, the daemon must be started from a root
35657 process. (Calling Exim from a root process makes it behave in the way it does
35658 when it is setuid root.) However, the daemon cannot restart itself after a
35659 SIGHUP signal because it cannot regain privilege.
35660
35661 It is still useful to set &%deliver_drop_privilege%& in this case, because it
35662 stops Exim from trying to re-invoke itself to do a delivery after a message has
35663 been received. Such a re-invocation is a waste of resources because it has no
35664 effect.
35665
35666 If restarting the daemon is not an issue (for example, if &%mua_wrapper%& is
35667 set, or &'inetd'& is being used instead of a daemon), having the binary setuid
35668 to the Exim user seems a clean approach, but there is one complication:
35669
35670 In this style of operation, Exim is running with the real uid and gid set to
35671 those of the calling process, and the effective uid/gid set to Exim's values.
35672 Ideally, any association with the calling process' uid/gid should be dropped,
35673 that is, the real uid/gid should be reset to the effective values so as to
35674 discard any privileges that the caller may have. While some operating systems
35675 have a function that permits this action for a non-root effective uid, quite a
35676 number of them do not. Because of this lack of standardization, Exim does not
35677 address this problem at this time.
35678
35679 For this reason, the recommended approach for &"mostly unprivileged"& running
35680 is to keep the Exim binary setuid to root, and to set
35681 &%deliver_drop_privilege%&. This also has the advantage of allowing a daemon to
35682 be used in the most straightforward way.
35683
35684 If you configure Exim not to run delivery processes as root, there are a
35685 number of restrictions on what you can do:
35686
35687 .ilist
35688 You can deliver only as the Exim user/group. You should explicitly use the
35689 &%user%& and &%group%& options to override routers or local transports that
35690 normally deliver as the recipient. This makes sure that configurations that
35691 work in this mode function the same way in normal mode. Any implicit or
35692 explicit specification of another user causes an error.
35693 .next
35694 Use of &_.forward_& files is severely restricted, such that it is usually
35695 not worthwhile to include them in the configuration.
35696 .next
35697 Users who wish to use &_.forward_& would have to make their home directory and
35698 the file itself accessible to the Exim user. Pipe and append-to-file entries,
35699 and their equivalents in Exim filters, cannot be used. While they could be
35700 enabled in the Exim user's name, that would be insecure and not very useful.
35701 .next
35702 Unless the local user mailboxes are all owned by the Exim user (possible in
35703 some POP3 or IMAP-only environments):
35704
35705 .olist
35706 They must be owned by the Exim group and be writeable by that group. This
35707 implies you must set &%mode%& in the appendfile configuration, as well as the
35708 mode of the mailbox files themselves.
35709 .next
35710 You must set &%no_check_owner%&, since most or all of the files will not be
35711 owned by the Exim user.
35712 .next
35713 You must set &%file_must_exist%&, because Exim cannot set the owner correctly
35714 on a newly created mailbox when unprivileged. This also implies that new
35715 mailboxes need to be created manually.
35716 .endlist olist
35717 .endlist ilist
35718
35719
35720 These restrictions severely restrict what can be done in local deliveries.
35721 However, there are no restrictions on remote deliveries. If you are running a
35722 gateway host that does no local deliveries, setting &%deliver_drop_privilege%&
35723 gives more security at essentially no cost.
35724
35725 If you are using the &%mua_wrapper%& facility (see chapter
35726 &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&), &%deliver_drop_privilege%& is forced to be true.
35727
35728
35729
35730
35731 .section "Delivering to local files" "SECID271"
35732 Full details of the checks applied by &(appendfile)& before it writes to a file
35733 are given in chapter &<<CHAPappendfile>>&.
35734
35735
35736
35737 .section "Running local commands" "SECTsecconslocalcmds"
35738 .cindex "security" "local commands"
35739 .cindex "security" "command injection attacks"
35740 There are a number of ways in which an administrator can configure Exim to run
35741 commands based upon received, untrustworthy, data. Further, in some
35742 configurations a user who can control a &_.forward_& file can also arrange to
35743 run commands. Configuration to check includes, but is not limited to:
35744
35745 .ilist
35746 Use of &%use_shell%& in the pipe transport: various forms of shell command
35747 injection may be possible with this option present. It is dangerous and should
35748 be used only with considerable caution. Consider constraints which whitelist
35749 allowed characters in a variable which is to be used in a pipe transport that
35750 has &%use_shell%& enabled.
35751 .next
35752 A number of options such as &%forbid_filter_run%&, &%forbid_filter_perl%&,
35753 &%forbid_filter_dlfunc%& and so forth which restrict facilities available to
35754 &_.forward_& files in a redirect router. If Exim is running on a central mail
35755 hub to which ordinary users do not have shell access, but home directories are
35756 NFS mounted (for instance) then administrators should review the list of these
35757 forbid options available, and should bear in mind that the options that may
35758 need forbidding can change as new features are added between releases.
35759 .next
35760 The &%${run...}%& expansion item does not use a shell by default, but
35761 administrators can configure use of &_/bin/sh_& as part of the command.
35762 Such invocations should be viewed with prejudicial suspicion.
35763 .next
35764 Administrators who use embedded Perl are advised to explore how Perl's
35765 taint checking might apply to their usage.
35766 .next
35767 Use of &%${expand...}%& is somewhat analagous to shell's eval builtin and
35768 administrators are well advised to view its use with suspicion, in case (for
35769 instance) it allows a local-part to contain embedded Exim directives.
35770 .next
35771 Use of &%${match_local_part...}%& and friends becomes more dangerous if
35772 Exim was built with EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS defined: the second string in
35773 each can reference arbitrary lists and files, rather than just being a list
35774 of opaque strings.
35775 The EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS option was added and set false by default because of
35776 real-world security vulnerabilities caused by its use with untrustworthy data
35777 injected in, for SQL injection attacks.
35778 Consider the use of the &%inlisti%& expansion condition instead.
35779 .endlist
35780
35781
35782
35783
35784 .section "Trust in configuration data" "SECTsecconfdata"
35785 .cindex "security" "data sources"
35786 .cindex "security" "regular expressions"
35787 .cindex "regular expressions" "security"
35788 .cindex "PCRE" "security"
35789 If configuration data for Exim can come from untrustworthy sources, there
35790 are some issues to be aware of:
35791
35792 .ilist
35793 Use of &%${expand...}%& may provide a path for shell injection attacks.
35794 .next
35795 Letting untrusted data provide a regular expression is unwise.
35796 .next
35797 Using &%${match...}%& to apply a fixed regular expression against untrusted
35798 data may result in pathological behaviour within PCRE. Be aware of what
35799 "backtracking" means and consider options for being more strict with a regular
35800 expression. Avenues to explore include limiting what can match (avoiding &`.`&
35801 when &`[a-z0-9]`& or other character class will do), use of atomic grouping and
35802 possessive quantifiers or just not using regular expressions against untrusted
35803 data.
35804 .next
35805 It can be important to correctly use &%${quote:...}%&,
35806 &%${quote_local_part:...}%& and &%${quote_%&<&'lookup-type'&>&%:...}%& expansion
35807 items to ensure that data is correctly constructed.
35808 .next
35809 Some lookups might return multiple results, even though normal usage is only
35810 expected to yield one result.
35811 .endlist
35812
35813
35814
35815
35816 .section "IPv4 source routing" "SECID272"
35817 .cindex "source routing" "in IP packets"
35818 .cindex "IP source routing"
35819 Many operating systems suppress IP source-routed packets in the kernel, but
35820 some cannot be made to do this, so Exim does its own check. It logs incoming
35821 IPv4 source-routed TCP calls, and then drops them. Things are all different in
35822 IPv6. No special checking is currently done.
35823
35824
35825
35826 .section "The VRFY, EXPN, and ETRN commands in SMTP" "SECID273"
35827 Support for these SMTP commands is disabled by default. If required, they can
35828 be enabled by defining suitable ACLs.
35829
35830
35831
35832
35833 .section "Privileged users" "SECID274"
35834 .cindex "trusted users"
35835 .cindex "admin user"
35836 .cindex "privileged user"
35837 .cindex "user" "trusted"
35838 .cindex "user" "admin"
35839 Exim recognizes two sets of users with special privileges. Trusted users are
35840 able to submit new messages to Exim locally, but supply their own sender
35841 addresses and information about a sending host. For other users submitting
35842 local messages, Exim sets up the sender address from the uid, and doesn't
35843 permit a remote host to be specified.
35844
35845 .oindex "&%-f%&"
35846 However, an untrusted user is permitted to use the &%-f%& command line option
35847 in the special form &%-f <>%& to indicate that a delivery failure for the
35848 message should not cause an error report. This affects the message's envelope,
35849 but it does not affect the &'Sender:'& header. Untrusted users may also be
35850 permitted to use specific forms of address with the &%-f%& option by setting
35851 the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option.
35852
35853 Trusted users are used to run processes that receive mail messages from some
35854 other mail domain and pass them on to Exim for delivery either locally, or over
35855 the Internet. Exim trusts a caller that is running as root, as the Exim user,
35856 as any user listed in the &%trusted_users%& configuration option, or under any
35857 group listed in the &%trusted_groups%& option.
35858
35859 Admin users are permitted to do things to the messages on Exim's queue. They
35860 can freeze or thaw messages, cause them to be returned to their senders, remove
35861 them entirely, or modify them in various ways. In addition, admin users can run
35862 the Exim monitor and see all the information it is capable of providing, which
35863 includes the contents of files on the spool.
35864
35865 .oindex "&%-M%&"
35866 .oindex "&%-q%&"
35867 By default, the use of the &%-M%& and &%-q%& options to cause Exim to attempt
35868 delivery of messages on its queue is restricted to admin users. This
35869 restriction can be relaxed by setting the &%no_prod_requires_admin%& option.
35870 Similarly, the use of &%-bp%& (and its variants) to list the contents of the
35871 queue is also restricted to admin users. This restriction can be relaxed by
35872 setting &%no_queue_list_requires_admin%&.
35873
35874 Exim recognizes an admin user if the calling process is running as root or as
35875 the Exim user or if any of the groups associated with the calling process is
35876 the Exim group. It is not necessary actually to be running under the Exim
35877 group. However, if admin users who are not root or the Exim user are to access
35878 the contents of files on the spool via the Exim monitor (which runs
35879 unprivileged), Exim must be built to allow group read access to its spool
35880 files.
35881
35882
35883
35884 .section "Spool files" "SECID275"
35885 .cindex "spool directory" "files"
35886 Exim's spool directory and everything it contains is owned by the Exim user and
35887 set to the Exim group. The mode for spool files is defined in the
35888 &_Local/Makefile_& configuration file, and defaults to 0640. This means that
35889 any user who is a member of the Exim group can access these files.
35890
35891
35892
35893 .section "Use of argv[0]" "SECID276"
35894 Exim examines the last component of &%argv[0]%&, and if it matches one of a set
35895 of specific strings, Exim assumes certain options. For example, calling Exim
35896 with the last component of &%argv[0]%& set to &"rsmtp"& is exactly equivalent
35897 to calling it with the option &%-bS%&. There are no security implications in
35898 this.
35899
35900
35901
35902 .section "Use of %f formatting" "SECID277"
35903 The only use made of &"%f"& by Exim is in formatting load average values. These
35904 are actually stored in integer variables as 1000 times the load average.
35905 Consequently, their range is limited and so therefore is the length of the
35906 converted output.
35907
35908
35909
35910 .section "Embedded Exim path" "SECID278"
35911 Exim uses its own path name, which is embedded in the code, only when it needs
35912 to re-exec in order to regain root privilege. Therefore, it is not root when it
35913 does so. If some bug allowed the path to get overwritten, it would lead to an
35914 arbitrary program's being run as exim, not as root.
35915
35916
35917
35918 .section "Dynamic module directory" "SECTdynmoddir"
35919 Any dynamically loadable modules must be installed into the directory
35920 defined in &`LOOKUP_MODULE_DIR`& in &_Local/Makefile_& for Exim to permit
35921 loading it.
35922
35923
35924 .section "Use of sprintf()" "SECID279"
35925 .cindex "&[sprintf()]&"
35926 A large number of occurrences of &"sprintf"& in the code are actually calls to
35927 &'string_sprintf()'&, a function that returns the result in malloc'd store.
35928 The intermediate formatting is done into a large fixed buffer by a function
35929 that runs through the format string itself, and checks the length of each
35930 conversion before performing it, thus preventing buffer overruns.
35931
35932 The remaining uses of &[sprintf()]& happen in controlled circumstances where
35933 the output buffer is known to be sufficiently long to contain the converted
35934 string.
35935
35936
35937
35938 .section "Use of debug_printf() and log_write()" "SECID280"
35939 Arbitrary strings are passed to both these functions, but they do their
35940 formatting by calling the function &'string_vformat()'&, which runs through
35941 the format string itself, and checks the length of each conversion.
35942
35943
35944
35945 .section "Use of strcat() and strcpy()" "SECID281"
35946 These are used only in cases where the output buffer is known to be large
35947 enough to hold the result.
35948 .ecindex IIDsecurcon
35949
35950
35951
35952
35953 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35954 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35955
35956 .chapter "Format of spool files" "CHAPspool"
35957 .scindex IIDforspo1 "format" "spool files"
35958 .scindex IIDforspo2 "spool directory" "format of files"
35959 .scindex IIDforspo3 "spool files" "format of"
35960 .cindex "spool files" "editing"
35961 A message on Exim's queue consists of two files, whose names are the message id
35962 followed by -D and -H, respectively. The data portion of the message is kept in
35963 the -D file on its own. The message's envelope, status, and headers are all
35964 kept in the -H file, whose format is described in this chapter. Each of these
35965 two files contains the final component of its own name as its first line. This
35966 is insurance against disk crashes where the directory is lost but the files
35967 themselves are recoverable.
35968
35969 Some people are tempted into editing -D files in order to modify messages. You
35970 need to be extremely careful if you do this; it is not recommended and you are
35971 on your own if you do it. Here are some of the pitfalls:
35972
35973 .ilist
35974 You must ensure that Exim does not try to deliver the message while you are
35975 fiddling with it. The safest way is to take out a write lock on the -D file,
35976 which is what Exim itself does, using &[fcntl()]&. If you update the file in
35977 place, the lock will be retained. If you write a new file and rename it, the
35978 lock will be lost at the instant of rename.
35979 .next
35980 .vindex "&$body_linecount$&"
35981 If you change the number of lines in the file, the value of
35982 &$body_linecount$&, which is stored in the -H file, will be incorrect. At
35983 present, this value is not used by Exim, but there is no guarantee that this
35984 will always be the case.
35985 .next
35986 If the message is in MIME format, you must take care not to break it.
35987 .next
35988 If the message is cryptographically signed, any change will invalidate the
35989 signature.
35990 .endlist
35991 All in all, modifying -D files is fraught with danger.
35992
35993 Files whose names end with -J may also be seen in the &_input_& directory (or
35994 its subdirectories when &%split_spool_directory%& is set). These are journal
35995 files, used to record addresses to which the message has been delivered during
35996 the course of a delivery attempt. If there are still undelivered recipients at
35997 the end, the -H file is updated, and the -J file is deleted. If, however, there
35998 is some kind of crash (for example, a power outage) before this happens, the -J
35999 file remains in existence. When Exim next processes the message, it notices the
36000 -J file and uses it to update the -H file before starting the next delivery
36001 attempt.
36002
36003 .section "Format of the -H file" "SECID282"
36004 .cindex "uid (user id)" "in spool file"
36005 .cindex "gid (group id)" "in spool file"
36006 The second line of the -H file contains the login name for the uid of the
36007 process that called Exim to read the message, followed by the numerical uid and
36008 gid. For a locally generated message, this is normally the user who sent the
36009 message. For a message received over TCP/IP via the daemon, it is
36010 normally the Exim user.
36011
36012 The third line of the file contains the address of the message's sender as
36013 transmitted in the envelope, contained in angle brackets. The sender address is
36014 empty for bounce messages. For incoming SMTP mail, the sender address is given
36015 in the MAIL command. For locally generated mail, the sender address is
36016 created by Exim from the login name of the current user and the configured
36017 &%qualify_domain%&. However, this can be overridden by the &%-f%& option or a
36018 leading &"From&~"& line if the caller is trusted, or if the supplied address is
36019 &"<>"& or an address that matches &%untrusted_set_senders%&.
36020
36021 The fourth line contains two numbers. The first is the time that the message
36022 was received, in the conventional Unix form &-- the number of seconds since the
36023 start of the epoch. The second number is a count of the number of messages
36024 warning of delayed delivery that have been sent to the sender.
36025
36026 There follow a number of lines starting with a hyphen. These can appear in any
36027 order, and are omitted when not relevant:
36028
36029 .vlist
36030 .vitem "&%-acl%&&~<&'number'&>&~<&'length'&>"
36031 This item is obsolete, and is not generated from Exim release 4.61 onwards;
36032 &%-aclc%& and &%-aclm%& are used instead. However, &%-acl%& is still
36033 recognized, to provide backward compatibility. In the old format, a line of
36034 this form is present for every ACL variable that is not empty. The number
36035 identifies the variable; the &%acl_c%&&*x*& variables are numbered 0&--9 and
36036 the &%acl_m%&&*x*& variables are numbered 10&--19. The length is the length of
36037 the data string for the variable. The string itself starts at the beginning of
36038 the next line, and is followed by a newline character. It may contain internal
36039 newlines.
36040
36041 .vitem "&%-aclc%&&~<&'rest-of-name'&>&~<&'length'&>"
36042 A line of this form is present for every ACL connection variable that is
36043 defined. Note that there is a space between &%-aclc%& and the rest of the name.
36044 The length is the length of the data string for the variable. The string itself
36045 starts at the beginning of the next line, and is followed by a newline
36046 character. It may contain internal newlines.
36047
36048 .vitem "&%-aclm%&&~<&'rest-of-name'&>&~<&'length'&>"
36049 A line of this form is present for every ACL message variable that is defined.
36050 Note that there is a space between &%-aclm%& and the rest of the name. The
36051 length is the length of the data string for the variable. The string itself
36052 starts at the beginning of the next line, and is followed by a newline
36053 character. It may contain internal newlines.
36054
36055 .vitem "&%-active_hostname%&&~<&'hostname'&>"
36056 This is present if, when the message was received over SMTP, the value of
36057 &$smtp_active_hostname$& was different to the value of &$primary_hostname$&.
36058
36059 .vitem &%-allow_unqualified_recipient%&
36060 This is present if unqualified recipient addresses are permitted in header
36061 lines (to stop such addresses from being qualified if rewriting occurs at
36062 transport time). Local messages that were input using &%-bnq%& and remote
36063 messages from hosts that match &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& set this flag.
36064
36065 .vitem &%-allow_unqualified_sender%&
36066 This is present if unqualified sender addresses are permitted in header lines
36067 (to stop such addresses from being qualified if rewriting occurs at transport
36068 time). Local messages that were input using &%-bnq%& and remote messages from
36069 hosts that match &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& set this flag.
36070
36071 .vitem "&%-auth_id%&&~<&'text'&>"
36072 The id information for a message received on an authenticated SMTP connection
36073 &-- the value of the &$authenticated_id$& variable.
36074
36075 .vitem "&%-auth_sender%&&~<&'address'&>"
36076 The address of an authenticated sender &-- the value of the
36077 &$authenticated_sender$& variable.
36078
36079 .vitem "&%-body_linecount%&&~<&'number'&>"
36080 This records the number of lines in the body of the message, and is always
36081 present.
36082
36083 .vitem "&%-body_zerocount%&&~<&'number'&>"
36084 This records the number of binary zero bytes in the body of the message, and is
36085 present if the number is greater than zero.
36086
36087 .vitem &%-deliver_firsttime%&
36088 This is written when a new message is first added to the spool. When the spool
36089 file is updated after a deferral, it is omitted.
36090
36091 .vitem "&%-frozen%&&~<&'time'&>"
36092 .cindex "frozen messages" "spool data"
36093 The message is frozen, and the freezing happened at <&'time'&>.
36094
36095 .vitem "&%-helo_name%&&~<&'text'&>"
36096 This records the host name as specified by a remote host in a HELO or EHLO
36097 command.
36098
36099 .vitem "&%-host_address%&&~<&'address'&>.<&'port'&>"
36100 This records the IP address of the host from which the message was received and
36101 the remote port number that was used. It is omitted for locally generated
36102 messages.
36103
36104 .vitem "&%-host_auth%&&~<&'text'&>"
36105 If the message was received on an authenticated SMTP connection, this records
36106 the name of the authenticator &-- the value of the
36107 &$sender_host_authenticated$& variable.
36108
36109 .vitem &%-host_lookup_failed%&
36110 This is present if an attempt to look up the sending host's name from its IP
36111 address failed. It corresponds to the &$host_lookup_failed$& variable.
36112
36113 .vitem "&%-host_name%&&~<&'text'&>"
36114 .cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
36115 .cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
36116 This records the name of the remote host from which the message was received,
36117 if the host name was looked up from the IP address when the message was being
36118 received. It is not present if no reverse lookup was done.
36119
36120 .vitem "&%-ident%&&~<&'text'&>"
36121 For locally submitted messages, this records the login of the originating user,
36122 unless it was a trusted user and the &%-oMt%& option was used to specify an
36123 ident value. For messages received over TCP/IP, this records the ident string
36124 supplied by the remote host, if any.
36125
36126 .vitem "&%-interface_address%&&~<&'address'&>.<&'port'&>"
36127 This records the IP address of the local interface and the port number through
36128 which a message was received from a remote host. It is omitted for locally
36129 generated messages.
36130
36131 .vitem &%-local%&
36132 The message is from a local sender.
36133
36134 .vitem &%-localerror%&
36135 The message is a locally-generated bounce message.
36136
36137 .vitem "&%-local_scan%&&~<&'string'&>"
36138 This records the data string that was returned by the &[local_scan()]& function
36139 when the message was received &-- the value of the &$local_scan_data$&
36140 variable. It is omitted if no data was returned.
36141
36142 .vitem &%-manual_thaw%&
36143 The message was frozen but has been thawed manually, that is, by an explicit
36144 Exim command rather than via the auto-thaw process.
36145
36146 .vitem &%-N%&
36147 A testing delivery process was started using the &%-N%& option to suppress any
36148 actual deliveries, but delivery was deferred. At any further delivery attempts,
36149 &%-N%& is assumed.
36150
36151 .vitem &%-received_protocol%&
36152 This records the value of the &$received_protocol$& variable, which contains
36153 the name of the protocol by which the message was received.
36154
36155 .vitem &%-sender_set_untrusted%&
36156 The envelope sender of this message was set by an untrusted local caller (used
36157 to ensure that the caller is displayed in queue listings).
36158
36159 .vitem "&%-spam_score_int%&&~<&'number'&>"
36160 If a message was scanned by SpamAssassin, this is present. It records the value
36161 of &$spam_score_int$&.
36162
36163 .vitem &%-tls_certificate_verified%&
36164 A TLS certificate was received from the client that sent this message, and the
36165 certificate was verified by the server.
36166
36167 .vitem "&%-tls_cipher%&&~<&'cipher name'&>"
36168 When the message was received over an encrypted connection, this records the
36169 name of the cipher suite that was used.
36170
36171 .vitem "&%-tls_peerdn%&&~<&'peer DN'&>"
36172 When the message was received over an encrypted connection, and a certificate
36173 was received from the client, this records the Distinguished Name from that
36174 certificate.
36175 .endlist
36176
36177 Following the options there is a list of those addresses to which the message
36178 is not to be delivered. This set of addresses is initialized from the command
36179 line when the &%-t%& option is used and &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%&
36180 is set; otherwise it starts out empty. Whenever a successful delivery is made,
36181 the address is added to this set. The addresses are kept internally as a
36182 balanced binary tree, and it is a representation of that tree which is written
36183 to the spool file. If an address is expanded via an alias or forward file, the
36184 original address is added to the tree when deliveries to all its child
36185 addresses are complete.
36186
36187 If the tree is empty, there is a single line in the spool file containing just
36188 the text &"XX"&. Otherwise, each line consists of two letters, which are either
36189 Y or N, followed by an address. The address is the value for the node of the
36190 tree, and the letters indicate whether the node has a left branch and/or a
36191 right branch attached to it, respectively. If branches exist, they immediately
36192 follow. Here is an example of a three-node tree:
36193 .code
36194 YY darcy@austen.fict.example
36195 NN alice@wonderland.fict.example
36196 NN editor@thesaurus.ref.example
36197 .endd
36198 After the non-recipients tree, there is a list of the message's recipients.
36199 This is a simple list, preceded by a count. It includes all the original
36200 recipients of the message, including those to whom the message has already been
36201 delivered. In the simplest case, the list contains one address per line. For
36202 example:
36203 .code
36204 4
36205 editor@thesaurus.ref.example
36206 darcy@austen.fict.example
36207 rdo@foundation
36208 alice@wonderland.fict.example
36209 .endd
36210 However, when a child address has been added to the top-level addresses as a
36211 result of the use of the &%one_time%& option on a &(redirect)& router, each
36212 line is of the following form:
36213 .display
36214 <&'top-level address'&> <&'errors_to address'&> &&&
36215 <&'length'&>,<&'parent number'&>#<&'flag bits'&>
36216 .endd
36217 The 01 flag bit indicates the presence of the three other fields that follow
36218 the top-level address. Other bits may be used in future to support additional
36219 fields. The <&'parent number'&> is the offset in the recipients list of the
36220 original parent of the &"one time"& address. The first two fields are the
36221 envelope sender that is associated with this address and its length. If the
36222 length is zero, there is no special envelope sender (there are then two space
36223 characters in the line). A non-empty field can arise from a &(redirect)& router
36224 that has an &%errors_to%& setting.
36225
36226
36227 A blank line separates the envelope and status information from the headers
36228 which follow. A header may occupy several lines of the file, and to save effort
36229 when reading it in, each header is preceded by a number and an identifying
36230 character. The number is the number of characters in the header, including any
36231 embedded newlines and the terminating newline. The character is one of the
36232 following:
36233
36234 .table2 50pt
36235 .row <&'blank'&> "header in which Exim has no special interest"
36236 .row &`B`& "&'Bcc:'& header"
36237 .row &`C`& "&'Cc:'& header"
36238 .row &`F`& "&'From:'& header"
36239 .row &`I`& "&'Message-id:'& header"
36240 .row &`P`& "&'Received:'& header &-- P for &""postmark""&"
36241 .row &`R`& "&'Reply-To:'& header"
36242 .row &`S`& "&'Sender:'& header"
36243 .row &`T`& "&'To:'& header"
36244 .row &`*`& "replaced or deleted header"
36245 .endtable
36246
36247 Deleted or replaced (rewritten) headers remain in the spool file for debugging
36248 purposes. They are not transmitted when the message is delivered. Here is a
36249 typical set of headers:
36250 .code
36251 111P Received: by hobbit.fict.example with local (Exim 4.00)
36252 id 14y9EI-00026G-00; Fri, 11 May 2001 10:28:59 +0100
36253 049 Message-Id: <E14y9EI-00026G-00@hobbit.fict.example>
36254 038* X-rewrote-sender: bb@hobbit.fict.example
36255 042* From: Bilbo Baggins <bb@hobbit.fict.example>
36256 049F From: Bilbo Baggins <B.Baggins@hobbit.fict.example>
36257 099* To: alice@wonderland.fict.example, rdo@foundation,
36258 darcy@austen.fict.example, editor@thesaurus.ref.example
36259 104T To: alice@wonderland.fict.example, rdo@foundation.example,
36260 darcy@austen.fict.example, editor@thesaurus.ref.example
36261 038 Date: Fri, 11 May 2001 10:28:59 +0100
36262 .endd
36263 The asterisked headers indicate that the envelope sender, &'From:'& header, and
36264 &'To:'& header have been rewritten, the last one because routing expanded the
36265 unqualified domain &'foundation'&.
36266 .ecindex IIDforspo1
36267 .ecindex IIDforspo2
36268 .ecindex IIDforspo3
36269
36270 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36271 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36272
36273 .chapter "Support for DKIM (DomainKeys Identified Mail)" "CHAPdkim" &&&
36274 "DKIM Support"
36275 .cindex "DKIM"
36276
36277 DKIM is a mechanism by which messages sent by some entity can be provably
36278 linked to a domain which that entity controls. It permits reputation to
36279 be tracked on a per-domain basis, rather than merely upon source IP address.
36280 DKIM is documented in RFC 4871.
36281
36282 Since version 4.70, DKIM support is compiled into Exim by default. It can be
36283 disabled by setting DISABLE_DKIM=yes in Local/Makefile.
36284
36285 Exim's DKIM implementation allows to
36286 .olist
36287 Sign outgoing messages: This function is implemented in the SMTP transport.
36288 It can co-exist with all other Exim features, including transport filters.
36289 .next
36290 Verify signatures in incoming messages: This is implemented by an additional
36291 ACL (acl_smtp_dkim), which can be called several times per message, with
36292 different signature contexts.
36293 .endlist
36294
36295 In typical Exim style, the verification implementation does not include any
36296 default "policy". Instead it enables you to build your own policy using
36297 Exim's standard controls.
36298
36299 Please note that verification of DKIM signatures in incoming mail is turned
36300 on by default for logging purposes. For each signature in incoming email,
36301 exim will log a line displaying the most important signature details, and the
36302 signature status. Here is an example (with line-breaks added for clarity):
36303 .code
36304 2009-09-09 10:22:28 1MlIRf-0003LU-U3 DKIM:
36305 d=facebookmail.com s=q1-2009b
36306 c=relaxed/relaxed a=rsa-sha1
36307 i=@facebookmail.com t=1252484542 [verification succeeded]
36308 .endd
36309 You might want to turn off DKIM verification processing entirely for internal
36310 or relay mail sources. To do that, set the &%dkim_disable_verify%& ACL
36311 control modifier. This should typically be done in the RCPT ACL, at points
36312 where you accept mail from relay sources (internal hosts or authenticated
36313 senders).
36314
36315
36316 .section "Signing outgoing messages" "SECID513"
36317 .cindex "DKIM" "signing"
36318
36319 Signing is implemented by setting private options on the SMTP transport.
36320 These options take (expandable) strings as arguments.
36321
36322 .option dkim_domain smtp string&!! unset
36323 MANDATORY:
36324 The domain you want to sign with. The result of this expanded
36325 option is put into the &%$dkim_domain%& expansion variable.
36326
36327 .option dkim_selector smtp string&!! unset
36328 MANDATORY:
36329 This sets the key selector string. You can use the &%$dkim_domain%& expansion
36330 variable to look up a matching selector. The result is put in the expansion
36331 variable &%$dkim_selector%& which should be used in the &%dkim_private_key%&
36332 option along with &%$dkim_domain%&.
36333
36334 .option dkim_private_key smtp string&!! unset
36335 MANDATORY:
36336 This sets the private key to use. You can use the &%$dkim_domain%& and
36337 &%$dkim_selector%& expansion variables to determine the private key to use.
36338 The result can either
36339 .ilist
36340 be a valid RSA private key in ASCII armor, including line breaks.
36341 .next
36342 start with a slash, in which case it is treated as a file that contains
36343 the private key.
36344 .next
36345 be "0", "false" or the empty string, in which case the message will not
36346 be signed. This case will not result in an error, even if &%dkim_strict%&
36347 is set.
36348 .endlist
36349
36350 .option dkim_canon smtp string&!! unset
36351 OPTIONAL:
36352 This option sets the canonicalization method used when signing a message.
36353 The DKIM RFC currently supports two methods: "simple" and "relaxed".
36354 The option defaults to "relaxed" when unset. Note: the current implementation
36355 only supports using the same canonicalization method for both headers and body.
36356
36357 .option dkim_strict smtp string&!! unset
36358 OPTIONAL:
36359 This option defines how Exim behaves when signing a message that
36360 should be signed fails for some reason. When the expansion evaluates to
36361 either "1" or "true", Exim will defer. Otherwise Exim will send the message
36362 unsigned. You can use the &%$dkim_domain%& and &%$dkim_selector%& expansion
36363 variables here.
36364
36365 .option dkim_sign_headers smtp string&!! unset
36366 OPTIONAL:
36367 When set, this option must expand to (or be specified as) a colon-separated
36368 list of header names. Headers with these names will be included in the message
36369 signature. When unspecified, the header names recommended in RFC4871 will be
36370 used.
36371
36372
36373 .section "Verifying DKIM signatures in incoming mail" "SECID514"
36374 .cindex "DKIM" "verification"
36375
36376 Verification of DKIM signatures in incoming email is implemented via the
36377 &%acl_smtp_dkim%& ACL. By default, this ACL is called once for each
36378 syntactically(!) correct signature in the incoming message.
36379
36380 To evaluate the signature in the ACL a large number of expansion variables
36381 containing the signature status and its details are set up during the
36382 runtime of the ACL.
36383
36384 Calling the ACL only for existing signatures is not sufficient to build
36385 more advanced policies. For that reason, the global option
36386 &%dkim_verify_signers%&, and a global expansion variable
36387 &%$dkim_signers%& exist.
36388
36389 The global option &%dkim_verify_signers%& can be set to a colon-separated
36390 list of DKIM domains or identities for which the ACL &%acl_smtp_dkim%& is
36391 called. It is expanded when the message has been received. At this point,
36392 the expansion variable &%$dkim_signers%& already contains a colon-separated
36393 list of signer domains and identities for the message. When
36394 &%dkim_verify_signers%& is not specified in the main configuration,
36395 it defaults as:
36396 .code
36397 dkim_verify_signers = $dkim_signers
36398 .endd
36399 This leads to the default behaviour of calling &%acl_smtp_dkim%& for each
36400 DKIM signature in the message. Current DKIM verifiers may want to explicitly
36401 call the ACL for known domains or identities. This would be achieved as follows:
36402 .code
36403 dkim_verify_signers = paypal.com:ebay.com:$dkim_signers
36404 .endd
36405 This would result in &%acl_smtp_dkim%& always being called for "paypal.com"
36406 and "ebay.com", plus all domains and identities that have signatures in the message.
36407 You can also be more creative in constructing your policy. For example:
36408 .code
36409 dkim_verify_signers = $sender_address_domain:$dkim_signers
36410 .endd
36411
36412 If a domain or identity is listed several times in the (expanded) value of
36413 &%dkim_verify_signers%&, the ACL is only called once for that domain or identity.
36414
36415
36416 Inside the &%acl_smtp_dkim%&, the following expansion variables are
36417 available (from most to least important):
36418
36419
36420 .vlist
36421 .vitem &%$dkim_cur_signer%&
36422 The signer that is being evaluated in this ACL run. This can be a domain or
36423 an identity. This is one of the list items from the expanded main option
36424 &%dkim_verify_signers%& (see above).
36425 .vitem &%$dkim_verify_status%&
36426 A string describing the general status of the signature. One of
36427 .ilist
36428 &%none%&: There is no signature in the message for the current domain or
36429 identity (as reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
36430 .next
36431 &%invalid%&: The signature could not be verified due to a processing error.
36432 More detail is available in &%$dkim_verify_reason%&.
36433 .next
36434 &%fail%&: Verification of the signature failed. More detail is
36435 available in &%$dkim_verify_reason%&.
36436 .next
36437 &%pass%&: The signature passed verification. It is valid.
36438 .endlist
36439 .vitem &%$dkim_verify_reason%&
36440 A string giving a litte bit more detail when &%$dkim_verify_status%& is either
36441 "fail" or "invalid". One of
36442 .ilist
36443 &%pubkey_unavailable%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="invalid"): The public
36444 key for the domain could not be retrieved. This may be a temporary problem.
36445 .next
36446 &%pubkey_syntax%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="invalid"): The public key
36447 record for the domain is syntactically invalid.
36448 .next
36449 &%bodyhash_mismatch%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="fail"): The calculated
36450 body hash does not match the one specified in the signature header. This
36451 means that the message body was modified in transit.
36452 .next
36453 &%signature_incorrect%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="fail"): The signature
36454 could not be verified. This may mean that headers were modified,
36455 re-written or otherwise changed in a way which is incompatible with
36456 DKIM verification. It may of course also mean that the signature is forged.
36457 .endlist
36458 .vitem &%$dkim_domain%&
36459 The signing domain. IMPORTANT: This variable is only populated if there is
36460 an actual signature in the message for the current domain or identity (as
36461 reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
36462 .vitem &%$dkim_identity%&
36463 The signing identity, if present. IMPORTANT: This variable is only populated
36464 if there is an actual signature in the message for the current domain or
36465 identity (as reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
36466 .vitem &%$dkim_selector%&
36467 The key record selector string.
36468 .vitem &%$dkim_algo%&
36469 The algorithm used. One of 'rsa-sha1' or 'rsa-sha256'.
36470 .vitem &%$dkim_canon_body%&
36471 The body canonicalization method. One of 'relaxed' or 'simple'.
36472 .vitem &%dkim_canon_headers%&
36473 The header canonicalization method. One of 'relaxed' or 'simple'.
36474 .vitem &%$dkim_copiedheaders%&
36475 A transcript of headers and their values which are included in the signature
36476 (copied from the 'z=' tag of the signature).
36477 .vitem &%$dkim_bodylength%&
36478 The number of signed body bytes. If zero ("0"), the body is unsigned. If no
36479 limit was set by the signer, "9999999999999" is returned. This makes sure
36480 that this variable always expands to an integer value.
36481 .vitem &%$dkim_created%&
36482 UNIX timestamp reflecting the date and time when the signature was created.
36483 When this was not specified by the signer, "0" is returned.
36484 .vitem &%$dkim_expires%&
36485 UNIX timestamp reflecting the date and time when the signer wants the
36486 signature to be treated as "expired". When this was not specified by the
36487 signer, "9999999999999" is returned. This makes it possible to do useful
36488 integer size comparisons against this value.
36489 .vitem &%$dkim_headernames%&
36490 A colon-separated list of names of headers included in the signature.
36491 .vitem &%$dkim_key_testing%&
36492 "1" if the key record has the "testing" flag set, "0" if not.
36493 .vitem &%$dkim_key_nosubdomains%&
36494 "1" if the key record forbids subdomaining, "0" otherwise.
36495 .vitem &%$dkim_key_srvtype%&
36496 Service type (tag s=) from the key record. Defaults to "*" if not specified
36497 in the key record.
36498 .vitem &%$dkim_key_granularity%&
36499 Key granularity (tag g=) from the key record. Defaults to "*" if not specified
36500 in the key record.
36501 .vitem &%$dkim_key_notes%&
36502 Notes from the key record (tag n=).
36503 .endlist
36504
36505 In addition, two ACL conditions are provided:
36506
36507 .vlist
36508 .vitem &%dkim_signers%&
36509 ACL condition that checks a colon-separated list of domains or identities
36510 for a match against the domain or identity that the ACL is currently verifying
36511 (reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&). This is typically used to restrict an ACL
36512 verb to a group of domains or identities. For example:
36513
36514 .code
36515 # Warn when Mail purportedly from GMail has no signature at all
36516 warn log_message = GMail sender without DKIM signature
36517 sender_domains = gmail.com
36518 dkim_signers = gmail.com
36519 dkim_status = none
36520 .endd
36521
36522 .vitem &%dkim_status%&
36523 ACL condition that checks a colon-separated list of possible DKIM verification
36524 results against the actual result of verification. This is typically used
36525 to restrict an ACL verb to a list of verification outcomes, for example:
36526
36527 .code
36528 deny message = Mail from Paypal with invalid/missing signature
36529 sender_domains = paypal.com:paypal.de
36530 dkim_signers = paypal.com:paypal.de
36531 dkim_status = none:invalid:fail
36532 .endd
36533
36534 The possible status keywords are: 'none','invalid','fail' and 'pass'. Please
36535 see the documentation of the &%$dkim_verify_status%& expansion variable above
36536 for more information of what they mean.
36537 .endlist
36538
36539 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36540 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36541
36542 .chapter "Adding new drivers or lookup types" "CHID13" &&&
36543 "Adding drivers or lookups"
36544 .cindex "adding drivers"
36545 .cindex "new drivers, adding"
36546 .cindex "drivers" "adding new"
36547 The following actions have to be taken in order to add a new router, transport,
36548 authenticator, or lookup type to Exim:
36549
36550 .olist
36551 Choose a name for the driver or lookup type that does not conflict with any
36552 existing name; I will use &"newdriver"& in what follows.
36553 .next
36554 Add to &_src/EDITME_& the line:
36555 .display
36556 <&'type'&>&`_NEWDRIVER=yes`&
36557 .endd
36558 where <&'type'&> is ROUTER, TRANSPORT, AUTH, or LOOKUP. If the
36559 code is not to be included in the binary by default, comment this line out. You
36560 should also add any relevant comments about the driver or lookup type.
36561 .next
36562 Add to &_src/config.h.defaults_& the line:
36563 .code
36564 #define <type>_NEWDRIVER
36565 .endd
36566 .next
36567 Edit &_src/drtables.c_&, adding conditional code to pull in the private header
36568 and create a table entry as is done for all the other drivers and lookup types.
36569 .next
36570 Edit &_scripts/lookups-Makefile_& if this is a new lookup; there is a for-loop
36571 near the bottom, ranging the &`name_mod`& variable over a list of all lookups.
36572 Add your &`NEWDRIVER`& to that list.
36573 As long as the dynamic module would be named &_newdriver.so_&, you can use the
36574 simple form that most lookups have.
36575 .next
36576 Edit &_Makefile_& in the appropriate sub-directory (&_src/routers_&,
36577 &_src/transports_&, &_src/auths_&, or &_src/lookups_&); add a line for the new
36578 driver or lookup type and add it to the definition of OBJ.
36579 .next
36580 Create &_newdriver.h_& and &_newdriver.c_& in the appropriate sub-directory of
36581 &_src_&.
36582 .next
36583 Edit &_scripts/MakeLinks_& and add commands to link the &_.h_& and &_.c_& files
36584 as for other drivers and lookups.
36585 .endlist
36586
36587 Then all you need to do is write the code! A good way to start is to make a
36588 proforma by copying an existing module of the same type, globally changing all
36589 occurrences of the name, and cutting out most of the code. Note that any
36590 options you create must be listed in alphabetical order, because the tables are
36591 searched using a binary chop procedure.
36592
36593 There is a &_README_& file in each of the sub-directories of &_src_& describing
36594 the interface that is expected.
36595
36596
36597
36598
36599 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36600 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36601
36602 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36603 . These lines are processing instructions for the Simple DocBook Processor that
36604 . Philip Hazel has developed as a less cumbersome way of making PostScript and
36605 . PDFs than using xmlto and fop. They will be ignored by all other XML
36606 . processors.
36607 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36608
36609 .literal xml
36610 <?sdop
36611 format="newpage"
36612 foot_right_recto="&chaptertitle;"
36613 foot_right_verso="&chaptertitle;"
36614 ?>
36615 .literal off
36616
36617 .makeindex "Options index" "option"
36618 .makeindex "Variables index" "variable"
36619 .makeindex "Concept index" "concept"
36620
36621
36622 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36623 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////